0% found this document useful (0 votes)
489 views

0100CT1501 PDF

Uploaded by

MAI_Quality
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
0% found this document useful (0 votes)
489 views

0100CT1501 PDF

Uploaded by

MAI_Quality
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
You are on page 1/ 1188

2015 $22

Digest 177

digestplus-us.schneider-electric.com
Schneider Electric brands that
deliver the solutions you demand.
Square D power solutions – ready for the future.
Square D by Schneider Electric brand NEMA power and control solutions have been trusted over 100 years for
TM TM

performance, reliability, and energy-saving design. From residential load centers and metering products to commercial
panelboards, energy conserving transformers, and safety switches, Square D brand products provide you with quality
solutions for distributing and monitoring electrical power. It’s more than an electrical system. It’s the backbone of
today’s energy-demanding homes and businesses.

Taking lighting technology to a new level.


Juno by Schneider Electric is a leading manufacturer of energy-efficient commercial and residential lighting
TM

solutions and advanced system controls. Since 1976, we have been serving customers throughout North America,
including electrical distributors, lighting showrooms, contractors, architects, engineers, lighting designers, and
commercial establishments, offering them high-quality, innovative products, designed and engineered in the
United States. The Juno Lighting Group product family includes over 50,000 items for commercial and residential
construction, and includes a rapidly expanding line of eco-friendly LED fixtures for outdoor, recessed, track,
decorative, and under-cabinet applications.

Delivering the best image quality in video security.


Pelco by Schneider Electric is a world leader in the design, development, and manufacture of video and security
TM

systems ideal for any industry. From megapixel cameras to video management and recording to display, Pelco
solutions deliver the best image quality in video security.
> pelco.com

Committed to data center critical power and cooling.


APC by Schneider Electric is a global leader in critical power and cooling, providing industry-leading hardware,
TM

TM software, and services designed to ensure availability and higher energy efficiency across the residential, business
network, data center, and manufacturing environments. The position of APC on the cutting edge of data center
thought leadership for over two decades has changed the way the world designs, installs, operates, and maintains
data centers. APC has unparalleled commitment to innovation and the world’s leading R&D investment (more than
$90 million annually) dedicated to critical power and cooling issues.

Telemecanique Sensors Simply easy .


TM

Founded over 90 years ago, Telemecanique Sensors is an independent brand of Schneider Electric, specializing
in sensors and sensor-related technology.
Telemecanique Sensors is a global player, present in more than 20 countries, with products distributed worldwide
through a broad network of partners.
As a global leader in the sensors business, we help our customers select the right technology to get the best
performance and reliability from their machines.
Focused on three core values – Simplicity, Proximity, and Expertise – we have become experts in factory automation
sensors as well as specialists in demanding applications, making our customers’ lives “simply easy!”

© 2015 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. Schneider Electric, Square D, Juno, Pelco, and APC are trademarks owned by Schneider Electric Industries SAS or its affiliated companies. All other trademarks are
the property of their respective owners. • www.schneider-electric.com • 998-19128217_GMA-US
How to Use Digest 177 Table of Contents
Product Section Listing
Welcome to the Schneider Electric Digest! Over a thousand pages of technical product
information to help you specify and select Schneider Electric products. 1 Load Centers
A key element of the Digest 177 is its color-coded Table of Contents, shown at the right, and
matching product section tabs throughout the Digest. This colorful approach aids navigation
and helps you quickly find the major product categories.
2 Metering Equipment
A detailed Table of Contents is provided at the beginning of each product section and two
indexes are available in the back of the book: an alphabetical listing and an alphanumeric 3 Safety Switches
listing. To ensure you have the latest pricing information, list prices are now available online
only. This meets our customer and market driven demand to merge technical information with
functionality. 4 Power Monitoring and Control
Finally, the Supplemental and Obsolescence Digest 177 contains additional product
information for our international product offer, our legacy products in the obsolescence
process, and more.
5 Advanced Products

DigestPLUS
6 Surge Protective Devices

DigestPLUS provides one location to access the technical product information you need to 7 Miniature and Molded Case
Circuit Breakers
specify and select Schneider Electric products, right at your fingers. With links to over 22,000
orderable parts and over 17,000 pages of the most up-to-date product data, including: the
Digest, Supplemental and Obsolescence Digest, related product catalogs, CAD drawings, 8 Operator Mechanisms and
Disconnect Switches
circuit breaker time-current characteristic curves, white papers, product cross reference, and
locator services tools. DigestPLUS is powerful, yet simple.
DigestPLUS offers you the option to install a mobile app (iOS or Android), which ensures you
9 Panelboards
have access to the latest Schneider Electric technical and product selection information.

www.digestplus-us.schneider-electric.com
10 Power Solutions: Integrated

11 Switchboards and Switchgear


Other Exciting Tools
PROficient 12 Busway
For Electrical Contractors

PROficient: is a Suite of Free Digital Tools, designed for electrical contractors, by electrical
13 Wire Management
contractors, to help increase efficiency in everything you do.
• Easy to use, on your desktop, smartphone, and tablet 14 Transformers
• Faster, more accurate


Quick response to change
Project history visible and accessible
15 Medical Products
• One log-in, one suite of tools
• Your 24/7 pathway to generating more business 16 NEMA Contactors and Starters
www.schneider-electric.us/proficient
17 Motor Control Centers
LayoutFAST: a Revit MEP Plugin that's going to help you select, configure and insert the
most updated Schneider Electric Product Models from the cloud into your design without
leaving your Revit Project. Depending on your project stage, build the most accurate Revit 18 IEC Contactors and Starters
family simply by answering a few questions.
Turn minutes of design work into seconds.
19 Push Buttons and
Operator Interface
Customer Care Center 20 Electronic Sensors and
Machine Cabling
Have questions?
Need technical support or onsite service? 21 Limit Switches
1-888-778-2733

Customer Care App


22 Pressure, Vacuum,
and Float Switches
Support is right at your fingertips:
23 Relays and Timers
• Check pricing and availability
• Look up Frequently Asked Questions
• Access documents 24 Terminal Blocks
• Email or call our Customer Care Center
• Check the status of an order 25 Machine Safeguarding Products
• . . . and more

26 AC Drives and Soft Starts


www.schneider-electric.us/en/support/

Access to all our Support, Training and Tools, including:


27 Automation Products

Product Cross Reference: Enter an obsolete or competitive part number to receive the
Schneider Electric equivalent.
28 Enclosures
Frequently Asked Questions: Access our Knowledge Base for answers to thousands of
our most frequently asked questions, updated daily. https://www.schneider-electric.us/en/faqs 29 Uninterruptible Power Supplies
Calculators and Configurators: Simplify your product selection.
Alphabetical Listing
Alpha-Numeric Listing
New and Enhanced Products in Digest 177

schneider-electric.us

Section 1 Load Centers Section 16 NEMA and Definite Purpose


QO Plug-On Neutral Load Centers with Qwik-Grip ................. 1-12 Contactors & Starters
QO and HOM Plug-On Neutral Load Centers with Qwik-Grip.. 1-16 TeSys N Non-Reversing Contactors ....................................... 16-14
HOM Plug-On Neutral Load Centers with Qwik-Grip ............... 1-23 TeSys N Reversing Contactors............................................... 16-15
TeSys N Non-Reversing Starters ............................................ 16-16
Section 4 Power Monitoring and Control TeSys N Reversing Starters.................................................... 16-17
PowerLogic ION7400 Utility Feeder Meter .............................. 4-10 LTMR Controller.................................................................... 16-102
PowerLogic PM8000 Power and Energy Meters...................... 4-11 Components ............................................................16-104, 16-105
Series 5000 Power Meters ...................................................... 4-13 Adapted Bimetallic Overload Relay Mounting Bracket Adapter
PowerLogic PM3000 Power and Energy Meters..................... 4-15 (NEMA Sizes 00–1) .............................................................. 16-107
iEM3000 Energy Meters .......................................................... 4-16 TeSys T Motor Management System (NEMA Sizes 1–6) ....... 16-32
PowerLogic EM4200 Enercept Meter....................................... 4-19 TeSys T Motor Management System ................................... 16-101
Com’X Data Loggers and Energy Servers ............................... 4-25 Adapted Bimetallic Overload Relay Mounting Adapter......... 16-107
VAMP V321 Arc Flash Mitigation System................................. 4-35
VAMP V321 I/O Units .............................................................. 4-35 Section 19 Push Buttons and Operator Interface
AccuSine PCS+ Active Harmonic Filter (AHF) ......................... 4-42 XB6E Flush, Spring Return Push Buttons ................................ 9-21
AccuSine PFV+ Active Harmonic Filter (AHF) ......................... 4-43 XB6E Pilot Lights .................................................................... 19-21
VarSet Low Voltage Capacitor Banks....................................... 4-46 XB6E Illuminated Push Buttons, Spring Return...................... 19-22
XB6E Illuminated Push Buttons, Latching .............................. 19-22
Section 5 Advanced Products XB6E Selector Switches......................................................... 19-23
EVlink DC Quick Charging ......................................................... 5-8 XB6E Accessories ................................................................. 19-23
Wiser Air ................................................................................... 5-10 XB5R Plastic and XB4R Metal Wireless, Batteryless Push
Buttons ................................................................................... 19-63
Section 6 Surge Protective Devices (SPDs) XB5R and XB4R Accessories. ............................................... 19-64
EMA Series SPDs ...................................................................... 6-2 ZBRN1 and ZBRN2 Access Points ........................................ 19-65
EBA Series SPDs ....................................................................... 6-4 XB7 Push Buttons .................................................................. 19-68
SDSA1175 and SDSA 3-Phase Surge Protective Devices ........ 6-8 XB7 Illuminated Push Buttons with Projecting Push .............. 19-69
XB7 Pilot Lights ...................................................................... 19-69
XB7 Selector Switches and Key Switches.............................. 19-70
Section 7 Miniature and Molded Case Circuit Breakers
XB7 Mushroom Head Push Buttons ....................................... 19-70
Multi 9 C60BP and C60BPR Miniature Circuit Breakers............. 7-23
XB7 Legend Holders and Legends ........................................ 19-71
Multi 9 C60SP Miniature Circuit Breakers ................................. 7-24 XB7 Accessories .................................................................... 19-71
Multi 9 C60H-DC Miniature Circuit Breakers for DC Circuits ..... 7-25 Point of Purchase—PoP Products........................................ 19-114
Multi 9 GFP Ground Fault Protectors ....................................... 7-26 XVU 60 mm Diameter Tower Lights Description................... 19-120
C60BP (UL489) Comb Busbars ............................................... 7-27 XVU Illuminated LED Units: IP 65 ........................................ 19-121
PowerPact B-Frame Circuit Breakers ..................................... 7-31 XVU Audible Units: IP 54...................................................... 19-121
500 Vdc Circuit Breakers.......................................................... 7-50 XVU Body Units: IP 65 ......................................................... 19-121
XVU Accessories.................................................................. 19-121
Section 8 Operating Mechanisms and Disconnect XVGU Multi-color USB Tower Lights .................................... 19-122
Switches Harmony eXLhoist Operator Control Stations. ..................... 19-125
Disconnect Switches, 16–25 A................................................... 8-9
Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches ..................................... 8-27 Section 23 Relays and Timers
Zelio™ RXG Interface Relays .................................................. 23-4
Section 9 Panelboards Zelio™ RUM Plug-In Relays .................................................. 23-11
Fingersafe IP2X Barriers for NQ Panelboards ......................... 9-20 Square D™ Universal Relays ................................................ 23-14
I-Line Combo Panelboard ........................................................ 9-35 Zelio™ SSL Relays ................................................................ 23-33
Zelio™ SSM Relays ............................................................... 23-34
Zelio™ SSP Relays ................................................................ 23-37
Section 11 Switchboards and Switchgear
Zelio™ RTC48 Temperature Controllers ................................ 23-44
Power-Zone™ 4 Arc Resistant Switchgear with ArcBlok
Technology ............................................................................. 11-10
Section 25 Machine Safety Products
Safety Chain Solutions and Functions...................................... 25-3
Section 12 Busway
H- , J-, and L-Frame Plug-In Units with Electronic Trip and
Communication ...................................................................... 12-15 Section 26 AC Drives and Soft Starters
Altivar™ Process 630 ............................................................. 26-21
Section 14 Transformers
Energy Efficient Three Phase................................................... 14-4 Section 27 Automation Products
Medium Voltage Distribution Transformers ............................ 14-21 Magelis GTU Universal Panels................................................. 27-9
Dry Type Medium Voltage ...................................................... 14-22 Magelis Simple Box PC .......................................................... 27-12
NEW 1,201–15,000 Vac Three-Phase Indoor Transformers .. 14-22 Magelis Rack PC .................................................................... 27-12
1,201–15,000 Vac Single-Phase Indoor Transformers............14-23 Magelis iDisplay Industrial Multi-Touch Monitor...................... 27-13
Enclosures.............................................................................. 14-23
Section 29 Uninterruptible Power Supplies
Section 15 Medical Products
IG2000CBM.............................................................................. 15-3

i-1 © 2017 Schneider Electric


All Rights Reserved
10/30/2017
Table of Contents

Section 1
Load Centers

LOAD CENTERS
EZ Selector - Selection Assistance 1-2

QO™ Load Centers 1-3

Indoor, 1Ø, Main Lugs 1-3


Indoor, 1Ø, Main Circuit Breaker 1-4
Indoor, 1Ø, Main Lugs and Main Breaker 1-5
Rainproof, 1Ø, Main Lugs and Main Circuit Breaker 1-6
3Ø, Main Lugs and Main Circuit Breaker 1-7
1Ø, Backup Power Solutions 1-8
1Ø, Special Applications 1-9

1
QO Minia ture Circuit Bre a ke rs
QO™ Miniature Circuit Breakers 1-10

QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers 1-10


Accessories 1-14
QO™ and Homeline™ Load Centers and Circuit Breakers 1-16
1Ø, Value Packs and Riser Panels 1-16
QO and Homeline Plug-On Neutral Load Centers with Qwik-Grip 1-16
1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed 1-16
QO Riser Panels 1-17
Panelboard-style Covers for Riser Panels 1-17
QO Loa d Ce nte rs
Load Center Accessories 1-17

QO and Homeline Load Center Accessories 1-17


QO Load Center Accessories 1-17
QO and HOM Qwik-Grip Load Center Accessories 1-18
Homeline Load Center Accessories 1-18
Surge Protective Devices 1-19
Homeline™ Load Centers 1-19

Indoor, 1Ø, Main Lugs and Main Circuit Breaker 1-19


Rainproof, 1Ø, Main Lugs and Main Circuit Breakers 1-20
1Ø, Field-Installed Mains Kits 1-20
Homeline™ Circuit Breakers 1-21
Home line Circuit Bre a ke rs
QO™ and Homeline™ Load Centers 1-24

Indoor, Dimensions and Knockouts 1-24


Rainproof, Dimensions, Knockouts and Bolt-on Hubs 1-26
Combination Service Entrance Devices 1-26

Rainproof, Meter Mains 1-26


Rainproof, All-In-Ones, 100 to 225 A Maximum 1-30
Rainproof, Meter Mains and All-In-Ones, 300–400 A 1-31
Circuit Breakers for CSEDs 1-32
Accessories and Hubs for CSEDs 1-33
Dimensions 1-34
RC/QC Solar Ready CSEDs 1-35
QO C ircuit Bre a ke rs
Homeline Solar Ready PoN CSEDs 1-36

Rainproof, Meter Mains and All-In-Ones, 125 to 225 A Maximum 1-36


Enclosed Devices 1-37

Servicepak™ Power Outlet Panels 1-39

© 2017 Schneider Electric


All Rights Reserved 1-1

11/10/2017
EZ Selector - Selection Assistance Load Center EZ Selector - Selection
Assistance
1

schneider-electric.us

QO™ and Homeline™ Load Center EZ Selector - Selection


Assistance
EZ Selector
Steps to select a load center.
LOAD CENTERS

1. Select product type:


• Homeline™ 1 inch format (HOM)
• QO™ 3/4 inch format with plug-on neutral (QO) (P)
• QO™ 3/4 inch format (QO)
2. Select enclosure type: indoor or outdoor (RB = rainproof)
3. Select single phase (1) or three phase (3)
4. Select type of main:
QO Load Center • Main circuit Breaker (M)
• Main lugs (L)
• Generator panel (GP)
5. Select main ampacity rating
6. Select pole spaces and max. number of 1-pole, single-phase circuits
7. Select cover style:
• Surface (box mounted on surface)
• Surface (box mounted on surface, hinged cover included)
• Flush (box recessed, cover is flush to wall)
8. Value pack (VP)
9. Select ground bar option:
• Ground bar factory installed (T)
• Ground bar included, field installation (G)
10. Select special application:
• Riser panel with gutter
• Mfg housing, single phase 3-wire, convertible mains
• Manufactured housing, single phase, 3-wire
• Manufactured housing, single phase, 2-wire
QO™ and Homeline™ Load Centers — Catalog Number Construction

Additional Information
• Search “Load Centers” from our technical FAQs page: www.schneider-electric.us/en/
faqs/home/
• Refer to catalog 1100CT0501.

1-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Indoor, 1Ø, Main Lugs QO™ Load Centers
Class 736, 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us

1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed Main Lugs

LOAD CENTERS
QO120L125G QO816L100F or S
without cover

Table 1.1: Main Lugs (Accepts Only QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers)

1
Mains Max. 1P Max. Indoor Cover with Door Main Wire Size
Space- Tandem Load Center (Order Separately) AWG/kcmil Equipment Ground Bar Box No.
Rat- Circuits
s Circuit Box and Interior Kit (Order Separately) [2]
ing [1] Flush Surface Al Cu
Breakers
Fixed Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs—10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating [3]
 30 A  2  2  0 QO2L30S [4] [5] Cover Included—Without Door 12–10 14–10 PK3GTA1 1
 70 A  2  4  2 QO24L70F/S [6] [7] Cover Included—Without Door 12–3 14–4 PK4GTA 2
 6 12  6 QO612L100F/S [6] [8] Cover Included—Without Door PK7GTA 4
 6 12  6 QO612L100DF/S [6] [8] Cover Included—With Door PK7GTA 4
 8 16  8 QO816L100F/S [6] [8] Cover Included—Without Door
100 A PK7GTA 4
 8 16  8 QO816L100DF/S [6] [8] Cover Included—With Door 8–1
 6 12  6 QO612L100DFCU/SCU [6] [8] [9] Cover Included—With Door PK7GTA 4
 8 16  8 QO816L100DFCU/SCU [6] [8] [9] Cover Included—With Door PK7GTA 4
125 A 4 8  4 QO148L125GF/S [6] [10] Cover Included—Without Door 12–2/0 14–2/0 PK7GTA [11] 21
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs—65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker—Cu Bus [3] [12]
12 12  0 QO112L125G QOC16UF QOC16US PK9GTA [11] 6
12 24 12 QO11224L125G QOC16UF QOC16US PK15GTA [11] 6
6–2/0
16 16  0 QO116L125G QOC24UF QOC24US PK12GTA [11] 7
16 24  8 QO11624L125G QOC24UF QOC24US PK15GTA [11] 7
125 A
20 20  0 QO120L125G QOC20U100F QOC20U100S 6–2/0 6–1 PK15GTA [11] 6
I 20 24  4 QO12024L125G QOC20U100F QOC20U100S 6–2/0 6–1 PK15GTA [11] 6
N
D 24 24  0 QO124L125G QOC24UF QOC24US PK15GTA [11] 7
6–2/0
O 32 32  0 QO132L125G QOC32UF Use Flush PK23GTA, LK100AN [11] 8
O Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs—65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating —Convertible To Main Circuit Breaker—Cu Bus [3] [12]
R
20 30 10 QO12030L150G QOC30UF QOC30US PK23GTA, LK100AN [11] 9
150 A 24 24  0 QO124L150G QOC30UF QOC30US 6–250 PK15GTA [11] 9
30 30  0 QO130L150G QOC30UF QOC30US PK23GTA, LK100AN [11] 9
12 12  0 QO112L200G QOC30UF QOC30US PK15GTA [11] 9
24 36 12 QO12436L200TFT [13] QOC40UF QOC40US PK23GTA, LK100AN [11] 10
30 30  0 QO130L200G QOC30UF QOC30US PK23GTA, LK100AN [11] 9
200 A 30 40 10 QO13040L200G QOC30UF QOC30US 6–250 PK23GTA, LK100AN [11] 9
40 40  0 QO140L200G QOC40UF QOC40US PK23GTA, LK100AN [11] 10
40 60 20 QO14060L200G QOC40UF QOC40US (2) PK15GTA [11] 10
42 52 10 QO14252L200G QOC42UF QOC42US (2) PK15GTA [11] 11
225 A 42 42  0 QO142L225G QOC42UF QOC42US 6–300 PK23GTA, LK100AN [11] 11
Fixed Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs—65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating [3] [12]
QONQ30LS400 (Int) [14]
30 30  0 NC50NQVF NC50NQVS PK27GTA [15] 15
MH50 (box) [16] (1) 1/0–750
400 A or (2) 1/0–300 or
QONQ42LS400 (Int) [14] PK15GTA6
42 42  0 NC50NQVF NC50NQVS 15
MH50 (box) [16]
Above listings through 200 A mains rating meet Federal Specification W-P-115C as Type 1, Class 2.

[1] Maximum single pole branch circuits utilizing QO and/or QOT circuit breakers.
[2] See Table 1.57 Knockout Information, page 1-24
[3] UL short circuit current rating depends on lowest interrupting rating of circuit breaker installed.
[4] Will not accept QO-EPD or Qwik-Gard™ QO-GFI or QO-AFI circuit breakers.
[5] Mains rated 25 A when Al wire is used.
[6] Order F for flush device or S for surface device.
[7] Use 10 AWG maximum size wire for GFI and AFI circuit breakers.
[8] 70 A Max. branch circuit breaker and 100 A max. back fed main circuit breaker.
[9] CU indicates copper bus.
[10] Copper bus.
[11] Factory-included.
[12] UL Listed 5000 A short circuit current rating for corner grounded Delta systems. Use QO-H circuit breakers only.
[13] Supplied with feed-thru lugs.
[14] Interior only, order box separately.
[15] PK27GTA includes a 6–2/0 AWG Al/Cu lug.
[16] PE1A Discount Schedule.
1-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ Load Centers Indoor, 1Ø, Main Circuit Breaker
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
1

schneider-electric.us

1Ø, Field-Installed Main Circuit Breaker Kits


Table 1.2: QOM1 Frame Size—Use with Convertible Main Load Centers Only
Main Circuit Breaker Convertible 22 k AIR [18] Lug Wire Size [19] AWG/
Rating [17] Load Center Mains Rating Main Circuit Breaker kcmil
50 A 100–125 QOM50VH
LOAD CENTERS

60 A 100–125 QOM60VH
70 A 100–125 QOM70VH
80 A 100–125 QOM80VH
12–2/0 Al or Cu
90 A 100–125 QOM90VH
QOM1 Frame Size 100 A 100–125 QOM100VH
50–125 Amperes
110 A 125 QOM110VH
125 A 125 QOM125VH

Table 1.3: QOM2 Frame Size—Use with Convertible Main Load Centers Only
Convertible 22 k AIR [18]
Main Circuit Breaker Lug Wire Size [19]
Load Center Mains
Rating [17] Rating Main Circuit Breaker [20] AWG/kcmil
100 A 150–225 QOM2100VH
125 A 150–225 QOM2125VH
150 A 150–225 QOM2150VH
4–300 Al or Cu
175 A 200–225 QOM2175VH
200 A 200–225 QOM2200VH
QOM2 Frame Size 225 A 225 QOM2225VH
100–225 Amperes

1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed Main Circuit Breaker


Table 1.4: Main Circuit Breaker (Accepts Only QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers.)
Max. Indoor Cover with Door Equipment
Max. Main Box No.
Mains Single (Order Separately) Ground Bar See
Spaces Pole Tandem Load Center Wire Size Kit
Rating Circuit Box and Interior AWG/kcmil (Order 1–17,
Circuits Flush Surface page 1-24
[21] Breakers Al or Cu Separately)
Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Circuit Breaker, 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating,
Convertible to Main Lugs (see below) or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker. (See1-5, page 1-3), [18]
QOM1 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size—Copper Bus
12 12  0 QO112M100 QOC12UF QOC12US PK9GTA  5
16 16  0 QO116M100 QOC20U100F QOC20U100S 6–1 PK12GTA  6
100 A 20 20  0 QO120M100 QOC20U100F QOC20U100S PK15GTA  6
24 24  0 QO124M100 QOC24UF QOC24US PK15GTA  7
6–2/0
32 32 0 QO132M100 QOC32UF Use Flush PK18GTA 8
24 24  0 QO124M125 QOC24UF QOC24US PK15GTA  7
125 A 32 32 0 QO132M125 QOC32UF Use Flush 6–2/0 PK18GTA 8
Convertible Mains —Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker, 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
Convertible to Main Lugs (see below) or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See page 1–5, page 1-3), [18]
QOM2 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size—Copper Bus
20 30 10 QO12030M150 QOC30UF QOC30US PK18GTA  9
24 24  0 QO124M150 QOC30UF QOC30US PK15GTA  9
150 A 4–250
30 30  0 QO130M150 QOC30UF QOC30US PK18GTA  9
I
N 32 32  0 QO132M150 QOC40UF QOC40US PK18GTA 10
D 20 40 20 QO12040M200 QOC30UF QOC30US PK23GTA  9
O 24 24  0 QO124M200 QOC30UF QOC30US PK15GTA  9
O PK23GTA
R 24 36 12 QO12436M200TFT[22] QOC40UF QOC40US and 10
4–250 LK100AN[23]
200 A 30 30  0 QO130M200 QOC30UF QOC30US PK18GTA  9
30 40 10 QO13040M200 QOC30UF QOC30US PK23GTA  9
40 40  0 QO140M200 QOC40UF QOC40US PK23GTA 10
40 60 20 QO14060M200 QOC40UF QOC40US PK23GTA 10
42 42  0 QO142M200 QOC42UF QOC42US PK23GTA 11
42 52 10 QO14252M200 QOC42UF QOC42US PK23GTA 11
4–300
QO140M200 40 40  0 QO140M225 QOC42UF QOC42US PK23GTA 11
225 A
42 42  0 QO142M225 QOC42UF QOC42US PK23GTA 11
Fixed Mains—Factory-installed LAL Main Circuit Breaker, 42 kA Short Circuit Current Rating [24]
QONQ42MS300 (int)[25] (1) 4–500
300 A 42 42  0 NC62NQVF NC62NQVS PK27GTA [26] 16
MH62 (box)[27] or (2) 4–3/0
or
QONQ42MS400 (int)[25] (1) 4–500 PK15GTA6
400 A 42 42  0 NC62NQVF NC62NQVS 16
MH62 (box)[27] or (2) 4–250
Above listings through 200 A mains rating meet Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2.

[17] Do not exceed the load center mains rating.


[18] 22 k AIR main circuit breaker UL Listed for use ahead of QO, QOT and QO-PL 10 k AIR branch circuit breakers to permit their application on systems with up to 22 kA available fault current.
[19] Wire range listed for QOM circuit breaker kits is the wire range of that circuit breaker. To find out maximum wire size permitted in a particular load center per UL, see pages 1-5 through 1-11
under Main Wire Size.
[20] Add suffix 1021 for 120, 208 or 240 Vac shunt trip.
[21] Maximum single pole branch circuits utilizing QO and/or QOT circuit breakers.
[22] Supplied with feed-thru lugs.
[23] Factory included.
[24] UL short circuit current rating depends on lowest interrupting rating of circuit breakers installed. Also, UL Listed 5000 A short circuit current for corner grounded Delta systems. Use QO-H
circuit breakers only.
[25] Interior only, order box separately.
[26] PK27GTA includes a 6–2/0 Al/Cu lug.
[27] PE1A Discount Schedule.
1-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Indoor, 1Ø, Main Lugs and Main Breaker QO™ Load Centers
Class 736, 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us

1Ø, Field-Installed Main Lugs Kits


Table 1.5: Use with Convertible Main Load Centers Only
Use on

LOAD CENTERS
Main Lugs Lug Wire Size [29]
Rating [28] Convertible Load Center Cat. No. AWG/kcmil
with Mains Rating Al or Cu
125 A 100–125 A QOL125 [30] 6–2/0
225 A 150–225 A QOL225 [30] 6–300

QOL125 QOL225

Indoor, 1Ø, Main Lugs and Main Breaker


QO Plug-on Neutral Load Centers and CAFI Breakers connect are engineered for a
quick Plug-on Neutral connection on every unit.

Table 1.6: QO Plug-on Neutral CAFI Load Center (accepts QO Circuit Breakers only)
Indoor Cover with Door Main Wire Equipment
Max. Max. (Order Separately) Size Ground Bar
Mains Load Center Box and Box No.
Spaces 1P Tandem AWG/kcmil Kit [31]
Rating Interior [32]

1
Circuits Breakers (Order
Flush Surface Al/Cu Separately)
Convertible Mains — Factory-Installed Main Lugs — 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating — Copper Bus
QOM1 Main Frame Size, Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker
125 A 24 24 0 QO124L125PG QOC24UF QOC24US 6–2/0 PK15GTA 7
Convertible Mains — Factory-Installed Main Lugs — 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating — Copper Bus
QOM2 Main Frame Size, Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker
200 A 30 30 0 QO130L200PG QOC30UF QOC30US 6–250 PK23GTA, 9
LK100AN
I 42 42 0 QO142L225PG QOC42UF QOC42US (2) PK15GTA 11
N 225 A 6–300 PK23GTA,
D 54 54 0 QO154L225PG QOC54UF — 12
LK100AN
O Convertible Mains — Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker — 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating — Copper Bus
O QOM1 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size, Convertible to Main Lugs or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker
R
100 A 24 24 0 QO124M100P QOC24UF QOC24US 6–2/0 PK15GTA 7
Convertible Mains — Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker — 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating — Copper Bus
QOM2 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size, Convertible to Main Lugs or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker
30 30 0 QO130M200P QOC30UF QOC30US PK18GTA 9
42 42 0 QO142M200P QOC42UF QOC42US PK23GTA 11
200 A 4–250
54 54 0 QO154M200P QOC54UF — PK23GTA 12
60 60 0 QO160M200PC [33] — — PK23GTA 24
Convertible Mains — Factory-Installed Main Lugs — 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating — Cu Bus
QOM1 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size, Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker — Equipment Ground Bar Included
125 A 24 24 0 QO124L125PGRB — — 6–2/0 PK15GTA 4R
Convertible Mains — Factory-Installed Main Lugs — 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating — Cu Bus
QOM2 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size, Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker — Equipment Ground Bar Included
QO130L200PGRB PK23GTA,
O 200 A 30 30 0 — — 6–250 6R
LK100AN
U 225 A 42 42 0 QO142L225PGRB — — 6–300 (2) PK15GTA 8R
QO154M200P T
D Convertible Mains — Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker — 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating — Copper Bus
O Convertible to Main Lugs (see below) or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See Indoor, 1Ø, Main Lugs, page 1-3),
O QOM1 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size
R 100 A 24 24 0 QO124M100PRB — — 6–2/0 PK15GTA 4R
Convertible Mains — Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker — 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating — Copper Bus
Convertible to Main Lugs (see below) or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See Indoor, 1Ø, Main Lugs, page 1-3),
QOM2 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size
150 A 30 30 0 QO130M150PRB — — PK18GTA 6R
30 30 0 QO130M200PRB — — 4–250 PK18GTA 6R
200 A
42 42 0 QO142M200PRB — — PK23GTA 8R

[28] Do not exceed the load center mains rating.


[29] Wire range listed for QOL lug kits is the wire range of that lug. To find out maximum wire size permitted in a particular load center per UL, see Tables in QO™ Load Centers, page 1-7 and
QO™ and Homeline™ Load Centers and Circuit Breakers, page 1-13 under main wire size.
[30] If main circuit breaker knockout has been removed from the load center’s trim, order appropriate filler plate from Table 1.51, page 1-20
[31] Any catalog number containing the suffix ‘G”, ground bar factory is included. In addition to LK100AN where listed.
[32] See Indoor Knockout Information and Enclosure Dimensions, page 1-24
[33] Flush cover without a door is included. Door kit available separately, order QOCDK60.
1-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ Load Centers Rainproof, 1Ø, Main Lugs and Main Circuit
Breaker
1

Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501 schneider-electric.us

1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed


Main Lugs and Main Circuit Breakers
Table 1.7: Main Lugs (Accepts Only QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers.)
LOAD CENTERS

Max. Main
Max. Wire Size Equipment
Mains Tandem Load Center Box No.
Rating Spaces Single Pole AWG/kcmil Ground Bar Kit
Circuit Box and Interior (Order Separately) [35]
Circuits [34]
Breakers Al Cu
Non-Metallic Enclosure
Fixed Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs—10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
 60 A  2  4  2 QO24L60NRNM 14–4 14–4 Factory-installed  1NM
Metallic Enclosure
Fixed Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs—10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
 40 A  2  2  0 QO2L40RB [36] 12–6 14–6 PK3GTA1  1R
 70 A  2  4  2 QO24L70RB [36] 12–3 14–4 PK4GTA  1R
 6 12  6 QO612L100RB[37] PK7GTA  2R
 6 12  6 QO612L100TRB[37] Factory-installed  2R
100 A  8 16  8 QO816L100RB [37] 8–1 PK7GTA  2R
 6 12  6 QO612L100RBCU[37] [38] PK7GTA  2R
R  8 16  8 QO816L100RBCU[37] [38] PK7GTA  2R
A 125 A 4 8 4 QO148L125GRB [38] 12–2/0 14–2/0 PK7GTA Factory-included 15R
I Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs—65 kA Short Circuit Current[39][40][41]
N QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker—Copper Bus
P
R 12 12  0 QO112L125GRB PK9GTA Factory-included 3R
O 12 24 12 QO11224L125GRB PK15GTA Factory-included 3R
O 125 A 6–2/0
F 16 24  8 QO11624L125GRB PK15GTA Factory-included 4R
24 24  0 QO124L125GRB PK15GTA Factory-included 4R
Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs—65 kA Short Circuit Current[39][40][41]
QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker—Copper Bus
150 A 30 30  0 QO130L150GRB 4–250 PK23GTA, LK100AN Factory-included 6R
12 12  0 QO112L200GRB PK9GTA Factory-included 5R
30 30  0 QO130L200GRB PK23GTA, LK100AN Factory-included 6R
30 40 10 QO13040L200GRB PK23GTA, LK100AN Factory-included 6R
200 A 4–250
40 40  0 QO140L200GRB PK23GTA, LK100AN Factory-included 7R
40 60 20 QO14060L200GRB (2) PK15GTA Factory-included 7R
42 52 10 QO14252L200GRB (2) PK15GTA Factory-included 8R
225 A 42 42  0 QO142L225GRB 4–300 PK23GTA, LK100AN Factory-included 8R

Table 1.8: Main Circuit Breaker (Accepts Only QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers.)
Max. Max. Main Equipment
Mains Tandem Load Center Wire Size Box No.
Rating Spaces Single Pole Ground Bar Kit
Circuit Box and Interior AWG/kcmil (Order Separately) [35]
Circuits [34]
Breakers Al or Cu
Convertible Mains —Factory-installed Main Circuit Breaker, 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
Convertible to Main Lugs (see 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed Main Circuit Breaker, page 1-4)
or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (see 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed Main Lugs, page 1-3)[41][42]
QOM1 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size—Copper Bus
12 12  0 QO112M100RB PK9GTA 3R
100 A 16 16  0 QO116M100RB 6–2/0 PK12GTA 4R
20 20  0 QO120M100RB PK15GTA 4R
125 A 24 24  0 QO124M125RB 6–2/0 PK15GTA 4R
Convertible Mains —Factory-installed Main Circuit Breaker, 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Convertible to Main Lugs (see 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed Main Circuit
Breaker, page 1-4) or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (see 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed Main Lugs, page 1-3) [41][42]
QOM2 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size—Copper Bus
R 20 30 10 QO12030M150RB PK18GTA 5R
A 150 A 4–250
I 30 30  0 QO130M150RB PK18GTA 6R
N 20 40 20 QO12040M200RB PK23GTA 5R
P 30 30  0 QO130M200RB PK18GTA 6R
R 30 40 10 QO13040M200GRB PK23GTA 6R
O
O 200 A 40 40  0 QO140M200RB 4–250 PK23GTA 7R
F 40 60 20 QO14060M200RB PK15GTA 7R
42 42 0 QO142M200RB PK23GTA 8R
42 52 10 QO14252M200RB PK15GTA 8R
225 A 42 42  0 QO142M225RB 4–300 PK23GTA 8R
Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Circuit Breaker, 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
Convertible to Main Lugs (see 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed Main Circuit Breaker, page 1-4) or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (see 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed
Main Lugs, page 1-3) [41][42]
QOM1 or QOM2 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size—Copper Bus
125 A 6 12  6 QO1612M125FTRB[43] 4–2/0 PK12GTA 3R
150 A 8 16  8 QO1816M150FTRB[43] 4–250 PK15GTA-L 6R
200 A 8 16  8 QO1816M200FTRB [43] 4–250 PK15GTA-L 6R
Above listings through 200 A mains rating meet Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2.

[34] Maximum single pole branch circuits utilizing QO and/or QOT circuit breakers.
[35] See Table 1.59 Enclosure Dimensions, page 1-26Indoor Knockout Information and Enclosure Dimensions, page 1-24
[36] Use 10 AWG maximum size wire for GFI and AFI circuit breakers.
[37] 70 A Max. branch circuit breaker and 70 A max. back fed main circuit breaker.
[38] Copper bus.
[39] UL short circuit current rating depends on lowest interrupting rating of circuit breaker installed.
[40] UL Listed 5000 A short circuit current rating for corner grounded Delta systems. Use QO-H circuit breakers only.
[41] Side hinge door device; allow 1-1/4 in. on left side for door to open.
[42] 22 k AIR main circuit breaker UL Listed for use ahead of QO, QOT, QO-GFI, QO-AFI, QO-EPD and QOPL 10 k AIR branch circuit breakers to permit their application on systems up to 22 kA
available fault current.
[43] QO1612M125FTRB provided with QOM1 frame main circuit breaker. QO1816M150FTRB and QO1816M200FTRB provided with QOM2 frame main circuit breaker.
1-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
3Ø, Main Lugs and Main Circuit Breaker QO™ Load Centers
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us

3Ø4W—208Y/120 Vac, 3Ø4W—240/120 Vac Delta and 3Ø3W—240


Vac Delta—UL Listed

LOAD CENTERS
Table 1.9: Main Lugs and Main Breakers (Accepts Only QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers)
Max. Indoor Cover with Door Main
Number Load Center Wire Size Equipment Box No.
Mains Box and Interior (Order Separately) Ground Bar Kit See
Rating of 1P QO AWG/kcmil Pages 1-17,
circuit (Order Separately)
Cat. No. Flush Surface Al Cu 1–18
breakers
Fixed Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs—Copper Bus—65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating [44]
Cover Included With Load Center (No
 60 A  3 QO403L60NF/S Door) — 10–6 PK4GTA 13
12 QO312L125G [45] QOC16UF QOC16US Factory-incl. [46] 6
125 A 20 QO320L125G [45] QOC24UF QOC24US 6–2/0 6–2/0 Factory-incl. [46]  7
24 QO324L125G [45] QOC24UF QOC24US Factory-incl. [46]  7
18 QO318L200G [45] QOC30UF QOC30US Factory-incl. [47]  9
I 200 A 6–250 6–250
N 30 QO330L200G [45] QOC30UF QOC30US Factory-incl. [47]  9
D 225 A 42 QO342L225G [45] QOC42UF QOC42US 6–300 6–300 Factory-incl. [47] 11

1
O
O Convertible Mains—Factory-installed QDL Main Circuit Breaker—Copper Bus—25 kA Short Circuit Current Rating [48]
R 100 A 27 QO327M100 [49] QOC30UF QOC30US 4–2/0 4–2/0 PK15GTA  9
125 A 30 QO330MQ125[50] [45] QOC342MQF QOC342MQS 4–300 4–300 PK18GTA 12
30 QO330MQ150[50] [45] QOC342MQF QOC342MQS PK18GTA 12
150 A 4–300 4–300
42 QO342MQ150[50] [45] QOC342MQF QOC342MQS PK23GTA 12
30 QO330MQ200[50] [45] QOC342MQF QOC342MQS PK18GTA 12
200 A 4–300 4–300
42 QO342MQ200[50] [45] QOC342MQF QOC342MQS PK23GTA 12
225 A 42 QO342MQ225[50] [45] QOC342MQF QOC342MQS 4–300 4–300 PK23GTA 12
Fixed Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs—Copper Bus—65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating [44] [51]
60 A 3 QO403L60NRB — 10–6 PK4GTA 10R
12 QO312L125GRB Factory Incl. [46]  3R
125 A 6–2/0 6–2/0
20 QO320L125GRB Factory Incl. [46]  4R
R Cover Included
18 QO318L200GRB Factory Incl. [47]  6R
A 200 A 6–250 6–250
I 30 QO330L200GRB Factory Incl. [47]  6R
N 225 A 42 QO342L225GRB 6–300 6–300 Factory Incl. [47]  8R
P
R Convertible Mains—Factory-installed QDL Main Circuit Breaker—Copper Bus—25 kA Short Circuit Current Rating [48] [51]
O 100 A 27 QO327M100RB [49] 4–2/0 4–2/0 PK15GTA  6R
O 125 A 30 QO330MQ125RB [50] 4–300 4–300 PK18GTA 14R
F
150 A 30 QO330MQ150RB [50] 4–300 4–300 PK18GTA 14R
Cover Included
30 QO330MQ200RB[50] PK18GTA 14R
200 A 4–300 4–300
42 QO342MQ200RB [50] PK23GTA 14R
225 A 42 QO342MQ225RB [50] 4–300 4–300 PK23GTA 14R
Above listings through 200 A mains rating meet Federal Specification W-P-115C as Type 1, Class 2.

Table 1.10: 3Ø, Main Circuit Breakers


Amperage 25 k AIR 65 k AIR 100 k AIR [52]
Field-installed alternate main circuit breakers for QO 3Ø main circuit breaker load centers rated 70–225 A.
Do not exceed the load center main rating.
70 A QDL32070 QGL32070 QJL32070
80 A QDL32080 QGL32080 QJL32080
 90 A QDL32090 QGL32090 QJL32090
100 A QDL32100 QGL32100 QJL32100
110 A QDL32110 QGL32110 QJL32110
125 A QDL32125 QGL32125 QJL32125
150 A QDL32150 QGL32150 QJL32150
175 A QDL32175 QGL32175 QJL32175
200 A QDL32200 QGL32200 QJL32200
225 A QDL32225 QGL32225 QJL32225

Table 1.11: 3Ø, Main Lugs Kits


Main Lugs Lug Wire Size
Amperage Rating Cat. No. AWG/kcmil
Field-installed main lugs for convertible 3Ø main circuit breaker load centers
125 A QOL3125 6–2/0 Cu/Al
QO342MQ200 QO312L125G 225 A QOL3225 6–300 Cu/Al

[44] UL short circuit current rating depends on lowest interrupting rating of circuit breaker installed.
[45] For Certification to IEC 60439-1 contact the local Square D sales office; otherwise panels are NOT CE marked. (For use on 415Y/240 Vac 3-phase 4-wire, 3,000 Short Circuit Current Rating
when QOXD...branch circuit breakers are used and 10,000 Short Circuit Current Rating when QO...VS branch circuit breakers are used).
[46] PK15GTA.
[47] PK23GTA and LK100AN.
[48] 25 kA short circuit current rating SSCR maximum with Square D Type QDL main circuit breaker, or 22 kA SCCR maximum with back-fed Type QO-VH main circuit breaker, feeding QO 10 k
AIR branch circuit breakers.
[49] Includes factory-installed back fed QO3100VH main circuit breaker.
[50] 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating maximum with field-installed Square D type QGL 65 k AIR minimum main circuit breaker feeding QO and Q1 10 k AIR minimum branch circuit breakers.
[51] Side hinge door device allow 1-1/4 in. on left side for door to open.
[52] When these 3P circuit breakers are used as the main circuit breaker of a 3Ø load center, the maximum AIR rating is 65 kA at 240 Vac and 100 kA at 208 Vac.

1-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ Load Centers 1Ø, Backup Power Solutions
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
1

schneider-electric.us

1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed Backup Power Solutions


Table 1.12: Backup Power Solutions (Accept Only QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers.)
Main
Mains Max. Single Max. Equipment Grounding Wire Size
Rating Spac- Load Center Bar Kit Box No.
Pole Tandem Circuit
LOAD CENTERS

es Box, Interior and Cover AWG/kcmil [54]


(A) Circuits [53] Breakers (Order Separately)
Al Cu
I Generator Panels—Manual Transfer for Sub-Feed Applications NEMA 1 (Indoor)
N Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breakers with Mechanical Interlock—10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
D
O 30 4 8 4 QO48M30DSGP 14–8 14–8 4
O PK7GTA
R 60 4 8 4 QO48M60DSGP 8–2 8–2 4
R Generator Panels—Manual Transfer with Generator Power Inlet Plug for Sub-Feed Applications NEMA 3R (Outdoor)
A Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breakers with Mechanical Interlock—10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
I
N 4 8 4 QO1DM10020TRBR — 17R
P 4 8 4 QO1DM10030TRBR — 17R
R 100 Factory-Installed 8–2
O
O 4 8 4 QO1DM10050TRBR — 17R
F
Generator Panel—Automatic Transfer Switch (Contact your local Square D Field Sales office for more information.) [55]
I Factory- or Field-Installed Main Circuit Breaker—22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
N 150 38 42 42 QO13842MX150 PK23GTA 4–250 4–250 12
D QO13842MX200
O 200 38 42 42 PK23GTA 4–250 4–250 12
O 38 42 42 QO13842MX225 4–250 4–250 12
225 PK23GTA
R 38 42 42 QO13842UX225 [56] 4–250 4–250 12
QOC38MXUF (Cover) —
150 14 28 28 QO11428MX150FTRB [57] [58] PK23GTA 4–250 4–250 7R
3 14 28 28 QO11428MX200FTRB [57] [58] PK23GTA 4–250 4–250 7R
R 200
14 28 28 QO11428UX200FTRB [56] [57] [58] PK23GTA 4–250 4–250 7R

Table 1.13: QO Load Center Manual Power Transfer Accessories


Description Cat. No. Schedule
For interlocking the handles of two 2P or one 2P and one 1P QO and Q1 circuit breakers mounted
side-by-side so that only one circuit breaker can be “ON’’ at a time. QO2DTI DE2E
QO2DTI mechanical interlock attachment with retaining kits for securing two adjacent back-fed circuit
breakers in dual power supply applications. Can be used with (2) 2P or (1) 2P and (1) 1P QO circuit QO2DTIM DE2E
breakers in QO816L100 load centers.
Secures two 2P circuit breakers to right side of interior when used as back-fed mains, a QO2DTI Kit
Manual Transfer Equipment included for back-up power supply applications. For 1Ø 100–125 ampere convertible main load PK4DTIM4LA DE3A
Kit centers. Series S01 and S02.
Secures two 2P circuit breakers to right side of interior when used as back-fed mains, a QO2DTI Kit
included for back-up power supply applications. For 1Ø 150–225 ampere convertible main load PK4DTIM4HA DE3A
centers. Series S01 and S02.
Secures two 2P circuit breakers to left side of interior when used as back-fed mains, a QO2DTI Kit
included for back-up power supply applications. For 1Ø 100–125 ampere convertible main load PK4DTIM4LAL DE3A
centers. Series S01 and S02.
For use on “G” and “S” Series NEMA 1 and “G”, “S1” and “S2” Series NEMA 3R load centers.
Interlocks a QOM1 2P main circuit breaker of a load center (100–125 A) with a QO 2P (15–125 A) QOCRBGK1C DE3A
branch circuit breaker. Includes a retaining kit.
Generator Circuit Breaker For use on “G” and “S” Series NEMA 1 and “G” and “S1” Series NEMA 3R load centers. Interlocks a
Interlock Kit QOM2 2P main circuit breaker of a load center (150–225 A) with a QO 2P (15–125 A) branch circuit QOCGK2C DE3A
breaker. Includes a retaining kit.
For use on “S2” Series NEMA 3R load centers. Interlocks a QOM2 2P main circuit breaker of a load
center (150–225 A) with a QO 2P (15–125 A) branch circuit breaker. Includes a retaining kit. QORBGK2C DE3A

[53] Maximum single pole branch circuits utilizing QO and/or QOT circuit breakers.
[54] See Indoor Knockout Information and Enclosure Dimensions, page 1-24 orRainproof, Dimensions, Knockouts and Bolt-on Hubs, page 1-26
[55] One main circuit breaker is included with panel. NEMA 1 indoor device requires cover ordered separately. Alternate source main circuit breaker (QO 125 A max.) ordered separately.
Automatic Transfer Switch and Generator for secondary power source are ordered through a Kohler authorized dealer or contractor.
[56] Universal mains – No factory-installed main circuit breaker or main lugs. QOM2 frame size, field-install 22 k AIR. Main circuit breaker or main lugs (see Table 1.10 3Ø, Main Circuit Breakers,
page 1-7 and Table 1.11 3Ø, Main Lugs Kits, page 1-7.
[57] Supplied with feed-thru lugs.
[58] Device is rated NEMA 3R and can be used for indoor or outdoor applications.
1-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
1Ø, Special Applications QO™ Load Centers
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us

1Ø2W—120Vac—1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed


Table 1.14: QO Special Application (Accepts Only QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers.)

LOAD CENTERS
Short Load Center [60] Equipment Ground Bar Main Wire Size
Mains Max. 1P Max. Tandem AWG/kcmil Box No.
Rating Circuit Current Spaces Box, Interior, and Kit
Rating Circuits [59] Circuit Breakers (Order Separately) [61]
Cover Al Cu
Manufactured Housing: 1Ø2W 120 Vac—Main Lugs Only—CSA Certified
 30 A[62] 10 kA 2 2 0 QO2L30TTS[63] 12–10 14–10 1
Factory-installed
 50 A 10 kA 2 4 2 QO24L50TTS [64] — 14–6 2
1Ø2W 120 Vac—Main Circuit Breaker—CSA Certified
 30 A 10 kA 3 5 2 QO35FM30TTF/S Factory-installed [65] 3
1Ø3W 120/240 Vac—Main Lugs Only—CSA Certified
 70 A 10 kA 2 4 2 QO24L70TS [64] 12–3 14–4 2
6 12 6 QO612L100TF/S [66] 4
QO612L100DTF/S [66] Factory
6 12 6 Installed 4
100 A 10 kA 4–1
8 16 8 QO816L100TF/S [66] 4
8 16 8 QO816L100DTF/S [66] 4

1
Load Center with Cover: 1Ø3W 120/240 Vac—UL Listed Complete QO Load Center—Box, Interior and Combination Cover in One Package
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs [67]—QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker (See page 1-4)—Copper Bus
65 kA  12  12 0 QO112L125GC PK12GTA Incl. 6–2/0 6
125 A 65 kA  12  24 12 QO11224L125GC PK15GTA Incl. 6–2/0 6
I
N 65 kA  20  20 0 QO120L125GC PK15GTA Incl. 6–2/0 6–1 6
D Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs [67]—QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker (See page 1-4)—Copper Bus
O PK23GTA, LK100AN
O 150 A 65 kA 30 30 0 QO130L150TC 6–250 9
Installed
R
200 A 65 kA 30 40 10 QO13040L200GC PK23GTA, LK100AN Incl. 6–250 9
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker—
QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Lugs (See page 1-5) or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See page 1-4)—Copper Bus [68]
22 kA 12 12 0 QO112M100C PK9GTA 4–1/0 5
22 kA 12 20 8 QO11220M100C PK15GTA 4–1/0 5
100 A
22 kA 16 16 0 QO116M100C PK12GTA 4–1/0 6
22 kA 20 20 0 QO120M100C PK15GTA 4–1/0 6
125 A 22 kA 32 32 0 QO132M125C PK18GTA 6–2/0 8
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker—
QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Lugs (Seepage 1-5) or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See page 1-4)—Copper Bus [68]
22 kA 20 30 10 QO12030M150C PK18GTA 4–250 9
150 A
22 kA 30 30 0 QO130M150C PK18GTA 4–250 9
22 kA 20 40 20 QO12040M200C PK23GTA 4–250 9
22 kA 30 30 0 QO130M200C PK18GTA 4–250 9
200 A
22 kA 30 40 10 QO13040M200C PK23GTA 4–250 9
22 kA 40 40 0 QO140M200C PK23GTA 4–250 10
Above listings through 200 A mains rating meet Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2.

Table 1.15: Service Upgrade Load Centers: 1Ø3W 120/240Vac—UL Listed Load Center with Removable End Walls
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Breaker—22KA
QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Lugs or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See page 1-8) [68]
Extra Long Cover with Door Main Wire Size Equipment Ground
I Mains Max. 1P Max. Tandem (Order Separately) Bar
N Load Center AWG / kcmil Box No.
Rating Spaces Circuits Circuit Kit (Order [61]
D [59] Box and Interior
Breakers Flush Surface Al Cu Separately)
O
O 30 60 30 HOM3060M200PCEP [69] HOMC30UFL — PK23GTA 10
R 4-250
200 A 40 40 0 QO140M200EP[70] QOC40UFL — PK23GTA 10

Table 1.16: Auxiliary Gutter


Cat. No. Cover Conduit Riser Size Width Height Depth
UL Listed for use with standard 1Ø and 3Ø load centers for riser applications [71]. For auxiliary gutter-load center compatibility, see catalog number 1100CT0501
SDAG26 Flush 1-3/4, 2, 2-1/2 or [72]3 13.50 26.12 3.75

Table 1.17: Tap Kits 120/240 Vac—UL Listed for use with Auxiliary Gutter SDAG26
Use with Auxiliary Riser Wire Tap Off Wire
Cat. N0. Gutter Cat. No. Lug Type Al/Cu Wire Size Lug Type Al/Cu Wire Size
SDGT30020 SDAG26 Mechanical (Included) (2) 6 AWG–300 kcmil Mechanical (Included) (1) 6–2/0 AWG
SDGT300300 SDAG26 Mechanical (Included) (2) 6 AWG–300 kcmil Mechanical (Included) (1) 6 AWG–300 kcmil
SDGT300C10C SDAG26 Anderson VCEL030516H1 (Not included) (2) 4 AWG–300 kcmil Anderson VCEL02114S1 (Not Included) (1) 8–1/0 AWG
Anderson VCEL030516H1 (Not
SDGT300C300C SDAG26 Anderson VCEL030516H1 (Not included) (2) 4 AWG–300 kcmil included) (1) 4 AWG–300 kcmil
QOGL20Grounding Mechanical (Included) (2) 6–2/0 AWG
Terminals SDAG26 — —

[59] Maximum single pole branch circuits utilizing QO and/or QOT circuit breakers.
[60] Order F for flush device or S for surface device.
[61] See Table 1.57 Knockout Information, page 1-24
[62] Mains rating 25 A when Al wire is used.
[63] Will not accept Qwik-Gard™ QO-GFI or QO-AFI circuit breaker.
[64] Use 10 AWG maximum size wire for GFI and AFI circuit breakers.
[65] Main circuit breaker is a field-installed standard QO single pole circuit breaker. Order separately from page 1-2, page 1-10.
[66] 70 A max. branch circuit breaker and 70 A max. back fed main circuit breaker.
[67] UL Listed 5000 A short circuit current rating for corner grounded Delta systems. Use QO-H circuit breakers only.
[68] 22 k AIR main circuit breaker UL Listed for use ahead of QO, QOT and QO-PL 10 k AIR branch circuit breakers to permit their application on systems with up to 22 kA available fault current.
[69] Ships with standard length cover.
[70] Copper Bus, order cover separately QOC40UF/S or QOC40UFL.
[71] One tap kit required for each riser wire.
[72] When used with B300 bolt-on hubs.
1-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ Miniature Circuit Breakers QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers
Class 730, 731, 733 / Refer to Catalog: 0730CT9801
1

schneider-electric.us

QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers


Square D brand QO miniature circuit breakers are plug-on products for use in QO load
centers, NQOD and NQ panelboards, NQOD and NQ OEM interiors or Speed-D™
switchboard distribution panels. Bolt-on QOB circuit breakers are for use in NQOD and
NQ panelboards or interiors. [1]
LOAD CENTERS

The Square D exclusive Qwik-Open™ mechanism, with a trip reaction within 1/60th of a
second, is standard on all 1P 15 A and 20 A QO circuit breakers.

Table 1.18: Plug-On Circuit Breakers


Amperes 2P—120/240 Vac 2P—240 Vac [3] 3P—240 Vac
Rating [2] 1P—120/240 Vac Common Trip Common Trip Common Trip
10 k AIR
10 A QO110 QO210 — QO310
15 A QO115 [4] [5] QO215 [4] QO215H QO315 [4]
20 A QO120 [4] [5] QO220 [4] QO220H QO320 [4]
25 A QO125 [4] QO225 [4] QO225H QO325 [4]
30 A QO130 [4] QO230 [4] QO230H QO330 [4]
35 A QO135 [4] QO235 [4] — QO335 [4]
40 A QO140 [4] QO240 [4] QO240H QO340 [4]
45 A QO145 [4] QO245 [4] — QO345 [4]
50 A QO150 [4] QO250 [4] QO250H QO350 [4]
QO 1P 60 A QO160 [4] QO260 [4] QO260H QO360 [4]
1 Space Required QO170 [4] QO270 [4] QO370 [4]
70 A QO270H
80 A — QO280 [4] QO280H QO380 [4]
90 A — QO290 [4] QO290H QO390 [4]
100 A — QO2100 [4] QO2100H QO3100 [4]
110 A — QO2110 [4] — —
125 A — QO2125 [4] — —
150 A — QO2150 [4] [6] [7] — —
175 A — QO2175 [4] [6] [7] — —
200 A — QO2200 [4] [6] [7] — —
Molded Case Switch 60 A max.–240 Vac — QO200 QO300
Molded Case Switch 100 A max.–240 Vac — QO2000 [8] QO3000 [8]
22 k AIR [4]
15 A QO115VH [5] QO215VH [9] — QO315VH [9]
QO 2P 20 A QO120VH [5] QO220VH [9] — QO320VH [9]
2 Spaces Required 25 A QO125VH QO225VH [9] — QO325VH [9]
30 A QO130VH QO230VH [9] — QO330VH [9]
40 A QO140VH QO240VH [9] — QO340VH [9]
50 A QO150VH QO250VH [9] — QO350VH [9]
60 A QO160VH QO260VH [9] — QO360VH [9]
70 A QO170VH QO270VH [9] — QO370VH [9]
80 A — QO280VH [9] — QO380VH [9]
90 A — QO290VH [9] — QO390VH [9]
100 A — QO2100VH [9] [10] — QO3100VH [9]
110 A — QO2110VH [9] [10] — —
125 A — QO2125VH [9] [10] — —
150 A — QO2150VH [6] [9] [7] — —
175 A — QO2175VH [6] [9] [7] — —
200 A — QO2200VH [6] [9] [7] — —
42 k AIR [4]
QO 3P  40 A — QOH240 [8] — —
3 Spaces Required  45 A — QOH245 [8] — —
 50 A — QOH250 [8] — —
 60 A — QOH26 [8] — —
 70 A — QOH270 — —
 80 A — QOH280 — —
 90 A — QOH290 — —
100 A — QOH2100 — —
110 A — QOH2110 [8] — —
125 A — QOH2125 — —
65 k AIR [4]
 15 A QH115 [5] QH215 — QH315 [4]
 20 A QH120 [5] QH220 — QH320
 25 A QH125 [8] QH225 [8] — QH325 [8]
 30 A QH130 QH230 — QH330

Refer topage 7-2 for Interrupting Ratings, Accessories, and Dimensions.

QO2200 2P 200 A
4 Spaces Required

[1] See Digest Section 1 for load centers, and Section 9 for panelboards and interiors.
[2] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–125 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[3] UL Listed 5 k AIR on corner grounded Delta systems.
[4] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[5] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated. Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[6] Requires four spaces (1 AWG–300 kcmil Al/Cu.) Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[7] Not suitable for use in 3Ø panels. Use only in 1Ø panel rated 150 A or greater.
[8] Order only. Contact your local Field Office.
[9] UL Listed for use ahead of QO, QO-GFI, QO-EPD, QOT, QO-AFI, and QO-PL 10 k AIR circuit breakers to permit their application at 22 kA fault level.
[10] 100 A maximum branch mounted opposite.
1-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers QO™ Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 730, 731, 733 / Refer to Catalog: 0730CT9801
schneider-electric.us

QO/QOB Ring Terminal


Table 1.19: QO/QOB Ring Terminal—Factory-installed only
Ampere Rating

LOAD CENTERS
Poles Suffix
10–30 A 1, 2, 3 5237
35–60 A 1,2
5238
35–50 A 3
 70–110 A 2
5273
 60–100 A 3

Wire Sizes for QO/QOB Circuit Breakers


Table 1.20: Wire Sizes
Ampere Rating Wire Size
Circuit Breaker Type (AWG/kcmil)
[11]
10–30 A 14–8 Al/Cu
QO 10–30 A (2) 14–10 Cu
1P
35–70 A 8–2 Al/Cu
10–30 A 14–8 Al/Cu

1
10–30 A (2) 14–10 Cu
QO
2P 35–70 A 8–2 Al/Cu
80–125 A 4–2/0 Al/Cu
150–200 A 4–300 Al/Cu
10–30 A 14–8 Al/Cu, (2) 14-10 Cu
QO
3P 35–70 A 8–2 Al/Cu
80–125 A 4–2/0 Al/Cu
QOB-VH 110–150 A 4–300 Al/Cu
QOT 15–20 A 12–8 Al 14–8 Cu
15–30 A 12–8 Al 14–8 Cu
QO-AFI, QO-GFI or QO-EPD
40, 50, 60 A 12–4 Al 14–6 Cu
QO-PL 10–60 A 12–2 Al 14–2 Cu

QOT Tandem Circuit Breakers


Circuit limiting QOT tandem circuit breakers have a mounting cam as shown. Installation
into a QO load center can only be made in those positions having a mounting pan rail
slot. Meets Paragraph 408.54 of the NEC®. UL Listed as Class CTL

Table 1.21: QOT Tandem Circuit Breakers


Ampere Rating [12] Cat. No. [13]
1P—120/240 Vac
15 A and 15 A QOT1515
15 A and 20 A QOT1520
20 A and 20 A QOT2020
2P—120/240 Vac Common Trip
Order two QOT1515 or QOT2020 circuit breakers and handle tie QOTHT for common switching of center two poles.

QOT 1P Tandem
Replacement Tandem Circuit Breakers Includes two circuit breakers (one QO2030
1 Space Required and one QO3020) and handle tie QOTHT.

Table 1.22: Replacement Tandem Circuit Breakers


Ampere Rating [12] Cat. No. [13]
1P—120/240 Vac—1 Space Required
15 A and 15 A QO1515
15 A and 20 A QO1520
20 A and 20 A QO2020
Mounting Cam 20 A and 30 A QO2030
Rail Bead
30 A and 20 A QO3020
Pan Rail Slot Two 1P Individual Trip—120/240 Vac—2 Spaces Required
15 A and 15 A Order Two QO1515 or QO2020 circuit breakers and
15 A and 20 A handle tie QOTHT
20 A and 20 A —
20 A and 30 A QO20303020 [14]
30 A and 20 A —

[11] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–125 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[12] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–125 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[13] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[14] Includes two circuit breakers (one QO2030 and one QO3020) and handle tie QOTHT.
1-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ Miniature Circuit Breakers QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers
Class 685, 690, 730, 912, 950 / Refer to Catalog: 0730CT9801
1

schneider-electric.us

QO Plug-On Neutral Load Centers with Qwik-Grip


Qwik-Grip simplifies rough-in by eliminating the need for most knockout removals and
eliminates the use of most box connectors. With a quick bend of the NM-B wire using the
wire bend guide on the Qwik-Grip.
LOAD CENTERS

QO Plug-on Neutral
Load Center with Qwik-Grip

Table 1.23: QO Plug-on Neutral Load Centers with Qwik-Grip


Indoor Cover with Door (Order Main Wire Size
Mains Max. Single Max. Tandem Circuit Load Center Box and Seperately) AWG/kcmil Equipment Box
Rating Spaces
Pole Circuits Breakers Interior Gound Bar Kit No.
Flush Surface Al Cu
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs, 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating—Copper Bus, QOM1 Main Frame Size, Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker
24 24 0 QO124L125PQG QOC24UF QOC24US PK15GTAL 7Q
125 A 6–2/0
30 30 0 QO130L125PQG QOC30U125C QOC30U125C PK23GTAL 9Q
Convertible Mains-Factory—Installed Main Lugs, 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating—Copper Bus, QOM2 Main Frame Size, Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker
I 200 A 30 30 0 QO130L200PQG QOC30UF QOC30US PK23GTAL 9Q
N
D 6–300 PK15GTAL and
O 225 A 42 42 0 QO142L225PQG QOC42UF QOC42US PK15GTA 9Q
O included
R Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker, 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating—Copper Bus, QOM2 Main Frame Size, Convertible to Main Lugs or Main Circuit Breaker
PK23GTA (Order
30 30 0 QO130M200PQ QOC30UF QOC30US seperately) 11Q
200 A 4–250
PK23GTA (Order
42 42 0 QO142M200PQ QOC42UF QOC42US seperately) 11Q

QO Arc-Fault Circuit Breaker


QO arc-fault circuit breakers provide protection for Series and Parallel Type Arcing as
required by the NEC and local code adoption, and comply with UL1699.

Table 1.24: QO Arc Fault Circuit Breakers (One-Pole)


One–Pole 120 Vac Two–Pole 120/240 Vac
Circuit Ampere
Breaker 10 k AIR
Rating 22 k AIR 10 k AIR 22 k AIR
Type [15] 1 Space 1 Space Required 2 Space Required 2 Space Required
Required
Combination
Arc-fault
Interrupter 15 QO115CAFI QO115VHCAFI QO215CAFI [16] QO215VHCAFI [16]
(Pigtail 20 QO120CAFI QO120VHCAFI QO220CAFI [16] QO220VHCAFI [16]
Neutral)
1P 1P Plug-On
QO-CAFI QO-CAFI Neutral
Combination 15 QO115PCAFI QO115VHPCAFI
Plug-On Neutral Pigtail 20 QO120PCAFI QO120VHPCAFI
Arc-fault
Interrupter

QO-Dual Function Circuit Breaker


QO Combination Arc Fault and Ground Fault Circuit Interrupters (Dual Function) provide
overload and short circuit protection, plus arc fault and ground fault protection in
accordance with the NEC, UL1699 and UL943.

Table 1.25: QO-Dual Function Arc Fault Circuit Breakers


Ampere 1P 120 Vac 1P 120 Vac
Circuit Breaker Type [17] 10 k AIR 22 k AIR
Rating
1 Space Required 1 Space Required
Combination Arc-fault and Ground Fault 15 QO115DF QO115VHDF
Circuit Interrupter (Pigtail Neutral) 20 QO120DF QO120VHDF
Plug-On Neutral Combination Arc-fault and 15 QO115PDF QO115VHPDF
Ground Fault Circuit Interrupter 20 QO120PDF QO120VHPDF

1P QO-DF 1P QO-DF
Plug-on Neutral Pigtail

[15] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[16] For 120/240 V only, not for 208Y/120 V.
[17] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
1-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers QO™ Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 685, 690, 730, 912, 950 / Refer to Catalog: 0730CT9801
schneider-electric.us

QO-GFI
Qwik-Gard™ circuit breakers provide overload and short circuit protection, combined with
Class A ground fault protection. Class A denotes a ground fault circuit interrupter that will

LOAD CENTERS
trip when a fault current to ground is 6 mA or more, for people protection. Do not connect
to more than 250 feet of load conductor for the total one-way run to prevent nuisance
tripping.

Table 1.26: QO-GFI Circuit Breakers


Qwik-Gard Circuit Breakers With Ground Fault Circuit Interrupter
Ampere 2P Common Trip 3P Common Trip
Rating 1P 120 Vac
120/240 Vac 208Y/120 Vac
[18] 10 k AIR 22 k AIR 10 k AIR 10 k AIR
1P 2P 1 Space Required 1 Space Required 2 Spaces Required 3 Spaces Required
QO-GFI QO-GFI 15 QO115GFI QO115VHGFI QO215GFI QO315GFI
20 QO120GFI QO120VHGFI QO220GFI QO320GFI
25 QO125GFI QO125VHGFI QO225GFI —
30 QO130GFI QO130VHGFI QO230GFI QO330GFI
40 — — QO240GFI QO340GFI

1
50 — — QO250GFI QO350GFI
60 — — QO260GFI [19] —

QO-EPD/EPE
QO-EPD/EPE circuit breakers provide overload and short circuit protection combined
with Class B ground fault protection. They are designed to provide ground fault
protection of equipment at a 30 mA level (EPD) or 100 mA level (EPE). They are not
designed to protect people from electrical shock.

Table 1.27: QO-EPD Circuit Breakers


1P 2P Common Trip 3P Common Trip
Ampere
120 Vac 120/240 Vac 240 Vac
Rating 10 k AIR 10 k AIR 10 k AIR
[20]
1 Space Required 2 Spaces Required 3 Spaces Required
15 QO115EPD QO215EPD QO315EPD [21] QO315EPE [21]
20 QO120EPD QO220EPD QO320EPD [21] QO320EPE [21]
25 QO125EPD QO225EPD — —
QO 1P 30 QO130EPD QO230EPD QO330EPD [21] QO330EPE [21]
With Shunt Trip
40 — QO240EPD QO340EPD [21] QO340EPE [21]
50 — QO250EPD QO350EPD [21] QO350EPE [21]
60 — QO260EPD [22] — —

QO-SWN
Switch Neutral Common Trip 2008 NEC® 514.11

Table 1.28: QO-SWN Circuit Breakers


Ampere 2 Wire 120 Vac 3 Wire 120/240 Vac
Rating [23] 10 k AIR 10 k AIR
2 Spaces Required 3 Spaces Required
10 QO210SWN QO310SWN
15 QO215SWN QO315SWN
20 QO220SWN QO320SWN
25 QO225SWN QO325SWN
30 QO230SWN QO330SWN
40 QO240SWN QO340SWN
Two-wire Three-wire 50 QO250SWN QO350SWN
QO-SWN QO-SWN

QO-HID
HID circuit breakers are for use on circuits feeding fluorescent and high intensity
discharge (HID) lighting systems such as mercury vapor, metal halide, or high pressure
sodium. These circuit breakers are physically interchangeable with QO circuit breakers.

Table 1.29: QO-HID Circuit Breakers


2P Common Trip 3P Common Trip
Ampere 1P 120/240 Vac
120/240 Vac 240 Vac
Rating [23] 10 k AIR 10 k AIR 10 k AIR
1 Space Required
2 Spaces Required 3 Spaces Required
15 QO115HID [24] QO215HID QO315HID
20 QO220HID QO320HID
25 QO125HID QO225HID QO325HID
30 QO130HID QO230HID QO330HID
40 QO140HID QO240HID —
50 QO150HID QO250HID —

[18] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[19] Suitable only for feeding 240 Vac and 208 Vac two-wire loads. Does not contain load neutral connection.
[20] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[21] See note in Instruction Bulletin when using in an enclosure with a QO403 or QON prefix.
[22] Suitable only for feeding 240 Vac and 208 Vac two-wire loads. Does not contain load neutral connection.
[23] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[24] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated. Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
1-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ Miniature Circuit Breakers Accessories
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
1

schneider-electric.us

QO-K
Key operated QO circuit breakers are available in single-pole construction and can be
mounted in any single-pole space which will accept a standard QO. These circuit
breakers can be turned ON or OFF or to RESET with a special key (catalog number
QOK10) included with the circuit breaker. These circuit breakers are UL Listed and
available as shown in the table.
LOAD CENTERS

Table 1.30: QO-K Circuit Breakers


120 Vac—10 k AIR (1 Space Required)
Ampere Ampere
Rating [25] Cat. No. Rating [25] Cat. No.
10 QO110K
25 QO125K
15 QO115K QO130K
20 QO120K 30

QO-K Key Operated

QO-HM
High magnetic trip circuit breakers are recommended for applications where high initial
inrush may occur and for individual dimmer applications.

Table 1.31: QO-HM Circuit Breakers


120 Vac—10 k AIR
Ampere Rating [25] 1P
15 A QO115HM [26] [27]
20 A QO120HM [26] [27]

Non-Automatic (Standard) Miniature Switches


Miniature non-automatic switches have the same physical packaging as miniature circuit
breakers, but open only when the handle is switched to the OFF position.
Non-automatic switches provide no overcurrent protection or short circuit protection.
They must not be used on systems that have an available fault current greater than the
values listed in the table. Non-automatic switches are UL Listed per UL 1087 and are
CSA certified.
Table 1.32: QO Non-Automatic Miniature Switches, 240 Vac 10 kA
Ampere Rating 2P 3P
 60 QO200 QO300
100 QO2000 QO3000

[25] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[26] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[27] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated. Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
1-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories QO™ Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us

Accessories for QO/QOB Circuit Breakers


Table 1.33: Accessories for use with QO and QOB Miniature Circuit Breakers
Description Cat. No. Schedule

LOAD CENTERS
Handle Attachments
Converts any two adjacent 120/240 Vac 1P QO circuit breakers to independent trip 2P QO1HT DE2E
Handle Tie Converts any two adjacent 120/240 Vac1P side-by-side QOT circuit breakers to independent trip 2P QOTHT DE2E
Clamp for holding QO 1P handle in ON or OFF position QO1LO DE2E
Handle Clamp Clamp for holding QO or Q1 either 1P, 2P or 3P circuit breaker handles in ON or OFF position HLO1 DE2E
For padlocking 1P QO circuit breaker in ON or OFF position
   Loose attachment QOHPL DE2E
   Fixed attachment QO1PA DE2E
Handle Padlock Attachment for For padlocking 1P side-by-side QOT circuit breaker in ON or OFF position QOTHPA DE2E
Padlocking in ON or OFF
position For padlocking 2P QO-GFI circuit breakers in either ON or OFF position, fixed attachment. GFI2PA DE2A
For 2P and 3P QO and Q1 standard circuit breakers which require padlocking in either ON or OFF position.
   Loose attachment QO1HPL DE2E
   Fixed attachment QO1PL DE2E
For padlocking 1P QO circuit breaker in OFF position only, fixed attachment. QO1PAF DE2E
Handle Padlock Attachment for For padlocking 2P and 3P QO circuit breakers in OFF position only, fixed attachment. QO2PAF DE2E
Padlocking in OFF position For padlocking 1P QO-GFI, QO-CAFI, QO-DF and QO-EPD circuit breakers in OFF position only, fixed attachment. QOGFI1PAF DE2E

1
For padlocking 2P QO-GFI, QO-CAFI and QO-EPD circuit breakers in OFF position only, fixed attachment. QOGFI2PAF DE2E
Ring Terminal Ring terminals are available as a factory-installed option. See page 7–10 DE2A
60 A 2P plug-on – 2 spaces required (6–2 Al/Cu) QO60SL DE2A
125 A 2P plug-on – 2 spaces required (12–2/0 Al/Cu) QO2125SL DE2A
Sub-feed Lugs 225 A 2P plug-on – 4 spaces required (4–300 Al/Cu) QO2225SL [28] DE2A
125 A 3P plug-on – 3 spaces required (12–2/0 Al/Cu) QO3125SL DE3
Mechanical Interlock For interlocking the handles of two 2P or one 2P and one 1P QO and Q1 circuit breakers mounted side-by-side so that
only one circuit breaker can be ON at a time (Not QOU) QO2DTI DE2E
Attachment
QO2DTI mechanical interlock attachment with retaining kits for securing two adjacent back-fed circuit breakers in dual
With Retaining Kit power supply applications. Can be used with (2) 2Ps or (1) 2P and (1) 1P QO circuit breakers in QO816L100 load QO2DTIM DE2E
centers.

Factory-Installed Accessories for use with QO and QOB Miniature


Circuit Breakers
Factory-installed electrical accessories take up an additional pole space on QO, QO-
GFI, QO-EPD, QO-SWN and QOU circuit breakers. All AC electrical accessories shown
below are rated for 50/60 Hz. Accessories are not available for QOB-VH (2P 150 A and
3P 110–150 A) circuit breakers or QO, QOU molded case switches. QO circuit breakers
will accept only one accessory per circuit breaker. Undervoltage trip is not available on
miniature circuit breakers. Factory-installed accessories are not available for QO-AFI or
QO-CAFI Arc Fault Circuit Breakers or on QO2150, QO2175, or QO2200 circuit
breakers.
Table 1.34: Factory-Installed Accessories
Rated Cat. Accesso- Max. Cat.
Accessory Description Coil Description Contact
Voltage No. ry Voltage Max. No.
Burden Suffix Comb. Suffix
Trips the circuit breaker from a Monitors circuit breaker contact status and
remote location by means of a trip provides a remote signal indicating the circuit
coil energized from a separate breaker contacts are OPEN or CLOSED.
Application 120
circuit. A 120 Vac shunt trip will 12 Vac/Vdc 60 VA Auxiliary 1A Vac 5A -1200
-1042
operate at 55% or more of rated
voltage. All other shunt trips will
24 Vac/Vdc 168 VA Switches • Auxiliary switch terminals accept (2) 14–12
AWG Cu leads.
1B 120
Vac
5A -1201
operate at 75% or more of rated
Shunt Trip
voltage. • Leads (EH): Yellow for “A’’, Blue for “B’’,
Striped common 18 AWG Cu.
Application
• For use with momentary or
maintained push button.
Used with control circuits and is actuated only
when the circuit breaker has tripped. Standard
120 Vac 72 VA construction includes a normally-open
• Not available on QO-GFI, QO-
EPD.
208 Vac
240 Vax
228 VA
288 VA
-1021 Alarm
Switches
contact.
Application
1A
120
Vac
5A -2100

• Shunt trip terminals accept (2)


0.14– 0.12 AWG Cu. • Leads: Alarm switch terminals accept (2)
14–12 AWG Cu leads.

[28] Not suitable for use in 3Ø panels. Use only in 1Ø panel rated 150 A or greater.
1-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ and Homeline™ Load Centers and 1Ø, Value Packs and Riser Panels
Circuit Breakers
1

Class 1130, 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501 schneider-electric.us

QO and Homeline Plug-On Neutral Load Centers with Qwik-Grip


Qwik grip simplifes rough-in by elimininating the need for most knockout removals and
eliminates the use of most box connectors. With a quick bend of the NM-B wire using the
wire bend guide on the Qwik-Grip insert, the wire easily slides into the slot. Solution is UL
listed.
LOAD CENTERS

Table 1.35: Value Packs Contains Complete Load Center (Box, Interior and Cover) with Selected Branch Circuit Breakers
Equipment
Max. Load Center Ground Bar Kit Main
Box, Interior, Cover and Branch Circuit Breakers Box
Main Spaces Max. 1P Tandem (Order Separately) Wire Size No.
Ratings Circuits Circuit AWG/kcmil [1]
Breakers Included Load Center/Circuit Al/Cu
Cat. No. Cat. No.
Breakers
QO Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs, up to 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating—Copper Bus, QOM1 Main Frame Size, Convertible to Main Circuit breaker
(1) QO124L125PQGC, (3)
QO124L125PQGCVP QO120, (2) QO230 and (1) PK15GTAL 7Q
125 A 24 24  0 6–2/0
PKQGA Qwik-Grip assembly kit Included
QO Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker, 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating—Copper Bus, QOM2 Main Frame Size, Convertible to Main Lugs or Main Circuit breaker
(1) QO142M200PQC, (3)
PK23GTA
200 A 42 42 0 QO142M200PQCVP QO120, (2) QO230 and (1) 4–250 11Q
I PKQGA Qwik-Grip assembly kit (Order seperately)
N
D Homeline Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Circuit breaker, 22kA Short Circuit Current Rating—Copper Bus, QOM1 Main Frame Size, Convertible to Main Lugs
O or Main Circuit Breaker
O (1) HOM2040M100PQC, (2)
PK18GTA
R 100 A 20 40 20 HOM2040M100PQCVP HOM120, (1) HOM230 and (1) (Order seperately) 6–2/0 6–1  6
PKQGA Qwik-Grip assembly kit
(1) HOM3060M200PQC, (3)
HOM120, (2) HOM230 and (1) PK23GTA
30 60 30 HOM3060M200PQCVP (Order seperately) 4–250 10Q
PKQGA Qwik-Grip assembly kit
200 A
(1) HOM2040M100PQC, (2)
PK27GTA
40 80 40 HOM4080M200PQCVP HOM120, (1) HOM230 and (1) 12Q
PKQGA Qwik-Grip assembly kit (Order seperately) 4–250

1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed


Table 1.36: Value Packs Contains Complete Load Center (Box, Interior and Cover) with Selected Branch Circuit Breakers
Max. Equipment
1P Max. Load Center Ground Bar Kit Main Box
Mains Spaces Cir- Tandem Box, Interior, Cover and Branch Circuit Breakers (Order Wire Size No.
Rating cuits Circuit Separately) AWG/kcmil [3]
[2] Breakers Al/Cu
Cat. No. Included Load Center/Circuit Breakers Cat. No.
QO (Accepts Only QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers) QO—Copper Bus
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker,
22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Convertible appropriate to Main Lugs (See 1Ø, Field-Installed Main Lugs Kits, page 1-5) or QOM Main Circuit Breaker (See 1Ø, Field-Installed Main
Circuit Breaker Kits, page 1-4)
125 A 24 24  0 QO124L125PGCVP (1) QO124L125PGC, (3) QO120, (2) QO230 PK15GTA 6–2/0 7
225 A 42 42 0 QO142L225PGCVP (1) QO142L225PGC, (3) QO120, (2) QO230 (2) PK15GTA 6–300 12
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker,
22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Convertible appropriate to Main Lugs or Main Circuit Breaker (See 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed, page 1-20)
24 24  0 QO124M100PCVP (1) QO124M100PC, (3) QO120, (2) QO230 PK15GTA 6–2/0 7
125 A
32 32  0 QO32M100VP (1) QO132M100C, (3) QO120, (2) QO230 PK18GTA 4–2/0 8
30 40 10 QO3040M200VP (1) QO13040M200C, (3) QO120, (2) QO230 PK23GTA 9
42 42  0 QO142M200PCVP (1) QO142M200PC, (3) QO120, (2) QO230 PK23GTA 11
200 A 4–250
(1) QO142M200PC, (3) QO120, (2) QO230, (3)
42 42  0 QO142M200PCAFVP PK23GTA 11
QO115PCAFI
Homeline (Accepts Only HOM Plug-On Circuit Breakers)
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs,
10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Convertible to appropriate QOM 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Main Circuit Breaker (See 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed, page 1-20)
I
N 125 A 12 24 12 HOM1224L125PGCVP (1) HOM1224L125PGC, (2) HOM120 PK15GTAL 6–2/0 6–1  6
D PK15GTAL
O 225 A 30 60 30 HOM3060L225PGCVP (1) HOM3060L225PGC, (3) HOM120, (2) HOM230 4–300 4–250 10
PK15GTA
O Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker,
R 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Convertible appropriate to Main Lugs or Main Circuit Breaker (See 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed, page 1-20)
20 40 20 HOM2040M100PCVP (1) HOM2040M100PC, (2) HOM120, (1) HOM230 PK18GTA 6–1 6–3  7
(1) HOM2040M100PC, (2) HOM120, (1) HOM230, (1)
100 A 20 40 20 HOM2040M100PC1AVP PK18GTA 6–1 6–3  7
HOM115PCAFI
24 48 24 HOM2448M100PCVP (1) HOM2448M100PC, (3) HOM120, (2) HOM230 PK23GTA 6–2/0 6–1/0  8
150 A 30 30 30 HOM3060M150PCVP (1) HOM3060M150PC, (3) HOM120, (2) HOM230 PK23GTA 4–250
20 40 20 HOM2040M200PCVP (1) HOM2040M200PC, (3) HOM120, (2) HOM230 PK18GTA  9
30 60 30 HOM3060M200PCVP (1) HOM3060M200PC, (3) HOM120, (2) HOM230 PK23GTA 10
30 60 30 HOM3060M200PC1AVP (1) HOM3060M200PC, (3) HOM120, (2) HOM230, (1) PK23GTA 10
HOM115PCAFI
(1) HOM3060M200PC, (3) HOM120, (2) HOM230, (3)
200 A 30 60 30 HOM3060M200PCAFVP HOM115PCAFI PK23GTA 4–250 10
40 80 40 HOM4080M200PCVP (1) HOM4080M200PC, (3) HOM120, (2) HOM230 PK27GTA 12
(1) HOM4080M200PC, (3) HOM120, (2) HOM230, (1)
40 80 40 HOM4080M200PC1AVP HOM115PCAFI PK27GTA 12
(1) HOM4080M200PC, (3) HOM120, (2) HOM230, (3)
40 80 40 HOM4080M200PCAFVP PK27GTA 12
HOM115PCAFI
R Homeline (Accepts Only HOM Plug-On Circuit Breakers)
A Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker,
I 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Convertible to Main Lugs or Lower Amperage QOM2 Main Circuit Breaker (See 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed, page 1-20)
N (1) HOM1224M125PRB, (3) HOM120, (2) HOM230
P 125 A 12 24 12 HOM1224M125PRBVP PK23GTA 6–2/0 6–1 3R
R
O 200 A 30 60 30 HOM3060M200PRBVP (1) HOM3060M200PRB, (3) HOM120, (2) HOM230 PK23GTA 4–250 7R
O
F

[1] See Indoor knockout information and Enclosure Dimensions for Qwik Grip Loadcenters, page 1-24
[2] Maximum single pole branch circuits utilizing QO and/or QOT circuit breakers.
[3] See Indoor, Dimensions and Knockouts, page 1-24 or Rainproof, Dimensions, Knockouts and Bolt-on Hubs, page 1-26
1-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO and Homeline Load Center Accessories Load Center Accessories
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us

QO Riser Panels
Table 1.37: Offset Interior for Wide Gutter—30 A Maximum Branch Circuit Breaker on left side of interior [4] [5]
(Accepts Only QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers)

LOAD CENTERS
Max. Single Equipment Main Wire Size AWG/
Mains Max. Tandem Circuit Load Center Box and Load Center kcmil Box No. [7]
Rating Spaces Pole Circuits Ground Bar Kit
[6] Breakers Interior Cover (Order Separately) Al Cu
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs, 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Convertible to QOM1 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Main Circuit Breaker (See Indoor, 1Ø, Main
Lugs, page 1-3) when used with QOC cover below—Copper Bus
12 24 12 QO11224L125WG QOC20UFWG PK15GTA 14
I 125 A 6–2/0
N 20 30 10 QO12030L125WG QOC20UFWG PK15GTA 14
D Convertible Mains-Factory—Installed Main Lugs, 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Convertible to QOM2 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Main Circuit Breaker (See Indoor, 1Ø, Main
O Lugs, page 1-3) when used with QOC cover below—Copper Bus
O 200 A 30 40 10 QO13040L200WG QOC30UFWG PK23GTA 4–250 23
R Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker, 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Convertible to Main Lugs (See Indoor, 1Ø, Main Circuit Breaker, page 1-4)
or Lower Amperage QOM2 Main Circuit Breaker (See Indoor, 1Ø, Main Lugs, page 1-3) when used with QOC cover below—Copper Bus
200 A 24 24 0 QO124M200WG125 [8] QOC30UFWG PK23GTA 4–250 23
Above listings through 200 A mains rating meet Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2.

1
Panelboard-style Covers for Riser Panels
Mono-Flat™ Front available for riser panels as an alternative to standard load center
Mains Rating of Load Center Cat. No. cover listed above. Provides a low-profile, aesthetically pleasing solution for high-traffic
125 A NQC20FWG areas in upscale multi-family applications. Deadfront included. Lock kit not provided.
200 A NQC30FWG Cover NQC30FWG CANNOT be used when panel has been converted to a main circuit
breaker panel. [9]
QO Load Center Accessories
Table 1.38: QO Load Center Accessories
Description Cat. No. Schedule
Secures circuit breaker to interior when used as a back-fed main. For QO612L100F/S, RB,
QO612L100DF/S, QO816L100F/S, RB, QO816L100DF/S and QO148L125GF/S, GRB load centers PK2MB DE3A
Secures 3P circuit breaker without accessories to left side of interior when used as a back-fed main. For 3Ø load centers PK3MB DE3A
Retaining Kit for Breakers Secures circuit breaker to interior when used as a back-fed main for 2P QO 150–200 A circuit breakers PK5RK DE3A
Used as Back-fed Mains Secures ONE circuit breaker with or without electrical accessories to right side of interior when used as a back-fed main
For 1Ø 100–125 ampere convertible main load centers. Series S01 and S02 PK4MB2LA DE3A
Secures ONE circuit breaker with or without electrical accessories to right side of interior when used as a back-fed main
For 1Ø 150–225 ampere convertible main load centers. Series S01 and S02 PK4MB2HA DE3A
Cover Sealing Strap Provides means of sealing trim mounting screws on QO load center covers QO1SE DE3A
Replacement Cover 1 through 42 numbered universal replacement directory label for load center covers
Directory Label LSDL DE5
Circuit Identification Circuit identification stickers for use on cover directory labels to identify branch circuits
Stickers PSDS DE5
Fills opening in covers if twistout is removed in error QOFP DE3A
Fills main circuit breaker opening in convertible load center covers 100–125 A QOM1FP DE3A
Filler Plates Fills main circuit breaker opening in convertible load center covers 150–225 A QOM2FP DE3A
Fills main circuit breaker opening in 3Ø load center covers (S01 and S02 Series) KFP DE3A
Fills main circuit breaker opening in “Q” style 3Ø load center covers (S03 Series) Q2FP DE3A
Use with QO612L100DF/S, QO612L100DFCU/SCU, QO612L100DTF/S, QO816L100DF/S, QO816L100DFCU/SCU, PK8FL [1]
QO816L100DTF/S, QO48M30DSGP, or QO48M60DSGP DE3A
Door Lock Kits Use with convertible mains, 1Ø and 3Ø 100–225 A, and fixed mains,
3Ø 125–225 A indoor load centers PK6FL DE3A
Use with 300 and 400 ampere indoor load centers PK4FL PE1A
Field-installed for 12– 2 Al or 14–4 Cu AWG wire LK70AN DE3A
Field-installed for 6–2/0 Al/Cu AWG wire LK100AN DE3A
Neutral / Ground Lugs Field-installed for 14–2/0 Al/Cu AWG wire LK125AN DE3A
Field-installed for 2–3/0 Al/Cu AWG wire LK150AN DE3A
Field-installed for 4 AWG to 300 kcmil Al/Cu wire. Use in Series S, LK225AN
150-225A QO load center or S03 and below, 150-225A HOM load center DE3A
LK225ANHOM
Standard PK15GTA with a 1–4/0 Al/Cu Lug PK15GTAL DE3A
Standard PK18GTA with a 1–4/0 Al/Cu Lug PK18GTAL DE3A
Ground Bar Kits
Standard PK23GTA with a 1–4/0 Al/Cu Lug PK23GTAL DE3A
Insulator Kit for PK7GTA through PK27GTA PKGTAB DE3A
50–125 A
QOM1PA DE2E
Handle Padlock For padlocking main circuit breakers in convertible load centers OFF
Attachment 100–225 A
QOM2PA DE2E
QO / Homeline 1Ø 100–125 A QOM1 convertible main load centers PKSB1LA DE3A
QO / Homeline 1Ø 150–225 A QOM2 convertible main load centers PKSB1HA DE3A
Service Entrance Barriers QO 3Ø convertible main load centers PKSB3 DE3A
QO 1Ø back-fed main breaker applications PKSB1QOBF DE3A
QO 3Ø back-fed main breaker applications PKSB3BF DE3A
QO Load Center Manual Power Transfer Accessories
For interlocking the handles of two 2P or one 2P and one 1P QO and Q1 circuit breakers mounted side-by-side so that only one QO2DTI
circuit breaker can be “ON’’ at a time. DE2E
QO2DTI mechanical interlock attachment with retaining kits for securing two adjacent back-fed circuit breakers in dual power
supply applications. Can be used with (2) 2P or (1) 2P and (1) 1P QO circuit breakers in QO816L100 load centers. QO2DTIM DE2E
Manual Transfer
Equipment Kit Secures two 2P circuit breakers to right side of interior when used as back-fed mains, a QO2DTI Kit included for back-up power
supply applications. For 1Ø 100–125 ampere convertible main load centers. Series S01 and S02. PK4DTIM4LA DE3A
Secures two 2P circuit breakers to right side of interior when used as back-fed mains, a QO2DTI Kit included for back-up power
supply applications. For 1Ø 150–225 ampere convertible main load centers. Series S01 and S02. PK4DTIM4HA DE3A

[4] UL short circuit current rating depends on lowest interrupting rating of circuit breaker installed.
[5] UL Listed 5000 A short circuit current rating for corner grounded Delta systems. Use QO-H circuit breakers only.
[6] Maximum single pole branch circuits utilizing QO and/or QOT circuit breakers.
[7] See Indoor Knockout Information and Enclosure Dimensions, page 1-24
[8] Comes with 125 A main circuit breaker factory installed.
[9] Order catalog number PK4FL for field-installed lock kit.
[1] QO403L60NF/S does not have provisions for a field-installed lock.
1-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Load Center Accessories QO and Homeline Load Center Accessories
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
1

schneider-electric.us

Table 1.38 QO Load Center Accessories (cont'd.)


Description Cat. No. Schedule
Secures two 2P circuit breakers to left side of interior when used as back-fed mains, a QO2DTI Kit included for back-up power
supply applications. For 1Ø 100–125 ampere convertible main load centers. Series S01 and S02. PK4DTIM4LAL DE3A
For use on “G” and “S” Series NEMA 1 and “G”, “S1” and “S2” Series NEMA 3R load centers. Interlocks a QOM1 2P main circuit
breaker of a load center (100–125 A) with a QO 2P (15–125 A) branch circuit breaker. QOCRBGK1C DE3A
LOAD CENTERS

Includes a retaining kit.


Generator Circuit Breaker For use on “G” and “S” Series NEMA 1 and “G” and “S1” Series NEMA 3R load centers. Interlocks a QOM2 2P main circuit
Interlock Kit breaker of a load center (150–225 A) with a QO 2P (15–125 A) branch circuit breaker. Includes a retaining kit. QOCGK2C DE3A
For use on “S2” Series NEMA 3R load centers. Interlocks a QOM2 2P main circuit breaker of a load center (150–225 A) with a
QO 2P (15–125 A) branch circuit breaker. Includes a retaining kit. QORBGK2C DE3A

PK2MB

PK3MB

QOFP

PKGTAB
PK6FL and PK8FL PK4FL

QO and HOM Qwik-Grip Load Center Accessories


Table 1.39: Qwik-Grip Load Center Accessories
Description Cat. No. Schedule
Qwik-Grip replacement shield (1) Qwik-Grip shield PKQGS DE3A
Qwik-Grip fillers (4) Qwik-Grip fillers PKQGFP DE3A
Qwik-Grip replacement insert (1) Qwik-Grip insert PKQGI DE3A
Qwik-Grip assembly kit (4) Qwik-Grip shields, (12) Qwik-Grip fillers PKQGA DE3A

Homeline Load Center Accessories


Table 1.40: Homeline Load Center Accessories
Description Cat. No. Schedule
Handle Padlock 50–125 A QOM1PA DE2E
For padlocking main circuit breakers in convertible load center, “OFF”
Attachment 100–225 A QOM2PA DE2E
Fills opening in covers if twistout is removed in error HOMFP DE3C
Filler Plates 100–125 A QOM1FP DE3A
Fills main circuit breaker opening in convertible load centers
150–225 A QOM2FP DE3A
Field-installed for 14–2 AWG Al or 14–4 AWG Cu wire LK70AN DE3B
Field-installed for 6–2/0 AWG Al/Cu wire LK100AN DE3B
Neutral / Ground Lugs Field-installed for 14–2/0 AWG Al/Cu wire LK125AN DE3B
Field-installed for 4 AWG to 300 kcmil Al/Cu wire. Use in Series S, 150-225A QO load center or S03 and below, 150- LK225AN DE3A
225A HOM load center
Field-installed for 4 AWG–300 kcmil Al/Cu wire. Use in Series S04, 150–225 A HOM load center LK225ANHOM DE3A
Secures circuit breaker to interior when used as a back-fed main. For HOM612L100F/S, RB and HOM48L125GC,
HOM1RK DE3C
GRB load centers
Secures ONE circuit breaker right side of interior when used as a back-fed main For 100–125 A convertible main load
Retaining Kit for Breakers centers, Series S01 and S02 HOM4RK2LA DE3C
Used as Back-fed Mains
Secures ONE circuit breaker right side of interior when used as a back-fed main For 150–225 A convertible main load
centers, Series S01 and S02 HOM4RK2HA DE3C
Secures circuit breaker to interior when used as a back-fed main For 2P 150–200 A circuit breakers HOM5RK DE3C
Door Lock Kit Use with convertible indoor load center covers (Series S-1) PK6FL DE3A
Replacement Cover
Directory Label 1 through 42 numbered universal replacement directory label for load center covers LSDL DE5
Circuit Identification Circuit identification stickers for use on cover directory labels to identify branch circuits PSDS DE5
Stickers
For use on “S” Series NEMA 1 and NEMA 3R load centers. Interlocks a QOM1 2P main circuit breaker of a load
center (100–125 A) with a Homeline 2P (15–125 A) branch circuit breaker HOMCRBGK1C DE3D
Generator Circuit For use on “S” Series NEMA 1 and “S1” Series NEMA 3R load centers. Interlocks a QOM2 2P main circuit breaker of
a load center (150–225 A) with a Homeline 2P (15–125 A) branch circuit breaker HOMCGK2C DE3D
Breaker Interlock Kit
For use on “S2” and “S3” Series NEMA 3R QOM2 load centers. Interlocks a QOM2 2P main circuit breaker of a load
center (150–225 A) with a Homeline 2P (15–125 A) branch circuit breaker HOMRBGK2C DE3D
QO / Homeline 1Ø 100–125 A QOM1 convertible main load centers PKSB1LA DE3A
Service Entrance Barriers QO / Homeline 1Ø 150–225 A QOM2 convertible main load centers PKSB1HA DE3A
Homeline back-fed main breaker applications PKSB1HOMBF DE3A

1-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Indoor, 1Ø, Main Lugs and Main Circuit Homeline™ Load Centers
Breaker
schneider-electric.us Class 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
Surge Protective Devices
Table 1.41: Load Center and CSED Surge Protection Devices
Description

LOAD CENTERS
Cat. No. Schedule
For use on 1Ø3W, 150 Vac maximum SDSA1175 DE1B
For use on 3Ø4W, 650 Vac maximum SDSA3650 DE1B
Surge Arresters QO Surgebreaker CULUS Listed Secondary Surge Arrester
150 Vac line-to-ground maximum QO2175SB DE1B
Homeline Surgebreaker CULUS Listed Secondary Surge
Arrester 150 Vac line-to-ground maximum HOM2175SB DE1B
QOSAMK UL Listed for mounting SDSA1175 surge arrester into ground
Surge Arrester
Mounting Kit bar mounting holes on 1Ø convertible main circuit breaker QOSAMK DE3A
load centers

Indoor, 1Ø, Main Lugs and Main Circuit Breaker


1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed
Table 1.42: Convertible Main Load Centers (Accepts Only HOM Plug-On Circuit Breakers)
Max. Max. Main Wire Size

1
Mains Equipment Ground
Single Tandem Load Center AWG/kcmil Bar Kit Box No.
Rating Spaces Pole Box, Interior and Cover [2] [3]
Circuit (Order Separately)
Circuits [1] Breakers Al Cu
Main Lugs—10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Order HOM Circuit Breakers (See Homeline™ Circuit Breakers, page 1-21) Factory-installed Fixed Main Lugs
 70 A 2 4 2 HOM24L70F/S [4] [5] 12–3 14–4 PK3GTA1 2
100 A 6 12 6 HOM612L100F/S [4] [6] 8–1 PK7GTA 4
125 A 4 8 4 HOM48L125GC 12–2/0 14–2/0 PK7GTA Included 21
Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs
QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker (See 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed, page 1-20)
8 16 8 HOM816L125PC 6–1 PK9GTA 6
12 24 12 HOM1224L125PC 6–1 PK15GTA  6
125 A 16 32 16 HOM1632L125PC 6–2/0 6–1/0 PK15GTA 8
20 40 20 HOM2040L125PC 6–1/0 PK18GTA 8
30 60 30 HOM3060L125PC 6–2/0 PK23GTA 10
Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs
QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker (See 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed, page 1-20)
30 60 30 HOM3060L225PC PK23GTA 10
40 80 40 HOM4080L225PC PK27GTA 12
4–300 4–250
225 A 42 84 42 HOM4284L225PC PK27GTA 12
60 120 60 HOM60120L225PC [7] PK27GTA 25
Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs—Ground Bar Included
QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker (See 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed, page 1-20)
8 16 8 HOM816L125PGC 6–1 PK15GTAL Included 6
12 24 12 HOM1224L125PGC 6–1 PK15GTAL Included 6
125 A 6–2/0
20 40 20 HOM2040L125PGC 6–1/0 PK15GTAL Included 8
24 80 24 HOM2448L125PGC 6–1/0 PK15GTAL Included 8
I Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs—Ground Bar Included
N QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker (See 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed, page 1-20)
D
O 30 60 30 HOM3060L225PGC PK15GTAL & 10
O PK15GTA Included
R 16 32 16 HOM1632L225PGC PK15GTAL Included 9
20 40 20 HOM2040L225PGC PK15GTAL Included 9
225 A 4–300 4–250
40 80 40 HOM4080L225PGC PK15GTAL &
PK15GTA Included 12
PK15GTAL &
42 84 42 HOM4284L225PGC PK15GTA Included 12
Main Circuit Breaker—22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Circuit Breaker
QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Lugs or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed, page 1-20)
8 16 8 HOM816M100PC 6–1 PK9GTA 5
12 24 12 HOM1224M100PC 6–2/0 PK15GTA 6
100 A 20 40 20 HOM2040M100PC 6–1 PK18GTA 7
24 48 24 HOM2448M100PC 6–2/0 PK23GTA 8
30 60 30 HOM3060M100PC 6–2/0 PK23GTA 10
24 48 24 HOM2448M125PC 6–1/0 PK23GTA 8
125 A
30 60 30 HOM3060M125PC 6–2/0 6–2/0 PK23GTA 10
Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Circuit Breaker
QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Lugs or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed, page 1-20)
150 A 30 60 30 HOM3060M150PC 4–250 PK23GTA 10
20 40 20 HOM2040M200PC PK18GTA 9
30 60 30 HOM3060M200PC PK23GTA 10
40 80 40 HOM4080M200PC PK27GTA 12
200 A 4–250
42 84 42 HOM4284M200PC PK27GTA 12
60 120 60 HOM60120M200C [7] PK27GTA 25
225 A 42 84 42 HOM4284M225PC 4–300 4–250 PK27GTA 12
Above listings through 200 A mains rating meet Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2.

[1] Maximum single pole branch circuits utilizing HOM and/or HOMT circuit breakers.
[2] C at end of catalog number indicates combination flush/surface cover included with device.
[3] See Indoor Knockout Information and Enclosure Dimensions, page 1-24
[4] F/S at end of catalog number indicates to order F for flush device or S for surface device. The cover does not have a door.
[5] HOM-GFI and HOM-AFI branch circuit breakers are limited to number 10 maximum wire.
[6] 70 A maximum branch circuit breaker, 100 A maximum back feed main circuit breaker.
[7] Door kit available separately. Order QOCDK60.
1-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Homeline™ Load Centers Rainproof, 1Ø, Main Lugs and Main Circuit
Breakers
1

Class 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501 schneider-electric.us

Rainproof, 1Ø, Main Lugs and Main Circuit Breakers


1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed
Table 1.43: Convertible Main Load Centers (Accepts Only HOM Plug-On Circuit Breakers.)
Equipment Ground
LOAD CENTERS

Max. Single Max. Tandem Load Center Main Wire Size Bar Kit
Mains Rating Spaces Box, Interior and Cover AWG/kcmil Box No.
Pole Circuit (Order Separately) [9]
Circuits [8] Breakers
Cat. No. (DE3C) Al Cu Cat. No. (DE3A)
Main Lugs—10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
Factory-installed Fixed Main Lugs, 10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
70 A  2  4  2 HOM24L70RB [10] 12–3 14–4 PK4GTA 1R
100 A  6 12  6 HOM612L100RB [11] 8–1 PK7GTA 2R
125 A 4 8 4 HOM48L125GRB 12–2/0 14–2/0 PK7GTA Included 15R
R Convertible Mains with Factory-installed Main Lugs [12], QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker (See Below)
A  8 16  8 HOM816L125PRB PK9GTA 3R
I 12 24 12 HOM1224L125PRB PK15GTA 3R
N 125 A 6–2/0 6–1
P 20 40 20 HOM2040L125PRB PK18GTA 4R
R 24 48 24 HOM2448L125PRB PK23GTA 6R
O Convertible Mains with Factory-installed Main Lugs [12], QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker (See Below)
O
12 12  0 HOM12L225PRB PK9GTA 5R
F
16 32 16 HOM1632L225PRB PK15GTA  6R
20 40 20 HOM2040L225PRB PK18GTA 6R
225 A 4–300 4–250
30 60 30 HOM3060L225PRB PK23GTA 7R
40 80 40 HOM4080L225PRB PK27GTA 14R
42 84 42 HOM4284L225PRB PK27GTA 14R
Main Circuit Breaker—22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
Convertible Mains with Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker, QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Lugs or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See Below) [13]
 8 16  8 HOM816M100PRB PK9GTA 3R
100 A 12 24 12 HOM1224M100PRB 6–2/0 6–1 PK15GTA 3R
20 40 20 HOM2040M100PRB PK18GTA 4R
8 16 8 HOM816M125PRB PK9GTA 3R
R 125 A 6–2/0 6–1
24 48 24 HOM2448M125PRB PK23GTA 6R
A Convertible Mains with Factory-installed Main Circuit Breaker , QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Lugs or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See Below)
I
N 150 A 30 60 30 HOM3060M150PRB 4–250 PK23GTA 7R
P 12 12 0 HOM12M200PRB PK9GTA 5R
R 20 40 20 HOM2040M200PRB PK18GTA 6R
O 200 A 4–250
O 30 60 30 HOM3060M200PRB PK23GTA 7R
F 40 80 40 HOM4080M200PRB PK27GTA 14R
Convertible Mains with Factory-installed Main Circuit Breaker with Feed-thru Lugs,
QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Lugs or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See Below) [12]
150 A  8 16  8 HOM816M150PFTRB 4–250 PK15GTA 6R
  200 A  8 16  8 HOM816M200PFTRB 4–250 PK15GTA 6R
Above listings through 200 A mains rating meet Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2.

1Ø, Field-Installed Mains Kits


Table 1.44: For Convertible Load Centers Only
Field- Use on Convertible Lug Wire Size
Main [14]
Installed Frame Size Ampere Rating Load Center with Cat. No. [15]
Main Type Mains Rating AWG/kcmil
Main Lugs 125 A 100–125 A QOL125 6–2/0 Al or Cu
[16] —
225 A 150–225 A QOL225 6–300 Al or Cu
 50 A 100–125 A QOM50VH
QOL125  60 A 100–125 A QOM60VH
 70 A 100–125 A QOM70VH
 80 A 100–125 A QOM80VH
QOM1 12–2/0 Al or Cu
 90 A 100–125 A QOM90VH
100 A 100–125 A QOM100VH
Main Circuit 110 A 125 A QOM110VH
Breaker [13] 125 A 125 A QOM125VH
100 A 150–225 A QOM2100VH
125 A 150–225 A QOM2125VH
QOL225 150 A 150–225 A QOM2150VH
QOM2 [17] 4–300 Al or Cu
175 A 200–225 A QOM2175VH
200 A 200–225 A QOM2200VH
225 A 225 A QOM2225VH

[8] Maximum single pole branch circuits utilizing HOM and/or HOMT circuit breakers.
[9] See Rainproof, Dimensions, Knockouts and Bolt-on Hubs, page 1-26
[10] HOM-GFI and HOM-AFI branch circuit breakers are limited to number 10 maximum wire.
[11] 70 A maximum branch circuit breaker, 100 A maximum back feed main circuit breaker.
[12] Side hinge door device allow 1-1/4 in. on left side for door to open.
[13] 22 k AIR main circuit breaker UL Listed for use ahead of HOM and HOMT 10 k AIR branch circuit breakers to permit their application on systems with up to 22 kA available fault current.
[14] Do not exceed the load center mains rating.
[15] Wire range listed for main device kits is the wire range of that device. To find out maximum wire size permitted in a particular load center per UL, see tables in QO™ Load Centers, page 1-3
and QO™ and Homeline™ Load Centers and Circuit Breakers, page 1-16 under Main Wire Size.
[16] If main circuit breaker knockout has been removed from the load center’s trim, order appropriate filler plate from QO and Homeline Load Center Accessories, page 1-17.
[17] Add suffix 1021 for 120, 208, 240 Vac shunt trip.
1-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Plug-On Circuit Breakers Homeline™ Circuit Breakers
Class 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us

LOAD CENTERS
Homeline Plug-On Circuit Breakers
The Square D Homeline circuit breakers are in a 1 in. wide format for 1-pole circuit
breakers. They are designed to plug into Homeline load centers.

Table 1.45: HOM


Ampere 1P—120/240 Vac 2P—120/240 Vac Common Trip
Rating AIR
Cat. No. Cat. No.
 15 A 10 kA HOM115 [1][2] HOM215 [2]
 20 A 10 kA HOM120 [1][2] HOM220 [2]
 25 A 10 kA HOM125 [2] HOM225 [2]
 30 A 10 kA HOM130 [2] HOM230 [2]
 35 A 10 kA — HOM235 [2]
HOM 1P HOM 2P
1 Space Required 2 Spaces Required  40 A 10 kA HOM140 [2] HOM240 [2]
 45 A 10 kA — HOM245 [2]

1
 50 A 10 kA HOM150 [2] HOM250 [2]
 60 A 10 kA — HOM260 [2]
 70 A 10 kA — HOM270 [2]
 80 A 10 kA — HOM280 [2]
 90 A 10 kA — HOM290 [2]
100 A 10 kA — HOM2100 [2]
110 A 10 kA — HOM2110 [2]
125 A 10 kA — HOM2125 [2]
150 A 10 kA — HOM2150BB [2][3]
175 A 10 kA — HOM2175BB [2][3]
HOM2200BB
Branch Circuit Breaker 200 A 10 kA — HOM2200BB [2][3]
4 Spaces Required
Homeline High Magnetic (HM) Circuit Breakers
High magnetic trip circuit breakers are recommended for applications where high initial
inrush current may occur.

Table 1.46: HOM-HM


Amperes 1P—120/240 Vac 2Ps
15 A HOM115HM [4] —
20 A HOM120HM [4] —

Homeline Combination Arc Fault Circuit Interruptors (HOM-CAFI)


Homeline Combination Arc Fault Circuit Interrupters—Provide overload and short circuit
protection, plus arc fault protection in accordance with the NEC and UL1699.

Table 1.47: HOM-CAFI


Circuit Breaker Type Ampere Rating Poles
Cat. No.
120 Vac
One-Pole
Combination Arc-Fault Circuit 15 A 1 HOM115CAFI [4]
Interrupter with Pigtail Neutral 20 A 1 HOM120CAFI [4]
Plug-On Neutral Combination 15 A 1 HOM115PCAFI [4]
Arc-Fault Interrupter 20 A 1 HOM120PCAFI [4]
Two-Pole
HOM 1P CAFI HOM 1P CAFI Combination Arc-Fault Circuit 15 A 2 HOM215CAFI [4] [5]
Plug-on Neutral Pigtail Interrupter with Pigtail Neutral 20 A 2 HOM220CAFI [4] [5]

Homeline Dual Function Circuit Breaker (HOM-DF)


Homeline Combination Arc Fault and Ground Fault Circuit Interrupters (Dual Function)—
Provide overload and short circuit protection, plus arc fault and ground fault protection in
a single device in accordance with the NEC, UL1699 and UL943.

Table 1.48: HOM-DF


Ampere Poles
Circuit Breaker Type Cat. No.
Rating 120 Vac
Combination Arc-Fault and Ground Fault Circuit 15 A 1 HOM115DF [4]
Interrupter with Pigtail Neutral 20 A 1 HOM120DF [4]
Plug-On Neutral Combination 15 A 1 HOM115PDF [4]
Arc-Fault and Ground Fault
Circuit Interrupter 20 A 1 HOM120PDF [4]
HOM 1P DF HOM 1P DF
Plug-on Neutral Pigtail

[1] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated. Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[2] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[3] Requires four spaces (1 AWG–300 kcmil Al/Cu). Use only in 1Ø panel rated 150 A or greater.
[4] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[5] For 120/240 V only, not for 208Y/120 V.
1-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Homeline™ Circuit Breakers Plug-On Circuit Breakers
Class 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
1

schneider-electric.us

Homeline GFI (HOM-GFI)


HOM-GFI circuit breakers provide overload and short circuit protection, combined with
Class A ground fault protection. Class A denotes a ground fault circuit interrupter that will
trip when a fault current to ground is 6 milliamperes or more.

Table 1.49: HOM-GFI


LOAD CENTERS

Ampere 1P—120 Vac 2P—120/240 Vac


Rating AIR Common Trip
1 Space Required
2 Spaces Required
15 A 10 kA HOM115GFI HOM215GFI
20 A 10 kA HOM120GFI HOM220GFI
30 A 10 kA — HOM230GFI
40 A 10 kA — HOM240GFI
HOM 2P GFI
(With Ground Fault 50 A 10 kA — HOM250GFI
HOM 1P GFI
(With Ground Fault Circuit Interrupter)
Circuit Interrupter) 2 Spaces Required
1 Space Required

Homeline Equipment Protection Device (HOM-EPD)


Homeline Equipment Protection Device—Circuit Breakers with 30 mA Equipment
Ground Fault Protection (UL Listed).

Table 1.50: HOM-EPD—10 k AIR


2P—120/240 Vac
Amperes 1P—120 Vac Common Trip
15 A HOM115EPD HOM215EPD
20 A HOM120EPD HOM220EPD
25 A — HOM225EPD
30 A — HOM230EPD
40 A — HOM240EPD
50 A — HOM250EPD

HOMT Tandem and HOMT Quad Tandem Circuit Breakers


Table 1.51: HOMT Tandem Circuit Breakers
Ampere Rating [6] AIR 1P Tandem—120/240 Vac (One Space Required)
15 and 15 A 10 kA HOMT1515 [7]
15 and 20 A 10 kA HOMT1520 [7]
20 and 20 A 10 kA HOMT2020 [7]
30 and 15 A 10 kA HOMT3015 [7]
30 and 20 A 10 kA HOMT3020 [7]

Table 1.52: HOMT Quad Tandem Circuit Breakers


Ampere Rating [6] 2P Tandem—120/240 Vac (Two Spaces
AIR Required)
1P 2P
(2) 15 A 15 A 10 kA HOMT1515215 [7]
(2) 15 A 20 A 10 kA HOMT1515220 [7]
(2) 15 A 25 A 10 kA HOMT1515225 [7]
(2) 15 A 30 A 10 kA HOMT1515230 [7]
HOMT Quad (2) 15 A 40 A 10 kA HOMT1515240 [7]
Circuit Breaker (2) 15 A 50 A 10 kA HOMT1515250 [7]
2 Spaces Required (2) 20 A HOMT2020220 [7]
20 A 10 kA
(2) 20 A 25 A 10 kA HOMT2020225 [7]
(2) 20 A 30 A 10 kA HOMT2020230 [7]
(2) 20 A 40 A 10 kA HOMT2020240 [7]
(2) 20 A 50 A 10 kA HOMT2020250 [7]
NOTE: Typical catalog number (e.g. HOMT 1515230) represents two 1P, outer poles
(two 15 A 1P CBs) and one 2P inner circuit breaker with common trip (one 30 A 2P
CB).

[6] 15– 20 A tandem or quad tandem circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 25– 50 A tandem or quad tandem circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC
conductors only.
[7] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
1-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Plug-On Circuit Breakers Homeline™ Circuit Breakers
Class 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us

HOM Plug-On Neutral Load Centers with Qwik-Grip


Qwik grip simplifes rough-in by elimininating the need for most knockout removals and
eliminates the use of most box connectors. With a quick bend of the NM-B wire using the

LOAD CENTERS
wire bend guide on the Qwik-Grip insert, the wire easily slides into the slot. Solution is UL
listed.

HOM Plug-on Neutral


Load Center with Qwik-Grip

Table 1.53: HOM Plug-on Neutral Load Centers with Qwik-Grip


Max. Load Center
Box, Interior, Cover and Branch Circuit Main Wire Size AWG/kcmil Equipment Box
Spaces Max. 1P Tandem
Main Circuits Circuit Breakers Ground Bar Kit No.

1
Ratings Cat. No.
Breakers Cat. No. Al Cu
HOM2448L125PQGC 6–2/0 6–1/0 PK15GTAL 8Q
24 48 24 Included
125 A
HOM3060L125PQGC PK23GTAL 10Q
30 60 30 6–2/0 6–2/0 Included
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs, 10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating— QOM2 Main Frame Size, Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker
PK15GTAL
I HOM3060L225PQGC and  10Q
30 60 30 4–250
N PK15GTA
D Included
225 A
O PK15GTAL
O HOM4080L225PQGC and  12Q
40 80 40 4–250
R PK15GTA
Included
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker, 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating— QOM2 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size, Convertible to Main Lugs or Main Circuit Breaker
PK23GTA
30 60 30 HOM3060M200PQC 4–250 (Order seperately) 10Q
200 A
PK27GTA
40 80 40 HOM4080M200PQC 4–250 (Order seperately) 12Q

Homeline Circuit Breaker Wire Sizes


Table 1.54: Circuit Breaker Wire Sizes
Wire Size (AWG/kcmil) [8]
Breaker Type Ampere Rating
Aluminum Copper
14–8 AWG or
HOM 15–30 A 14–8 AWG (2) 14–10 AWG
1P
40–50 A 8–2 AWG 8–2 AWG
14–8 AWG or
15–30 A 14–8 AWG (2) 14–10 AWG
HOM 35–70 A 8–2 AWG 8–2 AWG
2P
 80–125 A 4–2/0 AWG 4–2/0 AWG
150–200 A 4 AWG–300 kcmil 4 AWG–300 kcmil
HOMT and Quad 15–30 A 14–8 AWG 14–8 AWG
Quad Only 40–50 A 6–12 AWG 6–14 AWG
HOM-GFI - 1P 15–20 A 14–10 AWG 14–10 AWG
HOM-GFI - 2P 15–50 A 12–4 AWG 14–6 AWG

Accessories for Homeline Circuit Breakers


Table 1.55: Accessories
Description Cat. No.
Handle Attachments
Handle Tie: Converts any two adjacent 120/240 Vac single HOM circuit breakers to independent trip 2P HOM1HT
Handle Tie: Converts any two adjacent 120/240 Vac
1P side-by-side HOMT circuit breakers to independent trip 2P HOMTHT
Handle Clamp: Clamp for holding HOM 1P handle in the ON or OFF position QO1LO
Handle Blocking Device: Attaches to standard HOM 2P circuit breakers for holding the handle in the OFF position HOM2HBD
Handle Padlock Attachment: For padlocking 1P Standard HOM breakers in the ON or OFF position HOM1PA
15–70 A HOM2PALA
Handle Padlock Attachment: For
padlocking 2P Standard HOM circuit breakers in ON or OFF position 80–125 A HOM2PAHA
150–200 A HOM2PAVHA
Handle Padlock Attachment: For padlocking 1P CAFI, DF, GFI, and EPD HOM breakers in ON or OFF position HOMELEC1PA
Handle Padlock Attachment: For padlocking 2P CAFI, GFI, and EPD HOM breakers in ON or OFF position HOMELEC2PALA
Handle Padlock Attachment: For padlocking center poles of Homeline Quad breakers in the OFF position HOMQPA
50–125 A QOM1PA [9]
Handle Padlock Attachment: For padlocking main circuit breakers in convertible load center in OFF position
100–225 A QOM2PA [9]
Sub-Feed Lugs
125 A 2P plug-on—2 spaces required HOML2125
225 A 2P plug-on—4 spaces required HOML2225 [10]

[8] 15–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 40–125 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[9] 50–125 A QOM1 frame size; 100–225 A QOM2 frame size.
[10] Requires four spaces (1 AWG–300 kcmil Al/Cu). Use only in 1Ø panel rated 150 A or greater.
1-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ and Homeline™ Load Centers Indoor, Dimensions and Knockouts
Class 1130, 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
1

schneider-electric.us

Indoor Knockout Information and Enclosure Dimensions


Table 1.56: Enclosure Dimensions
Dimensions Dimensions
Box W H D Box W H D
No. No.
LOAD CENTERS

in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm


1  3.81  97  6.72 171 3.00 76 13  5.88 149 13.12  333 3.38  86
2  4.81 122  9.30 236 3.19 81 14 14.25 362 20.92  531 3.75  95
3  4.81 122  9.30 236 3.19 81 15 20.00 508 50.00 1270 5.75 146
 4  8.88 226 12.57 319 3.80 97 16 20.00 508 62.00 1727 5.75 146
 5 14.25 362 14.92 379 3.75 95 17 20.00 508 53.00 1346 5.75 146
 6 14.25 362 17.92 455 3.75 95 18  5.88 149 16.12 409 3.38  86
 7 14.25 362 20.92 531 3.75 95 19  7.56 192 23.12 587 4.25 108
8 14.25 362 26.04 661 3.75 95 20  9.62 244 26.12 663 4.75 121
 9 14.25 362 29.86 758 3.75 95 21 8.88 226 14.80 376 3.80 97
10 14.25 362 33.78 858 3.75 95 22 8.55 217 23.92 608 3.95 100
11 14.25 362 37.98 965 3.75 95 23 14.25 362 29.86 758 3.75  95
12 14.25 362 39.37 1000 3.75 95 24 14.25 362 43.15 1096 3.75 95
B,C,D,E 25 14.25 362 48.50 1235 3.75 95

Table 1.57: Knockout Information


Knockouts
Symbol A B C D E F G H I
Conduit
1/2 3/4 1 1-1/4 1-1/2 2 2-1/2 3 3-1/2
Size

D,E,F,G

D,E,F,G

B,C,D ,E

B,C,D ,E

B,C,D ,E

D,E,F,G D,E,F,G

D,E,F,G
C,D,E ,F

1-24
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Indoor, Dimensions and Knockouts QO™ and Homeline™ Load Centers
Class 1130, 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us

Table 1.58: Indoor knockout information and Enclosure Dimensions for Qwik Grip
Loadcenters
Dimensions

LOAD CENTERS
W H D
Box No.
in. mm in. mm in. mm
 7Q 14.25 362 20.92  531 3.75 95
 8Q 14.25 362 26.04  661 3.75 95
 9Q 14.25 362 29.86  758 3.75 95
 10Q 14.25 362 33.78  858 3.75 95
11Q 14.25 362 37.98  965 3.75 95
12Q 14.25 362 39.37  1000 3.75 95

A,B A C,D,E,F D,E,F,G


A,B
A,B C,D,E,F A,B,C
A C,D,E,F B,C,D,E
A,B D,E,F,G
D,E,F,G
C,D,E,F A,B,C
A,B A C,D,E,F A,B
B,C
A,B,C
C,D,E,F
B,C,D,E

A,B A,B

1
A,B

A A

A,B,C,D A,B,C,D A,B,C,D


B,C,D,E D,E,F,G
C,D,E,F

Box 7Q Box 8Q Box 9Q


A,B A C,D,E,F D,E,F,G
A,B A C,D,E,F D,E,F,G A,B
B,C,D,E
C,D,E,F A,B A,B,C
A,B A,B,C D,E,F,G
A C,D,E,F D,E,F,G A,B D,E,F,G
D,E,F,G D,E,F,G
C,D,E,F
A,B,C
D,E,F,G D,E,F,G B,G
B,C

B,C
A,B

A,B
A,B
A

A
A

A,B,C,D A,B,C,D D,E,F,G A,B,C,D


D,E,F,G D,E,F,G
C,D,E,F C,D,E,F C,D,E,F

Box 10Q Box 11Q Box 12Q

1-25
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Combination Service Entrance Devices Rainproof, Dimensions, Knockouts and
Bolt-on Hubs
1

Class 1130, 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501 schneider-electric.us

Enclosure Dimensions and Knockout Information


Table 1.59: Enclosure Dimensions
Dimensions
W H D
Box No.
LOAD CENTERS

in. mm in. mm in. mm


 1NM 6.52 166 8.79 223 3.90 99
 1R [1]  4.88 124  9.38  238 4.00 102
 2R  8.88 226 12.65  321 4.27 108
 3R 14.75 375 18.92  481 4.52 115
 4R 14.75 375 22.06  560 4.52 115
 5R 14.75 375 26.04  661 4.52 115
 6R 14.75 375 29.86  758 4.52 115
 7R 14.75 375 33.78  858 4.52 115
 8R 14.75 375 37.98  965 4.52 115
9R  4.56 116  6.50  165 3.88 99
10R  6.92 176 13.18  335 4.12 105
11R  7.56 192 23.24  590 4.75 121
12R  9.62 244 26.24  666 5.50 140
13R  6.92 176 16.18  411 4.12 105
14R 14.75 375 39.37 1000 4.52 115
15R 8.88 226 14.80 376 4.27 108
16R 8.55 217 24.75 629 4.16 106
17R 8.88 226 12.65 321 4.27 108

Table 1.60: Knockout Information


Knockouts
Symbol A B C D E F G H
Conduit Size 1/2 in. 3/4 in. 1 in. 1-1/4 in. 1-1/2 in. 2 in. 2-1/2 in. 3 in.

Bolt-On Hubs
Square D equipment with “R’’ or “RB’’ suffix, designated NEMA 3R rainproof
construction, utilizes bolt-on hubs listed below. “RB’’ devices will accept 3/4 in. through 2-
1/2 in. bolt-on hubs without the use of reducers. Off-center conduit thread openings and
elongated mounting holes provide quick and easy adjustment to eliminate costly conduit
offsets and bends. Catalog suffix “R’’ devices require 3 in. through 4 in. field cut opening.
Hubs are suitable for use with conduit having ANSI standard taper pipe thread.

Table 1.61: Bolt-On Hubs UL Listed for “RB” Devices


Conduit Size 3/4 in. 1 in. 1-1/4 in. 1-1/2 in. 2 in. 2-1/2 in.
Hub Cat. No. B075 B100 B125 B150 B200 B250
NOTE: Closing cap (Cat. No. BCAP) is provided factory-installed on each device having “RB’’ suffix.

Table 1.62: Bolt-On Hubs UL Listed for Mounting in Field-Cut Opening


Conduit Size 3 in. 4 in.
Designed for mounting in field cut opening. Includes
Hub Cat. No. B300 B400 gasket and four mounting bolts and nuts.

[1] HOME250SPA and QO260NATR top endwall has no hub opening.


1-26
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Rainproof, Meter Mains Combination Service Entrance Devices
Class 4119, 4120
schneider-electric.us

Catalog Number Logic for CSED


Table 1.63: Catalog Numbers for Combination Service Entrance Devices
Number Segment Character Description R Q C 8 16 D 200 C H X S

LOAD CENTERS
Q QO Ringless
R HOM Ringless
Socket Type
C QO Ring type
S HOM Ring type
Blank Field Installed
Service Disconnect Install
Q Factory Installed
Blank Combination overhead/underground
C Combination overhead/underground
O Overhead only
Service Feed
U Underground only
RA “A” Hub provision in top endwall
RB “B” Hub provision in top endwall
Spaces (Service Discounts # Maximum # of 1-pole circuits
or Branches) # Maximum # of 1-pole spaces

1
D Dual main service disconnects (feed-thru lugs on meter mains only)
F Single main service disconnect with feed-thru lugs
Interior
L Main lug interior (service disconnects field installed)
M Single main service disconnect
100 100 A
125 125 A
150 150 A
Amperage Rating
200 200 A
225 225 A
400 400 A
C Surface mount or convertible to semi-flush (use appropriate flange kit)
F Semi-flush mount only
R Reverse mount only
Enclosure Mounting Style
S Surface mount only
PF Home PoN semi-flush mount device
PS Home PoN surface mount device
H Horn by-pass
K K-4 bolt-on, no by-pass
L Class 320 with lever by-pass
Meter Socket Bypass Type N Class 320, No by-pass
B Class 320 with test block by-pass
Blank No by-pass
X 2 piece lever by-pass cover
S Solar ready
Application FMG Florida Meter Group
MEG Meter Equipment Group
This table is for interpreting existing part number only. All possible combinations are not
available.

1-27
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Combination Service Entrance Devices Rainproof, Meter Mains
Class 4119, 4120
1

schneider-electric.us

Rainproof Meter Mains


Table 1.64: Rainproof Meter Mains
Load Center and Branch Line
Service Disconnect(s) Circuit Breakers

Hub Type (Order


Side Service Weight
Ampere Rating

Current Rating
Service (Order separately [1])

separately [2])
Main Ground Each
Bypass Type

Short Circuit
(Type of Feed)

Rating Max.

Rating Max.
Max. Quantity Lugs Lug (Lbs)
LOAD CENTERS

Cat. No. AWG/ AWG/ and


2P Type 1P

Ampere

Ampere
Spaces
Circuits (Order kcmil kcmil Pallet
UL and (Al/ (Al/Cu) Qty.
UL EU- (Max.) separately [3]) Circuits Tan-
dems Cu)
SERC
Ring Type, QOTM
Surface Mount Only
125 A None OH/UG — 10 kA C125RB 1 QOM1-VH 125 A — — — — B 4–1/0 8–1/0 15, 54
OH/UG — 22 kA CM200S 1 QOM2-VH 200 A — — — — A 4–250 (2)8–2/0 26, 24
— 1 QOM2-VH 200 A — — — — (2)8–2/0
200 A None OH/UG 22 kA C2M200S A 4–250 27, 20
— 1 QO-VH  50 A — — — —
OH/UG — 10 kA C4L200S 2 QO 100 A — — — — A 4–250 (2)8–2/0 27, 28
Ring Type, HomelineTM
Surface Mount Only
125
125 A None OH/UG OH/UG 10 kA SC8L125S 4 HOM A [4] — — — — A 6–2/0 6–2/0 31, 24
200 A
200 A None OH/UG OH/UG 10 kA SC12L200S 6 HOM [5] — — — — A–L 4–250 8–2/0 40, 10
Semiflush Mount only
A or 37, 20
125 A None OH/UG OH/UG 10 kA SC8L125F 4 HOM 110 A — — — — 6–2/0 6–2/0
B300
OH [6]/ OH [6]/ 200 A
None 10 kA SC12L200F 6 HOM [7] — — — — A–L 4–250 8–2/0 47, 10
UG UG
200 A
OH [6]/ OH [6]/ QOM2200VH 200 A
None 22 kA SC816F200F [8] 1 200 A 8 16 8 A–L 4–250 8–2/0 51, 10
UG UG [4] [7]
Surface Mount—Supplied with Feed-Thru Lugs and provisions for Branch Circuit Breakers
SC816F150S [8] QOM2150VH 150 A
OH/UG 22 kA 1 [9] 150 A 8 16 8 [10] A–L 4–250 8–2/0 40, 10
150 A None OH/UG SC816D150C [8] [11]
— 1 HOM2150 [9] 150 A 100 A
10 kA 8 16 8 [12] A or A–L 6–300 8–1/0 48, 18
UG SU816D150C [8] [11] 1 HOM  50 A

SC816F200S [8] QOM2200VH 200 A


OH/UG 22 kA 1 [9] 200 A 8 16 8 [13] A–L 4–250 8–2/0 40, 10
200 A None UG SC816D200C [8] [11] HOM2200 [9]
— 1 200 A 100 A
10 kA 8 16 8 [12] A or A–L 6–300 8–1/0 48, 18
UG SU816D200C [8] [11] 1 HOM  50 A
Ringless, QOTM
Surface Mount Only
None 22 kA RC200S [14] 1 QOM2-VH 200 A A 6–350 (2)8–2/0 26, 24
Lever 10 kA RCM200SL [14] [15] 1 QOM2-VH 200 A A 6–350 8-1/0 60 / 14
None RC2M200S [14] 1 QOM2-VH 200 A A 6–350 (2)8–2/0 27, 20
22 kA QO-VH  50 A
Horn RC2M200SH [14] 1 A 6–350 (2)8–2/0 27, 20
200 A OH/UG — 1 QOM2-VH 200 A — — — — 8-1/0
Lever 10 kA RC2M200SL [14] [15] A 6–350 60 / 14
1 QO-VH 50 A 8-1/0
QC12L200S [14] [15]
None 22 kA [16] 6 QO-VH 200 A A 6–350 8–2/0 43, 21
200 A
None 22 kA QC12L200C [14] 6 QO-VH [7] A 6–350 12-2/0 40, 21
Surface Mount Only, Supplied with Feed-Thru Lugs and provisions for Branch Circuit Breakers
QC816F100SH [8][14] QOM2100VH
100 A Horn OH/UG — 22 kA [15] [16] 1 [9] 100 A 8 16 8 100 A 6–350 8–2/0 43, 21
QC816F100CH [8] [14] QOM2100VH
100 A Horn OH/UG — 22 kA [15] 1 [9] 100 A 8 16 8 100 A 6–350 12-2/0 40, 21
QC816F125S [8][14] QOM2125VH
None OH/UG — 22 kA [15] 1 [9] 125 A 8 16 8 100 A 6–350 8–2/0 43, 21
QOM2125VH
125 A None OH/UG — 22 kA QC816F125C [8][14] 1 [9] 125 A 8 16 8 100 A 6–350 12-2/0 40, 21
QC816F125SH [8][14] QOM2125VH
Horn OH/UG — 22 kA [15] [16] 1 [9] 125 A 8 16 8 100 A 6–350 8–2/0 43, 21
QC816F150S [8][14] QOM2150VH 150 A
None OH/UG — 22 kA [15] [16] 1 [9] 150 A 8 16 8 [17] A 6–350 8–2/0 43, 21
QOM2150VH 150 A
None OH/UG — 22 kA QC816F150C [8][14] 1 [9] 150 A 8 16 8 [17] A 6–350 12-2/0 40, 21
150 A
QC816F150SH [8][14] QOM2150VH 150 A
Horn OH/UG — 22 kA [15] [16] 1 [9] 150 A 8 16 8 [17] A 6–350 8–2/0 43, 21
QC816F150SL [18] QOM2150-VH
Lever OH/UG — 22 kA [14] [15] [16] 1 [9] 200 A 8 16 8 150 A A 6–350 8-2/0 74 / 12

[1] To order branch circuit breakers, see QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers, page 1-10
[2] To order hubs, see Accessories and Hubs for CSEDs, page 1-33
[3] To order service disconnects, see Circuit Breakers for CSEDs, page 1-32 except as noted)
[4] Service disconnect supplied factory-installed.
[5] Use only 15–110 A and 150–200 A breakers.
[6] Suitable for OH service with addition of tunnel kit (SCTK20). Order separately.
[7] Use only 15–100 A and 150–200 A circuit breakers.
[8] Supplied with load side feed-thru lugs, for 4 AWG–250 kcmil (Al/Cu) conductors.
[9] Service disconnect supplied factory-installed.
[10] Use only 15–110 A and 150 A breakers.
[11] Convertible to semiflush with SC200F flange kit (order separately).
[12] A 100 A circuit breaker can be installed in bottom position only, all other positions are limited to 70 A max.
[13] Use only 15–110 A and 150–200 A breakers.
[14] Device supplied with barrel lock provisions factory-installed.
[15] 5th jaw factory-installed.
[16] Suitable for load wires to exit top endwall with addition of Tunnel Kit OHBS, see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33, check with local utility for approval.
[17] Use only 15–100 A and 150 A circuit breakers.
[18] Supplied with load side feed-thru lugs, for 4 AWG–250 kcmil (Al/Cu) conductors.
1-28
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Rainproof, Meter Mains Combination Service Entrance Devices
Class 4119, 4120
schneider-electric.us

Table 1.64 Rainproof Meter Mains (cont'd.)


Load Center and Branch Line
Service Disconnect(s) Circuit Breakers

Hub Type (Order


Side Service Weight

separately [20])
Ampere Rating

Current Rating
Service (Order separately [19])

LOAD CENTERS
Main Ground Each
Bypass Type

Short Circuit
(Type of Feed)

Rating Max.

Rating Max.
Max. Quantity Lugs Lug (Lbs)
Cat. No. Type AWG/ AWG/ and
2P 1P

Ampere

Ampere
(Order

Spaces
Circuits kcmil kcmil Pallet
UL and separately (Al/ (Al/Cu) Qty.
UL EU- (Max.) Circuits Tan-
[21]) dems Cu)
SERC
QC816F200S [22] [23] QOM2200VH 200 A
None OH/UG — 22 kA [24] [25] 1 [26] 200 A 8 16 8 [27] A 6–350
8–2/0 43, 21
QC816F200SH [22] QOM2200VH 200 A
Horn OH/UG — 22 kA [23] [24] [25] 1 [26] 200 A 8 16 8 [27] A 6–350
200 A
QC816F200CH [22] QOM2200VH 200 A
Horn OH/UG — 22 kA [23] 1 [26] 200 A 8 16 8 [27] A 6–350 12-2/0 40, 21
QC816F200SL [22] QOM2200-VH
Lever OH/UG — 22 kA [23] [24] [25] 1 [26] 200 A 8 16 8 200 A A 6–350 8–2/0 74 / 12
Ringless, HomelineTM
Surface Mount Only
125 A

1
125 A None OH/UG — 10 kA RC8L125S [28] 4 HOM — — — — A 6–2/0 6–2/0 27, 32
[29]
RC12L200S [23] [24] 200 A
200 A None OH/UG — 10 kA [25] 6 HOM [27] — — — — A 6–350 8–2/0 43, 21

RC12L200C [23] 200 A


200 A None OH/UG — 22 kA 6 HOM [27] — — — — A 6–350 12-2/0 40, 21
Surface Mount Only, Supplied with Feed-Thru Lugs and provisions for Branch Circuit Breakers
RC816F100SH [22] QOM2100VH
100 A Horn OH/UG — 22 kA [23] [24] [25] 1 [26] 100 A 8 16 8 100 A 8–2/0 43, 21
RC816F100CH[22] QOM2100VH
100 A Horn OH/UG — 22 kA [23] [24] 1 [26] 100 A 8 16 8 100 A 12-2/0 40, 21
RC816F125SH [22] QOM2125VH
125 A Horn OH/UG — 22 kA [24] [25] 1 [26] 125 A 8 16 8 100 A 8–2/0 43, 21
RC816F125CH [22] QOM2125VH
125 A Horn OH/UG — 22 kA [23] 1 [26] 125 A 8 16 8 100 A 12-2/0 40, 21
RC816F150S [22] QOM2150VH 150 A
None OH/UG — 22 kA [23] [25] 1 [26] 150 A 8 16 8 [30] 8–2/0 43, 21
QOM2150VH 150 A
None OH/UG — 22 kA RC816F150C [22] [23] 1 [26] 150 A 8 16 8 [30] 12-2/0 40, 21
RC816F150SH [22] QOM2150VH 150 A
150 A Horn OH/UG — 22 kA [23] [24] [25] 1 [26] 150 A 8 16 8 [30] 8–2/0 43, 21
6–350
RC816F150CH [22] QOM2150VH 150 A
Horn OH/UG — 22 kA [23] [24] 1 [26] 150 A 8 16 8 [30] A 12-2/0 40, 21
RC816F150SL [23] QOM2150-VH
Lever OH/UG — 22 kA [24] [31] 1 [26] 200 A 8 16 8 150 A 8-2/0 72 / 12
RC816F200S [22] [23] QOM2200VH 200 A
None OH/UG — 22 kA [24] [25] 1 [26] 200 A 8 16 8 [27] 8–2/0 43, 21
QOM2200VH 200 A
None OH/UG — 22 kA RC816F200C [22] [23] 1 200 A 8 16 8 12-2/0 40, 21
[26] [27]
RC816F200SH[22] QOM2200VH 200 A
200 A Horn OH/UG — 22 kA [23] [24] [25] 1 [26] 200 A 8 16 8 [27] 8–2/0 43, 21
RC816F200CH [22] QOM2200VH 200 A
Horn OH/UG — 22 kA [23] [24] 1 [26] 200 A 8 16 8 [27] 12-2/0 40, 21
RC816F200SL [22] QOM2200-VH
Lever OH/UG — 22 kA [23] [24] [31] 1 [26] 200 A 8 16 8 200 A 8-2/0 72 / 12
RC816D200CH [32] 1 HOM2200 [26] 200 A 100 A
200 A Horn OH/UG — 10 kA [22] [24] [28] 8 16 8 [33] 6–300 6–1/0 48, 18
1 HOM  50 A

[19] To order branch circuit breakers, see QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers, page 1-10
[20] To order hubs, see Accessories and Hubs for CSEDs, page 1-33
[21] To order service disconnects, see Circuit Breakers for CSEDs, page 1-32 except as noted)
[22] Supplied with load side feed-thru lugs, for 4 AWG–250 kcmil (Al/Cu) conductors.
[23] Device supplied with barrel lock provisions factory-installed.
[24] 5th jaw factory-installed.
[25] Suitable for load wires to exit top endwall with addition of Tunnel Kit OHBS, see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33, check with local utility for approval.
[26] Service disconnect supplied factory-installed.
[27] Use only 15–100 A and 150–200 A circuit breakers.
[28] Knockout provided in cover for use with barrel lock kit SCBRLLOCK (see Accessories).
[29] 125 A Homeline™ 2P circuit breaker can be installed in top position only. All other positions are limited to 100 A max.
[30] Use only 15–100 A and 150 A circuit breakers.
[31] Suitable for load wires to exit top endwall with addition of Tunnel Kit OHBL, see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33, check with local utility for approval.
[32] Convertible to semiflush with SC200F flange kit (order separately).
[33] A 100 A circuit breaker can be installed in bottom position only, all other positions are limited to 70 A max.
1-29
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Combination Service Entrance Devices Rainproof, All-In-Ones, 100 to 225 A
Maximum
1

Class 4120 schneider-electric.us

Meter Mains and All-In-Ones (100 to 225 A Maximum)


• Ring or ringless type meter socket designs available • Service disconnect(s) are supplied factory-installed, except
where noted
• Supplied with 100% branch neutrals, all unused terminals
may be used for equipment grounding wires.
• UL Listed, suitable only for use as service equipment
• Semiflush-reverse design available, supplied with load
• Meets Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2
• Meets EUSERC standards center (indoor access)
LOAD CENTERS

Table 1.65: All-In-One Combination Service Entrance Devices


Load Center and Branch

(Order separately )
Circuit Breakers Line
Service Weight
Ampere Rating

Current Rating
Service Service Disconnect(s) (Order separately [34]) Side Ground Each

Hub Type [35]


Bypass Type

Short Circuit

(Type Main

Rating Max.
Cat. No. Max. Quantity Lug (Lbs)
of Feed) Lugs
(DE3A) 1P AWG/ and
UL and AWG/

Ampere
Spaces
kcmil kcmil Pallet
EUSERC 2P Type Ampere (Al/Cu) Qty.
Circuits (Factory Circuits Tan- (Al/Cu)
Rating dems
(Max.) Installed) Max.
Ring Type, Homeline™

Surface Mount Only
100 A None OH/UG 10 kA SC1624M100S 1 HOM2100 100 A 16 24 8 100 A
125 A A 6–2/0 6–2/0 32, 24
125 A None OH/UG 10 kA SC1624M125S 1 HOM2125 125 A 16 24 8 [36]
200 A
200 A None OH/UG 22 kA SC2040M200S 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 [37] A-L 4–250 6–2/0 45, 10

200 A None OH/UG 10 kA SC2040M200C [38] 1 HOM2200 200 A 20 40 20 100 A A or 6–300 8–1/0 47, 18
A-L
200 A None UG 10 kA SU2040M200C [38] 1 HOM2200 200 A 20 40 20 100 A A or 6–300 8–1/0 47, 18
A-L
Semiflush Mount Only
100 A None OH/UG 10 kA SC1624M100F 1 HOM2100 100 A 16 24 8 100 A A or
B30- 6–2/0 6–2/0 44, 20
OH/UG 10 kA SC1624M125F 1 HOM2125 125 A 16 24 8 110 A 0
125 A None
OH[39]/UG 22 kA SC2040M125F 1 QOM2125VH 125 A 20 40 20 110 A
200 A A-L 4–250 8–2/0 51, 10
OH[39]/UG 22 kA SC2040M200F 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 [37]
200 A None SC2636M200FPV [41] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 26 36 10 100 A
OH[40]/UG 22 kA
SC3040M200F 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 30 40 10 200 A
A-L 4–250 8–2/0 56, 10
SC3040M225F 1 QOM2225VH 225 A 30 40 10 200 A
225 A None OH[40]/UG 22 kA
SC2636M225FPV [41] 1 QOM2225VH 225 A 26 36 10 100 A
Surface Mount Only
100 A None OH[42] SO1020M100S 10 kA 1 HOM2100 100 A 10 20 10 80 A A 6–1 8–4 20, 42
200 A None OH[42] SO2040M200S 22 kA 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A A 6–350 8–2/0 43, 21
SC3040M200S 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 30 40 10 200 A 4–250 8–2/0 50, 10
200 A None OH/UG 22 kA A-L
SC40M200S 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 40 40 0 200 A 4–250 8–2/0 52, 10
REVERSE All-In-One—Semiflush Mount with Service Disconnect (outdoor access) and Load Center (indoor access)
200 A None UG 10 kA SU3040M200R 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 200 A A or
30 40 10 [37] B30- 6–300 12–1/0 60, 15
225 A None UG 10 kA SU3040M225R 1 QOM2225VH 225 A 0
Ringless, Homeline
Surface Mount Only
100 A RC1624M100S 1 HOM2100 100 A 100 A
OH/UG
None [42] 10 kA 16 24 8  125 A 6–2/0 6–2/0 32, 24
125 A RC1624M125S 1 HOM2125 125 A [36]
125 A Horn OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M125SH [43] [44] 1 QOM2125VH 125 A 20 40 20 125 A 43, 21
125 A Horn OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M125CH [43][45] 1 QOM2125VH 125 A 20 40 20 125 A 40, 21
Horn OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M150SH [43] [44] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 20 40 20 150 A 43, 21
150 A Horn OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M150CH [43][45] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 20 40 20 150 A 40, 21
Lever OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC3040M150SL [46] 1 QOM2150VH [36] 200 A 30 40 10 150 A A 76 / 12
None OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M200S [43] [44] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A 6–350 8–2/0 43, 21
None OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M200C [43] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A 40, 21
Horn OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M200SH [43] [44] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A 43, 21
200 A
Horn OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M200CH [43] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A 40, 21
Lever OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC3040M200SL [46] 1 QOM2200VH [36] 200 A 30 40 10 200 A 76 / 12
None OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M200CGP 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A 48 / 21
Ringless, QO
Surface Mount Only
OH/UG[42] QC2442M150SH [43]
150 A Horn 22 kA [44] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 24 42 18 150 A 43, 21
None OH/UG[42] 22 kA QC2442M200S [43] [44] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 24 42 18 200 A 43, 21
None OH/UG[42] 22 kA QC2442M200C [43] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 24 42 18 200 A 40, 21
200 A QC2442M200SH [43] A 6–350 8–2/0
Horn OH/UG[42] 22 kA 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 24 42 18 200 A 43, 21
[44]
Horn OH/UG[42] 22 kA QC2442M200CH [43][45] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 24 42 18 200 A 40, 21
None OH/UG[42] 22 kA QC3040M200S [44] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 30 40 10 200 A 40, 21
200 A Hom OH/UG[42] 22 kA QC3040M200SH [44] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 30 40 10 200 A 40, 21

[34] To order branch circuit breakers, see QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers, page 1-10
[35] To order hubs, see Accessories and Hubs for CSEDs, page 1-33
[36] 125 A Homeline™ 2P circuit breaker can be installed in top position only. All other positions are limited to 100 A max.
[37] Use only 15–110 A and 150–200 A circuit breakers.
[38] Convertible to semiflush with SC200F flange kit (order separately).
[39] Suitable for OH service with addition of tunnel kit (SCTK20). Order separately.
[40] Suitable for OH service with addition of tunnel kit (SCTK30). Order separately.
[41] For use with Photovoltaic Systems. Provisions for field-installed CT. If required by adopted code, order retaining kit PK2SCPV separately, see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33.
[42] Device does not meet EUSERC Specifications.
[43] Device supplied with barrel lock provisions factory-installed.
[44] Suitable for load wires to exit top endwall with addition of Tunnel Kit OHBS, (see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33, check with local utility for approval.
[45] 5th jaw factory-installed.
[46] Suitable for load wires to exit top endwall with addition of Tunnel Kit OHBL, (see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33, check with local utility for approval.
1-30
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Rainproof, Meter Mains and All-In-Ones, Combination Service Entrance Devices
300–400 A
schneider-electric.us Class 4119, 4120

Meter Mains and All-in-Ones (300–400 A Devices)


Meter Mains and All-in-Ones

LOAD CENTERS
Service disconnects are supplied factory-installed, except where noted
• Ring or ringless type meter socket designs available
• Supplied with 100% branch neutrals; all unused terminals may be used for equipment
• UL Listed, suitable only for use as service equipment grounding wires
• Meets EUSERC standards where indicated. • Meets Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2
Meter Mains: Meets Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2, UL Listed,
suitable only for use as service equipment, 120/240 Vac, 1Ø3W, NEMA 3R Enclosure

Table 1.66: Meter Mains


Load Center and Branch

(Order separately [49])


Service Circuit Breakers
(Order separately [48]) Line
(Type Service Disconnect(s) [47] Side Service Weight
of Feed) Max. Quantity Main Ground Each
Ampere Rating

Current Rating

1P Lugs Lug (Lbs)


Bypass Type

Short Circuit

Cat. No.

Rating Max.
AWG/ AWG/ and
2P

Hub Type
kcmil kcmil Pallet
UL and Cir- Ampere

Ampere
Spaces
Tan- (Al/ (Al/Cu) Qty.

1
UL EU- cuits Type Rating Circuits Cu)
(Order separately (Max.) dems
SERC
(Max.) [50])
Ring Type, QO
Surface and Semiflush Mount [47]
CU12L400CN [51] 1 QDL22200 [52] 200 A — — — —
400 CU12L400FN [51] 1 QDL, QGL, QJL [53] 200 A — — — — (2)
None UG UG 25 kA A–L 4–250 98, 4
A QO, QO-VH or QOH Studs
4 125 A [55] — — — —
[54]
Class CU12L400CB [51] [56] 1 QDL22200 [52] 200 A — — — —
400 320 1 QDL, QGL, QJL [53] 200 A — — — — (2)
Manual UG — 25 kA A–L 4–250 98, 4
A CU12L400FB [51] [56] QO, QO-VH or QOH Studs
Bypass 4 125 A [55] — — — —
[54]
400 CU816D400CN [51] [57] QDL22200 [52] (2) 98, 4
None UG UG 25 kA A–L 4–250
A Studs
Class 200 A 8 16 8 200 A
1
400 320 CU816D400CB [51] [55] (2)
Manual UG — 25 kA QDL, QGL, QJL [53] A–L 4–250 98, 4
A [56] Studs
Bypass
Class
400 320 65 kA (2)
Manual UG — CUM400CB [51] [56] 1 LJL36400U31X [52] 400 A — 2 [58] — 200 A A–L 4–250 115, 4
A [47] Studs
Bypass
Ringless Type, QO
QDL22200 [52] 1 200 A — — — —
Class QDL, QGL, QJL [53]
400 QU12L400SL [59] [56] 1 200 A — — — — (2) 98, 4
320 UG — 25 kA A–L 4–250
A Lever QO, QO-VH or QOH Studs
4 125 A [55] — — — —
[54]
Surface Mount Only, Supplied with Feed-Thru Lugs and Provisions for Branch Circuit Breakers
QU816D400SL [55] [59] QDL22200 [52]
400 [60] [56] (2) 98, 4
UG — 25 kA 1 200 A 8 16 8 200 A A–L 4–250
A QU816D400CK [57] [56] QDL, QGL, QJL [53] Studs
Surface and Semiflush Mount [47]
1 QDL22200 [52] 200 A — — — —
400 QU12L400CL [59] [61] 1 QDL, QGL, QJL [53] 200 A — — — — (2)
UG — 25 kA [56] A–L 4–250 98, 4
A QO, QO-VH or QOH Studs
Class 4 125 A [55] — — — —
[54]
320
Lever QU816D400CL [59] [55]
1 QDL22200 [52]
400 [61] [56] (2)
UG — 25 kA 8 16 8 200 A A–L 4–250 98, 4
A QU816D400FL [59] [55] 200 A Studs
1 QDL, QGL, QJL [53]
[61] [56]
Class 65 kA
400 QUM400CL [59] [56] LJL36400U31X [52] 2 [58] (2) 120, 4
320 UG — [47] 1 400 A — — 200 A A–L 4–250
A Lever Studs
K-4 Bolt-
400 On 65kA (2)
UG — QUM400CK [51] [56] 1 LJL36400U31X [52] 400 A — 2 [58] — 200 A A–L 4–250 123, 4
A [47] Studs
None

[47] UL short circuit current rating is equal to the lowest interrupting rating of any circuit breaker installed.
[48] To order branch circuit breakers, see QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers, page 1-10
[49] To order hubs, see Accessories and Hubs for CSEDs, page 1-33
[50] To order service disconnects, see Circuit Breakers for CSEDs, page 1-32 except as noted)
[51] For use only on 120/240 Vac 1Ø3W system (4-jaw meter socket).
[52] Service disconnect supplied factory-installed.
[53] Additional service disconnect for field-installation: order prefix QBL at 10 kA, QDL at 25 kA, QGL at 65 kA, or QJL at 100 kA. Order separately. For complete circuit breaker catalog number,
see Digest Section 7.
[54] Order two pole circuit breakers for field installation: order catalog designation QO for 10 kA, QO-VH for 22 kA or QOH for 42 kA short circuit current rating. See Table 1.18 Plug-On Circuit
Breakers, page 1-10 or Table 1.68 Circuit Breakers for use with Meter Mains and All-In-One Devices, page 1-32.
[55] QO panel is rated 200 A maximum.
[56] Device configuration is not included in EUSERC standards. Consult applicable utility for acceptance.
[57] Supplied with load side feed-thru lugs for 6 AWG–250 kcmil (Al/Cu) conductors.
[58] Option for field installation of two Q-frame, 200 A max. 2-pole branch circuit breakers used as mains for two downstream load centers. Purchase installation kit BMK2Q400 and two Q-frame
circuit breakers separately. Order QBL prefix at 10 kA, QDL prefix at 25 kA, or QGL prefix at 65 kA.
[59] Fifth jaw factory-installed.
[60] Device with suffix L has Class 320 lever bypass and device with suffix K has a K-4 bolt-on, no bypass.
[61] Knockout provided in cover for use with barrel lock kit SCBRLLOCK (see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33).
1-31
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Combination Service Entrance Devices Circuit Breakers for CSEDs
Class 4119, 4120
1

schneider-electric.us

Table 1.67: All-in-One Combination Service Entrance Devices


Surface and Semiflush Mount[62]
Ring Type, Homeline
SU3040D300CB[63][64]
Class [65] 1
QDL22200 [66] 200 A (2) Studs
300 A 320 UG — 25 kA QDL, QGL, QJL [67] 30 40 10 200 A A–L 4–250 100, 4
SU3040D300FB[63][64] 100 A
Manual 1
LOAD CENTERS

[65]
SU3040D400CN[63][64] 1 QDL22200 [66] 200 A
400 A None UG UG 25 kA 30 40 10 200 A A–L (2) Studs 4–250 100, 4
SU3040D400FN[63][64] 1 QDL, QGL, QJL [67] 200 A
SU3040D400CB[63][64] QDL22200 [66]
Class [65] 1 200 A
400 A 320 UG — 25 kA 30 40 10 200 A A–L (2) Studs 4–250 100, 4
Manual SU3040D400FB[63][64]
1 QDL, QGL, QJL [67] 200 A
[65]
Ringless, Homeline
RU3040D400CL[64][68] QDL22200 [66]
Class [65] 1 200 A
400 A 320 UG — 25 kA 30 40 10 200 A A–L (2) Studs 4–250 100, 4
Lever RU3040D400FL[64][68]
1 QDL, QGL, QJL [67] 200 A
[65]
K-4 Bolt- RU3040D400CK[64][65] 1 QDL22200 [66] 200 A
400 A UG — 25 kA 30 40 10 200 A A–L (2) Studs 4–250 100, 4
on RU3040D400FK[64][65] 1 QDL, QGL, QJL [67] 200 A

Circuit Breakers for CSEDs


Table 1.68: Circuit Breakers for use with Meter Mains and All-In-One Devices
Ampere Type: HOM, 1P Type: HOM, 2P Type: QO, 1P Type: QO, 2P Type: QO-VH, 1P Type: QO-VH, 2P
Rating Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
[69] (DE3D) (DE3D) (DE2A) (DE2A) (DE2A) (DE2A)
10 — — QO110 — — —
15 HOM115 — QO115 — QO115VH —
20 HOM120 — QO120 — QO120VH —
25 HOM125 — QO125 — QO125VH —
30 HOM130 HOM230 QO130 QO230 QO130VH QO230VH
35 — HOM235 QO135 QO235 — —
40 HOM140 HOM240 QO140 QO240 — QO240VH
45 — HOM245 QO145 QO245 — —
50 HOM150 HOM250 QO150 QO250 — QO250VH
60 — HOM260 QO160 QO260 — QO260VH
70 — HOM270 QO170 QO270 — QO270VH
80 — HOM280 — QO280 — QO280VH
90 — HOM290 — QO290 — QO290VH
100 — HOM2100 — QO2100 — QO2100VH
110 — HOM2110 — QO2110 — QO2110VH
125 — HOM2125 — QO2125 — QO2125VH
150 — HOM2150BB — QO2150 — QO2150VH
175 — HOM2175BB — QO2175 — QO2175VH
200 — HOM2200BB — QO2200 — QO2200VH

Ampere Type: QOM1-VH, 2P Type: QOM2-VH, 2P Type: QDL, 2P [70]


Rating
[69] Cat. No. (DE3D) Cat. No. (DE3D) Cat. No. (DE2A)
50 QOM50VH [71] — —
60 QOM60VH — —
70 QOM70VH — QDL22070
80 QOM80VH — QDL22080
90 QOM90VH — QDL22090
100 QOM100VH QOM2100VH QDL22100
110 QOM110VH — QDL22110
125 QOM125VH QOM2125VH QDL22125
150 — QOM2150VH QDL22150
175 — QOM2175VH QDL22175
200 — QOM2200VH QDL22200
225 — QOM2225VH —

[62] UL short circuit current rating is equal to the lowest interrupting rating of any circuit breaker installed.
[63] For use only on 120/240 Vac 1Ø3W system (4-jaw meter socket).
[64] Knockout provided in cover for use with barrel lock kit SCBRLLOCK (see Accessories).
[65] Device configuration is not included in EUSERC standards. Consult applicable utility for acceptance.
[66] Service disconnect supplied factory-installed.
[67] Additional service disconnect for field-installation: order prefix QBL at 10 kA, QDL at 25 kA, QGL at 65 kA, or QJL at 100 kA. Order separately. For complete circuit breaker catalog number,
see Digest Section 7.
[68] 5th jaw factory-installed.
[69] Do not exceed mains rating of device
[70] For additional interrupting rating circuit breakers, order circuit breaker prefix QBL at 10 kA, QGL at 65 kA or QJL at 100 kA.
[71] Reference National Electrical Code Article 230-79.
1-32
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories and Hubs for CSEDs Combination Service Entrance Devices
Class 4119, 4120
schneider-electric.us

Table 1.69: Hubs and Closing Plates


Hub Conduit Size Disc.
(inches) Cat. No.
Series Sch.

LOAD CENTERS
Closing Plate for “A” Hub opening ACP DE4
1.00 A100 DE4
1.25 A125 DE4
A 1.50 A150 DE4
2.00 A200 DE4
2.50 A250 DE4
Adapter plate to allow use of “A”
Hubs on “A-L” size hub openings AAP DE4
Closing Plate for “A-L” Hub opening ACPL DE4
2.00 A200L [72] DE4
2.50 A250L DE4
A-L 3.00 A300L DE4
3.50 A350L DE4
4.00 A400L DE4
Closing Plate for “B” Hub opening BCAP DE1A
0.75 B075 DE1A

1
1.00 B100 DE1A
1.25 B125 DE1A
B
1.50 B150 DE1A
2.00 B200 DE1A
2.50 B250 DE1A
B300 3.00 B300 DE1A

Accessories and Hubs for CSEDs


Table 1.70: Accessories
Description Disc.
Cat. No. Sch.
Generator Kit: Interlocks main service disconnect and generator circuit breaker (order
separately). For :
Homeline™ CSED Devices RC816F-, RC2040M-, SO2040M- containing suffix -C or RCGK2 DE4
-CH QCGK3 DE4
QO CSED Devices QC816F-, QC2442M- containing suffix -C or -CH
Backfed inverter circuit breaker retaining kit for SC2636M200FPV and SC2636M225FPV PK2SCPV DE4
Meter Main Types: C, RC, SC, QC
Fifth Jaw Kit for: All-In-One Types: SC, SU (100–225 A), QC, RC, SO 5J DE4
Bypass (Horn Type) for Ringless Type Meter Mains and All-In-Ones (100–200 A)
(except for RC8L125S, RC1624M100S and RC1624M125S–use RCHB). MMHB DE4
Lexan Meter Socket Cover Plate for:
Ring and Ringless Type Meter Mains 29007 DE4
Ring and Ringless Type All-In-Ones
Meter Socket Sealing Rings for Ring Type Meter Mains and All-In Ones:
Snap Type Aluminum (Std.) 2920910001 DE5
Screw Type Aluminum 29008W DE4
Snap Type Stainless Steel ARP00026 DE4
Anti-Inversion Kit . For use ONLY on 400 A Meter Mains and All-In-Ones with lever
bypass. MMLRK DE4
Trim Kit for 2 in. X 6 in. stud wall, used with Reverse All-In-Ones, SU3040M200R, and SU2X6TRIM DE4
SU3040M225R
Barrel Lock Kit (Barrel Lock not included), supplied with bracket and mounting screw, refer
to listings for where used. SCBRLLOCK DE4
Semiflush Flange Kit Meter Mains: SC816D150/200C and RC816D200CH
for: All-In-Ones: SC2040M200C SC200F DE4
Semiflush Flange Kit for ring- and ringless-type Meter Mains and All-In-Ones (400 A Only) FK400 DE4
Ringless Type Utility Cover for RU3040D400CL/FL, QU12L400CL/FL, and
QU816D400CL/FL. Includes one piece meter socket and pull box cover with handles and R400L DE4
closing plate.
Lug Kit includes (4) lugs, for use with 2 AWG–600 kcmil Al/Cu conductors. Lugs are for
standard 2-Hole mounting. Meter Main and All-In-One units supplied with (2) studs per
phase and neutral will accept one lug per phase and neutral. Not for use on 400 A devices CMELK4 DE4
with “K” suffix.
Branch Circuit Breaker Field Installation Kit for two Q-Frame Circuit Breakers (QBL, QDL,
or QGL, order separately). For CUM400CB, QUM400CL or QUM400CK - includes (2) BMK2Q400 DE4
mounting pans, (4) wires.
Overhead Feed Trough for 400 A ring- and ringless-type Meter Mains and All-In-Ones. OCK400 DE4
Touch-Up Paint (ASA49 Gray) PK49SP DE1
Ground Bar Kit, Meter Mains and All-In-Ones QC, RC, and SC (100–225 A) PK15GTA DE3A
Filler Plate for: Meter Main Types: QC, CU All-In-One Types: QC QOFP DE3A
Filler Plate for: Meter Main Types: RC, SC All-In-One Types: SC, RC, SU HOMFP DE3A
Neutral Lug (6-2/0 AWG) Meter Main Types: RC, SC, QC All-In-One Types: SC, SU, LK100AN DE3A
for: QC, RC
Overhead Barrier Tunnel Kit for Ringless & Horn Bypass in RC/QC Devices OHBS DE4
Overhead Barrier Tunnel Kit for Lever Bypass RC/QC Devices OHBL DE4

[72] Supplied with AAP adapter plate and “A” hub.


1-33
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Combination Service Entrance Devices Dimensions
Class 4119, 4120
1

schneider-electric.us

Dimensions for CSEDs


Table 1.71: Knockouts
14.97 28.28 Symbol A B C D E F G H I J
“A” Hub 718
380 B,C,D
C,D,F A Conduit Size
1/2 3/4 1 1-1/4 1-1/2 2 2-1/2 3 3-1/2 4
LOAD CENTERS

(in.)
7.14 7.50
181 191 ▲ Driphood supplied factory-installed and is required for surface mount installation. For semi-flush installation,
remove driphood and install flange kit SC200F (order separately).
Drip Hood Semi-Flush End Wall
■ Unit supplied with blank top endwall (factory-installed) for surface mount installation. For semi-flush installation,
install flange kit FK400 (order separately). Kit includes replacement top endwall (with knockouts) and flanges.
♦ Unit supplied with semi-flush top endwall factory installed and semi-flush flanges factory included.

“B” Hub “A” Hub 2 1/2 " Ma x “A” Hub

4.6 0 4.6 0 4.56 7.50


117 117 116 Bla nk End Wa ll
191
19.58
13.82 497 13.46 28.25
342 718
351

6.44 8.00
7.44 10.70 164 203
189 272
12.80 18.23
325 463 20.79
528

A,B C,D,E,F
A,B E,F,G,H 41.25
C,D,E,F 1048
A

C125RB (S hown ) B,C


D,F,G
CQRB100 A,B
Rin g Typ e : Rin gles s Typ e : S O1020M100S
CM200S RC200S
C2M200S (S h o wn ) RC2M200S 2 1/2 " Ma x “A” Hub
C4L200S RC2M200S H A
2 1/2 " Ma x “A” Hub G,H,I,J
2 1 /2 " Ma x “A” Hub 5.32 “A-L” Hub
C,D,F A,B 135
A B,C
4.67 C,D,F
4.80 119 18.35 B,C
3.39 466
122
S urfa ce CU12L400CNc CU816D400CBc
86
14. 37 CU12L400CBc CU816D400CNc
365
14.77 QU12L400CLc QU816D400CLc
375 10.94 12.57 QU12L400S L QU816D400S L (S h o wn )
14.50 278 319
368 CU12L400FNf
10.04 CU12L400FBf 2 1 /2 " Ma x “A” Hub
255 D,F,G
10.87 CU816D400FNf
276 B,C
CU816D400FBf C,D,F
10.87 QU816D400CKc
276
40.93 48.62 QU12L400FLf 6.95
1040 1235 176
25.12 QU816D400FLf
638
35.1 3
892 25.12
638 14.50
368

Lever ByPass
Lever ByPassDevices
Devices
A
2 1 /2 " Ma x
14.81
A,B B,C 376
“A” Hub A,B A
D,F,G B,C D,F,G A,B
2 1 /2 " Ma x E,F,G,H
A,B “A” Hub or A,B,C
C,D,F D,E, F,G B300
S C8L125S (S h o wn ) A,B,C 32.23
C,D,E,F 819
RC8L125S RC816F100S H C,D,E,F QC816F100S H
QC12L200C S C8L125F (S h o wn ) RC816F125S H QC816F125S H
S C1624M100S QC816F100CH C,D, E,F S C1624M100F RC816F150S L QC816F150S ,S H (S h o wn )
S C1624M125S QC816F125C RC816F150S ,S H
RC1624M100S
RC816F200C S C1624M125F QC816F150S L
QC816F150C RC816F200CH RC816F200S L
RC1624M125S QC816F200C QC816F200S L
RC2040M125CH RC816F200S ,S H
QC816F200CH C,D,E,F RC12L200S QC816F200S ,S H
RC12L200C RC2040M150CH QC12L200S
A,B RC2040M125S H B,C
RC816F100CH RC2040M200C A RC2040M150S H QC2442M150S H A
RC816F125CH RC2040M200CH RC2040M200S ,S H QC2442M200S ,S H C,E,F,G,H A,B
C,D,F A,B A 3.4 0 2 1 /2 " Ma x
RC816F150C QC2442M200C 86 RC3040M150S L S O2040M200S “A-L” Hub
RC816F150CH QC2442M200CH RC3040M200S L QC3040M200S H
B,C C,D,E,F B,C
14.85
14.62 7.90 377 S U816D150Cq
371 201 7.50 Bla nk End Wa ll
191 S U816D200Cq
S U2040M200Cq
28.25 RC816D200CH q
CL 718
Top S C816D150C q
Bran ch S C816D200C q (S h o wn )
Circuit
Brea ke r 8.00
203 2 1/2 " Ma x “A” Hub
31.61 39.60
803 27.00 35.40 1006 5.80
686 899 147

21.50
48.00 546
1219
41.25
1048
10.30
S C3040M200S

262 11.10
CL 282
Me te r
S ocke t
29.50
S C40M200S

B,C B 749

32.30
C,E ,F,G, H 820
2 1 /2 " Ma x A
“A-L” Hub
A 37.30
947
B,C B A 4.40 C,D,E,F G,H,I,J
“A” Hub or 112 “A-L” Hub
B 3.5 0 S C816F200F
B300 Hu b 89 35.40 S C2040M125F
899 S C2040M200F (S h o wn ) C,D,F B,C C,D,E,F A
D,F,G B C,D
S C3040M200F S U3040D400CBc (S h o wn ) S U3040D300CBc C,E,F,G,H
S U3040M200R (S h o wn ) RU3040D400CLc 2 1 /2 " Ma x B,C
S C3040M2225F S U3040D400CNc “A-L” Hub
S U3040M225R S C2636M200FP V RU3040D400CKc RU3040D400FLf
39.60 S U3040D300FBf
1006 S C2636M225FP V RU3040D400FK f B
S U3040D400FBf CUM400CB c S C12L200S S C40M200S
S U3040D400FNf QUM400CL c S C816F150S S C2040M200S (S h o wn )
QUM400CK c S C816F200S S C3040M200S

1-34
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Rainproof, Meter Mains and All-In-Ones, RC/QC Solar Ready CSEDs
150 to 200 A Maximum
schneider-electric.us Class 4120

Meter Mains and All-In-Ones


• Ringless Meter Sockets with barrel lock provisions factory • Service disconnect(s) are supplied factory-installed, except • All devices have a 3" KO in the bottom endwall

LOAD CENTERS
installed except for Cat. No. SO2040M200SS which is a
Ring Style meter socket with no provisions for barrel lock to

where noted
• Provisions for Field Installed CTs All Devices
secure the meter cover
Supplied with 100% branch neutrals, all unused terminals
may be used for equipment grounding wires • Solar Ready kit SR69064A fits All Devices Below, order
from Table 1.66
• UL Listed, suitable only for use as service equipment
• Meets Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2

Table 1.72: All-In-One Combination Service Entrance Devices


Load Center and Branch
Circuit Breakers
(Order Separately [1]) Hub Line
Short Service Disconnect(s) Side Service
Ampere Rating

Max. Quantity Type Ground


Circuit Main
Bypass Type

Service (Order Lug

Rating Max.
Cur- Cat. No. 1P Lugs
Type Sepa- AWG/
rent rately AWG/ kcmil
Type

Circuits

Ampere
Spaces
Rating 2P kcmil
(Factory Installed Ampere Tan- [2]) (Al/Cu)
Circuits (Al/Cu)
except where Rating dems
(Max.)
noted)

1
Meter Mains[3]
Surface Mount Only
Surface Mount—Supplied with Feed-Thru Lugs and Provisions for Branch Circuit Breakers
150 None OH/UG 22 kA QC816F150SS [4] [5] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 8 16 8 150 A
A Lever OH/UG 22 kA QC816F150SLS [4] [6] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 8 16 8 150 A
A 350 8–2/0
200 None OH/UG 22 kA QC816F200SS [4] [5] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 8 16 8 200 A
A Lever OH/UG 22 kA QC816F200SLS [4] [6] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 8 16 8 200 A
Surface Mount—Supplied with Feed-Thru Lugs and provisions for Branch Circuit Breakers
150 None OH/UG 22 kA RC816F150SS [4] [5] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 8 16 8 150 A A 6-350 8–2/0
A Lever OH/UG 22 kA RC816F150SLS [4] [6] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 16 8 150 A A 6-350 8–2/0
None OH/UG 22 kA RC816F200SS [4] [5] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 8 16 8 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
200 Horn OH/UG 22 kA RC816F200SHS [4] [7] [5] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 8 16 8 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
A
Lever OH/UG 22 kA RC816F200SLS [4] [6] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 16 8 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
All-in-One Combination Service Entrance Devices [3]
Surface Mount Only
200 None OH/UG 22 kA QC2442M200SS [5] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 24 42 18 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
A Horn OH/UG 22 kA QC2442M200SHS [7] [5] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 24 42 18 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
150 Horn OH/UG 22 kA RC2040M150SHS [7] [5] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 20 40 20 150 A A 6-350 8–2/0
A Lever OH/UG 22 kA RC3040M150SLS [6] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 30 40 10 150 A A 6-350 8–2/0
None OH/UG 22 kA RC2040M200SS [5] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
200 Horn OH/UG 22 kA RC2040M200SHS [7] [5] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
A None OH 22 kA SO2040M200SS [5] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
Lever OH/UG 22 kA RC3040M200SLS [6] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 30 40 10 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
* Kit is to be installed between meter socket and Main Disconnect. May be used with Solar PV, Wind, fuel generators, and other power generation sources up to 80% of Mains Rating Maximum
160 A.

Table 1.73: Knockouts


2 1/2 " Max “A” Hub
Symbol A B C D E F G H I J
5.32 Conduit Size
135 (in.) 1/2 3/4 1 1-1/4 1-1/2 2 2-1/2 3 3-1/2 4
18.35
466
RC816F150SS
RC816F200SS
RC816F200SHS
10.94 12.57 QC816F150SS
278 319
QC816F200SS
RC2040M150SHS
RC2040M200SS
RC2040M200SHS
40.93 48.62 SO2040M200SS
1040 1235
QC2442M200SS
QC2442M200SHS
Lever QC816F150SLS
ByPass RC816F150SLS
Devices RC3040M150SLS
QC816F200SLS
RC816F200SLS
A,B
RC3040M200SLS
E,F,G,H
A,B,C

C,D,E,F

Table 1.74: All-in-One Combination Service Entrance Devices—Plug on Neutral


Load Center and Branch
Circuit Breakers
Service Disconnect(s) (Order Separately ) Line
Side Service
Hub Type (Order

Ground
Ampere Rating

Max. Quantity
Current Rating

Service Main Lug


Main Breaker

Bypass Type

Short Circuit

1P Lugs
Rating Max.

Cat. No.
Separately )

Type AWG/
AWG/ kcmil
2P Type kcmil
Bus Bar

Circuits

Ampere
Spaces

(Al/Cu) (Al/Cu)
Circuits (Factory Installed Tandems
(Max.) except where noted)

Homeline Surface Mount Only


200 A 200 A None OH/UG 22 kA RC3042M200PS [5] 1 QOM2200VH 30 42 12 200 A A 6-350 12–2/0

[1] To order load centers and branch circuit breakers, see QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers, page 1-10 and Homeline Plug-On Circuit Breakers, page 1-21
[2] See Bolt-On Hubs, page 1-26
[3] Solar Ready Kit Part Number SR69064A * (This Kit Fits All Solar Ready Devices)
[4] Supplied with load side feed-thru lugs, for 4AWG-250 kcmil Al/Cu conductors.
[5] Suitable for load wires to exit top endwall with addition of Tunnel Kit OHBS. See (see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33, check with local utility for approval.
[6] Suitable for load wires to exit top endwall with addition of Tunnel Kit OHBL. See(see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33, check with local utility for approval.
[7] Device supplied with horn bypass and 5th jaw factory installed
1-35
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Homeline Solar Ready PoN CSEDs Rainproof, Meter Mains and All-In-Ones,
125 to 225 A Maximum
1

Class 4120 schneider-electric.us

Homeline Solar Ready PoN CSEDs


• Ring-type Meter Sockets • Interiors accept plug-on neutral and pigtail style branch
circuit breakers
• Solar Ready kit SR69064A fits all devices below
• UL Listed, suitable only for use as service equipment
• Supplied with a fully distributed neutral bar, all unused • All devices have a 3" KO in the bottom endwall
• Service disconnect(s) are supplied factory-installed, except terminals may be used for equipment grounding wires • Provisions for field installed CTs on All devices
LOAD CENTERS

where noted
• Meets Ferderal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2 • Meets EUSERC requirements

Table 1.75: All-In-One Combination Service Entrance Devices


Load Center and Branch
Circuit Breakers
(Order Separately Line
Service Disconnect(s) Pages 1-2, 1-3, 1-4) Hub Service
Side
Bus Bar Short Circuit Type Main Ground
Main Bypass Service Max. Quantity (Order Lug
Ampere Current Cat. No. [1] Lugs

Rating Max.
Breaker Rating Type Type Rating 1P Sepa- AWG/ AWG/
rately kcmil

Tandems
Type kcmil

Circuits

Ampere
Spaces
2P [2]) (Al/Cu)
(Factory Installed (Al/Cu)
Circuits
(Max.) except where
noted)
Semiflush Mount Only
200 A None OH[3]/UG 22 kA SC816F200PF [4] 1 QOM2200VH 8 16 8 200 A
125 A None OH[3]/UG 22 kA SC2040M125PF 1 QOM2125VH 20 40 20 110 A
225 A None OH[3]/UG 22 kA SC2040M200PF 1 QOM2200VH 20 40 20 200 A A-L 4-250 8-2/0
200 A
None OH[5]/UG 22 kA SC3042M200PF 1 QOM2200VH 30 42 12 200 A
225 A None OH[5]/UG 22 kA SC3042M225PF 1 QOM2225VH 30 42 12 200 A
Surface Mount Only
150 A None OH/UG 22 kA SC816F150PS [4] 1 QOM2150VH 8 16 8 150 A
None OH/UG 22 kA SC816F200PS [4] 1 QOM2200VH 8 16 8 200 A
225 A None OH/UG 22 kA SC2040M200PS 1 QOM2200VH 20 40 20 200 A A-L
200 A 4-250 8-2/0
None OH/UG 22 kA SC3042M200PS 1 QOM2200VH 30 42 12 200 A
None OH/UG 22 kA SC42M200PS 1 QOM2200VH 42 42 0 200 A

Table 1.76: Knockouts


Symbol A B C D E F G H I J
Conduit Size
(in.) 1/2 3/4 1 1-1/4 1-1/2 2 2-1/2 3 3-1/2 4

C,D,E,F
A,B
A
3.4 0
86

2 1/2 " Ma x “A” Hub


B,C 14.85
377 5.80
147

21.50
546

11.10
S C3042M200P S

282
42.60
38.40 1006
S C42M200P S

899 29.50
749

32.30
820

37. 30
8/16 - 20/40

947
.
30/42

10 30
262

C,D,E,F A
B,C B C,E,F,G,H
2 1 /2 " Ma x B,C
“A-L” Hub
C,E ,F,G, H
2 1 /2 " Ma x A
“A-L” Hub B
Surface Mount
C,D,E,F
Semiflush Mount

[1] Accepts Solar Ready Kit Part Number SR69064A. Check with local utility for approval and order separately.
[2] See Bolt-On Hubs, page 1-26
[3] Suitable for OH service with addition of tunnel kit (SCTKP20). Check with local utility for approval and order separately.
[4] Supplied with load side feed-thru lugs, for 4AWG-250 kcmil Al/Cu conductors.
[5] Suitable for OH service with addition of tunnel kit (SCTKP30). Check with local utility for approval and order separately.
1-36
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Enclosed Devices
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us

1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—240 Vac—UL Listed


Table 1.77: Enclosed Molded Case Switch, Switch Included, Does NOT provide

LOAD CENTERS
overcurrent protection
Ampere Box. No.
Service Rating General Purpose Rainproof
[1]
QO200TR 2, 9R [4]
240 Vac 60 A [2] [3] QO260NATS QO200TRNM 1NM
QO260NATR 1R

120/240 Vac 100 A [5] QO2000NS QO2000NRB 13, 10R

Table 1.78: Housing Bracket


Description Cat. No.
Bracket used with QO200TR for stucco, aluminum and vinyl siding. (This item is obsolete) PKHB

1
Table 1.79: Enclosed GFCI Circuit Breakers, GFCI Circuit Breaker Included—10 kA
Short Circuit Current Rating
QO200TRNM
Ampere Type 3R— Circuit Breaker Box. No.
Service Rating Rainproof Included [1]
1NM (Non-
QOE250GFINM QO250GFI metallic)
120/240 Vac 50 A
HOME250SPA HOM250GFI 1R (Metallic)

Table 1.80: 2-Pole Circuit Breaker Enclosures—22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
Ampere Box. No.
Service [6] Rating General Purpose [7] Rainproof
[1]

100 A QO2100BNF/S QO2100BNRB 13, 10R


120/240 Vac QO2125BNF/S QO2125BNRB 18, 13R
125 A

240 Vac 100 A QO3100BNF/S QO3100BNRB 13, 10R

60A Max. Circuit Breaker Enclosures—10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating


Circuit breaker not included. Order separately from QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers, page 1-10. Will not accept QO-
GFI circuit breaker nor QO circuit breakers with factory-installed accessories.

240 Vac 60 A [2] — QO2TR 9R [4]

QO3100BNF
With Cover Removed

Table 1.81: Q Frame Enclosures and Q Frame Circuit Breakers


Enclosure Only [8] Circuit Breaker (Order Separately)
Service Type 1—General Type 3R— Box No. Ampere
Purpose [7] Rainproof [1] Rating 10 k AIR 25 k AIR 65 k AIR 100 k AIR
 70 A QBL22070 QDL22070 QGL22070 QJL22070
 80 A QBL22080 QDL22080 QGL22080 QJL22080
 90 A QBL22090 QDL22090 QGL22090 QJL22090
100 A QBL22100 QDL22100 QGL22100 QJL22100
Q22200NS [9] Q22200NRB [9] 19, 11R 110 A QBL22110 QDL22110 QGL22110 QJL22110
or or 20, 12R
Q23225NF/S Q23225NRB 125 A QBL22125 QDL22125 QGL22125 QJL22125
2P 240 Vac
Maximum 150 A QBL22150 QDL22150 QGL22150 QJL22150
175 A QBL22175 QDL22175 QGL22175 QJL22175
200 A QBL22200 QDL22200 QGL22200 QJL22200
225 A QBL22225 QDL22225 QGL22225 QJL22225
 70 A QBL32070 QDL32070 QGL32070 QJL32070 [10]
 80 A QBL32080 QDL32080 QGL32080 QJL32080 [10]
 90 A QBL32090 QDL32090 QGL32090 QJL32090 [10]
100 A QBL32100 QDL32100 QGL32100 QJL32100 [10]
110 A QBL32110 QDL32110 QGL32110 QJL32110 [10]
Q23225NF/S Q23225NRB 20, 12R
125 A QBL32125 QDL32125 QGL32125 QJL32125 [10]
3P 240 Vac 150 A QBL32150 QDL32150 QGL32150 QJL32150 [10]
175 A QBL32175 QDL32175 QGL32175 QJL32175 [10]
200 A QBL32200 QDL32200 QGL32200 QJL32200 [10]
225 A QBL32225 QDL32225 QGL32225 QJL32225 [10]

[1] See Table 1.57 Knockout Information, page 1-24


[2] Not suitable for service equipment.
[3] Maximum 10 hp 240 Vac.
[4] Top endwall has no hub opening.
[5] Maximum 20 hp 240 Vac.
[6] Not for use with one pole QO circuit breakers. Circuit breakers not included. Order QO type circuit breakers separately from pages 1-2 and 1-3. Accepts QO circuit breakers with factory-
installed accessories. Order equipment ground bar PKOGTA2, if required.
[7] Order F for flush, S for surface.
[8] Factory-installed groundable neutral assembly includes (2) ground lugs and (2) neutral lugs. Equipment ground kit PKOGTA2 also included.
[9] Accepts 200 A max. 2P Q Frame circuit breakers.
[10] Equipment ground bar kit PKOGTA2 factory-included.

1-37
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Enclosed Devices
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
1

schneider-electric.us

Table 1.82: QOM2 Enclosures and QOM2 Circuit Breakers


QOM2 Circuit Breaker
Enclosure Only [11]
(Order Separately) [12]
Type 1 Type 3R
Service General Purpose
Rainproof Box No. Ampere 22 k AIR
[13] [14] Rating
Cat. No.[15]
LOAD CENTERS

Cat. No. Cat. No.


100 A QOM2100VH
125 A QOM2125VH
150 A QOM2150VH
QOM22225NF/S QOM22225NRB 22, 16R
175 A QOM2175VH
2P 240 Vac
Maximum 200 A QOM2200VH
225 A QOM2225VH

Q22200NS
QOM22225NS With Cover Removed Q23225NF
With Cover Removed
(Order Q-Frame circuit breaker separately)

[11] Equipment ground bar kit PKOGTA2 factory-included.


[12] Add suffix 1021 for 120, 208 or 240 Vac shunt trip.
[13] Order F for flush, S for surface.
[14] See Table 1.57 Knockout Information, page 1-24
[15] DE3A Discount Schedule.
1-38
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Servicepak™ Power Outlet Panels
Class 1140
schneider-electric.us

Power Outlet Panels for Construction Sites


LOAD CENTERS
Provide temporary power at construction sites.
T T • Each receptacle protected by QO-GFI circuit breaker in compliance with NEC®
requirements.
T T T • Each enclosure is rainproof.
• 10 kA short circuit current rating.
1C 2C 3C • UL Listed as suitable for use as temporary site service equipment.
• Provided with neutral bonding provisions.
T T T T T T • Boxes have provisions for type “B’’ hubs to be field-installed.
Table 1.83: Construction Site Panels
Receptacles Main Wire
Power Mains Size
Outlet Service Ampere Circuit Breaker (Included)
(Included) Cat. No. [2] AWG [3]
4C 5C 6C Configuration [1] Rating
A C D E F Cu Al

1
1C 1Ø2W  40 A (1) QO120GFI 1 PAK10C1 14–6 12–6
T T T T T T 2C 1Ø2W  40 A (2) QO120GFI 2 PAK11C [4] 14–6 12–6
T T T (2) QO120GFI
2C 1Ø2W  40 A 2 PAK11C1 14–6 12–6
(1) QO120GFI
3C 1Ø3W  70 A (1) QO230GFI 1 1 PAK31CGFI 8–1 8–1
(1) QO120GFI
7C 8C 9C 4C 1Ø3W  70 A (1) QO220GFI 1 1 PAK36C1GFI 8–1 8–1
(1) QO120GFI
5C 1Ø3W  70 A (1) QO250GFI 1 1 PAK51CGFI 8–1 8–1
T T T T (1) QO120GFI
6C 1Ø3W  70 A (1) QO250GFI 1 1 PAK55CGFI 8–1 8–1
10C 11C 12C (2) QO120GFI
7C 1Ø3W  70 A (1) QO220GFI 2 1 PAK72CGFI 8–1 8–1
(2) QO120GFI
8C 1Ø3W  70 A (1) QO250GFI 2 1 PAK76CGFI 8–1 8–1
T
T
(1) QO120GFI
9C 1Ø3W 100 A (2) QO250GFI 1 2 PAK1004CGFI 14–1 12–1

13C 14C

Power Outlet Panels for Recreational Vehicle Parks


• Provide electrical power to individual recreational vehicle park sites.
A 20 A 125 V 2W and Grd.
NEMA 5-20R • Each receptacle protected by appropriate GFI or Standard QO™ circuit breaker.

30 A 125 V 2W and Grd


• All receptacles and circuit breakers included.
B ANSI 73.13 • 10 kA short circuit current rating.

C 50 A 125/250 V 3W and Grd. • UL Listed.


NEMA 14-50R • All enclosures are rainproof.
D 20 A 250 V 2W and Grd. • No neutral bonding provisions.
NEMA 6-20R
• Loop-feed provisions.
E 30 A 125/250 V 3W and Grd.
NEMA 14-30R Table 1.84: Recreational Vehicle Park Panels
Mains Main Wire Size
50 A 250 V 2W and Grd. Power Outlet Serv- Receptacles
F NEMA 6-50R Configura- ice
Am- Circuit Breaker (Included) [5] Cat. No.
AWG/kcmil [6]
pere (Included) Phase and Neutral
tion [1] Rating
All non-pedestal devices have provisions to field-install a Type “B’’ hub A B C Cu Al
on the bottom endwall for bottom feed from a conduit riser. Order Type
“B’’ bolt-on hub (B250 Max.) and two mounting screws Underground or Overhead Loop-Feed Terminals—Non-Pedestal [2] [7]
(Cat. No. 8002505501) and two hex nuts (Cat. No. 2340102000). 11C 1Ø2W  40 A (2) QO120GFI 2 PAK11CTG
(1) QO120GFI 14–6 12–6
12C 1Ø2W  50 A (1) QO130 1 1 PAK41CTG [8]
(2) QO130 12–1
(1) QO120GFI PAK75CTG
14C 1Ø3W (1) QO250
100 A 1 1 1 (Not Loop Feed) 14–1 12–1
(1) QO130 [8]
Pedestal Mounted—Underground Loop-Feed Terminals [9] [10]
11C 1Ø2W  40 A (2) QO120GFI 2 PAK11PG
(1) QO120GFI
12C 1Ø2W  50 A (1) QO130 1 1 PAK41PG [8]
(1) QO120GFI (2)6–250 (2)6–250
13C 1Ø2W  75 A (2) QO130 1 2 PAK61PG [8]
(1) QO120GFI
14C 1Ø3W 100 A (1) QO250 1 1 1 PAK75PG [8]
(1) QO130

[1] (1Ø2W 120 Vac) (1Ø3W 120/240 Vac)


[2] Devices have a bolt-on factory-installed closing cap. Order type “B’’ bolt-on hub separately from page 1-18.
[3] Equipment ground terminal suitable for (2) 14 or 12 AWG Cu or (2) 12 or 10 AWG Al.
[4] Receptacles in this device are in bottom endwall and are accessible with outer door padlocked. “Order Only’’ from Lexington—Minimum order quantity is 50 devices.
[5] 20 A receptacles protected by 20 A GFI circuit breaker.
[6] Two wires each per phase, neutral, and equipment ground—for loop feed (except PAK75CTG).
[7] Equipment ground terminal suitable for (2) 14–12 AWG Cu or (2) 12–10 Al.
[8] GFI circuit breaker can be substituted for standard 30 A circuit breaker. Add suffix "FI’’ to catalog number. Example: PAK41CTGFI.
[9] Stabilizer foot available for use in unstable ground, order HNPSF
[10] Equipment ground terminals suitable for (2) 10–2/0 AWG Cu or (2) 6–2/0 AWG Al.
1-39
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Servicepak™ Power Outlet Panels
Class 1140
1

schneider-electric.us
LOAD CENTERS

1-40
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents

Section 2
Metering Equipment
Meter Sockets 2-2

Ring and Ringless Type Individual Meter Sockets 2-2


Horizontal Ganged, Test Block Bypass Sockets and Accessories 2-3
Dimensions 2-4
MP Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers 2-5

METERING EQUIPMENT
Ring and Ringless Devices 2-5
Ring and Ringless Type Devices 2-5
Individua l Me te r S ocke t
Tenant Circuit Breakers 2-7
Accessories for MP Meter-Pak Meter Centers 2-7
Dimensions and Knockouts for MP Meter-Pak Meter Centers 2-9
EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers 2-10

Indoor/Rainproof EZM General Information 2-10


Selection Information 2-12
1 Phase Main Devices 2-13
1 Phase Branch Devices 2-15
3 Phase Main Devices 2-16
3 Phase Branch Devices 2-18

2
3 Phase Main Devices (Busway Side Tap) 2-20
3 Phase Main Devices (Busway Center Tap) 2-21
Tenant Circuit Breakers and EZM Accessories 2-22
Dimensions 2-24

MP Me te r-P a k Me te ring Equipme nt

EZ Me te r-P a k Me te ring Equipme nt

© 2017 Schneider Electric


All Rights Reserved 2-1

11/10/2017
Meter Sockets Ring and Ringless Type Individual Meter
Sockets
Class 4131 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701 schneider-electric.us

Individual Meter Sockets


This metering is generally utility specific. Always check with local utility company
• Available single or three phase, 600 Vac max., before installing. Contact your nearest Field Sales Office for additional catalog
with and without horn or lever bypass, overhead numbers, if required by utility.
and underground service feed.
• 10 kA short circuit current rating (or higher with
utility approval).
• UL Listed, NEMA 3R enclosure.
• Units supplied with bonded neutral.
• Units supplied with hub opening in top endwall
require the use of a bolt-on hub, or closing plate.
• Units supplied with solid top are for underground
feed only.
• For accessories, refer to page 2-3.

UTRS202B UTH5203T
UTRS101B (Cover not shown) (Cover not shown) URTRS213B

Table 2.1: Individual Meter Sockets


Lug Wire Range (Al/Cu) Enclosure Information
Ampere Jaw Service Line, Load, Top Endwall Conf.
Rating [1] Qty. Type Cat. No. [2] Wire Gnd. Box No. [3]
and Neutral Binding (AWG) Material Hub Closing
(AWG/kcmil) Opening [4] Plate [4]
Ringless Type, 1Ø3W 600 Vac Max., Without Bypass or Jaw Release
125 4 UG UTZRS101A [5] 8–2/0 1/2 in. Hex 14–2 Steel Solid Top [5] — 1R
125 4 OH UTRS101B 8–2/0 Slotted 14–2 Steel Series A ACP 1R
125 4 OH UATRS101B 8–2/0 Slotted 14–2 Aluminum Series A ACPA 1R
125 4 OH URS101BCPL 8–2/0 Slotted 14–2 Steel Series A ACP 1R
125 5 OH/UG 1003880A [6] 8–2/0 Slotted 14–2 Steel Series A ACP 1R
200 4 OH UTRS202B 8–250 1/2 in. Hex 14–2 Steel Series A ACP 3R
200 4 OH UATRS202B 8–250 1/2 in. Hex 14–2 Aluminum Series A ACPA 3R
200 4 UG UTRS213A [5] 1/0–350 1/2 in. Hex 14–2 Steel Solid Top [5] — 5R
200 4 OH/UG UTRS213B [6] 1/0–350 1/2 in. Hex 14–2 Steel Series A ACP 5R
200 4 OH/UG UATRS213B [6] 1/0–350 1/2 in. Hex 14–2 Aluminum Series A ACPA 5R
200 4 OH/UG U92197CCCPL [7] 1/0–350 1/2 in. Hex 14–2 Steel (2) Series A (2) ACP[7] 7R
Ringless Type, 1Ø3W 600 Vac Max., With Horn Bypass, Without Jaw Release
125 4 OH/UG UHTRS101B 8–2/0 Slotted 14–2 Steel Series A ACP 1R
125 5 OH UGHTRS101L [8] 8–2/0 Slotted 14–2 Steel A125 [8] — 1R
125 4 OH URS101BDQ [9] 8–2/0 1/2 in. Hex None Steel Series A ACP 1R
125 5 OH/UG UGHTRS111C [10] 8–2/0 Slotted 14–2 Steel Series A ACP [10] 4R
200 4 OH/UG UBHMRS212B [6] 8–250 1/2 in. Hex None Steel Series A ACP 4R
200 4 OH UHTRS202B 8–250 1/2 in. Hex 14–2 Steel Series A ACP 3R
200 4 OH/UG UHTRS212B [6] 8–250 1/2 in. Hex 14–2 Steel Series A ACP 4R
200 4 OH/UG UHTRS213B [6] 1/0–350 1/2 in. Hex 14–2 Steel Series A ACP 5R
200 4 UG UHTRS223A [5] 1/0–350 1/2 in. Hex 14–2 Steel Solid Top [5] — 2R
200 4 UG URS212ADQ [9] 8–250 1/2 in. Hex None Steel Solid Top [5] — 4R
Ringless Type, 1Ø3W 600 Vac Max., With Lever Bypass and Jaw Release
200 4 OH UTH4203T 6–350 1/2 in. Hex 14–2 Steel Series A-L ACPL  8R
200 4 OH/UG UTH4213T [6] 6–350 1/2 in. Hex 14–2 Steel Series A-L ACPL  9R
200 5 OH UTH5203T 6–350 1/2 in. Hex 14–2 Steel Series A-L ACPL  8R
200 5 OH/UG UTH5213T [6] 6–350 1/2 in. Hex 14–2 Steel Series A-L ACPL  9R
320 4 OH/UG UTH4330T [11] Studs Only 3/8 in. dia. studs 14–1/0 Steel Series A-L ACPL 11R
Ringless Type, 3Ø4W 600 Vac Max., With Lever Bypass and Jaw Release
200 7 OH/UG UTH7213T [6] 6–350 1/2 in. Hex 14–2 Steel Series A-L ACPL  9R
320 7 OH UTH7300T [11] Studs Only 3/8 in. dia. studs 14–1/0 Steel Series A-L ACPL 10R
Ringless Type, 3Ø4W 600 Vac Max., Bolt-On Socket Without Bypass
UK7T [11] Studs Only 1/2 in.–20 1/2 in.–20
400 7 OH/UG dia. studs dia. studs Steel Series A-L ACPL 12R

UAK7T [11] Studs Only 1/2 in.–20 1/2 in.–20


400 7 OH/UG Aluminum Series A-L ACPLA 12R
dia. studs dia. studs
Ring Type, 1Ø3W 600 Vac Max., Without Bypass or Jaw Release
125 4 OH/UG URTRS101B [6] 8–2/0 Slotted 14–2 Steel Series A ACP 1R
200 4 OH/UG URTRS213B [6] 1/0–350 1/2 in. Hex 14–2 Steel Series A ACP 5R

[1] Rating is continuous.


[2] Device requires approval from the serving utility, consult your nearest Schneider Electric sales office.
[3] For box dimensions, see page 2-4
[4] Order appropriate bolt-on hub or closing plate separately and install on TOP endwall.
[5] Device supplied with solid top endwall (without hub opening).
[6] When unit is installed for underground feed, the appropriate closing plate must be ordered separately and installed over hub opening in TOP endwall of device.
[7] Device supplied with two closing plates ACP mounted in TOP endwall.
[8] Device supplied with 1-1/4 in. bolt-on hub (Cat. No. A125) mounted on TOP endwall.
[9] Contains “Duquesne Light Co.” approved label.
[10] Device supplied with closing plate ACP mounted on TOP endwall.
[11] Order lugs separately, see page 2-3
2-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Horizontal Ganged, Test Block Bypass Meter Sockets
Sockets and Accessories
schneider-electric.us Class 4131 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701

Horizontal Ganged Meter Sockets


• 1Ø, 600 Vac max., main lugs only, 2 through 6 meter positions, with and without
horn or lever bypass, end or center feed, overhead and underground service feeds.
• 10 kA short circuit current rating (or higher with utility approval).
• UL Listed, NEMA 3R enclosure.
• Supplied with ground lugs.
• Supplied with hub opening in top endwall, requires the use of a bolt-on hub, or closing
plate.
This metering is generally utility specific. Always check with local utility company

METERING EQUIPMENT
UT2R1121B before installing. Contact your nearest Field Sales Office for additional catalog
numbers, if required by utility.

Table 2.2: Ringless Type, 1Ø3W, 600 Vac Max., Without Bypass or Jaw Release
Branch Ratings Top Endwall [12]
Main Lugs
Socket Mains Branch Lugs
Phase and Neutral Hub Type Closing Plate
Amperes No. of Jaw Service Rating Cat. No. Al/Cu Phase and Neutral Box No. [13]
(A) Al/Cu (AWG) (Order (Order
[14] Positions Qty. Type (AWG/kcmil) Separately) Separately)
[15]
2 200 UT2R1121B 6–250 13R
3 205 UT3R1121B 6–250  13R1
100 A 4 4 OH/UG 205 UT4R1131B 6–350 8–2/0 Series A ACP 14R
5 250 UT5R1131B 6–350 15R
6 300 UT6R1131B 6–350 16R
2 205 UT2R2122B 6–250 Series A ACP 17R
4 360 UT4R2352T 1/0–500 Series A-L ACPL 18R
1/0–500 or
200 A 5 4 OH/UG 500 UT5R2392TU 8–250 Series A-L ACPL 19R
(2)1/0–350

2
1/0–500 or
6 620 UT6R2392TU Series A-L ACPL 20R
(2)1/0–350

Meter Mains with Test Block Bypass


Table 2.3: Ring Type, 1Ø3W and 3Ø4W, Meter Main with Test Block Bypass (Meets
EUSERC Requirements)
System (Incoming) Meter Ampere Short
Circuit Main Circuit Breaker Type
and Socket Rating Cat. No. [16][17]
Service (Outgoing) Type (Max.) Current (Order Separately) [18]
Rating
100 kA 2P Type QB, QD, QG, QJ
120/240 Vac 1Ø3W 5-Jaw 225 A EMT1225CB (QO, QO-VH, QOH) [19]
max.
208Y/120 Vac 3Ø4W[20]
or 3P Type QB, QD, QG or QJ
7-Jaw 225 A 65 kA max. EMT3225CB
240/120 Vac 3Ø4W
Delta

Table 2.4: EMT Terminal Wire Size [21]


Line Phase Lug Line Neutral Lug Service Ground Lug Equipment Ground Lug Load Neutral Lug
6 AWG–300 kcmil 6 AWG–350 kcmil 4 AWG–300 kcmil 6 AWG–300 kcmil 4 AWG–300 kcmil
EMT1225CB Al/Cu Al/Cu Al/Cu Al/Cu Al/Cu
EMT3225CB Without Covers

Meter Socket Accessories


Table 2.5: Adapter Plate, Lug Kits, Table 2.6: Fifth-Jaw Kit, Closing Plates, and Hubs
Accessory Description Cat. No.
and Sealing Rings
Converts a 4-jaw meter socket to a 5-jaw meter socket. For use on
Accessory Description Cat. No. Fifth-Jaw Kit meter sockets supplied without lever bypass or jaw release only. A5J
To allow the use of a Series A Hub on a For Series A (steel) ACP
Adapter
device that is setup for a series A-L AAP For Series A (aluminum)
Plate Hub. Closing Plates ACPA
(to seal hub openings) For Series A-L (steel) ACPL
For use on meter sockets supplied with Line, Load, and
Neutral Studs only. Be sure to order enough lugs for For Series A-L (aluminum) ACPLA
each device (a typical 1Ø device requires 6 lugs).
1.00 inch A100
Includes one, two-barrel lug (6-250 1.25 inch A125
kcmil) ARP00118
Lug Kits Series A 1.50 inch A150
Includes one, single barrel lug (4-600 2.00 inch A200
kcmil) ARP00129
Hubs 2.50 inch A250
Includes three, two-barrel lugs (6-350 (listed by 2.00 inch A200L
kcmil) ARP00427
conduit size) 2.50 inch A250L
Snap-on Aluminum (Standard) 2920910001 Series A-L 3.00 inch A300L
Sealing
Snap-on Stainless Steel (Non-standard) ARP00026 3.50 inch A350L
Ring
Screw Type Aluminum (Non-standard) 29008W 4.00 inch A400L
Series B 3.00 inch B300

[12] For hubs and closing plates, see page 2-3.


[13] For box dimensions, see page 2-4
[14] Rating is continuous.
[15] Fifth jaw kit available to convert 4-jaw socket to a 5-jaw socket. See page 2-3.
[16] For box dimensions, see page 2-4
[17] Supplied with bondable neutral, suitable for use as service equipment , suiteable for overhead or underground service. UL Listed E6294.
[18] See page 2-22 to select main circuit breaker.
[19] Requires use of an EZM125QOA adapter (order separately), when using QO (40 A–125 A, 2-pole) 10 kA max. SCCR, QO-VH (40 A–60 A, 2-pole) 22 kA max. SCCR, or QOH (40 A–60 A,
2-pole) 42 kA max. SCCR.
[20] 100 kA max.
[21] Refer to circuit breaker listings for usable load lug wire sizes.
2-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Meter Sockets Dimensions
Class 4131 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

Dimensions and Knockouts for Meter Sockets


D W Hub D W Hub
Table 2.7: Enclosure Dimensions D W Solid
Opening Opening
Top
Dimensions (Inches)
Meter Meter Meter
Hub Opening Socket Socket
Box (Max. Conduit Size) Socket
No. H W D
[22] H Offset H
A,B,C,D,E H E,F,G
 1R 10.88  8.00 3.50 Series A
 2R 13.00 13.00 4.94 Solid Top S
 3R 14.00  8.00 4.38 Series A
 4R 14.00 11.00 4.38 Series A C,D,E,F,G S
 5R 15.00 11.00 4.38 Series A A,B,C,D C,D,E,F A,B,C,D F,G,H
S A A
 6R 15.50  8.00 4.36 Series A
7R 17.13 13.00 4.94 (2) Series A 1R 2R 3R, 6R
 8R 19.00 10.50 4.94 Series A-L Hub
D W Hub D W Opening D W Hub
 9R 19.00 13.00 4.94 Series A-L Opening Opening
10R 34.50 15.00 5.68 Series A-L
11R 36.62 15.00 5.68 Series A-L Meter Meter Meter
12R 43.00 20.25 6.00 Series A-L Socket Socket Socket
13R 14.12 24.31 4.50 Series A Offset
H H H
 13R1 14.12 32.50 4.50 Series A C,D,E,F,G D,E,F,G F,G,H
A,B
14R 14.12 40.62 4.50 Series A S A S A
15R 14.12 48.75 4.50 Series A
16R 14.12 57.00 4.50 Series A A,B
S
17R 14.12 24.31 5.38 Series A
D,E,F,G F,G,H A F,G,H
18R 14.12 40.62 5.38 Series A-L
19R 14.12 54.75 5.38 (2) Series A-L 4R, 5R 7R 8R
20R 14.12 63.00 5.38 (2) Series A-L D W Hub D W Hub D W Hub
Table 2.8: Knockout Information Opening Opening Opening
Knockouts Meter Meter Meter
Symbol S A B C D Socket Socket Socket
Conduit Size 5/16 Offset
1/2 3/4 1 1-1/4 H H H
(in.) [23] F,G,H F,G,H,I F,G,H,I
A,B A,B
Symbol E F G H I J A A A
S S S
Conduit Size
(in.) 1-1/2 2 2-1/2 3 3-1/2 4

F,G,H F,G,H,I F,G,H,I


9R 10R 11R

Hub Opening
D W Hub D W Hub Opening
Opening D W
Meter
Socket Meter Meter
Socket Main Socket Main
G,H,I,J H Lugs H Lugs H

S A S A

C,D,E,F,G C,D,E,F,G (14R) C,D,E,F,G


C,D,E,F,G C,D,E,F,G (13R) C,D,E,F,G (14R, 18R) F,G,H (18R) (14R, 18R)
A,B (13R, 17R) (13R, 17R)
F,G,H (17R)
14R and 18R
12R
13R and 17R

Meter Socket
Left position omitted on
5-Gang unit (15R) Hub Opening
D W
Hub Op ening
D W
7.50 Suppli ed wi th (2)
191 ACP C losing P lates .
Main
Me te r
Lugs H Order A-Hubs
Soc ket Ma in 22.44 separ ately f or
Lugs H 570
S A
overhead ser vice
S A
feed.

C,D,E,F,G C,D,E,F,G C,D,E,F,G C,D,E,F,G C,D,E,F,G C,D,E,F,G


13R1 15R and 16R
Meter Socket 30.00
762
Left position omitted on C,D,E (3 Locations)
5-Gang unit (19R) Hub Opening (2 Locations)
W
E,F,G,H (8 Locati ons)
D

Main
Lugs H
S A A,B

F,G,H EMT1225C B and E MT3225CB


C,D,E,F,G C,D,E,F,G
(19R, 20R)
(19R, 20R) (19R, 20R)
19R and 20R

[22] Refer to page 2-3 for closing plates and hubs.


[23] Knockout for grounding conductor.
2-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Ring and Ringless Devices MP Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers
Class 4141 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

Ring and Ringless Type Devices


• Consult local utility for approval before installation.
• 120/240 Vac 1Ø3W.
• Main lugs only—two to six meter sockets.
• Enclosures are indoor/rainproof NEMA 3R construction.
• Suitable only for use as service equipment.
• Swingable mounting feet supplied at bottom of device.
• Factory-installed mechanical lugs, alternate lugs and NEMA/EUSERC lug landing kits
available.

METERING EQUIPMENT
• Surface mount, convertible to semi-flush with field installed flange kit.
• Ring type devices supplied with 4-jaw meter sockets (5th jaw kits available, order
separately).
• Ringless type devices supplied with 5-jaw meter sockets, available with and without
horn or lever bypass.
• Provisions for mounting 2-pole circuit breaker for each meter socket position (order
circuit breakers separately).
• Mounting channel supplied, except for box 1R (125 A, 2-position).

MP44125
• Combination overhead/underground feed.

Table 2.9: MP Catalog Number Description


Number Segment Character Description MP H 4 4 125
Device Name MP Meter-Pak Meter Center
Blank Ring Type
R Ringless Type with 5th Jaw
Socket/Bypass Type

2
H Ringless with Horn Bypass and 5th Jaw
L Ringless with Lever Bypass, Jaw Release and 5th Jaw
2 200 A
3 300 A
4 400 A
Bus Ampacity
5 500 A
6 600 A
8 800 A
2 2-Positions MP, MPH, MPL, and MPR
3 3-Positions MP, MPH, MPL, and MPR
Number of Meter Sockets 4 4-Positions MP, MPH, MPL, and MPR
5 5-Positions MP, MPH and MPR
6 6-Positions MP, MPH, MPL and MPR
125 125 A
Max. Tenant Circuit Breaker Amperage 200 200 A
225 225 A

2-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
MP Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers Ring and Ringless Devices
Class 4141 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

Table 2.10: Ring Type MP Meter-Pak Metering Equipment with 125 A (42 kA Maximum SCCR) or 200 A (22 kA Maximum SCCR) Meter
Socket Positions
Factory-Installed
Main Lugs Main Bus Line Lug Wire Circuit Semi-Flush
Amperes No. of Ampacity Breaker Type Box
per Pos. Ampacity Cat. No. Size Al/Cu Hub Prov. [2] Flange Kit Wt Lbs
Positions (A) (2P) No.
(alternate lugs [1]) AWG/kcmil
2 200 200 MP22125 [3] (1) 4–250 A/B300 MPSF12 46 1R
(1) 1/0–600 or
3 300 300 MP33125 [4] (2) 1/0–250 A-L MPSF14 95 2R
(1) 1/0–600 or QO,
2

4 400 400 MP44125 [4] (2) 1/0–250 A-L MPSF14 97 2R


125 QO-VH,
400 Al (1) 1/0–600 or QOH
5 500 MP55125 [4] (2) 1/0–250 (4) A-L MPSF16 130 3R
500 Cu
400 Al (1) 1/0–600 or
6 600 MP66125 [4] (4) A-L MPSF16 132 3R
500 Cu (2) 1/0–250
(1) 1/0–600 or
2 400 400 MP42200 [4] (2) 1/0–250 MPSF23 99 4R
METERING EQUIPMENT

(1) 1/0–600 or
3 400 400 MP43200 [4] (2) 1/0–250 MPSF23 99 4R
QOM2-MM, (4) A-L
200 (1) 1/0–600 or QOM2-MVH
4 400 600 MP64200 [4] (2) 1/0–250 MPSF24 135 5R
5 600 Al, 750 Cu 800 MP85200 [4] (2) 3/0–500 MPSF26 173 6R
6 600 Al, 750 Cu 800 MP86200 [4] (2) 3/0–500 MPSF26 173 6R

Table 2.11: Ringless Type MP Meter-Pak Metering Equipment with 125 A (42 kAMaximum SCCR) or 200 A Type MPR, MPH (22 kA
Maximum SCCR) or 225 A Type MPL (100 kA Maximum SCCR) Meter Socket Positions
Factory-Installed Line Lug Circuit Breaker
Amperes No. Main Lugs Main Bus Horn Lever Type Hub Semi-Flush
Per of No. Bypass Bypass Bypass Wire Size Wt Box
Ampacity Ampacity Cat. No. Al/Cu (2P) Prov. [2] Flange Kit Lbs No.
Pos. Pos. (alternate lugs [1]) Cat. No. Cat. No. [5].
AWG/kcmil
2 200 200 MPR22125 MPH22125 — (1) 4–250 A/B300 MPSF12 46 1R
(1) 1/0–600 or
3 300 300 MPR33125 MPH33125 — (2) 1/0–250 MPSF14 95 2R
A-L
(1) 1/0–600 or QO,
4 400 400 MPR44125 MPH44125 — (2) 1/0–250 QO-VH, MPSF14 97 2R
125
400 Al (1) 1/0–600 or QOH
5 500 MPR55125 MPH55125 — (2) 1/0–250 MPSF16 130 3R
500 Cu
(2) A-L
400 Al (1) 1/0–600 or
6 600 MPR66125 MPH66125 — (2) 1/0–250 MPSF16 132 3R
500 Cu
2 400 400 MPR42200 MPH42200 MPSF23 99 4R
(1) 1/0–600 or QOM2-MM,
200 3 400 400 MPR43200 MPH43200 — (2) 1/0–250 QOM2-MVH MPSF23 99 4R
4 400 600 MPR64200 MPH64200 MPSF24 135 5R
2 350 350 — — MPL32225 QBP-TM, N/A 105 7R
3 400 500 — — MPL53225 QDP-TM, N/A 147 8R
(1) 1/0–600 or QGP-TM or
QJ-TM (2) A-L
225 (2) 1/0–250
4 400 600 — — MPL64225 QO [6], N/A 200 9R
QO-VH [6]
or QOH [6]
5 600 Al, 750 Cu 800 MPR85200 MPH85200 — (2) 3/0–500 QOM2-MM, MPSF26 173 6R
200 QOM2-MVH
6 600 Al, 750 Cu 800 MPR86200 MPH86200 — (2) 3/0–500 MPSF26 173 6R
NOTE: UL Listed short circuit current rating depends on lowest interrupting rating of
circuit breaker installed.

[1] See page 2-7 for alternate lugs.


[2] For A and A-L Hubs see page 2-3, for B Hubs see Digest Section 3.
[3] Meets EUSERC standards.
[4] Meets EUSERC standards with addition of lug landing kit, MMSK2.
[5] See page 2-7
[6] Requires use of EZM125QOA adapter (order separately).
2-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Ring and Ringless Devices MP Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers
Class 4141 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

Tenant Circuit Breakers


UL Listed Short Circuit Current Rating depends on lowest interrupting rating of circuit
breaker installed. (Refer to page 2-12 for Square D certified ratings for downstream
panelboards and load centers.)

Table 2.12: Tenant Circuit Breakers


Amperes 10 k AIR 22 k AIR 42 k AIR 100 k AIR
120/240 Vac 120/240 Vac 120/240 Vac 120/240 Vac
For use in 125 A Max. Type MP, MPR and MPH Meter-Pak Metering Equipment
40 QO240 QO240VH [7] QOH240 —
50 QO250 QO250VH [7] QOH250 [7] —
60 QO260 QO260VH QOH260 [7] —
QOH270 [7]

METERING EQUIPMENT
70 QO270 QO270VH —
80 QO280 QO280VH QOH280 [7] —
90 QO290 QO290VH QOH290 —
100 QO2100 QO2100VH QOH2100 —
125 QO2125 QO2125VH QOH2125 —
QOM2200MVH For use in 200 A Max. Type MP, MPR and MPH Meter-Pak Metering Equipment
100 QOM2100MM QOM2100MVH — —
125 QOM2125MM QOM2125MVH — —
150 QOM2150MM QOM2150MVH — —
175 QOM2175MM QOM2175MVH — —
200 QOM2200MM QOM2200MVH — —
Amperes 10 k AIR 25 k AIR 65 k AIR 100 k AIR
120/240 Vac 120/240 Vac 120/240 Vac 120/240 Vac
For use in 225 A MPL Lever Bypass Meter-Pak Metering Equipment
40 QO240 [8] QO240VH [7] [9] [8] QOH240 [10] [8] —
50 QO250 [8] QO250VH [7] [9] [8] QOH250 [10] [7] [8] —
60 QO260 [8] QO260VH [7] [9][8] QOH260 [10] [7] [8] —
QO2100VH 70 QBP22070TM QDP22070TM QGP22070TM QJP22070TM

2
2P, Plug-on Type 80 QBP22080TM QDP22080TM QGP22080TM QJP22080TM
Circuit Breaker 90 QBP22090TM QDP22090TM QGP22090TM QJP22090TM
100 QBP22100TM QDP22100TM QGP22100TM QJP22100TM
110 QBP22110TM QDP22110TM QGP22110TM QJP22110TM
125 QBP22125TM QDP22125TM QGP22125TM QJP22125TM
150 QBP22150TM QDP22150TM QGP22150TM QJP22150TM
175 QBP22175TM QDP22175TM QGP22175TM QJP22175TM
200 QBP22200TM QDP22200TM QGP22200TM QJP22200TM
225 QBP22225TM QDP22225TM QGP22225TM QJP22225TM

QDP22200TM
2P, Plug-on Type
Circuit Breaker
Accessories for MP Meter-Pak Meter Centers
Table 2.13: Accessories
Accessory Description Cat. No.
Fifth Jaw Kit Fifth Jaw Kit 5J
Horn Bypass Kit For MPR and MPH only MMHB
QO Adapter For Bolt-on Q2M tenant circuit breakers (40–125 A, 2P) EZM125QOA
Slider Type Manual 125 A Ring Style 2 Position Top Meter (Only) MM125MB [11]
Circuit Closing: 125 and 200 A Ring Style MM200MB [11]
Snap-on Aluminum 2920910001
Sealing Rings: Screw Type Aluminum 29008W
MMLK500 Snap-on Type Stainless Steel ARP00026
Meter Cover- Meter Cover-Lexan™ 29007
Lexan™
(1) 1/0–600 AWG/kcmil or
(2) 1/0–250 AWG/kcmil per phase MMLK250 [12][13]
Optional Lug Kits:
(2) 3/0–500 AWG/kcmil per phase MMLK500 [13]
(2) 2–600 AWG/kcmil per phase MMLK600 [13]
125 A 2 Position MPSF12
125 A 3–4 Position MPSF14
125 A 5–6 Position MPSF16
Semiflush Kits:
200 A 2–3 Position MPSF23
200 A 4 Position MPSF24
200 A 5–6 Position MPSF26
NEMA/EUSERC For 3 through 6 position 125 A and 200 A devices. Each pad rated
Lug Landing Kit: 600 A maximum and includes (2) 1/2-13 studs and mounting MMSK2 [13]
hardware.
NEMA Lug Landing For use ONLY on MPL43225, MPL53225 and MPL64225 with
optional lugs. See wiring diagram of each device for optional lugs. MMSK4
Kit:

[7] Order only. Not stocked in PDS. Order Point: Lincoln.


[8] Requires use of EZM125QOA adapter (order separately).
[9] QO-VH tenant circuit breakers are rated 22 kAIR at 120/240 Vac.
[10] QOH tenant circuit breakers are rated 42 k AIR at 120/240 Vac.
[11] The meter center short circuit current rating is 10 kA when manual circuit closing is used. Not rated for continuous duty.
[12] Standard lug for 3 through 6 position 125 A and 2 through 4 position 200 A devices.
[13] Cannot be installed on 2 position 125 A device.

2-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
MP Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers Ring and Ringless Devices
Class 4141 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

Table 2.13 Accessories (cont'd.)


Accessory Description Cat. No.
125 A 2 Position ONLY MP43X8PED
MP Meter-Pak 125 A 3–6 Position MP43X11PED
Wireway: 200 A 2–6 Position MP43X11PED
(Wall Mount MPL32-225 MP35X11PED [14]
Pedestal) MPL53-225 MP43X11PED
MPL64-225 MP35X11PED [14]
MP Meter-Pak MP12X8PEDEXT [14]
Used ONLY with MP43X8PED MP12X11PEDEXT
Wireway
Used with MP43X11PED and MP35X11PED [14]
Extensions:
2
METERING EQUIPMENT

[14] Order only. Not stocked in PDS. Order point: Lexington.


For hubs and closing plates, see page 2-3.
2-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Ring and Ringless Devices MP Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers
Class 4141 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

Dimensions and Knockouts for MP Meter-Pak Meter Centers


A-L Hub Opening Supplied
with ACPL Closing Plate
A-L Hub Opening Supplied
7.28 with ACPL Closing Plates
A Hub Opening Supplied 185
with ACP Closing Plate
7.28
185
7.28 24.34
185 618
Top Position
Omitted on
36.46
926
12.28 3-Gang Unit
Mounting Holes
(4) Locations 312
(Supplied without Top Left
Mounting Channel) 9.00 Position
229 Omitted on
Typ.
37.50 5-Gang Unit
953 9.00
229
48.12 Typ.
1222

METERING EQUIPMENT
9.00
229
42.37
1076

18.50 11.19
470 C,D,F 284
C,D,F 11.19
C,D,F 284

C,D,F
E,F,G,H,I,J and A,B
C,D,F C,D,F A-L Hub Provision
D,F,G and A or
B300 Hub Provision
A E,F,G,H,I,J and
A A-L Hub Provision
Box 1R Box 2R A,B Box 3R
A-L Hub Opening Supplied
with ACPL Closing Plates
A-L Hub Opening Supplied
A-L Hub Opening Supplied 8.28 with ACPL Closing Plates
210
with ACPL Closing Plates
8.28
8.28 29.44 210
210 748

2
46.68
29.44 1186
748

Top Left
Top Position 9.00 Position
229
Omitted on Typ. Omitted on
2-Gang Unit 5-Gang Unit
9.00
9.00 229
229 Typ.
Typ. 52.00
1321

43.41
43.41 1103
1103

12.22
12.22 C,D,F 12.22 310
310 310 C,D,F
C,D,F

E,F,G,H,I,J and A-L Hub Provision


E,F,G,H,I,J and E,F,G,H,I,J and
A-L Hub Provision A-L Hub Provision

C,D,E,F C,D,E,F C,D,E,F

A,B A,B A,B,C


Box 4R Box 5R Box 6R
A-L Hub Opening Supplied
with ACPL Closing Plates
A-L Hub Opening Supplied
with ACPL Closing Plates 9.62
244
A-L Hub Opening Supplied
9.62 with ACPL Closing Plates
244
35.37
9.62 898
244
19.43
494

35.37
898

14.00
356

53.12 67.37
1349 1711
60.25
1530

14.00 14.00
356 356
34.00 Typ. Typ.
864

C,D,E,F C,D,E,F
13.43 13.43
C,D,E,F 341 341

E,F,G,H,I,J and E,F,G,H,I,J and E,F,G,H,I,J and


A-L Hub Provision A-L Hub Provision A-L Hub Provision
C,D,E,F C,D,E,F C,D,E,F

A,B A,B A,B


Box 7R Box 8R Box 9R

Knockouts
Symbol A B C D E F G H I J
Conduit Size (in.) 1/2 3/4 1 1-1/4 1-1/2 2 2-1/2 3 3-1/2 4

2-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers Indoor/Rainproof EZM General Information
Class 4141 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

EZM General Information


NEMA 3R Construction Main Devices

• 400, 600 and 800 A main disconnects may be end-mounted with branch units having
240 Vac Maximum, for use on AC systems, suitable 800 A or 1200 A continuous horizontal cross bus.
for use as Service Equipment. • 1000 and 1200 A main disconnect or terminal box must be center mounted when
used with branch devices with main bus rated 800 A continuous.
Utility Company Requirements Review local
utility requirements to ensure that metering • 1600 A main disconnect or terminal box must be center mounted.
equipment meets their standards. • 2000 A main disconnect must be center mounted and requires use of branch units
having 1200 A continuous horizontal cross bus.
EZ Meter-Pak meter center enclosures meet NEC • 400, 800 and 1200 A Type EZM-TBU terminal boxes supplied with lug landings to
meet EUSERC requirements.
wire bending requirements, and are designed for
wall mounting only (not suitable for floor mounting). Main Circuit Breaker ratings: 400, 600, 800, 1000, 1200, 1600 and 2000 A
All unmetered conductor compartments may be Main Fusible Switch ratings: 400, 600, 800, and 1200 A (1Ø3W only)
sealed by the utility company. Main Lugs Terminal Box ratings: 225, 400, 600, 800, 1200, 1600, and 2000 A

EZ Meter-Pak meter centers have UL Listed short


circuit current ratings up to 100 kA at 240 Vac when Branch Units
properly applied. For three-tier series ratings refer to
Data Bulletin 4100DB0301 and Instruction Bulletin
• 125 and 225 A residential branch units are available in ring type or ringless type
construction and are supplied with 800 A continuous aluminum horizontal cross bus
80043-303-22. as standard (Example: EZM314125). For optional 1200 A continuous copper
horizontal cross bus with aluminum vertical connectors, add suffix “X” to catalog
Suitable incoming services for an EZM main number (Example: EZM314125X). For optional 1200 A continuous all-copper
device and available outgoing feeder(s) to bussing, add suffix “CUX” to catalog number (Example: EZM314125CUX). NOTE:
downstream panelboards from EZM branch 5-gang 225 A EZM, EZMR and EZMH residential branch units are supplied with
section(s)— 1200 A continuous Cross Bus as standard, do not add suffix “X” or “CUX” to these
units (Examples: EZMR315225 or EZMR315225CU). Plug-in style residential meter
Incoming Service to Main Device 120/240 Vac, sockets are available as ring type EZM without bypass, ringless type EZMR without
1Ø3W bypass, and ringless type EZMH with horn bypass.
Available outgoing feeder(s) to downstream Tenant circuit breakers must be ordered separately for these branch units. 125 A
panelboards: max. units make use of Type QO, QO-VH or QO-H two-pole tenant circuit breakers
• 120/240 Vac, 1Ø3W (40–125 A). 225 A max. units make use of Type QDP-TM, QBP-TM, QGP-TM and
QJP-TM two-pole tenant circuit breakers (70–225 A), and may also make use of two-
(4-jaw ring type meter sockets, two-pole circuit
breakers), pole Type QO (40–125 A at 10 kA max.), two-pole Type QO-VH (40–60 A at 100 kA
(5-jaw ringless meter sockets, two-pole circuit max.), or two-pole Type QO-H (40–60 A at 100 kA max.) tenant circuit breakers.
breakers). • 225 A commercial branch units are available in ring type or ringless type
Incoming Service to Main Device 240/120 Vac, construction and are supplied with 1200 A copper horizontal cross bus with
3Ø4W Delta aluminum vertical connectors as standard (Example: EZML314225). For optional
Available outgoing feeder(s) to downstream 1200 A continuous all-copper bussing, add suffix “CU” to catalog number (Example:
panelboards: EZML314225CU). Plug-in style commercial meter sockets are available as ring type
• 120/240 Vac, 1Ø3W (Fed from transformer’s “A-
Phase” and “C-Phase” only.) NOTE: Connection
EZMT with test block bypass (meets EUSERC requirements), ringless type EZMR
without bypass, and ringless type EZML with lever bypass.
to High-Leg “B-Phase” not permitted for this
service 225 A max. units make use of type QDP-TM, QBP-TM, QGP-TM and QJP-TM two-
(4-jaw ring type meter sockets, two-pole circuit pole or three-pole tenant circuit breakers (70– 225 A), and may also make use of
breakers) two-pole type QO (40–125 A at 10 kA max.), two-pole type QO-VH (40–60 A at 100
(5-jaw ringless meter sockets, two-pole circuit kA max.), or two-pole type QO-H (40–60 A at 100 kA max.) tenant circuit breakers.
breakers) Note: QO, QO-VH and QO-H tenant circuit breakers used in 225 A branch units
Standard 3Ø IN/1Ø OUT branch units are not require the use of adapter EZM125QOA (purchased separately).
suitable for use on this Delta System. Special • 400 A branch units are available in ringless type construction only, and are supplied
branch units are available for this System by with 1200 A continuous all-copper bussing as standard (Example: EZML332400).
adding suffix: “CA” to catalog number (Typical These branch units are supplied with factory-installed type LJL tenant circuit
Examples: EZM313125CA, EZM313125XCA, breakers that have a field adjustable ampere rating trip setting from 125 A min. to
EZM313125CUXCA, EZM314225CA, 400 A max.
EZM314225XCA, EZM314225CUXCA, A tamper-evident seal kit is available where needed, order seal kit MICROTUSEAL
EZM315225CA, EZM314225CUCA, etc.). (refer to NEC 240-6 [c]). 400 A branch units are available as Type EZML with plug-in
• 240/120 Vac, 3Ø4W Delta (7-jaw meter sockets, style lever bypass type meter sockets, or Type EZMK with bolt-on style with manual
bypass type meter sockets.
three-pole circuit breakers).
Incoming Service to Main Device 208Y/120 Vac,
3Ø4W
• Units having 800 A continuous horizontal cross bus WILL CONNECT with units
having 1200 A continuous horizontal cross bus.
Available outgoing feeder(s) to downstream
panelboards: • Single phase units (three bus bars in horizontal cross bus) WILL NOT CONNECT
with three phase units (four bus bars in horizontal cross bus).
• 120/208 Vac, 1Ø3W (5-jaw meter sockets, two-
pole circuit breakers) For Load Center Three-Tiered Series Ratings used downstream from Metering
Equipment, refer to Data Bulletins: 4100DB0301 and 2700DB9901.
• 208Y/120 Vac, 3Ø4W (7-jaw meter sockets, three-
pole circuit breakers).

2-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Indoor/Rainproof EZM General Information EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers
Class 4141 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

Configuration Information
Table 2.14: EZM Mains Devices
Number Segment Character Description EZM 1 1000 CB U CU
Device Name EZM EZ Meter-Pak Meter Center
1 1Ph, 3W
Service Feed
3 3Ph, 4W
225 A
400 A
600 A
800 A
Mains Rating 1000 A
1200 A
1600 A

METERING EQUIPMENT
2000 A
CB Main Circuit Breaker
FS Main Fusible Switch
Main Type TB Terminal Box
GCB Main Circuit Breaker (65 kAIC)
JCB Main Circuit Breaker (100 kAIC)
Blank Overhead / Underground
C Overhead / Underground
B Underground Only
Feed Direction
T Overhead Only
U Underground Only, Meets EUSERC Standards up to 1200 A max.
E Underground Only, Meets EUSERC Standards up to 1200 A max.
Blank Aluminum Horizontal Cross Bus Bar up to 1000A max.
Special Construction CU Copper Horizontal Cross Bus Bar
MS Includes Energy Reduction Maintenance Switch
This table is for interpreting existing part numbers only. All possible combinations are not

2
available.
Table 2.15: EZM Branch Devices
Number Segment Character Description EZM R 1 1 3 125 CU
Device Name EZM EZ Meter-Pak Meter Center
Blank Ring Type
R Ringless Type with 5th Jaw
H Ringless with Horn Bypass and 5th Jaw
Socket/Bypass Type
L Lever Bypass with 5th Jaw, 7th Jaw if Three Phase
T Ring Type Test-Block Bypass EUSERC
K K-Base Bolt-On Type
1 1Ph, 3W
Service Feed
3 3Ph, 4W
1 1Ph, 3W
Load Feed
3 3Ph, 4W
Number of Meter Sockets Meter Sockets
Available 1,2,3,4,5 or 6
125 125 A
Maximum Tenant Circuit Breaker
Amperage 225 225 A
400 400 A
Blank Aluminum Horizontal Cross Bus Bar
CA For 240/120 Vac Delta Systems
CU Copper Horizontal Cross Bus Bar
Special Construction
D Removable Drip Hood with Indoor Top Endwall with Knockouts
M10 10-Inch Meter Centers
X 1200A Copper Horizontal Cross Bus Bar

2-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers Selection Information
Class 4141 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

Selection Information
• Review local utility
requirements to ensure that
• Using the SCCR table:
– Select meter center configuration, main lugs only (Six Disconnect Rule), or remote main, main circuit
metering equipment meets breaker, or main fusible switch.
their standards. – Read down to select SCCR equal to, or greater than desired rating.
• Check local utility to determine – Read across to select branch unit tenant circuit breaker type.
available fault current at the
meter center. – Continue reading across to select EZM main device type.
2

Table 2.16: UL Listed Meter Center Short Circuit Current Ratings (SCCR) [1]
EZM Meter Center Overcurrent Protection Devices
Short Circuit
Current Rating EZM Branch Unit Tenant Circuit Breaker
Figures (240 Vac Types Available (Branch Unit Amperes
EZM Main Device with Integral Mounted Main, Remote Mounted Main
Maximum) [2] max.,
METERING EQUIPMENT

or without an Upstream Mounted Main (Six Disconnect Rule)


[3] Number of Poles, Tenant Circuit Breaker
Amperes Rating Range)
EZ Meter-Pak (Six Disconnect Rule Applications)—See Figure 1
EZM Branch Units Load
QO (125 A, 2P, 40–125 A)
Service Centers  10 kA QO (225 A, 2P, 40–125 A) [5]
Disconnects (Main Lugs) QB (225 A, 2P or 3P, 70–225 A)
(6 Max.)
QO-VH (125 A, 2P, 40–125 A )
 22 kA QO-VH (225 A, 2P, 40–60 A) [5]
Transformer
 25 kA QD (225 A, 2P or 3P, 70–225 A) 400–2000 A Main Lugs Terminal Box
(Tenant Circuit Breakers used as Service Disconnects—6 maximum)
QOH (125 A, 2P, 40–125 A)
EZM Main Lugs  42 kA QOH (225 A, 2P, 40–60 A) [5]
Terminal Box
Figure 1 [4]  65 kA QG (225 A, 2P or 3P, 70–225 A)
QJ (225 A, 2P or 3P, 70–225 A) [6]
100 kA LJL (125–400 A, 2P or 3P) [7]
EZ Meter-Pak 225–2000 A Main Lugs Terminal Box Applications Protected by Remote Main—See Figure 2
QO (125 A, 2P, 40–125 A)
QO (225 A, 2P, 40–125 A) [5] Must be protected by an upstream disconnecting means rated 10 k AIR
 10 kA QB (225 A 2P or 3P, 70–225 A) minimum
LJL (125–400 A, 2P or 3P) [7]
QO-VH (125 A, 2P, 40–125 A)
QO-VH (225 A, 2P, 40–60 A) [5] Must be protected by an upstream disconnecting means rated 22 k AIR
 22 kA minimum
LJL (125–400 A, 2P or 3P) [7]
QD (225 A 2P or 3P, 70–225 A) Must be protected by an upstream disconnecting means rated 25 k AIR
 25 kA LJL (125–400 A, 2P or 3P) [7] minimum
QOH (125 A, 2P, 40–125 A)
QOH (225 A, 2P, 40–60 A) [5] Must be protected by an upstream disconnecting means rated 42 k AIR
EZM Main Lugs Terminal Box LJL (125–400 A, 2P or 3P) [7] minimum
EZM Branch Units  42 kA
QO-VH (125 A, 2P, 40–125 A) Must be protected by a Square D circuit breaker Type LA (400 A max.) or
QO-VH (225 A, 2P, 40–60 A) [5] MA
QD (225 A 2P or 3P, 70–225 A) (1000 A max.) Rated 42 k AIR minimum
QG (225 A 2P or 3P, 70–225 A) Must be protected by an upstream disconnecting means rated 65 k AIR
LJL (125–400 A, 2P or 3P) [7] minimum
Tenant  65 kA QO-VH (125 A, 2P, 40–125 A)
Load Must be protected by a Square D circuit breaker Type LH (400 A max.);
Transformer Circuit Centers QO-VH (225 A, 2P, 40–60 A) [5]
Breakers QD (225 A 2P or 3P, 70–225 A) MG or MJ (800 A max.); MH (1000 A max.); PG or PJ (1200 A max.); RG or
(Main Lugs)
RJ (2000 A max.).
Upstream Disconnection LJL (125–400 A, 2P or 3P) [7]
Means and Overcurrent
Protection as Required QJ (225 A 2P or 3P, 70–225 A ) [6] Must be protected by an upstream disconnecting means rated 100 k AIR
LJL (125–400 A 2P or 3P) [7] minimum
Figure 2 [4]
QO-VH (125 A, 2P, 40–125 A) Must be protected by an upstream disconnection means with Class R (600
A max.); Class J (600 A max); Class T6 (800 A max.); Class T3 (1200 A
QO-VH (225 A, 2P, 40–60 A) [5] max.) or Class L (1200 A max.).
100 kA
Must be protected by an upstream disconnection means with Class R (600
QD (225 A 2P only, 70–225 A) A max.); Class J (600 A max); Class T6 (800 A max.); Class T3 (1200 A
LJL (125–400 A, 2P or 3P) [7] max.) or Class L (1200 A max.) fuses or by a Square D circuit breaker Type
QD (225 A 3P only, 70–225 A) [6] MJ (800 A max.); MHF (1000 A max.); PJ (1200 A max.); or RJ (2000 A
max.) rated 100 k AIR minimum.
EZ Meter-Pak—Main Circuit Breaker Applications—See Figure 3
QO (125 A, 2P, 40–125 A)
10 kA QO (225 A, 2P, 40–125 A) [5]
QB (225 A 2P or 3P, 70–225 A) 400–2000 A EZM Main Device with Type LH (400 A max.); MG or MJ (800
QO-VH (125 A, 2P, 40–125 A) A max.); MH (1000 A max); PG or PJ (1200 A max.); RG or RJ (2000 A
QO-VH (225 A, 2P, 40–60 A) [5] max.)
65 kA QD (225 A 2P or 3P, 70–225 A)
LJL (125–400 A, 2P or 3P) [7]
EZM Circuit Breaker Main QO-VH (125 A, 2P, 40–125 A)
or EZM Main Fusible Switch QO-VH (225 A, 2P, 40–60 A) [5]
QD (225 A 2P only, 70–225 A) 1000 A Main Device with catalog number suffix "CBU" supplied with Type
EZM Branch Units MHF circuit breaker.
QD (225 A 3P only, 70–225 A) [6]
100 kA LJL (125–400 A, 2P or 3P) [7]
QD (225 A 2P only, 70–225 A)
QD (225 A 3P only, 70–225 A) [6] 800–2000 A EZM Main Device with Type MJ (800 A max.); MHF (1000 A
max.); PJ (1200 A max.) or RJ (2000 A max.)
LJL (125–400 A 2P or 3P) [7]
Transformer
Te na nt Load
EZ Meter-Pak—Main Fusible Switch Applications—See Figure 3
Circuit Centers QO (125 A, 2P, 40–125 A)
Breakers (Main Lugs) QO (225 A, 2P, 40–125 A) [5] 400–1200 A EZM Main Device (1Ø or 3Ø) with Class T (300 Vac) fuses
10 kA
QB (225 A 2P or 3P, 70–225 A) installed.
Figure 3 [4]
QO-VH (125 A, 2P, 40–125 A)
QO-VH (225 A, 2P, 40–60 A) [5]
QD (225 A 2P, only, 70–225 A) 400–1200 A EZM Main Device (1Ø or 3Ø) with Class T (300 Vac) fuses
100 kA
QD (225 A 3P only, 70–225 A) [6] installed.
LJL (125–400 A, 2P or 3P) [7]

[1] Tenant circuit breakers of same frame size having higher AIR values may replace tenant circuit breakers as listed in this table and maintain the series rating.
[2] Meter center short circuit current rating is equal to the lowest short circuit current rating given in table for any circuit breaker installed in any meter panelboard in the meter center.
[3] Short circuit current rating is measured at the LINE SIDE terminals of the integral mounted or remote mounted main providing overcurrent protection for the EZM metering equipment lineup.
[4] For three-tier series ratings refer to Data Bulletin 4100DB0301 and Instruction Bulletin 80043-303-22.
[5] Requires use of EZM125QOA adapter (order separately).
[6] 3P only tenant circuit breaker(s) are limited to: 100 kA Max. at 208Y/120 Vac or 65 kA Max at 240/120 Vac.
[7] Supplied with factory-installed circuit breaker(s), with an adjustable trip range of 125–400 A.
2-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
1 Phase Main Devices EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers
Class 4161 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

1Ø 3W 120/240 Vac EZ Meter-Pak Meter Centers—


1Ø, Indoor/Rainproof, UL Listed
1200 A Main CB/Fusible Switch Devices come Standard with 2-STEP Removable
Service Entrance Endwalls
Select EZM meter center short circuit current rating from Table 2.16 UL Listed Meter
Center Short Circuit Current Ratings (SCCR), page 2-12. Using this table as a reference,
make the following selections:
1. Select EZM 1Ø main device from Table 2.17 or Table 2.18, with an equal or higher
short circuit rating than the application.

METERING EQUIPMENT
2. Select EZM 1Ø branch units from Table 2.19, Table 2.20 or Table 2.21.
3. Select proper 2P type QO, QO-VH, QOH, QBP-TM, QDP-TM, QGP-TM or QJP-TM
branch circuit breakers for use as tenant mains in branch unit from Table 2.33 and
Table 2.34.
4. Select accessories as required fromTable 2.35.
5. Dimensions; see page 2-24 and page 2-25.
Select Main Devices—NEMA 3R Construction
Table 2.17: Main Devices, Overhead Feed
Horizontal Cross Factory-Installed Line Side Lug
Ampere Width
Rating Bus Rating and Cat. No. [8] (in.) (Conductors per Phase and Neutral)
Bus Bar Material Wire Size (AWG/kcmil)
Main Circuit Breaker (1Ø Incoming and 1Ø Outgoing)
65 kA 100 kA
400 400 A, Al EZM1400CB [9] — 18.66 (1) 1–600 or (2) 1–250

2
600 600 A, Al EZM1600CB[9] — 18.66 (3) 3/0–500
800 800 A, Al EZM1800CB[9] — 18.66 (3) 3/0–500
1000 1200 A, Cu EZM11000CB[9] — 18.66 (3) 3/0–500
1200 1200 A, Al EZM11200GCBT [10] EZM11200JCBT [10] 23.69 (4) 3/0-500
1600 1200 A, Al/Cu EZM11600GCBC [9][10] [11] EZM11600JCBC [9][10] [11] 30.19 (6) 1/0–750 or (12) 1/0–250
2000 1200 A, Al/Cu — EZM12000CB [9] [11] 30.19 (6) 1/0–750 or (12) 1/0–250
Main Fusible Switches (1Ø Incoming and 1Ø Outgoing) Requires 300 Vac Class T Fuses (Order Separately)
 400 400 A, Al — EZM1400FS[9] 18.66 (1) 1–600 or (2) 1–250
 600 600 A, Al — EZM1600FS[9] 18.50 (3) 3/0–500
 800 800 A, Al — EZM1800FS[9] 18.50 (3) 3/0–500
1200 1200 A, Al — EZM11200FST [9] 23.69 (4) 3/0–500
Main Lug Terminal Boxes (1Ø Incoming and 1Ø Outgoing)
 225 800 A, Al — EZM1225TB [9][12] 11.66 (1) 4–300
 400 800 A, Al — EZM1400TB [9] [13] 17.15 (2) 3/0–500
 600 800 A, Al — EZM1600TB [9] [13] 17.15 (2) 1/0–750 or (4) 1/0–300
 800 800 A, Al — EZM1800TB [9] [13] 18.66 (4) 3/0–500
 800 800 A, Cu — EZM1800TBCU [9][13][14] 24.08 (4) 3/0–500
EZM11200FST
1600 1200 A, Al/Cu — EZM11600TB [9] [13][14] 22.48 (6) 1/0-600 or (12) 1/0-300
2000 1200 A, Cu — EZM12000TB [9][13] [11] 30.19 6 (Order Lugs Separately)
Main Circuit Breaker (1Ø Incoming and 1Ø Outgoing) with Energy Reduction Maintenance (ERMS)
1200 1200 A, Cu EMZ11200GCBTMS [15] EZM11200JCBTMS [15] 23.69 (4) 3/0–500
1600 1200 A, Cu EMZ11600GCBCMS [9] EZM11600JCBCMS [9] 30.19 (6) 1/0–750 or (12) 1/0–250
2000 1200 A, Cu EMZ12000CBMS [9] — 30.19 (6) 1/0-750 or (12) 1/0-250

[8] Does not meet EUSERC requirements.


[9] Overhead and underground feed.
[10] Ampere rating of the circuit breaker supplied with this device can be changed to a LOWER value in the field by changing the setting on the circuit breaker.
[11] Supplied with copper horizontal bus bars and aluminum vertical bus bars.
[12] 225 A terminal box supplied with isolated neutral that cannot be bonded Not suitable for use on the LINE side of service equipment.
[13] Terminal box is suitable for use on LINE or LOAD side of service equipment. Supplied with isolated neutral and provided with neutral bonding kit for use as required. Refer to page 2-12 for
appropriate short circuit current ratings.
[14] Feed-thru lug kit available, see page 2-22.
[15] Top feed only.
2-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers 1 Phase Main Devices
Class 4161 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

Table 2.18: Main Devices, Underground Feed Only


Factory-Installed Lug Landings for use
Ampere Horizontal Cross Width with Crimp-Type Lugs (2-Hole Mounting)
Rating Bus Rating and Bus Cat. No. (in.) Qty. per Phase and Neutral, except non-
Bar Material EUSERC. [16]
Main Circuit Breakers (1Ø Incoming and 1Ø Outgoing)[16]
65 kA 100 kA
 400 400 A, Al EZM1400CBU [17] — 20.46 1 (Order Lugs Separately)
 600 600 A, Al EZM1600CBU [17] — 26.19 2 (Order Lugs Separately)
 800 800 A Al EZM1800CBU[17] — 26.19 2 (Order Lugs Separately)
2

1000 1200 A, Cu — EZM11000CBU[18] 34.19 2 (Order Lugs Separately)


1200 1200 A, Al EZM11200GCBU [19][20] [21] EZM11200JCBU [19][20] [21] 23.69 (4) 3/0–500
1200 1200 A, Al EZM11200GCBE [20] EZM11200JCBE [20] 32.39 3 (Order Lugs Separately)
1600 1200 A, Al/Cu EZM11600GCBU [19][20] [18] EZM11600JCBU [19][20] [18] 22.48 6 (Order Lugs Separately)
2000 1200 A, Al/Cu — EZM12000CBU [19][18] 30.19 6 (Order Lugs Separately)
Main Fusible Switches (1Ø Incoming and 1Ø Outgoing) [16] Requires 300 Vac Class T Fuses (Order Separately)
METERING EQUIPMENT

 400 400 A, Al — EZM1400FSU 20.46 1 (Order Lugs Separately)


 600 600 A, Al — EZM1600FSU[19] 20.46 2 (Order Lugs Separately)
 600 600 A, Al — EZM1600FSE 18.36 2 (Order Lugs Separately)
 800 800 A, Al — EZM1800FSU[19] 20.46 2 (Order Lugs Separately)
 800 800 A, Al — EZM1800FSE 18.36 2 (Order Lugs Separately)
1200 1200 A, Al — EZM11200FSB[19] [21] 23.69 (4) 3/0–500
1200 1200 A, Al — EZM11200FSE 32.39 3 (Order Lugs Separately)
Main Lug Terminal Boxes (1Ø Incoming and 1Ø Outgoing)
 400 800 A, Al — EZM1400TBU [22] 17.16 1 (Order Lugs Separately)
EZM11200GCBE 800 A, Al EZM1800TBU [22] 2 (Order Lugs Separately)
 800 — 25.16
1200 1200 A, Al/Cu — EZM11200TBU [22] 33.16 3 (Order Lugs Separately)
Main Circuit Breaker (1Ø Incoming and 1Ø Outgoing) with Energy Reduction Maintenance Switch (ERMS)
1200 1200 A, Al EZM11200GCBUMS EZM11200JCBUMS 26.39 (4) 3/0–500
1200 1200 A, Al EZM11200GCBEMS EZM11200JCBEMS 32.39 3 (Order Lugs Separately)
1600 1200 A, Al EZM11600GCBUMS EZM11600JCBUMS 30.19 6 (Order Lugs Separately)
2000 1200 A, Al EZM12000CBUMS — 30.19 6 (Order Lugs Separately)

[16] For mechanical lugs (3/0 AWG– 600 kcmil) order kit CMELK4. Kit includes 4 lugs only. Multiple kits may be required, consult factory. For crimp-type lugs refer to Anderson Electrical
Connector Products Catalog AEC-40R.
[17] Available by special order with main circuit breaker supplied with other standard ampere ratings, consult local Field Office (allow 6 weeks for delivery).
[18] Supplied with copper horizontal bus bars and aluminum vertical bus bars.
[19] Does not meet EUSERC requirements.
[20] Ampere rating of the circuit breaker supplied with this device can be changed to a LOWER value in the field by changing the setting on the circuit breaker.
[21] For field installed Lug Landing Kit, order catalog number EZM1200ULL. Order lugs separately.
[22] Terminal box is suitable for use on LINE or LOAD side of service equipment. Supplied with isolated neutral and provided with neutral bonding kit for use as required. Refer to page 2-12 for
appropriate short circuit current ratings.
2-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
1 Phase Branch Devices EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers
Class 4161 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

1 Phase Branch Devices—NEMA 3R Construction

Table 2.19: Branch Units—1Ø Incoming and 1Ø Outgoing


Number of Horizontal Cross Ring Type 4-Jaw Meter Ringless Type 5-Jaw Ringless Type 5-Jaw
System Width
Type (in.) Meter Bus Rating and Bus Socket Meter Socket Meter Socket
Sockets Bar Material without Bypass [23] without Bypass with Horn Bypass
125 A Maximum (Order Type QO, QO-VH or QOH Circuit Breakers Separately) [24]
800 A Al EZM113125 [25] EZMR113125 [25] EZMH113125 [25]
3
1200 A Cu EZM113125CUX EZMR113125CUX EZMH113125CUX
800 A Al EZM114125 [25] EZMR114125 [25] EZMH114125 [25]
1Ø3W 4

METERING EQUIPMENT
120/240 Vac 1200 A Cu EZM114125CUX EZMR114125CUX EZMH114125CUX
2P Branch 12.25
800 A Al EZM115125 [25] EZMR115125 [25] EZMH115125 [25]
Circuit Breakers 5
1200 A Cu EZM115125CUX EZMR115125CUX EZMH115125CUX
800 A Al EZM116125 [25] EZMR116125 [25] EZMH116125 [25]
6
1200 A Cu EZM116125CUX EZMR116125CUX EZMH116125CUX
225 A Maximum Branch Units (Order Type QBP-TM, QDP-TM, QGP-TM or QJP-TM Circuit Breakers Separately) [26]
800 A Al EZM112225 [25] EZMR112225 [25] EZMH112225 [25]
2
1200 A Cu EZM112225CUX EZMR112225CUX EZMH112225CUX
800 A Al EZM113225 [25] EZMR113225 [25] EZMH113225 [25]
1Ø3W 3
1200 A Cu EZM113225CUX EZMR113225CUX EZMH113225CUX
120/240 Vac 17.38
2P Branch 800 A Al EZM114225 [25] EZMR114225 [25] EZMH114225 [25]
4
Circuit Breakers 1200 A Cu EZM114225CUX EZMR114225CUX EZMH114225CUX
1200 A Al/Cu EZM115225 EZMR115225 EZMH115225
5
1200 A Cu EZM115225CU EZMR115225CU EZMH115225CU
EZMH114125
6 1200 A Cu EZM116225 EZMR116225 EZMH116225

Table 2.20: Branch Units—225 A Maximum Commercial

2
(Order Type QBP-TM, QDP-TM, QGP-TM or QJP-TM Circuit Breakers Separately) [27]
Ringless Type 5-Jaw Meter Socket Ring Type 5-Jaw Meter Socket
Horizontal Cross with Test Block Bypass.
Number with Lever Bypass and Jaw Release
System Type of Meter Bus Meets EUSERC Requirements
Rating and Bus Bar
Sockets Width Width
Material Cat. No. Cat. No.
(in.) (in.)
1200 A Al/Cu EZML111225 EZMT111225 [28] 22.42
1 1200 A Cu EZML111225CU 19.44 — —
1200 A Al/Cu EZML111225D [29] — —
1200 A Al/Cu EZML112225 EZMT112225 [28] 22.42
2 1200 A Cu EZML112225CU 19.44 — —
1200 A Al/Cu EZML112225D [29] — —
1200 A Al/Cu EZML113225 EZMT113225 [28][30] 22.42
3 1200 A Cu EZML113225CU 19.44 — —
1200 A Al/Cu EZML113225D [29] — —
1Ø3W
120/240 Vac 1200 A Al/Cu EZML114225 — —
2P Branch 1200 A Cu EZML114225CU — —
Circuit
Breakers

4 19.44
EZMT111225 EZML114225D [29]
1200 A Al/Cu — —

EZML113225

Table 2.21: Branch Units—400 A Maximum Commercial


Ringless Type 5-Jaw Meter Socket Ringless Type K Bolt-on
Main with Lever Bypass and Jaw Release. 4-Jaw Meter Socket with Manual Bypass.
Number of Cross Bus Includes Factory-Installed 400 A Type LJL Includes Factory-Installed 400 A Type LJL
System Type Rating Circuit Breaker [31] [32] Circuit Breaker [32]
Meter Sockets
and Bus Bar
Material Width Width
Cat. No. (in.) Cat. No. (in.)
1Ø3W 1 1200 A Cu EZML111400 23.21 EZMK111400 27.56
120/240 Vac
2P Branch Circuit Breakers 2 1200 A Cu EZML112400 23.21 EZMK112400 27.56

[23] Snap-on aluminum sealing rings supplied as standard.


[24] Supplied with removable drip hood and equipped with an indoor top endwall with knockouts provided.
[25] For 1200 A main cross bus add suffix “X” to catalog number (Example: EZM314125X). Allow 6 weeks for delivery.
[26] Type QO, QO-VH and QOH branch circuit breakers (40–60 A) may be installed with use of EZM125QOA adapter kits, see page 2-22.
[27] 2P Type QO (40–125 A, 10 kA max. meter center SCCR) or QO-VH and QO-H (40–60 A, 100 kA max. meter center SCCR) may be installed using EZM125QOA adapter kit, see page 2-22.
[28] Supplied with bondable neutral, suitable for use as service equipment. Use main lugs terminal box type EZM-TBU for Six Disconnect Rule applications to feed this device. Supplied with
copper horizontal bus bars and aluminum vertical bus bars.
[29] Supplied with removable drip hood and equipped with an indoor top endwall with knockouts provided.
[30] Does not meet EUSERC 48 in. minImum / 75 in. maximum meter height requirements for outdoor installations. The bottom meter socket is 37 inches above ground when the device is
mounted with the top meter socket at 75 inches above ground. EUSERC indoor requirements are 36 in. minimum / 75 in. maximum.
[31] Supplied with Class 320 lever bypass meter socket. Utilizes anti-inversion clip kit MMLRK, if required, refer to page 2-22.
[32] LJL circuit breaker has adjustable trip settings from 125-400 A. Use seal kit MICROTUSEAL, if required. LJL circuit breaker terminal lug kit factory-installed and accommodates (2) 2/0-500
kcmil Cu-Al per phase. Alternate lug kit AL400L61K3 for LJL circuit breaker is available, see. page 2-22.
2-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers 3 Phase Main Devices
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

3Ø4W 208Y/120 Vac or 240/120 Vac Delta EZ Meter-Pak Meter


Centers—3Ø Indoor/Rainproof, UL Listed
1200 A Main CB/Fusible Switch Devices come Standard with 2-STEP Removable
Service Entrance Endwalls
Select EZM meter center short circuit current rating from Table 2.16. Using this table as a
reference, make the following selections:
2

1. Select 3Ø EZM main device below with an equal or higher short circuit rating than
the application from Table 2.22 and Table 2.23.
2. Select EZM 3Ø branch units from Table 2.24, Table 2.25, and Table 2.26.
3. Select proper 2P type QO, QO-VH, QOH, QBP-TM, QDP-TM, QGP-TM or QJP-TM
or 3P QBP-TM, QDP-TM, QGP-TM or QJP-TM branch circuit breakers for use as
METERING EQUIPMENT

tenant mains in branch unit; from Table 2.33 and Table 2.34.
4. Select accessories as required, from page 2-22.
5. Dimensions see page 2-24.
3 Phase Main Devices—NEMA 3R Construction
Table 2.22: Main Devices, Overhead/Underground Feed
Ampere Horizontal Cross Width Factory-Installed Line Side Lug
Bus Rating and Bus Cat. No.[33] (Conductors per Phase and
Rating (in.)
Bar Material Neutral) Wire Size (AWG–kcmil)
Main Circuit Breakers (3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing)
65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating (400–1600 A Max.), 100 kA Short Circuit Current Rating (2000 A Max.)
Short Circuit Rating 65 kA 100 kA
 400 400 A, Al EZM3400CB [34] — 18.66 (1) 1–600 or (2) 1–250
 600 600 A, Al EZM3600CB[34] — 18.66 (3) 3/0–500
 800 800 A, Al EZM3800CB[34] — 18.66 (3) 3/0–500
1000 1200 A, Al EZM31000CB[34] — 18.66 (3) 3/0–500
1200 1200 A, Al EZM31200GCBT [35] [36] EZM31200JCBT [35] [36] 23.69 (4) 3/0-500
1600 1200 A, Al/Cu EZM31600GCBC[36] [37] EZM31600JCBC[36] [37] 30.19 (6) 1/0–750 or (12) 1/0–250
2000 1200 A, Al/Cu — EZM32000CB [37] 30.19 (6) 1/0–750 or (12) 1/0–250
Main Fusible Switches (3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing) Requires 300 Vac Class T Fuses (Order Separately)
 400 400 A, Al — EZM3400FS[34] 18.66 (1) 1–600 or (2 )1–250
 600 600 A, Al — EZM3600FS[34] 18.66 (3) 3/0–500
 800 800 A, Al — EZM3800FS[34] 18.66 (3) 3/0–500
1200 1200 A, Al — EZM31200FST [35] 23.69 (4) 3/0–500
Main Lug Terminal Boxes (3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing)
225 800 A, Al — EZM3225TB [38] 11.66 (1) 4–300
400 800 A, Al — EZM3400TB [39] 17.15 (2) 3/0–500
600 800 A, Al — EZM3600TB [39] 17.15 (2) 1/0–750 or (4) 1/0–300
800 800 A, Al — EZM3800TB [39] 18.66 (4) 3/0–500
800 800 A, Cu — EZM3800TBCU [39] [40] 24.08 (4) 3/0–500
EZM31200FST 1600 1200 A, Al/Cu — EZM31600TB [37] [40] [39] 22.48 (6) 1/0-600 or (12) 1/0-300
2000 1200 A, Cu — EZM32000TB [39] 30.19 6 (Order Lugs Separately)
Main Circuit Breakers (3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing) with Energy Reduction Maintenance Switch (ERMS)
1200 1200 A, Cu EZM31200GCBTMS[35] EZM31200JCBTMS[35] 23.69 (4) 3/0–500
1600 1200 A, Cu EZM31600GCBCMS[34] EZM31600JCBCMS[34] 30.19 (6) 1/0–750 or (12) 1/0–250
2000 1200 A, Cu EZM32000CBMS[34] — 30.19 (6) 1/0–750 or (12) 1/0–250

[33] Does not meet EUSERC requirements.


[34] Overhead and underground feed.
[35] Top feed only.
[36] Ampere rating of the circuit breaker supplied with this device can be changed to a LOWER value in the field by changing the setting on the circuit breaker.
[37] Supplied with copper horizontal bus bars and aluminum vertical bus bars.
[38] 225 A terminal box supplied with isolated neutral that cannot be bonded.
[39] Terminal box is suitable for use on LINE or LOAD side of service equipment. Supplied with isolated neutral and provided with neutral bonding kit for use as required. Refer to page 2-12 for
appropriate short circuit current ratings.
[40] Feed-thru lug kit available, seeTable 2.35
2-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
3 Phase Main Devices EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

Table 2.23: Main Device, Underground Feed Only


Factory-Installed Lug Landings For use
Ampere Horizontal Cross Width with Crimp-Type Lugs (2-Hole
Rating Bus Rating and Cat. No. (in.) Mounting) Qty. per Phase and Neutral,
Bus Bar Material except non-EUSERC device.[41]
Main Circuit Breakers (3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing)
Short Circuit Rating 65 kA 100 kA
400 400 A, Al EZM3400CBU [42] — 20.46 1 (Order Lugs Separately)
600 600 A, Al EZM3600CBU[42] — 26.19 2 (Order Lugs Separately)
800 800 A, Al EZM3800CBU [42] — 26.19 2 (Order Lugs Separately)
1000 1200 A, Cu — EZM31000CBU 34.19 3 (Order Lugs Separately)
1200 1200 A, Al EZM31200GCBU [43] [44] [45] EZM31200JCBU [43] [44] [45] 23.69 (4) 3/0-500
1200 1200 A, Al EZM31200GCBE [45] EZM31200JCBE [45] 32.39 3 (Order Lugs Separately)

METERING EQUIPMENT
1600 1200 A, Al/Cu EZM31600GCBU [43] [45][46] EZM31600JCBU [43] [45][46] 30.19 6 (Order Lugs Separately)
2000 1200 A, Al/Cu — EZM32000CBU [43][46] 30.19 6 (Order Lugs Separately)
Main Fusible Switches (3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing) Requires 300 Vac Class T Fuses (Order Separately)
 400 400 A, Al — EZM3400FSU 20.46 1 (Order Lugs Separately)
 600 600 A, Al — EZM3600FSU 26.19 2 (Order Lugs Separately)
 800 800 A, Al — EZM3800FSU 26.19 2 (Order Lugs Separately)
1200 1200 A, Al — EZM31200FSB [43][44] 23.69 (4) 3/0-500
1200 1200 A, Al — EZM31200FSE 32.39 3 (Order Lugs Separately)
Main Lugs Terminal Boxes (3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing)
 400 400 A, Al — EZM3400TBU [47] 17.16 1 (Order Lugs Separately)
 800 800 A, Al — EZM3800TBU [47] 25.16 2 (Order Lugs Separately)
1200 1200 A, Cu — EZM31200TBU [47] 33.16 3 (Order Lugs Separately)
Main Circuit Breaker (3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing) with Energy reduction Maintenance Switch (ERMS)
EZM31200GCBU 1200 1200 A, Cu EZM31200GCBUMS EZM31200JCBUMS 23.69 (4) 3/0–500
1200 1200 A, Cu EZM31200GCBEMS EZM31200JCBEMS 32.39 3 (Order Lugs Separately)
1600 1200 A, Cu EZM31600GCBUMS EZM31600JCBUMS 30.19 6 (Order Lugs Separately)

2
2000 1200 A, Cu EZM32000CBUMS — 30.19 6 (Order Lugs Separately)

[41] For mechanical lugs (3/0 AWG– 600 kcmil) order kit CMELK4. Kit includes 4 lugs only. Multiple kits may be required, consult factory. For crimp-type lugs refer to Anderson Electrical
Connector Products Catalog AEC-40R.
[42] Available by special order with main circuit breaker supplied with other standard ampere ratings, consult your nearest Field Sales Office (allow 6 weeks for delivery).
[43] Does not meet EUSERC requirements.
[44] For field installed Lug Landing Kit order catalog number EZM1200ULL.
[45] Ampere rating of the circuit breaker supplied with this device can be changed to a LOWER value in the field by changing the setting on the circuit breaker.
[46] Supplied with copper horizontal bus bars and aluminum vertical bus bars.
[47] Terminal box is suitable for use on LINE or LOAD side of service equipment. Supplied with isolated neutral and provided with neutral bonding kit for use as required. Refer to page 2-12 for
appropriate short circuit current ratings.
2-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers 3 Phase Branch Devices
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

3 Phase Branch Devices—NEMA 3R Construction


Table 2.24: Branch Units—3Ø Incoming and 1Ø Outgoing
Horizontal Cross Bus Cat. No.
System Type Width Number of
(in.) Meter Sockets Rating [48] Ring Type 5-Jaw Meter Socket Ringless Type 5-Jaw Meter Ringless Type 5-Jaw Meter
and Bus Bar Material without Bypass[49] Socket without Bypass Socket with Horn Bypass
125 A Maximum (Order Type QO, QO-VH or QOH Circuit Breakers Separately) [50]
800 A Al EZM313125 [48] EZMR313125 [48] EZMH313125 [48]
2

3 800 A Al EZM313125M10 [51] — —


1200 A Cu EZM313125CUX EZMR313125CUX EZMH313125CUX
800 A Al EZM314125 [48] EZMR314125 [48] EZMH314125 [48]
3Ø4W 4 800 A Al EZM314125M10 [51] — —
208Y/120 Vac 1200 A Cu EZM314125CUX EZMR314125CUX EZMH314125CUX
5-Jaw-Meter Socket 12.25
2P Branch 800 A Al EZM315125 [48] EZMR315125 [48] EZMH315125 [48]
Circuit Breakers 5 800 A Al EZM315125M10 [51] — —
METERING EQUIPMENT

1200 A Cu EZM315125CUX EZMR315125CUX EZMH315125CUX


800 A Al EZM316125 [48] EZMR316125 [48] EZMH316125 [48]
6 800 A Al EZM316125M10 [51] — —
1200 A Cu EZM316125CUX EZMR316125CUX EZMH316125CUX
225 A Maximum (Order Type QBP-TM, QDP-TM,QGP-TM or QJP-TM Circuit Breakers Separately) [52]
800 A Al EZM312225 [48] EZMR312225 [48] EZMH312225 [48]
2
1200 A Cu EZM312225CUX EZMR312225CUX EZMH312225CUX
800 A Al EZM313225 [48] EZMR313225 [48] EZMH313225 [48]
3
3Ø4W 1200 A Cu EZM313225CUX EZMR313225CUX EZMH313225CUX
17.38
208Y/120 Vac 800 A Al EZM314225 [48] EZMR314225 [48] EZMH314225 [48]
5-Jaw-Meter Socket 4
1200 A Cu EZM314225CUX EZMR314225CUX EZMH314225CUX
2P Branch 1200 A Al/Cu EZM315225 EZMR315225 EZMH315225
Circuit Breakers 5
1200 A Cu EZM315225CU EZMR315225CU EZMH315225CU
1200 A Al/Cu EZM316225 EZMR316225 EZMH316225
17.37 6 1200 A Cu EZM316225CU EZMR316225CU EZMH316225CU
1200 A Al/Cu EZM316225CA EZMR316225CA EZMH316225CA

Table 2.25: Branch Units—225 A Maximum Commercial


Ringless Type Meter Socket
Ringless Type Meter Socket Ring Type Meter Socket with
Number Horizontal with Lever Bypass and Jaw Test Block Bypass. Meets
Cross Bus without Bypass
System Type of Meter Release EUSERC Requirements
Rating and Bus
Sockets Width Width Width
Bar Material Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
(in.) (in.) (in.)
3Ø Incoming and 1Ø Outgoing [53] (Order Type QBP-TM, QDP-TM,QGP-TM or QJP-TM circuit breakers separately) [54]
1 1200 A Al/Cu — — — — EZMT311225 [55] 22.42
1200 A Al/Cu — — EZML312225 EZMT312225 [55] 22.42
3Ø4W
208Y/120 Vac 2 1200 A Cu — — EZML312225CU 19.44 — —
5-Jaw 1200 A Al/Cu — — EZML312225D [50] — —
Meter 1200 A Al/Cu — — EZML313225 EZMT313225 [55][56] 22.42
Sockets
2P 3 1200 A Cu — — EZML313225CU 19.44 — —
Branch 1200 A Al/Cu — — EZML313225D [50] — —
Circuit 1200 A Al/Cu — — EZML314225 —
Breakers
4 1200 A Cu — — EZML314225CU 19.44 — —
1200 A Al/Cu — — EZML314225D [50] —
EZMT311225
3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing (Order QBP-TM, QDP-TM, QGP-TM or QJP-TM circuit breakers separately, see [54]
1200 A Al/Cu — — EZML331225 EZMT331225 [55] 22.42
1 1200 A Cu — — EZML331225CU 19.44 — —
3Ø4W 1200 A Al/Cu — — EZML331225D [50] — —
240/120 Vac
Delta 1200 A Al/Cu EZMR332225 EZML332225 EZMT332225 [55] 22.42
or 2 1200 A Cu EZMR332225CU 19.44 EZML332225CU 19.44 — —
208Y/120 Vac 1200 A Al/Cu — EZML332225D [50] — —
7-Jaw
EZML313225 Meter Socket 1200 A Al/Cu EZMR333225 EZML333225 EZMT333225 [55][56] 22.42
3P 3 1200 A Cu EZMR333225CU 19.44 EZML333225CU 19.44 — —
EZMT311225 Branch 1200 A Al/Cu — EZML333225D [50] — —
Without Cover Circuit
Breakers 1200 A Al/Cu EZMR334225 EZML334225 —
4 1200 A Cu EZMR334225CU 19.44 EZML334225CU 19.44 — —
1200 A Al/Cu — EZML334225D [50] —

[48] For 1200 A main cross bus, add suffix “X” to catalog number. Example: EZMR313125X.. Allow 6 weeks for delivery.
[49] Snap-On aluminum sealing rings supplied as standard.
[50] Supplied with removable drip hood and equipped with an indoor top endwall with knockouts provided.
[51] Distance between meter sockets as measured from centerline to centerline is 10 inches.
[52] 2P Type QO (40–125 A, 10 kA max. meter center SCCR) or QO-VH and QO-H (40–60 A, 100 kA max. meter center SCCR) may be installed using EZM125QOA adapter kit, see page 2-22.
[53] For 240/120 Vac Delta Systems add Suffix “CA” to catalog number (Example: EZM314125CA). All meter sockets are phased A and C only. Price remains the same as the base catalog
number. Order only branch units, not stocked in PDS (6-week delivery).
[54] 2P Type QO (40–125 A, 10 kA max. meter center SCCR) or QO-VH and QO-H (40–60 A, 100 kA max. meter center SCCR) may be installed using EZM125QOA adapter kit, refer to.
[55] Supplied with bondable neutral, suitable for use as service equipment. Use main lugs terminal box type EZM-TBU for Six Disconnect Rule applications to feed this device. Supplied with
copper horizontal bus bars and aluminum vertical bus bars.
[56] Does not meet EUSERC 48 in. minImum / 75 in. maximum meter height requirements for outdoor installations. The bottom meter socket is 37 inches above ground when the device is
mounted with the top meter socket at 75 inches above ground. EUSERC indoor requirements are 36 in. minimum / 75 in. maximum.
For 400 A maximum Commercial Branch Units, see page 2-19.
2-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
3 Phase Branch Devices EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

Table 2.26: Branch Units—400 A Maximum Commercial


Ringless Type K Bolt-on
Ringless Type Meter Socket Meter Socket with Manual
with Lever Bypass and Jaw
Bypass—Includes
Number Horizontal Release—Includes Factory- Factory-Installed 400 A
System Type of Meter Cross Bus Installed 400 A Type LJL
Type LJL Circuit Breaker.
Sockets Rating Circuit Breaker. [57], [58] [58]
Width
Cat. No. Width (in.) Cat. No. (in.)
3Ø Incoming and 1Ø Outgoing [59]
3Ø4W 208Y/120 Vac 1 1200 A Cu EZML311400 23.21 EZMK311400 27.56
5-Jaw Meter Socket
2P Circuit Breakers 2 1200 A Cu EZML312400 23.21 EZMK312400 27.56
3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing
3Ø4W 240/120 Vac 1 1200 A Cu EZML331400 23.21 EZMK331400 27.56

METERING EQUIPMENT
Delta
or 208Y/120 Vac
7-Jaw Meter Socket 2 1200 A Cu EZML332400 23.21 EZMK332400 27.56
EZMK311400 3P Circuit Breakers

3Ø–1Ø OUT EZM Branch Unit Phase Balancing Flexibility


The major benefit of factory phase balancing is that most jobs will not require field phase
Starting Position Possible Ending Position balancing. To see if meter socket phase balancing in the field is required (refer to wiring
(By moving only one “Z” diagram for complete instructions):
connector)
AØ and BØ can be changed to AØ and CØ A. Determine if the load in amperes on each phase of the transformer using handle rating
AØ and CØ can be changed to AØ and BØ or BØ and CØ of tenant circuit breakers installed at each number of meter sockets. Use Phase
BØ and CØ can be changed to AØ and CØ
Balancing Chart to determine total number of connections each meter socket makes on
each phase of transformer.
B. If phase balancing is required, determine which meter sockets should be changed to
properly phase balance metering equipment lineup.

2
C. Once meter socket(s) is selected to be phase balanced, remove individual meter
socket cover from each meter socket to be phase balanced. The vertical bus bars
running top to bottom in the branch unit behind each meter socket are phased: AØ, BØ,
CØ, left to right.
D. By moving only the line side meter socket “Z” shaped connectors per meter socket to
be changed, phase balancing can easily be accomplished on-site:

Table 2.27: Example: To change an AØ and CØ meter socket to a BØ and CØ socket

Starting Position Step 2: Loosen hex nut from AØ line side meter socket jaw Step 1: Remove hex nut from AØ line side connection to
Meter Socket Phaseing: AØ and CØ and slide “Z” connector down to free connector from stud. vertical bus.

Step 3: Rotate “Z” connector to right and align with stud on BØ Step 4: Slide “Z” connector up to engage stud on BØ vertical
vertical bus. bus. Torque hex nut of meter socket jaw to 75 lb-in (8 N•m). Step 6: Replace hex nut (removed in Step 1) onto stud of BØ
vertical bus and torque to 75 lb-in (9 N•m).
Phase balancing of meter socket is complete: BØ and CØ.

[57] Supplied with Class 320 lever bypass meter socket. Use anti-inversion clip kit, catalog number MMLRK, if required. See page 2-22.
[58] LJL circuit breaker has adjustable trip settings from 125-400 A. Use seal kit MICROTUSEAL, if required. LJL circuit breaker terminal lug kit factory-installed and accommodates (2) 2/0-500
kcmil Cu-Al per phase. Alternate lug kit AL400L61K3 for LJL circuit breaker is available, see page 2-22.
[59] For 240/120 Vac Delta Systems add Suffix “CA” to catalog number (Example: EZML312400CA). All meter sockets are phased A and C only. Price remains the same as the base catalog
number. “Order only” branch units, not stocked in PDS (4–6 week delivery). Order point Lexington.
2-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers 3 Phase Main Devices (Busway Side Tap)
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

EZM Main with Busway Side Tap


EZ Meter-Pak metering equipment is available for use in high rise applications for
Wall connection to 800–5000 A I-Line™ or I-Line II plug-in busway installed as a vertical riser.
Three phase only EZM main devices in the form of a main circuit breaker or main fusible
5.75 switch are available with an integral busway tap extending from the right or left side of
146
CL of
the main device and phased to align with the busway for either neutral front or neutral
Busway back installations.
Plan View Detail Busway Mains, 3Ø only (Indoor only) ordering instructions:
Width Width
Step 1: Determine height to center line of busway plug-in opening, check local utility
Top of EZM Top of EZM requirements for minimum and maximum meter socket heights.
Mounting Mounting
Channel Channel Step 2: Determine side of EZM main section for busway tap to extend from (busway tap
(See Note)
EZM EZM (See Note) is an integral part of the main and extends to the left or right on the EZM device as
Bus Tap Bus Tap viewed from the front).
56.11 56.11
1425 1425 Step 3: Check phasing of busway riser to insure that it matches phasing of busway tap
CL of Busway CL of Busway
Plug-in Opening Plug-in Opening on main section (indicated as neutral front or neutral back as viewed from the front).
31.11 31.11
4.11 790 790 4.11 Step 4: Select Cat. No. from tables below.
104 104
Step 5: Busway main devices are build to order specials and require 4 to 6 weeks for
Floor Level Floor Level delivery.
EZM3800CBNFBTR EZM3800FSNBBTL

Table 2.28: EZM Busway Side Tap Mains Devices


Number Segment Character Description EZM 3 800 CB NF BTR
Device Name EZM EZ Meter-Pak Meter Center
Service Feed 3 3Ph, 4W
400 A
600 A
Mains Rating 800 A
1000 A
1200 A
CB Main Circuit Breaker
FS Main Fusible Switch
Main Type
GB Main Circuit Breaker (65 kAIC)
JB Main Circuit Breaker (100KAIC)
NF Neutral Front
Neutral Position
NB Neutral Back
BTL Bus Tap Left
Bus Tap Location
BTR Bus Tap Right
This table is for interpreting existing part numbers only. All possible combinations are not
available.
Table 2.29: 1200 A EZM Mains with Busway Side Tap (Three Phase Only—Note positioning left or right below)
Ampere Width Horizontal Cross Busway to LEFT of EZM Metering Equipment Lineup Busway to RIGHT of EZM Metering Equipment Lineup
Rating (in.) Bus Rating Neutral Front Neutral Back Neutral Front Neutral Back
Main Circuit Breaker with Busway Tap
65,000 RMS Symmetrical Amperes Maximum Short Circuit Current Rating
 400 18.66 400 A Al EZM3400CBNFBTL EZM3400CBNBBTL EZM3400CBNFBTR EZM3400CBNBBTR
 600 18.66 600 A Al EZM3600CBNFBTL EZM3600CBNBBTL EZM3600CBNFBTR EZM3600CBNBBTR
 800 18.66 800 A Al EZM3800CBNFBTL EZM3800CBNBBTL EZM3800CBNFBTR EZM3800CBNBBTR
1000 18.66 1000 A Al EZM31000CBNFBTL [60] EZM31000CBNBBTL [60] EZM31000CBNFBTR [60] EZM31000CBNBBTR [60]
1200 23.36 1200 A Cu EZM31200GBNFBTL [60] EZM31200GBNBBTL[60] EZM31200GBNFBTR [60] EZM31200GBNBBTR [60]
100,000 RMS Symmetrical Amperes Maximum Short Circuit Current Rating
1200 23.36 1200 A Cu EZM31200JBNFBTL [60] EZM31200JBNBBTL [60] EZM31200JBNFBTR [60] EZM31200JBNBBTR [60]
Main Fusible Switch with Busway Tap Requires Class T (300 Vac) Fuses - Order Separately
100,000 RMS Symmetrical Amperes Maximum Short Circuit Current Rating
 400 18.66 400 A Al EZM3400FSNFBTL EZM3400FSNBBTL EZM3400FSNFBTR EZM3400FSNBBTR
 600 18.66 600 A Al EZM3600FSNFBTL EZM3600FSNBBTL EZM3600FSNFBTR EZM3600FSNBBTR
 800 18.66 800 A Al EZM3800FSNFBTL EZM3800FSNBBTL EZM3800FSNFBTR EZM3800FSNBBTR
1200 22.36 1200 A Cu EZM31200FSNFBTL [60] EZM31200FSNBBTL [60] EZM31200FSNFBTR [60] EZM31200FSNBBTR [60]
NOTE: Dimensions shown position the centerline of top meter socket of a 125 A, 5-
Gang or 6-Gang branch unit at 72" above floor level. Check with utility to meet local
requirements.
Busway Transition Section
EZM busway transition section provides no overcurrent protection for the downstream
16.11 16.11 EZM branch units.
409 409
Width Width
Tenant main circuit breakers in these branch units must be selected as “fully rated”
4.11
104
4.11
104
equipment. (Examples: QO for 10 kA, QO-VH for 22 kA or QOH for 42 kA.)
EZM EZM
Bus Tap Bus Tap
Top of EZM
Table 2.30: EZM Busway Transition Sections (3Ø only)
1.00 1.00 Top of EZM
Mounting 25 25 Mounting Ampere Width
Channel Channel I-Line™ Busway location Neutral Front Neutral Back
Rating (in.)
CL of Busway CL of Busway
Plug-in Opening Plug-in Opening 1200 RIGHT of EZM Transition Section EZM3BUSRF EZM3BUSRB 12.00
56.11 55.11 55.11 56.11 1200 LEFT of EZM Transition Section EZM3BUSLF EZM3BUSLB 12.00
1425 1400 1400 1425

Floor Level Floor Level

EZM3BUSRF and EZM3BUSRB EZM3BUSLF and EZM3BUSLB

[60] Requires use of branch units supplied with 1200 A horizontal cross bus.
2-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
3 Phase Main Devices (Busway Center Tap) EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

EZM Main with Center-Mounted Busway Tap


The EZM Main with center-mounted busway tap is a space-saving design for high rise
applications that is installed as an integral component of the vertical riser busway and
allows standard EZM branches to be mounted from both sides. See online digest
updates for availability or contact your local field sales office for additional information
EZM Busway Center Tap Mains
The EZM Busway Center Tap mains offer provides a convenient space saving method
for connecting EZM Branch Meter sections to I-Line II Busway in vertical riser
applications. The mains are connected "inline" with the Busway column conserving
precious electrical room space.
1. The Part Number Coding Table is to be used for interpreting existing part numbers

METERING EQUIPMENT
only. All possible combinations are not available. Please contact product support for
additional references needed.
2. Outgoing Feeder Bus Joint-Pak is included with each EZM CTM Section.
3. EZM Horizontal Cross Bus is 1200 A Copper Only
4. Busway Center Tap Mains are fully NEMA 3R Rated.
5. Mains Devices are fully sealable by utility.
6. EZM Branch units are installed using the mounting kit - EZMCTMKIT.
7. Short circuit current rating = 150,000 symmetrical amps.
8. EZM CTM is configured for neutral front only (G-> N-> C-> B->A-> G) as viewed front
to rear.
9. Compatible with I-LINE II Busway rated 2000–5000 A.
10. Includes factory installed PowerPact M- and P-frame Circuit Breakers and Switches
(Rated 600–1200 A.)
11. Fully compatible with all standard EZ Meter-Pak Branch Devices and Extenders.

2
Table 2.31: Part Number Coding
Number Segment Character Description EZM 3 1000 JCB C 20
Device Name EZM EZM Busway Center Tap Main
System Connection (Phase Order: Front to Back) 3 3 Phase (N, C, B, A)
600 600 A
800 800 A
Maximum Current of Main Service Disconnect
1000 1000 A
1200 1200 A
GCB 65 kAIC Circuit Breaker
Type of Main Service Disconnect (with AIC Rating) JCB 100 kAIC Circuit Breaker
FS 100 kAIC Fused Switch
C Copper
Material of I-Line II
A Aluminum
20 2000 A
25 2500 A
30 3000 A
Amperage of I-Line II
32 3200 A
40 4000 A
50 5000 A
This table is for interpreting existing part numbers only. All possible combinations are not
available.
Table 2.32: EZM Busway Center Tap Mains
Main CB MC
I-Line II Busway Height Width Depth
Ampere Rating Rating Material Cat. No. (in.) (in.) (in.) Height
(A) (in.)
Main Circuit Breakers (3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing)
SCCR 65 kA 100 kA
2000A, Al — EZM3600JCBA20 43.08 22.70 14.78 56.11
3000A, Al — EZM3600JCBA30 43.08 22.70 14.78 56.11
4000A, Al — EZM3600JCBA40 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
600
4000A, Al EZM3600GCBA40 — 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
4000A, Cu EZM3600GCBC40 — 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
2000A, Al EZM3800GCBA20 — 43.08 22.70 14.78 56.11
3000A, Al EZM3800GCBA30 — 43.08 22.70 14.78 56.11
3000A, Cu EZM3800GCBC30 — 43.08 22.70 14.78 56.11
800
3000A, Al — EZM3800JCBA30 43.08 22.70 14.78 56.11
4000A, Al — EZM3800JCBA40 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
4000A, Al EZM3800GCBA40 — 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
4000A, Al EZM31000GCBA40 — 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
1000 4000A, Al — EZM31000JCBA40 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
4000A, Cu — EZM31000JCBC40 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
4000A, Al EZM31200GCBA40 — 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
1200 4000A, Al — EZM31200JCBA40 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11

2-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers Tenant Circuit Breakers and EZM
Accessories
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701 schneider-electric.us

Tenant Circuit Breakers and EZM Accessories


Table 2.33: 125 A Max. EZM Branch Unit Tenant Circuit Breakers
Poles Ampere Rating 10 k AIR 22 k AIR 42 k AIR 100 k AIR
40 QO240 QO240VH QOH240 —
50 QO250 QO250VH QOH250 —
60 QO260 QO260VH QOH260 —
QO2100VH, 70 QO270 QO270VH QOH270 —
Plug-on Type 2 80 QO280 QO280VH QOH280 —
QO290 QO290VH QOH290
2

Circuit Breaker 90 —
100 QO2100 QO2100VH QOH2100 —
110 QO2110 QO2110VH QOH2110 —
125 QO2125 QO2125VH QOH2125 —

Table 2.34: 225 A Max. EZM Branch Unit Tenant Circuit Breakers
Poles Ampere Rating 10 k AIR 25 k AIR 65 k AIR 100 k AIR
METERING EQUIPMENT

40 QO240 [61] QO240VH [61] [62] QOH240 [61] [63] —


50 QO250 [61] QO250VH [61] [62] QOH250 [61] [63] —
60 QO260 [61] QO260VH [61] [62] QOH260 [61] [63] —
70 QBP22070TM QDP22070TM QGP22070TM QJP22070TM
80 QBP22080TM QDP22080TM QGP22080TM QJP22080TM
90 QBP22090TM QDP22090TM QGP22090TM QJP22090TM
2 100 QBP22100TM QDP22100TM QGP22100TM QJP22100TM
110 QBP22110TM QDP22110TM QGP22110TM QJP22110TM
125 QBP22125TM QDP22125TM QGP22125TM QJP22125TM
150 QBP22150TM QDP22150TM QGP22150TM QJP22150TM
175 QBP22175TM QDP22175TM QGP22175TM QJP22175TM
200 QBP22200TM QDP22200TM QGP22200TM QJP22200TM
225 QBP22225TM QDP22225TM QGP22225TM QJP22225TM
70 QBP32070TM QDP32070TM QGP32070TM QJP32070TM [64]
80 QBP32080TM QDP32080TM QGP32080TM QJP32080TM [64]
90 QBP32090TM QDP32090TM QGP32090TM QJP32090TM [64]
100 QBP32100TM QDP32100TM QGP32100TM QJP32100TM[64]
QDP22200TM 110 QBP32110TM QDP32110TM QGP32110TM QJP32110TM [64]
3 125 QBP32125TM QDP32125TM QGP32125TM QJP32125TM [64]
150 QBP32150TM QDP32150TM QGP32150TM QJP32150TM [64]
175 QBP32175TM QDP32175TM QGP32175TM QJP32175TM [64]
200 QBP32200TM QDP32200TM QGP32200TM QJP32200TM [64]
225 QBP32225TM QDP32225TM QGP32225TM QJP32225TM [64]

[61] Must use EZM125QOA adapter.


[62] QO-VH tenant circuit breaker is rated 22 k AIR max.
[63] QOH tenant circuit breaker is rated 42 k AIR max.
[64] 3-pole QJP tenant circuit breaker is rated 65 k AIR max. at 240/120 Vac, 3Ø4W High Leg Delta, or 100 k AIR max. at 208Y/120 Vac, 3Ø4W.
2-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Tenant Circuit Breakers and EZM EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers
Accessories
schneider-electric.us Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
Table 2.35: Accessories
Accessory Description Cat. No.
1Ø3W Bus Extension (6 in.wide) EZM1EXT6
1200 A Bus Extension (Indoor/ Outdoor Cu 1Ø3W Bus Extension (12 in.wide) EZM1EXT
bus) 3Ø4W Bus Extension (6 in. wide) EZM3EXT6
3Ø4W Bus Extension (12 in. wide) EZM3EXT
1Ø3W Inside Corner (14.75 in. wide) EZM1CORNER
1200 A Bussed Corner Sections (Indoor Cu 1Ø3W Outside Corner (6.20 in. wide) EZM1ELBOW
bus only) 3Ø4W Inside Corner (14.75 in. wide) EZM3CORNER
3Ø4W Outside Corner (6.20 in. wide) EZM3ELBOW
Add right of old style 1Ø EZM lineup EZM1TRANR
1200 A Transition Sections— Add right of old style 3Ø EZM lineup
Old to New EZM3TRANR
(10.7 in. wide Cu bus) Add left of old style 1Ø EZM lineup EZM1TRANL
Add left of old style 3Ø EZM lineup EZM3TRANL
Mounting Channel 72" long EZM72MC

METERING EQUIPMENT
Secondary Surge Arrester Mounting kit For use with 1 or 2-SDSA1175 or 1-SDSA3650 (order surge arrester separately) MMSAMK [65]
Stud Kit for EZM-TB 400–600 A terminal Includes (2) 1/2 in.-13 studs per pad and mounting hardware. Four pads per kit. EZMSK2
box
(1) 1/0–600 kcmil or (2) 1/0–250 kcmil per lug MMLK250
Al/Cu Lug Kits (2) 3/0–500 kcmil per lug
(Each kit includes three, 2-barrel lugs.) MMLK500
(2) 2–600 kcmil per lug MMLK600
Feed -Thru for EZM-TB 800 A Terminal Box (4) 750 kcmil Al/Cu lugs per phase and neutral. Al wire 600 A max. Cu wire 800 A max. EZM600FTLK3
Feed-Thru for EZM-TB 1600 A Terminal (24) additional lugs, 600 kcmil Al/Cu, (6) per phase and neutral. EZM1600FTLK3
Box
EZM Mains Right Side Closure Cap Replacement right side end cap for EZM Cross Bus Opening EZMSCAP
EZM Mains Left Side Closure Cap Replacement left side end cap for EZM Cross Bus Opening EZMCAP
Fifth Jaw Kit 1 per kit 5J [66]
Horn Bypass Kit Use with Type EZMR 1Ø meter socket only MMHB
Slider Type Manual Circuit Closer For (1) 125–225 A ring-type socket only—indoor/outdoor MM200MB [67] [68]
Anti-inversion Clip Rejects 100 A and 200 A watt-hour meters in Class 320 meter sockets in Type EZML branch units. MMLRK
QO Adapter for bolt-on Q-frame tenant For 2P Type QO (40–125 A, 10 kA max. meter center SCCR) or QO-VH and QOH (40–60 A, 100 kA max. meter center
SCCR) EZM125QOA
circuit breakers

2
LJL Circuit Breaker Alternate Lug (DE2) Kit includes (3) separate lugs for (1) #2 AWG - 500 kcmil Al or (1) #2 AWG - 600 kcmil Cu per lug. AL400L61K3
LJL Circuit Breaker Seal Kit Tamper-evident kit to seal LJL trip dial cover, (1) per circuit breaker, if required. Meets NEC 240-6 [c] MICROTUSEAL
Lexan Closing Plate—EZM, EZMR, EZMH, EZMT 29007
Meter Socket Closing Plates
Metal Closing plate—EZMR, EZMH, EZML RSG4
Snap-on (Stainless Steel) ARP00026
Sealing Rings Screw-Type (Aluminum) 29008W
Latch-Type (Aluminum)-standard 2920910001
For use on ringless EZM or MP branch unit covers, includes 6 each of head protectors, lock nuts and sealing caps. (Barrel
Barrel Lock Kit lock not included.) MMBLC
125 A Branches—2P Type QO (2 per opening)
Tenant Circuit Breaker Filler Plates QOFP
225 A Branches—2P and 3P Q-Frame
Lug Landing Kit For use with EZM 1200 A Mains suffix -CBU or -FSB. Order lugs separately. EZM1200ULL
Branch Section Mounting Kit for Riser This kit is needed when installing and connecting meter center branch sections to EZ-Meter Pak busway center tap mains in
Applications. multi-floor riser applications (1 per branch section) EZMCTMKIT

[65] Consult your nearest Schneider Electric sales office for details.
[66] All sockets include 5th Jaw factory-installed except EZM11__ devices.
[67] Meter center short circuit current rating is 10,000 RMS symmetrical amperes with manual circuit closers installed (bypass is not designed for use as continuous duty).
[68] For use on ring type meter sockets only.
2-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers Dimensions
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us

Dimensions for EZ Meter-Pak Meter Centers


Table 2.36: Main Device Dimensions (in.)
Height Width Depth MC Channel Height Width Depth MC Channel
Cat. No. (H) (W) (D) (MC) Cat. No. (H) (W) (D) (MC)
EZM11000CB 53.91 18.66 11.50 34.30 EZM1ELBOW [69] [70] [71] 19.50 14.52 8.01 11.85
EZM11000CBU 70.05 34.19 18.33 46.99 EZM31000CB 53.91 18.66 11.50 34.30
EZM11200G/JCBT 46.90 23.69 13.69 13.75 EZM31000CBU 70.05 34.19 18.33 46.99
EZM11200G/JCBE 66.20 32.39 13.69 50.09 EZM31200G/JCBT 46.90 23.69 13.69 13.75
2

EZM11200FST 46.90 23.69 13.69 13.75 EZM31200G/JCBE 66.20 32.39 13.69 50.09
W EZM11200FSE 66.20 32.39 13.69 50.09 EZM31200TBU 44.71 33.16 11.68 31.17
EZM11200G/JCBU 65.30 23.69 13.69 49.11 EZM31200G/JCBU 65.30 23.69 13.69 49.11
EZM11200FSB 65.30 23.69 13.69 49.11 EZM31200FSB 65.30 23.69 13.69 49.11
EZM11200TBU 44.71 33.16 11.68 31.17 EZM31200FST 46.90 23.69 13.69 13.75
EZM11200GCBUMS 65.30 23.69 13.63 49.12 EZM31200FSE 66.20 32.39 13.69 51.09
EZM11200GCBEMS 66.27 32.39 13.70 50.09 EZM31200GCBUMS 65.30 23.69 13.63 49.12
METERING EQUIPMENT

MC (Mounting Channel)

EZM11200GCBTMS 46.93 23.69 13.63 13.75 EZM31200GCBEMS 66.27 32.39 13.70 50.09
EZM11200JCBUMS 65.30 23.69 13.63 49.12 EZM31200GCBTMS 46.93 23.69 13.63 13.75
EZM11200JCBEMS 66.27 32.39 13.70 50.09 EZM31200JCBUMS 65.30 23.69 13.63 49.12
H EZM11200JCBTMS 46.93 23.69 13.63 13.75 EZM31200JCBEMS 66.27 32.39 13.70 50.09
EZM11600G/JCBC 68.70 30.19 18.33 38.13 EZM31200JCBTMS 46.93 23.69 13.63 13.75
EZM11600G/JCBU 68.70 30.19 18.33 49.12 EZM31600G/JCBC 68.70 30.19 18.33 38.13
EZM11600TB 55.09 22.48 13.00 27.92 EZM31600G/JCBU 68.70 30.19 18.33 49.12
EZM11600GCBUMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50 EZM31600TB 55.09 22.48 13.00 27.92
EZM11600GCBCMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50 EZM31600GCBUMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50
EZM11600JCBUMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50 EZM31600GCBCMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50
EZM11600JCBCMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50 EZM31600JCBUMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50
EZM12000CB 68.70 30.19 18.33 44.25 EZM31600JCBCMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50
Main Device EZM12000CBU 68.70 30.19 18.33 44.25 EZM32000CB 68.70 30.19 18.33 44.25
EZM12000TB 71.09 30.19 21.46 37.62 EZM32000CBU 68.70 30.19 18.33 44.25
W EZM12000CBMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50 EZM32000TB 71.09 30.19 21.46 37.62
EZM12000CBUMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50 EZM32000CBMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50
T EZM1225TB [71] 21.81 11.66 6.37 13.00 EZM32000CBUMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50
EZM1400CB 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30 EZM3225TB [71] 21.81 11.66 6.37 13.00
EZM1400CBU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37 EZM3400CB 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30
EZM1400FS 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30 EZM3400CBU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37
MC (Mounting Channel)

EZM1400FSU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37 EZM3400FS 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30
EZM1400TB 30.46 17.15 7.09 16.29 EZM3400FSU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37
EZM1400TBU 35.71 17.16 8.00 27.17 EZM3400TB 30.46 17.15 7.09 16.29
H EZM1600CB 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30 EZM3400TBU 35.71 17.16 8.00 27.17
EZM1600CBU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37 EZM3600CB 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30
EZM16000FS 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30 EZM3600CBU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37
EZM1600FSU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37 EZM36000FS 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30
EZM1600TB 30.46 17.15 7.09 16.29 EZM3600FSU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37
EZM1800CB 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30 EZM3600TB 30.46 17.15 7.09 16.29
B EZM1800CBU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37 EZM3800CB 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30
EZM1800FS 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30 EZM3800CBU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37
EZM1800FSU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37 EZM3800FS 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30
Branch Device EZM1800TB 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30 EZM3800FSU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37
EZM1800TBCU 51.76 22.48 7.09 28.01 EZM3800TB 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30
EZM1800TBU 39.96 25.16 11.68 31.17 EZM3800TBCU 51.76 22.48 7.09 28.01
EZM1EXT [71] 19.34 11.66 6.37 11.85 EZM3800TBU 39.96 25.16 11.68 31.17
EZM1EXT6 [71] 19.34 6.00 6.37 11.85 EZM3EXT [71] 19.34 11.66 6.37 11.85
EZM1CORNER [69][71][72] 19.50 14.40 8.02 11.85 EZM3EXT6 [71] 19.34 6.00 6.37 11.85
EZM3CORNER [69] [71] [72] 19.50 14.40 8.02 11.85

[69] Indoor only.


[70] Each leg of elbow section measures 6.17 in. corner of wall to start of next enclosure.
[71] Device supplied without mounting channel, secure to wall by use of swingable mounting feet.
[72] Each leg of this corner section measures 14.72 in. from wall to start of next enclosure.
2-24
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Dimensions EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us
W

MC (Mounting Channel)
H

METERING EQUIPMENT
B

Branch Device
Table 2.37: Single Phase Branch Device Dimensions (in.) [73]
Height Width Depth MC Top Bottom Height Width Depth MC Top Bottom
Cat. No. Channel Meter Meter Cat. No. Channel Meter Meter
[available suffix] (H) (W) (D) [available suffix] (H) (W) (D)
(MC) (T) (B) (MC) (T) (B)
EZM112225 [X, CUX] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 22.18 12.23 EZML111400 44.55 23.21 9.44 37.81 24.02 21.53
EZM113125 [X, CUX] 42.37 12.25 7.09 31.30 13.18 11.19 EZML112225 [CU] 39.06 19.44 9.44 25.51 11.67 13.39
EZM113225 [X, CUX] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 13.18 12.23 EZML112225D 39.06 19.44 9.44 25.51 11.67 13.39
EZM114125 [X, CUX] 48.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19 EZML112400 69.61 23.21 9.44 37.81 20.64 21.53
EZM114225 [X, CUX] 52.00 17.38 8.09 32.34 12.77 12.23 EZML113225 [CU] 53.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39
EZM115125 [X, CUX] 57.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19 EZML113225D 53.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39
EZM115225 [CU] 61.00 17.38 8.09 32.35 12.77 12.23 EZML114225 [CU] 67.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39
EZM116125 [X, CUX] 66.12 12.25 7.09 40.30 9.93 11.19 EZML114225D 67.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39

2
EZM16225 69.94 17.387 8.09 41.33 12.72 12.22 EZMR112225 [X, CUX] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 22.18 12.23
EZMH112225 [X, CUX] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 22.18 12.23 EZMR113125 [X, CUX] 42.37 12.25 7.09 31.30 13.18 11.19
EZMH113125 [X, CUX] 42.37 12.25 7.09 31.30 13.18 11.19 EZMR113225 [X, CUX] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 13.18 12.23
EZMH113225 [X, CUX] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 13.18 12.23 EZMR114125 [X, CUX] 48.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19
EZMH114125 [X, CUX] 48.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19 EZMR114225 [X, CUX] 52.00 17.38 8.09 32.34 12.77 12.23
EZMH114225 [X, CUX] 52.00 17.38 8.09 32.34 12.77 12.23 EZMR115125 [X, CUX] 57.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19
EZMH115125 [X, CUX] 57.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19 EZMR115225 [CU] 61.00 17.38 8.09 32.35 12.77 12.23
EZMH115225 [CU] 61.00 17.38 8.09 32.35 12.77 12.23 EZMR116125 [X, CUX] 66.12 12.25 7.09 40.30 9.93 11.19
EZMH116125 [X, CUX] 66.12 12.25 7.09 40.30 9.93 11.19 EZMR116225 69.94 17.37 8.09 41.33 12.72 12.22
EZMH116225 69.94 17.37 8.09 41.33 12.72 12.22 EZMT111225 25.45 22.42 9.38 16.19 4.67 20.45
EZMK111400 45.55 27.56 9.74 37.81 24.51 21.04 EZMT112225 60.56 22.42 9.38 43.63 12.67 28.89
EZMK112400 72.99 27.56 9.74 37.81 22.26 21.04 EZMT113225 79.56 22.42 9.38 48.25 12.67 28.89
EZML111225 [CU] 39.06 19.44 9.44 25.51 25.67 13.39
EZML111225D 39.06 19.44 9.44 25.51 25.67 13.39

Table 2.38: Three Phase Branch Device Dimensions (in.) [73]


MC Top Bottom Heig- MC Top Bottom
Cat. No. Height Width Depth Cat. No. Width Depth
(H) (W) (D) Channel Meter Meter ht (W) (D) Channel Meter Meter
[available suffix] (MC) (T) (B) [available suffix] (H) (MC) (T) (B)
EZM312225 [X, CUX, CA, XCA, CUXCA] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 22.18 12.23 EZML314225 [CU, CA, CUCA] 67.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39
EZM313125 [X, CUX, CA, XCA, CUXCA] 42.37 12.25 7.09 31.30 13.18 11.19 EZML314225D [CA] 67.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39
EZM313125M10 42.37 12.25 7.09 24.29 10.18 12.19 EZML331225 [CU] 39.06 19.44 9.44 25.51 25.67 13.39
EZM313225 [X, CUX, CA, XCA, CUXCA] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 13.18 12.23 EZML331225D 39.06 19.44 9.44 25.51 25.67 13.39
EZM314125 [X, CUX, CA, XCA, CUXCA] 48.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19 EZML331400 45.55 23.21 9.44 37.81 24.02 21.53
EZM314125M10 52.12 12.25 7.09 34.29 9.93 12.19 EZML332225 [CU] 39.06 19.44 9.44 35.51 11.67 13.39
EZM314225 [X, CUX, CA, XCA, CUXCA] 52.00 17.38 8.09 32.34 12.77 12.23 EZML332225D 39.06 19.44 9.44 35.51 11.67 13.39
EZM315125 [X, CUX, CA, XCA, CUXCA] 57.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19 EZML332400 [CU] 69.61 23.21 9.44 37.82 20.64 21.53
EZM315125M10 62.12 12.25 7.09 34.29 9.93 12.19 EZML333225 [CU] 53.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39
EZM315225 [CU, CA, CUCA] 61.00 17.38 8.09 32.35 12.77 12.23 EZML333225D 53.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39
EZM316125 [X, CUX, CA, XCA, CUXCA] 66.12 12.25 7.09 40.30 9.93 11.19 EZML334225 [CU] 67.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39
EZM316225 [CU, CA] 69.94 17.37 8.09 41.33 12.72 12.22 EZML334225D 67.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39
EZMH312225 [X, CUX, CA, XCA] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 22.18 12.23 EZMR312225 [X, CUX, CA, XCA] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 22.18 12.23
EZMH313125 [X, CUX, CA, XCA] 42.37 12.25 7.09 31.30 13.18 11.19 EZMR313125 [X, CUX, CA, XCA] 42.37 12.25 8.09 31.30 13.18 11.19
EZMH313225 [X, CUX, CA, XCA] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 13.18 12.23 EZMR313225 [X, CUX, CA, XCA] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 13.18 12.23
EZMH314125 [X, CUX, CA, XCA] 48.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19 EZMR314125 [X, CUX, CA, XCA] 48.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19
EZMH314225 [X, CUX, CA, XCA] 52.00 17.38 8.09 32.34 12.77 12.23 EZMR314225 [X, CUX, CA, XCA] 52.00 17.38 8.09 32.34 12.77 12.23
EZMH315125 [X, CUX, CA, XCA] 57.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19 EZMR315125 [X, CUX, CA, XCA] 57.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19
EZMH315225 [CU, CA, CUCA] 61.00 17.38 8.09 32.35 12.77 12.23 EZMR315225 [CU, CA, CUXCA] 61.00 17.38 8.09 32.35 12.77 12.23
EZMH316125 [X, CUX, CA, XCA] 66.12 12.25 7.09 40.30 9.93 11.19 EZMR316125 [X, CUX, CA, XCA] 66.12 12.25 7.09 40.30 9.93 11.19
EZMH316225 [CU, CA] 69.94 17.37 8.09 41.33 12.72 12.22 EZMR316225 [CU, CA] 69.94 17.37 8.09 41.33 12.72 12.22
EZMK311400 [CA] 45.55 27.56 9.74 30.60 24.51 21.04 EZMR332225 [CU] 39.06 19.44 9.44 25.51 11.67 13.39
EZMK312400 [CA] 72.99 27.56 9.74 37.81 22.26 21.04 EZMR333225 [CU] 53.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39
EZMK331400 45.55 27.56 9.74 30.60 24.51 21.04 EZMR334225 [CU] 67.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39
EZMK332400 72.99 27.56 9.74 37.81 22.26 21.04 EZMT311225 [CA] 25.45 22.42 9.38 16.19 4.67 20.45
EZML311400 [CA] 45.55 23.21 9.44 37.81 24.02 21.53 EZMT312225 [CA] 60.56 22.42 9.38 43.63 12.67 28.89
EZML311225 [CU, CA, CUCA] 39.06 19.44 9.44 25.51 25.67 13.39 EZMT313225 [CA] 79.56 22.42 9.38 48.25 12.67 28.89
EZML312225 [CU, CA, CUCA] 39.06 19.44 9.44 25.51 11.67 13.39 EZMT331225 25.12 22.42 9.38 16.19 4.67 20.45
EZML312225D [CA] 39.06 19.44 9.44 25.51 11.67 13.39 EZMT332225 60.56 22.42 9.38 43.63 12.67 28.89
EZML312400 [CA] 69.61 23.21 9.44 37.82 20.64 21.53 EZMT333225 79.56 22.42 9.38 48.25 12.67 28.89
EZML313225 [CU, CA, CUCA] 53.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39
EZML313225D [CA] 53.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39

[73] Standard branch units are available without suffix added.


2-25
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers Dimensions
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us
2
METERING EQUIPMENT

2-26
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents

Section 3
Safety Switches
EZ Selector - Selection Assistance 3-2

Safety Switches EZ Selector - Selection Assistance 3-2


Light Duty Safety Switches 3-3

Light Duty—Visible Blades 10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating 3-3


General Duty Safety Switches 3-3

General Duty—Up to 100 kA Short Circuit Current Rating 3-3


240 Volt—Single Throw Fusible Switches 3-3
Light Duty 240 Volt—Single Throw Non-Fusible Switches 3-4
UL Listed Maximum Short Circuit Current Ratings — AC Only 3-4
Accessories and Lug Data 3-5
Field-Installed Fuse Puller Kits 3-5
Field-Installed Electrical Interlock Kits 3-5
Equipment Grounding Kits 3-5
Field-Installed Lug Kit 400 A – 600 A 3-5

SAFETY SWITCHES
Terminal Lug Data 3-5
Dimensions for General Duty Safety Switches 3-6
Heavy Duty Safety Switches 3-7

240 Volt—Single Throw Fusible Switches 3-7


600 Volt—Single Throw Fusible Switches 3-8
600 Volt—Single Throw Non-Fusible Switches 3-9
UL Listed Maximum Short Circuit Current Ratings—AC only 3-10
Ge ne ra l Duty Special Applications 3-11
Receptacle Switches 3-13
Accessories and Special Features 3-14
Dimensions for Heavy Duty Safety Switches 3-20

3
NEMA Type 1 and 3R 3-20
NEMA Type 4, 4X, 5, 7, 9, and 12 3-21
Double Throw Safety Switches 3-23

Fusible and Non-Fusible Overview 3-23


240 Volt — Double Throw Safety Switches 3-24
600 Volt — Double Throw Safety Switches 3-25
Accessories and Lug Data 3-26
Application Data 3-28
Terminal Lug Data 3-29
Dimensions for Double Throw Safety Switches 3-30
He a vy Duty Series F Devices 30–100 A 3-30
Series A, E, and T4 Devices 3-31
Photovoltaic Disconnect Switches 3-32

1000 Vdc Photovoltaic Heavy Duty Disconnect Switch 3-32

S ta inle s s S te e l He a vy Duty

© 2017 Schneider Electric


All Rights Reserved 3-1

11/10/2017
EZ Selector - Selection Assistance Safety Switches EZ Selector - Selection
Assistance
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701 schneider-electric.us

Safety Switches EZ Selector - Selection Assistance


EZ Selector
Steps to select a safety switch.
1. Select product type:
• General duty safety switch
• Heavy duty safety switch
• Double throw safety switch
2. Select switch type.
3. Select fuse type: fused, non-fused, cartridge, class T or plug
4. Select maximum voltage: 240 Vac, 600 Vac
5. Select amperes:
• General/light duty – 30 A, 60 A, 100 A, 200 A, 400 A, 800 A
• Heavy duty – 30 A, 60 A, 100 A, 200 A, 225 A, 400 A, 600 A, 800 A, 1200 A
• Double throw – 30 A, 60 A, 100 A, 200 A, 400 A, 600 A
3

6. Select number of poles:


• General/light duty – 1, 2 or 3
• Heavy duty – 2, 3, 4 or 6
• General/light duty – 2, 3, 4 or 6
7. Select if neutral is needed.
8. Select enclosure type:
SAFETY SWITCHES

• General/light duty – NEMA 1, NEMA 3R


• Heavy duty – NEMA1, NEMA 12K, NEMA 3R, 5, 12, NEMA 4, 4X, 5
(stainless steel 304), NEMA 4, 4X, 5 (stainless steel 316)
• Double throw – NEMA1, NEMA 12K, NEMA 3R, 5, 12, NEMA 4, 4X, 5
(stainless steel 304)
• Optional enclosure types for special heavy duty applications.
Additional Information
• Search “Safety Switches” from our technical FAQs page: www.schneider-electric.us/
en/faqs/home/
• Refer to catalog 3100CT1602.

3-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Light Duty Safety Switches
Class 3130 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

Light Duty—Visible Blades 10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating


The Square D light duty enclosed switch is ideal for home applications in disconnecting
power to workshops, hobby rooms, furnaces, and garages. The light duty safety switch
has visible blades and a ground lug as standard features.

Table 3.1: Fusible


Horsepower Ratings
NEMA Type 1 120 Vac 240 Vac
System Amperes Fuse Indoor
Cat. No. Std. Max. Std. Max.
1Ø 1Ø 1Ø 1Ø
2 Wire (1 Blades and Fuseholders, 1 Neutral)—120 Vac

30 Plug L111N — — — —

L221N 3 Wire (2 Blades and Fuseholders, 1 Neutral)—120/240 Vac

Plug L211N 1/2 2 1-1/2 3


30 Cart 1/2 1-1/2 3
L221N 2

SAFETY SWITCHES
General Duty—Up To 100 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
General duty safety switches are designed for residential and commercial applications
where durability and economy are prime considerations. Typical loads are lighting, air
conditioning, and appliances. They are suitable for use as service equipment when
equipped with a factory or field-installed neutral assembly or a field-installed service
grounding kit, (see page 3-5) as applicable.
General duty safety switches are UL Listed, File E2875, and meet or exceed the NEMA
Standard KS1.
240 Volt—Single Throw Fusible Switches
Table 3.2: Fusible
Horsepower Ratings
NEMA NEMA Class R Max. (Dual
Type 1 Type 3R [1] Fuse Kits Std. (Fast Acting Element
System Amperes Fuse Indoor Rainproof [2] One-Time Fuses) Time-Delay

3
Fuses)
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. 1Ø 3Ø 1Ø 3Ø
2 Wire (1 Blade and Fuseholder, 1 Neutral)—120 Vac
Use Light Duty Device for this Application
 30 Plug — — — —
(see above)
Use three-wire devices for this
 30 Cart. application. — — — —
3 Wire (2 Blades and Fuseholders, 1 Neutral)—120/240 Vac (Plug), 240 Vac (Cart.) Maximum
 30 Plug D211N D211NRB —  1-1/2 —  3 —
3[3]  7-1/2
 30 Cart. D221N D221NRB DRK30  1-1/2  3 [3]
D223N
 60 Cart. D222N D222NRB RFK03H  3 7-1/2[3] 10 15[3]
100 Cart. D223N D223NRB RFK10  7-1/2 15[3] 15 30[3]
200 Cart. D224N [4] D224NRB [4] HRK1020 15 25[3] — 60[3]
400 Cart. D225N D225NR DRK40 — — — —
600 [5] Cart. D226N D226NR DRK600 — — — —
4 Wire (3 Blades and Fuseholders, 1 Neutral)—240 Vac Maximum
 30 Cart. D321N D321NRB DRK30  1-1/2   3  3   7-1/
2
 60 Cart. D322N D322NRB RFK03H  3 7-1/2[6] 10 15[6]
100 Cart. D323N D323NRB RFK10  7-1/2 15[6] 15 30[6]
200 Cart. D324N [4] D324NRB [4] HRK1020 15 25[6] — 60[6]
400 Cart. D325N D325NR DRK40 —  50 — 125
400 [7] Class T D325NT D325NTR — —  50 — —
600 [5] Cart. D326N D326NR DRK600 —  75 — 150
600 [7] Class T D326NT D326NTR — —  75 — —
800 [7] Class T T327N T327NR — — 100 — —

[1] Bolt-on hubs —Refer to Rainproof Bolt-On Hubs, Table 1.27, page 3-14.
[2] When properly installed, the Class R Fuse Kit rejects all but Class R fuses.
[3] For corner grounded delta systems only. Use switching poles for ungrounded conductors. See data bulletin 2700DB0202 for additional information.
[4] For 200% neutral, order (1) additional neutral kit SN20A and (1) neutral jumper kit SN20NI.
[5] Order Class J Fuse Kit GDJK600 if using Class J fuses.
[6] If corner grounded delta, use outer switching poles for ungrounded conductors.
[7] D325NT, D325NTR, D326NT, D326NTR, T327N and T327NR accept only 300Vac Class T fuses.
3-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
General Duty Safety Switches General Duty—Up to 100 kA Short Circuit
Current Rating
Class 3130 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602 schneider-electric.us

240 Volt—Single Throw Non-Fusible Switches


Table 3.3: Non-Fusible
NEMA Type 3R Horsepower Ratings
NEMA Type 1 Indoor
System Amperes Rainproof [8] (Max.)
Cat. No. Cat. No. 1Ø 3Ø
2 Wire (2 Blades)—240 Vac Maximum
 30 — DU221RB  3 —
 60 — DU222RB 10 —
 60 QO260NATS [9] [10] QO200TR [9] [10] [11] 10 —
100 QO2000NS [9] [10] QO2000NRB [9] [11] 20 —
200 Use 3P Switch Use 3P Switch — —
400 Use 3P Switch Use 3P Switch — —
600 Use 3P Switch Use 3P Switch — —
3 Wire (3 Blades)—240 Vac Maximum
 30 DU321 DU321RB  3   7-1/2
 60 DU322 DU322RB 10  15
100 DU323 [12] DU323RB [12] 15  40
200 DU324 [13] DU324RB [13] 15  60
400 DU325 — — 125
600 DU326 [14] — — 150
3

UL Listed Maximum Short Circuit Current Ratings — AC Only


Table 3.4: Fusible Safety Switch Short Circuit Current Rating
Fuse Class UL Listed Short Circuit Rating
Plug 10 kA
H, K 10 kA
J [15], R 100 kA
SAFETY SWITCHES

T [16] 100 kA

Non-Fusible Safety Switches


Systems equal or less than 10 kAIR SCCR —Any brand of circuit breaker or fuse not
exceeding the ampere rating of the switch may be used in conjunction with a non-fusible
safety switch.
Systems above 10 kAIR SCCR—The UL Listed short circuit current rating for Square D
non-fusible switches is based upon the switch being used in conjunction with fuses or
Square D circuit breakers or Mag-Gard motor circuit protectors.

Table 3.5: Non-Fusible Safety Switch Short Circuit Current Rating


Fuse Class or Circuit Breaker Type [17] UL Listed Short Circuit Rating
Any Brand Circuit Breaker 10 kA
H or J PowerPact Circuit Breaker Up to 65 kA [18]
H, K 10 kA
J, R 100 kA [19]
T 100 kA [20]

[8] Bolt-on hubs—Refer to Hubs, page 3-14.


[9] Enclosed molded case switch—Refer to Section 1.
[10] Includes factory-installed grounding kit.
[11] Not service entrance rated—Refer to Table 3.34 for more information.
[12] If a neutral assembly is required, order and field install SN0610.
[13] If a neutral assembly is required, order and field install a SN20A Neutral Assembly Kit. For a 200% neutral application, order and field install (2) SN20A Neutral Assembly Kits and (1)
SN20NI Neutral Jumper Kit.
[14] If a neutral assembly is required, order and field install D600SN.
[15] Only applicable to 200 A - 600 A except D325NT, D325NTR, D326NT and D326NTR.
[16] Only applicable to D325NT, D325NTR, D326NT, D326NTR, T327N and T327NR.
[17] Ampere rating of fuse or circuit breaker not to exceed switch ampere rating.
[18] Only applicable to DU324 and DU324RB. HD, JD = 25 kA maximum.
[19] SCCR = 50 kA, applicable to DU222RB, DU322 and DU322RB.
[20] Only applicable to DU323, DU323RB, DU325 and DU326.
3-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories and Lug Data General Duty Safety Switches
Class 3130 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

Field-Installed Fuse Puller Kits


Kit consists of three fuse pullers as required for a 3P, fusible, 60 or 100 A general duty
switch. Kits can be installed only in 60 or 100 A Series F fusible switches.

Table 3.6: Fuse Puller Kits


Fuse Puller Kit Switch Ampere Rating Series No. Cat. No.
Series F Fusible Switches Only
60 F FPK03
100 F FPK0610

Field-Installed Electrical Interlock Kits


Electrical interlocks for Series F 100–200 A general duty safety switches & Series F 60 A fusible general duty safety switches are available in kit
form for field installation. Each kit contains instructions for proper field mounting. A pivot arm operates from switch mechanism, breaking the
control circuit before the main switch blades break. Switches with electrical interlocks installed are UL Listed.

Table 3.8: Electrical Interlock Contact Ratings [22]


Table 3.7: Electrical Interlock Kit
Switch Electrical Interlock Kit Cat. No. AC 50 or 60Hz DC
Amperes Rating [21] Interlock Type Make /
Volts Make Break Cont. Volts Break Cont.
Fusible Series F 60 EIK031 or EIK032
120 40.00 A 15.00 A 15.00 A 115 0.50 A 15.00 A
Series F 100–200 EIK1 or EIK2 1 N. O. / 1 N. C.
Contact 240 20.00 A 10.00 A 15.00 A 230 0.25 A 15.00 A
(-1 Suffix [23])
120 30.00 A 3.00 A 10.00 A 115 1.00 A 10.00 A

SAFETY SWITCHES
2 N. O. / 2 N. C.
Contacts 240 15.00 A 1.5 A 10.00 A 230 0.30 A 10.00 A
(-2 Suffix [24])

Equipment Grounding Kits


Table 3.9: Equipment Grounding Kits
Switch Ampere Rating Cat. No. Lug Wire Range (AWG)
(1) 14 – 10 Cu or
30[25] Std. (1) 12 – 8 Al
(3) 14 – 4 Cu or (3) 12 – 4 Al or
30 PK3GTA1 (6) 14 – 12 Cu or (6) 12 – 10 Al
(2) 14 – 4 Cu or (2) 12 – 4 Al
60 [26] GTK03 (4) 14 – 12 Cu or (4) 12 – 10 Al
(2) 14 – 1/0 Cu or (2) 12 – 1/0 Al
100 GTK0610 (2) 14 – 6 Cu or (2) 12 – 6 Al

3
200 PKOGTA2 (2) 10 – 2/0 Cu or (2) 6 – 2/0 Cu Al
PK3GTA1 GTK0610 PK0TGA2
400, 600 PKOGTA2 [27] (2) 10 – 2/0 Cu or (2) 6 – 2/0 Cu Al
800 PKOGTA3 (6) 6 – 3/0 Al/Cu Max.

Field-Installed Lug Kit 400 A – 600 A


Table 3.10: Field-Installed Lug Kit 400 A – 600 A
Switch Ampere Rating Lug Kit Cat. No. Wire Range/NEC Lug Wire Range
1-1/0-600 kcmil
400 or 600 Series [28] GD4060LK 2-1/0-500 kcmil 2-1/0-600 kcmil
4-1/0-250 kcmil
4-1/0-250 kcmil

Terminal Lug Data


Table 3.11: Terminal Lug Data [29]
Wire Range
Amperes Conductors Lug Wire Range
Wire Bending Space Per NEC Table 312.6
Per Phase AWG/kcmil AWG/kcmil
 30[30] 1 12–8 (Al) or 14–8 (Cu) 12–8 (Al) or 14–8 (Cu)
 30 1 12–6 (Al) or 14–6 (Cu) 12–6 (Al) or 14–6 (Cu)
 60 1 12–3 (Al) or 14–3 (Cu) 12–2 (Al) or 14–2 (Cu)
100 1 12–1 (Al) or 14–1 (Cu) 12–1/0 (Al) or 14–1/0 (Cu)
200 1 6 –250 (Al/Cu) 6 –300 (Al/Cu)
400 1/0 –600 (Al/Cu) or (1) 1/0 –750 (Al/Cu) or
NEMA 1 or
2 1/0 –300 (Al/Cu) (2) 1/0 –300 (Al/Cu)
Type 1
400
(1) 1 –600 (Al/Cu) or
NEMA 2 1/0–250 (Al/Cu) (2) 1/0 –250 (Al/Cu)
Type 3R
600 2 4 –500 (Al/Cu) 4 –600 (Al/Cu)
800 3 3/0 –500 (Al/Cu) 3/0 –500 (Al/Cu)

[21] Electrical interlock kit catalog numbers with -1 suffix indicate one normally open and one normally closed contact; -2 indicates two normally open and two normally closed contacts. Kits are
UL Listed.
[22] Single-pole single-throw interlock kits are rated 1/2 hp at 110 and 220 Vac.
[23] -1 Suffix uses a 9007A01 limit switch.
[24] -2 Suffix uses a 9007C03 limit switch.
[25] Light duty safety switches.
[26] 60 A non-fusible switches accept PK3GTA1.
[27] Two required if ground conductors are run in parrellel.
[28] Not suitable for use on 400 A NEMA Type 3R.
[29] 30–100 A switches suitable for 60oC or 75oC conductors. 200–800 A switches suitable for 75oC conductors.
[30] Light duty switches only.
3-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
General Duty Safety Switches Dimensions for General Duty Safety
Switches
Class 3130 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602 schneider-electric.us

Dimensions for General Duty Safety Switches


Table 3.12: Approximate Dimensions
H W W/H D Std.
Cat.No. Series
in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm Pack
L111N E2 7.63  194  5.00 127  6.13 156 4.00 102 1
L211N E2 7.63  194  5.00 127  6.13 156 4.00 102 1
L221N E2 7.63  194  5.00 127  6.13 156 4.00 102 1
D211N E3  9.25  235  6.75 171  7.25 184  3.63  92 5
D211NRB E2  9.63  245  7.25 184  7.75 197  3.75  95 5
D221N E3  9.25  235  6.75 171  7.25 184  3.63  92 5
D221NRB E3  9.63  245  7.25 184  7.75 197  3.75  95 5
D222N F1 14.63  372  6.50 165  7.45 189  4.88 124 1
D222NRB F1 14.88  378  6.63 168  7.45 189  4.88 124 1
D223N F3 17.50  445  8.50 216 10.50 267  6.50 165 1
D223NRB F3 17.50  445  8.50 216 10.50 267  6.50 165 1
D224N F1 29.00  737 17.25 438 19.00 483  8.25 210 1
D224NRB F1 29.25  743 17.25 438 19.00 483  8.25 210 1
D225N E3 45.12 1146 24.00 610 24.88 632  8.88 226 1
D225NR E1 30.63  778 21.38 543 22.25 565 10.13 257 1
D226N E3 49.13 1248 24.00 610 24.88 632  8.88 226 1
D226NR E1 49.13 1248 24.75 629 25.13 638  8.88 226 1
D321N E3  9.25 235  6.75 171  7.25 184  3.63  92 5
D321NRB E3  9.63  245  7.25 184  7.75 197  3.75  95 5
D322N F1 14.63  372  6.50 165  7.45 189  4.88 124 1
D322NRB F1 14.88  378  6.63 168  7.45 189  4.88 124 1
D323N F3 17.50  445  8.50 216 10.50 267  6.50 165 1
D323NRB F3 17.50  445  8.50 216 10.50 267  6.50 165 1
D324N F1 29.00  737 17.25 438 19.00 483  8.25 210 1
D324NRB F1 29.25  743 17.25 438 19.00 483  8.25 210 1
D325N E3 45.12 1146 24.00 610 24.88 632  8.88 226 1
D325NT E3 45.12 1146 24.00 610 24.88 632  8.88 226 1
D325NR E1 30.63  778 21.38 543 22.25 565 10.13 257 1
D325NTR E1 30.63  778 21.38 543 22.25 565 10.13 257 1
D326N E3 49.13 1248 24.00 610 24.88 632  8.88 226 1
D326NT E3 49.13 1248 24.00 610 24.88 632  8.88 226 1
D326NR E1 49.13 1248 24.75 629 25.13 638  8.88 226 1
D326NTR E1 49.13 1246 24.75 629 25.13 638  8.88 226 1
DU221RB E2  9.63  245  7.25 184  7.75 197  3.75  95 5
DU222RB E1  9.63  245  7.25 184  7.75 197  3.75  95 5
DU321 E2  9.25  235  6.75 171  7.25 184  3.63  92 5
DU321RB E2  9.63  245  7.25 184  7.75 197  3.75  95 5
DU322 E1  9.25  235  6.75 171  7.25 184  3.63  92 5
DU322RB E1  9.63  245  7.25 184  7.75 197  3.75  95 5
DU323 F3 17.50  445  8.50 216 10.50 267  6.50 165 1
DU323RB F3 17.50  445  8.50 216 10.50 267  6.50 165 1
DU324 F1 29.00  737 17.25 438 19.00 483  8.25 210 1
DU324RB F1 29.25  743 17.25 438 19.00 483  8.25 210 1
DU325 E3 45.12 1146 24.00 610 24.88 632  8.88 226 1
DU326 E3 49.13 1248 24.00 610 24.88 632  8.88 226 1
QO200TR G3  6.50  165  4.63 118 — —  3.88  99 5
QO260NATS E2  9.25  235  4.88 124 — —  3.25  83 1
QO2000NRB E1 14.00  356  7.75 197 — —  4.50 114 1
QO2000NS E1 13.38  340  6.13 156 — —  3.50  89 1
T327N E1 49.13 1248 24.00 610 24.88 632  8.88 226 1
T327NR E1 49.13 1248 24.75 629 25.13 638  8.88 226 1

3-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
240 Volt—Single Throw Fusible Switches Heavy Duty Safety Switches
Class 3130 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

Heavy Duty Safety Switches


Visible blade heavy duty safety switches are designed for application where maximum
performance and continuity of service are required. All heavy duty safety switches
feature quick-make, quick-break operating mechanism, a dual cover interlock and a color
coded indicator handle. They are suitable for use as service equipment when equipped
with a field- or factory-installed neutral assembly or equipment grounding kit, unless a
600Y/347 V or 480 Y/277 V, 1000 A or greater, solidly grounded WYE system is used,
per NEC 230-95. Heavy duty safety switches are UL Listed (except as noted). Files
E2875 and E154828 meet or exceed the NEMA Standard KS1. For UL Listed short
circuit current ratings, see UL Listed Maximum Short Circuit Current Ratings-AC only,
page 3-10.
NEMA Type
4, 4X, 5
NEMA Type 1 NEMA Type 3R Stainless Steel NEMA Type 12

Table 3.13: 240 Volt—Single Throw Fusible


NEMA Type Horsepower Ratings
4, 4X, 5, [2] 240 Vac
304 Stainless NEMA Type 12K NEMA Type
NEMA Type 3R 3R, 5 or 12 [4]
NEMA Steel [3]) Dust With
Rainproof tight, Watertight, Knockouts Without Std. Max.
Type 1 (Bolt-on Hubs Knockouts
System Amperes Indoor Corrosion (Watertight (Using Fast (Using Dual 250 Vdc
[1]) (Watertight Acting, Element, Time [5]
Resistant Hubs [1])
Hubs [1]) One Time Fuses) Delay Fuses)
(Watertight Hubs
[1])
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. 1Ø 3Ø 1Ø 3Ø

SAFETY SWITCHES
2-Wire (2 Blades and Fuseholders)—240 Vac, 250 Vdc
  30 H221DS H221A H221AWK 1-1/2  3 [6]  3   7-1/2 [6]  5
  30 — — H2212AWK [7] 1-1/2 —  3 —  5
Use three-wire devices
  60 For two-wire applications H222DS — H222AWK  3  7-1/2 [6] 10  15 [6] 10
 100 H223DS H223A H223AWK 7-1/2 15 [6] 15  30 [8] 20
 200 H224DS H224A H224AWK 15 25 [6] —  60 [6] 40
 400 H225 H225R H225DS — H225AWK — — — — 50
 600 H226 H226R H226DS — H226AWK — 75 [6]  — 200 [6]  50
 800 H227 H227R — — H227AWK 50 — — — 50
1200 H228 H228R — — H228AWK 50 — — — 50
3-Wire (2 Blades and Fuseholders, 1 Neutral)—240 Vac, 250 Vdc
  30 H221N H221NRB    1-1/2  3 [6]  3   7-1/2 [8]  5
  60 H222N H222NRB Use two-wire devices, 3  7-1/2 [6] 10  15 [6] 10
 100 H223N H223NRB See Field-Installed Neutral Assemblies, page 3-16 7-1/2 15 [6] 15  30 [6] 20
 200 H224N H224NRB 15 25 [6] —  60 [6] 40

3
 400 H225N H225NR H225NDS — H225NAWK — 50 [6] — 125 [6] 50
 600 H226N H226NR H226NDS — H226NAWK — 75 [6] — 200 [6] 50
 800 H227N H227NR [9] — — H227NAWK 50 — — — 50
1200 H228N H228NR [9] — — H228NAWK 50 — — — 50
3-Wire (3 Blades and Fuseholders)—240 Vac, 250 Vdc
  30 H321DS H321A H321AWK 1-1/2   3   3   7-1/2  5
  60 Use four-wire devices H322DS H322A H322AWK  3   7-1/2 10  15 10
 100 For three-wire applications H323DS H323A H323AWK 7-1/2  15 15  30 20
 200 H324DS H324A H324AWK 15  25 —  60 40
 400 H325 H325R H325DS — H325AWK —  50 — 125 50
 600 H326 H326R H326DS — H326AWK —  75 — 200 50
 800 H327 H327R [9] — — H327AWK 50 100 — 250 50
1200 H328 H328R [9] — — H328AWK 50 100 — 250 50
4-Wire (3 Blades and Fuseholders, 1 Neutral)—240 Vac, 250 Vdc
  30 H321N H321NRB 1-1/2   3  3     7-1/2  5
  60 H322N H322NRB Use three-wire devices, 3     7-1/2 10  15 10
 100 H323N H323NRB See Field-Installed Neutral Assemblies, page 3-16 7-1/2  15 15  30 20
 200 H324N H324NRB 15  25 —  60 40
 400 H325N H325NR H325NDS — H325NAWK —  50 — 125 50
 600 H326N H326NR H326NDS — H326NAWK —  75 — 200 50
 800 H327N H327NR [9] — — H327NAWK 50 100 — 250 50
1200 H328N H328NR [9] — — H328NAWK 50 100 — 250 50
4-Wire (4 Blades and Fuseholders)
 30
 60
100
Use 600 Vac devices. See 600 Volt—Single Throw Fusible Switches, page 3-8.
200
400
600

Accessories: see page 3-14


Dimensions: NEMA Type 1 and 3R, see page 3-20
Dimensions: NEMA Type 4, 4X and 5 Stainless and NEMA Type 12, see page 3-21

[1] For Rainproof Bolt-On Hubs and Watertight Hubs see Hubs, page 3-14.
[2] Complete rating is NEMA Type 3, 3R, 4, 4X, 5 and 12. For NEMA Type 3R applications, remove drain screw from bottom endwall.
[3] See 316 Grade Stainless Steel—NEMA Type 3, 3R, 4, 4X, 5, 12, page 3-11.
[4] Also suitable for NEMA Type 3R application by removing drain screw from bottom endwall.
[5] For switching dc, use two outside switching poles.
[6] For corner grounded delta systems, use switching poles for ungrounded conductors. See data bulletin 2700DB0202 for additional information.
[7] 60 ampere switch with 30 ampere fuse spacing and clips. Must use 60 A enclosure accessories including electrical interlocks.
[8] For corner grounded delta systems, use switching poles for ungrounded conductors.
[9] Suitable for NEMA Type 5 applications with drain screw installed.
3-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Heavy Duty Safety Switches 600 Volt—Single Throw Fusible Switches
Class 3130 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

600 Volt—Single Throw Fusible


Table 3.14: 600 Volt—Single Throw Fusible
NEMA Type Horsepower Ratings
4, 4X, 5 [11] 480 Vac 600 Vac
304 Stainless Steel NEMA Type NEMA Type
NEMA Type Max. Std. Max.
(316 stainless [12]) 12K 3R, 5 or 12 [13] Std.
NEMA 3R Dust tight, With Without (Using (Using (Using
Type 1 Rainproof (Using
System Amperes Watertight, Knockouts Knockouts Dual Fast Dual dc [14]
Indoor (Bolt-on Fast Element, Acting, Element,
Corrosion (Watertight (Watertight Hubs Acting,
Hubs [10]) Time One Time
Resistant Hubs [10]) [10]) One Time
(Watertight Hubs Delay Time Delay
Fuses)
[10]) Fuses) Fuses) Fuses)
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. 3Ø 3Ø 3Ø 3Ø 250 600
2-Wire (2 Blades and Fuseholders)—600 Vac, 600 Vdc
  30 — — — — — —
  60 Use three-wire devices — — — — — —
 100 for two-wire applications — — — — — —
 200 — — — — — —
 400 H265 H265R H265DS — H265AWK 100 [15] 250 [15] — — 50 50
 600 H266 H266R H266DS — H266AWK 150 [15] 400 [15] — — 50 50
 800 H267 H267R [16] — — H267AWK — — — — — 50
3

1200 H268 H268R [16] — — H268AWK — — — — — 50


3-Wire (3 Blades and Fuseholders)—600 Vac, 600 Vdc
  30 H361 H361RB H361DS H361A H361AWK   5  15   7-1/2  20  5 15
H361-2
  30 H3612RB [17] — H361-2A [17] H3612AWK [17]   5  15   7-1/2  20 — 15
[16] [17]
  60 H362 H362RB H362DS H362A H362AWK  15  30  15  50 — 30
 100 H363 H363RB H363DS H363A H363AWK  25  60  30 100 — 50
 200 H364 H364RB H364DS H364A H364AWK  50 125  60 150 40 50
SAFETY SWITCHES

 400 H365 H365R H365DS — H365AWK 100 250 125 350 50 50


 600 H366 H366R H366DS — H366AWK 150 400 200 500 50 50
 800 H367 H367R [16] — — H367AWK 200 500 250 500 — 50
1200 H368 H368R [16] — — H368AWK 200 500 250 500 — 50
4-Wire (3 Blades and Fuseholders, 1 Neutral)—600 Vac, 600 Vdc
  30 H361N H361NRB   5  15   7-1/2  20 — 15
Use three-wire devices,
  60 H362N H362NRB See Field-Installed Neutral Assemblies, page 3-16  15  30  15  50 — 30
 100 H363N H363NRB  25  60  30  75 — 50
 200 H364N H364NRB H364NDS H364NA H364NAWK  50 125  60 150 40 50
 400 H365N H365NR H365NDS — H365NAWK 100 250 125 350 50 50
 600 H366N H366NR H366NDS — H366NAWK 150 400 200 500 50 50
H367NR
 800 H367N [16] — — H367NAWK 200 500 250 500 — 50
H368NR
1200 H368N [16] — — H368NAWK 200 500 250 500 — 50
4-Wire (4 Blades and Fuseholders)—600 Vac, 600 Vdc [18] 2Ø 2Ø 2Ø 2Ø
 30 H461 — H461DS — H461AWK   7-1/2  20  10  25  5 15
 60 H462 — H462DS — H462AWK  15  40  20  50 10 30
100 H463 — H463DS — H463AWK  25  60  30  75 20 30
200 H464 — H464DS — H464AWK  50 125  60 150 40 50
400 H465 — — — H465AWK 100 250 125 350 50 50
600 H466 — — — — 150 400 200 500 50 50
6-Wire (6 Blades and Fuseholders)—600 Vac[18] 3Ø 3Ø 3Ø 3Ø
100 — — H663DS — H663AWK  25  60  30  75 — —
For applications requiring motor disconnect capability, see Electrical
200 — — H664DS — H664AWK Interlock Kits, page 3-15

Accessories: see page 3-14


Dimensions: NEMA Type 1 and 3R, see page 3-20
Dimensions: NEMA Type 4, 4X and 5 Stainless and NEMA Type 12, see page 3-21

Class H, R, J, and L Fuse Provisions:


Class H or K Fuse Provisions: Fusible Square D 30–600 A heavy duty safety switches accept Class H or K fuses as
standard. With Class H or K fuses installed, the switch is UL Listed for use on systems with up to 10 kA available fault
current.
Class R Fuse Provisions: Fusible Square D 30–600 A heavy duty safety switches will accept Class R fuses as
standard. A field-installed rejection kit is available which, when installed, rejects all but Class R fuses. With the installation
of the rejection kit and Class R fuses, the switch is UL Listed for use on systems with up to 200 kA available fault current.
See Class R Fuse Kits, page 3-15.
Class J Fuse Provisions: Provisions for installing Class J fuses are included in 30–400 A 600 Volt, and 100–400 A 240
Volt, fusible heavy duty safety switches. Conversion to Class J fuse spacing requires relocating the load side fuse base
assembly from the standard Class H fuse location to an alternate position as marked in the enclosure. With Class J fuses
installed, the switch is UL Listed for use on systems with up to 200 kA available fault current. Switches rated 600 A, 240
Class R Fuse or 600 Volt, require the addition of an adapter kit, H600J. One kit per three-pole switch.
Class L Fuse Provisions: Fusible 800 A and 1200 A safety switches use Class L bolt-in fuses and are rated for use on
systems with up to 200 kA at 600 Vac maximum. 1200 A switches accept class L fuses from 601–1200 A, 800 A switches
accept class L fuses from 601–800 A.

[10] For Rainproof Bolt-On Hubs and Watertight Hubs see Hubs, page 3-14.
[11] Complete rating is NEMA Type 3, 3R, 4, 4X, 5 and 12..
[12] See Table 3.18 316 Grade Stainless Steel 3 Pole 600 Vac, 600 Vdc, page 3-11.
[13] Also suitable for NEMA Type 3R application by removing drain screw from bottom endwall.
[14] For switching dc, use two outside switching poles.
[15] For corner grounded delta systems, use switching poles for ungrounded conductors. See data bulletin 2700DB0202 for additional information.
[16] Suitable for NEMA Type 5 applications with drain screw installed.
[17] 60 A switch with 30 A fuse spacing and clips. Must use 60 A enclosure accessories including electrical interlocks.
[18] Not suitable for use as service equipment.
3-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
600 Volt—Single Throw Non-Fusible Heavy Duty Safety Switches
Switches
schneider-electric.us Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602

600 Volt—Single Throw Non-Fusible


Table 3.15: 600 Volt—Single Throw Non-Fusible
NEMA Type 4, 4X, 5 [20] NEMA Type NEMA Type 3R, 5 Horsepower Ratings
NEMA NEMA Type 3R 304 Stainless Steel [21] 12K or 12 [22] (Max.)
Type 1 Rainproof [19] Dust tight, Watertight With Without
System Amperes Indoor Volts ac
Corrosion Resistant [19] Knockouts [19] Knockouts [19] dc [23]
240 480 600
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. 1Ø 3Ø 1Ø 3Ø 1Ø 3Ø 250 600
2-Wire (2 Blades)—600 Vac, 600 Vdc
  30 — — — — — — — —
  60 Use three-wire devices — — — — — — — —
 100 for two-wire applications. — — — — — — — —
 200 — — — — — — — —
 400 HU265 HU265R HU265DS — HU265AWK — 125 — 250 — — 50 50
 600 HU266 HU266R HU266DS — HU266AWK — 200 — 400 — — 50 50
 800 HU267 HU267R [24] — — HU267AWK — — — — 50 — — 50
1200 HU268 HU268R [24] — — HU268AWK — — — — 50 — — 50
3-Wire (3 Blades)—600 Vac, 600 Vdc
  30 HU361 HU361RB HU361DS HU361A HU361AWK  5  10 7-1/2  20 10  30  5 15
HU361EI[25] HU361RBEI HU361DSEI [25] HU361AEI [25] HU361AWKEI[25]
  30 [25]  5  10 7-1/2  20 10  30  5 15
  30 — HU3612RB [26] — HU3612A[26] HU3612AWK[26]  5  10 7-1/2  20 10  30  5 15
  60 HU362 HU362RB HU362DS HU362A HU362AWK 10  20 25  50 30  60 10 30
  60 — — HU362DSEI[25] — — 10  20 25  50 30  60 10 30
 100 HU363 HU363RB HU363DS HU363A HU363AWK 20  40 40  75 40 100 20 50

SAFETY SWITCHES
 200 HU364 HU364RB HU364DS HU364A HU364AWK 15  60 50 125 50 150 40 50
 400 HU365 HU365R HU365DS — HU365AWK — 125 — 250 — 350 50 50
 600 HU366 HU366R HU366DS — HU366AWK — 200 — 400 — 500 50 50
 800 HU367 HU367R [24] — — HU367AWK — — — 500 50 500 — 50
1200 HU368 HU368R [24] — — HU368AWK — — — — 50 500 — 50
4-Wire (4 Blades)—600 Vac, 600 Vdc [27] 2Ø 3Ø 2Ø 3Ø 2Ø 3Ø
  30 HU461 [28] — HU461DS — HU461AWK [29] 10  10 20  20 25  30 10[30] 15[30]
  60 HU462 [28] — HU462DS — HU462AWK 20  20 40  50 50  60 10 30
 100 HU463 [28] — HU463DS — HU463AWK 30  40 50  75 50  75 20 30
 200 HU464 [28] — HU464DS — HU464AWK 50  60 50 125 50 150 40 50
 400 HU465 — — — HU465AWK — 125 — 250 — 350 50 50
 600 HU466 — — — — — 200 — 400 — 500 50 50
6-Wire (6 Blades)—600 Vac [27] 3Ø 3Ø 3Ø
  30 — — HU661DS — HU661AWK —  10 —  20 —  30 — —
  60 — — HU662DS — HU662AWK —  20 —  50 —  60 — —
 100 — — HU663DS — HU663AWK —  50 —  75 —  75 — —

3
 200 — — HU664DS — HU664AWK —  60 — 125 — 150 — —

[19] For Rainproof Bolt-On Hubs and Watertight Hubs see Hubs, page 3-14.
[20] Complete rating is NEMA Type 3, 3R, 4, 4X, 5 and 12.
[21] For 316 stainless, see 316 Grade Stainless Steel—NEMA Type 3, 3R, 4, 4X, 5, 12, page 3-11.
[22] Also suitable for NEMA Type 3R application by removing drain screw from bottom endwall.
[23] For switching dc, use two outside switching poles.
[24] Suitable for NEMA Type 5 applications with drain screw installed.
[25] Switches with EI suffix are stocked with factory-installed electrical interlocks with one normally-open and one normally-closed contact.
[26] Use 60 A enclosure accessories, including electrical interlocks.
[27] Not suitable for use as service equipment.
[28] No knockouts are provided.
[29] Requires 60 A accessories. See NEMA Type 4, 4X, 5, 7, 9, and 12, page 3-21 for series rating.
[30] HU461AWK (Series F6) is rated 5 hp@250 Vdc, 15 hp@600 Vdc.
3-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Heavy Duty Safety Switches UL Listed Maximum Short Circuit Current
Ratings—AC only
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602 schneider-electric.us

UL Listed Maximum Short Circuit Current Ratings—AC only


Table 3.16: Fusible Safety Switches
NOTE: Consult the wiring diagram of the switch Heavy Duty UL Listed UL Listed Short Circuit
to verify the UL Listed short circuit current rating. Safety Switch Type Fuse Class Current Ratings
H, K   10 kA
Fusible
R, J, L 200 kA [31]

Non-Fusible Safety Switches


Systems equal or less than 10 kAIR SCCR —Any brand of circuit breaker or fuse not
exceeding the ampere rating of the switch may be used in conjunction with a non-
fusible safety switch.
Systems above 10 kAIR SCCR—The UL Listed short circuit current rating for Square
D non-fusible switches is based upon the switch being used in conjunction with fuses
or Square D circuit breakers or Mag-Gard motor circuit protectors.

Table 3.17: Non-Fusible Safety Switches [32] [33]


Switch Rating 3-Phase 250 Vdc /
(A) Fuse or Circuit Breaker Type [34]
240 Vac 480 Vac 600 Vac 600 Vdc
3

With Upstream Fuse Protection


H, K 10 kA 10 kA 10 kA Up to 10
All
R,T,J,L 200 kA 200 kA 200 kA kA
With Upstream Circuit Breaker Protection
All Any brand circuit breaker 10 kA 10 kA 10 kA
30–100 HD 25 kA 18 kA 14 kA
30–100 HG 65 kA 35 kA 18 kA
SAFETY SWITCHES

30–100 HJ 65 kA 35 kA 25 kA
30–100 HL 65 kA 35 kA 35 kA
30–100 HR 65 kA 35 kA 35 kA
30–100 FA 14 kA 14 kA 14 kA
30–100 FH 18 kA 18 kA 18 kA
200 HD, JD 25 kA 18 kA 14 kA
200 HG, JG 65 kA 35 kA 18 kA
200 HJ, JJ 65 kA 35 kA 25 kA Up to 10
200 HL, JL 65 kA 35 kA 35 kA kA
200 HR, JR 65 kA 35 kA 35 kA
400 LA 22 kA 22 kA 22 kA
400 LH 25 kA 25 kA 25 kA
400–600 LD 25 kA 18 kA 14 kA
400–600 LG 65 kA 35 kA 18 kA
400–600 LJ 100 kA 65 kA 25 kA
400–600 LL 100 kA 65 kA 50 kA
400–600 LR 100 kA 65 kA 65 kA

[31] On 600 V, 200 A switches, 100,000 A max. on corner grounded delta when protected by Class J or R fuses.
[32] For NEMA Type 4X Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester switches, see page 3-11.
[33] NEMA Type 7/9 SCCR 10 kAIR 600 Vac maximum.
[34] Ampere rating of fuse or circuit breaker not to exceed switch ampere rating.
3-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Special Applications Heavy Duty Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

Special Application Heavy Duty Safety Switches


316 Grade Stainless Steel—NEMA Type 3, 3R, 4, 4X, 5, 12
316 stainless steel enclosure safety switches offer superior corrosion resistance to a
wider range of chemicals than 304 stainless switches. 316 better resists chloride and is
often used in marine, waste treatment and transportation applications. Use watertight
hubs, see Hubs, page 3-14. Equipment grounding lugs are supplied as standard through
200 A. See Table 3.42 Terminal Lug Data, page 3-19 for wire Termination data for
grounding lugs. (For 304 stainless switches, see 240 Volt, page 3-7 and 600 Volt, page
3-8.
Table 3.18: 316 Grade Stainless Steel 3 Pole 600 Vac, 600 Vdc
Horsepower Ratings– 3Ø
Amperes Cat. No 480 Vac[35] 600 Vac [35] 600 Vdc [36]
Std. Max. Std. Max. Max.
Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 600 Vdc
 30 H361SS  5  15 7-1/2  20 15
 60 H362SS 15  30 15  50 30
100 H363SS 25  60 30  75 50
200 H364SS 50 125 60 150 50
H361SS 400 H365SS 100 250 125 350 50
600 H366SS 150 400 200 500 50
Non-Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 600 Vdc
 30 HU361SS —  20 —  30 15
 60 HU362SS —  50 —  60 30
100 HU363SS —  75 — 100 50

SAFETY SWITCHES
200 HU364SS — 125 — 150 50
400 HU365SS — 250 — 350 50
600 HU366SS — 400 — 500 50

Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester Enclosures—NEMA Type 4X


Fiberglass reinforced polyester enclosures are watertight, corrosion resistant, and
impervious to windblown dust, rain, and splashing liquid. The molded fiberglass is
extremely stable in a wide range of operating temperatures and can withstand heavy
impact. Switches are furnished with hubs, conduit provisions Table 3.43, and equipment
grounding lugs. See CAD drawings of the switch to verify the UL listed short circuit
current rating or the enclosed safety switch catalog. UL Listed.

3
H363DF

Table 3.19: Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester Enclosures NEMA Type 4X 3 Pole 600 Vac, 600 Vdc
Class R Electrical Interlock Kits Horsepower Ratings– 3Ø
Solid Neutral Fuse Kits Field-Installed Cat. No. 480 Vac [35] 600 Vac [35] 600 Vdc [36]
Amperes Cat. No. Assembly Kit
1 NO/1 NC 2 NO/2 NC Hubs[37]
Cat. No. Contacts Contacts Std. Max. Std. Max. Max.
Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 600 Vdc
 30 H361DF SN03 RFK06 9999TC10 9999TC20  5  15 7-1/2  20 15 3/4
 60 H362DF SN03 RFK06H 9999TC10 9999TC20 15  30 15  50 30 1-1/4
100 H363DF SN0610 RFK10 9999TC10 9999TC20 25  60 30  75 50 2
200 H364DF — HRK1020 9999R8 9999R9 50 125 60 150 50 2-1/2
Non-Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 600 Vdc
 30 HU361DF SN03 — 9999TC10 9999TC20 —  20 —  30 15 3/4
 60 HU362DF SN03 — 9999TC10 9999TC20 —  50 —  60 30 1-1/4
100 HU363DF SN0610 — 9999TC10 9999TC20 —  75 — 75 50 2
200 HU364DF — — 9999R8 9999R9 — 125 — 150 50 2-1/2

[35] Std.—Using fast acting, one time fuses. Max.—Using dual element time delay fuses.
[36] For switching dc use two switching poles.
[37] Two hubs and hub drilling template are provided for field installation.
3-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Heavy Duty Safety Switches Special Applications
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

KrydonTM Enclosures—NEMA Type 4X


Krydon enclosures are compression molded of fiberglass reinforced polyester, specially
formulated to withstand attack from almost any corrosive atmosphere found in the
toughest industrial application. Switches are furnished with watertight hubs and
equipment grounding lugs. See CAD drawing of the switch to verify the UL listed short
circuit current rating or the enclosed safety switch catalog. UL Listed.

H361DX

Table 3.20: KrydonTM Enclosures — NEMA Type 4X 3 Pole 600 Vac, 600 Vdc
Class R Fuse Electrical Interlock Kits Horsepower Ratings– 3Ø
Solid Neutral Kits Field-Installed Cat. No. 480 Vac [39] 600 Vac [39] 600 Vdc [40]
Amperes Cat. No. Hubs [38]
3

Assembly Kit
Cat. No. 1 NO/1 NC 2 NO/2 Std. Max. Std. Max. Max.
Contact NC Contacts
Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 600 Vdc
 30 H361DX H60SN RFK06 9999TC10 9999TC20  5 15 7-1/2 20 15 3/4
 60 H362DX H60SN RFK06H 9999TC10 9999TC20 15 30 15  50 30 1-1/4
100 H363DX SN0610 RFK10 9999TC10 9999TC20 25 60 30  75 50 2
Non-Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 600 Vdc
 30 HU361DX H60SN — 9999TC10 9999TC20 — 20 —  30 15 3/4
SAFETY SWITCHES

 60 HU362DX H60SN — 9999TC10 9999TC20 — 50 —  60 30 1-1/4


100 HU363DX SN0610 — 9999TC10 9999TC20 — 75 — 75 50 2

NEMA Type 7 and 9


An enclosed automatic molded case switch for use in Divisions 1 and 2 of the following:
Class I, Groups C and D; Class II, Groups E, F and G; or Class III, Hazardous Locations
as defined in NECTM Article 500. Furnished with threaded conduit openings in both top
and bottom endwall. Suitable for use as service equipment and listed as “Raintight’’ for
outdoor applications. cULus Listed. Equipment grounding lugs supplied as standard. See
CAD drawing of the switch to verify the UL listed short circuit current rating or the
enclosed safety switch catalog.

Table 3.21: NEMA Type 7/9, 3 Pole Molded Case Switch, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc [41], Short
Circuit Current Rating 10 kA AIR
Enclosed Molded Solid Neutral Horsepower Ratings—3Ø Size of Threaded
H60XFA Case Switch [42] Assembly Conduit
Amperes
Openings
Cat. No. Cat. No. 240 Vac 480 Vac 600 Vac Provided (in.) [43]
 60 H60XFA 100SNA 15 30 50 3/4
 60 H60XFA1212 [44] 100SNA 15 30 50 3/4
100 H100XFA 100SNA 30 60 75 1-1/4
100 H100XFA1212[44] 100SNA 30 60 75 1-1/4
225 H225XJG[45] 225SNA 60 125 150 2-1/2
225 H225XJGAA[45] [44] 225SNA 60 125 150 2-1/2

[38] Two hubs and hub drilling template are provided for field installation.
[39] Std.—Using fast acting one time fuses. Max.—Using dual element time delay fuses.
[40] For switching dc, use two outside switching poles.
[41] For switching dc, use two outside switching poles. Not for use on dc motor applications.
[42] Includes PKDB1, breather and drain kit, required for rainproof application.
[43] Threaded conduit opening provided in top and bottom endwall.
[44] Includes 1NO/1NC auxiliary contacts.
[45] Not cULus listed due to wire bending space.
3-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Receptacle Switches Heavy Duty Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

Interlocked Receptacle Switches


Interlocked Receptacle Switches [46] are furnished with a factory-installed three-phase
four-wire Appleton PowertiteTM, Crouse-Hinds Style 2 ArktiteTM, or HubbellockTM
receptacle. The fourth wire is connected to the switch equipment grounding terminal and
is not a solid neutral termination. Interlocking linkage between the receptacle and switch
mechanism prevents insertion or removal of the plug while the switch is in the “ON’’
position or insertion of any plug other than specified. Grounding lugs are included. See
wiring diagram of the switch to verify the UL listed short circuit current rating or the
enclosed safety switch catalog.
Appleton Powertite Receptacle
• UL Listed and CSA Certified
• Available in 30 -100 A, 600 Vac/250 Vdc, fused or non-fused, NEMA Type 1, NEMA
Type 4/4X/5 stainless steel and NEMA Type 12/3R
• Suitable for use as service equipment (USA only)
• Receptacles are epoxy powder coated over copper-free cast aluminum
Table 3.22: Appleton Powertite Receptacle Switches
NEMA Type Horsepower
3, 3R, 4, Ratings–3Ø
NEMA 4X, 5, 12 NEMA Type Use with 480 Vac [48] 600 Vac [48] 250 Vdc[49]
Amperes Type 1 304 Plug [47]
12, 3R
Stainless
Steel Std. Max. Std. Max. Std. Max.

SAFETY SWITCHES
Enclosure
Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc
 30 H361WA H361DSWA H361AWA ACP3034BC 5 15 7-1/2  20  5 —
H362AWA  60 H362WA H362DSWA H362AWA ACP6034BC 15 30 15  50 10 —
Interlocked Receptacle 100 H363WA H363DSWA H363AWA ACP1034CD 25 60 30  75 20 —
Switch with Appleton Non-Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc
Powertite Receptacle
 30 HU361WA HU361DSWA HU361AWA ACP3034BC — 20 —  30 —  5
 60 HU362WA HU362DSWA HU362AWA ACP6034BC — 50 —  60 — 10
100 HU363WA HU363DSWA HU363AWA ACP1034CD — 75 — 100 — 20

Table 3.23: Appleton Powertite 600 Vac Short Circuit Current Rating
Amperes 10 kAIR 100 kAIR 200 kAIR 14 kAIR 18kAIR
Fuses Fuses Fuses Circuit Breaker Circuit Breaker
Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc
 30 H, K — J, R — —
 60 H, K — J, R — —

3
100 H, K — J, R — —
Non-Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc
 30 H, K J, R, T[50] J, R, T FA FH
 60 H, K — J, R, T FA FH
100 H, K — J, R, T FA FH

Crouse-Hinds Arktite Receptacle


• UL Listed
• Available in 30 -100 A, 600 Vac/250 Vdc, fused or non-fused, NEMA Type 1, NEMA
Type 4/4X/5 stainless steel and NEMA Type 12/3R
• Suitable for use as service equipment
• Receptacles are cast aluminum, copper free for NEMA Type 1 and NEMA Type 12/3R
safety switches
• Receptacles are epoxy powder coated, copper free cast aluminum for NEMA Type 4/
4X/5 stainless steel safety switches
Table 3.24: Crouse-Hinds Arktite Safety Switch
NEMA Type Horsepower
4, 4X, 5 Ratings–3Ø
NEMA 304 NEMA Type Use with
Amperes Type 1 Stainless 12, 3R Plug
Steel 480 Vac [48] 600 Vac [48] 250 Vdc [49]
Enclosure
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Std. Max. Std. Max. Std. Max.
Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc
H362AWC
Interlocked Receptacle  30 H361WC H361DSWC H361AWC APJ3485  5 15 7-1/2  20 5 —
Switch with Crouse-Hinds  60 H362WC H362DSWC H362AWC APJ6485 15 30 15  50 10 —
Arktite Receptacle 100 H363WC H363DSWC H363AWC APJ10487 25 60 30  75 20 —
Non-Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc

 30 HU361WC HU361DSWC HU361AWC APJ3485 — 20 —  30 — 5

 60 HU362WC HU362DSWC HU362AWC APJ6485 — 50 —  60 — 10

100 HU363WC HU363DSWC HU363AWC APJ10487 — 60 — 100 — 20

[46] Accessories and Special Features, page 3-14


[47] Receptacle UL listed for use with AppletonTM ACP or CPH plugs; UL Classified for use with Crouse-Hinds APJ Arktite™ plugs. (see Table 3.24.
[48] Std.—Using fast acting one time fuses. Max.—Using dual element time delay fuses.
[49] For switching dc, use two outside switching poles.
[50] SCCR when using 60 Amp Max fuse.
3-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Heavy Duty Safety Switches Accessories and Special Features
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

Table 3.25: Crouse-Hinds 600 Vac Short Circuit Current Rating


Amperes 10 kAIR 100 kAIR 200 kAIR 14 kAIR 18kAIR
Fuses Fuses Fuses Circuit Breaker Circuit Breaker
Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc
 30 H, K — J, R — —
 60 H, K — J, R — —
100 H, K — J, R — —
Non-Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc
 30 H, K J, R, T [51] J, R, T FA FH
 60 H, K — J, R, T FA FH
100 H, K — J, R, T FA FH

Hubbellock Receptacle
• UL Listed
• Available in 30 -100 A, 600 Vac/250 Vdc, fused or non-fused, NEMA Type 1, and
NEMA Type 12
• Suitable for use as service equipment [52]
• Receptacles are zinc plated steel for NEMA Type 1 and 12 safety switches
• Short Circuit Current Rating for fusible switches is 10 kAIR maximum when used with
Class H, K, J or R fuses
• Short Circuit Current Rating for non-fusible switches is 10 kAIR maximum when
protected by Class H, K, J, R or T fuses
Table 3.26: Hubbellock Receptacle Safety Switch
NEMA NEMA Horsepower Ratings—3Ø
Use with Plug[53]
H362AWH Amperes Type 1 Type 12 480 Vac [54] 600 Vac [54]
Interlocked Receptacle
Switch with Hubbell™ Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Std. Max. Std. Max.
Hubbellock Receptacle Fusible—3P, 600 Vac
60 H362WH H362AWH SD12781 15 30 15 50
Non-Fusible—3P, 600 Vac
60 HU362WH HU362AWH SD12781 — 50 — 60

Square D by Schneider Electric brand heavy duty safety switches are UL listed for use
with the following accessories:
Rainproof Bolt-On Hubs
• UL Listed for indoor or rainproof applications
• Suitable for use with conduit having ANSI standard taper pipe thread
• NEMA Type 3R switches with catalog number ending in RB have a bolt-on closing cap
factory installed
– Accepts 3/4 in. through 2-1/2 in. bolt-on hubs
– No gaskets required
• NEMA Type 3R switches with R suffix have blank top endwalls
– Accepts 3 in. through 4 in. bolt on hubs
– Gaskets provided
– Conduit entry holes must be cut in the field

Table 3.27: Rainproof Bolt-On Hubs [55]


Conduit 3/4 1 1-1/4 1-1/2 2 2-1/2 3 4 Closing
Size Cap
Hub Cat. B075 B100 B125 B150 B200 B250 B300 B400 BCAP
No

Watertight Hubs
• UL Listed for dusttight and watertight applications
• Suitable for use with conduit having ANSI standard taper pipe thread
• Watertight hubs are field installed on NEMA Type 4/4X/5 stainless steel and NEMA
Type 12/3R and 12K enclosures
• Watertight hubs are available in zinc or chrome plated finish
• Gaskets provided
Table 3.28: Watertight Hubs [56]
Watertight Hubs
Conduit
1/2 3/4 1 1-1/4 1-1/2 2 2-1/2 3 3-1/2 4
Size
Standard-
Zinc
Hub Cat. H050 H075 H100 H125 H150 H200 H250 H300 H350 H400
No
Chrome
Plated
Hub Cat. H050CP H075CP H100CP H125CP H150CP H200CP — — — —
No.

[51] SCCR when using 60 Amp Max fuse.


[52] Receptacle only rated for NEMA Type 1 and 12 applications.
[53] Hubbell plug is furnished with a Kellems grip for 1-1/2 in. to 1-21/64 in. cable diameter.
[54] Std.—Using fast acting one time fuses. Max.—Using dual element time delay fuses.
[55] Gaskets are provided on 3 in. and larger hubs.
[56] Gaskets are provided.
3-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories and Special Features Heavy Duty Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

Electrical Interlock Kits


Electrical interlocks for heavy duty safety switches 30 A through 1200 A are available
factory installed or in kit form for field installation. A pivot arm operates from the switch
mechanism, breaking the control circuit before the main switch blades break. For factory-
installed electrical interlocks add EI (for one contact) or EI2 (for two contacts) suffix to
catalog number. See Supplemental Digest Section 2 for electrical interlock contact
ratings. UL Listed, factory or field installed.

Table 3.29: Electrical Interlock Kit [57] [58]


Switch’s Electrical Interlock Kit
Amperes Rating Series Number [59]
Cat. No. [60]
EIK031
30 F5–F6
EIK032
EIK1
60 F5–F6
(600 V) EIK2
60 EIK031
(240 V) F5–F6
EIK032
EIK1
EIK2 Electrical Interlock Kit 100–200 F5–F6
EIK2
30–100 EIK1
Receptable Switches F5–F7
EIK2
30–200 EIK1
F5–F6
Four- and Six-Pole Switches EIK2
EIK40601
400–1200 E4–E5 EIK40602

SAFETY SWITCHES
Class R Fuse Kits
When installed, this kit rejects all but Class R fuses. Kits are available for field
installation. One kit required for a three pole switch. For factory installation, add “CLR’’
suffix to catalog number.

Table 3.30: 240 Vac — Class R Fuse Kits [61]


Amperes Series Number Class R Fuse Kit
Cat. No.
30 F5–F6 RFK03L
60 F5–F6 RFK03H
100 F5–F6 RFK10
200 F5–F6 HRK1020
400–600 E4–E5 HRK4060

Table 3.31: 600 Vac — Class R Fuse Kits [61] [62]

3
Amperes Class R Fuse Kit
Series Number Cat. No.
30 [63] F5–F6 RFK03H
30 A
Receptacle Switches F7 RFK06
30 A
F5–F6 RFK06
Four-Pole Switches
60 F5–F7 RFK06H
100 F5–F7 RFK10
200 F5–F6 HRK1020
400–600 E4–E5 HRK4060

Internal Barrier Kits


Internal Barrier Kits provide an additional barrier that helps prevent accidental contact
with live parts. Field-installed transparent barriers do not restrict visual inspection of the
switch. Barriers provide IEC529 IP2X “finger safe” protection when door of enclosed
disconnect switch is open. Convenient door allows use of test probes without accessing
fuses and replacement of fuses without removing barrier. For use with three-pole
switches.
Table 3.32: Internal Barrier Kits
Safety Switch Application
Cat. No. Description (F Series Only)
Interior Barrier for 30 A and 240 V 60 A 240 / 600 Vac – 30 A
SS03 Safety Switch [64] 240 Vac – 60 A
Interior Barrier for 600 V, 60 A
SS06 Safety Switch 600 Vac – 60 A
Interior Barrier for 240 / 600 V, 100 A
SS10 Safety Switch 240 / 600 Vac – 100 A
Interior Barrier for 240 / 600 V, 200 A
SS20 Safety Switch 240 / 600 Vac – 200 A

[57] For series not shown in table refer to the switch wiring diagram.
[58] Electrical interlocks for NEMA Type 4X fiberblass reinforced polyester and KrydonTM see Table 3.19 and Table 3.20 respectively.
[59] See page 3-20 and page 3-21 for safety switch series.
[60] Electrical interlock kit catalog numbers ending in 1 indicates one normally open and one normally closed contact. These kits use a 9007A01 industrial snap switch. Electrical interlock kit
catalog numbers ending in 2 indicates two normally open and two normally closed contacts. These kits use a 9007C03 industrial snap switch.
[61] For series not shown in the table, refer to the switch wiring diagram.
[62] Class R Fuse Kits for Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester enclosures and KrydonTM enclosures see Table 3, page 3-11 and Table 5, page 3-12 respectively.
[63] H361-2, H361-2A, H361-2AWK and H361-2RB use RFK06.
[64] Requires arc shield on 240 V switches be changed to 600 V arc suppressor. Contact the Customer Care Center at 1–888–778–2733 fo the arc suppressor part number.
3-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Heavy Duty Safety Switches Accessories and Special Features
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

Fuse Puller Kits


Fuse Puller Kits are standard equipment on the following 30 A - 100 A switches: NEMA
Type 12 and 12K, NEMA Type 4/4X/5 stainless steel, NEMA Type 4X fiberglass
reinforced polyester and KrydonTM.
Fuse Puller Kit available for field installation on NEMA Type 1 and NEMA Type 3R, 30 A
– 100 A switches. One Fuse Puller Kit required for a 3 pole fusible 240 V or 600 V heavy
duty switch. Fuse Puller Kits can be field installed on switches manufactured since
February 1980.
Amperes Series Number [65] Fuse Puller Kit Cat. No.
30 F5–F7 FPK03 [66]
60 F5–F7 (600 V) FPK0610
60 F5 (240 V) FPK03
100 F5–F7 FPK0610
Fuse Puller Kits

Solid Neutral Assembly Kits


Table 3.33: Solid Neutral Assembly Kits[65] [67] [68] [69]
Amperes Series Number [70] Standard Neutral Kit Cat. No. Terminal Data Optional Copper Only Terminal Data
AWG/kcmil Neutral Kit Cat. No. AWG/kcmil
3

(2) 14-3 Al/Cu plus (2) 14-6 Cu plus


30 F5–F6 SN03 [71] (1) 14-3 Al/Cu Svc Ground SN03C [71] (1) 14-6 Cu Svc Ground
F5–F6, (2) 14-1/0 Al/Cu plus (2) 14-1/0 Cu plus
(600 V) SN0610 (2) 14-6 Al/Cu Svc Ground SN0610C (2) 14-6 Cu Svc Ground
60
F5–F6 (2) 14-3 Al/Cu plus (2) 14-1/0 Cu plus
(240 V) SN03 (1) 14-3 Al/Cu Svc Ground SN03C (2) 14-6 Cu Svc Ground
(2) 14-1/0 Al/Cu plus (2) 14-1/0 Cu plus
100 F5–F6, SN0610 (2) 14-6 Al/Cu Svc Ground SN0610C (2) 14-6 Cu Svc Ground
200 [72] (2) 6-250 Al/Cu plus (2) 6-250 Cu plus
SAFETY SWITCHES

F5–F6 SN20A (1) 14-10 Al/Cu Svc Ground SN20C (1) 14-1/0 Cu Svc Ground
(4) 1-750 Al/Cu plus (2) 1-600 Cu and
400 and 600 E4–E5 H600SN H600SNC (2) 4-350 Cu plus
(1) 4-300 Al/Cu Svc Ground (2) 6-250 Cu Svc Ground
(6) 3/0-750 Al/Cu plus
800 E4 H800SNE4 (2) 6-350 Al/Cu Svc Ground – –
(8) 3/0-750 Al/Cu plus
1200 E4 H1200SNE4 (2) 6-350 Al/Cu Svc Ground – –

Equipment Grounding Kits


Equipment grounding kits are available for factory or field installation. For factory
installation of equipment grounding kit, add suffix GL to standard Cat. No. (Example:
H361GL).

Table 3.34: Equipment Grounding Kits and Terminal Data [73] [74]
Amperes Series Number Standard Terminal Data Optional Copper Only Terminal Data
Cat. No. AWG/kcmil Cat. No. AWG/kcmil
(2) 14-4 Cu or (2) 12-4 Al
30 F5–F6 GTK03 [75] or GTK03C [75] [76] (2) 14-6 Cu
(4) 14-12 Cu or (4) 12-10 Al
(2) 14-1/0 Cu or (2) 12-1/0 Al
F5–F6 (2) 14-1/0 Cu and
60 GTK0610 and GTK0610C
(600 V) (2) 14-6 Cu or (2) 12-6 Al (2) 14-6 Cu
(2) 14-4 Cu or (2) 12-4 Al
F5–F6
60 (240 V) GTK03 or GTK03C (2) 14-6 Cu
(4) 14-12 Cu or (4) 12-10 Al
(2) 14-1/0 Cu or (2) 12-1/0 Al (2) 14-1/0 Cu and
100 F5–F6 GTK0610 and GTK0610C (2) 14-6 Cu
(2) 14-6 Cu or (2) 12-6 Al
(2) 10-2/0 Cu or
200 F5–F6 PKOGTA2 PKOGTC2 (2) 14-4 Cu
(2) 6-2/0 Al
(2) 10-2/0 Cu or
400 and 600 E4–E5 PKOGTA2 [77] PKOGTC3 (4) 14-1/0 Cu
(2) 6-2/0 Al
800 E4 PKOGTA7 (4) 4-350 Al/Cu — —
1200 E4 PKOGTA8 (8) 4-350 Al/Cu — —

[65] For series not shown in chart refer to the switch wiring diagram.
[66] 30 A 4 pole, H361-2 and H361-2RB Series F5, H361WA and H361WC Series F6 use FPK0610.
[67] For solid Neutral Assembly Kits for Krydon TM enclosure see Table 3.20.
[68] For Solid Neutral Assembly Kits for Fiberglass Reinforced Ployester enclosures see Table 3.19.
[69] Neutrals cannot be installed in 4 or 6 pole switches or receptable switches.
[70] See page 3-20 and page 3-21 for safety switch series.
[71] The following 30 A Series F5-F6 switches use SN0610 or SN0610C: H3612, H3612RB, H3612A, H3612AWK, HU3612, HU3612RB, HU3612A and HU3612AWK.
[72] For 200% neutral, order (2) SN20A Neutral Kits and (1) SN20NI Neutral Jumper Kit.
[73] For series not shown in table refer to the switch wiring diagram.
[74] Equipment Ground Kits (Al/Cu) are factory installed standard in 30-200 A Series F NEMA Type 4/4X/5 (stainless steel), 12 and 12K. Equipment Ground Kits are standard factory installed on
all receptacle switches and all Series F 30-200 A, 4 and 6 pole switches.
[75] H2212AWK accepts GTK03 or GTK03C. H3612A or AWK accepts GTK03C. H3612 and H3612RB accepts GTK0610 HU3612AWK accepts GTK03C. HU3612A accepts GTK0610C.
HU3612RB accepts GTK0610 or GTK0610C.
[76] Optional copper equipment grounding kit for the 4 and 6 pole 30 A F Series: H461DS, H461AWK, HU461DS, HU661DS and HU661AWK accepts GTK03C HU461AWK accepts GTK0610C.
[77] Two required if equipment grounding conductors are run in parallel.
3-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories and Special Features Heavy Duty Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

Special Paint and Touch-Up Paint


UL Listed heavy duty switches are available painted with special safety colors. To order
safety colored switches, add suffixes from the Safety Colors table to the standard switch
catalog number.
Not available on NEMA Type 4X Fiberglass, Krydon, NEMA Type 4/4X/5 Stainless Steel
nor NEMA Type 7 and 9 switches.
All colors comply with OSHA Standard 1910.144 and ANSI Specification Z535.1 for
marking physical hazards.

Table 3.35: Safety Colors [78]


Safety Color Suffix Safety Color Suffix

Black SP0 Blue SP6


Red SP2 Purple SP7
Orange SP3 Gray SP8 [79]
Yellow SP4 Gray ANSI 61 SP861
Green SP5 White SP9

Table 3.36: Square D Gray Touch-Up Paint


Description Cat. No.
12 oz. Aerosol Paint Can, Square D ANSI-49 Gray Touch-Up Paint PK49SP
NOTE: Minimum quantity of 6 required.

Lock-Off Guard Kits [80] [81]

SAFETY SWITCHES
Available factory- or field-installed the lock-off guard works by covering the lockout/
tagout opening whenever the switch is in the ON position. This prevents a padlock from
being inadvertantly inserted into the switch lockplate. The device is designed to help
prevent accidental misapplication of a lockout device. These kits are marked cURus (UL
Component Recognized) for field or factory installation.

Table 3.37: Lock-Off Guard Kits


Switch Rating Cat. No.
30 A
LOGK1
60 A 240 V
60 A 600 V
LOGK2
100 and 200 A

3
Optional Lock-OFF Guard Kit Installed

Key Interlock Systems


Factory-installed only on heavy duty safety switches and double throw safety switches.
Interlocks are used to prevent the authorized operator from making an unauthorized
operation. Not available on NEMA Type 4X Fiberglass, Krydon or NEMA Type 7 and 9
switches.
The key interlock system is a simple and easy method of applying individual key interlock
units and assemblies to the above equipment so as to require operation in a
predetermined sequence. UL Listed.
Quoting: Contact Schneider Electric for catalog number, availability, and pricing prior to
quoting a job. Detailed information is required before an order can be processed. Please
see Supplemental Digest Section 2 for further information.
Use these suffixes on switch catalog numbers:
Key Interlock System • KI = 1 lock per switch
• KI2 = 1 lock with 2 cylinders (2 keys) per switch
• KIKI = 2 separate locks per switch

Lock-ON Provisions
Lock-OFF provisions are standard on all heavy duty safety switches. Provision for one 3/
8 inch hasp padlock is available factory-installed on 30–1200 A, NEMA Type 1, 3R, 4-4X-
5 stainless steel 12 and 12K switches. Not avaliable on NEMA Type 4X, Fiberglass,
Krydon or NEMA Type 7 and 9 switches. This modification will allow the switch to be
locked in the “ON’’ position. UL Listed.
To order, add suffix SPLO to standard catalog number. Example: H364-SPLO

[78] A minimum quantity of 10 is required.


[79] Standard Square D ANSI 49 grey paint, when selecting this suffix, switches will receive additional coat of paint.
[80] Available factory assembled or as a field installable kit on NEMA Type 1, 3R, 12 or 12K switches. Not available for use on NEMA Type 4X Fiberglass, Krydon, NEMA Type 4/4X/5 Stainless
Steel nor NEMA Type 7 and 9 switches.
[81] For factory installation add suffix LOG to the standard switch catalog number.
3-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Heavy Duty Safety Switches Accessories and Special Features
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

Cover Viewing Window


Optional cover viewing window is positioned over the blades to allow visual verification of
“ON-OFF” status. Available on 30 through 1200 A heavy duty switches, NEMA Type 1,
3R, 4/4X/5 Stainless Steel, 12 and 12K. (Not avaliable on NEMA Type 4X, Fiberglass,
Krydon or NEMA Type 7 and 9 switches). Add VW suffix to the catalog number for factory
installation.
Voltage Monitors
Voltage monitors installed on safety switches indicate when voltage is present, helping to
prevent arc-flash hazards and electric shocks during maintenance work. Voltage
monitors can be combined with other safety features such as Key Interlock, Viewing
Windows or Lock-ON provisions.
• UL Listed
• Factory installed only
• Order the voltage monitors by adding the appropriate suffix shown in the table below
to the switch catalog number
• Not available on NEMA Type 7 and 9 and NEMA Type 4X Fiberglass and KrydonTM
switches
Table 3.38: Voltage Monitors [82] [83] [84]
Description Suffix [85]
Line Side Monitor SI
Load Side Monitor LI
Line and Load Side Monitors LI2

Copper Lug Kits


Lug kits that accept only copper wire are available for field or factory installation:
SAFETY SWITCHES

• UL Listed
• UL Marine Listed
– UL Marine listing is applicable ONLY to 30 - 200 A, NEMA Type 12/3R, NEMA Type
12K and NEMA Type 4/4X/5 stainless steel, safety switches
– When copper only lugs kits are factory installed the switch will bear the UL Marine
mark and be suitable for use on vessels over 65 feet long
– When the copper only lugs kits are field installed the switch will not bear the UL
Marine mark and would not be suitable for use on vessels over 65 feet long
• Not available for use on NEMA Type 4X Fiberglass, Krydon or NEMA Type 7 and 9
switches
• For field installation, order copper lug kits. See Table below
• For factory installation of copper lugs, add the suffix SLC to the standard catalog
number
Table 3.39: Copper Lug Kits [86]
Al/Cu to Cu Only Amperes Lug Kit Cat. No. Lug Wire Range AWG/kcmil
(1) 14-8 Cu solid or
30–60 CL0306F 14-4 Cu stranded
(1) 14-8 Cu solid or
100 CL10F
14-1/0 Cu stranded
200 CL20F (1) 6-250 Cu
(1) 1-600 Cu plus
400 CL40F (1) 6-250 Cu
600 CL60F (1) 4-350 Cu
 800 — —
1200 — —

[82] Available on 30–1200 A Heavy Duty Safety Switches.


[83] Order 600 Vac Heavy Duty Safety Switch for all 30–60 A 240 Vac applications.
[84] Available on 30–200 A Double Throw Safety Switches. Two and three-pole, 200 A Type 3R switches are not available with these voltage monitors.
[85] In addition to the suffix shown in the table above, a 3 must be added to the switch catalog number for all 30 and 60 A switches, i.e. H361AWK becomes H3613AWKLI. 30 and 60 A switches
require 100 A enclosure accessories. Double Throw Safety Switches are exempt from this requirement.
[86] One kit includes all phase line/load lugs for a 3-pole switch. CL0306F, CL10F and CL20F includes six lugs. CL40F and CL60F includes twelve lugs.
3-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories and Special Features Heavy Duty Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

Double Lug Kits


200 A heavy duty F-series switches are supplied standard with lugs suitable for one wire
per phase. For two wires per phase and neutral, order the Double Lug Kit.
Not UL Listed. Not listed on switch’s wiring diagram as an accessory.

Table 3.40: Double Lug Kits


Lug Wire Range Wire Range Wire
Amperes Cat. No. [87] per Phase and Neutral Bending Space per
AWG/kcmil NEC Table 312.6 AWG/kcmil
200 AL20DTF (2) 6 –300 Cu/Al (2) 6 –250 Cu/Al

Compression Lug Kits — 800 A and 1200 A Safety Switches


• UL Listed. • Compression Lug Kits contain
• Compression Lug Kits available for field VCEL07512H1 Versa-CrimpTM
installation compression lugs
• Compression Lug Kits available for
• Order one Compression Lug Kit per
factory installation; Add suffix LK to switching pole and/or neutral (see Table
standard catalog number below)

Table 3.41: Compression Lug Kits


Amperes Lug Kit Conductors per Phase Lug Wire Range
Cat. No. kcmil
500-750 kcmil (AI)

SAFETY SWITCHES
 800 H8LKE2 (3) Line and (3) Load or
500 kcmil (CU)
500-750 kcmil (AI)
1200 H12LKE2 (4) Line and (4) Load or
500 kcmil (CU)

Table 3.42: Terminal Lug Data [88]


Wire Range Wire Bending Optional Copper Only [89]
Rating (A) Wires Per Phase Space per NEC Table 312.6 Lug Wire Range Optional [89]Compression Lug Compression Lug Field-
and Neutral AWG/kcmil Field-Installed Installed [90]
AWG/kcmil
12–6 (Al)
1 or
14–6 (Cu) 12–2 (Al)
or C10–14,[91] D8–14–SK,
30
12–10 (Al) 14–2 (Cu) or —
2 or E6–14
14–10 (Cu)
12–3 (Al) 12–2 (Al)

3
60 [92] or or C10–14,[91] D8–14–SK,
1 or
14–3 (Cu) 14–2 (Cu) —
E6–14
12–1/0 (Al) 12–1/0 (Al)
100 [93] 1 or or VCEL02114S1 VCELC02114S1
14–1/0 (Cu) 14–1/0 (Cu)
200 [94] 1 6–250 (Al/Cu) 6–300 (Al/Cu) VCEL030516H1 VCELC030516H1
VCEL07512H1 VCELC07512H1
1 1/0–750 (Al/Cu) 1/0–750 (Al/Cu) or or
400[95] or or or VCEL030516H1 [96] VCELC030516H1[97]
2 1/0–300 (Al/Cu) 1/0–300 (Al/Cu) and and
VCEL05012H1 VCELC05012H1
600 2 3/0–500 (Al/Cu) 3/0–500 (Al/Cu) VCEL05012H1 VCELC05012H1
800 3 3/0–750 (Al/Cu) 3/0–750 (Al/Cu) H8LKE2[98] —
1200 4 3/0–750 (Al/Cu) 3/0–750 (Al/Cu) H12LKE2[98] —

Table 3.43: Conduit Provisions


Top and Bottom
Endwall
Amperes
NEMA Type 4X Fiberglass
Reinforced Polyester and Krydon [99] NEMA Type 7 and 9 [100]
 30  3/4 in. —
 60 1-1/4 in. 3/4 in.
100 2 in. 1-1/4 in.
200 2-1/2 in. 2-1/2 in.

[87] Kit contains 3 lugs. Order two kits for line and load lugs.
[88] 30–100 A switches suitable for 60°C or 75°C conductors. 200–1200 A switches suitable for 75°C conductors.
[89] Hubbell Versa-Crimp™ unless otherwise noted.
[90] For NEMA Type 1, 12/3R, 12K and 4/4X/5 stainless steel switches only.
[91] Order from Thomas and Betts.
[92] H60XFA and H60XFA1212 — use 75°C copper wire only. #6 AWG copper wire required for 60 A rating.
[93] H100XFA and H100XFA1212 — use 75°C copper wire only. #3 AWG copper wire required for 100 A rating.
[94] H225XJG and H225XJGAA — use 75°C copper wire only. Lug wire range is #3 AWG – 350 kcmil. Not UL Listed due to inadequate wire bending space (5” on ON end, 6” on OFF end).
[95] Maximum wire bending space allows for (1) 600 kcmil or (2) 300 kcmil Al/Cu on NEMA Type 4/4X/5 stainless steel and NEMA Type 12 switches.
[96] Order two PK516KN mounting kits when installing VCEL030516H1 lugs. Only one kit is required on 2 pole switches. PK516KN consists of (4) 5/16-18 Keps Nuts.
[97] Order two PK516KN mounting kits when installing VCEL030516H1 or VCELC030516H1 lugs. Only one kit is required on 2 pole switches. PK516KN consists of (4) 5/16-18 Keps Nuts.
[98] For 800 and 1200 A compression lug kits see Table 3.41 for additional information.
[99] Hubs and hub drilling templates are provided for field-installation.
[100] Threaded conduit opening.
3-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Heavy Duty Safety Switches Dimensions for Heavy Duty Safety
Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602 schneider-electric.us

NEMA Type 1 and 3R


See Table 3.42 Terminal Lug Data, page 3-19 for terminal lug data for the series switches
listed in the dimension table below.
W W

H H

W/H D W/H D
Typical NEMA Type 1 Typical NEMA Type 3R

Table 3.44: Approximate Dimensions


3

H W D W/H Ser- H W D W/H


Cat. No. Series Cat. No.
in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm ies in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm
H221N F5 14.60  371  6.50 165  4.88 124  7.55 192 H364, N F5 29.00  737 17.13 435 8.25 210 18.50 470
H221NRB F5 14.88  378  6.63 168  4.88 124  7.55 192 H364RB, F5 29.25  743 17.25 438 8.50 216 18.63 473
NRB
H222N F5 14.60  371  6.50 165  4.88 124  7.55 192 H365, N E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702
H222NRB F5 14.88  378  6.63 168  4.88 124  7.55 192 H365R, NR E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708
SAFETY SWITCHES

H223N F5 21.25  540  8.50 216  6.38 162 10.50 267 H366, N E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702
H223NRB F5 21.25  540  8.50 216  6.38 162 10.50 267 H366NR, R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708
H224N F5 29.00  737 17.13 435 8.25 210 18.50 470 H367, N E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H224NRB F5 29.25  743 17.25 438 8.50 216 18.63 473 H367NR, R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H225, N E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702 H368, N E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H225NR, R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708 H368NR, R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H226, N E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702 H461 F5 20.50  521 14.75 375  6.85 174 16.13 410
H226NR, R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708 H462 F5 20.50  521 14.75 375  6.85 174 16.13 410
H227, N E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 H463 F5 20.50  521 14.75 375  6.85 174 16.13 410
H227NR, R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 H464 F5 29.00  737 23.25 591  8.75 222 24.88 632
H228, N E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 H465 E4 50.25 1276 33.88 861 10.13 257 33.88 861
H228NR, R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 H466 E4 50.25 1276 33.88 861 10.13 257 33.88 861
H265 E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702 HU265 E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702
H265R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708 HU265R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708
H266 E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702 HU266 E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702
H266R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708 HU266R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708
H267 E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 HU267 E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H267R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 HU267R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H268 E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 HU268 E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H268R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 HU268R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H321N F5 14.60  371  6.50 165  4.88 124  7.55 192 HU361 F5 14.60  371  6.50 165  4.88 124  7.55 192
H321NRB F5 14.88  378  6.63 168  4.88 124  7.55 192 HU361RB F5 14.88  378  6.63 168  4.88 124  7.55 192
H322N F5 14.60  371  6.50 165  4.88 124  7.55 192 HU361WA F6 18.19  462  9.00 229  6.81 173 10.50 267
H322NRB F5 14.88  378  6.63 168  4.88 124  7.55 192 HU361WC F6 18.19  462  9.00 229  6.81 173 10.50 267
H323N F5 21.25  540  8.50 216  6.38 162 10.50 267 HU362 F5 17.50  445  9.00 229  6.38 162 10.50 267
H323NRB F5 21.25  540  8.50 216  6.38 162 10.50 267 HU362RB F5 17.50  445  9.00 229  6.38 162 10.50 267
H324N F5 29.00  737 17.13 435 8.25 210 18.50 470 HU362WA F6 18.19 462  9.00 229  6.81 173 10.50 267
H324NRB F5 29.25  743 17.25 438 8.50 216 18.63 473 HU362WC F6 16.75 425  9.00 229  7.00 178 10.50 267
H325, N E4 50.25 1276 27.88 708 10.13 257 27.88 708 HU362WH F5 18.19  462  9.00 229  6.81 173 10.50 267
H325R, NR E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708 HU363 F5 21.25  540  8.50 216  6.38 162 10.50 267
H326, N E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702 HU363RB F5 21.25  540  8.50 216  6.38 162 10.50 267
H326R, NR E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708 HU363WA F6 21.85 462  9.00 229  6.81 173 10.50 267
H327, N E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 HU363WC F6 21.85 555  9.00 229  6.81 173 10.50 267
H327R, NR E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 HU364 F5 29.00  737 17.13 435  8.25 210 18.50 470
H328, N E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 HU364RB F5 29.25  743 17.25 438  8.50 216 18.63 473
H328R, NR E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 HU365 E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702
H361, N F5 14.60  371  6.50 165  4.88 124  7.55 192 HU365R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708
H361-2 F5 17.50  445  9.00 229  6.38 162 10.50 267 HU366 E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702
H361NRB, RB F5 14.88 378  6.63 168  4.88 124  7.55 192 HU366R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708
H361WA F6 18.19 462  9.00 229  6.81 173 10.50 267 HU367 E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H361WC F6 18.19 462  9.00 229  6.81 173 10.50 267 HU367R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H362, N F5 17.50  445  9.00 229  6.38 162 10.50 267 HU368 E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H362NRB, RB F5 17.50  445  9.00 229  6.38 162 10.50 267 HU368R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H362WA F6 18.19 462  9.00 229  6.81 173 10.50 267 HU461 F5 20.50  521 14.75 375  6.85 174 16.13 410
H362WC F6 16.75  425  9.00 229  7.00 178 10.50 267 HU462 F5 20.50  521 14.75 375  6.85 174 16.13 410
H362WH F5 18.19  462  9.00 229  6.81 173 10.50 267 HU463 F5 20.50  521 14.75 375  6.85 174 16.13 410
H363, N F5 21.25 540  8.50 216  6.38 162 10.50 267 HU464 F5 29.00  737 23.25 591  8.75 222 24.88 632
H363NRB, RB F5 21.25 540  8.50 216  6.38 162 10.50 267 HU465 E4 50.25 1276 33.88 861 10.13 257 33.88 861
H363WA F6 21.85  462  9.00 229  6.81 173 10.50 267 HU466 E4 50.25 1276 33.88 861 10.13 257 33.88 861
H363WC F6 21.85  555  9.00 229  6.81 173 10.50 267

3-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Dimensions for Heavy Duty Safety Heavy Duty Safety Switches
Switches
schneider-electric.us Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
NEMA Type 4, 4X, 5, 7, 9, and 12
See Table 3.42 Terminal Lug Data, page 3-19 for terminal lug data for the series switches
listed in the dimension table below.
Table 3.45: Approximate Dimensions
W H W D W/H
Cat. No. Series
in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm
H60XFA E1 15.93  405  9.87 251  6.96 177  9.87 251
H100XFA E1 15.93  405  9.87 251  6.96 177  9.87 251
H221AWK,A F6 14.60  371  6.63 168  4.96 125  7.55 192
H221DS F6 14.93  379  7.22 183  5.11 130  8.67 220
H221-2AWK F6 16.50  419  9.00 229  7.00 178 10.50 267
H222AWK,A F6 14.60  371  6.63 168  4.96 125  7.55 192
H222DS F6 14.93  379  7.22 183  5.11 130  8.67 220
H H223AWK,A F6 20.50  521  9.00 229  7.00 178 10.50 267
H223DS F6 20.82  529  9.36 238  6.97 177 11.25 286
H224A,AWK F6 29.00  737 17.25 438  8.75 216 18.63 473
H224DS F6 29.00  737 17.75 451  8.88 226 19.25 489
H225AWK,DS E4 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H225NAWK,NDS E4 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H225XJG A1 22.56  573 10.88 276  7.75 197 10.88 276
H226AWK,DS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H226NAWK,NDS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
W/H D H227AWK,NAWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
Typical NEMA Type 4, 4X, 5, 12, 12K H228AWK,NAWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
(Stainless has flat front) H265AWK,DS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H266AWK,A,DS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
W D
H267AWK,NAWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H268AWK,NAWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H321AWK,A F6 14.60  371  6.63 168  4.96 125  7.55 192

SAFETY SWITCHES
H321DS F6 14.93  379  7.22 183  5.11 130  8.67 220
H322AWK,A F6 14.60  371  6.63 168  4.96 125  7.55 192
H322DS F6 14.93  379  7.22 183  5.11 130  8.67 220
H H323AWK,A F6 20.50  521  9.00 229  7.00 178 10.50 267
H323DS F6 20.82  529  9.36 238  6.97 177 11.25 286
H324A,AWK F6 29.00  737 17.25 438  8.75 216 18.63 473
H324DS F6 29.00  737 17.75 451  8.88 226 19.25 489
H325AWK,DS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H325NAWK,NDS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H326AWK,DS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H326NAWK,NDS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
Typical NEMA Type 4X H327AWK,NAWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
Fiberglass and Krydon H328AWK,NAWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H361AWA F7 16.50 419 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H361AWC F7 16.50 419 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H361AWK,A F6 14.60  371  6.63 168  4.96 125  7.55 192
H361DS F6 14.93  379  7.22 183  5.11 130  8.67 220
H361DSWA F7 16.87 428 8.92 227 5.11 130 10.81 275
H361DSWC F7 16.87 428 8.92 227 5.11 130 10.79 274

3
H361DF F1 16.50  419 11.00 279  8.80 224 11.00 279
H361DX F1 19.40  493 11.40 290  8.60 218 11.40 290
H361SS F6 14.93 379 7.22 183 5.11 130 8.67 220
H H361-2AWK,A F6 16.50  419  9.00 229  7.00 178 10.50 267
H362AWA F7 16.50  419  9.00 229  7.00 178 10.50 267
H362AWC F7 16.50  419  9.00 229  7.00 178 10.50 267
H362AWH F6 16.50  419  9.00 229  7.00 178 10.50 267
H362AWK,A F6 16.50  419  9.00 229  7.00 178 10.50 267
H362DS F6 16.87  428  8.92 227  6.97 177 10.81 275
H362DSWA F7 16.87 428 8.92 227 5.11 130 10.81 275
W D H362DSWC F7 16.87 428 8.92 227 5.11 130 10.79 274
H362DF F1 16.50  419 11.00 279 8.80 224 11.00 279
Typical NEMA Type 7, 9 H362DX F1 19.40  493 11.40 290  8.60 218 11.40 290
H362SS F6 16.87 428 8.92 227 6.97 177 10.81 275
H363AWA F7 20.50 521 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H363AWC F7 20.50 521 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H363AWK,A F6 20.50  521  9.00 229  7.00 178 10.50 267
H363DS F6 20.82  529  9.36 238  6.97 177 11.25 286
H363DSWA F7 20.82 529 9.36 238 6.97 177 11.25 286
H363DSWC F7 20.82 529 9.36 238 6.97 177 11.25 286
H363DF F1 24.80  630 13.70 348 12.00 305 13.70 348
H363DX F1 25.25  641 11.40 290  8.60 218 11.40 290
H363SS F6 20.82 529 9.36 238 6.97 177 11.25 286
H364A,AWK F6 29.00  737 17.25 438  8.75 216 18.63 473
H364DS,NDS F6 29.00  737 17.75 451  8.88 226 19.25 489
H364NA,NAWK F6 29.00  737 17.25 438  8.75 216 18.63 473
H364DF E1 31.30  795 26.30 668 11.80 300 26.30 668
H364SS F6 29.00 737 17.75 451 8.88 226 19.25 489
H365AWK,DS,SS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H365NAWK,NDS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H366AWK,DS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H366NAWK,NDS,SS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H367AWK,NAWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H368AWK,NAWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H461AWK F6 20.50 521 14.75 375 6.80 173 16.13 410
H461DS F6 20.82 529 15.08 383 6.97 177 16.85 428
H462AWK F6 20.50 521 14.75 375 6.80 173 16.13 410
H462DS F6 20.82  529 15.08 383  6.97 177 16.85 428
H463AWK F6 20.50  521 14.75 375  6.80 173 16.13 410
H463DS F6 20.82  529 15.08 383  6.97 177 16.85 428
H464AWK F6 29.00  737 23.25 591  8.75 222 24.88 632
H464DS F6 29.00  737 23.75 603  8.88 226 25.25 641
H465AWK E5 46.25 1175 32.50 826 10.13 259 32.50 826
H663AWK F6 20.50  521 14.75 375  6.80 173 16.13 410
H663DS F6 20.82  529 15.08 383  6.97 177 16.85 428
H664AWK F6 29.00  737 23.25 591  8.75 222 24.88 632
H664DS F6 29.00  737 23.75 603  8.88 226 25.25 641
HU265AWK,DS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
HU266AWK,DS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
HU267AWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
HU268AWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
HU361AWA F7 16.50 419 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
HU361AWC F7 16.50 419 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
HU361AWK,A F6 14.60  371  6.63 168  4.96 125  7.55 192
HU361DS F6 14.93  379  7.22 183  5.11 130  8.67 220
HU361DSWA F7 16.87 428 8.92 227 5.11 130 10.81 275
HU361DSWC F7 16.87 428 8.92 227 5.11 130 10.79 274

3-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Heavy Duty Safety Switches Dimensions for Heavy Duty Safety
Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602 schneider-electric.us

Table 3.45 Approximate Dimensions (cont'd.)


H W D W/H
Cat. No. Series
in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm
HU361DF F1 16.50  419 11.00 279  8.80 224 11.00 279
HU361DX F1 19.40  493 11.40 290  8.60 218 11.40 290
HU361SS F6 14.93 379 7.22 183 5.11 130 8.67 220
HU362AWA F7 16.50  419  9.00 229  7.00 178 10.50 267
HU362AWC F7 16.50  419  9.00 229  7.00 178 10.50 267
HU362AWH F6 16.50  419  9.00 229  7.00 178 10.50 267
HU362AWK,A F6 16.50  419  9.00 229  7.00 178 10.50 267
HU362DS F6 16.87  428  8.92 227  6.97 177 10.81 275
HU362DSWA F7 16.87 428 8.92 227 5.11 130 10.81 275
HU362DSWC F7 16.87 428 8.92 227 5.11 130 10.79 274
HU362DF F1 16.50  419 11.00 279  8.80 224 11.00 279
HU362DX F1 19.40  493 11.40 290  8.60 218 11.40 290
HU362SS F6 16.87 428 8.92 227 6.97 177 10.81 275
HU363AWA F7 20.50 521 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
HU363AWC F7 20.50 521 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
HU363AWK,A F6 20.50  521  9.00 229  7.00 178 10.50 267
HU363DS F6 20.82  529  9.36 238  6.97 177 11.25 286
HU363DSWA F7 20.82 529 9.36 238 6.97 177 11.25 286
HU363DSWC F7 20.82 529 9.36 238 6.97 177 11.25 286
HU363DF F1 24.80  630 13.70 348 12.00 305 13.70 348
HU363DX F1 25.25 641 11.40 290 8.60 218 11.40 290
HU363SS F6 20.82 529 9.36 238 6.97 177 11.25 286
3

HU364A,AWK F6 29.00  737 17.25 438  8.75 216 18.63 473


HU364DF E1 31.30 795 26.30 668 11.80 300 26.30 668
HU364DS F6 29.00  737 17.75 451  8.88 226 19.25 489
HU364SS F6 29.00 737 17.75 451 8.88 226 19.25 489
HU365AWK,DS,SS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
HU366AWK,DS,SS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
HU367AWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
HU368AWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
HU461AWK F6 20.50 521 14.75 375  6.80 173 16.13 411
HU461DS F6 20.82  529 15.08 383  6.97 177 16.85 428
SAFETY SWITCHES

HU462AWK F6 21.25 540 16.13 410  6.80 173 16.13 410


HU462DS F6 20.82  529 15.08 383  6.97 177 16.85 428
HU463AWK F6 20.50  521 14.75 375  6.80 173 16.13 410
HU463DS F6 20.82  529 15.08 383  6.97 177 16.85 428
HU464AWK F6 29.00  737 23.25 591  8.75 222 24.88 632
HU464DS F6 29.00  737 23.75 603  8.88 226 25.25 641
HU465AWK E5 46.25 1175 32.50 826 10.13 259 32.50 826
HU661AWK F6 20.50  521 14.75 375  6.80 173 16.13 410
HU661DS F6 20.82  529 15.08 383  6.97 177 16.85 428
HU662AWK F6 20.50  521 14.75 375  6.80 173 16.13 410
HU662DS F6 20.82  529 15.08 383  6.97 177 16.85 428
HU663AWK F6 20.50  521 14.75 375  6.80 173 16.13 410
HU663DS F6 20.82  529 15.08 383  6.97 177 16.85 428
HU664AWK F6 29.00  737 23.25 591  8.75 222 24.88 632
HU664DS F6 29.00  737 23.75 603  8.88 226 25.25 641

3-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Fusible and Non-Fusible Overview Double Throw Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

30–100 A Types DT, DTU (Series F)


• Fusible (DT) and non-fusible (DTU) switches available
• Manually-operated switch suitable for use in accordance with article 702 of the NEC,
ANSI/NFPA 70
• Standards: UL 98, Type KS1, CSA, and NOM
• Modular design—switch handle, lock-plate, switch mechanism; line and load bases
are field replaceable
• UL Listed short circuit current ratings up to 200 kA (using with (fusible) or protected by
(non-fusible) Class R, J, or T fuses—see table for rating)
• Load make/break rated
• Horsepower rated
• Dual cover interlock
• May be padlocked ON (I) or OFF (O)
• Lock-off accepts up to three padlocks
• Side-opening door
• Quick make / quick break mechanism
• Meets NEMA requirements as heavy duty switch
• Field-installed electrical interlock kits
• Field-installed neutral assembly kits (2P and 3P switches)
• UL Listed as suitable for use as service equipment

SAFETY SWITCHES
30–100 A DT, DTU (Series F)
• Supplied as standard for switching one load between two power sources, and may be
field-converted to switch one power source between two loads.
NEMA Type 1

30 (Series T4), 200–600 A Types 82,000 and 200 A DTU


(Series E, A)
• Non-fusible
• Designed for manual transfer of one load between two power sources
• UL Listed switches are suitable for use in accordance with Article 702 of the National
Electrical Code, ANSI / NFPA 70
• All 82,000 and DTU double throw switches are continuous duty rated for their
nameplate ampere rating
• The 82,000 and DTU (Series E, A) switches are load make/break rated

3
• UL Listed as suitable for use as service equipment
• Horsepower rated only as footnoted
Field-Installable Accessories
• Neutral
• Electrical Interlock
82,000 Line
• Grounding Terminals
NEMA Type 1

3-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Double Throw Safety Switches 240 Volt — Double Throw Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

Double-Throw Safety Switches


Table 3.46: 240 V Double Throw Safety Switches
NEMA Type Horsepower Ratings [1][2]
NEMA Type 1 NEMA Type 3R 4,4X,5 NEMA Type 12 240 Vac
System Amperes Current 304 Stainless Gasketed
Series Steel Std. Max. 250 Vdc[3]
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. 1Ø 3Ø 1Ø 3Ø
Fusible—2P, 240 Vac—250 Vdc
Line

100 F DT223 DT223RB — —  7.5 15 [4] 15 30 [4] 20


Line

Load

Fusible—3P, 240 Vac—250 Vdc


3

Line 30 F DT321 DT321RB — — 1.5 [5]  3 [4]  3 [5]  7.5 [4]  5


60 F DT322 DT322RB — — 3 [5]  7.5 [4] 10 [5] 15 [4] 10

Line 100 F DT323 DT323RB — — 7.5 [5] 15 [4] 15 [5] 30 [4] 20


SAFETY SWITCHES

Load

Non-Fusible—2P, 240 Vac—250 Vdc


Line 60 F DTU222 — — — — — 10 — 10 [6]

Line 100 F DTU223 DTU223RB — — — — 15 — 20 [6]

Load

30 T4 92251 [7] — — — — — — — —
200 E 82254 DTU224NRB [7] [8] — H82254 15 — — — —
400 A 82255 [7] 82255R [7] — H82255 [7] — — — — —
Non-Fusible—3P, 240 Vac—250 Vdc
Line 30 F DTU321 — — — — 3 [4]   5 [5] 10 [4]  5 [6]
60 F DTU322 — — — — — 10 [5] 15 [4] 10 [6]

Line
100 F DTU323 DTU323RB — — — — 15 [5] 30 [4] 20 [6]

Load

30 T4 92351 [7] — — — — — — — —
200 E 82354 [7] — — H82354 [7] — 15 — — —
200 E DTU324N [7] [8] DTU324NRB [7] [8] — — — 15 — — —
400 A 82355 [7] 82355R [7] — H82355 [7] — — — — —
600 A DTU326 DTU326R — — — 125 — — 50
Non-Fusible—4P, 240 Vac
30 T4 92451 — — — — — — — —
200 E 82454 [9] 82454R [9] — H82454 [10] — 15 [10] — — —
400 A 82455 82455R — H82455 — — — — —
600 A DTU426 DTU426R — — — 125 — — 50

600 V Double Throw: page 3-25


Accessories: page 3-26
Application Data: Application Data, page 3-28
Dimensions, 30–100 A (Series F): page 3-30
Dimensions, 30, 200–600 A (Series E, T4, A): page 3-31

[1] The starting current of motors or more than standard horsepower may require the use of fuses with appropriate time delay characteristics.
[2] Std.—Using fast acting one time fuses. Max.—Using dual element time delay fuses.
[3] For switching dc, use two switching poles.
[4] If used on corner grounded delta systems, install neutral and use outer switching pole for ungrounded conductors. See data bulletin 2700DB0202 for additional information.
[5] Use outer switching poles.
[6] Maximum rating.
[7] 240 Vac only. Not Vdc rated.
[8] Neutral included with device.
[9] 240 Vac, 250 Vdc.
[10] Hp rating applies only to H82454.
3-24
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
600 Volt — Double Throw Safety Switches Double Throw Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

Double Throw Safety Switches


Table 3.47: 600 V Double Throw Safety Switches
NEMA Type Horsepower Ratings [11][12]
NEMA NEMA 4,4X,5 NEMA Type 12
Current Type 1 Type 3R 240 Vac 480 Vac 600 Vac Vdc [13]
System Amperes 304 Stainless Gasketed
Series Steel Std Max Std Max Std Max
250 600
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. 3Ø 3Ø 3Ø [14] 3Ø[14] 3Ø 3Ø
Fusible 3P, 600 Vac—600 Vdc
Line  5 15 15
 30 F DT361 DT361RB — — — — [15] [15]  7.5 20  5 [16]
15 30 30
 60 F DT362 DT362RB — — — — [17] [17] 15 50 — [18]

Line
25 60 50
100 F DT363 DT363RB — — — — [19] [19] 30 75 — [20]
Load

1Ø 3Ø 1Ø [13] 3Ø [14] 1Ø 3Ø
Non-Fusible 3P, 600 Vac—600 Vdc [13] [14] [13]
[21] [21] [21]
[21] [21] [21]
Line  30 F DTU361 DTU361RB — —  5 10 7.5 20 10 30  5 15
DTU362AWK[22] 20[23] 50 60
 60 F DTU362 DTU362RB DTU362DS 10 25 [24] 30 [25] 10 30

SAFETY SWITCHES
Line
100
100 F DTU363 DTU363RB DTU363DS DTU363AWK[22] 20 40[26] 40 75[26] 40 20 50
[26]
Load

82344DS [27]
200 E 82344 [27] 82344RB [27] H82344 [27] — — — 15 [29] — — — —
[28]
400 A 82345 [30] 82345R[30] 82345DS[30] H82345[30] — — — — — — — —
600 A DTU366[30] DTU366R[30] — DTU366AWK[30] — 125 — 250 — 350 50 —
Non-Fusible 4P, 600 Vac—600 Vdc 2Ø 3Ø 2Ø 3Ø 2Ø 3Ø
Line DTU462AWK[22]
 60 F DTU462[31] DTU462DS [31] 20 20 40 50 50 60 10 30
[31]

Use NEMA
Line Type 12 DTU463AWK[22]
100 F DTU463 [31] DTU463DS [31] 30 40 50 75 50 100 20 50
[31]

3
Load

82444[30] 82444R[30] 82444DS[30] H82444 [22] [31] —


200 E [32] [30] — — — — — — —
400 A 82445[30] 82445R[30] — H82445[30] — — — — — — — —
600 A DTU466[30] DTU466R[30] — — — 125 — 250 — 350 50 —
Non-Fusible 6P, 600 Vac—600 Vdc 1Ø 3Ø 1Ø 3Ø 1Ø 3Ø
Line DTU662AWK[22]
 60 F — — — [31] — 20 — 50 — 60 10 30

Line DTU663AWK[22]
100 F — — — [31] — 40 — 75 — 100 20 50
Load

240 V Double Throw: page 3-24


Accessories: page 3-26
Application Data: page 3-28
Dimensions, 30–100 A (Series F): page 3-30
Dimensions, 30, 200–600 A (Series E, T4, A): page 3-31

[11] The starting current of motors of more than standard horsepower may require the use of fuses with appropriate time delay characteristics.
[12] Std.—Using fast acting one time fuses. Max.—Using dual element time delay fuses. (Non-fusible switches have max rating unless noted.)
[13] Use outer switching poles.
[14] If used on corner grounded delta systems, install neutral and use outer switching pole for ungrounded conductors.See data bulletin 2700DB0202 for additional information.
[15] 480 Vac 1 Phase HP = 3 Std, 7.5 Max
[16] 10 Std, 15 Max
[17] 480 Vac 1 Phase HP = 5 Std, 20 Max
[18] 25 Std, 30 Max
[19] 480 Vac 1 Phase HP = 10 Std, 30 Max
[20] 40 Std, 50 Max
[21] Maximum HP
[22] Complete rating on switch is NEMA Type 3R, 5 or 12. For 3R applications, remove drain screw from bottom endwall.
[23] Maximum HP is 15 for corner grounded delta systems.
[24] Maximum HP is 30 for corner grounded delta systems.
[25] Use 75oC #4 Cu or #2 Al conductors only on DTU362 and DTU362RB.
[26] Use 75oC #1 Cu conductors only.
[27] 480 Vac, 250 Vdc maximum
[28] Not UL Listed.
[29] Standard Hp rating.
[30] 250 Vdc maximum.
[31] Not suitable for use as service equipment.
[32] 480 Vac, 250 Vdc maximum.
3-25
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Double Throw Safety Switches Accessories and Lug Data
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

Accessories
Table 3.48: Electrical Interlocks (For Electrical Interlock Contact Ratings, see
Supplemental Digest Section 2)
Switch Field-Installed Electrical Interlock Kit Cat. No.[33]
30–100 A Type DT, DTU (Series F) EIK1, EIK2[34][35]
200 A Type 82000 and DTU (Series E)[36] [37]
400 A Type 82000 (Series A) EK400DTU2
600 A Type DTU (Series A) DS200EK2D

Table 3.49: Neutral Assembly


Field-Installed Terminal Field-Installed Terminal
Switch Standard Neutral Kit Data Copper only Data
Cat. No. AWG/kcmil Neutral Kit Cat. No. AWG/kcmil
30–100 A Type DT, DTU (Series F) (2- and 3- (3) 14-1/0 Al/Cu plus (3) 14-1/0 Cu plus
pole switches only) SN0310 (2) 14-6 Al/Cu Svc Ground SN0310C (2) 14-6 Cu Svc Ground
(3) 14-4 Al/Cu plus
30 A (Series T4) (2- and 3-pole switches only) [38] — —
(2) 14-4 Al/Cu Svc Ground
200 A Type 82000 (Series E) (2 and 3 pole (3) 6-300 Al/Cu plus
switches only)[39] [38] (1) 6-2/0 Al or 10-2/0 Cu Svc Ground — —
3

(3) 4-300 Al/Cu plus


200A Type DTU (Series E) Factory Installed — —
(1) 4-300 Al/Cu Svc Ground
(1) 1/0 - 600 Al/Cu or
400 A Type 82000 (Series A) DT400N (2) 1/0 - 250 Al/Cu plus — —
(2) 6-300 Al/Cu Svc Ground
(6) 250-500 Al/Cu plus
600 A Type DTU (Series A) DT600NKD — —
(1) 6-250 Al/Cu Svc Ground
SAFETY SWITCHES

Table 3.50: Service Grounding Kit—Required for service equipment use


Field-Installed Service
Switch Grounding Lug Kit Cat. No. Terminal Data AWG/kcmil
30–60 A Type DT, DTU (3) 14-2 Al/Cu or
(Series F) Included (6) 14-10 Al/Cu
100 A Type DT, DTU (3) 14 - 1/0 Al/Cu
(Series F) Included
30 A Type 92,000 (4) 14-4 Al/Cu
(Series T4) DT30SG
200 A Type 82000 and DTU
(Series E) DT100SG (3) 14–1/0 Al/Cu
400 A Type 82000 (4) 10–2/0 Cu or
(series A) PKOGTA2 (2 required) (4) 6–2/0 Al
600 A Type DTU (2) 6–250 Al/Cu
(Series A) DS468GKD [40]

Table 3.51: Class R Fuse Kits


When properly installed, this kit rejects all but Class R fuses. Kits are available for field installation. For factory
installation add suffix CLR to the switch catalog number.
Switch Series Number Class R Fuse Kit Cat. No.
Class R Fuse Kits—240 V (two kits per 3P switch)
30 A F5 RFK03
60 A F5 RFK06
100 A F5 RFK10
Class R Fuse Kits—600 V (two kits per 3P switch)
30 A F5 RFK06
60 A F5 RFK06H
100 A F5 RFK10

Viewing Windows: Accessory available on 30–100 A DTU switches only. Add the suffix
VW to the catalog number.
Key Interlock Systems: For factory-installed key interlocks, refer to page 3-17.
Phenolic Legend Plate: For factory-installed phenolic legend plates, refer to
Supplemental Digest section 2.
Lock-ON Provisions: Standard feature on 30–100 A type DT and DTU (Series F),
82,000 (400 A only) and type 92,000 switches.
Feature available as factory installed option for Type 82,000 (200 A only) and 200 A DTU
(Series E) switches. Add the suffix SPLO to the catalog number.

[33] Electrical interlock kit catalog numbers with “1” suffix indicate one normally open and normally closed contact; “2” indicates two normally open and two normally closed contacts. See Table
3.29 Electrical Interlock Kit, page 3-15 for electrical interlock ratings.
[34] 30–100 A Type DT, DTU (Series F) switches contain (2) separate switching mechanisms. Each mechanism will accept an electrical interlock. Some applications may therefore require (2)
electrical interlocks.
[35] Double throw switches 92251, 92351, and 92451 are not available with factory or field installed electrical interlocks.
[36] Electrical interlock EK400DTU2 can be added to 200 A, 4-pole Type 82000 switches in the field.
[37] Type 82000 and DTU switches are available with electrical interlock factory-installed only. Not UL listed. Electrical interlocks are furnished with 2 N.O./N.C. contacts and are installed in both
“ON” positions. To order, add suffix EI to standard switch catalog number.
[38] For 200 A Type 82000 and 30 A Type 92000 switches, a neutral assembly is available factory installed on 2P and 3P switches. Not UL Listed. To order, add suffix N to the standard catalog
number. Terminated data = (3) 4 - 250 Al / Cu plug, (1) 4 - 250 Al / Cu SVC ground.
[39] Neutral assembly catalog number DT200N can be added to 4P, 200 A, Type 82000 switches in the field.
[40] (3) 6-250 ground lugs are provided as standard. DS468GKD provides an additional (2) 6-250 ground lugs.
3-26
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories and Lug Data Double Throw Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

Rainproof Bolt-On Hubs

• UL Listed for indoor or rainproof applications


• Suitable for use with conduit having ANSI standard taper pipe thread
• NEMA Type 3R switches with catalog number ending in RB have a bolt-on closing cap
factory installed
– Accepts 3/4 in. through 2-1/2 in. bolt-on hubs
– No gaskets required
• NEMA Type 3R switches with R suffix have blank top endwalls
– Accepts 3 in. through 4 in. bolt on hubs
– Gaskets provided
– Conduit entry holes must be cut in the field

Table 3.52: Rainproof Bolt-On Hubs [41]


Conduit Closing
3/4 1 1-1/4 1-1/2 2 2-1/2 3 3-1/2 4 Cap
Size
Hub
B075 B100 B125 B150 B200 B250 B300 B350 B400 BCAP
Cat. No

Watertight Hubs
• UL Listed for dusttight and watertight applications
• Suitable for use with conduit having ANSI standard taper pipe thread

SAFETY SWITCHES
• Watertight hubs are field installed on NEMA Type 4/4X/5 stainless steel and NEMA
Type 12/3R and 12K enclosures
• Watertight hubs are available in zinc or chrome plated finish
• Gaskets provided
Table 3.53: Watertight Hubs [42]
Watertight Hubs
Conduit
1/2 3/4 1 1-1/4 1-1/2 2 2-1/2 3 3-1/2 4
Size
Standard-
Zinc
Hub Cat. H050 H075 H100 H125 H150 H200 H250 H300 H350 H400
No
Chrome
Plated
Hub Cat. H050CP H075CP H100CP H125CP H150CP H200CP — — — —
No.

3
240 V Double Throw: page 3-24
600 V Double Throw: page 3-25
Application Data: page 3-28
Dimensions, 30–100 A (Series F): page 3-30
Dimensions, 30, 200–600 A (Series E, T4, A): page 3-31

[41] Gaskets are provided on 3 in. and larger hubs.


[42] Gaskets are provided.
3-27
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Double Throw Safety Switches Application Data
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

Application Data for Double Throw Safety Switches


Situations Requiring Fuses
30–100 A Type DT (Series F):
Select DT switches from 240 Volt Double-Throw Safety Switches, page 3-24 and 600
Volt Double Throw Safety Switches, page 3-25 which have provisions for accepting
fuses.

30 A, 200–600 A Type 82,000 (Series E, T4, A), all DTU devices:


Use the non-fusible double throw switches from 240 Volt Double-Throw Safety Switches,
page 3-24 and 600 Volt Double Throw Safety Switches, page 3-25 in conjunction with
standard fusible devices, and install them according to diagram 1 or 2, below.

Table 3.54: UL Listed Short Circuit Current Ratings


Line Short Circuit
Voltage UL Listed
Switch Type Amperes Rating Current Rating [43]
Fuse Class (A)
Line Fus ible 10,000
Type 92000 30 A 240 V H, K
S ingle Throw [44]
Non-Fus ible S witch or Type DT 240 V or H, K  10,000
(Series F) 30–100 A
Double Throw Circuit 600 V R, J 200,000
S witch Bre a ke r  10,000
Type DTU[45] 240 V or H or K [44]
(Series F) 30–100 A
600 V
R, J or T 200,000
Line Non-Fus ible DTU224NRB and
Double DTU324NRB 200 A 240 V H, K  10,000[46]
Loa d (Series E)
Throw
S witch DTU324N H, K  10,000[46]
(Series E) 200 A 240 V
R, J 100,000
Type 82,000 240 V or H, J 10,000[46]
Fus ible S ingle All
Fus ible 600 V
Throw S witch S ingle Throw Type DTU 240 V or H, K 10,000
(Series A) 600 A
or Circuit S witch or 600 V R, J, T 100,000
Bre a ke r Circuit
Bre a ke r

Loa d Line

Dia g ram 1 Dia g ram 2

[43] Rating applies to AC only. The UL Listed short circuit current rating for non-fusible switches is based on the switch being used in conjunction with the corresponding fuse type. Evaluation of
non-fusible switches in conjunction with molded case circuit breakers has not been performed.
[44] Any brand of circuit breaker or fuse not exceeding the ampere rating of the switch may be used ahead of a non-fusible safety switch when there is up to 10 kA short circuit current available.
[45] The DTU361 and DTU361RB are also suitable for use on a circuit capable of delivering not more than
(A) 18 kA, 600 Vac maximum when protected by Type FH circuit breaker rated 30 A maximum or
(B) 14 kA, 600 Vac maximum when protected by Type FA circuit breaker rated 30 A maximum.
[46] Any brand of circuit breaker or fuse not exceeding the ampere rating of the switch may be used ahead of a non-fusible safety switch when there is up to 10 kA short circuit current available.
3-28
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Terminal Lug Data Double Throw Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us

Terminal Lug Data


Table 3.55: Terminal Lug Data for Type DT, DTU (Series F) Double Throw Safety
Switches [47]
NEMA Type 1, 3R, 4, 4X, 12
Switch Wires Wire Range Wire Standard Optional Copper Only
per Optional
Type Bending Space Lug Lug
Phase Per NEC Table 373-6 Wire Range Compression Lug
Field-Installed
AWG/kcmil AWG/kcmil
30–60 A
Type DT, 12–2 Al 12–2 Al C10-14,
DTU 1 or or D8-14-SK, See Table 3.39 Copper
(Series F) 14–2 Cu 14–2 Cu or E6-14 [48] Lug Kits, page 3-18 and
Double Lug Kits, page 3-
100 A 19 for appropriate kit.
Type DT, 12–1/0 Al 12–1/0 Al
1 or or VCEL02114S1[49] Order two kits per switch.
DTU
(Series F) 14–1/0 Cu 14–1/0 Cu

Table 3.56: Terminal Lug Data for Types 82,000 and for A and E-Series DTU
devices [47]
Wire Range Wire Bending
Optional
Amperes Wires per Space Lug Wire Range
Phase Per NEC Table 373-6 AWG/kcmil Compression Lugs
Field-Installed
AWG/kcmil
12–2 Al
30 A (Series T4) 1 14–8 Al/Cu or —

SAFETY SWITCHES
14–2 Cu
200 1 6–300 Al/Cu 6–300 Al/Cu VCEL030516H1[49]
1 1/0–600 Al/Cu 1/0 - 750 Al/Cu
400 or or or —
2 1/0–300 Al/Cu 1/0 - 300 Al/Cu
600 2 250–500 Al/Cu 250–500 Al/Cu —

240 V Double Throw: page 3-24


600 V Double Throw: page 3-25
Accessories: page 3-26
Dimensions, 30–100 A (Series F): page 3-30
Dimensions, 30, 200–600 A (Series E, T4, A): page 3-31

[47] 30-100 A switches suitable for 60° C or 75° C conductors. 200-600 A switches suitable for 75° C conductors.
[48] Order from Thomas and Betts
[49] Hubbell Versa-CrimpTM catalog numbers.
3-29
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Double Throw Safety Switches Dimensions for Double Throw Safety
Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602 schneider-electric.us

Series F Devices 30–100 A


Table 3.57: 30–100 A Type DT, DTU (Series F)—Approximate Dimensions
W H W W/H D
Cat. No. Series
in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm
DT223 F5 38.00 965 9.88 251 11.13 283 6.75 171
DT223RB F5 38.00 965 6.87 174 8.12 206 6.60 168
DT321 F5 38.00 965 10.25 260 11.50 292 6.75 171
DT321RB F5 38.00 965 10.25 260 11.80 300 6.60 168
DT322 F5 38.00 965 10.25 260 11.50 292 6.75 171
DT322RB F5 38.00 965 10.25 260 11.80 300 6.60 168
DT323 F5 38.00 965 9.88 251 11.13 283 6.75 171
DT323RB F5 38.00 965 6.87 174 8.12 206 6.60 168
DT361 F5 38.00 965 10.25 260 11.50 292 6.75 171
H DT361RB F5 38.00 965 10.25 260 11.80 300 6.60 168
DT362 F5 38.00 965 10.25 260 11.50 292 6.75 171
DT362RB F5 38.00 965 10.25 260 11.80 300 6.60 168
DT363 F5 38.00 965 9.88 251 11.13 283 6.75 171
DT363RB F5 38.00 965 6.87 174 8.12 206 6.60 168
DTU222 F5 29.94 760 10.25 260 11.96 304 6.93 176
DTU223 F5 29.94 760 10.25 260 11.96 304 6.93 176
DTU223RB F5 30.50 775 10.25 260 11.96 304 6.93 176
DTU321 F5 29.94 760 10.25 260 11.96 304 6.93 176
DTU322 F5 29.94 760 10.25 260 11.96 304 6.93 176
DTU323 F5 29.94 760 10.25 260 11.96 304 6.93 176
DTU323RB F5 30.50 775 10.25 260 11.96 304 6.93 176
W/H D
DTU361 F5 29.94 760 10.25 260 11.96 304 6.93 176
NEMA Type 1
DTU361RB F5 30.50 775 10.25 260 11.96 304 6.93 176
DTU362 F5 29.94 760 10.25 260 11.96 304 6.93 176
W DTU362AWK F6 29.94 760 10.25 260 11.96 304 6.93 176
DTU362DS F6 30.26 769 10.25 260 11.50 292 7.12 181
DTU362RB F5 30.50 775 10.25 260 11.96 304 6.93 176
DTU363 F5 29.94 760 10.25 260 11.96 304 6.93 176
DTU363AWK F6 29.94 760 10.25 260 11.96 304 6.93 176
DTU363DS F6 30.26 769 10.25 260 11.50 292 7.12 181
DTU363RB F5 30.50 775 10.25 260 11.96 304 6.93 176
DTU462 F5 29.94 760 10.25 260 11.96 304 6.93 176
DTU462AWK F6 30.26 769 15.50 394 16.75 425 7.12 181
DTU462DS F6 30.26 769 15.50 394 16.75 425 7.12 181
DTU463 F5 29.94 760 10.25 260 11.96 304 6.93 176
DTU463AWK F6 30.26 769 15.50 394 16.75 425 7.12 181
H DTU463DS F6 30.26 769 15.50 394 16.75 425 7.12 181
DTU662AWK F6 30.26 769 15.50 394 16.75 425 7.12 181
DTU663AWK F6 30.26 769 15.50 394 16.75 425 7.12 181

240 V Double Throw: page 3-24


600 V Double Throw: page 3-25
Accessories: page 3-26
Application Data: page 3-28
Dimensions, 30, 200–600 A (Series E, T4, A): page 3-31

W/H D
NEMA Type 3R

W/H D

NEMA Type 4, 4X, 5, and 12

3-30
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Dimensions for Double Throw Safety Double Throw Safety Switches
Switches
schneider-electric.us Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
Series A, E, and T4 Devices
Table 3.58: 200–600 A Types 82,000 and E-Series DTU and 30 A devices—
W/H Approximate Dimensions
W D H W W/H D
Cat. No. Series
in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm
DTU224NRB E1 32.50 826 20.63 524 24.00 610 10.63 270
82254 E1 30.88 784 15.75 400 19.63 499  9.75 248
82254NW E1 30.88 784 20.00 508 23.88 607 11.75 298
82344 E2 30.88 784 20.00 508 23.88 607 11.75 298
82344RB E1 32.50 826 20.63 524 24.00 610 10.63 270
82354 E1 30.88 784 20.00 508 23.88 607 11.75 298
92251 T4 10.00 254  8.00 203  9.75 248  4.75 121
H 82344DS E1 30.88 784 20.00 508 23.88 607 11.75 298
DTU324N E1 32.50 826 24.50 622 26.25 667 10.63 270
DTU324NRB E1 32.50 826 24.50 622 26.25 667 10.63 270
H82344 E2 32.50 826 24.50 622 26.25 667 10.63 270
H82444 E2 32.50 826 30.21 767 33.61 854 10.63 270
H82454 E3 32.50 826 30.21 767 33.61 854 10.63 270
82454 E3 38.00 965 29.62 753 33.02 839 10.63 270
82444 E3 38.00 965 29.62 753 33.02 839 10.63 270
NEMA Type 1 82454R E3 38.00 965 29.62 753 33.02 839 10.63 270
82444R E3 38.00 965 29.62 753 33.02 839 10.63 270
H82254 E3 32.50 826 24.50 622 26.25 667 10.63 270
H82354 E3 32.50 826 24.50 622 26.25 667 10.63 270
W/H 82444DS E3 38.00 965 29.62 753 33.02 839 10.63 270
82255 A1 38.50 978 26.10 663 29.51 750 10.63 270
W D 82255R A1 39.00 991 26.62 676 30.02 763 10.63 270
82345 A1 38.50 978 26.10 663 29.51 750 10.63 270
82345DS A1 39.00 991 26.62 676 30.02 763 10.63 270
82345R A1 39.00 991 26.62 676 30.02 763 10.63 270

SAFETY SWITCHES
82355 A1 38.50 978 26.10 663 29.51 750 10.63 270
82355R A1 39.00 991 26.62 676 30.02 763 10.63 270
82445 A1 38.50 978 30.10 765 33.50 851 10.63 270
82445R A1 39.00 991 30.21 767 33.61 854 10.63 270
H 82455 A1 38.50 978 30.10 765 33.50 851 10.63 270
82455R A1 39.00 991 30.21 767 33.61 854 10.63 270
H82255 A1 39.00 991 26.62 676 30.02 763 10.63 270
H82345 A1 39.00 991 26.62 676 30.02 763 10.63 270
H82355 A1 39.00 991 26.62 676 30.02 763 10.63 270
H82445 A1 39.00 991 30.21 767 33.61 854 10.63 270
H82455 A1 39.00 991 30.21 767 33.61 854 10.63 270
DTU326 A1 63.31 1608 23.66 601 24.46 621  8.88 226
DTU—200 A DTU426 A1 63.31 1608 27.00 686 27.80 706  8.88 226
NEMA Type 3R DTU366 A1 63.31 1608 23.66 601 24.46 621  8.88 226
DTU466 A1 63.31 1608 27.00 686 27.80 706  8.88 226
DTU326R A1 63.76 1619 23.66 601 24.46 621  8.88 226
DTU426R A1 63.76 1619 27.00 686 27.80 706  8.88 226
DTU366R A1 63.76 1619 23.66 601 24.46 621  8.88 226
DTU466R A1 63.76 1619 27.00 686 27.80 706  8.88 226
DTU366AWK A1 63.76 1619 23.66 601 24.46 621  8.88 226

3
240 V Double Throw: page 3-24
600 V Double Throw: page 3-25
Accessories: page 3-26
Application Data: page 3-28
Dimensions, 30–100 A (Series F): page 3-30

3-31
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Photovoltaic Disconnect Switches 1000 Vdc Photovoltaic Heavy Duty
Disconnect Switch
Class 3110 schneider-electric.us

1000 Vdc Photovoltaic Heavy Duty Disconnect Switch


Put over 100 years of Schneider Electric’s experience as a global specialist in energy
management to work on your photovoltaic (PV) project. The Square D 1000 Vdc
disconnect switch is the perfect solution for your 1000 Vdc, PV disconnect applications. It
is compact and available in both a 100 and 200 amp non-fusible versions. IEC 60947-1
and UL 98 certified (file E343341).

Extended Life Expectancy


• Exceeds IEC 60947-3 mechanical endurance requirements by factor of 18
• Exceeds IEC 60947-1 electrical endurance requirements by factor of 10
• Exceeds NEMA KS-1 mechanical endurance requirements by factor of 3.

Designed for Harsh PV Easy to Install


Environments
• NEMA Type 3 and IP63 enclosure • Preconfigured solar solution
3

• Resists windblown dirt/dust • Familiar enclosed safety switch


• Exceeds NEMA Type 1, 3R and 12 design
• Operating range of -37°C to 50°C • Suitable for both grounded and
• Specially designed PV paint reduces solar gain ungrounded PV
up to 35% over standard grey enclosures

Table 3.59: 1000 Vdc Photovoltaic Heavy Duty Disconnect Switches [1] [2] [3] [4]
SAFETY SWITCHES

NEMA Type 1, 3R, 12, 3 Dimensions


System and IP63 Height Width Depth
Amperes Cat. No. (in.) (in.) (in.)
3 Pole Grounded [5]

100 REHU393IP 22.13 18.63 8.75

200 REHU394IP 22.13 18.63 8.75

4 Pole Ungrounded

100 REHU493IP 29.00 18.63 8.75

200 REHU494IP 29.00 18.63 8.75

Table 3.60: 200 A Enclosed Switch—Approximate Dimensions


H W D
Switch
in. mm in. mm in. mm
100 A 21.75 552 18.86 479  8.75 197
200 A 29.00 737 18.86 479  8.75 197

200 A Enclosed Switch Dimensions

[1] Order EIK1PV for single contact field-installed kit.


[2] Order EIK2PV for double contact field-installed kit.
[3] Terminal block accommodates (2) 250 max Cu or (1) 1/0 max Cu wiring; Order SN20CPV for field-installed kit.
[4] Order REHGNDKIT for field installable ground lug kit.
[5] Terminal blocks standard with 3 pole switches; accommodates (2) 1/0 max Al/Cu or (2) 6 max Al/Cu wiring.
3-32
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents

Section 4
Power Monitoring and Control
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Management Systems 4-2

Power Monitoring Software 4-4


StruxureWare Power Monitoring Expert Software 4-4
StruxureWare PowerSCADA Expert 4-6
Power Quality Meters — ION8650 4-7
ION8650 Power and Energy Meters 4-7
ION7550 and ION7650 Power and Energy Meters 4-8
S truxure Wa re P owe r Monitoring
Exp e rt S oftwa re
Series 4000 Circuit Monitor 4-9
PowerLogic ION7400 Utility Feeder Meter 4-10
PowerLogic PM8000 Power and Energy Meters 4-11
Power Quality Meter Selection 4-12
Power and Energy Meters — PM5000 Series 4-14
Series 5000 Power Meters 4-14
ION8650
ION6200 Power and Energy Meter 4-14
ION7550 a nd ION7650 Series 3500 Energy and Power Meter 4-15
P owe r a nd P owe r a nd
Ene rgy Me te rs Ene rgy Me te rs PowerLogic PM3000 Power and Energy Meters 4-16
iEM3000 Energy Meters 4-17
Power and Energy Meter Selection 4-19
PowerLogic Energy Meter 4-20
PowerLogic EM4200 Enercept Meter 4-20
PowerLogic Enercept™ Meter 4-21
Multi Circuit Energy Meters 4-22
P owe rLogic P M8000 PowerLogic Branch Circuit Power Meter 4-23
P owe r a nd CM400T with PowerLogic Multi-Circuit Meter 4-26

POWER MONITORING AND


Ene rgy Me te rs VFD Dis pla y PowerLogic Submeter Display 4-26
Communications 4-27
Com’X Data Loggers and Energy Servers 4-27

CONTROL
Link150 Ethernet Gateway 4-28
Engineering Services 4-29
Integration and Equipment 4-31
System Integration 4-31
Com’X Da ta Logge rs Ethe rne t Ga te wa ys Factory Assembled Equipment 4-31
a nd Ene rgy S e rve rs PowerLogic High Density Metering 4-33
Support Services 4-34
Sepam Digital Protective Relays 4-35

Arc Flash Protection and Mitigation Systems 4-37

4
Va mp 321 Arc Fla s h
S e pa m S e rie s 80 Pro te ction a nd Mitiga tion ReactiVar™ 4-39

Reactive Power Compensation and Harmonic Mitigation 4-39


Low Voltage Fixed Capacitors 4-40
LV Standard Automatic Capacitor Banks 4-41
LV Anti-Resonant and Filtering Automatic Capacitor Banks 4-41
Current Transformer Selection Information 4-42
LV Transient Free Reactive Compensation Capacitor Banks 4-42
Medium Voltage Fixed Capacitors 4-43
Medium Voltage Metal Enclosed Capacitor Systems 4-44
High Voltage Reactive Power Compensation Systems 4-44
AccuSine™ 4-45
Re a ctiVa r Low Volta ge Accu S ine Accu S ine
Automa tic Ca pa citor Ba nk P CS + P FV+ PCS+ Active Harmonic Filter 4-45
PFV+ Active Harmonic Filter 4-46
Current Transformers 4-47
Hybrid VAR Compensator (HVC) 4-48
VarSet Low-Voltage Capacitor Banks 4-49

Va rS e t Low-Volta ge Ca pa citor Ba nks

© 2017 Schneider Electric


All Rights Reserved 4-1

11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Introduction
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

Join the Next Generation of Power and Energy Management


More performance. More intelligence. More integration.
Our industry-leading systems offer the latest in technological advancements to help you
simultaneously maximize reliability, availability, and quality, as well as improve
operational and cost efficiency for your entire enterprise. You’ll benefit from:
• Holistic approach
Our solutions aggregate data from all your energy assets, including power, building,
and process systems, into one user-friendly view so you can make more informed
decisions and address problems efficiently.
• Actionable intelligence
Our solutions provide real-time and historical information to multiple stakeholders
anywhere in the world, including easy-to-use analytics, alarms and controls, as well as
regulatory compliance and financial reporting.
• Proactive capabilities
Our sophisticated products help you analyze and identify future needs so you can
develop a long-term plan for things like energy purchasing, demand response, load
changes, and equipment maintenance or replacement.

Advanced Power Management Sup erior Energy Management


Delivers power quality, availability, and reliability Delivers cost and operational efficiencies
4

Don’t settle for fragmented views and unreliable data


POWER MONITORING AND

Maximize performance with a fully integrated power management solution


You’ll benefit from our decades of expertise in electrical system management, hardware
and software development, and integration. Our solutions are designed for compatibility
CONTROL

so your installation is both optimized and more efficient. Our systems are modular and
interoperable for better continuity of supply, enhanced safety for people and equipment,
and more effective monitoring and control. Plus, our full range of in-person and remote
services keep your system operating at peak performance.

4-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Introduction PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

Application
Data Presentment & Management Data Acquisition, Alarms & Monitoring
Online Energy Supervisory Control & Power Monitoring System Tenant Submetering
Enterprise Analysis Data Acquisition
Data Centers; Water/Wastewater, Heavy Industrial, large Commercial Buildings,
Industrial Buildings, Property Utilities Process Industry, Data commercial buildings, Government Buildings,
Management, Utilities Centers, Critical Power Military Bases, Healthcare Military Bases
Meter Application
Automatic Meter Reading • •••• ••
Revenue Metering • •••• ••
WAGES Utility Pulses •••
Sub-billing ••• ••• ••••
Measurement &
Verification •••• •• •••
Cost Allocation & Utility Billing
Energy Usage Analysis •••• ••• • •• •
Cost Procurement Optimization •• ••• • •
Management
Allocate Energy Costs • •
Interval Benchmarking &
Profiling •••• ••• • ••
Total Load Aggregation ••••
Energy Efficiency
Emissions Tracking •• •••
Power Factor Correction • • •••
Peak Demand Reduction •• • ••• •••
Demand Response &
Curtailment ••• •••
Improve Maintenance Practices
Commissioning &
Troubleshooting ••• ••••
Equipment Monitoring:
transformers, MCCs,
switchgear, switchboards,
circuit breaker status,
protective equipment, ••• ••••
capacitors, generators,
panelboards, PDU, UPS,
etc.

POWER MONITORING AND


Ensure Facility Planning
Power
Quality Identify Equipment
Capacity •••
Determine Transformer

CONTROL
Stress •••
Equipment Asset
Optimization •• •• •••
Improve Efficiency
Balance Circuit Loading •••
Balance Generator Usage •••
Optimize Chiller &
Mechanical Equipment •
System Monitoring & Analysis
Transient Voltage
Detection ••••
Sag/Swell Disturbance
Monitoring ••••
Power Quality & Harmonic
••••

4
Analysis
Network
Management Power Quality
Compliance •••• • •••
Alarm & System Diagnositics
Electrical Distribution
Alarm & Event Analysis • ••• ••••
Waveform capture
viewing ••••
Remote alarm notification •••• •••
Energy Services
see Engineering
Total Energy Control
Services •••• Services, page •••
4-29
Peak Shaving/Generator see Engineering
Control •••• ••
Services, page 4-29
Load Management/ see Engineering Services, page 4-29
Shedding •••• ••
WAGES •••
Advanced Reliability Services
Auto Throw Over (ATO) •••• ••
Engineering Emergency Power Supply
System Test Reporting ••••
Services
Sequence of Events
Recording (1ms time/ see Engineering Services, page 4-29 •••• ••• see Engineering
stamp) Services, page 4-29
GPS Time Stamping •••• •••
Power System Control •••• •
Network Protection •••• ••
Consulting Services
System Studies (SC/TCC/
Arc Flash)
see Engineering Services, page 4-29
Power System
Assessments

4-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Power Monitoring Software
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

StruxureWare Power Monitoring Expert Software


StruxureWare Power Monitoring Expert
StruxureWare™ Power Monitoring Expert is an integrated power & energy management
software platform that enables you to optimize your power distribution infrastructure,
maximize operational efficiency, and improve your bottom-line performance. This
complete, interoperable, and scalable solution will help you
• Maximize facility uptime and reliability
• Analyze and mitigate power quality related issues
• Track and optimize equipment performance
• Analyze energy consumption, uncover savings opportunities and accurately allocate
energy related costs
• Enable
ISO50001
compliance with power quality and energy standards such as ANSI/IEEE and

Typical Applications
• Manage power quality, availability, and reliability
• Optimize use of your electrical and infrastructure • Monitor the facility electrical network to verify reliable operation and proactively
optimize performance
assets
• Drive energy efficiency initiatives and improve • Maximize facility uptime by improving response to power-related events and restore
operations quickly
financial performance
• Perform root cause analysis to power-related disturbances through sequence of
events reporting
• Analyze and isolate the source of power quality problems
• Analyze total energy use from all electrical and piped utilities identify waste and
reduce cost
• Improve sustainability performance with greenhouse gas emissions tracking and
industry compliance reporting
• Identify billing discrepancies and avoid contract penalties by validating utility bills to
4

verify accuracy
• Allocate energy costs to departments to drive accountability, awareness and support
energy action programs like ISO50001
• Reduce peak demand and power factor penalties with monitoring, alerts, and
corrective actions
POWER MONITORING AND

• Negotiate
programs
rates with energy suppliers and enable participation in demand response

• Confirm return on investment for infrastructure improvements with advanced reporting


and analysis
CONTROL

• Optimize existing infrastructure capacity and avoid over-building


• Prolong asset life with proactive maintenance and optimization
Functional Components:
• Power quality analytics
– Monitor events and waveform plotting system-wide
– Monitor harmonics, K-factor, crest factor, symmetrical components
– Diagnose and isolate PQ problems to increase reliability
– Automatically detect and report on voltage disturbances
– Quickly evaluate PQ events plotted on standard ITIC curve
• Customized real-time monitoring
– Access real-time status of sensitive power distribution components
– Trend chart tools with customized views to reveal patterns and anomalies quickly

• Data analytics and visualization


– Smart dashboards with configurable presentation widgets and kiosk options
– Powerful graphics templates and libraries
Modular Design: – Automated power quality reports and waveform analysis tools
Power Monitoring Expert also features many
application modules that add specific functionality to – Comprehensive templates for energy and power reporting, with flexible report
extend the base platform. Available modules include distribution options
• Energy Analysis • Alarm and event management
• UPS Performance – Powerful alarm triggering, notification, and analysis tools
• Breaker Performance – Accurate time-stamped sequence of events reporting for power system event root
• Energy Cost Allocation & Billing cause analyses
• Automated Generator Testing • Robust technical infrastructure
– Solid data acquisition architecture including ready-to-use communications drivers
with many electrical distribution devices
– Fully compatible with current operating systems and databases
– Interoperable with integration to other systems and devices through open data and
protocol standards (ODBC, OPC, XML, Modbus, Web/SOAP Services)
– Scalable to thousands of metered points through flexible deployment options

4-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power Monitoring Software PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

Segment Editions:
Power Monitoring Expert also features segment-specific solutions for data centers,
healthcare, industry and buildings, delivering pre-engineered functionality customized to
meet your needs.

StruxureWare Power Monitoring StruxureWare Power Monitoring StruxureWare Power Monitoring


Expert Data Center Edition Expert Data Healthcare Edition Expert Data Buildings Edition
• Decrease the number and duration of
unplanned outages
• Improve energy availability • Ensure electrical system health
• Manage power system reliability • Optimize operational efficiency
• Manage power capacity and reduncancy • Perform power quality analysis and • Gain energy insight
• Improve
activities
effectiveness of maintenance management • Improve energy accountability
• Support energy efficiency initiatives to
• Improve power distribution efficiency improve financial performance
• Support energy cost allocation and billing
Description Catalog Number
Power Monitoring Expert Standard Edition BASE license (includes 1 Engineering
Client) PSWSANCZZSPEZZ
Power Monitoring Expert Data Center Edition BASE license (includes 1 Engineering
Client) PSWSDNCZZSPEZZ

POWER MONITORING AND


Power Monitoring Expert Healthcare Edition BASE license (includes 1 Engineering
Client) PSWSHNCZZSPEZZ
Power Monitoring Expert Buildings Edition BASE license (includes 1 Engineering
Client) PSWSBNCZZSPEZZ

CONTROL
5 Device Pack for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWDANCZZNPEZZ
25 Device Pack for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWDBNCZZNPEZZ
50 Device Pack for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWDCNCZZNPEZZ
100 Device Pack for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWDDNCZZNPEZZ
200 Device Pack for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWDFNCZZNPEZZ
Unlimited Devices for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWDZNCZZSPEZZ
Engineering Client for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWCENCZZNPEZZ
Web Client for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWCWNCZZNPEZZ
Unlimited Engineering and Web Clients for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWCZNCZZSPEZZ
Event Notification Module for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWMVNCZZSPEZZ
Cost Allocation & Billing Module for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWMBNCZZSPEZZ
Breaker Performance Module for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWMXNCZZSPEZZ
Energy Analysis Module for Power Monitoring Expert software

4
PSWMZNCZZSPEZZ
Energy Awareness Module for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWMYNCZZSPEZZ
UPS Performance Module for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWMUNCZZSPEZZ
EPSS Module for Power Monitoring Expert software (HealthCare) PSWMENCZZSPEZZ
Generator Performance Module for Power Monitoring Expert software (Data
Centers) PSWMGNCZZSPEZZ
IT Billing Module for Power Monitoring Expert software (Data Centers) PSWMTNCZZSPEZZ
Power Capacity Module for Power Monitoring Expert software (Data Centers) PSWMPNCZZSPEZZ
Power Efficiency Module for Power Monitoring Expert software (Data Centers) PSWMNNCZZSPEZZ
SQL Server 2012 License - 2 COREs IE7SQLCZSNPEZZ

4-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Power Monitoring Software
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

StruxureWare PowerSCADA Expert


• Increase uptime of power systems
• Provides accurate and actionable information in real time
• Highlights issues, remediation, and their impacts
StruxureWare™ PowerSCADA Expert is electrical distribution network monitoring and
control software that provides vital tools to enhance your power system reliability and
operational efficiency. Its powerful architecture combines our proven expertise in
electrical distribution with the speed and control of high-performance SCADA to reduce
outages while increasing power system efficiency. An excellent fit for virtually every
industry and application, PowerSCADA Expert delivers exceptional scalability so that it
can grow to match your changing business requirements while driving down the total
cost of ownership. Components interact seamlessly across Schneider Electric’s
extensive product portfolio and third party suppliers.
• Dynamic electrical network view to improve production, reduce costs and boost safety
• Highly reliable monitoring and control tailored to unique electrical network needs
• Detailed electrical information across the multi-vendor network
• Fast issue resolution and reporting to improve electrical network quality and energy
use
• Report KPIs, energy costs, and filtered alarming
• Real-time visualization of the network
• Disturbance waveform views for analysis and control for remediation
For quoting and pricing, please contact PowerLogic Sales at 615-287-3535.
PowerLogic ION EEM Software
PowerLogic™ ION EEM is a complete Enterprise Energy and Sustainability
Management System (EESMS) to provide energy data warehousing capabilities,
integrating data from multiple sites and disparate systems. For example, the EESMS will
be capable of integrating data from building and process systems, power management
systems, energy billing and pricing systems, business and accounting systems, weather
services, spot-market energy pricing feeds etc. to facilitate green economic policies
(such as reducing CO2 emissions), energy conservation measures, or sustainability
targets.
Personalized dashboards help management and operations
Typical applications:
personnel monitor all aspects of energy use
• Display visually rich energy intelligence dashboards to drive energy behavior change.
• Allocate costs and usage across facilities, departments, and other organizational units.
• Benchmark, measure and verify energy key performance indicators for performance
versus target.
• Track and manage environmental impact carbon/GHG emissions and carbon
inventories (by source, scope and pollutant), using appropriate global emission
factors.
• Reduce peak demand surcharges and power factor penalties.
• Identify billing discrepancies.
• Model energy accurately using statistical regression techniques.
• Forecast energy needs and compare rates for efficient procurement.
• Facilitate participation in load curtailment programs.
Produce aggregate billing, load profile, cost allocation, • Track performance of energy and sustainability programs, and assess cumulative
savings and return on investments.
power quality, forecasting or budget reports to help
inform stakeholders and track results against goals. • Manage energy and sustainability projects and scenarios and assess potential
financial impact prior to implementation.
• Store and manage energy invoices in a central repository.
Key features:
• True enterprise-level software architecture: data quality assurance, data warehouse,
web framework
• Web portal: personalized dashboards, key performance indicators, charts, trends,
real-time conditions
• Reporting: rich and customized content, support for complex data and graphics,
scheduled distribution
• Trending: advanced visualization, dimensional analysis, prediction, statistical rollups
• Modeling: regression analysis, normalization, correlation, integration of all relevant
drivers and contextual data
• Billing: built-in rate engine and rate wizard
• Power quality analysis: wide-area event monitoring, classification, filtering, correlation
• Alarms and events: triggering on complex conditions, notification, logging
• Integration: data acquisition systems, weather and pricing feeds, other enterprise
applications (e.g. BAC, ERP)
• Greenhouse Gas Emissions (CO2) Reporting
For quoting and pricing, please contact PowerLogic Sales at 615-287-3535.

4-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power Quality Meters — ION8650 PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

ION8650 Power and Energy Meters


The web-enabled PowerLogic ION8650 is used to monitor electric distribution networks,
service entrances and substations. It enables businesses to manage complex energy
supply contracts that include power quality guarantees. Low-range current accuracy
makes it ideal for independent power producers and cogeneration applications that
require the accurate bi-directional measurement of energy. It is well suited to load
curtailment, equipment monitoring and control and energy pulsing and totalization
applications. Integrate it with Power Management Software applications.
ION8650 Power and Energy Meter Features
Feature set C includes:
• 9S, 35S, 36S socket and switchboard cases
• True RMS 3-phase voltage, current, power and meets stringent ANSI revenue
metering standards including ANSI C12.20 0.2 and Class 2, 10, & 20
• Power quality: sag/swell, individual, even, odd, total harmonics to the 31st and
symmetrical components
• 32MB log/event memory, min/max for any parameter, historical logs up to 80 channels,
timestamp resolution to 0.001 seconds and GPS time synchronization
• Transformer/line loss compensation and Instrument transformer correction
• Communications: Ethernet, Serial, Modem, Internet and Ethernet to serial gateway
and ION, DNP 3.0, Modbus RTU, Modbus TCP, MV-90 protocols, IEC 61850
• Cuser
model limited to IR + 2 other ports at one time. Ports can be enabled/disabled by

• Dial-out capability when memory is near full


• Multi-user, multi-level security with control and customized access to sensitive data for
up to 50 users
• Data push capability through SMTP (email)
• 65 setpoints — math, logic, trig, log, linearization formulas
• Password protection and anti-tamper seal protection
• Built-in I/O: 4 KYZ digital outs and 3 form A digital ins, 4 KYZ digital outs and 1 form A

POWER MONITORING AND


digital out and 1 form A digital in, an optional external I/O expander provides additional
I/O
Feature set B adds the following to feature set C:

CONTROL
• Harmonics—individual, total even, total odd up to the 63rd
• 64MB standard memory
• Historical logs up to 320 channels
• Modbus RTU Master on serial ports
• Cycle setpoint minimum response time
Feature set A adds the following to feature sets C and B:
• Waveform capture up to 1024 samples/cycle, PQ compliance monitoring, flicker to
EN50160 Ed2, IEC 61000-4-7/4-15 (also configurable to IEEE519 2014, IEEE159,
SEMI) CBEMA/ITIC
• Transient detection to 6517µs at 60Hz;
• Harmonics: magnitude, phase and inter-harmonics to the 50th

4
• 128MB standard memory
• Max 96 cycles of waveform logs and 800 channels of historical logs
Table 4.1: Typical PowerLogic ION8650 Power and Energy Meter Ordering
Configurations
Description Catalog No.
ION8650, feature set A, 9S socket base, 5 A nominal current inputs,
10MB memory, 127–177 Vac, 60 Hz, communications card with:
10BaseT, RS-232/485, RS-485, Optical port, 4 Digital Outputs, 3 Digital S8650A0C0E6E1B0A
Inputs
ION8650, feature set A, 35S socket base, 5 A nominal current inputs,
10MB memory, 120–480 Vac, 60 Hz, communications card with:
10Base T, RS-232/485, RS-485, Optical port, 4 Digital Outputs, 3 S8650A1C0E6E1B0A
Digital Inputs
ION8650, feature set C, 9S socket base, 5 A nominal current inputs,
2MB memory, 120–277 Vac, 60 Hz, communications card with: RS-232/ S8650C0C0E6A0B0A
485, RS-485, Optical port, 4 Digital Outputs, 3 Digital Inputs
ION8650, feature set C, 35S socket base, 5 A nominal current inputs,
2MB memory, 120–277 Vac, 60 Hz, communications card with: RS-232/ S8650C1C0E6A0B0A
485, RS-485, Optical port, 4 Digital Outputs, 3 Digital Inputs

4-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Power Quality Meters — ION7550 / ION7650
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

ION7550 and ION7650 Power and Energy Meters


Used at key distribution points and sensitive loads, the web-enabled PowerLogic
ION7550 and PowerLogic ION7650 meters combine a wealth of advanced features from
power quality analysis capabilities, revenue accuracy and multiple communications
options, through web compatibility, and control capabilities. Both are compatible with
PowerLogic Power Management Software applications and can be integrated with other
energy management or building control systems through multiple communication
channels and protocols.
The meters are ideal for compliance monitoring, disturbance analysis, cost allocation
and billing, demand and power factor control and equipment monitoring and control. The
meters have a high visibility, adjustable front panel display that can depict TOU,
harmonics, event logs, phasers, and instantaneous power parameters. They meet
stringent ANSI C12.20 0.2, Class 10 & 20 revenue metering standards.
PowerLogic ION7550 and ION7650 Power and Energy Meter Features:
• 3.5” x 4.5” (87 x 112 mm) backlit LCD display
• True RMS 3-phase voltage, current, and power that meets stringent ANSI C12.20 0.2,
Class 2, 10, & 20
• Power quality: sag/swell, harmonics - individual, even, odd, total to the 63rd, waveform
capture at 256 samples/cycle
• 5MB log/event memory (10MB optional), waveform logging up to 96 cycles, up to 800
channels historical, min/max, timestamp resolution to 0.001 seconds, GPS time
synchronization and historical trends through front panel
• Communications: fiber, Ethernet, serial, internal modem, optical port, and a gateway
functionality, ION, DNP 3.0, Modbus RTU - master & slave, Modbus TCP, MV-90, and
IEC 61850. IEC 61850 only available with Ethernet options
• Dial-out capability when memory is near full
• Data push capability through SMTP (email)
• Multi-user, multi-level security with control and customized access to sensitive data for
4

up to 16 users
• 65 configurable 1/2 cycle setpoints for single, multi-condition and dial out on alarm and
math, logic, trig, log, linearization formulas
• Password protection and anti-tamper seal protection enhance meter security
• Extensive standard I/O includes: 8 digital inputs, 4 digital outputs and 3 onboard relays
POWER MONITORING AND

• Disturbance direction detection determines disturbance location and direction relative


to the meter.
• Alarm setpoint learning analyzes the circuit and recommends optimum alarm setpoints
CONTROL

to minimize nuisance or missed alarms.


• Customize metering or analysis functions at your work station, without hard wiring via
ION Frameworks technology.
The ION7650 has all the features of the ION7550 and adds:
• Waveform capture up to 1024 samples/cycle
• Transient detection to 17µs at 60Hz
• Harmonics: magnitude, phase and inter-harmonics to the 40th
• Flicker to EN50160 and IEC 61000-4-7/4-15 (also configurable for IEEE 519-1992,
IEEE159, SEMI), plus CBEMA/ITIC
• Symmetrical components
• Power quality measurements per IEC 61000-4-30 Class A, Ed. 2
Table 4.2: Typical PowerLogic ION7550/7650 Power and Energy Meter Ordering Configurations
Description Catalog No.
Typical PowerLogic ION7550 Power and Energy Meter Ordering Configurations
Integrated display, with 256 samples/cycle, 5 MB logging memory, 5 A inputs, standard power supply, standard comms. (1 RS232/RS485 port, 1
RS485, 1 Type 2 optical port) plus Ethernet, standard I/O S7550A0C0B6E0A0A
Integrated display, with 256 samples/cycle, 5 MB logging memory, 5 A inputs, standard power supply, standard comms. (1 RS232/RS485 port, 1
RS485, 1 Type 2 optical port), standard I/O S7550A0C0B6A0A0A
Typical PowerLogic ION7650 Power and Energy Meter Ordering Configurations
Integrated display, with 1024 samples/cycle, 10 MB logging memory, 5 A inputs, standard power supply, standard comms. (1 RS232/RS485 port, 1
RS485, 1 Type 2 optical port) plus Ethernet, standard I/O, EN50160 compliance monitoring S7650B1C0B6E0A0E
Integrated display, with 512 samples/cycle, 5 MB logging memory, 5 A inputs, standard power supply, standard comms. (1 RS232/RS485 port, 1
RS485, 1 Type 2 optical port) plus Ethernet, standard I/O S7650A0C0B6E0A0A
Integrated display, with 512 samples/cycle, 5 MB logging memory, 5 A inputs, standard power supply, standard comms. (1 RS232/RS485 port, 1
RS485, 1 Type 2 optical port) plus Ethernet and 56k modem, standard I/O S7650A0C0B6C1A0A
Integrated display, with 512 samples/cycle, 5 MB logging memory, 5 A inputs, standard power supply, standard comms. (1 RS232/RS485 port, 1
RS485, 1 Type 2 optical port), standard I/O S7650A0C0B6A0A0A
Integrated display, with 1024 samples/cycle, 10 MB logging memory, 5 A inputs, standard power supply, standard comms. (1 RS232/RS485 port, 1
RS485, 1 Type 2 optical port) plus Ethernet, standard I/O S7650B1C0B6E0A0A

NOTE: Please refer to www.schneider-electric.us for the most complete and up-to-
date list of feature availability. Some features are optional.

4-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power Quality Meters — CM4000T PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

Series 4000 Circuit Monitor


The award winning, Web-enabled PowerLogic Series 4000 Circuit Monitor (CM4000T) is
the most advanced permanently mounted circuit monitor in the industry today. Designed
for critical power and large energy users who cannot afford to be shut down, the
CM4000T provides the ability to monitor, troubleshoot and preempt power quality
problems. Transients (disturbances lasting less than one cycle) are particularly difficult to
detect, due to their short duration. The CM4000T detects and captures oscillatory and
impulsive transients (up to 10,000V peak, line-to-line at 5 MHz per channel) as short as
one microsecond in duration. The CM4000T automatically performs a high-speed
transient waveform capture and a longer disturbance capture to show the conditions
surrounding an event. The CM4000T maintains a complete historical record of the
number of transients per phase, along with the magnitude, duration and time of
occurrence of each. It also performs a stress calculation to determine the circuits that
have received the greatest stress from transient overvoltages.
• Waveform capture with up to 512 samples/cycle
• Built-in Trending and Forecasting functionality allows you to forecast energy usage up
to 4 days in advance
CM4000T with VFD Display
• Sag/Swell disturbance monitoring
• Two option card slots for field installable cards
• Optional field installable Ethernet communications card with standard and custom web
pages
• Alarm Setpoint Learning feature allowing optimum threshold setting (patent pending)
• Multiple alarms: standard, digital, Boolean, high-speed, and disturbance alarms
• Waveshape alarm monitoring
• High speed transient voltage detection at 5 MHz per channel with field installable
CVMT current/voltage module
• True RMS Metering through the 255th harmonic
• Extended waveform capture (up to 110 seconds)
• Field installable Digital/Analog I/O cards and flexible I/O extender modules
• Harmonic powerflows up to the 40th harmonic

POWER MONITORING AND


• Standard KYZ pulse output
• Standard 32 MB of non-volatile memory
• Integrated power quality standards including EN50160, IEC 61000-4-15 (Flicker)

CONTROL
• Sequence of events recording using GPS synchronization technology
• Oscillatory transient detection and recording
• UL Listed, CSA Approved, NOM Approved, FCC compliant
PowerLogic Series 4000 Circuit Monitor Optional Displays
• High visibility remote VF (vacuum fluorescence) display
• Displays metering data, min/max values, alarms, inputs
• Remote LC (liquid crystal) display with backlighting also available
• Optional user configurable display screens
Table 4.3: Series 4000 Circuit Monitors
Description Catalog No.

4
Series 4000 Circuit Monitors
Instrumentation, On-board Data Logging, Waveform Capture, Disturbance Recording, Configurable
I/O, 0.04% Accuracy, Impulsive Transient Detection and Flicker (IEC 61000-4-15) CM4000T
Series 4000 Circuit Monitor Accessories
Field installable I/O card with 3 relay outputs, 1 pulse output (KYZ) and 4 status inputs IOC44
I/O Extender module with 4 DC status inputs, 2 DC digital outputs, 1 analog input and 1 analog
output IOX2411
I/O Extender module with 4 status inputs and 4 analog inputs (4–20 mA) IOX0404
I/O Extender module with 8 status inputs IOX08
I/O Extender module with no pre-installed I/O [1] IOX
Ethernet Communications Card; 100 MB Fiber or 10/100 MB UTP Ethernet port and 1 RS-485
master port ECC21
Current/Voltage module with high speed transient detection CVMT
4-line x 20—character liquid crystal display with backlighting CMDLC
ECC21 IOC44 I/O Card
4-line x 20—character vacuum fluorescent display with proximity sensor CMDVF
4 foot display cable CAB4
12 foot display cable CAB12
30 foot display cable CAB30

Table 4.4: SER Time Synchronization


Description Catalog No.
PowerLogic Satellite Time System, Circuit Monitor and SEPAM GPS Time Synchronization, 100 microsecond accuracy STS3000
Satellite Time Reference Module STRM
CyTime Sequence of Events Recorder, 24 Vdc power / 24 Vdc inputs, 32 inputs, web server 9788SER3200
SER 3200 EZ connector for IRIG-B signal 9788EZCIRIGB
Smart Antenna Module SAM
Smart Antenna Module Interface Cable—200 FT SAIF200
Power Supply, 24DC/50W, DIN-mountable PS080

[1] Contact your nearest Square D/Schneider Electric sales office for additional I/O options.
4-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Power Quality Meters — ION7400
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

PowerLogic ION7400 Utility Feeder Meter


The PowerLogic ION7400 utility feeder meter is a highly accurate, extremely reliable
power and energy meter with unmatched flexibility and usability. The meter combines
accurate 3-phase energy and power measurements with data logging, power quality
analysis, alarming and I/O capabilities not typically available in such a compact meter.
The panel or DIN mounted ION7400 meter is flexible enough to fit into a utility’s existing
billing or SCADA system, providing industry leading cost management (Class 0.2) and
network management (Class S PQ) data. It is compliant with stringent international
standards that guarantee their metering accuracy and power quality measurements.
Ideal for installations that are responsible for maintaining the operation and profitability of
a facility.

PowerLogic ION7400
Applications and benefits
• Maximize profits by providing the highest output
possible with the least amount of risk to
availability.
• Optimize availability and reliability of electrical
systems and equipment.
• Monitor power quality (PQ) for compliance and to
prevent problems.
• Meters fully supported by StruxureWare Power
Monitoring Expert and PowerSCADA Expert
Software.
Main Characteristics
• Precision metering
• PQ compliance reporting and basic PQ analysis
• Used with StruxureWare Power Monitoring Expert
software, provides detailed PQ reporting across
entire network
• Onboard data and event logging
• Alarming and control
• Excellent quality: ISO 9001 and ISO 14000
certified manufacturing.
Table 4.5: PowerLogic ION7400 Meters
Description Catalog Number
ION7400 Panel mount meter
(integrated display with optical METSEION7400
port and 2 energy pulse LEDs)
DIN rail mount - utility meter base METSEION7403

Table 4.6: PowerLogic ION7400 Accessories


Description Catalog Number
Remote display, 3 metre cable,
mounting hardware for 30mm
hole (nut & centering pin), METSEPM89RD96
mounting hardware for DIN96
cutout (92x92mm) adapter plate
Digital I/O module (6 digital inputs
& 2 relay outputs) METSEPM89M2600
Analog I/O module (4 analog
inputs & 2 analog outputs) METSEPM89M0024
Display Cable, 10 meters METSECAB10

4-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power Quality Meters — PM8000 PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

Table 4.7: PowerLogic ION7400 Features


Description ION7400
General
Use on LV and MV systems ■
Current accuracy (5A Nominal) 0.1 % reading
Voltage accuracy (90-690 V AC L-L, 50, 60, 400 Hz) 0.1 % reading
Active energy accuracy 0.2 %
Number of samples/cycle or sample frequency 256
PowerLogic ION7400 PowerLogic ION7400
showing active with harmonics PowerLogic ION7400 Instantaneous rms values
alarms. display. with phasor display. Current, voltage, frequency ■
Active, reactive, apparent power Total and per phase ■
Power factor Total and per phase ■
Current measurement range (autoranging) 0.05 - 10A
Energy values
Active, reactive, apparent energy ■
Settable accumulation modes ■
Demand values
Current Present and max. values ■
Active, reactive, apparent power Present and max. values ■
Predicted active, reactive, apparent power ■
Synchronisation of the measurement window ■
Setting of calculation mode Block, sliding ■
Power quality measurements
Harmonic distortion Current and voltage ■
Via front panel and web page 63
Individual harmonics
Via StruxurWare software 127
Waveform capture ■
Detection of voltage swells and sags ■
Flicker ■
Fast acquistion 1/2 cycle data ■
EN 50160 compliance checking ■
Customizable data outputs (using logic and math functions) ■
Data recording
Min/max of instantaneous values ■

POWER MONITORING AND


Data logs ■
Event logs ■
Trending/forecasting ■
SER (Sequence of event recording) ■

CONTROL
Time stamping ■
GPS synchronization (+/- 1 ms) ■
Memory (in Mbytes) 512
10 MB for Frameworks
Display and I/O
Front panel display 89 mm (3.5 in.) TFT ■
Wiring self-test ■
Pulse output 1
Digital 6 in / 2 out
Analogue 4 in / 2 out
1 digital
Digital or analogue outputs (max, including pulse output) 8 relay
8 analog
Communication

4
RS 485 port 1
10/100BaseTX 2
Serial port (Modbus, ION, DNP3) ■
Ethernet port (Modbus/TCP, ION TCP, DNP3 TCP, IEC 61850 [2]) ■
ANSI C12.19 Optical port ■
Standards
IEC 61000-4-30, IEC 61000-4-7, IEC 61000-4-15, IEC 61326-1, ANSI C12.20, IEC 62052-11, IEC 62053-22, CLC/
TR50579

PowerLogic PM8000 Power and Energy Meters


These compact meters help ensure the reliability and efficiency of your facility by making
the management of power quality, availability, and reliability easy. Measure, understand,
and act on insightful power and energy data gathered from your entire system.

[2] All the communication ports may be used simultaneously.


4-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Power Quality Meters — Selection
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

The best choice for power management


Address power issues before they cause
problems PM8000 meters combine accurate 3-phase energy and power measurements with data
• Monitor harmonics to mitigate excessive heating logging, power quality analysis, alarming and I/O capabilities not typically available in
and premature failure of transformers such compact meters. Four-metered current inputs allow direct measurement of 3-phase
currents and neutral current for enhanced view of harmonics. Dual Ethernet ports
• Use trending and alarming to detect fluctuations in support daisy-chaining, removing need for an Ethernet switch inside power equipment,
current pull of critical equipment to prevent motor
failure while redundant ring topology provides enhanced availability. Modular, field installable I/
O provides expandable scalability. Patented ION technology combines convenient, pre-
• Utilize millisecond time stamping to analyze configured functionality with the ability to customize the meter configuration to meet
sequence of events unique requirements. This embedded capability can save the expense and complexity of
• Identify root cause by analyzing electrical faults additional equipment, both today and tomorrow. Plus, simple installation and networking
with patented disturbance direction detection make energy information quickly accessible, while integration with StruxureWare™
• Identify power quality issues per EN 50160, software and your energy management system make it immediately actionable.
including frequency inconsistency, voltage
fluctuations and unbalance, and harmonic Table 4.9: PM8000 Series Features
contribution Intermediate meter
General
• Allocate costs for water, air, gas, electricity, and Use on LV and MV systems ■
steam (WAGES) across departments, phases of
industrial process, or cost centers Current accuracy (5A Nominal) 0.1 % reading
Voltage accuracy (57 V LN/100 V LL to 400 V LN/690 V LL) 0.1 % reading
• Utilize time-of-use calendar to capture electrical Active energy accuracy 0.2 %
consumption for specific times, including on/off
Number of samples/cycle or sample frequency 256
peak and holidays
Instantaneous rms values
Current, voltage, frequency ■
Table 4.8: PM8000 Power and Energy Meter Active, reactive, apparent power Total and per phase ■
Catalog Numbers Power factor Total and per phase ■
Description Catalog Number Current measurement range (autoranging) 0.05–10 A
PM8000 Panel Mount Meter with Energy values
Integrated Display METSEPM8240
Active, reactive, apparent energy ■
PM8000 DIN Rail Mount Meter without Settable accumulation modes ■
Display METSEPM8243
Demand values
PM8000 DIN Rail Mount Meter + Remote Current Present and max. values ■
Display METSEPM8244 Active, reactive, apparent power Present and max. values ■
Predicted active, reactive, apparent power ■
Remote Display, Color LCD, 96 x 96 METSEPM89RD96 Synchronization of the measurement window ■
I/O module, 2 relay outputs, 6 digital inputs METSEPM89M2600 Setting of calculation mode Block, sliding ■
I/O module, 2 analog outputs, 4 analog Power quality measurements
inputs METSEPM89M0024
Harmonic distortion Current and voltage ■
Display Cable, 10 meters METSECAB10
Via front panel and web page 63
Display Cable, 3 meters METSECAB3 Individual harmonics
Via StruxureWare software 127
Display Cable, 1 meters METSECAB1
Waveform capture ■
Sealing kit METSEPM8000SK
Detection of voltage swells and sags ■
Mounting adapter kit (ANSI 4") METSEPMAK
Fast acquisition 1/2 cycle data ■
Replacement hardware kit, PM8000 meter METSEPM8HWK
EN 50160 compliance checking ■
Replacement hardware kit, PM8000
remote display METSEPM8RDHWK Customizable data outputs (using logic and math functions) ■
Data recording
Min/max of instantaneous values ■
Data logs ■
Event logs ■
Trending/forecasting ■
SER (Sequence of event recording) ■
Time stamping ■
GPS synchronization (+/- 1 ms) ■
Memory (in Mbytes) 512
Display and I/O
Front panel display ■
Wiring self-test ■
Pulse output 1
Digital or analog inputs(max) 27 digital 16 analog
1 digital 8 relay 8
Digital or analog outputs (max, including pulse output) analog
Communication
RS 485 port 1
Ethernet ports 2
Serial port (Modbus, ION, DNP3) ■
Ethernet port (Modbus/TCP, ION TCP, DNP3 TCP, IEC 61850) ■
Ethernet gateway ■
Alarm notification via email ■
HTTP web server ■
SNMP with custom MIB and traps for alarms ■
SMTP email ■
NTP time synchronization ■
FTP File transfer ■

Power Quality Meter Selection


ION8650
Features [3] ION7650 ION7550 CM4000T ION7400 PM8000
A B C
Inputs, outputs and control power
3-phase / single-phase •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/•
Digital in and out / analog in and out 16 / 4 16 / 4 16 / 4 20 / 8 20 / 8 24 / 4 36/24 36/24

[3] Specifications represent maximum capabilities with all options installed. Some options are not available concurrently. This is not a complete feature list, please refer to detailed product
specifications.
4-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power Quality Meters — Selection PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
ION8650
Features [4] ION7650 ION7550 CM4000T ION7400 PM8000
A B C
Power supply options AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC
Power and energy measurements
Voltage, current, frequency, power factor • • • • • • • •
Power / Demand •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/•
Energy / time-of-use (energy per shift) •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/•
IEC / ANSI energy accuracy class (% of reading) 0.2(1) 0.2(1) 0.2(1) 0.2 0.2 0.2 0.2 0.2
Loss compensation • • • • • - - -
Power quality analysis
EN50160 compliance reporting / IEC 61000-4-30 Class A or S •/A •/S -/- •/A -/- •/- •/S •/S
Flicker measurement • • - • - • - -
Transient detection duration 17 μs - - 17 μs - 200 ns - -
Sag and swell monitoring / disturbance direction detection •/- •/- •/- •/• •/• •/• •/• •/•
Harmonic distortion: total/ individual / inter •/•/• •/•/- •/•/- •/•/• •/•/- •/•/- •/•/- •/•/-
Waveform capture • - - • • • • •
On-board data and event logging
Trending / forecasting / billing •/-/• •/-/• •/-/• •/•/• •/•/• •/•/• •/•/• •/•/•
Minimum and maximum • • • • • • • •
Events and alarms with timestamps • • • • • • • •
Timestamp resolution (seconds) 0.001 0.001 0.001 0.001 0.001 0.001 0.001 0.001
Time sync: Network / GPS / IRIG-B / DCF77-B •/•/•/- •/•/•/- •/•/•/- •/•/-/- •/•/-/- •/•/-/• •/•/•/- •/•/•/-
Setpoints, alarms and control
Log alarm conditions / call out on alarm •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/•
Trigger data logging / waveform capture •/• •/- •/- •/• •/• •/• •/• •/•
Trigger relay or digital output • • • • • • • •
Special features
Custom programming • • • • • • • •
Downloadable firmware • • • • • • • •
Communications
Ports:
Ethernet: Copper / Fiber •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• 2/- 2/-
Ethernet-to-serial gateway • • • • • • 2/- •
Telephone modem • • • • • - - -
Modem-to-serial gateway • • • • • - - -

POWER MONITORING AND


Infrared port • •/• •/• •/• •/• - • -
RS485/RS232 •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/- •/-
Misc: Web server / Email / SNMP / XML •/•/-/• •/•/-/• •/•/-/• •/•/•/• •/•/•/• •/•/-/• •/•/•/• •/•/•/•
Protocols: Modbus / DNP / MV-90 / DLMS •/•/•/- •/•/•/- •/•/•/- •/•/•/- •/•/•/- •/-/-/- •/•/•/- •/•/•/-

CONTROL
Protocols: IEC61850 / Jbus / M-Bus / LON / BACnet •/-/-/-/- •/-/-/-/- •/-/-/-/- •/-/-/-/- •/-/-/-/- -/-/-/-/- •/-/-/-/- •/-/-/-/-

NOTE:
1. The ION8650 is two times more accurate than the 0.2 IEC/ANSI accuracy
classes according to the same conditions used to specify the 0.2 accuracy class.
2. ION8800, ION8650, ION8600, ION7650, ION7550, PM8000 also offer Modbus
Master capabilities.

[4] Specifications represent maximum capabilities with all options installed. Some options are not available concurrently. This is not a complete feature list, please refer to detailed product
specifications.
4-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Power and Energy Meters — PM5000
Management Systems Series
schneider-electric.us

Series 5000 Power Meters


The PowerLogic PM5000 series power meters are the new benchmark in affordable,
precision metering. It is the ideal fit for high-end cost management applications,
providing measurement capabilities needed to allocate energy usage, perform tenant
metering and sub-billing, pin-point energy savings, optimize equipment efficiency and
utilization, and perform a high level assessment of the power quality in electrical
networks.
All meters provide Modbus serial communications. PM5500 level meters are also
capable of simultaneous ModBus TCP and BTL-certified BACnet IP communications
over Ethernet.
• Panel instrumentation (OEMs)
• Sub-billing and cost allocation
• Remote monitoring of an electrical installation
• Harmonic monitoring (THD)
Table 4.10: Series 5000 Power Meters
Description Catalog No.
Power Meter, Class 0.5 Serial Port METSEPM5110
Meter, Class 0.5 Alarms TOU Serial Port METSEPM5330
PM5000 Series
Power Meter Power Meter, Class 0.5 Alarms TOU Ethernet Port METSEPM5340
Power Meter Class 0.2 Serial Port and Dual Ethernet METSEPM5560
Power Meter without Display Class 0.2 Serial Port and Dual Ethernet METSEPM5563
Remote Display for METSEPM5563 METSEPM5RD
Power Meter with Remote Display Class 0.2 Serial Port and Dual Ethernet METSEPM5563RD[5]

ION6200 Power and Energy Meter


The modular PowerLogic ION6200 is a low-cost, ultra-compact meter that offers
outstanding versatility and functionality. It is simple to use, and has a big, bright LED
display. It offers four-quadrant power, demand, energy, power factor and frequency
measurements, and is available in a variety of flexible configurations. It is available as a
low-cost base model to which enhanced functionality can be added over the long term.
The PowerLogic ION6200 is ideal for customers who need revenue-accurate and/or
certified measurements and want easy integration with power distribution assemblies
and building automation systems. A Megawatt version is available for applications
requiring readings in megawatts and kilovolts. It is well suited for sub-metering, energy
cost tracking load profiling, and substation panel metering and is an ideal replacement
for analog meters. It can be used for stand-alone metering in custom panels,
switchboards, switchgear, gensets, motor control centers and UPS systems.
The meter consists of a base unit with options card and a power supply pack, with a
remote display being optional.
PowerLogic ION6200 Power and Energy Meter Features
PowerLogic ION6200 Series
• Only two inches deep, and fits a standard ANSI four-inch switchboard cutout, or as a
TRAN model with no display and can be fastened to a flat surface with a 4” (10cm)
ANSI bolt pattern or mounted to a DIN rail. A remote display module (RMD) can be
ordered for the TRAN and mounted through an ANSI 4” (10cm) and DIN 96 cutout.
• LED display with twelve 3/4” (19mm) high digits that display all basic power
parameters
• Pulse Outputs: optional kWh, kVARh and/or kVAh pulsing
• Via two Form A outputs
• Communications: optional RS-485 port with Modbus RTU and ION compatible
• 64 samples per cycle true RMS
• 3-phase voltage and current inputs
The standard ION6200 is available with the following: Voltage L-N average and per
phase, Voltage L-L average and per phase, Current average and per phase.
Option EP#1, includes the standard measurements and provides the following
additional parameters:I4, kW/mW total, kWh/mWh total, kW/mW peak, Current
demand average and per phase, Current peak demand average and per phase, Power
factor total.
Optional Enhanced Package, includes the standard measurements and provides
the following additional parameters: kW/mW per phase, kVAR/mVAR total and per
phase, kVA/mVA total and per phase, kWh/mWh and del/rec per phase, kVARh/mVARh
total and del/rec per phase, kVAh/mVAh total and per phase, kW/mW demand, kVAR/
mVAR demand and peak, kVA/mVA demand and peak, Power Factor per phase, Voltage
THD per phase, Current THD per phase.

Table 4.11: Typical PowerLogic ION6200 Ordering Configurations


Description Catalog No.
Integrated display, 10 A inputs, standard 100–240 Vac power supply, RS485 port (Modbus RTU), 2 pulse outputs, Enhanced Package #2 S6200A0A0B0A0B0R
TRAN Model, with remote display, 10 A inputs, standard 100–240 Vac power supply, RS485 port (Modbus RTU), 2 pulse outputs, Enhanced
Package #2 S6200R1A0B0A0B0R
TRAN Model, (no display), 10 A inputs, standard 100–240 Vac power supply, RS485 port (Modbus RTU), 2 pulse outputs, Enhanced
Package #2 S6200T1A0B0A0B0R

NOTE: Please refer to www.schneider-electric.us for the most complete and up-to-
date list of feature availability. Some features are optional.

[5] METSEPM5563RD includes both METSEPM5563 and METSEPM5RD.


4-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power and Energy Meters — EM3500 PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Series Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

Series 3500 Energy and Power Meter


The EM3500 series Energy and Power Meter combines exceptional performance and
easy installation to deliver a cost-effective solution for power monitoring applications.
The EM3500 series can be installed on standard DIN rail or surface mounted, and has
bi-directional monitoring designed expressly for renewable energy applications.
• Pulse output and phase alarms
• Data logging capability in some models
• Modbus and BACnet output options
Table 4.12: Series 3500 Energy and Power Meters
Description Catalog Number
Power Meter, DIN-rail, Pulse Output Only, for LVCTs METSEEM3502
Power Meter, DIN-rail Pulse Output Only, for METSECTR Rope CTs METSEEM3502A
EM3500 Series Power Meter, DIN-rail Modbus Output for LVCTs METSEEM3550
Energy and Power Meter Power Meter, DIN-rail, Modbus Output, for METSECTR Rope CTs METSEEM3550A
Power Meter, DIN-rail Modbus Output, Bi-Directional, Logging for LVCTs METSEEM3555
Power Meter, DIN-rail Modbus Output, Bi-Directional, Logging for METSECTR
Rope CTs METSEEM3555A
Power Meter, DIN-rail, BACnet Output, Logging for LVCTs METSEEM3560
Power Meter, DIN-rail, BACnet Output, Logging for METSECTR Rope CTs METSEEM3560A
Power Meter, DIN-rail, BACnet Output, for LVCTs METSEEM3561
Power Meter, DIN-rail, BACnet Output, for METSECTR Rope CTs METSEEM3561A

METSECTR Series Rope-Style Current Transformers


The METSECTR series works with the EM3500A, EM4236, and iEM35xx series power
and energy meters. These meters have a built in power supply and integrator, so CT
connecton is fast and simple. The coil opens at the connector juncton for fast and easy
installaton onto an existng cable or buss-bar. The flexible core makes it easy to fit in tght
enclosure
• Agency Approvals cURus, ANSI/IEEE 57.13, CE, RoHS
• Accuracy ±1% from 50 A to 5000 A

POWER MONITORING AND


• Insulation up to 600 Vac
Table 4.13: METSECTR Series Rope-Style Current Transformers
Description Catalog Number

CONTROL
Rogowski CT, 300 mm (12”), 600 Vac, 5 kA, U018 equivalent METSECTR30500
Rogowski CT, 460 mm (18”), 600 Vac, 5 kA, U018 equivalent METSECTR46500
Rogowski CT, 600 mm (24”), 600 Vac, 5 kA, U018 equivalent METSECTR60500
Rogowski CT, 900 mm (35”), 600 Vac, 5 kA, U018 equivalent METSECTR90500
LVCT Series Current Transformers
LVCT current transducers provide a 0.333 V output for use with EM3500 series meters.
Available in both solid and split core styles.
• Solid core accuracy ±0.5 of reading from 5% to 120% of rated current
• Split core accuracy 1% from 10% to 100% of rated current
• Leads 22 AWG, 600 Vac, UL 1015 bonded pair, 6 ft. (1.8 m) standard length

4
Table 4.14: LVCT Series Current Transformers
Description Catalog Number
Split core
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 0, 50 A:0.33 V LVCT00050S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 1, 100 A:0.33 V LVCT00101S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 2, 100 A:0.33 V LVCT00102S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 1, 200 A:0.33 V LVCT00201S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 2, 200 A:0.33 V LVCT00202S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 2, 300 A:0.33 V LVCT00302S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 3, 400 A:0.33 V LVCT00403S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 3, 600 A:0.33 V LVCT00603S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 3, 800 A:0.33 V LVCT00803S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 4, 800 A:0.33 V LVCT00804S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 4, 1000 A:0.33 V LVCT01004S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 4, 1200 A:0.33 V LVCT01204S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 4, 1600 A:0.33 V LVCT01604S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 4, 2000 A:0.33 V LVCT02004S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 4, 2400 A:0.33 V LVCT02404S
Solid core
Low-Voltage CT, Solid Core, Size 0, 50 A:0.33 V LVCT20050S
Low-Voltage CT, Solid Core, Size 0, 100 A:0.33 V LVCT20100S
Low-Voltage CT, Solid Core, Size 2, 200 A:0.33 V LVCT20202S
Low-Voltage CT, Solid Core, Size 3, 400 A:0.33 V LVCT20403S

4-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Power and Energy Meters — PM3000
Management Systems Series
schneider-electric.us

PowerLogic PM3000 Power and Energy Meters


PM3000 series power meters are a cost-attractive, feature-rich range of DIN rail-
mounted power meters that offers all the measurement capabilities required to monitor
an electrical installation. Ideal for power metering and network monitoring applications
that seek to improve the availability and reliability of your electrical distribution system,
the meters are also fully capable of supporting sub billing and cost allocation
applications. Four different models are available. Choose from models that provide
Display Only, Display + Pulse Output, Display + Modbus, and Display + Modbus + DI/DO
+ Logging. All models use 1A/5A CTs.

Table 4.15: PM3000 Features


PM3200 Range
Available Features
PM3200 PM3210 PM3250 PM3255
Performance Standard
IEC61557-12 PMD/Sx/K55/0.5 • • • •
General
Use on LV and HV systems • • • •
Number of samples per cycle 32 32 32 32
CT input 1A/5A • • • •
VT input • • • •
Multi-tariff 4 4 4 4
Multi-lingual backlit display • • • •
Instantaneous rms Values
Current, voltage Per phase and average • • • •
Active, reactive, apparent power Total and per phase • • • •
PM3000 Series Power Meter
Power factor Total and per phase • • • •
Energy Values
Active, reactive and apparent energy; import and export • • • •
Demand Values
Current, power (active, reactive, apparent) demand;
present • • • •
4

Current, power (active, reactive, apparent) demand; peak • • •


Power Quality Measurements
THD Current and voltage • • •
Data Recording
Min/max of the instantaneous values • • • •
POWER MONITORING AND

Power demand logs •


Energy consumption log (day, week, month) •
Alarms with time stamping 5 5 15
Digital inputs/digital outputs 0/1 2/2
CONTROL

Communication
RS-485 port • •
Modbus protocol • •

Table 4.16: PM3000 Series Power Meters


Description Catalog Number
PM3200 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S, no
communications, MID compliant METSEPM3200
PM3210 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S, pulse out, MID
compliant, THD, one (1) DO METSEPM3210
PM3250 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S, Modbus, THD METSEPM3250
PM3255 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S, Modbus, MID
compliant, THD, two (2) DI, two (2) DO METSEPM3255

4-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power and Energy Meters — iEM3000 PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

iEM3000 Energy Meters


The economical iEM3000 energy meters are ideal for helping facilities become more
energy efficient. These feature-rich meters reduce installation and commissioning costs
thanks to their efficient design and include native support for a variety of protocols,
including Modbus, BACnet, LON, and M-Bus, for seamless integration into networks.
Choose from models supporting a variety of current-sensing methods, including standard
1A/5A current transformers, 0.333 V low-voltage CTs, and METSECTR Rogowski coils.
There are also direct connect models with internal current sensors that save installation
time. The compact size is ideal for new and retrofit installations. Whether metering for
energy awareness, billing, or advanced energy programs requiring full-featured, multi-
tariff energy meters, there is an iEM3000 meter that fits the application.

Table 4.17: iEM3000 Features


Function Acti 9 iEM3000 Series Three-Phase Meters
Current Input / Accuracy
63A Direct / Class 1 iEM3100 iEM3110 iEM3135 iEM3150 iEM3155 iEM3165 iEM3175
1A or 5A CT / Class 0.5S iEM3200 iEM3210 iEM3235 iEM3250 iEM3255 iEM3265 iEM3275
125A Direct / Class 1 iEM3300 iEM3310 iEM3335 iEM3350 iEM3355 iEM3365 iEM3375
0.333V or 1.0V LVCT / Class
iEM3455 iEM3465
0.5S
Rogowski coil / Class 0.5S iEM3555 iEM3565
Protocol
M-Bus •
Modbus • •
BACnet •
LonWorks •
iEM3000 Series Energy Meter
Measurement
NOTE: MID compliant • • • • •
4 quadrant energy • • • •
• For meter part number replace “i” in model
name with “A9M”. (Example: iEM3150 = Multi Tariff
Internal clock 4 4 4 4
A9MEM3150) External control 2 4 4 4
• DIN rail housing size is 18mm x 5 width.
(iEM33xx is 18mm x 7 width.)
Digital I/O
Number of inputs/outputs -/1 1/1 1/1 1/1 1/1
• Digital input is selectable for Tariff control or

POWER MONITORING AND


WAGES
• Digital output is selectable for kWh pulse or
kW alarm. (iEM3x10 is kWh pulse only.)

CONTROL
Measurement parameters Multiple Tariffs
• Total and partial kWh shows consumption behavior • Save up to four different time slots to manage multiple tariffs (peak/off-peak,
• Four-quadrant metering differentiates energy workday/weekend)
consumption • Control tariffs via digital inputs, internal clock, or communication
• Target green technologies (delivered/received) Digital Inputs
• Reduce utility penalties (active/reactive) • Use the meter as a pulse counter for another meter (WAGES monitoring)
• Additional parameters (P, Q, S, 3xI, V, PF, F) to • Manage double-source applications (e.g., utility main plus on-site generator)
monitor network balance and overload behavior • Monitor circuit breaker status or cabinet door opening
Smart Alarm Digital Outputs
• kW overload alarm helps prevent utility demand
charges
• Use to trip a light or sound an alarm
• Configure as a pulse output

4
Table 4.18: iEM3000 Series Energy Meters
Description Catalog Number
iEM3100 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 63A, Class 1 A9MEM3100
iEM3110 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 63A, Class 1, pulse out, MID, one (1) DO A9MEM3110
iEM3135 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 63A, Class 1, M-Bus, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3135
iEM3150 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 63A, Class 1, Modbus A9MEM3150
iEM3155 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 63A, Class 1, Modbus, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3155
iEM3165 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 63A, Class 1, BACnet, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3165
iEM3175 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 63A, Class 1, LON, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3175
iEM3200 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S A9MEM3200
iEM3210 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S, pulse out, MID one (1) DO A9MEM3210
iEM3235 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S, M-Bus, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3235
iEM3250 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S, Modbus A9MEM3250
iEM3255 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S, Modbus, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3255
iEM3265 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S, BACnet, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3265
iEM3275 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S, LON, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3275
iEM3300 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 125A, Class 1 A9MEM3300
iEM3310 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 125A, Class 1, pulse out, MID, one (1) DO A9MEM3310
iEM3335 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 125A, Class 1, M-Bus, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3335
iEM3350 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 125A, Class 1, Modbus A9MEM3350
iEM3355 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 125A, Class 1, Modbus, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3355
iEM3365 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 125A, Class 1, BACnet, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3365
iEM3375 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 125A, Class 1, LON, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3375
iEM3455 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, LVCT, Class 0.5S, Modbus, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3455
iEM3465 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, LVCT, Class 0.5S, BACnet, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3465
iEM3555 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, Rogowski coil, Class 0.5S, Modbus, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3555
iEM3565 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, Rogowski coil, Class 0.5S, BACnet, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3565

4-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Power and Energy Meters — iEM3000
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

Multiple Meter Unit Enclosures for iEM3000 Energy Meters

Schneider Electric’s Multi-Meter Unit (MMU) enclosures are the ideal complement for the
iEM3000 Series of energy meters. This compact solution saves wall space and is
scalable for the exact number of meters required. Factory-assembled, pre-wired, and
tested enclosures can speed installation, reduce the amount of field wiring, and save
time troubleshooting.
Multi-meter unit enclosures and iEM3000 meters provide the highest quality, best value
hardware for tenant sub-metering, and are designed for contractor convenience and
simplicity.
4

MMU enclosures are available in three sizes:


• Small MMU enclosures with capacity for up to 4 iEM3000 meters.
• Medium size MMU enclosures with capacity for up to 8 iEM3000 meters, plus one
gateway/data logger/energy server.
• Extra-large MMU enclosures with capacity for up to 24 iEM3000 meters, plus one
POWER MONITORING AND

gateway/ data logger/energy server.

Multi meter units are configured to order as described below.


CONTROL

S e rie s MMU 1 08 08 A D 1 S ys te m Type

MMU = Multi-meter unit 1 = Prewired for sin gle-phase


208Y/120 V L-L-N metering
NEMA Ra ting 2 = Prewired for sin gle-phase
120V or 2 77V L-N metering
1 = N EMA Type 1 2 = Prewired for sin gle-phase
120/240V L-L-N metering
Enclos ure Ca pa city
2 = Prewired for th ree-phase 208Y/1 20V
04 = 4 mete rs, 16"H x 1 2"W x 6"D or 480Y/2 77V L-L-L-N mete ring

08 = 8 mete rs, 20"H x 2 0"W x 6"D Ga te wa y/Da ta Logge r/Ene rgy S e rve r
24 = 24 mete rs, 30"H x 24"W x 6"D N = None ( Re quire d if Me te r Type
is B or D, or Meter Cap acity = 04)
Numb er o f Mete rs Ins ta lle d
L = EGX150 ga tew a y
01 = 1 meter D = EBX210 d a ta logger
Meter Type (Sen s or, S e ria l P rotocol)
xx = up to cap acity limit E = EBX510 energ y se rve r
A = iEM3455 (LVCT, Modbus)
X = EGX300 energ y se rve r
B = iEM3465 (LVCT, BACnet) B = EGX300 energ y se rver
C = iE M3555 (Rogo wsk i, Modbus) with Tenant Bill 32 applic a tion
T = EGX300 energ y se rver with Te na nt Bill
D = iEM3565 (Rogo wsk i, BACnet) 64 applic a tion

4-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power and Energy Meters — Selection PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

Power and Energy Meter Selection


Features [6] PM5110 PM5330 PM5340 PM5500 ION6200 EM3500 PM3000 iEM3000
Inputs, outputs and control power
3-phase / single-phase •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/•
Digital in and out / analog in and out 1/0 4/0 4/0 6/0 2/- 2 or 3 / 0 up to 2/2 up to 1/1
Power supply options AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC AC
Power and energy measurements
Voltage, current, frequency, power factor • • • • • • • •
Power / Demand •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/–
Energy / time-of-use (energy per shift) •/- •/• •/• •/• •/- -/- •/• •/•
IEC / ANSI energy accuracy class (% of reading) 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.2 0.5 0.2 0.5 0.5
Loss compensation - - - - - - - -
Power quality analysis
EN50160 compliance reporting / IEC 61000-4-30 Class A or S -/- -/- -/- -/- -/- -/- -/- -/-
Flicker measurement - - - - - - - -
Transient detection duration - - - - - - - -
Sag and swell monitoring / disturbance direction detection -/- -/- -/- -/- -/- -/- -/- -/-
Harmonic distortion: total/ individual / inter •/•/- •/•/- •/•/- •/•/- •/-/- -/-/- •/-/- -/-/-
Waveform capture - - - - - - - -
On-board data and event logging
Trending / forecasting / billing -/-/- -/-/- -/-/- -/-/- -/-/- -/-/- -/-/- -/-/-
Minimum and maximum • • • • - - • -
Events and alarms with timestamps - • • • - - • -
Timestamp resolution (seconds) 1 1 1 1 - 1 1 -
Time sync: Network / GPS / IRIG-B / DCF77-B -/-/-/- -/-/-/- -/-/-/- -/-/-/- -/-/-/- -/-/-/- -/-/-/- -/-/-/-
Setpoints, alarms and control
Log alarm conditions / call out on alarm -/- •/• •/• •/• -/- -/- •/-
Trigger data logging / waveform capture -/- -/- -/- -/- -/- -/- -/- -/-
Trigger relay or digital output - • • • - - • •
Special features
Custom programming - - - - - - - -
Downloadable firmware • • • • - - - -
Communications

POWER MONITORING AND


Ports:
Ethernet: Copper / Fiber -/- -/- 1/- 2/ - -/- -/- -/- -/-
Ethernet-to-serial gateway - - - • - - - -
Telephone modem

CONTROL
- - - - - - - -
Modem-to-serial gateway - - - - - - - -
Infrared port - - - - - - - -
RS485/RS232 •/- •/- -/- •/- •/- •/- •/- •/-
Misc: Web server / Email / SNMP / XML -/-/-/- -/-/-/- -/-/-/- •/-/-/- -/-/-/- -/-/-/- -/-/-/- -/-/-/-
Protocols: Modbus / DNP / MV-90 / DLMS •/-/-/- •/-/-/- •/-/-/- •/-/-/- •/-/-/- •/-/-/- •/-/-/- •/-/-/-
Protocols: IEC61850 / Jbus / M-Bus / LON / BACnet -/-/-/-/- -/-/-/-/- -/-/-/-/- -/-/-/-/• -/-/-/-/- -/-/-/-/• -/-/-/-/- -/-/•/•/•

[6] Specifications represent maximum capabilities with all options installed. Some options are not available concurrently. This is not a complete feature list, please refer to detailed product
specifications.
4-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power PowerLogic Energy Meter
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

PowerLogic Energy Meter


The Energy Meter is ideal for stand-alone and systems-based submetering applications.
It is easy to install and provides exceptional metering accuracy. Available in Basic and
Extended Range models. The Basic model is designed for metering of 120/240 and
208Y/120 volt services. The Extended Range model will meter 120/240 volt up to 480
volt Wye connected services. Extended Range meters come with pulse output and
phase loss output not available on the Basic unit. Optional Modbus™ RS-485 serial
communications are provided with the Energy Meter Comms Board, EMCB. Optional kW
demand is also provided by the EMCB.
Meter up to 3 individual services with one Energy Meter. The Energy Meter will allow the
addition of up to 3 sets of parallel CTs for metering multiple electric loads. Additional sets
of CTs can be ordered separately. Please refer to the multiple CT application notes in the
Energy Meter Energy Meter instruction bulletin for the proper installation procedures.

Table 4.19: Basic 120/240 V to 208Y/120 V Table 4.20: Extended Range 120/240 V to 480Y/277 V
Description Catalog No. Description Catalog No.
Basic 100 A, .518"x1.28" ID, 1 CT EMB1010 Extended Range 100 A, .518"x1.28" ID, 1 CT EME1010
Basic 200 A, 0.75” x 1.10” ID, 1 CT EMB1021 Extended Range 200 A, 0.75” x 1.10” ID, 1 CT EME1021
Basic 300 A, .90"x1.90" ID, 1 CT EMB1032 Extended Range 300 A, .90"x1.90" ID, 1 CT EME1032
Basic 100 A, .518"x1.28" ID, 2 CTs EMB2010 Extended Range 100 A, n.518"x1.28" ID, 2 CTs EME2010
Basic 200 A, 0.75” x 1.10” ID, 2 CTs EMB2021 Extended Range 200 A, 0.75” x 1.10” ID, 2 CTs EME2021
Basic 300 A, .90"x1.90" ID, 2 CTs EMB2032 Extended Range 300 A, .90"x1.90" ID, 2 CTs EME2032
Basic 400 A, 2.45"x2.89" ID, 2 CTs EMB2043 Extended Range 400 A, 2.45"x2.89" ID, 2 CTs EME2043
Basic 800 A, 2.45"x2.89" ID, 2 CTs EMB2083 Extended Range 800 A, 2.45"x2.89" ID, 2 CTs EME2083
Basic 100 A, .518"x1.28" ID, 3 CTs EMB3010 Extended Range 100 A, .518"x1.28" ID, 3 CTs EME3010
Basic 200 A, 0.75” x 1.10” ID, 3 CTs EMB3021 Extended Range 200 A, 0.75” x 1.10” ID, 3 CTs EME3021
Basic 300 A, .90"x1.90" ID, 3 CTs EMB3032 Extended Range 300 A, .90"x1.90" ID, 3 CTs EME3032
Basic 400 A, 2.45"x2.89" ID, 3 CTs EMB3043 Extended Range 400 A, 2.45"x2.89" ID, 3 CTs EME3043
Basic 800 A, 2.45"x2.89" ID, 3 CTs EMB3083 Extended Range 800 A, 2.45"x2.89" ID, 3 CTs EME3083
Basic 800 A, 2.45"x5.50" ID, 3 CTs EMB3084 Extended Range 800 A, 2.45"x5.50" ID, 3 CTs EME3084
Basic 1600 A, 2.45"x5.50" ID, 3 CTs EMB3164
Extended Range 1600 A, 2.45"x5.50" ID, 3 CTs EME3164

Table 4.21: Energy Meter Accessories Table 4.22: Additional CT Sets


Description Catalog No.
Description Catalog No. 100 A, .518” x 1.28” ID, 1 CT EMCT010
Energy Meter Communication Board [7] EMCB 200 A, 0.75” x 1.10” ID, 1 CT EMCT021
Energy Meter Fuse Pack, Set of 1 EMFP1 300 A, .90” x 1.90” ID, 1 CT EMCT032
Energy Meter Fuse Pack, Set of 2 EMFP2 400 A, 2.45” x 2.89” ID, 1 CT EMCT043
Energy Meter Fuse Pack, Set of 3 EMFP3 800 A, 2.45” x 2.89” ID, 1 CT EMCT083
Energy Meter Bonding Kit EMBOND 800 A, 2.45” x 5.50” ID, 1 CT EMCT084
1600 A, 2.45” x 5.50” ID, 1 CT EMCT164
NOTE: CT quantity and amperage must match meter model. Total of combined loads
must not exceed rating of meter. All additional CTs shipped with 6 ft. white and black
color-coded wire leads.

PowerLogic EM4200 Enercept Meter


Next generation Enercept meters provide a unique solution for measuring energy data.
The small form factor enables retrofit installation in existing panels to save wall space,
installation time, and material cost. They are compatible with O.333V LVCT split-core,
solid-core and METSECTR rope-style current transducers 50–5000A and communicate
using Modbus and BACnet protocols.
Features
• High
Vac
reliability with ANSI C12.20 0.2% accuracy, IEC 62053-22 Class 0.2S, 90 to 480

• Compact size for easy in-panel mounting, DIN rail or screw mount options
• Easy integration with a variety of CT form factors – split-core, solid-core, and Rope-
Style Rogowski (METSECTR), and compatibility from 5 to 5000A
• Seamless integration with StruxureWare Power Monitoring Expert (PME),
StruxureWare Building Operation (SBO), and StruxureWare Building Expert (SBE)
• Configurable with or without power
• Quick connection with auto protocol, baud rate, and uni-directional/bi-directional
detection
• Native Modbus and BACnet protocols along with uni-directional and bi-directional
feature sets in one unit
EM4200 Series Enercept
Table 4.23: EM4200 Enercept Meter
Description Catalog Number
Enercept Power Meter, Class 0.2S, Modbus/BACnet
RS485, ANSI wire code, compatible with LVCT and EM4236
Rogowski coils, order separately

[7] Energy Meter communication board (EMCB) can be used with all models of the Energy Meter. Order one EMCB for each Energy Meter where either kW demand and/or communication is
specified.
4-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic Enercept™
™ Meter PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

PowerLogic Enercept™ Meter


The Enercept Meter is the ideal solution for submetering electric loads where space is at
a premium. The compact design consists of three interconnected split-core CTs with the
metering and communication electronics built into the CT housing. Simply snap on the
CTs, connect the voltage inputs, the communication lines, and installation is complete.
Both versions can be connected to either three-phase or single-phase circuits.
Enercept meters employ the Modbus™ RTU 2-wire communication protocol, and can
utilize the same communication network and Power Management Software applications
as other PowerLogic devices. Data from the Enercept meters can be presented in
tabular or graphical format, used for alarming and historical logging and trending, and to
Enercept Meter
produce reports.
Optional Submeter display (SMD) acts as a stand-alone operator interface supporting up
to 32 meters (63 with a repeater). In addition, the Submeter display (SMD) can act as a
network adapter allowing Enercept meters to be incorporated into a network.

Table 4.24: Enercept Meter


Description Catalog No.
Basic 100 A, 1.25" x 1.51" ID 3020B012[8]
Basic 300 A, 1.25" x 1.51" ID 3020B032 [8]
Basic 400 A, 2.45" x 2.89" ID 3020B043 [8]
Basic 800 A, 2.45" x 2.89" ID 3020B083 [8]
Basic 800 A, 2.45" x 5.50" ID 3020B084 [8]
Basic 1600 A, 2.45" x 5.50" ID 3020B164 [8]
Basic 2400 A, 2.45" x 5.50" ID 3020B244 [8]
Enhanced 100 A, 1.25" x 1.51" ID 3020E012
Enhanced 300 A, 1.25" x 1.51" ID 3020E032
Enhanced 400 A, 2.45" x 2.89" ID 3020E043
Enhanced 800 A, 2.45" x 2.89" ID 3020E083
Enhanced 800 A, 2.45" x 5.50" ID 3020E084
Enhanced 1600 A, 2.45" x 5.50" ID 3020E164
Enhanced 2400 A, 2.45" x 5.50" ID 3020E244

POWER MONITORING AND


Table 4.25: Accessories
Description Catalog No.
Submeter display mounted in enclosure SMD

CONTROL
Open style submeter display, no enclosure SMD OPN
2-Wire 232–485 Conv 30502W485C
Enercept Mounting Brackets (Set of 3) 3050EMBK-3

Table 4.26: Enercept Metering Quantities


Basic[8] Enhanced•
kWh, kW per phase and total, min kW, max kW, kWd, kVAR, kVA, PF per phase
kWh, energy usage kW, real and total voltage- V, L-L, L-N per phase and avg. Current - A, per phase and
power average

PowerLogic Instrument Grade 5 Amp Split-Core Current Transformers


The 3090 SCCT series of split-core current transformers provide secondary amperage
proportional to the primary (sensed) current. For use with Circuit Monitors, Power

4
Meters, data loggers, chart recorders and other instruments the 3090 SCCT series
provides a cost-effective means to transform electrical service amperages to a 0–5A
level compatible with monitoring equipment.

Table 4.27:
Description Catalog No.
Split Core CT—200 A (sz.2): 1.25" x 1.51 3090SCCT022
Split Core CT—300 A (sz.2): 1.25" x 1.51 3090SCCT032
SA Split-Core Current Transformers
Split Core CT—400 A (sz.3): 2.45" x 2.89 3090SCCT043
Split Core CT—600 A (sz.3): 2.45" x 2.89 3090SCCT063
Split Core CT—800 A (sz.3): 2.45" x 2.89 3090SCCT083
Split Core CT—800 A (sz.4): 2.45" x 5.05 3090SCCT084
Split Core CT—1200 A (sz.4): 2.45" x 5.50 3090SCCT124
Split Core CT—1600 A (sz.4): 2.45" x 5.50 3090SCCT164
NOTE: Max. Voltage without additional insulation 600 Vac. Do not apply 600 V Class
current transformers to circuits having a phase-to-phase voltage greater than 600 V,
unless adequate additional insulation is applied between the primary conductor and
the current transformers. Square D assumes no responsibility for damage of
equipment or personal injury caused by transformers operated on circuits above
their published ratings.

[8] See Handout / Instruction Bulletin for derating properties.


4-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Multi Circuit Energy Meters
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

Multi Circuit Energy Meters


The PowerLogic EM4800 and EM4000 multi-circuit energy meters combine accurate
electricity sub-metering with advanced communications technology. They are ideal for
multi-tenant or departmental metering and M&V applications within office towers,
condominiums, apartment buildings, shopping centers and other multipoint
environments, or small footprint retail. This meter is available separately or as part of a
Square D integrated power center (IPC) for use in building retrofits or new construction.
Each compact multipoint meter provides energy measurement for up to 24 (1CT) or 12
(2CT) single-phase circuits or 8 (3CT) 3-phase circuits. Select a model to match the
desired CT type. The 0.333 V output CT option does not require shorting blocks, making
it the ideal choice for retrofit installations.
All meters have an accuracy of Class 0.5%, have onboard interval logging, and feature
flexible communication options with an Ethernet port that supports multiple protocols:
Modbus TCP/IP, HTTP, BACnet/IP, FTP, and SNTP. EM4800 series meters have a V.90
modem while EM4000 series meters provide Modbus RTU over RS-485.

Table 4.28: Multi Circuit Energy Meters


Description Catalog No.
EM4800 series; Ethernet; modem; compatible with 80mA low-power CTs; 120V control power 60 Hz METSEEM488016
EM4800 series; Ethernet; modem; compatible with 333mV low-power CTs; 120V control power 60 Hz METSEEM483316
EM4800 series; Ethernet; modem; compatible with standard 5A CTs; 120V control power 60 Hz METSEEM480516
4

EM4000 series; Ethernet; Modbus RTU over RS-485; compatible with 80mA low-power CTs; 120V control power 60 Hz METSEEM408016
EM4000 series; Ethernet; Modbus RTU over RS-485; compatible with 80mA low-power CTs; 277V control power 60 Hz METSEEM408036
EM4000 series; Ethernet; Modbus RTU over RS-485; compatible with 333mV low-power CTs; 120V control power 60 Hz METSEEM403316
EM4000 series; Ethernet; Modbus RTU over RS-485; compatible with 333mV low-power CTs; 277V control power 60 Hz METSEEM403336
200 A current transformer (CT), 80 mA secondary, solid-core (1 CT) METSECT80200
POWER MONITORING AND

400 A current transformer (CT), 80 mA secondary, solid-core (1 CT) METSECT80400


600 A current transformer (CT), 80 mA secondary, solid-core (1 CT) METSECT80600
50 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 0.75 in Window Size ECT075050SC
100 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 0.75 in Window Size ECT075100SC
CONTROL

150 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 0.75 in Window Size ECT075150SC
200 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 0.75 in Window Size ECT075200SC
100 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 1.25 in Window Size ECT125100SC
150 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 1.25 in Window Size ECT125150SC
200 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 1.25 in Window Size ECT125200SC
400 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 1.25 in Window Size ECT125400SC
200 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 2.00 in Window Size ECT200200SC
400 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 2.00 in Window Size ECT200400SC
600 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 2.00 in Window Size ECT200600SC
600 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 3 x 5 in Window Size ECT300600SC
800 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 3 x 5 in Window Size ECT300800SC

4-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic Branch Circuit Power Meter PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

PowerLogic Branch Circuit Power Meter


The ideal solution for data center managers, energy or facility managers, engineers and
operational executives who are responsible for delivering power to critical applications.
In corporate and hosted data center facilities, this technology helps you plan and
optimize the critical power infrastructure to meet the demands of continuous availability.
The PowerLogic BCPM is a highly accurate, full-featured metering product designed for
the unique, multi-circuit and minimal space requirements of a high performance power
distribution unit (PDU) or remote power panel (RPP). It offers class 1 (1%) power and
energy system accuracy (including 50 A or 100 A CTs) on all branch channels.
The BCPM monitors up to 84 branch circuits with a single device and also monitors the
incoming power mains to provide information on a complete PDU. It also offers multi-
phase measurement totals with flexible support for any configuration of multi-phase
breakers. Full alarming capabilities ensure that potential issues are dealt with before they
become problems.
Unlike products designed for specific hardware, the flexible BCPM will fit any PDU or
RPP design and supports both new and retrofit installations. It has exceptional dynamic
range and accuracy, and optional feature sets to meet the energy challenges of mission
critical data centers.
Key Features:
• Integrated
BCPME models
Ethernet with advanced SNMP, BACnet, and Modbus TCP support on

• Class 1% system accuracy (including 50 A or 100 A branch CTs


• Flexible configuration of Logical Meters for multi-phase loads
• Full PDU monitoring
• Flexible configuration
• Split core version for retrofit installations
• Wide monitoring range
• Low current monitoring
• Advanced alarming

POWER MONITORING AND


• Easily integrates into a PowerLogic system or other existing networks using Modbus™
communications

CONTROL
50 A CT

4
100 A CT

200 A CT

4-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power PowerLogic Branch Circuit Power Meter
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

Table 4.29: BCPM with Solid-Core CTs


Description Catalog
Number
42-circuit solid-core power & energy meter, 100A CTs (2 strips), ¾ in. spacing BCPMA042S
84-circuit solid-core power & energy meter, 100A CTs (4 strips), ¾ in. spacing BCPMA084S
42-circuit solid-core power & energy meter, 100A CTs (2 strips), 1 in. spacing BCPMA142S
84-circuit solid-core power & energy meter, 100A CTs (4 strips), 1 in. spacing BCPMA184S
24-circuit solid-core power & energy meter, 100A CTs (2 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMA224S
36-circuit solid-core power & energy meter, 100A CTs (2 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMA236S
42-circuit solid-core power & energy meter, 100A CTs (2 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMA242S
48-circuit solid-core power & energy meter, 100A CTs (4 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMA248S
72-circuit solid-core power & energy meter, 100A CTs (4 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMA272S
84-circuit solid-core power & energy meter, 100A CTs (4 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMA284S
Typical BCPMSC panelboard installation
42-circuit solid-core branch current, mains power meter, 100A CTs (2 strips), ¾ in. spacing BCPMB042S
84-circuit solid-core branch current, mains power meter, 100A CTs (4 strips), ¾ in. spacing BCPMB084S
42-circuit solid-core branch current, mains power meter, 100A CTs (2 strips), 1 in. spacing BCPMB142S
84-circuit solid-core branch current, mains power meter, 100A CTs (4 strips), 1 in. spacing BCPMB184S
24-circuit solid-core branch current, mains power meter, 100A CTs (2 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMB224S
36-circuit solid-core branch current, mains power meter, 100A CTs (2 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMB236S
42-circuit solid-core branch current, mains power meter, 100A CTs (2 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMB242S
48-circuit solid-core branch current, mains power meter, 100A CTs (4 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMB248S
72-circuit solid-core branch current, mains power meter, 100A CTs (4 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMB272S
84-circuit solid-core branch current, mains power meter, 100A CTs (4 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMB284S
42-circuit solid-core branch current meter, 100A CTs (2 strips), ¾ in. spacing BCPMC042S
84-circuit solid-core branch current meter, 100A CTs (4 strips), ¾ in. spacing BCPMC084S
42-circuit solid-core branch current meter, 100A CTs (2 strips), 1 in. spacing BCPMC142S
84-circuit solid-core branch current meter, 100A CTs (4 strips), 1 in. spacing BCPMC184S
24-circuit solid-core branch current meter, 100A CTs (2 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMC224S
36-circuit solid-core branch current meter, 100A CTs (2 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMC236S
42-circuit solid-core branch current meter, 100A CTs (2 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMC242S
48-circuit solid-core branch current meter, 100A CTs (4 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMC248S
4

72-circuit solid-core branch current meter, 100A CTs (4 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMC272S
84-circuit solid-core branch current meter, 100A CTs (4 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMC284S
42-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (2 strips), ¾ in. spacing BCPME042S
84-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (4 strips), ¾ in. spacing BCPME084S
42-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (2 strips), 1 in. spacing BCPME142S
POWER MONITORING AND

84-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (4 strips), 1 in. mm spacing BCPME184S
24-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (2 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPME224S
36-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (2 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPME236S
42-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (2 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPME242S
CONTROL

48-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (4 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPME248S
72-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (4 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPME272S
84-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (4 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPME284S

4-24
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic Branch Circuit Power Meter PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

Table 4.30: BCPM with Split-Core CTs


Description Catalog Number
42-circuit split-core power and energy meter, CTs and cables sold separately BCPMSCA1S
84-circuit split-core power and energy meter, CTs and cables sold separately BCPMSCA2S
30-circuit split-core power and energy meter, (30) 50A CTs & (2) 4 ft. cables BCPMSCA30S
42-circuit split-core power and energy meter, (42) 50A CTs & (2) 4 ft. cables BCPMSCA42S
60-circuit split-core power and energy meter, (60) 50A CTs & (4) 4 ft. cables BCPMSCA60S
42-circuit split core power and energy meter, all boards on backplate, CTs and cables sold BCPMSCAY63S
separately
84-circuit split-core power and energy meter, with (84) 50A CTs & (4) 4 ft. cables BCPMSCA84S
42-circuit split-core branch current, mains power meter, CTs and cables sold separately BCPMSCB1S
84-circuit split-core branch current, mains power meter, CTs and cables sold separately BCPMSCB2S
30-circuit split-core branch current, mains power meter, (30) 50A CTs & (2) 4 ft. cables BCPMSCB30S
42-circuit split-core branch current, mains power meter, (42) 50A CTs & (2) 4 ft. cables BCPMSCB42S
60-circuit split-core branch current, mains power meter, (60) 50A CTs & (4) 4 ft. cables BCPMSCB60S
42-circuit split-core branch current, mains, all boards on backplate, CTs and cables sold BCPMSCBY63S
separately
84-circuit split-core branch current, mains power meter, (84) 50A CTs & (4) 4 ft. cables BCPMSCB84S
42-circuit split-core current meter, CTs and cables sold separately BCPMSCC1S
84-circuit split-core current meter, CTs and cables sold separately BCPMSCC2S
30-circuit split-core current meter, (30) 50A CTs & (2) 4 ft. cables BCPMSCC30S
42 circuit split-core current meter, (42) 50A CTs & (2) 4 ft. cables BCPMSCC42S
60-circuit split-core current meter, (60) 50A CTs & (4) 4 ft. cables BCPMSCC60S
42-circuit split-core current meter, all boards on backplate, CTs and cables sold separately BCPMSCCY63S
84-circuit split-core current meter, (84) 50A CTs & (4) 4 ft. cables BCPMSCC84S
42-circuit split-core power and energy meter w/Ethernet, CTs and cables sold separately BCPMSCE1S
84-circuit split-core power and energy meter w/Ethernet, CTs and cables sold separately BCPMSCE2S
30-circuit split-core power and energy meter w/Ethernet, (30) 50A CTs & (2) 4 ft. cables BCPMSCE30S
42-circuit split-core power and energy meter w/Ethernet, (42) 50A CTs & (2) 4 ft. cables BCPMSCE42S
60-circuit split-core power and energy meter w/Ethernet, (60) 50A CTs & (4) 4 ft. cables BCPMSCE60S
84-circuit split-core power and energy meter w/Ethernet, (84) 50A CTs & (4) 4 ft. cables BCPMSCE84S

Table 4.33: BCPM Split-Core Branch CTs and Adapter Boards


Table 4.31: 1/3 V Low-Voltage Split-Core CTs for

POWER MONITORING AND


Description Catalog Number
Aux Inputs (Mains)
BCPM adapter boards, quantity 2, for split core BCPM BCPMSCADPBS
Amperage Rating Inside Dimensions Catalog BCPM 50A split core CTs, Quantity 6, 1.8 m lead lengths BCPMSCCT0
Number
50A 10 x 11 mm LVCT00050S BCPM 50A split core CTs, quantity 6, 6 m lead lengths BCPMSCCT0R20

CONTROL
200A 16 x 20 mm LVCT00101S BCPM 100A split core CTs, Quantity 6, 1.8 m lead lengths BCPMSCCT1
200A 32 x 32 mm LVCT00202S BCPM 100A split core CTs, Quantity 6, 6 m lead lengths BCPMSCCT1R20
100A 30 x 31 mm LVCT00102S BCPM 200A split core CTs, Quantity 1, 1.8 m lead lengths BCPMSCCT3
200A 30 x 31 mm LVCT00202S BCPM 200A split core CTs, Quantity 1, 6 m lead lengths BCPMSCCT3R20
300A 30 x 31 mm LVCT00302S
400A 62 x 73 mm LVCT00403S
600A 62 x 73 mm LVCT00603S Table 4.34: Additional Accessories for use with BCPM Products
800A 62 x 73 mm LVCT00803S Description Catalog Number
800A 62 x 139 mm LVCT00804S BCPM circuit board cover BCPMCOVERS
1000A 62 x 139 mm LVCT01004S CT repair kit for solid core BCPM (includes one CT) BCPMREPAIR
1200A 62 x 139 mm LVCT01204S Additional 100A split core CT for use with solid core repair kit H6803R-0100
1600A 62 x 139 mm LVCT01604S
Modbus to BACnet protocol converter E8951
2000A 62 x 139 mm LVCT02004S
Flat Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 0.45 m CBL008
2400A 62 x 139 mm LVCT02404S
Flat Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 1.2 m CBL016

4
Table 4.32: 1/3 V Low-Voltage Solid-Core CTs for Flat Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 1.5 m CBL017
Aux Inputs (Mains) Flat Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 1.8 m CBL018
Amperage Rating Inside Dimensions Catalog Flat Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 2.4 m CBL019
Number Flat Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 3.0 m CBL020
50A 10 mm LVCT20050S Flat Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 6.1 m CBL021
100A 10 mm LVCT20100S Round Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 1.2 m CBL022
200A 25 mm LVCT20202S
Round Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 3 m CBL023
400A 31 mm LVCT20403S
Round Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 6.1 m CBL024
Round Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 0.5 m CBL031
Round Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 0.8 m CBL033

4-25
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power PowerLogic Multi-Circuit Meter
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

PowerLogic Multi-Circuit Meter


Designed for OEM style placement in electrical distribution equipment the MCM8364 is
configurable to meter 1 or 3 phases of up to eight individual loads, six loads if neutral
monitoring is required. The MCM will monitor up to 10,000 amps per service using
standard 5 Amp CTs. All of the metered circuits must share a common voltage source.
The MCM8364 is a great solution for monitoring critical power distribution equipment and
provides 24 different electrical metering quantities plus an additional nine Modbus
register alarms.
With one RS-485 connection, the multi-circuit meter provides Modbus RTU
communications output that communicates to each individual metered circuit. Up to 30
multi-circuit meters can be addressed on the same Modbus network. The multi-circuit
meter can provide warnings to the central monitoring computer via its Modbus output
using the MNode software provided or can be integrated into PowerLogic SMS software.
The MCM also works with the submeter display as shown below.
Electrical Data:
Energy Consumption (kWHr), Real Power (kW), Reactive Power (kVAR), Apparent
Power (kVA), Power Factor Total, Voltage, L-L, avg. of 3 phases, Voltage, L-N, avg. of 3
3-phase, 4-wire phases, Current, average of 3 phases, Real Power (kW) phase A, B, & C, Power Factor,
(with neutral current phase A, B,&C, Line to Line Voltage, phase A-B, B-C, A-C, Line to Neutral Voltage,
phase A-N, B-N, C-N, Current, phase A, B, & C, Frequency (measured from phase A)
(Hz).
Modbus Alarms:
Over Voltage, Under Voltage, Over Current, Under Current, Over kVA, Under kVA,
Phase Loss A, Phase Loss B, Phase Loss C

Table 4.35:
Description Catalog No.
Multi-Circuit Meter 8364 MCM8364
4

PowerLogic Submeter Display


The PowerLogic Submeter Display (SMD) is a comprehensive electrical submetering
display that provides a view of electrical parameters from multiple metering products with
one networked LCD. In addition to viewing system data on the display itself, you can also
POWER MONITORING AND

view data on a remote PC via a network connection. Touch pad buttons provide a
convenient way to view downstream devices on the power-monitoring network. The
display is RS-485 Modbus RTU compatible. It has additional RS-485 and RS-232
Modbus ports for networking to additional displays or to a master PC. The submeter
CONTROL

display is compatible with the following metering devices: BCM, BCPM, EM3500, MCM,
& Enercept™ meters.

Table 4.36:
Description Catalog No.
Submeter display mounted in enclosure SMD
Open style submeter display, no enclosure SMD OPN
Submeter Display

4-26
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Communications PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us Class 3030

Com’X Data Loggers and Energy Servers


Powerful data logging with flexible communication options
Connect your entire power system with Com’X data loggers and energy servers. Com’X
surpasses conventional gateways and data loggers by incorporating multiple capabilities
into one compact device. In addition to being a real-time gateway to downstream
devices, Com’x logs all essential WAGES and environmental readings through a broad
range of downstream data feeds and local I/O. Logged data can be automatically pushed
to a hosted platform or downloaded for report generation. Ethernet and Wi-Fi ready,
Com’x leverages on the building’s existing IT infrastructure to reduce cost. Its GPRS
capability makes it ideal for sites with no access to IT networks.
Easy configuration and commissioning
Configuration and commissioning is made easy by automatic device detection, and IP
address setting and allocation. No additional software is needed for the intuitive, web-
based configuration pages. A device library enables quick configuration for more than 70
Modbus devices and also provides for custom configuration of additional devices.
Configuration via Wi-Fi lets technicians use tablets or notebooks to work comfortably
Com’X 510 Energy Sever away from switchboard rooms.

POWER MONITORING AND


Com’X 510 Energy Dashboard

Embedded energy management software

CONTROL
The Com’X 510 Energy Server further includes embedded web pages that display data
in a meaningful way so you can make informed decisions about your energy usage. Web
pages display real-time data in easy to understand tabular and summary formats. In
addition, you can access simple analysis of historical data in bar graph or trending
formats. Pages are accessible via any standard web browser without plug-ins or
additional components.

Table 4.37: Com'X Data Loggers, Energy Services, and Accessories


Description Catalog Number
Com’X200 Data logger with internal 100 to 230 VAC power supply EBX200
Com’X210 Data logger, requires 24 VDC power supply EBX210
Com’X510 Energy server, requires 24 VDC power supply EXB510
Wi-Fi USB stick EBXAUSBWIFI

4
Zigbee USB stick EXBAUSBZIGBEE
GPRS modem with SIM card EBXAGPRSSIM
GPRS modem without SIM card EBXAGPRS
External GPRS antenna EBXAANT5M

4-27
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Communications — Link150 Ethernet
Management Systems Gateway
Class 3030 schneider-electric.us

Link150 Ethernet Gateway


Communications for high-speed access to critical information
The Link150 gateway provides fast, reliable Ethernet connectivity in the most demanding
applications, from a single building to a multi-site enterprise. This gateway supports
meters, monitors, protective relays, trip units, motor controls and other devices that need
to communicate data quickly and efficiently. It is your simple, cost-effective serial line to
full Ethernet connectivity.
Applications
• Energy management
• Power distribution
• Building automation
• Factory automation
Link150 Ethernet Gateway

Link150 has embedded web pages for easy setup and


maintenance

Security
• Secure user interface including user’s name and password for login
• Advanced security features to allow users to specify which Modbus TCP/IP master
devices may access attached serial slave devices
– Modbus TCP/IP filtering feature
– Allows user to specify the level of access for each master device as Read-only or
Full access

• Web pages provide easy configuration and setup


Advantages
• Easy to install and setup
• Easy to maintain
• Compatible with Schneider Electric software offerings (StruxureWare Power
Monitoring Expert, StruxureWare PowerSCADA Expert, etc.)
• Compatible with Com'X 200/210 and Com'X 510 Energy Servers
• Reliable Modbus to Ethernet protocol conversion
Table 4.38: Ethernet Gateway
Type Catalog Number
Link150 Ethernet gateway EGX150
Modbus 3 m cable RJ–45 to free wires VW3A8306D30

Modbus 3 m cable RJ–45 to free wires

4-28
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Engineering Services PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

Consulting and Analysis


Power System Engineering
The Square D Power System Engineering team offers a wide range of engineering
services to improve the safety, efficiency and reliability of your power distribution system.
The team is comprised of registered professional engineers, safety trained and
equipped, to perform a variety of engineering functions.
Power System Studies
The Square D Power System Engineering Team provides expertise for a variety of
electrical power system studies. Some of the more common system studies include…

• Short-circuit analysis • Motor starting/torque-speed • Transient analysis


• Time-current coordination • Safe motor re-energization • Power factor correction analysis
• Motor starting/voltage drop
• Harmonic analysis • Other system specific analysis

Arc Flash Analysis


Square D offers on-site services to perform arc flash analysis for a facility, complex,
office, or campus. An Arc flash analysis is used to determine …

• Flash Protection Boundary • Appropriate Personal Protective Equipment (PPE)


• Incident Energy Value • Low cost arc flash reduction methods
• Hazard/Risk Category

Features of Square D arc flash analysis include…

• Time current coordination analysis showing both • Arc flash label affixation
existing and recommended over/current device
settings • NFPA 70E—Safe Workplace Practices Training
provided by OSHA authorized outreach instructors
• Short-circuit study to ensure adequacy of equipment
• Recommendations and solutions to reduce potential
• Onsite verification and documentation of equipment arc flash hazards

POWER MONITORING AND


Arc flash labels (populated with the results of the arc
flash analysis)

Power Quality Studies

CONTROL
Square D offers onsite power quality engineering studies and solutions to eliminate
process disruptions, power system shutdowns, and equipment damage due to electrical
power system disturbances. A power quality study is used to...

• Determine compliance with the IEEE 519-


Recommended Practices and Requirements for
• Reduce economic effects of poor power quality

Harmonic Control in Electrical Power Systems • Identify disturbances originating on electric utility
system and improvements to reduce the number and
guidelines
severity
• Identify most cost-effective solution to power quality
problems
• Solve process disruptions due to power disturbances

Power System Assessment

4
Square D offers engineering services to meet a variety of power system needs …

• Basic codes and standards


compliance
• Power quality troubleshooting
and analysis
• Single-line documentation of
power system
• Protective coordination
assessment
• Power factor and harmonics
analysis
• Power monitoring
recommendations
• Maintenance program review
• Electrical safety hazards • Loading measurements
• Recommendations for power
system optimization • Short-circuit withstand overview

Power System Improvement Projects


Square D offers engineering services for …

• New equipment installation


• Existing equipment modification
• Ground Fault Schemes for multiple source distribution systems
• High Resistance Grounding (HRG) Conversion

• Automatic Transfer Control Schemes & Generator Operations


Square D professional engineers - safety trained and equipped - will listen to your
concerns and goals, define the problem or enhancement, and engineer the solution that
best satisfies your needs.
For additional information on power system engineering services and pricing, contact
your nearest Square D/Schneider Electric office.

4-29
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Engineering Services
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

Advanced Microgrid Solutions and Distributed Energy Resource Management


With our custom solutions and proven expertise, we deliver advanced microgrids that
offer the advantages of grid independence – without forfeiting the benefits of being part
of the central grid. Our flexible microgrid architecture features a scalable set of grid
components designed to efficiently manage your entire energy infrastructure, including
distributed generation, energy storage, and load demand, while giving you the ability to
easily adapt the system to your changing needs. Learn more at www.microgrids.
schneider-electric.us.

Industrial Energy Efficiency


Schneider Electric Certified Energy Managers (CEM’s) work on-site with knowledgeable
plant personnel to develop a long-term, comprehensive, “Energy Action Plan”, that
serves as the blueprint for energy savings. Unlike performance contracts or one-time
energy audits, the Total Energy ControlSM program offers a strategic partnership for
energy-intensive industrials who want to improve energy efficiency.
• Total Energy Control – Comprehensive integration of all three areas affecting energy
efficiency
Microgrids deliver — Procurement (electricity and gas)
energy flexibility — Demand management
— Optimization of process and plant utilities
• Program deliverables:
— Long-term Energy Action Plan
— Energy efficiency projects
— Ongoing accountability for results

Engineered Solutions
Schneider Electric provides an engineered solution approach to your specific power
system applications. Our total solutions for power monitoring and power system controls
allow greater safety, reliability, and energy efficiency of your power systems. As a long
4

standing industry leader in Power Monitoring and Control Systems, we understand your
power system requirements and needs.
All of our Engineered Solutions are tailored to your specific system requirements.
Schneider Electric is your total Solution provider.
POWER MONITORING AND

Power Monitoring Applications


Increased Reliability and Energy Efficiency are key results produced from our Power
Monitoring Applications. Schneider Electric power monitoring applications provide
CONTROL

detailed reporting, testing and analysis capabilities for your systems and related
components.
• EPSS Emergency Power Supply Systems– The PowerLogic EPSS Test Report
provides information regarding the health and status of the emergency power supply
system, including automatic transfer switches and generators.
• SER Sequence of Events Recording– The PowerLogic Sequence of Events
Recorder (SER) Module is a root-cause analysis tool for rapid response for problem
resolution that is ideal for pinpointing the cause of a service disruption in very large
complex power systems.
• WAGES Water, Air Gas, Electric, Steam– PowerLogic energy and power
management systems can provide instantaneous readings, alarm notifications, and
graphical diagrams for monitoring electrical and piped utilities (Water, Air, Gas,
Electric, Steam).
• ENM Event Notification Module– The PowerLogic Event Notification Module allows
automatic paging to alphanumeric pagers, cell phones and PCs.

Power System Control Applications


Automated solutions for increased Reliability and Energy Efficiency: Schneider
Electric engineers provide Power System Control Applications with automated solutions
for addressing your system reliability and efficiency control needs. Our offer covers
Automatic Throwover Schemes, Load Shedding/Peak Shaving, and Load Preservation
and Mircrogrids.
• Automatic Throwover Systems – Automatic selection of available utility or generator
sources to maintain service continuity to connected loads.
• Load Shedding/Peak Shaving – Control peak demand levels or ensure service
continuity to critical load or operate breakers in accordance with user specified
sequences and time delays such as bringing large motors online across several billing
kw demand periods to avoid demand penalties.
• Load Preservation – Fast acting sophisticated control systems designed to stabilize
critical power systems to the greatest extend possible by monitoring frequency and
power sources from utility plus generator capacity versus total circuit load.
PowerLogic Engineers provide graphic solutions for realtime
monitoring of power systems.

4-30
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Integration and Equipment PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

System Integration
System Design and Engineering
Our Square D Engineering Services solution specialists can work with you to design or
upgrade your existing system to best achieve your energy and power management
objectives and informational needs. With expertise in electrical systems,
communications, and automatic control systems, we can integrate, install, and
commission your system for optimal performance.

• System Design and Bill of Material Recommendations


• Power Monitoring and Control
• WAGES (Water, Air, Gas, Electric, Steam)
• Enterprise web-based monitoring
• Specification development, drawings, documentation
• Enclosure panel design and build
• Metering Connection Verification/Testing
• Power distribution automation
• On-Site Installation Assistance, Component Configuration &
Startup

PowerLogic Engineers design power • Turn-key project management


control systems that meet your
operational requirements
• Third Party Device and communication interfaces
• Configured Workstations, User Software Interfaces
• Interactive Graphic Design to mimic facility layout, one-lines,
equipment status PowerLogic Engineers specialize in the
• Custom Software, Reports & Applications – Billing and Event
Notification
design and setup of Emergency Power
Supply Systems (EPSS).
For additional information, contact your nearest Square D / Schneider Electric office.
Factory Assembled Equipment
Square D™ PowerLogic™ Factory Assembled Equipment offers a wide range of designs
for metering, communications, and control applications to simplify retrofit installations.
Our equipment is designed to order as a free-standing or wallmounted system. With

POWER MONITORING AND


PowerLogic™ Factory Assembled Equipment, you’ll receive professionally crafted,
factory tested, pre-wired equipment that will greatly improve the speed of your system
startup. All backed by the Square D™ quality standard of excellence.

CONTROL
• Assemblies include meters & devices wired to terminal blocks, disconnects, and
shorting blocks or test switches
• Tailored to any system voltage :
– 208/120 V, 480/277 V & 600/347 V Wye
– 240 V, 480 V & 600 V Delta
– Utilization of PT's required for higher voltage levels
• Wall mountable and easy to install using concealed holes in the back of the enclosure.
• Complete with necessary documentation and mounting hardware for quick and easy
installation
• Carbon steel construction, with industry standard ANSI 61 gray powder coat finish
• Equipped with concealed hinged door, and universal pad-lockable latch.

4
• Custom engraved nameplates available for all units.
Table 4.39: Industrial Enclosure Types 12 & 4, UL & CUL 508A Listed
Available Meter Types Digital Inputs Digital Outputs Analog Inputs Analog Outputs
ION6200 N/A Up to 2/ Meter N/A N/A
PM5563RD Up to 4 / Meter Up to 2 / Meter N/A N/A
PM8244 Up to 15 / Meter Up to 5 / Meter Up to 4 / Meter Up to 2 / Meter
CM4000T Up to 8 / Meter Up to 7 / Meter Up to 1 / Meter Up to 1 / Meter
ION 7550 & 7560 Up to 16 / Meter Up to 7 / Meter Up to 4 / Meter Up to 4 / Meter

• Supports Single or Multiple Voltage Sources for Indoor (Types 1 and 12) & Outdoor
(Type 4) applications
• Available with 1–4 meters per panel. Serial & Ethernet Communications are options
for all units
• EGX & ION RTU Communication Enclosures with 1–4 devices per panel also
available

4-31
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Integration and Equipment
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

Light Industrial Enclosure Type 1, UL & CUL 508A Listed


• Available for the following meter types: PM8244, PM5563RD, and ION6200
• Supports Single Voltage Source only for Indoor (Type 1) applications.
• Available with 1–12 meters per panel. Serial Communications are standard for all
units.
• No Digital or Analog I/O is available for this option.
Service Entrance/Utility Socket Enclosure Type 3R, UL & CUL 508A Listed
• Available for ION8600 only, with up to 3 Digital Inputs and 4 Digital Outputs and E5600
2 Digital Inputs and 2 Digital Outputs.
• Supports Single Voltage Source only for Indoor & Outdoor (Type 3R) applications.
• Units are Ring Type with removable cover.
• Available with 1 meter per panel. Serial & Ethernet Communications options available.
• Supports Form 9S, 35S, 36S, 39S and 76S configurations for ION8600 and forms 9S
and 36S for E5600.
• Options available for remote mounted CTs
• Options available for integrated, bar type CTs
• Optional Test Switch.
Additional engineered to order products are available for a wide variety of design
solutions.
• Switchgear Transfer Control Panels
• Generator Control Panels
• Load Shed Control Panels
• Sequence of Events Recording (SER) Panels
• Control System Mimic Panels
• Lighting Control Interface Panels
• Programmable Logic Controller (PLC) Control Panels (Hot Standby, Relay Control,
4

Data Concentration etc. ...)


• Emergency Power Supply Systems (EPSS) Control Panels
• Water, Air, Gas, Electrical, and Steam (WAGES) Monitoring Panels
• Input Status Monitoring & Alarming Panels
• Remote Annunciator Control Panels
POWER MONITORING AND

• Remote Operator Control Panels


• Serial, Ethernet, and Cellular Wireless Systems
• Server Rack and Network Equipment (Servers, Switches, UPS’s) for Energy
CONTROL

Management Systems.
• Industrialized PC’s, Touch Screens (Magelis), and Human Machine Interfaces (HMI’s)
with Custom System Graphics.
• Designed to fit any environment – Indoor (Type 1 & 12) & Outdoor (Type 3R & 4)
applications
For additional information and pricing please contact your local PowerLogic sales
specialist or PowerLogic Inside Sales Support at 615-287-3535. Equipment pricing
and literature available for download on our website at www.powerlogic.com/
products/enclosures.
To better serve you please have the following information on hand when calling.
• Enclosure
Corrosive)
type (Indoor or Outdoor) and Environment details (Corrosive or Non-

• Power System Voltage Level and Type (Direct Current (DC) or Alternating Current
(AC))
• Digital & Analog Input and Output requirements
• Device Type and Quantity per enclosure
• Ethernet and Serial Communication Requirements
• For Drawout Retrofits, need existing cradle type (i.e. GE, Westinghouse, etc.)

4-32
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Integration and Equipment PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

PowerLogic High Density Metering


High Density Metering (HDM) is engineered to answer the metering and billing needs of
multi-tenant properties:
Features and Benefits
• HDM comes standard with PowerLogic PM5000 series.
• Lockable, 16 gauge NEMA Type 1 enclosure provides tamper-resistant security.
• NEMA Type 3R also available. Please consult factory.
• Mounting channel and surface-mount flanges simplify installation.
• Factory installed cover plates are included to cover empty meter spaces.
• Factory installed wiring harness simplifies installation of additional meters and
provides future system expansion.
• Each High Density Metering cabinet is provided with RS485 Modbus® or Modbus
Ethernet TCP communications. For wireless communications, please consult factory.
• Supports 120/208V & 277/480V WYE, and 240V & 480V Delta System Types, 1Ph or
3Ph
• CTs required. Must select separately.
High Density Meter System Includes:
• Enclosure
• Power Meters, installed
High Density Metering factory assembled • Installation bulletin for Enclosure
enclosure for multi-tenant properties • Wall hanging bracket
• Installation bulletin for Meters
Table 4.40: High Density Metering Cabinet
Category Number of Meters Enclosure Rating Description
Meter Enclosure Size [9]
High Density Meter Enclosure with PM5110 meters; Modbus RTU serial
HDM PM5110 1, 4 or 8 1–8 Type 1 or Type 3R communications; Ideal for single or three phase indoor commercial building
applications
High Density Meter Enclosure with PM5330 meters; Modbus RTU serial

POWER MONITORING AND


HDM PM5330 1, 4 or 8 1–8 Type 1 or Type 3R communications; Ideal for single or three phase indoor commercial building
applications
High Density Meter Enclosure with PM5340 meters; Modbus TCP Ethernet
HDM PM5340 1 1 Type 1 or Type 3R Communications; Ideal for single or three phase indoor commercial building

CONTROL
applications
High Density Meter Enclosure with PM5560 meters; Dual wiring for both
HDM PM5560 1, 4 or 8 1–8 Type 1 or Type 3R Modbus RTU serial and Modbus TCP Ethernet communicaions; Ideal for
single or three phase indoor commercial building applications

Table 4.41: Accessories


Description Catalog No.
50 Amp HDM Solid Core Current Transformer, 1.13” window size HDMCT050S1
100 Amp HDM Solid Core Current Transformer, 1.13” window size HDMCT100S1
125 Amp HDM Solid Core Current Transformer, 1.13” window size HDMCT125S1
150 Amp HDM Solid Core Current Transformer, 1.13” window size HDMCT150S1
200 Amp HDM Solid Core Current Transformer, 1.13” window size HDMCT200S1
250 Amp HDM Solid Core Current Transformer, 1.13” window size HDMCT250S1
400 Amp HDM Solid Core Current Transformer, 1.13” window size HDMCT400S1

4
7.42 7.12 1.43
[189] [181] [36]
1.95
[50]
8.5 16.0
Top Vie w for 1X a nd 4X [406.4]
[215.9]
0.25 / [6.4]
13.8 0.38 / [9.7]
7.40 [350]
[188] in.
Dual Dimensions:
[mm]

Top Vie w
30.8 0.33
1.95 [782]
[50] [8.382] 14.00
7.42 7.12 1.43 21.13 24.75 [355.6]
[189] [180.85] [36] [536.7] [628.7]

13.8
[350] 14.88
[378]
11.33 8.00
[288] [203]

4.75 4.8
Front V iew Side V iew Front V iew Side V iew 0.78 / [19.8]
[121] [122] 7.38 0.38 / [9.652]
Back V iew Back V iew [187.5] 21.88 / [555.8]
1X Enclosure Dimensions 4X Enclosure Dimensions 8X Enclos ure Dime ns ions

[9] Meters Ordering Notes: Please indicate the number of meters to be pre-installed when placing your order. You may order any number of meters in the enclosure between one and the
maximum number of meters each cabinet will hold.
4-33
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Support Services
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us

Technical Engineering Support Services


No power management system is complete without it. Technical support should go
beyond basic troubleshooting. Continued optimization and maintenance extends the life
of your system and ensures it’s working efficiently and effectively. Our number one
priority is to help you protect your investment and get the most out of it.
• Proactive diagnostics and maintenance
• Access to our self-help web portal and knowledge base
• Email, telephone, and remote VPN troubleshooting assistance
• On-demand and in-person training
A variety of service levels available based on your needs and budget, plus options add-
ons such as onsite maintenance or 24x7 support, allows you to build the support that’s
right for your system.
Premium +
Our most comprehensive service level is ideal for large organizations with mission critical
systems, multiple locations and/or in-house energy management expertise.
Premium
Great for the experienced manager with complex power management systems and/or
multiple locations, you can choose Premium support and partner with a dedicated
engineer to help you drive improved system performance.
Priority
Sign up for Priority support and benefit from the expertise of our senior technical
engineers. They can remotely connect to your system and resolve issues while you
observe or work on other tasks.
Standard
We stand behind our products. If you have the time and knowledge to do-it-yourself, then
4

we’re happy to assist you with troubleshooting or answer your questions at no extra cost.
Priority Support: Excellent Service, Free Software Upgrades, Training Discounts & More!
Energy Performance Services
Unleash Your System’s True Potential with the Power of Partnership
POWER MONITORING AND

Energy Performance Services helps you improve and sustain energy performance,
reduce costs, and support compliance efforts. From facility insight to optimization
solutions, let us customize an energy management program that’s right for you. Contact
your representative and ask them about power quality analysis or an energy health
CONTROL

check.
Solutions to fit your needs:
• Facility Insight Solutions—These core energy health checks designed to evaluate your
existing systems
• Optimization Solutions—Let our team of experts monitor or fine-tune your systems to
maximize energy savings, efficiency and power quality.
Choose from remote or onsite solutions to ensure sustained results year over year.
Various funding options available. Visit www.schneider-electric.com/eps or contact us at
615-287-3535.
Power Management University (PMU)
Attending a PMU sponsored course will enable attendees to better utilize their
Schneider-Electric power monitoring solution thus enabling them to realize energy
savings as quick as possible. PMU offers a variety of options with instructor led options
being 80% hands-on, with each student having their own lab workstation. Below is a list
of the different training options offered by PMU.
Course Course No. Length
Factory Courses: Software Solutions
Power Monitoring Fundamentals Bundle
(includes 12-mo. On-Demand Campus access) 3000PMUFUNDSPMCR 4 Days
Power Monitoring Fundamentals
3000PMUFUNDSPM 4 Days
(without 12-mo. On-demand Campus access)
Power Monitoring Designer 3000PMUPROG 4 Days
Power Monitoring Administrator 3000PMUADMINSPM 4 Days
Other Software Courses
Hardware Installation and Troubleshooting 3000PLUC100 4 Days
PowerSCADA Expert Administrator 3000PMUPLSADMIN 4 Days
Online Training Solutions
On-Demand Campus (one-year subscription—online access) 3000PMUDEMAND12 12 months
SMSTrainer (one-year subscription—online access) 3000PMUSMSTRAINER 12 months
EEMTrainer (one-year subscription—online access) 3000PMUEEMTRAINER 12 months
webED, custom webinar training for up to five people
(call or email for more information) 3000PLUCWEBCST 3–4 hours

4-34
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Series 20, 40, 60, and 80 Features Sepam Digital Protective Relays

schneider-electric.us

The Sepam Range


Sepam protection relays are time-tested, high-performance devices that ensure
dependability. This range of products was designed with a simple idea in mind: All users
should be able to find a solution corresponding exactly to their needs with the right
balance between performance, simplicity and cost. With Series 10, 20, 40 and 80, the
Sepam range does just this. This family of relays offers a solution for every application
need, specifically targeting industrial installations. These multi-functional protection
devices allow an easy and hassle-free startup with simple-to-use programming software.
Sepam relays also comply with the latest communication protocols on the market,
including IEC61850, DNP3 and Modbus. In addition, all relays within this range come
with a standard 10 year warranty and conformal coating for protection against harsh
environments.
Features and Benefits
• Compact devices with clearly defined connection terminals allowing for easy
installation
• User-friendly
programming
software with built-in manuals for every relay and support for offline

• Application-specific design ensuring appropriate protection for any given application


• Low power CT options for the use of relays on new installations where the load is low
• Field-upgradable
software
technology allows user to stay up-to-date on the latest hardware and

Sepam Series 10
The Sepam Series 10 relays are suitable for basic protection applications involving
current metering.
Applications covered:
• Substation
• Transformer

POWER MONITORING AND


Sepam Series 20
Sepam Series 10 The Series 20 consists of high-performing solutions suited for standard applications
requiring current or voltage metering.

CONTROL
Applications covered:
• Substation
• Transformer
• Motor
• Busbar
Sepam Series 40
The Series 40 family of protection relays are designed for demanding applications
requiring current, voltage and/or frequency metering.
Applications covered:

4
• Substation
Sepam Series 20 and 40 • Transformer
• Motor
• Generator
Sepam Series 80
The Series 80 relays are for custom applications requiring enhanced protection of
electrical distribution networks.
Applications covered:
• Substation
• Transformer
• Motor
• Generator
• Busbar
• Capacitor
Sepam Series 80

4-35
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Sepam Digital Protective Relays Series 20, 40, 60, and 80 Features

schneider-electric.us

Protection Configurations
Four relay series with increasing protection capabilities for six types of applications to
provide all possible protection configurations

Table 4.42: Protection Configurations


Series 10 Series 20 Series 40 Series 80
Protection Functions
25, 26/63, 27/27S, 27D, 27R, 30, 32R, 12, 14, 21B, 24, 25, 26/63, 27/27S, 27D, 27R, 30,
26/63, 27/27S, 27D, 27R, 30, 37, 38/49T, 46, 32Q/40, 37, 38/49T, 46, 47, 48, 49RMS, 32P, 32Q/40, 37, 37P, 38/49T, 40, 46, 47, 48,
49RMS, 50/51, 50G/ 48, 49RMS, 50/51, 50BF, 50G/51G, 50N/ 50/51, 50BF, 50G/51G, 50N/51N, 50V/51V, 49RMS, 50/27, 50/51, 50BF, 50G/51G, 50N/51N,
51G, 50N/51N, 68, 51N, 51LR, 59, 59N, 66, 68, 79, 81H, 81L, 51LR, 59, 59N, 60/60FL, 66, 67, 67N/ 50V/51V, 51C, 51LR, 59, 59N, 60/60FL, 64G,
86 81R, 86, 94/69, CPLU 50/51, CPLU 50N/51N 67NC, 68, 79, 81H, 81L, 81R, 86, 94/69, 64REF, a 66, 67, 67N/67NC, 68, 74, 78PS, 79,
21FL, 46BC, CPLU 50/51, CPLU 50N/51N 81H, 81L, 81R, 86, 87M, 87T, 94/96
Characteristics
Inputs 0-4 Inputs 0–10 Inputs 0–10 Inputs 0–42
Logic input/outputs
Outputs 3-7 Outputs 4–8 Outputs 4–8 Outputs 5–23
Temperature sensors 0 0–8 0–16 0–16
Current 3I + Io Current 3I + Io Current 3I + Io Current 2x 3I + 2x Io
— Voltage 3 V + Vo Voltage 3 V + Vo Voltage 2x 3 V + Vo
Channels
— LPCT [1] LPCT [1]
LPCT [1]
0–1 1–2 1–2 2–4
ModBus, IEC 103 ModBus, IEC 103, DNP3, IEC 61850 ModBus, IEC 103, DNP3, IEC 61850
Communication Ports ModBus, IEC 103, DNP3, IEC 61850
— — Redundancy Redundancy
— — — Goose Message
Matrix [2] Matrix [2]
Matrix [2] Matrix [2]
Control Logic equation editor Logic equation editor
— — — Logipam [3]
— — — Front memory cartridge with settings
Other
— — Backup 48 hours (capacitor) Backup lithium battery [4]

Table 4.43: ANSI Codes


4

Code Definition Code Definition


12 Overspeed (2 set points) 50N/51N Ground fault
14 Underspeed (2 set points) 50V/51V Voltage restrained overcurrent
21B Underimpedance 51C Capacitor bank unbalance
21FL Fault Locator 51LR Locked rotor
24 Overfluxing (V/Hz) 59 Overvoltage (L-L or L-N)
POWER MONITORING AND

25 Synch-check 59 Overvoltage (L-L)


26/63 Thermostat / Buchholz 59N Neutral voltage displacement
27/27S Undervoltage (L-L/L-N) 60/60FL CT/VT supervision
CONTROL

27D Positive-sequence undervoltage 64G 100% stator earth fault


27R Remanent undervoltage 64REF Restricted earth fault
30 Annunciation 66 Starts per hour
32P Directional real overpower 67 Directional phase overcurrent
32Q/40 Directional reactive overpower 67N/67NC Directonal ground fault
Logic discrimination / zone selective
37 Phase undercurrent 68 interlocking
37P Directional active underpower 74 Circuit connnection supervision
38/49T Temperature mounting 78PS Pole slip
40 Field loss (underimpedance) 79 Recloser (4 cycles)
46 Unbalance/negative sequence 81H Overfrequency
46BC Broken conductor detection 81L Underfrequency
47 Negative sequence overvoltage 81R Rate of change of frequency (df/dt)
48 Excessive starting time 86 Latching / acknowledgement
49RMS Thermal overload 87M Machine differential
50/27 Inadvertent energization 87T Two-winding transformer differential
50/51 Phase overcurrent 94/69 Circuit breaker / contactor control
Cold load pick-up with phase overcurrent
50BF Breaker failure CLPU 50/51 protection
CLPU 50N/ Cold load pick-up with earth fault protection
50G/51G Ground sensitive 51N

[1] LPCT: low-power current transducer complying with standard IEC 60044-8.
[2] Control matrix for simple assignment of information from the protection, control and monitoring functions.
[3] Logipam ladder language (PC programming environment) to make full use of Sepam Series 80 functions.
[4] Standard lithium battery 1/2 AA format 3,6 V front face exchangeable.
4-36
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
VAMP V321 Arc Flash Protection and Mitigation
Systems
schneider-electric.us

VAMP V321 Arc Flash Mitigation System


• VAMP V321 is the fastest and most advanced arc flash mitigation system on the
market.
• As a fast-acting arc flash mitigation system, VAMP V321 reduces the level of incident
energy within a switchgear, thereby reducing equipment damage.
• VAMP V321 is a modular system consisting of a central unit, input/ouput (I/O) units
and arc flash sensors. Its modular design gives it the flexibility to expand and adapt to
various applications in an electrical distribution system.
System Features
• Operates on light and/or overcurrent conditions
• Operating time of 2 ms or less
• Supports up to 16 I/O units and 170 arc flash sensors
VAMP V321 Arc Flash Mitigation System • Four programmable arc protection zones per central unit
• Fully configurable using VAMPSet software
• Mimic bus display
• Supports nearly every communication protocol on the market
• Phase current measuring
• Ground fault current measuring
• Circuit breaker fail protection (50BF)

VAMP V321 I/O Units


The I/O units are used to connect sensors to the central unit in the VAMP V321 system.
These units are classified as either light sensor or current I/O units.

POWER MONITORING AND


VAM 12LD I/O Unit VAM 10LD I/O Unit VAM 4CD I/O Unit

CONTROL
VAM 12L I/O Unit VAM 10L I/O Unit VAM 4C I/O Unit VAM 3LX I/O Unit VAM 3L I/O Unit

• VAM 12L, VAM 12LD: Light-sensing point sensor I/O units with connections for 10 arc
sensors and 3 trip contacts
• VAM 10L, VAM 10LD: Light-sensing point sensor I/O units with connections for 10 arc
sensors and 1 trip contact

4
• VAM 3L, VAM 3LX: Light-sensing fiber arc sensor I/O units with connections for 3 fiber
loops and 1 trip contact
• VAM 4C, VAM 4CD: Dedicated I/O units used to measure current from alternative
locations
All VAMP V321 I/O units provide active indication when appropriately placed inside the
switchgear enclosure. They are connected to each other using intra-unit cabling supplied
by Schneider Electric.

VAMP V321 Sensors and Accessories

VA1EH-x VA1DA-x

4-37
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Arc Flash Protection and Mitigation VAMP V321
Systems
schneider-electric.us

• Point sensor VA1EH-x (pipe) Installed typically in the tube or next to the
compartment window.
• Point sensor VA1DA-x (surface) Compartment wall or mounting plate installation.
• Arc SLm-x Used when a large number of compartments are to be monitored.
• VX001 Modular Cable Intra-unit cabling that is used to connect the I/O units to the
central unit.
Arc SLm-x VX001
VAMP V321 is currently available in solution-based projects. Please contact a Schneider
Electric representative for more information.
[email protected]
4
POWER MONITORING AND
CONTROL

4-38
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Reactive Power Compensation and ReactiVar™
Harmonic Mitigation
schneider-electric.us

Reactive Power Compensation and Harmonic Mitigation


Solutions
How can reactive power compensation and harmonic mitigation solutions be part
of your energy efficiency programs?

Power factor is a measure of how efficiently you are using electricity. In an electric power
system, a load with low power factor draws more current than a load with a high power
factor for the same amount of real power transferred. Utility customers with a low power
factor could realize an increase or penalty in their electric bill. Over time, these penalties
may reach into thousands of dollars, depending upon the utility’s rate structure.
Harmonics may disrupt normal operation of other devices and increase operating costs.
Symptoms of problematic harmonic levels include overheating of transformers, motors
and cables, thermal tripping of protective devices, logic faults of digital devices and
drives.
Harmonics can cause vibrations and noise in electrical machines (motors, transformers,
reactors).
The life span of many devices can be reduced by elevated operating temperature.

POWER MONITORING AND


Schneider Electric provides different solutions to meet different application
requirements.

CONTROL
Table 4.44: Descriptions, Applications, and Features
Product Description LV MV Application Product Features
Suited for applications where the load does not change or where the
ReactiVar Fixed Power Factor Capacitors X X Power Factor correction capacitor is switched with the load, such as on the load side of a
motor contactor.
ReactiVar Standard Automatic Power Factor Capacitor Suited for centralized power factor correction in applications where
Banks plant loading is constantly changing, resulting in the need for varying
X X Power Factor correction amounts of reactive power. Designed for electrical networks with little
(AV5000/MV5000)
or no harmonic content.
ReactiVar Anti-Resonant Automatic Power Factor Suited for centralized power factor correction in applications
Power Factor Correction and
Capacitor Banks X X Harmonics Filtering containing harmonic energies that would otherwise damage
(AV6000/MV6000) standard fixed or automatic capacitor banks.
ReactiVar Harmonic Filtering Automatic Power Factor
Capacitor Banks Power Factor Correction and Provides power factor correction as well as harmonic filtering with
X X Harmonics Filtering specific harmonic order (5th) in industrial networks.
(AV7000/MV7000)

4
ReactiVar Transient Free Reactive Compensation Enhanced technology utilizing solid state switching elements that
Power Factor Correction and
Systems X replace standard electromechanical contactors. Provides quicker
(AT6000/AT7000) Harmonics Filtering response to load fluctuations with transient free capacitor switching.
Monitors a distorted electrical signal and determines the frequency
and magnitude of harmonics in the signal. Cancels the harmonic
AccuSine™ (PCS) Active Harmonic Filter X X [1] Active Harmonic Filtering content with the dynamic injection of opposing phase current in the
distribution system or individual load.
Reactive Power Compensation Provides real-time reactive power compensation, and voltage
ReactiVar Hybrid VAR Compensator (HVC) X X [1] (Real-time) support in networks with highly cyclical load profiles.

[1] With transformer.


4-39
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
ReactiVar™ Low Voltage Fixed Capacitors

schneider-electric.us

Low Voltage Fixed Capacitors


ReactiVar low voltage fixed capacitors are ideally suited for power factor correction
applications where the load does not change or where the capacitor is switched with the
load, such as on the load side of a motor starter. ReactiVar fixed capacitors are best
suited for applications where there are no harmonic currents or voltages present.
Application Note: Capacitors are low impedance path for the harmonic currents
Features: produced by variable frequency drives, motor soft starters, welders, computers, PLCs,
• Heavy edge, slope metallizations and wave-cut profile to ensure
high inrush current capabilities.
robotics and other electronic equipment. These harmonic currents can cause the
capacitor to overheat, and shorten its life. Furthermore, the resonant circuit formed by
• Special resistivity and profile metallization for better self-healing
and enhanced life (up to 130,000 hours).
shunt capacitors coupled with system inductances (motors and transformers) can
amplify harmonic currents and voltages in the electrical network. This amplification can
• Unique safety feature which disconnects the capacitors at the end
of their useful life electrically.
cause nuisance fuse operation and/or damage to electrical equipment including
capacitors and other electronic devices. If power factor correction is required in the
• Less than 0.5w/kVAR losses, including discharage resistors. network where harmonic is present, please contact your nearest Square D/Schneider
Electric sales office for assistance.
• Constructed with a dry type metalized polypropylene capacitor
element with no liquid dielectrics.
• Can be easily mounted inside panels or in a stand alone
configuration.

Table 4.45: Unfused 208 V 3 phase/ 60Hz unit [2] Table 4.46: Unfused 240 V 3 phase/ 60Hz unit [2]
Recom- Recom- Recommended circuit
Regular duty Rated Recommended circuit Regular duty Rated mended
kVAR rating mended protection kVAR rating protection
Indoor NEMA 1 Current (A) copper wire Indoor NEMA Current (A) copper
unit device rating[4] 1 unit device rating[4]
size[3] wire size[3]
@ 208 V Catalog @ 208 V Circuit @ 240 V Catalog @ 240 V AWG Fuse Circuit
AWG Fuse Number breaker
Number breaker
2 PFCD1002 6.3 14 15 15 3 PFCD2003 7.2 14 15 15
5 PFCD1005 13.6 10 30 20 6 PFCD2006 15.6 10 35 25
6 PFCD1006 17.7 10 40 25 8 PFCD2008 20.5 8 45 30
7.5 PFCD1007 20.9 8 45 30 10 PFCD2010 24.1 8 50 35
10 PFCD1010 27.1 8 60 40 13 PFCD2013 31.3 6 70 45
13 PFCD1013 35.4 6 75 50 15 PFCD2015 36.1 6 75 50
15 PFCD1015 41.7 4 90 60 17.5 PFCD2017 40.9 6 90 60
17 PFCD1017 48 4 100 70 20 PFCD2020 48.1 4 100 70
21 PFCD1021 59.4 3 125 90 22.5 PFCD2023 55.3 3 125 80
25 PFCD1025 68.8 2 150 100 25 PFCD2025 61.4 3 125 90
27 PFCD1027 75.1 2 150 110 27.5 PFCD2028 68.6 2 150 100
30 PFCD1030 83.4 1 175 125 30 PFCD2030 72.2 2 150 100
34 PFCD1033 93.8 1/0 200 150 32.5 PFCD2033 79.4 1 175 110
37.5 PFCD1037 104.3 2/0 225 150 37.5 PFCD2036 86.6 1 175 125
41 PFCD1040 114.7 2/0 250 175 40 PFCD2040 96.2 1/0 200 150
45 PFCD1045 125.1 3/0 250 175 45 PFCD2045 108.3 2/0 225 150
49 PFCD1048 135.5 4/0 300 200 50 PFCD2050 120.3 2/0 250 175
53 PFCD1053 147 4/0 300 225 60 PFCD2060 144.4 4/0 300 200
60 PFCD1060 168.9 300 kcmil 350 250 70 PFCD2070 169.6 300 kcmil 350 250
70 PFCD1070 198.1 350 kcmil 450 300 80 PFCD2080 194.9 350 kcmil 400 300
80 PFCD1080 222 500 kcmil 450 350 90 PFCD2090 218.9 400 kcmil 450 300
100 PFCD2100 239.4 500 kcmil 500 350

Table 4.47: Unfused 480V 3 phase/ 60Hz unit [2] Table 4.48: Unfused 600V 3 phase/ 60Hz unit [2]
Regular duty Recommend- Recommended circuit Regular Recom-
Rated duty Recommended circuit
kVAR rating Indoor ed copper protection kVAR Rated mended
Current (A) device rating[4] Indoor protection
NEMA 1 unit wire size[3] rating Current (A) copper wire
NEMA 1 device rating[4]
@ 480 V Catalog @ 480 V Circuit size[3]
AWG Fuse unit
Number breaker
6 PFCD4006 7.2 14 15 15 Catalog @ 600 V Circuit
600 V AWG Fuse
Number Breaker
8 PFCD4008 10.2 12 20 15
10 PFCD6010 9.6 12 20 15
10 PFCD4010 12 12 25 20
15 PFCD6015 14.4 10 30 20
12.5 PFCD4012 15 10 30 25
20 PFCD6020 19.2 10 40 30
15 PFCD4015 18 10 40 30
23 PFCD6022 22.1 8 50 35
17 PFCD4017 19.8 8 40 30
25 PFCD6025 24 8 50 35
20 PFCD4020 24 8 50 35
27 PFCD6027 26 8 50 40
25 PFCD4025 30 6 60 45
30 PFCD6030 28.8 8 60 45
27.5 PFCD4027 33 6 70 50
35 PFCD6035 33.6 6 70 50
30 PFCD4030 36 6 75 50
40 PFCD6040 38.4 6 80 60
33 PFCD4033 39.6 6 80 60
45 PFCD6045 43.2 4 90 60
35 PFCD4035 42 4 90 60
50 PFCD6050 48 4 100 70
40 PFCD4040 48 4 100 70
60 PFCD6060 57.6 3 125 80
45 PFCD4045 54 4 110 75
70 PFCD6070 67.2 3 150 100
50 PFCD4050 60 3 125 90
75 PFCD6075 72 2 150 100
60 PFCD4060 72 2 150 100
80 PFCD6080 76.8 1 150 110
65 PFCD4065 78 1 175 110
90 PFCD6090 86.4 1 175 125
70 PFCD4070 84 1 175 125
100 PFCD6100 96 1/0 200 150
75 PFCD4075 90 1/0 200 125
125 PFCD6125 120 3/0 250 175
80 PFCD4080 96 1/0 200 150
150 PFCD6150 144 4/0 300 200
90 PFCD4090 108 2/0 225 150
175 PFCD6175 168 300 kcmil 350 250
100 PFCD4100 120 2/0 250 175
125 PFCD4125 150 250 300 225
150 PFCD4150 180 300 400 250
175 PFCD4175 210 400 450 300
200 PFCD4200 240 500 500 350

[2] For fused unit, add suffix “F” to the existing part number. Consult Schneider Electric sales office for pricing.
[3] Conductor should be copper and rated 90 °C min. Refer to local electrical codes for proper wire size
[4] Consult local electrical codes for proper sizing of molded case circuit breaker frame or disconnect switch rating
4-40
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
LV Standard Automatic Capacitor Banks ReactiVar™

schneider-electric.us

Low Voltage Standard Automatic Capacitor Banks


The AV5000 standard automatic power factor correction banks are designed for
centralized power factor correction to supply varying amounts of reactive power required
to compensate for changing load conditions. The AV5000 banks are ideally suited for
facility electrical distribution systems with TDD (total harmonic current distortion) < = 5%
and THD(V) (total harmonic voltage distortion) < = 5%. An advanced power factor
controller measures plant power factor via a single remote CT. Plus, it switches capacitor
modules in and out of service to maintain a user selected target power factor.
Main Features:
• Modular construction; free standing QED switchboard enclosures (30wx36dx90h) and
allow for easy future expansion
• Rugged design — units are constructed with removable steel panels over heavy
gauge steel frame
• Standard offering available up to 400 kVAR at 208 Vac, 1000 kVAR at 480 or 600 Vac
• Main lugs or main breaker section at your choice
• Dry capacitor element design eliminates risk of fluid leakage, environmental hazard
and drip pans
• Capacitor rated contactors are designed specifically for the switching of capacitive
currents and feature a patented capacitor precharge circuit that exceeds air-core
reactor transient dampening
The AV5000 is suitable for use where harmonic generating loads are
• Different power factor controller options provide a choice in functionality and control
less than 15% of the total connected load (AV5000 shown here).
sophistication
• Backlit display on controller displays actual power factor (PF), alarms, number of steps
energized and much more
• Available in NEMA 1 and NEMA 3R enclosures
Low Voltage Anti-Resonant and Filtering
Automatic Capacitor Banks
ReactiVar AV6000 anti-resonant and AV7000 harmonic filtering automatic switched
capacitor banks are specifically designed for networks containing harmonic energies

POWER MONITORING AND


which would otherwise damage standard fixed or automatic capacitor banks.
The problem: Harmonics are caused by non-linear loads such as variable frequency
drives, motor soft starters, welders, uninterruptable power supplies, robotics, PLCs and
other electronic devices. Harmonics are higher-than-60 Hz current and voltage

CONTROL
components in the electrical distribution system. Capacitors are a low impedance path
for these higher frequency components and thus absorb the harmonic energies.
Combinations of capacitors and system inductances (motors and transformers) can form
series and parallel tuned circuits which can resonate at certain frequencies. The
harmonics caused by non-linear loads can excite a standard capacitor bank into
resonance. The resonance can magnify currents and voltages, causing system wide
damage and equipment failure. This problem is growing in today's distribution systems.
The Solution: Anti-Resonant Automatic Capacitor Banks The AV6000 anti-
resonance capacitor bank's primary function is power factor correction. Iron core
reactors are added in series with the capacitor modules. The 3 phase reactors are
custom designed and manufactured under tight tolerance specifically for the AV6000.
The reactors tune the bank below the first dominant harmonic (usually the 5th, or 300

4
Hz). Below the tuning point, the system appears capacitive and thus corrects power
factor. Above the tuning point, the system appears Inductive and thus resonance is
minimized. The AV6000 design has the added advantage of removing up to 50% of the
AV 6000 Capacitor Bank 5th harmonic to reduce overall voltage distortion.
Harmonic Filtering Automatic Capacitor Banks Although the AV7000 looks identical
to the AV6000, its primary function is harmonic mitigation, with power factor correction
being a secondary benefit. The distinction between an AV6000 and an AV7000 is the
tuning point. By definition, if the tuning point of the capacitor/reactor combination is within
±10% of the target harmonic it is intended to absorb, it is referred to as a filter. If the
tuning point is outside the ±10% limit, it is referred to as an anti-resonant system.
Schneider Electric power quality solution experts should be consulted prior to
recommending AV7000 to customers.
Main Features:
• Standard offering available up to 480 kVAR at 208 V, 1200 kVAR at 480 or 600 Vac
• Capacitor modules are designed with higher than standard voltage and current ratings
to provide long life on systems with high harmonic energies. Reactors are designed to
operate at 115 °C rise over a maximum 40 °C ambient temperature.
• In addition to the standard features provided in the AV5000 systems, the reactors in
the AV6000 and AV7000 have an embedded thermistor temperature detector. The
stage will shut down and annunciate if the reactor is overheated, usually a result of
excessive harmonic energies
Application Assistance: Schneider Electric power quality experts can provide
engineering assistance for the application of capacitors in harmonic rich environments.
Specialists can assess the likelihood of application problems and arrange for more
detailed study if required. Solutions can include computer modeling and system
simulation. Our application engineers can arrange for systems studies, provide custom
engineering proposal, perform installation and commissioning, as required by the
application. Please contact Schneider Electric power quality experts or email us at
[email protected].

4-41
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
ReactiVar™ Current Transformer Selection Information

schneider-electric.us

CT Selection
The current transformer is located on a phase A bus or cable at the main service
entrance as illustrated in Diagram 1.
CT catalog number: TRAI• • • •SC ♦ ♦ where • • • • is current rate code of bus/cable and ♦
♦ is window size code. Codes are listed in table 4.42. e.g. TRAI1000SC07 is a CT for
1000 A bus with 7"x4" window.
Table 4.49: CT Selection Table
Current Rating of Bus/Cable Window Size
Amperes Rating Code 7" x 4" Size Code 11" x 4" Size Code
•••• ♦♦ ♦♦
300 0300 07 11
400 0400 07 11
500 0500 07 11
600 0600 07 11
750 0750 07 11
800 0800 07 11
1000 1000 07 11
1200 1200 07 11
1500 1500 07 11
1600 1600 07 11
2000 2000 07 11
2500 2500 07 11
3000 3000 07 11
3500 3500 07 11
4000 4000 07 11
5000 5000 N/A 11
6000 6000 N/A 11

Low Voltage Transient Free Reactive Compensation Capacitor


Banks
Square D™ ReactiVar Transient Free Reactive Compensation (TFRC) anti-resonant
(AT/BT6000) systems and filtering system (AT/BT7000) are ideally suited for use on
electrical systems where connected equipment is extremely sensitive to variations in the
supply voltage.
The problem: Capacitor systems featuring electromechanical contactors could generate
voltage transients on the electrical network when they switch capacitor stages on/off,
even when current limiting or tuning reactors are employed. Transients can impair the
operation of sensitive equipment, including programmable logic controllers, variable
speed drives, computers and UPS systems. In sensitive networks such as hospitals,
data processing centers, airports and many manufacturing environments, any transient,
however slight, may not be acceptable.
The solution: TFRC systems feature an advanced controller to precisely activate
electronic switching elements to connect capacitor stages and avoid the creation of
transients. Transient free switching also reduces wear on capacitors due to switching
and will result in longer life for the overall capacitor system. With a response time of less
than ten seconds to load changes, TFRC systems can reduce the kVAR or kVA demand
quickly.
Main Features:
• Standard offering up to 1350 kVAR at 480 Vac
• Transient free switching of capacitor steps
• Electronic switching elements yield an unlimited number of switching operations
• Different power factor controller options provide a choice in functionality and control
sophistication
• Backlit display on controller displays actual PF, alarms, number of steps energized
and much more
• Heavy duty dry capacitor element design provides no risk of fluid leakage, no
environmental pollution and no need for drip pans
• The reactors have an embedded thermistor temperature detector. The stage will shut
down and annunciate if the reactor is overheated which is usually a result of excessive
harmonic energies
• Units
frame.
are constructed with removable heavy duty steel panels over heavy gauge steel

• Available in NEMA 1 and NEMA 3R enclosures.


AT6000 Transient Free Capacitor Bank

4-42
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Fixed Capacitors ReactiVar™

schneider-electric.us
Low Voltage Capacitor Bank General Specifications
208, 240, 480, 600 Vac standard, other
Voltage:
voltages available
Ambient temperature: -5 °C to 40 °C
Average temperature <=40 °C within 24 hours, <35 °C over 1 year
limit:
Elevation: <=1800 meter (6000 feet)
Humidity: 0–95% non-condensing
Overvoltage limit: 110% maximum (continuously)
Dielectric withstand test 2.15 times rated voltage or 1000 V,
level: whichever is higher for 10s
Overcurrent limit: 135% maximum (continuously)
Incoming: Top (standard), bottom.
Main lug: Copper mechanical standard, compression
optional
Main breaker (BT): PowerPact™ with Micrologic™ trip unit. LI
standard, LSI available
Enclosure rating: NEMA 1 standard, N3R available
ANSI 49 standard, ANSI 61, ANSI 70
Color: optional
Standards: CSA C22.2 No. 190, UL810

POWER MONITORING AND


Typical low voltage capacitor bank dimension
(reference only, subject to change without notice)

CONTROL
Medium Voltage Fixed Capacitors
The ReactiVar MVC fixed capacitors are ideally suited for power factor correction in
applications where the load does not change or where the capacitor is switched with the
load, such as the load side of a motor contactor. ReactiVar capacitor sizes are available
up to 300 kVAR as individual units, and up to 900 kVAR in banks.
Main Features:
• Standard rating up to 900 kVAR, 4800 V (for specials, consult factory)
• Extra low dielectric loss (<0.15w/kVAR), including discharge resistors
• Internally mounted discharge resistors
• Internally delta connected capacitor elements

4
• Built to applicable NEMA, IEEE, and IEC standards
• Available in indoor (Type 1/12) and outdoor (Type 3R) enclosures
• Painted ASA 70 gray
Application Note:
Capacitors are low impedance path for the harmonic currents produced by variable
frequency drives, motor soft starters, welders, computers, PLCs, robotics and other
electronic equipment. These harmonic currents can cause the capacitor to overheat, and
shorten its life. Furthermore, the resonant circuit formed by shunt capacitors coupled with
system inductances (motors and transformers) can amplify harmonic currents and
voltages in the electrical network. This amplification can cause nuisance fuse operation
and/or damage to electrical equipment including capacitors and other electronic devices.
If power factor correction is required in the network where harmonic is present, please
contact your nearest Square D/Schneider Electric sales office for assistance.
MVC systems are suitable for
power factor correction of steady
and harmonic-free motor loads.

4-43
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
ReactiVar™ Medium Voltage Metal Enclosed Capacitor
Systems
schneider-electric.us

Medium Voltage Metal Enclosed Capacitor Systems


The medium voltage capacitor systems are ideally suited for centralized power factor
correction and/or harmonic filtering in applications. Various equipment topologies are
available, from fixed stage to fully automatic—to cover project specific application, load
characteristic and installation needs. ReactiVar brand covers metal enclosed systems
built in North America (5/15 kV class). Global =S= Brand can be used for expanded
voltage range.
Main Features:
• Designed and built per applicable ANSI/NEMA/IEEE and/or IEC standards
• Standard metal enclosures available up to 20 mVAR, up to 34.5 kV, 50/60 Hz
• Steel or Aluminum based enclosure bays
• Externally or internally fused capacitors with excellent life due to high temperature
withstand, small temperature rise, chemical stability, overvoltage and overcurrent
withstand.
• Current limiting capacitor fuses with blown fuse pop-up indicators
• Inrush current limiting reactors or tuned (anti-resonant or filtered) iron core reactors
• Key interlocking system forces sequential operation of the controls,
• Fully rated three- or four-pole grounding switches
MV5000 systems are suitable for use where harmonic generating
loads are less than 15% of the total connected load.
• Schneider Electric NRC12 Power factor controller provides user with friendly interface,
superior performance, simplified installation and set-up procedure, and real time
MV6000 systems are suitable for use where harmonic generating
loads are less than 50% of the total connected load. monitoring and protection features for the capacitor system.
MV7000 systems are suitable for use where harmonic generating
loads exceed 50% of the total connected load. • Available in Type 1 indoor and 3R outdoor enclosure types
MVHVC High-Speed compensation systems are designed for reactive
power compensation of rapidly fluctuating loads.

High Voltage Reactive Power Compensation Systems


The high voltage reactive power compensation systems are ideally suited for installation
at utility distribution and transmission grids. Various equipment topologies are available
4

to cover project specific utility application, and installation needs. Typically these
compensation systems are open style, rack mounted, installed in utility substation areas.
Main Features:
• Custom designed and built per requested applicable standards
POWER MONITORING AND

• Systems rated up to 230 kV, 50/60 Hz


• Internally fused capacitors with excellent life due to high temperature withstand, small
temperature rise, chemical stability, overvoltage and overcurrent withstand.
• Double wye ungrounded configuration with neutral CT protection
CONTROL

• Inrush current limiting or tuned (anti-resonant or filtered) air core, open style reactors

4-44
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PCS+ Active Harmonic Filter AccuSine™
Class 5820
schneider-electric.us

AccuSine PCS+ Active Harmonic Filter (AHF)


AccuSine PCS+ Active Harmonic Filter (AHF) injects harmonic current to cancel
harmonic current in the electrical distribution system. This reduced harmonic level results
in improved electrical network reliability and reduced operating cost. AccuSine PCS+ is
simple to size, install, set up and operate. In addition, AccuSine PCS+ eliminates the
complex harmonic compliance limit calculations and removes nuisance harmonics from
the electrical network.
The Problem:
Power electronic devices that have rapid and frequent load variations have become
abundant today due to their many process control related and energy saving benefits.
However, they also bring a few major drawbacks to electrical distribution systems;
harmonics and rapid change of reactive power requirement. Harmonics may disrupt
normal operation of other devices and increase operating costs. Symptoms of
problematic harmonic levels include overheating of transformers, motors, drives, cables,
thermal tripping of protective devices and logic faults of digital devices. In addition, the
life span of many devices can be reduced by elevated operating temperature.
The Solution:
The AccuSine PCS+ AHF provides the simplest and most effective means to mitigate
harmonics, to reduce process related voltage fluctuations. The AccuSine PCS+ AHF
actively injects opposite harmonics current on the source side of the load and it:
• Decreases harmonic related overheating of cables, switchgear and transformers
• Reduces downtime caused by nuisance thermal tripping of protective devices
• Increases electrical network reliability and reduces operating costs
• Corrects to the 51st harmonic, reduce harmonics level to meet IEEE 519, IEC 61000
3-4, and UK G5/4-1 standards.
• Compensates entire network or specific loads depending on installation point
Standard Features:
• Real-time dynamic current injection for harmonic cancellation and VAR compensation
(lead or lag power factor)

POWER MONITORING AND


• Load balancing capability
• Parallel connection allows for easy retrofit and installation of multiple units for large
networks
• Response to load fluctuations within 2 cycles for harmonics, 1/4 cycle for power factor

CONTROL
or load balancing
• Full color touch screen HMI (Human Machine Interface)
• UL Type 1, UL Type 2, UL Type 12, IP31, and IP54 enclosures
• Seismic rated per ICC IBC and ASCE 7
• UL, CE, ABS, and CSA certified
AccuSine PCS+ Sizing
For proper sizing of AccuSine units, contact the Schneider Electric sales office or e-mail
[email protected]. To expedite the product selection process,
please have a single line diagram and/or details of the application including sizes of
transformers, non-linear and linear loads, and any existing filters and capacitors.

4
Table 4.50: PCS+ Active Harmonic Filter Selection
Harmonic and PF Correction (380–480 V models, 50/60 Hz)
Enclosure Information
Rated Current (A) Frequency (Hz) Catalog Number Frame Weight (kg)
Rating Style Cable Entry
PCSP060D5IP00 IP00 (UL Type Open) Wall Mount Bottom 1 88
PCSP060D5N2 UL Type 2
277
60 50/60 PCSP060D5IP31 IP31
Floor Standing Top or Bottom 2
PCSP060D5N12 UL Type 12
280
PCSP060D5IP54 IP54
PCSP120D5IP00 IP00 (UL Type Open) Wall Mount Bottom 3 113
PCSP120D5N2 UL Type 2
287
120 50/60 PCSP120D5IP31 IP31
Floor Standing Top or Bottom 4
PCSP120D5N12 UL Type 12
293
PCSP120D5IP54 IP54
PCSP200D5IP00 IP00 (UL Type Open) Wall Mount Bottom 5 171
PCSP200D5N2 UL Type 2
397
200 50/60 PCSP200D5IP31 IP31
Floor Standing Top or Bottom 6
PCSP200D5N12 UL Type 12
402
PCSP200D5IP54 IP54
PCSP300D5IP00 IP00 (UL Type Open) Wall Mount Bottom 7 210
PCSP300D5N2 UL Type 2
422
300 50/60 PCSP300D5IP31 IP31
Floor Standing Top or Bottom 8
PCSP300D5N12 UL Type 12
436
PCSP300D5IP54 IP54
NOTE: Contact Schneider Electric sales office for other voltage models.

4-45
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
AccuSine™ PFV+ Active Harmonic Filter
Class 5820
schneider-electric.us

AccuSine PFV+ Active Harmonic Filter (AHF)


AccuSine PFV+ is a very simple and effective means to eliminate leading or lagging
power factor, reduce voltage fluctuations, enhance equipment operating life, and
improve system power capacity. AccuSine PFV+ offers many features in one package
that others require multiple models to accomplish.
AccuSine PFV+ can help you solve:
• Power factor
• Imbalance (specifically important for motor applications)
• Voltage stability (such as localized photovoltaic networks)
• Flicker
AccuSine PFV+ Sizing
For proper sizing of AccuSine units, contact the Schneider Electric sales office or e-mail
[email protected]. To expedite the product selection process,
please have a single line diagram and/or details of the application including sizes of
transformers, non-linear and linear loads, and any existing filters and capacitors.
4

Table 4.51: AccuSine PFV+ Selection


PF Correction and Load Balancing (380-480V models 50/60Hz)
Rated Current Enclosure Information
Frequency (Hz) Catalog Number Frame Weight (kg)
(A) Rating Style Cable Entry
EVCP060D5IP00 IP00 (UL Type Open) Wall Mount Bottom 1 88
POWER MONITORING AND

EVCP060D5N2 UL Type 2
277
60 50/60 EVCP060D5IP31 IP31
Floor Standing Top or Bottom 2
EVCP060D5N12 UL Type 12
280
EVCP060D5IP54 IP54
CONTROL

EVCP120D5IP00 IP00 (UL Type Open) Wall Mount Bottom 3 113


EVCP120D5N2 UL Type 2
287
120 50/60 EVCP120D5IP31 IP31
Floor Standing Top or Bottom 4
EVCP120D5N12 UL Type 12
293
EVCP120D5IP54 IP54
EVCP200D5IP00 IP00 (UL Type Open) Wall Mount Bottom 5 171
EVCP200D5N2 UL Type 2
397
200 50/60 EVCP200D5IP31 IP31
Floor Standing Top or Bottom 6
EVCP200D5N12 UL Type 12
402
EVCP200D5IP54 IP54
EVCP300D5IP00 IP00 (UL Type Open) Wall Mount Bottom 7 210
EVCP300D5N2 UL Type 2
422
300 50/60 EVCP300D5IP31 IP31
Floor Standing Top or Bottom 8
EVCP300D5N12 UL Type 12
436
EVCP300D5IP54 IP54

AccuSine+ Wall Mount Conversion Kit


• Converts IP00 (UL Type Open) to IP20 (UL Type 1) wall mounted enclosed
assemblies.
• Includes HMI mounting plate and cable entry enclosure for mounting on the bottom of
the IP00 assemblies.

Table 4.52: AccuSine PCS+ and AccuSine PFV+ Table 4.53: AccuSine+ Wall Mount Kits
IP20 Cable Entry
Exterior Dimensions Assembled Dimensions — IP20 Assembly Enclosure
Catalog Number
Frame Exterior Dimensions Unit Rating
(A) Height Width Depth Weight (kg) Weight (kg)
Size Height (mm) Width (mm)
1 1300 421 PCSPWMKIT60A 60 1530 421 349 97.3 8.7
2 2092 800 PCSPWMKIT120A 120 1730 421 384 122.0 9.3
3 1400 421 PCSPWMKIT300A 200 1642 575 435 180.0 8.6
4 2089 800 PCSPWMKIT300A 300 1882 575 435 218.6 8.6
5 1323 582
6 2089 900
7 1560 582
8 2092 900

4-46
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Current Transformers AccuSine™
Class 5820
schneider-electric.us

Round Split-Core Current Transformer (CT) Selection:


Two remote current transformers (CT) are required for three phase loads. Three CT’s are
required for networks with line to neutral loads. Depending on installation, additional CTs
may be required. Additional sizes are available.

Table 4.54: Round Split-Core CT—UL Recognized


Weight Burden
Ampacity Catalog Dimensions Accuracy Capacity Secondary
Number Class (VA) Current
in mm lbs kg
A 4 101
B 1.25 32
1000 CT1000SC 3.5 1.75 1 10 5
C 1.5 38
D 6.5 165
A 6 152
B 1.25 32
3000 CT3000SC 4.25 1.90 1 45 5
C 1.5 38
D 8.5 216
A 8 203
CTFC- B 1.25 32
5000 5.5 2.50 1 45 5
L500058 C 1.5 38
D 10.5 267

POWER MONITORING AND


4 CONTROL

4-47
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
AccuSine™ Hybrid VAR Compensator (HVC)
Class 5890
schneider-electric.us

Hybrid VAR Compensator (HVC)


The Hybrid VAR Compensator (HVC) is ideally suited for industrial facilities with power
quality or production problems caused by rapidly changing reactive power demands
Main typically associating with highly cyclical loads such as welders, mining conveyors and
Breaker heavy stamping machines.
(Optional)
The Problem: Rapid reactive power changes demand timely reactive power (VAR)
compensation. Lack of timely and adequate VAR compensation can lead to voltage
fluctuations in the electrical distribution system, impacting equipment operation, as well
as product quality.
Traditional capacitor systems have a minimum response time of five to thirty seconds for
load fluctuations. As a result of this limitation, uncompensated reactive power demand by
cyclical loads can produce voltage instability, cause flicker, increase losses, and result
poor power factor which reduces the electric supply capacity. Problems can include:
• Poor weld quality or reduced weld line productivity (due to restrikes or interlock weld
controls)
• Failure to start motor loads (due to voltage sag on startup)
• Undervoltage tripping of sensitive loads (Robots, PLCs, VFDs)
AccuSine • Lighting flicker and/or HID lighting shutdown
PFV+ • Overloaded distribution equipment (cyclical current pulses may exceed the rated
current of the distribution equipment)
• Poor power factor and associated utility demand charges
The Solution: The Hybrid VAR Compensator is ideally suited for ultra fast reactive
100 k VAR 100 k VAR 100 k VAR 300 Ampere power compensation in many low and medium voltage distribution networks containing
PASSIVE ACTIVE highly transient loads where conventional systems are not suitable.
HVC Topology ( Typical) The HVC employs a fixed or automatic capacitor bank to provide reactive power at all
times, while AccuSine PFV+ adjusts the output to meet system reactive power
requirement in timely manner. AccuSine PFV+ provides dynamic VAR injection to meet
4

reactive power requirement within 1/4 cycle, reduce voltage sags created by inductive
load switching, welding operation, etc.
HVC systems can alleviate most of the problems created by cyclical loads that require
Main Features: large amount of reactive power for short duration. HVC system can be applied in the low
voltage and medium voltage system from 480 V up to 33 kV.
• Real-time reactive power compensation for
POWER MONITORING AND

transient or cyclical loads Unique, cost-effective construction: The ReactiVar HVC is a custom engineered
• Infinite VAR resolution product designed for specific reactive power compensation requirements. It consists of
both passive and active components. The passive component may consist of capacitors
• Transient free compensation
CONTROL

only or include tuned reactors. Depending on the application, the passive portion may
• Improves voltage stability, reduces flicker include contactor or solid state switching device to permit some adjustment of the
• Constructed with 12 gauge steel frame passive elements. The active component is provided by Schneider Electric’s AccuSine
PFV+ unit. HVC systems also can prevent resonance by including custom designed iron
core reactors in series with each three phase capacitor module when required. The
series reactor/capacitor combinations prevent resonance by turning the network below
the first dominant harmonic (usually the 5th and 300 Hz). In doing so, HVC can also
reduce harmonic voltage distortion, which further improves overall network conditions.
The HVC employs a fixed capacitor bank to inject leading reactive current (leading
kVAR) into the network at all times, and an AccuSine PFV+ unit to precisely adjust the
total output of the HVC according to the load reactive power demand profile. When load
reactive demand is zero, the AccuSine PFV+ injects lagging reactive current to cancel
the leading reactive current of the fixed capacitor bank such that the total output of the
HVC is minimized. As the load kVAR demand increases, the AccuSine PFV+ adjusts its
output such that the total output of the HVC precisely matches the load demand. If load
demand increases above the fixed capacitor bank capability, then the AccuSine PFV+
injects leading reactive current. This continues until the full leading kVAR capacity of the
AccuSine PFV+ is met. Thus, the HVC total output provides leading kVAR compensation
to match load demand.
To optimize system design, Schneider Electric expert will normally need to take real-time
measurements on the network site. Please contact Schneider Electric power quality
experts or email us at [email protected].

4-48
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
VarSet Low-Voltage Capacitor Banks

schneider-electric.us

VarSet Low Voltage Capacitor Banks


Standard VLVAW2N Standard VLVAW3N Detuned VLVAF4P/
VLVFF4P
Lugs 125 to 250 KVAR
480 V 60 Hz Incoming Circuit 25 to 100 KVAR 75 to 200 KVAR
125 to 300 KVAR
Breaker
Lugs
600 V 60 Hz Incoming Circuit 25 to 100 KVAR 125 to 250 KVAR 75 to 200 KVAR
Breaker

Key Features
• Auxiliary transformer (120 V) included
• Top cable entry and connections
• NEMA 1
Options
• Incoming circuit breaker protection option with rotary handle
• Plinth accessory for floor mounting
– Included for VLVAF4P and VLVFF4P version.
Plinth for Floor Mounting – For VLVAW2N and VLVAW3N versions, order the following:
for Enclosure VLVAW2N: order NSYSPF8100 and NSYSPS4100
for Enclosure VLVAW3N: order NSYSPF10100 and NSYSPS4100
• Communication option: NRC12 controller + modbus communication module. Order
your reference with addition of suffix C.
• Sprinkler proof: Included in 600 V offer
Table 4.55: General Characteristics
VarSet
Environment
Installation Indoor
Humidity up to 95%
Maximum altitude 2000 m

POWER MONITORING AND


Enclosure
Degree of protection NEMA 1
Color RAL 7035
Degree of mechanical resistance IK10

CONTROL
Steps
Step protection With circuit breaker
Electrical Characteristics
Connection type Three-phase
< 2.5 W/kVAR without detuned reactors
Power losses
< 6 W/kVAR with detuned reactors
Tuning order (VarSet Detuned) 4.2 p.u. (60 Hz ref)
Maximum permissible over voltage 1.1 x Un, 8 h every 24 h
Standards
CSA 22.2 No. 190
UL810, UL508a
Incoming Connection Short Circuit With Incoming Circuit Breaker With Lugs
Rating
65 kA (480 V)

4
From 25 to 100 KVAR/no reactors 25 kA
50 kA (600 V)
65 kA (480 V)
From 125 to 300 KVAR/no reactors 25 kA
50 kA (600 V)
65 kA (480 V)
With reactors 25 kA
50 kA (600 V)
NOTE: A Current Transformer is required for automatic Control. In order to have
automatic control, a current transformer must be ordered in addition to the PFC
bank. A current transformer (not included) is necessary to provide accurate network
information to the VarSet’s controller in order to apply the correct quantity of kVAR at
any given time. It is recommended to choose a Split Core Current Transformer
Model 270R from the following list of options.
NOTE: CT must be sized to your network and have a secondary rating of 5A. More
details on the CT can be found in document 4210CT9701.
NOTE: When selecting a CT, be sure to use proper rating factors for ambient
temperature conditions.
Table 4.56: Current Transformers
Catalog Number Current Rating (Amperes)[1]
270R-501 500:5
270R-102 1000:5
270R-152 1500:5
270R-202 2000:5
270R-302 [2] 3000:5
270R-402 [2] 4000:5

[1] Rating Factor 30 °C/80 °F Ambient Temp. = 1.33


Rating Factor 55 °C/131 °F Ambient Temp. = 1.0
[2] Models -302 and -402
Rating Factor 30 °C/80 °F Ambient Temp. = 1.0
Rating Factor 55 °C/131 °F Ambient Temp. = 0.75
4-49
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
VarSet Low-Voltage Capacitor Banks

schneider-electric.us

VarSet Selection[3]

Table 4.57: 480 V/60 Hz, Low-Polluted Network Table 4.58: 600 V/60 Hz, Low-Polluted Network
Standard Catalog Numbers Standard Catalog Numbers
Power Lugs Incoming CB Power Lugs Incoming CB
25 VLVAW2N66025AA VLVAW2N66025AB 25 VLVAW2N76025AA VLVAW2N76025AB
50 VLVAW2N66050AA VLVAW2N66050AB 50 VLVAW2N76050AA VLVAW2N76050AB
75 VLVAW2N66075AA VLVAW2N66075AB 75 VLVAW2N76075AA VLVAW2N76075AB
100 VLVAW2N66100AA VLVAW2N66100AB 100 VLVAW2N76100AA VLVAW2N76100AB
125 VLVAW3N66125AA VLVAW3N66125AB 125 VLVAW3N76125AA VLVAW3N76125AB
150 VLVAW3N66150AA VLVAW3N66150AB 150 VLVAW3N76150AA VLVAW3N76150AB
175 VLVAW3N66175AA VLVAW3N66175AB 175 VLVAW3N76175AA VLVAW3N76175AB
200 VLVAW3N66200AA VLVAW3N66200AB 200 VLVAW3N76200AA VLVAW3N76200AB
225 VLVAW3N66225AA VLVAW3N66225AB 225 VLVAW3N76225AA VLVAW3N76225AB
250 VLVAW3N66250AA VLVAW3N66250AB 250 VLVAW3N76250AA VLVAW3N76250AB
275 VLVAW3N66275AB VLVAW3N66275AB
300 VLVAW3N66300AB VLVAW3N66300AB

Table 4.59: 480 V/60 Hz, Polluted Network, Detuned Reactors Table 4.60: 600 V/60 Hz, Polluted Network, Detuned Reactors
Automatic Catalog Numbers Automatic Catalog Numbers
Power Lugs Incoming CB Power Lugs Incoming CB
75 VLVAF4P66075AA VLVAF4P66075AB 75 VLVAF4P76075AA VLVAF4P76075AB
100 VLVAF4P66100AA VLVAF4P66100AB 100 VLVAF4P76100AA VLVAF4P76100AB
125 VLVAF4P66125AA VLVAF4P66125AB 125 VLVAF4P76125AA VLVAF4P76125AB
150 VLVAF4P66150AA VLVAF4P66150AB 150 VLVAF4P76150AA VLVAF4P76150AB
175 VLVAF4P66175AA VLVAF4P66175AB 175 VLVAF4P76175AA VLVAF4P76175AB
200 VLVAF4P66200AA VLVAF4P66200AB 200 VLVAF4P76200AA VLVAF4P76200AB
Fixed Catalog Numbers Fixed Catalog Numbers
Power Lugs Incoming CB Power Lugs Incoming CB
75 VLVFF4P66075AA VLVFF4P66075AB 75 VLVFF4P76075AA VLVFF4P76075AB
100 VLVFF4P66100AA VLVFF4P66100AB 100 VLVFF4P76100AA VLVFF4P76100AB
125 VLVFF4P66125AA VLVFF4P66125AB 125 VLVFF4P76125AA VLVFF4P76125AB
150 VLVFF4P66150AA VLVFF4P66150AB 150 VLVFF4P76150AA VLVFF4P76150AB
175 VLVFF4P66175AA VLVFF4P66175AB 175 VLVFF4P76175AA VLVFF4P76175AB
200 VLVFF4P66200AA VLVFF4P66200AB 200 VLVFF4P76200AA VLVFF4P76200AB

Table 4.61: Physical and Electrical Steps (480 V and 600 V/60 Hz)
Num
Type Min Step Mechanical Num Electrical Sequence Electrical Steps (Resolution)
kVAR Resolution
POWER MONITORING AND

Steps (CBs) Steps


25 125 2x12,5 2 2 1,111 12,5/25,0
50 125 2x12.5 + 1x25 3 4 1.1.2.2 12,5/25,0/37,5/50,0
75 125 1x12,5 + 1x25 + 1x37,5 3 6 1,233 12,5/25,0/37,5/50,0/62,5/ 75,0
100 25 2x25 + 50 3 4 1,122 25/50/75/100
125 25 1x25 + 2x50 3 5 1.2.2.2 25/50/75/100/125
150 25 2x25 + 2x50 4 6 1.1.2.2 25/50/75/100/125/150
Standard
175 25 1x25 + 3x50 4 7 1,222 25/50/75/100/125/150/175
200 25 2x25 + 3x50 5 5 11,222 25/50/75/100/125/150/ 175/200
225 25 1x25 + 4x50 5 9 1.2.2.2 25/50/75/100/125/150/175/ 200/225
250 50 5x50 5 5 1,111 50/100/150/200/250
275 25 1x25 + 5x50 6 11 1,222 25/50/75/100/125/150/175/ 200/225/250/275
300 50 6x50 6 6 1.1.1.1 50/100/150/200/250/300
75 25 1x25 + 1x50 2 3 1,222 25/50/75
100 25 2x25 + 1x50 3 4 1,122 25/50/75/100
125 25 1x25 + 2x50 3 5 1.2.2.2 25/50/75/100/125
Detuned
150 25 2x25 + 2x50 4 6 1,122 25/50/75/100/125/150
175 25 1x25 + 3x50 4 7 1.2.2.2 25/50/75/100/125/150/175
200 50 4x50 4 4 1,111 50/100/150/200

[3] Low-Polluted Network = TDDi < 8%, THD(V) < 3%


Polluted Network = TDDi < 20%, THD(V) < 7%
4-50
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
VarSet Low-Voltage Capacitor Banks

schneider-electric.us

VarSet Dimensions and Weights

Table 4.62: VLVAW2N


VLVAW2N [4]
H 850 mm / 33.5 in.
W 800 mm / 31.5 in.
D 400 mm / 15.7 in.
D1 1200 mm / 47.2 in.
Weight 80 kg / 175 lbs.

VLVAW2N

Table 4.63: VLVAW3N


VLVAW3N [4]
H 1200 mm / 47.2 in.
W 1000 mm / 39.4 in.
D 400 mm / 15.7 in.
D1 1400 mm / 55.1 in.
Weight 125 kg / 275 lbs.

VLVAW3N

Table 4.64: VLVAF4P and VLVFF4P

POWER MONITORING AND


VLVAF4P / VLVFF4P
H 1200 mm / 47.2 in.
W 1300 mm / 51.2 in.
D 400 mm / 15.7 in.
D1 1200 mm / 47.2 in.

CONTROL
Weight 265 kg / 585 lbs.

VLVAF4P and VLVFF4P

[4] Does not include plinth for VLVAW2N and VLVAW3N, optional, which adds 100 mm to height.
4-51
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
VarSet Low-Voltage Capacitor Banks

schneider-electric.us
4
POWER MONITORING AND
CONTROL

4-52
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents

Section 5
Advanced Products
Wis e r™ Air Wiser™ Energy Efficiency Solutions 5-2

Wiser™ Energy Efficiency Solutions 5-2


Wiser Air 5-2
Residential Solar Power Solutions 5-3

Solar Inverters 5-3


Conext™ CL-NA Three-Phase Grid-Tie Inverter 5-3
Conext™ XW+NA Hybrid Inverter / Charger 5-4
S ola r P owe r S olutions Conext™ SW-NA Hybrid Inverter / Charger 5-6
Conext™ MPPT 80 600 Solar Charge Controller 5-7
Conext™ MPPT 60 150 Solar Charge Controller 5-8

Cone xt™ CL

Cone xt™ XW+

Cone xt™ S ola r Cha rge Controlle r

ADVANCED PRODUCTS
5

© 2017 Schneider Electric


All Rights Reserved 5-1

11/10/2017
Wiser™ Energy Efficiency Solutions Wiser™ Energy Efficiency Solutions

schneider-electric.us

Wiser Air

Wiser Air is a complete home energy management solution that gives you peace of mind
through effortless control of comfort and savings. Wiser Air works with most heating and
cooling low voltage systems and connects to your home Wi-Fi to allow you to see your
energy use remotely, using a smart phone, tablet, or laptop.
• Simplicity – Wiser Air is easy to install and has a sleek, intuitive design with familiar
touch screen display to keep you informed.
• Comfort – Enjoy features like Comfort Boost that quickly delivers comfort at the touch
of a button and helps you use energy more efficiently.
• Insight – See how your system is running from a distance, with Wiser Pulse that
glows a different color depending on different modes.
• Control – Control and manage your home energy use from anywhere with your smart
phone, tablet or laptop. Wiser Air is a stand-alone, Wi-Fi thermostat.
Model Faceplate Color Country of Use
WISERAIR10BLKUS Black USA
WISERAIR10WHTUS White USA
WISERAIR10BLKCA Black Canada
WISERAIR10WHTCA White Canada
Wiser Air is designed for use with HVAC systems using 24 Vac control signaling.
Connection to a WPA-2 encrypted WiFi network is necessary for communication. More
information can be found at www.wiserair.com.
Wiser Air Specifications
Unit Dimensions 4 in. (10.2 cm) H Wire Gauge 18−22 AWG (0.33−0.82
4 in. (10.2 cm) W mm²)
1.2 in. (3 cm) D
Trim Plate Dimensions 4.8 in. (12.2 cm) H Temperature Resolution: 1ºF (0.5°C)
6.3 in. (16 cm) W Control accuracy: 1ºF (0.5°
0.1 in. (0.3 cm) D C)
Cooling setpoint range: 48
5

−95°F (9−35°C)
Heating setpoint range:
45.5−92°F (7.5−33°C)
Display range: 40−95°F (5
−35°C)
Remote sensor
compatibility: 10 k NTC,
Type 2
ADVANCED PRODUCTS

Shipping Weight 1.32 lb (599 g) Humidity Sensor Manufacturer calibrated:


not required
Precision: RH +/-3%
Dehumidification range: N/
A
Screen 2.1 in. (5.4 cm) H Light Sensor Application: LCD-Auto dim
2.8 in. (7.2 cm) W
640 x 480 RGB
Power Requirements Input: ~24 Vac (+/-15%) Occupancy Sensor Application: LCD wake-up
50/60 Hz Wiser Pulse intensity
Consumption: 6 VA
Maximum rating: 100 VA,
4.17 A
Class 2 circuits only
Output Ratings Maximum output: 94 VA Safety Standards UL 873
Relay rating: ~24 Vac, 50/ CSA C22.2 No. 24–93
60 Hz, 1 A RoHS
Inrush = 3 A
Connections: G, W, W2, Y,
Y2, U, O/B
Class 2 circuits only
Operating Conditions Temperature: 32−104ºF (0 EMC and Radio Standards EMC: FCC 15 Subpart B
−40ºC) ICES-003
Humidity: 0−75% R.H. Radio: FCC 15 Subpart C
non-condensing RSS 210
Storage Conditions Temperature: -22−122ºF Network Zigbee (on-board)
(-30−50ºC) Wi-fi (802, 11 b/g/n, 2.4 G
Humidity: 0−75% R.H. Hz)
non-condensing Open ADR ready
Indoor, Dry, Pollution
Degree 2

5-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Solar Inverters Residential Solar Power Solutions

schneider-electric.us

Conext™ CL-NA Three-Phase Grid-Tie Inverter


The Conext™ CL Series is a new line of three-phase string inverters designed for high
efficiency, maximum flexibility, and easy installation and service. Electrolyte-free design
with Schneider Electric’s rigorous reliability test procedures improve the long-term
reliability. Integrated wiring box with multiple options allow for flexible and low-cost
installations. Remote asset management and troubleshooting are easier than ever with
Schneider Electric Conext SmartBox and Conext Insight portal. Decentralized
architecture and system capability together with a broad range of medium voltage
products make Conext CL the ideal choice for commercial buildings and decentralized
power plants. Backed by global service infrastructure, leading manufacturing facilities,
and expertise in energy management, the Conext CL Series is the inverter trusted for
quality and reliability.

Table 5.1: Conext™ CL-NA Series


Electrical Specifications CL18000 NA CL25000 NA CL40000 NA [2]
Input (DC)
Full Power MPPT Voltage Range 300–800 V 500–800 V 540–800 V
Operating Voltage Range 250–1000 V 250–1000 V 250–1000 V
Max. Input Voltage, open circuit 1000 V 1000 V 1000 V
Number of MPPT / Strings per
MPPT [3] 2/4 2/4 1 / 10
Absolute Max. Short Circuit
Current per MPPT 36 A 36 A 108 A
Nominal DC Input Power 19 kW 26.5 kW 42 kW
Max. DC Input Power per MPPT
Schneider Electric Conext [4] 11.4 kW 15.9 kW 42 kW
CL 18 / 25 / 40 kW
String Inverter with Wiring Box DC Connection (in wiring box) Base model: spring cage clamp connector; Screw type
Essential and Optimum models: fuse holder fuse holder
Output (AC)
Features Rated Output Power (PF=1) 18 kW 25 kW 40 kW
Max. Apparent Power 18 kW 25 kW 40 kW
• High conversion efficiency: 98.4% peak efficiency, Nominal Output Voltage 277 / 480 V 277 / 480 V 277 / 480 V
98.0% CEC efficiency
AC Voltage Range 244–305 V / 422–528 V 244–305 V / 422–528 V 244–305 V / 422–528 V
• Large heatsink offers excellent heat dispersion
without the need for a cooling fan Frequency 60 Hz 60 Hz 60 Hz
Frequency Range (adjustable) 60 +/- 3 Hz 60 +/- 3 Hz 60 +/- 3 Hz
• Integrated wiring box saves customer the cost of Max. Output Current 25 A 33 A 50 A
external DC combiner box[1] Nominal Continuous Output
21.7 A 30.1 A 48.1 A
• Built-in Cloud Connect feature to allow direct Current
connection to Conext Insight portal for free remote Total Harmonic Distortion < 3% < 3% < 3%
monitoring Power Factor (adjustable) 0.8 lead to 0.8 lag 0.8 lead to 0.8 lag 0.8 lead to 0.8 lag
AC Connection (in wiring box) Bottom and side conduit / cable entry, spring cage clamp connector.
• Robust design through rigorous Multiple Efficiency
Environmental Over Stress Testing (MEOST),
Highly Accelerated Life Test (HALT) and Peak 98.0% 98.4% 98.4%
CEC 97.5% 98.0% 98.0%
Temperature Humidity and Bias Testing (THB)
General Specifications
• Electrolyte-free design to guard against dried cap Power Consumption at Night Time <3W <3W <3W

ADVANCED PRODUCTS
issue and help to improve long-term reliability Enclosure Rating Type 4 (electronics) Type 4 (electronics) Type 4 (electronics)
• Designed and qualified for applications in tropical Cooling Fan cooled Fan cooled Fan cooled
environments through salt fog testing and use of Inverter Weight 119 lb. (54 kg) 119 lb. (54 kg) 137 lb. (62 kg)
conformal coating Wiring Box Weight 33 lb. (15 kg) 33 lb. (15 kg) 51 lb. (23 kg)
• SunSpect Alliance profile, wire line and wireless
(optional) communication
Inverter Dimensions
(H x W x D)
28.1 x 26.5 x 10.5 in.
(71.4 x 67.4 x 26.8 cm)
28.1 x 26.5 x 10.5 in.
(71.4 x 67.4 x 26.8 cm)
28.1 x 26.7 x 12.0 in.
(71.4 x 67.8 x 30.7 cm)
Wiring Box Dimensions 14.2 x 26.5 x 10.5 in. 14.2 x 26.5 x 10.5 in. 15.6 x 26.7 x 12.0 in.
• Easy installation and service, including pre-wired (H x W x D) (36.1 x 67.4 x 26.8 cm) (36.1 x 67.4 x 26.8 cm) (39.6 x 67.8 x 30.7 cm)
wiring box, detachable inverter, and EasyConfig -13–140°F -13–140°F -13–140°F
tool to allow for fast commissioning. Ambient Air Temp. for Operation (-20–60°C) (-20–60°C) (-20–60°C)
Max Operating Altitude w/o 6560 ft. (2000 m) 6560 ft. (2000 m) 6560 ft. (2000 m)
Derating
Relative Humidity % 4...100 condensing 4...100 condensing 4...100 condensing
Noise Emission (at 1 m distance) < 55 dBA < 55 dBA < 58 dBA

[1] An external fuse protection shall be installed if base model from available product variants is chosen.
[2] Preliminary specification. Specifications are subject to change without notice.
[3] Base model 2/1.
[4] Under unbalanced condition.
5-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Residential Solar Power Solutions Solar Inverters

schneider-electric.us

Conext™ XW+NA Hybrid Inverter / Charger


One solution for global power needs
Conext XW+ is an adapatable single- and three-phase inverter / charger system with
grid-tie functionality and dual AC power inputs. Available solar charge controllers,
monitoring, and automated generator control modules enable further adaptability. From a
single Conext XW+ unit to clusters up to 102 kW, the Conext XW+ is a scalable system
that allows for the integration of solar capacity as required. Adaptable and scalable, the
Schneider Electric Conext XW+ system is the one solution for grid-interactive and off-
grid, residential and commercial, solar and backup power applications.
Features
• Excellent load starting with high 30-minute and
5-second power
• Performs in hot environments up to 158°F (70°C)
• Intelligent functionality enables solar prioritization, load shifting, peak shaving, and
assists small generators with heavy loads
• Backup power with grid-tie functionality converts external DC power to AC power for
export to the utility grid
• Single or three-phase systems from 7.0 to 102 kW
• Supports DC coupled and AC coupled off-grid and grid-tie architectures
• Supports charging of Lithium Ion battery packs
• Field serviceable with replacement boards and
spare parts
• Monitor, troubleshoot, or upgrade firmware with Conext ComBox
• Extensive quality and reliability testing
• Highly Accelerated Life Testing (HALT)
• Globally proven and recognized field performance
• System configures quickly into compact wall-mounted system
• Integrates both grid and generator power with dual AC inputs
Conext XW+NA
• Balance-of-system
generators
components integrates battery bank, solar charger controllers and
Hybrid Inverter / Charger
• Commission the entire system with PC software tool and Conext ComBox
5
ADVANCED PRODUCTS

5-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Solar Inverters Residential Solar Power Solutions

schneider-electric.us

Table 5.2: Conext™ XW+ Series (120/240 V)


Electrical Specifications XW+ 5548 NA XW+ 6848 NA
Inverter AC Output
Output Power (continuous) at 77°F (25°C) 5500 W 6800 W
Overload 30 min / 60 sec at 77°F (25°C) 7000 W / 9500 W 8500 W / 12000 W
Output Power (continuous) at 104°F (40°C) 4500 W 6000 W
Maximum Output Current 60 sec (rms) 82 A (120 V); 41 A (240 V) 102 A (120 V); 52 A (240 V)
Output Frequency (selectable) 50 / 60 Hz 50 / 60 Hz
Output Voltage L-N: 120 V +/- 3%; L-L: 240 V +/- 3%
Total Harmonic Distortion (THD) at Rated Power < 5% < 5%
Idle Consumption Search Mode <8W <8W
Input DC Voltage Range 42–60 V (48 V nominal) 42–60 V (48 V nominal)
Max Input DC Current 150 A 180 A
Charger DC Output
Max. Output Charge Current 110 A 140 A
Output Voltage Range 40–64 V (48 V Nominal) 40–64 V (48 V Nominal)
Charge Control Three stage, two stage, boost, custom
Charge Temperature Compensation Battery temperature sensor included
Power Factor Corrected Charging 0.98 0.98
Compatible Battery Types Flooded (default), GEL, AGM, LiON, Custom [5]
Battery Bank Range (scaled to PV array size) 440–10000 Ah 440–10000 Ah
AC Input
AC 1 (grid) Input Current (selectable limit) 30–60 A (60 A default) 30–60 A (60 A default)
AC 2 (generator) Input Current (selectable limit) 30–60 A (60 A default) 30–60 A (60 A default)
Automatic Transfer Relay Rating/Typical Transfer Time 60 A / 8 ms 60 A / 8 ms
AC Input Voltage Limits (bypass/charge mode) L-N: 78–140 V (120 V nominal) L-L: 160–270 V (240 V nominal)
AC Input Frequency Range (bypass/charge mode) 55–65 Hz (default); 52–68 Hz (allowable)
AC Grid-Tie Output
0–40 A (120 V) 0–48 A (120 V)
Grid Sell Current Range on AC1 (selectable limit)
0–20 A (240 V) 0–27 A (240 V)
Grid Sell Voltage Range on AC1 L-N: 105.5–132 V +/-1.5 V; L-L: 211–264 V +/- 3 V
Grid Sell Frequency Range on AC1 (auto adjust entering sell mode) 59.4–60.4 +/-0.5 Hz
Efficiency
Peak 95.7% 95.7%
CEC Weighted Efficiency 93.0% 92.5%
General Specifications
Part Number 865–5548–01 865–6848–01
Product / Shipping Weight 118 lb. (53.5 kg) / 165 lb. (75 kg) 121.7 lb. (55.2 kg) / 169 lb. (76.7 kg)
Product Dimensions (H x W x D) 23 x 16 x 9 in. (58 x 41 x 23 cm) 23 x 16 x 9 in. (58 x 41 x 23 cm)
28.0 x 22.5 x 15.5 in. 28.0 x 22.5 x 15.5 in.
Shipping Dimensions (H x W x D)
(71.1 x 57.2 x 39.4 cm) (71.1 x 57.2 x 39.4 cm)
IP Degree of Protection NEMA Type 1 Indoor
Operating Air Temperature Range –13–158°F (–25–70°C) power derated above 77°F (25°C)
Warranty (depending on the country of installation) 2 or 5 years 2 or 5 years
Features
System Monitoring and Network Communications Available Available

ADVANCED PRODUCTS
Intelligent Features Grid sell, peak load shave, generator support, prioritized consumption of battery or external DC energy
Auxiliary Port 0–12 V, maximum 250 mA DC output, selectable triggers
Off-grid AC Coupling Frequency Control
Multi-unit Operation Single and split phase: up to four units in parallel, three phase: up to 12 units in multi-cluster configuration with
external AC contractor
Regulatory Approval
Safety UL1741, CSA 107.1
EMC Directive FCC and Industry Canada Class B
Interconnect IEEE 1547 and CSA 107.1
Compatible Products
Conext XW+ Power Distribution Panel 865–1014–01
Conext System Control Panel 865–1050
Conext Automation Generator Start 865–1060
Conext MPPT 60 150 865–1030–1
Conext MPPT 80 600 865–1032
Conext ComBox 865–1058

5
Conext Battery Monitor 865–1080–01
Conext Battery Fuse Combiner Box 865–1031–01
Conext Portable Installation / Configuration Tool 865–1155–01

[5] Specifications subject to change without notice.


5-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Residential Solar Power Solutions Solar Inverters

schneider-electric.us

Conext™ SW-NA Hybrid Inverter / Charger


Conext SW delivers new value and price point to installers and system owners globally.
Perfect for off-grid, backup power and self-consumption applications, it’s a pure sine
wave, inverter/charger system with switchable 50/60 Hz frequencies, providing power for
every need.
North American Conext SW units feature 120/240 Vac output, and is capable of
producing 120/240 Vac output from a 120 Vac input, without the need for an external
transformer.
For expanded off-grid capacity, the Conext SW is integrated with fuel-based generators
as required to support loads larger than the generator’s output. It’s also self consumption
ready, able to prioritize solar consumption over the grid, while maintaining zero grid
export. The Conext SW works with the grid to avoid peak utility charges and support the
grid when utility supply is limited. Accessories include pre-wired universal DC and AC
distribution panels. Stacking two Conext SW units will double the system’s total output
power and available solar charge controllers allow for the integration of solar capacity as
required.

Table 5.3: Conext SW Inverter/Charger


Electrical Specifications SW 2524 NA SW 4024 NA SW 4048 NA
Inverter
Output Power (continuous) at 77°F (25°C) 2400 W 3400 W 3800 W
Output Power 30 min. at 77°F (25°C) 2700 W 4000 W 4400 W
Output Power (5 sec) at 77°F (25°C) 5000 W 7000 W 7000 W
Peak Current 24.3 A 41 A 41 A
Output Frequency (selectable) 50 / 60 Hz 50 / 60 Hz 50 / 60 Hz
Output Voltage 120 / 240 Vac 120 / 240 Vac 120 / 240 Vac
Output Wave Form True Sine Wave True Sine Wave True Sine Wave
Optimal Efficiency 91.5% 92% 92%
Idle Consumption Search Mode < 11 W < 11 W < 11 W
Input DC Voltage Range 20–34 Vdc 20–34 Vdc 4–68 Vdc
AC Connections Single / Split Phase Single / Split Phase Single / Split Phase
Charger
Output Current 65 A 90 A 45 A
Nominal Output Voltage 24 Vdc 24 Vdc 48 Vdc
Output Voltage Range 12–32 Vdc 12–32 Vdc 24–64 Vdc
Conext SW-NA Inverter / Charger Charge Control 3 stage 3 stage 3 stage
Charge Temperature Compensation Yes-BTS Included Yes-BTS Included Yes-BTS Included
Features Optimal Efficiency 90% 90% 90%
• Higher return on investment AC Input Power Factor > 0.98 > 0.98 > 0.98
• Excellent load start capabilities with high 30- Input Current 9A 13 A 13 A
minute and 5-second surge power Input AC Voltage 120 / 240 Vac Split Phase
95–135 Vac Single Phase
• Harness the continuously declining production Input AC Voltage Range Line to Neutral
135–270 Vac Single Phase
cost of solar power Dead Battery Charge Yes [6] Yes [6] Yes [6]
• Robust
(HALT)
design through rigorous reliability testing General Specifications
Compatible Battery Types FLA, Gel, AGM, Custom
• Available in 24 and 48 Vdc models. All models
support both 50 and 60 Hz output
Transfer Relay Rating 30 A 30 A 30 A
Transfer Time (AC to Inverter to AC) < 1 cycle (16.7 ms)
• Stack two units to double output power up to 8 kW Optimal Operating Temperature Range -4–140°F (-20–60°C)

• Supports AC and DC coupled off-grid and grid-tie Storage Ambient Temperature Range -40–185°F (-40–85°C)
architectures Humidity Operation / Storage < =95% RH, non-condensing
Ingress Protection Rating Indoor Only, IP20
• Intelligent functionality enables self-consumption Altitude (operating) 6562 ft. (2000 m)
with solar prioritization, peak shaving, and
assisting small generators with heavy loads Product Weight 49.0 lb. (22.3 kg) 62.0 lb. (28.1 kg) 62.0 lb. (28.1 kg)
Shipping Weight 60.0 lb. (27.2 kg) 77.1 lb. (35.0 kg) 77.1 lb. (35.0 kg)
• Monitor, troubleshoot or upgrade firmware with Product Dimensions (H x W x D) 16.5 x 13.4 x 7.6 in. (41.8 x 34.1 x 19.7 cm)
Conext ComBox
Shipping Dimensions (H x W x D) 22.0 x 17.3 x 12.6 in. (56.0 x 44.0 x 32.0 cm)
• Global support and training System Network and Remote Monitoring Available Available Available
• Replaceable boards and spare parts Warranty (Depending on the Country of
2 or 5 years 2 or 5 years 2 or 5 years
• Configures quickly into compact wall-mounted Installation)
system Part Number 865–2524 865–4024 865–4048
Regulatory Approvals
• Companion circuit breaker panels integrate Safety c(CSA) us mark, CSA C22.2 No. 107.1–01, UL1741 Ed. 2
inverter with battery bank and solar charge
controllers Compatible Products
Universal DC Distribution Panel 865–5548–01
• Mounting bracket design makes hanging inverter AC Distribution Panel (120/240 V) 865–1017
on the wall easy AC Distribution Panel (230 V) 865–1017–61
Conext System Control Panel 865–1050
Conext Automation Generator Start 865–1060
Conext ComBox 865–1058
Conext MPPT 60 150 Solar Charge 865–1030–1
Controller
Conext SW On/Off Remote Switch 865–1052
Conext SW Stacking Kit 865–1019–61 for 230 Vac, 865–1019 for 120/240 Vac
Conext Portable Installation and
Configuration Tool 865–1155–01

[6] Specifications to change without notice.


5-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Solar Inverters Residential Solar Power Solutions

schneider-electric.us

Conext™ MPPT 80 600 Solar Charge Controller


The Conext MPPT 80 600 solar charge controller offers an industry-first set of integration
features and top performance that allows for large photovoltaic (PV) array systems to be
easily installed and connected to the battery bank at the lowest overall cost. Installing
one MPPT 80 600 is faster than installing multiple smaller charge controller and lowers
overall costs further by utilizing fewer PV strings, smaller wiring and conduit, and by
eliminating the need for PV combiner boxes and DC circuit breakers. Longer distances
from array site to battery bank are also easier to accommodate than with smaller charge
controllers. Advanced Fast Sweep Maximum Power Point Tracking (MPPT) charging
technology helps harvest the most energy available from the PV array, even in partial
shade conditions. 80 A of battery charge current allows for the connection of PV arrays
rated up to 600 V STC (2560 W for 24 V systems, 4800 W for 48 V systems).

Table 5.4: Conext MPPT 80 600 Solar Charge Controller


Electrical Specifications [7] MPPT 80 600
Inverter
Nominal Battery Voltage 24 and 48 (default is 48 V)
PV Array Operating Voltage 195–550 V
Max. PV Array Open Circuit Voltage 600 V (including temperature correction factor)
Battery Voltage Operating Range 16 to 67 V dc
Array Short-circuit Current 35 A (28 A at STC)
Max. Charge Current 80 A
Max. and Min. Wire Size in Conduit #6 to #14 AWG
Max. Output Power 2560 W (nominal 24 V), 4800 W (nominal 48 V)
Three-stage [8]
Charger Regulation Method
Two-stage [9]
Supported Battery Types Flooded, GEL, AGM, Custom
Efficiency
Max. Power Conversion Efficiency 94% (nominal 24 V), 96% (nominal 48 V)
General Specifications
Power Consumption (night time) <1W
Battery Temperature Sensor Included
Auxiliary Output Dry Contact Switching up to 60 Vdc, 30 Vac, 8 A
Enclosure Material Indoor, ventilated, sheet metal chassis with 2.2 and 2.8 cm
knockouts and aluminum heat sink
IP Degree of Protection IP 20
MPPT Solar Charge Controller Product Weight 29.8 lb. (13.5 kg)
Features Shipping Weight 38.3 lb. (17.4 kg)

• Installs faster with fewer costly components Product Dimensions (H x W x D)


Shipping Dimensions (H x W x D)
30.0 x 8.6 x 8.6 in. (76.0 x 22.0 x 22.0 cm)
34.3 x 13.0 x 10.6 in. (87.0 x 33.0 x 27.0 cm)
• Improve battery life with selectable multi-stage
temperature compensated charging Device Mounting Vertical wall-mount
Ambient Air Temperature for Operation -4–149°F (-20–65°C)
• Harvest more energy with shade tolerant fast Storage Temperature Range -40–185°F (-40–85°C)
sweep MPPT algorithm
Operating Altitude Sea level to 6562 ft. (2000 m)
• Robust design through rigorous Multiple
Environmental Over Stress Testing (MEOST)
System Network and Remote Monitoring Available
Warranty 5 year standard

ADVANCED PRODUCTS
• Available remote monitoring and configuration Part Number 865–1032
• Compatible with any brand of PV module, any
grounding method
Regulatory Approval
CSA Certified (UL1741, CSA 107.1) and CE Marked for Low
Safety Voltage Directive (EN50178)
• Stand-alone application or full integration with
Context XW inverter charger system EMC
FCC and Industry Canada (Class B), CE Marked for the
EMC Directive (EN61000-6-1, -6-3), C-Tick Compliant
• Fewer string wires Compatible Products
• Smaller AWG wire Conext XW+ Interver/Charger (230 V) XW 7048 E product no. 865-7048-61
XW 8548 E product no. 865-8548-61
• No need for combiner box or GFI circuit breaker Conext XW+ Interver/Charger (120/240 V) XW 5548 NA product no. 865-5548-01
XW 6848 NA product no. 865-6848-01
SW 2524 product no. 865-2524-61
Conext SW (230 V) SW 4024 product no. 865-4024-61
SW 4048 product no. 865-4048-61
SW 2524 product no. 865-2524
Conext SW (120 V) SW 4024 product no. 865-4024
SW 4048 product no. 865-4048
Conext System Control Panel 865–1050

5
Conext Automatic Generator Start 865–1060
Conext ComBox 865–1058
Conext Portable Installation and Configuration Tool 865–1155–01

[7] Specifications are subject to change without notice.


[8] Bulk, absorption, float, plus manual equalization.
[9] Bulk, absorption, plus manual equalization.
5-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Residential Solar Power Solutions Solar Inverters

schneider-electric.us

Conext™ MPPT 60 150 Solar Charge Controller


The Conext MPPT 60 150 is a photovoltaic (PV) charge controller that tracks the
maximum power point of a PV array to deliver the maximum available current for
charging batteries. When charging, the MPPT 60 150 regulates battery voltage and
output current based on the amount of energy available from the PV array and state-of-
charge of the battery.

Table 5.5: Conext MPPT 60 150 Solar Charge Controller


Electrical Specifications [10] MPPT 60 150
Inverter
Nominal Battery Voltage 12, 24, 36, 48, 60 V
Battery Voltage Operating Range 0–80 V dc
PV Array Operating Voltage 140 V
Max. PV Array Open Circuit Voltage 150 V (including temperature correction factor)
Max. Array Short-circuit Current 60 A [11]
Max. Charge Current 60 A [12]
Max. and Min. Wire Size in Conduit #6 to #14 AWG
Max. Output Power 3500 W
Three-stage [13]
Charger Regulation Method
Two-stage [14]
Supported Battery Types Flooded, GEL, AGM, Custom
Efficiency
93% (nominal 12 V), 96% (nominal 24 V), 97% (nominal 36
Max. Power Conversion Efficiency
V), 98% (nominal 48 V), 99% (nominal 60 V)
General Specifications
Power Consumption (night time) 2.5 W
Battery Temperature Sensor Included
Auxiliary Output 5–13 V, up to 200 mA
Enclosure Material Indoor, ventilated, sheet metal chassis with 2.2 and 2.8 cm
knockouts and aluminum heat sink
MPPT Multi-Stage Charging IP Degree of Protection IP 20
Product Weight 10.8 lb. (4.8 kg)
Shipping Weight 17.6 lb. (8.0 kg)
Features
Product Dimensions (H x W x D) 14.5 x 5.8 x 5.5 in. (36.8 x 14.6 x 13.8 cm)
• Maximum Power Point Tracking (MPPT) algorithm Shipping Dimensions (H x W x D) 19.0 x 9.0 x 9.8 in. (48.3 x 22.9 x 35.0 cm)
continually seeks the maximum power available
from the PV array Device Mounting Vertical wall-mount
Ambient Air Temperature for Operation -4–113°F (-20–45°C)
• Improve battery life with selectable multi-stage Storage Temperature Range -40–185°F (-40–85°C)
temperature compensated charging
Operating Altitude Sea level to 6562 ft. (2000 m)
• Five year standard warranty System Network and Remote Monitoring Available
• Stand-alone application or full integration with Warranty 5 year standard
Context XW and Conext SW inverter charger Part Number 865–1030–1
system Features
• Compatible with any brand of PV Module Display Type LCD, 2 lines,
16 digits
• Available remote monitoring and configuration Regulatory Approval
• LCD screen with face plate buttons for
configuration and system monitoring Safety CSA Certified (UL1741, CSA 107.1) and CE Marked for Low
Voltage Directive (EN50178)

• Integrated PV ground fault protection for negative EMC


FCC and Industry Canada (Class B), CE Marked for the
EMC Directive (EN61000-6-1, -6-3), C-Tick Compliant
grounded arrays
Compatible Products
XW 7048 E product no.
Conext XW+ interver/charger (230 V) 865-7048-61
XW 8548 E product no.
865-8548-61
Conext XW+interver/charger (120/240 V) XW 5548 NA product no. 865-5548-01
XW 6848 NA product no. 865-6848-01
SW 2524 product no. 865-2524-61
Conext SW (230 V) SW 4024 product no. 865-4024-61
SW 4048 product no. 865-4048-61
SW 2524 product no. 865-2524
Conext SW (120 V) SW 4024 product no. 865-4024
SW 4048 product no. 865-4048
Conext System Control Panel 865–1050
Conext Automatic Generator Start 865–1060
Conext ComBox 865–1058
Conext Portable Installation and Configuration Tool 865–1155–01

[10] Specifications are subject to change without notice.


[11] 48 A at STC.
[12] For all battery voltages except 60 V.
[13] Bulk, absorption, float, plus manual equalization.
[14] Bulk, absorption, plus manual equalization.
5-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents

Section 6
Surge Protective Devices (SPDs)
Comme rcia l Applica tions
Externally Mounted SPDs 6-2

Overview 6-2
EMA Series SPDs 6-2
Replacement Modules 6-3
EBA Series SPDs 6-4
Internally Mounted SPDs 6-4

Overview 6-4
Internally Mounted—New Construction/Factory Assembled 6-4
EMA Ser ie s S P Ds Internally Mounted SPDs—Retrofit/Ready to Install 6-4
Internally Mounted—Retrofit/Ready to Install 6-5
SurgelogicTM SurgeLoc for NQ Panelboards 6-5
OEM/Assembler Kits 6-6
Nipple-Mounted SPDs 6-7

HWA SPDs 6-7


XR Surge Protective Devices 6-7
Mounting Brackets and Flush Mount Kits 6-8
SDSA1175 and SDSA 3-Phase SPDs 6-8
Residential SPDs 6-9
Re trofit EBA Ser ie s S P Ds
Whole House SPDs 6-9
Plug on Neutral QO™ and Homeline™ Load Center SPDs 6-10
QO™, NQ, and Homeline™ Load Center Surge Protective Devices 6-11

TM
S urge logic Sur ge Loc

Re s ide ntia l & Light


Comme rcia l Applica tions

S DS A 3-P ha s e HEP D80

SURGE PROTECTIVE DEVICES


(SPDS)

QO/ HOM SPDs


Who le Hous e S P Ds
6

© 2017 Schneider Electric


All Rights Reserved 6-1

11/10/2017
Externally Mounted SPDs Overview
Class 1310 / Refer to Catalog 1310CT0202
schneider-electric.us

Externally Mounted Surge Protective Devices


Surgelogic™ EMA and EBA series SPDs offer a full range of externally mounted surge
suppression solutions. These units are designed to provide surge suppression from
service entrance panels to point-of-use equipment.
US and Canadian UL® Listed to the UL 1449 standard. Complies with requirements of
NEC® Article 285 and CSA 22.2 No. 8-M1986 as appropriate. Complies with UL 96A
12th Edition Master Label requirements for Lightning Protection Systems.

• 10 year product • EMI/RFI filtering • Indicator LEDs; normal


(green) and fault condition
warranty
• Audible alarm with enable/
disable switch, dry contacts (red) for each phase
• 10 modes of
protection and surge counter standard • UL 1449 Type 1 to be used
• 200 kA SCCR in both Type 1 and Type 2
applications

• Standard. UL 1449 Type 1 SPDs can be located at any point in the electrical
system, on the line or load side of the equipment overcurrent device.
• Remote Monitor. This option displays the alarm status of the surge protective
device up to 1000 feet from the unit.
EMA Series SPDs

EMA Series SPDs


EMA SPD products feature a design based on individual phase modules for a flexible,
cost effective way to achieve superior surge suppression at every level of the electrical
distribution system. Modularity results in lower life cycle costs and fast, easy service or
replacement.

EMA SPD Options:

• Enhanced Filtering Module. Sine wave tracking circuitry provides enhanced EMI/
RFI filtering of -54 dB at 100 kHz and establishes the power surge clamping window
relative to the sine wave voltage to increase performance at distribution and branch
panel applications.
• Disconnect Switch. The integral switch provides a mechanical means to electrically
isolate the entire surge suppressor before opening the enclosure door to facilitate
servicing of the unit’s components.

Table 6.1: EMA SPDs


Peak Surge Current NEMA 1 NEMA 4X Stainless
Service Voltage
Rating per Phase (kA) Cat. No. Steel Cat. No.
120 SSP01EMA12( ) SSP01EMA12S( )
120/240 V, 1-phase, 160 SSP01EMA16( ) SSP01EMA16S( )
240 SSP01EMA24( ) SSP01EMA24S( )
3-wire + ground [1]
320 SSP01EMA32( ) SSP01EMA32S( )
480 SSP01EMA48( ) SSP01EMA48S( )
120 SSP02EMA12( ) SSP02EMA12S( )
208Y/120 V, 3-phase, 160 SSP02EMA16( ) SSP02EMA16S( )
4-wire + ground [2] [3] [1] 240 SSP02EMA24( ) SSP02EMA24S( )
Wye 320 SSP02EMA32( ) SSP02EMA32S( )
480 SSP02EMA48( ) SSP02EMA48S( )
120 SSP03EMA12( ) SSP03EMA12S( )
240/120 V, 3-phase, 160 SSP03EMA16( ) SSP03EMA16S( )
4-wire + ground [1] 240 SSP03EMA24( ) SSP03EMA24S( )
6

High-leg Delta 320 SSP03EMA32( ) —


480 SSP03EMA48( ) —
100 SSP06EMA10( ) SSP06EMA10S( )
120 SSP06EMA12( ) SSP06EMA12S( )
240 V, 3-phase, 160 SSP06EMA16( ) SSP06EMA16S( )
3-wire + ground 200 SSP06EMA20( ) SSP06EMA20S( )
SURGE PROTECTIVE DEVICES

Delta 240 SSP06EMA24( ) SSP06EMA24S( )


320 SSP06EMA32( ) SSP06EMA32S( )
480 SSP06EMA48( ) SSP06EMA48S( )
120 SSP04EMA12( ) SSP04EMA12S( )
480Y/277 V, 3-phase, 160 SSP04EMA16( ) SSP04EMA16S( )
4-wire + ground [3] [4] [1] 240 SSP04EMA24( ) SSP04EMA24S( )
Wye 320 SSP04EMA32( ) SSP04EMA32S( )
(SPDS)

480 SSP04EMA48( ) SSP04EMA48S( )


100 SSP05EMA10( ) SSP05EMA10S( )
120 SSP05EMA12( ) SSP05EMA12S( )
480 V, 3-phase, 160 SSP05EMA16( ) SSP05EMA16S( )
3-wire + ground [5] 200 SSP05EMA20( ) SSP05EMA20S( )
Delta 240 SSP05EMA24( ) SSP05EMA24S( )
320 SSP05EMA32( ) SSP05EMA32S( )
480 SSP05EMA48( ) SSP05EMA48S( )

[1] Do not use on ungrounded systems. Systems must be solidly grounded.


[2] 208Y/120 series also applies to the following voltage 220Y/127.
[3] Can be used on 4-wire or 3-wire grounded wye systems with or without neutral.
[4] 480Y/277 series applies to the following voltages 380Y/220, 400Y/230, and 415Y/240.
[5] 480 V Delta series also applies to the following voltage 480Y/277V HRG.

6-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Replacement Modules Externally Mounted SPDs
Refer to Catalog 6671CT9701
schneider-electric.us

Table 6.1 EMA SPDs (cont'd.)


Peak Surge Current NEMA 1 NEMA 4X Stainless
Service Voltage Rating per Phase (kA) Cat. No. Steel Cat. No.
120 SSP08EMA12( ) SSP08EMA12S( )
600Y/347 V, 3-phase, 160 SSP08EMA16( ) SSP08EMA16S( )
4-wire + ground, [6] [7] 240 SSP08EMA24( ) SSP08EMA24S( )
WYE 320 SSP08EMA32( ) SSP08EMA32S( )
480 SSP08EMA48( ) SSP08EMA48S( )
SSP09EMA10( ) SSP09EMA10S( )
100 SSP09EMA12( ) SSP09EMA12S( )
120 SSP09EMA16( ) SSP09EMA16S( )
600 V, 3-phase,
3-wire + ground [8] 160 SSP09EMA18( ) SSP09EMA18S( )
180 SSP09EMA20( ) SSP09EMA20S( )
Delta 240 SSP09EMA24( ) SSP09EMA24S( )
320 SSP09EMA32( ) SSP09EMA32S( )

External Modular Options ( )


(D) [9] Disconnect Switch
(F) Enhanced Filtering Module (not applicable for Delta, HRG or HLD)
(DF) [9] Disconnect Switch and Enhanced Filtering Module (not applicable for Delta, HRG or HLD)

Accessory Description Cat. No.


Remote Monitor TVS12RMU

Replacement Modules
All module assemblies are US and Canadian UL® Recognized to UL 1449 standards.
Complies with requirements of NEC® Article 285 and CSA C22.2 No. 8-M1986 as
appropriate.

Table 6.2: EMA Replacement Modules


Peak Surge Catalog Numbers
System [10]
Voltage Current Rating
(kA) Phase A Phase B Phase C
120 MA1IMA12 — MA1IMA12
120/240 V, 1-phase,
3-wire + ground 160 MA1IMA16 — MA1IMA16
240 MA1IMA24 — MA1IMA24
Wye Replacement Delta/HRG Replacement 208Y/120 V, 3-phase, 120 MA1IMA12 MA1IMA12 MA1IMA12
Module Module 4-wire + ground [11] 160 MA1IMA16 MA1IMA16 MA1IMA16
Wye 240 MA1IMA24 MA1IMA24 MA1IMA24
240/120 V, 3-phase, 120 MA1IMA12 MA3IMA12 MA1IMA12
4-wire + ground [12] 160 MA1IMA16 MA3IMA16 MA1IMA16
High-Leg Delta 240 MA1IMA24 MA3IMA24 MA1IMA24
100 MA6IMA10 MA6IMA10 MA6IMA10
240 V, 3-phase, 120 MA6IMA12 MA6IMA12 MA6IMA12
3-wire + ground 160 MA6IMA16 MA6IMA16 MA6IMA16
Delta 200 MA6IMA20 MA6IMA20 MA6IMA20
240 MA6IMA24 MA6IMA24 MA6IMA24
480Y/277 V, 3-phase, 120 MA4IMA12 MA4IMA12 MA4IMA12
4-wire + ground [13] 160 MA4IMA16 MA4IMA16 MA4IMA16
Wye 240 MA4IMA24 MA4IMA24 MA4IMA24
100 MA5IMA10 MA5IMA10 MA5IMA10
480 V, 3-phase, 120 MA5IMA12 MA5IMA12 MA5IMA12
3-wire + ground [14] 160 MA5IMA16 MA5IMA16 MA5IMA16
Delta 200 MA5IMA20 MA5IMA20 MA5IMA20
240 MA5IMA24 MA5IMA24 MA5IMA24
600Y/347 V, 3-phase, 120 MA8IMA12 MA8IMA12 MA8IMA12
4-wire + ground 160 MA8IMA16 MA8IMA16 MA8IMA16
Wye 240 MA8IMA24 MA8IMA24 MA8IMA24

SURGE PROTECTIVE DEVICES


100 MA9IMA10 MA9IMA10 MA9IMA10
600 V, 3-phase, 120 MA9IMA12 MA9IMA12 MA9IMA12
3-wire + ground [8]
Delta 160 MA9IMA16 MA9IMA16 MA9IMA16
180 MA9IMA18 MA9IMA18 MA9IMA18

6 (SPDS)

[6] Do not use on ungrounded systems. Systems must be solidly grounded.


[7] Can be used on 4-wire or 3-wire grounded wye systems with or without neutral.
[8] 600 V Delta series also applies to the following voltage 600Y/347V HRG.
[9] Not available in stainless steel for 320 and 480 kA.
[10] For UL 1449 Type 1 Modules, add suffix (1). Example: MA1IMA121
[11] 208Y/120 series also applies to the following voltage 220Y/127.
[12] High-leg delta (Phase B modules are different than Phase A and Phase C modules).
[13] 480Y/277 series applies to the following voltages 380Y/220, 400Y/230, and 415Y/240.
[14] 480 V Delta series also applies to the following voltage 480Y/277V HRG.
6-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Internally Mounted SPDs EBA Series SPDs
Refer to Catalog 6671CT9701
schneider-electric.us

EBA Series SPDs


EBA SPD products consist of a consolidation of phase modules into one solid brick
casting and offered at a competitive price for those who want superior surge suppression
on a limited budget. EBA series are nipple-mounted SPDs that allow installation flexibility
and retain superior performance.

• 10 year product warranty


• 10 modes of protection
• 200 kA SCCR
• -45 dB EMI/RFI Filtering
• Audible alarm with enable/disable switch, dry contacts and surge counter standard
• Indicator LEDs; normal (green) and fault condition (red) for each phase
• NEMA 1 rated enclosure

Table 6.3: EBA SPDs


Service Peak Surge
Current Rating NEMA 1
EBA Series SPD Voltage Cat. No.
per Phase (kA)
80 SSP01EBA08
100 SSP01EBA10
120/240 V,1-phase, 120 SSP01EBA12
3-wire + ground[15] 160 SSP01EBA16
200 SSP01EBA20
240 SSP01EBA24
80 SSP02EBA08
100 SSP02EBA10
Remote Monitor 208Y/120 V, 3-phase, 120 SSP02EBA12
4-wire + ground [16] [17] [15]
Wye 160 SSP02EBA16
200 SSP02EBA20
240 SSP02EBA24

Accessory Description Cat. No.


Remote Monitor TVS12RMU

Internally Mounted Surge Protective Devices


Internally mounted surge protective devices are installed integrally to systems for service
entrance and branch panel surge suppression. Internally mounted SPDs installed next to
the supply bus provides maximum performance inside Square D™ systems. Built-in
performance is the best way to ensure cost effective power quality (especially important
for critical power facilities).
US and Canadian UL® Recognized as a Type 2 (or 1 with optional suffix in catalog
number) SPD Component Assembly to UL 1449 and UL 1283 standards. Complies with
requirements of NEC® Article 285 and CSA C22.2 No. 8-M1986 as appropriate.
Complies with UL 96A 12th Edition Master Label requirements for Lightning Protection
Systems.
Internally Mounted—New Construction / Factory Assembled
Factory installed integral/internal Surgelogic™ SPD products make adding surge
suppression to new construction projects easy. Refer to the sections listed below to
identify the correct product for your application or contact Surgelogic™ TAG at 1-800-
6

577-7353 for assistance.


SURGE PROTECTIVE DEVICES
(SPDS)

[15] Do not use on ungrounded systems. Systems must be solidly grounded.


[16] 208Y/120 series also applies to the following voltage 220Y/127.
[17] Can be used on 3-wire or 4-wire grounded wye systems with or without neutral.
6-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Internally Mounted SPDs—Retrofit/Ready Internally Mounted SPDs
to Install
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 6671CT9701
Internally Mounted—Retrofit/Ready to Install
To ensure high-performance surge suppression at critical power locations, a variety of
Surgelogic™ products have been designed specifically for retrofitting into commonly
used Square D™ systems. The QMB fusible switch, 6 in. MCC bucket, I-Line & Busway
plug-on units and the new SurgeLoc for the NQ panelboards come read to install.
Retrofitting SPD units into I-Line, QMB, MCC, Busway and NQ Panelborad applications
is simple.
• Audible alarm with enable/disable switch, dry contacts and surge counter standard
• 200 kA SCCR
• Indicator LEDs
• EMI/RFI filtering
Table 6.4: Internally Mounted—Retrofit / Ready To Install
Model 6
Surge QMB Branch Busway
I-Line Branch Units [1] Units [2] MCC Units
Voltage Current Units [3]
Rating
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. [4] Cat. No. [4]
I-Line™ Surgelogic™ 120 kA HL1IMA12C( ) HR1IMA12C QMB1IMA12 — —
SPD Unit 120/240 V, 1-phase,
160 kA HL1IMA16C( ) HR1IMA16C QMB1IMA16 — —
3-wire + ground
240 kA HL1IMA24C( ) HR1IMA24C QMB1IMA24 — —
208Y/120 V, 3-phase, 120 kA HL2IMA12C( ) HR2IMA12C QMB2IMA12 — MCC2IMA12
4-wire + ground [5] HL2IMA16C( ) QMB2IMA16
[6] 160 kA HR2IMA16C PIU2IMA16 MCC2IMA16
Wye 240 kA HL2IMA24C( ) HR2IMA24C QMB2IMA24 PIU2IMA24 MCC2IMA24
240/120 V, 3-phase, 120 kA HL3IMA12C( ) HR3IMA12C QMB3IMA12 — MCC3IMA12
4-wire + ground 160 kA HL3IMA16C( ) HR3IMA16C QMB3IMA16 PIU3IMA16 MCC3IMA16
QMB Surgelogic™ High-leg Delta HL3IMA24C( ) QMB3IMA24
240 kA HR3IMA24C PIU3IMA24 MCC3IMA24
SPD Unit
120 kA HL6IMA12C( ) HR6IMA12C — — —
240 V, 3-phase,
3-wire + ground, 160 kA HL6IMA16C( ) HR6IMA16C — — —
Delta 240 kA HL6IMA24C( ) HR6IMA24C — — —
480Y/277 V, 3-phase, 120 kA HL4IMA12C( ) HR4IMA12C QMB4IMA12 — MCC4IMA12
4-wire + ground [5] HL4IMA16C( ) QMB4IMA16
[7] 160 kA HR4IMA16C PIU4IMA16 MCC4IMA16
Wye 240 kA HL4IMA24C( ) HR4IMA24C QMB4IMA24 PIU4IMA24 MCC4IMA24
480 V, 3-phase, 120 kA HL5IMA12C( ) HR5IMA12C — — —
3-wire + ground, 160 kA HL5IMA16C( ) HR5IMA16C — — —
Delta [8] HL5IMA24C( )
240 kA HR5IMA24C — — —
Busway Surgelogic™ 600Y/347 V, 3-phase, 120 kA — HR8IMA12C QMB8IMA12 — MCC8IMA12
SPD Unit 4-wire + ground [5] 160 kA — HR8IMA16C QMB8IMA16 PIU8IMA16 MCC8IMA16
Wye 240 kA — HR8IMA24C QMB8IMA24 PIU8IMA24 MCC8IMA24
600V, 3-phase, 120 kA — HR9IMA12C — — —
3-wire + ground, [9] 160 kA — HR9IMA16C — — —
Delta 180 kA — HR9IMA18C — — —
( ) For a Type 1 SPD, add a “1” suffix to the catalog number.

MCC Surgelogic™
SPD Unit

SurgelogicTM SurgeLoc for NQ Panelboards


SurgelogicTM SurgeLoc is the industries first Field Installable Internally Mounted SPD in
NQ panelboards - fully installed in aprox. 2 minutes. Surgelogic (TM) SurgeLoc can be
ordered as factory assembled in NQ Panelboards or can be ordered from your local
Schneider Electric distributor for retrofit opportunities for NQ panelboards.

SURGE PROTECTIVE DEVICES


US and Canadian UL® Recognized to UL 1449 and UL 1283 standards. Complies with
requirements of NEC® Article 285 and CSA 22.2 No. 8-M1986 as appropriate. Complies
with UL 96A 12th Edition Master Label requirements for Lightning Protection Systems.

• Retrofit into existing NQ Panelboards

(SPDS)
SurgelogicTM SurgeLoc
• 10 year product warranty
• 10 modes of protection
• 200 kA SCCR
• Audible alarm with enable/disable switch, dry contacts and surge counter standard
• Indicator LEDs; normal (green) and fault condition (red) for each phase

** FOR SURGELOC PART NUMBERS, PLEASE REFERENCE Table 6.5 Internally


Mounted—Retrofit / Ready to Install, page 6-6.
6

[1] Requires 13.5-inch mounting height.


[2] Requires 9-inch mounting height.
[3] Requires 6-inch mounting height.
[4] PE7 Discount Schedule.
[5] Can be used on 4-wire or 3-wire grounded wye systems with or without neutral.
[6] 208Y/120 series also applies to the following voltage 220Y/127.
[7] 480Y/277 series applies to the following voltages 380Y/220, 400Y/230, and 415Y/240.
[8] 480 V Delta series also applies to the following voltage: 480Y/277V HRG.
[9] 600 V Delta series also applies to the following voltage: 600Y/347V HRG.
6-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Internally Mounted SPDs Internally Mounted SPDs—Retrofit/Ready
to Install
Refer to Catalog 6671CT9701 schneider-electric.us

Table 6.5: Internally Mounted—Retrofit / Ready to Install


Surge Current NQ Panelboard Units—SurgLoc [10]
Voltage
Rating Cat. No.
80 kA SSP01BIA08PBQ1
100 kA SSP01BIA10PBQ1
120/240 V, 1-phase, 120 kA SSP01BIA12PBQ1
3-wire + ground 160 kA SSP01BIA16PBQ1
200 kA SSP01BIA20PBQ1
240 kA SSP01BIA24PBQ1
80 kA SSP02BIA08PBQ1
100 kA SSP02BIA10PBQ1
208Y/120 V, 3-phase, 120 kA SSP02BIA12PBQ1
4-wire + ground [11] [12]
Wye 160 kA SSP02BIA16PBQ1
200 kA SSP02BIA20PBQ1
240 kA SSP02BIA24PBQ1
80 kA SSP03BIA08PBQ1
100 kA SSP03BIA10PBQ1
240Y/120 V, 3-phase, 120 kA SSP03BIA12PBQ1
4-wire + ground
High-leg Delta 160 kA SSP03BIA16PBQ1
200 kA SSP03BIA20PBQ1
240 kA SSP03BIA24PBQ1

OEM/Assembler Kits
Surgelogic™ OEM/assembler kits allow manufacturers to add industry-leading surge
suppression directly to customized equipment. Manufacturers benefit from shorter wire
lengths that optimize the clamping voltage of the SPD. Products come with a backplane-
mounted SPD, mounting hardware and diagnostic display with 36-inch cables. Audible
alarm, silence switch, remote monitoring contacts, and surge counter are standard.
Available as UL 1449 Type 2 (or 1 with optional suffix in catalog number).
US and Canadian UL® Recognized to UL 1449 and UL 1283 standards. Complies with
requirements of NEC® Article 285 and CSA 22.2 No. 8-M1986 as appropriate. Complies
with UL 96A 12th Edition Master Label requirements for Lightning Protection Systems.

Table 6.6: OEM/Assembler Kits


Service Peak Surge Current Rating
Voltage per Phase (kA) Cat. No. [13]

120 TVS1IMA12O( )
120/240 V, 1-phase,
160 TVS1IMA16O( )
3-wire + ground
240 TVS1IMA24O( )
208Y/120 V, 3-phase, 120 TVS2IMA12O( )
4-wire + ground [14] [15] 160 TVS2IMA16O( )
Wye TVS2IMA24O( )
240
240/120 V, 3-phase, 120 TVS3IMA12O( )
4-wire + ground 160 TVS3IMA16O( )
High-leg Delta TVS3IMA24O( )
240
120 TVS6IMA12O( )
240 V, 3-phase,
3-wire + ground [14] [16] 160 TVS6IMA16O( )
Delta 240 TVS6IMA24O( )
480Y/277 V, 3-phase, 120 TVS4IMA12O( )
4-wire + ground [14] [16] 160 TVS4IMA16O( )
Wye TVS4IMA24O( )
OEM Kit 240
120 TVS5IMA12O( )
6

480 V, 3-phase,
3-wire + ground [17] 160 TVS5IMA16O( )
Delta 240 TVS5IMA24O( )
600Y/347 V, 3-phase, 120 TVS8IMA12O( )
4-wire + ground [14] 160 TVS8IMA16O( )
Wye
SURGE PROTECTIVE DEVICES

240 TVS8IMA24O( )
120 TVS9IMA12O( )
600 V, 3-phase,
3-wire + ground [18] 160 TVS9IMA16O( )
Delta 180 TVS9IMA18O( )
( ) For a Type 1 SPD, add a “1” suffix to the catalog number.
(SPDS)

[10] Requires 12 circuit positions (6 adjacent mounting spaces per side).


[11] Can be used on 4-wire or 3-wire grounded neutral system.
[12] 208/120 series also applies to the following voltage 220Y/127.
[13] Note the last character of the catalog number is the letter “O”, not a zero.
[14] Can be used on 4-wire or 3-wire grounded wye systems with or without neutral.
[15] 208Y/120 series also applies to the following voltage 220Y/127.
[16] 480Y/277 series applies to the following voltages 380Y/220, 400Y/230, and 415Y/240.
[17] 480 V Delta series also applies to the following voltage: 480Y/277V HRG.
[18] 600 V Delta series also applies to the following voltage: 600Y/347V HRG.
6-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
HWA SPDs Nipple-Mounted SPDs
Refer to Catalog 6671CT9701
schneider-electric.us

HWA Surge Protective Devices


Surgelogic™ HWA surge protective devices are compact, nipple-mounted parallel-
connected surge suppressors that come in a variety of voltage configurations, including
Delta. A surge suppression path is provided for each mode, and the product is rated
NEMA Type 4X. Internal diagnostics continuously monitor the device status.
US and Canadian UL® Listed as a Type 2 SPD to UL 1449 and UL 1283 standards.
Complies with requirements of NEC® Article 285 and CSA C22.2 No. 8-M1986 as
appropriate. Complies with UL 96A 12th Edition Master Label requirements for Lightning
Protection Systems.

• LEDs indicate operational status • -54 dB EMI/RFI filtering


• Short circuit current rating 200 kA • Sine wave tracking
• Suitable for indoor and outdoor
applications (NEMA Type 4X rated) • Audible alarm indicates loss of
suppression (does not contain alarm
• Convenient side-nipple mounting enable/disable switch)
• Compact design provides easy • Dry contacts
HWA Series mounting inside or outside the • Optional flush-mount kit TVSHWAFMK
equipment cabinets

Table 6.7: HWA Surge Protective Devices


Peak Surge Current Rating per
Service Voltage Phase (kA) NEMA 4X Cat. No.
50 TVS1HWA50X
120/240 V, 1-phase,
3-wire + ground [1] 80 TVS1HWA80X
100 TVS1HWA10X
50 TVS2HWA50X
208Y/120 V, 3-phase,
4-wire + ground [2] [3] [1] 80 TVS2HWA80X
100 TVS2HWA10X
240/120 V, 3-phase, 50 TVS3HWA50X
4-wire + ground [1] 80 TVS3HWA80X
High-leg Delta 100 TVS3HWA10X
240 V, 3-phase, 50 TVS6HWA50X
3-wire + ground 80 TVS6HWA80X
Delta 100 TVS6HWA10X
50 TVS4HWA50X
480Y/277 V, 3-phase,
4-wire + ground [2] [4] [1] 80 TVS4HWA80X
100 TVS4HWA10X
480 V, 3-phase, 50 TVS5HWA50X
3-wire + ground 80 TVS5HWA80X
Delta 100 TVS5HWA10X
50 TVS8HWA50X
600Y/347 V, 3-phase,
4-wire + ground [1] 80 TVS8HWA80X
100 TVS8HWA10X
600 V, 3-phase, 50 TVS9HWA50X
3-wire + ground 80 TVS9HWA80X
Delta 100 TVS9HWA10X

XR Surge Protective Devices


The XR SPD provides high-quality surge suppression in a compact and versatile
package. This product is ideal for panel builders as well as manufacturers and
integrators of instrumentation cabinets for industrial, commercial, and residential
applications for single-phase power systems.
US and Canadian UL® Listed as Type 1 SPD to the UL 1449 standard. Complies with

SURGE PROTECTIVE DEVICES


requirements of NEC® Article 285, CSA 233.1-87, and CSA C22.2 No. 8-M1986 as
appropriate.

• LEDs indicate operational • Suitable for indoor and outdoor applications


status (NEMA Type 4X rated)

(SPDS)
Short circuit current rating 25
kA • Optional flush mount kit TVSXRFMK
XR Series
• Convenient side nipple
mounting

Table 6.8: XR Nipple-Mounted Surge Protective Devices


Peak Surge Current Rating per
System Voltage Cat. No.
Phase (kA)
120/240 V, 1-phase, 50 TVS120XR50S
3-wire + ground 80 TVS120XR80S
6

[1] Do not use on ungrounded systems. Systems must be solidly grounded.


[2] Can be used on 4-wire or 3-wire grounded wye systems with or without neutral.
[3] 208Y/120 series also applies to the following voltage 220Y/127.
[4] 480Y/277 series applies to the following voltages 380Y/220, 400Y/230, and 415Y/240.
6-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Nipple-Mounted SPDs Mounting Brackets and Flush Mount Kits
Refer to Catalog 6671CT9701
schneider-electric.us

Mounting Brackets and Flush Mount Kits


The nipple products shown in this catalog provide a convenient means of incorporating
surge suppression within a new or existing cabinet. The mounting bracket and flush-
mount kits are designed for easy mounting of nipple products.

Table 6.9: Mounting Bracket for Enclosures


Description Cat. No.
Mounting bracket for SDSA1175 or SDSA1175T QOSAMK
Flush-mount kif for HWA SPDs TVSHWAFMK
QOSAMK

SDSA1175 and SDSA 3-Phase Surge Protective Devices


SDSA1175 are designed and listed for indoor or outdoor installation and surge
suppression for single-phase three-wire 120/240 Vac or two-wire 120 Vac 60 Hz
electrical services. This product is ideal for panel builders as well as manufacturers and
integrators of instrumentation cabinets for industrial, commercial, and residential
applications for single-phase power systems. Two SDSA1175 surge protection devices
can be installed to provide suppression for 208Y/120 Vac three-phase four-wire services.
SDSA 3-Phase SPDs are designed and listed for indoor or outdoor installation and surge
suppression for three-phase electrical services up to 600 Vac. The SDSA 3-Phase series
is used extensively in service entrance panels to provide an efficient and economical
means of surge suppression and also ideal for point of use applications for that added
level of protection.
SDSA1175
US and Canadian UL® Listed as Type 1 SPD to the UL 1449 standard. Complies with
requirements of NEC® Article 285, CSA 233.1-87, and CSA C22.2 No. 8-M1986 as
appropriate.
• LED indicates operational status
• Short circuit current rating 25 kA (SDSA1175), 200 kA (SDSA 3-Phase)
• Suitable for indoor and outdoor applications (NEMA Type 4X rated)
• Convenient back-nipple mounting
SDSA 3-Phase Table 6.10: SDSA1175 and SDSA 3-Phase Surge Protective Devices
Peak Surge
System Voltage Current Rating Cat. No.
per Phase (kA)
SDSA1175
120/240 V, 1-phase, 3-wire 36 SDSA1175
120 V, 1-phase, 2-wire 36 SDSA1175T
SDSA 3-Phase
208Y/120 V,
3-phase, 4-wire [5] [6] 40 SDSA2040
240 V Delta,
3-phase, 3-wire [7] 40 SDSA2040D
480Y/277 V,
3-phase, 4-wire [8] [5] 40 SDSA4040
480 V Delta,
3-phase, 3-wire 40 SDSA4040D
600Y/347 V,
3-phase, 4-wire [5] 40 SDSA3650
600 V Delta,
3-phase, 3-wire 40 SDSA3650D
6
SURGE PROTECTIVE DEVICES
(SPDS)

[5] Do not use on ungrounded systems. Systems must be solidly grounded.


[6] Applicable voltages: 220Y/127V, 208Y/120V.
[7] Applicable voltages: 240V Delta, 240/120V High-Leg Delta.
[8] Applicable voltages: 480Y/277V, 415Y/240V, 400Y/230V, 380Y/220V.
6-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Whole House SPDs Residential SPDs
Refer to Catalog 6671CT9701
schneider-electric.us

Surgebreaker Plus Whole House Surge Protective Device


The Surgebreaker Plus Whole House device is designed to deliver surge suppression
that addresses the entire home. AC modules are connected to the circuit breaker load
center and provide suppression for all equipment connected to the power system. This
Whole House system incorporates AC modules as well as modules for other metallic
lines coming into the home including telephone/DSL and coaxial video/data.
US and Canadian UL® Listed as Type 2 SPD to the UL 1449 standard. Complies with
requirements of NEC® Article 285, CSA 233.1-87, and CSA C22.2 No. 8-M1986 as
appropriate. Telephone and coaxial video modules US and Canadian UL® Recognized to
UL 497A 4th Edition and UL 497B 4th Edition.
• 120/240 Vac, 80 kA/phase AC surge suppression
• LED status indicators for AC surge suppression
• Telephone surge suppression module supports one RJ45 cable up to four lines.
• Coaxial surge suppression module supports one line of video/data
• Network suppression module supports one RJ45 modem/fax/DSL
Table 6.11: Whole House Surge Protective Devices
SDSB80111
Description Included Modules Cat. No.
Whole House NEMA 1 AC, Telephone, Coax, Network SDSB80111

Table 6.12: SDSB80111 Replacement Modules


Description Cat. No.
Telephone Suppression Module PTEL2R
Video Suppression Module PVR
Network Suppression Module PNETR6
Home Electronics Protective Device HEPD80

** To purchase Telephone, Video or Network Replacement Modules - go online to:


http://www.apc.com/products/family/index.cfm?id=219

Surgebreaker Plus Whole House Accessories


Add additional surge suppression or replace existing modules in Whole House products.
Coaxial, telephone and network modules: US and Canadian UL® Recognized to UL
497A 4th Edition and UL 497B 4th Edition.

HEPD Whole House Surge Protective Device


HEPD Whole House devices are designed to deliver superior AC surge protection for
the entire AC power system in a home. HEPDs are compact in size and are designed
to protect AC wires in the home from surges that could affect home electronics and
appliances not connected to surge strips.
HEPD50 cULus Listed to the latest UL 1449 standard, UL Type 1 SPD, CSA C22.2 No. *-M1986,
C233.1-87.
HEPD80
• 120/240 Vac
• Max surge current ratings avaliable: 50, 80 and 108 kA
• NEMA 4X rate for indoor or outdoor applications

SURGE PROTECTIVE DEVICES


• LED status indicators
• Compatible with all brands of load centers
• Flush Mount Kits sold separately - see table below
• HEPD50: 3 year/$50,000 connected equipment warranty

(SPDS)
• HEPD80: 5 year/$75,000 connected equipment warranty
Table 6.13: HEPD Whole House Surge Protective Devices
HEPD80MKF Description Surge Current Rating Cat. No.
HEPD80MKF 50kA Home Electronic Protective Device 50 kA HEPD50
80kA Home Electronic Protective Device 80 kA HEPD80
Flush Mount Kit for HEPD80 HEPD80MKF
6

6-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Residential SPDs Plug on Neutral QO™ and Homeline™ Load
Center SPDs
schneider-electric.us

Plug-on Neutral QO™ and Homeline™ Load Center Surge


Protective Devices
The industry's first exclusive Plug on Neutral (PoN) Surge Protective Device (SPD).
Square D™ load center PoN SPDs are a simple and quick installation. It's as easy as
snap, click, done! PoN SPDs are easier to install than a standard circuit breaker. No
wires are needed for installation. The PoN SPD simply plugs on to the bus and neutral
bar. The surge suppressors use two-pole spaces in a QO™ or Homeline™ load center.
US and Canadian UL® Listed as Type 2 SPD to the UL 1449 standard. Complies with
requirements of NEC® Article 285, CSA 233.1-87, and CSA C22.2 No. 8-M1986 as
appropriate.

HOM250PSPD • Industry First: No wires or tools required • Whole House Protection: 50 kA surge
QO250PSPD for installation current capacity per phase
• Installation Flexibility: Works on Plug-on
• LED indicates operational status
Neutral design QO or HOM loadcenters
using two-pole spaces • Peace of mind: 5 year/ $50,000
connected equipment warranty

Table 6.14: QO™, NQ, and Homeline™ Load Center Surge Protective Device
Description Cat. No.
Plug on Neutral QO™ Surgebreaker QO250PSPD
Plug on Neutral Homeline™ Surgebreaker HOM250PSPD
6
SURGE PROTECTIVE DEVICES
(SPDS)

6-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™, NQ, and Homeline™ Load Center Residential SPDs
Surge Protective Devices
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 6671CT9701

QO™, NQ, and Homeline™ Load Center Surge Protective Devices


Square D™ load center surge protective devices are easy to install plug-in units that
install as quickly as a standard circuit breaker. The surge suppressors use two pole
spaces in a QO™ or Homeline™ load center, or NQ panelboard.
US and Canadian UL® Listed as Type 2 SPD to the UL 1449 standard. Complies with
requirements of NEC® Article 285, CSA 233.1-87, and CSA C22.2 No. 8-M1986 as
appropriate.

• QO2175SB for QO™ load centers, • Plug-on design requires two pole
spaces
combination devices, and NQ
panelboards • LED indicates operational status
• HOM2175SB for Homeline™ load
centers and combination devices • 22.5 kA per phase

Table 6.15: QO™, NQ, and Homeline™ Load Center Surge Protective Devices
QO217SB HOM217SB Description Cat. No.
QO™ Surgebreaker for QO and NQ QO2175SB
Homeline™ Surgebreaker HOM2175SB

SURGE PROTECTIVE DEVICES


6 (SPDS)

6-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Residential SPDs QO™, NQ, and Homeline™ Load Center
Surge Protective Devices
Refer to Catalog 6671CT9701 schneider-electric.us
6
SURGE PROTECTIVE DEVICES
(SPDS)

6-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents

Section 7
Miniature and Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Selection Information 7-1

QO™ and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers 7-11

Homeline™ Circuit Breakers 7-19

Multi 9™ Miniature Circuit Breakers 7-23


B-Frame H-Frame
PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers 7-30

Motor Circuit Protectors 7-42

Automatic Switches 7-49

500 Vdc Circuit Breakers 7-50

Mission Critical Circuit Breakers 7-52

J-Frame L-Frame
PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories 7-54

Micrologic™ Electronic Trip Units 7-65

Masterpact™ Universal Power Circuit Breakers 7-71

Ground-Fault Protection 7-74

Dimensions and Shipping Weights 7-76

Circuit Breaker Enclosures 7-78


M-Frame

P-Frame

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

R-Frame

© 2017 Schneider Electric


All Rights Reserved 7-1
7

11/10/2017
Selection Information Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 500, 600
schneider-electric.us

QO Miniature Circuit Breakers


QO™ Circuit Breakers

Plug-on QO QO-H QO-VH QH QOT QO- QO- QO- QOVH-


Circuit CAFI VHCAFI DF DF
Breaker QOB- QOB- QOB- QOB-
Type Bolt-on QOB QOB-H — — — QOB-VH QHB — CAFI VHCAFI DF VHDF
Unit Mount — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Number of Poles 1 2 3 2 1 2 3 1 2, 3 [1] 1,2 3 1 1, 2 1, 2 1 1
Current Range (A) 10–200 15– 15–
10–70 [2] 10–100 15–100 15–70 15–125 15–100 15–70 150 30 15–30 15–30 15–20 15–20 15–20 15–20
Interrupting Ratings
120 Vac 10 10 10 10 22 22 22 22 22 65 65 10 10 22 10 22
120/240
10 10 10 10 22 22 22 22 22 65 65 10 10 22 — —
Vac
UL/CSA 208Y/120 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Rating
(kA) 240 Vac
— — 10 10 — — 22 — 22 [4] — 65 — — — — —
(50/60 Hz) [3]
277 Vac — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
480Y/277
Vac — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
48 Vdc 5 [5] 5 [5] 5 [5] — — — — — — — — — — — — —
60 Vdc — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
DC Ratings 65 Vdc — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
125 Vdc — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
250 Vdc — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
500 Vdc — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
IEC 60947-2 IEC — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
(50/60 Hz) [6] (Icu) — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Special Ratings
CCC — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Fed. Specs
W-C-375B/GEN X — — — X — — — — X — X X — X X
HACR [7] HACR
Other Standard HACR [7] — — — — HACR [7] HACR [7]
NOM [7]
Accessories and Modifications
Shunt Trip [8] X X X X X X X X X [9] X X X — — — —
Undervoltage Trip — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Auxiliary Switches [8] X X X X X X X X X [9] X X X — X — —
Alarm Switch [8] X X X X X X X X X [9] X X X — X — —
Handle Operators — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Handle Padlock
X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Attachment
Trip System Type
Thermal-magnetic X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Molded Case Switch X X X — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Dimensions (1P Unit Mount)
Dimensions Height 3.5 (89) [1] 4.75 (121)
(1P Unit 0.75 (19) [1]
Mount) Width
in. (mm) Depth 2.92 (74) [1]
Pages page 7-11
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[1] For dimensions for QOB2150VH, QOB3110VH, QOB3125VH and QOB3150VH, see page 7-76
[2] 2P 150–200 A requires 4P width.
[3] See the Supplemental Digest, Section 3 for 3Ø corner grounded systems.
[4] 22 kA @ 240 Vac for 3P only.
[5] 1P and 2P, 10–70 A and 3P 10–60 A only.
[6] See the Supplemental Digest Section 10 for circuit breakers with IEC ratings.
[7] HACR on QO, QOB 1P 10–70 A, 2P 15–100 A, 3P 10–100 A; QOB-VH 1P 15–70 A, 2P 15–125 A, 3P 15–100 A.
[8] Factory-installed option only.
[9] Factory-installed accessories are not available on QOB-VH 2P150 A and 3P 110–150 A.
7-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Miniature Circuit Breakers Selection Information
Class 500, 600
schneider-electric.us

QO-GFI, QO-EPD, QOU, QOM Miniature Circuit Breakers


QO Circuit Breakers QOU Circuit Breakers QOM1 and QOM2 Main
Circuit Breakers

Plug-on QO- QO-EPD


QO-GFI — — — —
VHGFI QO-EPE
Circuit Breaker
Type QOB- QOB-EPD
Bolt-on QOB-GFI — — QOM1-VH QOM2-VH
VHGFI QOB-EPE
Unit Mount — — — — — — — QOU QYU [10] — —
Number of Poles 1 2 3 1 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 2
Current Range (A) 15–30 15–60 15–50 15–30 15–30 15–60 15–50 10–100 10–125 10–100 10–30 50–125 100–225
Interrupting Ratings
120 Vac 10 10 — 22 10 10 — 10 10 10 — 22 22
120/240 Vac — 10 — — — 10 — 10 10 10 — 22 22
UL/CSA Rating 208Y/120 — — 10 — — — —
(kA RMS)
(50/60 Hz) 240 Vac [11] — — — — — — 10 — — 10 — — —
277 Vac — — — — — — — — — — 5 — —
480Y/277 Vac — — — — — — — — — — — — —
48 Vdc — — — — — — — 5 [12] 5 [12] 5 [12] — — —
60 Vdc — — — — — — — 5 [13] 5 [13] 5 [13] — — —
DC Ratings 65 Vdc — — — — — — — — — — — — —
125 Vdc — — — — — — — — — — — — —
250 Vdc — — — — — — — — — — — — —
500 Vdc — — — — — — — — — — — — —
IEC 60947-2 240 Vac — — — — — — — — — — — — —
(50/60 Hz)
Icu 415 Vac — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Special Ratings
CCC — — — — — — — X [14] X [14] X [14] — — —
Fed. Specs W-C-375B/GEN X — — X — X X X X X X
Other Standard NOM — NOM HACR [15] — — —
Accessories and Modifications
Shunt Trip — — — — — — — X [16] X [16] X [16] X [16] — X [16]
Undervoltage Trip — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Auxiliary Switches X X X X X X X X [16] X [16] X [16] X[16] — —
Alarm Switch X X X X X X X X [16] X [16] X [16] X [16] — —
Handle Operators — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Handle Padlock Attachment X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Trip System Type
Thermal-magnetic X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Molded Case Switch — — — — — — — — X X — — —
Dimensions (1P Unit Mount)
Height 4.12 (103) 4.05 (103) 5.09 (129) [17] 5.60 (142)
[17]
Dimensions
(1P Unit Mount) 0.75 (19) 0.75 (19) 5.00 (127) [17] 5.07 (129)
Width [17]
in. (mm)
Depth 2.92 (74) 2.92 (74) 3.47 (88) [17] 3.60 (91)
[17]
Pages page 7-11 page 7-17 See Section 1
NOTE: All circuit breakers on this chart are UL Listed and CSA Certified unless otherwise noted.

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[10] QYU is a UL 1077 supplementary protector.


[11] For information regarding 3Ø corner grounded systems see the Supplemental Digest, Section 3.
[12] 1P and 2P, 10–70 A and 3P 10–60 A only.
[13] QOU is UL Listed for 60 Vdc per pole 80–100 A, 1P; 80–125 A, 2P; and 70–100 A, 3P.
[14] 15–70 A 1P and 2P, 15–60 A 3P
[15] HACR on QOU 1P and 3P 15–100 A, 2P 15–125 A;
[16] Factory-installed option only.
[17] QOM1 and QOM2 dimensions are for 2-pole unit.
7

7-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Selection Information Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 500, 600
schneider-electric.us

HOM Circuit Breakers


HOM Circuit Breakers

Circuit Plug-on HOM HOM-CAFI HOM-DF HOM-GFI HOM-EPD HOMT


Breaker Bolt-on — — — — — — — — —
Type Unit Mount — — — — — — — — —
Number of Poles 1 2 1, 2 1 1 2 1 2 1
Current Range (A) 15–50 15–200 [18] 15–20 15–20 15–20 15–50 15–20 15–50 15–50 [19]
Interrupting Ratings
120 Vac 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
UL/CSA 120/240 Vac 10 10 10 — — 10 — 10 10
Rating 208Y/120 — — — — — — — — —
(kA) 240 Vac [20] — — — — — — — — —
(50/60 Hz)
277 Vac — — — — — — — — —
480Y/277 Vac — — — — — — — — —
48 Vdc — — — — — — — — —
60 Vdc — — — — — — — — —
DC Ratings 65 Vdc — — — — — — — — —
125 Vdc — — — — — — — — —
250 Vdc — — — — — — — — —
IEC 60947-2 IEC — — — — — — — — —
(50/60 Hz) [21] (Icu) — — — — — — — — —
Special Ratings
CCC — — — — — — — — —
Fed. Specs
X X X X X X X X X
W-C-375B/GEN
Other Standard HACR [22] NOM HACR [22]
Accessories and Modifications
Shunt Trip [23] — — — — — — — — —
Undervoltage Trip — — — — — — — — —
Auxiliary Switches [23] — — — — — — — — —
Alarm Switch [23] — — — — — — — — —
Handle Operators — — — — — — — — —
Handle Padlock X [24]
Attachment X X X X — — — —
Trip System Type
Thermal-magnetic X X X X X X X X X
Molded Case Switch — — — — — — — — —
Dimensions (1P Unit Mount)
Dimensions Height 3.13 (79)
(1P Unit Mount) Width 1.00 (25)
in. (mm) Depth 2.98 (76)
Pages page 1-21
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[18] 2P 150–200 A requires 4P width.


[19] HOMT tandem is 30 A maximum. HOMT quad tandem has 20 A maximum on outside poles, and 50 A maximum on the inside poles.
[20] See the Supplemental Digest, Section 3 for 3Ø corner grounded systems.
[21] See the Supplemental Digest Section 10 for circuit breakers with IEC ratings.
[22] HACR on HOM 1P 15–50 A and 2P 15–100 A.
[23] Factory-installed option only.
[24] Handle padlock attachment available for HOMT quad tandem only.
7-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Miniature Circuit Breakers Selection Information
Class 500, 600
schneider-electric.us

Multi 9, EDB Miniature Circuit Breakers


Multi 9™ Circuit Breakers and
Supplementary Protectors EDB Circuit Breakers

Plug-on — — — — —
Circuit
Breaker Bolt-on — — EDB EGB EJB
Type UL 489 UL1077
Unit Mount C60SP [25] C60H-DC — — —
C60BP
Number of Poles 1 2 3 1 2 3,4 1 2 1 2, 3 1 2, 3 1 2, 3
Current Range (A) 0.5–63 0.5–63 0.5–63 0.5–63 1–63 1–63 0.5–63 0.5–63 15–70 15–125 15–70 15–125 15–70 15–125
Interrupting Ratings
120 Vac 14 [26] 14 [26] 14 [26] 14 [27] 14 [27] 14 [27] — — 25 25 65 65 100 100
UL/CSA 120/240 Vac 14 [26] 14 [26] 14 [26] 14 [27] 14 [27] 14 [27] — — 18 25 35 65  65 100
Rating
(kA RMS) 240 Vac [28] 14 [26] 14 [26] 14 [26] 14 [27] 14 [27] 14 [27] — — 18 25 35 65  65 100
(50/60 Hz) 277 Vac — — — 10 [29] 10 [29] 10 [29] — — 18 18 35 35  65  65
480Y/277 Vac 10 [30] 10 [31] 10 [31] — 10 [29] 10 [29] — — — 18 — 35 —  65
48 Vdc — — — — 10 — 5 5 — — — — — —
60 Vdc 10 10 — 20 — — 5 5 — — — — — —
65 Vdc — — — — — — 5 5 — — — — — —
DC Ratings
125 Vdc — 10 — — — — 5 5 — — — — — —
250 Vdc — — — — — — 5 5 — — — — — —
500 Vdc — — — — — — — 5 [32] — — — — — —
IEC 60947-2 240 Vac 10 20 20 10 20 20 — — 20 — — — — —
(50/60 Hz)
Icu 415 Vac — 10 10 —  5  5 — — 10 — — — — —
Special Ratings
CCC X X X X X X X X — — — — — —
Fed. Specs W-C-375B/GEN X X X — — — — — X X X X X X
Other Standard IEC HACR
Accessories and Modifications
Shunt Trip X X X X X X X X X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33]
Undervoltage Trip X X X X X X X X — — — — — —
Auxiliary Switches X X X X X X X X X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33]
Alarm Switch X X X X X X X X X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33]
Handle Operators X X X X X X X X — — — — — —
Handle Padlock Attachment X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Trip System Type
Thermal-magnetic X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Molded Case Switch — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Dimensions (1P Unit Mount)
Dimensions Height 4.05 (103) 3.19 (81) 3.19 (81) 5.66 (144)
(1P Unit Mount) Width 0.71 (18) 0.71 (18) 0.71 (18) 1.42 (36) 0.98 (25)
in. (mm) Depth 2.76 (70) 2.76 (70) 2.56 (65) 4.05 (103)
Pages page 7-23 See Section 9
NOTE: All circuit breakers on this chart are UL Listed and CSA Certified unless otherwise noted.

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[25] C60 are recognized components per UL 1077.


[26] 14 kA up to 35 A, 10 kA from 40 to 63 A.
[27] 14 kA up to 32 A, 10 kA from 40 to 63 A.
[28] For information regarding 3Ø corner grounded systems see the Supplemental Digest, Section 3.
[29] 10 kA up to 32 A, 5 kA from 40 to 63 A.
[30] Up to 35 A.
[31] 10 kA up to 35 A.
[32] 2 poles must be wired in series for 500 Vdc.
[33] Factory-installed option only.
7

7-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Selection Information Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Class 500, 600, 800
schneider-electric.us

B-, H-, J-Frame Molded Case Circuit Breakers


PowerPact™ 125 A B-Frame PowerPact 150 A H-Frame PowerPact 250 A J-Frame
Electronic Trip Version Electronic Trip Version

Circuit Breaker Type BD BG BJ BK HD HG HJ HL HR JD JG JJ JL JR


Number of Poles 1, 2, 3, 4 1, 2, 3, 4 1, 2, 3, 4 1, 2 2, 3 2, 3 2, 3 [34] 2, 3 [34] 3 2, 3 [34] 2, 3 [34] 2, 3 [34] 2, 3 [34] 3
Current Range (A) 70–250 70–250 70–250 70–250 70–250
15–125 15–125 15–125 15–30 15–150 15–150 15–150 15–150 15–150 [35] [35] [35] [35] [35]
Interrupting Ratings
UL/CSA/ 240 Vac 25 65 100 100 25 65 100 125 200 25 65 100 125 200
NOM AC 480Y/277 Vac 18 35 65 65 18 35 65 100 200 18 35 65 100 200
Rating 480 Vac 18 35 65 65 18 35 65 100 200 18 35 65 100 200
(kA RMS) 600Y/347 Vac 14 18 25 65 14 18 25 50 100 14 18 25 50 100
(50/60 Hz)
600 Vac — — — — 14 18 25 50 100 14 18 25 50 100
UL/CSA/ 250 Vdc [36] — — — — 20 20 20 20 — 20 20 20 20 —
NOM DC
Ratings 500 Vdc [36] — — — — — 20 — 50 — — 20 — 50 —
IEC AC 220/240 Vac 25 65 100 100 25 65 100 125 150 25 65 100 125 150
Rating 380/415 Vac 18 35 65 65 18 35 65 100 125 18 35 65 100 125
(kA RMS) 440/480 Vac 18 35 65 65 18 35 65 100 125 18 18 25 50 125
(50/60 Hz) 500/525 Vac 14 18 25 25 14 18 25 50 75 14 20 20 20 75
Icu/lcs [37]
690 Vac — — — — — — — — 20 — — — — 20
IEC DC 250 Vdc — — — — — — — — — 20 20 20 20 —
Ratings 500 Vdc — — — — — — — — — 20 20 20 20 —
Special Ratings
CCC X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Fed. Specs W-C-375B/GEN X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
HACR X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Connections/Terminations
Unit Mount X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
I-Line™ X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Rear Connection — — — — X [38] X [38] X X X X X X X X
Drawout — — — — X [38] X [38] X X X X X X X X
Optional Lugs X X X X X [38] X [38] X X X X X X X X
Accessories and Modifications
Shunt Trip X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Undervoltage Trip X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Auxiliary Switches X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Alarm Switch X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Motor Operator — — — — X [38] X [38] X X X X X X X X
Handle Operators X X X X X [38] X [38] X X X X X X X X
Mechanical Interlocks (3P) X X X — X X X X X X X X X X
Handle Padlock Attachment X X X X X [38] X [38] X X X X X X X X
Cylinder Lock (3P) — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Optional GF Protection — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Trip System Type
Thermal-magnetic X X X X X X X X — X X X X X
Instantaneous-only (MCP) — — — — — X X [39] X [39] X [39] — X [39] X [39] X X
Molded Case Switch
(Automatic) X X X X — X — X — — X — X X
Electronic — — — — X [39] X [39] X [39] X [39] X [39] X [39] X [39] X [39] X [39] X [39]
Enclosures (page 7-76–page 7-78)
General Purpose (NEMA 1) — — — — X X X X — X X X X —
Raintight (NEMA 3R) — — — — X X X X — X X X X —
7

Dust-tight (NEMA 12) — — — — X X X X — X X X X —


Watertight (NEMA 4, 4X, 5) — — — — X X X X — X X X X —
Explosion Proof (NEMA 7, 9) — — — — — — — — — X [40] X [40] — — —
Dimensions Height 5.4 (137) 6.4 (163) 7.5 (191)
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

(3P Unit 3.2 (81) 4.1 (104) 4.1 (104)


Mount) Width
in. (mm) Depth 3.5 (89) 3.4 (86) 3.4 (86)
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

Pages (Unit Mount)/(I-Line) page 7-31/Section 9 page 7-32/Section 9 page 7-32/Section 9


NOTE: All circuit breakers on this chart are UL Listed and CSA Certified unless otherwise noted.

[34] 2P in a 3P module.
[35] 70–250 A with electronic trip system
[36] Not available with electronic trip units
[37] Dual UL and IEC ratings and CE markings on circuit breakers. For additional IEC ratings, see the Supplemental Digest, Section 10.
[38] Not available in HD and HG 2P rating (2P module).
[39] 3P only.
[40] Not UL Listed due to wire bending space.
7-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Molded Case Circuit Breakers Selection Information
Class 500, 600, 800
schneider-electric.us

PowerPact™ Q-, L-Frame Molded Case Circuit Breakers


PowerPact 250 A Q-Frame PowerPact 600 A L-Frame

Circuit Breaker Type QB QD QG QJ LD LG LJ LL LR


Number of Poles 2, 3 2, 3 2, 3 2, 3 3, 4 3, 4 3, 4 3, 4 3, 4
Current Range (A) 70–250 [41] 70–250 [41] 70–250 [41] 70–250 [41] 70–600 70–600 70–600 70–600 70–600
Interrupting Ratings
240 Vac 10 25 65 100 25 65 100 125 200
UL/CSA/NOM AC 480Y/277 Vac — — — — 18 35 65 100 200
Rating
(kA RMS) 480 Vac — — — — 18 35 65 100 200
(50/60 Hz) 600Y/347 Vac — — — — 14 18 25 50 100
600 Vac — — — — 14 18 25 50 100
UL/CSA/NOM DC 250 Vdc [42] — — — — — — — — —
Ratings 500 Vdc [43][42] — — — — — 20 — 50 —
220/240 Vac 10/5 10/5 10/5 10/5 25 65 100 125 150
IEC AC Rating 380/415 Vac 10/5 10/5 10/5 10/5 18/18 18 65 100 125
(kA RMS)
(50/60 Hz) 440/480 Vac — — — — 18/18 18 65 100 125
Icu/lcs [44] 500/525 Vac — — — — 18/18 14 25 50 75
690 Vac — — — — — — — — 20
IEC DC Ratings 250 Vdc — — — — — — — — —
500 Vdc — — — — — — — — —
Special Ratings
CCC — — — — X X X X X
Fed. Specs W-C-375B/GEN X X X X X X X X X
HACR (2P, 3P) X X X — X X X X X
Connections/Terminations
Unit Mount X X X X X X X X X
I-Line™ X X X X X X X X X
Rear Connection — — — — X X X X X
Drawout — — — — X X X X X
Optional Lugs — — — — X X X X X
Accessories and Modifications
Shunt Trip — — — — X X X X X
Undervoltage Trip — — — — X X X X X
Auxiliary Switches — — — — X X X X X
Alarm Switch — — — — X X X X X
Motor Operator — — — — X X X X X
Handle Operators — — — — X X X X X
Mechanical Interlocks (3P) X X X X X X X X X
Handle Padlock Attachment X X X X X X X X X
Cylinder Lock (3P[45]) — — — — — — — — —
Optional GF Protection[46] — — — — X X X X X
Trip System Type
Thermal-magnetic X X X X — — — — —
Instantaneous-only (MCP) — — — — — X X X X
Molded Case Switch (Automatic) X — — — — X — X X
Electronic — — — — X X X X X
Enclosures (page 7-76–page 7-78)
General Purpose (NEMA 1) X X X X — — — — —
Raintight (NEMA 3R) X X X X — — — — —
Dust-tight (NEMA 12) — — — — X [47] X [47] X [47] X [47] X [47]
Watertight (NEMA 4, 4X, 5) — — — — — — — — —
Explosion Proof (NEMA 7, 9) — — — — — — — — —
Dimensions Height 6.47 (164) 13.38 (340)
(3P Unit Mount) Width 4.5 (114) 5.51 (140)
in. (mm) Depth 3.93 (100) 4.33 (110)
Pages (Unit Mount)/(I-Line) page 7-36/Supplemental Section 9 page 7-37/Supplemental Section 9
NOTE: All circuit breakers on this chart are UL Listed and CSA Certified unless otherwise noted.
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[41] I-Line Q-frame circuit breakers are available 70–225 A only. 250 A Q-frame unit-mount circuit breakers are limited to Cu conductors only.
[42] Not available with electronic trip units
[43] Ungrounded UPS systems only. See page 7-50. Special DC J-Frame only.
[44] Dual UL and IEC ratings and CE markings on circuit breakers. For additional IEC ratings, see the Supplemental Digest, Section 10.
[45] Factory-installed option only.
[46] Requires factory-installed “G” shunt trip and 3P module.
[47] Enclosure rating 1, 3R, 5 and 12.,
7

7-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Selection Information Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Class 600, 612, 800
schneider-electric.us

M-, P-, and R-Frame Molded Case Circuit Breakers


PowerPact 800 A M-Frame PowerPact 1200 A P-Frame PowerPact 3000 A R-Frame

Circuit Breaker Type MG MJ PG PJ PK PL RG RJ RK RL


Number of Poles 2, 3 2, 3 2, 3, 4 2, 3, 4 2, 3, 4 2, 3, 4 2, 3, 4 2, 3, 4 2, 3, 4 2, 3, 4
Current Range (A) 300–800 300–800 100–1200 100–1200 100–1200 100–1200 240–3000 240–3000 240–3000 240–3000
Interrupting Ratings
240 Vac 65 100 65 100 65 125 65 100 65 125
UL/CSA/NOM 480Y/277 Vac 35 65 35 65 50 100 35 65 65 100
Rating
(kA RMS) 480 Vac 35 65 35 65 50 100 35 65 65 100
(50/60 Hz) 600Y/347 Vac 18 25 18 25 50 25 18 25 65 50
600 Vac 18 25 18 25 50 25 18 25 65 50
250 Vdc — — — — — — — — — —
DC Ratings
500 Vdc [48] — — — — — — — — — —
IEC 240 Vac 50/25 65/35 50/25 65/35 50/25 125/65 50/25 65/35 85/65 125/65
(kA RMS)
(50/60 Hz) 415 Vac 35/20 50/25 35/20 50/25 50/25 85/45 35/20 50/25 70/55 85/45
Icu/Ics [49]
Special Ratings
CCC X X X X X X X X X X
Fed. Specs W-C-375B/GEN X X X X X X X X X X
HACR (2P, 3P) X X X X X X X X X X
Connections/Terminations
Unit Mount X X X X X X X X X X
I-Line™ X X X X X X X [50] X [50] X [50] X[50]
Rear Connection — — — — — — — — — —
Drawout — — X [51] X [51] X [51] X [51] — — — —
Optional Lugs X X X X X X X X X X
Accessories and Modifications
Shunt Trip X X X X X X X X X X
Undervoltage Trip X X X X X X X X X X
Auxiliary Switches X X X X X X X X X X
Alarm Switch X X X X X X X X X X
Motor Operator — — X [51] X [51] X [51] X [51] — — — —
Handle Operators — — X [51] X [51] X [51] X [51] — — — —
Mechanical Interlocks (3P) — — X X X X — — — —
Handle Padlock Attachment X X X X X X X X X X
Cylinder Lock (3P) — — — — — — — — — —
Optional GF Protection — — X X X X X X X X
Trip System Type
Thermal-magnetic — — — — — — — — — —
Instantaneous-only (MCP) — — — X X — — — — —
Molded Case Switch (Automatic) — — X X X X X X X X
Electronic X X X X X X X X X X
Enclosures (page 7-76–page 7-78)
General Purpose (NEMA 1) X X X X X X — — — —
Raintight (NEMA 3R) X X X X X X — — — —
Dust-tight (NEMA 12) X X X X X X — — — —
Watertight (NEMA 4, 4X, 5) X X — — — — — — — —
Explosion Proof (NEMA 7, 9) — — — — — — — — — —
Height–in.
12.80 (325) 16.20 (413) 15 (381)
(mm)
Dimensions Width—in. 8.30 (210) 8.30 (210) 16.50 (420)
(3P Unit Mount) (mm)
7

Depth—in. 8.10 (205) 8.10 (205) 14.40 (366)


(mm)
Pages (Unit Mount)/(I-Line) page 7-38/Section 9 page 7-39, page 7-49/Section 9 page 7-40, page 7-49/Section 9
NOTE: All circuit breakers on this chart are UL Listed and CSA Certified unless otherwise noted.
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[48] Ungrounded UPS systems only. See page 7-50.


[49] Dual UL and IEC ratings and CE markings on circuit breakers. For additional IEC ratings, see the Supplemental Digest, Section 10.
[50] 1000 A and 1200 A only.
[51] 65/50 kA Icu/Ics for 450–600 A ratings.
7-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Insulated Case Circuit Breakers Selection Information
Class 600, 800
schneider-electric.us

Masterpact NT, NW Molded Case Circuit Breakers


Masterpact 1200 A Masterpact 6000 A

Circuit Breaker Type NT-LF NW-LF


NT-N NT-H NT-L1 NT-L [52] NW-N NW-H NW-L [52] NW-H NW-L NW-H NW-L
Number of Poles 3 ,4 3, 4 3 3 3 3, 4 3, 4 3 3 3 ,4 3 3 ,4 3
Current Range 100– 100– 100– 100– 100– 100– 100– 100– 100– 640– 640– 1200– 1200–
1200 1200 1200 1200 1200 2000 2000 2000 2000 3000 3000 6000 6000
Interrupting Ratings
240 Vac 50 65 100 200 200 65 100 200 200 100 200 100 200
UL/CSA/NOM 480Y/277 Vac 50 50 65 100 100 65 100 150 150 100 150 100 150
Rating
(kA RMS) 480 Vac 50 50 65 100 100 65 100 150 150 100 150 100 150
(50/60 Hz) 600Y/347 Vac 35 50 — — — 50 85 100 100 85 100 85 100
600 Vac 35 50 — — — 50 85 100 100 85 100 85 100
250 Vdc — — — — — — — — — — — — —
DC Ratings
500 Vdc — — — — — — — — — — — — —
IEC [53] 240 Vac — — — — — — — — — — — — —
(kA RMS) Icu/
Ics 415 Vac — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Special Ratings
CCC — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Fed. Specs W-C-375B/GEN — — — — — — — — — — — — —
HACR (2P, 3P) — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Connections/Terminations
Unit Mount X X X X X X X X X X X X X
I-Line™ — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Rear Connection X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Drawout X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Optional Lugs — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Accessories and Modifications
Shunt Trip X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Undervoltage Trip X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Auxiliary Switches X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Alarm Switch X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Motor Operator X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Handle Operators — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Mechanical Interlocks X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Padlock Attachment X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Cylinder Lock — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Optional GF Protection X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Trip System Type
Thermal-magnetic — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Instantaneous-only (MCP) — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Molded Case Switch
(Automatic) X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Electronic X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Enclosures
General Purpose (NEMA 1) — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Raintight (NEMA 3R) — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Dust-tight (NEMA 12) — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Watertight (NEMA 4, 4X, 5) — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Explosion Proof (NEMA 7, 9) — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Dimensions Height 12.67 (322) 17.28 (439) 17.28 (439) 17.28 (439)
(3P Unit Mount) Width 11.25 (286) 17.74 (450) 17.74 (450) 30.94 (786)
in. (mm) Depth 13.00 (331) 18.38 (467) 18.38 (467) 18.38 (467)
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

Pages page 7-71 and Catalog 0613CT0001 page 7-71 and Catalog 0613CT0001
NOTE: All circuit breakers on this chart are UL Listed and CSA Certified unless otherwise noted.
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[52] Tested to show arc flash hazard risk category as reference by NFPA70E.
[53] See Catalog 0613CT0001 for additional ratings and other information.
7

7-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Selection Information Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Class 500, 600, 800
schneider-electric.us

Q4 and L-Frame Molded Case Circuit Breakers


400 A L-Frame

Circuit Breaker Type Q4 LA LH


Number of Poles 2, 3 2, 3 2, 3
Current Range 250–400 125–400 125–400
Interrupting Ratings
240 Vac 25 42 65
UL/CSA/NOM 480Y/277 Vac — 30 35
Rating
(kA RMS) 480 Vac — 30 35
(50/60 Hz) 600Y/347 Vac — 22 25
600 Vac — 22 25
250 Vdc [54] — 10 50
DC Ratings
500 Vdc [55][54] — — 20
IEC Rating 240 Vac — — —
(kA RMS)
Icu/lcs [56] 415 Vac — 20/5 20/5

IEC 50/60 Hz For additional IEC ratings, see the Supplemental Digest
Section 10.
Special Ratings
CCC — — —
Fed. Specs W-C-375B/GEN X X X
HACR (2P, 3P) — X X
Connections/Terminations
Unit Mount X X X
I-Line™ X X X
Rear Connection X X X
Drawout — — —
Optional Lugs X X X
Accessories and Modifications
Shunt Trip X X X
Undervoltage Trip X X X
Auxiliary Switches X X X
Alarm Switch X X X
Motor Operator X X X
Handle Operators X X X
Mechanical Interlocks (3P) — X [57] X [57]
Handle Padlock Attachment X X X
Cylinder Lock (3P) [54] X X X
Optional GF Protection [58] — — —
Trip System Type
Thermal-magnetic X X X
Instantaneous-only (MCP) — X X
Molded Case Switch (Automatic) — — X
Electronic — — —
Enclosures (page 7-76–page 7-78)
General Purpose (NEMA 1) X X X
Raintight (NEMA 3R) X X X
Dust-tight (NEMA 12) X X X
Watertight (NEMA 4, 4X, 5) X X X
Explosion Proof (NEMA 7, 9) — — —
Dimensions Height 11 (279)
(3P Unit Mount) Width 6 (152)
in. (mm) Depth 5.84 (148)
7

Pages (Unit Mount)/(I-Line) Supplemental Digest Section 3 / Digest Section 9


NOTE: All circuit breakers on this chart are UL Listed and CSA Certified unless
otherwise noted.
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[54] Factory-installed option only.


[55] Ungrounded UPS systems only. See page 7-50.
[56] Dual UL and IEC ratings and CE markings on circuit breakers. For additional IEC ratings, see the Supplemental Digest, Section 10.
[57] Requires circuit breaker with WB suffix .
[58] Requires factory-installed “G” Shunt trip and 3P module.
7-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers QO™ and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 730, 731, 733 / Refer to Catalog: 0730CT9801
schneider-electric.us

QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers


Square D brand QO miniature circuit breakers are plug-on products for use in QO load
centers, NQOD and NQ panelboards, NQOD and NQ OEM interiors or Speed-D™
switchboard distribution panels. Bolt-on QOB circuit breakers are for use in NQOD and
NQ panelboards or interiors. [1]
The Square D exclusive Qwik-Open™ mechanism, with a trip reaction within 1/60th of a
second, is standard on all 1P 15 A and 20 A QO circuit breakers.

Table 7.1: Plug-On Circuit Breakers


Amperes 2P—120/240 Vac 2P—240 Vac [3] 3P—240 Vac
Rating [2] 1P—120/240 Vac Common Trip Common Trip Common Trip
10 k AIR
10 A QO110 QO210 — QO310
15 A QO115 [4] [5] QO215 [4] QO215H QO315 [4]
20 A QO120 [4] [5] QO220 [4] QO220H QO320 [4]
25 A QO125 [4] QO225 [4] QO225H QO325 [4]
30 A QO130 [4] QO230 [4] QO230H QO330 [4]
35 A QO135 [4] QO235 [4] — QO335 [4]
40 A QO140 [4] QO240 [4] QO240H QO340 [4]
45 A QO145 [4] QO245 [4] — QO345 [4]
50 A QO150 [4] QO250 [4] QO250H QO350 [4]
QO 1P 60 A QO160 [4] QO260 [4] QO260H QO360 [4]
1 Space Required QO170 [4] QO270 [4] QO370 [4]
70 A QO270H
80 A — QO280 [4] QO280H QO380 [4]
90 A — QO290 [4] QO290H QO390 [4]
100 A — QO2100 [4] QO2100H QO3100 [4]
110 A — QO2110 [4] — —
125 A — QO2125 [4] — —
150 A — QO2150 [4] [6] [7] — —
175 A — QO2175 [4] [6] [7] — —
200 A — QO2200 [4] [6] [7] — —
Molded Case Switch 60 A max.–240 Vac — QO200 QO300
Molded Case Switch 100 A max.–240 Vac — QO2000 [8] QO3000 [8]
22 k AIR [4]
15 A QO115VH [5] QO215VH [9] — QO315VH [9]
QO 2P 20 A QO120VH [5] QO220VH [9] — QO320VH [9]
2 Spaces Required 25 A QO125VH QO225VH [9] — QO325VH [9]
30 A QO130VH QO230VH [9] — QO330VH [9]
40 A QO140VH QO240VH [9] — QO340VH [9]
50 A QO150VH QO250VH [9] — QO350VH [9]
60 A QO160VH QO260VH [9] — QO360VH [9]
70 A QO170VH QO270VH [9] — QO370VH [9]
80 A — QO280VH [9] — QO380VH [9]
90 A — QO290VH [9] — QO390VH [9]
100 A — QO2100VH [9] [10] — QO3100VH [9]
110 A — QO2110VH [9] [10] — —
125 A — QO2125VH [9] [10] — —
150 A — QO2150VH [6] [9] [7] — —
175 A — QO2175VH [6] [9] [7] — —
200 A — QO2200VH [6] [9] [7] — —
42 k AIR [4]
QO 3P  40 A — QOH240 [8] — —
3 Spaces Required  45 A — QOH245 [8] — —
 50 A — QOH250 [8] — —
 60 A — QOH26 [8] — —
 70 A — QOH270 — —
 80 A — QOH280 — —
 90 A — QOH290 — —
100 A — QOH2100 — —
110 A — QOH2110 [8] — —
125 A — QOH2125 — —
65 k AIR [4]
 15 A QH115 [5] QH215 — QH315 [4]
 20 A QH120 [5] QH220 — QH320
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

 25 A QH125 [8] QH225 [8] — QH325 [8]


 30 A QH130 QH230 — QH330
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

Refer topage 7-2 for Interrupting Ratings, Accessories, and Dimensions.

QO2200 2P 200 A
4 Spaces Required

[1] See Digest Section 1 for load centers, and Section 9 for panelboards and interiors.
[2] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–125 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[3] UL Listed 5 k AIR on corner grounded Delta systems.
[4] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[5] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated. Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[6] Requires four spaces (1 AWG–300 kcmil Al/Cu.) Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[7] Not suitable for use in 3Ø panels. Use only in 1Ø panel rated 150 A or greater.
[8] Order only. Contact your local Field Office.
[9] UL Listed for use ahead of QO, QO-GFI, QO-EPD, QOT, QO-AFI, and QO-PL 10 k AIR circuit breakers to permit their application at 22 kA fault level.
[10] 100 A maximum branch mounted opposite.
7

7-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers
Class 730, 731, 733 / Refer to Catalog: 0730CT9801
schneider-electric.us

QO/QOB Ring Terminal


Table 7.2: QO/QOB Ring Terminal—Factory-installed only
Ampere Rating Poles Suffix
10–30 A 1, 2, 3 5237
35–60 A 1,2
5238
35–50 A 3
 70–110 A 2
5273
 60–100 A 3

Wire Sizes for QO/QOB Circuit Breakers


Table 7.3: Wire Sizes
Ampere Rating Wire Size
Circuit Breaker Type (AWG/kcmil)
[11]
10–30 A 14–8 Al/Cu
QO 10–30 A (2) 14–10 Cu
1P
35–70 A 8–2 Al/Cu
10–30 A 14–8 Al/Cu
10–30 A (2) 14–10 Cu
QO
2P 35–70 A 8–2 Al/Cu
80–125 A 4–2/0 Al/Cu
150–200 A 4–300 Al/Cu
10–30 A 14–8 Al/Cu, (2) 14-10 Cu
QO
3P 35–70 A 8–2 Al/Cu
80–125 A 4–2/0 Al/Cu
QOB-VH 110–150 A 4–300 Al/Cu
QOT 15–20 A 12–8 Al 14–8 Cu
15–30 A 12–8 Al 14–8 Cu
QO-AFI, QO-GFI or QO-EPD
40, 50, 60 A 12–4 Al 14–6 Cu
QO-PL 10–60 A 12–2 Al 14–2 Cu

QOT Tandem Circuit Breakers


Circuit limiting QOT tandem circuit breakers have a mounting cam as shown. Installation
into a QO load center can only be made in those positions having a mounting pan rail
slot. Meets Paragraph 408.54 of the NEC®. UL Listed as Class CTL

Table 7.4: QOT Tandem Circuit Breakers


Ampere Rating [12] Cat. No. [13]
1P—120/240 Vac
15 A and 15 A QOT1515
15 A and 20 A QOT1520
20 A and 20 A QOT2020
2P—120/240 Vac Common Trip
Order two QOT1515 or QOT2020 circuit breakers and handle tie QOTHT for common switching of center two poles.

QOT 1P Tandem
Replacement Tandem Circuit Breakers Includes two circuit breakers (one QO2030
1 Space Required and one QO3020) and handle tie QOTHT.

Table 7.5: Replacement Tandem Circuit Breakers


Ampere Rating [12] Cat. No. [13]
1P—120/240 Vac—1 Space Required
15 A and 15 A QO1515
15 A and 20 A QO1520
20 A and 20 A QO2020
Mounting Cam 20 A and 30 A QO2030
Rail Bead
30 A and 20 A QO3020
Pan Rail Slot Two 1P Individual Trip—120/240 Vac—2 Spaces Required
15 A and 15 A Order Two QO1515 or QO2020 circuit breakers and
15 A and 20 A handle tie QOTHT
20 A and 20 A —
20 A and 30 A QO20303020 [14]
30 A and 20 A —
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[11] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–125 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[12] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–125 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[13] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[14] Includes two circuit breakers (one QO2030 and one QO3020) and handle tie QOTHT.
7-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers QO™ and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 685, 690, 730, 912, 950 / Refer to Catalog: 0730CT9801
schneider-electric.us

QO Arc-Fault Circuit Breaker


QO arc-fault circuit breakers provide protection for Series and Parallel Type Arcing as
required by the NEC and local code adoption, and comply with UL1699.

Table 7.6: QO Arc Fault Circuit Breakers (One-Pole)


One–Pole 120 Vac Two–Pole 120/240 Vac
Circuit
Ampere 10 k AIR
Breaker 22 k AIR 10 k AIR 22 k AIR
Type [15] Rating 1 Space 1 Space Required 2 Space Required 2 Space Required
Required
Combination
Arc-fault
Interrupter 15 QO115CAFI QO115VHCAFI QO215CAFI [16] QO215VHCAFI [16]
(Pigtail 20 QO120CAFI QO120VHCAFI QO220CAFI [16] QO220VHCAFI [16]
Neutral)
1P 1P Plug-On
QO-CAFI QO-CAFI Neutral
Combination 15 QO115PCAFI QO115VHPCAFI
Plug-On Neutral Pigtail 20 QO120PCAFI QO120VHPCAFI
Arc-fault
Interrupter

QO-Dual Function Circuit Breaker


QO Combination Arc Fault and Ground Fault Circuit Interrupters (Dual Function) provide
overload and short circuit protection, plus arc fault and ground fault protection in
accordance with the NEC, UL1699 and UL943.

Table 7.7: QO-Dual Function Arc Fault Circuit Breakers


Ampere 1P 120 Vac 1P 120 Vac
Circuit Breaker Type [17] Rating 10 k AIR 22 k AIR
1 Space Required 1 Space Required
Combination Arc-fault and Ground Fault 15 QO115DF QO115VHDF
Circuit Interrupter (Pigtail Neutral) 20 QO120DF QO120VHDF
Plug-On Neutral Combination Arc-fault and 15 QO115PDF QO115VHPDF
Ground Fault Circuit Interrupter 20 QO120PDF QO120VHPDF

1P QO-DF 1P QO-DF
Plug-on Neutral Pigtail

QO-GFI
Qwik-Gard™ circuit breakers provide overload and short circuit protection, combined with
Class A ground fault protection. Class A denotes a ground fault circuit interrupter that will
trip when a fault current to ground is 6 mA or more, for people protection. Do not connect
to more than 250 feet of load conductor for the total one-way run to prevent nuisance
tripping.

Table 7.8: QO-GFI Circuit Breakers


Qwik-Gard Circuit Breakers With Ground Fault Circuit Interrupter
Ampere 2P Common Trip 3P Common Trip
Rating 1P 120 Vac 120/240 Vac 208Y/120 Vac
[18] 10 k AIR 22 k AIR 10 k AIR 10 k AIR
1P 2P 1 Space Required 1 Space Required 2 Spaces Required 3 Spaces Required
QO-GFI QO-GFI 15 QO115GFI QO115VHGFI QO215GFI QO315GFI
20 QO120GFI QO120VHGFI QO220GFI QO320GFI
25 QO125GFI QO125VHGFI QO225GFI —
30 QO130GFI QO130VHGFI QO230GFI QO330GFI
40 — — QO240GFI QO340GFI
50 — — QO250GFI QO350GFI
60 — — QO260GFI [19] —

QO-EPD/EPE
QO-EPD/EPE circuit breakers provide overload and short circuit protection combined
with Class B ground fault protection. They are designed to provide ground fault
protection of equipment at a 30 mA level (EPD) or 100 mA level (EPE). They are not
designed to protect people from electrical shock.

Table 7.9: QO-EPD Circuit Breakers


1P 2P Common Trip 3P Common Trip
Ampere 120 Vac 120/240 Vac 240 Vac
Rating
[20] 10 k AIR 10 k AIR 10 k AIR
1 Space Required 2 Spaces Required 3 Spaces Required
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

15 QO115EPD QO215EPD QO315EPD [21] QO315EPE [21]


20 QO120EPD QO220EPD QO320EPD [21] QO320EPE [21]
25 QO125EPD QO225EPD — —
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

QO 1P 30 QO130EPD QO230EPD QO330EPD [21] QO330EPE [21]


With Shunt Trip
40 — QO240EPD QO340EPD [21] QO340EPE [21]
50 — QO250EPD QO350EPD [21] QO350EPE [21]
60 — QO260EPD [22] — —

[15] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[16] For 120/240 V only, not for 208Y/120 V.
[17] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[18] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[19] Suitable only for feeding 240 Vac and 208 Vac two-wire loads. Does not contain load neutral connection.
[20] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[21] See note in Instruction Bulletin when using in an enclosure with a QO403 or QON prefix.
[22] Suitable only for feeding 240 Vac and 208 Vac two-wire loads. Does not contain load neutral connection.
7

7-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers
Class 685, 690, 730, 912, 950 / Refer to Catalog: 0730CT9801
schneider-electric.us

QO-SWN
Switch Neutral Common Trip 2008 NEC® 514.11

Table 7.10: QO-SWN Circuit Breakers


Ampere 2 Wire 120 Vac 3 Wire 120/240 Vac
Rating [23] 10 k AIR 10 k AIR
2 Spaces Required 3 Spaces Required
10 QO210SWN QO310SWN
15 QO215SWN QO315SWN
20 QO220SWN QO320SWN
25 QO225SWN QO325SWN
30 QO230SWN QO330SWN
40 QO240SWN QO340SWN
Two-wire Three-wire 50 QO250SWN QO350SWN
QO-SWN QO-SWN

QO-HID
HID circuit breakers are for use on circuits feeding fluorescent and high intensity
discharge (HID) lighting systems such as mercury vapor, metal halide, or high pressure
sodium. These circuit breakers are physically interchangeable with QO circuit breakers.

Table 7.11: QO-HID Circuit Breakers


2P Common Trip 3P Common Trip
Ampere 1P 120/240 Vac
120/240 Vac 240 Vac
Rating [23] 10 k AIR 10 k AIR 10 k AIR
1 Space Required
2 Spaces Required 3 Spaces Required
15 QO115HID [24] QO215HID QO315HID
20 QO220HID QO320HID
25 QO125HID QO225HID QO325HID
30 QO130HID QO230HID QO330HID
40 QO140HID QO240HID —
50 QO150HID QO250HID —

QO-K
Key operated QO circuit breakers are available in single-pole construction and can be
mounted in any single-pole space which will accept a standard QO. These circuit
breakers can be turned ON or OFF or to RESET with a special key (catalog number
QOK10) included with the circuit breaker. These circuit breakers are UL Listed and
available as shown in the table.
Table 7.12: QO-K Circuit Breakers
120 Vac—10 k AIR (1 Space Required)
Ampere Ampere
Rating [23] Cat. No. Rating [23] Cat. No.
10 QO110K
QO115K 25 QO125K
15 30 QO130K
20 QO120K
QO-K Key Operated

QO-HM
High magnetic trip circuit breakers are recommended for applications where high initial
inrush may occur and for individual dimmer applications.

Table 7.13: QO-HM Circuit Breakers


120 Vac—10 k AIR
Ampere Rating [23] 1P
15 A QO115HM [25] [26]
20 A QO120HM [25] [26]

Non-Automatic (Standard) Miniature Switches


Miniature non-automatic switches have the same physical packaging as miniature circuit
breakers, but open only when the handle is switched to the OFF position.
Non-automatic switches provide no overcurrent protection or short circuit protection.
They must not be used on systems that have an available fault current greater than the
values listed in the table. Non-automatic switches are UL Listed per UL 1087 and are
CSA certified.
7

Table 7.14: QO Non-Automatic Miniature Switches, 240 Vac 10 kA


Ampere Rating 2P 3P
 60 QO200 QO300
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

100 QO2000 QO3000


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[23] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[24] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated. Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[25] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[26] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated. Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
7-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories QO™ and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us

Accessories for QO/QOB Circuit Breakers


Table 7.15: Accessories for use with QO and QOB Miniature Circuit Breakers
Description Cat. No. Schedule
Handle Attachments
Converts any two adjacent 120/240 Vac 1P QO circuit breakers to independent trip 2P QO1HT DE2E
Handle Tie Converts any two adjacent 120/240 Vac1P side-by-side QOT circuit breakers to independent trip 2P QOTHT DE2E
Clamp for holding QO 1P handle in ON or OFF position QO1LO DE2E
Handle Clamp Clamp for holding QO or Q1 either 1P, 2P or 3P circuit breaker handles in ON or OFF position HLO1 DE2E
For padlocking 1P QO circuit breaker in ON or OFF position
   Loose attachment QOHPL DE2E
   Fixed attachment QO1PA DE2E
Handle Padlock Attachment for For padlocking 1P side-by-side QOT circuit breaker in ON or OFF position QOTHPA DE2E
Padlocking in ON or OFF
position For padlocking 2P QO-GFI circuit breakers in either ON or OFF position, fixed attachment. GFI2PA DE2A
For 2P and 3P QO and Q1 standard circuit breakers which require padlocking in either ON or OFF position.
QO1HPL DE2E
   Loose attachment
   Fixed attachment QO1PL DE2E
For padlocking 1P QO circuit breaker in OFF position only, fixed attachment. QO1PAF DE2E
Handle Padlock Attachment for For padlocking 2P and 3P QO circuit breakers in OFF position only, fixed attachment. QO2PAF DE2E
Padlocking in OFF position For padlocking 1P QO-GFI, QO-CAFI, QO-DF and QO-EPD circuit breakers in OFF position only, fixed attachment. QOGFI1PAF DE2E
For padlocking 2P QO-GFI, QO-CAFI and QO-EPD circuit breakers in OFF position only, fixed attachment. QOGFI2PAF DE2E
Ring Terminal Ring terminals are available as a factory-installed option. See page 7–10 DE2A
60 A 2P plug-on – 2 spaces required (6–2 Al/Cu) QO60SL DE2A
125 A 2P plug-on – 2 spaces required (12–2/0 Al/Cu) QO2125SL DE2A
Sub-feed Lugs
225 A 2P plug-on – 4 spaces required (4–300 Al/Cu) QO2225SL [27] DE2A
125 A 3P plug-on – 3 spaces required (12–2/0 Al/Cu) QO3125SL DE3
Mechanical Interlock For interlocking the handles of two 2P or one 2P and one 1P QO and Q1 circuit breakers mounted side-by-side so that
only one circuit breaker can be ON at a time (Not QOU) QO2DTI DE2E
Attachment
QO2DTI mechanical interlock attachment with retaining kits for securing two adjacent back-fed circuit breakers in dual
With Retaining Kit power supply applications. Can be used with (2) 2Ps or (1) 2P and (1) 1P QO circuit breakers in QO816L100 load QO2DTIM DE2E
centers.

Factory-Installed Accessories for use with QO and QOB Miniature


Circuit Breakers
Factory-installed electrical accessories take up an additional pole space on QO, QO-
GFI, QO-EPD, QO-SWN and QOU circuit breakers. All AC electrical accessories shown
below are rated for 50/60 Hz. Accessories are not available for QOB-VH (2P 150 A and
3P 110–150 A) circuit breakers or QO, QOU molded case switches. QO circuit breakers
will accept only one accessory per circuit breaker. Undervoltage trip is not available on
miniature circuit breakers. Factory-installed accessories are not available for QO-AFI or
QO-CAFI Arc Fault Circuit Breakers or on QO2150, QO2175, or QO2200 circuit
breakers.
Table 7.16: Factory-Installed Accessories
Rated Cat. Accesso- Max. Cat.
Accessory Description Coil No. Description Contact Max. No.
Voltage Burden ry Comb. Voltage
Suffix Suffix
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

Trips the circuit breaker from a Monitors circuit breaker contact status and
remote location by means of a trip provides a remote signal indicating the circuit
coil energized from a separate breaker contacts are OPEN or CLOSED.
120
circuit. A 120 Vac shunt trip will Application
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

12 Vac/Vdc 60 VA Auxiliary 1A Vac 5A -1200


-1042
operate at 55% or more of rated
voltage. All other shunt trips will
24 Vac/Vdc 168 VA Switches • Auxiliary switch terminals accept (2) 14–12
AWG Cu leads.
1B 120
Vac
5A -1201
operate at 75% or more of rated
Shunt Trip
voltage. • Leads (EH): Yellow for “A’’, Blue for “B’’,
Striped common 18 AWG Cu.
Application
• For use with momentary or
maintained push button.
Used with control circuits and is actuated only
when the circuit breaker has tripped. Standard
120 Vac 72 VA construction includes a normally-open
• Not available on QO-GFI, QO-
EPD.
208 Vac
240 Vax
228 VA
288 VA
-1021
Alarm
Switches
contact.
Application
1A
120
Vac 5A -2100

• Shunt trip terminals accept (2)


0.14– 0.12 AWG Cu. • Leads: Alarm switch terminals accept (2)
14–12 AWG Cu leads.

[27] Not suitable for use in 3Ø panels. Use only in 1Ø panel rated 150 A or greater.
7

7-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers QO™ Mounting Bases
Class 652 / Catalog 0730CT9801, 0860CT0201
schneider-electric.us

QO Mounting Bases
Table 7.17: QO OEM Mounting Bases—UL Recognized Components
Main Lug 1P Max. No. Mounting Bases Main Wire Size
Voltage System
Rating Spaces 1P Cat. No. AWG/kcmil
QO Plug-On Mounting Bases—For unit mounting QO, QO-GFI, QO-AFI and QO-EPD circuit breakers
 70 A  2  2 QON2L70 14–4 Cu, 12–3 Al
125 A  4  4 SK9948BW 12–1/0 Cu/Al
125 A  4  4 SK9842 12–1/0 Cu/Al
1Ø2W 240 Vac Max. 10 k AIC
(Without Neutral Assembly) 125 A  6  6 SK9795 12–1/0 Cu/Al
125 A  6  6 SK9801 12–1/0 Cu/Al
150 A  6  6 SK9796BW 8–3/0 Cu/Al
150 A  8  8 SK9797 8–3/0 Cu/Al
 40 A  2  2 QON2L40 14–6 Cu, 12–6 Al
 70 A  2  4 QON24L70 14–4 Cu, 12–3 Al
SN12125 100 A  6 12 QON612L100 8–1/0 Cu/Al
100 A  8 16 QON816L100 8–1/0 Cu/Al
100 A 12 12 QON12L100 12–2/0 Cu/Al
100 A 12 12 QON12L100SF[28] 6–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 12 12 QON112L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 12 24 QON11224L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 16 16 QON116L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 16 24 QON11624L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
1Ø3W 240 Vac Max. 10 k AIC 125 A 20 20 QON120L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 24 24 QON124L125I 6–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 32 32 QON132L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 20 24 QON12024L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
150 A 24 24 QON124L150I 4–250 Cu/Al
200 A 12 12 QON124L200I 4–250 Cu/Al
200 A 12 12 QON12L200FTL [28] 4–250 Cu/Al
QON2L40
200 A 24 24 QON124L200I 4–250 Cu/Al
200 A 24 24 QON124L200DL [28] (2) 4–300 Cu/Al
200 A 30 30 QON130L200I 4–250 Cu/Al
225 A 42 42 QON142L225I 4–300 Cu/Al
125 A 12 12 QON312L125 4–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 20 20 QON320L125 4–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 24 24 QON324L125 4–2/0 Cu/Al
3Ø3W 240 Vac Max. 10 k AIC
(Without Neutral Assy.) 200 A 18 18 QON318L200 4–300 Cu/Al
200 A 24 24 QON324L200 4–300 Cu/Al
200 A 30 30 QON330L200 4–300 Cu/Al
225 A 42 42 QON342L225 4–300 Cu/Al
 60 A  3  3 QON403L60N 12–6 Cu/Al
125 A 12 12 QON312L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 20 20 QON320L125I [29] 4–2/0 Cu/Al
3Ø4W 240 Vac Max. 125 A 24 24 QON324L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
10 k AIC 200 A 18 18 QON318L200I 4–300 Cu/Al
200 A 24 24 QON324L200I 4–300 Cu/Al
200 A 30 30 QON330L200I [29] 4–300 Cu/Al
225 A 42 42 QON342L225I 4–300 Cu/Al
QO Plug-On Mounting Bases—For unit mounting QO, QO-GFI and QO-EPD circuit breakers
1Ø2W 240 Vac Max. 10 k AIC 70 A 1 1 QOMB1 14–4 Cu 12–2 Al
(Without Neutral Assembly) 70 A 2 2 QOMB2 14–4 Cu 12–2 Al
70 A 3 3 QOMB3 14–4 Cu 12–2 Al
QOB Bolt-On Mounting Bases—For unit mounting QOB, QOB-GFI, QOB-EPD circuit breakers
3Ø3W 240 Vac Max.10 k AIC
100 A 3 3 QON3B 12–1 Cu/Al
QON120L1251 (Without Neutral Assembly)

Table 7.18: Solid Neutral Assemblies


Main Lug Number of Main Neutral Lug Wire Branch Neutral Terminal Wire Size
Rating Branch Neutral Cat. No. Size
Terminals Cu/Al Cu Al
125 A 12 SN12125 4–2/0 AWG 14–4 AWG 12–4 AWG
125 A 20 SN20 4–2/0 AWG 14–4 AWG 12–4 AWG
200 A 12 SN12200 4 AWG–300 kcmil 14–4 AWG 12–4 AWG
200 A 30 SN30 4 AWG–300 kcmil 14–4 AWG 12–4 AWG
225 A 42 SN42 4 AWG–300 kcmil 14–4 AWG 12–4 AWG

Table 7.19: Accessories for US Mounting Base for UL489 C60


Description Cat. No.
7

Main lug kit for US mounting bases, 1 lug per kit, for 6 AWG to 300 kcmil cable USMBLK
Terminal cover for US mounting base; provides IP20 ingress protection per IEC 60529; suitable for
jumper bars or cable USMBTC
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[28] Device comes with factory-installed sub-feed lugs.


[29] Also IEC rated and CE marked for IEC 60439-1. Use only Square D brand Type QOXC, QOXD, QOHX and QOE circuit breakers for 415Y/240 Vac max. systems.
7-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers / QYU QO™ and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers
Supplementary Protectors
schneider-electric.us Class 720 / Refer to Catalog 0730CT9801

Low Ampere QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers


QOU unit mount miniature circuit breakers (cable-in/cable-out) are ideal for OEM
applications. They have the Square D™ circuit breaker’s unique Visi-Trip™ feature and
can be DIN rail-mounted or surface- or flush-mounted using mounting feet. Mounting feet
not provided [30].
General Specifications Common to All Low Ampere QOU Circuit Breakers
• For convenient flush mount, surface mount or DIN mount
(symmetrical rail 35 x 7.5 DIN/EN 50 022)
• Single handle with internal common trip
• Terminal lug wire size (1) 14–2 AWG Cu or Al
Low Ampere QOU
• Reversible line and load lugs
• Field-installable quick connectors
• UL Listed 48 Vdc (5 k AIR)
• UL Listed as HACR Type: 10–70 A
• High magnetic trip circuit breakers (QOU-HM) are recommended for applications
where high initial inrush may occur and for individual dimmer applications.
• For DIN mounting rails, see IEC Starters and Relays, Section 18.
Table 7.20: QOU Low Ampere Miniature Circuit Breakers
Ampere Cat. No.
Rating 1P 120/240 Vac 2P 120/240 Vac 2P 240 Vac [31] 3P 240 Vac
10 k AIR
 10 A QOU110 QOU210 — QOU310
 15 A QOU115 QOU215 QOU215H QOU315
 20 A QOU120 QOU220 QOU220H QOU320
 25 A QOU125 QOU225 QOU225H QOU325
 30 A QOU130 QOU230 QOU230H QOU330
 35 A QOU135 QOU235 — QOU335
 40 A QOU140 QOU240 — QOU340
 45 A QOU145 QOU245 — QOU345
 50 A QOU150 QOU250 — QOU350
 60 A QOU160 QOU260 — QOU360
 70 A QOU170 QOU270 — QOU370
22 k AIR
 15 A QOU115VH QOU215VH — QOU315VH
 20 A QOU120VH QOU220VH — QOU320VH
 25 A QOU125VH QOU225VH — QOU325VH
 30 A QOU130VH QOU230VH — QOU330VH
 35 A QOU135VH QOU235VH — —
 40 A QOU140VH QOU240VH — —
 45 A QOU145VH QOU245VH — —
 50 A QOU150VH QOU250VH — —
 60 A QOU160VH QOU260VH — —

Table 7.21: QOU-HM Miniature Circuit Breakers (10 k AIR)


Ampere Cat. No.
Rating 1P 120/240 Vac 2P 120/240 Vac 2P 240 Vac 3P 240 Vac
 15 A QOU115HM — — —
 20 A QOU120HM — — —

Table 7.22: QYU UL1077 Recognized Supplementary Protectors (5 k AIR)


Ampere Cat. No.
Rating 1P 277 Vac 2P 120/240 Vac 2P 240 Vac 3P 240 Vac
 10 A QYU110 — — —
 15 A QYU115 — — —
 20 A QYU120 — — —
 25 A QYU125 — — —
 30 A QYU130 — — —

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[30] See QOU Accessories, page 7-19.


[31] QOU-H interrupting rating is 10 kA at 240 Vac.
7

7-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers / QYU
Supplementary Protectors
Class 720 / Refer to Catalog 0730CT9801 schneider-electric.us

High Ampere QOU Circuit Breakers


General Specifications Common to All High Ampere QOU Circuit Breakers
• Flush mount, surface mount, and DIN rail mount.
• Internal common trip.
• Non-reversible line and load lugs.
• Terminal lug wire size (1) 12– 2/0 AWG Cu or Al.
• UL Listed 60 Vdc per pole (5 k AIR). (Note: except switches)
• UL Listed as HACR type, 80–125 A.
• Non-automatic switches have the same physical packaging as miniature circuit
breakers, but provide no overcurrent or short circuit protection. They are UL Listed per
UL1087 and are CSA certified.
Table 7.23: QOU High Ampere Miniature Circuit Breakers (10 k AIR)
High Ampere QOU
Ampere Cat. No.
Rating 1P 120/240 Vac 2P 120/240 Vac 2P 240 Vac 3P 240 Vac
 80 A QOU180 QOU280 — QOU380
 90 A QOU190 QOU290 — QOU390
100 A QOU1100 QOU2100 — QOU3100
125 A — QOU2125 — —

Table 7.24: QOU Non-Automatic Switches


Ampere Cat. No.
Rating 1P 120 Vac 2P 120/240 Vac 2P 240 Vac 3P 240 Vac
 60 A — — QOU200 QOU300
100 A — — QOU2000 QOU3000
125 A — — QOU20001 QOU30001

Interrupting ratings see page 7-3


Accessories see page 7-19
Dimensions see page 7-76
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

7-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QOU Accessories Homeline™ Circuit Breakers
Class 720 / Refer to Catalog 0730CT9801
schneider-electric.us

QOU Accessories
Table 7.25: Accessories for QOU Low Ampere Circuit Breakers (Except as Noted)
Order
Description Qty. Cat. No.
Factory-installed ring tongue terminal, 10–32 screw, for 1P, 2P, 3P QOU, 10–60 A — Suffix -5283
Hex drive 5/32 in. wire binding screw for QOU — Suffix -5280
For padlocking 1P low ampere QOU circuit breaker in OFF or ON position — QOU1PA
For padlocking 2P and 3P low ampere QOU circuit breaker in OFF or ON position — QOU1PL
For padlocking 1P low ampere QOU circuit breaker in OFF position only — QOU1PAFLA
For padlocking 2P and 3P low ampere QOU circuit breaker in OFF position only — QOU2PAFLA
For padlocking 2P and 3P high ampere QOU circuit breaker in OFF position only — Suffix -7100
Handle lock-out, ON or OFF position — HLO1
4P 100 A Jumper bar assy. w/front wiring with base, cover and screw 1 QOU14100JBAF
4P 100 A Jumper bar assy. w/right side wiring with base, cover and screw 1 QOU14100JBAR
4P 100 A Jumper bar assy. w/left side wiring with base, cover and screw 1 QOU14100JBAL
1Ø, 4P, 100 A Jumper bar base with front wiring 40 QOU14100BAFB
1Ø, 4P, 100 A Jumper bar base with left side wiring 40 QOU14100BALB
1Ø, 4P, 100 A Jumper bar base with right side wiring 40 QOU14100BARB
QOU14100JBAF
4P Jumper bar cover 40 QOU14100CAB
Mounting screw for jumper bar cover 40 QOU1CMSB
6P 150 A Jumper bar assy. w/front wiring with base, cover and screw 1 QOU16150JBAF
1Ø, 6P, 150 A Jumper bar base with front wiring 40 QOU16150BAFB
1Ø, 6P, 150 A Jumper bar base with left side wiring 40 QOU16150BALB
1Ø, 6P, 150 A Jumper bar base with right side wiring 40 QOU16150BARB
6P jumper bar cover 40 QOU16150CAB
Vertical rainproof cover 2P and 3P QO, QOU, FA and KA 1 BCV [32]
10 BCVB [32]
Horizontal rainproof cover 2P QO, QOU, and 3P Q2, EH 1 BCH [32]
10 BCHB [32]
1P Fingersafe™ cover for high ampere QOU circuit breaker 1 QOUHFSC1
40 QOUHFSC1B
1P Fingersafe cover for low ampere QOU circuit breaker 1 QOULFSC1
40 QOULFSC1B
Cover plate for one 2P QOU circuit breaker 1 QOUCP2
40 QOUCP2B
2P DIN-Mounted QOU Circuit Breaker
Cover plate for one 3P QOU circuit breaker 1 QOUCP3
40 QOUCP3B
Cover plate for two 2P QOU circuit breakers 1 QOUCP4
40 QOUCP4B
Cover plate for three 2P QOU circuit breakers 1 QOUCP6
40 QOUCP6B
Field-installable ring tongue terminal adaptor 1 QOURT
80 QOURTB
Quick connector end connection wiring 1 QOUEC
40 QOUECB
Quick connector forward or reverse wiring 1 QOUFR
Mounting Foot 40 QOUFRB
QOUMF1 1P QOU mounting foot 1 QOUMF1[32]
80 QOUMF1B [32]
2P QOU mounting foot 1 QOUMF2 [32]
40 QOUMF2B [32]
3P QOU mounting foot 1 QOUMF3 [32]
24 QOUMF3B [32]
Tapped mounting foot for QOU, 1P and 2P 10–70 A, 3P 10–60 A
Packaged with circuit breaker Suffix -3100
Individually packaged 1 QOUMFS1
Bulk packed 80 QOUMFS1B
Mechanical interlock attachment: Used to interlock two circuit breakers mounted
side-by-side so that only one circuit breaker can be ON at a time. A 1P or 2P circuit
breaker can be mounted on the left and interlocked with a 2P or 3P circuit breaker 1 QOU2DTILA [33]
on the right.

QOUQ Low Ampere Circuit Breakers


QOUQ low ampere circuit breakers with four-point quick-connect terminals are provided
with permanent factory-installed terminals which are affixed to the Load or OFF end of
the circuit breaker. This special terminal will accommodate up to four 1/4-inch insulated
female quick connect wire terminations. Total ampacity of these connections must not
exceed the rating of the circuit breaker.
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

Table 7.26: QOUQ Four-Point Quick-Connect Terminals


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

Poles Order Qty. Cat. No.


1 1
Change QOU to
Four-Point Quick-Connect Terminals 2 1 QOUQ
3 1

The QOU uses the same electrical accessories as the QO. See the QO information for available electrical
accessories.

[32] For use on low and high ampere QOU.


[33] 10–70 A 1P and 2P, 10–60 A 3P.
7

7-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Homeline™ Circuit Breakers Plug-On Circuit Breakers
Class 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us

Homeline Plug-On Circuit Breakers


The Square D Homeline circuit breakers are in a 1 in. wide format for 1-pole circuit
breakers. They are designed to plug into Homeline load centers.

Table 7.27: HOM


Ampere 1P—120/240 Vac 2P—120/240 Vac Common Trip
Rating AIR Cat. No. Cat. No.
 15 A 10 kA HOM115 [1][2] HOM215 [2]
 20 A 10 kA HOM120 [1][2] HOM220 [2]
 25 A 10 kA HOM125 [2] HOM225 [2]
 30 A 10 kA HOM130 [2] HOM230 [2]
 35 A 10 kA — HOM235 [2]
HOM 1P HOM 2P
1 Space Required 2 Spaces Required  40 A 10 kA HOM140 [2] HOM240 [2]
 45 A 10 kA — HOM245 [2]
 50 A 10 kA HOM150 [2] HOM250 [2]
 60 A 10 kA — HOM260 [2]
 70 A 10 kA — HOM270 [2]
 80 A 10 kA — HOM280 [2]
 90 A 10 kA — HOM290 [2]
100 A 10 kA — HOM2100 [2]
110 A 10 kA — HOM2110 [2]
125 A 10 kA — HOM2125 [2]
150 A 10 kA — HOM2150BB [2][3]
175 A 10 kA — HOM2175BB [2][3]
HOM2200BB
Branch Circuit Breaker 200 A 10 kA — HOM2200BB [2][3]
4 Spaces Required
Homeline High Magnetic (HM) Circuit Breakers
High magnetic trip circuit breakers are recommended for applications where high initial
inrush current may occur.

Table 7.28: HOM-HM


Amperes 1P—120/240 Vac 2Ps
15 A HOM115HM [4] —
20 A HOM120HM [4] —

Homeline Combination Arc Fault Circuit Interruptors (HOM-CAFI)


Homeline Combination Arc Fault Circuit Interrupters—Provide overload and short circuit
protection, plus arc fault protection in accordance with the NEC and UL1699.

Table 7.29: HOM-CAFI


Circuit Breaker Type Ampere Rating Poles Cat. No.
120 Vac
One-Pole
Combination Arc-Fault Circuit 15 A 1 HOM115CAFI [4]
Interrupter with Pigtail Neutral 20 A 1 HOM120CAFI [4]
Plug-On Neutral Combination 15 A 1 HOM115PCAFI [4]
Arc-Fault Interrupter 20 A 1 HOM120PCAFI [4]
Two-Pole
HOM 1P CAFI HOM 1P CAFI Combination Arc-Fault Circuit 15 A 2 HOM215CAFI [4] [5]
Plug-on Neutral Pigtail Interrupter with Pigtail Neutral 20 A 2 HOM220CAFI [4] [5]

Homeline Dual Function Circuit Breaker (HOM-DF)


Homeline Combination Arc Fault and Ground Fault Circuit Interrupters (Dual Function)—
Provide overload and short circuit protection, plus arc fault and ground fault protection in
a single device in accordance with the NEC, UL1699 and UL943.

Table 7.30: HOM-DF


Ampere Poles
Circuit Breaker Type Rating Cat. No.
120 Vac
Combination Arc-Fault and Ground Fault Circuit 15 A 1 HOM115DF [4]
Interrupter with Pigtail Neutral 20 A 1 HOM120DF [4]
Plug-On Neutral Combination 15 A 1 HOM115PDF [4]
Arc-Fault and Ground Fault
Circuit Interrupter 20 A 1 HOM120PDF [4]
HOM 1P DF HOM 1P DF
Plug-on Neutral Pigtail

[1] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated. Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[2] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[3] Requires four spaces (1 AWG–300 kcmil Al/Cu). Use only in 1Ø panel rated 150 A or greater.
[4] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[5] For 120/240 V only, not for 208Y/120 V.
7-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Plug-On Circuit Breakers Homeline™ Circuit Breakers
Class 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us

Homeline GFI (HOM-GFI)


HOM-GFI circuit breakers provide overload and short circuit protection, combined with
Class A ground fault protection. Class A denotes a ground fault circuit interrupter that will
trip when a fault current to ground is 6 milliamperes or more.

Table 7.31: HOM-GFI


Ampere 1P—120 Vac 2P—120/240 Vac
Rating AIR Common Trip
1 Space Required
2 Spaces Required
15 A 10 kA HOM115GFI HOM215GFI
20 A 10 kA HOM120GFI HOM220GFI
30 A 10 kA — HOM230GFI
40 A 10 kA — HOM240GFI
HOM 2P GFI
(With Ground Fault 50 A 10 kA — HOM250GFI
HOM 1P GFI
(With Ground Fault Circuit Interrupter)
Circuit Interrupter) 2 Spaces Required
1 Space Required

Homeline Equipment Protection Device (HOM-EPD)


Homeline Equipment Protection Device—Circuit Breakers with 30 mA Equipment
Ground Fault Protection (UL Listed).

Table 7.32: HOM-EPD—10 k AIR


2P—120/240 Vac
Amperes 1P—120 Vac Common Trip
15 A HOM115EPD HOM215EPD
20 A HOM120EPD HOM220EPD
25 A — HOM225EPD
30 A — HOM230EPD
40 A — HOM240EPD
50 A — HOM250EPD

HOMT Tandem and HOMT Quad Tandem Circuit Breakers


Table 7.33: HOMT Tandem Circuit Breakers
Ampere Rating [6] AIR 1P Tandem—120/240 Vac (One Space Required)
15 and 15 A 10 kA HOMT1515 [7]
15 and 20 A 10 kA HOMT1520 [7]
20 and 20 A 10 kA HOMT2020 [7]
30 and 15 A 10 kA HOMT3015 [7]
30 and 20 A 10 kA HOMT3020 [7]

Table 7.34: HOMT Quad Tandem Circuit Breakers


Ampere Rating [6] 2P Tandem—120/240 Vac (Two Spaces
AIR Required)
1P 2P
(2) 15 A 15 A 10 kA HOMT1515215 [7]
(2) 15 A 20 A 10 kA HOMT1515220 [7]
(2) 15 A 25 A 10 kA HOMT1515225 [7]
(2) 15 A 30 A 10 kA HOMT1515230 [7]
HOMT Quad (2) 15 A 40 A 10 kA HOMT1515240 [7]
Circuit Breaker (2) 15 A 50 A 10 kA HOMT1515250 [7]
2 Spaces Required (2) 20 A HOMT2020220 [7]
20 A 10 kA
(2) 20 A 25 A 10 kA HOMT2020225 [7]
(2) 20 A 30 A 10 kA HOMT2020230 [7]
(2) 20 A 40 A 10 kA HOMT2020240 [7]
(2) 20 A 50 A 10 kA HOMT2020250 [7]
NOTE: Typical catalog number (e.g. HOMT 1515230) represents two 1P, outer poles
(two 15 A 1P CBs) and one 2P inner circuit breaker with common trip (one 30 A 2P
CB).

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[6] 15– 20 A tandem or quad tandem circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 25– 50 A tandem or quad tandem circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC
conductors only.
[7] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
7

7-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Homeline™ Circuit Breakers Plug-On Circuit Breakers
Class 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us

Homeline Circuit Breaker Wire Sizes


Table 7.35: Circuit Breaker Wire Sizes
Wire Size (AWG/kcmil) [8]
Breaker Type Ampere Rating
Aluminum Copper
14–8 AWG or
HOM 15–30 A 14–8 AWG (2) 14–10 AWG
1P
40–50 A 8–2 AWG 8–2 AWG
14–8 AWG or
15–30 A 14–8 AWG (2) 14–10 AWG
HOM 35–70 A 8–2 AWG 8–2 AWG
2P
 80–125 A 4–2/0 AWG 4–2/0 AWG
150–200 A 4 AWG–300 kcmil 4 AWG–300 kcmil
HOMT and Quad 15–30 A 14–8 AWG 14–8 AWG
Quad Only 40–50 A 6–12 AWG 6–14 AWG
HOM-GFI - 1P 15–20 A 14–10 AWG 14–10 AWG
HOM-GFI - 2P 15–50 A 12–4 AWG 14–6 AWG

Accessories for Homeline Circuit Breakers


Table 7.36: Accessories
Description Cat. No.
Handle Attachments
Handle Tie: Converts any two adjacent 120/240 Vac single HOM circuit breakers to independent trip 2P HOM1HT
Handle Tie: Converts any two adjacent 120/240 Vac
1P side-by-side HOMT circuit breakers to independent trip 2P HOMTHT
Handle Clamp: Clamp for holding HOM 1P handle in the ON or OFF position QO1LO
Handle Blocking Device: Attaches to standard HOM 2P circuit breakers for holding the handle in the OFF position HOM2HBD
Handle Padlock Attachment: For padlocking 1P Standard HOM breakers in the ON or OFF position HOM1PA
15–70 A HOM2PALA
Handle Padlock Attachment: For
padlocking 2P Standard HOM circuit breakers in ON or OFF position 80–125 A HOM2PAHA
150–200 A HOM2PAVHA
Handle Padlock Attachment: For padlocking 1P CAFI, DF, GFI, and EPD HOM breakers in ON or OFF position HOMELEC1PA
Handle Padlock Attachment: For padlocking 2P CAFI, GFI, and EPD HOM breakers in ON or OFF position HOMELEC2PALA
Handle Padlock Attachment: For padlocking center poles of Homeline Quad breakers in the OFF position HOMQPA
50–125 A QOM1PA [9]
Handle Padlock Attachment: For padlocking main circuit breakers in convertible load center in OFF position
100–225 A QOM2PA [9]
Sub-Feed Lugs
125 A 2P plug-on—2 spaces required HOML2125
225 A 2P plug-on—4 spaces required HOML2225 [10]
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[8] 15–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 40–125 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[9] 50–125 A QOM1 frame size; 100–225 A QOM2 frame size.
[10] Requires four spaces (1 AWG–300 kcmil Al/Cu). Use only in 1Ø panel rated 150 A or greater.
7-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
C60BP and C60BPR Circuit Breakers Multi 9™ Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 860 / Refer to Catalog LVCATM9OEM_EN
schneider-electric.us

Multi 9 C60BP and C60BPR Miniature Circuit Breakers


C60BP and C60BPR are multi-standard miniature circuit breakers and branch circuit
protection as defined by UL489. They combine the following functions:
• circuit protection against short-circuit curves
IEC • circuit protection against overload currents
• tripping and fault indication by the addition of auxiliary accessories
UL489 / CSA C22.2 No 5 / IEC/EN 60947-2 / GB14048-2 Number of Breaking Capacity (kA rms)
Miniature Circuit Breakers 18 mm Rating (A)
(0.71 in.) 25°C/77°F AIR Icu
Poles UL 489 / CSA C22.2 No 5 IEC 60947-2
Voltage
(Ue) 277 Vac 240 Vac 120 Vac 60 Vdc 440 Vac 415 Vac 240 Vac 60 Vdc
0.5 to 35 10 14 14 10 — 3 10 20
1P
40 to 63 — 10 10 10 — 3 10 20
Voltage 125
(Ue) 480Y/277 Vac 240 Vac 125 Vdc 440 Vac 415 Vac 240 Vac Vdc
1 to 25 10 14 10 6 10 20 —
2P
30 to 35 10 14 — 6 10 20 —
3P 1 to 35 10 14 — 6 10 20 —
2P/3P 40 to 63 — 10 — 6 10 20 —

Table 7.37: C60BP and C60BPRCatalog Numbers


Type UL489 and 1P 2P 3P
Rating CSA Curve Curve Curve
(In) Voltages Z C D (= K) C D (= K) C D (= K)
C60BP (Tunnel Terminal Connection )
0.5 M9F44170 M9F42170 M9F43170 — — — —
1 M9F44101 M9F42101 M9F43101 M9F42201 M9F43201 M9F42301 M9F43301
2 M9F44102 M9F42102 M9F43102 M9F42202 M9F43202 M9F42302 M9F43302
3 M9F44103 M9F42103 M9F43103 M9F42203 M9F43203 M9F42303 M9F43303
4 M9F44104 M9F42104 M9F43104 M9F42204 M9F43204 M9F42304 M9F43304
5 M9F44105 M9F42105 M9F43105 M9F42205 M9F43205 M9F42305 M9F43305
6 480Y/277 V M9F44106 M9F42106 M9F43106 M9F42206 M9F43206 M9F42306 M9F43306
8 and 240 V M9F44108 M9F42108 M9F43108 M9F42208 M9F43208 M9F42308 M9F43308
C60BP 1P C60BP 2P C60BP 3P 10 M9F44110 M9F42110 M9F43110 M9F42210 M9F43210 M9F42310 M9F43310
15 M9F44115 M9F42115 M9F43115 M9F42215 M9F43215 M9F42315 M9F43315
20 M9F44120 M9F42120 M9F43120 M9F42220 M9F43220 M9F42320 M9F43320
25 M9F44125 M9F42125 M9F43125 M9F42225 M9F43225 M9F42325 M9F43325
30 M9F44130 M9F42130 M9F43130 M9F42230 M9F43230 M9F42330 M9F43330
35 M9F44135 M9F42135 M9F43135 M9F42235 M9F43235 M9F42335 M9F43335
40 M9F44140 M9F42140 M9F43140 M9F42240 M9F43240 M9F42340 M9F43340
45 M9F44145 M9F42145 M9F43145 M9F42245 M9F43245 M9F43245 M9F43345
240 V only
50 M9F44150 M9F42150 M9F43150 M9F42250 M9F43250 M9F42350 M9F43350
63 M9F44163 M9F42163 M9F43163 M9F42263 M9F43263 M9F42363 M9F43363
C60BPR (Ring Tongue Terminal Connection)
1 M9F54101 M9F52101 M9F53101 M9F52201 M9F53201 M9F52301 M9F53301
2 M9F54102 M9F52102 M9F53102 M9F52202 M9F53202 M9F52302 M9F53302
4 M9F54104 M9F52104 M9F53104 M9F52204 M9F53204 M9F52304 M9F53304
6 M9F54106 M9F52106 M9F53106 M9F52206 M9F53206 M9F52306 M9F53306
8 M9F54108 M9F52108 M9F53108 M9F52208 M9F53208 M9F52308 M9F53308
480Y/277 V
10 and 240 V M9F54110 M9F52110 M9F53110 M9F52210 M9F53210 M9F52310 M9F53310
15 M9F54115 M9F52115 M9F53115 M9F52215 M9F53215 M9F52315 M9F53315
20 M9F54120 M9F52120 M9F53120 M9F52220 M9F53220 M9F52320 M9F53320
25 M9F54125 M9F52125 M9F53125 M9F52225 M9F53225 M9F52325 M9F53325
30 M9F54130 M9F52130 M9F53130 M9F52230 M9F53230 M9F52330 M9F53330
35 M9F54135 M9F52135 M9F53135 M9F52235 M9F53235 M9F52335 M9F53335
40 M9F54140 M9F52140 M9F53140 M9F52240 M9F53240 M9F52340 M9F53340
45 M9F54145 M9F52145 M9F53145 M9F52245 M9F53245 M9F52345 M9F53345
240 V only
50 M9F54150 M9F52150 M9F53150 M9F52250 M9F53250 M9F52350 M9F53350
63 M9F54163 M9F52163 M9F53163 M9F52263 M9F53263 M9F52363 M9F53363

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

C60BPR 1P
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

C60BPR 2P
C60BPR 3P
7

7-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Multi 9™ Miniature Circuit Breakers C60SP Circuit Breakers
Class 860 / Refer to Catalog LVCATM9OEM_EN
schneider-electric.us

Multi 9 C60SP Miniature Circuit Breakers


C60SP circuit breakers are multi-standard miniature circuit beakers and supplementary
protection as defined by UL1077. They combine the following functions:
• circuit protection against short-circuit curves
IEC • circuit protection against overload currents
• tripping and fault indication by the addition of auxiliary accessories
UL1077 / CSA C22.2 No 235 / IEC/EN 60947-2 / GB14048-2 Number of Breaking capacity (kA rms)
18 mm Rating (A)
Multi 9 Miniature Circuit Breaker 25°C/77°F AIR Icu
(0.71 in.) Poles UL 489 / CSA C22.2 No 235 IEC 60947-2
Voltage
(Ue) 277 Vac 240 ac 120 Vac 65 Vdc 440 Vac 415 Vac 240 Vac 60 Vdc
0.5 to 32 10 14 14 10 — 3 10 20
1P
40 to 63 5 10 10 10 — 3 10 20
Voltage 125 125
(Ue) 480Y/277 Vac 240 Vac Vdc 440 Vac 415 Vac 240 Vac Vdc
1 to 25 10 14 10 6 10 20 —
2P
32 10 14 — 6 10 20 —
3P/4P 2 to 32 10 14 — 6 10 20 —
2P/3P /4P 40 to 63 5 10 — 6 10 20 —

Table 7.38: C60SP Catalog Numbers


Tunnel Terminal Connection
Curve Curve
Rating (In)
B C D (= K) B C D (= K)
1P 2P
0.5 M9F21170 M9F22170 M9F23170 — — —
1 M9F21101 M9F22101 M9F23101 M9F21201 M9F22201 M9F23201
2 M9F21102 M9F22102 M9F23102 M9F21202 M9F22202 M9F23202
3 M9F21103 M9F22103 M9F23103 M9F21203 M9F22203 M9F23203
C60SP 1P
4 M9F21104 M9F22104 M9F23104 M9F21204 M9F22204 M9F23204
5 M9F21105 M9F22105 M9F23105 M9F21205 M9F22205 M9F23205
6 M9F21106 M9F22106 M9F23106 M9F21206 M9F22206 M9F23206
8 M9F21108 M9F22108 M9F23108 M9F21208 M9F22208 M9F23208
10 M9F21110 M9F22110 M9F23110 M9F21210 M9F22210 M9F23210
13 M9F21113 M9F22113 M9F23113 M9F21213 M9F22213 M9F23213
16 M9F21116 M9F22116 M9F23116 M9F21216 M9F22216 M9F23216
20 M9F21120 M9F22120 M9F23120 M9F21220 M9F22220 M9F23220
25 M9F21125 M9F22125 M9F23125 M9F21225 M9F22225 M9F23225
C60SP 2P 32 M9F21132 M9F22132 M9F23132 M9F21232 M9F22232 M9F23232
40 M9F21140 M9F22140 M9F23140 M9F2124 M9F22240 M9F23240
45 M9F21145 M9F22145 M9F23145 M9F21245 M9F22245 M9F23245
50 M9F21150 M9F22150 M9F23150 M9F21250 M9F22250 M9F23250
63 M9F21163 M9F22163 M9F23163 M9F21263 M9F22263 M9F23263
3P 4P
0.5 — — — — — —
1 — — — — — —
2 M9F21302 M9F22302 M9F23302 M9F21402 M9F22402 M9F23402
3 — — — — — —
C60SP 3P 4 — — — — — —
5 — — — — — —
6 M9F21306 M9F22306 M9F23306 M9F21406 M9F22406 M9F23406
8 M9F21308 M9F22308 M9F23308 M9F21408 M9F22408 M9F23408
10 M9F21310 M9F22310 M9F23310 M9F21410 M9F22410 M9F23410
13 M9F21313 M9F22313 M9F23313 M9F21413 M9F22413 M9F23413
16 M9F21316 M9F22316 M9F23316 M9F21416 M9F22416 M9F23416
20 M9F21320 M9F22320 M9F23320 M9F21420 M9F22420 M9F23420
25 M9F21325 M9F22325 M9F23325 M9F21425 M9F22425 M9F23425
32 M9F21332 M9F22332 M9F23332 M9F21432 M9F22432 M9F23432
C60SP 4P 40 M9F21340 M9F22340 M9F23340 M9F21440 M9F22440 M9F23440
45 M9F21345 M9F22345 M9F23345 M9F21445 M9F22445 M9F23445
50 M9F21350 M9F22350 M9F23350 M9F21450 M9F22450 M9F23450
63 M9F21363 M9F22363 M9F23363 M9F21463 M9F22463 M9F23463
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

7-24
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
C60H-DC Circuit Breakers Multi 9™ Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 860 / Refer to Catalog LVCATM9OEM_EN
schneider-electric.us

Multi 9 C60H-DC Miniature Circuit Breakers for DC Circuits


C60H-DC circuit breakers are multi–standard miniature circuit beakers and supplementary
protection as defined by UL1077, dedicated to direct current applications. They combine
the following functions:
IEC • circuit protection against short-circuit curves
• circuit protection against overload currents
UL1077, IEC/EN 60947-2, GB14048.2
• tripping and fault indication by the addition of auxiliary accessories
Multi 9 Miniature Circuit Breakers Breaking capacity (kA rms)
Number of 18 mm Rating (A)
(0.71 in.) Poles 25°C/77°F AIR Icu
UL 1077SA C22.2 No 5 IEC 60947-2
Voltage (Ue) 12–250 Vdc 110 Vdc 220 Vdc 250 Vdc
1P 0.5 to 63 5 20 10 6
Voltage (Ue) 12–250 Vdc 220 Vdc 440 Vdc 500 Vdc
2 0.5 to 63 5 — 20 10 6

Table 7.39: C60H-DC Catalog Numbers


Curve Curve
Rating (In)
B C K (= D) B C K (= D)
1P 2P
0.5 — M9U21170 — — M9U21270 —
1 — M9U21101 M9U31101 — M9U31201 M9U31201
2 — M9U21102 M9U31102 — M9U21202 M9U31202
3 — M9U21103 M9U31103 — M9U21203 M9U31203
4 — M9U21104 M9U31104 — M9U21204 M9U31204
C60H-DC 1P C60H-DC 2P
6 M9U11106 M9U21106 M9U31106 M9U11206 M9U21206 M9U31206
10 M9U11110 M9U21110 M9U31110 M9U11210 M9U21210 M9U31210
13 M9U11113 M9U21113 M9U31113 M9U11213 M9U21213 M9U31213
16 M9U11116 M9U21116 M9U31116 M9U11216 M9U21216 M9U31216
20 M9U11120 M9U21120 M9U31120 M9U11220 M9U21220 M9U31220
25 M9U11125 M9U21125 M9U31125 M9U11225 M9U21225 M9U31225
32 M9U11132 M9U21132 M9U31132 M9U11232 M9U21232 M9U31232
40 M9U11140 M9U21140 M9U31140 M9U11240 M9U21240 M9U31240
50 M9U11150 M9U21150 M9U31150 M9U11250 M9U21250 M9U31250
63 M9U11163 M9U21163 M9U31163 M9U11263 M9U21263 M9U31263

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


7 CIRCUIT BREAKERS

7-25
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Multi 9™ Miniature Circuit Breakers GFP Ground Fault Protectors
Class 860 / Refer to Catalog LVCATM9OEM_EN
schneider-electric.us

Multi 9 GFP Ground Fault Protectors


UL 1053 residual current circuit breakers already protected upstream by a short circuit
and overload protection device are used for:
• control and disconnection of electric circuits
IEC • protection of people against electric shock by direct and indirect contacts
• protection of installations against insulation faults
UL1053, IEC/EN 61008 • enhanced continuity of supply, during a series of close lightning strokes, IT earthing
Multi 9 Ground Fault Protectors system, equipment including interference suppression filters, variable speed
controllers, frequency converters, electronic ballasts for lighting
• enhanced earth leakage protection: in presence of harmonics or high frequency
ejections.
A-SI type GFPs are ideal for operation in environments with a humid atmosphere and/or
polluted by aggressive agents: swimming pools, marinas, agri-food industries, water
treatment stations, industrial sites, etc.

Table 7.40: GFP UL 1053 Type A-SI


Sensitivity (mA) Catalog No
Width in
240 V modules of
A-S1 Type Rating (A) IEC/ EN 120 or 240 V 480Y/277 V 9 mm
UL 1053 61008 230 or 240 V 230/400 or (0.354 in.)
240/415 V
2P
26 30 M9R81225 M9R41225
25 86 100 M9R12225 M9R44225
Multi 9 GFP 2P Multi 9 GFP 4P 260 300 M9R84225 —
26 30 M9R81240 M9R41240 4
40
260 300 M9R84240 —

63 26 30 M9R81263 —

4P
26 30 — M9R81425
25 86 100 — M9R12425
260 300 — M9R84425
26 30 — M9R81440
40
260 300 — M9R84440 8
26 30 — M9R81463
63
86 100 — M9R12463
86 100 — M9R12491
100
260 300 — M9R84491
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

7-26
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Multi 9 Circuit Breakers Busbar Offer Multi 9™ Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 860 / Refer to Catalog LVCATM9OEM_EN
schneider-electric.us

C60BP (UL489) Comb Busbars


These comb busbars are aimed to be used only with C60BP circuit-breakers.
They perform distribution and subdistribution of the electric power supply and allow rapid
assembly and disassembly of equipment.
IEC
Table 7.41: C60BP Comb Busbars
Insulated
Connection Accessories Comb Busbars Connectors Tooth Covers End-Piece
Function
• The comb busbars make it easier to install C60BP UL489 circuit breakers. • Comb busbar • Insulation of teeth • Ensures
• They must not be cut. power supply remaining free the correct
comb
• Vertical
incoming
busbar
insulation
feeder
Use
Power supply by insulated connector Tightening
torque: 3.5 N•m
• Use with rigid and flexible copper cable
(31 lb.in.)
• 6 to 35 mm2 (AWG #10 to #2):
Standard Comb Busbars

Number of poles 1P 2P 3P All All —


Catalogue numbers M9XUP106 M9XUP312 M9XUP312 M9XUP312 M9R81425 M9XUPC04 M9XCTC18 —
M9XUP312
Number of 18 mm modules 6 6 12 6 12 — — —
12
Set of 1 1 1 4 5x3 —
Cuttable Comb Busbars

Number of poles x 1P 2P 3P 1P+Aux 3P+Aux All All —


Catalogue numbers M9XCP157 M9XCP256 M9XCP357 M9XCA137 M9XCA348 M9XCPC04 M9XUTC18 M9XCEC10
Number of 18 mm modules 57 56 57 37 37 — — —
Set of 1 1 1 1 1 4 5x3 —
Technical Specifications
Acceptable current at 40°C Standard comb busbars: 115 A
(Ie) Cuttable comb busbars: 80 A
Resistance to short-circuit Compatible with the breaking capacity of Schneider Electric modular circuit breakers
currents
Voltage rating (Ue) 480Y/277 V
Insulation voltage (Ui) 1000 V AC
Pollution degree 3
Fire resistance Self-extinguishability 960°C 30 s/30 s
Colour RAL 7035
Standards UL508

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


7 CIRCUIT BREAKERS

7-27
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Multi 9™ Miniature Circuit Breakers Multi 9 Circuit Breakers Busbar Offer
Class 860 / Refer to Catalog LVCATM9OEM_EN
schneider-electric.us

C60SP (UL1077) Comb Busbars


The comb busbars are used only for C60SP circuit breakers UL 1077 supplementary
protection in conformity with standards:
• UL 1077 / CSA C22.2 No. 235 / IEC 60947-2 / GB 14048-2.
IEC They perform distribution and subdistribution of the electric power supply and allow rapid
assembly and disassembly of equipment.

Table 7.42: C60SP Comb Busbars


Connection Accessories Comb Busbars Tooth Cover End-Piece

Function
• The comb busbars make it easier to install Schneider Electric circuit breakers UL1077
supplementary protection.
• The Tooth Caps are insulated protectors which may be
slipped onto the unused teeth of the comb busbar.
• Power supply directly in the cage of the circuit breaker. • They come in strips with 1-pole spacing, but can be
snapped apart to be used individually.
Number of poles 1P 2P 3P All
Voltage rating (Ue) 480Y/277 Vac 480Y/277 Vac 480Y/277 Vac —
Catalogue numbers 10285 10286 10287 60488
Number of 18 mm modules 12 (8.5 in./216 mm) 12 (8.5 in./216 mm) 12 (8.5 i./216 mm) —
Set of 1 1 1 20
Technical Specifications
Insulation voltage (Ui) 690 Vac —
Impulse withstand voltage 12 kV under 240 V —
(Uimp) 5 kV under 480Y/277 V or 277 V
Acceptable current at 40°C 63 A with 1 central power supply point 100 A with 2 power supply points —
(Ie) —

Power supply via cable directly in the cage of the device: —


• cross section max: 3 AWG (25 mm2)
• cross section min: 10 AWG (5.27 mm2)
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

7-28
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
C60 Accessories Multi 9™ Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 860 / Refer to Catalog 0860CT0201
schneider-electric.us

Multi 9 C60 Accessories


Electrical Accessories for C60 Circuit Breakers and Supplementary Protectors
Possible Combinations
Mounted to the left of the circuit breaker with a maximum width of 54 mm.
Indication Tripping

Ring Tongue
Terminal Kit Spacer

SD OF MX MN
Auxiliary Shunt trip + Aux Undervoltage C60
Alarm Switch
Switch Switch Release

C60 Padlock
Attachment Heavy-Duty Padlock Table 7.43: Multi 9 C60 Electrical Accessories
Attachment Control Voltage Width in 9 mm C60 UL/IEC
Descriptions
Vac Vdc Modules Cat. No.
OF Auxiliary Switch (1a1b) 12–277 12–125 1 M9A26924
SD Alarm Switch (1a1b) 12–277 12–125 1 M9A26927
24 24 2 M9A26948
MX Shunt Trip + OF Auxiliary
Switch (1a1b) 48 48 2 M9A26947
110–240–277 125 2 M9A26946
24 24 2 M9A27108
48 48 2 M9A26961
MN Undervoltage Release
120 — 2 M9A27107
240 — 2 M9A26960
Multi-9 GFP UL 1053 Listed 120 to 480Y/277 Vac; 30, 100, and 300 mA; 2P and 4Ps.
Ground Fault Protectors See Multi 9 GFP Ground Fault Protectors, page 7-26 or Catalog LVCATM9OEM_
EN
Rotary Handle
Table 7.44: Multi 9 C60 Mechanical Accessories
Descriptions C60 Cat. No.
Ring tongue terminal kit for UL1077 C60 For one pole M9A17400
Spacer for DIN rail, Not UL Recognized 9 mm wide 27062
Padlock Attachment (1 per for 1P, 2P, 3P or 4P) 2 per pack 26970
Heavy-duty Padlock Attachment for C60, Locks OFF only 2 per pack M9PAF
Padlocking Device Left Side Mount, Locks OFF only [1] MGN26380
1 per pack
Padlocking Device Right Side Mount, Locks OFF only [2] MGN26381
1P MG26983
Front Mounting Kit for C60
1P, 2P, 3P, 4P 2P MG26984
Front Mounting Kit
(1 per circuit breaker) 3P MG26985
4P MG26989
Terminal Screw Shield (Not UL Recognized) Bag of two 26981
4P shields
1P 26975
2P 26976
Terminal cover (Not UL Recognized) 26975 +
3P
26976
4P 26978
Rotary Handle for C60 (Non UL Recognized)
Operating Subassembly 27046
Door Interlock Handle 2P/3P/4P 27047
Fixed Handle (Front or Lateral) 27048
Multi-pole Front Mounting Kit
Rail Support (20 of 9 mm modules) 14211
MGN26380 Locking MGN26380 Locking Hinged Transparent Cover 14210
Device Left Side Mount Device Right Side Mount
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

Multi-Pole
Front Mounting Kit

[1] Left-side mounted padlocking device cannot be used in conjunction with accessories SD, OF, MX or MN. Use right-side mounted padlocking device when accessories are required.
[2] Right-side mounted padlocking device cannot be used in conjunction with VIGI module. Use left-side mounted padlocking device when VIGI Module is required.
7

7-29
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers PowerPact Family
Class 611, 612
schneider-electric.us

The PowerPact Advantage


• Proven Performance: Industry-leading circuit breaker innovation and protection for
heavy-duty commercial and industrial applications.
• Smart: Integrated metering options provide a cost-effective solution to reduce energy
consumption, optimize energy costs, and improve energy availablility for your facilities.
• Flexible: Full range of thermal-magnetic and electronic trip molded case circuit
breakers from 15 A to 3000 A, delivering the ratings, configurations, and operators for
your unique applications.
• Simple: Common catalog numbers, standardized ratings, and a full range of field-
installable accessories make product selection, installation and maintenance easier
than ever.
• Common Design Features: Mounting holes, door trim, and handle accessories
B-Frame H-Frame J-Frame Q-Frame L-Frame M-Frame P-Frame R-Frame
125 A 150 A 250 A 250 A 600 A 800 A 1200 A 3000 A

Electronic Trip
Version
Electronic Trip
Version

Table 7.45: PowerPact Interrupting Ratings


Interrupting Rating
Voltage
B D G J K L R
240 Vac 10 kA 25 kA 65 kA 100 kA 65 kA [1] 125 kA 200 kA
480 Vac 18 kA 35 kA 65 kA 65 kA[2] 100 kA 200 kA
600 Vac 14 kA 18 kA 25 kA 65 kA[2] 50 kA [3] 100 kA

Table 7.46: Common Catalog Numbering System


Frame Rating Termination Poles Voltage Amperage[4] Suffix Code Suffix Code
H G L 3 6 1 5 0 A B S A

1 1Pole 4 480 V 2A/2B Auxiliary Switch 110 Vac Shunt Trip


2 2Pole 6 600 V
3 3Pole
4 4Pole

Interrupting Rating Terminations


Frame Designation 240 Vac 480 Vac 600Vac
B 10 kA — — A I-Line
B 125 A Frame D 25 kA 18 kA 14 kA L Lugs on Both Ends
H 150 A Frame F Bus Bar (No Lugs)
J 250 A Frame G 65 kA 35 kA 18 kA M Lugs Line Side Only
Q 250 A Frame J 100 kA 65 kA 25 kA P Lugs Load End Only
L 600 A Frame K 100 kA 65 kA 65 kA N Plug-in
M 800 A Frame L 125 kA 100 kA 50 kA D Drawout
P 1200 A Frame R 200 kA 200 kA 100 kA S Rear Connected Studs
R 3000 A Frame

Description
B-Frame Circuit Breakers, page 7-31
H- and J-Frame Circuit Breakers, page 7-32
Q-Frame Circuit Breakers, page 7-36
L-Frame Circuit Breakers, page 7-37
P-Frame Circuit Breakers, page 7-39
R-Frame Circuit Breakers, page 7-40
PowerPact™ H- and J-Frame Electronic Motor Circuit Protectors, page 7-42
7

Motor Circuit Protectors and Motor Protector Circuit Breakers, page 7-45
Automatic Switches, page 7-49
500 Vdc Circuit Breakers, page 7-50
Mission Critical Circuit Breakers, page 7-52
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories, page 7-54


Motor Operators and Rotary Handles, page 7-55
Locks, Installation Accessories, and Rear Connections, page 7-57
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

Mechanical Lugs, page 7-57


Compression Lugs and Power Distribution Connectors (PDC), page 7-60
Terminal Nuts, Terminal Pads, Terminal Shields and Accessories, page 7-62
Plug-In and Drawout Mountings, page 7-63
Micrologic™ Electronic Trip Units, page 7-65
Micrologic™ Trip Unit Accessories, page 7-69

[1] B-Frame K interrupting rating is 100 kA at 240 Vac


[2] P-frame K interrupting is 50 kA at 480 and 600 Vac.
[3] P-frame L interrupting is 25 kA at 600 Vac.
[4] For amperage of M,-, P- or R-frame circuit breakers, add a zero to the three amperage digits; for example, 120 = 1200 A.
7-30
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
B-Frame Circuit Breakers PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Class 0613
schneider-electric.us

PowerPact B-Frame Circuit Breakers

B-Frame
Thermal-Magnetic Trip Unit

Table 7.47: PowerPact B-Frame 125 A Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers (600Y/347 Vac) with EverLink Lugs
Cur- Interrupting Rating
rent D G J K
Rat- 2 Pole 3 Pole 4 Pole 2 Pole 3 Pole 4 Pole 2 Pole 3 Pole 4 Pole 2 Pole
ing @ 1 Pole 1 Pole 1 Pole 1 Pole
600Y/347 600Y/347 600Y/347 600Y/347 600Y/347 600Y/347 600Y/347 600Y/347 600Y/347 600Y/347
40o C 347 Vac 347 Vac 347 Vac 347 Vac
Vac Vac Vac Vac Vac Vac Vac Vac Vac Vac
15 A BDL16015 BDL26015 BDL36015 BDL46015 BGL16015 BGL26015 BGL36015 BGL46015 BJL16015 BJL26015 BJL36015 BJL46015 BKL16015 BKL26015
20 A BDL16020 BDL26020 BDL36020 BDL46020 BGL16020 BGL26020 BGL36020 BGL46020 BJL16020 BJL26020 BJL36020 BJL46020 BKL16020 BKL26020
25 A BDL16025 BDL26025 BDL36025 BDL46025 BGL16025 BGL26025 BGL36025 BGL46025 BJL16025 BJL26025 BJL36025 BJL46025 BKL16025 BKL26025
30 A BDL16030 BDL26030 BDL36030 BDL46030 BGL16030 BGL26030 BGL36030 BGL46030 BJL16030 BJL26030 BJL36030 BJL46030 BKL16030 BKL26030
35 A BDL16035 BDL26035 BDL36035 BDL46035 BGL16035 BGL26035 BGL36035 BGL46035 BJL16035 BJL26035 BJL36035 BJL46035 — —
40 A BDL16040 BDL26040 BDL36040 BDL46040 BGL16040 BGL26040 BGL36040 BGL46040 BJL16040 BJL26040 BJL36040 BJL46040 — —
45 A BDL16045 BDL16045 BDL36045 BDL46045 BGL16045 BGL26045 BGL36045 BGL46045 BJL16045 BJL26045 BJL36045 BJL46045 — —
50 A BDL16050 BDL26050 BDL36050 BDL46050 BGL16050 BGL26050 BGL36050 BGL46050 BJL16050 BJL26050 BJL36050 BJL46050 — —
60 A BDL16060 BDL26060 BDL36060 BDL46060 BGL16060 BGL26060 BGL36060 BGL46060 BJL16060 BJL26060 BJL36060 BJL46060 — —
70 A BDL16070 BDL26070 BDL36070 BDL46070 BGL16070 BGL26070 BGL36070 BGL46070 BJL16070 BJL26070 BJL36070 BJL46070 — —
80 A BDL16080 BDL26080 BDL36080 BDL46080 BGL16080 BGL26080 BGL36080 BGL46080 BJL16080 BJL26080 BJL36080 BJL46080 — —
90 A BDL16090 BDL26090 BDL36090 BDL46090 BGL16090 BGL26090 BGL36090 BGL46090 BJL16090 BJL26090 BJL36090 BJL46090 — —
100 A BDL16100 BDL26100 BDL36100 BDL46100 BGL16100 BGL26100 BGL36100 BGL46100 BJL16100 BJL26100 BJL36100 BJL46100 — —
110 A BDL16110 BDL26110 BDL36110 BDL46110 BGL16110 BGL26110 BGL36110 BGL46110 BJL16110 BJL26110 BJL36110 BJL46110 — —
125 A BDL16125 BDL26125 BDL36125 BDL46125 BGL16125 BGL26125 BGL36125 BGL46125 BJL16125 BJL26125 BJL36125 BJL46125 — —

Table 7.48: B-Frame Termination Options Table 7.49: B-Frame Interrupting Ratings
Interrupting Rating
Termination Letter Voltage
A = I-Line (See Section 9) BDL36100 D G J K
For factory-installed 240 Vac 25 kA 65 kA 100 kA 100 kA
F = No Lugs (includes terminal nut kit on both
ends) termination, place 480/277 Vac 18 kA 35 kA 65 kA 65 kA
termination letter in 480 Vac 18 kA 35 kA 65 kA 65 kA
L =EverLink Lugs both ends the third block of the 600Y/347 Vac 14 kA 18 kA 25 kA 65 kA
M = Lugs ON end Terminal Nut Kit OFF end circuit breaker catalog
number.
P = Lugs OFF end Terminal Nut Kit ON end Table 7.51: PowerPact B-Frame 125 A Magnetic Trip Values
Current Rating @ Fixed AC Magnetic Trip
Table 7.50: B-Frame Lug Options 40o C Hold Trip
Lug Option Suffix 15 A 400 A 600 A
No Suffix = EverLink Lugs both ends B D L 3 6 1 0 0 LU 20 A 400 A 600 A
LU = EverLink Lug with Control Wire For factory-installed 25 A 400 A 600 A
Terminal ON end; EverLink Lug OFF end lug option, place suffix 30 A 400 A 600 A
after the amperage in
LV = EverLink Lug ON end; EverLink Lug the circuit breaker 35 A 400 A 600 A
with Control Wire Terminal OFF end catalog number. 40 A 400 A 600 A
LW = EverLink Lug with Control Wire 45 A 400 A 600 A
Terminal both ends 50 A 480 A 720 A
LC = Copper Mechanical Lugs both ends 60 A 640 A 960 A
LH = Aluminum Mechanical Lugs both ends 70 A 640 A 960 A
80 A 800 A 1200 A
90 A 1000 A 1500 A
100 A 1000 A 1500 A
110 A 1000 A 1500 A
125 A 1000 A 1500 A

Accessories see page 7-54


MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

Optional Lugs see page 7-59


Dimensions see page 7-77
7 CIRCUIT BREAKERS

7-31
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers H- and J-Frame Circuit Breakers
Class 611 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001
schneider-electric.us

PowerPact H- and J-Frame Circuit Breakers

HD and HG 2P
Thermal-Magnetic Trip Unit H-Frame
(2P HJ, HL in 3P module) Thermal-Magnetic Trip Unit

Table 7.52: H-Frame 150 A Thermal-Magnetic UL Current-Limiting [5] Circuit Breakers (600 Vac, 250 Vdc) [6] With Factory Sealed Trip Unit
Suitable for Reverse Connection [7]
Interrupting Rating
Current Fixed AC Magnetic Trip
D G J [6] L [6]
Rating @
40o C Standard Standard Standard Standard
Hold Trip (80% Rated) 100% Rated (80% Rated) 100% Rated (80% Rated) 100% Rated (80% Rated) 100% Rated
H-Frame, 150A 2P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc [8]
15 A 350 A  750 A HDL26015 HDL26015C HGL26015 HGL26015C HJL26015 HJL26015C HLL26015 HLL26015C
20 A 350 A  750 A HDL26020 HDL26020C HGL26020 HGL26020C HJL26020 HJL26020C HLL26020 HLL26020C
25 A 350 A  750 A HDL26025 HDL26025C HGL26025 HGL26025C HJL26025 HJL26025C HLL26025 HLL26025C
30 A 350 A  750 A HDL26030 HDL26030C HGL26030 HGL26030C HJL26030 HJL26030C HLL26030 HLL26030C
35 A 400 A  850 A HDL26035 HDL26035C HGL26035 HGL26035C HJL26035 HJL26035C HLL26035 HLL26035C
40 A 400 A  850 A HDL26040 HDL26040C HGL26040 HGL26040C HJL26040 HJL26040C HLL26040 HLL26040C
45 A 400 A  850 A HDL26045 HDL26045C HGL26045 HGL26045C HJL26045 HJL26045C HLL26045 HLL26045C
50 A 400 A  850 A HDL26050 HDL26050C HGL26050 HGL26050C HJL26050 HJL26050C HLL26050 HLL26050C
60 A 800 A 1450 A HDL26060 HDL26060C HGL26060 HGL26060C HJL26060 HJL26060C HLL26060 HLL26060C
70 A 800 A 1450 A HDL26070 HDL26070C HGL26070 HGL26070C HJL26070 HJL26070C HLL26070 HLL26070C
80 A 800 A 1450 A HDL26080 HDL26080C HGL26080 HGL26080C HJL26080 HJL26080C HLL26080 HLL26080C
90 A 800 A 1450 A HDL26090 HDL26090C HGL26090 HGL26090C HJL26090 HJL26090C HLL26090 HLL26090C
100 A 800 A 1700 A HDL26100 HDL26100C HGL26100 HGL26100C HJL26100 HJL26100C HLL26100 HLL26100C
110 A 900 A 1700 A HDL26110 HDL26110C HGL26110 HGL26110C HJL26110 HJL26110C HLL26110 HLL26110C
125 A 900 A 1700 A HDL26125 HDL26125C HGL26125 HGL26125C HJL26125 HJL26125C HLL26125 HLL26125C
150 A 900 A 1700 A HDL26150 HDL26150C HGL26150 HGL26150C HJL26150 HJL26150C HLL26150 HLL26150C
H-Frame 150A 3P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc
15 A 350 A  750 A HDL36015 HDL36015C HGL36015 HGL36015C HJL36015 HJL36015C HLL36015 HLL36015C
20 A 350 A  750 A HDL36020 HDL36020C HGL36020 HGL36020C HJL36020 HJL36020C HLL36020 HLL36020C
25 A 350 A  750 A HDL36025 HDL36025C HGL36025 HGL36025C HJL36025 HJL36025C HLL36025 HLL36025C
30 A 350 A  750 A HDL36030 HDL36030C HGL36030 HGL36030C HJL36030 HJL36030C HLL36030 HLL36030C
35 A 400 A  850 A HDL36035 HDL36035C HGL36035 HGL36035C HJL36035 HJL36035C HLL36035 HLL36035C
40 A 400 A  850 A HDL36040 HDL36040C HGL36040 HGL36040C HJL36040 HJL36040C HLL36040 HLL36040C
45 A 400 A  850 A HDL36045 HDL36045C HGL36045 HGL36045C HJL36045 HJL36045C HLL36045 HLL36045C
50 A 400 A  850 A HDL36050 HDL36050C HGL36050 HGL36050C HJL36050 HJL36050C HLL36050 HLL36050C
60 A 800 A 1450 A HDL36060 HDL36060C HGL36060 HGL36060C HJL36060 HJL36060C HLL36060 HLL36060C
70 A 800 A 1450 A HDL36070 HDL36070C HGL36070 HGL36070C HJL36070 HJL36070C HLL36070 HLL36070C
80 A 800 A 1450 A HDL36080 HDL36080C HGL36080 HGL36080C HJL36080 HJL36080C HLL36080 HLL36080C
90 A 800 A 1450 A HDL36090 HDL36090C HGL36090 HGL36090C HJL36090 HJL36090C HLL36090 HLL36090C
100 A 800 A 1700 A HDL36100 HDL36100C HGL36100 HGL36100C HJL36100 HJL36100C HLL36100 HLL36100C
110 A 900 A 1700 A HDL36110 HDL36110C HGL36110 HGL36110C HJL36110 HJL36110C HLL36110 HLL36110C
125 A 900 A 1700 A HDL36125 HDL36125C HGL36125 HGL36125C HJL36125 HJL36125C HLL36125 HLL36125C
150 A 900 A 1700 A HDL36150 HDL36150C HGL36150 HGL36150C HJL36150 HJL36150C HLL36150 HLL36150C
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[5] Circuit breakers with J and L interrupting ratings are UL certified as current limiting.
[6] Standard lug kit: AL150HD. Terminal wire range: 14–3/0 AWG Al or Cu.
[7] See Supplemental Digest Section 3 for circuit breakers with field interchangeable trip units.
[8] HD and HG circuit breakers are true two-pole construction.
7-32
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
H- and J-Frame Circuit Breakers PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Class 611 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001
schneider-electric.us

Table 7.53: J-Frame 250 A Thermal-Magnetic UL Current-Limiting [9] Circuit Breakers (600 Vac, 250 Vdc) With Factory Sealed Trip Unit
Suitable for Reverse Connection [10]
Adjustable AC Interrupting Rating
Current Magnetic Trip
Rating D G J [9] L [9] R [9]
@ 40oC High Standard Standard Standard Standard Standard
Low (80% Rated) 100% Rated (80% Rated) 100% Rated (80% Rated) 100% Rated (80% Rated) 100% Rated (80% Rated) 100% Rated
J-Frame 250A 2P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc
150 A[11] 750 A 1500 A JDL26150 JDL26150C JGL26150 JGL26150C JLL26150 JLL26150C JLL26150 JLL26150C — —
175 A[11] 875 A 1750 A JDL26175 JDL26175C JGL26175 JGL26175C JLL26175 JLL26175C JLL26175 JLL26175C — —
200 A[12] 1000 A 2000 A JDL26200 JDL26200C JGL26200 JGL26200C JLL26200 JLL26200C JLL26200 JLL26200C — —
225 A[12] 1125 A 2250 A JDL26225 JDL26225C JGL26225 JGL26225C JLL26225 JLL26225C JLL26225 JLL26225C — —
250 A[12] 1250 A 2500 A JDL26250 JDL26250C JGL26250 JGL26250C JLL26250 JLL26250C JLL26250 JLL26250C — —
J-Frame 250A 3P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc
150 A[11] 750 A 1500 A JDL36150 JDL36150C JGL36150 JGL36150C JJL36150 JJL36150C JLL36150 JLL36150C JRL36150 JRL36150C
175 A[11] 875 A 1750 A JDL36175 JDL36175C JGL36175 JGL36175C JJL36175 JJL36175C JLL36175 JLL36175C JRL36175 JRL36175C
200 A[12] 1000 A 2000 A JDL36200 JDL36200C JGL36200 JGL36200C JJL36200 JJL36200C JLL36200 JLL36200C JRL36200 JRL36200C
225 A[12] 1125 A 2250 A JDL36225 JDL36225C JGL36225 JGL36225C JJL36225 JJL36225C JLL36225 JLL36225C JRL36225 JRL36225C
250 A[12] 1250 A 2500 A JDL36250 JDL36250C JGL36250 JGL36250C JJL36250 JJL36250C JLL36250 JLL36250C JRL36250 JRL36250C

Table 7.54: H- and J-Frame Interrupting Ratings


Interrupting Rating
Voltage
D G J L R
240 Vac 25 kA 65 kA 100 kA 125 kA 200 kA
480 Vac 18 kA 35 kA 65 kA 100 kA 200 kA
600 Vac 14 kA 18 kA 25 kA 50 kA 100 kA

Table 7.55: H- and J-Frame Termination Options


Termination Letter
A = I-Line (See Section 9) HGL36100
Plug-in Drawout Rear Connected For factory-installed termination,
F = No Lugs (includes terminal nut kit on both ends)
place termination letter in the third
L = Lugs both ends block of the circuit breaker catalog
M = Lugs ON end Terminal Nut Kit OFF end number.
P = Lugs OFF end Terminal Nut Kit ON end
N = Plug-in
D = Drawout
S = Rear Connected

Accessories see page 7-54


Optional Lugs see page 7-59
Dimensions see page 7-77
Enclosures see page 7-78

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[9] Circuit breakers with J, L, and R interrupting ratings are UL certified as current limiting.
[10] See Supplemental Digest Section 3 for circuit breakers with field interchangeable trip units.
[11] Standard lug kit: AL175JD. Terminal wire range: 4–4/0 AWG Al or Cu.
[12] Standard lug kit: AL250JD. Terminal wire range: 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil Al or Cu.
7

7-33
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers H- and J-Frame Circuit Breakers
Class 611 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001
schneider-electric.us

5 .2 E
.9 5 .9 6
0 .9 4 .9 7
>11
>30 .9 3 .9 8
.9 2
% Ir 1
.9 Io )
>30
A Ir 4( x

M icor lo g ic
5
3 6
2 .5 8
2 10
1 .5 x Ir )
Is d(

H-Frame
Micrologic™ Trip Unit J-Frame H-Frame Circuit Breaker
Micrologic Trip Unit Optional FDM and IFM Module

Table 7.56: H-Frame 150 A and J-Frame 250 A Electronic Trip UL Current-Limiting [13] Standard (80% Rated) Circuit Breakers (600 Vac)
With Factory Sealed Trip Unit [14] Suitable for Reverse Connection [15]
Electronic Trip Unit Interrupting Rating (80% Rated)
Sensor Rating
Type Function Trip Unit D G J [13] L [13] R [13]
600 Vac, 50/60 Hz, 3P
60 A [17] HDL36060U31X HGL36060U31X HJL36060U31X HLL36060U31X HRL36060U31X
Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100U31X HGL36100U31X HJL36100U31X HLL36100U31X HRL36100U31X
LI 3.2 [16]
Standard 150 A [17] HDL36150U31X HGL36150U31X HJL36150U31X HLL36150U31X HRL36150U31X
250 A [18] JDL36250U31X JGL36250U31X JJL36250U31X JLL36250U31X JRL36250U31X
60 A [17] HDL36060U33X HGL36060U33X HJL36060U33X HLL36060U33X HRL36060U33X
Micrologic 3.2S [16] 100 A [17] HDL36100U33X HGL36100U33X HJL36100U33X HLL36100U33X HRL36100U33X
LSI [19]
Standard 150 A [17] HDL36150U33X HGL36150U33X HJL36150U33X HLL36150U33X HRL36150U33X
250 A [18] JDL36250U33X JGL36250U33X JJL36250U33X JLL36250U33X JRL36250U33X
60 A [17] HDL36060U43X HGL36060U43X HJL36060U43X HLL36060U43X HRL36060U43X
Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100U43X HGL36100U43X HJL36100U43X HLL36100U43X HRL36100U43X
LSI 5.2A
Ammeter 150 A [17] HDL36150U43X HGL36150U43X HJL36150U43X HLL36150U43X HRL36150U43X
250 A [18] JDL36250U43X JGL36250U43X JJL36250U43X JLL36250U43X JRL36250U43X
60 A [17] HDL36060U53X HGL36060U53X HJL36060U53X HLL36060U53X HRL36060U53X
Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100U53X HGL36100U53X HJL36100U53X HLL36100U53X HRL36100U53X
Energy LSI 5.2E
150 A [17] HDL36150U53X HGL36150U53X HJL36150U53X HLL36150U53X HRL36150U53X
250 A [18] JDL36250U53X JGL36250U53X JJL36250U53X JLL36250U53X JRL36250U53X
60 A [17] HDL36060U44X HGL36060U44X HJL36060U44X HLL36060U44X HRL36060U44X
Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100U44X HGL36100U44X HJL36100U44X HLL36100U44X HRL36100U44X
LSIG 6.2A [20]
Ammeter 150 A [17] HDL36150U44X HGL36150U44X HJL36150U44X HLL36150U44X HRL36150U44X
250 A [18] JDL36250U44X JGL36250U44X JJL36250U44X JLL36250U44X JRL36250U44X
60 A [17] HDL36060U54X HGL36060U54X HJL36060U54X HLL36060U54X HRL36060U54X
Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100U54X HGL36100U54X HJL36100U54X HLL36100U54X HRL36100U54X
Energy LSIG 6.2E
150 A [17] HDL36150U54X HGL36150U54X HJL36150U54X HJL36150U54X HRL36150U54X
250 A [18] JDL36250U54X JGL36250U54X JJL36250U54X JLL36250U54X JRL36250U54X

Table 7.57: H-Frame 150 A and J-Frame 250 A Electronic Trip UL Current-Limiting [13] 100% Rated Circuit Breakers (600 Vac) With Factory
Sealed Trip Unit [14] Suitable for Reverse Connection [15]
Electronic Trip Unit Sensor Interrupting Rating (100% Rated)
Type Function Trip Unit Rating D G J [13] L [13] R [13]
600 Vac, 50/60 Hz, 3P
60 A [17] HDL36060CU31X HGL36060CU31X HJL36060CU31X HLL36060CU31X HRL36060CU31X
Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100CU31X HGL36100CU31X HJL36100CU31X HLL36100CU31X HRL36100CU31X
LI 3.2 [16]
Standard 150 A [17] HDL36150CU31X HGL36150CU31X HJL36150CU31X HLL36150CU31X HRL36150CU31X
250 A [18] JDL36250CU31X JGL36250CU31X JJL36250CU31X JLL36250CU31X JRL36250CU31X
60 A [17] HDL36060CU33X HGL36060CU33X HJL36060CU33X HLL36060CU33X HRL36060CU33X
Micrologic 3.2S [16] 100 A [17] HDL36100CU33X HGL36100CU33X HJL36100CU33X HLL36100CU33X HRL36100CU33X
LSI [19]
Standard 150 A [17] HDL36150CU33X HGL36150CU33X HJL36150CU33X HLL36150CU33X HRL36150CU33X
250 A [18] JDL36250CU33X JGL36250CU33X JJL36250CU33X JLL36250CU33X JRL36250CU33X
60 A [17] HDL36060CU43X HGL36060CU43X HJL36060CU43X HLL36060CU43X HRL36060CU43X
Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100CU43X HGL36100CU43X HJL36100CU43X HLL36100CU43X HRL36100CU43X
LSI 5.2A
Ammeter 150 A [17] HDL36150CU43X HGL36150CU43X HJL36150CU43X HLL36150CU43X HRL36150CU43X
250 A [18] JDL36250CU43X JGL36250CU43X JJL36250CU43X JLL36250CU43X JRL36250CU43X
60 A [17] HDL36060CU53X HGL36060CU53X HJL36060CU53X HLL36060CU53X HRL36060CU53X
Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100CU53X HGL36100CU53X HJL36100CU53X HLL36100CU53X HRL36100CU53X
Energy LSI 5.2E
150 A [17] HDL36150CU53X HGL36150CU53X HJL36150CU53X HLL36150CU53X HRL36150CU53X
250 A [18] JDL36250CU53X JGL36250CU53X JJL36250CU53X JLL36250CU53X JRL36250CU53X
7

60 A [17] HDL36060CU44X HGL36060CU44X HJL36060CU44X HLL36060CU44X HRL36060CU44X


Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100CU44X HGL36100CU44X HJL36100CU44X HLL36100CU44X HRL36100CU44X
LSIG 6.2A [20]
Ammeter 150 A [17] HDL36150CU44X HGL36150CU44X HJL36150CU44X HLL36150CU44X HRL36150CU44X
250 A [18] JDL36250CU44X JGL36250CU44X JJL36250CU44X JLL36250CU44X JRL36250CU44X
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

60 A [17] HDL36060CU54X HGL36060CU54X HJL36060CU54X HLL36060CU54X HRL36060CU54X


Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100CU54X HGL36100CU54X HJL36100CU54X HLL36100CU54X HRL36100CU54X
Energy LSIG 6.2E
150 A [17]
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

HDL36150CU54X HGL36150CU54X HJL36150CU54X HLL36150CU54X HRL36150CU54X


250 A [18] JDL36250CU54X JGL36250CU54X JJL36250CU54X JLL36250CU54X JRL36250CU54X

[13] Circuit breakers with J, L, and R interrupting ratings are UL certified as current limiting.
[14] See Supplemental Digest Section 3 for circuit breakers with field interchangeable trip units.
[15] For applications requiring communications see page 7-69.
[16] 3P circuit breakers with this trip unit can be used for 2P applications.
[17] Standard lug kit: AL150HD. Terminal wire range: 14–3/0 AWG Al or Cu.
[18] Standard lug kit: AL250JD. Terminal wire range: 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil Al or Cu.
[19] Fixed ST and LT delays.
[20] 3P circuit breakers with this trip unit can be used for 2P applications in order to have ground fault protection. Additional metering capabilities will not work properly on the unconnected
phase.
7-34
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
H- and J-Frame Circuit Breakers PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Class 611 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001
schneider-electric.us

Table 7.58: H- and J-Frame Termination Options


Termination Letter
A - I-Line (See Section 9) HDL36015T
F = No Lugs (includes terminal nut kit on both ends) For factory-installed termination, place termination
letter in the third block of the circuit breaker catalog
L = Lugs both ends number.
M = Lugs ON end Terminal Nut Kit OFF end
P = Lugs OFF end Terminal Nut Kit ON end
N = Plug-in
D = Drawout
S = Rear Connected

Table 7.59: H- and J-Frame Interrupting Ratings


Interrupting Rating
Voltage
D G J L R
240 Vac 25 KA 65 kA 100 kA 125 kA 200 kA
480 Vac 18 kA 35 kA 65 kA 100 kA 200 kA
600 Vac 14 kA 18 kA 25 kA 50 kA 100 kA

Accessories see page 7-54


Optional Lugs see page 7-59
Dimensions see page 7-77
Enclosures see page 7-78

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


7 CIRCUIT BREAKERS

7-35
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers Q-Frame Circuit Breakers
Class 0734 / Refer to Catalogs: 0734CT0201
schneider-electric.us

Q-Frame Molded Case Circuit Breakers


Table 7.60: PowerPact Q-Frame 250 A Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker (240 Vac)
[21]
Fixed AC Interrupting Rating
Ampere Magnetic Trip Terminal Wire
Rating B D G J Range
Hold Trip
2P, 240 Vac
 70 A 1000 A 1800 A QBL22070 QDL22070 QGL22070 QJL22070
 80 A 1000 A 1800 A QBL22080 QDL22080 QGL22080 QJL22080
 90 A 1000 A 1800 A QBL22090 QDL22090 QGL22090 QJL22090
100 A 1200 A 2400 A QBL22100 QDL22100 QGL22100 QJL22100
110 A 1200 A 2400 A QBL22110 QDL22110 QGL22110 QJL22110
125 A 1200 A 2400 A QBL22125 QDL22125 QGL22125 QJL22125 #4 AWG - 300
kcmil Al/Cu
150 A 1200 A 2400 A QBL22150 QDL22150 QGL22150 QJL22150
175 A 1200 A 2400 A QBL22175 QDL22175 QGL22175 QJL22175
200 A 1200 A 2400 A QBL22200 QDL22200 QGL22200 QJL22200
QBL 2P 225 A 1200 A 2400 A QBL22225 QDL22225 QGL22225 QJL22225
70–250 250 A [22] 1200 A 2400 A QBL22250 QDL22250 QGL22250 QJL22250
3P, 240 Vac
 70 A 1000 A 1800 A QBL32070 QDL32070 QGL32070 QJL32070
 80 A 1000 A 1800 A QBL32080 QDL32080 QGL32080 QJL32080
 90 A 1000 A 1800 A QBL32090 QDL32090 QGL32090 QJL32090
100 A 1200 A 2400 A QBL32100 QDL32100 QGL32100 QJL32100
110 A 1200 A 2400 A QBL32110 QDL32110 QGL32110 QJL32110
125 A 1200 A 2400 A QBL32125 QDL32125 QGL32125 QJL32125 #4 AWG - 300
kcmil Al/Cu
150 A 1200 A 2400 A QBL32150 QDL32150 QGL32150 QJL32150
175 A 1200 A 2400 A QBL32175 QDL32175 QGL32175 QJL32175
200 A 1200 A 2400 A QBL32200 QDL32200 QGL32200 QJL32200
225 A 1200 A 2400 A QBL32225 QDL32225 QGL32225 QJL32225
250 A [22] 1200 A 2400 A QBL32250 QDL32250 QGL32250 QJL32250

Table 7.61: Q-Frame Termination Options


Termination Letter
QBL 3P A = I-Line (See Section 9) QGL32200
70–250 A E = Bolt-on I-Line (See Section 9) For factory-installed termination, place
termination letter in the third block of the circuit
F = No lugs breaker catalog number.
L = Lugs both ends
M = Lugs ON end, studs on OFF end
P = Lugs OFF end, studs on ON end

Table 7.62: Q-Frame Interrupting Ratings


Interrupting Rating
Voltage
B D G J
240 Vac [23] 10 kA 25 kA 65 kA 100 kA[24]

Dimension see page 7-77


Enclosures see page 7-78
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[21] Replacement lugs and electrical accessories are not available for PowerPact Q-frame circuit breakers.
[22] 250 A lugs are suitable for copper conductors only.
[23] Q-frame circuit breakers are 240 Vac only.
[24] 3P QJ circuit breakers are rated at 208Y/120 Vac only.
7-36
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
L-Frame Circuit Breakers PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Class 611 / Refer to Catalogs: 0611CT1001
schneider-electric.us

PowerPact L-Frame Molded Case Circuit Breakers


Table 7.63: L-Frame 600 A Standard (80% Rated) UL Current-Limiting [25] Circuit Breakers with Lugs and Factory-Sealed Electronic Trip
Units Suitable for Reverse Connection [26][27]
Electronic Trip Unit Sensor Interrupting Rating (80% Rated)
Type Function Trip Unit Rating D G J [25] L [25] R [25] Terminal
600 Vac, 50/60 Hz, 3P
250 A LDL36250U31X LGL36250U31X LJL36250U31X LLL36250U31X LRL36250U31X AL400L61K3 [29]
Micrologic 3.3 [28]
Standard LI 400 A LDL36400U31X LGL36400U31X LJL36400U31X LLL36400U31X LRL36400U31X
AL600LS52K3 [30]
600 A LDL36600U31X LGL36600U31X LJL36600U31X LLL36600U31X LRL36600U31X
250 A LDL36250U33X LGL36250U33X LJL36250U33X LLL36250U33X LRL36250U33X AL400L61K3 [29]
Micrologic 3.3S [28]
LSI [31] 400 A LDL36400U33X LGL36400U33X LJL36400U33X LLL36400U33X LRL36400U33X
Standard
600 A LDL36600U33X LGL36600U33X LJL36600U33X LLL36600U33X LRL36600U33X AL600LS52K3 [30]
Micrologic 400 A LDL36400U43X LGL36400U43X LJL36400U43X LLL36400U43X LRL36400U43X
LSI 5.3A
Ammeter 600 A LDL36600U43X LGL36600U43X LJL36600U43X LLL36600U43X LRL36600U43X
Micrologic 400 A LDL36400U53X LGL36400U53X LJL36400U53X LLL36400U53X LRL36400U53X
Energy LSI 5.3E
600 A LDL36600U53X LGL36600U53X LJL36600U53X LLL36600U53X LRL36600U53X
AL600LS52K3 [30]
Micrologic 400 A LDL36400U44X LGL36400U44X LJL36400U44X LLL36400U44X LRL36400U44X
Ammeter LSIG 6.3A
600 A LDL36600U44X LGL36600U44X LJL36600U44X LLL36600U44X LRL36600U44X
Micrologic 400 A LDL36400U54X LGL36400U54X LJL36400U54X LLL36400U54X LRL36400U54X
Energy LSIG 6.3E [32]
600 A LDL36600U54X LGL36600U54X LJL36600U54X LLL36600U54X LRL36600U54X
600 Vac, 50/60 Hz, 4P
250 A LDL46250U31X LGL46250U31X LJL46250U31X LLL46250U31X LRL46250U31X AL400L61K4 [29]
Micrologic
Standard LI 3.3 400 A LDL46400U31X LGL46400U31X LJL46400U31X LLL46400U31X LRL46400U31X
600 A LDL46600U31X LGL46600U31X LJL46600U31X LLL46600U31X LRL46600U31X AL600LS52K4 [30]
250 A LDL46250U33X LGL46250U33X LJL46250U33X LLL46250U33X LRL46250U33X AL400L61K4 [29]
Micrologic 3.3S[31]
LSI 400 A LDL46400U33X LGL46400U33X LJL46400U33X LLL46400U33X LRL46400U33X
Standard
600 A LDL46600U33X LGL46600U33X LJL46600U33X LLL46600U33X LRL46600U33X AL600LS52K4 [30]
Micrologic 400 A LDL46400U43X LGL46400U43X LJL46400U43X LLL46400U43X LRL46400U43X
LSI 5.3A
Ammeter 600 A LDL46600U43X LGL46600U43X LJL46600U43X LLL46600U43X LRL46600U43X
Micrologic 400 A LDL46400U53X LGL46400U53X LJL46400U53X LLL46400U53X LRL46400U53X
Energy LSI 5.3E
600 A LDL46600U53X LGL46600U53X LJL46600U53X LLL46600U53X LRL46600U53X
AL600LS52K4 [30]
Micrologic 400 A LDL46400U44X LGL46400U44X LJL46400U44X LLL46400U44X LRL46400U44X
LSIG 6.3A
Ammeter 600 A LDL46600U44X LGL46600U44X LJL46600U44X LLL46600U44X LRL46600U44X
Micrologic 400 A LDL46400U54X LGL46400U54X LJL46400U54X LLL46400U54X LRL46400U54X
Energy LSIG 6.3E 600 A LDL46600U54X LGL46600U54X LJL46600U54X LLL46600U54X LRL46600U54X

Table 7.64: L-Frame 600 A 100% Rated UL Current-Limiting [25] Circuit Breakers with Lugs and Factory-Sealed Electronic Trip Units
Suitable for Reverse Connection [26][27]
Electronic Trip Unit Sensor Interrupting Rating (100% Rated)
Rating Terminal
Type Function Trip Unit D G J [25] L [25] R [25]
600 Vac, 50/60 Hz, 3P
250 A LDL36250CU31X LGL36250CU31X LJL36250CU31X LLL36250CU31X LRL36250CU31X AL400L61K3 [29]
Micrologic Standard LI 3.3 [28]
400 A LDL36400CU31X LGL36400CU31X LJL36400CU31X LLL36400CU31X LRL36400CU31X AL600LS52K3 [30]
3.3S [28] 250 A LDL36250CU33X LGL36250CU33X LJL36250CU33X LLL36250CU33X LRL36250CU33X AL400L61K3 [29]
Micrologic Standard LSI [31] 400 A LDL36400CU33X LGL36400CU33X LJL36400CU33X LLL36400CU33X LRL36400CU33X AL600LS52K3 [30]
Micrologic Ammeter LSI 5.3A 400 A LDL36400CU43X LGL36400CU43X LJL36400CU43X LLL36400CU43X LRL36400CU43X
Micrologic Energy LSI 5.3E 400 A LDL36400CU53X LGL36400CU53X LJL36400CU53X LLL36400CU53X LRL36400CU53X
AL600LS52K3 [30]
Micrologic Ammeter LSIG 6.3A 400 A LDL36400CU44X LGL36400CU44X LJL36400CU44X LLL36400CU44X LRL36400CU44X
Micrologic Energy LSIG 6.3E [32] 400 A LDL36400CU54X LGL36400CU54X LJL36400CU54X LLL36400CU54X LRL36400CU54X
600 Vac, 50/60 Hz, 4P
250 A LDL46250CU31X LGL46250CU31X LJL46250CU31X LLL46250CU31X LRL46250CU31X AL400L61K4 [29]
Micrologic Standard LI 3.3
400 A LDL46400CU31X LGL46400CU31X LJL46400CU31X LLL46400CU31X LRL46400CU31X AL600LS52K4 [30]
250 A LDL46250CU33X LGL46250CU33X LJL46250CU33X LLL46250CU33X LRL46250CU33X AL400L61K4 [29]
Micrologic Standard LSI 3.3S
400 A LDL46400CU33X LGL46400CU33X LJL46400CU33X LLL46400CU33X LRL46400CU33X AL600LS52K4 [30]
Micrologic Ammeter LSI 5.3A 400 A LDL46400CU43X LGL46400CU43X LJL46400CU43X LLL46400CU43X LRL46400CU43X
Micrologic Energy LSI 5.3E 400 A LDL46400CU53X LGL46400CU53X LJL46400CU53X LLL46400CU53X LRL46400CU53X
AL600LS52K4 [30]
Micrologic Ammeter LSIG 6.3A 400 A LDL46400CU44X LGL46400CU44X LJL46400CU44X LLL46400CU44X LRL46400CU44X
Micrologic Energy LSIG 6.3E 400 A LDL46400CU54X LGL46400CU54X LJL46400CU54X LLL46400CU54X LRL46400CU54X

Table 7.65: Termination Options


Termination Letter Termination Option
A I-Line (See Section 9)
F No lugs
L Lugs both ends For factory-installed termination, place
Lugs ON end, terminal nut kit OFF end termination letter in the third block of the
M
circuit breaker catalog number.
P Lugs OFF end, terminal nut kit ON end Termination Letter
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

N Plug In LGL36600U44X
D Drawout
L-Frame Circuit Breaker
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

S Rear Connected

[25] Circuit breakers with J, L, and R interrupting ratings are UL certified as current limiting.
[26] See Supplemental Digest Section 3 for circuit breakers with field interchangeable trip units.
[27] For applications requiring communications see page 7-69.
[28] 3P circuit breakers with this trip unit can be used for 2P applications.
[29] AL400L61K3 terminal wire ranges are (1) 2 AWG–600 kcmil Cu or 1) 2 AWG–500 kcmil Al.
[30] AL600LS52K3 terminal wire range is (2) 2/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al/Cu.
[31] Fixed ST and LT delays.
[32] 3P circuit breakers with this trip unit can be used for 2P applications in order to have ground fault protection. Additional metering capabilities will not work properly on the unconnected
phase.
7

7-37
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers M-Frame Circuit Breakers
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us
Accessories see page 7-54
Table 7.66: Interrupting Ratings
Optional Lugs see page 7-59
Interrupting Rating
Dimensions see page 7-77 Voltage
D G J L R
Enclosures see page 7-78
240 Vac 25 kA 65 kA 100 kA 125 kA 200 kA
480 Vac 18 kA 35 kA 65 kA 100 kA 200 kA
600 Vac 14 kA 18 kA 25 kA 50 kA 100 kA

PowerPact M-Frame Molded Case Circuit Breakers


Table 7.67: M-Frame 800 A, Basic Electronic Trip System Type ET 1.0 [33] Factory-
Sealed Trip Unit
Electronic Trip Unit Sensor Interrupting Rating Terminal Wire
Range
Type Function Rating G J (AWG/kcmil)
2P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
300 A MGL26300 MJL26300
350 A MGL26350 MJL26350
Fixed 400 A MGL26400 MJL26400
Long-time, 450 A MGL26450 MJL26450 AL800M23K
Basic Adjustable (3) 3/0–500 Al/Cu
500 A MGL26500 MJL26500
Instantaneous Trip 600 A MGL26600 MJL26600
700 A MGL26700 MJL26700
800 A MGL26800 MJL26800
M-Frame Circuit Breaker
3P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
300 A MGL36300 MJL36300
350 A MGL36350 MJL36350
Fixed 400 A MGL36400 MJL36400
Long-time, 450 A MGL36450 MJL36450 AL800M23K
Basic Adjustable (3) 3/0–500 Al/Cu
500 A MGL36500 MJL36500
Instantaneous Trip 600 A MGL36600 MJL36600
700 A MGL36700 MJL36700
800 A MGL36800 MJL36800

Table 7.68: Termination Options


Termination Letter Termination Option
A I-Line (See Section 9)
F No lugs
L Lugs both ends
M Lugs ON end, terminal nut kit OFF end
P Lugs OFF end, terminal nut kit ON end
MGL36400
For factory-installed termination, place termination letter in the third block of the circuit breaker catalog number.

Table 7.69: Frame Interrupting Ratings


Interrupting Rating
Voltage
D G J L
240 Vac 25 kA 65 kA 100 kA 125 kA
480 Vac 18 kA 35 kA 65 kA 100 kA
600 Vac 14 kA 18 kA 25 kA 50 kA

Accessories see page 7-54


Optional Lugs see page 7-59
Dimensions see page 7-77
Enclosures see page 7-78
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[33] The ET 1.0 trip unit cannot be field replaced or have the long-time trip point setting adjusted. It is considered an electronic equivalent of a thermal-magnetic circuit breaker.
7-38
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
P-Frame Circuit Breakers PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us

PowerPact P-Frame Molded Case Circuit Breakers


Table 7.70: P-Frame Interrupting Ratings Table 7.72: P-Frame 1200 A (600 Vac, 50/60 Hz) 3P [34] Circuit Breaker with
P-Frame Interrupting Rating
Electronic Trip Unit
Voltage Electronic Trip Unit
G J K L Sensor Terminal
Trip Rating Cat. No.[35] Wire Range
240 Vac 65 kA 100 kA 65 kA 125 kA Type Function
480 Vac 35 kA 65 kA 50 kA 100 kA Unit
600 Vac 18 kA 25 kA 50 kA 25 kA Basic Electronic Fixed long-  600 A P■L36060 AL800M23K
Trip Unit time, E-  800 A P■L36080 (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
(Not Adjustable 1000 A P■L36100
Instantane- T1.01 AL1200P25K
Interchangeable) (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
Table 7.71: P-Frame Termination Options ous 1200 A P■L36120
Termination Letter  250 A P■L36025(C)U31A
F = No Lugs (Includes terminal nut kit on both ends)  400 A P■L36040(C)U31A AL800M23K
L = Lugs both ends  600 A P■L36060(C)U31A (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
LI 3.0
M = Lugs ON end, terminal nut kit OFF end  800 A P■L36080(C)U31A
P = Lugs OFF end, terminal nut kit ON end 1000 A P■L36100(C)U31A AL1200P25K
Micrologic
D = Drawout Interchangeable 1200 A P■L36120(C)U31A (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
A = I-Line (See Section 9) Standard  250 A P■L36025(C)U33A
Trip Unit
PGL36040U41A  400 A P■L36040(C)U33A AL800M23K
For factory-installed termination, place termination letter in the third  600 A P■L36060(C)U33A (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
block of the circuit breaker catalog number. LSI 5.0
 800 A P■L36080(C)U33A
Dimensions see page 7-77 1000 A P■L36100(C)U33A AL1200P25K
Trip Unit Options see page 7-67 1200 A P■L36120(C)U33A (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
Optional Lugs see page 7-59  250 A P■L36025(C)U41A
Alternate Rating Plugs see page 7-69  400 A P■L36040(C)U41A AL800M23K
Enclosures see page 7-78  600 A P■L36060(C)U41A (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
LI 3.0A
Accessories see page 7-54  800 A P■L36080(C)U41A
1000 A P■L36100(C)U41A AL1200P25K
1200 A P■L36120(C)U41A (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
 250 A P■L36025(C)U43A
 400 A P■L36040(C)U43A AL800M23K
Micrologic
Interchangeable  600 A P■L36060(C)U43A (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
Ammeter LSI 5.0A
 800 A P■L36080(C)U43A
Trip Unit
1000 A P■L36100(C)U43A AL1200P25K
1200 A P■L36120(C)U43A (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
 250 A P■L36025(C)U44A
 400 A P■L36040(C)U44A AL800M23K
 600 A P■L36060(C)U44A (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
LSIG 6.0A
 800 A P■L36080(C)U44A
1000 A P■L36100(C)U44A AL1200P25K
1200 A P■L36120(C)U44A (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
 250 A P■L36025(C)U63AE1
 400 A P■L36040(C)U63AE1 AL800M23K
 600 A P■L36060(C)U63AE1 (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
LSI 5.0P
 800 A P■L36080(C)U63AE1
1000 A P■L36100(C)U63AE1 AL1200P25K
Micrologic
Interchangeable 1200 A P■L36120(C)U63AE1 (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
Power  250 A P■L36025(C)U64AE1
Trip Unit
 400 A P■L36040(C)U64AE1 AL800M23K
 600 A P■L36060(C)U64AE1 (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
LSIG 6.0P
 800 A P■L36080(C)U64AE1
1000 A P■L36100(C)U64AE1 AL1200P25K
1200 A P■L36120(C)U64AE1 (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
250 A P■L36025(C)U73AE1
400 A P■L36040(C)U73AE1 AL800M23K
600 A P■L36060(C)U73AE1 (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
LSI 5.0H
800 A P■L36080(C)U73AE1
1000 A P■L36100(C)U73AE1 AL1200P25K
Micrologic
Interchangeable 1200 A P■L36120(C)U73AE1 (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
Harmonic 250 A P■L36025(C)U74AE1
Trip Unit
400 A P■L36040(C)U74AE1 AL800M23K
600 A P■L36060(C)U74AE1 (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
LSIG 6.0H
800 A P■L36080(C)U74AE1
1000 A P■L36100(C)U74AE1 AL1200P25K
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

1200 A P■L36120(C)U74AE1 (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[34] For 2P and 4P information see Catalog 0612CT0101.


[35] To complete the catalog number:
Replact the ■ with the appropriate interrupting rating (G, J, K or L).
For all L interrupting ratings, change the 5th character (voltage rating) from a 6 (600 V) to a 4 (480V). The 480 V AIR is standard 100 kA.
For 100% rated circuit breakers, add a “C” in the 9th character place. For example, the catalog number for a 100% rated trip unit with LI trip functions at 250 A would be PBL36025CU31A.
7

7-39
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers R-Frame Circuit Breakers
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us

PowerPact R-Frame Molded Case Circuit Breakers


R-frame circuit breakers can be bus- or cable-connected. For cable connections,
Table 7.73: R-Frame Interrupting Ratings optional terminal pad kit RLTB or equivalent bus structure is required. Each RLTB kit
R-Frame Interrupting Rating contains terminal pads for one end of the circuit breaker only and has provisions for
Voltage
G J K L mounting a maximum of 8 lugs per phase (9 lugs for 3000 A). RLTB kits are included with
240 Vac 65 kA 100 kA 65 kA 125 kA 2500 A 100% rated circuit breakers. The RL3TB kits are included with the 3000 A, 80%
480 Vac 35 kA 65 kA 65 kA 100 kA and 100% rated circuit breakers. For other circuit breakers, order terminal pad kit (RLTB)
600 Vac 18 kA 25 kA 65 kA 50 kA
and optional lugs separately. See page 7-59–page 7-61.

Table 7.74: R-Frame 3000 A (600 Vac, 50/60 Hz) 3P Circuit Breaker with Electronic
Trip Unit
Electronic Trip Unit[36] Sensor
Rating Cat. No. [37]
Type Function Trip Unit
Fixed 1200 A R■F36120
Basic Electronic Trip 1600 A R■F36160
Unit long-time, ET1.0I
(Not Interchangeable) Adjustable 2000 A R■F36200
Instantaneous 2500 A R■F36250
600 A R■F36060(C)U31A
800 A R■F36080(C)U31A
1000 A R■F36100(C)U31A
1200 A R■F36120(C)U31A
LI 3.0
1600 A R■F36160(C)U31A
2000 A R■F36200(C)U31A
2500 A R■F36250(C)U31A
Micrologic 3000 A R■F36300(C)U31A
Interchangeable
Standard Trip Unit 600 A R■F36060(C)U33A
800 A R■F36080(C)U33A
1000 A R■F36100(C)U33A
1200 A R■F36120(C)U33A
LSI 5.0
1600 A R■F36160(C)U33A
2000 A R■F36200(C)U33A
2500 A R■F36250(C)U33A
3000 A R■F36300(C)U33A
600 A R■F36060(C)U41A
800 A R■F36080(C)U41A
1000 A R■F36100(C)U41A
1200 A R■F36120(C)U41A
LI 3.0A
1600 A R■F36160(C)U41A
2000 A R■F36200(C)U41A
2500 A R■F36250(C)U41A
3000 A R■F36300(C)U41A
600 A R■F36060(C)U43A
800 A R■F36080(C)U43A
1000 A R■F36100(C)U43A
Micrologic
Interchangeable 1200 A R■F36120(C)U43A
Ammeter LSI 5.0A
1600 A R■F36160(C)U43A
Trip Unit
2000 A R■F36200(C)U43A
2500 A R■F36250(C)U43A
3000 A R■F36300(C)U43A
600 A ■F36060(C)U44A
800 A R■F36080(C)U44A
1000 A R■F36100(C)U44A
1200 A R■F36120(C)U44A
LSIG 6.0A
1600 A R■F36160(C)U44A
2000 A R■F36200(C)U44A
2500 A R■F36250(C)U44A
3000 A R■F36300(C)U44A
600 A R■F36060(C)U63AE1
800 A R■F36080(C)U63AE1
1000 A R■F36100(C)U63AE1
1200 A R■F36120(C)U63AE1
7

LSI 5.0P
1600 A R■F36160(C)U63AE1
2000 A R■F36200(C)U63AE1
2500 A R■F36250(C)U63AE1
Micrologic 3000 A R■F36300(C)U63AE1
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

Interchangeable Power
Trip Unit 600 A R■F36060(C)U64AE1
800 A R■F36080(C)U64AE1
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

1000 A R■F36100(C)U64AE1
1200 A R■F36120(C)U64AE1
LSIG 6.0P
1600 A R■F36160(C)U64AE1
2000 A R■F36200(C)U64AE1
2500 A R■F36250(C)U64AE1
3000 A R■F36300(C)U64AE1
Micrologic LSI 5.0H 600 A R■F36060(C)U73AE1

[36] For 2P and 4P information see Catalog 0612CT0101.


[37] To complete the catalog number: Replact the ■ with the appropriate interrupting rating (G, J, K or L).; For 100% rated circuit breakers, add a “C” in the 9th character place. For example, the
catalog number for a 100% rated trip unit with LI trip functions at 2500 A would be GF36025CU31A.
7-40
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
R-Frame Circuit Breakers PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us

Table 7.74 R-Frame 3000 A (600 Vac, 50/60 Hz) 3P Circuit Breaker with Electronic
Trip Unit (cont'd.)
Electronic Trip Unit[38] Sensor
Rating Cat. No. [39]
Type Function Trip Unit
Interchangeable 800 A R■F36080(C)U73AE1
Harmonic Trip Unit R■F36100(C)U73AE1
1000 A
1200 A R■F36120(C)U73AE1
1600 A R■F36160(C)U73AE1
2000 A R■F36200(C)U73AE1
2500 A R■F36250(C)U73AE1
3000 A R■F36300(C)U73AE1
600 A R■F36060(C)U74AE1
800 A R■F36080(C)U74AE1
1000 A R■F36100(C)U74AE1
1200 A R■F36120(C)U74AE1
LSIG 6.0H
1600 A R■F36160(C)U74AE1
2000 A R■F36200(C)U74AE1
2500 A R■F36250(C)U74AE1
3000 A R■F36300(C)U74AE1

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[38] For 2P and 4P information see Catalog 0612CT0101.


[39] To complete the catalog number: Replact the ■ with the appropriate interrupting rating (G, J, K or L).; For 100% rated circuit breakers, add a “C” in the 9th character place. For example, the
catalog number for a 100% rated trip unit with LI trip functions at 2500 A would be GF36025CU31A.
7

7-41
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Motor Circuit Protectors PowerPact™ H- and J-Frame Electronic
Motor Circuit Protectors
Class 611 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001 schneider-electric.us

Motor Circuit Protection Selection


PowerPact H- and J-frame electronic Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) are magnetic-only
instantaneous-trip circuit breakers. They are designed to offer short circuit protection and
are National Electrical Code (NEC) compliant when installed as part of a combination
controller having motor overload protection. MCP circuit breakers accept the same
accessories and terminals as the equivalent thermal-magnetic circuit breakers.
Determine the hp rating from the nameplate of the motor. Select a MCP with an ampere
rating recommended for the hp and voltage involved. When using the automatic settings
the MCP microprocessor automatically adjusts the trip settings for both current and time
to align with the start-up characteristic for the motor type, whether it is a standard or
energy-efficient motor. This includes a dampening means to accommodate a transient
motor in-rush current without nuisance tripping of the circuit breaker.

Table 7.75: H- and J-Frame Electronic Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP)


dard
Stan
ient
gy Effic ace
Energie Efficente
Energia Efici
Ener

Interrupting Rating
Adjustable
Sensor Full Load Instantane- J L R
Frame Amperes Suffix (See SCCR (See SCCR (See SCCR
Rating ous Trip
Range Range Table Below) Table Below) Table Below)
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
Standard 30 A 1.5–25 A 9–325 A M71 HJL36030M71 HLL36030M71 HRL36030M71
Energy Efficient
Energie Efficace
H- 50 A 14–42 A 84–546 A M72 HJL36050M72 HLL36050M72 HRL36050M72
Energia Eficiente Frame 100 A 30–80 A 180–1040 A M73 HJL36100M73 HLL36100M73 HRL36100M73
150 A 58–130 A 348–1690 A M74 HJL36150M74 HLL36150M74 HRL36150M74
J-Frame 250 A 114–217 A 684–2500 A M75 JJL36250M75 JLL36250M75 JRL36250M75

Table 7.76: Maximum Rating or Setting of Motor Protective Devices [1]


Percentage of Full-load Current
Type of Motor
t Setting Not to Exceed[2]
A, B, C, D Standard 800% 1300%
B, E Energy Efficient 1100% 1700%

Table 7.77: MCP Selection by HP Ratings [3] of Induction-type Squirrel-Cage and


I Wound-Rotor Motors [4]
3Ø 60 Hz Voltages[5]
Motor Type / Tipo de Motor / Type de Moteur Full-Load Amperes Suffix
200 Vac 230 Vac 460 Vac 575 Vac
.5–5 .5–7.5 .75–15 1–20 1.5–25 M71
Standard
5–10 5–15 10–30 15–40 14–42 M72
Energy Efficient 10–25 15–30 25–60 30–75 30–80 M73
Energie Efficace 20–40 25–50 50–100 60–125 58–130 M74
Energia Eficiente
40–60 50–75 100–150 125–200 114–217 M75
Short Circuit Current Rating (SCCR)
Tested to meet NEC and UL508A requirements for short circuit current ratings as part of
an approved combination controller.

Table 7.78: Short Circuit Current Ratings (SCCR)


Interrupting Rating
Contactor/Starter J L
200–240 Vac 480 Vac 600 Vac 200–240 Vac 480 Vac 600 Vac
Tesys D-line and F-line 100 kA 65 kA 25 kA 125 kA 100 kA 50 kA
NEMA Type S 100 kA 65 kA 25 kA 125 kA 100 kA 50 kA
See www.us.schneider-electric.us for specific ratings and combination ID numbers.
To select combination starters and motor controllers using MCP’s Meeting NEC
Accessories see page 7-54 Article 430, refer to Section 16.
Lugs see page 7-59
Dimensions see page 7-77
Enclosures see page 7-78
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[1] Based on 2005 NEC Table 430.52.


[2] See NEC Exception No. 1 to Table 430.52. The NEC 1300% maximum setting may be inadequate for instantaneous trip circuit breakers to withstand current surges typical of the
magnetization current of autotransformer type reduced voltage starters, or open transition wye-delta starters during transfer from “start” to “run,” constant hp multi-speed motors, and motors
labeled “high efficiency.”
[3] Based on 2005 NEC Table 430.250.
[4] Per NEC 430.3, part-winding motors should select two circuit breakers, each at not more than one-half the allowable trip setting for the horsepower rating. The two circuit breakers should
operate simultaneously as a disconnecting means per NEC 430.103.
[5] Listed voltages are rated motor voltages. Corresponding system voltages are 200 Vac, 220–240 Vac, 440–480 Vac and 550–600 Vac. Select wire and circuit breakers based on horsepower
rather than nameplate full-load current per NEC 430.6 (A) for general motor applications.
7-42
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
H-Frame and J-Frame MCP Selector Motor Circuit Protectors
Class 611 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001
schneider-electric.us

H-, J-Frame Motor Circuit Protectors


Table 7.79: Application of PowerPact™ H-Frame and J-Frame Electronic Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP)
Horsepower Rating of Induction-Type Squirrel-Cage and Wound-Rotor Motors 3Ø 60 Hz NEC Full Load PowerPact H-Frame and
Starter Size 200 Vac 230 Vac 480 Vac 575 Vac Amperes J-Frame Electronic MCP
1/2 0.9 A
1/2 1.1 A
3/4 1.3 A
3/4 1 1.7 A
1 2.1 A
1/2 2.2 A
1-1/2 2.4 A
1/2 2.5 A
2 2.7 A
1-1/2 3A
00 3/4 3.2 A
2 3.4 A
3/4 3.7 A
3 3.9 A
1 4.2 A
1 4.8 A HJL36030M71
and
3 4.8 A HLL36030M71
1-1/2 6A 1/2–10 hp
5 6.1 A
2 6.8 A
1-1/2 6.9 A
5 7.6 A
2 7.8 A
0 7-1/2 9A
3 9.6 A
3 7-1/2 10 11 A
10 14 A
5 15.2 A
15 17 A
1 5 17.5 A
15 21 A
7-1/2 20 22 A
7-1/2 25.3 A HJL36050M72
and
20 25 27 A HLL36050M72
10 28 A 10–25 hp
2
30 32 A
10 32.2 A
25 34 A
30 40 A
40 41 A
15 42 A
15 48.3 A HJL36100M73
and
40 50 52 A HLL36100M73
3
20 54 A 15–50 hp
20 60 62 A
50 65 A
25 68 A
60 75 77 A
25 78.2 A
30 80 A HJL36150M74
30 92 A and
75 96 A HLL36150M74
4 30–100 hp
100 99 A
40 104 A
40 120 A
100 124 A
125 125 A
50 130 A
150 144 A JJL36250M75
and
50 150 A JLL36250M75
5 60 154 A 50–150 hp
125 156 A
60 177.1 A
150 180 A
75 200 192 A
75 221 A
200 240 A
100 248 A
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

Shaded area is not covered by J-frame electronic motor circuit protector.


7 CIRCUIT BREAKERS

7-43
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Motor Circuit Protectors Instantaneous Trip Circuit Breakers

schneider-electric.us

Instantaneous Trip Circuit Breakers


Adjustable instantaneous-trip circuit breakers are intended for use in combination with
motor starters with overload relays for the protection of motor circuits from short circuits.
Other specific applications include rectifiers and resistance welders. These circuit
breakers contain a magnetic trip element in each pole with the trip point adjustable from
the front. Interrupting ratings are determined by testing the instantaneous-trip circuit
breakers in combination with a contactor and overload relay.
Select instantaneous-trip circuit breakers as follows:
This selection table is suitable for motors, other than NEMA Design E, with locked-rotor
indicating code letters per NEC® Table 430.7 (b) as follows:

Table 7.80: Locked-Rotor Indicating Codes


Horsepower Motor Code Letter
1/2 or less A–L
3/4 to 1-1/2 A–K
2 to 3 A–J
5 to 25 A–H
30 to 125 A–G
150 or more A–F

• For other motors order a special thermal-magnetic circuit breaker with magnetic trip
settings for the specific motor— specify motor horsepower, voltage, frequency, full-
load current and code letter or locked rotor current.
• Determine motor hp rating from the motor nameplate.
• Refer to the tables and select an instantaneous-trip circuit breaker with an ampere
rating recommended for the hp and voltage involved.
• Select an adjustable trip setting of at least 800%, not to exceed 1300%, of the motor
full-load amperes (FLA) for other than Design E motors. For Design E motors, select
an adjustable trip setting of at least 1100% not to exceed 1700% of FLA.
• The NEC 1300% maximum setting may be inadequate for instantaneous-trip circuit
breakers to withstand current surges typical of the magnetization current of
autotransformer type reduced voltage starters, or open transition wye-delta starters
during transfer from “start” to “run,” constant hp multi-speed motors, and motors
labeled “high efficiency.” Select thermal-magnetic circuit breakers from page 7-47 for
those applications.
• Part-winding motors, per NEC 430.3, should have two circuit breakers selected from
the above at not more than one half the allowable trip setting for the horsepower
rating. The two circuit breakers should operate simultaneously as a disconnecting
means per NEC 430.103.
• Based on NEC 430.52 and NEC Table 430.150. See page 7-45 for available
Adjustable Instantaneous-Trip Circuit Breakers.
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

7-44
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Motor Circuit Protectors and Motor Motor Circuit Protectors
Protector Circuit Breakers
schneider-electric.us Class 580, 585, 680, 685

Motor Circuit Protectors


Mag-Gard™ Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) are instantaneous-trip magnetic-only circuit
breakers. They have a single adjustment which simultaneously sets the magnetic trip
level of each individual pole. Mag-Gard™ circuit breakers comply with NEC
requirements for providing motor circuit protection when installed as part of a UL Listed
combination controller having motor overload protection. Interrupting ratings are
established for these UL Recognized Components only when they are used in
combination with motor starters with properly sized overload relays and contactors.
All Mag-Gard circuit breakers will accept the same lugs and accessories as equivalent
circuit breakers. Mag-Gard circuit breakers are available with I-Line construction [6].
High-interruption (H) construction Mag-Gard circuit breakers (LHL) are also available.

Table 7.81: Magnetic Only 3 Pole, 600 Vac, 50/60 Hz [6]—Three Device Solutions [7]
Trip Adjustable [8]
Ampere Rating 250 Vdc Multiplier Cat. No.
Unit Trip Range (A)
500–1000 A LAL3640022M
750–1600 A LAL3640028M
1000–2000 A LAL3640030M
Motor Circuit Protector 1125–2250 A High = 1.2 LAL3640031M
LAL 400 — 1250–2500 A Low = 1.4 LAL3640032M
1500–3000 A LAL3640033M
Motor Protector Circuit Breaker 1750–3500 A LAL3640035M
2000–4000 A LAL3640036M
For PowerPact L- and P-Frames, an instantaneous-only version of the electronic trip
circuti breaker is also available for motor circuit protection. These MCPs comply with
NEC® requirements for providing short-circuit protection when installed as part of a
Listed combination controller having motor overload protection.

Table 7.82: Magnetic Only 3 Pole, 600 Vac, 50/60 Hz[6]—Three Device Solutions [7]
Trip Adjustable [8] Interrupting Rating
Sensor Rating
Unit Trip Range (A) G J L R
PowerPact  400 500–1200% LGL36400M37X LJL36400M37X LLL36400M37X LRL36400M37X
L-Frame [6] 1.3 M
 600 500–1200% LGL36600M37X LJL36600M37X LLL36600M37X LRL36600M37X
 600 — 1200–10000 A — PJL36060M68 PLL34060M68 —
PowerPact  800 — 1200–10000 A — PJL36080M68 PLL34080M68 —
PJL, PLL [6] 1000 — 1500–10000 A — PJL36100M69 PLL34100M69 —
1200 — 1800–10000 A — PJL36120M70 PLL34120M70 —

Motor Protector Circuit Breakers


Motor protection circuit breakers provide built-in thermal and magnetic protection. They
are used in two-device motor feeder solutions to provide protection against short-circuits,
overloads, and phase unbalance.

Table 7.83: H-Frame (150 A), J-Frame (250 A) and L-Frame (600 A) Electronic Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (UL Ratings)—
Two Device Solutions [9]
Electronic Trip Sensor Full Load Interrupting Rating
Frame Trip Unit Amperes Isd (x FLA)
Unit Type Rating G J L R
Range (FLA)
30 14–25 5-13 x FLA HGL36030M38X HJL36030M38X HLL36030M38X HRL36030M38X
50 14–42 5-13 x FLA HGL36050M38X HJL36050M38X HLL36050M38X HRL36050M38X
H-Frame
100 2.2 M 30–80 5-13 x FLA HGL36100M38X HJL36100M38X HLL36100M38X HRL36100M38X
Standard [10] 150 58–130 5-13 x FLA HGL36150M38X HJL36150M38X HLL36150M38X HRL36150M38X
J-Frame 250 114–217 5-13 x FLA JGL36250M38X JJL36250M38X JLL36250M38X JRL36250M38X
400 190–348 5-13 x FLA LGL36400M38X LJL36400M38X LLL36400M38X LRL36400M38X
L-Frame 2.3 M
600 312–520 5-13 x FLA LGL36600M38X LJL36600M38X LLL36600M38X LRL36600M38X

Accessories see page 7-54 and Supplemental Digest Section 3


Optional Lugs see page 7-59 and Supplemental Digest Section 3
Dimensions see page 7-77
Enclosures see page 7-78
To select combination starters and motor controllers using MCP’s meeting NEC
Article 430, refer to Section 16.
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[6] These electronic magnetic-only motor circuit protectors are available with I-Line constructions. Consult the factory.
[7] Three-device solutions are the traditional solutionss: motor circuit protector plus motor starter plus overload relay.
[8] UL magnetic trip tolerances are -20%/+30% from the nominal values shown.
[9] Two-device solutions (these electronic motor protector circuit breakers include short circuit and overload protection)
—1 electronic motor circuit protector with a Micrologic 2.2 M plus
—1 contactor
[10] The standard trip unit offers Class 5, 10 and 20 and phase unbalance or phase loss protection.
7

7-45
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Motor Circuit Protectors H-, J-, and LA-Frame MCP Selection
Class 680
schneider-electric.us

Table 7.84: PowerPact H- and L-Frame Motor Protector Circuit Breaker


Hp Ratings of Induction Type Squirrel-
Cage and PowerPact Family Magnetic Trip
Wound Rotor Motors Full Settings[13]
Load Motor Protector
3Ø 60 Hz Circuit Breaker
Amperes[11] Cat. No. [12]
200 230 Vac 460 Vac 575 Vac MIN MAX
Vac
10 14 H( )L36030M38X
5 15.2 H( )L36030M38X
500% 1300%
15 17 H( )L36030M38X
5 17.5 H( )L36030M38X
15 21 H( )L36030M38X
7-1/2 20 22 H( )L36030M38X
500% 1300%
7-1/2 25.3 H( )L36030M38X
20 25 27 H( )L36050M38X
10 28 H( )L36050M38X
30 32 H( )L36050M38X
500% 1300%
10 32.2 H( )L36050M38X
25 34 H( )L36050M38X
30 40 H( )L36050M38X
40 41 H( )L36050M38X
500% 1300%
15 42 H( )L36050M38X
15 48.3 H( )L36100M38X
40 50 52 H( )L36100M38X
20 54 H( )L36100M38X
500% 1300%
20 60 62 H( )L36100M38X
50 65 H( )L36100M38X
75 221 L( )L36400M38X
200 240 L( )L36400M38X
500% 1300%
250 242 L( )L36400M38X
100 248 L( )L36400M38X
100 285 L( )L36400M38X
300 289 L( )L36400M38X
500% 1300%
250 302 L( )L36400M38X
125 312 L( )L36400M38X
350 336 L( )L36400M38X
125 359 L( )L36600M38X
500% 1300%
150 360 L( )L36600M38X
300 361 L( )L36600M38X
400 382 L( )L36600M38X
150 350 414 L( )L36600M38X
500 472 L( )L36600M38X 500% 1300%
400 477 L( )L36600M38X
200 480 L( )L36600M38X

Table 7.85: LAL Adjustable Instantaneous-Trip Circuit Breakers for Single Motor
Circuit Protection
Hp Ratings of Induction Type Squirrel- Magnetic Trip
Cage and Wound Rotor Motors Full Load Mag-Gard
Circuit Breaker Settings[13]
3Ø 60 Hz Amperes[11]
Cat. No.
200 Vac 230 Vac 460 Vac 575 Vac MIN MAX
 75 221 LAL3640033M  700% 1400%
200 240 LAL3640035M  700% 1500%
250 242 LAL3640035M  700% 1400%
100 248 LAL3640035M  700% 1400%
100 285 LAL3640036M  700% 1400%
300 289 LAL3640036M  700% 1400%
250 302 LAL3640036M  700% 1300%
125 312 LAL3640036M  600% 1300%
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

[11] Motor full-load currents are taken from NEC Table 430.150. Select wire and circuit breakers on basis of horsepower rather than nameplate full-load current per NEC 430.6 (A) for general
motor applications. Do not use these values to select overload relay thermal units. See Digest Secti0on 14 for selection of thermal units when actual full load current is not known. The
voltages listed are rated motor voltages. Corresponding nominal system voltages are 200–208, 220–240, 440–480 and 550–600 V.
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[12] To complete catalog number, replace the blank with the appropriate rating (G, J, L or R).
[13] Only MIN and MAX settings are shown, intermediate settings are available on all circuit breakers.

7-46
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Motor Protection Selection Tables Motor Circuit Protectors
Class 601
schneider-electric.us

Motor Circuit Protection Selection


Table 7.86: Selection Tables for Conductors, Safety Switches and Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers
Based on 2005 NEC® Tables 430.147, 430.148 & 430.150
Horsepower Ratings Amperage of Thermal-Magnetic [15][16] QMB Minimum Size metallic Conduit
Squirrel-Cage and Wound- Inverse Time Circuit Breaker and 75° C, C Wire Field-Installed Sized
Rotor Motors with Norm. Average Direct Heavy for 125% FLA[18]
1Ø Current Motors Full For Motor Code Duty
Torque Characteristics For
Operating at Usual Speeds 10 Hz ac Operating at Load Letter B to E Switch Conduit 3 W
Base Speed Amperage Motor with
3Ø 60 Hz [14] Code Time AWG
Ordinary Heavy Service Letter F kcmil THHN
200 200 Service and Energy Delay
230 460 575 115 230 120 240 to V [19] Fuses THWN THW
Vac Vac [20] Efficient [21] XHHW
[22] Vac Vac Vac Vac [22] Vac Vdc Vdc [17]
3/4 6.9 A
15 A
1/3 7.2 A
5 3.4 7.6 A
2 7.8 A 20 A
3/4 7.9 A
1 8.0 A
15 A
2 8.5 A
7-1/2 9.0 A 20 A
1 9.2 A
1 9.5 A
25 A
3 9.6 A
14 1/2 in. N/A
1/2 9.8 A
1-1/2 10.0 A
3 7-1/2 10 11.0 A
20 A 30 A
1-1/2 11.5 A 30 A
2 12.0 A 25 A
3 12.2 A
1-1/2 13.2 A
25 A 35 A
3/4 2 13.8 A
10 14.0 A
5 15.2 A
40 A
1 16.0 A 30 A
35 A
15 3 2 17.0 A
45 A
5 17.5 A
35 A 12 1/2 in. N/A
3 19.6 A
40 A 50 A
1-1/2 5 20.0 A
15 21.0 A 40 A
45 A
7-1/2 22.0 A 60 A
2 24.0 A 45 A
50 A
3 25.0 A 10 1/2 in. N/A
7-1/2 25.3 A
50 A 70 A
20 25 27.0 A
60 A
10 5 28.0 A
7-1/2 29.0 A
80 A
30 32.0 A
60 A
10 32.2 A 70 A
90 A 60 A 8 1/2 in. [23] N/A
25 3 34.0 A
10 38.0 A
80 A 100 A
7-1/2 5 40.0 A
80 A
41.0 A
90 A 110 A
15 42.0 A
7–1/2 46.0 A
6 3/4 in. 1 in.
15 48.3 A 125 A
10 50.0 A
110 A
40 50 52.0 A
20 54.0 A 90 A
15 55.0 A
150 A
5 56.0 A
10 57.5 A
7-1/2 58.0 A 125 A 4 1 in. 1 in.
60 62.0 A 100 A
20 62.1 A
100 A 175 A
50 65.0 A
25 68.0 A 150 A
20 72.0 A 110 A
10 76.0 A 125 A 200 A 3 1 in. 1-1/4 in.
175 A
60 75 77.0 A 110 A

[14] Motor full load currents thru 200 hp are taken from NEC Tables 430.147, 148 and 150. Above 200 hp from UL 98. Select wire size, circuit breakers, or fuses on basis of hp rather than
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

nameplate full load current per NEC 430.6. Do not use these values to select overload relay thermal units. See Digest pages 16-129—16152 for selection of thermal units when actual full
load current is not known. Voltages listed are rated motor voltages. Corresponding nominal system voltages are 110–120 V, 200–208 V, 220–240 V, 440–480 V and 550–600 V
[15] Thermal-magnetic circuit breaker ampere ratings recommended are approximate for average conditions, based on trip characteristics of Square D circuit breakers and NEC Table 430.52.
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

Under some conditions, the next size larger switch or circuit breaker rating may be necessary to accommodate the motor starting current and is permitted by NEC 430.52(C)(1) Exception 2.
High starting currents are anticipated with Design E and other energy efficient motors. For explanation of Code letter markings, see NEC 430.7(B). For Busway Plug-in units, see page 9-7.
[16] Type LC, LI, LX, LXI, and LE circuit breakers are NOT recommended for use on single motor branch circuits.
[17] Switch size only is shown in table. Selected fuses should not exceed maximum percent of full-load current as given in NEC Table 430.52. Above 50 hp dc switches are not hp rated by UL as
Motor Circuit Switches, but as General Use Switches only and are not necessarily capable of interrupting the max. operating overload current of a motor. See NEC 100 for definition of
General Use Switch. When protecting a 3Ø, Design E energy efficient motor, the switch is required by NEC 430.109 to have a hp rating of not less than 1.4 times that of a motor rated 3–100
hp, or not less than 1.3 times that of a motor rated over 100 hp. Switches shown in this table do not necessarily comply with that requirement.
[18] NEC 430.22 for Single Motor, Smaller conductors may be permitted for light duty-cycle service per 430.22 (B) Exception No. 1. DC motors operating from rectified 1Ø power supply will
require larger conductors per 430.22 (A) Exception No. 1. For motor-generator arc welders, see 630.11
[19] Thermal-magnetic breaker ampere ratings recommended are approximate for average conditions and based on trip characteristics of Square D circuit breakers and NEC Tables 430.7(B)
and 430.52.
[20] Ordinary service for normal starting duty only, acceleration time of 10 sec. or less.
[21] Heavy service is jogging or plugging duty or cycling load with over 25 starts per hour or over 5 starts per minute. Energy efficient motors are polyphase motors defined in NEMA Standard
MG1 and exhibit high starting current.
[22] 200 V motors are commonly used on 208 V services.
[23] 8 XHHW requires 3/4 in. conduit for 3W.
7

7-47
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Motor Circuit Protectors Motor Protection Selection Tables
Class 601
schneider-electric.us

Table 7.86 Selection Tables for Conductors, Safety Switches and Thermal-Magnetic Circuit BreakersBased on 2005 NEC® Tables
430.147, 430.148 & 430.150 (cont'd.)
Horsepower Ratings Amperage of Thermal-Magnetic [25][26] QMB Minimum Size metallic Conduit
Squirrel-Cage and Wound- Inverse Time Circuit Breaker and 75° C, C Wire Field-Installed Sized
Rotor Motors with Norm. Average Direct Heavy for 125% FLA[28]
Torque Characteristics 1Ø Current Motors Full For Motor Code Duty
10 Hz ac Operating at Load Letter B to E For Switch Conduit 3 W
Operating at Usual Speeds Motor
Base Speed Amperage with
3Ø 60 Hz [24] Code Time AWG
Ordinary Heavy Service Letter F kcmil THHN
200 200 Service and Energy Delay
230 460 575 115 230 120 240 to V [29] Fuses THWN THW
Vac Vac [30] Efficient [31] XHHW
[32] Vac Vac Vac Vac [32] Vac Vdc Vdc [27]
25 78.2 A
30 7-1/2 80.0 A
25 89.0 A 225 A
2 1 in. 1-1/4 in.
30 92.0 A 125 A
75 96.0 A
200 A 250 A
100 99.0 A
1 1-1/4 in. 1-1/2 in.
10 100.0 A 150 A
40 104.0 A
225 A
30 106.0 A 300 A
175 A 1/0 1-1/4 in. 1-1/2 in.
40 120.0 A
250 A 200 A
100 124.0 A
125 125.0 A 250 A
350 A 2/0 1-1/2 in. 1-1/2 in.
50 130.0 A
200 A
40 140.0 A
300 A
150 144.0 A
50 150.0 A
3/0 1-1/2 in. 2 in.
60 154.0 A 400 A
225 A
125 156.0 A 350 A
50 173.0 A
60 177.0 A 4/0 2 in. 2 in.
250 A
150 180.0 A 400 A 500 A
75 200 192.0 A 250 2 in. 2 in.
75 221.0 A 300 A 450 A 300 2 in. 2-1/2 in.
600 A
200 240.0 A
250 242.0 A 350 A 500 A 400 A 350 2-1/2 in. 2-1/2 in.
700 A
100 248.0 A
100 285.0 A
600 A
300 289.0 A 400 A 500 3 in. 3 in.
800 A
250 302.0 A
125 312.0 A 450 A 700 A (2) 3/0 (2) 2-1/2 in. (2) 2 in.
350 336.0 A 500 A
900 A
125 359.0 A
(2) 4/0 (2) 2 in. (2) 2 in.
150 360.0 A
800 A
300 361.0 A 600 A 1000 A
400 382.0 A
600 A (2)300 (2) 2 in. (2) 2-1/2 in.
150 350 414.0 A 900 A
500 472.0 A
1200 A
400 477.0 A 1000 A (2) 350 (2) 2-1/2 in. (2) 2-1/2 in.
800 A
200 480.0 A
200 552.0 A
500 590.0 A 1200 A 1600 A — (3) 300 (3) 2 in. (3) 2-1/2 in.
900 A
250 602.0 A
Contact your local Field Office for circuit breaker selection on constant horsepower multi-
speed motors.
7

[24] Motor full load currents thru 200 hp are taken from NEC Tables 430.147, 148 and 150. Above 200 hp from UL 98. Select wire size, circuit breakers, or fuses on basis of hp rather than
nameplate full load current per NEC 430.6. Do not use these values to select overload relay thermal units. See Digest pages 16-129—16152 for selection of thermal units when actual full
load current is not known. Voltages listed are rated motor voltages. Corresponding nominal system voltages are 110–120 V, 200–208 V, 220–240 V, 440–480 V and 550–600 V
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

[25] Thermal-magnetic circuit breaker ampere ratings recommended are approximate for average conditions, based on trip characteristics of Square D circuit breakers and NEC Table 430.52.
Under some conditions, the next size larger switch or circuit breaker rating may be necessary to accommodate the motor starting current and is permitted by NEC 430.52(C)(1) Exception 2.
High starting currents are anticipated with Design E and other energy efficient motors. For explanation of Code letter markings, see NEC 430.7(B). For Busway Plug-in units, see page 9-7.
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[26] Type LC, LI, LX, LXI, and LE circuit breakers are NOT recommended for use on single motor branch circuits.
[27] Switch size only is shown in table. Selected fuses should not exceed maximum percent of full-load current as given in NEC Table 430.52. Above 50 hp dc switches are not hp rated by UL as
Motor Circuit Switches, but as General Use Switches only and are not necessarily capable of interrupting the max. operating overload current of a motor. See NEC 100 for definition of
General Use Switch. When protecting a 3Ø, Design E energy efficient motor, the switch is required by NEC 430.109 to have a hp rating of not less than 1.4 times that of a motor rated 3–100
hp, or not less than 1.3 times that of a motor rated over 100 hp. Switches shown in this table do not necessarily comply with that requirement.
[28] NEC 430.22 for Single Motor, Smaller conductors may be permitted for light duty-cycle service per 430.22 (B) Exception No. 1. DC motors operating from rectified 1Ø power supply will
require larger conductors per 430.22 (A) Exception No. 1. For motor-generator arc welders, see 630.11
[29] Thermal-magnetic breaker ampere ratings recommended are approximate for average conditions and based on trip characteristics of Square D circuit breakers and NEC Tables 430.7(B)
and 430.52.
[30] Ordinary service for normal starting duty only, acceleration time of 10 sec. or less.
[31] Heavy service is jogging or plugging duty or cycling load with over 25 starts per hour or over 5 starts per minute. Energy efficient motors are polyphase motors defined in NEMA Standard
MG1 and exhibit high starting current.
[32] 200 V motors are commonly used on 208 V services.
7-48
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact Automatic Switches Automatic Switches
Class 600 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us

PowerPact Automatic Switches


Automatic molded case switches open instantaneously at a factory preset magnetic trip
point, calibrated to protect only the molded case switch itself, when it is subjected to high
fault currents. The trip point is nonadjustable and provides no overload or low level fault
protection.
Molded case switches open when the handle is switched to the OFF position or in
response to an auxiliary tripping device such as a shunt trip.
All molded case switches will accept the same lugs and accessories as equivalent
thermal-magnetic circuit breakers, with the exception of Q-frame switches which do not
have electrical accessories available.
J-Frame L-Frame Automatic molded case switches are UL Listed per UL 489 and are CSA Certified.
Switch Switch

Table 7.87: PowerPact™ B-Frame Automatic Molded Case Switches, 600 Vac
D Withstand G Withstand J Withstand
Circuit Ampere
Poles Trip Terminal Wire Range
Breaker Rating Cat. No. Cat. No. Trip Point Cat. No. Trip Point
Point
2 [1] 125 A BDL26000S12 1625 A BGL26000S12 1625 A BJL26000S12 1625 A LV426973 14–2/0 AWG Cu
B-Frame
3 125 A BDL36000S12 1625 A BGL36000S12 1625 A BJL36000S12 1625 A LV426974 14–2/0 AWG Cu

Table 7.88: H-, J-, and L-Frame PowerPact™ Automatic Molded Case Switches, 600 Vac
G Withstand L Withstand R Withstand
Circuit Ampere
Poles Trip Terminal Wire Range
Breaker Rating Cat. No. Cat. No. Trip Point Cat. No. Trip Point
Point
150 A HGL26000S15 [1] 2250 A HLL26000S15 2250 A — — AL150HD 14 AWG–3/0 AWG Al/Cu
2 175 A JGL26000S17 3125 A JLL26000S17 3125 A — — AL175JD 4–4/0 AWG Al/Cu
H-Frame 250 A JGL26000S25 3125 A JLL26000S25 3125 A — — AL250JD 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil Al/Cu
J-Frame 150 A HGL36000S15 2250 A HLL36000S15 2250 A — — AL150HD 14 AWG–3/0 AWG Al/Cu
3 175 A JGL36000S17 3125 A JLL36000S17 3125 A JRL36000S17 3125 A AL175JD 4–4/0 AWG Al/Cu
250 A JGL36000S25 3125 A JLL36000S25 3125 A JRL36000S25 3125 A AL250JD 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil Al/Cu
400 A LGL36000S40X 4800 A LLL36000S40X 4800 A LRL36000S40X 4800 A AL150HD AL600LS52K3
3 (2) 2/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al/Cu
600 A LGL36000S60X 6600A LLL36000S60X 6600 A LRL36000S60X 6600 A AL250JD
L-Frame
400 A LGL46000S40X 4800 A LLL46000S40X 4800 A LRL46000S40X 4800 A AL150HD AL600LS52K4
4 (2) 2/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al/Cu
600 A LGL46000S60X 6600A LLL46000S60X 6600 A LRL46000S60X 6600 A AL250JD

Table 7.89: P-Frame and R-Frame PowerPact™ Automatic Molded Case Switches [2], 600 Vac
Ampere J Withstand K Withstand L Withstand
Frame Poles Rating Terminal Wire Range
Cat. No. Trip Point Cat. No. Trip Point Cat. No. Trip Point
600 A PJL26000S60 10 kA PKL26000S60 24 kA PLL24000S60 [3] 10 kA (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil
AL800M23K
800 A PJL26000S80 10 kA PKL26000S80 24 kA PLL24000S80 [3] 10 kA Al or Cu
2
1000 A PJL26000S10 10 kA PKL26000S10 24 kA PLL24000S10 [3] 10 kA (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil
AL1200P25K
1200 A PJL26000S12 10 kA PKL26000S12 24 kA PLL24000S12 [3] 10 kA Al or Cu
P
600 A PJL36000S60 10 kA PKL36000S60 24 kA PLL34000S60 [3] 10 kA (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil
AL800M23K Al or Cu
800 A PJL36000S80 10 kA PKL36000S80 24 kA PLL34000S80 [3] 10 kA
3
1000 A PJL36000S10 10 kA PKL36000S10 24 kA PLL34000S10 [3] 10 kA (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil
AL1200P25K
1200 A PJL36000S12 10 kA PKL36000S12 24 kA PLL34000S12 [3] 10 kA Al or Cu
1200 A — — RKF26000S12 57 kA RLF26000S12 48 kA
1600 A — — RKF26000S16 57 kA RLF26000S16 48 kA
2 R-frame circuit breakers can be
2000 A — — RKF26000S20 57 kA RLF26000S20 48 kA
2500 A — — RKF26000S25 57 kA RLF26000S25 48 kA bus-connected or cable-connected.
For cable connections, RLTB kit or
R 1200 A — — RKF36000S12 57 kA RLF36000S12 48 kA equivalent bus structure is required.
1600 A — — RKF36000S16 57 kA RLF36000S16 48 kA Kit is included with 3000 A switches.
3 2000 A — — RKF36000S20 57 kA RLF36000S20 48 kA For all others, see page 7-62.
2500 A — — RKF36000S25 57 kA RLF36000S25 48 kA
3000 A — — RKF36000S30 57 kA RLF36000S30 48 kA

Table 7.90: Q-Frame (240 Vac) PowerPact™ Automatic Molded Case Switches
Accessories see page 7-54 and Supplemental Digest Section 3 J Withstand
Circuit Ampere
Optional Lugs see page 7-59 and Supplemental Digest Section 3 Poles Rating Wire Range
Breaker Cat. No. Trip Point
Dimensions see page 7-76 and page 7-77 Q-Frame 2 225 A QBL22000S22 4500 A
[4] 4 AWG–300 kcmil
Enclosures see page 7-78 3 225 A QBL32000S22 4500 A

Table 7.91: B-, H-, J-, L- P-, and R-Frame Withstand Ratings [5]
Withstand
Voltage
D G J K L R
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

240 Vac 25 kA 65 kA 100 kA 65 kA 125 kA 200 kA


480 Vac 18 kA 35 kA 65 kA 50 kA [6] 100 kA 200 kA
600 Vac 14 kA 18 kA 25 kA 50 kA [6] 50 kA 100 kA
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[1] True 2P device. Others are a 2P in a 3P module.


[2] UL magnetic trip tolerances are -20% / +30% from the nominal values shown.
[3] P-frame L-interrupting is available in 480 Vac only.
[4] Withstand rating of 10 kA at 240 Vac.
[5] The withstand rating is the fault current at rated voltage that the molded case switch will withstand without damage when protected by a circuit breaker with an equal continuous current
rating.
[6] B- and R-frame withstand is 65 kA.
7

7-49
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
500 Vdc Circuit Breakers UL Listed 500 Vdc Circuit Breakers
Class 500, 600
schneider-electric.us

500 Vdc Circuit Breakers


The UL Listed thermal-magnetic molded case circuit breakers shown below are
specifically designed for use on ungrounded dc systems having a maximum short-circuit
voltage of 500 Vdc or a maximum floating (unloaded) voltage of 600 Vdc. The circuit
CAUTION/PRECAUCION/
breakers are suitable for use only with UPS (ungrounded uninterruptable power supplies
ATTENTION systems).
Connect only as shown/Conectar solo asi/
Brancher seulement comme suit:
600 V MAX.
Load/Carga/
+ 600 VMAX. - This two-level voltage rating allows these circuit breakers to be applied to battery
+
Charge or sources having a short-circuit availability of 20,000 amperes or 50,000 amperes for
o
ou PowerPact H-, J-, and L-frame DC circuit breakers at 500 Vdc.
Load/Carga/
- Charge
600 V MAX.
PowerPact H-frame DC circuit breakers have a fixed magnetic trip system. PowerPact J-
and L-frame DC circuit breakers are provided with an adjustable magnetic trip that is
readily accessible by means of a single adjustment on the face of the circuit breaker.
PowerPact H- and J-frame circuit breakers are UL Listed for the interrupting ratings
shown only if applied with three poles connected in series (series connection is external
to circuit breaker). (See figure for example of diagram.)
PowerPact L-frame circuit breakers are UL Listed for the interrupting ratings shown with
two or three poles connected in series (series connection is external to circuit breaker).
NOTE: Due to external series connection, I-Line™ circuit breakers are not available
for this application.
Table 7.93: DC Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Fixed Magnetic Adjustable Magnetic Trip Interrupting
Ampere Rating Circuit Breaker Trip —DC Range—DC Amperes [1] Rating
Cat. No. Amperes @ 500 Vdc
Low High
30 A HGL37030D87 450 — —
50 A HGL37050D87 450 — — 20 k AIR
70 A HGL37070D87 450 — —
100 A JGL37100D81 — 400 600
Connection Diagram 125 A JGL37125D81 — 400 600
150 A JGL37150D81 — 400 600 20 k AIR
175 A JGL37175D81 — 400 600
Table 7.92: Termination Options
200 A JGL37200D82 — 500 850
Termination Letter Termination Option 225 A JGL37225D82 — 500 850
L Lugs Both Ends 250 A JGL37250D82 — 500 850 20 k AIR
F No Lugs (bus bar connection) 300 A LGL37030D27 — 750 1500
S Rear Connection 350 A LGL37035D29 — 875 1750
JGL37125D81–Place termination letter in third block of circuit breaker 400 A LGL37040D30 — 1000 2000
catalog number. 450 A LGL37045D31 — 1125 2250
500 A LGL37050D32 — 1250 2500
600 A LGL37060D33 — 1500 3000 20 k AIR
700 A LGL47070D35 — 1750 3500
800 A LGL47080D36 — 2000 4000
900 A LGL47090D86 — 2250 4500
1000 A LGL47100D40 — 2500 5000
1200 A LGL47120D42 — 3000 6000
30A HLL37030D87 450 — —
50A HLL37050D87 450 — — 50 k AIR
70A HLL37070D87 450 — —
100A JLL37100D81 — 400 600
125A JLL37125D81 — 400 600
150A JLL37150D81 — 400 600
175A JLL37175D81 — 400 600 50 k AIR
200A JLL37200D82 — 500 850
225A JLL37225D82 — 500 850
250A JLL37250D82 — 500 850
300A LLL37030D27 — 750 1500
350A LLL37035D29 — 875 1750
400A LLL37040D30 — 1000 200
450 A LLL36045D31 — 1125 2250
500 A LLL37050D32 — 1250 2500
600 A LLL37060D33 — 1500 3000
50 k AIR
700 A LLL47070D35 — 1750 3500
800 A LLL47080D36 — 2000 4000
900 A LLL47090D86 — 2250 4500
1000 A LLL47100D40 — 2500 5000
7

1200 A LLL47120D42 — 3000 6000

Accessories see page 7-54 and Supplemental Digest Section 3


Optional Lugs see page 7-59 and Supplemental Digest Section 3
Dimensions see page 7-77 and Supplemental Digest Section 3
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

Enclosures see page 7-82


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[1] Magnetic trip tolerances are -20%/+30% from the nominal values shown.
7-50
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL Listed 500 Vdc NW Circuit Breakers 500 Vdc Circuit Breakers
Class 500, 600
schneider-electric.us

500 Vdc Masterpact NW Circuit Breakers


Table 7.94: Masterpact NW DC Circuit Breakers
Circuit Breaker Interrupting Rating 500 Vdc
Ampere Rating
Reference No. (max 600 Vdc unloaded)
800 A NW08NDC 35 kA
1000 A NW10NDC 35 kA
1200 A NW12NDC 35 kA
1400 A NW14NDC 35 kA
1600 A NW16NDC 35 kA
2000A NW20NDC 35 kA
2500 A NW25NDC 35 kA
3000 A NW30NDC 35 kA
4000 A NW40NDC 35 kA
800 A NW08HDC 85 kA
1000 A NW10HDC 85 kA
1200 A NW12HDC 85 kA
1400 A NW14HDC 85 kA
1600 A NW16HDC 85 kA
2000A NW20HDC 85 kA
2500 A NW25HDC 85 kA
3000 A NW30HDC 85 kA
4000 A NW40HDC 85 kA
Masterpact NW DC Circuit Breaker

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


7 CIRCUIT BREAKERS

7-51
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Mission Critical Circuit Breakers Selective Coordination
Class 500, 600
schneider-electric.us

Mission Critical Circuit Breakers


Designed for selectively coordinated systems, mission critical circuit breakers maximize
continuity of the electrical service by allowing the branch circuit breaker to clear the fault.
Mission critical circuit breakers are engineered with technology that optimizes current,
time and energy selectivity so the fault is cleared by the circuit breaker immediately
upstream of the occurrence. This technology (see figure below) allows the remaining
areas of the electrical system to continue operation without disruption. In addition to
unique design attributes, Square D mission critical circuit breakers have also undergone
rigorous testing procedures to certify the coordination with downstream circuit breakers
Plug-in Drawout Rear Connected —combining innovative engineering with validated test results.
Apply Square D mission critical circuit breakers in emergency power distribution
Table 7.95: PowerPact J- and L-Frame Mission systems, data centers, hospitals or anywhere continuity of service is desired.
Critical Circuit Breakers The PowerPact™ J- and L-Frame Mission Critical circuit breakers deliver high levels of
Ratings Available Configurations selective coordination in a flexible design that can be easily configured for a variety of
I-Line mounting applications. Tested to be selectively coordinated with the QO™ family of miniature
UL 489 Listed Main circuit breaker in NQ and NF panelboards circuit breakers and the ED, EG, and EJ circuit breakers, this solution provides peace of
CSA Certified Unit mount for OEM users
Voltage: 480 V Plug-in base for OEM users
mind when power availability is critical.
Drawout base ofr OEM users An electronic trip unit provides adjustable long-time settings in four sensor sizes,
allowing coverage from 70 A through 600 A on a 120–240, 208Y/120, 240, 480Y/277,
and 480 V systems.
PowerPact Circuit Breakers with Micrologic Electronic Trip Units
The advantages of being able to adjust the trip curve of a circuit breaker equipped with
an electronic trip system are obvious. There are other advantages, such as being able to
adjust or turn off the instantaneous trip function on some circuit beakers and models of
trip units.

Table 7.96: J-Frame 250 A Electronic Trip Mission Critical 100% Rated Circuit Breakers (480/277 Vac) with Factory Sealed Trip Units
Suitable for Reverse Connection
Electronic Trip Trip Continuous Cat. No.
Unit Type Trip Unit Terminal
Function Current D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting
Standard LI 3.2 W 250 A JDL34250WU31X JGL34250WU31X JJL34250WU31X JLL34250WU31X AL250JD [1]
Standard LSI 3.2S-W 250 A JDL34250WU33X JGL34250WU33X JJL34250WU33X JLL34250WU33X AL250JD [1]
High Perf. Ammeter LSI 5.2A-W 250 A JDL34250WU43X JGL34250WU43X JJL34250WU43X JLL34250WU43X AL250JD [1]
High Perf. Energy LSI 5.2E-W 250 A JDL34250WU53X JGL34250WU53X JJL34250WU53X JLL34250WU53X AL250JD [1]
High Perf. Ammeter LSIG 6.2A-W 250 A JDL34250WU44X JGL34250WU44X JJL34250WU44X JLL34250WU44X AL250JD [1]
High Perf. Energy LSIG 6.2E-W 250 A JDL34250WU54X JGL34250WU54X JJL34250WU54X JLL34250WU54X AL250JD [1]

Table 7.97: J-Frame Termination Options


Termination Letter
A = I-Line (See Section 9) JGL36100
F = No Lugs (includes terminal nut kit on both ends)[2] For factory-installed termination, place
termination letter in the third block of the circuit
L = Lugs both ends breaker catalog number.
M = Lugs ON end Terminal Nut Kit OFF end Termination Letter
P = Lugs OFF end Terminal Nut Kit ON end
N = Plug-in
D = Drawout
S = Rear Connected

Table 7.98: J-Frame Interrupting Ratings


Interrupting Rating
Voltage
D G J L
240 Vac 25 kA 65 kA 100 kA 125 kA
480 Vac 18 kA 35 kA 65 kA 100 kA
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[1] AL250JD terminal wire range is (1) 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil Al or Cu.
[2] Add TS suffix for circuit breaker without terminal nut kit.
7-52
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Selective Coordination Mission Critical Circuit Breakers
Class 500, 600
schneider-electric.us

Table 7.99: L-Frame 600 A Electronic Trip Mission Critical Circuit Breakers (480/277 Vac) with Factory Sealed Trip Units Suitable for
Reverse Connection [3]
Electronic Trip Trip Continuous Cat. No.
Unit Type Trip Unit Terminal
Function Current D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting.
480/277 Vac, 50/60 Hz, 3P
250 A LDL34250WU31X LGL34250WU31X LJL34250WU31X LLL34250WU31X AL400L61K3 [4]
Standard LI 3.3 W 400 A LDL34400WU31X LGL34400WU31X LJL34400WU31X LLL34400WU31X
AL600LS52K3 [5]
600 A LDL34600WU31X LGL34600WU31X LJL34600WU31X LLL34300WU31X
250 A LDL34250WU33X LGL34250WU33X LJL34250WU33X LLL34250WU33X AL400L61K3 [4]
Standard LSI 3.3S-W 400 A LDL34400WU33X LGL34400WU33X LJL34400WU33X LLL34400WU33X
AL600LS52K3 [5]
600 A LDL34600WU33X LGL34600WU33X LJL34600WU33X LLL34300WU33X
400 A LDL34400WU43X LGL34400WU43X LJL34400WU43X LLL34400WU43X
High Perf. Ammeter LSI 5.3A-W AL600LS52K3 [5]
600 A LDL34600WU43X LGL34600WU43X LJL34600WU43X LLL34300WU43X
400 A LDL34400WU53X LGL34400WU53X LJL34400WU53X LLL34400WU53X
High Perf. Energy LSI 5.3E-W AL600LS52K3 [5]
600 A LDL34600WU53X LGL34600WU53X LJL34600WU53X LLL34300WU53X
400 A LDL34400WU44X LGL34400WU44X LJL34400WU44X LLL34400WU44X
High Perf. Ammeter LSIG 6.3A-W AL600LS52K3 [5]
600 A LDL34600WU44X LGL34600WU44X LJL34600WU44X LLL34300WU44X
400 A LDL34400WU54X LGL34400WU54X LJL34400WU54X LLL34400WU54X
High Perf. Energy LSIG 6.3E-W AL600LS52K3 [5]
600 A LDL34600WU54X LGL34600WU54X LJL34600WU54X LLL34300WU54X
480/277 Vac, 50/60 Hz, 4P
250 A LDL44250WU31X LGL44250WU31X LJL44250WU31X LLL44250WU31X AL400L61K4 [4]
Standard LI 3.3 W 400 A LDL44400WU31X LGL44400WU31X LJL44400WU31X LLL44400WU31X
AL600LS52K4 [5]
600 A LDL44600WU31X LGL44600WU31X LJL44600WU31X LLL44300WU31X
250 A LDL44250WU33X LGL44250WU33X LJL44250WU33X LLL44250WU33X AL400L61K4 [4]
Standard LSI 3.3S-W 400 A LDL44400WU33X LGL44400WU33X LJL44400WU33X LLL44400WU33X
AL600LS52K4 [5]
600 A LDL44600WU33X LGL44600WU33X LJL44600WU33X LLL44300WU33X
400 A LDL44400WU43X LGL44400WU43X LJL44400WU43X LLL44400WU43X
High Perf. Ammeter LSI 5.3A-W AL600LS52K4 [5]
600 A LDL44600WU43X LGL44600WU43X LJL44600WU43X LLL44300WU43X
400 A LDL44400WU53X LGL44400WU53X LJL44400WU53X LLL44400WU53X
High Perf. Energy LSI 5.3E-W AL600LS52K3 [5]
600 A LDL44600WU53X LGL44600WU53X LJL44600WU53X LLL44300WU53X
400 A LDL44400WU44X LGL44400WU44X LJL44400WU44X LLL44400WU44X
High Perf. Ammeter LSIG 6.3A-W AL600LS52K4 [5]
600 A LDL44600WU44X LGL44600WU44X LJL44600WU44X LLL44300WU44X
400 A LDL44400WU54X LGL44400WU54X LJL44400WU54X LLL44400WU54X
High Perf. Energy LSIG 6.3E-W AL600LS52K4 [5]
600 A LDL44600WU54X LGL44600WU54X LJL44600WU54X LLL44300WU54X

Accessories see page 7-54


Optional Lugs see page 7-59
Compression and PDC Lugs see Supplemental Digest, Section 3
Dimensions see page 7-77
Enclosures see page 7-78

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[3] Standard rating (100%) for 250 A and 400 A only. Standard rating 80% for 600 A.
[4] AL400L61K3 terminal wire ranges are (1) #2 AWG–500 kcmil Al or (1) #2 AWG–600 kcmil Cu.
[5] AL600LS52K3 terminal wire ranges are (2) 2/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu.
7

7-53
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories Electrical Accessories
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us

PowerPact Accessories
Table 7.100: Electrical Accessories
B-, H-, J-, and L-Frame M-, P-, and R-Frame
H- and J-
B-Frame L-Frame
Factory Frame
Accessory Description Rated Voltage Factory Field-
Installed Field-
Field- Field- Field- Installed Installable
Cat. Installable Cat. Suffix Cat. No.
Suffix Installable Installable Installable
Pre-Wired
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
Cat. No.
1 auxiliary switch (OF) 1a1b AA LV426950 LV426951 S29450 S29450 AA S29450
2 auxiliary switch (OF) 2a2b AB — — 2x S29450 2x S29450 AB 2x S29450
Auxiliary and
Alarm Switches 3 auxiliary switch (OF) 3a3b AC — — — 3x S29450 AC 3x S29450
(OF, SD, SDE) Alarm Switch (SD) 1a1b BC LV426950 LV426952 S29450 S29450 BC S29450
Standard Overcurrent trip switch (SDE)
1a1b BD — — — S29450 BD S29450
Min
Load = Consisting OF Switch — — — S29450 — — —
10mA of: SDE Adapter — — — S29451 — — —
with
24V Alarm switch and Overcurrent
trip switch BE — — — 2x S29450 BE 2x S29450
Provides
circuit breaker Consisting OF Switch — — — 2x S29450 — — —
contact status. of: SDE Adapter — — — S29451 — — —
Note: The
Auxiliary Switch/Alarm Switch/
B-Frame location of the Adapter (OF/SD/SDE) Kit — — — — — — S33801 [1]
accessory in
the circuit One auxiliary switch (OF) 1a1b AE — — S29452 S29452 AE S29452
breaker Two auxiliary switches (OF)
determines its 2a2b AF — — 2x S29452 2x S29452 AF 2x S29452
function.
3 auxiliary switches (OF) 3a3b AG — — — 3x S29452 AG 3x S29452
Low Alarm Switch (SD) 1a1b BH — — S29452 S29452 BH S29452
Level Overcurrent trip switch (SDE)
Min BJ — — — S29452 BJ [2] S29452
1a1b
Load =
1mA with Consisting OF Switch — — — S29452 — — —
24V of: SDE Adapter — — — S29451 — — —
Alarm switch and Overcurrent
H-, J-, L-, M-, P, and trip switch BK — — — 2x S29452 BK [2] 2x S29452
R-Frame
Consisting OF Switch — — — 2x S29452 — — —
of: SDE Adapter [3] — — — S29451 — — —
Shunt Trip (MX) 24 SK LV426841 LV426861 S29384 S29384 SK S33659
48 SL LV426842 LV426862 S29385 S29385 SL S33660
110–130 SA LV426843 LV426863 S29386 S29386 SA S33661
AC 220–240 SD, SF — — — — SC S33662
208–277 SD LV426844 LV426864 S29387 S29387 SD S33663
380–480 SH LV426846 LV426866 S29388 S29388 SH S33664
525–600 SJ — — S29389 S29389 — —
B-Frame Trips the circuit breaker 12 SN — — S29382 S29382 SN S33658
from a remote location by 24 SO LV426841 LV426861 S29390 S29390 SK S33659
means of a trip coil
energized from a separate 30 SU — — S29391 S29391 SK S33659
supply voltage circuit. 48 SP LV426842 LV426862 S29392 S29392 SL S33660
60 SV — — S29383 S29383 SL S33660
DC 125 SR LV426843 LV426863 S29393 S29393 SA S33661

250 SS LV426844 LV426864 S29394 S29394 SC S33662

H-, J-, and L-Frame


24 UK LV426801 LV426821 S29404 S29404 UK S33668
48 UL LV426802 LV426822 S29405 S29405 UL S33669
110–130 UA LV426803 LV426823 S29406 S29406 UA S33670
Instantaneously opens the 220–240 UC LV426804 LV426824 — — UC S33671
AC
circuit breaker when the 208–277 UD LV426805 LV426825 S29407 S29407 — —
under-voltage trip supply 380–415 UF LV426806 LV426826 — — — —
voltage drops to a value 380–480 UH LV426807 LV426827 S29408 S29408 UH S33673
between 35% and 70% of
its rated voltage. Closing 525–600 UJ — — S29409 S29409 — —
is allowed when the 12 UN — — S29402 S29402 — —
supply voltage of the 24 UO LV426801 LV426821 S29410 S29410 UK S33668
undervoltage trip reaches 30 UU — — S29411 S29411 UK S33668
Undervoltage Trip 85% of rated voltage. DC 48 UP LV426802 LV426822 S29412 S29412 UL S33669
(MN) 60 UV — — S29403 S29403 UL S33669
H-, J-, and L-Frame
125 UR LV426803 LV426823 S29413 S29413 UA S33670
250 US LV426815 LV426835 S29414 S29414 UC S33671
Time Delay Unit Undervoltage trip with 48 — S33680 [4] — S33680 [4] S33680 [4] — S33680 [4]
7

externally mounted 100–130 — S33681 [4] — S33681 [4] S33681 [4] — S33681 [4]
adjustable time delay unit
for UVR of 0.5, 0.9, 1.5, AC/DC 220–250 — S33682 [4] — S33682 [4] S33682 [4] — S33682 [4]
3.0 seconds before circuit
breaker trips 380–480 — — — — — — S33683 [4]
S29426 [4] S29426 [4] S29426 [4]
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

Undervoltage trip with 48 — — — —


externally mounted non- 100–130 — — — — — — S33684 [4]
adjustable time delay unit AC/DC
of 0.25 sec before circuit 200–250 — — — — — — S33685 [4]
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

breaker trips. 220–240 — S29427 [4] — S29427 [4] S29427 [4] — —

[1] P-frame drawout circuit breaker only.


[2] Not available on electrically operated P-frame.
[3] SDE Adapter used for H- and J-frame only.
[4] Field-installable kit includes time delay module only. Order undervoltage trip separately.

7-54
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Motor Operators and Rotary Handles PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us

Motors and Rotary Handles


Table 7.101: Motor Operators for H-, J-, and L-Frame Circuit Breakers
Field-Installable Kit
Description Rated Voltage Factory Installed
Cat. No. Suffix H-Frame [5] J-Frame L-Frame 600 A
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
48–60 ML S29440 S31548 S432639
110–130 MA S29433 S31540 S432640
208–277
AC MD S29434 S31541 S432641
220–240
Standard motor for electrically-operated 380–415 MF — — S432642
circuit breakers [6] 440–480 MH S29435 S31542 S432647
24–30 MO S29436 S31543 S432643
48–60 MV S29437 S31544 S432644
DC
110–130 MR S29438 S31545 S432645
250 MS S29439 S31546 S432646
Communicating motor for electrically-
operated circuit breakers [7] AC 220–240 NC S429441 S431549 S432652
Motor Operator
Mounting hardware — — — S32649
Locking device Ronis lock — S41940 S41940 S41940
Profalux lock — S42888 S42888 S42888
Mounting hardware plus Ronis
— S429449 S429449 —
lock
Operations counter — — — S32648
Adapter for I-Line circuit breaker — S37420 S37420 —

Table 7.102: Spring-Charging Motors for Electrically-Operated P-Frame Circuit Breakers


P-Frame (For Field Replacement
Factory Installed Replacement Coils
Description Rated Voltage Only) Opening/Closing Coil Cat. No.
Cat. No. Suffix Spring Charging Motor Cat. No.
48 ML S47391 S33660
100–130 MA S47395 S33661
AC
Standard motor for electrically- 220–240 MC S47396 S33662
operated circuit breakers. 380–415 MF S47398 S33664
Factory-installed includes motor 24–30 MO S47390 S33659
and opening/closing coils. 48–60 MV S47391 S33660
DC
110–130 MR S47392 S33661
200–250 MS S47393 S33662
48 NL S47391 S33034
100–130 NA S47395 S33035
Communicating motor AC
220–240 NC S47396 S33036
mechanism for electrically 380–415 NF S47398 S33038
operated circuit breakers.
Factory-installed includes motor 24–30 NO S47390 S33033
Spring-Charging Motor and opening/closing coils. 48–60 NV S47391 S33034
DC
110–130 NR S47392 S33035
200–250 NS S47393 S33036

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[5] Not available in H-frame 2P modules.


[6] Factory and field-installed standard motor operators for H- and J-frame circuit breakers require the SDE switch and SDE adapter (both included).
Factory and field-installed standard motor operators for L-frame circuit breakers require the SDE switch (included).
[7] Installation requires BSCM with NSX Cord. For ordering information see page 7-69.
7

7-55
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories Motor Operators and Rotary Handles
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us

Rotary Handles

Door-Mounted
Direct-Mounted Handle
Handle

Table 7.103: Rotary Operated Handles


B-Frame H- and J-Frame [8] L-Frame P-Frame
Factory Factory Factory Factory
Device Description Installed Field- Installed Field- Installed Field- Installed
Installable Installable Installable
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
Suffix Suffix Suffix Suffix
Standard black handle Operating mechanism kit RD10 LV426930 RD10 S29337 RD10 S32597 RD10
Two early-break and two early make
switches — — — — — — RD16
Standard black handle One early-break switch S29337 + S32597 +
— — RD12 S29345 RD12 S32605 —
with
Two early-make switches S29337 + S32597 +
— — RD13 RD13 —
Direct S29346 S29346
Mounted Operating mechanism kit RD20 LV426931 RD20 S29339 RD20 S32599 —
Red handle on yellow One early-break switch S29339 + S32599 +
— — RD22 S29345 RD22 S32605 —
bezel
Two early-make switches S29339 + RD23 S32599 +
— — RD23 S29346 S29346 —
MCC conversion accessory — — — S429341 — S32606 —
CNOMO conversion accessory — — — 29342 — S32602 —
Standard black handle Operating mechanism kit — LV426932 RE10 S29338 RE10 S32598 RE10
Two early-break and two early make
— — — — — — RE16
Standard black handle switches
Door Mounted with: S29338 + S32598 +
Two early make switches — — RE13 RE13 —
S29346 S29346
Red handle on yellow Operating mechanism kit
bezel — LV426933 RE20 S29340 RE20 S32600 —
Rotary Handle Replacement Kit — — — — — — S33875
Telescoping — — RT10 S29343 RT10 S32603 —
Key lock adapter — — — S429344 — S32604 —
Ronis 1351.500 — — — S41940 — S41940 —
Profalux KS5 B24 D4Z — — — S42888 — S42888 —
Key locks
Accessories 2 Ronis keylocks with 1 key — — — S41950 — S41950 —
2 Profalux keylocks with 1 key — — — S42878 — S42878 —
Indication Auxiliary One early-break switch — — — S29445 — S32605 —
Switch Two early-make switches — — — S29346 — S29346 —
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[8] Not available in H-frame 2P modules.


7-56
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Locks, Installation Accessories, and Rear PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories
Connections
schneider-electric.us Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101

Locks, Installation Accessories, and Rear Connectors

Removable Padlock Attachment Fixed Padlock Attachment

Table 7.104: Locks, Interlocking


B-Frame H- and J-Frame Q-Frame L-Frame M- and P-Frame R-Frame
Factory- Factory- Field- Factory- Field- Field- Factory- Field- Factory- Field-
Device Description Field-
Installed Installed Installa- Installed Instal- Installa- Installed Installa- Installed Installa-
Cat. No. Installable Cat. No. ble Cat. No. led ble Cat. No. ble Cat. No. ble
Cat. No.
Suffix Suffix Cat. No. Suffix Cat. No. Cat. No. Suffix Cat. No. Suffix Cat. No.
Removable (lock OFF only) — S29370 — S29370 — S29370 — S44936 — S33996
LV426905
Fixed (lock OFF or ON) YP LV426907 YP S29371 YP QBPA S32631 YP S32631 YP S32631
Handle (I-Line)
Padlocking
Device LV426906
Fixed (lock OFF only)[9] YQ LV426908 YQ S37422 YQ QBPAF NJPAF YQ MPRPAF YQ MPRPAF
(I-Line)
Fixed (lock OFF only)–2P — — YQ H2PHLA YQ — — — — — —
Mechanical for circuit breakers
Interlocking with rotary handles[10] — — — S29369 — — S32621 — S33890 — —
(Not UL
listed) Mechanical for circuit breakers
with toggles[10] — LV426994 — S29354 — QBMIK S32614 — — — —
Provision only, vertical
mount, 1 or 2 locks Kirk — — — — — — — JA — —
Provisions only,
vertical mounting one
key interlock including Kirk — — — — — — — JE [11][12] — JE [12] —
padlock provision,
open position only.
Provision only, Kirk — — — — — — — JK — JK —
horizontal mount Ronis — — — — — — — JB [13] — JB —
1 lock, M- and P-frame
1 or 2 locks, R-frame Profalux — — — — — — — JD [13] — JD —
Provision and 1 lock,
vertical mount Kirk — — — — — — — JG — — —
Kirk — — — — — — — JL — JL —
Key Lockng Provision and 1 lock, JC [13]
Ronis — — — — — — — — JC —
horizontal mount
Profalux — — — — — — — JF [13] — JF —
Provision and 2 locks
keyed alike Kirk — — — — — — — JN — JN —
Provision and 2 locks
keyed differently Kirk — — — — — — — JP — JP —

Table 7.105: Installation Accessories for B-, H-, J-, and L-Frame Circuit Breakers
Field-Installable Cat. No.
Description
B-Frame H- and J-Frame L-Frame
Front Panel Escutcheon for Toggle Breakers — S29315 32556
Front Panel Escutcheon for Rotary Handle, Motor Operator, or
extended escutcheon — S29317 S32558
Phase Barriers (set of 6) LV426920 S29329 32570
Handle Rubber Boot[14] — S29319 S32560
Sealing Accessories (for front cover screws) S29375 S29375 S29375
Handle Rubber DIN rail mounting kit (requires 15 mm depth on a 35 mm DIN
rail)[14] Standard S29305 —
Boot
DIN rail adapter Standard — —
Handle Extensions (set of 5) — S29313 S432553
Rear Insulation Kit (2P) LV426921 — —
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

Rear Insulation Kit (3P) LV426922 — —


Rear Insulation Kit (4P) LV426923 — —
Terminal Extensions-Spreaders (3P) LV426940 — —
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

Terminal Extensions-Spreaders (4P) LV426941 — —


5 N-m Torque Limiting Bit, Set of 6 LV426992 — —
5 N-m Torque Limiting Bit, Set of 8 LV426993 — —
9 N-m Torque Limiting Bit, Set of 6 LV426990 — —
9 N-m Torque Limiting Bit, Set of 8 LV426991 — —

[9] Not available on HD and HG 2P modules.


[10] Not available in M frame or HD and HG 2P modules.
[11] Not available on M-frame.
[12] Not available on I-Line.
[13] Not available for M, P or P frame drawout. Only available on P frame electronic.
[14] Not available in HD and HG 2P modules.
7

7-57
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories Locks, Installation Accessories, and Rear
Connections
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101 schneider-electric.us

Table 7.106: Installation Accessories for M-, P-, and R-Frame Circuit Breakers
Description Field-Installable
Frame Cat. No.
M-, P-Frame S33718
Accessory Cover
R-Frame S33929
Door Escutcheon
Toggle Handle M-, P-Frame S33717
Drawout P-Frame S33857
Short lug cover 3P S33932
Door Escutcheon
Terminal Covers Short lug cover 4P S33933
Terminal Covers P-Frame
Long lug cover 3P S33934
Long lug cover 4P S33935
Standard R-Frame S33997
Replacement Handle Standard Short M-, P-Frame S46998
Long M-, P-Frame S46996

Table 7.107: Rear Connections


H-Frame J-Frame L-Frame
Factory- Field- Factory- Field- Factory-
Description Installed Installed Installed Field-Installable
Device Poles Installable Poles Installable Poles
Termination Cat. No. Termination Cat. No. Termination Cat. No.
No. No. No.
Mixed Rear 2 S — 2 S — 3 S S32477
Connection Kit
[15] 3 S S37432 3 S S37437 4 S S32478
Short rear connections 2-
(set of 2) — 2x S37433 — 2x S37438 — S432475
x
2 or 3 2 or 3 3
Long rear connections S37439 2-
(set of 2) — S37434 — [16] — S432476
Consisting of: x
Short terminal cover (3P) 3 — S37436 3 — S37440 3 — 2- S32562
x
Rear Short terminal cover (4P) 2-
Connection 4 — — — — — 4 — S32563
x
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[15] Kit contains 4 short rear connections, 2 long rear connections (4 long rear connections for 4P), hardware, and 2 terminal covers..
[16] For use with 3P circuit breakers only.
7-58
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Mechanical Lugs PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us

Mechanical Lugs
Table 7.108: Mechanical Lug Kits for B-Frame Circuit Breakers [17]
Circuit Breaker Application Number of Wires Field-
Description Ampere Rating Factory-Installed Qty Per
Per Lug and Wire Range Installable
Standard Ampere Rating Optional Cat. Suffix Cat. No. Kit

Al Lugs for Use with Al BD BG BJ 15-125 A (1) 14-2/0 AWG Al or Cu LH LV426988 2


or Cu Wire BD BG BJ 15-125 A (1) 14-2/0 AWG Al or Cu LH LV426989 3
Cu Lugs for Use with BD BG BJ 15-125 A (1) 14-1/0 AWG Cu LC LV426986 2
Cu Wire Only BD BG BJ 15-125 A (1) 14-1/0 AWG Cu LC LV426987 3
BD BG BJ (1P) 15 - 125 A (1) 14-3/0 AWG Cu — LV426972 1
BD BG BJ (2P) 15 - 125 A (1) 14-3/0 AWG Cu — — —
EverLink Lug
BD BG BJ (3P) 15 - 125 A (1) 14-3/0 AWG Cu — — —
BD BG BJ (4P) 15 - 125 A (1) 14-3/0 AWG Cu — — —
15 - 125 A BD BG BJ (2P) (1) 14-3/0 AWG Cu LU, LV, or LW [18] LV426973 1
EverLink Lug with BD BG BJ (3P) (1) 14-3/0 AWG Cu LU, LV, or LW [18]
15 - 125 A LV426974 1
Control Wire Terminal
15 - 125 A BD BG BJ (4P) (1) 14-3/0 AWG Cu LU, LV, or LW [18] LV426975 1

Table 7.109: Mechanical Lug Kits for H- and J-Frame Circuit Breakers [17]
Circuit Breaker Application Number of Wires Qty Per
Description Ampere Rating Per Lug and Wire Range Kit Cat. No.
Standard Ampere Rating Optional Kit
HD, HG, HJ, HL 15–150 A (1) 14–3/0 AWG Al or Cu AL150HD 3
Al Lugs for Use with JD, JG, JJ, JL (1) 4-4/0 AWG Al or Cu
150–175 A AL175JD 3
Al or Cu Wire
JD, JG, JJ, JL 200–250 A JD,JG,JJ,JL 150–175 A (1) 3/0–350 kcmil Al or Cu AL250JD 3
Cu Lugs for Use with HD,HG,HJ,HL 15–150 A (1) 14–2/0 AWG Cu CU150HD 3
Cu Wire Only JD,JG,JJ,JL 150–250 A (1) 1/0–300 kcmil Cu CU250JD 3
Control Wire Terminal for H-frame lug kit S37423 2
Control Wire Terminal for J-frame lug kit S37424 2

Table 7.110: Mechanical Lug Kits for L-Frame Circuit Breakers [19]
Circuit Breaker Application Qty
Descrip- Number of Wires
Ampere Unit Per Lug and Wire Range Kit Cat. No. Per
tion Poles I-Line Kit
Rating Mount
250 3 X X (1) 2 AWG–500 kcmil Al AL400L61K3 3
4 X — (1) 2 AWG–600 kcmil Cu AL400L61K4 4
Al Lugs for
Use with Al 400/600 3 X — AL600LS52K3 3
(2) 2/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
or Cu Wire 4 X — AL600LS52K4 4
400/600 3 X X (2) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu AL600LF52K3 3
250 3 X X CU400L61K3 3
Cu Lugs for (1) 2 AWG–600 kcmil Cu
4 X — CU400L61K4 4
Use with 400/600 3 X — CU600LS52K3 3
J-Frame Lug L-Frame Lug Cu Wire (2) 2/0 AWG–500 kcmil Cu
Only 4 X — CU600LS52K4 4
400/600 3 X X (2) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Cu CU600LF52K3 3

Table 7.111: Mechanical Lug Kits for M-, P- and R-Frame Circuit Breakers [20]
Descrip- Circuit Breaker Application Wires per Lug Lugs
and Wire Range Cat. No. Per
tion Standard Rating Optional Rating Kit
AL800M23K 3
800 A — 800 A (3) 3/0 AWG-500 kcmil
AL800M23K4 4
MG, MJ, PG, (4) 3/0 AWG-500 kcmil AL1200P24K [21]
1200 A PJ, PK, PL 800 A 1
M-Frame, AL800P6K [21] 3
P-Frame MG, MJ, PG, (2) 3/0 AWG-600 kcmil
— PJ, PK, PL 800 A
AL800P6K4 [21] 4
M- and P-Frame Lugs
(800 A and below) (2) 3/0 AWG-750 kcmil AL800P7K [21] 3
MG, MJ, PG, 750 kcmil: compact AL
— PJ, PK, PL 800 A
only AL800P7K4 [21] 4
Al Lugs
for AL or PG, PJ, PK, AL1200P25K [22] 3
Cu Wire 1200 A 800 A (4) 3/0 AWG-500 kcmil
PL AL1200P25K4 [22] 4
P-Frame
PG, PJ, PK, 800– AL1200P6KU [22] 3
— (3) 350-600 kcmil
PL 1200 A AL1200P6KU4 [22] 4
(3) 3/0 AWG-750 kcmil AL1200P7KU [22] 3
PG,PJ,PL PG, PJ, PK, 1200 A 750 kcmil: compact AL

PL only AL1200P7KU4 [22] 4
1200 A I-Line — (4) 3/0 AWG-600 kcmil AL1200R53K 1
R-Frame
2500 A Unit Mount — (1) 3/0 AWG-750 kcmil AL2500RK [23] 2
100– (1) 1-1/0 AWG CU250P1K [25]
— PJ 3
150 A
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

M-Frame, MG, MJ, PG, CU800M23K 3


800 A — (3) 3/0 AWG-500 kcmil
Cu Lugs P-Frame PJ, PK, PL CU800M23K4 4
for Cu MG, MJ, PG, 800–
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

Wire 1200 A (4) 3/0 AWG-500 kcmil CU1200P24K [21] 1


PJ, PK, PL 1200 A
P-Frame Lugs Only[24]
(Above 800 A) PG, PJ, PK, 800– CU1200P25K [22] 3
P-Frame 1200 A (4) 3/0 AWG-500 kcmil
PL 1200 A CU1200P25K4 4
R-Frame 1200 A I-Line — (4) 3/0 AWG-500 kcmil CU1200R53K 1

[17] For terminal nuts/bus bar connections see page 7-62.


[18] LU = ON end only, LV = OFF end only, LW = BOTH ends
[19] Lug kits for Legacy L-frame circuit breakers can be found in Supplemental Digest Section 11 (i.e. LA, LH circuit breakers).
[20] For lug with a tapped hole for control wire, add a “T” before the “K” in the catalog number (for example, AL800P6TK).
[21] Does not fit onto ON end of unit-mount P-frame circuit breakers.
[22] For unit-mount circuit breaker only.
[23] All unit-mount R-frame circuit breakers require terminal pads for mounting lugs of any type. See page 7-62.
[24] Not available with tapped hole for control wire.
[25] This lug can only be used on low amp PJ frame breakers where the Instantaneous setting must not be turned OFF. The cables must be laced with rope per lug instructions.
7

7-59
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories Compression Lugs and Power Distribution
Connectors (PDC)
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101 schneider-electric.us

Compression Lugs

P-Frame R-Frame
Compression Lug Kit Compression Lug Kit
J-Frame
Compression Lug

Table 7.112: Compression Lug Kits for PowerPact™ Circuit Breakers


Circuit Breaker Ampere Mounting Dimension A Max. Lugs per Qty.
Description Type Rating System Range Type (in) Cat. No.
Terminal Per Kit
Compression Lug Kits for B-Frame Circuit Breakers
Aluminum Compression 125 A 8-1/0 AWG Al or Cu 1.3 1 LV426988 2
Lug Kits B-frame
125 A 8-1/0 AWG Al or Cu 1.3 1 LV426989 3
Unit
Copper Compression 125 A 6-1/0 AWG Cu 1.4 1 LV426986 2
Lug Kits B-frame
125 A 6-1/0 AWG Cu 1.4 1 LV426987 3
Compression Lug Kits for H-Frame and J-Frame Circuit Breakers
60 A 6–2 AWG Al or Cu 1.2 1 YA060HD 3
H-frame
Aluminum Compression 150 A 1/0–4/0 AWG Al or Cu 2.5 1 YA150HD 3
Lug Kits 150 A 1–3/0 AWG Al or Cu 1.2 1 YA150JD 3
J-frame
250 A 3/0–350 kcmil Al or Cu 2.5 1 YA250J35 3
Unit/I-line [26]
60 A 6–1/0 AWG Cu 1.0 1 CYA060HD 3
H-frame
Copper Compression 150 A 4–2/0 AWG Cu 1.2 1 CYA150HD 3
Lug Kits 150 A 6–1/0 AWG Cu 0.7 1 CYA150JD 3
J-frame
250 A 2/0–300 kcmil Cu 1.1 1 CYA250J3 3
Compression Lug Kits for L-Frame Circuit Breakers
250 A 4-300 kcmil Al/Cu 1.2 1 YA400L31K3 3
400 A 4-300 kcmil Al/Cu 2.5 2 YA600L32K3 6
250 A 2/0-500 kcmil Al/Cu 1 YA400L51K3 3
600 A 2/0-500 kcmil Al/Cu 2 YA600L52K3 6
500-750 kcmil Al
400 A 1 YA400L71K3 3
Aluminum Compression 500 kcmil Cu
Lug Kits L-frame Unit/I-line [26]
250 A 4-300 kcmil Al/Cu 1 YA400L31K4 4
400 A 4-300 kcmil Al/Cu 2 YA600L32K4 8
250 A 2/0-500 kcmil Al/Cu 1 YA400L51K4 4
600 A 2/0-500 kcmil Al/Cu 1.2 2 YA600L52K4 8
400 A 500-750 kcmil Al 2.5 1 YA400L71K4 4
500 kcmil Cu
250 A 2/0-300 kcmil Cu 1.2 1 CYA400L31K3 3
400 A 2/0-300 kcmil Cu 2.5 2 CYA600L32K3 6
250 A 250-500 kcmil Cu 1 CYA400L51K3 3
Copper Compression 600 A 250-500 kcmil Cu 2 CYA600L52K3 6
Lug Kits L-frame Unit/I-line [26]
250 A 2/0-300 kcmil Cu 1 CYA400L31K4 4
400 A 2/0-300 kcmil Cu 2 CYA600L32K4 8
250 A 250-500 kcmil Cu 1 CYA400L51K4 4
600 A 250-500 kcmil Cu 2 CYA600L52K4 8
Compression Lug Kits for M-Frame, P-Frame, and R-Frame Circuit Breakers
250 A 2/0-300 kcmil 3.7 1 YA250P3 1
300 A 4/0-500 kcmil 3.9 1 YA300P5 1
400 A 2/0-300 kcmil 4.3 2 YA400P3 1
M-, P-frame Unit/I-line [26]
400 A 500-750 kcmil 3.7 1 YA400P7 1
600 A 4/0-500 kcmil 3.9 2 YA600P5 1
Aluminum Compression 800 A 500-750 kcmil 4.3 2 YA800P7 1
Lug Kits 1200 A 2/0-300 kcmil 3.8 4 YA1200R3 1
1200 A 4/0-500 kcmil I-line [26] 4.0 4 YA1200R5 1
1200 A 500-750 kcmil 4.4 4 YA1200R7 1
R-frame[27] —[27]
2000 A 2/0-300 kcmil 8 YA2000R3 2
2000 A 4/0-500 kcmil Unit [26] —[27] 8 YA2000R5 2
2500 A 500-750 kcmil —[27] 8 [28] YA2500R7 1
400 A 4/0-500 kcmil 3.3 1 CYA400P5 1
M-, P-frame 600 A 4/0-500 kcmil Unit [26] 3.3 2 CYA600P5 1
Copper Compression
Lug Kits 800 A 500-750 kcmil 3.6 2 CYA800P7 1
1200 A 4/0-500 kcmil 3.5 4 CYA1200R5 1
R-frame I-Line [26]
1200 A 500-750 kcmil 3.8 4 CYA1200R7 1
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[26] Not for use on I-Line™ circuit breakers unless wire bending space is adequate.
[27] All unit-mount R-frame circuit breakers require terminal pads for mounting lugs of any type. See page 7-62.
[28] 9 lugs for 3000 A circuit breakers
7-60
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Compression Lugs and Power Distribution PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories
Connectors (PDC)
schneider-electric.us Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
Power Distribution Connectors
Table 7.113: Power Distribution Connectors for B-Frame, H-Frame, J-Frame and L-
Frame Circuit Breakers [29]
Use with Qty.
Ampere (Wires Per Terminal) Dimension A
Circuit Breaker Rating Wire Range (in.) Cat. No. Per
Type Kit
PDC6HD6 PDC6JD4 125 A (3) 14 - 2 AWG 1.2 PDC3BD2 3
BD, BG, BJ
125 A (6) 14 - 6 AWG 1 PDC6BD6 3
HD, HG, HJ, HL 15–150 A (6) 14–6 AWG Cu 1.0 PDC6HD6 3
[30] 15–150 A (3) 14–2 AWG Cu 1.2 PDC3HD2 3
JD, JG, JJ, JL 150–250 A (6) 14–4 AWG Cu 1.0 PDC6JD4 3
PDC3HD2 PDC3JD20 [30] 150–250 A (2) 14–1 AWG and (1) 3–2/0 AWG Cu 1.5 PDC3JD20 3
LD, LG, LJ, LL 150–600 A (3) 14–1 AWG and (2) 3–2/0 AWG 1.28 PDC5DG20L3 3
[31] 150–600 A (12) 14–4 AWG 1.31 PDC12DG4L3 3

Table 7.114: Power Distribution Connectors for M-Frame and P-Frame Circuit
Breakers [29]
Ampere (Wires Per Terminal) Qty
Rating Wire Range Cat. No. Per
Kit
Use for multiple load connections on one circuit (6) 12–2/0 AWG Cu PDC6P20 3
breaker in place of standard distribution block to 250–1200 A
(6) 12–2/0 AWG Cu PDC6P204 4
PDC12P4 PDC6P20 save space and time.
• Use on load end of circuit breaker only PDC12P4 3
Crimp lugs or PDC connectors extension “A” past end of circuit • Use in UL508 Industrial Control applications only.
breaker • Use in UL1995/CSA C22.2 No. 236 heating and 250–1200 A (12) 10–4 AWG Cu
cooling equipment. PDC12P44 4
“A” See Ta ble • For Cu wire only.

Molded Case
w/Mechanical
Lugs

“A” See Ta ble

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[29] Not for use with I-Line™ circuit breakers.


[30] Special Purpose—Not for General Use. Use on ON end of the circuit breaker only when ON end is used as Load end. Use on OFF end of the circuit breaker only when OFF end is used as
Load end.
[31] Kit includes long terminal shield and cover, which adds 1.65 inches to standard lug with short terminal shield.
7

7-61
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories Terminal Nuts, Terminal Pads, Terminal
Shields and Accessories
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101 schneider-electric.us

Terminal Accessories
Table 7.115: Terminal Nuts for Bus Bar Connection of B-, H- and J-Frame Circuit
Breakers
Description Tap Qty Per
Frame Cat. No.
Kit
B-Frame Terminal Nut Insert-Metric BD/BG/BJ (2P) M6 LV426962 2
B-Frame Terminal Nut Insert-Metric BD/BG/BJ (3P) M6 LV426963 3
H-Frame Terminal Nut Insert–English HD/HG/HJ/HL 1/4-20 S37425 2
H-Frame Terminal Nut Insert–English HD/HG/HJ/HL 1/4-20 S37444 3
H-Frame Terminal Nut Insert–Metric HD/HG/HJ/HL M6 S37426 2
J-Frame Terminal Nut Insert–English JD/JG/JJ/JL 1/4-20 S37427 2
J-Frame Terminal Nut Insert–English JD/JG/JJ/JL 1/4-20 S37445 3
J-Frame Terminal Nut Insert–Metric JD/JG/JJ/JL M8 S37428 2
Control Wire Terminal for H-Frame Terminal Nut HD/HG/HJ/HL S37429 2
H-Frame Lug with Control Wire Terminal for J-Frame Terminal Nut JD/JG/JJ/JL S37430 2
Terminal Nut Insert

Table 7.116: Bus Bar Connections Hardware for L-, M-, and P-Frame Circuit
Breakers
Frame Description Term. No. Poles Cat. No.
L-Frame Set of 4 terminal screws and washers for one side F 4 S36967
M- and P-Frame Bus Connector Kit for one pole, one end 1 S33928

Table 7.117: Terminal Pad Kits for R-Frame Circuit Breakers


Terminal Pad Kit Field-Installable Kits
Terminal Nut Insert R-Frame Lugs 3P Kit (One 4P Kit (One
Circuit Breaker Usage per End Only) End Only)
Phase Cat. No. Cat. No.
3000 A, 100% Rated Required for cable or bus 9 RL3TB RL3TB4
3000 A, Standard (80% Rated) Required for cable or bus
2500 A, 100% Rated Required for cable or bus
8 RLTB RLTB4
2500 A, Standard (80% Rated) Required for cable, optional for bus
All Other R-Frame Circuit Breakers Required for cable, optional for bus
For cable connection to RLTB, use AL2500RK lug. See page 7-60.

RLTB Terminal Pad Kit


Table 7.118: Terminal Shields and Phase Barriers
Dimension B Qty Per
Used With Description (in.) Cat. No.
Kit
Frame Max. Wire Size
H- and J-Frame H-Frame 60 A 3 AWG 0.50 S37446 1
Mechanical Short Lug
Lugs Shield[32] H-Frame 150 A 3/0 AWG 0.50 S37447 1
J-Frame 350 kcmil 0.24 S37448 1
Compatible with:
Compression Lugs
PDC
Aluminum Copper
H-Frame Short J-Frame Short PDC3BD2 LV426988 LV426986
Lug Shield Lug Shield LV426911
B-, H- and J- (2P)
Phase barrier or terminal Frame Power B-Frame Long
PDC6BD6 LV426989 LV426987 1.9
LV426912
1
shield extension past end Distribution Lug Shield (3P)
Connectors and LV426913
of circuit breaker Compression (4P)
Lugs CY-
PDC6HD6 YA060HD
H-Frame Long A060HD
Lug Shield 2.24 S37449 1
PDC3HD2 YA150HD CY-
A150HD
J-Frame Long PDC6JD4 YA150JD CYA150JD
Lug Shield 1.68 S37450 1
PDC3JD2 [33] CYA250J3
3P Short Terminal Shield LTSS3P 1
3P Medium Terminal Shield LTSM3P 1
L-Frame 3P Long Terminal Shield LTSL3P 1
4P Medium Terminal Shield LTSM4P 1
“B” See Ta ble 4P Long Terminal Shield LTSL4P 1
M-, P-Frame S33646
Phase Barriers 3
R-Frame S33998

Table 7.119: Miscellaneous H-, J-, and L-Frame Circuit Breaker Accessories
Molded Case Field-Installable
w/Mechanical Accessory Description
Cat. No.
Lugs Bag of screws for accessory cover, L-frame S432552
Spare Parts 1 spare toggle extension, L-frame 32595
Set of 10 identification labels LV429226
“B” See Ta ble

R-Frame
Phase Barrier

[32] Short lug shields provide IP20 protection for mechanical lugs and are compatible with control wire terminals.
[33] J-frame terminal shield is not compatible with the YA250J35 compression terminal.
7-62
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Plug-In and Drawout Mountings PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories
Class 611, 612 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001,0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us

Mountings
Table 7.120: Plug-In and Drawout Mountings for H- and J-Frame Circuit Breakers
(3P or 2P in a 3P module)
Factory Field-
Description Installed Installable
Cat. No. Cat. No.
Complete Factory- Plug-in base shipped with circuit breaker N
Assembled Circuit Breakers Drawout cradle shipped with circuit breaker D
Circuit breaker Only HJ00
Plug-In Base
Plug-in base kit S29278
Special Order Options for Circuit breaker only HJ00
Plug-In and Drawout Circuit Plug-in base kit S29278
H- and J-Frame H- and J-Frame Breakers Drawout
Cradle Cradle side plates (fixed part of chassis) S29282
Plug-In Mounting Drawout Mounting
Circuit breaker side plates (moving part
of chassis) S29283
H-Frame Shutter Kit (set of two) S37442
J-Frame Shutter Kit (set of two) S37443
Fixed part 9-wire connector (mounted on
base) S29273
Secondary
Disconnect Moving part 9-wire connector (mounted
Blocks on circuit breaker) S29274
Accessories for Plug-In and
Drawout Support for 2-moving connectors S29275
Extended escutcheon with extended toggle handle S29284
Two position indicating switches (connected/
disconnected) S29287
H-Frame Short Terminal Cover (3P S37436
J-Frame Short Terminal Cover (3P) S37440

Table 7.121: Plug-In and Drawout Mountings for L-Frame Circuit Breakers
Plug-in Mounting Drawout Mounting
Description Poles Factory- Field- Factory- Field-
Installed Installed Installed Installable
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
3 N D
Kit (stationary and moving parts)
4 N D
3 S32514 S32514
Plug-in base
Stationary Part 4 S32515 S32515
Fixed part of chassis S32532
Circuit breaker only HJ00 HJ00
Moving part of chassis S32533
L-Frame L-Frame Moving Part
3 2x S32562 2x S32562
Plug-In Mounting Drawout Mounting Short terminal covers
4 2x S32563 2x S32563

Table 7.122: Plug-In and Drawout Accessories for L-Frame Circuit Breakers
Field-
Description Installable
Cat. No.
Fixed Part 9-wire connector S29273
9-wire connector S32523
Secondary Disconnecting Blocks Moving Part
Support for 3 moving connectors S32525
Fixed + Moving 9-wire manual auxiliary connector S29272
Shutters Two shutters for plug-in base 32521
Extended escutcheon for toggle S32534
L-Frame Locking Device Chassis Accessories Locking device (key lock is not included) S29286
L-Frame Disconnecting Blocks Two position indicating switches (connected/disconnected) 29287

Table 7.123: Termination Options Table 7.124: Drawout Cradle and Accessories for P-Frame Circuit Breakers
Description Cat. No.
Termination Letter Termination No. Product
N = Plug-in LGL36400U31X Drawout Cradle
Selector
For factory-installed termination, place Front Connected Flat (FCF) SFCF12 [34]
termination letter in the third block of the Cradle
D = Drawout Connectors
circuit breaker catalog number. Rear Connected T Horizontal/Vertical (RCTH/RCTV) SRCTV12 [34]
Modbus™ cradle communication module S33852
Safety shutters S48933
Secondary disconnects terminal shield S33763
Cradle position switch 1a/1b Form C— Connected/test/disconnected S33170
Low level cradle position switch 1a/1b Form C—Connected/test/disconnected S33171
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

Cell keying kit S33767


Disconnected position key locking—provision for Kirk or Federal Pioneer Lock S33772
Cradle
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

Door interlock kit S33786


Accessories
Racking interior kit S33788
Door escutcheon (for replacement only, included with circuit breaker) S33857
Transparent cover S33859
Push-in terminal kit (3 wires) S33098
Push-in terminal kit (6 wires) S33099
Finger cluster S33166
Cluster grease (12 oz. tube) S48899

P-Frame Drawout Cradle Connections

[34] Needs 2 kits per cradle.


7

7-63
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories Plug-In and Drawout Mountings
Class 611, 612 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001,0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

7-64
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact H-, J-, and L-Frame Trip Units Micrologic™ Electronic Trip Units
Class 611 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001
schneider-electric.us

Micrologic Trip Units [1]


Micrologic Standard 3.2/3.3 Trip Units
PowerPact H-, J-, and L-Frame Micrologic Trip Units PowerPact™ H-, J-, and L-frame molded case circuit breakers may be specified with any
of the following Micrologic Electronic Trip Units.
• True RMS sensing
• LI, LSI trip configurations
• Field-interchangeable trip units
• LED long-time pickup and trip indication
• Test kits available
• Thermal imaging
Micrologic Ammeter 5.2A/5.3A/6.2A/6.3A Trip Units
Micrologic Ammeter and
Micrologic Standard Trip Unit Energy Trip Unit Includes all features listed for Micrologic standard trip unit, as well as:
• Advanced user interface
• Neutral protection
• Incremental fine tuning of settings
• Up to 12 alarms
• Digital ammeter—phase and neutral (4-pole only)
• Phase loading bar graph
• Maintenance indicators including contact wear, number of operations, operating hours,
and load profiles
• Cause of trip information for troubleshooting assistance
• LCD Display
• Zone-selective interlocking (ZSI) (short-time & ground-fault)
• Optional Modbus™ communications—PowerLogic™ compatible
Micrologic Energy 5.2E/5.3E/6.2E/6.3E Trip Units
Includes all features listed for Micrologic ammeter trip unit, as well as:
• Ground-fault trip with programmable ground fault alarm (available on 6.2E/6.3E only)
• Power and energy measurement
• Power quality measurements
• Current demand and power demand measurements
Table 7.125: Micrologic Trip Unit Settings for H- and J-Frame
Model Trip Function Trip Unit Ampere Setting
15-20-25-30-35-40-45-50-60
35-40-45-50-60-70-80-90-100
LI 3.2
50-60-70-80-90-100-110-125-150
70-80-100-125-150-175-200-225-250
Standard
15-20-25-30-35-40-45-50-60
35-40-45-50-60-70-80-90-100
LSI 3.2S
50-60-70-80-90-100-110-125-150
70-80-100-125-150-175-200-225-250
15–60
35–100
LSI 5.2A
50–150
70–250
Ammeter
15–60
35–100
LSIG 6.2A
50–150
70–250
15–60
35–100
LSI 5.2E
50–150
70–250
Energy
15–60
35–100
LSIG 6.2E
50–150
70–250

Table 7.126: Micrologic Trip Unit Settings for L-Frame


Model Trip Function Trip Unit Ampere Setting
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

70-80-100-125-150-175-200-225-250
LI 3.3 125-150-175-200-225-250-300-350-400
200-225-250-300-350-400-450-500-600
Standard
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

70-80-100-125-150-175-200-225-250
LSI 3.3S 125-150-175-200-225-250-300-350-400
200-225-250-300-350-400-450-500-600
125–400
LSI 5.3A
200–600
Ammeter
125–400
LSIG 6.3A
200–600
125–400
LSI 5.3E
200–600
Energy
125–400
LSIG 6.3E
200–600

[1] See Supplemental Digest Section 3 for circuit breakers with field-interchangeable trip units.
7

7-65
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Micrologic™ Electronic Trip Units PowerPact H-, J-, and L-Frame Trip Units
Class 611 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001
schneider-electric.us

Table 7.127: Micrologic Trip Units [2] for PowerPact H-, J-, and L-Frame Circuit
Breakers
x– Standard Feature o – Available Option
Standard Ammeter Energy
Features
3.2/3/3 3.2S/3.3S 5.2A/5.3A 6.2A/6.3A 5.2E/5.3E 6.2E/6.3E
LI x
LSI [3] x x x
LSIG / Ground-Fault Trip[4] x x
Ground-Fault Alarm/Trip[4] x x
Current Setting Directly in Amperes x x x x x x
True RMS Sensing x x x x x x
UL Listed x x x x x x
Thermal Imaging x x x x x x
LED for Long-time Pickup x x x x x x
LED for Trip Indication x x x x x x
LED for Green “Ready” x x x x x x
Up to 12 Alarms Used Together x x x x
Digital Ammeter x x x x
Zone-selective Interlocking [5] x x x x
Communications o o o o o o
LCD Display x x x x
Front Display Module FDM121 o o o o
Advanced User Interface x x x x
Neutral Protection[4] x x x x
Contact Wear Indication [6] x x x x
Incremental Fine Tuning of Settings x x x x
Load Profile [6],[7] x x x x
Power Measurement x x
Power Quality Measurements x x
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[2] DC not available with electronic trip units.


[3] The LSI with 3.2S/3.3S trip units have fixed short time and long time delays.
[4] Requires neutral current transformer on the three-phase four-wire loads.
[5] ZSI for H/J frames in only OUT. for L-frame ZSI is In and OUT.
[6] Indication available using the communication system only.
[7] % of hours in 4 current ranges: 0–49%, 50–79%, 80–89%, and >90% In.
7-66
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact P- and R-Frame Trip Units Micrologic™ Electronic Trip Units
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us

PowerPact P- and R-Frame Micrologic Trip Units

Micrologic (Standard) 3.0 and 5.0 Trip Units


PowerPact P- and R-Frame Micrologic Trip Units
PowerPact™ P- and R-frame molded case circuit breakers may be specified with any of
the following Micrologic Electronic Trip Units.
• True RMS sensing
• LI, LSI trip configurations
• Field-interchangeable long-time rating plugs
• LED long-time pickup indication
• Test kits available
• Thermal imaging
Micrologic (Ammeter) 3.0A, 5.0A and 6.0A Trip Units
Includes all features listed for Micrologic standard trip unit, as well as:
Standard Ammeter Power Harmonic Adjustable
Trip Unit Trip Unit Trip Unit Trip Unit Rating Plug • LSIG trip configurations
• Digital ammeter—phase and neutral (4-pole only)
• Phase loading bar graph
• LED trip indication
• Zone-selective interlocking (ZSI) (short-time & ground-fault)
• Optional Modbus™ communications—PowerLogic™ compatible
Micrologic (Power) 5.0P and 6.0P Trip Units
Power measurement and advanced protection features includes all features listed for
Micrologic ammeter trip unit, as well as:
• LSI trip configuration with programmable ground fault alarm
• LSIG (Ground-fault trip) with programmable ground fault alarm
• Incremental “fine tuning” of L, S, I, and G pickup and delay settings
• LCD dot matrix display and LED trip indication
• Advanced user interface
• Advanced protection IDMTL—selectable long-time delay bands
• Neutral protection
• Power measurement
• Contact wear indication
• Modbus communications—PowerLogic compatible
• Local and remote settings
Micrologic (Harmonic) 5.0H and 6.0H Trip Units
Power quality measurement and advanced protection features. Includes all features
listed for the Micrologic power trip unit, as well as:
• Enhanced power measurements functions
• Power quality measurements
Adjustable Rating Plugs for PowerPact™ P-Frame and R-Frame and Masterpact™
NT and NW Circuit Breakers—Selection
To provide maximum design flexibility, system protection, and field upgradeability, each
Micrologic™ trip unit is equipped with an interchangeable long-time rating plug. Each trip
unit requires an adjustable rating plug to determine the long-time pickup range of the
circuit breaker. These plugs are factory installed on new trip units, or can be ordered
separately for field-installable upgrades.
Adjustable rating plugs are offered in eight different ranges of long-time pickup
adjustments. The following chart show the ranges of adjustments. Each adjustment
times the sensor rating (lr x In) of the circuit breaker sets the long-time pickup value of
the circuit breaker.
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
7 CIRCUIT BREAKERS

7-67
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Micrologic™ Electronic Trip Units PowerPact P- and R-Frame Trip Units
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us

Table 7.128: Micrologic Trip Unit and Options


Field-Installable Cat.
Model Protection Additional Features No.[8]
2.0 (IEC only) LSO S132R
3.0 (UL/ANSI only) LI None S131A
5.0 LSI S133A
2.0A (IEC only) LSO S142R [9]
3.0A (UL/ANSI only) LI S141A [9]
Ammeter
5.0A LSI S143A [9]
6.0A LSIG S144A [9]
5.0P LSI S163A [9][10]
Metering, Adv. Protection
6.0P LSIG S164A [9][10]
5.0H LSI Metering, Adv. Protection & S173A [9][10]
6.0H LSIG Harmonic Analysis S174A [9][10]

Table 7.129: Micrologic Trip Units


x– Standard Feature o – Available Option
Standard Ammeter Power Harmonic
Features
3.0 5.0 3.0A 5.0A 6.0A 5.0P 6.0P 5.0H 6.0H
LI x x
LSI (Instantaneous can be turned off) x x x x x x x
LSIG / Ground-Fault Trip[11] x x x
Ground-Fault Alarm (No Trip)[11][12] x x
Ground-Fault Alarm and Trip[11][12] x x
Adjustable Rating Plugs x x x x x x x x x
True RMS Sensing x x x x x x x x x
UL Listed x x x x x x x x x
Thermal Imaging x x x x x x x x x
Phase Loading Bar Graph x x x x x x x
LED for Long-time Pickup x x x x x x x x x
LED for Trip Indication x x x x x x x
Digital Ammeter x x x x x x x
Zone-selective Interlocking x x x x x x x
Communications o o o x x x x
LCD Dot Matrix Display x x x x
Advanced User Interface x x x x
Protective Relay Functions x x x x
Neutral Protection x x x x
Contact Wear Indication x x x x
Incremental Fine Tuning of Settings x x x x
Selectable Long-time Delay Bands x x x x
Power Measurement x x x x
Power Quality Measurements x x
Waveform Capture x x

Table 7.130: Long-Time Pickup Settings


Rating Plug Long-time Pickup Settings
A .40 .45 .50 .60 .63 .70 .80 .90 1.0
B .40 .44 .50 .56 .63 .75 .88 .95 1.0
C .42 .50 .53 .58 .67 .75 .83 .95 1.0
D .40 .48 .64 .70 .80 .90 .93 .95 1.0
E .60 .70 .75 .80 .85 .90 .93 .95 1.0
F .84 .86 .88 .90 .92 .94 .96 .98 1.0
G .66 .68 .70 .72 .74 .76 .78 .80 .82
H .48 .50 .52 .54 .56 .58 .60 .62 .64

Table 7.131: Special Options


Description Factory-Installed Suffix Field-Installable
Cat. No.
Ship circuit breaker in closed position YK N/A
CT Characterization (Calibrated trip system) Q N/A
Alternate Maintenenace Setting (AMS) kit
(use with 5.0/6.0 A, P or H and 5.3/6.3 A or E — 84957
Micrologic trip units)
Energy Reduction Maintenenace Setting
(ERMS) kit — 84956
7

(use with 5.0/6.0 P or H Micrologic trip units)


MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[8] The standard rating plug supplied with a trip unit will be the “A” rating plug. To specify an alternative adjustable rating plug, please add the letter designation to the end of the catalog number.
Please refer to page 7-69for a complete listing of adjustable settings available with each plug. (Example: S143B would specify a “B” rating plug instead of the standard "A" plug.) Use suffix
“N” if no rating plug is required, deduct.
[9] When replacing a standard trip unit with Type A (Ammeter), P (Power metering) or H (Harmonic analysis) trip unit, order the 12-pin connector kit S33101 for the Masterpact NW and NT and
the PowerPact P-frame drawout circuit breakers or kit S33100 for PowerPact P-frame and R-frame unit-mount and I-Line circuit breakers. See page 7-69.
[10] Requires Circuit Breaker Communications Module.
[11] Requires neutral current transformer in 3Ø4W systems.
[12] Alarm history is available through the trip unit display and communications. Local indication of an alarm requires an M2C or M6C Programmable Contact Module.
7-68
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Micrologic™ Trip Unit Accessories Micrologic™ Electronic Trip Units
Class 612, 612 / Refer to Catalogs 0611CT1001 and 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us

Trip Unit Accessories


Adjustable rating plug "A" is installed as standard on all Micrologic trip unit orders.
However, an alternative selection may be specified from the "Assembled" table below,
and factory installed with your trip unit order at no additional charge. To order, please
attach the appropriate catalog suffix to the end of the trip unit Cat. No. (after specifying
trip unit options). Adjustable rating plugs may also be purchased as field-installable
components from the table below.
Trip Unit Seal
Table 7.134: Trip Unit Accessories
Device Frame Cat. No.
Pocket Tester S434206
UTA Tester STRV00910
Spare UTA Tester STRV00911
Sensor Plug Bluetooth/Modbus for UTA Tester H/J/L SVW3A8114
Full Function Test Kit Spare Power Supply for UTA Tester
110–120 Vac TRV00915
Table 7.132: Rating Plugs Micrologic Cord for UTA Tester TRV00917
Rating Plug Factory Installed Field-Installable Micrologic 5/6 Cover, Transparent S429478
[13] Cat. Suffix Cat. No. H/J
Micrologic 2/3 Cover, Transparent S429481
A A (standard) S48818 Micrologic 5/6 Cover, Transparent S432459
B B S48819 L
Micrologic 2/3 Cover, Transparent S432461
C C S48820 LCD Display for Micrologic 5 S429483
D D S48836 H/J/L
LCD Display for Micrologic 6 S429484
E E S48837
F F S48838 Hand-held Test Kit S33594
G G S48839 Primary Injection Test Adaptor S33937
H H S48840 Full-function Adapter Kit S48981
P/R
Full-function Test Kit S33595
Table 7.133: Neutral Current Transformers Seven-pin Test Cable (for connection between test kit and trip unit)[15] S48907
For Use with Two-pin Test Cable (for connection between test kit and trip unit)[16] S48908
Cat. No. Sensor
Circuit Breaker 230 Vac Filtered Power Cord[17] S48856
S429521 60–100
H-Frame 120 Vac Filtered Power Cord[17] P/R S48855
S430562 150
Trip Unit Battery for Trip Indicator Lights S33593
J-Frame S430563 250
L-Frame S432575 400–600 Power supply with:
S33575 [14] 250 24–30 Vdc input 685823
P-Frame 48/60 Vdc input
S33576 [14] 400–1600 685824
S48916 [14] 250 125 Vdc input H/J/L/P/R 685825
S34036 [14] 400–1600 110–130 Vac input 685826
R-Frame
S48896 [14] 2000 200–240 Vac input 685827
S48182 [14] 3000 380–415 Vac input 685829
All NCTWIRING All Micrologic A Trip Unit Cover, clear S33592
P/R
Micrologic P/H Trip Unit Cover, opaque gray S47067
Trip Unit Seal (6 pieces) for compliance with NEC 240.6(c) H/J/L/P/R MICROTUSEAL
12-pin Trip Unit Connector for NT/NW Masterpact Circuit Breakers S33101
12-pin Trip Unit Connector for P- and R-Frame Circuit Breakers P/R S33100
Battery Back-up (12 Hours) 685831

Table 7.135: Sensor Plugs for P- and R-Frame Circuit Breakers [18][19]
Circuit Sensor Plug Sensor Plug
Circuit Breaker Frames Accepting Sensor Plug
Breaker Range Catalog No.
P-Frame Circuit Breaker 250 A 400 As 600 As 630 A [20] 800 A 1000 A 1200 A 1250 A [20] 1600 A
250 A S47052 X
400 A S47053 X X X
600 A S48823 X X X X
UL
800 A S33092 X X X
1000 A S33093 X X
1200 A S48824 X
630 A S33091 X X X X X
800 A S33092 X X X X
IEC 1000 A S33093 X X X
1250 A S33094 X X
1600 A S33095 X
R-Frame Circuit Breaker 600 A 800 As 1000 As 1200 A 1600 A 2000 A 2500 A 3000 A 3200 A
600 A S48823 X X X X
800 A S33092 X X X X
1000 A S33093 X X X X
1200 A S48824 X X X X
UL
1600 A S33095 X X X X
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

2000 A S33982 X X X
2500 A S33983 X X
3000 A S48825 X
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

1600 A S33095 X X X X X
2000 A S33982 X X X X
IEC
2500 A S33983 X X X
3200 A S33984 X

[13] Long-time pickup amperes (Ir) = Sensor Rating (In) X Setting of rating plug. “Fine adjustment tuning” is included on Micrologic Power and Harmonic trip units, allowing for incremental
settings of 1 A between the plug setting and.40 X Sensor Rating.
[14] Includes NCTWIRING kit.
[15] Used for testing Micrologic trip units. Included in the price of the Hand-held/Full-function Test Kits. Kit for replacement only.
[16] Used for testing STR trip units. Included in the price of the Hand-held/Full-function Test Kits. Kit for replacement only.
[17] Included with the Full-function Test Kit. Kit for replacement only.
[18] For use only with circuit breakers with date codes later than 07011.
[19] See rating plug for long-time pickup range page 7-65.
[20] IEC Only.
7

7-69
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Micrologic™ Electronic Trip Units Micrologic™ Trip Unit Accessories
Class 612, 612 / Refer to Catalogs 0611CT1001 and 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us

Trip Unit Accessories


Table 7.136: Communication Modules, Display Screens, and Wiring Accessories
Description Field-Installable
Kit Cat. No.
IFM Modbus-SL Interface for LV Circuit Breaker STRV00210
Stacking Accessory (10 Stacking Accessories for IFM) TRV00217
IFE Interface (Ethernet Module) LV434010
IFE Interface + Gateway (Ethernet and ModbuGateway) LV434011
I/O Module (Input/Output ProgrammableModule) LV434063
Circuit Breaker ULP Cord–BCM to COMS L = 0.35 m (1.15 ft) LV434195
L = 1.3 m (4.27 ft) LV434196
L = 3 m (9.24 ft) LV434197
ULP Cable, 10 Cables (Male to Male RJ45) L = 0.3 m (0.98 ft) TRV00803
L = 0.6 m (1.97 ft) TRV00806
Modbus Interface Breaker Status and ULP Cable, 5 Cables (Male to Male RJ45) L = 1 m (3.28 ft) TRV00810
Module (IFM) Control Module (BSCM)
L = 2 m (6.56 ft) TRV00820
L = 3 m (9.84 ft) TRV00830
ULP Cable, 1 Cable (Male to Male RJ45) L = 5 m (16.40 ft) TRV00850
RJ45 Female/Female Connector, 10 Connectors TRV00870
ULP Line Terminator, 10 Terminators TRV00880
Insulated ULP Module and Circuit Breaker Cord L = 1 m (3.28 ft) S434204
(for System Voltage Greater than 480 Vac) (Cord with Female Socket) L = 3 m (9.84 ft) S434303
Two-Wire RS 485 Isolated Repeater Module STRV00211
Modbus Line Terminator, 2 Terminators VW3A8306DRC
FDM121 (1 Circuit Breaker to 1 Front Display) STRV00121
Surface-Mounting Accessory for FDM TRV00128
FDM128 (8 Circuit Breakers to 1 Front Display) LV434128

Front Display Module


(FDM)
NSX Cord for
Modbus Communications
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

7-70
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Masterpact™ NT/NW Circuit Breakers Masterpact™ Universal Power Circuit
Breakers
schneider-electric.us Class 613 / Refer to Catalog 0613CT0001
Table 7.137: Trip Unit Field-Installable Accessories, Wire Harness [21] and ULP
Cords for H-, J-, and L-Frame Circuit Breakers [22]
Description Factory-Installed Field-Installable
Cat. No. Suffix Kit Cat. No.
External Accessories
Isolated Modbus Repeater Module — STRV00211
ZSI Interface Module — S434212
Internal Accessories
NSX Cord [23] L = 1.3 m (4.27 ft) EA S434201
(for Modbus Communication) L = 3 m (9.84 ft) EB S434202
BSCM (Breaker Status and Control Module) with L = 1.3 m (4.27 ft) EG [24] S434201BS
NSX Cord [23] L = 3 m (9.84 ft) EH [24] S434202BS
ZSI Interface Module Replacement BSCM — S434205
(Connects PowerPact H/J/L L = 1.3 m (4.27 ft) EK [24] S434204BS
circuit breakers to BSCM with NSX Cord for V > 480 Vac [23]
L = 3 m (9.84 ft) EL [24] S434303BS
SDTAM Module PowerPact P/R and Masterpact
(Remote indication relay NT/NW 24 Vdc Terminal Block EN S434210
for motor applications) circuit breakers) SDTAM 24/415 Vac/dc Module [25] V S429424
SDX Module 24/415 Vac/dc [26] V S429532
ZSI Wire Harness, H/J Frame YH3 S434300
ZSI Wire Harness, L-Frame YH3 S434301
ENCT Wire Harness YH2 S434302
OF Wire Harness YH1 S434500
SD/SDE Wire Harness YH1 S434501
SDx/SDTAM Wire Harness YH1 S434502
MN Wire Harness YH1 S434503
MX Wire Harness YH1 S434504
24 Vdc Terminal Block Wire Harness [27] YH1 S434505
Motor Operator Wire Harness YH1 S434506
Communicating Motor Operator Wire Harness YH1 S434507
NSX Wire Harness [27] YH1 S434508
ENCT and ZSI Wire Harness YH4 —

Table 7.138: Trip Unit Field-Installable Accessories for P- and R-Frame Circuit Breakers
Factory- Field-Installable Kit Cat. No.
Installed P-Frame R-Frame
Description
Cat. No. Motor With Rotary
Suffix Unit Mount I-Line Operated Drawout Unit Mount I-Line
Handle
Circuit Breaker Communication Module (BCM) (Modbus) E1 S64205 S64205 S64207 S64206 S64205 S64205 S64205
Two Programmable Contacts Module (M2C) V S64273 S64273 S64273 S64273 S64273 S64273 S64273
Six Programmable Contacts Module (M6C) W S64204 S64204 S64204 S64202 S64204 S64201 S64201
External Voltage Sensing (EVS) YV S64203 S64203 S64210 S64209 S64210 S64208 S64208

Full-Featured Performance
The Masterpact universal power circuit breaker offers a family of circuit protection
products meeting the most common world standards, ANSI, UL and IEC. The basic
design platform for each is common. The final result is UL, ANSI and IEC circuit breakers
with the same basic external dimensions, features and accessories.
• Complete product offering up to 200 k AIR without fuses
• Circuit
NFPA70E
breakers tested to show arc flash hazard risk category as referenced by

• 800 A to 6000 A frames, fixed and draw-out


• Rated for AC voltage systems through 600 V (635 V ANSI)
• Short-time withstand ratings up to 100 kA
Masterpact NT Masterpact NW
• Cradle position indicator: connected, test and disconnected
• Simple, visual contact wear indicators
• Full complement of field-installable accessories common to all standards
• Four interchangeable Micrologic trip units to choose from
• Available PowerLogic™ based power metering and monitoring capabilities
• Available protective relay functions as defined by ANSI C37.2 and C37.90
The following charts show the Masterpact NW and NT ratings for ANSI and UL 489. See
Pricing Guide 0613PL0001 and Catalog 0613CT0001.
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[21] Wire harness is required for I-Line applications, optional for unit-mount applications
YH1 = all installed accessories but ZSI and ENCT
YH2 = ENCT and all installed accessories
YH3 = ZSI and all installed accessories
YH4 = ZSI, ENCT and all installed accessories
[22] For proper selection, see catalog 0611CT1001.
[23] Installation requires IFM (STRV00210) for Modbus communication and/or FDM (STRV00121) for external display.
[24] If using with motor operator requires communicating motor operator (suffix NC).
[25] Remote indication relay for motor applications
[26] Remote indication relay
[27] I-Line wire harness is included for communication network accessories.
Optional wire harness for unit mount requires YH1 suffix.
7

7-71
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Masterpact™ Universal Power Circuit Masterpact™ NT/NW Circuit Breakers
Breakers
Class 613 / Refer to Catalog 0613CT0001 schneider-electric.us

Table 7.139: Masterpact NW Circuit Breaker Ratings


ANSI C37 Certified/UL 1066 Listed UL 489 Listed
Standard 3200/4000 A [1] 2500/3000 4000/5000/
Frame Rating 800–1600 A 2000 A 4000/5000 A 800/1200/1600/2000 A
A 6000 A
Interrupting Code L1 L1F H- L1 L1F L1 L1 LF L
N1 H1 H2 H3 [2] [2] H2 H3 [2] [2] H1 H2 H3 [2] H2 H3 [2] N H L [2] [2] H [2] H L [2]
1
Interrupting 240 Vac 42 65 85 100 200 200 65 85 100 200 200 65 85 100 200 85 100 200 65 100 200 200 100 200 100 200
Current 480 Vac 42 65 85 100 200 200 65 85 100 200 200 65 85 100 200 85 100 200 65 100 150 150 100 150 100 150
(kA RMS)
50/60 Hz 600 Vac 42 65 85 85 130 130 65 85 85 130 130 65 85 85 130 85 85 130 50 85 100 100 85 100 85 100
Short-time Withstand 42 30[3]
Current (kA RMS) 42 65 85 85 30 22 65 85 85 30 22 65 85 85 100 85 85 100 65[3] 22 65 65 85 100
[3] [4]
Built-in Instantaneous
Override 35 35 35 35 35[3]
[5] [5] [5] 85 [5] 24 — — 85 35 24 — — 85 117 — — 117 40 40 [4] 24 65 65 75 75
(kA RMS ±10%)
Close and latch rating (kA
RMS) 42 65 40 40 25 22 65 40 40 25 22 65 40 40 40 85 75 40 40 40 25[6] 22 40 40 40 40
Tested to show arc flash
hazard risk category as — — — — — Yes — — — — Yes — — — — — — — — — — Yes — — — —
referenced by NFPA70E
Breaking time 25–30 ms with no intentional delay (9 ms for L1, L1F, L and LF)
Closing time 70 ms
100–250 A 2000–4000
100–250 A 400–800 A 1200–2500 A
Sensor Rating 2000–4000 A A 2500–5000
400–800 A 1000–2000 A 1600–3200 A 2500–5000 A 600–1200 A
800–1600 A 800–1600 A 1600–3000 A
1000–2000 A A 3000–6000
A
Endurance Mechanical 12,500 10,000 10,000 5k 5,000 12,500[7] 10,000 5,000
Rating (C/O
Cycles)
With No Electrical 2800 1,000 1,000 1k 1,000 2800[7] 1,000 1,000
Mainte-
nance
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[1] 4000 A standard width circuit breaker is not available in L1 interrupting rating code or drawout construction (fixed mounting only).
[2] Drawout mounted only.
[3] 24 kA RMS for 800 A circuit breaker frame with 100 A or 250 A sensor.
[4] 65 kA RMS for 2000 A.
[5] None except 24 kA RMS for 800 A circuit breaker frame with 100 A or 250 A sensor.
[6] 40 kA RMS for 2000 A.
[7] The endurance rating for 2000 A, N/H/L/LF is 10,000 for mechanical and 1000 for electrical.
7-72
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Masterpact™ NT/NW Circuit Breakers Masterpact™ Universal Power Circuit
Breakers
schneider-electric.us Class 613 / Refer to Catalog 0613CT0001
Table 7.140: Masterpact NT Circuit Breaker Ratings
ANSI C37 Certified/
Standard UL 1066 Listed UL 489 Listed
Frame Rating 1600 A [8]
Interrupting Code 800 A 800 A 1200 A
N1 N H L1 L LF [9] N H L1 L LF [9] N H L1 L
240 Vac 42 50 65 100 200 200 50 65 100 200 200 50 65 100 200
Interrupting Current
(kA RMS) 50/60 Hz 480 Vac 42 50 50 65 100 100 50 50 65 100 100 50 50 65 100
600 Vac — 35 50 — — — 35 50 — — — 35 50 N/A N/A
Short-time Withstand Current (kA RMS) 42 35 35 10 10 10 35 35 10 10 10 35 35 10 10
Built-in Instantaneous Override (kA RMS ±10%) — 40 40 10 10 10 40 40 10 10 10 40 40 10 10
Close and latch rating (kA RMS) 40 25 25 10 10 10 25 25 10 10 10 25 25 10 10
Tested to show the arc flash hazard risk
category as referenced by NFPA70E — — — — — Yes — — — — Yes — — — —
25–30 ms with no
Breaking time 25–30 ms with no intentional delay (9 ms for L and LF)
intentional delay
Closing time < 50 ms
100–250 A 100–250 A 600–1200 A
Sensor Rating 800–1600 A
400–800 A 400–800 A —
Endurance Rating (C/O Cycles) Mechanical 12,500 12,500 12,500 12,500
With No Maintenance Electrical 2800 2800 2800 2800

Table 7.141: Masterpact NW/NT Circuit Breaker Remote Racking


Description Cat. No.
Masterpact NW/NT Remote Racking Devices [10] NWNTMPRRT
Masterpact NW Remote Racking Device [10] NWMPRRT
Masterpact NT Remote Rackign Device [10] NTMPRRT
Mounting Bracket Kit for NW Remote Racking (contains 10 mounting brackets) [11] S47100
Mounting Bracket Kit for NT Remove Racking (contains 10 mounting brackets) [11] S47104
Control Unit for NW Remote Racking [11] S47101
30 ft Control Cable for NW Remote Racking [11] S47102
Drive Shaft for NW Remote Racking [11] S47103
Drive Shaft for NT Remote Racking [11] S47105
NWMPRR

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[8] Fixed mounted only.


[9] Drawout mounted only.
[10] Unit comes with 10 mounting brackets included.
[11] For replacement only.
7

7-73
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Ground-Fault Protection Vigirex™ Ground-Fault Relay System
Class 931, 840, 960
schneider-electric.us

Vigirex™ Ground-Fault Relay System


The Vigirex ground-fault relays, with associated sensors (current transformers), measure
the residual current in an electrical installation to detect levels which may be damaging.
When used for protection, they cause an associated circuit breaker or switch to interrupt
the supply of power to the protected system. They may also be used for monitoring only,
with output to an alarm. The product line includes fixed sensitivities from 30 mA to 1 A
and adjustable sensitivities up to 30 A.
The Vigirex relays may be easily mounted on DIN rail or may be panel mounted in a
meter cutout. Sensors for conductors range from a little more than an inch diameter
toroids, to large rectangular sensors measuring 6 x 18 inches. The compact size of the
relay and its sensor make it ideal for protection of OEM equipment as well as branch
circuits.
Table 7.142: Vigirex Ground-Fault Relays (UL 1053 Listed)
Model Delay Reset Control Voltage Sensitivity Cat. No.
DIN Rail Mounted
30 mA 56300
100 mA 56302
12–24 Vac/12–48 Vdc 300 mA 56305
500 mA 56306
1A 56307
30 mA 56320
100 mA 56322
RH10M Instantaneous Manual 110–130 Vac 300 mA 56325
500 mA 56326
1A 56327
30 mA 56330
100 mA 56332
220–240 Vac 300 mA 56335
500 mA 56336
1A 56337
RH99M Instantaneous 12–24 Vac/12–48 Vdc 56360
30 mA[1] or 300 mA
RH21M or 60 msec Manual 110–130 Vac (2 settings) 56362
(2 settings) 220–240 Vac 56363
12–24 Vac/12–48 Vdc 56370TD
Adjustable Manual 110–130 Vac Adjustable, 56372TD
(9 settings): 220–240 Vac 56373TD
(9 settings):
RH99M 0, 0.06, 0.15, 0.03[1], 0.1, 0.3, 0.5,
0.23, 0.31, 0.5, 12–24 Vac/12–48 Vdc 56390TD
Automatic 110–130 Vac 1, 3, 5, 10, 30 A 56392TD
0.8, 1.0, 4.5 sec
220–240 Vac 56393TD
Panel Mounted
30 mA 56400
100 mA 56402
12–24 Vac/12–48 Vdc 300 mA 56405
500 mA 56406
1 Amp 56407
30 mA 56420
100 mA 56422
RH99P RH10P Instantaneous Manual 110–130 Vac 300 mA 56425
500 mA 56426
1 Amp 56427
30 mA 56430
100 mA 56432
220–240 Vac 300 mA 56435
500 mA 56436
1A 56437
Instantaneous 12–24 Vac/12–48 Vdc 56460
30 mA[1] or 300 mA
RH21P or 60 msec Manual 110–130 Vac 56462
(2 settings)
(2 settings) 220–240 Vac 56463
12–24 Vac/12–48 Vdc 56470TD
Adjustable Manual 110–130 Vac 56472TD
Adjustable
(9 settings): 220–240 Vac (9 settings): 56473TD
RH99P 0, 0.06, 0.15,
12–24 Vac/12–48 Vdc 0.03[1], 0.1, 0.3, 0.5, 56490TD
0.23, 0.31, 0.5, 1, 3, 5, 10, 30 A
0.8, 1.0, 4.5 sec Automatic 110–130 Vac 56492TD
220–240 Vac 56493TD

Table 7.143: Sensors for Vigirex Ground-Fault Relays


Maximum Inside Diameter
Sensors Type Cat. No.
Current [2] in. mm
TA30 65 A 1.18 30 50437
PA50 85 A 1.97 50 50438
IA80 160 A 3.15 80 50439
Closed Toroids, Type A
MA120 250 A 4.72 120 50440
SA200 400 A 7.87 200 50441
GA300 630 A 11.81 300 50442
TA30 65 A 0.79 20 56055
Vigirex Sensor Iron Rings PA50 85 A 1.58 40 56056
SA200 (Optional) IA80 160 A 2.76 70 56057
PA50 MA120 250 A 4.33 110 56058
TOA80 160 A 3.15 80 50420
Split toroids, Type TOA
TOA120 250 A 4.73 120 50421
280 x 115 1600 A 11.02 x 4.53 280 x 115 56053
Rectangular Sensors
470 x 160 3200 A 18.50 x 6.30 470 x 160 56054

[1] 30 mA is instantaneous only, except for RH99M and RH99P models. Their suffix TD indicates time delay at 30 mA. For models with no time delay (IEC compliant) consult catalog
0972CT0401.
[2] Use as a guideline for sizing wire through sensor.
7-74
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Add-On Ground-Fault and Earth-Leakage Ground-Fault Protection
Modules
schneider-electric.us Class 931, 940, 960

Micrologic™ Add-on Ground-Fault Module (GFM)


The Micrologic Ground-Fault Module (GFM) is a UL Listed/CSA Certified circuit breaker
accessory which protects equipment from damage caused by ground faults. It is an add-
on module which, when connected to a PowerPact H- or J-frame thermal-magnetic
circuit breaker only, provides ground-fault sensing and ground-fault relay functions.
HD/JD ground-fault modules feature:
• Adjustable ground-fault pickup levels
• Adjustable ground-fault time delays
• Integral ground fault push-to-test feature
• Ground-fault indicator (mechanical for local, contacts for remote)
GFM250 with Optional GFM25CT
• All GFMs are supplied for I-Line™ mounting as standard, easily convertible to unit
mount by removing the I-Line bracket
• Fault-powered (through the sensing current transformer) for electronics, shunt trip,
and integral test feature. Meets NEC 230.95(C)
• AThis
12 Vdc shunt trip module (Catalog No. S29382) is required in the circuit breaker.
may be field installed or factory installed when the circuit breaker is ordered with
an -SN suffix.
• UL 1053 — Ground-fault Sensing and Relaying Equipment
The GFM system requires the following:
• H-frame (15–150 A) or J-frame (150–250 A) molded case circuit breaker
• Shunt trip is required for the function of the GFM (may be factory-installed or field-
installed)
• Bus bar connection (terminal nut inserts) for OFF end of circuit breaker
• Optional neutral current transformer, catalog number GFM25CT (must be ordered for
4-wire applications).NOTE: Ground-fault modules cannot be used for alarming only.
Table 7.144: Module/Enclosure Selection Chart[3]
Companion Circuit I-Line Ground-fault Pickup
Cat. No. [4] Adjustment Range
Breaker Prefix Switchboard
HD, HG, HJ, HL GFM150HD LA 20–100 A
JD, JG, JJ, JL GFM250JD LA 40–200 A
Accessories
H&J GFM25CT Optional Neutral Current Transformer (required for 4-wire loads)

Earth Leakage Module (ELM) for PowerPact H- and J-Frame


MCCBs
The Earth Leakage Module (ELM) is an add-on module which, when connected to a
PowerPact H- or J-frame MCCB, provides low-level ground-fault sensing and ground-
fault relay functions.
Because these ELMs are highly sensitive (30 mA to 3 A), they provide much greater
protection than GFMs (20 Amps to 200 Amps sensitivity). The ELMs provide greater
protection of control circuits and other sensitive equipment. The associated circuit
breaker must have a 48 Vdc shunt trip, which may be field-installed (kit S29392) or
factory-installed (suffix –SP) in the H- or J-Frame circuit breaker.
Add-on Earth Leakage Module (ELM) Features:
• Adjustable ground-fault pickup levels as low as 30 mA
• Adjustable ground-fault time delays from instantaneous to 500 msec
(Time delay can be applied to the 30 mA setting)
• Integral ground fault push-to-test feature
• Ground-fault indicator; pop-up button for local status and contacts for remote
indication (to be used only with the tripping option)
• All ELMs are supplied for I-Line™ mounting and are easily convertible to unit-mount
by removing the I-Line brackets
I-Line J-Frame with ELM Installed
• Three poles; 240 to 600 Vac maximum: 3-wire applications only (no neutral)
• Line-power obtained through internal bus to provide power for electronics, shunt trip,
and integral test feature.
• Ainstalled
shunt trip is required in the circuit breaker; it may be field-installed or factory-
in the PowerPact H and J circuit breakers.
• UL 1053 – Ground-fault Sensing and Relaying Equipment
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE

Table 7.145: ELM Selection Chart [5]


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

Companion Circuit Breaker [6] Enclosure Space Pick-Up Adjustment


Required I-Line Range Catalog Number
Prefix Size Switchboard
HD, HG, HJ, HL 15–150 A LA 30 mA–3 A ELM150HD
JD, JG, JJ, JL 150–250 A LA 30 mA–3 A ELM250JD

[3] At 250 A, the GFM250JD can be used with 80% rated circuit breakers only.
[4] See Supplemental Digest Section 3 for additional GFMs.
[5] At 250 A, the ELM250JD can be used with 80% rated circuit breakers only.
[6] For Factory Installation of ELM Module: For termination designation (3rd letter of catalog number) use ONLY “M”. Add factory installed 48 Vdc shunt trip (suffix SP) to breaker plus suffix VL
or VM.
7

7-75
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Dimensions and Shipping Weights Miniature and Molded Case Circuit
Breakers
Class 931, 940, 960 schneider-electric.us

Miniature and Molded Case Circuit Breaker Dimensions


Table 7.146: QO™, QOU, Multi 9™ Circuit Breakers
Figure 1 Figure 2 Figure 3 QO, QOB Circuit Breaker Fig. Dimensions—Inches
A A D Poles
A Cat. No. Prefix No. A B C D E F G
G G G C 1 1 0.75 3.00 [1] 2.31 2.91 2.25 — 0.59
QO, QOB 2 2 1.50 3.00 [1] 2.31 2.91 2.25 — 1.34
3 3 2.25 3.00[1] 2.31 2.91 2.25 — 2.09
B E B E B E
QOB-VH 150 A 2 2 3.0 5.72 2.53 4.90 3.78 — 2.85
QOB-VH 110–150 A 3 3 4.50 5.72 2.53 4.90 3.78 — 4.35
QO-PL 1 4 0.75 4.12[2] 2.31 2.91 2.25 — 0.59
QO-GFI, QO- QOU, QYU QO-GFI 2 5 1.50 4.12[2] 2.31 2.91 2.25 — 1.34
Figure 4 Figure 5 PL Low Ampere QO-EPD 3 5 2.25 4.12 [2] 2.31 2.91 2.25 — 2.09
A A QO-EPD D
1 6 0.75 4.05[3] 2.38 2.98 2.25 5.00[4] 0.62
G D C QOU
G QYU 2 7 1.50 4.05 [3] 2.38 2.98 2.25 5.00[4] 1.37
C Low Ampere 3 8 2.25 4.05 [3] 2.38 2.98 2.25 5.00[5] 2.12
E E 1 10 0.75 4.45 2.37 2.96 2.25 6.78 —
QOU
B B B F High Ampere 2 11 1.50 4.45 2.37 2.96 2.25 6.78 —
3 12 2.25 4.45 2.37 2.96 2.25 6.78 —
1 13 0.71 3.19 1.73 2.76 1.77 — —
2 14 1.42 3.19 1.73 2.76 1.77 — —
Multi 9™ C60
3 15 2.13 3.19 1.73 2.76 1.77 — —
Figure 6 Figure 7 Figure 8 4 16 2.84 3.19 1.73 2.76 1.77 — —
A A A QO-PLPS Power Supply 2 9 1.45 4.35 2.42 3.11 — — —
G G G
Figure 9
QO-PLPS
A
D
C
Table 7.147: QB, QD, QG, QJ, Q4, FA, LA, Circuit Breakers
Circuit Breaker Fig. Dimensions—Inches
Poles
Cat. No. Prefix No. A B C D E F G H
B E B E B E B
QB, QD, 2 22 6.47 3.00 3.02 3.93 [6] 4.25 — —
QG, QJ 3 23 6.47 4.50 3.02 3.93 [6] 4.25 1.50 0.75
1 21 6.00 1.50 3.16 4.13 0.44 5.13 1.50 —
FAL, FHL 2 22 6.00 3.00 3.16 4.13 0.44 5.13 — —
3 23 6.00 4.50 3.16 4.13 0.44 5.13 1.50 0.75
Figure 10 QOU
Figure 11 Figure 12 High Ampere Q4L, LAL, LHL 2&3 23 11.00 6.00 4.06 5.84 0.88 9.25 2.00 1.00
A A A D
C Table 7.148: Shipping Weights[7]
Approx. Shipping Approx. Shipping
Frame Size Weight (Lbs.) Frame Size Weight (Lbs.)
B E B E B E FAL, FHL 1P 2 QB, QD, QG, QJ 4
B F
FAL, FHL 2P 3 LAL, LHL 15
FAL, FHL 3P 5 Q4L 15

Figure 21 Figure 22
C60 E B E Figure 23
Figure 13 Figure 14 Figure 15 Figure 16 G B B
D
A A A A G D
C E HH C
C/L
C/L
B B B B F A F A
E F A

E
E E
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[1] 35–70 A is 3.12 in; 80–100 A 2P and 70–100 A 3P are 3.50 in.
[2] QO-PL is 4.55 in.
[3] 80–100 A 1P and 80–125 A 2P are 4.45 in.
[4] 80–100 A 1P and 80–125 A 2P are 6.78 in.
[5] 70–100 A is 6.78 in.
[6] Dimensions E are 1.59 in at ON end and 0.63 in at OFF end.
[7] All weights are for 3P circuit breakers unless otherwise noted.
7-76
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Molded Case Circuit Breakers Dimensions and Shipping Weights
Class 931, 940, 960
schneider-electric.us

Molded Case Circuit Breaker Dimensions


Table 7.149: PowerPact B-, H-, J-, and L-Frame Circuit Breakers
Figure 25 Circuit Breaker No. of Fig. Dimensions — Inches
B Figure 26 Frame Poles No. A B C D E F G H
B 1 35 6.79 1.06 3.15 4.01 0.20 6.33 — 5.39
E
G
2 36 6.22 2.12 3.15 4.01 0.86 4.48 — 5.39
B-Frame
3 37 6.22 3.19 3.15 4.01 0.86 4.48 1.06 5.39
A F A F
4 38 6.22 4.25 3.15 4.01 0.86 4.48 2.12 5.39
D
2 [8] 25 6.40 2.74 2.87 4.36 0.74 4.92 — —
E C H-Frame
3 26 6.40 4.12 2.87 4.36 0.74 4.92 1.38 —
J-Frame 3 27 7.52 4.12 2.87 5.00 1.30 4.92 1.38 —
L-Frame 3 28 13.38 5.51 3.75 6.61 2.22 7.87 1.77 —
Figure 27
G B Table 7.150: ED, EG, EJ, and GJ Circuit Breakers
Circuit Breaker No. of Dimensions — Inches
Fig. No.
Cat. No. Prefix Poles A B C D E
ED, EG, EJ 1 29 0.98 5.66 3.09 4.05 3.32
ED, EG, EJ 2 30 1.96 5.66 3.09 4.05 3.32
D ED, EG, EJ 3 31 2.94 5.66 3.09 4.05 3.32
A F GJ 3 32 3.54 4.72 2.76 3.94 2.20
C

E Table 7.151: PowerPact M-, P-, and R-Frame Circuit Breakers


Circuit Breaker No. of Fig. Dimensions — Inches
Frame Poles No. A B C D E F G
M-Frame
(800 A and below) 2, 3 33 12.86  8.27 5.77  8.05 2.49  7.87  7.83
Figure 28
G P-Frame
(1000–1200 A) 2, 3 33 16.16  8.27 5.77  8.05 4.19  7.87  7.83
R-Frame 2, 3 34 16.24 16.54 6.63 14.49 8.73 14.25 15.35

A
Table 7.152: Shipping Weights [9]
F Approx. Shipping Approx. Shipping
Frame Size Weight (Lbs.) Frame Size Weight (Lbs.)
B-Frame 1P 1 H-Frame 2P 4
B-Frame 2P 2 H-Frame 3P 5
B-Frame 3P 3 J-Frame 5
B-Frame 4P 4 L-Frame 14
B EDB 1P 2 M-Frame 29
C
EDB 2P 3 P-Frame 32
D EDB 3P 4 R-Frame (Without RLTB) 52
Figure 29 Figure 30
Figure 35
Figure 36
Figure 31 1P E
B E 2P B

E B B E E B

A C A F H
D A F H

A A

Figure 33
Figure 32 B D
C
G C
C D
D
E Figure 37 Figure 38
E B
3P B E 4P B E
AF

A C
E
D
A F H A F H
Figure 34
B
G D
F C
G C G C
D D

AE
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[8] Only HD and HG are in 2P module, HJ, HL and HR 2P are in 3P module.


[9] All weights are for 3P circuit breakers unless otherwise noted.
7

7-77
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breaker Enclosures Enclosures
Class 610
schneider-electric.us

Circuit Breaker Enclosures


F- and L–Frame Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker Enclosures
The enclosures for the F- and L-Frame thermal-magnetic circuit breakers are UL listed
and CSA certified. The enclosures are suitable for service entrance equipment when
neutral assembly is installed. The short circuit ratings of these enclosed circuit breakers
are equal to the interrupter rating, at the supply voltage marked on the circuit breaker
installed.
F-Frame Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker Enclosures
The FA100RB enclosure has a provision of 3/4 through 2 1/2 inch B-Type bolt-on hubs in
the top end wall. For details and hub catalog numbers see page 3-10.

Table 7.153: F-Frame Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker Enclosures


Circuit Breaker Cat. No.
Neutral
Cat. No. Rating Poles Enclosure Assembly Service
Prefix Ground Kit
Kit
NEMA 1 Flush NEMA 1 NEMA 3R
FA100S Surface
FAL, FHL, 1, 2, 3
FCL 15–100 A FA100F FA100S FA100RB SN100FA PKOGTA2
NEMA 4, 4X, 5
NEMA 12K NEMA 12/3R
[1] Type 304 Without
Stainless Steel With
Knockouts Knockouts [2]
[2]
FAL, FHL, 15–100 A 1, 2, 3 FA100DS FA100A FA100AWK SN100FA PKOGTA2
FCL

L-Frame Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker Enclosures


The LA400R enclosure has a blank top end wall and requires field cut openings. For
details and hub catalog numbers see page 3-10.

Table 7.154: L-Frame Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breaker Enclosures


Neutral Service
Circuit Breaker Enclosure Assembly Kit Ground Kit
Cat. No. Rating Poles Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
Prefix
FA100RB
NEMA 1 NEMA 1
NEMA 3R
Flush Surface
LAL, LHL, 125–225 A SN225KA
2, 3 LA400F[3] LA400S[3] LA400R
Q4L 225–400 A 400SN
PKOGTA2
LA400LS [4]
LAL 125–400 3 — [5][6][7] — SN400LA
NEMA 4, 4X,
5 [1] Type NEMA 12K NEMA 12/3R
With Without
304 Stainless
Steel [2] Knockouts Knockouts [2]
LAL, LHL, 125–225 A SN225KA
2, 3 LA400DS[6] — LA400AWK[6] PKOGTA2
Q4L 225–400 A SN400LA

FA100DS
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[1] Complete rating is NEMA 3, 3R, 4, 4X, 5, and 12.


[2] For NEMA 3R applications, remove drain screw from bottom endwall.
[3] Enclosures are provided with the Handle Padlock Attachment (HPALM) for field installation to lock the circuit breaker in the “ON” or “OFF” positions.
[4] Use copper conductors only.
[5] Maximum short circuit and voltage is 30 kAIR at 480 Vac.
[6] LAL or LHL circuit breakers with an MB or MT suffix are not compatible with these enclosures: LA400DS, LA400AWK, and LA400LS.
[7] Enclosure cover has an integral padlock provision to provide a means to lock the circuit breaker in the “ON” or “OFF” position.
7-78
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Enclosures Circuit Breaker Enclosures
Class 610
schneider-electric.us

PowerPact Circuit Breaker Enclosures


The enclosures for the family of PowerPact circuit breakers H- through Q-frame are
cULus listed unless otherwise noted. The enclosures are suitable for service entrance
equipment when neutral assembly is installed. The short circuit current rating of the
enclosed circuit breakers is equal to the rating of the circuit breaker installed unless
otherwise noted. All enclosures will accept 100% rated circuit breakers unless otherwise
noted.
PowerPact H- and J-Frame Circuit Breaker Enclosures
The enclosures' maximum short circuit ratings are 25 kAIR at 600 Vac, 65 kAIR at 480
Vac, 125 kAIR at 240 Vac and 20 kA at 250 Vdc unless otherwise noted. Enclosures
accept 100% rated circuit breakers [8]. The enclosures are not compatible with earth-
leakage or ground-fault modules.

Table 7.155: PowerPact H- and J-Frame Circuit Breaker Enclosures


Circuit Breaker Neutral Assembly Kit Service Ground Kit
Enclosure Cat. No.
Cat. No. Prefix Rating Poles Cat. No. Cat. No.
NEMA 1 Flush NEMA 1 Surface NEMA 3R
HDL 15–100 A 3 — HD100S [9][10][11] — SN100FA PKOGTA2
125–225 A SN225KA
HDL, JDL 3 — JD250S [12][10][11] — PKOGTA2
125–250 SN400LA
15–100 A 2 SN100FA
HDL, HGL H150F H150S H150R [13] PKOGTH150
125–150 A 2 SN400LA
HJL, HLL 15–100 A 2
SN100FA
15–100 A 3 PKOGTH150
HDL, HGL, HJL, HLL J250F J250S [14] J250R [13][15]
125–150 A 3
SN400LA[16]
JDL, JGL, JJL, JLL 150–250 A 2, 3 PKOGTJ250
NEMA 4, 4x, 5 [17]
NEMA 4, 4X, 5 [17] Type NEMA 12/3R Without
Type 316 Stainless
304 Stainless Steel [18] Steel [18] Knockouts [18]
15–100 A 2, 3 SN100FA
HDL, HGL, HJL, HLL PKOGTH150
125–150 A 2, 3 J250DS [19] J250SS [19] J250AWK [19]
JDL, JGL, JJL, JLL 150–250 A 2, 3 SN400LA [16] PKOGTJ250

PowerPact L-Frame Circuit Breaker and Molded Case Switch Enclosures


All enclosures accept 80% rated circuit breakers. The enclosures will also accept 100%
rated circuit breakers to 400 amps. The enclosures have a blank top end wall and require
field-cut openings. For details and hub catalog numbers see page 3–10.

Table 7.156: PowerPact L-Frame Circuit Breaker Enclosures


Circuit Breaker Cat. No.
Rating NEMA 12/3R Enclosures Neutral Assembly Kit Copper Only Neutral
Cat. No. Prefix Poles Without Knockouts Assembly Kit Service Ground Kit
250–400 A SN400LA SNC400LX
LDL, LGL, LJL, LLL, LRL 3 L600AWK [20][18][19] PKOGTA4
400–600 A SN1000MA SNC800LX
250–400 A SN400LA SNC400LX
LGL, LLL, LRL 3 L600AWKMC [21][18] PKOGTA4
400–600 A SN1000MA SNC800LX

PowerPact Q-Frame Circuit Breaker Enclosures


The enclosures for the PowerPact Q Frame Circuit Breaker are UL listed. The short
circuit ratings of these enclosed circuit breakers are equal to the interrupter ratings, at
the supply voltage marked on the circuit breaker installed, unless otherwise noted.

Table 7.157: PowerPact Q-Frame Circuit Breaker Enclosures


Circuit Breaker Enclosure Cat. No. Neutral Assembly Kit Service Ground Kit
Cat. No. Prefix Rating Poles NEMA 1 Flush NEMA 1Surface NEMA 3R Cat. No. Cat. No.
2 — Q22200NS [23] Q22200NRB [23]
QBL, QDL, QGL, QJL [22] 70–225 A — PKOGTA2
2, 3 Q23225NF Q23225NS Q23225NRB

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[8] Use only 90°C (minimum) rated wire sized per ampacity of 75°C rated conductors for 100% rated circuit breakers.
[9] Rated for 240 Vac maximum. Short circuit current rating is 25 kAIR at 240 Vac.
[10] Accepts standard 80% rated circuit breakers only. Not rated for 100% rated circuit breakers.
[11] Use copper conductors only.
[12] Rated 480 Vac maximum. Short circuit current rating is 18 kAIR at 480 V.
[13] For conduit entry through the top end wall use one of the following Square D conduit hubs: A200L for 2.00 in., A250L for 2.50 in., A300L for 3.00 in., A350L for 3.50 in. or A400L for 4.00 in.
[14] Add suffix BE if no knockouts are required on the end walls.
[15] For access to the circuit breaker’s standard, ammeter or energy trip unit panel/LCD, add suffix T.
[16] For 200% neutral use copper wire only.
[17] Complete rating is NEMA 3, 3R, 4, 4X, 5, and 12.
[18] For NEMA 3R applications, remove drain screw from bottom endwall.
[19] Add suffix VW for visibility to the standard, ammeter or energy trip unit of the PowerPact circuit breaker.
[20] Will accept PowerPact L-frame circuit breakers and Motor Protectors with suffixes M38X
[21] Will accept PowerPact L-frame Molded Case Switches.
[22] When the QJL circuit breaker is installed in the enclosure, the enclosure is limited to Short Circuit Current ratings of 65 kAIR at 240 V and 100 kAIR at 208 V.
[23] Limited to 200 A.
7

7-79
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breaker Enclosures Enclosures
Class 610
schneider-electric.us

PowerPact M- and P-Frame Circuit Breaker Enclosures


All enclosures will accept 80% rated circuit breakers. The P1200 enclosures will accept
100% rated circuit breakers to 800 A. If a CT neutral is required, the enclosure will no
longer accept a 200% neutral. The M800R and the P1200R enclosures have a blank top
end wall and require field-cut openings. For details and hub catalog numbers see page
3-10.
Table 7.158: PowerPact M- and P-Frame Circuit Breaker Enclosures
Circuit Breaker Cat. No.
Neutral 200% Neutral CT Neutral Kit Service Ground
Cat. No. Prefix Rating Poles Enclosure Assembly Kit Kit [24][25] Kit
NEMA 1 Flush NEMA 1 Surface NEMA 3R
MGL, MJL. PGL, PJL, SN800SNI
PKL, PLL 300–800 A 2, 3 — M800S M800R AL800SN and 2 each S33576MK PKOGTA4
SN1200
PGL, PJL, PKL, PLL 250–1200 A 2, 3 — P1200S P1200R SN1200 — S33576MK PKOGTA4
NEMA 4, 4X, 5 [26] NEMA 4, 4X, 5 [26] NEMA 12/3R
Type 304 Stainless Type 316 Stainless Without Knockouts
Steel [27] Steel [27] [27]
MGL, MJL. PGL, PJL,
300–800 A 2, 3 M800DS M800SS M800AWK AL800SN — S33576MK PKOGTA4
PKL, PLL
PGL, PJL, PKL, PLL 250–1200 A 2, 3 — — P1200AWK SN1200 — S33576MK PKOGTA4

PowerPact L-Frame 500 Vdc Circuit Breaker Enclosures


The PowerPact L-frame circuit breaker enclosure's maximum short circuit rating is 20
kAIR at 250 Vdc and 50 kAIR at 500 Vdc.
Listed for use ONLY on UPS systems.

Table 7.159: DC CIrcuit Breaker Enclosures for LG and LL DC-Rated Circuit


Breakers
NEMA 1 Surface Replacement Service Ground
Circuit Breaker [28] Ground Lugs
Enclosure Kit
Ampere
Cat. No. Prefix Rating Poles Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
300–600 A 3 L1200S
LGL, LLL 8010440301 Standard
700–1200 A 4 L1200S
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[24] Order current transformer kit S33576 seperately.


[25] Current transformers applicable only on PowerPact P circuit breakers. Current limitations are 400–800 A and 400–1200 A respectively for the M800 and P1200 family of enclosures.
[26] Complete rating is NEMA 3, 3R, 4, 4X, 5, and 12.
[27] For NEMA 3R applications, remove drain screw from bottom endwall.
[28] Use 500 Vdc or 250 Vdc rated circuit breakers only.
7-80
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Enclosures Circuit Breaker Enclosures
Class 610
schneider-electric.us

Enclosures for Special Applications


Hazardous Locations: NEMA 7 And NEMA 9 Circuit Breaker Enclosures
The NEMA 7 and 9 enclosures are cULus listed unless otherwise noted. They are rated
for use in hazardous locations as defined in NEC Article 500. The short circuit current
rating of the enclosed circuit breakers is equal to the rating of the circuit breaker installed
unless otherwise noted. They are suitable for use as service entrance equipment when
neutral is installed. Enclosures require the use of 75°C copper wire only. The NEMA 7
enclosures are suitable for rainproof applications when the included PKDB1 breather
and drain kit is installed.
Table 7.160: NEMA 7 and NEMA 9 Circuit Breaker Enclosures;
Thermal-Magnetic F-Frame and PowerPact J-Frame Cicuit Breakers
Circuit Breaker Enclosure Catalog Number Threaded
Neutral Service
NEMA 7 Cast NEMA 9 Cast Conduit
Cat. No. Assembly Ground Kit Provisions,
Rating Poles Aluminum Aluminum Kit Cat. No. Cat. No.
Prefix [29] [30] Inches
FAL, FHL 15–60 A 1, 2, 3 FA060X FA060Y 100SNA Included 3/4 in.
FAL, FHL 15–100 A 1, 2, 3 FA100X FA100Y 100SNA Included 1 1/4 in.
JDL, JGL 150–225 A 2, 3 J225X [31][32] J225Y [31][32] 225SNA Included 2 1/2 in.

Enclosures for Walking Beam Circuit Breakers

Table 7.161: Enclosures for Walking Beam Manually Operated Mechanical


Interlock Circuit Breakers (UL Listed) [33]
Circuit Breaker NEMA 1 Surface[34] NEMA 3R[34][35]
Cat. No. Ampere Enclosure Enclosure
Rating Poles Cat. No. Cat. No.
Prefix...Suffix
FAL...WB, FHL...WB 15–100 A 2, 3 KA250SWB KA250RWB

Enclosed Motor-Operated Molded Case Circuit Breakers


For information on Enclosed Motor-Operated Molded Case Circuit Breakers see
Supplemental Digest Section 3.
Enclosed Molded Case Switches
For information on enclosed molded case switches, see Supplemental Digest Section 3.

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


CIRCUIT BREAKERS

[29] NEMA 7 — Indoor Hazardous Locations — Division 1 and 2, Class I, Groups C and D; Class II, Groups E, F and G; Class III
[30] NEMA 9 — Indoor Hazardous Locations — Division 1 and 2, Class ii, Groups E, F and G; Class iii
[31] Short circuit current rating: 65 kAIR at 240 Vac, 25 kAIR at 480 Vac, and 18 kAIR at 600 Vac
[32] Not cULus listed due to wire bending space.
[33] Catalog number in table is enclosure only. For complete installation, the following must be ordered separately: WB Circuit Breakers (qty. 2, Supplemental Digest Section 3), Walking Beam
Assembly (Supplemental Digest Section 3), Mounting Pan (Supplemental Digest Section 3) and Neutral and Service Ground Kits, below
[34] Enclosure has blank top endwall.
[35] For applications above 200 A requiring a neutral, use copper wire only.
7

7-81
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breaker Enclosures Enclosure Accessories and Dimensions
Class 610
schneider-electric.us

Enclosure Accessories
Table 7.162: Neutral Kit Terminal Data
Neutral Kit Terminal Lug Data -Total Available (Line All Copper Neutral Terminal Lug Data -Total
Catalog Number plus Load) AWG/kcmil AL/CU Available (Line plus Load) AWG/kcmil
(2) 14–1/0 Cu or
100SNA (2) 12–1/0 Al plus (1) 14–4 Cu —
(4) 14–1/0 Cu or
SN100FA (4) 12–1/0 Al —
SN225KA (2) 4–300 Al/Cu plus (2) 14–1/0 Al/Cu —
225SNA (4) 6–350 Al/Cu —
(2) 1–600 or
400SN (4) 1–250 Al/Cu, plus (2) 4–300 Al/Cu —
(2) 1–600 or
SN400LA (4) 1–250 Al/Cu, plus (2) 4–300 Al/Cu —
SN1000MA (6) 3/0–500 Al/Cu, plus (1) 1–4/0 Al/Cu —
SNC400LX — (2) 2–-600 Cu, plus (2) 6–250 Cu
SNC800LX — (4) 2–600 Cu, plus (1) 2–4/0 Cu
AL800SN (6) 3/0–500 Al/Cu, plus (2) 6–250 Al/Cu —
SN1200 (8) 3/0–750 Al/Cu, plus (2) 6–350 Al/Cu —
S33576MK (8) 3/0–500 Al/Cu, plus (2) 4–300 Al/Cu —

Table 7.163: Service Ground Kit Terminal Data


Service Ground Kit Catalog Terminal Data Lugs Per Kit
Number AWG/kcmil
PKOGTA2 10–2/0 Cu or 6–2/0 Al 2
PKOGTH150 14–2 Al/Cu 2
PKOGTJ250 6–300 Al/Cu 2
PKOGTA4 6–250 Al/Cu 4
See Supplemental Digest Section 3 for special options for enclosures:
• Stainless steel fronts
• Pilot lights, push buttons
• Lock-on SPL0
• Key interlock systems
• Legend plates
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

7-82
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Enclosure Accessories and Dimensions Circuit Breaker Enclosures
Class 610
schneider-electric.us

Enclosure Dimensions

H
H
H H H

W D W D
W WB enclosure WB enclosure uses 2 circuit breakers W D
uses 2 circuit breakers NEMA Type 3R NEMA Type 7, Type 9
(Uses side hinge cover) W D
NEMA Type 1
NEMA Type 4, 4X, 5, 12, 12K

Table 7.164: Dimensions


Approximate Dimension
Cat. No. H W D
Series
in. mm in. mm in. mm
FA100A, AWK E05 19.50 495 9.13 232 4.88 124
FA100DS E05 19.50 495 9.13 232 4.88 124
FA100F E2 19.50 495 9.88 251 4.13 105
FA100RB E2 18.00 457 8.88 226 4.88 124
FA100S E2 18.13 461 8.63 219 4.13 105
FA060X E1 16.00 406 9.88 251 7.00 178
FA060Y E1 16.00 406 9.88 251 7.00 178
FA100X E1 16.00 406 9.88 251 7.00 178
FA100Y E1 16.00 406 9.88 251 7.00 178
HD100S A01 17.00 431.8 7.90 200.7 4.75 120.7
H150F A01 32.40 823 15.40 391 6.00 152
H150R A01 31.05 789 14.47 368 6.28 160
H150S A01 31.36 797 14.36 365 6.00 152
J250F A01 32.40 823 15.40 391 6.00 152
J250R A01 31.05 789 14.47 368 6.28 160
J250S A01 31.36 797 14.36 365 6.00 152
J250DS A01 32.26 819 9.72 247 7.94 202
J250SS A01 32.26 819 9.72 247 7.94 202
J250AWK A01 32.26 819 9.72 247 7.94 202
JD250S A01 26.40 670.6 8.90 226.1 5.50 139.7
J225X A01 22.70 577 10.93 278 7.70 196
J225Y A01 22.70 577 10.93 278 7.70 196
KA250SWB E2 20.00 508 19.00 483 5.63 143
KA250RWB E2 20.25 514 19.00 483 7.12 181
L600AWK A01 57.50 1461 20.38 518 8.25 210
L600AWKVW A01 57.50 1461 20.38 518 8.25 210
L600AWKMC A01 57.50 1461 20.38 518 8.25 210
L1200S A01 51.88 1818 20.25 514 7.75 197
LA400AWK E05 42.25 1073 13.75 349 7.25 184
LA400DS E05 42.25 1073 13.75 349 7.25 184
LA400F E03 45.63 1159 16.50 419 6.50 165
LA400R E03 44.00 1118 15.38 391 7.88 200
LA400S E03 44.50 1130 15.38 391 6.50 165
LA400LS A01 27.40 696.0 15.40 391.2 6.625 168.3
M800S A01 40-3/8 1025.52 21 533.4 9-3/4 247.65
M800R A01 40-3/8 1025.52 21 533.4 9-3/4 247.65
M800DS A01 40-7/8 1036.96 20-3/4 527.05 9-1/2 241.3
M800SS A01 40-7/8 1036.96 20-3/4 527.05 9-1/2 241.3
M800AWK A01 40-7/8 1036.96 20-3/4 527.05 9-1/2 241.3
P1200S A01 52-1/8 1323.98 21 533.4 9-3/4 247.65
P1200R A01 52-1/8 1323.98 21 533.4 9-3/4 247.65
P1200AWK A01 53 1346.20 20-3/4 527.05 9-1/2 241.3
Q22200NRB E05 23.38 594 7.63 194 4.75 121
Q22200NS E05 23.13 588 7.63 194 4.25 108
Q23225NF E05 26.25 667  9.88 251 4.75 121
Q23225NRB E05 26.25 667 9.88 251 5.50 140
Q23225NS E05 26.25 667 9.88 251 4.75 121

MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE


7 CIRCUIT BREAKERS

7-83
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breaker Enclosures Enclosure Accessories and Dimensions
Class 610
schneider-electric.us
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS

7-84
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents

Section 8

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Operating Mechanisms and Disconnect
Switches
Operating Mechanisms and Disconnect Switches 8-2

Selection Guide 8-2


UL 508 Motor Disconnect Switches 8-3

Mini-Vario and Vario™ Assembled and Enclosed Switches 8-3


UL508 Mo to r Dis c o n n e c t UL98 Fu s ib le S witc h
Mini-Vario and Vario™ Accessories 8-7
S witc h MD Motor Disconnect Switches 8-8
UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect Switches 8-9

8
TeSys™ VLS Disconnect Switches 8-9
Disconnect Switches, 16–125 A 8-9
TeSys™ VLS Accessories 8-11
Fourth Pole Add-on 8-11
Add-on Blocks 8-12
Sequence and Maximum Combination of Add-on Blocks 8-13
UL508 VLS S witc h UL98 VLS S witc h Rotary Handles 8-16
Shaft Extensions, Terminal Covers, Fuse Holders, and Fuse Blocks 8-18
Dimensions: 16–125 A Disconnect Switches 8-19
Wiring Diagrams 8-22
Technical Specifications, VLS Range, 16–125 A 8-23
UL 98 IEC Style Disconnect Switches 8-24

9421 Typ e L LK4 Nonfusible and GS2 Fusible Disconnect Switches 8-24
UL98 S tyle Fla n g e Ha n d le Circ u it Bre a ke r LK4 Nonfusible Disconnect Switches 8-24
Dis c o n n e c t S witc h Me c h a n is m GS2 Fusible Disconnect Switches 8-26
Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches 8-27
Accessories, LK4 Nonfusible and GS2 Fusible 8-27
Accessories 8-27
Dimensions, LK4 Nonfusible and GS2 Fusible 8-28
LK4JU3N / LK4MU3N / LK4QU3N, 100–400 A Nonfusible Disconnect
Switches—Dimensions 8-28
GS2QU3N, 400 A Fusible Disconnect Switches, Class J Fuses 8-32
Flange Mounted and Cable Operated 8-32

Disconnect Switches 8-33


9422 Typ e R Circ u it Bre a ke r Me c h a n is m
Accessories, Disconnect Switches 8-34
Dimensions, Disconnect Switches 8-37
Operating Mechanisms for Circuit Breakers 8-39

Door Mounted 8-39


Flexible Cable Mechanisms 8-41
Door Closing Mechanisms 8-45

Introduction 8-45
Types M5, M6, M1, and M8 8-46
Single and Multi-Door Enclosures 8-47
Types M5, M6, M1, and M8 8-48
Operating Mechanisms, Accessories 8-49

Disconnect Switches and Circuit Breakers 8-49


9422 Typ e C Circ u it Bre a ke r 9423 Do o r Clo s in g
Ca b le Op e ra to r Me c h a n is m s

© 2017 Schneider Electric


All Rights Reserved 8-1

11/10/2017
Operating Mechanisms and Disconnect Selection Guide
Switches
8

Class 610 schneider-electric.us

Selection Guide
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

Class MD Vario LK4 VLS GS2


Type Motor disconnect Manual motor control Nonfusible IEC style Fusible IEC style
switches switches disconnect switches Disconnect switches Disconnect switches disconnect switches
UL Rating UL 508 UL 508 UL 98 UL 508 UL 98 UL 98
Handle Type Rotary Rotary Rotary Rotary Rotary Rotary
Mounting DIN Rail (Rear Mounting) DIN Rail (Rear Mounting) Flange with cable
— Door or panel — Door Mounting Door Mounting mechanism panel
Voltage (max.) 600 Vac 600 Vac 600 Vac 690 Vac 690 Vac 600 Vac
Current Ratings 30–60 10–115 30–1200 16–63 A 63–125 A 30–800
Horsepower Ratings
(max.) 7.5–40 2–60 7.5–500 1–30 3–60 7.5–500
Metallic:
Non-Metallic NEMA 1, 12, 4, 4X Handle ratings: NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and Handle ratings:
Enclosure Type NEMA 1, 3, 3R, 4, 4X, Plastic: NEMA 1, 3R, 4, 4X, 12 4X; IEC IP65, IP66 4X; IEC IP65, IP66 NEMA 1, 3R, 4, 4X, 12
and 12 IP55, NEMA Type 4X
Power poles and Power poles and Auxiliary contacts and Power poles and Power poles and Auxiliary contacts and
Accessories auxiliary contacts auxiliary contacts power lugs auxiliary contacts auxiliary contacts power lugs
UL File E164864 NLRV UL File E191098 WP2X / UL File E487906 UL File E191098 WP2X /
Approvals UL File E164864 WP2X7 UL File E487907 WP2X7
IEC standard 60947-3 CSA File LR 81630 CSA 703149 UL60947-4-1/CSA 22.2 n UL98/CSA 22.2 n° 4 CSA 703149
Class 3211 05 ° 60947-4-1-14
Class 4652 04 Class 4652 04
Page page 8-8 page 8-3 page 8-24 page 8-9 page 8-9 page 8-26

Class 9422 9421 9422 9423


Type NEMA style fused or non-fusible Circuit breaker Circuit breaker Door closing mechanisms
disconnect switches operating mechanisms operating mechanisms
UL Rating UL98 — — —
Flange Flange Rotary, works in conjunction with
Handle Type Rotary
Adjustable rod or cable mechanism Adjustable rod or cable mechanism 9422 handle mechanisms
Mounting Panel or bracket mount Panel Panel —
Load Voltage (max.) 600 Vac 600 Vac 600 Vac —
Current Ratings Circuit breaker frame sizes 100– Circuit breaker frame sizes 100–
30–400 —
1200 1200
Horsepower Ratings (max.) 7.5–350 — — —
Handle ratings: Handle ratings: Handle ratings: Handle ratings:
Enclosure Type NEMA 1, 3R, 4, NEMA 1, 3R, 4, NEMA 1, 3R, 4, NEMA 4 and 12
4X, 12 4X, 12 4X, 12 sheet steel or stainless
Accessories Auxiliary contacts Auxiliary contacts Auxiliary contacts Right or left-hand operation
UL File E52639 WHTY2 UL File E62922 DIHS2 UL File E62922 DIHS2
Approvals CSA LR44199 CSA LR44199 CSA LR44199 —
Class 4652-04 Class 3211 07 Class 3211 07
Page page 8-33 page 8-39 page 8-41 page 8-45

8-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Mini-Vario and Vario™ Assembled and UL 508 Motor Disconnect Switches
Enclosed Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Identification System
Mini-Vario and Vario rotary manual motor-control switches from 12–175 A are suitable for
on-load making and breaking of resistive or mixed resistive inductive circuits where
frequent operation is required. They can also be used for direct switching of motors in
utilization categories AC-3 and DC-3 specific to motors. Vario manual motor-control
switches are suitable for isolator applications with fully visible indication (since the handle
cannot be in the open position unless all the contacts are actually open and separated by
the appropriate isolating distance), and the handles are padlockable.
The Mini-Vario and Vario catalog numbers are described in Table 8.1.

Table 8.1: Identification System


V CF N12 GE

8
Model (V-Vario, K-Operator)

Operator Type/ Accessory Designation


CD Single hole Red & Yellow BD Single hole Black and Gray
CF Four hole Red & Yellow BF Four hole Black and Gray
CCD Single hole Red & Yellow w/ VE Switch with Red handle installed on unit
extension shaft (one padlock only)
CCF Four hole Red & Yellow w/ VD Switch with Black handle installed on
extension shaft unit (no padlock provision)
Blank No operator or accessory Z Accessory, power pole, neutral or
ground
Switch Type (Switches and contacts are dual rated, UL/IEC).
VCFN12GE Blank 1 Vario 20/32 A
N12 Mini-Vario 10/12 A 2 Vario 25/40 A
N20 Mini-Vario 16/20 A 3 Vario 45/63 A
02 Vario 10/12 A 4 Vario 63/80 A
01 Vario 16/20 A 5 Vario 100/125 A
0 Vario 20/25 A 6 Vario 115/175 A
Enclosure Type (if applicable)
Blank No Enclosure G30, A30, W30 Type 1/12/4/4X
Metallic (Class 9421)
GE Mini-Vario IP55 GU Vario IP55 Non-Metallic
Non-Metallic

Mini-Vario
Table 8.2: Assembled Switches—Degree of Protection IP65, Type 1 and 12
Complete Switches for Rear
Complete Switches for Door Mounting (3- Mounting, Includes Extension Shaft
Padlock)
Rating (A) (3-Padlock)
Red/Yellow (Single Black/Gray (Single Red/Yellow (Single Hole)
Hole) Hole)
UL IEC Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
10 12 VCDN12 VBDN12 VCCDN12
16 20 VCDN20 VBDN20 VCCDN20
VN12

VN12/KCC1YZ
Table 8.3: Mini-Vario Enclosed Switches
Complete Switches Mounted in IP55 Non-Metallic Enclosure
Catalog No.
Description
VCFN12GE Red/Yellow Mounted In Sealable Enclosure,
VCFN20GE Non-UL Listed, Non-NEMA Rated

Table 8.4: Component Parts


Catalog No. Description
VN12 [1] 10/12 A switch only
VN20 [1] 16/20 A switch only
VZN12 [1] Add on power pole for 10/12 A switch
VBDN12 VCDN12 VZN20 [1] Add on power pole for 16/20 A switch
VZN11 Neutral Pole with early make, late break for VN12 or VN20 switch
VZN14 Grounding module for VN12 or VN20
VZN05 N.O. late make auxiliary contact [2]
VZN06 N.C. early break auxiliary contact [2]
VZN26 Single-pole shroud for auxiliary contacts
VZN08 Three-pole shroud for VN12 or VN20

Table 8.5: Operators and Accessories


Catalog No. Description
KCC1YZ 45 x 45 mm Red & Yellow operator
KCD1PZ 60 x 60 mm Red & Yellow operator
KAD1PZ 60 x 60 mm Black & Gray operator
VZN17 300–340 mm shaft extension
VZN30 400–430 mm shaft extension
KZ32 Door interlocking plate for 45 or 60 mm operator
VCCDN20 KZ83 Door mounting plate for 45 or 60 mm operator

[1] Switches/contacts are dual rated (UL/IEC).


[2] Auxiliary contacts are dual rated (UL/IEC 10/12 A).
8-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 508 Motor Disconnect Switches Mini-Vario and Vario™ Assembled and
Enclosed Switches
8

Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301 schneider-electric.us

Vario
Table 8.6: NEMA Type 1 and 12 Assembled Switches for Door Mounting
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

Complete Switches (Switch and Handle) for Door Mounting (3-padlock)


DISCONNECT SWITCHES

Rating (A) Red/Yellow (Four Black/Gray (Four Red/Yellow (Single Black/Gray (Single
Hole) Hole) Hole) Hole)
UL IEC Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
10 12 VCF02 VBF02 VCD02 VBD02
16 20 VCF01 VBF01 VCD01 VBD01
20 25 VCF0 VBF0 VCD0 VBD0
20 32 VCF1 VBF1 VCD1 VBD1
25 40 VCF2 VBF2 VCD2 VBD2
45 63 VCF3 VBF3 — —
63 80 VCF4 VBF4 — —
100 125 VCF5 VBF5 — —
115 175 VCF6 VBF6 — —

Table 8.7: NEMA Type 1 and 12 Assembled Switches for Rear Mounting
Complete Switches for Rear Mounting Switches with Handles Installed
with Extension Shaft (3-Padlock)[3] on Unit, DIN Rail Mount Only
Rating (A)
Red/Yellow (Four Red/Yellow (Single Red/Yellow (1- Black/Gray (No-
Hole) Hole) Padlock) Padlock)
UL IEC Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
10 12 VCCF02 VCCD02 — —
16 20 VCCF01 VCCD01 — —
20 25 VCCF0 VCCD0 VVE0 VVD0
20 32 VCCF1 VCCD1 VVE1 VVD1
25 40 VCCF2 VCCD2 VVE2 VVD2
45 63 VCCF3 — VVE3 VVD3
63 80 VCCF4 — VVE4 VVD4
100 125 VCCF5 — — —
115 175 VCCF6 — — —

Vario Non-Metallic Enclosed Switches


The Vario Motor Disconnect Switch is also offered as an enclosed switch. The three-pole
version makes the Vario switch ideal for manual motor control applications. They are
compact, easy to wire and connect, and come undrilled to allow cable entry positions.
NOTE: VC•GUN enclosures are UL approved.
Table 8.8: Non-Metallic Enclosed Switch [4] [5]
Ampere Size IP55-PVC 3-Pole, NEMA Type 1 & 12
UL/IEC Catalog No.
20/32 VC1GUN
25/40 VC2GUN
45/63 VC3GUN
63/80 VC4GUN
100/125 VC5GUN
115/175 VC6GUN

Table 8.9: Dimensions


Type No. of
Poles a b c d e f
VC1GUN
VC2GUN 3 6.5 (164) 4.8 (121) 3.4 (87) 5.6 (141) 3.9 (98) 5.2 (132)
VC2GUN
VC3GUN
3 7.6 (193) 6.5 (164) 3.4 (87) 6.7 (170) 5.6 (141) 5.2 (132)
VC4GUN
VC5GUN
3 11.5 (291) 9.5 (241) 5.0 (128) 10.6 (269) 8.6 (219) 7.5 (191)
VC6GUN

VC•GUN

[3] Complete switch includes handle operator, shaft, door interlock plate, and line terminal shroud.
[4] Assembled, includes switches mounted in enclosure with handle.
[5] Refer to Table 8.11 Vario Manual Motor Control Switches, IEC, page 8-5 and Table 8.12 Vario Manual Motor Control Switches, page 8-5 for horsepower ratings.
8-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Mini-Vario and Vario™ Assembled and UL 508 Motor Disconnect Switches
Enclosed Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


Vario Metallic Enclosed Switches

DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Vario switches meet UL508 requirements as both enclosed and open manual motor
controllers. They are also marked “Suitable as Motor Disconnect” allowing installation on
the load side of the motor branch circuit short-circuit and ground-fault protection. If motor
branch circuit short-circuit and ground-fault protection is needed, use a GS1 or 9422
fusible switch or circuit breaker meeting NEC 430.52 requirements.

Table 8.10: Metallic Enclosed Switches [6] [7]


Rating (A) Horsepower Ratings NEMA Type 1 NEMA Type 12 NEMA Type 4/4X
[7]
UL IEC 240 V 480 V 600 V Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
20 32 5 10 10 9421V1G30 9421V1A30 9421V1W30
25 40 5 10 15 9421V2G30 9421V2A30 9421V2W30

8
Class 9421 NEMA Type 1 V1G30, V2G30 Class 9421 NEMA Type 4, 4X, 12
V1W30, V2W30, V1A30, V2A30

Vario Manual Motor Control Switches


The V1 and V2 come in metallic enclosures (NEMA Type 1, 4, 4X, and 12). The NEMA 1
enclosure comes with conduit knockouts top and bottom. To factory install a VZ7
auxiliary contact in these metallic enclosures, add Form X11 to the end of the catalog
number (for example, 9421V1G30X11). To factory install a VZ20 auxiliary contact in
these enclosures, add Form X20 to the end of the catalog number (for example,
9421V1W30X20).

Table 8.11: Vario Manual Motor Control Switches, IEC


Rating (A) kW Rating—3-Pole Switch Body
IEC 230 V 240 V 400 V 415 V 500 V 690 V
12 3 3 4 4 5.5 7.5
20 4 4 5.5 5.5 7.5 11
Manual Motor 25 5.5 5.5 7.5 7.5 11 15
Control Switch 32 5.5 5.5 11 11 11 15
40 7.5 7.5 15 15 18.5 15
63 15 15 22 22 30 22
80 18.5 18.5 30 30 37 30
125 22 22 37 37 45 37
175 30 30 45 45 55 45

Table 8.12: Vario Manual Motor Control Switches


Rating (A) Horsepower Rating Shaft 3-Pole Switch Body
Size
UL 240 V 480 V 600 V mm Type
10 2 5 5 6 V02
16 3 7.5 7.5 6 V01
20 5 10 10 6 V0
20 5 10 10 6 V1
25 5 10 15 6 V2
45 10 20 30 8 V3
63 15 30 40 8 V4
100 25 50 50 8 V5
115 30 50 60 8 V6

Table 8.13: Switch Body


Rating (A) Shaft Size 3-Pole Switch Body
UL IEC mm Type
10 12 6 V02
16 20 6 V01
20 25 6 V0
20 32 6 V1
25 40 6 V2
45 63 8 V3
63 80 8 V4
100 125 8 V5
115 175 8 V6
NOTE: Refer to Table 8.10 and Table 8.12 for horsepower ratings.

[6] Assembled, includes switches mounted in enclosure with handle.


[7] For indoor use only. The NEMA Type 4/4X enclosure is made of #304 stainless steel with 3/4 in. T&B stainless steel hubs on the top and bottom.
8-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 508 Motor Disconnect Switches Mini-Vario and Vario™ Assembled and
Enclosed Switches
8

Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301 schneider-electric.us

Table 8.14: NEMA Type 1 and 12 Handle Operators: V02–V2 (6 mm Shaft), V3–V6
(8 mm Shaft) [8]
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

Red/Yellow Single Red/Yellow Four Black/Gray Single Black/Gray Four


Operator Type Hole Hole Hole Hole
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

45 x 45 mm 45 x 45 mm 45 x 45 mm 45 x 45 mm
No. of Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
Switches
Padlocks
V02–V2 0 KCC1LZ KCE1LZ KAC1BZ KAE1BZ
Single-Hole Operator Four-Hole Operator V02–V2 1 KCC1YZ KCE1YZ — —
(All except KDF3PZ Red/Yellow Single Red/Yellow Four Black/Gray Single Black/Gray Four
and KBF3PZ) Operator Type Hole Hole Hole Hole
60 x 60 mm 60 x 60 mm 60 x 60 mm 60 x 60 mm
V02–V2 0 KDD1PZ KDF1PZ KBD1PZ KBF1PZ
V3–V4 0 — KDF2PZ — KBF2PZ
V02–V2 3 KCD1PZ KCF1PZ KAD1PZ KAF1PZ
V3–V4 3 — KCF2PZ — KAF2PZ
Red/Yellow Four Black/Gray Four
Operator Type Hole Hole
90 x 90 mm 90 x 90 mm
Four-Hole Operator V5–V6 0 KDF3PZ KBF3PZ
KDF3PZ and KBF3PZ V5–V6 3 KCF3PZ KAF3PZ

Table 8.15: Low Profile Handle Operators [8]


Red/Yellow Single Red/Yellow Four Black/Gray Single Black/Gray Four
Operator Type Hole Hole Hole Hole
60 x 60 mm 60 x 60 mm 60 x 60 60 x 60 mm
Switches No. of Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
Padlocks
V02–V2 3 KCD1YZ KCF1YZ KADIXZ KAF1XZ
Low-Profile Handle KCD1YZ V3–V4 3 — KCF2YZ — KAF2XZ
Red/Yellow Four Black/Gray Four
Operator Type Hole Hole
90 x 90 mm 90 x 90 mm
V5–V6 3 KCG2YZ KAG2XZ

Table 8.16: Gasket Kits


Catalog No. Description
KZ65 45 x 45 mm gasket for V02-V2 for 4-hole type handles (order in quantities of 5)—IP65
KZ66 60 x 60 mm gasket for V02-V2 for 4-hole type handles (order in quantities of 5)—IP65
KZ62 60 x 60 mm gasket for V3-V4 for 4-hole type handles (order in quantities of 5)—IP65
KZ67
KZ67 90 x 90 mm gasket for V5-V6 for 4-hole type handles (order in quantities of 5)—IP65

0.51 0.51
0.12 0.22 13.0 0.22
3.0 13.0
5.5 5.5
0.5
12.7

2.67
1.89

68
48

0.88 2.67
22.5 1.89
48 68
Single-Hole
Mounting Dimensions Four-Hole 60 x 60 Four-Hole 90 x 90
Mounting Dimensions [9] Mounting Dimensions [9]

Table 8.17: Rear/Panel Mounting Switch Body Dimensions


1.5 b Dimensions
Type Shaft
dia. d Extension a b c d
in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm
c V02 to V2 VZ17 5.5–13.0 140–330 0.60 15 2.4 60 0.17 4.2
VZ30 5.5–16.9 140–430
VZ18 5.5–12.6 140–320
V3 to V4 VZ31 5.5–16.5 140–420 0.79 20 2.4 60 0.20 5.2
1.73 VZ18 6.5–13.8 165–350
a V5 to V6 1.20 30 3.9 100 0.28 7.0
44 VZ31 6.5–17.7 165–450

[8] When using these handles for replacements on the non-metallic enclosed switches, the handle shaft that comes with the enclosure must be reused. See Section 15 of the Supplemental
Digest.
[9] The door interlock plate included with VCC Kits has the same drilling as the handle operators.
8-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Mini-Vario and Vario™ Accessories UL 508 Motor Disconnect Switches
Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301
schneider-electric.us

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Mini-Vario and Vario™ Accessories
Table 8.18: Door Mounting Switch Body Dimensions
1.5-6 .512 .512 Dimensions
.217 13 .217 13 Weight
Switch Type a b c
5.5 5.5 Approx. lbs.
in. mm in. mm in. mm
c 1.89 2.68 V02 to V2 [10] 2.83 72 2.17 55 2.91 74 0.44
48 68
V02 to V2 2.36 60 2.17 55 2.91 74 0.44
V3 to V4 2.56 65 2.36 60 3.27 83 1.10
1.89 2.68
48 68 V5 to V6 3.54 90 3.54 90 4.92 125 2.00
1.73 a b
44
Table 8.19: Shaft Extension and Door Interlock
Maximum Shaft Door Door
Switch Type Panel Depth Extension Interlock Mounting
in. mm Kit Plate Plate
V02 to V2 13.0 330 VZ17 KZ 32 KZ83
V3, V4 12.6 320 VZ18 KZ 74 KZ81
V5, V6 13.8 351 VZ18 KZ 74 KZ81

8
V02 to V2 16.9 429 VZ30 KZ 32 KZ83
V3, V4 16.5 419 VZ31 KZ 74 KZ81
V5, V6 17.7 450 VZ31 KZ 74 KZ81

Door Interlock Plate Table 8.20: Accessories


KZ32 Line Side Terminal Shroud Terminal Shroud
Switch Type Terminal Shroud for Add-on for Auxiliary
For Main Switch Power Pole Contact
V02 to V2 VZ8 VZ26 VZ29
V3, V4 VZ9 VZ27 VZ29
V5, V6 VZ10 VZ28 VZ29

Table 8.21: Add-On Contact Modules


Shaft Extension Kit Ampere Auxiliary Contacts
Switch Type Main Pole Main Rating Rated UL/IEC 10/12 A
Module Pole
UL/IEC 1 N.O., 1 N.C. 2 N.O.
V02 VZ02 VZ02 10/12
V01 VZ01 VZ01 16/20
V0 VZ0 VZ0 20/25
V1 VZ1 VZ1 20/32 VZ7
Early Break, VZ20
V2 VZ2 VZ2 25/40
V3 VZ3 VZ3 45/63 Late Make.
V4 VZ4 VZ4 63/80
V5 — — —
V6 — — —

Table 8.22: Add-On Contact Modules


Add-On Contact Module Neutral
Modules Early Grounding Auxiliary Contacts
Switch Make/Late Module
Type Break
Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Description
V02–V2 VZ11 VZ14 VZ7 1 Late Make N.O. & 1 Early Break N.C.
V3–V4 VZ12 VZ15 VZ20 2 N.O. Contacts
V5–V6 VZ13 VZ16 — —

Table 8.23: Labeling Accessories


Nameplate Holder
Nameplate Holder with Nameplate Nameplate Only
Only
Size Catalog No. Catalog No. Use With Catalog No.
45 x 45 mm KZ13 KZ14 KZ14 KZ76
60 x 60 mm KZ15 KZ16 KZ16 KZ77
90 x 90 mm KZ103 KZ101 KZ1010 KZ100
Terminal Shroud for Terminal Shroud for
Main Switch VZ8 Auxiliary Contact VZ29
Table 8.24: Shrouds
3-Pole Shroud Single-Pole Shroud
Switch Type
Catalog No. For Add-On Power Pole Catalog No.
V02–V2 VZ8 VZ02-VZ2, VZ11 & VZ14 VZ26
b V3–V4 VZ9 VZ23, VZ4, VZ12 & VZ15 VZ27
V5–V6 VZ10 VZ13 & VZ16 VZ28
— — For 2-Pole Aux. Contact VZ29

a c Table 8.25: Main Pole Module Dimensions


Main Pole Module Dimensions
Switch Type Weight
a b c Approx. lbs.
in. mm in. mm in. mm
V 02 to V Z2 0.63 16 2.9 74 1.38 35 0.10
V Z3 to V Z4 0.79 20 3.3 83 1.80 46 0.22

[10] Dimensions for single-hole mounting.


8-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 508 Motor Disconnect Switches MD Motor Disconnect Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT0901
8

schneider-electric.us

MD Motor Disconnect Switches


OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

The MD motor disconnect switch is listed UL 508 Suitable for Motor Control
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

(UL File E164864) and conforms to IEC standard 60947-3. It is in a compact NEMA 4X
enclosure suitable for use in NEMA 1, 3, 3R, 4, 4X, and 12 applications. The MD's key
benefits are an extremely small footprint, a more economically efficient NEMA 4X
solution, and a handle interlock preventing cover removal when the switch is in the ON
position.
Switch features:
• Suitable for NEMA 1, 3R, 4, 4X, and 12 enclosure applications.
• Complies with OSHA lockout/tagout requirements—accepts up to three 8 mm
padlocks.
• For accessories, see Table 8.20.
Table 8.26: MD Motor Disconnect Switch—Non-Metallic NEMA 1, 3, 3R, 4, 4X, and
12 Enclosure
Maximum Horsepower Ratings
Height Width Depth
D Amperes Cat. No. Three-Phase Vac (in.) (in.) (in.)
220–240 440–480 600
30 MD3304X 7.5 20 25 6.38 3.9 4.37
60 MD3604X 20 40 40 8.27 4.94 4.37

H
Table 8.27: MD Motor Disconnect Accessories
Cat. No. Description
MDSAN20 2 N.O. auxiliary contact module
MDSAN11 1 N.O. and 1 N.C. auxiliary contact module
MDS30P 30 A add on power pole

W
MD Motor Disconnect Switch

8-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ VLS Disconnect Switches UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect
Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Disconnect Switches, 16–125 A
• Versions: DIN rail mounting, door mounting, and rear
mounting
• Wide range of accessories
• Changeover switches
• Conforming to UL 60947-4-1 (16–63 A) or UL 98 (63–125
A) specifications

Style DIN Rail, Rear Mounting Door Mounting


Width 36 mm (1.42 in.) 70 mm (2.75 in.) 36 mm (1.42 in.) 70 mm (2.75 in.)
Ampere rating 16 25 32 40 63 63 80 100 125 16 25 32 40 63 80 100 125
Three pole ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ●
4th pole—simultaneous closing ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ●
4th pole—early-make closing ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ●

8
Fuse holder ● ● ●
Mechanical 6-8 pole coupling system ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ●
Mechanical interlock for line switching ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ●

Interpreting the Catalog Number


Some combinations are not available. Use this table only for interpreting the catalog
number.
Table 8.28: Interpreting the Catalog Number
Example VLS 3P 016 R 1
Description Disconnect switch 1P = 1 pole 016 = 16 A 063 = 63 A D = Door mounting 1 = Small size (16–63 A), UL 508
3P = 3 poles 025 = 25 A 080 = 80 A R = DIN rail mounting 2 = Large size (63–125 A), UL 98
032 = 32 A 100 = 100 A
040 = 40 A 125 = 125 A

Example VLSH 2 S 5 R
Description Rotary handle 1 = Recessed, 65 x 65 mm H = Hole fixing 5 = 5 mm shaft opening B = Black
2 = Protruding, 65 x 65 mm S = Screw mounting 7 = 7 mm shaft opening BC = Black, changeover
3 = Pistol grip, 75 mm dia. BD = Black, defeatable
4 = Protruding, 48 x 48 mm R = Red
RD = Red, defeatable

Example VLSS 150 5


Description Shafts Length: Cross-section:
150–500 mm 5 = 5 mm
7 = 7 mm

Example VLS 1P 040 R 1 S


Description Additional Poles Number of Poles: Current: Mounting: Body Size: Closing:
1P = 1 Pole 016 = 16 A R = DIN rail mounted 1 = Small size (16–63 A) S = Simultaneous closing
to D = Door mounted 2 = Large size (63–125 A) E = Early Make closing
125 = 125 A

Example VLS 1N R 1
Description Ground and Neutral 1G = 1 Pole Ground terminal R = DIN rail mounted 1 = Small size (16–63 A), UL 508
Terminals 1N = 1 Pole Neutral terminal D = Door mounted 2 = Large size (63–125 A), UL 98

Example VLS A 11 R 1 S
Description Auxiliary contacts A = Auxiliary contact 10 = 1 N.O. R = DIN rail mounted Blank = Size 1 and 2 S = Simultaneous closing
11 = 1 N.O. + 1 N.C. D = Door mounted 1 = Size 1 E = Early make closing
2 = Size 2

8-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect TeSys™ VLS Disconnect Switches
Switches
8

Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601 schneider-electric.us

Product Overview
Compact Size
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

The three-pole 16–63 A disconnect switches are made up of a single unit body, a mere
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

36 mm (1.4 in.) wide, while those rated 63–125 A are only 70 mm (2.8 in.) wide.
Accessory Flexibility
Mounting and removal of the fourth pole and add-on blocks are simple and quick
operations with no need for tools.
Certifications
All VLS disconnect switches are certified by cCSAus and are UL Listed for Canada and
VLS3P016R1– USA:
VLS3P063R1
• 16–63 A types: certified according to UL 60947-4-1 / CSA 22.2 n° 60947-4-1-14
standards
• 63–125 A types: certified according to UL 98 / CSA 22.2 n° 4 standards
Three-Pole Disconnect Switches
Table 8.29: Certifications and Compliance (● = certification obtained)
Catalog number cULus per UL 60947-4-1 / cULus per UL 98 / IEC/EN 60947-1,
CSA C22.2 n° 60947-4-1-14 CSA C22.2 n° 4 IEC/EN 60947-3
UL Listed (File E487906) UL Listed (File E487907)
VLS3P016R1–
VLS3P040R1 ● —
VLS3P063R1 ● —
VLS3P016D1–
VLS3P040D1 ● — Compliant
VLS3P063R2–
VLS3P125R2 — ●
VLS3P063D2–
VLS3P125D2 — ●

Table 8.30: Selection—Three-Pole Disconnect Switches


VLS3P063R2– Catalog IEC conventional free air IEC rated operational current (Ie) UL general use at
VLS3P125R2 number thermal current (Ith), AC21A AC22A (≤690 V), AC23A (≤415 V) 600 Vac
(≤690 V) (A) (A)
(A)
DIN rail mounting version, complete with black handle. For rear-mounting version, separately purchase the handle
and shaft extension. Refer to page 8-16 and page 8-18.
VLS3P016R1 16 16 16
VLS3P025R1 25 25 25
VLS3P032R1 32 32 32
VLS3P040R1 40 40 40
VLS3P063R1 63 45 60
VLS3P063R2 63 63 60
VLS3P080R2 80 80 100
VLS3P100R2 100 100 100
VLS3P125R2 125 125 100
Door-mounting version (no shaft required). Separately purchase the handle. Refer to page page 8-16.
VLS3P016D1 16 16 16
VLS3P025D1 25 25 25
VLS3P032D1 32 32 32
VLS3P040D1 40 40 40
VLS3P063D2 63 63 60
VLS3P080D2 80 80 100
VLS3P100D2 100 100 100
VLS3P125D2 125 125 100
VLS3P016D1–
VLS3P040D1
VLS3P063D2–
VLS3P125D2
Strokes of VLS switch poles
Travel 0 1 0° 30° 60° 90°
60°
VLS3P016R1–VLS3P063R1
60°
VLS3P016D1–VLS3P040D1
55°
VLS3P063R2–VLS3P125R2
55°
VLS3P063D2–VLS3P125D2
Off On

Table 8.31: UL / CSA Ratings


Catalog number Horsepower General use Short-circuit rating Max. fuse rating
1 phase 3 phase at 600 Vac at 600 Vac at 600 V
(A) (kA) (A)
120 V 240 V 200–208 V 240 V 480 V 600 V
UL 60947-4-1 and CSA 22.2 n° 60947-4-1-14 [1]
VLS3P016•• 1 2 5 5 10 10 16 5 30 (Type RK5)
VLS3P025•• 1.5 3 7.5 7.5 15 20 25 5 30 (Type RK5)
VLS3P032•• 2 5 10 10 20 20 32 5 45 (Type RK5)
VLS3P040•• 2 5 10 15 20 25 40 5 45 (Type RK5)

[1] Ratings are valid for VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P•••D• types, according to UL 60947-4-1 and CSA 22.2 n° 60947-4-1-14. UL Listed for USA and Canada (cULus - File E487907) as Manual Motor
Controllers, while the UL designation is “General Purpose Switch. Interrupteur Usage General” and “Suitable As Motor Disconnect.”

8-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ VLS Accessories UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect
Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


Table 8.31 UL / CSA Ratings (cont'd.)

DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Catalog number Horsepower General use Short-circuit rating Max. fuse rating
1 phase 3 phase at 600 Vac at 600 Vac at 600 V
(A) (kA) (A)
120 V 240 V 200–208 V 240 V 480 V 600 V
VLS3P063R1 2 7.5 10 15 30 30 60 5 45 (Type RK5)
UL 98 and CSA C22.2 n° 4 [2]
VLS3P063•• 3 7.5 20 [3] 20 40 40 60 50 60
VLS3P080•• 3 10 25 [3] 25 40 40 100 50 100
VLS3P100•• 5 10 30 [3] 30 50 50 100 50 100
VLS3P125•• 7.5 10 30 [3] 30 60 60 100 50 100

Fourth Pole Add-on


Table 8.32: General Specifications—Fourth Pole Add-on
IEC ampere ratings 16–125 A
Available versions DIN rail mounting
Door mounting
Simultaneous closing with switch poles

8
Early-make closing with respect to switch poles
Size Compact and modular

Table 8.33: Selection—Fourth Pole Add-on


Catalog number IEC conventional free air thermal current Ith IEC rated operational current Ie
AC21A (≤690V) AC22A (≤690V), AC23A (≤415V)
VLS1P•••R•S VLS1P040D1S (A) (A)
VLS1P•••R•E VLS1P040D1E Simultaneous closing operation with respect to switch poles
DIN Rail Mounting (VLS3P•••R•)
VLS1P040R1S [4] 40 40
Strokes of VLS poles (switch and add-on pole)
VLS1P063R1S [5] 63 45
Travel 0 1 0° 30° 60° 90°
VLS1P063R2S 63 63
VLS3P016R1/D1–VLS3P040R1/D1, VLS3P063R1 60°
Main poles VLS1P080R2S 80 80
VLS1P040R1S–VLS1P063R1S 60° VLS1P100R2S 100 100
Simultaneous fourth-pole add on VLS1P125R2S 125 125
VLS1P040R1E/D1E, VLS1P063R1E 55° Door Mounting (VLS3P•••D•)
Early-make fourth-pole add on VLS1P040D1S [6] 40 40
VLS3P063R2/D2–VLS3P125R2/D2 55° VLS1P063D2S 63 63
Main poles VLS1P080D2S 80 80
VLS1P063R2S/D2S–VLS1P125R2S/D2S 55° VLS1P100D2S 100 100
Simultaneous fourth-pole add on VLS1P125D2S 125 125
VLS1P125R2E/D2E 48° Early-make closing operation with respect to switch poles
Early-make fourth-pole add on
Off On DIN Rail Mounting (VLS3P•••R•)
VLS1P040R1E [4] 40 40
VLS1P063R1E [6] 63 45
VLS1P125R2E [7] 125 125
Door Mounting (VLS3P•••D•)
VLS1P040D1E [6] 40 40
VLS1P125D2E [8] 125 125
NOTE: For Fourth Pole UL / CSA ratings, see page 8-10 —they are the same as the
ratings for the corresponding single-phase contact switch.
Table 8.34: Certifications and Compliance for Fourth Pole Add-on Blocks (● = certification obtained)
Certification Standard
Catalog number cULus per UL 60947-4-1 / CSA C22.2 n° 60947-4-1-14 / cULus per UL 98 / CSA C22.2 n° 4 /
UL Listed (File E487906) UL Listed (File E487907) IEC/EN 60947-1, IEC/EN 60947-3
VLS1P040R1E, VLS1P040R1S ● —
VLS1P063R1E, VLS1P063R1S ● —
VLS1P040D1E, VLS1P040D1S ● —
Compliant
VLS1P125R2E, VLS1P125D2E — ●
VLS1P063R2S–VLS1P125R2S — ●
VLS1P063D2S–VLS1P125D2S — ●

[2] Ratings are valid for VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P•••D• types, according to UL 98 and CSA C22.2 n° 4. UL Listed for USA and Canada (cULus - File E487907) as Open Type Switches – Open
type unfused switch, while UL designation is “General Purpose Switch. Interrupteur Usage General.”
[3] Voltage value is not considered in UL98 / CSA 22.2 n° 4 standards, and so is not indicated in the UL product marking.
[4] For VLS3P016R1–040R1 only.
[5] For VLS3P063R1 only.
[6] For VLS3P016D1–040D1 only.
[7] For VLS3P063R2–125R2 only.
[8] For VLS3P063D2–125D2 only.
8-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect TeSys™ VLS Accessories
Switches
8

Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601 schneider-electric.us

Add-on Blocks
Table 8.35: Operational Specifications
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

Auxiliary contacts
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

IEC conventional free air thermal current (Ith) 10 A


UL/CSA and IEC/EN 60947-5-1 designation A600-Q600
Tightening torque 0.8 N•m (7.1 lb-in.)

Other devices
Tightening torque VLS1NR1/D1, VLS1GR1/D1 terminals 1.8–2 N•m (16–18 lb-in)
VLS1NR2/D2, VLS1GR2/D2 terminals 5–6 N•m (45–54 lb-in)
VLS8C1/C2, VLS8M1/M2 mounting: 0.5 N•m (4.4 lb-in)
extension with handle: 0.8 N•m (7.1 lb-in)
VLSA11RS VLSA11DS

Table 8.36: Selection—Add-on Blocks


Catalog number Specifications
Auxiliary contacts, simultaneous operation with respect to switch poles
VLSA11RS 1NO+1NC for VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P063R1
VLSA11DS 1NO+1NC for VLS3P•••D•
Auxiliary contacts, early-break operation with respect to switch poles
VLSA10R1E 1EB (NO) for VLS3P016R1–VLS3P040R1, VLS3P063R1
VLSA10R2E 1EB (NO) for VLS3P063R2–VLS3P125R2
Neutral terminal
VLSA10R1E VLS1NR1 For VLS3P016R1–VLS3P040R1, VLS3P063R1
VLSA10R2E VLS1NR2 For VLS3P063R2–VLS3P125R2
VLS1ND1 For VLS3P016D1–VLS3P040D1
VLS1ND2 For VLS3P063D2–VLS3P125D2
Earth/Ground terminal
VLS1GR1 For VLS3P016R1–VLS3P040R1, VLS3P063R1
VLS1GR2 For VLS3P063R2–VLS3P125R2
VLS1GD1 For VLS3P016D1–VLS3P040D1
VLS1GD2 For VLS3P063D2–VLS3P125D2
Mechanical interlock for line changeover (I-0-II)
VLS8C1 For VLS3P016R1–VLS3P040R1, VLS3P063R1, and VLSH2S5BC: □ 5 mm (0.2 in.) [9]
VLS8C2 For VLS3P063R2–VLS3P125R2 and VLSH2S5BC: □ 5 mm (0.2 in.) [9]
Mechanical coupling system for 6-8 pole disconnect switches
VLS8M1 For VLS3P016R1–VLS3P040R1 and VLS3P063R1: □ 5 mm (0.2 in.) [9]
VLS8M2 For VLS3P063R2–VLS3P125R2: □ 7 mm (0.3 in.) [10]

Strokes of VLS poles (switch with auxilia


ry contact blocks)
Travel 0Õ 1 0° 30° 60° 90°
VLS3P016R1/D1, VLS3P040R1/D1, VLS3P063R1 60°
Main poles
VLSA11RS/DS 60°
Auxiliary contacts (1 NO + 1 NC) NO
NC
40°
VLSA10R1E Travel 0Õ 1 60°
Auxiliary contact
(1EB – NO early break) Travel 1Õ 0 70°

VLS3P063R2/D2…VLS3P125R2/D2 55°
Main poles
VLS1NR• VLSA11RS/DS 45°
VLS1GR• Auxiliary contacts (1 NO + 1 NC) NO
VLS1ND• NC
VLS1GD• 25°
VLSA10R2E Travel 0Õ 1 55°
Auxiliary contact
(1EB – NO early break) Travel 1Õ 0 65°

Off On

VLS8C•
VLS8M•

[9] Use VLSS shaft extensions.


[10] Use VLSH3S7RD handles and VLSS•••7 extensions for a rear-mounting version.
8-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ VLS Accessories UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect
Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


Sequence and Maximum Combination of Add-on Blocks

DISCONNECT SWITCHES
DIN Rail Mounting Disconnect Switches
Table 8.37: VLS3P016R1–VLS3P040R1 (DIN Rail Mounting)

VLS1NR1 VLS1GR1 VLSA11RS VLSA10R1E VLS1P040R1E VLS3P016R1 VLS1P040R1E VLSA10R1E VLSA11RS VLS1GR1 VLS1NR1
VLS1P040R1S VLS3P025R1 VLS1P040R1S
1 1 1 — 1 VLS3P032R1 — — 2 1 1
1 1 2 — — VLS3P040R1 1 — 1 1 1
1 1 1 — 1 — 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 — 1 — 1 1 1

8
1 1 1 1 — — — 2 1 1
1 1 2 — — — 1 1 1 1
1 1 2 — — — — 2 1 1
1 1 — — — 1 — — 1 1
1 1 — — 1 — — — 1 1
1 1 — — — — — — 1 1

Table 8.38: VLS3P063R1 (DIN Rail Mounting)

VLS1NR1 VLS1GR1 VLSA11RS VLSA10R1E VLS1P063R1E VLS3P063R1 VLS1P063R1E VLSA10R1E VLSA11RS VLS1GR1 VLS1NR1
VLS1P063R1S VLS1P063R1S
1 1 1 — 1 — — 2 1 1
1 1 2 — — 1 — 1 1 1
1 1 1 — 1 — 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 — 1 — 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 — — — 2 1 1
1 1 2 — — — 1 1 1 1
1 1 2 — — — — 2 1 1
1 1 — — — 1 — — 1 1
1 1 — — 1 — — — 1 1
1 1 — — — — — — 1 1

Table 8.39: VLS3P063R2–VLS3P125R2 (DIN Rail Mounting)

VLS1NR2 VLS1GR2 VLSA11RS VLSA10R2E VLS1P125R2E VLS3P063R2 VLS1P125R2E VLSA10R2E VLSA11RS VLS1GR2 VLS1NR2
VLS1P•••R•S VLS3P080R2 VLS1P•••R•S
— — 1 — 1 VLS3P100R2 — — 2 — —
— — 2 — — VLS3P125R2 1 — 1 — —
— — 1 — 1 — 1 1 — —
— — 1 1 — 1 — 1 — —
— — 1 1 — — — 2 — —
— — 2 — — — 1 1 — —
— — 2 — — — — 2 — —
1 1 — — — 1 — — 1 1
1 1 — — 1 — — — 1 1
1 1 — — — — — — 1 1

8-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect TeSys™ VLS Accessories
Switches
8

Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601 schneider-electric.us

Door Mounting Disconnect Switches


Table 8.40: VLS3P016D1–VLS3P040D1 (Door Mounting)
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

VLS1ND1 VLS1GD1 VLSA11DS VLS1P040D1E VLS3P016D1 VLS1P040D1E VLSA11DS VLS1GD1 VLS1ND1


VLS1P040D1S VLS3P025D1 VLS1P040D1S
1 1 1 1 VLS3P032D1 — 1 1 1
1 1 1 — VLS3P040D1 1 1 1 1
1 1 — 1 — 1 1 1
1 1 1 — 1 — 1 1
1 1 1 — — 1 1 1
1 1 — — — — 1 1

Table 8.41: VLS3P063D2–VLS3P125D2 (Door Mounting)

VLS1ND2 VLS1GD2 VLSA11DS VLS1P125D2E VLS3P063D2 VLS1P125D2E VLSA11DS VLS1GD2 VLS1ND2


VLS1P125D2S VLS3P080D2 VLS1P125D2S
— — 1 1 VLS3P100D2 — 1 — —
— — 1 — VLS3P125D2 1 1 — —
1 1 — 1 — 1 — —
— — 1 — 1 — 1 1
— — 1 — — 1 — —
1 1 — — — — 1 1

8-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ VLS Accessories UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect
Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


Mechanical Coupling and Mechanical Interlock for Line Changeover

DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Table 8.42: VLS3P016R1–VLS3P040R1, VLS8C1–VLS8M1 (Rear Mounting)

VLS1NR1 VLS1GR1 VLSA11RS VLSA10R1E VLS1P040R1E VLS8C1–VLS8M1 VLS1P040R1E VLSA10R1E VLSA11RS VLS1GR1 VLS1NR1
VLS1P040R1S VLS1P040R1S
1 1 1 — 1 VLS3P016R1 + 1 — 1 1 1
1 1 1 — 1 VLS3P016R1 — — 2 1 1
1 1 2 — — VLS3P025R1 + 1 — 1 1 1
VLS3P025R1
1 1 1 — 1 VLS3P032R1 + — 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 — VLS3P032R1 1 — 1 1 1

8
1 1 1 1 — VLS3P040R1 + — — 2 1 1
1 1 2 — — VLS3P040R1 — 1 1 1 1
1 1 2 — — — — 2 1 1
1 1 — — 1 1 — — 1 1
1 1 — — — — — — 1 1

Table 8.43: VLS3P063R1 + VLS8C1–VLS8M1 (Rear Mounting)

VLS1NR1 VLS1GR1 VLSA11RS VLSA10R1E VLS1P063R1E VLS8C1– VLS1P063R1E VLSA10R1E VLSA11RS VLS1GR1 VLS1NR1
VLS1P063R1S VLS8M1 VLS1P063R1S
1 1 1 — 1 VLS3P063R1 + 1 — 1 1 1
1 1 1 — 1 VLS3P063R1 — — 2 1 1
1 1 2 — — 1 — 1 1 1
1 1 1 — 1 — 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 — 1 — 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 — — — 2 1 1
1 1 2 — — — 1 1 1 1
1 1 2 — — — — 2 1 1
1 1 — — 1 1 — — 1 1
1 1 — — — — — — 1 1

Table 8.44: VLS3P063R2–VLS3P125R2 + VLS8C2–VLS8M2 (Rear Mounting)

VLS1NR2 VLS1GR2 VLSA11RS VLSA10R2E VLS1P125R2E VLS8C2 - VLS8M2 VLS1P125R2E VLSA10R2E VLSA11RS VLS1GR2 VLS1NR2
VLS1P•••R•S VLS1P•••R•S
— — 1 — 1 VLS3P063R2 + 1 — 1 — —
— — 1 — 1 VLS3P063R2 — — 2 — —
— — 2 — — VLS3P080R2 + 1 — 1 — —
VLS3P080R2
— — 1 — 1 VLS3P100R2 + — 1 1 — —
— — 1 1 — VLS3P100R2 1 — 1 — —
— — 1 1 — VLS3P125R2 + — — 2 — —
— — 2 — — VLS3P125R2 — 1 1 — —
— — 2 — — — — 2 — —
1 1 — — 1 1 — — 1 1
1 1 — — — — — — 1 1

8-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect TeSys™ VLS Accessories
Switches
8

Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601 schneider-electric.us

Rotary Handles
Table 8.45: Selection—Rotary Handles (NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4X. IEC IP65 unless
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

otherwise specified)
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

Catalog Specifications
number
Door Mounting and Rear Mounting Handles, Padlock-ready[11]
Red/yellow, rotating
VLSH1S5R For VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P•••D•. Screw mounting. Recessed selector. □ 5 mm (0.2 in.) [12].
VLSH2S5R For VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P•••D•. Screw mounting. Protruding selector. □ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12]
VLSH2H5R For VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P016D1–VLS3P040D1. Ring mounting. Protruding selector.
□ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12] [13]
VLSH1S5R (65 x 65 mm) VLSH2H5RD For VLS3P•••R•. Ring mounting. Protruding selector with release, defeatable per UL60947-4-1;
□ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12]
VLSH3S7RD For VLS3P063R2–VLS3P125R2, and VLS8M2. Screw mounting. Pistol grip with release,
defeatable per 60947-4-1; □ 7 mm (0.3 in.). IEC IP66. [14]
VLSH4S5R For For VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P•••D•. Screw mounting. Protruding selector. 48 mm square.
□ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12]
Black, rotating
VLSH1S5B For VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P•••D•. Screw mounting. Recessed selector. □ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12]
VLSH2S5B For VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P•••D•. Screw mounting. Protruding selector. □ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12]
VLSH2H5B For VLS3P•••R•, VLS3P063R1, VLS3P016D1–VLS3P040D1. Ring mounting. Protruding selector.
□ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12] [13]
VLSH2H5BD For VLS3P•••R•. Ring mounting. Protruding selector with release, defeatable per 60947-4-1.
□ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12]
VLSH2S5R (65 x 65 mm) VLSH3S7BD For VLS3P063R2–VLS3P125R2, and VLS8M2. Screw mounting. Pistol grip with release,
defeatable per UL60947-4-1; □ 7 mm (0.3 in.). [14]
VLSH2S5BC For VLS8C• mechanical interlock mechanism (I-O-II). □ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12]
VLSH4S5B For For VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P•••D•. Screw mounting. Protruding selector. □ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12]
Accessories for Rear Mounting Control For VLSH3S7RD and VLSH3S7BD handles.
VLSHA7 Adapter, □ 7 mm (0.3 in.) for VLS3P063R2-–VLS3P125R2.

VLSH3S7RD (75 mm dia.)

VLSH2H5B (65 x 65 mm) VLSH2S5BC (65 x 65 mm)

VLSH4S5R (48 x 48 mm)

VLSH4S5B (48 x 48 mm) VLSHA7

Table 8.46: Certifications and Compliance (● = certification obtained)


cULus per UL60947-4-1 /
VLS3P…R1 cULus per UL98 / CSA C22.2 n° 4
Catalog number CSA C22.2 n° 60947-4-1-14
VLS3P...R2 +VLS8C…1 / UL Listed (File E487906) UL Listed (File E487907)
+VLS8M…1 65
+VLS8C…2 / VLSA11RS/DS —
+VLS8M…2 UL Listed, cULus File E478582
VLSA10R1E —
CSA C22.2 n° 14-10
VLSA10R2E —
VLS1NR1/D1 ● —
VLS1NR2/D2 — ●
VLS1GR1/D1 ● —
VLS1GR2/D2 — ●
VLSS…5 VLS8C1/M1 ● —
VLS8C2/M2 — ●
VLSH2H5BC
VLSH1S5R/B ● ●
VLSH2S5R/B ● ●
VLSH2H5R/B ● ●
0
II VLSH4S5R/B ● ●
I
VLSH2S5RD/BD ● ●
VLSH3S7RD/BD — ●
VLSH2H5BC ● ●
Figure 8.1: Transformation of the DIN rail VLSHA7 — ●
mounting version into the rear mounting version Compliant with standards: IEC/EN 60947-1, IEC/EN 60947-3, IEC/EN 60947-5-1, UL 60947-4-1, UL 98, CSA C22.2.

[11] Catalog numbers ending in BD or RD are for rear mounting units only.
[12] For VLS3P•••R• disconnect switches, separately purchase VLSS shaft extensions.
[13] Snap-on mounting of VLS3P016–VLS3P040D1 disconnect switches with the handle.
[14] Separately purchase the VLSS•••7 shaft extension and a VLSHA7 handle having a 7 mm (0.3 in.) square section—not required for VLS8M2.
8-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ VLS Accessories UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect
Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


Table 8.47: Operating Specifications

DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Handle mounting ring or screw
VLSH1S5R/B
Mounting handle interaxis VLSH2S5R/B 36 x 36 mm (1.4 x 1.4 in.) or 48 x 48 mm (1.9 x 1.9 in.)
(compatible with the pre-existing drillings of the VLSH2S5BC
most common types in the marketplace)
VLSH3S7RD/BD 36 x 36 mm (1.4 x1.4 in.)
Padlocks 1–3 for all handles Ø4–8 mm (Ø0.2–0.3 in.)
Mounting ring types 2.3 N•m (20.4 lb-in)
VLS8M1 0.8 N•m (7 lb-in)
Tightening torque
VLSH3S7RD/BD 1.5 N•m (13.3 lb-in)
All others 1 N•m (9 lb-in)
IEC / EN: IP65 for all except VLSH3S7RD/BD, which are IP66.
UL / CSA: VLSH1S5R/B and VLSH3S7RD/BD are Type 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4X outdoor use with all VLS switch models.
Degree of protection
VLSH2S5R/B, VLSH2H5R/B, VLSH2H5RD/BD and VLSH2S5BC are Types 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4X outdoor use with
VLS3P016R1/D1–VLS3P040R1/D1 and VLS3P063R1 models, otherwise Type 1 only.

VLS3P016D1
VLS3P025D1

8
VLSS1 505 VLS3P016D1 VLS3P032D1
VLSS3 005 VLS3P025D1 VLS3P040D1
VLSS5 005 VLS3P032D1
( 5 mm)
VLS3P016R1 VLS3P040D1 VLSH2H5R/B
VLSH2S5RD/BD
VLS3P025R1 VLSH1S5B
VLS3P032R1
VLS3P040R1 VLSH2H5R/B VLSH2H5R/B
VLS3P063R1 VLSH2H5R/B VLSH2H5RD/BD
VLSH1S5B

VLS3P063D2
VLSH2S5R/B VLS3P080D2
VLS3P100D2
VLS3P125D2

VLSH1S5R/B

VLSH1S5R/B

VLSH2S5R/B
VLSH4S 5R/B

VLSHA7
B
VLSS1507
C VLSS3007
VLS3P063R2 VLSH4S5R/B
VLS3P080R2 A
( 5 mm) E
VLS3P100R2 E E
D
VLS3P125R2 D
E VLSH3S7RD/BD
D
E Figure 8.3: Door mounting version
D Certifications and Compliance:
D
See Table 8.46 for details.
Figure 8.2: Changing the DIN rail mounting version for rear
mounting

8-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect TeSys™ VLS Accessories
Switches
8

Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601 schneider-electric.us

Shaft Extensions, Terminal Covers, Fuse Holders, and Fuse


Blocks
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

Table 8.48: Selection—Shaft Extensions, Terminal Covers, Fuse Holders, and Fuse
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

Blocks
Catalog Specifications Qty per Weight,
number package kg (lb)
Shaft extension for rear-mounting handles VLSH1S5R–VLSH2H5RD, VLSH1S5B–VLSH2H5BD, VLSH2H5BC;
interlocking changeover type VLS8C1, VLS8C2; and mechanical disconnect switch system VLS8M1
VLSS1505 150 mm long; □ 5 mm (0.2 in.) 1 0.032
(0.07)
VLSS•••5 (5 mm) VLSS•••7 (7 mm) VLSS3005 300 mm long; □ 5 mm (0.2 in.) 1 0.068
(0.15)
VLSS5005 500 mm long; □ 5 mm (0.2 in.) 1 0.090
(0.20)
Shaft extension for rear-mounting handles VLSH3S7RD/BD, and mechanical coupling system VLS8M2
VLSS1507 150 mm long; □ 7 mm (0.3 in.) 1 0.090
(0.20)
VLSS3007 300 mm long; □ 7 mm (0.3 in.) 1 0.160
(0.35)
Set of 2 one-pole terminal covers for fourth pole
VLSC1P1 For VLS1P040R1S, VLS1P040D1S, VLS1P040R1E, VLS1P040D1E, 1 0.009
VLS1P063R1E, VLS1P063R1S (0.02)
VLSC1P2 For VLS1P063R2S–VLS1P125R2S, VLS1P063D2S–VLS1P125D2S, 1 0.012
VLS1P125R2E, VLS1P125D2E (0.03)
Set of 2 three-pole terminal covers
VLSC VLSFH1UL VLSC3P1 For VLS3P016R1–VLS3P040R1, VLS3P063R1, VLS3P016D1–VLS3P040D1 1 0.018
(0.04)
VLSC3P2 For VLS3P063R2–VLS3P125R2, VLS3P063D2–VLS3P125D2 1 0.030
(0.07)
Fuse holder/block for disconnect switches
VLSFH1UL For VLS3P016R1–VLS3P032R1 (suitable for Class CC fuses) 1 0.135
(0.30)

Table 8.49: Operational Specifications of Fuse Holder


IEC rated insulation voltage, Ui 1000 V
IEC rated impulse withstand voltage, 8 kV
Uimp
• The fuse holder/block connects directly to the disconnect switches.
• Access to fuses only when the disconnect switches are in Off position.

Terminal covers
VLS1P…R1
VLS1P…R2

VLS3P…R1
VLS3P...R2

VLS C1P 1
VLS C1P 2

VLS C3P 1
VLS C3P 2 VLSC1P1
VLSC1P2
VLSC3P1
VLSC3P2

VLS 1P …D1
VLS 3P …D1
VLS 3P...D2 VLS 1P …D2

For disconnect switches For fourth pole

Table 8.50: Certifications and Compliance (● = certification obtained)


Catalog number cULus per UL60947-4-1 / CSA C22.2 n° 60947-4-1-14 cULus per UL98 / CSA C22.2 n° 4
UL Listed (File E487906) UL Listed (File E487907)
VLSS1505, VLSS3005, VLSS5005 ● —
VLSS1507, VLSS3007 ● —
VLSC1P1, VLSC3P1 — —
VLSC1P2, VLSC3P2 — —
VLSFH1UL ● —
Compliant with standards: IEC/EN 60947-1, IEC/EN 60947-3, UL60947-4-1, UL98, CSA C22.2.

8-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Dimensions: 16–125 A Disconnect UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect
Switches Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Table 8.51: DIN Rail Mounting Disconnect Switches
VLS3P016R1–VLS3P040R1, VLS3P063R1 VLS3P063R2–VLS3P125R2
36 5 70 (2.75) 5 70 (2.75)
(1.42) (0.20) 43.9 70 (2.75) (0.20) 43.9
(1.73) (1.73)

45 (1.77)
78 (3.07)
74 (2.91)

(1.28)

100 (3.94)
94 (3.70)
32.5

(1.77)
45
Dim. = mm (in.)

(1.65)
41.9
22 14.2 (0.56)
(0.87)
38.2 14.4 (0.57)
(1.50)

Table 8.52: Door Mounting Disconnect Switches

8
VLS3P016D1–VLS3P040D1 VLS3P063D2–VLS3P125D2
36 19.9 48.6
(1.42) 52.7 (2.07) 70 (2.75) (1.91) 20.8
(0.78)
(0.82)
55.5 (2.18)
78 (3.07)

(1.76)
44.8

100 (3.94)

65 (2.56)
Dim. = mm (in.)

Table 8.53: Add-on Blocks and Accessories


For VLS3P016R1–VLS3P040R1, VLS3P063R1
Fourth pole
Auxiliary contacts VLS1P040R1E/R1S, VLS1P063R1E/R1S
VLSA11RS, VLSA10R1E VLS1NR1 neutral, VLS1GR1 ground terminals
12 46.2 70 (2.75)
(0.47) (1.82) 12
43.6 (0.47) 5 43.6
9 (1.72)
(0.35) (1.72) (0.20)
72.6 (2.86)

78 (3.07)
78 (3.07)

(1.28)
(1.64)

32.5
41.6

Dim. = mm (in.)

VLSA10R1E VLS3P016R1, VLS3P025R1, VLS3P032R1,


VLSA11RS VLS3P040R1, VLS3P063R1, VLSA11RS

For VLS3P063R2–VLS3P125R2
Auxiliary contacts Fourth pole
VLSA11RS VLS1P125R2E, VLS1P063R2S–VLS1P125R2S
VLSA10R2E VLS1NR2 neutral, VLS1GR2 ground terminals
12 48. 9 (1.93) 23 70 (2.75)
9 (0.47) 46.2 (0.90) 5 43.9
(0.35) (1.82) (0.20) (1.73)
72.6 (2.86)

100 (3.94)
78 (3.07)

(1.64)
41.6

Dim. = mm (in.)

VLSA10R2E VLS3P063R2, VLS3P080R2, VLS3P100R2, VLS3P125R2,


VLSA11RS VLSA10R1E, VLSA10R2E, VLS1P063R2S, VLS1P080R2S,
VLS1P100R2S, VLS1P125R2S, VLS1P125R2

Mechanical interlock VLS8C1 and Mechanical interlock VLS8C2 and


mechanical coupling system VLS8M1 mechanical coupling system VLS8M2
72 (2.83) 89 (3.50) 140 (5.51) 89 (3.50)
27
(1.06) 27
(1.06)
78 (3.07)

(1.77)

100 (3.94)
45

(1.77)
45

Dim. = mm (in.)

VLS8C1 - VLS8M1

VLS8C2 - VLS8M 2

8-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect Dimensions: 16–125 A Disconnect
Switches Switches
8

Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601 schneider-electric.us


For VLS3P016D1–VLS3P040D1 Auxiliary contacts Fourth pole
VLSA11DS VLS1P040D1E–VLS1P040D1S
VLS1ND1 neutral, VLS1GD1 ground terminals
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

46.2 43
12
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

8.5 (1.82) (1.69)


(0.33) (0.47)

72.6 (2.86)
78 (3.07)

78 (3.07)
(1.64)
41.6
Dim. =
mm (in.)

VLSA11DS VLS3P016D1, VLS3P025D1, VLS3P032D1,


VLS3P040D1, VLS1P040D1S, VLS1P040D1E

For VLS3P063D2–VLS3P125D2 Auxiliary contacts Fourth pole


VLSA11DS VLS1P125D2E, VLS1P063D2S–125D2S
VLS1ND2 neutral, VLS1GD2 ground terminals
46.2 23 48.6
8.5 (1.82) (0.90) (1.91)
(0.33)

72.6 (2.86)
100 (3.94)

100 (3.94)
(1.64)
41.6
Dim. =
mm (in.)

VLSA11DS
VLS1P063D2S, VLS1P080D2S, VLS1P100D2S,
VLS1P125D2S, VLS1P125D2E, VLS1ND1,
VLS1ND2, VLS1GD1, VLS1GD2

Table 8.54: Rotary handles


VLSH1S5R/B VLSH2S5R/B
1–4 36 (1.42) 1–4 48 (1.89)
(0.04–0.16) 28–32 (0.04–0.16)
(1.10–1.26) 36 (1.42)
22 23 22 35
65 (2.56) (0.87) (0.90) 65 (2.56) (0.87) (1.38)

Dim. =

Ø16 (0.63)
(1.10–1.26)
61.8 (2.43)

Ø16 (0.63)

48 (1.89)
36 (1.42)
65 (2.56)
65 (2.56)

36 (1.42)

mm (in.)
28–32

Ø3 (0.12) Ø3 (0.12)

VLSH2H5R/B VLSH2H5RD/BD
34.3 (1.35) 35 (1.38) 35.5 1–4
3.3 (0.13) (1.40) (0.04–0.16) 3.3 (0.13)
1–4 35
65 (2.56) (0.04–0.16) 65 (2.56) (1.38)
(0.79)
Ø20

Dim. =
37 (1.46)
65 (2.56)

65 (2.56)
(0.96)

2.5
Ø32.9
(1.29)

2.5

(0.96)
24.3

mm (in.)
24.3
Ø2 .88) Ø2 0.88)
(0 (
(0.87)
Ø22

VLSH3S7RD/BD VLSH2S5BC
1–4 1–4 48 (1.89)
(0.04–0.16) (0.04–0.16) 36 (1.42)
98 (3.86) 46 36 (1.42) 22 35
(1.81) 65 (2.56) (0.87) (1.38)
60 (2.36)
Ø16 (0.63)
36 (1.42)
65 (2.56)

48 (1.89)

Dim. =
Ø66 (2.60)
Ø48 (1.89)

36 (1.42)
75 (2.95)

2
Ø3 .26) mm (in.)
(1

Ø3
(0.12)

Ø4.2 (0.16)

VLSH4S5R/B
36 (1.42) Dim. =
28–32 mm (in.)
16 (1.10–1.26)
48 (1.89) (0.63) 21.8
(0.86)
(1.10–1.26)
Ø16 (0.63)

36 (1.42)
28–32

1–4 Ø3 (0.12)
(0.04–0.16)

8-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Dimensions: 16–125 A Disconnect UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect
Switches Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


Shaft extensions for rear-mounting handles (for Dimension A, see Table 8.55)
VLSS

DISCONNECT SWITCHES
5 (0.20) 5 (0.20)
65 (2.56) A 65 (2.56) A

65 (2.56)

65 (2.56)
Dim. =
mm (in.)

VLS3P016R1…063R1 VLSS…5 VLSH…5


VLSS..5 VLSH..5
VLS3P 063…125R2

Table 8.55: Dimension A for VLSS Shaft Extensions


Dimension A for VLSS Shaft Extensions (see below)
Maximum Dimension A, mm (in.)

8
Length Type of handle
Extension mm (in.)
VLSH VLSH VLSH VLSH VLSH
1S5• 2S5• 2H5R 2H5RD 2S5BC
VLSS1505 150 (5.90) 194 (7.64) 192 (7.56) 197 (7.75) 211 (8.31) 192 (7.56)
VLSS3005 300 (11.81) 344 (13.54) 342 (13.46) 347 (13.66) 361 (14.21) 342 (13.46)
VLSS5005 500 (19.68) 544 (21.42) 542 (21.34) 547 (21.53) 561 (22.09) 542 (21.34)

VLSS used with VLS8C1, VLS8C2, and VLS8M1


A1 A1
VLS8M1
VLS8C2
65 (2.56)
78 (3.07)

100 (3.94)

65 (2.56)
Dim. =
mm (in.)
23
(0.90) 20
VLSS… VLSH… (0.90)
VLS3P016R1–063R1 VLSS...5 VLSH2S5BC
VLS3P063R2, VLS3P080R2,
VLS3P100R2, VLS3P125R2

Table 8.56: Dimension A1 for VLSS used with VLS8C1, VLS8C2, and VLS8M1
Extension (5 mm) Length A1 maximum, mm (in.)
mm (in.) Used with VLS8M1 Used with VLS8C1/VLS8C2
Type of handle
VLSH1S5• VLSH2S5• VLSH2H5R VLSH2H5RD VLSH2S5BC
VLSS1505 150 (5.90) 211 (8.31) 209 (8.23) 214 (8.42) 228 (8.98) 209 (8.23)
VLSS3005 300 (11.81) 361 (14.21) 359 (14.13) 364 (14.33) 378 (14.88) 359 (14.13)
VLSS5005 500 (19.68) 561(22.09) 559 (22.01) 564 (22.20) 578 (22.75) 559 (22.01)

VLSS•••7 used with VLS8M2 and VLSH3S7RD/BD


VLSS•••7 used with VLSHA7 and VLSH3S7RD/BD handle
88 (3.46) 46 (1.81)
98 (3.86) 73 (2.87) 46 (1.81) 20 ±1
5 (0.20) B1 (0.79
60 (2.36) B 20 ±1 ±0.04)
(0.79 VLS8M
2
min. 10 ±0.04) min. 10
(0.39) (0.39)
VLSHA7
(2.60)

75 (2.95)
Ø66

100 (3.94)

Dim. =
75 (2.95)

mm (in.)
19
(0.75)
VLSS...7 VLSH3S7RD,
VLSH3S7RD/BD VLSH3S7BD
VLSS•••7 VLS3P063R2–125R2
40 19 1–4
VLS3P063R2–125R2 (1.57) 1–4 (0.75) (0.04–0.16)
48 (1.89) 19 (0.04–0.16)
(0.75)

Length B B1
Extension (7 mm) with VLSH3S7RD/BD handle
mm (in.) mm (in.) mm (in.)
VLSS1507 176 (6.93) 118–229 (4.64–9.01) 119–205 (4.68–8.07)
VLSS2007 226 (8.90) 118–279 (4.64–10.99) 119–255 (4.68–10.03)
VLSS3007 326 (12.83) 118–379 (4.64–14.92) 119–355 (4.68–13.98)

8-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect Wiring Diagrams
Switches
8

Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601 schneider-electric.us

Table 8.57: Terminal Cover and Fuse Holder Dimensions


Terminal Cover Dimensions Fuse Holder Dimensions
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

VLSC1P1, VLSC3P1 VLSFH1UL


VLSC1P1 VLSC3P1 VLSC1P2 VLSC3P2
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

3.6 46 (1.81) 20.7


36 (0.14) 23 70 (2.75) (0.81) 46 (1.81)
12 (0.90)

80.1 (3.15)
(0.47) (1.42)

(1.04)

(1.46)
26.4

37
10 (0.39)
9.9 (0.39)

52.5 (2.07) 75.2 (2.96)

VLSC1P2, VLSC3P2
VLSC1P1 VLSC3P1 VLSC1P2 VLSC3P2 8.6 (0.34)
(0.39)

(0.39)
12.7 (0.50)
10

10
12 36 23 70 (2.75) 46 (1.81)
(0.47) (1.42) 46 (1.81) (0.90)
(1.04)
26.4

(1.47)
37.3
Dim. =
mm (in.)

Table 8.58: Wiring Diagrams—VLS Disconnect Switches (16–125 A)


Three-pole disconnectors
VLS3P016•• – Fourth pole add-on
VLS3P125R2/D2 VLS1P•••••S VLS1P•••••E
Line Line Line
L1 L2 L3 7 L4 7 L4
8 T4 8 T4

T1 T2 T3
Load 7 L4 7 L4

8 T4 8 T4
Load Load
Add-on Blocks and Accessories
Auxiliary contacts Neutral terminal Earth/Ground terminal Fuse holder
VLSA11•S VLSA10R1E–VLSA10R2E VLS1NR1/D1–VLS1NR2/ VLS1GR1/D1–VLS1GR2/ VLSFH1
D2 D2
13 21 57 N PE L1 L2 L3
68

14 22 N PE
67
T1 T2 T3
58

8-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Technical Specifications, VLS Range, 16– UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect
125 A Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


DISCONNECT SWITCHES
3-pole: VLS3P… 016… 025… 032… 040… 063R1 063R2 080… 100… 125…
Model
4th pole: VLS1P… 040… 040… 040… 040… 063R1S 063R2S 080… 100… 125…
Contact Specifications
IEC conventional free air thernal current, Ith (≤40 °C) A 16 25 32 40 63 63 80 100 125
IEC rated insulation voltage, Ui V 1000
IEC rated impulse withstand voltage, Uimp kV 8
IEC rated operational current, Ie
400 V A 16 25 32 40 63 63 80 100 125
AC21A 500 V A 16 25 32 40 63 63 80 100 125
690 V A 16 25 32 40 63 63 80 100 125
400 V A 16 25 32 40 45 63 80 100 125
AC22A 500 V A 16 25 32 40 45 63 80 100 125
690 V A 16 25 32 40 45 63 80 100 125
400 V A 16 25 32 40 45 63 80 100 125
AC23A 500 V A 16 25 25 25 25 63 63 80 100
690 V A 16 25 25 25 25 47 47 47 47
IEC rated operational power
400 V kW 7.5 11 15 18.5 22 30 45 55 55

8
AC23A
690 V kW 11 22 22 22 22 45 45 45 45
IEC reactive power for capacitor control 400 V kvar 7.5 10 12.5 15 15 25 30 40 50
IEC protection against short-circuit
Rated short-time withstand current (1 s), Icw A rms 800 2500
Rated conditional short-circuit current kA rms 50
With fuse class gG A 16 25 32 40 63 63 80 100 125
IEC making capacity (AC23A 400 V) A 400 450 1250
IEC breaking capacity (AC23A 400 V) A 320 360 1000
Mechanical life (depending on the application) cycles 100,000 100,000 30,000
Electrical life (IEC AC21A) cycles 100,000 15,000 30,000
UL/CSA general use at 600 V A 16 25 32 40 50 60 100 100 100
UL/CSA short-circuit rating at 600 V kA 5 5 5 5 5 50 50 50 50
UL/CSA fuse class/max rating at 600 V Type/A RK5/20 RK5/30 RK5/35 RK5/45 RK5/45 –/100 –/100 –/100 –/100
UL/CSA Hp ratings
120 V hp 1 1.5 2 2 2 3 3 5 7.5
Single phase
240 V hp 2 3 5 5 7.5 7.5 10 10 10
200–208 V hp 5 7.5 10 10 10 20 25 30 25
240 V hp 5 7.5 10 15 15 20 30 30 30
Three phase
480 V hp 10 15 20 20 30 40 40 50 50
600 V hp 10 20 20 25 30 40 40 60 40
Terminals
Type Lug clamp
IEC/EN 60947-1 designation: Pillar terminal.
A 5.6 mm (0.22 in.) 12.4 mm (0.49 in.)
B

B 6.5 mm (0.26 in.) 10.4 mm (0.41 in.)


A
Screw M4 M8
Tool Phillips 2 Metric Allen key 4
N•m 1.8–2 5–6
Tightening torque
lb-in 16–18 45–54
mm² 0.75–16 4–50
Conductor section (solid/stranded)
AWG 18–6 12–1
Ambient Conditions
Operating °C –25 to +55
Temperature
Storage °C –40 to +70
Maximum altitude m 3000
Normal Vertical
Mounting position
Admissible Any
Mounting Screw or 35 mm DIN rail (IEC/EN 60715)

8-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 98 IEC Style Disconnect Switches LK4 Nonfusible and GS2 Fusible
Disconnect Switches
8

Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301 schneider-electric.us

LK4 and GS2 Disconnect Switches


OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

Table 8.59: Building a Complete GS or LK Switch


DISCONNECT SWITCHES

To build a complete GS or LK switch, order the following parts:


Choose a Switch + Shaft + Handle Assembly + Lugs if needed

600 A, LK4SU3N Shaft 320 mm, GS2AE6 Black Handle, GS2AH150 Lugs Kit, GS1AW503
Example:
LK4SU3N (600 A non-fusible switch) + GS2AE6 (320 mm Style D shaft) + GS2AH150 (black/black, locking)
To add auxiliary contacts:
For front-mounted contacts order LK4AD30N (front-mounted auxiliary contact holder) + GS2AM110.

LK4 Nonfusible Disconnect Switches


NOTE: Switches in the shaded area are now available as Kits. SeeTable 8.61.
Table 8.60: LK Nonfusible IEC Style Disconnect Switches
Short Circuit Current
Rating Maximum Horsepower Rating Rating Shaft
Pole (A) Catalog No. 600 Vac Style
240 V 480 V 600 V 250 Vdc Fuse SCCR kA
NOTE: Switches in the shaded area are now available as Kits.
3 30 LK4DU3CN[1] 10 20 30 — J 100 AL
3 60 LK4GU3CN[1] 20 40 50 — J 100 AL
3 100 LK4JU3CN[1] 20 50 50 N/A J 100 AL
3 100 LK4JU3N 30 75 100 15 J 200 B
3 200 LK4MU3N 75 150 200 15 J 200 B
3 400 LK4QU3N 125 250 350 50 J 200 B
3 600 LK4SU3N 200 400 350 50 J 200 D
3 800 LK4TU3N 200 500 500 — L 100 D
3 1000 LK4UU3N 200 500 500 — L 100 D
3 1200 LK4WU3N 200 500 500 — L 100 D
100–400 A

Table 8.61: Kits for Compact Switches LK4: 30, 60 and 100 A
Pieces Included [2]
Rating Kit Catalog
(A) Number Compact 400 mm Handle Color / Handle Guide Cone
Switch Shaft NEMA Rating
Black /
LK4DUKB1 LK4DU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 1, 12, 3R LK4AH0110CN GS2AEH12
Black /
LK4DUKB4 LK4DU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 4, 4X LK4AH0410CN GS2AEH12
30 A
Red /
LK4DUKR1 LK4DU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 1, 12, 3R LK4AH0120CN GS2AEH12
Red /
30–100 A Compact LK4DUKR4 LK4DU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 4, 4X LK4AH0420CN GS2AEH12
Black /
LK4GUKB1 LK4GU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 1, 12, 3R LK4AH0110CN GS2AEH12
Black /
LK4GUKB4 LK4GU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 4, 4X LK4AH0410CN GS2AEH12
60 A
Red /
LK4GUKR1 LK4GU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 1, 12, 3R LK4AH0120CN GS2AEH12
Red /
LK4GUKR4 LK4GU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 4, 4X LK4AH0420CN GS2AEH12
Black /
LK4JUKB1 LK4JU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 1, 12, 3R LK4AH0110CN GS2AEH12
Black /
LK4JUKB4 LK4JU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 4, 4X LK4AH0410CN GS2AEH12
100 A
Red /
LK4JUKR1 LK4JU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 1, 12, 3R LK4AH0120CN GS2AEH12
Red /
LK4JUKR4 LK4JU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 4, 4X LK4AH0420CN GS2AEH12

[1] No longer sold as components. Purchase Kits containing Switch, Handle, Shaft, and Guide Cone as listed inTable 8.61.
[2] Components are NOT sold separately. Only 400 mm shaft can be purchase separately.
8-24
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
LK4 Nonfusible and GS2 Fusible UL 98 IEC Style Disconnect Switches
Disconnect Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


DISCONNECT SWITCHES
GS2AH150

GS2AH130

GS2AH170

NOTE: Switches in the shaded area are now available as Kits. SeeTable 8.61.

Table 8.62: Handles and Shafts for LK Switches


Shaft Shaft
Rating Handle 12.6 in. / 15.7 in. / 19.6 in. / Guide Cone[3] Shaft Support

8
(A) 320 mm 400 mm 500 mm Style Bracket
Catalog No. Type Color Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
NOTE: Switches in the shaded area are now available as Kits.
30–100 LK4AH110CN[4] 1, 3R, 12 Black
30–100 LK4AH1120CN[4] 1, 3R, 12 Red/Yellow
LK4AE12CN — — GS2AEH12 AL —
30–100 LK4AH410CN[4] 4, 4X Black
30–100 LK4AH420CN[4] 4, 4X Red/Yellow
100–400 GS2AH130 1, 3R, 12 Black
100–400 GS2AH140 1, 3R, 12 Red
GS2AE2 GS2AE21 GS2AE23 GS2AEH12 B GS2AESB
100–400 GS2AH430 4, 4X Black
100–400 GS2AH440 4, 4X Red/Yellow
600 GS2AH150 1, 3R, 4, 4X, Black
12
600 GS2AH160 1, 3R, 4, 4X, Red/Yellow
12
GS2AE6 GS2AE61 — GS2AEH12 D —
800–1200 GS2AH170 1, 3R, 4, 4X, Black
12
1, 3R, 4, 4X,
800–1200 GS2AH180 Red/Yellow
12

Table 8.63: Auxiliary Contacts for LK Switches


Switch Amperes Catalog No. Description
30–60 MDSAN11 Aux Contact 1 N.O. and 1 N.C.
30–60 MDSAN20 Aux Contact 2 N.O.
100–400 LK4AD10N Aux Contact 1 N.O. and 1 N.C.
100–400 LK4AD20N Aux Contact 2 N.O.
600–1200 LK4AD30N Aux Contact Holder
600–1200 GS2AM110 Aux Contact 1 N.O.
600–1200 GS2AM101 Aux Contact 1 N.C.

Table 8.64: Terminal Shrouds for LK Switches


Switch Amperes Catalog No. Description
30–60 LK4AP3CN Shroud Top and Bottom, 3-Pole
100–200 LK4AP33TN Shroud Top LK4, 3-Pole, 100/200 A
100–200 LK4AP33BN Shroud Bottom LK4, 3-Pole, 100/200 A
400 LK4AP53TN Shroud Top LK4, 3-Pole, 400 A
400 LK4AP53BN Shroud Bottom LK4, 3-Pole, 400 A
600 [5] LK4AP63N Shroud Bottom LK4, 3-Pole, 600 A
800–1200 [5] LK4AP83N Shroud Bottom LK4, 3-Pole, 800–1200 A

[3] Optional on shafts for LK4DU3CN, LK4GU3CN and LK4JU3CN.


[4] No longer sold as components. Purchase Kits containing Switch, Handle, Shaft, and Guide Cone as listed inTable 8.61.
[5] 600–1200 A standard with top shroud.
8-25
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 98 IEC Style Disconnect Switches LK4 Nonfusible and GS2 Fusible
Disconnect Switches
8

Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301 schneider-electric.us

GS2 Fusible Disconnect Switches


Table 8.65: GS Fusible IEC Style Disconnect Switches
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

Short Circuit Current


Rating Maximum Horsepower Rating Rating Shaft
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

Pole Catalog No. 600 Vac


(A) Style
240 V 480 V 600 V 250 Vdc Fuse SCCR kA
3 30 GS1DDU3 7.5 15 20 5 CC 100 AG
3 30 GS1DU3 7.5 15 20 5 J 100 AG
3 30 GS2EEU3 7.5 15 20 5 CC 100 B
3 30 GS2EU3N 7.5 15 20 5 J 100 B
3 60 GS2GU3N 15 30 50 10 J 100 B
3 100 GS2JU3N 30 60 75 20 J 200 B
3 200 GS2MU3N 60 125 150 40 J 200 B
3 400 GS2QU3N 125 250 350 50 J 200 B
3 600 GS2SU3 200 500 500 — J 200 C
3 800 GS2TU3 200 500 500 — J 200 C

GS2GU3N Table 8.66: Handles and Shafts for GS Switches [6]


Shaft: Shaft: Shaft:
12.6 in. 15.7 in. 19.7 in. Shaft
Rat- Handle
(320 mm) (400 mm) (500 mm) Guide Shaft Support
ing
Style Bracket [7]
(A) Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
Type Color
No. No. No. No. No.
1,
30–60 GS2AH110 3R, Black
GS2AH110 12
1, Red/
30–60 GS2AH120 3R, GS2AE8 GS2AE81 — GS2AEH12 AG —
Yellow
12
30–60 GS2AH410 4, 4X Black
4, 4X Red/
30–60 GS2AH420
Yellow
1,
30– GS2AH130 Black
400 3R,
GS2AH130 12
30– 1, Red/
400 GS2AH140 3R, Yellow
12 GS2AE2 GS2AE21 GS2AE23 GS2AEH12 B GS2AESB
30– 4, 4X
GS2AH430 Black
400
30– GS2AH440 4, 4X Red/
400 Yellow
1,
600– GS2AH150 3R, Black
800 4, 4X,
12
GS2AE5 GS2AE51 GS2AE53 GS2AEH12 C —
1,
600– 3R, Red/
GS2AH160
800 4, 4X, Yellow
GS2AH150 12
NOTE: Hole adapter kit for GS1 to GS2 Handles: GS2AH100TO200.
Table 8.67: Auxiliary Contacts for GS Switches [8]
Switch Amperes Catalog No. Description
30–800 GS1AM110 Aux Contact 1 N.O.
30–800 GS1AM101 Aux Contact 1 N.C.
30 GS1AD10 Aux Contact Holder

Table 8.68: Shorting Links


For use on: Shorting Links per Kit Catalog No.
GS2, 60 A 3 GS1AU203
GS2, 100 A 3 GS1AU303
GS2, 200 A 3 GS1AU403
GS2, 400 A 3 GS1AU503
GS2, 600–800 A 3 GS1AU803
Auxiliary Contacts
GS1AD10 + GS2AM110 Table 8.69: NFPA79 Kit
For Use With: Description Kit PartNumber
GS2Q3N NFPA 79 Internal Handle Kit 400 A Switch Shaft GS2AD040N
GS2GU3N, GS2GLU3N,
GS2JU3N, GS2JLU3N NFPA 79 Internal Handle Kit 60–200 A Switch Shaft GS2AD030N
GS1DDU3, GS1DU3 NFPA 79 Internal Handle Kit for 5 mm Shafts GS1AD010

Table 8.70: Terminal Shrouds for GS Switches, Line or Load [9]


Switch Amperes Catalog No. Description
30–100 — Standard on product
200 GS2AP43 GS2, 3-Pole, 200 A
400 GS2AP53 GS2, 3-Pole, 400 A
Shorting Links 600–800 GS2AP73 GS2, 3-Pole, 600–800 A

[6] GS2AH100TO200–GS1 to GS2 Handle Adapter if using GS1 holes.


[7] Not for use with flange disconnects.
[8] GS1DU3 and GS1DDU3 switches allow up to 4 auxiliary contacts without adding contact holder GS1AD10. For more than 4 contacts, GS1AD10 is required.
[9] Order one terminal shroud per side. For example, order one terminal shroud for
either the line side or load side; order two terminal shrouds for both the line side
and load side.
8-26
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories, LK4 Nonfusible and GS2 UL 98 IEC Style Disconnect Switches
Fusible
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches

DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Table 8.71: Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches [10] [11]
Catalog No. Description
200 A and Below
GS2AH36F 36 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 200 A and Below
GS2AH60F 60 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 200 A and Below
GS2AH120F 120 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 200 A and Below
GS2AH144F 144 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 200 A and Below
GS2AH180F 180 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 200 A and Below
400 A
GS2AH460F 60 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 400 A
GS2AH4120F 120 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 400 A
GS2AH4144F 144 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 400 A
GS2AH4180F 180 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 400 A

Flange Handle Table 8.72: Handles for use with Cable Operator Kits
Cable Operator Kit Catalog No. NEMA Type Enclosure Type of Handle

8
9422A1 1, 3, 3R, 4, (Sheet Steel) 6 in.
9422A2 4, 4X (Stainless) 6 in.
9422A3 1, 3, 3R, 4, (Sheet Steel) 4 in.
9422A4 4, 4X (Stainless) 4 in.

Accessories
Table 8.73: Terminal Lugs
No. of Lug Kit
No. of Lugs Lug Size Wire Lugs
For Use On: Rating Wires (AWG) Type Catalog
per Lug per Terminal per Kit
Number
LK4DU3CN 30 1 1 #12–2/0 Cu — Standard
LK4GU3CN 60 1 1 #12–2/0 Cu — Standard
LK4JU3N 100 1 1 6–300 kcmil Cu/Al 6 GS1AW403
LK4MU3N 200 1 1 6–300 kcmil Cu/Al 6 GS1AW403
2 1 350 MCM—6 Cu/Al 6 GS1AW603
LK4QU3N 400 1 600 MCM—4
1 Cu/Al 6 GS1AW606
2 250 MCM—1/0
LK4SU3N 600 2 1 2 x 2–600 kcmil Cu/Al 6 GS1AW503
LK4TU3N 800 2 2 2 x 2–600 kcmil Cu/Al 12 GS1AW903
LK4UU3N 1000 2 2 2 x 2–600 kcmil Cu/Al 12 GS1AW903
LK4WU3N 1200 2 2 2 x 2–600 kcmil Cu/Al 12 GS1AW903
GS1DDU3 30 1 1 #14–#10 Cu — Standard
GS1DU3 30 1 1 #14–#10 Cu — Standard
GS2EEU3 30 1 1 #14–#10 Cu — Standard
GS2EU3N 30 1 1 #14–#6 Cu — Standard
GS2GU3N 60 1 1 #10–#6 Cu — Standard
GS2JU3N 100 1 1 #12–#1 Cu — Standard
GS2MU3N 200 1 1 6–300 kcmil Cu/Al 6 GS1AW403
Terminal Lugs
2 1 350 MCM—6 Cu/Al 6 GS1AW603
GS2QU3N 400 1 600 MCM—4
1 Cu/Al 6 GS1AW606
2 250 MCM—1/0
GS2SU3 600 2 1 2 x 2–600 kcmil Cu/Al 6 GS1AW503
GS2TU3 800 2 1 2 x 2–600 kcmil Cu/Al 6 GS1AW503

Table 8.74: Power Distribution Lugs GS1 or GS2 Only


No. of Wires Lug Size Lugs per Lug Kit
For Use On: Rating Wire Type
per Lug (AWG) Kit Catalog No.
GS1JU3 100 6 #14–#6 Cu 3 GS1AW306 [12]
GS2MU3N 200 12 #14–#4 Cu 3 GS1AW406
GS2QU3N 400 12 #14–#4 Cu 3 GS1AW406
GS2MU3N 200 6 #12–2/0 Cu 3 GS1AW506
GS2QU3N 400 6 #12–2/0 Cu 3 GS1AW506

[10] Does not include handle. For handle, see Table 8.72.
[11] Not compatible with GS2EEU3..
[12] Cannot be used on GS2JU3N.
8-27
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 98 IEC Style Disconnect Switches Dimensions, LK4 Nonfusible and GS2
Fusible
8

Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301 schneider-electric.us

LK4DU3CN and LK4GU3CN, 30–100 A Compact Nonfusible


OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

Disconnect Switches
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

3.133
79.6
2.53 1.02 1.02
64.3 0.543 26 26
13.8 4

5.169
131.3

2.078
52.8

Handle for 30–100 A Compact Nonfusible Disconnect Switches


Ha ndle P a rt No. Right-s ide or Door drilling Door drilling
LK4AH110CN front ope ra tion with 4 fixing s cre ws with fixing nut
LK4AH120CN
LK4AH410CN
LK4AH420CN

LK4JU3N / LK4MU3N / LK4QU3N, 100–400 A Nonfusible


Disconnect Switches—Dimensions
E

Ha ndle P a rt No.
1.74
GS2AH130
(44.2) GS2AH140
GS2AH430
GS2AH440
3.07
(78)
3.07
Ø 1.57
(78)
F B (40)
1.22
Ø 1.10
(31)
(28)

0.27
4x Ø
(7)
4.925
(125.1)

in .
Dim e n s io n s :
mm
D A
C

Dimensions = in. (mm)


Rating (A)
A B C D E F
100–200 3.72 (94.6) 10.1 (256) 7.09 (1.80) 1.97 (50) 6.3 (160) 6.3 (160)
400 4.92 (128) 16 (406) 9.05 (230) 2.56 (65) 8.26 (210) 10.2 (260)

8-28
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Dimensions, LK4 Nonfusible and GS2 UL 98 IEC Style Disconnect Switches
Fusible
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


LK4SU3N, 600 A Nonfusible Disconnect Switches—Dimensions

DISCONNECT SWITCHES
H M

Z J

0.51
13

N1
X

AC

AA
N

8
3.15
80
F

Rating Dimensions = in. (mm)


(A) AC F H J M N N1 AA Z
18.12 5.0 10.03 6.88 2.34 12.6
600 11 (280) 5.5 (140) 1.85 (47)
(460) (127.5) (255) (175) (59.5) (320)

Handle for 600 A and 800 A Fusible Disconnect Switches


Ha ndle P a rt No. Front ope ra tion
GS2AH150 Dire ction of ope ra tion Door drilling te mpla te
GS2AH160

LK4TU3N / LK4UU3N / LK4WU3N, 800–1200 A Nonfusible


Disconnect Switches—Dimensions

Dimensions = in. (mm)


Rating (A)
AC F H J M N N1 Z
800–1200 18.12 (460) 14.64 (372) 5.5 (140) 6.83 (173.5) 13.66 (347) 6.88 (175) 2.34 (59.5) 1.85 (47)

8-29
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 98 IEC Style Disconnect Switches Dimensions, LK4 Nonfusible and GS2
Fusible
8

Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301 schneider-electric.us

Handle for 800–1200 A Fusible Disconnect Switches


Ha ndle P a rt No. Front ope ra tion
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

GS2AH170 Dire ction of ope ra tion Door drilling te mpla te


GS2AH180
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

in.
Dime ns ions :
mm

GS1DDU3, 30 A Fusible Disconnect Switches, Class CC Fuses


and GS1DU3, 30 A Fusible Disconnect Switches, Class J Fuses—
Dimensions
Handle for 30 A and 60 A Fusible Disconnect Switches

Example:
GS1DU3

Dimensions = in. (mm)


Rating (A)
F H J J1 N N1 AA Z
3.28 1.47 3.13 1.12
30 / CC 3.78 (96) (83.5) (37.5) 0.59 (15) (79.5) 1 (25.5) 4.56 (116) (28.5)
1.47 3.13 1.12
30 / J 4.13 (105) 3.89 (99) 0.59 (15) 1 (25.5) 4.56 (116)
(37.5) (79.5) (28.5)

GS2GU3N, 60 A Fusible Disconnect Switches, Class J Fuses

8-30
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Dimensions, LK4 Nonfusible and GS2 UL 98 IEC Style Disconnect Switches
Fusible
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


GS2JU3N, 100 A Fusible Disconnect Switches, Class J Fuses

DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Handle for 100 A, 200 A, and 400 A Fusible Disconnect Switches

8
GS2MU3N, 200 A Fusible Disconnect Switches, Class J Fuses

8-31
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Flange Mounted and Cable Operated Dimensions, LK4 Nonfusible and GS2
Fusible
8

Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301 schneider-electric.us

GS2QU3N, 400 A Fusible Disconnect Switches, Class J Fuses


OPERATING MECHANISMS AND
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

GS2SU3, 600 A Fusible Disconnect Switches, Class J Fuses


GS2TU3, 800 A Fusible Disconnect Switches, Class J Fuses
Handle for 600 A and 800 A Fusible Disconnect Switches

8-32
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Disconnect Switches Flange Mounted and Cable Operated
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Disconnect Switches
The 9422 disconnect switches are the ideal selections for the PV String Combiner Box
internal disconnect switch and control panel applications. These switches are designed
for variable depth, flange mounting, traditional side mounting and bracket mounting
applications providing complete flexibility in the PV string combiner box designs. The
switches are compatible with 9422A handle operators and 9423 door mechanisms and
are UL 98 recognized (E52369 Vol. 1, Sec. 18) and CSA certified. See page 8-34, page
8-37, and page 8-38 for dimensional information.

Table 8.75: 9422 Disconnect Switches, Flange Mounted and Variable Depth
Switch and Switch Used with Switch and Operating
Maximum Horsepower Ratings Fuse Clip Rating Cable Operators Mechanism with Handle
(A), Non- Operating
Mechanism ONLY ONLY (No Handle Mechanism, Overpacked[2]
Disconnect Variable Interchangeable Mechanism or
AC Systems Volts Fuse Type, For Class H, (No Handle
Switch Depth Cable Operator) Type A1 Handle Type A2 Handle
(Motor Volts) Vdc Type J, K or R Fuses Mechanism)
Size (in.) [1]
208 240 480 600
250 600 250 V 600 V Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.

8
(200) (230) (460) (575)
None — — 9422TCN30 9422TCN30C 9422ATCN301 9422ATCN302
30 A 6.625–18 7.5 7.5 15 20 5 15 H, J, 30 — 9422TCF30 9422TCF30C 9422ATCF301 9422ATCF302
K, R 60 30 9422TCF33 9422TCF33C 9422ATCF331 9422ATCF332
None — — 9422TDN60 9422TDN60C 9422ATDN601 9422ATDN602
60 A 6.625–18 — 15 30 50 10 30 H, J, 60 30 9422TDF60 9422TDF60C 9422ATDF601 9422ATDF602
K, R — 60 9422TDF63 9422TDF63C 9422ATDF631 9422ATDF632
None — — 9422TEN10 9422TEN10C 9422ATEN101 9422ATEN102
100 A 6.625–18 25 30 60 75 20 50 H, J,
K, R 100 100 9422TEF10 9422TEF10C 9422ATEF101 9422ATEF102
None — — 9422TF1 — 9422ATF11 9422ATF21
9.12–19.25 200 200 9422TF2 — 9422ATF12 9422ATF22
200 A [3] 40 60 125 150 40 50 H, J,
K, R — 400 9422TF3 [4] — 9422ATF13 [4] 9422ATF23 [4]
11.38
400 A (A5 or A6
Fixed Depth [5] None — — 9422TG1 [6][7] —
Handle) For handle selection, see page 8-
75 125 250 350 50 50
400 A 15.87–19 34.
Variable Depth (A7 or A8 H, J, 9422TG2 [6][9]
K, R 400 400 —
[5] Handle) [8]

The 9422 Bracket Mount Disconnect Switch is designed for combiner boxes and control
panel applications. The Bracket Mount Disconnect Switch is shipped with the switch and
external handle assembled to a bracket, ready for quick installation. A protective trim
plate is provided to prevent any mounting screws from being accessible from the front.
The trim plate also provides an attractive installation feature. The switches are fully
compatible with the 9423 closing mechanisms.

9422TCN30 Table 8.76: 9422 Bracket Mounted Disconnect Switches


Maximum Horsepower Rating Fuse Clip Rating Switch and
(A), Non- Operating
Disconnect Interchangeable Mechanism
AC Systems (Motor Volts) Vdc Fuse Type for Class H,
Switch Type Only
Size J, K, or R Fuses
208 240 480 600
(200) (230) (460) (575) 250 600 250 V 600 V Cat. No.
None — — 9422BTCN30
H, J, K, 30 — 9422BTCF30
30 A 7.5 7.5 15 20 5 15 R 60 30 9422BTCF33
J [10] 60 30 9422BTCF32
None — — 9422BTDN60
H, J, K, 60 30 9422BTDF60
60 A 15 15 30 50 10 30 R — 60 9422BTDF63
J [10] — 60 9422BTDF62
None — — 9422BTEN10
H, J, K, 100 100 9422BTEF10
100 A 25 30 60 75 20 50 R
J [10] 100 100 9422BTEF11
None — — 9422TFB1
H, J, K, 200 200 9422TFB2
200 A 40 60 125 150 40 50 R
Bracket Mounted J [10] — 400 9422TFB3
Disconnect Switch

[1] See Table 8.81 for ordering information for the cable operator.
[2] Variable depth only — no cable operator.
[3] 9422 R2 will extend maximum mounting depth 7 inches, see Table 8.86for information.
[4] Accommodates Class J fuses only.
[5] Switches are fixed-depth or adjustable depending on handle selection.
[6] Commercially available enclosures may not accept 9422TG1 and 2 operating mechanisms. Contact enclosure manufacturer for availability of enclosures for use with these switches.
[7] Right hand flange mounting only and requires a special enclosure.
[8] Variable in increments of 0.63 inches.
[9] Right hand flange mounting only and requires a special enclosure.
[10] Space saving design—Type J fuses mounted on the non-fused bracket.
8-33
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Flange Mounted and Cable Operated Accessories, Disconnect Switches
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
8

schneider-electric.us

Handle Information for 9422 Disconnect Switches


The Handle Mechanism Kit contains all parts needed to mount the handle to the flange of
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

the enclosure. Two flange mounting methods are offered. For right or left hand flange
mounting use Types A1–A4 and Types A9–A10 kits. For right-hand mounting only, use
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

Type A5–A8 handles. The type AP1 and AP2 handles are used exclusively on the
PowerPact™ M and P operating mechanisms, 9422 RM1 and 9422 CMP. The
dimensions are identical to 9422 A1.

Type A1

Table 8.77: 9422 Disconnect Switch and Circuit Breaker Handle Mechanisms
NEMA Type 1, 3, 3R, 4, 12 NEMA Type 4, 4X Stainless
Handle Depth (in.) Enclosures Steel Enclosures
Cat. No. Cat. No.
4 [11] 9422A3 9422A4
6 [11] 9422A1 9422A2
6 [12] 9422AP1 9422AP2
10 [13] 9422A9 9422A10
10 9422AP9 9422AP10
12 [14] [15] 9422A7 9422A8

Accessories
Class R Fuse Kits
When installed, this kit rejects all fuses except Class R. The kits are available for field
installation. With rejection kit and Class R fuses installed, the switch is UL component
recognized for use on systems with fault current up to 200,000 RMS symmetrical
amperes.

Table 8.78: Class R Fuse Kits


Disconnect Switch Switch Fuse Clip Rating Class R Kit
Type Type 250 V[16] 600 V Cat No.
TCF30 30 — RFK03 [17]
30 A
TCF33 60 30 RFK06 [17]
TDF60 60 30 RFK06 [17]
60 A
TDF63 — 60 RFK06H [17]
100 A TEF10 100 100 RFK10 [17]
TF2 200 200 9999SR4
200 A
TF3 200 200 9999SR4
400 A TG2 400 400 9999SR5

Electrical Interlocks for Disconnect Switches


Table 8.79: Electrical Interlocks
Disconnect Electrical Interlocks
Switch Type
Switch Size Cat No.
TCF, TCN, TDF, TDN, 9999TC10 [18]
30 A TEF, TEN 9999TC20 [19]
60 A
100 A 9999TC11 [18]
BTCF, BTCN, BTDF, BTDN, BTEF, BTEN
9999TC21 [19]
TF, ATF 9999R8 [18]
200 A
TF, ATF 9999R9 [19]
TG 9999R35 [18]
400 A
TG 9999R36 [19]

[11] Use with 30–200 A 9422 switches and all circuit breaker mechanisms.
[12] Use only with 9422 RM1, 9422 CMP and PowerPact M and P operating mechanisms.
[13] Use with Type D2 remote or dual adapter kit.
[14] Use only with 400 A 9422TG1 and 9422TG2 disconnect switch.
[15] Adjustable depth.
[16] Use Discount Schedule DE1, not CP1.
[17] Use Discount Schedule DE1 for price, not CP1.
[18] 1 N.C. or N.O. Contact depending on wiring.
[19] 2 N.C. or N.O. or 1 N.O. or 1 N.C. Contact depending on wiring.
8-34
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories, Disconnect Switches Flange Mounted and Cable Operated
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


Internal Barrier Kits

DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Provides an additional barrier that helps prevent accidental contact with live parts. Field-
installed transparent barriers do not restrict visual inspection of the switch. Barriers
provide IEC529 IP2X “finger safe” protection when door of enclosed disconnect switch is
open. A convenient door allows use of test probes without accessing fuses and
replacement of fuses without removing barrier. Barrier must be used with the skirt kit to
enclose a panel mounted 9422 disconnect.

Table 8.80: Internal Barrier Kits


Barrier Skirt
Disconnect
Switch Size Cat. No. Cat No.
[20] [20]
30 A SS06 SS0306SK
60 A SS06 SS0306SK
100 A SS10 SS10SK

8
Cable Operators for 9422 Disconnect Switches
Table 8.81: Cable Operators for 9422 Disconnect Switches
Cable Mechanisms with
Cable Mechanisms [21] A1 Handle for NEMA Type 1,
Switch Type 3, 3R, 4, and 12 Enclosures
Cable Length
(inches) Cat. No. Cat. No.
36 9422CFT30 9422CFT31
TCN30C, TCF30C, TCF33C, 48 9422CFT40 —
TDN60C, TDF60C, TDF63C,
TEN10C, TEF10C 60 9422CFT50 9422CFT51
120 9422CFT10 9422CFT11

Table 8.82: Class 9422 Replacement / Refrofit Fuse Clip Kits


Line and Load Fuse
Disconnect Fuse Clip Rating Clip Kit (includes load
Switch Switch Type Fuse Type (Amperes) base
Size and fuse pullers)
9422CFT40 250 V 600 V Cat. No.
TCF30 30 — 9422TC30
30 A TCN30 H, K, J, R
TCF33 60 30 9422TC33
60 30 9422TC33
60 A TDN60 H, K, J, R
— 60 9422TD63

Table 8.83: Lug Data


Disconnect Wire Size (Min-Max) Lug Kits Lug Kits Al
Switch Copper
Size Cu Al Cat No. Cat No.
30–60 A #14–#2 #10–#2 CL0306F AL0306F
100 A #10–#0 #6–#0 CL10F AL10F
200 A #6–600 kcmil #6–#600 kcmil — —
400 A #4–500 kcmil — — —

[20] Use Discount Schedule DE1 for price, not CP1.


[21] Purchase handle mechanism separately (9422A1, A2, A3, or A4).
8-35
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Flange Mounted and Cable Operated Accessories, Disconnect Switches
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
8

schneider-electric.us

Table 8.84: Dimensions 30, 60, and 100 A Class 9422 Disconnect Switches
Switch Maximum Voltage Fuse Type Dimension A Dimension B
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

Type
30 A, 250 V H, K, R 1.625
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

30 A 30 A, 600 V H, K, R 4.25
30 A, 600 V J 1.625

60 A, 250 V H, K, R 2.25
60 A 60 A, 600 V H, K, R 4.75
60 A, 600 V J 1.625
100 A, 250 V H, K, R 3.25
100 A 100 A, 600 V H, K, R — 5.25
100 A, 600 V J 3.25

F
0.38
10
C
0.38
10
Disconnect
Device ON

A E
OFF

Non Fused
D 0.38 and Circuit
10
Breaker
Disconnect
Device Fused
(2) 0.38 Dia. Mounting Holes
10
(For back panel support if necessary.)

Table 8.85: Dimensions


E
Min. Enclosure in. (mm)
A C D F
Type Depth [22]
in. (mm) in. (mm) in. (mm) in. (mm) Fusible in. (mm)
Device
BTCN, BTDN, 6.56 (167) 8.00 (203)
BTEN — — — —
BTCF, BTDF, BTEF 9.50 (241) 1.88 (48) 8.56 (217) 10.00 (254) 11.88 (302) 6.38 (162)
TFB1 11.50 (292) 3.88 (99) 9.50 (241) 12.00 (305) — 13.19 (335)
NOTE: Back panel support is recommended for Types TFB1, 2, & 3. Other devices
may also require support if the flange is not sufficiently rigid.

[22] The minimum enclosure depth is greater than Dimension D since additional space is needed when mounting the mechanism.
8-36
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Dimensions, Disconnect Switches Flange Mounted and Cable Operated
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Dimensions
Table 8.86: Dimensions (in. / mm) for 200 A Type TF Disconnect Switches
Switch Size D [23]
Type A B C E F G H J K L M N P Q R S T
(A) Fuse Clips Min.–Max.
13.33 9.38 1.64 9.12–19.25 2.33 8.00 9.44 6.50 9.53 3.14 1.03 0.75
TF1 200 None 339 238 232 489 59 203 — — — 240 165 — — — 80 26 19
42 242
Class J 13.33 9.38 1.64 9.12–19.25 2.33 8.00 0.09 2.77 9.44 6.50 14.11 9.63 3.14 1.03 0.75
TF2 200 200 A 600 V 339 238 232 489 59 203 3 — 70 240 165 — 358 — 245 80 26 19
42
Class H, K, R 13.33 9.38 1.64 9.12–19.25 2.33 8.00 0.09 4.14 9.44 6.50 15.48 9.63 3.14 1.03 0.75
TF2 200 — — —
200 A 250 V 339 238 42 232 489 59 203 3 105 240 165 393 245 80 26 19
Class H, K, R 13.33 9.38 1.64 9.12–19.25 2.33 8.00 0.09 6.64 9.44 6.50 17.98 9.63 3.14 1.03 0.75
TF2 200 200 A 600 V 339 238 232 489 59 203 3 — 169 240 165 — 457 — 245 80 26 19
42
TF3 200 Class J 13.33 9.38 1.64 9.12–19.25 2.33 8.00 0.09 2.77 9.44 6.50 9.53 18.53 9.63 3.14 1.03 0.75
400 A 600 V 339 238 232 489 59 203 3 — 70 240 165 — 245 80 26 19
42 242 471

[23] The dimensions shown may be extended 7 in. by using 9422R2 (two required per switch).
8-37
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Flange Mounted and Cable Operated Dimensions, Disconnect Switches
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
8

schneider-electric.us

Disconnect Switches—400 A Type TG


Outline Dimensions and General Location
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

400 A Disconnect Switches Nonfusible and Non-Interchangeable Fuse Clip Type Fusible
Switches
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

Table 8.87: Handle Mechanism—Type A7 and A8


3.75 Max. 1.44 NOTE: Commercially available enclosures may not accept type TG operating
95 "On" 37
mechanisms. Contact the enclosure manufacturer for availability of enclosures for use
Enclosure
Flange
with these switches.
Switch
Type B X 3.00
11.69 76
1.88 297
TG1, 2 11.28 16.06
48 286 408 B
13.00 X
11.50 330
292
NOTE: B and X = Minimum to wall or
barrier to ensure adequate wire bending
Operating
space to lug surface when maximum 1.50
Link wire size is used. 4.78 38 4.88
121 0.75 124
19 24.00
Refer to NEC Article 430.10. 610
0.38
CL of Operating
10
Mechanism
9.88 Door Hook
251
Door 4.25
108 0.50
13

8.50
CL of Operating 216
Defeater
Guide Handle 7.50
3.63 191
for
Class 9423
92 23.81
Type M1 Kit 605
Figure 1

Figure 2 (2) 0.34 Dia.


9 Holes
(2) Switch Mtg.
Brackets

(2) Mtg. Holes


in Switch Mtg. D30064-973 B
Surface

Figure 3

*D 13.54
Table 8.88: Nonfusible and Fusible Switches 5.50 1.86 1.40 12.14
344
0.86
Dimension D = Distance from outside of flange to 140 47 36 308 22
disconnect switch mounting surface. 0.60
15 B
For Type TG1 or TG2 with:
Type A7 or A8 adjustable 15.87 19
depth handle mechanism D= to
403 483
In steps of 0.63
16
Weld
NOTE: Copper lugs are standard on all Type TG
disconnect switches. CL of Operating
Mechanism

* D = Mounting depth measured from the switch mounting surface to 23.80 25.00
604 635
the surface of flange.

24.00
610

8.38
213
6.97
177
3.97
101
Class J use
F
Weld 400 A 600Volt

Class H, ,KR F
uses Enclosure
400 A 250Volt Provision for (2) 5/16 Mtg. Screws
Class H, ,KR Fuses
400 A 600Volt
8.13
206

Dim. = in.
mm

8-38
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Door Mounted Operating Mechanisms for Circuit Breakers
Class 9421 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Type L Circuit Breaker Mechanisms
Type L door-mounted, variable depth operating mechanisms feature heavy duty, all
metal construction with trip indication. All mechanisms can be padlocked in the Off
position when the enclosure door is open. Further, the handle assemblies can be locked
Off with up to three padlocks, which also locks the enclosure when the door is closed.
(The 3 in. handle accepts one padlock.) Complete kits are rated for NEMA 1, 3R, and 12
enclosures. They include a handle assembly, operating mechanism, and shaft assembly.

Table 8.89: Complete Kits


Complete Kit Includes Operating Mechanism and Handle
Does Not Include Circuit Breaker
Standard 6 in. Handle Short 3 in. Handle
Use With
Standard Shaft Kit Long Shaft Kit Long Shaft Kit
Circuit Breaker or No. Frame
Size Mounting Mounting Mounting
Interrupter Type of Cat. No. Depth [1] Cat. No. Depth [1] Cat. No. Depth [1]
Poles (A)
5.50– 5.50– 5.50–

8
PowerPact™ B 2–3 125 9421LB1 9421LB4 9421LB3
10.75 21.38 21.38
9421 Type L PowerPact H and J; 5.50– 5.50– 5.50–
Circuit Breaker Operating Mechanism 2–3 250 9421LJ1 9421LJ4 9421LJ3
NSF 10.75 21.38 21.38
7.25– 7.25– 3 in. handles are not
PowerPact D and L 2–3 600 9421LD1 12.06 9421LD4 22.63 recommended for use
PowerPact M and P 9421LW1 9.00– 9421LW4 9.00– with these circuit
[2] 3 1200 [3] 12.50 [4] 23.50 breakers.

Table 8.90: Component Parts


3 in. Handle Standard Handle Operating Standard Shaft Long Shaft
Use With Assemblies Assemblies Mechanism (Support Bracket Not Required) (Support Bracket Included)
NEMA 1, 3R, 12 NEMA 1, 3R, 12 Includes Lockout
Circuit Breaker or No. of Frame Mounting Mounting
Interrupter Type Size (A) Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Depth [5] Cat. No. Depth [5] Cat. No.
Poles
PowerPact B 2–3 125 9421LH3 [6] 9421LH6 [6] 9421LB7 5.50–10.75 9421LS8 5.50–21.38 9421LS13
PowerPact H & J; NSF 2–3 250 9421LH3 [6] 9421LH6 [6] 9421LJ7 5.50–10.25 9421LS8 5.50–21.38 9421LS13
PowerPact D & L 2–3 600 [7] 9421LH6 [6] 9421LD7 7.25–12.06 9421LS8 7.25–22.63 9421LS13
PowerPact M & P [2] 3 1200 [7] 9421LHP8 [6] 9421LW7 7.19–11.63 9421LS8 7.19–22.25 9421LS10

Table 8.91: NEMA 4 and 4X Handle Assemblies


Use With Standard Handle Assemblies Special 3 in. Version
NEMA 1, 3R, 4, 12 NEMA 1, 3R, 4, 4X, 12 NEMA 1, 3R, 4, 12 NEMA 1, 3R, 4, 4X, 12
Circuit Breaker or No. of Frame (Painted) (Chrome Plated) (Painted) (Chrome Plated)
Interrupter Type Poles Size (A)
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
PowerPact B 2–3 125 9421LH46 9421LC46 9421LH43 9421LC43
PowerPact H and J; NSF 2–3 250 9421LH46 9421LC46 9421LH43 9421LC43
PowerPact D and L 2–3 600 9421LH46 9421LC46 3 in. handles are not recommended for use with these circuit
PowerPact M and P 3 1200 9421LHP48 9421LCP48 breakers.

Table 8.92: Auxiliary and Alarm Switches for PowerPactTM Circuit Breakers [8]
Description B-Frame H- and J-Frame D- and L-Frame D- and L-Frame
1 Auxiliary Switch 1a 1b LV26950 S29450 S29450 S29450
2 Auxiliary Switch 2a 2b — 2 x S29450 2 x S29450 2 x S29450
3 Auxiliary Switch 3a 3b — — 3 x S29450 3 x S29450
NOTE: The location of the accessory in the circuit breaker determines its function.

3 in. Handle Assembly


Standard Handle Assembly

[1] Mounting depth measured in inches from circuit breaker mounting surface (control panel) to outside of enclosure door.
[2] These circuit breaker operating mechanisms must use the 9421LHP** or LCP** handles only.
[3] Type LW1 and LW4 include an 8 in. handle (9421LHP8) rather than a 6 in. handle.
[4] Type LW1 and LW4 include an 8 in. handle (9421LHP8) rather than a 6 in. handle.
[5] Mounting depth measured in inches from circuit breaker mounting surface (control panel) to outside of enclosure door.
[6] For a red handle and yellow bezel, add suffix RY to catalog number, e.g., 9421LH6RY.
[7] 3 in. handles are not recommended for use with these circuit breakers.
[8] Discount Schedule: DE2.
8-39
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Operating Mechanisms for Circuit Breakers Door Mounted
Class 9421 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
8

schneider-electric.us

Dimensions for Type L Operating Mechanisms


Panel Drilling for PowerPactTM H and J Circuit Breaker Panel Drilling for PowerPactTM D and L Circuit Breaker
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

Operating Mechanisms: 9421LJ1, 9421LJ4, and 9421LJ7 Operating Mechanisms: 9421LD1, 9421LD4, and 9421LD7
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

Panel Drilling for PowerPactTM M and P Circuit Breaker


Operating Mechanisms: 9421LW1, 9421LW4, and 9421LW7

Table 8.93: Shaft Cutting Dimensions


Shaft Length H = Standard Shaft H = Long Shaft
Class Type
Formula Min. Max. Min. Max.
5.5 10.75 5.5 21.63
9421 LJ1, LJ4, LJ7 L = H – 3.00 (76)
(138) (273) (138) (543)
7.25 12.06 7.25 22.63
9421 LD1, LD4, LD7 L = H – 4.25 (108)
(184) (306) (184) (575)
7.19 11.63 7.19 22.25
9421 LW1, LW4, LW7 L = H – 4.89 (124)
(183) (295) (183) (565)

8-40
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Flexible Cable Mechanisms Operating Mechanisms for Circuit Breakers
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Flexible Cable Mechanisms
• For use with Class 9422 handle operators (you must select a 9422A• handle to
complete the operating mechanism)

• Specially designed for tall, deep enclosures where placement flexibility is required
Table 8.94: Flexible Cable Mechanisms for use with Schneider Electric™ (formerly
Merlin Gerin™) Circuit Breakers and PowerPact™ 3-Pole Circuit Breakers
Circuit Breaker Cable Mechanism
Type No. of Poles Frame Size (A)
Length Catalog No.
 36 in. 9422CSB30
PowerPact  60 in. 9422CSB50
2–3 125
B-Frame  84 in. 9422CSB70
120 in. 9422CSB10
 36 in. 9422CSF30
MG-NSF  60 in. 9422CSF50
PowerPact 2–3 250

8
H- and J-Frame  84 in. 9422CSF70
120 in. 9422CSF10
 36 in. 9422CSF304
MG-NSF 4 250  60 in. 9422CSF504
120 in. 9422CSF104
 36 in. 9422CSJ30
Flexible Cable Mechanism MG-NSJ PowerPact
3 600  60 in. 9422CSJ50
9422CSJ30 D- and L-Frame
120 in. 9422CSJ10
 36 in. 9422CSJ304
MG-NSJ PowerPact
D- and L-Frame 4 600  60 in. 9422CSJ504
120 in. 9422CSJ104
48 in. 9422CMP40
PowerPact M- and
P-Frame [9] 3 1200 50 in. 9422CMP50
120 in. 9422CMP10

NOTE: Refer to NEC Article 430-10 for minimum dimension X from


circuit breaker top mounting hole to wall or barrier to ensure adequate
wire bending space.
NOTE: Bend radius in cable must never be less than 6 inches.
Electrical clearances must be maintained between cable and live
electrical parts.

[9] Must use 9422AP1 or 9422AP2 Handle with this operating mechanism.
8-41
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Operating Mechanisms for Circuit Breakers Flexible Cable Mechanisms
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
8

schneider-electric.us

Dual Cable Operating Mechanisms for Square D™ Circuit Breakers


Dual Cable Operating Mechanisms are designed for use with Square D brand
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

PowerPact™ B, D, H, J, and L circuit breakers through 600 A frame sizes. The cable
mechanisms allow for a single handle operator, Class 9422Ax, to operate both circuit
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

breakers. The cable mechanism is designed especially for tall, deep enclosures where
placement flexibility is required. There are numerous cable arrangements to choose from
to accommodate many applications.
Features

• Separate cables for each circuit breaker


• Rugged metal flange handle operator
• Maximized flexibility of circuit breaker placement for existing and new applications
• Control panel can be fed from two separate supply voltages (if required)
• Dual mechanism allows both separate supply voltages to be controlled by a single
handle to improve security features

Table 8.95: Dual Cable Operating Mechanisms Selection


Cable Length Catalog Frame Size
Circuit Breaker Type in. / mm (quantity) (max.)
Number
120 in. / 3048 mm (2) 9422CSBD1
36 in. / 914 mm (1)
60 in. / 1524 mm (1) 9422CSBD35
60 in. / 1524 mm (1-CSF 3 pole)
60 in. / 1524 mm (1-CSF 4 pole) 9422CSBD55
PowerPact B 125 A
36 in. / 914 mm (1)
120 in. / 3048 mm (1) 9422CSBD31
36 in. / 914 mm (2) 9422CSBD33
60 in. / 1524 mm (1)
9422CSFD33 120 in. / 3048 mm (1) 9422CSBD51
120 in. / 3048 mm (2) 9422CSFD1
36 in. / 914 mm (1)
60 in. / 1524 mm (1) 9422CSFD35
60 in. / 1524 mm (1-CSF 3 pole)
60 in. / 1524 mm (1-CSF 4 pole) 9422CSFD345
PowerPact H & J 36 in. / 914 mm (1)
MG NSF 9422CSFD31 250 A
120 in. / 3048 mm (1)
36 in. / 914 mm (2) 9422CSFD33
60 in. / 1524 mm (1)
120 in. / 3048 mm (1) 9422CSFD51
60 in. / 1524 mm (2) 9422CSFD55
60 in. / 1524 mm (2-CSJ) 9422CSJD50
[10]
120 in. / 3048 mm (2-CSJ) 9422CSJD10
[10] 600 A
PowerPact D & L 60 in. / 1524 mm and 9422CSJD51
MG NSJ 120 in. / 3048 mm (2-CSJ) [10]
120 in. / 3048 mm (1-CSF) and
120 in. / 3048 mm (1-CSJ) 9422CSFJD10 250 A
and
60 in. / 1524 mm (1-CSF) 600 A
60 in. / 1524 mm (1-CSJ) 9422CSFJD50

Handle Mechanisms
These handle mechanism kits are used with the circuit breaker variable depth and cable
operating mechanisms. The kits contain all parts necessary for mounting the handle to
the flange of the enclosure. Types A1/AP1 to A4 are suitable for right or left-hand flange
mounting.
For handle selection, see Table 8.77.
NOTE: See Handle Information, page 8-34 for dimensional information.

Handle Mechanisms

[10] Must use the 9422AP1 or 9422AP2 operating handle with this operating mechanism.
8-42
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Flexible Cable Mechanisms Operating Mechanisms for Circuit Breakers
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


Flange-Mounted, Variable-Depth Operating Mechanisms

DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Designed for installation in custom built control enclosures where main or branch circuit
protective devices are required. All circuit breaker operating mechanisms are suitable for
either right- or left-hand flange mounting, convertible on the job.
NOTE: The operating mechanisms do not include handle mechanisms. You must
select a 9422A• handle to complete the installation.
Table 8.96: Variable-Depth Operating Mechanisms for Use with Schneider
Electric™ Brand Circuit Breakers (Formerly Merlin Gerin™ Brand)
Use with Operating Mechanism
Frame Variable Depth (Does Not Include Handle
No. of Mtg. Range (in.) Mechanism)
Circuit Breaker Frame Size Size
9422 Type R Poles [11]
A Cat. No.
Circuit Breaker Mechanism
Schneider Electric (formerly Merlin Gerin) Circuit Breakers and PowerPact™ Frame 3-Pole Circuit Breakers
PowerPact B-Frame 2–3  125 5.88–17.75 9422RB1
MG-NSF PowerPact H- and J-Frame 2–3  250 5.88–17.75 9422RQ1
MG-NSJ PowerPact D-and L-Frame 3  600 9.00–17.75 9422RS1
PowerPact M- and P-Frame [12] 3 1200 10.50–18.38 9422RM1

8
Table 8.97: Electrical Interlocks—Class 9999
Description Cat. No.
Single Pole, Double Throw 9999R26
Double Pole, Double Throw 9999R27

[11] Class 9422 Type R2 will extend mounting depth 7 inches—not recommended for use with the 9422RM1 operating mechanism (see Table 8.77).
[12] These circuit breaker operating mechanisms must use the 9422APx handles.
8-43
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Operating Mechanisms for Circuit Breakers Flexible Cable Mechanisms
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
8

schneider-electric.us

Dimensions
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

Minimum to wall or barrier to insure adequate wire bending space to


lug surface when the maximum wire size is used with standard lugs.
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

Refer to NEC 430-10.


Dimensions: in.
mm

8-44
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Introduction Door Closing Mechanisms
Class 9423 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Door Closing Mechanisms
Class 9423 door closing mechanisms cover a range of enclosures with door openings up
to a maximum of 91 in. high. The door closing mechanisms are designed to be used on
control enclosures and interlocked with a Class 9422 disconnect device, although they
all can be used independently. Three different systems are available, and their use is as
recommended below. A complete system is available for interlocking all the doors of a
multi-door enclosure with the master door when using the 6 in. or 8 in. vault handle
mechanism.
Note that the “Master Door” is defined to be the door of a single or multi-door enclosure
which is interlocked directly with the disconnect device. The master door can be hinged
on either the right or left hand side. It can be located in any position on a multi-door
enclosure. An “Auxiliary Door” is defined to be any remaining doors of a multi-door
enclosure which are interlocked with the master door by means of the overhead
interlocking system as illustrated on page 8-45 and page 8-46.
Selection Procedure

8
1. Determine enclosure construction (no. of doors, door height, hinge location, etc.).
2. Determine Class 9422 disconnect device to be used—either a disconnect switch or a
circuit breaker mechanism.
3. Determine the location of the disconnect device and handle mechanism (right- or
left-hand flange or center channel).
4. Select the door closing mechanism required.
5. Select the auxiliary door closing mechanisms and multi-door interlocking hardware, if
required. (A complete system for interlocking all auxiliary doors of a multi-door
enclosure with center channel is available for the medium and large enclosures.)
Table 8.98: Door Closing Mechanism
60 in. Maximum Door 46–60 in. Door 61–91 in. Door
Opening Opening Opening
(Recommended) (Recommended) (Recommended)
• 2 Point Locking is
Standard
• For use on Single
or
• For use on Single or
Multi-Door
• A Third Roller
Latch Kit is
Multi-Door
Enclosures

Enclosures
For use with Doors
Available for 3
Point Locking
• For use with
Doors Hinged on
Hinged on Right or
Left Side
• For 3/4 in. Door
Right or Left Side
• Referred to as the 8
Depths • Referred to as the
6 in. Vault Handle
in. Vault Handle
Mechanism
Mechanism • For 1-1/8 in. Door
• For 3/4 in. Door
Depths
Depths

Type M4 Latch bar not included, but most prepunched enclosures that
accept Square D™ operating mechanisms supply a pre-drilled latch
bar.

The door closing mechanisms listed below are for use on small to medium size single
door control enclosures. They are designed to be used in conjunction with Class 9422
flange-mounted disconnect switches and circuit breaker operating mechanisms;
however, they can be used independently as well. When used on properly designed and
gasketed NEMA Type 12 enclosures, they meet NFPA 79 standards.

Table 8.99: Single Door Enclosures—NEMA Type 4 or 12 with 60 in. High Maximum
Opening
For Use On: Door Suggested
Use in Latch Door
Description (Enclosure Conjunction Handle Maximum Cat. No.
Type) Door Opening Depth
With: Length
NEMA Class 9422 4 in. Less than 39 in. 3/4 in. 9423M4
Two point, roller latch, Type 4 and 12 Types A1, A3, 4 in. Less than 39 in. [1] 9423M10
door closing mechanism Sheet Steel A9
for use on enclosures with 6 in. 60 in. 3/4 in. 9423M9
doors hinged on the left NEMA Type 4 Class 9422
side. and 12 Stainless Types A2, A4, 4 in. Less than 39 in. 3/4 in. 9423M24
Steel A10
Circuit Breaker
Operating Mechanism NEMA Type 4 Class 9422 4 in. Less than 39 in. 3/4 in. 9423M4L
Two point, roller latch, and 12 Sheet Types A1, A3, 4 in. Less than 39 in. [1] 9423M10L
door closing mechanism Steel A9
for use on enclosures with 6 in. 60 in. 3/4 in. 9423M9L
doors hinged on the right NEMA Type 4 Class 9422
side. and 12 Stainless Types A2, A4, 4 in. Less than 39 in. 3/4 in. 9423M24L
Steel A10
NEMA Type 4 Class 9423
Third roller latch kit for and 12 Sheet Types M4, M9, — — 3/4 in. 9423M3
3 point locking; for use Steel M4L, M9L
where 3 point locking is
desired or where the door NEMA Type 4 Class 9423
opening is ≥39 in. and 12 Stainless Types M24, — — 3/4 in. 9423M23
Steel M24L

[1] Suitable for door depths of 1-1/8 in., 1-1/4 in., 1-3/8 in. and 1-1/2 in.
8-45
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Door Closing Mechanisms Types M5, M6, M1, and M8
Class 9423 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
8

schneider-electric.us

Vault Type for Single and Multi-Door Enclosures


OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

Table 8.100 shows the requirements for the door closing mechanism, the locking bar kit,
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

and the mechanical interlock kit, if used.

Table 8.100: Single or Multi-Door Enclosures—NEMA Type 12 with 40 in. to 60 in. Door Opening
Single-Door Enclosure Multi-Door Enclosure
Without Interlocking With Interlocking Without Interlocking With Interlocking
For Master door: For each Auxiliary door:
1—M6 door closing mechanism For each door: 1—M6 door closing mechanism 1—M6 door closing mechanism
1—M6 door closing mechanism 1—Type M660 locking bar kit
1—M6 door closing mechanism 1—Type M660 locking bar kit 1—Type M660 locking bar kit
1—Type M660 locking bar kit 1—Type M5 (use with 9422A 1—Type M660 locking bar kit 1—Type M5 (for use with 9422A Necessary quantities of Types M2
handles)
handles) and M7 for each door (see below)

NOTE: All mechanisms listed on this page are suitable for either left or right hand
mounting.
1/4 in. Dia. Rod (supplied by user)

Table 8.101: Door Interlocks


Type Description
The Class 9423 Type M6 door closing mechanism is designed to close and seal 0.75 in.
Type M6 Door Closing deep doors of single or multi-door NEMA Type 12 enclosures. The Type M6 can be used
Mechanism on doors hinged on either the left or right hand side. Recommended door openings are
from 40–60 in. Vault type handle length is 6 in.
Locking
The lock bar kit for the Type M6 door closing mechanism contains two lock bars and is
Locking Type M660 Locking Bar available from stock. The bars can be cut to fit door openings through 60 in. One lock bar
Bar Bar Kits kit is required for each Type M6 ordered.
The Class 9423 Type M5 mechanical interlock kit is designed to interlock a Class 9422
handle mechanism with the Type M6 door closing mechanism. This kit prevents the
Type M5 opening of the master door (or single door) with the disconnect handle in the “ON”
position, making it mandatory to use a screwdriver to gain entry to the enclosure at any
A time, regardless of the disconnect handle position.
B
Door
Opening Table 8.102: Required Accessories for Auxiliary Doors
Type Description
One Type M2 kit is required for each auxiliary door. This kit is required to interlock any
Type M2 auxiliary door(s) with the master door.
The first auxiliary door requires 2 Type M7 kits. Additional auxiliary doors require only 1
Type M7 Type M7 kit. The 0.25 in. diameter rod used to interconnect the M7 kits is furnished by
C the user. If the distance between any two Type M7 kits exceeds 36 in., an additional
Type M7 kit should be installed to prevent the rod from buckling.
Locking Locking
Bar Bar

Auxiliary Door Master Door


(Single Door)

Type M8 Type M1 Type M7 Type M2


NOTE: A - Interlocking lever extension of the
flange-mounted handle mechanism.
NOTE: B - Actual enclosure opening—not door
height.
NOTE: C - Screwdriver interlock assembly can
be ordered separately. Class 9423 Type
CEQ2493.

8-46
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Single and Multi-Door Enclosures Door Closing Mechanisms
Class 9423 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Vault Type for Single and Multi-Door Enclosures
Table 8.103 shows the requirements for the door closing mechanism, the locking bar kit,
and the mechanical interlock kit, if used.

Table 8.103: Single Or Multi-Door Enclosures—NEMA Type 12 with 61 in. to 91 in. Door Openings
Single-Door Enclosure Multi-Door Enclosure
Without Interlocking With Interlocking Without Interlocking With Interlocking
For Master door: For each Auxiliary door:
1—M8 door closing mechanism For each door: 1—M8 door closing mechanism 1—M8 door closing mechanism
1—M8 door closing mechanism 1—Type M891 locking bar kit
1—M8 door closing mechanism 1—Type M891 locking bar kit 1—Type M891 locking bar kit
1—Type M891 locking bar kit 1—Type M1 (for use with 9422A 1—Type M891 locking bar kit 1—Type M1 (for use with 9422A Necessary quantities of Types M2
handles)
handles) and M7 for each door (see below)

NOTE: All mechanisms listed on this page are suitable for either left or right hand
mounting.
1/4 in. Dia. R
od (supplied by user)
Table 8.104: Door Interlocks

8
Type Description
The Class 9423 Type M8 door closing mechanism is designed to close and seal
Type M8 Door Closing 1.125 in. deep doors of single or multi-door NEMA Type 12 enclosures. The Type
Mechanism M8 can be used on doors hinged on either the left or right hand side.
Recommended door openings are from 61–91 in. Vault type handle length is 8 in.
The lock bar kit for the Type M8 door closing mechanism contains two lock bars
Type M891 Locking Bar Kits and is available from stock. The bars can be cut to fit door openings through 91 in..
Locking Locking One lock bar kit is required for each Type M8 ordered.
Bar Bar
The Class 9423 Type M1 mechanical interlock kit is designed to interlock a Class
9422 handle mechanism with the Type M8 door closing mechanism. This kit
Type M1 prevents the opening of the master door (or single door) with the disconnect handle
in the “ON” position, making it mandatory to use a screwdriver to gain entry to the
enclosure at any time, regardless of the disconnect handle position.
A
B
Door Table 8.105: Required Accessories for
Opening Auxiliary Doors
Type Description
One Type M2 kit is required for each auxiliary door. This kit is required to interlock
Type M2 any auxiliary door(s) with the master door.
The first auxiliary door requires 2 Type M7 kits. Additional auxiliary doors require
only 1 Type M7 kit. The 0.25 in. diameter rod used to interconnect the M7 kits is
C Type M7
furnished by the user. If the distance between any two Type M7 kits exceeds 36 in.,
an additional Type M7 kit should be installed to prevent the rod from buckling.
Locking Locking
Bar Bar

Auxiliary Door Master Door


(Single Door)

Type M8 Type M1 Type M7 Type M2

NOTE: A - Interlocking lever extension of the


flange-mounted handle mechanism.
NOTE: B - Actual enclosure opening—not door
height.
NOTE: C - Screwdriver interlock assembly can
be ordered separately. Class 9423 Type
CEQ2493.

8-47
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Door Closing Mechanisms Types M5, M6, M1, and M8
Class 9423 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
8

schneider-electric.us

Enclosure Construction and General Location Information For


OPERATING MECHANISMS AND

Types M5 and M6
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

Drilling and location information below is complete for a single door enclosure with door
hinged on left side, incorporating a Type M6, M5, and Class 9422 handle mechanism.
Transpose all horizontal dimensions for doors hinged on right side.
Dimension A
• Single door enclosures: A minimum = 1 in.
• Multi-door enclosures without overhead interlocking system:
A minimum = 1 in.
• Multi-door enclosures with overhead interlocking system:
A minimum = 4–1/2 in.
NOTE: Overhead interlocking system consists of the required number of Class 9423
Type M2 and M7 kits for interlocking the auxiliary doors with the master door. See
page 8-46.
Table 8.106: Dimension B (Minimums)
Type If A = 1 If A = 4–1/2
Disconnect Device C
Minimum B = Minimum B =
TCF, TCN, TDF, TDN, TD 60 A Disconnect Switch 3-/16 2-1/2 3-3/16
TE, TEF, TEN 100 A Disconnect Switch 5-1/4 2-1/2 3-3/16
TF 200 A Disconnect Switch 11-5/8 8-1/8 3-3/16
TG 400 A Disconnect Switch 15-1/16 11-9/16 6-3/4
RN1 FAL, FHL, Circuit Breaker 4-27/32 2-1/2 3-3/16
RP1 KAL, KHL Circuit Breaker 11-5/32 7-21/32 3-3/16
RR2 ILL Circuit Breaker 17-31/32 14-15/32 3-3/16
MAL, MHL, MEL, MXL Circuit
RT1 Breaker 18-5/8 15-1/8 3-3/16

8-48
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Disconnect Switches and Circuit Breakers Operating Mechanisms, Accessories
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us

OPERATING MECHANISMS AND


Enclosure Construction and General Location Information

DISCONNECT SWITCHES
For Types M1 and M8
Drilling and location information below is complete for a single door enclosure with the
door hinged on the left side, incorporating a Type M8, M1, and Class 9422 handle
mechanism. Transpose all horizontal dimensions for doors hinged on the right side.
Dimension A
• Single door enclosures: A minimum = 1-1/2 in.
• Multi-Door enclosures without overhead interlocking system:
A minimum = 1-1/2 in.
• Multi-Door enclosures with overhead interlocking system:
A minimum = 4-1/2 in.
NOTE: Overhead interlocking system consists of the required number of Class 9423
Type M2 and M7 kits for interlocking the auxiliary doors with the master door. See
page 8-46.
Table 8.107: Dimension B (Minimums)

8
If A = 1–½ If A = 4–½
Type Disconnect Device Minimum Minimum C
B= B=
TCF, TCN, TDF, TDN, TD 60 A Disconnect Switch 2-15/16 2-1/2 3-3/16
TE, TEF, TEN 100 A Disconnect Switch 4-3/4 2-1/2 3-3/16
TF 200 A Disconnect Switch 11-1/8 8-1/8 3-3/16
TG 400 A Disconnect Switch 14-9/16 11-9/16 5-7/8
RN1 FAL, FHL Circuit Breaker 4-11/32 2-1/2 3-3/16
RP1 KAL, KHL Circuit Breaker 10-21/32 7-21/32 3-3/16
RR2 ILL Circuit Breaker 17-15/32 14-15/32 3-3/16
RT1 MAL, MHL, MEL, MXL Circuit Breaker 18-1/8 15-1/8 3-3/16

Additional Accessories
Table 8.108: Additional Accessories
Accessory Description Cat. No.
Permits mounting Class 9422 Type A1 or A2 handle mechanisms in
Alternate Mounting Kit 9422AM2
enclosures with flange thickness of 16 gauge to 0.5 in.
Auxiliary kit recommended for use with the Class 9422 Type A-1
flange handle to facilitate padlocking the handle in the “OFF”
Alternate Mounting Kit position. Primarily used when the handle is mounted on the center
Auxiliary Lock Plate 9422L1
channel of a multi-door enclosure. Also in any case where the
enclosure doors interfere with the normal padlock slot in the flange
handle. Meets both the Automotive and NFPA 79 specifications.
Copper Lugs only—Specify Form Y157 —
Tin Plated Aluminum Lugs for 400 A Type TG Switch—Specify Form
Special Lugs for Y1572 (000–750 kcmil Cu/Al wire) —
Channel/Flange Disconnect Switches Anderson Type VCEL Compression Lugs—Specify Form Y1574
Support Kit Exceptions: None of the 30 A or 60 A disconnect switches are —
available with compression lugs.
Standard operating rod for use with Class 9422 variable depth 9422R1
mechanisms. Included as standard in each kit.
Operating Rods Extra long operating rod for use with Class 9422 variable depth
mechanisms. Can be used as a substitute for the standard rod
included in each kit to increase the maximum mounting depth 7 in. 9422R2
(Two are required for Types ARR, RR, ART, RT, ATE, TE, ATF, TF).
Auxiliary Lock Plate

8-49
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Operating Mechanisms, Accessories Disconnect Switches and Circuit Breakers
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
8

schneider-electric.us
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND
DISCONNECT SWITCHES

8-50
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents

Section 9
Panelboards
Series Ratings 9-3

NQ and NF Panelboards 9-3


NF and I-Line™ Panelboards 9-10
I-Line™ Panelboards 9-13
NQ and NF Panelboard Merchandised Selection
Procedure 9-14

PANELBOARDS
NQ and NF Panelboard Merchandised Selection Procedure 9-14
NQ Merchandised Panelboards 9-15
NQ Panelboards
NQ Main Lug Interiors—240 Vac, 48 Vdc 9-15
NQ Main Circuit Breaker Interiors—240 Vac, 48 Vdc 9-16
NQ Main Circuit Breaker Interiors—240 Vac, 48 Vdc 9-16
NQ 14-inch-wide—240 Vac, 48 Vdc 9-17
Features 9-17
NQ Merchandised Accessories 9-18
QOB Bolt-On Circuit Breakers 9-20

With Visi-Trip™ Indicator for NQ Panelboards 9-20

9
NQ Factory Assembled Panelboards 9-22

240 Vac, 48 Vdc 9-22


Sub-feed Circuit Breakers 9-22
Common Features 9-22
Sub-feed Lugs 9-22
NF Panelboards Feed-through Lugs 9-22
Fingersafe IP2X per IEC 60529 Barriers for NQ Panelboards 9-24
Features 9-24
Specifications 9-25
Replacement Parts 9-25
NF Merchandised Panelboards 9-26

20-inch Wide Enclosures 480Y/277 Vac Max. 9-26


Accessories 9-27
Circuit Breakers 9-28

For NF Merchandised Panelboards 9-28


NF Factory Assembled Panelboards 9-29

I-Line Panelboards Maximum 480Y/277 Vac 9-29


Sub-feed Circuit Breaker 9-29
Common Features 9-30
Separated Distribution and Split Bus NF and NQ Panelboards 9-32
NQ/NF Merchandised Single Row (Column Width)
Panelboards 9-33

NQ Single-Row (Column-width)—240 Vac Bolt-on 9-33


(60 A Max. Branch Circuit Breaker)NQ Application Data 9-33
NF Single-Row (Column-width)—480Y/277 Vac Bolt-on 9-34
(60 A Max. Branch Circuit Breaker)NF Application Data 9-34

QMB Panelboards

© 2017 Schneider Electric


All Rights Reserved 9-1

11/10/2017
Operating Mechanisms, Accessories Disconnect Switches and Circuit Breakers
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us

Powerlink™ Lighting Control Systems 9-35

Lighting Control Products 9-35


Powerlink™ Intelligent Lighting Control Systems 9-35
Powerlink™ ECB-G3 Circuit Breakers 9-36
Powerlink™ Accessories 9-37
Remote Mount Controller 9-38
Powerlink Network Accessories 9-38
9

NF Panelboards 240 V and 480Y/277 V Factory Assembled Systems—


Max. Voltage 480Y/277 Vac 9-38
Powerlink™ Energy Management (EM) 9-39

Lighting Control System, Relay Panels, and Switches 9-39


Energy Management (EM) Lighting Control System 9-39
PANELBOARDS

I-Line™ Merchandised Panelboards 9-40

I-Line Combo Panelboard 9-40


I-Line Panelboard 9-41
Accessories 9-44
Circuit Breakers B- and F-frame for I-Line Panelboards and
Switchboards 9-47

PowerPact™ B-frame 9-47


F-frame 9-47
Circuit Breakers 9-50

F-frame, PowerPact Q-frame for I-Line™ Panelboards and Switchboards 9-50


H- and J-frame for I-Line™ Panelboards and Switchboards 9-51
K-, PowerPact H-, J-, L-frame for I-Line™ Panelboards & Switchboards 9-53
J-frame Mission Critical Circuit Breaker 9-53
L-frame Mission Critical Circuit Breaker 9-53
LA-frame for I-Line™ Panelboards and Switchboards 9-54
L- and PowerPact M-frame for I-Line™ Panelboards and Switchboards 9-55
PowerPact P- and R-frame for I-Line™ Panelboards and Switchboards 9-56
I-Line™ Factory Assembled Panelboards 9-57

600 Vac, 250 Vdc 9-57


QMB Fusible Branch Switches 9-58

600 Vac, 250 Vdc 9-58


For QMB/QMJ Panelboards and Switchboards 9-58
Fusible—600 Vac, 250 Vdc 9-59
Common Features 9-59
QMB Layout Information 9-60
Modifications for Factory Assembled Panelboards 9-61

Modifications For Factory Assembled Panelboards 9-61


Main Circuit Breaker Without Overload Trip 9-61
Shunt Trip Circuit Breakers 9-61
Special Features 9-61
Panelboards 9-62

NQ and NF Terminal Data 9-62


I-Line™ and QMB 9-63

Terminal Data 9-63


NQ Merchandised Panelboards 9-64

NQ Merchandised Accessories 9-64

9-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ and NF Panelboards Series Ratings
Class 1640 and 1670
schneider-electric.us

NQ Panelboards
This page contains UL Tested and Certified series combination ratings for panelboards.
These ratings apply to either an integral main located in the same enclosure or a remote
main located in a separate enclosure.

Table 9.1: NQ Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical)


Maximum Short Square D™ Brand Integral or Remote Square D™ Brand Branch Circuit Breaker Catalog Designation and
Maximum System Circuit Current Allowable Ampere Ranges [3][4][5][6]
Voltage AC [1][2] Main Circuit Breakers and Remote Main
Rating Fuses Type 1 Pole 2 Pole 3 Pole
22,000 MG QO (B) 15–30 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A —

PANELBOARDS
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
25,000 LD, HD, JD
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
HG, JG
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
65,000 QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —

9
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
LG QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 40–60 A —
LJ
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 40–60 A —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
HJ, JJ
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
120/240 1P/3W[7] QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) GFI — 15–30 A —
LJ
QO (B) EPD — 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
100,000 QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH — 150 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
DJ 400 A QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) AS 15–30 A 15–30 A —
QO (B) VH — 150 A —
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QJ
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A —
125,000 HL, JL
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —

[1] For shown circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage, the indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[2] Short circuit tests are conducted at 100–105% of the maximum rated voltage of the panelboard.
[3] Suffixes HID, SWD, and SWN may also be applied to the applicable branch circuit breakers shown above. Suffix SWN may not be applied in combination with LC main breakers.
[4] Where QO (B) circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) H, QO (B) VH, and QH (B) circuit breakers may also be used.
[5] Where QO (B) GFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) EPD and/or QO (B) EPE circuit breakers may also be used. QO-EPE only comes in 3-pole construction.
[6] Where QO (B) AFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) CAFI circuit breakers may also be used.
[7] Two-pole CAFI circuit breakers are only 120/240 Vac and may only be used on 120/240 VAC single phase 3 wire systems.
9-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Series Ratings NQ and NF Panelboards
Class 1640 and 1670
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.1 NQ Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical) (cont'd.)
Maximum Short Square D™ Brand Integral or Remote Square D™ Brand Branch Circuit Breaker Catalog Designation and
Maximum System Allowable Ampere Ranges [10][11][12][13]
Circuit Current Main Circuit Breakers and Remote Main
Voltage AC [8][9] Rating Fuses Type 1 Pole 2 Pole 3 Pole
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
LA/LH (L) 34200MC
LA/LH (L) 34225MC
18,000 QO (B) 15–30 A 15–30 A 15–30 A
LA/LH (L) 34250MC
9

LA/LH (L) 34400MC


QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–30 A 15–125 A 15–150 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
25,000 LD
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
PANELBOARDS

QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–100 A —
QO (B) VH — 15–125 A 15–150 A
DJ-W 150 A MC[8]
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
30,000
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–100 A —
QO (B) VH — — 15–100 A
DJ-W 250 A MC[8]
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–100 A —
QO (B) VH — — 15–150 A
30,000 DJ-W 600 A MC[8]
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
LG QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
208Y/120 3P/4W QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
65,000 QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
LJ QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) GFI — — 15–30 A
LL QO (B) EPD — — 15–30 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH — — 15–150 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
100,000 DJ 400 A QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–30 A
QO (B) VH — — 15–150 A
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QJ QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) EPE 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
100,000 QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
LJ
QO (B) GFI — 15–30 A —
QO (B) EPD — 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —

[8] For shown circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage, the indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[9] Short circuit tests are conducted at 100–105% of the maximum rated voltage of the panelboard.
[10] Suffixes HID, SWD, and SWN may also be applied to the applicable branch circuit breakers shown above. Suffix SWN may not be applied in combination with LC main breakers.
[11] Where QO (B) circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) H, QO (B) VH, and QH (B) circuit breakers may also be used.
[12] Where QO (B) GFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) EPD and/or QO (B) EPE circuit breakers may also be used. QO-EPE only comes in 3-pole construction.
[13] Where QO (B) AFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) CAFI circuit breakers may also be used.
[8] To achieve selective coordination, the rating of the DJ main circuit breaker must be at least two times greater than the ampere rating of any branch circuit breaker.
9-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ and NF Panelboards Series Ratings
Class 1640 and 1670
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.1 NQ Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical) (cont'd.)
Maximum Short Square D™ Brand Integral or Remote Square D™ Brand Branch Circuit Breaker Catalog Designation and
Maximum System Allowable Ampere Ranges [11][12][13][14]
Circuit Current Main Circuit Breakers and Remote Main
Voltage AC [9][10] Rating Fuses Type 1 Pole 2 Pole 3 Pole
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
22,000 QO (B) VH
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —

PANELBOARDS
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–30 A
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QD QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
ED, FD QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
25,000 QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —

9
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) AS 15–30 A 15–30 A 15–30 A
KD
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
HD, JD QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
240/120 3P/4W
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–30 A 15–125 A 15–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
25,000 LD QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
Q2L-H — 100–225 A 100–225 A
LA, MA
QDL — 70–225 A 70–225 A
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–70 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
LC 400 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
42,000
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
LC 600 A QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
MG QO (B) VH 15–30 A 15–30 A 15–30 A
QO (B) 15–30 A 15–30 A —
QO (B) VH 15–30 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
LC 400 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
65,000
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) VH 15–30 A 15–125 A 15–150 A
QO (B) GFI — — 15–30 A
LC 600 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —

[9] For shown circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage, the indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[10] Short circuit tests are conducted at 100–105% of the maximum rated voltage of the panelboard.
[11] Suffixes HID, SWD, and SWN may also be applied to the applicable branch circuit breakers shown above. Suffix SWN may not be applied in combination with LC main breakers.
[12] Where QO (B) circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) H, QO (B) VH, and QH (B) circuit breakers may also be used.
[13] Where QO (B) GFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) EPD and/or QO (B) EPE circuit breakers may also be used. QO-EPE only comes in 3-pole construction.
[14] Where QO (B) AFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) CAFI circuit breakers may also be used.
9-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Series Ratings NQ and NF Panelboards
Class 1640 and 1670
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.1 NQ Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical) (cont'd.)
Maximum Short Square D™ Brand Integral or Remote Square D™ Brand Branch Circuit Breaker Catalog Designation and
Maximum System Allowable Ampere Ranges [11][12][13][14]
Circuit Current Main Circuit Breakers and Remote Main
Voltage AC [9][10] Rating Fuses Type 1 Pole 2 Pole 3 Pole
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
DJ 400 A QO (B) VH — — 15–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–150 A —
9

QO (B)-VH — 110–125 A 15–150 A


QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
DJ_W
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
DJ, DG, DL 150–600 A QO (B) EPD — — 15–30 A
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
PANELBOARDS

EG, FG, KG QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —


QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–30 A
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QG QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
HG, JG
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
FC_ or KC_22___ QO (B) 15–70 A 15–100 A 15–100 A
FC_ or KC_34___ QO (B) AS 15–30 A 15–30 A 15–30 A
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
LG
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 40–60 A —
LJ
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 40–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
QO (B) EPD — — 15–30 A
LL
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
FC_ or KC_22___ QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–30 A —
FC_ or KC_34___ QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) VH — — 15–150 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
DJ 400 A
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
100,000 EJ QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) GFI — 15–30 A —
LJ
QO (B) EPD — 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
HJ, JJ
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —

[9] For shown circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage, the indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[10] Short circuit tests are conducted at 100–105% of the maximum rated voltage of the panelboard.
[11] Suffixes HID, SWD, and SWN may also be applied to the applicable branch circuit breakers shown above. Suffix SWN may not be applied in combination with LC main breakers.
[12] Where QO (B) circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) H, QO (B) VH, and QH (B) circuit breakers may also be used.
[13] Where QO (B) GFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) EPD and/or QO (B) EPE circuit breakers may also be used. QO-EPE only comes in 3-pole construction.
[14] Where QO (B) AFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) CAFI circuit breakers may also be used.
9-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ and NF Panelboards Series Ratings
Class 1640 and 1670
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.1 NQ Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical) (cont'd.)
Maximum Short Square D™ Brand Integral or Remote Square D™ Brand Branch Circuit Breaker Catalog Designation and
Maximum System Allowable Ampere Ranges [11][12][13][14]
Circuit Current Main Circuit Breakers and Remote Main
Voltage AC [9][10] Rating Fuses Type 1 Pole 2 Pole 3 Pole
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A

PANELBOARDS
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
125,000 HL, JL QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
200,000 FI, KI, HR, JR
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) — — 15–100 A
QO (B) VH QO (B) GFI — — 15–50 A

9
22,000
QO (B) PL — 15–30 A —
Q2-H QO (B) — — 15–30 A
QO (B) — — 15–30 A
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QD QO (B) PL — 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) EPD — — 15–50 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
QO (B) GFI — — 15–50 A
25,000
QO (B) — — 15–100 A
ED, FD
QO (B) GFI — — 15–50 A
KD QO (B) — — 15–100 A
QO (B) — — 15–100 A
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
HD, JD
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) GFI — — 15–50 A
QO (B) VH — — 15–150 A
25,000 LD QO (B) EPD — — 15–30 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
LA, MA QDL — 70–225 A 70–225 A
LC 400 A QO (B) VH — — 15–100 A
240 3P/3W or 42,000
LC 600 A QO (B) VH — — 15–100 A
240 1P/2W
(two pole only) MG QO (B) VH — — 150 A
LC 400 A QO (B) VH — — 15–100 A
LC 600 A QO (B) VH — — 15–30 A
QO (B) VH — — 15–150 A
DJ 400 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) EPD — — 15–30 A
DJ, DG, DL 150–600 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
QO (B) — — 15–100 A
EG, FG, KG
QO (B) GFI — — 15–50 A
QG QO (B) — — 15–30 A
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
65,000 QG, HG, JG QO (B) PL — — 15–30 A
HG, JG QO (B) — — 15–100 A
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
FC_ or KC_22___ QO (B) — — 15–100 A
FC_ or KC_34___ QO (B) AS — 15–30 A 15–30 A
QO (B) VH — — 15–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
LG
QO (B) EPD — — 15–30 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
QO (B) EPD — — 15–30 A
LJ
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A

[9] For shown circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage, the indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[10] Short circuit tests are conducted at 100–105% of the maximum rated voltage of the panelboard.
[11] Suffixes HID, SWD, and SWN may also be applied to the applicable branch circuit breakers shown above. Suffix SWN may not be applied in combination with LC main breakers.
[12] Where QO (B) circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) H, QO (B) VH, and QH (B) circuit breakers may also be used.
[13] Where QO (B) GFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) EPD and/or QO (B) EPE circuit breakers may also be used. QO-EPE only comes in 3-pole construction.
[14] Where QO (B) AFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) CAFI circuit breakers may also be used.
9-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Series Ratings NQ and NF Panelboards
Class 1640 and 1670
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.1 NQ Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical) (cont'd.)
Maximum Short Square D™ Brand Integral or Remote Square D™ Brand Branch Circuit Breaker Catalog Designation and
Maximum System Allowable Ampere Ranges [11][12][13][14]
Circuit Current Main Circuit Breakers and Remote Main
Voltage AC [9][10] Rating Fuses Type 1 Pole 2 Pole 3 Pole
QO (B) EPD — — 15–30 A
65,000 LL
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
FC_ or KC_24___
QO (B) GFI — 15–30 A —
FC_ or KC_34___
DJ 400 A QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
9

EJ, FJ QO (B) — — 15–100 A


QO (B) VH — — 15–100 A
LJ
100,000 QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) — — 15–100 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
HJ, JJ QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
QO (B) EPD — — 15–30 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
PANELBOARDS

QO (B) — — 15–100 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
125,000 HL, JL QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
QO (B) EPD — — 15–30 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
200,000 FI, KI, HR, JR QO (B) — — 15–100 A
42,000 400 A Max. Class T3 Fuses QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–150 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
400 A Max.Class J Fuses
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
65,000
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–150 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
400 A Max.Class T6 Fuses
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
120/240 1P/3W[9]
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
100,000 200 A Max. Class T3 Fuses
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
200,000 400 A Max. Class T3 Fuses QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
200 A Max. Class T6, J Fuses QO (B) GFI — — 15–50 A
QO (B) EPD — — 15–50 A
208Y/120 3P/4W 200,000 QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
400 A Max. Class T3 Fuses
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
42,000 400 A Max. Class T3 Fuses QO (B) VH 15–30 A 15–125 A —
50,000 400 A Max. Class T3 Fuses QO (B) VH — — 15–30 A
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) EPD — — 15–50 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
400 A Max. Class JFuses
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
65,000
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–150 A
400 A Max. Class T6 Fuses
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) VH — — 15–30 A
240/120 3P/4W QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
100,000 200 A Max. Class T3 Fuses QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QOT 15–30 A 15–30 A —
QO (B) EPD — — 15–50 A
200 A Max.Class J or T6Fuses
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
200,000
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
400 A Max. Class T3 Fuses
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A

[9] For shown circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage, the indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[10] Short circuit tests are conducted at 100–105% of the maximum rated voltage of the panelboard.
[11] Suffixes HID, SWD, and SWN may also be applied to the applicable branch circuit breakers shown above. Suffix SWN may not be applied in combination with LC main breakers.
[12] Where QO (B) circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) H, QO (B) VH, and QH (B) circuit breakers may also be used.
[13] Where QO (B) GFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) EPD and/or QO (B) EPE circuit breakers may also be used. QO-EPE only comes in 3-pole construction.
[14] Where QO (B) AFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) CAFI circuit breakers may also be used.
[9] Two-pole CAFI circuit breakers are only 120/240 Vac and may only be used on 120/240 VAC single phase 3 wire systems.
9-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ and NF Panelboards Series Ratings
Class 1640 and 1670
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.1 NQ Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical) (cont'd.)
Maximum System Maximum Short Square D™ Brand Integral or Remote Square D™ Brand Branch Circuit Breaker Catalog Designation and
Voltage AC [10] Circuit Current Main Circuit Breakers and Remote Main Allowable Ampere Ranges [12][13][14][15]
[11] Rating Fuses Type 1 Pole 2 Pole 3 Pole
50,000 400 A Max.Class J or T6Fuses QO (B) VH — — 15–30 A
QO (B) VH — — 15–30 A
400 A Max.Class JFuses QO (B) EPD — — 15–50 A
65,000 QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
QO (B) VH — — 15–150 A
400 A Max.Class T6Fuses
240 3P/3W or QOB VH1?, 2W only — 150 A —
240 1P/2W QO (B) — — 15–100 A
(two pole only) 100,000 200 A Max. Class T3 Fuses
QO (B) VH — — 15–30 A
QO (B) EPD — — 15–50 A
200 A Max.Class J or T6Fuses
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A

PANELBOARDS
200,000 QO (B) — — 15–100 A
400 A Max. Class T3 Fuses QO (B) EPD — — 15–50 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A

[10] For shown circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage, the indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[11] Short circuit tests are conducted at 100–105% of the maximum rated voltage of the panelboard.
[12] Suffixes HID, SWD, and SWN may also be applied to the applicable branch circuit breakers shown above. Suffix SWN may not be applied in combination with LC main breakers.
[13] Where QO (B) circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) H, QO (B) VH, and QH (B) circuit breakers may also be used.
[14] Where QO (B) GFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) EPD and/or QO (B) EPE circuit breakers may also be used. QO-EPE only comes in 3-pole construction.
[15] Where QO (B) AFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) CAFI circuit breakers may also be used.
9-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Series Ratings NF and I-Line™ Panelboards
Class 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us

NF and I-Line™ Panelboards


This page contains UL Tested and Certified series combination ratings for panelboards.
These ratings apply to either an integral main located in the same enclosure or a remote
main located in a separate enclosure.

Table 9.2: NF Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical)


Maximum System Max. Short Circuit Square D™ Brand Integral or Remote Square D™ Brand Branch Circuit Breaker Catalog
Voltage, AC [16] Current Rating Designation and Allowable Ampere Ranges
9

Main Circuit Breakers and Remote Main Fuses


EG, FH, FG, KH, LH, MH, MX, HG, JG, DG EDB, EDB-EPD
65,000 LG EDB
EG ECB-G3
EJ, FC, FJ, KC, LC, HJ, JJ EDB, EDB-EPD, EGB
120 100,000 DJ, LJ EDB, EGB
120/240 EJ, FC, KC, HJ, JJ
240 ECB-G3
125,000 HL, JL EDB, EDB-EPD, EGB, ECB-G3
FI, KI, LI, LXI, HR, JR, LR EDB, EDB-EPD, EGB, EJB
PANELBOARDS

200,000 FI, KI, HR, JR ECB-G3


Class J or T (600 V) 200 A Max Fuses ECB-G3
EG, FG, KH, LH, HG, JG, DG, LG EDB, EDB-EPD
35,000
EG, HG, JG ECB-G3
EJ, FC, FJ, KC, LC, LX, HJ, JJ, DJ EDB, EDB-EPD, EGB
EJ, FC, KC, HJ, JJ ECB-G3
65,000 EDB, EDB-EPD, EGB,
LJ EGB-EPD
277 LL EDB-EPD, EGB-EPD
480Y/277
HL, JL EDB, EDB-EPD, EGB, EJB
100,000 DL, LL EDB, EGB, EJB
400 A Max Fuses EDB, EDB-EPD, EGB, EJB
FI, KI, LI, LXI, HR, JR, LR EDB, EDB-EPD, EGB, EJB
200,000 FI, KI, HR, JR ECB-G3
200 A Max Fuses EDB, EDB-EPD, EGB, EJB, ECB-G3
HG, JG, MG, EDB
18,000
LG EDB (15–110 A)
EJ, FI, KH, KI, LC, LE, LX, LI, LXI, HJ, JJ EDB, EGB
EDB (15–110 A),
25,000 LJ EGB (15–110 A)
LH (15–70 A) EDB, EGB
600Y/347 35,000 LC, LE, LX EDB, EGB, EJB
HL, JL, EDB, EGB, EJB
50,000 EDB (15–110 A), EGB
LL (15–110 A),EJB (15–110 A)
FI, KI, HR, JR EDB, EGB, EJB
65,000
LI, LXI, LR EJB
200,000 Class J or T (600 V) 200 A Max Fuses EDB, EGB, EJB

Table 9.3: I-Line Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical)
Maximum Short Circuit Current Square D Brand Integral or Square D Brand Branch Circuit Breaker
Maximum System Voltage AC [17] Remote 2- or 3-Pole Main Circuit
Rating Catalog Designation Poles
Breaker [18]
42,000 MG FY
QG, LH FA, FD
65,000
QG, BG6, HG, JG, LG, MG, PG BD6 (60 A Max.)
FJ, QJ FD
QJ, LC FA
120 100,000 1
LJ FH
QJ, BJ, HJ, JJ, LJ, MJ, PJ BD6, BG6 (60 A Max.)
125,000 HL, JL, LL BD6, BG6, BJ (60 A Max.)
LR FH, FY
200,000
HR, JR BD6, BG6, BJ (60 A Max.)
65,000 QG, BG6, HG, JG, LG, MG, PG BD6
QJ FA, FD
208Y/120 2, 3
100,000 QJ, BJ, HJ, JJ, LJ, MJ, PJ BD6, BG6
QJ, PH, PJ, RJ QD, QG
35,000 MG FA 1
KA FD 1, 2, 3
42,000
LA, MA HD, JD, QD
2, 3
MG FA
50,000
MG FA (25 A Max.) 1
HG, JG FA, HD
JG JD, QD
QG FA, FD, QD 2, 3
240 QG, BG6, HG, JG, LG, MG, PG BD6
LH, MH, PA, PG, RG HD, JD, QD
FG, FH, MH, MX, PJ FD
65,000
FC, KC, KH, LC, LH FD, FG 1, 2, 3
LH FA
LH LA
MG HD, JD, KA
2, 3
DG FH, HD, JD, KA, LA, MA
LG HD, JD, KA, LA, MA

[16] Short circuit tests are conducted at 100–105% of the maximum rated voltage of the panelboard.
[17] For indicated circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage. The indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[18] LD, LG, LJ, and LL are only available in 3-pole configurations.
9-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NF and I-Line™ Panelboards Series Ratings
Class 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.3 I-Line Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical) (cont'd.)
Maximum Short Circuit Current Square D Brand Integral or Square D Brand Branch Circuit Breaker
Maximum System Voltage AC [19] Rating Remote 2- or 3-Pole Main Circuit
Breaker [20] Catalog Designation Poles
LG LD 3
85,000 RL FH, KH 2, 3
FC, KC, LC, LX FD, FG, FJ 1
PH, PJ, RJ QD, QG 2, 3
QJ FD 2
FJ FD
HD, HG, JD, JG, FH, KA, LA, MA, 2, 3
LJ
MG
LJ LD, LG 3
FC, KC FA, FH, FD, FG, FJ
LC, LX FH, FD, FG, FJ
QJ, BJ, HJ, JJ, LJ, MJ, PJ BD6, BG6

PANELBOARDS
2, 3
KC, LC, LX KA
100,000
KC, LC KH
LC LA, LH, MG
LC FA 1, 2, 3
HJ, JJ FA, FH, HD, HG
JJ JD, JG
LC, LX, MJ, PJ, RJ HD, HG, JD, JG
MJ LA, LH
FH, HD, HG, JD, JG, KA, LA, MA,
DJ
MG
RL RG
HL, JL HD, HG, HJ, FA, FH 2, 3
JL JD, JG, JJ
HL, JL, LL BD6, BG6, BJ
PC, PH, PL, RL HD, HG, JD, JG

9
125,000
PC, PL, RL HJ, JJ
FI, KI, LI, LXI HD, HG, HJ
KI, LI, LXI JD, JG, JJ
FI, KI, LI, LXI FD, FG, FJ 1
FI, KI FA, FH, FC, FD, FG, FJ
LI, LXI FH, FD, FG, FJ
LI FC
200,000 HR, JR, LR BD6, BG6, BJ
KI, LI, LXI KA, QD, QG, QJ 2, 3
LI KC
JR QD
HJ, HL, JJ, JL, FH, LA, LH, QD, QG,
LR QJ
18,000 LD FY
25,000 FH, KA FD
FG, KH, LH FD
DG, LG FH, FY
35,000
FC, KC FH
BG6, HG, JG, LG, MG, PG BD6 (60 A Max.)
FJ FD
FC, KC FA, FY, FD, FG
LC, LX (400 A Max.) FH
LC, LX (600 A Max.) FY, FD, FG
277 65,000 DJ FH, FY 1
LL FY
LJ FH, FY
BJ, HJ, JJ, LJ, MJ, PJ BD6, BG6 (60 A Max.)
FI, KI FH
DL, LL FH, FJ
100,000
HL, JL, LL BD6, BG6, BJ (60 A Max.)
FI, KI FA, FY, FD, FG, FJ
LI, LXI, (400 A Max.) FH
200,000
LI, LXI, (600 A Max.) FY, FD, FG, FJ
HR, JR BD6, BG6, BJ (60 A Max.)
MG FA
22,000
MX, PA, PC, PX FH
KH, LA, MA, PJ FH
LA, MA, PA, PC, PX KA
30,000 LA, MA, PA HD, JD
MG FA (25 A Max.), FH, KA
MX, PA HD, JD
2, 3
MH HD, JD
HG, JG FA, HD
480
JG JD
LH, MG, PG, RG HD, JD
35,000 BG6, HG, JG, LG, MG, PG BD6
LH HG, JG
DG FH, HD, JD, KA, LA, MA
LG LD 3
LG HD, JD, FH, KA, LA, MA 2, 3
MJ FH (25 A Max.)
42,000 2, 3
RL RG

[19] For indicated circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage. The indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[20] LD, LG, LJ, and LL are only available in 3-pole configurations.
9-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Series Ratings NF and I-Line™ Panelboards
Class 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.3 I-Line Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical) (cont'd.)
Maximum Short Circuit Current Square D Brand Integral or Square D Brand Branch Circuit Breaker
Maximum System Voltage AC [19] Rating Remote 2- or 3-Pole Main Circuit
Breaker [20] Catalog Designation Poles
50,000 MJ KA, KH
FC, KC FA, FH
HJ, JJ FA, FH, HD, HG
BJ, HJ, JJ, LJ, MJ, PJ BD6, BG6
JJ JD, JG
9

LC, LI, LX, LXI HD, HG, JD, JG


65,000 LC, LX, (400 A Max.) FH
KC, LC, LX KA
LC, LX LA
DJ FH, HD, HG, JD, JG, KA, LA, MA
LJ LD, LG 3
LJ HD, HG, JD, JG, FH, KA, LA, MA 2, 3
HL, JL FA, FH, HD, HG, HJ
HL, JL, LL BD6, BG6, BJ
PANELBOARDS

JL JD, JG, JJ
LI, LXI (600 A Max.) KA 2, 3
PC, PH, PL, RL HJ, JJ
100,000 RL RG
FH, HD, HG, HJ, JD, JG, JJ, KA, LA,
DL
MA
LL LD, LG, LJ 3
LL HD, HG, HJ, JD, JG, JJ, FH, KA, LA,
MA
JR FA
FI, KI FA, FH, FC, HD, HG, HJ
HR, JR BD6, BG6, BJ
KI JD, JG, JJ, KA
LI FC, KA, KC, LA, HJ, HL, JJ, JL
200,000
LXI KA, HJ, HL, JJ, JL
HR FA, HD, HG, HJ, HL
JR HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
LR HJ, HL, JJ, JL, FH, LA, LH
25,000 FH, KA FD 2, 3
FG, KH, LH FD
35,000
BG6, HG, JG, LG, MG, PG BD6
FJ FD
BJ, HJ, JJ, LJ, MJ, PJ BD6, BG6
65,000
480Y/277 FC, KC FD, FG
LC, LX (600 A Max.) FD, FG
100,000 HL, JL, LL BD6, BG6, BJ
FI, KI FD, FG, FJ
200,000 HR, JR BD6, BG6, BJ
LI, LXI (600 A MAX.) FD, FG, FJ
HG, JG FA, HD
JG JD
2, 3
MG, PG, RG HD, JD
18,000
MG FA
LG LD 3
LG HD, JD
HJ, JJ FA, HD, HG
2, 3
JJ JD
25,000 PJ, RJ MG
LJ LD, LG 3
LJ JD, JG, HD, HG, MA
600 35,000 LC FH, HD, HG, HJ, JD, JG, JJ, LA
HL, JL FA, HD, HG, HJ 2, 3
JL JD, JG, JJ
50,000 PK HJ, JJ, MJ
LL LD, LG, LJ 3
LL HD, HG, HJ, JD, JG, JJ, MA
FI, KI HD, HG, HJ
KI JD, JG, JJ
HR FA, HD, HG, HJ, HL 2, 3
100,000
JR FA, HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
KI, LI FH
LI LA
18,000 BG6, HG, JG, LG, MG, PG BD6 (60 A Max.)
347 25,000 BJ, HJ, JJ, LJ, MJ, PJ BD6, BG6 (60 A Max.) 1
100,000 HR, JR BD6, BG6, BJ (60 A Max.)
BG6, HG, JG, LG, MG, PG BD6 3
18,000
MG FA (25 A Max.) 1
BJ, HJ, JJ, LJ, MJ, PJ BD6, BG6 3
25,000
600Y/347 MJ FA (25 A Max.) 1
HL, JL, LL BD6, BG6, BJ 3
50,000
HL, JL FJ 1
100,000 HR, JR BD6, BG6, BJ 3

[19] For indicated circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage. The indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[20] LD, LG, LJ, and LL are only available in 3-pole configurations.
9-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ Panelboards Series Ratings
Class 2110
schneider-electric.us

I-Line Panelboards
Table 9.4: Fuse/I-Line Circuit Breaker Series Connected Ratings
Maximum System Maximum Short Circuit Remote Main Fuse Square D Brand Branch Circuit Breaker Catalog Designation (2- or 3-Pole)
Voltage AC [19] Current Rating Max A Class Unless Otherwise Stated
1200 A L, T (300 V)
120/240 1Ø 208Y/120 100,000 800 A T (600 V) QD, QG
600 A J, RK5
1200 A L, T (300 V)
65,000 800 A T (600 V) QD
600 A J, RK5
1200 A L, T (300 V)
800 A T (600 V) QD, QG (2-Pole)
J, RK5

PANELBOARDS
J, T (600 V) FA, FH, KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, MA, MH, MX, PG
600 A
RK5 FH, KA, KH, LA, LH, MA, MH, MX, PG, HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
100,000 J HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
T (600 V) FH, KA, KH, LA, LH, MA, MH, MX, PG
800 A T (300 V) PG
240 L FH, KA, KH, LA, LH, MA, MH, MX, PG
L FH, KH, LA, LH, MA, MH, MX, PG
1200 A
T (600 V) HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
J, T (600 V) FA (3-pole only) FH, FC, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, NC, NX, PG, PJ, PL
FH, FC, HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NC, NX,
600 A RK5 PG,PJ, PL
J HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
200,000 T (600 V) FH, FC, KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, NC, NX, PG, PJ, PL
800 A T (300 V) PG, PJ, PL

9
L FH, FC, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, NC, NX, PG, PJ, PL
L FC, KH, KC, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, NC, NX, PG, PJ, PL
1200 A
T (600 V) HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
400 A J, T(600 V) HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
600 A J, RK5 HJ, HL, JJ, JL
J, T (600 V) FC, KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, PG, PJ
600 A
100,000 RK5 FC, KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, PG, PJ
800 A L, T(600V) FC, KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, PG, PJ
L FC, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, PG, PJ
1200 A
T (600 V) HJ, HL, JJ, JL
200 A RK5 HJ, HL
FA, FH, FC, HJ, HL, JJ, JL, KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, NC, NX, PG,
480 J PJ, PL
400 A
T (600 V) FA, FH, FC, HJ, HL, JJ, JL, KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, MA, MH, MX, NA, NC, NX
J FC, KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, MG, MJ, NA, NC, NX, PG, PJ, PL
200,000 600 A T(600 V) KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, MA, MH, MX, NA, NC, NX
RK5 KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, MG, MJ, NC, NX, PG, PJ
T(300 V) PG, PJ, PL
800 A T(600 V) KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, MA, MH, MX, MG, MJ, NA, NC, NX, PG, PJ, PL
L KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, NC, NX, PG, PJ, PL
1200 A L KC, LC, MA, MH, MX, MG, MJ, NA, NC, NX, PG, PJ, PL
30 A CC HG, JG (Molded Case Switches)
600 100,000 200 A J HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
400 A J, T (600 V) HJ, HL, JJ, JL

• The fuse used in this UL test is an envelope (umbrella) fuse. This fuse is designed as
a “worst case’’ fuse. Thus, no matter what manufacturer’s fuse is used, the Square
D™ brand circuit breaker is protected.
• The line side fused switch may be in a separate enclosure or in the same enclosure as
the loadside circuit breaker. A line side fused switch may be a submain, integral main,
or remote main. A load side circuit breaker may be a branch, submain, or an integral
main used on the load side of a remote main. This series combination short circuit
current rating shall not exceed that of the line side fused switch. The charts apply to
Square D™ brand load side circuit breakers only. However, the line side fuse ratings
are independent of the fuse manufacturer.
• Not applicable to Corner Grounded Systems.
• Limiters used in Square D™ brand DSL and DSL II fused power circuit breakers are
not class L fuses and do not have series ratings.

[19] For indicated circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage. The indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
9-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ and NF Panelboard Merchandised NQ and NF Panelboards
Selection Procedure
Class 1640 and 1670 schneider-electric.us

NQ and NF Panelboard Merchandised Selection Procedure


1. Review maximum electrical system voltage, ampacity, and available fault current,
and determine the type of panelboard is desired (see tables Table 9.1–).
2. Identify type (plug-on or bolt-on) and total quantity of branch circuit breaker poles
and panel spaces required (see Digest sections 7 and 9 for catalog numbers).
3. Select proper main lug interior (from tables Table 9.5, Table 9.7, or Table 9.40) or:
• Select main circuit breaker interior and main circuit breaker adapter kit (from
9

tables Table 9.6, Table 9.8, or Table 9.41), based upon the equivalent number of
poles and ampere rating.
NOTE: Interiors include solid neutral and are field convertible to top-feed.
• If a main circuit breaker interior was selected, select a main circuit breaker (or
fuse) from pages page 7-2, page 7-6, page 7-7, page 7-10, or page 7-11, or Table
9.49.
4. Select ground bars from tables Table 9.9 or Table 9.48 and any non-standard neutral
PANELBOARDS

bars (i.e., 200% neutral for non-linear loads) from tables Table 9.10 or Table 9.43.
5. Select any required sub-feed circuit breakers, sub-feed lugs (SFL), or feed-through
lugs (FTL) kits:
• Sub-feed lugs (SFL) or feed-through lugs (FTL) kits: tables Table 9.11 or Table
9.44 in the NQ or NF Accessories sections.
• Any subfeed circuit breakers: Table 7.1 or tables Table 9.16–Table 9.20 or tables
Table 9.49–Table 9.61.
6. Determine the total mounting inches required by adding requirements from interior,
main circuit breaker, neutrals and ground bars, SFL, FTL, or sub-feed circuit breaker.
7. Select enclosure from the tables Table 9.5–Table 9.14, Table 9.22, Table 9.24, Table
9.26, Table 9.42, Table 9.45, and Table 9.46.
Type 1—select box and front (cover) catalog number corresponding to interior
catalog number.
Type 3R, 5, 12—select enclosure. Cover for Type 3R, 5, 12 is included with the
enclosure.
8. Select the branch circuit breakers to be installed in the panel.
For NQ panelboards use QO circuit breakers from tables Table 7.1, page 7-13–page
7-14, or QOB circuit breakers from Table 9.16–Table 9.20.
For NF panelboards, use E-frame circuit breakers from Table 9.49.
9. Select options and accessories from tables Table 9.7–Table 9.15 or Table 9.43–Table
9.48.
NOTE: Additional NF and NQ options may be found in the Supplemental and
Obsolescence Digest, Section 4.
NQ Merchandised Selection Example
208Y/120 Vac, 3Ø4W, 10 kA SCCR, 225 A, MLO, Type-1, surface-mount, bolt-on,
branch circuit breakers, main sub-feed lugs
Branches Table No. Catalog Number Spaces
(20) 20/1 Table 9.17 (20) QOB120 20
two 40/2 Table 9.17 two QOB240 4
two 30/3 Table 9.17 two QOB330 6
Total 30 spaces

Min. Box Height


225 A MLO Interior Table 9.5 NQ430L2 32 inches
Enclosure (Box) Table 9.5 MH38 —
Front (Cover) Table 9.5 NC382S —
Sub-feed Lugs Table 9.11andTable 9.12 NQSFL2 6 inches
Total 38 inches

NF Merchandised Selection Example


480Y/277 Vac, 3Ø4W, 25 kA SCCR, fully rated, copper bus, 100 A, main circuit
breaker, Type 1, flush-mount, bolt-on, branch circuit breakers
Branches Table No. Catalog Number Spaces
(13) 20/1 Table 9.49 EGB14020 13
one 40/2 Table 9.49 EGB24040 2
one 50/3 Table 9.49 EGB34050 3
Total 18 spaces

Min. Box Height


125 A MLO Cu Bus Interior Table 9.40 NF418L1C —
With Main Circuit Breaker Table 9.41 N150MH 38 inches
Adapter Kit
Main Circuit Breaker Section 7 page 31 HGL36100 —

Enclosure (Box) Table 9.41 MH38 —


Front (Cover) Table 9.41 NC38F —
Total 38 inches

9-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Main Lug Interiors—240 Vac, 48 Vdc NQ Merchandised Panelboards
Class 1640 / Refer to Catalog 1640CT0801
schneider-electric.us

NQ Merchandised Panelboards
Table 9.5: Main Lug Interiors—Accepts plug-on and bolt-on circuit breakers
Type 1 Enclosure Type 3R, 5, 12 Enclosure [1]
Interior Only
Pole Mains (Order Branch Circuit Box
20 in. W x 5.75 in. Mono-Flat™ Front [3] Hinged Front Enclosure
Spaces Rating Breakers Separately) 20 in. W x 6.5 in. D Height
D [2] (In.)
Catalog No. [4] Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
20-inch-wide Cabinet —Single Phase 3-Wire
NQ18L1
18 MH26 NC26 ( ) NC26( )HR MH26WP 26
NQ18L1C
100
NQ30L1
30 MH32 NC32 ( ) NC32( )HR MH32WP 32
NQ30L1C
NQ30L2
30 MH32 NC32 ( ) NC32( )HR MH32WP 32

PANELBOARDS
NQ30L2C
NQ42L2
42 MH38 NC38 ( ) NC38( )HR MH38WP 38
NQ42L2C
225
NQ72L2
72[5] MH44 NC44 ( ) NC44( )HR MH44WP 44
NQ72L2C
NQ84L2
84[5] MH50 NC50 ( ) NC50( )HR MH50WP 50
NQ84L2C
NQ30L4
30
NQ30L4C
MH50 NC50V ( ) NC50V( )HR MH50WP 50
NQ42L4
42
400 NQ42L4C
NQ54L4
54 MH56 NC56V( ) NC56V( )HR MH56WP 56
NQ54L4C
84[5] NQ84L4C MH68 NC68V ( ) NC68V( )HR MH68WP 68
30 NQ30L6C
MH50 NC50V ( ) NC50V( )HR MH62WP[6] 50/62
42 NQ42L6C

9
600 NC56V( ) NC56V( )HR
54 NQ54L6C MH56 MH56WP 56
84[5] NQ84L6C MH68 NC68V ( ) NC68V( )HR MH80WP[6] 68/80
20-inch-wide Cabinet —Three Phase 4-Wire
NQ418L1
18 MH26 NC26 ( ) NC26( )HR MH26WP 26
NQ418L1C
100
NQ430L1
30 MH32 NC32 ( ) NC32( )HR MH32WP 32
NQ430L1C
NQ430L2
30 MH32 NC32 ( ) NC32( )HR MH32WP 32
NQ430L2C
NQ442L2
42
NQ442L2C
MH38 NC38 ( ) NC38( )HR MH38WP 38
NQ454L2
54 225
NQ454L2C
NQ472L2
72[5] MH44 NC44 ( ) NC44( )HR MH44WP 44
NQ472L2C
NQ484L2
84[5] MH50 NC50 ( ) NC50( )HR MH50WP 50
NQ484L2C
NQ430L4
30
NQ430L4C
MH50 NC50V ( ) NC50V( )HR MH50WP 50
NQ442L4
42
NQ442L4C
400 NQ454L4
54 MH56 NC56V( ) NC56V( )HR MH56WP 56
NQ454L4C
NQ472L4
72[5] MH62 NC62V ( ) NC62V( )HR MH62WP 62
NQ472L4C
84[5] NQ484L4C MH68 NC68V ( ) NC68V( )HR MH68WP 68
30 NQ430L6C
MH50 NC50V ( ) NC50V( )HR MH62WP[6] 50/62
42 NQ442L6C
600 NC56V( ) NC56V( )HR
54 NQ454L6C MH56 MH56WP 56
84[5] NQ484L6C MH68 NC68V ( ) NC68V( )HR MH80WP[6] 68/80

[1] Enclosure includes trim kit.


[2] Embossed mounting holes add a 0.25-inch standoff to back of MH box.
[3] Add “F” for flush mount, “S” for surface mount.
[4] “C’’ suffix indicates copper bussing.
[5] Use only if the Local Jurisdiction where this panelboard interior is being applied has adopted the 2008 NEC, which allows single panelboard interiors greater than 42 circuits.
[6] When NEMA 3R, 5, or 12 enclosures are selected, an NQ12RDE kit should also be selected. See NQ Merchandised Accessories, page 9-18.
9-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Merchandised Panelboards NQ Main Circuit Breaker Interiors—240 Vac,
48 Vdc
Class 1640 / Refer to Catalog 1640CT0801 schneider-electric.us

NQ Main Circuit Breaker Interiors—240 Vac, 48 Vdc


Table 9.6: Main Circuit Breaker Interiors—Will accept plug-on and bolt-on circuit breakers
Interior Only Type 1 Enclosure Type 3R, 5, 12 Enclosure [7]
(Order Branch Main Circuit Breaker Adapter Kit Box Enclosure
Pole Mains Circuit Breakers (Less Circuit Breaker) 20 in. W x Mono-Flat™ Hinged Front 20 in. W x
Spaces Rating Separately) 5.75 in. D [8] Front Height
6.5in. D
(In.)
Catalog No. [9] Catalog No. Circuit Breaker Frame Catalog No. Catalog Catalog No. Catalog No.
Size [10] No. [11]
9

20-inch-wide Cabinet [12]—Single Phase 3-Wire


NQ18L1 —
16[13] Select MH26 NC26 ( ) NC26( )HR MH26WP 26
100 NQ18L1C —
QOB 2-pole or
back-fed NQ30L1 — QOB-VH[14]
28[13] MH32 NC32 ( ) NC32( )HR MH32WP 32
NQ30L1C —
NQ18L1
18 100 HD, HG, HJ, HL[15] or QB, MH38 NC38 ( ) NC38( )HR MH38WP 38
NQ18L1C NQMB2HJ
NQMB2Q QD, QG, QJ
NQ30L1 100A maximum
30 100 MH44 NC44 ( ) NC44( )HR MH44WP 44
PANELBOARDS

NQ30L1C
NQ30L2
30 225 MH44 NC44 ( ) NC44( )HR MH44WP 44
NQ30L2C
NQ42L2
42 225 HD, HG, HJ, HL[15] or JD, MH50 NC50 ( ) NC50( )HR MH50WP 50
NQ42L2C NQMB2HJ JG, JJ, JL
NQ72L2 NQMB2Q QB,QD,QG,QJ
72[16] 225 MH56 NC56 ( ) NC56( )HR MH56WP 56
NQ72L2C
NQ84L2
84[16] 225 MH62 NC62 ( ) NC62( )HR MH62WP 62
NQ84L2C
NQ30L4
30 400 NQMB4LA LA/LH[17] MH62 NC62V ( ) NC62V( )HR MH62WP 62
NQ30L4C
NQ42L4
42 400 NQMB4LA LA/LH[17] MH62 NC62V ( ) NC62V( )HR MH62WP 62
NQ42L4C
NQ54L4
54 400 NQMB4LA LA/LH[17] MH68 NC68V ( ) NC68V( )HR MH68WP 68
NQ54L4C
84[16] 400 NQ84L4C NQMB4LA LA/LH[17] MH80 NC80V ( ) NC80V( )HR MH80WP 80
20-inch-wide Cabinet [12]—Three Phase 4-Wire
NQ418L1 —
15[13] Select MH26 NC26 ( ) NC26( )HR MH26WP 26
100 NQ418L1C —
QOB 3-pole or
back-fed NQ430L1 — QOB-VH[14]
27[13] MH32 NC32 ( ) NC32( )HR MH32WP 32
NQ430L1C —
NQ418L1
18 HD, HG, HJ, HL, or QB, MH38 NC38 ( ) NC38( )HR MH38WP 38
NQ418L1C NQMB2HJ
100 NQMB2Q QD, QG, QJ
NQ430L1 100A maximum
30 MH44 NC44 ( ) NC44( )HR MH44WP 44
NQ430L1C
NQ430L2
30 MH44 NC44 ( ) NC44( )HR MH44WP 44
NQ430L2C
NQ442L2
42
NQ442L2C
HD, HG, HJ, HL or JD, JG, MH50 NC50 ( ) NC50( )HR MH50WP 50
NQ454L2 NQMB2HJ
54 225 JJ, JL
NQ454L2C NQMB2Q QB,QD,QG,QJ
NQ472L2
72 MH56 NC56 ( ) NC56( )HR MH56WP 56
NQ472L2C
NQ484L2
84 MH62 NC62 ( ) NC62( )HR MH62WP 62
NQ484L2C
NQ430L4
30
NQ430L4C
NQMB4LA LA/LH[17] MH62 NC62V ( ) NC62V( )HR MH62WP 62
NQ442L4
42
NQ442L4C
400 NQ454L4
54 NQMB4LA LA/LH[17] MH68 NC68V ( ) NC68V( )HR MH68WP 68
NQ454L4C
NQ472L4
72[16] NQMB4LA LA/LH[17] MH74 NC74V ( ) NC74V( )HR MH74WP 74
NQ472L4C
84[16] NQ484L4C NQMB4LA LA/LH[17] MH80 NC80V ( ) NC80V( )HR MH80WP 80

[7] Enclosure includes trim kit.


[8] Embossed mounting holes add a 0.25 inch standoff to back of MH box.
[9] “C’’ suffix indicates copper bussing.
[10] Circuit breaker interrupt ratings, see the tables starting on page 7-30.
[11] Add “F” for flush mount, “S” for surface mount.
[12] For the NQ14-inch-wide panelboard offer, See NQ 14-inch-wide—240 Vac, 48 Vdc, page 9-17.
[13] Pole spaces shown are available for branch circuits, with spaces deducted for the back fed main breaker.
[14] QOB2150VH takes four pole spaces; all other QOB two pole circuit breakers take two pole spaces.
NOTE: Do not select a back-fed main for panels to be “Suitable for use as UL service equipment.”
[15] For single phase applications, order a 3-pole breaker. Example: HDL36100.
[16] Use only if the Local Jurisdiction where this panelboard interior is being applied has adopted the 2008 NEC, which allows single panelboard interiors greater than 42 circuits.
[17] For 400 A applications, order short handle circuit breaker (LAL36400MB).
9-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Main Circuit Breaker Interiors—240 Vac, NQ Merchandised Panelboards
48 Vdc
schneider-electric.us Class 1640 / Refer to Catalog 1640CT0801
NQ 14-inch-wide—240 Vac, 48 Vdc
Features
14-inch-wide NQ panelboards are now available for those customers whose equipment
space is limited. Developed with customer input, Square D™ brand NQ panelboards are
built to last, featuring innovations for ease of installation and durability.

• 240 Vac, 48 Vdc maximum • Interiors accept bolt-on and plug-on branch circuit
breakers
• 225 A maximum main circuit breaker or main lugs
• Three-phase, four-wire, and single-phase, three-wire
• 60 A maximum branch circuit breakers interiors available
• Visi-Trip™ indication on branch circuit breakers • Panelboards available with Mono-Flat™ front
• 10,000–65,000 A Short Circuit Current Rating
(SCCR)
• Suitable for use as service entrance equipment
• Branch circuit filler plates provide fast and easy
• Interiors supplied with tin plated copper bus as installation
standard •

PANELBOARDS
Both fully and series-rated systems are available

Table 9.7: Main Lug Interiors—Accepts Plug-On and Bolt-On Branch Breakers
Interior Only Type 1 Enclosure
(Order Branch
Max. Number Main Circuit Breakers Box 14"W x Mono Flat
Ratings Hinged Front
of Breakers Seperately) 5.75" Db Front
14–inch wide NQ
Panelboard Main Lug Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. [18] Cat. No.
14-inch-wide Cabinet—Single Phase 3-Wire
18 NQ18L1C14 NQB532 NQC32 N/A
100 A
30 NQ30L1C14 NQB532 NQC32 N/A
30 NQ30L2C14 NQB532 NQC32 N/A
225 A
42 NQ42L2C14 NQB538 NQC38 N/A
14-inch-wide Cabinet—Three Phase 4-Wire
18 NQ418L1C14 NQB532 NQC32 N/A
100 A

9
30 NQ430L1C14 NQB532 NQC32 N/A
30 NQ430L2C14 NQB532 NQC32 N/A
225 A
42 NQ442L2C14 NQB538 NQC38 N/A

Table 9.8: Main Circuit Breaker Interiors—Accepts Plug-On and Bolt-On Branch
Breakers
Interior Only Type 1 Enclosure
(Order Branch
Max. Circuit Main Circuit Breaker Adapter
Number Main Kit (Less Circuit Breaker) Box 14"W Mono Flat Hinged
Breakers x 5.75" Db Front Front
of Ratings Seperately)
Main Circuit Breaker Breakers
Panelboard Cat. No.
Cat. No. Cat. No Cat. No [19] Cat. No. [18] Cat. No.
14-inch-wide Cabinet—Single Phase 3-Wire
16 [20] NQ18L1C14 — Select QOB NQB532 NQC32 N/A
100 2-pole or
28 [20] NQ30L1C14 — QOB-VH[21] NQB532 NQC32 N/A
30 NQ30L2C14 HD, HG, HJ, NQB544 NQC44 N/A
NQMB2HJ14 HL, OR JD,
225 or JG, JJ, JL,
42 NQ42L2C14 NQMB2Q14 QB , QD, QG, NQB550 NQC50 N/A
QJ
14-inch-wide Cabinet—Three Phase 4-Wire
15 [20] NQ418L1C14 — Select QOB NQB532 NQC32 N/A
100 3-pole or
Main Lug Panelboard 27 [20] NQ430L1C14 — QOB-VH[21] NQB532 NQC32 N/A
30 NQ430L2C14 HD, HG, HJ, NQB544 NQC44 N/A
NQMB2HJ14 HL, OR JD,
225 or JG, JJ, JL,
42 NQ442L2C14 NQMB2Q14 QB , QD, QG, NQB550 NQC50 N/A
QJ

Table 9.9: NQ Accessories


Description Catalog No.
Equipment Ground Bars
Aluminum PK27GTA
PK23GTA+ #1 to #4/0 Al or Cu lug PK23GTAL
Copper PK27GTACU
Ground Bar Insulator Kit PKGTAB
Filler plate (15 per package) NQFP15
Handle Attachments—Branch Circuit Breakers
Handle lock-off HLO1
Handle tie - (QO and QOB only) QO1HT
Handle padlock attachment—1-pole QO1PA
2- and 3-pole QO1PL
Handle tie and lock-off for three 1-pole (QO, QOB) QO3HT

[18] Add “F” for flush mount, “S” for surface mount.
[19] All 14” W boxes come with blank endwalls.
[20] Pole spaces shown are available for branch circuits, with spaces deducted for the back-fed main breaker.
[21] Select a Q or H frame circuit breaker (and associated main circuit breaker kit) from the list for 225 interiors, for panels to be "Suitable for use as UL service equipment."
9-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Merchandised Panelboards NQ Merchandised Accessories
Class 1640 / Refer to Catalog 1640CT0801
schneider-electric.us

NQ Merchandised Accessories
Table 9.10: NQ Merchandised Neutrals
Mains 200% Neutral Kit Copper 100% Neutral Kit
Ampacity Catalog No. Box Add Schedule Catalog No. Box Add Schedule
100 NQNL1 NQN1CU
no adder PE-1A no adder PE-1A
225 NQNL2 or NQNL2ACCY[22] NQN2CU
400 NQNL4[23] no adder PE-1A NQN6CU
no adder PE-1A
9

600 Not Available NQN6CU

Table 9.11: NQ Merchandised Sub-feed Lugs, Feed-through Lugs and Sub-feed Breakers
Sub-feed Circuit Breaker Kits (breaker not incl.)
Mains Sub-feed Lugs (N/A in MCB Interiors) Feed-through Lugs
Ampacity Single SFB Two SFB
Catalog No. Schedule Catalog No. Schedule Catalog No. Schedule Catalog No. Schedule
NQSFL1 100 A not available; use
100 A PE-1A 225 A interior — — — — —
PANELBOARDS

NQFTL2L[24] NQSFB2Q or
225 A NQSFL2 PE-1A PE-1A PE-1A — —
NQFTL2H[25] NQSFB2HJ
NQFTL4L[24] NQSFB4Q or
400 A NQSFL4 PE-1A PE-1A Use the 2 SFB kit — NQSFB4HJ PE-1A
NQFTL4H[25]
600 A Use FTL Factory Assembled Only
NOTE: See Table 9.12 and Table 9.13.

Table 9.12: Box Selection Table: Merchandised NQ Main Lug Panelboards with Accessories
Sub-feed Lugs Feed-through Lugs Sub-feed Circuit Breakers
Feature
Circuits 225 A
100 A 225 A 400 A 600 A 100 A 225 A 400 A 600 A 100 A (one) 400 A (two) 600 A (two)
18 MH26 — — Use FTL — — — — — —
30 MH32 MH38 MH50 Use FTL MH38 MH50 Factory — MH50 MH74 Factory
42 — MH44 MH50 Use FTL Use 225A MH38 MH56 Asssembled — MH56 MH74 Asssembled
72 — MH50 MH62 Use FTL Interior MH50 MH68 Only — MH62 MH86 Only
84 — MH56 MH68 Use FTL MH56 MH68 — MH68 [26]

Table 9.13: Box Selection Table: Merchandised NQ Vertically Mounted Main Breaker Panelboards w/ Accessories
Feature Feed-through Lugs Sub-feed Circuit Breakers
Circuits 100 A 225 A 400 A 600 A 100 A 225 A (one) 400 A (two) 600 A (two)
18 — — — — — —
30 — MH62 Factory — MH62 MH86 Factory
MH50
42 — MH68 Asssembled — MH68 MH86 Asssembled
72 — MH62 MH80 Only — MH74 [26] Only
84 — MH68 MH80 — MH80 [26]
NOTE: See Table 9.157 NQ SurgeLogic SurgeLoc Plug-on SPDs, page 9-64

Table 9.14: NQ Optional Lugs


AL Compression Lug Kit CU Mechanical Lug Kit CU Compression Kit
Ampacity
Catalog No. Lug Wire Range Catalog No. Lug Wire Range Catalog No. Lug Wire Range
100 NQALV1 one #8–1/0 AWG NQCUM1 one #6–2/0 AWG NQCUV1 one #6–1/0 AWG
225 NQALV2 one #4–300 kcmil NQCUM2 one #6–250 kcmil NQCUV2 one 2/0–300 kcmil
NQALV4 NQCUM4 one 1/0–750 kcmil NQCUV4
400 two 2/0–500 kcmil one 400–700 kcmil
two 1/0–350 kcmil
600 NQALV6 two 2/0–500 kcmil NQCUM6 one 1/0–750 kcmil NQCUV6 two 250–500 kcmil
two 1/0–350 kcmil

[22] For 225A panel with SFL, FTL, or SFB, use NQNL2ACCY (enclosure size increases by 6 inches). Otherwise, use NQNL2.
[23] Not to be used with SFL, FTL, or SFB. These combinations are factory assembled only.
[24] The final character L indicates the kit is used for Low circuit count interiors 30 and 42.
[25] The final character H indicates the kit is used for High circuit count interiors 54, 72, and 84.
[26] Requires box longer than available box offer.
9-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Merchandised Accessories NQ Merchandised Panelboards
Class 1640 / Refer to Catalog 1640CT0801
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.15: NQ Accessories


Description Catalog No.
Sub-feed (Bolt-on)
2-pole QOB2125SL
3-pole QOB3125SL
Equipment Ground Bars
Aluminum PK27GTA
PK23GTA+ #1 to #4/0 Al or Cu lug PK23GTAL
Copper PK27GTACU
Ground Bar Insulator Kit PKGTAB
Filler plate (15 per package) NQFP15
Circuit I.D. Number Strips
1–102 odd/even (left side numbered 1,3,5 ...101) NQ102OE
103–204 odd/even (left side numbered 103,105,107 ... 203) NQ204OE

PANELBOARDS
1–102 sequential (left side numbered 1,2,3 ... 102) NQ102S
103–204 sequential (left side numbered 103,104,105 ... 204) NQ204S
6 in. Extension NQ6RDE
12 in. Extension NQ12RDE
Rail and Deadfront Extensions
18 in. Extension NQ18RDE
24 in. Extension NQ24RDE
Touch-up paint USAS #49 Gray (Aerosol can) PK49SP
Handle Attachments—Branch Circuit Breakers
Handle lock-off HLO1
Handle tie - (QO and QOB only) QO1HT
Handle padlock attachment—1-pole QO1PA
2- and 3-pole QO1PL
Handle tie and lock-off for three 1-pole (QO, QOB) QO3HT
Handle tie for two 10–30 A single pole QO(B) circuit breaker QOHT2
Handle tie for three 10–30 A single pole QO(B) circuit breaker QOHT3

9
Handle Padlock Attachment for Padlocking in OFF position
For padlocking 1P QO circuit breaker in OFF position only, fixed attachment QO1PAF
For padlocking 2P and 3P QO circuit breaker in OFF position only, fixed attachment QO2PAF
For padlocking 1P QO-GFI, QO-AFI, QO-CAFI, and QO-EPD circuit breakers in OFF position only, fixed attachment QOGFI1PAF
For padlocking 2P QO-GFI and QO-EPD circuit breakers in OFF position only, fixed attachment QOGFI2PAF
Neutral or Ground Lugs
#10 to #2 Al or #14 to #4 Cu QO70AN
#4 to #1/0 Al or Cu Q1100AN
#1 to #4/0 Al or Cu Q1150AN
Endwalls for MH Enclosures
Blank (one per package) 8011010501
With Knockouts (one per package) 8011010401

9-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QOB Bolt-On Circuit Breakers With Visi-Trip™ Indicator for NQ
Panelboards
Class 690, 730, 910, 950 schneider-electric.us

QOB Bolt-On Circuit Breakers [1]


Table 9.16: QOB-GFI, QOB-EPD, and QOB-EPE Circuit Breakers
Am- Two-pole—Common
pere One-pole Trip Three-pole—Common Trip
Rating
[2] Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
QOB-GFI—QOB Qwik-Gard™ Circuit Breaker With Ground Fault Circuit Interrupter—UL Class A 4–6 mA People
Protection. [3]
9

120/240 Vac— 208Y/120 Vac—


120 Vac—10 k AIR
10 k AIR 10 k AIR
 15 A QOB115GFI QOB215GFI QOB315GFI
 20 A QOB120GFI QOB220GFI QOB320GFI
 25 A QOB125GFI QOB225GFI —
 30 A QOB130GFI QOB230GFI QOB330GFI
 40 A — QOB240GFI QOB340GFI
 50 A — QOB250GFI QOB350GFI
 60 A — QOB260GFI [4] —
PANELBOARDS

QOB-VHGFI [5]
120 Vac—22 k AIR
 15 A QOB115VHGFI
 20 A QOB120VHGFI
 25 A QOB125VHGFI
 30 A QOB130VHGFI
QOB-EPD—QOB Equipment protection circuit breakers
with UL Listed 30 mA (EPD) or 100 mA (EPE) equipment protection.
120 Vac—10 k AIR 120/240 Vac— 240 Vac—10 k AIR
10 k AIR
 15 A QOB115EPD QOB215EPD QOB315EPD[6] QOB315EPE[6]
 20 A QOB120EPD QOB220EPD QOB320EPD[6] QOB320EPE
 25 A QOB125EPD QOB225EPD — —
 30 A QOB130EPD QOB230EPD QOB330EPD[6] QOB330EPE[6]
 40 A — QOB240EPD QOB340EPD[6] QOB340EPE[6]
 50 A — QOB250EPD QOB350EPD[6] QOB350EPE[6]
 60 A — QOB260EPD — —
QOB-VHEPD
120 Vac—22 k AIR
 15 A QOB115VHEPD
 20 A QOB120VHEPD
 25 A QOB125VHEPD
 30 A QOB130VHEPD
QOB-HM—High magnetic trip circuit breakers
15 A QOB115HM[7]
20 A QOB120HM[7]
QOB-K—Key operated QOB circuit breakers [8]
120 Vac—10 k AIR
10 A QOB110K
15 A QOB115K
20 A QOB120K
25 A QOB125K
30 A QOB130K

Table 9.17: Standard Interrupting QOB 10,000 AIR Circuit Breakers


Two-pole—Common Two-pole— Three-pole—
Ampere One-pole Trip Common Trip [9] Common Trip
Rating [2]
Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
QOB Bolt-On
120/240 Vac—10 k
120 Vac—10 k AIR AIR 240 Vac— 240 Vac—10 k AIR
48 Vdc—5 k AIR 10 k AIR 48 Vdc—5 k AIR [10]
48 Vdc—5 k AIR [10]
 10 A QOB110 QOB210 — QOB310
 15 A QOB115[7][11] QOB215[11] QOB215H QOB315[11]
 20 A QOB120[7][11] QOB220[11] QOB220H QOB320[11]
 25 A QOB125[11] QOB225 [11] QOB225H QOB325[11]
 30 A QOB130[11] QOB230[11] QOB230H QOB330[11]
 35 A QOB135[11] QOB235[11] — QOB335[11]
 40 A QOB140[11] QOB240[11] QOB240H QOB340[11]
 45 A QOB145[11] QOB245[11] — QOB345[11]
 50 A QOB150[11] QOB250[11] QOB250H QOB350[11]
 60 A QOB160[11] QOB260[11] QOB260H QOB360[11]
 70 A QOB170[11] QOB270[11] QOB270H QOB370[11][10]
 80 A — QOB280[11] [10] QOB280H QOB380[11][10]
 90 A — QOB290[11] [10] QOB290H QOB390[11] [10]
100 A — QOB2100[11] [10] QOB2100H QOB3100[11] [10]

[1] For QO plug-on circuit breakers, see the tables starting on Digest page 7-11.
[2] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60 °C or 75 °C conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75 °C conductors.
[3] Do not connect to more than 250 feet of load conductor for the total one-way run to prevent nuisance tripping.
[4] Suitable only for feeding 240 Vac and 208 Vac two-wire loads. Does not contain load neutral connection.
[5] Recommended for applications where high initial inrush may occur and for individual dimmer applications.
[6] See note in Instruction Bulletin when using in an enclosure with a QO403 or QON prefix.
[7] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[8] Available in single pole construction and can be mounted in any single pole space which will accept a standard QOB. These circuit breakers can be turned ON or OFF or RESET with a
special key (Catalog No. QOK10) included with the circuit breaker. These circuit breakers are UL Listed and available as shown in the table.
[9] UL Listed 5,000 AIR on 3Ø corner grounded delta systems.
[10] DC Rating is not available on indicated products.
[11] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating, and refrigeration equipment having motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
9-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
With Visi-Trip™ Indicator for NQ QOB Bolt-On Circuit Breakers
Panelboards
schneider-electric.us Class 690, 730, 910, 950
Table 9.17 Standard Interrupting QOB 10,000 AIR Circuit Breakers (cont'd.)
Two-pole—Common Two-pole— Three-pole—
Ampere One-pole Trip Common Trip [13] Common Trip
Rating [12]
Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
110 A — QOB2110[14] [15] — —
125 A — QOB2125[14] [15] — —
Molded Case Switch 60 A max—240 Vac QOB200 — QOB300
Molded Case Switch 100 A max—240 Vac QOB2000 — QOB3000

Table 9.18: High Interrupting QOB and Specialty Circuit Breakers[16]


Ampere One-pole Two-pole—Common Trip Three-pole—Common Trip
Rating [12] Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
QOB-VH
120 Vac—22 k AIR 120/240 Vac —22 k AIR 240 Vac—22 k AIR

PANELBOARDS
 15 A QOB115VH [17][14] QOB215VH[14] QOB315VH[14]
 20 A QOB120VH [17][14] QOB220VH[14] QOB320VH[14]
 25 A QOB125VH[14] QOB225VH[14] QOB325VH[14]
 30 A QOB130VH[14] QOB230VH[14] QOB330VH[14]
 40 A QOB140VH QOB240VH[14] QOB340VH[14]
 50 A QOB150VH QOB250VH[14] QOB350VH[14]
 60 A QOB160VH QOB260VH[14] QOB360VH[14]
 70 A QOB170VH QOB270VH[14] QOB370VH[14]
 80 A — QOB280VH[14] QOB380VH[14]
 90 A — QOB290VH[14] QOB390VH[14]
100 A — QOB2100VH[14] QOB3100VH[14]
110 A — QOB2110VH[14] QOB3110VH [18]
125 A — QOB2125VH[14] QOB3125VH [18]
150 A — QOB2150VH [18] QOB3150VH [18]

9
QHB
120 Vac—65 k AIR 120 Vac/240 Vac—65 k AIR 240 Vac—65 k AIR
 15 A QHB115 [17] QHB215[14] QHB315[14]
 20 A QHB120 [17] QHB220[14] QHB320[14]
 25 A QHB125[14] QHB225[14] QHB325[14]
 30 A QHB130[14] QHB230[14] QHB330[14]
QOB-HID—HID circuit breakers [19]
120 Vac—10 k AIR 120/240 Vac—10 k AIR 240 Vac—10 k AIR
 15 A QOB115HID [17] QOB215HID QOB315HID
 20 A QOB120HID [17] QOB220HID QOB320HID
 25 A QOB125HID QOB225HID QOB325HID
 30 A QOB130HID QOB230HID QOB330HID
 40 A QOB140HID QOB240HID —
 50 A QOB150HID QOB250HID —
QOB-SWN—Switch Neutral—Common Trip—NEC 514.11
1-pole—2-Wire 2-pole—3-Wire
2 Spaces —120 Vac 3 Spaces—120/240 Vac
10 A — QOB210SWN QOB310SWN
15 A — QOB215SWN QOB315SWN
20 A — QOB220SWN QOB320SWN
25 A — QOB225SWN QOB325SWN
30 A — QOB230SWN QOB330SWN
40 A — QOB240SWN QOB340SWN
50 A — QOB250SWN QOB350SWN

Table 9.19: QO/QOB Circuit Breaker Wire Sizes


Wire Size (AWG)
Breaker Type Ampere Rating
Al Cu
10–30 A #14–8 #14–8
QOB
1-pole 10–30 A — two #14–10
35–70 A #8–2 #8–2
10–30 A #14–8 #14–8
10–30 A — two #14–10
QOB
2-pole 35–70 A #8–2 #8–2
80–125 A #4–2/0 #4–2/0
150–200 A #4–300 kcmil #4–300 kcmil
10–30 A #14–8 #14–8
QOB
3-pole 35–70 A #8–2 #8–2
80–125 A #4–2/0 #4–2/0
QOB-VH 110–150 A #4–300 kcmil #4–300 kcmil
QOB-GFI and 15–30 A #12–8 #14–8
QOB-EPD 40, 50, or 60 A #12–4 #14–6

[12] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60 °C or 75 °C conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75 °C conductors.
[13] UL Listed 5,000 AIR on 3Ø corner grounded delta systems.
[14] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating, and refrigeration equipment having motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[15] DC Rating is not available on indicated products.
[16] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60 °C or 75 °C conductors. 35–0 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75 °C conductors.
[17] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[18] QOB2150VH uses 4 pole spaces. QOB3110VH, QOB3125VH, and QOB3150VH each use 6 pole spaces. 40A maximum circuit breaker mounted opposite. Use with 75 °C wire only.
[19] UL Listed for use on circuit feeding fluorescent and High Intensity Discharge (HID) lighting systems such as mercury vapor, metal halide, or high pressure sodium. These circuit breakers are
physically interchangeable with QOB circuit breakers.

9-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Factory Assembled Panelboards 240 Vac, 48 Vdc
Class 1640 / Refer to Catalog 1640CT0801
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.20: QO™ Arc-Fault Circuit Breakers [20][21][22]


1P 120 Vac 1P 120 Vac
Ampere 10 kAIR 22 kAIR
Circuit Breaker Type 1 Space Required 1 Space Required
Rating [23]
Catalog Number Catalog Number
Combination 15 A QOB115CAFI QOB115VHCAFI
Arc-Fault
Interupter 20 A QOB120CAFI QOB120VHCAFI
NOTE: For accessories, see Accessories for QO/QOB Circuit Breakers, page 7-
15.
9

Sub-feed Circuit Breakers


Main lugs or main circuit breaker interior—1Ø or 3Ø.
Maximum 1 circuit breaker per 225 A main lug or 250 A main circuit breaker panelboard,
2 circuit breakers per 400–600 A panelboard.

Table 9.21: Sub-feed Circuit Breaker (PowerPact Q-frame - see Tables PowerPact
PANELBOARDS

Interrupting Ratings, page 7-30 and Common Catalog Numbering System, page 7-
30)
No. of Poles Ampacity
2 110–225 A
3 110–225 A
Space Only 110–225 A
PowerPact H, J, & L frame circuit breakers are also available - see Tables PowerPact Interrupting Ratings, page 7-
30 and Common Catalog Numbering System, page 7-30

Table 9.22: Sub-feed Circuit Breaker Cabinet Data


Box Height (20 in. W x 5.75 in. D)
Max. No. of Branch Spaces
(Does not include 225 A 250 A 400 A 600 A
sub-feed Main Main Main Main Main Main
circuit breaker spaces) Lug Circuit Lug Circuit Lug Circuit
Breaker Breaker Breaker
30 50 62 74 86 74
42 56 68 74 86 80 Not
54 56 68 80 — 80 available
72 62 74 86 — 86 with MCB
84 68 80 — — —
Not Available in Type 3R, 5, 12 if subfeed breaker is over 150 A.

Sub-feed Lugs
NOTE: Available on main lug interiors only, 1Ø or 3Ø.

Table 9.23: Sub-feed Wire Range Per Phase Table 9.24: Sub-feed Lug Cabinet Data
Mains Rating Incoming Outgoing Max. No. of Box Height (20 in. W x 5.75 in. D)
100 one #6-2/0 Al or Cu one #6-2/0 Al or Cu Branch Spaces 100 A 225 A 400 A
225 one 1/0-350 kcmil Al or Cu one 1/0-350 kcmil Al or Cu 18 MH26 — —
400 one 1/0-750 kcmil Cu only one 1/0-750 kcmil Cu only 30 MH32 MH38 MH50
42 — MH44 MH50
54 — MH44 MH50
72 — MH50 MH62
84 — MH56 MH68

Feed-through Lugs
Table 9.25: Feed-through Lugs Table 9.26: Feed-through Lug Cabinet Data
Mains Rating Feed-Through Wire Range Per Phase Box Height (20 in. W x 5.75 in. D)
100 A one #6-2/0 Al or Cu Max. No. 225 A 250 A 400 A 600 A
225 A one #6–350 kcmil Al or Cu of Branch Main
Main Main Main Main Main Circuit
400 A one 1/0–750 kcmil or two 1/0–350 kcmil Al or Cu Spaces Circuit Circuit
Lugs Lugs Lugs Break-
600 A two 1/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu Breaker Breaker er [1]
30 38 50 50 62 62 68
42 38 50 56 68 62 80
72 50 62 68 80 74 —
84 56 68 68 80 80 —

Table 9.27: Ground Bars Table 9.28: Name Plates


Ground Bars Name Plates
Equipment Ground Bar Standard white face/black letter laminated bakelite,
Copper Ground Bar 1 in. x 3.5 in., adhesive backed or screw mountable with
screws in a bag assembly
Insulated/Isolated Ground Bar

Table 9.29: Copper Bus Bars Table 9.30: Copper Neutrals


Copper Bus Bars Copper Neutrals
100 A, 225 A, 250 A 100–600 A
400 A
600 A

[20] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating, and refrigeration equipment having motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[21] QO arc-fault circuit breakers provide branch feeder protection (for example, QO115AFI) or combination protection (for example, QO115CAFI) as required by the NEC and local code
adoption, and comply with UL 1699.
[22] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60 °C or 75 °C conductors. 35–0 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75 °C conductors.
[23] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60 °C or 75 °C conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75 °C conductors.
[1] 8.75 in. deep box, ship fully assembled only.
9-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Common Features NQ Factory Assembled Panelboards
Class 1640 / Refer to Catalog 1640CT0801
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.31: 200% Rated Neutrals Table 9.32: NQ Main Neutral Conductors—Required Size and
Panelboards with 200% rated neutrals are not available with 250 A J- and K-frame main
circuit breakers or integral lighting contactors Quanitity
100 A[2] one #6-2/0 kcmil Al or Cu per lug Panelboard Actual Lug Wire
Ampacity Neutral Conductors Required Range
225 A[2] one #6-350 kcmil Al or Cu per lug
one #1/0-750 kcmil Al or Cu per lug or 100/125 (2) 1/0 Cu or Al (2) #4-300kcmil
400 A[2] two 1/0-300 kcmil per lug 225 (2) 4/0 Cu or (2) 300 kcmil Al (2) #4-300 kcmil
(4) 3/0 Cu or
(4) 250 kcmil Al (2) 1/0-300 kcmil or
400 A (2) 600 kcmil Cu (1) 750 kcmil
(2) 750 kcmil Al
NOTE: Neutral conductors must be of size and quantity per
table above.

Table 9.33: Metal Directory Frames Table 9.34: Hinged Door-in-Door Trims

PANELBOARDS
Metal Directory Frame Hinged Door-in-Door Trim
Replaces standard plastic stick-on directory pouch Hinged Door-in-Door Trim has piano hinge down one side.
Inner door has a lock, outer door is retained with screws
Hinged Door-in-Door with Outer Door Lock in place of screws

Table 9.35: Weatherproof or Dusttight Cabinets—Type 3R, 5, 12 Table 9.36: Optional Factory Assembled Lugs
Weatherproof or Dusttight Cabinets for Main Lug Interiors
NOTE: 600 A L-Frame main circuit breaker NQ panelboards are not Main Lug Interiors
available with a weatherproof enclosure (Use I-Line) Aluminum Compression Lugs
Copper Mechanical Lugs
Copper Compression Lugs
400 and 600 A NQ panelboards with sub-feed circuit breakers are not available with a weatherproof
enclosure (Use I-Line).
400 A NQ panelboards are available with a subfeed breaker up to 150 A. See Table 9.22 Sub-feed

9
Circuit Breaker Cabinet Data, page 9-22.

NOTE: Optional lugs are not available for Q frame main or QOB
Table 9.37: Optional Factory Assembled Lugs circuit breakers
for Main Circuit Breaker Interiors
Main Circuit Breaker Interiors: Table 9.38: Surgelogic™ SurgeLoc Plug-On SPD [3]
Aluminum Compression Lugs
Surge Current Rating kA
Copper Mechanical Lugs
80 kA
Copper Compression Lugs 100 kA
120 kA
160 kA
200 kA
240 kA

Table 9.39: Surgelogic SPD Options


Description
Surge Counter
Dry Contacts
Remote Monitor
NOTE: Additional factory modifications, see Modifications For
Factory Assembled Panelboards, page 9-61.

[2] Two incoming neutral lugs per panel


[3] SurgeLogic units occupy 12 circuit positions (6 adjacent mounting spaces per side.)
9-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Factory Assembled Panelboards Fingersafe IP2X per IEC 60529 Barriers for
NQ Panelboards
Class 1640 schneider-electric.us

Factory-installed IP2X barriers for NQ Panelboards reduce the risk of accidental contact
with energized components if a cover is removed.
Features
• Plastic barriers cover Mains (lugs or circuit breaker), copper bus, and branch circuit
breakers
– IP2X per IEC 60529 on all ungrounded parts
9

• 240 Vac maximum


• Three phase (Wye and Delta)
NEMA 1, 2, 3R, 4/4X, 5, or 12 (up to 225 A)
– NEMA 1 panelboards up to 400 A[4]
• Branch circuits up to 100 A: 1-, 2-, and 3-pole
• Selectively coordinated up to 30k AIC
• Available with main lugs, or PowerPact Q-, H-, J-frame, and LA/LH[4] main
PANELBOARDS

circuit breakers
• Series rated up to 200 kAIC with integral main circuit breaker—fully rated
up to 65 kAIC
• Sub feed[4] lugs up to 225 A
• cULus Listed to UL 67 and CSA C22.2, No. 29
New Enhanced IP2X design meets IEC 60529 with or without a branch circuit
breaker installed.
• Same plastic barriers over mains, bus ends, and branch circuit breaker terminations
as standard NQ Fingersafe design
• Unique
barriers
jaw kit allows QOB branch circuit breakers to plug onto NQ interior with IP2X

Two factory-assembled constructions:


Standard IP2X per IEC 60529 Enhanced IP2X per IEC 6052
(Bus Finger Covers Empty Spaces) (Bus Covered Without Branch Circuit Breaker)

[4] Available only in Standard IP2X design.


9-24
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Fingersafe IP2X per IEC 60529 Barriers for NQ Factory Assembled Panelboards
NQ Panelboards
schneider-electric.us Class 1640
Specifications
NQ Fingersafe Bus Ratings, Enclosures, and Circuit Counts
IP2X Mains Enclo- Circuit Count
Design rating sures: 18 30 42 54 72 84
NEMA
types
100 1, 2, 3R, X X — — — —
Standard 225 4/4X, 5, 12 — X X X X X
400 1 — X X — X X
Enhanced 225 1, 2, 3R, — — X — — —
4/4X, 5, 12

QO(B) Branch Circuit Breaker Ratings[5]


Branch Circuit Amperes 1–Pole 1–Pole 3–Pole
Breaker
10–60 L L L

PANELBOARDS
QO / QOB 70 L L H
80–100 — H H
QO-H / QOB-H 15–30 — L —
40–100 — H —
15–30 L L L
QO-HID / QOB-HID
40–50 L L —
QO-HM / QOB-HM 15–20 L — —
15–30 — L L
QO- VH / QOB-VH 15–70 L — —
40–100 — H H
QOH[6] 40–100 — H —
QHB[6] 15–30 L L —
IP2X QO(B) Lug L (Low Amp) - QOFSLALB
overs: H (High Amp) - QOFSHALB

Replacement Parts

9
Replacement Parts
Catalog Number Quantity Per Package Description
QOFSBF12 12 NQ IP2X Bus Finger Filler[7]
QOFSLALB12 12 NQ IP2X QO(B) Lug Cover Low Amp
NQ IP2X QO(B) Lug Cover High
QOFSHALB12 12 Amp
HJQLLC HJQ Main Breaker IP2X Line Lug
1
Cover
LA/LH Main Breaker IP2X Line Lug
LALLC 1
Cover
NQHJLSC HJ Main Breaker IP2X Load Side
1 Cover
NQQLSC Q Main Breaker IP2x Load Side
1 Cover
NQLALHLSC LA/LH Main Breaker IP2X Load Side
1
Cover
NQMLLSC 1 Main Lugs IP2X Cover
NQNCC 1 NQ IP2X Neutral Cover
QO1PJ15 1 QOB Jaw Kit[8]

[5] QOB circuit breakers and jaw kits required for Enhanced IP2X design.
[6] Available only in standard IP2X design
[7] Used only with Standard IP2X design.
[8] Used only with Enhanced IP2X design.
9-25
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NF Merchandised Panelboards 20-inch Wide Enclosures 480Y/277 Vac
Max.
Class 1670 / Refer to Catalog 1670CT0701 schneider-electric.us

20-inch Wide Enclosures 480Y/277 Vac Max.


Table 9.40: NF Main Lug Interiors—Use I-Line™ Panelboards on 480 V 3Ø3W Delta Applications
NEMA 1 Enclosure NEMA 3R, 5, 12 Enclosure [2]
Max No. of Box
Single Pole Interior Only [1] Mono-Flat™ Enclosure
Mains Rating 20 in. W x Hinged Front
EDB Circuit Front [4] 20 in. W x 6.5 in. D Height (In.)
5.75 in. D [3]
Breakers
Catalog No. [5] Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
(Single Phase 3-Wire: Factory Assembled Only) Three Phase 4-Wire
9

NF418L1 MH26 NC26( ) NC26( )HR MH26WP


18 125 26
NF418L1C MH26 NC26( ) NC26( )HR MH26WP
NF430L1 MH32 NC32( ) NC32( )HR MH32WP
30 125 32
NF430L1C MH32 NC32( ) NC32( )HR MH32WP
NF430L2 MH38 NC38( ) NC38( )HR MH38WP
30 250 38
NF430L2C MH38 NC38( ) NC38( )HR MH38WP
NF442L2 MH44 NC44( ) NC44( )HR MH44WP
42 250 44
NC44( ) NC44( )HR
PANELBOARDS

NF442L2C MH44 MH44WP


NF454L2 MH50 NC50( ) NC50( )HR MH50WP
54 250 56
NF454L2C MH50 NC50( ) NC50( )HR MH50WP
NF466L2 MH62 NC62( ) NC62( )HR MH62WP
66 [6] 250 62
NF466L2C MH62 NC62( ) NC62( )HR MH62WP
NF430L4 MH50 NC50V( ) NC50V( )HR MH50WP
30 400 50
NF430L4C MH50 NC50V( ) NC50V( )HR MH50WP
NF442L4 MH56 NC56V( ) NC56V( )HR MH56WP
42 400 56
NF442L4C MH56 NC56V( ) NC56V( )HR MH56WP
NF466L4 MH74 NC74V( ) NC74V( )HR MH74WP
66 [6] 400 74
NF466L4C MH74 NC74V( ) NC74V( )HR MH74WP
NF484L4 MH86 NC86V( ) NC86V( )HR MH86WP
84 [6] 400 86
NF484L4C MH86 NC86V( ) NC86V( )HR MH86WP
30 600 NF430L6C MH50 NC50V( ) NC50V( )HR Factory 50
42 600 NF442L6C MH56 NC56V( ) NC56V( )HR Assembled 56
66 [6] NC74V( ) NC74V( )HR Only
600 NF466L6C MH74 74
84 [6] 600 NF484L6C MH86 NC86V( ) NC86V( )HR — —
800 Factory Assembled Only

Table 9.41: NF Main Circuit Breaker Interiors—Use I-Line Panelboards on 480 V 3Ø3W Delta Applications
NEMA 1 Enclosure NEMA 3R, 5, 12 Enclosure [2]
Max. No. of Main Circuit
Mains Breaker Main Circuit Interior Only [1] Box Mono-Flat™
One-pole EDB 20 in. W x Hinged Front Enclosure
Circuit Rating Adapter Kit Breaker Front [4] 20 in. W x 6.5 in. D Height
Frame 5.75in. D [3] (In.)
Breakers
Kit Catalog No. [5] Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
(Single Phase 3-Wire: Factory Assembled Only) Three Phase 4-Wire
NF418L1 MH26 NC26( ) NC26( )HR MH26WP
15 125 Back-fed 26
EDB, EGB or NF418L1C MH26 NC26( ) NC26( )HR MH26WP
Main
Breaker[7] EJB NF430L1 MH32 NC32( ) NC32( )HR MH32WP
27 125 32
NF430L1C MH32 NC32( ) NC32( )HR MH32WP
NF418L1 MH38 NC38( ) NC38( )HR MH38WP
18 125 38
N150MH HD/HG/ NF418L1C MH38 NC38( ) NC38( )HR MH38WP
[8] HJ/HL NF430L1 MH44 NC44( ) NC44( )HR MH44WP
30 125 44
NF430L1C MH44 NC44( ) NC44( )HR MH44WP
NF430L2 MH50 NC50( ) NC50( )HR MH50WP
30 250 50
NF430L2C MH50 NC50( ) NC50( )HR MH50WP
NF442L2 MH56 NC56( ) NC56( )HR MH56WP
42 250 56
N250MJ JD/JG/ NF442L2C MH56 NC56( ) NC56( )HR MH56WP
[8] JJ/JL NF454L2 MH62 NC62( ) NC62( )HR MH62WP
54 250 56
NF454L2C MH62 NC62( ) NC62( )HR MH62WP
NF466L2 MH74 NC74( ) NC74( )HR MH74WP
66 [9] 250 74
NF466L2C MH74 NC74( ) NC74( )HR MH74WP
NF430L4 MH62 NC62V( ) NC62V( )HR MH62WP
30 400 N400M[8] 62
NF430L4C MH62 NC62V( ) NC62V( )HR MH62WP
NF442L4 MH68 NC68V( ) NC68V( )HR MH68WP
42 400 N400M[8] LA/LH 68
NF442L4C MH68 NC68V( ) NC68V( )HR MH68WP
NF466L4 MH86 NC86V( ) NC86V( )HR MH86WP
66 [9] 400 N400M[8] 86
NF466L4C MH86 NC86V( ) NC86V( )HR MH86WP

Table 9.42: NF Merchandised SPD Box Selection Table


Main Lug Panelboard Box Requirements Main Circuit Breaker Panelboard Box Requirements
Mains Max.
Breaker NEMA 1 NEMA 3R, 5, 12 NEMA 1 Enclosure NEMA 3R, 5,
Rating Enclosure Enclosure 12 Enclosure
Spaces
Box Front Hinged Enclosure Box Front Hinged Enclosure
250A 42 MH56 NC56( ) NC56( )HR MH56WP MH68 NC68( ) NC68( )HR MH68WP
400 A 42 MH68 NC68V( ) NC68V( )HR MH68WP MH80 NC80( ) M/B NC80V( )HR MH80WP

[1] Order branch circuit breakers separately.


[2] Enclosure includes trim kit.
[3] Embossed mounting holes add a 0.25-inch standoff to back of MH box.
[4] Add “F” for flush mount, “S” for surface mount.
[5] “C” suffix indicates copper bussing.
[6] Use only if the Local Jurisdiction where this panelboard interior is being applied has adopted the 2008 NEC, which allows single panelboard interiors greater than 42 circuits.
[7] Back-fed EDB 125 A 3 pole main circuit breaker must be ordered separately and field installed. Maximum breaker rating opposite is 20 A.
[8] Select the appropriate main circuit breaker from pages starting on The PowerPact Advantage, page 7-30.
[9] Use only if the Local Jurisdiction where this panelboard interior is being applied has adopted the 2008 NEC, which allows single panelboard interiors greater than 42 circuits.
9-26
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories NF Merchandised Panelboards
Class 1670 / Refer to Catalog 1670CT0701
schneider-electric.us

Accessories
Table 9.43: NF Merchandised Neutrals
Mains 200% Neutral Kit Copper 100% Neutral Kit
Ampacity Catalog No. Catalog No.
125 NFNL1 NFN1CU
250 NFNL2 NFN2CU
400 NFNL4[10] NFN6CU
600 Factory Assembled Only NFN6CU[10]

Table 9.44: Modifications (Single- or Three-phase)


Feed-through Sub-feed Circuit Breaker Kits [11]
Sub-feed Lugs [11] [12]
Lugs [11] [12] (circuit breaker not Included) [13]
Mains Mains
Ampacity Ampacity Single Sub-feed Twin Sub-feed

PANELBOARDS
Catalog No. Catalog No. Circuit Breaker Circuit Breakers
Catalog No. Catalog No.
125 NF125SFL NF125FTL 250 NF250SFBH/NF250SFBJ —
250 NF250SFL NF250FTL — NF600SFBH
400
400 NF400SFL [14] NF400FTL — NF600SFBJ
600
[15] [15] 600 FACTORY ASSEMBLED ONLY
800
800 FACTORY ASSEMBLED ONLY
NOTE: NF250SFBH and NF600SFBH are for use with HDL, HGL, HJL, and HLL circuit breakers. NF600SFBJ are for use with JDL, JGL,
JJL, and JLL circuit breakers.

Table 9.45: Special Features Box Selection Table—Standard Mechanical Lugs Only
Main Lugs Only
Feature Sub-feed Lugs Feed-through Lugs Sub-feed Circuit Breaker

9
No. of
18 30 42 66 84 18 30 42 66 84 30 42 66
Circuits
Ampacity Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat No. Cat No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
100/125 MH26 MH32 — — — MH32 MH38 — — — — — —
 250 — MH38 MH44 MH62 — — MH50 MH56 MH74 — MH56 MH62 MH80
 400 — MH50 MH56 MH74 MH86 — MH56 MH62 MH80 MH92 MH68 MH74 —
 600
— [15] [15] [15] [15] — [15] [15] [15] [15] [15] [15] [15]
 800

Table 9.46: Special Features Box Selection Table—Standard Mechanical Lugs Only (continued)
Vertical Main Circuit Breaker [16] Back-fed Main Circuit Breaker
Feature Feed-through Lugs Sub-feed Circuit Breaker Feed-through Lugs
No. of Circuits 18 30 42 66 30 42 18 30
Ampacity Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
100/125 MH44 MH50 — — — — MH32 MH38
250 — MH62 MH68 MH86 MH68 MH74 MH38 MH44
400[16] — MH68 MH74 MH92 MH80 MH86 — —
600 Available factory assembled only. — —

Table 9.47: Optional Main Lug Kits for Main Lug Panelboards
AL Compression Lug Kit CU Mechanical Lug Kit CU Compression Lug Kit [14]
Ampacity
Catalog No. Lug Wire Range Catalog No. Lug Wire Range Catalog No. Lug Wire Range
125 NFALV1 [17] one #4–300 kcmil NFCUM1 #6–2/0 AWG NFCUV1 [18] one #6–1/0
250 NFALV2 one 250–350 kcmil NFCUM2 #6–250 kcmil NFCUV2 [18] one 2/0–300 kcmil
one 1/0–750 kcmil,
400 NFALV4 two 2/0–500 kcmil NFCUM4 two 1/0–350 kcmil NFCUV4 one 400–750 kcmil
600 NFALV6 two 2/0–500 kcmil NFCUM6 two 1/0–750 kcmil NFCUV6 two 250–500 kcmil
800 Contact your local Schneider Electric representative or distributor.

Table 9.48: NF Accessories


Description Catalog No. Description Catalog No.
Aluminum Equipment Ground Bar PK27GTA Filler plate (15 per package) NFFP15
Copper Equipment Ground Bar PK27GTACU EXB Fixed padlock attachment, Lock ON/OFF
for ED, EG, and EJ Circuit Breakers 1, 2, or 3 poles EDPA
Large Aluminum Lug for Equipment Ground Bar PK23GTAL
Equipment Ground Bar Insulator Kit PKGTAB EXB Fixed padlock attachment, Lock OFF only
for ED, EG, and EJ Circuit Breakers 1, 2, or 3 poles EDPAF
Circuit I.D. number strips
1–102 odd/even (left side numbered 1, 3, 5...101) NF102OE
103–204 odd/even (left side numbered 103, 105, 107...203) NF204OE Oversized Lugs for Neutral or Ground Bar
1–102 sequential (left side numbered 1, 2, 3 ...102) NF102S #10 to #2 Al or #14 to #4 Cu QO70AN
103–204 sequential (left side numbered 103, 104, 105... 204) NF204S #4 to #1/0 Al or Cu Q1100AN
Rail and Deadfront Extensions #1 to #4/0 Al or Cu Q1150AN
6 in. Extension NF6RDE Drip Hood for 20 in. wide enclosures MHT2DH20
12 in. Extension NF12RDE
18 in. Extension NF18RDE

[10] Not to be used with SFL, FTL, or SFB. These combinations are factory assembled only.
[11] Available factory assembled only on non-linear panelboards.
[12] Select box from the Box Selection Table.
[13] Order appropriate circuit breaker.
[14] Use copper wire only.
[15] Available factory assembled only.
[16] 400 A dimension for LA/LH main circuit breakers only.
[17] Use of this kit requires an additional 6 in. added to box height.
[18] Use of this kit to terminate larger than standard wire size requires an additional 6 in. added to box height.
9-27
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breakers For NF Merchandised Panelboards
Class 515
schneider-electric.us

For NF Merchandised Panelboards


Table 9.49: E-frame—125 A, Thermal-magnetic (480Y/277 Vac)
“D” Interrupting “G” Interrupting “J” Interrupting
ED, EG, EJ (480Y/ Level Level Level
Ampere 277 Vac) 18 kA @ 480Y/ 35 kA @ 480Y/ 65 kA @ 480Y/ Terminal
Rating 277 Vac 277 Vac 277 Vac Wire Range
Hold Trip Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
1-pole, 277 Vac
 15 A EDB14015[1][2] EGB14015[1][2] EJB14015[1][2]
 20 A EDB14020[1][2] EGB14020[1][2] EJB14020[1][2] AL30FD
270 875 #14–#6
 25 A EDB14025[2] EGB14025[2] EJB14025[2] Al or Cu
 30 A EDB14030[2] EGB14030[2] EJB14030[2]
 35 A EDB14035[2] EGB14035[2] EJB14035[2]
 40 A EDB14040[2] EGB14040[2] EJB14040[2]
 45 A EDB14045[2] EGB14045[2] EJB14045[2] AL100FD
630 1800 #14–2/0
 50 A EDB14050[2] EGB14050[2] EJB14050[2] Al or Cu
 60 A EDB14060 EGB14060 EJB14060
EDB, EGB, EJB
1–pole  70 A EDB14070 EGB14070 EJB14070
15–70 A 2-pole, 480Y/277 Vac [3]
 15 A EDB24015[2] EGB24015[2] EJB24015[2]
 20 A EDB24020[2] EGB24020[2] EJB24020[2] AL30FD
270 875 #14–#6
 25 A EDB24025[2] EGB24025[2] EJB24025[2] Al or Cu
 30 A EDB24030[2] EGB24030[2] EJB24030[2]
 35 A EDB24035[2] EGB24035[2] EJB24035[2]
 40 A EDB24040[2] EGB24040[2] EJB24040[2]
 45 A EDB24045[2] EGB24045[2] EJB24045[2] AL100FD
630 1800 #14–2/0
 50 A EDB24050[2] EGB24050[2] EJB24050[2] Al or Cu
 60 A EDB24060 EGB24060 EJB24060
 70 A EDB24070 EGB24070 EJB24070
 80 A EDB24080 EGB24080 EJB24080
 90 A EDB24090 EGB24090 EJB24090 AL100FD
100 A 1000 2300 EDB24100 EGB24100 EJB24100 #14–2/0
110 A EDB24110 EGB24110 EJB24110 Al or Cu
EDB, EGB, EJB 125 A EDB24125 EGB24125 EJB24125
2–pole 3-pole, 480Y/277 Vac
15–125 A EDB34015[2] EGB34015[2] EJB34015[2]
 15 A
 20 A EDB34020[2] EGB34020[2] EJB34020[2] AL30FD
270 875 #14–#6
 25 A EDB34025[2] EGB34025[2] EJB34025[2] Al or Cu
 30 A EDB34030[2] EGB34030[2] EJB34030[2]
 35 A EDB34035[2] EGB34035[2] EJB34035[2]
 40 A EDB34040[2] EGB34040[2] EJB34040[2]
 45 A EDB34045[2] EGB34045[2] EJB34045[2] AL100FD
630 1800 #14–2/0
 50 A EDB34050[2] EGB34050[2] EJB34050[2] Al or Cu
 60 A EDB34060 EGB34060 EJB34060
 70 A EDB34070 EGB34070 EJB34070
 80 A EDB34080 EGB34080 EJB34080
 90 A EDB34090 EGB34090 EJB34090 AL100FD
100 A 1000 2300 EDB34100 EGB34100 EJB34100 #14–2/0
110 A EDB34110 EGB34110 EJB34110 Al or Cu
125 A EDB34125 EGB34125 EJB34125
EPDs (Equipment Protection Devices), 1-pole, 277 Vac, Thermal-magnetic with 30 mA ground-fault protection[4]
EDB14015EPD[1] EGB14015EPD[1] EJB14015EPD[1]
 15 A [2] [2] [2]
270 875 EDB14020EPD[1] EGB14020EPD[1] EJB14020EPD[1] #14–#6 Cu
 20 A [2] [2] [2] or
 30 A EDB14030EPD[2] EGB14030EPD[2] EJB14030EPD[2] #12–#4 Al
 40 A EDB14040EPD[2] EGB14040EPD[2] EJB14040EPD[2]
630 1800
 50 A EDB14050EPD[2] EGB14050EPD[2] EJB14050EPD[2]
NOTE: All EDB, EGB, and EJB circuit breakers are UL Listed as HACR Type. For
50 oC calibration, use a CA suffix. NF branch circuit breakers are fungus proof as
standard.

[1] UL Listed as SWD (Switching duty rated).


[2] UL Listed as HID (High Intensity Discharge rated).
[3] UL Listed for use on 240 V Corner-grounded Delta Systems (Grounded B Phase). See data bulletin 2700DB0202.
[4] All EPDs occupy two spaces, with or without Alarm Switch option. For alarm switch, add 158 list Price and the suffix BA.
9-28
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Maximum 480Y/277 Vac NF Factory Assembled Panelboards
Class 1670 / Refer to Catalog 1670CT0701
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.50: Factory installed Electrical Accessories


Minimum
Recommended
Coil Burden Max. (VA)
Auxiliary Switch (1A/1B) Alarm Switch (NO) Supply Transformer
(VA)
288 50
Monitors circuit breaker contact Used with control circuits Shunt Trip—Trips the circuit breaker from a
and is actuated only when
status and provides a remote remote location by means of a coil energized
signal indicating the circuit breaker the circuit breaker has from a separate circuit. A 120 V shunt trip will
tripped.
contacts are OPEN or CLOSED. operate at 55% or more of rated voltage.
Application Application Application
Max Load = 7 A @ 120 Vac
Max Load = 10 A @ 120 Vac 50/60 50/60 Hz For use with momentary or maintained push
Hz button. 120 Vac 50/60 Hz
Terminals for #14 AWG Cu
Terminals for #14 AWG Cu wire wire. Terminals for #14 AWG Cu wire.

EDB, EGB, EJB Table 9.51: Factory Installed Electrical Accessory Packages for ED, EG, EJ
3–pole

PANELBOARDS
15–125 A Circuit Breakers
Accessory Package Suffix
[5][6] AABA
Shunt Trip Package[5][6] SA
Auxiliary Switch/Alarm
Switch/Shunt Trip Package[5][6] AABASA
Alarm Switch (N.O.) Package for EPDs only BA

Table 9.52: Terminal Nut Insert Kit


Circuit Breaker Type Qty. per Kit Catalog No.
ED, EG, EJ 3 TIKFD

Table 9.53: Handle Accessories


Circuit Breaker Type No. of Poles Catalog No.

9
EXB Fixed Padlock Attachment, Lock ON/OFF
EDB, EPD
1–pole ED, EG, EJ 1, 2, or 3 EDPA
with Alarm Switch EXB Fixed padlock attachment, Lock OFF only
ED, EG, EJ 1, 2, or 3 EDPAF
EXB Removable padlock attachment, Lock OFF only
ED, EG, EJ 1, 2, or 3 HPAFD
EXB Handle Ties
Ties 2 – 1P ECB2HT
ED, EG, EJ
Ties 3 – 1P ECB3HT

Table 9.54: Interrupt Ratings (kA)


EDB EGB EJB
120 V 25 65 100
240 V 18 (1P), 25 35 (1P), 65 65 (1P), 100
480Y/277 V 18 35 65

Table 9.55: Mechanical Lug Kit Information (Al lugs for use with Al or Cu wire)[6]
Circuit Breaker Application Number of Wires Per
Lug Catalog Lugs
Ampere Ampere Number Per Kit
Standard Rating Optional Rating and Wire Range

15–30 A — — one #12—#6 AWG Al or AL30FD 3


EDB, EGB, one #14—#6 AWG Cu
EJB EDB, EGB, one #12—2/0 AWG Al or
35–125 A 15–30 A [7] AL100FD 3
EJB one #14—2/0 AWG Cu
EDB, EGB,
— — 15–125 A one #14—1/0 AWG Cu CU100FD 3
EJB
E-frame dimensions ED, EG, EJ, and GJ Circuit Breakers, page 7-77.
Sub-feed Circuit Breaker
Available on 1Ø or 3Ø, 250–800 A main lugs or 250–600 A main circuit breaker interiors
• One sub-feed HD, HG, HJ, or HL or JD, JG, JJ, or JL circuit breaker per 250 A
panelboard
• Two sub-feed HD, HG, HJ, or HL or two JD, JG, JJ, or JL circuit breakers per 400 A
panelboard (do not mix H and J in a Panel)
• One sub-feed LA or LH circuit breaker (400 A max.) and one JD, JG, JJ, or JL circuit
breaker or two sub-feed JD, JG, JJ, or JL circuit breakers per 600 A or 800 A
panelboard.

Table 9.56: Sub-feed Circuit Breaker Table 9.57: Sub-feed Circuit Breaker Cabinet Data
Max. No. of Box Height (20 in. W x 5.75 in. D)
(150–400 A) Branch Spaces 250 A 400 A LA/LH 600 A 800 A
(Does not include
No. of sub-feed circuit Main Main Main Main Main Main
Poles Lugs Lugs Main Lugs Lugs [2]
breaker spaces) Breaker Breaker Breaker [1]
2
30 56 68 68 80 74 80[3] 68
3
42 62 74 74 86 80 86[3] 74
54 68 80 80 92 86 92[3] 80
66 80 N/A
84 N/A

[5] Accessory package takes an additional pole space.


[6] Not available for EPD.
[7] Factory installed only. Use suffix “LH”
[1] 600 A main circuit breaker panelboards require an 8.75 in. deep, 26 in. wide box.
[2] 800 A main lug panelboards require an 8.75 in. deep, 26 in. wide box.
[3] Dimensions also for 400 A LC/LI main circuit breaker panels.
9-29
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NF Factory Assembled Panelboards Common Features
Class 1670 / Refer to Catalog 1670CT0701
schneider-electric.us

Common Features
Table 9.58: Sub-feed (Double) Lugs (Standard Aluminum Mechanical Lugs)
Mains Rating Sub-feed Wire Range
Wire Bending Space per NEC Table 373-6
125 A two #6–2/0 Al or Cu
250 A two 1/0–350 kcmil Al or Cu
400 A two 1/0–600 kcmil Cu
600 A (4) 4/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu
9

800 A (6) 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu


Sub-feed (Double) Lugs (Standard Aluminum Mechanical Lugs): An additional mains and termination point that can
be used to feed out to another panelboard or device from the incoming service lines.
Available on main lug interiors only.

Table 9.59: Sub-feed Lug Cabinet Data (Standard Aluminum Mechanical Lugs)
Max. No. of Main Lugs Box Height in Inches (20 in. W x 5.75 in. D)
Branch Spaces 125 A 250 A 400 A 600 A 800 A [4]
PANELBOARDS

18 26 — — — —
30 32 38 50 74 74
42 — 44 56 80 80
54 — 50 62 86 86

Table 9.60: Feed-through Lugs (Standard Aluminum Mechanical Lugs)


Mains Rating Feed-through Wire Range Wire Bending Space per NEC Table 373-6
125 A one #6–2/0 kcmil Al or Cu
250 A one #6–350 kcmil Al or Cu
400 A one 1/0–750 kcmil or
two 1/0–350 kcmil Al or Cu
600 A two 1/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu
Feed-through Lugs (Standard Aluminum Mechanical Lugs): A second set of lugs assembled at the opposite end
from the mains of the panelboard. Often used to connect another panelboard or device to the incoming lines.
Available on main lugs and main circuit breaker panelboards.

Table 9.61: Feed-through Lug Cabinet Data (Standard Aluminum Mechanical Lugs)
Max. Box Height in Inches (20 in. W x 5.75 in. D)
No. 125 A 100/125 A 250 A 400 A LA/LH 600 A 800 A
of
Bran- Main
Breaker Main Main Main Main Main Main
ch Main Main Main Breaker Lugs
Spa- (back-fed Lugs Breaker Lugs Breaker Lugs Breaker Lugs
only) [5] [6]
ces
18 38 32 44 — — — — — — —
30 44 38 50 50 62 56 68 62 74 56
42 50 — — 56 68 62 74 68 80 62
54 — — — 62 74 68 80 74 86 68

Table 9.62: Ground Bars


Ground Bars
Equipment Ground Bar
Copper Ground Bar
Insulated/Isolated Ground Bar

Table 9.63: Name Plates


Name Plates
Standard white face/black letter laminated bakelite, 1 in. x 3.5 in., adhesive-backed or screw mountable with screws
in a bag assembly

Table 9.64: Copper Bus Bars


Copper Bus Bars
100 A, 250 A
400 A
600 A, 800 A

Table 9.65: Copper Neutral


Copper Neutral
100–600 A
800 A

Table 9.66: 200% Rated Neutrals


Panelboards with 200% rated neutrals are available with sub-feed lugs, feed-through lugs, and main circuit
breakers
250 A
400 A
600 A
800 A

Table 9.67: NF Main Neutral Conductors—Required Size and Quantity


Panelboard
Ampacity Neutral Conductors Required [6] Actual Lug Wire Range

125 (2) 1/0 Cu or (2) 1/0 Al (2) #6-2/0


250 (2) 4/0 Cu or (2) 300 kcmil Al (2) #6-350 kcmil

[4] 800 A main lug panelboards require an 8.75 in. deep and 26 in. wide box.
[5] 600 A main circuit breaker panelboards require an 8.75 in. deep, 26 in. wide box.
[6] 800 A main lug panelboards require an 8.75 in. deep, 26 in. wide box.
9-30
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Common Features NF Factory Assembled Panelboards
Class 1670 / Refer to Catalog 1670CT0701
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.67 NF Main Neutral Conductors—Required Size and Quantity (cont'd.)


Panelboard
Ampacity Neutral Conductors Required [7] Actual Lug Wire Range
(4) 250 kcmil Al or (2) 1/0-300 kcmil or
400 A (4) 3/0 Cuor (2) 600 kcmil Al (1) 1/0-750 kcmil
600 (4) 500 kcmil Al or (4) 350 kcmil Cu (2) 1/0-750 kcmil
NOTE: Neutral conductors must be of size and quantity per table above.
Table 9.68: Metal Directory Frame
Metal Directory Frame
Not available with LC/LI main circuit breaker
(Replaces standard plastic stick-on directory pouch)

Table 9.69: Hinged Door-in-Door Trim

PANELBOARDS
Hinged Door-in-Door Trim
Hinged Door-in-Door Trim has piano hinge down one side.
Inner door has a lock, outer door is retained with screws
Hinged Door-in-Door with Outer Door Lock in place of screws

Table 9.70: Weatherproof or Dusttight Cabinets (Type 3R, 5, 12)


Weatherproof or Dusttight Cabinets —Type 3R, 5, 12
(Not available with panelboards having
LC/LE/LI/LX/LXI main circuit breakers)

Table 9.71: Optional Factory Assembled Lugs for Main Lug Interiors
Main Lug Interiors
Aluminum Compression Lugs
Copper Mechanical Lugs

9
Copper Compression Lugs

Table 9.72: Optional Factory Assembled Lugs for Main Circuit Breaker Interiors
Main Circuit Breaker Interiors
Aluminum Compression Lugs
Copper Mechanical Lugs
Copper Compression Lugs

Table 9.73: Surgelogic™ Hard Bus SPD—Model IMA [8]


Surge Current
Rating kA
100
120
160
200
240

Table 9.74: Surgelogic SPD Options


Surgelogic SPD Options
Surge Counter
Dry Contacts
Remote Monitor
NOTE: For additional factory modifications, see Modifications For Factory
Assembled Panelboards, page 9-61.

[7] 800 A main lug panelboards require an 8.75 in. deep, 26 in. wide box.
[8] Panelboard box height with SPD unit—Contact your local Schneider Electric representative or distributor.
9-31
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NF Factory Assembled Panelboards Separated Distribution and Split Bus NF
and NQ Panelboards
Class 1670 schneider-electric.us

Separated Distribution and Split Bus NF and NQ Panelboards


9

Square D Separated Distribution and Split Bus Panelboards provide


compact, affordable options to protect lighting, HVAC, renewable
energy, and appliance circuits in buildings.
PANELBOARDS

Separated Distribution Panelboards facilitate Separation of Electrical


Circuits for Electrical Energy Monitoring to simplify compliance with
Section 130.5-B of California’s 2016 Building Energy Efficiency
Standards.

Special lug pad adaptors allow field removal of cables, for easy field
installation of solid core or split CTs for electrical energy measurement,
by load type.

Split Bus panelboards enable configurations of two or three back fed


main circuit breakers, with independent branch distribution sections, in
a single enclosure.

Square D NF and NQ Separated Distribution and Split Bus Panelboards come Factory
Assembled with copper bus, with or without an integral Main Circuit Breaker. A wide
variety of configurations may be submitted for quotation via Square D QuoteFAST, and
may be quoted or ordered by Authorized Distributors using SE Advantage or E-Way
Quote Management.

Features:
• Multiple branch section configurations (pole spaces per section):
– Split Bus: 18-30; 30-18; 30-30; 30-18-18
– Separated Distribution: 30-18-18; 18-18-18

• Up to 400A Mains rating for NQ; up to 250A Main in NF panelboards


Notes:
Enclosure width / depth: 20” / 5.75” minimum.
Subfeed breaker or lugs, feed through lugs not available at top or bottom ends of panel.
• Split Bus - feeder breaker (125A max.) in downstream split section back-fed from
feeder breaker in upstream main or split section.
• Segregated Distribution - cables may be removed in the field. Downstream Split
section may have same rating as Main.

9-32
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Single-Row (Column-width)—240 Vac NQ/NF Merchandised Single Row (Column
Bolt-on Width) Panelboards
schneider-electric.us Class 1640 / Refer to Catalog 1670CT0701, 1640CT0801

(60 A Max. Branch Circuit Breaker)


NQ Application Data
Application: For use on ac only. Meet Federal Specification W-P-115c, Type 1, Class 1.
UL Listed.
Service: 1Ø3W, 3Ø3W, 3Ø4W,
3 Grd. “B” Ø—240 Vac max.
AIR: See the tables starting on page 7-1.
Mains: Type NQ—Bolt-on main lugs: 100 A, 225 A
• Main circuit breaker: 100 A—QOU, 225 A—QB
• See the tables starting on page 7-1for main circuit breaker interrupt ratings. See
catalog for terminal lug data.
• Main circuit breakers with higher interrupt ratings are available as factory assembled

PANELBOARDS
panelboards.
Branches: Bolt-on QOB, 60 A maximum. QOB 10-60 A 1-, 2- and 3-pole. See QOB Bolt-
On Circuit Breakers, page 9-20 and NQ Factory Assembled Panelboards, page 9-22 for
branch circuit breaker terminal data. QOB-VH and QHB branch circuit breakers are also
available as factory assembled.
Cabinet: Front—Screw cover. Box—galvanized steel with removable endwalls.
Gutters:
• 100 A—4 in. min. mains end, 3 in. min. opposite mains
• 225 A—10 in. min. mains end, 5 in. min. opposite mains
Table 9.75: NQ Single-Row (Column-width)—240 Vac Bolt-on [1]
Box and Interior with Solid Neutral
Max. (8.625 in. W. x 5 in. D.) Front
Mains

9
No. of (Surface Mount)
Rating (Order branch circuit breakers separately)
Poles
Catalog Number Box Height (In.) Catalog Number
1 Phase 3-Wire Main Lugs Only
30 225 NQ830L2C 45 LX45TS
Main Circuit Breaker—2-pole
20 100 NQ820B1C 40 LX40TS
3 Phase 4-Wire Main Lugs Only
30 100 NQ8430L1C 40 LX40TS
42 225 NQ8442L2C 58 LX58TS
Main Circuit Breaker—3-pole
30 100 NQ8430B1C 45 LX45TS
42 225 NQ8442B2C 62 LX62TS

Table 9.76: Cable Troughs and Pull Boxes


Cable Troughs (L=Length) [2] Pull Boxes with Solid Neutral
L 8.625 in. x 5 in. S/N Catalog
(In.) Catalog Number Terminals Number
36 MTX836
48 MTX848
42 MPX81542
56 MTX856
66 MTX866

[1] 60 A Maximum Branch—Copper Bus Standard.


[2] Cable troughs are standard with a trough barrier.
9-33
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ/NF Merchandised Single Row (Column NF Single-Row (Column-width)—480Y/277
Width) Panelboards Vac Bolt-on
Class 1640 / Refer to Catalog 1670CT0701, 1640CT0801 schneider-electric.us

(60 A Max. Branch Circuit Breaker)


NF Application Data
Application: For use on ac only. Meet Federal Specification W-P-115c, Type 1, Class 1.
UL Listed.
Service: 480Y/277 Vac, 3Ø4W
AIR: See the tables starting on page 7-1.
9

Mains: Type NF–Bolt-on main lugs: 125 A, 225 A


• Main circuit breaker: 100 A—FA, 100 A—HD, 225 A—JD. See the tables starting on
page 7-1 for main circuit breaker interrupt rating. See the catalog section for terminal
lug data.
• Main circuit breakers with higher interrupt ratings are available as factory assembled
panelboards.
Branches: EDB, EDG, or EDJ, 60 A maximum. See Table 9.49 E-frame—125 A,
PANELBOARDS

Thermal-magnetic (480Y/277 Vac), page 9-28 for branch circuit breaker catalog numbers
and terminal data.
Cabinet: Front—Screw cover. Box—galvanized steel with removable endwalls.
Gutters:
• 100 A—4 in. min. mains end, 3 in. min.opposite mains
• 225 A—10 in. min. mains end, 5 in. min. opposite mains
Table 9.77: NF Single-Row (Column-width)—480Y/277 Vac Bolt-on
20 in.
Box and Interior with S/N Front
Max. No. Mains (8.625 in. W. x 5.625 in. D.) (Surface Mount)
of Poles Rating Catalog Catalog
Box Height (In.)
15 in.
Number Number
Cable
Trough
Main Lugs Only—3 Phase 4-Wire
Length 30 125 NF8430L1C 59 NC59TS
42 225 NF8442L2C 71 NC71TS
Main Circuit Breaker—3-pole
Solid NF8430M1C
Pull Box Neutral 30 100 65 NC65TS
(Cover Removed) Bar NF8430M1HDC
42 225 NF8442M2JDC 85 NC85TS
Cable
Trough Table 9.78: Cable Troughs and Pull Boxes
Panel Cable Troughs (L=Length) [3] Pull Boxes with Solid Neutral
Height L 8.625 in. x 5.625 in. S/N Catalog
Column (In.) Catalog Number [4] Terminals Number
Width 36 NTX836
Lighting 48 NTX848
Panelboard 42 MPX81542
56 NTX856
8 5⁄8 in. 66 NTX866

[3] Cable troughs are standard with a trough barrier.


[4] Box width = 8.625 in.; width at front, including flange, is 9.625 in..
9-34
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Lighting Control Products Powerlink™ Lighting Control Systems
Class 1210
schneider-electric.us

Powerlink™ Intelligent Lighting Control Systems


Powerlink intelligent lighting control systems are ideally suited for controlling lighting and
other loads in commercial, institutional, and industrial facilities. Such systems are
typically used to lower utility cost by switching branch circuits OFF during non-occupied
periods when lighting is unnecessary or during peak demand periods when a partial
reduction in load can save significant money.
These systems utilize remotely operated circuit breakers to switch branch circuits ON
and OFF via a time schedule or by an externally generated signal (typically a low voltage
wall switch, photocell, access system, fire alarm or building management system). All
Powerlink components mount inside a standard lighting panelboard to provide a
compact, space saving installation.
Powerlink intelligent lighting control systems feature a powerful microprocessor based

PANELBOARDS
controller that provides system intelligence for 168 remotely operated branch circuits.
Master panelboards contain the control electronics, power supply, and control bus strips
for up to 42 branch circuit breakers. Sub-panels extend the capability of the system by
allowing remotely operated branch circuit breakers to be operated from the master
controller via a simple, 4-wire, sub-net connection.
Powerlink panels systems have the capability of being networked together and operated
from a central workstation or via a remote modem connection. Powerlink software allows
users to remotely configure the system, change time schedules, monitor circuit breaker
or input status, and override zones and breakers.
BACnet Capability
The Building Automation and Control network (BACnet) communication protocol is
incorporated into the Powerlink™ controller design. The addition of the BACnet protocol
allows Powerlink panels to be easily integrated into a Building Automation System (BAS)
Powerlink available in employing this open communication standard without the need for communication

9
column width design
bridges or gateways.
Controller Models
The following Powerlink controller models support ‘native’ BACnet communications:
• NF2000G3 — Ethernet communications, shared remote inputs, network time
synchronization
• NF3000G3 — Email upon alarm, onboard web pages for status/control/configuration
• NF3500G4 — Embedded web server, 256 communication inputs available

9-35
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Powerlink™ Lighting Control Systems Lighting Control Products
Class 1210
schneider-electric.us

Factory Assembled System


The following factory engineered pricing procedure may be used to price either 240 V or
480Y/277 V Powerlink intelligent lighting control systems:
• Select system type and interior size from Table 9.79 , page 9-36. All Powerlink panels
are furnished with either 1 or 2 control bus strips.
• All Powerlink panels use NF type panelboard interiors, boxes, and trims and are
suitable for either 240 V or 480Y/277 V systems.
• Select branch circuit breaker requirements. Powerlink panels can accommodate both
9

ECB-G3 remotely operated circuit breakers and EDB, EGB and EJB standard branch
circuit breakers.
• Refer to panelboard section for additional panelboard accessories.
• For complete price, order by description.
• Apply appropriate discount schedule.
240 V Factory Assembled System Example:
PANELBOARDS

500 level system with 225 A MLO panelboard rated for 208Y/120 V, 3Ø4W, 10kAIR,
Type 1, surface mount with ground bar and (12) 20 A 1-pole bolt-on remote operated
circuit breakers.
Table 9.79:
Item Page No.
System Type: 500 controller with 12 ckt bus page 9-37
Panel type: 250 A MLO page 9-26
Branch circuit breakers: (12) 20 A 1-pole page 9-36
Ground bar page 9-30

Table 9.80:
System Level
Feature
500 1000 2000 3000 3500
Inputs
2 - wire 8 16 16 16 16
2 - wire with status feedback[1] 8 8 8 8 8
3 - wire 8 8 8 8 8
Time Scheduler
Independent schedules — 16 16 16 64
ON-OFF periods/schedule — 24 24 24 999
Special events/holiday periods — 32 32 32 64
Up to eight panels can Automatic daylight savings — X X X X
be controlled from a Sunrise/sunset tracking — X X X X
single controller. Network Variables
Communications inputs accessible 64 64 64 64 256
Remote sources (per controller) — — 32 32 128
Maximum subscriptions — — 256 256 256
Zones
Maximum number 64 64 64 64 256
Maximum number of sources per zone 1 1 4 4 4
Maximum number of remotely operated circuit
breakers (per subnet) 168 168 168 168 168
Networking
RS-232 port/RS-485 port X X X X X
Ethernet (100BaseT port) — — X X X
Protocols
Modbus™ ASCII/RTU X X X X X
Modbus TCP — — X X X
BACnet/IP, BACnet MS/TP — — X X X
DMX512 — X X X X

Powerlink™ ECB-G3 Circuit Breakers


Table 9.81: ECB-G3 Circuit Breakers Bolt-On Remotely Operated
Two-Pole
Ampere One-Pole 480Y/277 Vac – 14,000 AIR Three-Pole
Rating 27 7 Vac – 14,000 AIR 120/240 Vac – 65,000 AIR 480Y/277 Vac – 14,000 AIR
120 Vac – 65,000 AIR 240 Vac – 14,000 AIR Ground B 240 Vac – 42,000 AIR
Phase
15 ECB14015G3[2] ECB24015G3[2] ECB34015G3[2]
20 ECB14020G3[2] ECB24020G3[2] ECB34020G3[2]
30 ECB14030G3 ECB24030G3 ECB32030G3[3]

Table 9.82: ECB-G3 Circuit Breakers for Emergency Lighting


(requires 2-pole spaces)
Ampere Rating One-Pole 480 Y/277 – 14,000 AIR 240 V – 65,000 AIR
20 ECB142020G3EL
NOTE: All are listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and
ECB-G3 Circuit Breakers refrigeration equipment having motor group combinations and marked for use with
HACR type circuit breakers. UL listed as HID rated for use with high intensity
discharge lighting systems. (1) #12–8 Al or (1) #10–8 Cu. Suitable for use with 75°C
conductors.

[1] 7.5 mA maximum load per input terminal.


[2] UL listed as SWD (switching duty) rated.
[3] Rated for 240 Vac only – 42,000 AIR
9-36
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Lighting Control Products Powerlink™ Lighting Control Systems
Class 1210
schneider-electric.us

Powerlink™ Accessories
Table 9.83: Control Bus
Max. No. of
Required Catalog No.
Control Panel Orientation
Circuits Interior Size
12 30 Left NF12SBLG3
12 30 Right NF12SBRG3
18 42 Left NF18SBLG3
18 42 Right NF18SBRG3
21 54 Left NF21SBLG3
21 54 Right NF21SBRG3

Table 9.84: Power Supply


Voltage Primary Source Catalog No.
120 V Panel Bus NF120PSG3

PANELBOARDS
240 V Panel Bus NF240PSG3
277 V Panel Bus NF277PSG3
120 V External NF120PSG3L
240 V External NF240PSG3L
277 V External NF277PSG3L

Table 9.85: Controller


Description Catalog No.
500 NF500G3
1000 NF1000G3
Control Bus Power Supply 2000 NF2000G3
3000 NF3000G3
3500 NF3500G4

Table 9.86: Remote Source Controller (for additional inputs)—

9
Voltage Catalog No.
120 V RSC16G3120
240 V RSC16G3240
277 V RSC16G3277

Table 9.87: Cables & Accessories


NF3500G4 Controller Description Catalog No.
Control bus cables
Harness standard panel NF2HG3
Sub-net accessories & cables
Sub-panel address selector[4] NFSELG3
6’ sub-net cable NFSN06
10’ sub-net cable NFSN10
25’ sub-net cable NFSN25
50’ sub-net cable NFSN50
Serial cables
Controller front panel cable NFFPCG3

Table 9.88: Miscellaneous Hardware


Description Catalog No.
Circuit Breaker Handle Padlock (Lock On or Off) HPAFD
Fixed Barrier NFASBKG3
Remote Mounting Adapter NFADAPTERG3

Table 9.89: Software


Description Catalog No.
LCSV2 Software[5] LCSV2

Powerlink Software

[4] One address selector required for each sub-panel.


[5] Required for G4 controllers (NF3500G4). Will also support G3 controllers.
9-37
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Powerlink™ Lighting Control Systems Lighting Control Products
Class 1210
schneider-electric.us

Remote Mount Controller


Table 9.90: Remote Mount Controller (for externally mounted electronics) Includes
NEMA 1 enclosure, controller, and power supply
Voltage Catalog No. Controller Type
120 V RMC500G3120 NF500G3
240 V RMC500G3240 NF500G3
277 V RMC500G3277 NF500G3
120 V RMC1000N2G3120 NF1000N2G3
240 V RMC1000N2G3240 NF1000N2G3
277 V RMC1000N2G3277 NF1000N2G3
120 V RMC1000G3120 NF1000G3
240 V RMC1000G3240 NF1000G3
277 V RMC1000G3277 NF1000G3
120 V RMC2000G3120 NF2000G3
240 V RMC2000G3240 NF2000G3
277 V RMC2000G3277 NF2000G3
Remote Mount Controller 120 V RMC3000G3120 NF3000G3
240 V RMC3000G3240 NF3000G3
277 V RMC3000G3277 NF3000G3
120 V RMC3000G3C120 NF3000G3C
240 V RMC3000G3C240 NF3000G3C
277 V RMC3000G3C277 NF3000G3C

Powerlink Network Accessories


Table 9.91: Powerlink Network Accessories
Description Catalog No.
RS232/485 Converter 6382RS485G3KIT

Table 9.92: Powerlink Remote Modem Support[6]


Description Catalog No.
Modem Kit (for G3 Controllers) 6382G3MODEM

NF Panelboards 240 V and 480Y/277 V Factory Assembled


Systems—Max. Voltage 480Y/277 Vac
Table 9.93: Branch Circuit Breaker
Standard Breakers—EDB
Powerlink G3—ECB Bolt-On Standard Breakers HIC Standard Breakers Extra
Bolt-On 18 kA AIR 1-pole, —EGB Bolt-On HIC—EJB Bolt-On
65 kA AIR@240 Vac, 25 kA AIR 2 & 3-pole @ 240 65 kA AIR@240 Vac, 100 kA AIR@240 Vac,
14 kA AIR@480 Y/277 V, 35 kA AIR@480 Y/277 65 kA AIR@480 Y/277
18 kA AIR@480 Y/277
Voltage Ampere Voltage Ampere Voltage Ampere Voltage Ampere
Rating Rating Rating Rating
240 15–20 15–60 15–60 15–60
Vac 30 480Y/ 70 480Y/ 70 480Y/ 70
480Y/277 15–20 277 80–100 277 80–100 277 80–100
Vac 30 Vac 110–125 Vac 110–125 Vac 110–125
Space Only Space Only Space Only Space Only
NOTE: All EC, ED, EG and EJ branch circuit breakers are UL Listed as HACR type.
Table 9.94: Sub-Feed Breaker Cabinet Data
• Available on 1Ø or 3Ø, 125–800 A main lugs or 125–600 A main
circuit breaker interiors Max. No. of 250 A
Box Height (20" W x 5.75" D)
400 A LA/LH 600 A 800 A
• One sub-feed JD, JG, JJ or JL circuit breaker per 250 A
panelboard
Branch Spaces (Does
not include sub-feed Main Main Main Main Main
Main
Circuit Main
breaker spaces) Lugs Circuit Lugs Circuit Lugs[8] Breaker Lugs[11]
• Two sub-feed JD, JG, JJ or JL circuit breakers per 400 A
panelboard [7]
Breaker Breaker [9][10]
30 56 68 68 80 68 80 68
42 62 74 74 86 74 86 74
54 68 80 80 92 80 92 80

• PowerLogic™ metering • Stainless steel trim front (NQOD, NF and I-LINE)


• Customer equipment space • Padlockable hasp
• Increased box depth • Special locks (Corbin, Yale, Best)
• Box extensions top, bottom and side • Equal height boxes
• Drip hoods • Common trip to cover two equal height boxes
• Non-standard paint • Panelboard skirthides conduits feeding a panelboard
• NEMA 1 gasketed • Panelboard wireway for terminating conduit in wireway
endwall
• NEMA 4 Stainless steel enclosure
• Panelboard interiors and special fronts to fit existing
• NEMA 4X Fiberglass enclosure (NQOD and NF) boxes

[6] Requires 2000 and 3000 controller and either Analog or Ethernet modem connection to each master panel.
[7] LC and JJ may not be combined.
[8] 600 A main lug panelboards require an 8.75" deep box.
[9] Dimensions also for 400 A LC/LI main circuit breaker panels.
[10] 600 A main lug panelboards require an 8" deep, 26” wide box.
[11] 800 A main lug panelboards require an 8.75” deep, 26” wide box.
9-38
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Lighting Control System, Relay Panels, and Powerlink™ Energy Management (EM)
Switches
schneider-electric.us Class 1210

Energy Management (EM) Lighting Control System


The Powerlink Energy Management (EM) Lighting Control System incorporates the
same features found in the Powerlink 3000 level system, in addition to integral branch
circuit and optional main metering for energy monitoring and verification of the lighting
system. Integral metering is accomplished using the PowerLogic™ Branch Circuit Power
Meter (BCPM), which is a highly accurate, full-featured multi-branch circuit power meter
that provides unrivalled low-current monitoring.
The Powerlink system reduces electrical energy consumption associated with lighting
and other loads by automatically switching loads off during non-occupied periods. The
Powerlink system is often ideal for reducing th epeak demand by switching unnecessary
lights off in response to an automated response signal or when high time-of-day energy
tariffs occur.

PANELBOARDS
• Integral individual and optional mains metering to provide utmost flexibility in assurng a sustainable metering and
verification program
• Monitors current, voltage, energy consumption, demand, and power factor for complete energy profiling
• Accumulated metering information transmitted via Modbus communications interface
• Data updates occurring within seconds to provide timely preventative maintenance information
• Optional EGX web interface for storing and reporting data via standard web browser (suggested for applications
without Energy Management System [EMS] software)
• Alarm indication when parameters approach user-configured thresholds
• 16 hard-wired inputs available for connection to devices with physical dry-contacts
• 64 communication inputs available for network connection
• 16 independent time schedules, each can be configured into 24 distinct periods
• 7-day repeating clock with changeable automatic daylight savings time
• Automatic sunrise/sunset tracking with offsets

9
• 32 special event periods
• 32 remote sources for sharing input status, time schedules, or zone status between controllers
• Full custom logic capabilities, including full Boolean functions and synchronization services

Powerlink Energy Management • RS232 and RS485


(EM) Lighting Control System • Serial communications using Modbus ASCII/RTU, BACnet MS/TP and DMX512 protocols (metering Modbus
only)
• Ethernet 10BaseT communications using Modbus TCP and BACnet/IP protocols

Table 9.95: Characteristics, Standards Compliance, and BCPM Specifications


Characteristics
Operating Temperature -5° to 40°C (23° to 104°F) (95%RH, non-condensing)
Storage Temperature -20° to 85°C (-4° to 185°F) (<95%RH, non-condensing)
Regulatory/Standards Compliance

• UL Listed 916, Energy Management Equip


• FCC Part 15, Class A
• NEC Class 1 and Class 2 Control Circuits
• ESD Immunity: IEC 1000, level 4
• RF Susceptibility: IEC 1000, level 3
• Electrical Fast Transient Susceptibility: IEC 1000, level 3
• Electrical Surge Susceptibility: IEC 1000, level 4 (power line)
• Electrical Fast Transient Susceptibility: IEC 1000, level 3 (interconnection lines)
BCPM Specifications
General
Control Power 90–277 Vac
Frequency 50/60 Hz
Sampling Frequency 2560 Hz
Update Rate 1.6 seconds per panelboard
Overload Capability 10 kAIC
Ribbon Cable Support Up to 20 ft.
Operating Temperature 0° to 60°C (32°C to 122°F) (<95%RH, non-condensing)
Storage Temperature -40° to 70°C (-40° to 158°F)
Accurancy
Current Monitoring 0.25 A to 100A: 3% of reading from 0.25 A to 2 A; 2% of reading from 2 A to 100 A
2% of reading from 1% to 10% of rated current; 1% of reading from 10% to 100% of rated
Auxiliary Inputs
current (0 to 0.333 Vac)
Voltage Input 90–277 Vac; 1% of reading from 90–277 L-N (models BCPMA and BCPMB only)
4% of reading from 0.25 A to 2 A; 3% of reading 2 A to 100 A[1] (models BCPMA and
Power BCPM only)
Network Communications
Serial Modbus™ RTU
Ethernet TCP/IP

[1] Recommended for application where EMS software monitoring is not provided.
9-39
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ Merchandised Panelboards I-Line Combo Panelboard
Class 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us

I-Line Combo Panelboard


Table 9.96: Interior Boxes and Fronts — Includes Solid Neutral
Panel- Light-
I-Line Lighting ing NEMA 3R/5/
Mount- board Single/ Lighting Bus- 4 Piece Trim
Section Section Trim with 12 (Includes
ing Part Number Ampaci- Duplex Section ing Phase Ground Bar Box Without
Type Amper- Circuits Door Door Front)
Space ty age
18 CP18864N3Q2C 400 S NQ 225 30 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC2686DB HC2686T( ) HC2686T( ) HC2686WP
4P HR
9

18 CP18864N3Q2 400 S NQ 225 30 Al 3 PK32DGTA HC2686DB HC2686T( ) HC2686T( ) HC2686WP


4P HR
18 CP18864N4Q2C 400 S NQ 225 42 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC2686DB HC2686T( ) HC2686T( ) HC2686WP
4P HR
18 CP18864N4Q2 400 S NQ 225 42 Al 3 PK32DGTA HC2686DB HC2686T( ) HC2686T( ) HC2686WP
4P HR
18 CP18864N3F2C 400 S NF 250 30 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC2686DB HC2686T( ) HC2686T( ) HC2686WP
4P HR
18 CP18864N3F2 400 S NF 250 30 Al 3 PK32DGTA HC2686DB HC2686T( ) HC2686T( ) HC2686WP
4P HR
PANELBOARDS

18 CP18864N4F2C 400 S NF 250 42 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC2686DB HC2686T( ) HC2686T( ) HC2686WP


4P HR
18 CP18864N4F2 400 S NF 250 42 Al 3 PK32DGTA HC2686DB HC2686T( ) HC2686T( ) HC2686WP
4P HR
18 CP118864N4Q4C 400 S NQ 400 42 Cu 1 PK32DGTACU HC2686DB HC2686T( ) HC2686T( ) HC2686WP
4P HR
18 CP18866N3Q4C 600 S NQ 400 30 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC2686DB HC2686T( ) HC2686T( ) HC2686WP
4P HR
18 CP18866N4Q4C 600 S NQ 400 42 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC2686DB HC2686T( ) HC2686T( ) HC2686WP
4P HR
18 CP118866N4Q6C 600 S NQ 600 42 Cu 1 PK32DGTACU HC2686DB HC2686T( ) HC2686T( ) HC2686WP
4P HR
18 CP18866N3F4C 600 S NF 400 30 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC2686DB HC2686T( ) HC2686T( ) HC2686WP
4P HR
18 CP18866N4F4C 600 S NF 400 42 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC2686DB HC2686T( ) HC2686T( ) HC2686WP
4P HR
22.5 CP23734N3Q2C 400 S NQ 225 30 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC3273DB9 HCM73T( )V HCM73T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23734N3Q2 400 S NQ 225 30 AL 3 PK32DGTA HC3273DB9 HCM73T( )V HCM73T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP123734N3Q4C 400 S NQ 400 30 Cu 1 PK32DGTACU HC3273DB9 HCM73T( )V HCM73T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23734N3F2C 400 S NF 250 30 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC3273DB9 HCM73T( )V HCM73T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23734N3F2 400 S NF 250 30 AL 3 PK32DGTA HC3273DB9 HCM73T( )V HCM73T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23736N3Q4C 600 S NQ 400 30 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC3273DB9 HCM73T( )V HCM73T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23736N3F4C 600 S NF 400 30 Cu 3 PK32DGTA HC3273DB9 HCM73T( )V HCM73T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23914N4Q2C 400 S NQ 225 42 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC3291DB9 HCM91T( )V HCM91T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23914N4Q2 400 S NQ 225 42 Al 3 PK32DGTA HC3291DB9 HCM91T( )V HCM91T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23914N5Q2C 400 S NQ 225 54 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC3291DB9 HCM91T( )V HCM91T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23914N5Q2 400 S NQ 225 54 Al 3 PK32DGTA HC3291DB9 HCM91T( )V HCM91T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23914N4F2C 400 S NF 250 42 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC3291DB9 HCM91T( )V HCM91T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23914N4F2 400 S NF 250 42 Al 3 PK32DGTA HC3291DB9 HCM91T( )V HCM91T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23914N5F2C 400 S NF 250 54 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC3291DB9 HCM91T( )V HCM91T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23914N5F2 400 S NF 250 54 Al 3 PK32DGTA HC3291DB9 HCM91T( )V HCM91T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23916N4Q4C 600 S NQ 400 42 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC3291DB9 HCM91T( )V HCM91T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23916N5Q4C 600 S NQ 400 54 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC3291DB9 HCM91T( )V HCM91T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP123916N5Q4C 600 S NQ 400 54 Cu 1 PK32DGTACU HC3291DB9 HCM91T( )V HCM91T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23916N4F4C 600 S NF 400 42 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC3291DB9 HCM91T( )V HCM91T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23916N5F4C 600 S NF 400 54 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC3291DB9 HCM91T( )V HCM91T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP123916N5Q6C 600 S NQ 600 54 CU 1 PK32DGTACU HC3291DB9 HCM91T( )V HCM91T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23916N44Q4C 600 D NQ 400 42/42 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC3291DB9 HCM91T( )V HCM91T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP123916N44Q4C 600 D NQ 400 42/42 Cu 1 PK32DGTACU HC3291DB9 HCM91T( )V HCM91T( )VD N/A
22.5 CP23916N53Q4C 600 D NQ 400 54/30 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC3291DB9 HCM91T( )V HCM91T( )VD N/A
31.5 CP32866N44Q4C 600 D NQ 400 42/42 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP32866N53Q4C 600 D NQ 400 54/30 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP32866N4BQ4C 600 D NQ 400 42/B* Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP132866N44Q6C 600 D NQ 600 42/42 Cu 1 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP32866N44F4C 600 D NF 400 42/42 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP32866N53F4C 600 D NF 400 54/30 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP32866N4BF4C 600 D NF 400 42/B* Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP32868N44Q6C 800 D NQ 600 42/42 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP132868N44Q6C 800 D NQ 600 42/42 Cu 1 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP32868N53Q6C 800 D NQ 600 54/30 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP32868N3BQ6C 800 D NQ 600 30/B[1] Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP32868N4BQ6C 800 D NQ 600 42/B[1] Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP132868N4BQ6C 800 D NQ 600 42/B[1] Cu 1 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP32868N5BQ6C 800 D NQ 600 54/B[1] Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP32868N44F6C 800 D NF 600 42/42 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP32868N53F6C 800 D NF 600 54/30 Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP32868N3BF6C 800 D NF 600 30/B[1] Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP32868N4BF6C 800 D NF 600 42/B[1] Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP
31.5 CP32868N5BF6C 800 D NF 600 54/B[1] Cu 3 PK32DGTACU HC4486DB HCR86T( ) HCR86T( )D HC4486WP

[1] B denotes a blank space on the right hand side of a duplex panel for future expansion
9-40
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line Combo Panelboard I-Line™ Merchandised Panelboards
Class 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.97: RTI Cabled Lighting Section Kit for I-Line Combo Panelboard
Lighting Lighting
MLO Panelboard Section
Part Number Description Ampacity Section
Type Circuits
NFICRT418L1C NF Lighting Section Kit 125 NF 18 dual
NFICRT442L2C NF Lighting Section Kit 250 NF 42
NFICRT442L4C NF Lighting Section Kit 400 NF 42
NFICRT442L6C NF Lighting Section Kit 600 NF 42
NQICRT418L1C NQ Lighting Section Kit 100 NQ 18 dual
NQICRT442L2C NQ Lighting Section Kit 225 NQ 42
NQICRT442L4C NQ Lighting Section Kit 400 NQ 42
NQICRT442L6C NQ Lighting Section Kit 600 NQ 42
Contactor with 18 Circuit
NQICRT418C1C NQ Lighting Section Kit 100 NQ 18
Contactor with 18 Circuit

PANELBOARDS
NFICRT418C1C NF Lighting Section Kit 125 NF 18

I-Line Panelboard

TYPE HCM TYPE HCP-SU[2]


250 A max. branch circuit breaker 800 A max. main circuit breaker
BD, BG, BJ, FA, FH, FY, QB, QD, QG, QJ, HD, HG, HJ, HL, HR, JD, JG, JJ, JL, JR 600 A max. branch circuit breaker
BD, BG, BJ, FY, FA, FH, LA, LD, LG, LJ, LL, LH, LR, MG,
MJ, PG, PJ, PL, PGC, PJC, PLC[3], QB, QD, QG, QJ, HD, HG, HJ,
QB, QD QB, QD

9
QG, QJ QG, QJ HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
FA, FH FA, FH
FY FY FY, FA, FH
HD, HG, HJ, HL, HR
HD, HG HD, HG
HJ, HL, HR HJ, HL, HR Q B,Q D ,Q G ,Q J
JD, JG JD, JG
JJ, JL, JR JJ, JL, JR
JD, JG, JJ, JL, JR
BD, BG BD, BG
BJ BJ
1⁄2 Total LD, LG, LJ, LL, LA, LH, LR
Breaker
Mounting
Space BD, BG, BJ
Each
Side
MG, MJ, PG, JP, PL
PGC, JPC, PL C

S 800 AMax. Main Lugs


or S 800 A M ax.M ain Lugs
N 800 AMax. Main Breaker or
N 800 A M ax.M ain Breaker

Box Size:
32 in. Wide, 8.25 in. Deep Box Size:
26 in. Wide, 9.5 in. Deep

Table 9.98: Interiors, Boxes and Fronts


Front [4] Box [5]
Total Interior Assembly
Circuit Mains (Less Branch NEMA
4 Piece Trim Trim With Door[6] Type 1 3R/5/12 [7]
Breaker Ampere Circuit Breakers) Without Door Box Height (In.)
Mounting Rating (Includes Front)
Space (In.) Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
Number Number Number Number Number
HCM Main Lugs Only
3-pole—Suitable for use as service equipment when provided with a main circuit breaker. [8]
225 A HCM14482N
400 A HCM14484
27 HCM48T( ) HCM48T( )D HC3248B HC3248WP 48
600 A HCM14486
800 A HCM14488
225 A HCM23642N
400 A HCM23644
45 HCM64T( ) HCM64T( )D HC3264B HC3264WP 64
600 A HCM23646
800 A HCM23648
225 A HCM32732N
400 A HCM32734
63 HCM73T( ) HCM73T( )D HC3273B HC3273WP 73
600 A HCM32736
800 A HCM32738
225 A HCM50912N
400 A HCM50914
99 HCM91T( ) HCM91T( )D HC3291B HC3291WP 91
600 A HCM50916
800 A HCM50918
HCM Main Circuit Breaker [9] [10]
Includes 3-pole, vertically mounted main circuit breaker—Suitable for use as service equipment.

[2] For main circuit breaker panel, order plug-on I-Line type PG, PJ, PL, MG, or MJ circuit breakers from 9–47 through 9–48 and backfeed as the main breaker (order solid neutral from 9–37).
[3] PG, PJ, PL circuit breakers are available with both thermal-magnetic equivalent and Micrologic trip. The Micrologic circuit breakers are available 80% and 100% rated. “C” suffix denotes a
100% rating.
[4] Add “F” for flush mount, “S” for surface mount.
[5] For Type 1 applications, order interior, front, and box. For Type 3R/5/12 applications, order interior and box only. The front is included with the box.
[6] For Type 1 applications order interior, trim and box. For type 3R/5/12, order interior and box only.
[7] Remove drain screws for Type 3R rating.
[8] Suitable for use as service equipment if equipped with an integral main circuit breaker or when not more than six main disconnecting means are provided and the panelboard is not used as
a lighting and appliance branch circuit panelboard.
[9] Bottom feed standard.
[10] Circuit breaker interrupt ratings, see the tables starting on page 7-30.
9-41
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ Merchandised Panelboards I-Line Combo Panelboard
Class 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.98 Interiors, Boxes and Fronts (cont'd.)


Front [11] Box [12]
Total Interior Assembly
Circuit Mains (Less Branch NEMA
4 Piece Trim Trim With Door[13] Type 1 3R/5/12 [14]
Breaker Ampere Circuit Breakers) Without Door Box Height (In.)
Mounting Rating (Includes Front)
Space (In.) Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
Number Number Number Number Number
27 400 A HCM14644M HCM64T( ) HCM64T( )D HC3264B HC3264WP 64
225 A HCM18642MN
36 600 A HCM18736MP
HCM73T( ) HCM73T( )D HC3273DB9[15]
9

Use HCP —
800 A HCM18738MP
45 400 A HCM23734M
HCM73T( ) HCM73T( )D HC3273B HC3273WP 73
54 225 A HCM27732MN
600 A HCM36916MP
72 HCM91T( ) HCM91T( )D HC3291DB9[15] Use HCP —
800 A HCM36918MP
81 400 A HCM41914M HCM91T( ) HCM91T( )D HC3291B HC3291WP 91
HCP-SU [16] Universal Single Row Main Lugs or Main Circuit Breaker [17]
3-pole—Suitable for use as service equipment when provided with a main circuit breaker. [18]
54 800 HCP54868SU HC2686T( )4P HC2686T( )HR[19] HC2686DB HC2886WP 86
PANELBOARDS

TYPE HCP TYPE HCR-U Universal Mains


800 A max. branch circuit breaker 1200 A max. branch circuit breaker
FA [20], BD, BG, BJ, FA, FH, QB, QD, QG, QJ, HD, HG, HJ, HL, HR, JD, JG, JJ, JL, JR, LA, FA [22], BD, BG, BJ, FA, FH, QB, QD, QG, QJ, HD, HG, HJ, HL, HR, JD, JG, JJ, JL, JR, LA,
LH, LD, LG, LJ, LL, LR, MG, MJ, PG, PJ, PL, PGC, PJC, PLC [21] LH, LD, LG, LJ, LL, LR, MG, MJ, PG, PJ, PK, PL, RG, RJ, RK, RL, PGC, PJC, PKC, PLC,
RGC, RJC, RKC, RLC[23][21]
BD, BG, BJ QB, QD
FA,FH, HD QG, QJ
1⁄2 Total HG, HJ BD, BG, BJ, BD, BG, BJ QB, QD
Breaker HL, HR FA,FH FA,FH QG, QJ
Mounting QB, QD HD, HG HD, HG
QG, QJ HJ, HL, HR 1⁄2
Total HJ, HL, HR
Space BD, BG, BJ
Each JD, JG, JJ JD, JG Breaker FA,FH
Side JL, JR JJ, JL, JR Mounting QB, QD HD, HG
QG, QJ HJ, HL, HR
LD, LG, LJ Space
LL, LA, LH, LR Each JD, JG JD, JG
LC, LI, LX Side JJ, JL, JR JJ, JL, JR
LXI, LE
LD, LG, LJ
LL, LA, LH, LR

1200 A Max. Main Lugs LC, LI, LX


S LXI, LE
or
N 800 A Max. Main Breaker RG, RJ, RK,
RL, RGC, RJC
RKC, RLC

1200 A Max. Main Lugs or


S/N
1200 A Max. Main Breaker
Box Size: 42 in. Wide, 9.5 in. Deep Box Size: 44 in. Wide, 9.5 in. Deep

Table 9.99: Circuit Breaker / Sub-feed Lug Kit Mounting Space Requirement
Type of Maximum No. of Inch Type of Maximum No. of Inch
Circuit Breaker Ampacity Poles Mounting Circuit Breaker Ampacity Poles Mounting
Require- Require-
ments ments
FY 30 1 1.5
FA, FH 100 1 1.5 QB, QD, QG, QJ 225 2 3
FA, FH 2 3 QB, QD, QG, QJ 225 3 4.5
FA, FH, SL-100 3 4.5 JD, JG, JJ, JL, JR, 250 2, 3 4.5
KI, SL250
FI 2, 3 4.5 LA, LH, SL400 400 6
BD, BG, BJ 125 1 1.5 LD, LG, LJ, LL, LR 600 6
BD, BG, BJ 2 3 LC, LI, LXI 600 7.5
BD, BG, BJ 3 4.5 MG, MJ, MA, MH, 800 9
HD, HG 150 2 3 SL800, PGC, PJC,
PLC
HD, HG 3 4.5 PG, PJ, PL, 1200
S33931
HJ, HL, HR 2, 3 4.5 RG, RJ, RL, RGC, 15
RJC, RLC,
S33930

[11] Add “F” for flush mount, “S” for surface mount.
[12] For Type 1 applications, order interior, front, and box. For Type 3R/5/12 applications, order interior and box only. The front is included with the box.
[13] For Type 1 applications order interior, trim and box. For type 3R/5/12, order interior and box only.
[14] Remove drain screws for Type 3R rating.
[15] DB9 box is 9.5 inches deep.
[16] For main lugs panel, order sub-feed lug kit and back-feed as main lugs.
[17] Circuit breaker interrupt ratings, see the tables starting on page 7-30.
[18] Suitable for use as service equipment if equipped with an integral main circuit breaker or when not more than six main disconnecting means are provided and the panelboard is not used as
a lighting and appliance branch circuit panelboard.
[19] Hinged trim with door.
[20] FA and JDA circuit breakers with field installable ground fault kits may be mounted in type HCP, HCP-SU, and HCR-U panelboards as shown, and require L-frame mounting space.
[21] PG, PJ, and PL circuit breakers are available with both thermal-magnetic equivalent and Micrologic trip. The Micrologic circuit breakers are available 80% and 100% rated. “C” suffix denotes
a 100% rating.
[22] FA and JDA circuit breakers with field installable ground fault kits may be mounted in type HCP, HCP-SU, and HCR-U panelboards as shown, and require L-frame mounting space.
[23] When RL main circuit breakers with equipment ground fault are applied on a 3Ø4W system, order solid neutral catalog number HCR12SNCT. The HCR12SNCT includes a neutral current
transformer.
9-42
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line Combo Panelboard I-Line™ Merchandised Panelboards
Class 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.100: (1200 A Interiors Include solid neutral, all others without solid neutral) [24]
Total Max. Front [25]
Circuit No. of Interior Assembly
Mains (Less Branch Circuit Breakers) 4 Piece Trim Box [26] Box
Breaker LC, MJ, Without Door [27] Trim With Door
Mtg. Amp. Height
Rating PL, RL (In.)
Space Circuit Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
(In.) Breakers Number Number Number Number
HCP Main Lugs Only—3-pole
Suitable for use as service equipment when provided with a main circuit breaker. [28]
 400 HCP14504
 600 HCP14506
27 1PL HCW50T( ) HCW50T( )D HC4250DB 50
 800 HCP14508
1200 HCP145012N
 400 HCP23594
 600 HCP23596
45 2PL HCW59T( ) HCW59T( )D HC4259DB 59
 800 HCP23598
1200 HCP235912N

PANELBOARDS
 400 HCP32684
 600 HCP32686
63 3PL HCW68T( ) HCW68T( )D HC4268DB 68
 800 HCP32688
1200 HCP326812N
 400 HCP50864
 600 HCP50866
99 5PL HCW86T( ) HCW86T( )D HC4286DB 86
 800 HCP50868
1200 HCP508612N
HCP Main Circuit Breaker[29]—Includes 3-pole
Vertically mounted main circuit breaker—Suitable for use as service equipment.
 600 HCP18686M
36 2LC HCW68T( ) HCW68T( )D HC4268DB 68
 800 HCP18688M
 600 HCP36866M
72 4LC HCW86T( ) HCW86T( )D HC4286DB 86
 800 HCP36868M
HCR-U Universal Main Lugs or Main Circuit Breaker [30] —3-pole
Suitable for use as service equipment when provided with a main circuit breaker.

9
For Main Lugs panel, order sub-feed lug kit catalog number S33930 and back feed as main lugs.
For Main Circuit Breaker panel, order plug-on I-Line type PG, PJ, PL, RGC, RJC, or RLC [31]circuit breakers from page 9-53 through page 9-56,
and back feed as the main circuit breaker. (Order solid neutral separately)
108 [32] 1200 6PL or 3RLC HCR548612U HCR86T( )[33] HCR86T( )D HC4486DB 86

Table 9.101: Main Circuit Breaker Interiors —Standard Frame Types [29]
Panelboard Factory Supplied
Main Circuit Breaker Ampacity Type Main Circuit Breaker
225 HCM JDA36225
400 HCM LAP36400MB
600 MGP36600
or HCM, HCP or
800 MGP36800

Table 9.102: Standard Copper Bus Interiors


Type Main Ampacity
HCM, HCP-SU 800
HCP, HCR-U 800 and Above
NOTE: Merchandised copper interiors are not available in all ampacities.

[24] Order solid neutral from Table 9.103 I-Line Merchandised Panelboard Accessories, page 9-44.
[25] Add “F” for flush mount, “S” for surface mount.
[26] For 42 in. wide weatherproof enclosures, see Table 9.107 Type 3R/5/12 Enclosures, page 9-45
[27] Add-on door kit available. Example: For HCW50TS trim kit, order HCW50D door kit.
[28] Suitable for use as service equipment if equipped with an integral main circuit breaker or when not more than six main disconnecting means are provided and the panelboard is not used as
a lighting and appliance branch circuit panelboard.
[29] Circuit breaker interrupt ratings, see the tables starting on page 7-30.
[30] Add “F” for flush mount, “S” for surface mount.
[31] When RL main circuit breakers with equipment ground fault are applied on a 3Ø4W system, order solid neutral catalog number HCR12SNCT.
The HCR12SNCT includes a neutral current transformer.
[32] 15 in. of mounting space is taken up by the back fed main lug kit or RG, RJ, RL main circuit breaker, leaving 93 in. of branch circuit breaker mounting space.
[33] Add-on door kit available. Example: For HCR86TS trim kit, order HCW86D door kit.
9-43
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ Merchandised Panelboards Accessories
Class 690, 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us

Accessories
9

Blank Fillers Equipment Ground Bar Solid Neutral

Table 9.103: I-Line Merchandised Panelboard Accessories


Description Catalog No.

HNM1BL
PANELBOARDS

Blank Filler Kit—1.5 in.[34] (One kit contains quantity of 3 blank fillers.)

Blank Filler Kit—4.5 in.[34] (One kit contains quantity of 5 blank fillers.) HNM4BL
Solid Neutral Assemblies
HC2SN
225 A
HC4SN [35], HCW4SN [36]
400 A
HC6SN [35], HCW6SN [36]
600 A
HC8SN [35], HCW8SN [36]
HCPSU8SN[37]
800 A
HCPSU8SNCW[37]
HCW12SN[36]
1200 A

1200 A, for use with HCR-U universal panel only HCWM12SN[38]

1200 A, including neutral Current Transformer (CT) for 3Ø4W systems HCR12SNCTW[38]
Equipment Ground Bar Kits—HCJ, HCM, HCP, HCP-SU (single row), HCR-U PK32DGTA
Blank Extensions (For replacement purposes)
1.5 in. for mounting on wide side of I-Line panelboard used with HNM1BL and
HNM4BL as a filler plate on the wide side of the panel (HCP, HCP-SU and HCRU). HLW1BL
(Kit contains quantity of 3.)
Do not use with Micrologic trip unit as this filler will cover the trip unit. [34]
4.5 in. for mounting on wide side of I-Line panelboard used with HNM1BL and HLW4BL
HNM4BL as a filler plate on the wide side of the panel (HCP, HCP-SU and HCRU).
Do not use with Micrologic trip unit as this filler will cover the trip unit. [34] (Kit contains quantity of 5.)
1.5 in. for mounting on narrow side of I-Line panelboard used with HNM1BL and
HLN1BL
HNM4BL as a filler plate on the narrow side of the panel. Do not use with (Kit contains quantity of 3.)
Micrologic trip unit as this filler will cover the trip unit. [34]
4.5 in. for mounting on narrow side of I-Line panelboard used with HNM1BL and HLN4BL
HNM4BL as a filler plate on the narrow side of the panel. Do not use with
(Kit contains quantity of 5.)
Micrologic trip unit as this filler will cover the trip unit. [34]
4.5 in. for mounting on wide side of I-Line panelboard. For use with PowerPact H HLW4EBL
and J circuit breakers mounted on the wide side of the panel so that electronic trip (Kit contains quantity of 5.)
unit can be accessed. [34]

4.5 in. for mounting on narrow side of I-Line panelboard. For use with PowerPact H
HLN4EBL
and J circuit breakers mounted on the narrow side of the panel so that electronic (Kit contains quantity of 5.)
trip unit can be accessed. [34]

Blank Extensions

Table 9.104: Blank Extensions


Circuit Breaker Branch Catalog
Application Mounting Ht. Circuit Side Number
All applications, except Powerpact H/J with Micrologic trip unit 1.5 in. HLW1BL
Wide Side
5/6 4.5 in. HLW4BL
All applications, except Powerpact H/J with Micrologic trip unit 1.5 in. HLN1BL
5/6 Narrow Side
4.5 in. HLN4BL
Only Powerpact H/J circuit breakers with Micrologic trip unit 5/6 4.5 in. Narrow Side HLN4EBL
Only Powerpact H/J circuit breakers with Micrologic trip unit 5/6 4.5 in. Wide Side HLW4EBL

[34] Blank extension and blank filler pricing is per kit. See note on kit number for number included in each kit.
[35] Used on Type HCJ, HCN, HCM.
[36] Used on 400 A, 600 A, 800 A, and 1200 A HCP (main lugs), and 600 A and 800 A (main circuit breaker).
[37] Used on Type HCP-SU (single row).
[38] Used on Type HCR-U.
9-44
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories I-Line™ Merchandised Panelboards
Class 690, 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.105: Solid Neutral Lug Quantities and Sizes


Solid Neutral Assembly Terminal Wire Range
HC2SN (9)-#14-1/0, (1)-#6-300, (45)-#14-#4
HC4SN (7)-#6 - 350, (45)-#14 - #4
HC6SN, HC6SNCU (9)-#14 - 1/0, (7)-#6 - 350, (28)-#14 - #4
HC8SN (9)-#14 - 1/0, (7)-#6 - 350, (34)-#14 - #4
HC8SNCU (9)-#14 - 1/0, (7)-#6 - 350, (28)-#14 - #4
HCW12SN (9)-#14 - 1/0, (7)-#6 - 350, (34)-#14 - #4, (4)-3/0-750
HCW12SNCU (9)-#14 - 1/0, (7)-#6 - 350, (28)-#14 - #4, (4)-2/0-500
HCW4SN (2)-#4-600, (7)-#6-350, (45)-#14-#4
HCW4SNCU (9)-#14 - 1/0, (7)-#6 - 350, (28)-#14 - #4, (2)-#2-600
HCW6SN (9)-#14 - 1/0, (7)-#6 - 350, (34)-#14 - #4, (4)-3/0-750
HCW6SNCU (9)-#14 - 1/0, (7)-#6 - 350, (28)-#14 - #4, (2)-#2-600
HCW8SN (9)-#14 - 1/0, (7)-#6 - 350, (34)-#14 - #4, (4)-3/0-750

PANELBOARDS
HCW8SNCU (9)-#14 - 1/0, (7)-#6 - 350, (28)-#14 - #4, (4)-3/0-750
HCWM12SN (9)-#14 - 1/0, (7)-#6 - 350, (34)-#14 - #4, (4)-3/0-750
HCPSU8SN (7) #6-350, (34) #4- #14, (9) #14-1/0
HCPSU8SNCW (3) 3/0-750, (7) #6-350, (34) #14-#4, (9) #14-1/0

Table 9.106: Panelboard Adapter Kits


I-Line Panelboard Type
Crimp Lug Adapter Kits [39]
HCM HCP, HCR-U [40]
400 A HCM400VCA HCW400VCA
600 A HCM600VCA HCW600VCA
800 A HCM800VCA HCW800VCA
1200 A — HCW1200VCA

Table 9.107: Type 3R/5/12 Enclosures

9
Dimensions (In.)
Catalog Number Interior Type
H W D
HC4250WP HCP 50 42 12.95
HC4259WP HCP 59 42 12.95
HC4268WP HCP 68 42 12.95
HC4286WP HCP 86 42 12.95
HC4486WP HCR-U 86 44 14.50

Table 9.108: Box Extensions


Catalog Number Interior Type Extension
HC2609DEX (F or S) HCP-SU  9 in.
HC3209EX (F or S) HCM  9 in.
HC4212DEX (F or S) HCP 12 in.
HC4406DEX (F or S) HCR-U  6 in.
HC4412DEX (F or S) HCR-U 12 in.

Sub-feed Lug Kits

[39] For use with MLO panel, order VCEL lugs seperately.
[40] Not for use with P- or R-frame circuit breakers or sub-feed kits S33930 or S33931.
9-45
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ Merchandised Panelboards Accessories
Class 690, 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.109: Sub-feed Lug Kits [41][42][43]


Max. Short Circuit System Ratings
Ampere Height Catalog RMS Symmetrical Amperes Protected by For Use in I-Line
Rating Number Circuit Breaker Panelboard Types
In. (mm) 240 Vac 480 Vac 600 Vac
 100 A 4.5 114 SL100 100,000 65,000 18,000 FA, FH, FD, FG, FJ HCM, HCP, HCP-SU, HCR-U
FA, FD, FG, FH, FJ, HD,
 250 A 4.5 114 SL250 200,000 200,000 100,000 HG, HJ, HL, HR, JD, JG, HCM, HCP, HCP-SU, HCR-U
JJ, JL, JR, KI
FA, FD, FG, FH, FJ, KA,
KH, KC, KI, HD, HG, HJ,
9

HL, HR, JD, JG, JJ, JL,


 400 A 6 152 SL400 [43] 200,000 200,000 100,000 JR, LA, LH, LC, LX, LI, HCP, HCP-SU, HCR-U (wide side only)
LXI, DG, DJ, DL, LD, LG,
LJ, LL, LR (“L” & “D”
FRAME 400 A MAX.)

FA, FD, FG, FH, FJ, KA,


KH, KC, KI, HD, HG, HJ,
 800 A 9 229 SL800 HL, HR, JD, JG, JJ, JL, HCM, HCP, HCP-SU, HCR-U
200,000 100,000 50,000
JR, LA, LH, LC, LX, LI,
LXI, MA, MH, MX, DG, DJ,
PANELBOARDS

DL, LD, LG, LJ, LL, LR

FA, FD, FG, FH, FJ, KA,


KH, KC, KI, HD, HG, HJ,
 800 A 9 229 SL800M5 HL, HR, JD, JG, JJ, JL, HCM, HCP, HCP-SU, HCR-U
125,000 100,000 25,000
JR, MA, MH, MX, MG, PG,
MJ, PJ, PK, PL, DG, DJ,
DL, LD, LG, LJ, LL, LR
FA, FD, FG, FH, FJ, KA,
KH, KC, KI, HD, HG, HJ,
HL, HR, JD, JG, JJ, JL,
1200 A 9 229 S33931 125,000 100,000 50,000 JR, LA, LH, LC, LX, LI, HCP, HCP-SU, HCR-U
LXI, MA, MH, MX, MG,
PG, MJ, PJ, PK, PL, DG,
DJ, DL, LD, LG, LJ, LL, LR
FA, FD, FG, FH, FJ, KA,
KH, KC, KI, HD, HG, HJ,
HL, HR, JD, JG, JJ, JL,
JR, LA, LH, LC, LX, LI,
1200 A 15 381 S33930 125,000 100,000 50,000 LXI, MA, MH, MX, NA, HCR-U
NC, NX, MG, PG, MJ, PJ,
PK, PL, RG, RJ, RL, RK,
DG, DJ, DL, LD, LG, LJ,
LL, LR
FA, FD, FG, FH, FJ, KA,
KH, KC, KI, HD, HG, HJ,
SL1200P5, HL, HR, JD, JG, JJ, JL,
1200 A 9 229 SL1200P6, 125,000 100,000 50,000 HCP, HCP-SU, HCR-U
JR, MG, PG, MJ, PJ, PK,
SL1200P7 PL, RG, RJ, RL, RK, DG,
DJ, DL, LD, LG, LJ, LL, LR
NOTE: S33930, S33931, SL1200P5, SL1200P6, SL1200P7, SL Kits are rated 1200
A and may be applied to 1200 ampere loads when installed into HCRU panelboards.
However, when installed into HCP and HCPSU panelboards they are only rated 800
amperes maximum due to restricted wire bending space.
For Surgelogic™ I-Line plug-on SPD information, starting on Digest page 6-2.
For field-installable I-Line door kits, see the Supplemental and Obsolescence Digest,
Section 4.
Table 9.110: Sub-feed Lug kit terminal data
Catalog No. No. Ampere
(Prefix) Rating Standard Lug Wire Size [44]
Poles
SL100 3  100 #14–1/0 AWG Cu or #12–1/0 AWG Al
SL250 3  250 1– #4 AWG–300 kcmil
SL400 3  400 1– #1 AWG–600 kcmil or 2– #1 AWG–250 kcmil
SL800 3  800 3– #3/0 AWG–500 kcmil
SL800M5 3  800 3– #3/0 AWG–500 kcmil
S33931 3 1200 4– #3/0 AWG–500 kcmil
S33930 3 1200 4– #3/0 AWG–600 kcmil
SL1200P5 3 1200 4– #3/0 AWG–500 kcmil
SL1200P6 3 1200 3– 350–600 kcmil
SL1200P7 3 1200 3– #3/0 AWG–750 kcmil

[41] Plug-on in same manner as a branch circuit breaker


[42] For other ratings, see the latest edition of I-Line Information Manual, #80043-309-xx.
[43] SL400 cannot be used in HCM panelboards due to inadequate wire bending space.
[44] Unless otherwise specified, wire sizes apply to both aluminum and copper conductors.
9-46
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ B-frame Circuit Breakers B- and F-frame for I-Line
Panelboards and Switchboards
schneider-electric.us Class 650, 651

PowerPact™ B-frame
Accessories are located in Section 7 PowerPact Accessories, page 7-54.

Table 9.111: B-frame Interrupting Rating


Interrupting Rating
D - SCCR
D G J K
240 Vac 25 kA 65 kA 100 kA 100 kA
480/277 Vac 18 kA 35 kA 65 kA 65 kA
480 Vac 18 kA 35 kA 65 kA 65 kA

PANELBOARDS
600Y/347 Vac 14 kA 18 kA 25 kA 65 kA

Table 9.112: PowerPact B-frame, 125A max, Thermal Magnetic UL Circuit Breaker
(PowerPact B-frame 1–pole branch circuit breakers utilize 1.5" of I-Line mounting
space, 2–pole branch circuit breakers utilize 3" of I-Line mounting space and 3–
pole B-frame circuit breakers utilize 4.5" of I-Line mounting space.)
D - SCCR
480Y/277 Vac 1-pole 2-pole 3-pole Fixed AC Magnetic Trip
Amps 277 Vac 480/277 Vac 480/277 Vac Hold Trip
15 BDA14015 BDA24015Y BDA34015Y 400 A 600 A
20 BDA14020 BDA24020Y BDA34020Y 400 A 600 A
25 BDA14025 BDA24025Y BDA34025Y 400 A 600 A
30 BDA14030 BDA24030Y BDA34030Y 400 A 600 A
35 BDA14035 BDA24035Y BDA34035Y 400 A 600 A

9
40 BDA14040 BDA24040Y BDA34040Y 400 A 600 A
45 BDA14045 BDA24045Y BDA34045Y 400 A 600 A
50 BDA14050 BDA24050Y BDA34050Y 480 A 720 A
60 BDA14060 BDA24060Y BDA34060Y 640 A 960 A
70 BDA14070 BDA24070Y BDA34070Y 640 A 960 A
80 BDA14080 BDA24080Y BDA34080Y 800 A 1200 A
90 BDA14090 BDA24090Y BDA34090Y 1000 A 1500 A
100 BDA14100 BDA24100Y BDA34100Y 1000 A 1500 A
110 BDA14110 BDA24110Y BDA34110Y 1000 A 1500 A
125 BDA14125 BDA24125Y BDA34125Y 1000 A 1500 A
G - SCCR
480Y/277 Vac 1-pole 2-pole 3-pole Fixed AC Magnetic Trip
Amps 277 Vac 480/277 Vac 480/277 Vac Hold Trip
15 BGA14015 BGA24015Y BGA34015Y 400 A 600 A
20 BGA14020 BGA24020Y BGA34020Y 400 A 600 A
25 BGA14025 BGA24025Y BGA34025Y 400 A 600 A
30 BGA14030 BGA24030Y BGA34030Y 400 A 600 A
35 BGA14035 BGA24035Y BGA34035Y 400 A 600 A
40 BGA14040 BGA24040Y BGA34040Y 400 A 600 A
45 BGA14045 BGA24045Y BGA34045Y 400 A 600 A
50 BGA14050 BGA24050Y BGA34050Y 480 A 720 A
60 BGA14060 BGA24060Y BGA34060Y 640 A 960 A
70 BGA14070 BGA24070Y BGA34070Y 640 A 960 A
80 BGA14080 BGA24080Y BGA34080Y 800 A 1200 A
90 BGA14090 BGA24090Y BGA34090Y 1000 A 1500 A
100 BGA14100 BGA24100Y BGA34100Y 1000 A 1500 A
110 BGA14110 BGA24110Y BGA34110Y 1000 A 1500 A
125 BGA14125 BGA24125Y BGA34125Y 1000 A 1500 A
J - SCCR
600Y/347 Vac 1-pole 2-pole 3-pole Fixed AC Magnetic Trip
Amps 347 Vac 600Y/347 Vac 600Y/347 Vac Hold Trip
15 BJA16015 BJA26015 BJA36015 400 A 600 A
20 BJA16020 BJA26020 BJA36020 400 A 600 A
25 BJA16025 BJA26025 BJA36025 400 A 600 A
30 BJA16030 BJA26030 BJA36030 400 A 600 A
35 BJA16035 BJA26035 BJA36035 400 A 600 A
40 BJA16040 BJA26040 BJA36040 400 A 600 A
45 BJA16045 BJA26045 BJA36045 400 A 600 A
50 BJA16050 BJA26050 BJA36050 480 A 720 A
60 BJA16060 BJA26060 BJA36060 640 A 960 A
70 BJA16070 BJA26070 BJA36070 640 A 960 A
80 BJA16080 BJA26080 BJA36080 800 A 1200 A
90 BJA16090 BJA26090 BJA36090 1000 A 1500 A
100 BJA16100 BJA26100 BJA36100 1000 A 1500 A
110 BJA16110 BJA26110 BJA36110 1000 A 1500 A
125 BJA16125 BJA26125 BJA36125 1000 A 1500 A

F-frame
For phase option information see Table 9.114.

Table 9.113: QO™ Distribution Panel—240 Vac Max. Only Mounts in Type HCM,
HCP, HCP-SU, or HCR-U I-Line panelboards, 30 A max. branch circuit breaker.
Maximum No. 1-pole Phase Mounting Height 2-pole 3-pole
QO Circuit Breakers Connection In. mm Catalog Number Catalog Number
6 AB 4.5 114 HQO206AB —
6 BC 4.5 114 HQO206BC —

9-47
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breakers B- and F-frame for I-Line F-frame
Panelboards and Switchboards
Class 650, 651 schneider-electric.us

Table 9.113 QO™ Distribution Panel—240 Vac Max. Only Mounts in Type HCM,
HCP, HCP-SU, or HCR-U I-Line panelboards, 30 A max. branch circuit breaker.
(cont'd.)
Maximum No. 1-pole Phase Mounting Height 2-pole 3-pole
QO Circuit Breakers Connection In. mm Catalog Number Catalog Number
6 AC 4.5 114 HQO206AC —
6 ABC 4.5 114 — HQO306
9
PANELBOARDS

FA/FH, 1-pole FA/FH, 3-pole


1.5 in (38 mm) FA/FH, 2-pole 4.5 in (114 mm)
Mounting Height 3 in (76 mm) Mounting Height
Mounting Height

Table 9.114: Example: BD, 20 A 1-Pole, 277 Vac and 90 A 2- and 3- Pole Table 9.115: Example: FA, 30 A, 480 Vac. Use phase option
BD 240 Vac. Use phase option number for BD, BG, BJ, HD, HG, HJ, HL, letters for FA, FH, LA, and LH.
HR, JD, JG, JJ, JL, JR, MG, and MJ. Phase 1-pole 2-pole 3-pole
Option Letter
Phase
Phase 1-pole 2-pole 3-pole A FA14035A — —
Option Connection
Number B FA14035B — —
1 A FJA140201 — — C FA14035C — —
3 B FJA140203 — — AB — FA24030AB —
5 C FJA140205 — — AC — FA24030AC —
1 AB — QBA220701 — BC — FA24030BC —
2 AC — QBA220702 — ABC — — FA34030
3 BA — QBA220703 — CBA — — FA34030CBA
4 BC — QBA220704 —
5 CA — QBA220705 —
6 CB — QBA220706 —
Standard [1] ABC — — QBA32070
6 CBA — — QBA320706

Table 9.116: Interrupt Ratings (kA) Table 9.117: F-frame—100 A, Thermal-magnetic (240 Vac)
FA (240 V) FA (480 V) FJ 40 A AC Magnetic FA22040( )
18 (1P), 25 (2, 3P) Trip Settings Standard
240 V 10 65
Ampere Interrupting Terminal Wire Range
277 V — 18 65
Rating Hold Trip Catalog
480 V — 18 —
Number
600 V — — —
2-pole, 240 Vac [2]
F-frame accessories starting on Supplemental Digest Section 3.
15 A FA22015( )
20 A FA22020( ) AL50FA
275 600 #14–#4 AWG Cu or
25 A FA22025( ) #12–#4 AWG Al
30 A FA22030( )
AL100FA
35 A 400 850 FA22035( ) #14–#1/0 AWG Cu
or #12–#1/0 AWG Al
45 A FA22045( )
50 A FA22050( )
60 A FA22060( )
70 A 800 1450 FA22070( )
80 A FA22080( )
90 A FA22090( )
900 1700
100 A FA22100( )
3-pole, 240 Vac
15 A FA32015
20 A FA32020 AL50FA
275 600 #14–#4 AWG Cu or
25 A FA32025 #12–#4 AWG Al
30 A FA32030
35 A FA32035
40 A FA32040 AL100FA
400 850 #14–#1/0 AWG Cu
45 A FA32045 or #12–#1/0 AWG Al
50 A FA32050
60 A FA32060 AL100FA
70 A 800 1450 FA32070 #14–#1/0 AWG Cu
80 A FA32080 or #12–#1/0 AWG Al
90 A FA32090 AL100FA
900 1700 #14–#1/0 AWG Cu
100 A FA32100 or #12–#1/0 AWG Al

[1] The absence of a phase option number after a 3-pole catalog number will result in an ABC phase connection.
[2] 1- and 2-pole circuit breaker catalog numbers are completed by adding the required phase connection letters as a suffix.

9-48
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
F-frame Circuit Breakers B- and F-frame for I-Line
Panelboards and Switchboards
schneider-electric.us Class 650, 651
Table 9.118: F-frame—100 A, Thermal-magnetic (480 Vac)
AC Magnetic
Trip Settings Standard Interrupting Extra High Interrupting Terminal Wire Range
Ampere
Rating Catalog
Hold Trip Catalog Number FY/FA Lugs FJ/FC Lugs
Number
1-pole, 277 Vac, 125 Vdc [3]
15 A FY14015( )[4] FJA14015( )
20 A FY14020( )[4] FJA14020( ) AL50FA AL30FD
275 600 #14-#4 AWG Cu, or #12–#6 AWG Al, or
25 A FY14025( )[4] FJA14025( ) #12-#4 AWG Al #14–#6 AWG Cu
30 A FY14030( )[4] FJA14030( )
35 A FA14035( ) FJA14035( )
40 A FA14040( ) FJA14040( )
400 850
45 A FA14045( ) FJA14045( )
50 A FA14050( ) FJA14050( ) AL100FD
AL100FA #12–#2/0 AWG Al
60 A FA14060( ) FJA14060( ) #14–#1/0 AWG Cu or

PANELBOARDS
#12–#1/0 AWG Al or
70 A 800 1450 FA14070( ) FJA14070( ) #14–#2/0 AWG Cu
80 A FA14080( ) —
90 A FA14090( ) —
900 1700
100 A FA14100( ) —
2-pole, 480 Vac, 250 Vdc [3][4][5]
15 A FA24015( ) —
20 A FA24020( ) — AL50FA CU30FA4
275 600 #14–#4 AWG Cu or one #14–#10 AWG
25 A FA24025( ) — #12–#4 AWG Al Cu only
30 A FA24030( ) —
35 A FA24035( ) —
40 A FA24040( ) —
400 850
45 A FA24045( ) —
50 A FA24050( ) — AL100FA4
AL100FA
one #14–#3 AWG Cu

9
60 A FA24060( ) — #14–#1/0 AWG Cu or
#12–#1/0 AWG Al or
70 A 800 1450 FA24070( ) — one #12–#1 AWG Al
80 A FA24080( ) —
90 A FA24090( ) —
900 1700
100 A FA24100( ) —
3-pole, 480 Vac, 250 Vdc [3]
15 A FA34015 —
20 A FA34020 — AL50FA CU30FA4
275 600 #14–#4 AWG Cu or one #14–#10 AWG
25 A FA34025 — #12–#4 AWG Al Cu only
30 A FA34030 —
35 A FA34035 —
40 A FA34040 —
400 850
45 A FA34045 —
50 A FA34050 — AL100FA4
AL100FA
60 A FA34060 — #14–#1/0 AWG Cu or one #14–#3 AWG Cu
or
70 A 800 1450 FA34070 — #12–#1/0 AWG Al
one #12–#1 AWG Al
80 A FA34080 —
90 A FA34090 —
900 1700
100 A FA34100 —

[3] 1- and 2-pole circuit breaker catalog numbers are completed by adding the required phase connection letters as a suffix.
[4] Rated 277 Vac 15 and 20 A FY circuit breakers are rated for switching duty (SWD). 15, 20, 25, and 30 A FA I-Line circuit breakers are also available (no SWD rating).
[5] Rated 277 Vac, 125 Vdc, except FY circuit breakers, which have no dc rating.
15–30 A circuit breakers suitable for use with 60 oC or 75 oC conductors. 35–100 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75 oC conductors.
9-49
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breakers F-frame, PowerPact Q-frame for I-Line™
Panelboards and Switchboards
Class 650, 734, 820 schneider-electric.us

F-frame, PowerPact Q-frame for I-Line™ Panelboards and


Switchboards

Table 9.119: F-frame—100 A, Thermal-magnetic (600 Vac)


AC Magnetic Standard High Current
Ampere Trip Settings Interrupting Interrupting Limiting Terminal
Wire
Rating Catalog Catalog Catalog
Hold Trip Range
Number Number Number
1-pole, 277 Vac, 125 Vdc [1]
15 A — FH16015( ) —
20 A — FH16020( ) — AL50FA
275 600 #14–#4 AWG Cu or
25 A — FH16025( ) — #12–#4 AWG Al
30 A — FH16030( ) —
35 A — FH16035( ) —
40 A — FH16040( ) —
400 850
45 A — FH16045( ) —
50 A — FH16050( ) — AL100FA
60 A — FH16060( ) — #14–#1/0 AWG Cu or
70 A 800 1450 — FH16070( ) — #12–#1/0 AWG Al
80 A — FH16080( ) —
90 A — FH16090( ) —
900 1700
100 A — FH16100( ) —
2-pole, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc [1]
15 A FA26015( ) FH26015( ) —
20 A FA26020( ) FH26020( ) FI26020( ) AL50FA
FI36100 275 600
FA26025( ) FH26025( )
#14–#4 AWG Cu or
25 A — #12–#4 AWG Al
2- and 3-pole
30 A FA26030( ) FH26030( ) FI26030( )
4.5 in (114 mm)
35 A FA26035( ) FH26035( ) —
Mounting Height
40 A FA26040( ) FH26040( ) FI26040( )
400 850
45 A FA26045( ) FH26045( ) —
50 A FA26050( ) FH26050( ) FI26050( )
AL100FA
60 A FA26060( ) FH26060( ) FI26060( ) #14–#1/0 AWG Cu or
70 A 800 1450 FA26070( ) FH26070( ) FI26070( ) #12–#1/0 AWG Al
80 A FA26080( ) FH26080( ) FI26080( )
90 A FA26090( ) FH26090( ) FI26090( )
900 1700
100 A FA26100( ) FH26100( ) FI26100( )
3-pole, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc
15 A FA36015 FH36015 —
20 A FA36020 FH36020 FI36020 AL50FA
275 600 #14–#4 AWG Cu or
25 A FA36025 FH36025 — #12–#4 AWG Al
30 A FA36030 FH36030 FI36030
35 A FA36035 FH36035 —
40 A FA36040 FH36040 FI36040
400 850
45 A FA36045 FH36045 —
50 A FA36050 FH36050 FI36050 AL100FA
60 A FA36060 FH36060 FI36060 #14–#1/0 AWG Cu or
70 A 800 1450 FA36070 FH36070 FI36070 #12–#1/0 AWG Al
80 A FA36080 FH36080 FI36080
90 A FA36090 FH36090 FI36090
900 1700
100 A FA36100 FH36100 FI36100
QB/QD/QG/QJ NOTE: As of January 1st, FI breakers will only fit on the wide side of I-Line
Mounting Height: panelboards.
2-pole—3 in (76 mm)
3-pole—4.5 in (114 mm)

Table 9.120: PowerPact™ Q-frame— 225 A, Thermal-magnetic (240 Vac)


(PowerPact Q-frame 2–pole branch circuit breakers utilize 3" of I-Line mounting space and 3–pole Q-frame circuit breakers utilize 4.5" of
I-Line mounting space.)
AC Magnetic
Ampere Trip Settings "B" Interrupting "D" Interrupting "G" Interrupting "J" Interrupting
Rating
Hold Trip Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
2-pole, 240 Vac [2].
 70 A QBA22070( ) QDA22070( ) QGA22070( ) QJA22070( )
 80 A 1000 1800 QBA22080( ) QDA22080( ) QGA22080( ) QJA22080( )
 90 A QBA22090( ) QDA22090( ) QGA22090( ) QJA22090( )
100 A QBA22100( ) QDA22100( ) QGA22100( ) QJA22100( )
110 A QBA22110( ) QDA22110( ) QGA22110( ) QJA22110( )
125 A QBA22125( ) QDA22125( ) QGA22125( ) QJA22125( )
150 A 1200 2400 QBA22150( ) QDA22150( ) QGA22150( ) QJA22150( )
175 A QBA22175( ) QDA22175( ) QGA22175( ) QJA22175( )
200 A QBA22200( ) QDA22200( ) QGA22200( ) QJA22200( )
225 A QBA22225( ) QDA22225( ) QGA22225( ) QJA22225( )
3-pole, 240 Vac [3]
70 A 1000 1800 QBA32070( ) QDA32070( ) QGA32070( ) QJA32070( )

[1] 1- and 2-pole circuit breaker catalog numbers are completed by adding the required connection letters as a suffix, see F-frame, page 9-47.
[2] 2-pole QB, QD, QG, and QJ circuit breakers are completed by adding the required phasing numbers as indicated in the parentheses, see F-frame, page 9-47
[3] 3-pole QB, QD, QG, and QJ circuit breakers for ABC phasing are complete without additional phasing number. For CBA phasing, complete the catalog number by inserting the number “6” in
the parentheses.
9-50
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
H- and J-frame for I-Line™ Panelboards Circuit Breakers
and Switchboards
schneider-electric.us Class 612
Table 9.120 PowerPact™ Q-frame— 225 A, Thermal-magnetic (240 Vac)(PowerPact Q-frame 2–pole branch circuit breakers utilize 3" of
I-Line mounting space and 3–pole Q-frame circuit breakers utilize 4.5" of I-Line mounting space.) (cont'd.)
AC Magnetic "B" Interrupting "D" Interrupting "G" Interrupting "J" Interrupting
Ampere Trip Settings
Rating
Hold Trip Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
80 A QBA32080( ) QDA32080( ) QGA32080( ) QJA32080( )
90 A QBA32090( ) QDA32090( ) QGA32090( ) QJA32090( )
100 A QBA32100( ) QDA32100( ) QGA32100( ) QJA32100( )
110 A QBA32110( ) QDA32110( ) QGA32110( ) QJA32110( )
125 A QBA32125( ) QDA32125( ) QGA32125( ) QJA32125( )
150 A 1200 2400 QBA32150( ) QDA32150( ) QGA32150( ) QJA32150( )
175 A QBA32175( ) QDA32175( ) QGA32175( ) QJA32175( )
200 A QBA32200( ) QDA32200( ) QGA32200( ) QJA32200( )
225 A QBA32225( ) QDA32225( ) QGA32225( ) QJA32225( )

PANELBOARDS
See [4] below.

Table 9.121: Interrupt Ratings (kA)


QB QD QG QJ [5] HG/
FA FH FI HD/JD HI/JJ HL/JL
JG
25 (1P 35–100
A),
240 V 25 65 (1P 15–30 A, 10 25 65 100 25 65 100 125
200
2P, 3P)
480 V 18 25 (2, 3P) — — — — 18 35 65 100
600 V 14 18 (2, 3P) 100 — — — — 14 18 25 50

F-frame, see Supplemental Digest Section 3 Q-frame dimensions Digest Section 7


Q-frame accessories Digest Section 7 Q-frame optional lugs Supplemental Digest Section 3

9
H- and J-frame for I-Line™ Panelboards and Switchboards
Table 9.122: H-frame 150 A Thermal-Magnetic UL Current-Limiting[6] Circuit
Breakers (600 Vac, 250 Vdc) With Factory Sealed Trip Unit[7] Suitable for Reverse
Connection[7]
(PowerPact HD and HG 2–pole circuit breakers utilize 3" of I-Line mounting space,
HJ and HL 2–pole circuit breakers utilize 4.5" of I-Line mounting space, all 3–pole
H and J-frame circuit breakers utilize 4.5" of I-Line mounting space.)
Current Fixed AC Magnetic
Trip Terminal
Rating @ Cat. No.[8] Wire Range
40o C Hold Trip
H-frame, 150A 2P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc[9]
15 A 350 A  750 A H( )A26015( )
20 A 350 A  750 A H( )A26020( )
25 A 350 A  750 A H( )A26025( )
30 A 350 A  750 A H( )A26030( )
35 A 400 A  850 A H( )A26035( )
40 A 400 A  850 A H( )A26040( )
45 A 400 A  850 A H( )A26045( )
50 A 400 A  850 A H( )A26050( ) AL150HD
14–3/0 AWG
60 A 800 A 1450 A H( )A26060( ) Al or Cu
70 A 800 A 1450 A H( )A26070( )
80 A 800 A 1450 A H( )A26080( )
90 A 800 A 1450 A H( )A26090( )
100 A 800 A 1700 A H( )A26100( )
110 A 900 A 1700 A H( )A26110( )
125 A 900 A 1700 A H( )A26125( )
150 A 900 A 1700 A H( )A26150( )
H-frame 150A 3P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc
15 A 350 A 750 A H( )A36015
20 A 350 A 750 A H( )A36020
25 A 350 A 750 A H( )A36025
30 A 350 A 750 A H( )A36030
35 A 400 A 850 A H( )A36035
40 A 400 A 850 A H( )A36040
45 A 400 A 850 A H( )A36045
50 A 400 A 850 A H( )A36050 AL150HD
14–3/0 AWG
60 A 800 A 1450 A H( )A36060 Al or Cu
70 A 800 A 1450 A H( )A36070
80 A 800 A 1450 A H( )A36080
90 A 800 A 1450 A H( )A36090
100 A 800 A 1700 A H( )A36100
110 A 900 A 1700 A H( )A36110
125 A 900 A 1700 A H( )A36125
150 A 900 A 1700 A H( )A36150

[4] Replacement lugs are not available on QB, QD, QG, or QJ circuit breakers. Lugs for QB, QD, QG, or QJ circuit breakers accept one #4 AWG–300 kcmil.
No accessories are available for PowerPact Q Frame breakers.
[5] 3-pole QJ circuit breakers are rated at 208Y/120 Vac only.
[6] Circuit breakers with J, L, and R interrupting ratings are UL certified as current limiting.
[7] See Supplemental Digest Section 3 for circuit breakers with field-interchangeable trip units.
[8] To complete catalog number, replace the blank with the appropriate rating (D, G, J, L).
[9] 2 pole circuit breaker catalog numbers are completed by adding the required phase connection number as a suffix see Table 9.128, page 9-53.
9-51
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breakers H- and J-frame for I-Line™ Panelboards
and Switchboards
Class 612 schneider-electric.us

Table 9.123: J-frame 250 A Thermal-Magnetic UL Current-Limiting[10]Circuit


Breakers (600 Vac, 250 Vdc) With Factory Sealed Trip Unit[11] Suitable for Reverse
Connection[11]
(All PowerPact J-frame circuit breakers, both 2– and 3–pole, utilize 4.5" of I-Line
mounting space.)
Current Adjustable AC Magnetic
Trip Terminal
Rating @ Cat. No.[12] Wire Range
40oC Low High
9

J-frame 250A 2P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc[13]


150 A 750 A 1500 A J( )A26150( ) AL175JD
175 A 875 A 1750 A J( )A26175( ) 4–4/0 AWG Al or Cu
200 A 1000 A 2000 A J( )A26200( )
AL250JD
225 A 1125 A 2250 A J( )A26225( ) 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil
250 A 1250 A 2500 A J( )A26250( ) Al or Cu
J-frame 250A 3P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc
150 A 750 A 1500 A J( )A36150 AL175JD
PANELBOARDS

175 A 875 A 1750 A J( )A36175 4–4/0 AWG Al or Cu


200 A 1000 A 2000 A J( )A36200
AL250JD
225 A 1125 A 2250 A J( )A36225 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil
250 A 1250 A 2500 A J( )A36250 Al or Cu

Table 9.124: H-frame 150 A and J-frame 250 A Electronic Trip UL Current-Limiting
[10]Circuit Breakers
(600 Vac) With Factory Sealed Trip Unit[11] Suitable for Reverse Connection [14]
(PowerPact Electronic Trip H- and J-frame circuit breakers utilize 4.5" of I-Line
mounting space.)
Electronic Trip Unit Sensor
Rating Cat. No.[12] Terminal
Type Function Trip Unit
600 Vac, 50/60 Hz, 3P
60 A H( )A36060U31X
100 A H( )A36100U31X AL150HD[16]
LI 3.2[15]
150 A H( )A36150U31X
Micrologic 250 A J( )A36250U31X AL250JD[17]
Standard 60 A H( )A36060U33X
100 A H( )A36100U33X AL150HD[16]
LSI 3.2S[15]
150 A H( )A36150U33X
250 A J( )A36250U33X AL250JD[17]
60 A H( )A36060U43X
Micrologic 100 A H( )A36100U43X AL150HD[16]
LSI 5.2A
Ammeter 150 A H( )A36150U43X
250 A J( )A36250U43X AL250JD[17]
60 A H( )A36060U53X
Micrologic 100 A H( )A36100U53X AL150HD[16]
Energy LSI 5.2E
150 A H( )A36150U53X
250 A J( )A36250U53X AL250JD[17]
60 A H( )A36060U44X
Micrologic 100 A H( )A36100U44X AL150HD[16]
Ammeter LSIG 6.2A
150 A H( )A36150U44X
250 A J( )A36250U44X AL250JD[17]
60 A H( )A36060U54X
Micrologic 100 A H( )A36100U54X AL150HD[16]
Energy LSIG 6.2E
150 A H( )A36150U54X
250 A J( )A36250U54X AL250JD[17]

Table 9.125: Interrupt Ratings (kA)


D G J L
240 V 25 65 100 125
480 V 18 35 65 100
600 V 14 18 25 50

[10] Circuit breakers with J, L, and R interrupting ratings are UL certified as current limiting.
[11] See Supplemental Digest Section 3 for circuit breakers with field-interchangeable trip units.
[12] To complete catalog number, replace the blank with the appropriate rating (D, G, J, L).
[13] 2 pole circuit breaker catalog numbers are completed by adding the required phase connection number as a suffix see Table 9.128, page 9-53.
[14] For applications requiring communications, see page 7-65.
[15] 3P circuit breakers with this trip unit can be used for 2P applications.
[16] AL150HD wire range is 14–3/0 AWG Al or Cu.
[17] AL250JD wire range is 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil Al or Cu. For smaller wire range (4–4/0 AWG Al or Cu), replace the lug’s wire binding screws with the larger binding screws provided.
9-52
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
K-, PowerPact H-, J-, L-frame for I-Line™ Circuit Breakers
Panelboards & Switchboards
schneider-electric.us Class 825, 0612

J-frame Mission Critical Circuit Breaker


Table 9.126: J-frame 250 A Electronic Trip Mission Critical Circuit Breakers (480/277 Vac) With Factory Sealted Trip Units Suitable for
Reverse Connection[18]
Electronic Trip Trip Continuous D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting
Unit Type Trip Unit Terminal
Function Current Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
Standard LI 3.2 W 250 JDA34250WU31X JGA34250WU31X JJA34250WU31X JLA34250WU31X AL250JD[19]
Standard LSI 3.2S-W 250 JDA34250WU33X JGA34250WU33X JJA34250WU33X JLA34250WU33X AL250JD[19]
High Perf. Ammerter LSI 5.2A-W 250 JDA34250WU43X JGA34250WU43X JJA34250WU43X JLA34250WU43X AL250JD[19]
High Perf. Energy LSI 5.2E-W 250 JDA34250WU53X JGA34250WU53X JJA34250WU53X JLA34250WU53X AL250JD[19]
High perf. Ammerter LSIG 6.2A-W 250 JDA34250WU44X JGA34250WU44X JJA34250WU44X JLA34250WU44X AL250JD[19]
High Perf. Energy LSIG 6.2E-W 250 JDA34250WU54X JGA34250WU54X JJA34250WU54X JLA34250WU54X AL250JD[19]

PANELBOARDS
L-frame Mission Critical Circuit Breaker
Table 9.127: L-frame 600 A Electronic Trip Mission Critical Circuit Breakers (480/277 Vac) With Factory Sealed Trip Units Suitable for
Reverse Connection[20]
Electronic Trip Trip Continuous D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting
Trip Unit Terminal
Unit Type Function Current Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
250 LDA34250WU31X LGA34250WU31X LJA34250WU31X LLA34250WU31X AL400L61K3[21]
Standard LI 3.3 W 400 LDA34400WU31X LGA34400WU31X LJA34400WU31X LLA34400WU31X
AL600LF52K3[22]
600 LDA34600WU31X LGA34600WU31X LJA34600WU31X LLA34600WU31X
250 LDA34250WU33X LGA34250WU33X LJA34250WU33X LLA34250WU33X AL400L61K3[21]
Standard LSI 3.3S-W 400 LDA34400WU33X LGA34400WU33X LJA34400WU33X LLA34400WU33X
AL600LF52K3[22]
600 LDA34600WU33X LGA34600WU33X LJA34600WU33X LLA34600WU33X
400 LDA34400WU43X LGA34400WU43X LJA34400WU43X LLA34400WU43X
High Perf. Ammeter LSI 5.3A-W AL600LF52K3[22]
600 LDA34600WU43X LGA34600WU43X LJA34600WU43X LLA34600WU43X
400 LDA34400WU53X LGA34400WU53X LJA34400WU53X LLA34400WU53X
High Perf. Energy LSI 5.3E-W AL600LF52K3[22]
600 LDA34600WU53X LGA34600WU53X LJA34600WU53X LLA34600WU53X

9
400 LDA34400WU44X LGA34400WU44X LJA34400WU44X LLA34400WU44X
High Perf. Ammeter LSIG 6.3A-W AL600LF52K3[22]
600 LDA34600WU44X LGA34600WU44X LJA34600WU44X LLA34600WU44X
400 LDA34400WU54X LGA34400WU54X LJA34400WU54X LLA34400WU54X
High Perf. Energy LSIG 6.3E-W AL600LF52K3[22]
600 LDA34600WU54X LGA34600WU54X LJA34600WU54X LLA34600WU54X

Table 9.128: PowerPact™ H-, J-, and L-frame Automatic Molded Case Switches, 600 Vac
G Withstand L Withstand R Withstand
Circuit Ampere
Poles Trip Terminal Wire Range
Breaker Rating Cat. No. Cat. No. Trip Point Cat. No. Trip Point
Point
150 A HGA26000S15( ) 2250 A HLA26000S15 2250 A — — — —
2[23] 175 A JGA26000S17( ) 3125 A JLA26000S17 3125 A — — — —
H-frame 250 A JGA26000S25( ) 3125 A JLA26000S25 3125 A — — — —
J-frame 150 A HGA36000S15 2250 A HLA36000S15 2250 A HRA36000S15 2250 A AL150HD 14 AWG–3/0 AWG Al/Cu
3 175 A JGA36000S17 3125 A JLA36000S17 3125 A JRA36000S17 3125 A AL175JD 4–4/0 AWG Al/Cu
250 A JGA36000S25 3125 A JLA36000S25 3125 A JRA36000S25 3125 A AL250JD 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil Al/Cu
400 A LGA36000S40X 4800 A LLA36000S40X 4800 A LRA36000S40X 4800 A AL150HD AL600LS52K3
L-frame 3 (2) 2/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al/Cu
600 A LGA36000S60X 6600A LLA36000S60X 6600 A LRA36000S60X 6600 A AL250JD

Table 9.129: KI Interrupt Ratings (kA)


V KI
240 200
480 200
600 100
K-frame accessories starting on Supplemental Digest Section 3.
K-frame dimensions Supplemental Digest Section 3.
K-frame optional lugs Supplemental Digest Section 3.
H-, J-, and L-frame accessories starting on PowerPact Accessories, page 7-54.
H-, J-, and L-frame dimensions starting on Molded Case Circuit Breaker Dimensions,
page 7-77.
H-, J-, and L-frame optional lugs Mechanical Lugs, page 7-59.

Table 9.130: Interrupt Ratings (kA) Table 9.131: Phase Options—Example HDA26150( )
D G J L Phase Option Phase 2-pole 3-pole
240 V 25 65 100 125 Number Connection
480 V 18 35  65 100 1 AB HDA261501 —
2 AC HDA261502 —
3 BA HDA261503 —
4 BC HDA261504 —
5 CA HDA261505 —
6 CB HDA261506 —
Standard ABC — JDA34250WU31X
6 CBA — JDA34250WU31X6

[18] Standard rated (80%). Not available in 100% rated.


[19] AL250JD terminal wire range is (1) 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil Al or Cu.
[20] Standard rated (80%). Not available in 100% rated.
[21] AL400L61K3 terminal wire range is (1) #2 AWG–500 kcmil Al or #2 AWG–600 kcmil Cu..
[22] AL600LF52K3 terminal wire range is (2) #3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu.
[23] 2-pole circuit breaker catalog numbers are completed by adding the required phase connection number as a suffix, see Table 9.128, page 9-53.
9-53
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breakers LA-frame for I-Line™ Panelboards and
Switchboards
Class 660, 665, 670, 830 schneider-electric.us

LA Circuit Breakers
Table 9.132: L-frame—400 A, Thermal-magnetic (600 Vac)
AC Magnetic Standard Interrupting Terminal
Ampere Trip Settings
Rating Wire
Low High Catalog Number Range
2-pole, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc [24]
125 A 625 1250 LA26125( )
150 A 750 1500 LA26150( )
175 A 875 1750 LA26175( )
200 A 1000 2000 LA26200( ) AL400LA
225 A 1125 2250 LA26225( ) one #1 AWG–600 kcmil or
two #1 AWG–250 kcmil
250 A 1250 2500 LA26250( ) AL or Cu
300 A 1500 3000 LA26300( )
350 A 1750 3500 LA26350( )
400 A 2000 4000 LA26400( )
3-pole, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc
125 A 625 1250 LA36125
150 A 750 1500 LA36150
FI36100 175 A 875 1750 LA36175
2- and 3-pole 200 A 1000 2000 LA36200 AL400LA
225 A 1125 2250 LA36225 one #1 AWG–600 kcmil or
4.5 in (114 mm) two #1 AWG–250 kcmil
250 A 1250 2500 LA36250 AL or Cu
Mounting Height 300 A 1500 3000 LA36300
350 A 1750 3500 LA36350
400 A 2000 4000 LA36400
L-frame acccessories starting on Supplemental Digest Section 3.
L-frame dimensions Molded Case Circuit Breaker Dimensions, page 7-77.
L-frame optional lugs Mechanical Lugs, page 7-59.

Table 9.133: Interrupt Ratings (kA)


LA LC LI
240 V 42 100 200
480 V 30 65 200
600 V 22 35 100

[24] 2-pole circuit breaker catalog numbers are completed by adding required phase connection letters as suffix to catalog number. See page 9-47.
9-54
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
L- and PowerPact M-frame for I-Line™ Circuit Breakers
Panelboards and Switchboards
schneider-electric.us Class 612, 661

L- and PowerPact M-frame for I-Line™ Panelboards and


Switchboards
Table 9.134: L-frame 600 A Circuit Breakers with Lugs and Factory-Sealed
Electronic Trip Units Suitable for Reverse Connection[25]
(L-frame circuit breaker utilizes 6" of available I-Line bus)
Electronic Trip Unit
Sensor Catalog
Trip Rating Number[26] Terminal
Type Function Unit
600 Vac, 53/60 Hz, 3P
250 A L( )A36250U31X AL400L61K3[28]
Micrologic 3.3[27]
Standard LI 400 A L( )A36400U31X
L( )A36600U31X AL600LF52K3[29]
600 A

PANELBOARDS
250 A L( )A36250U33X AL400L61K3[28]
Micrologic 3.3S[27]
LSI 400 A L( )A36400U33X
Standard
600 A L( )A36600U33X
Micrologic 400 A L( )A36400U43X
LSI 5.3A L( )A36600U43X
Ammeter 600 A
Micrologic 400 A L( )A36400U53X
Energy LSI 5.3E L( )A36600U53X AL600LF52K3[29]
600 A
Micrologic 400 A L( )A36400U44X
LSIG 6.3A L( )A36600U44X
Ammeter 600 A
Micrologic 400 A L( )A36400U54X
Energy LSIG 6.3E L( )A36600U54X
600 A

Table 9.135: Interrupt Ratings (kA) for PowerPact L and M Frames


G J L [30]
240 V 65 100 125
480 V 35 65 100

9
600 V [31] 18 25 50

Table 9.136: PowerPact M-frame: with ET1.0 Factory – sealed trip unit (not field adjustable)—800 A [32]
(PowerPact M-frame circuit breakers utilize 9" of the available I-Line bussing.)
Adjustable Instantaneous
Ampere G Interrupting J Interrupting Terminal
Trip Range [33]
Rating Wire Range
Low High Catalog Number [34] Catalog Number [34]
300 A  600 3000 MGA26300( ) MJA26300( )
350 A  700 3500 MGA26350( ) MJA26350( )
400 A  800 4000 MGA26400( ) MJA26400( )
450 A  900 4500 MGA26450( ) MJA26450( ) 3–3/0
2-pole, 600 Vac, through 500 kcmil
50/60 Hz 500 A 1000 5000 MGA26500( ) MJA26500( ) Al or Cu
600 A 1200 6000 MGA26600( ) MJA26600( )
700 A 1400 7000 MGA26700( ) MJA26700( )
800 A 1600 8000 MGA26800( ) MJA26800( )
300 A  600 3000 MGA36300 MJA36300
350 A  700 3500 MGA36350 MJA36350
400 A  800 4000 MGA36400 MJA36400
450 A  900 4500 MGA36450 MJA36450 3–3/0
3-pole, 600 Vac,
50/60 Hz through 500 kcmil
500 A 1000 5000 MGA36500 MJA36500 Al or Cu
600 A 1200 6000 MGA36600 MJA36600
700 A 1400 7000 MGA36700 MJA36700
800 A 1600 8000 MGA36800 MJA36800

L-frame accessories, see Supplemental Digest Section 3. M-frame accessories, page 7-54.
L-frame dimensions, page 7-77. M-frame dimensions, page 7-77.
L-frame optional lugs, page 7-59. M-frame optional lugs, page 7-59.

Table 9.137: Automatic Molded Case Switches—600 Vac, 50/60 Hz


Ampere 2-pole 3-pole Withstand Rating [35] Trip Point Amperes Terminal
Rating Catalog Number [36] Catalog Number 240 Vac 480 Vac 600 Vac AC Wire Range
600 A PJA26000S60( ) PJA36000S60 100 65 25 10000 3–3/0 through
800 A PJA26000S80( ) PJA36000S80 100 65 25 10000 500 kcmil Al or Cu
1000 A PJA26000S10( ) PJA36000S10 100 65 25 10000 4–3/0 through
1200 A PJA26000S12( ) PJA36000S12 100 65 25 10000 500 kcmil Al or Cu

Table 9.138: PowerPact P- and R-frame Interrupt Ratings


P-frame Interrupt Rating R-frame Interrupt Rating
Voltage
G J K L G J K L
240 Vac 65 kA 100 kA 65 kA 125 kA 65 kA 100 kA 65 kA 125 kA
480 Vac 35 kA 65 kA 50 kA 100 kA 35 kA 65 kA 65 kA 100 kA

[25] See Supplemental Digest page 3-4 for circuit breakers with field-interchangeable trip units.
[26] For 100% rated circuit breakers (250 A and 400 A only), add a “C” in the 9th character place (for example, LRA36400CU31X).
[27] 3P circuit breakers with this trip unit can be used for 2P applications.
[28] AL400L61K3 terminal wire ranges are (1) 2 AWG–600 kcmil Cu or (1) 2 AWG–500 kcmil Al.
[29] AL600LFS52K3 terminal wire range is (2) 3/0 –500 kcmil.
[30] L interrupting rating is not available in M-frame.
[31] 600 V interrupt ratings not available for D-frame.
[32] The ET 1.0 trip unit cannot be field replaced, nor does it allow adjustment of the long-time trip point setting. It is considered an electronic equivalent of a thermal-magnet circuit breaker.
[33] UL magnetic trip setting tolerances are ±10% from the nominal values shown.
[34] Fill in parentheses with the following phase connection options: (2) for AC and (5) for CA.
[35] The withstand rating is the fault current, at rated voltage, that the molded case switch will withstand without damage when protected by a circuit breaker with an equal ampere rating.
[36] Fill in parentheses with the following phase connection options: (2) for AC or (5) for CA.
9-55
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breakers PowerPact P- and R-frame for I-Line™
Panelboards and Switchboards
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101 schneider-electric.us

Table 9.138 PowerPact P- and R-frame Interrupt Ratings (cont'd.)


P-frame Interrupt Rating R-frame Interrupt Rating
Voltage
G J K L G J K L
600 Vac 18 kA 25 kA 50 kA 25 kA 18 kA 25 kA 65 kA 50 kA
P- and R-frame accessories, page 7-54.
P- and R-frame dimensions, page 7-77.
P- and R-frame optional lugs, page 7-59.

PowerPact P- and R-frame for I-Line™ Panelboards and


9

Switchboards
Table 9.139: PowerPact P-frame 1200 A (600 Vac, 50/60 Hz) 3P Circuit Breaker with Electronic Trip Unit
(PowerPact P-frame circuit breakers utilize 9" of the available I-Line bussing.)
Electronic Trip Unit Sensor Terminal
Rating Cat. No.[37][38][39][40] Wire Range
Type Function Code
 600 A P( )A36060 (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
Basic Electronic
Trip Unit Fixed long-time,  800 A P( )A36080 AL800M23K
Adjustable ET1.0I
PANELBOARDS

(Not 1000 A P( )A36100


Interchangeable) Instantaneous (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
1200 A P( )A36120 AL1200P24K
 250 A P( )A36025(C)U31A
 400 A P( )A36040(C)U31A (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
 600 A P( )A36060(C)U31A AL800M23K
LI 3.0
 800 A P( )A36080(C)U31A
1000 A P( )A36100U31A (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
Micrologic 1200 A P( )A36120U31A AL1200P24K
Interchangeable Standard
Trip Unit  250 A P( )A36025(C)U33A
 400 A P( )A36040(C)U33A (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
 600 A P( )A36060(C)U33A AL800M23K
LSI 5.0
 800 A P( )A36080(C)U33A
1000 A P( )A36100U33A (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
1200 A P( )A36120U33A AL1200P24K
 250 A P( )A36025(C)U41A
 400 A P( )A36040(C)U41A (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
 600 A P( )A36060(C)U41A AL800M23K
LI 3.0A
 800 A P( )A36080(C)U41A
1000 A P( )A36100U41A (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
1200 A P( )A36120U41A AL1200P24K
 250 A P( )A36025(C)U43A
 400 A P( )A36040(C)U43A (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
Micrologic  600 A P( )A36060(C)U43A AL800M23K
Interchangeable Ammeter LSI 5.0A
Trip Unit  800 A P( )A36080(C)U43A
1000 A P( )A36100U43A (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
1200 A P( )A36120U43A AL1200P24K
 250 A P( )A36025(C)U44A
 400 A P( )A36040(C)U44A (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
 600 A P( )A36060(C)U44A AL800M23K
LSIG 6.0A
 800 A P( )A36080(C)U44A
1000 A P( )A36100U44A (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
1200 A P( )A36120U44A AL1200P24K
 250 A P( )A36025(C)U63AE1
 400 A P( )A36040(C)U63AE1 (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
 600 A P( )A36060(C)U63AE1 AL800M23K
LSI 5.0P
 800 A P( )A36080(C)U63AE1
1000 A P( )A36100U63AE1 (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
Micrologic 1200 A P( )A36120U63AE1 AL1200P24K
Interchangeable Power
Trip Unit  250 A P( )A36025(C)U64AE1
 400 A P( )A36040(C)U64AE1 (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
 600 A P( )A36060(C)U64AE1 AL800M23K
LSIG 6.0P
 800 A P( )A36080(C)U64AE1
1000 A P( )A36100U64AE1 (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
1200 A P( )A36120U64AE1 AL1200P24K
250 A P( )A36025(C)U73AE1
400 A P( )A36040(C)U73AE1 (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
600 A P( )A36060(C)U73AE1 AL800M23K
LSI 5.0H
800 A P( )A36080(C)U73AE1
1000 A P( )A36100U73AE1 (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
Micrologic 1200 A P( )A36120U73AE1 AL1200P24K
Interchangeable Harmonic
Trip Unit 250 A P( )A36025(C)U74AE1
400 A P( )A36040(C)U74AE1 (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
600 A P( )A36060(C)U74AE1 AL800M23K
LSIG 6.0H
800 A P( )A36080(C)U74AE1
1000 A P( )A36100U74AE1 (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
1200 A P( )A36120U74AE1 AL1200P24K

[37] To complete the catalog number, replace the blank ( ) with the appropriate interrupt rating (G, J, K, or L).
[38] For 100% rated circuit breakers add a “C” in the 9th character place. For example, the catalog number for a 100% standard-type trip unit with LI trip functions at 250 A would be
PGA36025CU31A.
[39] The L interrupt rating is supplied in 480 V only. Change the 5th character (voltage rating) from a 6 (600 V) to a 4 (480 V); for example, PLA34025U31A.
[40] See Table 9.138 PowerPact P- and R-frame Interrupt Ratings, page 9-55 for interrupt ratings.
9-56
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
600 Vac, 250 Vdc I-Line™ Factory Assembled Panelboards
Class 2110 / Refer To Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us

Table 9.140: PowerPact R-frame 1200 A (600 Vac, 50/60 Hz) 3P Circuit Breaker with Electronic Trip Unit
Electronic Trip Unit Terminal
Sensor Wire
Rating Cat. No. [41][42][43][44]
Type Function Code Range
Basic Electronic Trip Unit Fixed Long-Time, Adjustable R( )A36120
(Not Interchangeable) Instantaneous ET1.01 1200 A
1000 A R( )A36100CU31A
Micrologic LI 3.0
1200 A R( )A36120CU31A
Interchangeable Standard
Trip Unit 1000 A R( )A36100CU33A
LSI 5.0
1200 A R( )A36120CU33A
1000 A R( )A36100CU41A
LI 3.0A
1200 A R( )A36120CU41A
Micrologic 1000 A R( )A36100CU43A
Interchangeable Ammeter LSI 5.0A
Trip Unit 1200 A R( )A36120CU43A AL1200R53K
R( )A36100CU44A (4) 3/0-600 kcmil
1000 A

PANELBOARDS
LSI 6.0A Al or Cu
1200 A R( )A36120CU44A
1000 A R( )A36100CU63AE1
Micrologic LSI 5.0P
1200 A R( )A36120CU63AE1
Interchangeable Power
Trip Unit 1000 A R( )A36100CU64AE1
LSIG 6.0P
1200 A R( )A36120CU64AE1
1000 A R( )A36100CU73AE1
Micrologic LSI 5.0H
1200 A R( )A36120CU73AE1
Interchangeable Harmonic
Trip Unit 1000 A R( )A36100CU74AE1
LSIG 6.0H
1200 A R( )A36120CU74AE1
P- and R-frame accessories, Mechanical Lugs, page 7-59.
P- and R-frame dimensions, Molded Case Circuit Breaker Dimensions, page 7-77.
P- and R-frame trip unit options, Micrologic™ Electronic Trip Units, page 7-65.

9
P- and R-frame optional lugs, Mechanical Lugs, page 7-59.
P- and R-frame alternate rating plugs, Micrologic™ Electronic Trip Units, page 7-65.
I-Line™ Factory Assembled Panelboards
Table 9.141: I-Line 200% Rated Neutral—Standard Terminal Configuration
Branch Space Neutral Terminals Quantity and Size Type 1 Enclosure
Panel
Type Ampacity Type H W D
In. mm Main Branch
In. mm In. mm In. mm
600 A MLO 72 1829 (8) 750 kcmil 91 2311 32 813 8.25 210
600 A (MG, MJ) M/B 72 1829 (8) 750 kcmil (35) 350 kcmil, 91 2311 32 813 9.50 241
HCM (9)#14-1/0, (17)#14-#4
800 A MLO 72 1829 (8) 750 kcmil 91 2311 32 813 8.25 210
800 A (MG, MJ) M/B 72 1829 (8) 750 kcmil 91 2311 32 813 9.50 241
(8) 600 kcmil, (15) 350 kcmil
HCR-U[1] 1200A M/B, MLO 108 2743 (8) 750 kcmil (9) #14-1/0, (17)#14-#4 86 2184 44 1118 9.50 241
(35) 350 kcmil,
600A M/B, MLO 63 1600 (8) 750 kcmil (9)#14-1/0, (17)#14-#4 68 1727 42 1067 9.50 241
HCP
(35) 350 kcmil,
800A M/B, MLO 99 2515 (8) 750 kcmil 86 2184 42 1067 9.50 241
(9)#14-1/0, (17)#14-#4
HCP-SU (8) 750 kcmil, (21) 350 kcmil,
800A M/B, MLO 54 1371 (8) 750 kcmil 86 2184 26 660 9.5 241
[2] (9) #14-1/0, (17) #14-#4

[41] To complete the catalog number, replace the blank ( ) with the appropriate interrupt rating (G, J, K, or L).
[42] For 100% rated circuit breakers add a “C” in the 9th character place. For example, the catalog number for a 100% standard-type trip unit with LI trip functions at 250 A would be
PGA36025CU31A.
[43] The L interrupt rating is supplied in 480 V only. Change the 5th character (voltage rating) from a 6 (600 V) to a 4 (480 V); for example, PLA34025U31A.
[44] See Table 9.138 PowerPact P- and R-frame Interrupt Ratings, page 9-55 for interrupt ratings.
[1] 6 in. enclosure extension is required for HCRU I-Line panelboard.
[2] 9 in. enclosure extension is required for HCP-SU I-Line panelboard.
9-57
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QMB Fusible Branch Switches 600 Vac, 250 Vdc
Class 4620 / Refer to Catalog 4620CT9601
schneider-electric.us

For QMB/QMJ Panelboards and Switchboards


Table 9.142: QMB Branch Switch Units
Class R Fuse Kits Electrical Interlock Horsepower Ratings [1]
Kit
Unit Unit
Ampere Height Catalog No. 240 Vac 480 Vac 600 Vac
Rating (In.) Number Kits Catalog Catalog Std. Max. Std. Max. Std. Max. 250
Req’- Number Number [2] Vdc
d. 1Ø 3Ø 1Ø 3Ø 1Ø 3Ø 1Ø 3Ø 1Ø 3Ø 1Ø 3Ø
2-pole, 240 Vac, 250 Vdc
9

30 A-30 A QMB221TW 2 — — — — — — — — 5
HRK30 QMB300EK (1 or 2) 1.5 3 3 7.5
 30 A-Blank QMB221HW [3] — — — — — — — — 5
4.5
60 A-60 A QMB222TW — — — — — — — — 10
QMB36R QMB300EK (1 or 2) 3 7.5 10 15
 60 A-Blank QMB222HW [3] — — — — — — — — 10
100 A-100 A QMB223TW — — — — — — — —
6 1 QMB100R QMB610EK (1 or 2) 7.5 15 15 30 20
100 A-Blank QMB223HW [3] — — — — — — — —
200 A 9 QMB224W HRK1020 QMB200EK (1 or 2) — 25 15 60 — — — — — — — — 40
15 QMB225W QMB4060R — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
PANELBOARDS

400 A
9 QMB225WT3 [4] — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
600 A Use 3-pole devices for 2-pole application. — — — — — — — — — — — — —
3-pole, 240 Vac
30 A-30 A QMB321TW 2 — — — — — — — — — — —
HRK30 3 7.5
 30 A-Blank QMB321HW [3] — — — — — — — — — — —
4.5 QMB300EK (1 or 2)
60 A-60 A QMB322TW — — — — — — — — — — —
QMB36R 7.5 15
 60 A-Blank QMB322HW [3] — — — — — — — — — — —
100 A-100 A QMB323TW 1 — — — — — — — — — — —
6 QMB100R QMB610EK (1 or 2) 15 30
100 A-Blank QMB323HW [3] — — — — — — — — — — —
200 A 9 QMB324W HRK1020 QMB200EK (1 or 2) — 25 — 60 — — — — — — — — —
15 QMB325W QMB4060R — — — 125 — — — — — — — — —
400 A QMB325WT3 50
9 [4] — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
QMB326W 1 QMB4060R — — — 150 — — — — — — — — —
600 A QMB326WT3
15 [4] — — — — 75 — — — — — — — — — — —
800 A QMB327WT3 [4] — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
2-pole, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc[5]
30 A-30 A QMB261TW — — — —
QMB36R QMB300EK (1 or 2) 1.5 3 3 5 7.5 15 3 10  5
 30 A-Blank QMB261HW [3] — — — —
 4.5 1
60 A-60 A QMB262TW — — — —
QMB60R 3 10 5 15 20 30 10 25 10
 60 A-Blank QMB262HW [3] — — — —
QMB610EK (1 or 2)
100 A-100 A QMB263TW 2 — — 30 60 15 — 40 —
6 HRK1020 7.5 15 10 25 20
100 A-Blank QMB263HW [3] — — — — — — — —
1
200 A  9 QMB264W HRK1020 QMB200EK (1 or 2) 15 — — — 25 50 50 125 30 — 50 — 40
400 A Use 3-pole devices
for 2-pole application. — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
600 A
3-pole, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc[5]
QMB361TW 1 QMB36R — 3 — 7.5 — 5 — 15 — 7.5 — 20 —
30 A-30 A
4.5 QMJ361T — — QMB300EK (1 or 2) — — — — — — — — — — — 20 5
 30 A-Blank QMB361HW [3] QMB36R — 3 — 7.5 — 5 — 15 — 7.5 — 20 —
1
QMB362TW QMB60R — 7.5 — 15 — 15 — 30 — 15 — 50 —
60 A-60 A
QMJ362T — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 10
 60 A-Blank 6 QMB362HW [3] QMB60R — 7.5 — 15 — 15 — 30 — 15 — 50 —
1 QMB60R and
60 A-30 A QMB362T21W QMB36R — — — — — — — — — — — — —
7.5 QMB363TW 2 HRK1020 QMB610EK (1 or 2) — 15 — 30 — 25 — 60 — 30 — 75 —
100 A-100 A
6 QMJ363T — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 20
7.5 QMB363HW [3] 1 HRK1020 — 15 — 30 — 25 — 60 — 30 — 75 —
100 A-Blank
6 QMJ363H [3] — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 20
100 A-30 A QMB363T31W QMB36R
7.5 1 — — — — — — — — — — — — —
100 A-60 A QMB363T32W QMB60R
200 A 9 QMB364W 1 HRK1020 QMB200EK (1 or 2) — 25 — 60 — 50 — 125 — 60 — 150 —
200 A-200 A QMJ364T — — 25 — 60 — 50 — 125 — 60 — 150 40
7.5 — QMB610EK (1 or 2)
200 A-Blank QMJ364H [3] — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
400 A[6] 15 QMB365W 1 QMB4060R — — — — — — 100 — 250 — 125 — 350 50
400 A QMJ365 — QMB200EK (1 or 2) — 50 — 125 — 100 — 250 — 125 — 350 50
9 —
400 A[6] QMB365WT6 [7] — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
600 A [6] QMB366W 1 QMB4060R — — — — — — 150 — 400 — 250 — 500 —
600 A 15 QMJ366 — — — 75 — 150 — — — — — — — — —

800 A QMB367W — — — — — — — 150 — 400 — 250 — 500 —
NOTE: See the Supplemental Digest for merchandised motor starter units, QMB RTI panelboards, and replacement switches for Series 1–4
and D2 QMB panelboards.
NOTE: For series E1 and E2, QMJ switches may be used in 400 A–1200 A interiors in a NEMA 1 without door only. QMJ switches cannot be
used in series E1 and E2, 225 A panelboards. QMJ switches cannot be used in NEMA 1 with door or any NEMA 3R/12 enclosure.

[1] Horsepower rating applicable to 480Y/277 V system only.


[2] “1’’ indicates one normally open and one normally closed contact.
“2’’ indicates two normally open and two normally closed contacts.
[3] Blank units cannot be modified to accept a switch interior.
[4] Use 300 Vac Class T fuses only.
[5] Class J fuse provisions—to field modify switch, move load side fuse base to position indicated in switch. Not available on 100-30, 100-60, or 800 A switch units.
[6] 250 Vdc rating.
[7] Use 600 Vac Class T fuses only.
9-58
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Common Features QMB Fusible Branch Switches
Class 4620 / Refer to Catalog 4620CT9601
schneider-electric.us

Fusible—600 Vac, 250 Vdc


Table 9.143: Available QMB Accessories
Electrical Interlocks
1 NO and 1NC Electrical Interlocks on Main Switches
2NO and 2NC Electrical Interlocks on Main Switchs
Equipment Ground Bars
Standard Ground Bar
Copper Ground Bar
Insulated/Isolated Ground Bar
Name Plates
Copper Neutral
Copper Neutral
125-400A
600A
800A

PANELBOARDS
Enclsoure Modifications
Hinged Trim
Weatherproof - NEMA 3R
Lugs
Mechanical Lugs - Standard
Copper Mechanical Lugs
Copper Compression Lugs
Aluminum Compression Lugs
VCEL Lugs
UL Listed Short Circuit Ratings for QMB Starters
Fusible switch-600V Max.
Starter Size (with Class R or J Fuses) RMS Sym. Thermal-Magnetic Bircuit Breaker 600V Max.
Amps Rms Sym. Amps
0 100,000 5,000
100,000 5,000

9
1
2 100,000 5,000
3 100,000 5,000

9-59
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QMB Fusible Branch Switches Common Features
Class 4620 / Refer to Catalog 4620CT9601
schneider-electric.us

QMB Layout Information


To maximize the quantity of branch switches, use QMJ switches from page 9-58. Class J
fuses are available in time delay construction suitable for motor and transformer loads.

Main Switch or Table 9.144: NQ and NF Lighting Contactors—Mechanically Held


Main Lugs (Furnish a one-line power and control voltage connection diagram.)
Mechanically Held
30/30 @ 240 or 600 V
or 60/60 @ 240 V Ampacity Minimum Additional
100 A twin QMB are 4.5" high Type Box Height Required [8]
6" H @ 240 Volt H (In.)
60 A twin QMB Square D™ Brand PB
Wiring Gutter
6" H @ 600 Volt  30 A 2P PBM10B 18
Maximum
Mounting 100 A twin QMB  60 A 2P PBP10B 18
Space 7.5" H @ 600 Volt  75 A 2P PBN10B 18
for 100 A twin QMJ 100 A 2P PBQ10B 18
Branch 6" H @ 600 Volt 150 A 2P PBR10B 18
Units
200 A QMB 200 A 2P PBV10B 18
9" mounting height, 225 A 2P PBW10B 18
200 Amp twin QMJ  30 A 3P PBM11B 18
7.5" mounting height
 60 A 3P PBP11B 18
400 A QMJ 9" H,  75 A 3P PBN11B 18
400 A Class T 9" H, 100 A 3P PBQ11B 18
400, 600 or 800 A
QMB all require 15" H 150 A 3P PBR11B 18
200 A 3P PBV11B 18
38" 225 A 3P PBW11B 18
ASCO Type 920
 30 A 2P 9202030 18
 60 A 2P 9202060 18
 75 A 2P 9202075 18
100 A 2P 9202100 18
150 A 2P 9202150 18
200 A 2P 9202200 18
225 A 2P 9202225 18
 30 A 3P 9203030 18
 60 A 3P 9203060 18
 75 A 3P 9203075 18
100 A 3P 9203100 18
150 A 3P 9203150 18
200 A 3P 9203200 18
225 A 3P 9203225 18

Table 9.145: NQ and NF Panelboard Split Bus Bars


Maximum Number of
Maximum Ampacity Pole Spaces Available Box Height
MLO (ft.)
Main Split
[9]
18 30
225 A 18 44
30
30
[9]
18 30
56
250 A 18
30
30 62

Table 9.146: I-Line™ Panelboard Split Bus Bars


Additional Mounting Height
Ampacity Required On Split Bus Section [10]
MLO
Split Bus
 225 A  7.5 in.
 400 A  9 in.
 600 A 12 in.
 800 A 12 in.
1200 A 18 in.
NOTE: For applications with main circuit breaker panelboards, contact your local
Schneider Electric representative or distributor.

[8] NF panels require 18 in. of additional box height regardless of contactor ampacity or manufacturer.
[9] When greater than 125 A lugs are required on the split section of the bus, contact your local Schneider Electric representative or distributor for the box height.
[10] For I-Line panelboards, dimension includes height of “SL” sub-feed lug kit from Digest, plus 3 in. from available branch mounting space.
9-60
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Modifications For Factory Assembled Modifications for Factory Assembled
Panelboards Panelboards
schneider-electric.us Class 1640, 1670, 2110, 4620, 6650 / Refer to 2110CT9701, 1640CT0701, 1640CT0801, 4620CT9601

Main Circuit Breaker Without Overload Trip


(Automatic Molded Case Switch)
• (Not UL Listed)
Shunt Trip Circuit Breakers
• NOTE: For molded case switch and automatic molded case switch short circuit current
ratings, see Short Circuit Current Ratings (SCCR), page 7-42.
Special Features
For information on the following special features, please see the Supplemental and
Obsolescence Digest.
• Powerlogic™ metering [1]

PANELBOARDS
• Customer equipment space (NQ and NF) [1]
• Increased box depth [1]
• Increased gutters–top, bottom, and sides [1]
• Non-standard paint [1]
• Welded base channel [1]
• Type 1 gasketed [1]
• Type 2 drip hood [1]
• Type 3R/4/4X/5/12 stainless steel enclosure [1]
• Type 4X fiberglass enclosure [1]
• Stainless steel trim front [1]
• Padlockable hasp [1]
• Special locks (Corbin, Yale, Best) [1]

9
• Equal height boxes [1]
• Common trim to cover two equal height boxes [1]
• Panelboard skirt—hides conduits feeding a panelboard [1]
• Panelboard wireway—for terminating conduit in wireway endwall [1]
• Keyed mechanical interlocking of two or more circuit breakers (I-Line and QMB) [1]
• Motor operators (I-Line only)
• Panelboard interiors and special fronts to fit existing boxes
• A standard panelboard box has one blank endwall and one with knockouts. Blank
endwalls or knockouts in both endwalls are also available [1]

[1] Supported by the Panelboard Product Selector.


9-61
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Panelboards NQ and NF Terminal Data
Class 1640, 1670, / Refer to Catalog 1670CT0701,1640CT0801
schneider-electric.us

NQ and NF Terminal Data


Table 9.147: NQ Standard Aluminum Mechanical Lugs—Main Lugs Table 9.148: NQ Standard Aluminum Mechanical Lugs—Main
Panel Type Ampere Rating Lug Wire Range Circuit Breaker
100 A one #6-2/0 Al or Cu Circuit
Panel Ampere Rating Breaker Lug Wire Range [1]
225 A one #6-350 kcmil Al or Cu Type
NQ Type
one 1/0-750 kcmil or
400 A 100 A QOB one #4–#2/0 Al or Cu
two 1/0-350 kcmil Al or Cu
600 A two 1/0-750 kcmil Al or Cu 150 A HD, HG, HJ, one #14–#3/0 Al or Cu
HL
QB, QD, QG,
225 A QJ one #4-300 kcmil Al or Cu
NQ JD, JG, JJ,
250 A one #3/0–350 kcmil Al or Cu [1]
JL
LA, LH one #1–600 kcmil Al or Cu or
400 A two #1–250 kcmil Al or Cu
600 A LD, LG, LJ, two #4/0-500 kcmil Al or Cu
LL
PANELBOARDS

Table 9.149: NF Standard Mechanical Lugs—Main Lugs Table 9.150: NF Standard Mechanical Lugs—Main Circuit
Panel Type Ampere Rating Lug Wire Range Breaker
125 A one #6–2/0 Al or Cu Circuit Breaker
Panel Type Ampere Rating Type Lug Wire Range [1]
250 A one #6–350 kcmil Al or Cu
NF 400 A one #1/0–750 kcmil or two #1/0–350 kcmil Al or Cu 125 A ED, EG, EJ one #14–#2/0 Al or Cu
600 A two #1/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu 150 A HD, HG, HJ, HL one #14–#3/0 Al or Cu
800 A three #4/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu JD, JG, JJ, JL one #3/0–350 kcmil Al or Cu [1]
250 A
NF DJ one #2–600 Cu or #2–500 Al
LA, LH one #1–600 kcmil or two #1–250
400 A kcmil Al or Cu
600 A LD, LG, LJ, LL, two #4/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu
LR

[1] The lug range shown is for the highest amperage of the circuit breaker frame shown in the table.
9-62
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Terminal Data I-Line™ and QMB
Class 2110, 4620 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701,4620CT9601
schneider-electric.us

Terminal Data
Table 9.151: Standard Mechanical Lugs—Main Lugs Table 9.152: Standard Mechanical Lugs—Main Circuit Breaker
Wire Range Am-
Panel Ampere Panel pere Circuit Breaker Wire Range
Lug Wire Range [1] Wire Bending Space per NEC Lug Wire Range [1] Wire Bending Space per
Type Rating Type Rat- Type
Table 312-6 [1] NEC Table 312-6 [1]
100 A — — ing
225 A one #6–300 kcmil Al or Cu one #6–300 kcmil Al or Cu 100 A FA, FH, FI one #14-1/0 Al or Cu one #14-1/0 Al or Cu
one #2–600 kcmil Al or Cu 150 A HD, HG, HJ, HL one #14-3/0 Al or Cu one #14-3/0 Al or Cu
400 A two #2–600 kcmil Al or Cu two #2–500 kcmil Al or Cu
I-Line one #4-300 kcmil Al or
225 A KI one #4-300 kcmil Al or Cu
600 A two #2–600 kcmil Al or Cu two #2–500 kcmil Al or Cu Cu
800 A (4) 3/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu (3) 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu JD, JG, JJ, JL one #1/0-#4/0 Al or Cu one #1/0-300 kcmil Al or
(4) 3/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu (4) 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu Cu
1200 A 250 A
LX, LXI, LE two #1-350 kcmil Al or
Cu two #1-350 kcmil Al or Cu

PANELBOARDS
I-Line one #1-600 or two #1-
400 A LA, LH one #1-600 kcmil Al or Cu
250 kcmil Al or Cu
LC, LI, LX, LXI, two 4/0-500kcmil Al or
600 A two 4/0-500kcmil Al or Cu
LE Cu
MG, MJ, PG, three 3/0-500 kcmil Al three 3/0-500 kcmil Al or
800 A PJ, PL or Cu Cu
PG, PJ, PL, four 3/0-500 kcmil Al or four 3/0-500 kcmil Al or
1200 RGC, RJC,
A RLC Cu Cu

Table 9.153: Standard Mechanical Lugs—Main Lugs Table 9.154: Standard Mechanical Lugs—Main Switch
Mains Wire Range Mains Wire Range
Panel Panel
Ampere Lug Wire Range [1] Wire Bending Space per NEC Type Ampere Lug Wire Range [1] Wire Bending Space per NEC
Type Rating Table 312-6 [1]
Rating Table 312-6 [1]
225 A one #6–300 kcmil Al or Cu one #6–300 kcmil Al or Cu 200 A #4–300 kcmil Al or Cu one #4–300 kcmil Al or Cu
one #6–300 kcmil Al or Cu 400 A 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu
one #6–300 kcmil Al or Cu and, QMB

9
400 A and, 600 A 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu two 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu
one 3/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu one 3/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu
800 A 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu (3) 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu
600 A two 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu two 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu
QMB (3) 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu or
800 A (4) 3/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu
two 3/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu
(4) 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu or
1200 A (4) 3/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu
(4) 3/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu
1600 A VCEL compression lugs Standard.

Table 9.155: Standard Mechanical Lugs—QMB Branch Switch Units Table 9.156: Standard Mechanical Lugs—QMJ Branch Switch
Panel
Switch Wire Range Units [2]
Ampere Lug Wire Range [1] Wire Bending Space per NEC
Type Switch Wire Range
Rating Table 312-6 [1] Panel Ampere Lug Wire Range [1]
Type Wire Bending Space per NEC
30 A one #14–#2 Al or Cu one #14–#2 Al or Cu Rating Table 312-6 [1]
60 A one #14–#2 Al or Cu one #14–#2 Al or Cu 30 A one #14–#2 Al or Cu one #14–#2 Al or Cu
100 A one #14–1/0 Al or Cu one #14–1/0 Al or Cu 60 A one #14–#2 Al or Cu one #14–#2 Al or Cu
QMB 200 A one #4–300 kcmil Al or Cu one #4–300 kcmil Al or Cu 100 A one #14–1/0 Al or Cu one #14–1/0 Al or Cu
400 A two 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu two 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu one #6–300 kcmil Al or
600 A two 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu two 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu QMJ 200 A Cu one #6–300 kcmil Al or Cu
800 A (3) 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu (3) 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu one 1/0–750 kcmil Al or
400 A one 1/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu
Cu
two 3/0–600 kcmil Al or
600 A two 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu
Cu

[1] (#) = Number of conductors per phase.


[2] Use only 90 oC insulated conductors based on an ampacity of 75 oC conductors.
9-63
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Merchandised Panelboards NQ Merchandised Accessories
Class 1640
schneider-electric.us

NQ Merchandised Accessories
Table 9.157: NQ SurgeLogic SurgeLoc Plug-on SPD [1][2]
Voltage Part Number Poles Occupied
80 kA SSP01BIA08PBQ1
100 kA SSP01BIA10PBQ1
120 kA SSP01BIA12PBQ1
120 / 240 V 12
160 kA SSP01BIA16PBQ1
9

200 kA SSP01BIA20PBQ1
240 kA SSP01BIA24PBQ1
80 kA SSP02BIA08PBQ1
100 kA SSP02BIA10PBQ1
120 kA SSP02BIA12PBQ1
208 Y / 120 V 12
160 kA SSP02BIA16PBQ1
200 kA SSP02BIA20PBQ1
240 kA SSP02BIA24PBQ1
80 kA SSP03BIA08PBQ1
PANELBOARDS

100 kA SSP03BIA10PBQ1
120 kA SSP03BIA12PBQ1
240 / 120 HLD 12
160 kA SSP03BIA16PBQ1
200 kA SSP03BIA20PBQ1
240 kA SSP03BIA24PBQ1

[1] When selecting a panelboard with SurgeLoc SPD, an additional 12 circuit positions (6 adjacent mounting spaces per side) are occupied. For example, if the desired number of circuits is 30,
refer to page 9-15 and page 9-16 to select the NQ442L2/NQ442L2C interior and corresponding Box and Trim.
[2] SPD is only available up to 72 desired circuit counts.
9-64
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents

Section 10
Power Solutions Integrated Equipment
Power Solutions Integrated Equipment 10-2

Power Solutions Integrated Equipment Overview 10-2


Modular Panelboard System and Integrated Power Center 10-3
Modular Panelboard System 10-3
Integrated Power Center 10-4
Integrated Power Center 2 (IPC2™) 10-4

Standby Power Connection Solutions 10-4


Submetering Integrated Power Center 10-5
Integrated Power Center 2 10-5
Integrated Power Center 2 Transformer Combo 10-6

POWER SOLUTIONS INTEGRATED


MPS

10 EQUIPMENT
IP C

IP C2

© 2017 Schneider Electric


All Rights Reserved 10-1

11/10/2017
Power Solutions Integrated Equipment NQ Merchandised Accessories
Class 2200 / Refer to Documents 2230DB0601, and 2735CT0001
schneider-electric.us

Power Solutions Integrated Equipment Overview


For over 30 years, the Schneider Electric Power Solutions business has been providing
integrated equipment solutions for retail construction, commercial, and industrial
projects. The Square D™ brand family of integrated equipment combines electrical
distribution, building controls, and automation into a single, factory-assembled and pre-
wired enclosure/lineup. Our innovative, cost-effective, integrated solutions save valuable
floor space, shorten construction cycle times, and reduce installation and material
handling costs.
Modular Panelboard System—Pre-Engineered Solution
The Modular Panelboard System (MPS) is tailored to customer specifications and may
include panels and lighting control equipment. Special Powerlink™ lighting control and
column-width panel interiors are available. Additional options include power and control
cable wiring, contactors, terminal blocks, surge protective devices (SPDs), equipment
spaces, and power metering/monitoring solutions. Seismically qualified MPS sections
are also available.
Tailored to customer specifications, MPS sections are:
• 86 in. (2184 mm) high,
• 9.5 in. (241 mm) deep, and
10

• vary in width depending on customer specifications


Integrated Power Center—Custom-Designed Solution
POWER SOLUTIONS INTEGRATED

For more complex applications, the Integrated Power Center (IPC) allows for the
integration of a variety of components, including electrical distribution equipment, HVAC
controls, lighting controls, power quality and power conditioning products, SPDs, building
management systems and power metering/monitoring solutions. As with all Power
Solutions Integrated Equipment products, the IPC is designed to meet applicable codes
EQUIPMENT

and standards and is available as seismically qualified. Factory-assembled, pre-wired


(based on shipping splits), and tested in a controlled environment, IPC sections are:
• 84 in. (2134 mm) high,
• 10.5 in. (267 mm) deep, and
• vary in width depending on customer specifications
Standby Power Connection Solutions—UL Listed
The new family of Standby Power Connection Solutions are designed, tested,
manufactured and listed to the UL standards providing you with a reliable solution to
quickly and safely connect to a portable generator for standby power. The SPQ cam-lock
(SPQCL) tap box design incorporates cam-lock receptacles for generator connection
and the capabilities to be wired back to the standby power disconnect in the electrical
distribution equipment. The SPQ lug-lug (SPQTB) tap box provides the capabilities to
connect to a portable generator and the generator breaker cables using mechanical lugs
in lieu of the cam-lock connectors.
The SPQ Cam-Lock Box is: The SPQ Lug-Lug Box is:
• 36 in. (915 mm) high • 36 in. (915 mm) high
• 30 in. (762 mm) wide • 30 in. (762 mm) wide
• 16 in. (407 mm) deep • 13 in. (330 mm) deep

Submetering Integrated Power Center


The Submetering Integrated Power Center (IPC) is an ideal solution for multi-tenant or
departmental metering applications within office towers, condominiums, apartment
buildings, shopping centers, and other multi-user environments. The Submetering IPC
combines the panel with breakers, the PowerLogic EM4800 multi-circuit energy meter
and the associated CTs in a factory-assembled and pre-wired solution saving significant
space and on-site installation time. Submetering IPC sections are:
• 10.5 in. (267 mm) deep, and
• vary in width and height depending on the application
Integrated Power Center 2
The newest addition to the family of Integrated Equipment products, the Integrated
Power Center 2 (IPC2™) provides maximum flexibility to meet customers' specifications.
Features include those found in the IPC and are provided in a free-standing enclosure
that can be front and rear aligned when transformers are included. The IPC2 family is
available as seismically-qualified. Enclosure options include NEMA 1, NEMA 1 with
driphood and NEMA 3R. IPC2 sections are:
• 91.5 in. (2324 mm) high, and
• vary in width and depth depending on customer specifications

10-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Merchandised Accessories Modular Panelboard System and Integrated
Power Center
schneider-electric.us Class 2210, 2220 / Refer to Document 2735CT0001
Integrated Power Center 2 Transformer Combo
Ideally suited for projects having both 480Y/277V and 208Y/120V requirements.
Available as a stand-alone solution or can be incorporated into an MPS, IPC or IPC2
lineup. The standard 42" wide x 24" deep footprint will decrease space requirements by
40% or more. A typical IPC2 Transformer Combo includes two panels in the upper cells
and a transformer in the bottom cell. Other upper cell options include contactors,
individually mounted circuit breakers, ATS's, equipment spaces and power metering/
monitoring solutions. The IPC2 Transformer Combo is available as seismically qualified.
Enclosure options include NEMA 1, NEMA 1 with driphood and NEMA 3R. IPC2
Transformer Combo sections are:
• 91.5 in. (2324 mm) high, and
• vary in width and depth depending on the transformer kVA
Additional savings are realized on installation, material costs and material handling, as
shown in the table below.
Table 10.1: IPC2 Transformer Combo—Estimated Savings [1]
Stick-Built Transformer Combo Savings Realized
Estimated Installation
26–32 3–6 23–26
Hours
Associated pipe, wire and Associated pipe, wire and
Materials fittings — fittings

POWER SOLUTIONS INTEGRATED


No. of Pieces Handled 20–30 1 19–29
The IPC2 Transformer Combo has been recognized by the electrical industry by winning
the following awards:
• 2006 INNOVATION Award given by the Electrical Contracting Products magazine

EQUIPMENT
• 2006 Product of the Year Gold Medal Award given by the Consulting/Specifying
Engineer magazine

Modular Panelboard System


The pre-engineered Modular Panelboard System (MPS) bundles electrical distribution
equipment into a single factory-assembled and wired integrated system. This approach
replaces the traditional method of independently mounting each panelboard and lighting
control system. MPS allows for the integration of a variety of components including:
• Panelboards: I-Line, NF, NQ, and Column-width
• Surge Suppression: SPD integral to panel and/or separately mounted
• Lighting Controls: Powerlink™ or lighting contactors
• Monitoring/Metering: Powerlogic™ power meters, circuit monitors, branch circuit

10
monitoring, and system display meters
Equipment spaces including factory-installed lighting contactors are available in three
configurations:
1. Unwired: Mounted in cell only
2. Line side wired: Line side of each pole is wired to a branch circuit breaker
3. Fully wired: Line side of each pole is wired to a branch circuit breaker, load side of
each pole is wired to a terminal block
Built on a panelboard platform, Modular Panelboard System sections are NEMA 1-rated
and meet the requirements of UL 67. Individual MPS configurations include panel
sections in full-height, stacked or side-by-side arrangements. Individual sections
measure:
• 86 in. (2184 mm) high
Modular Panelboard System • 10–44 in. (254–1118 mm) wide
• 9.5 in. (241 mm) deep
Typical applications for MPS equipment include:
• Restaurants / Food service
• Office buildings / Public buildings
• Warehouses
• Schools / Universities

MPS Interior

[1] Based on an NF 480 V panel, 75 kVA transformer, NQ 240 V panel installation.


10-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Integrated Power Center 2 (IPC2™) NQ Merchandised Accessories
Class 2230 / Refer to Document 2230DB0601
schneider-electric.us

Integrated Power Center


The custom-designed Integrated Power Center (IPC) combines electrical distribution
equipment and building management controls into a single factory-assembled and wired
integrated system. IPC has much greater design flexibility for producing a fully
customized solution integrating a variety of distribution and control components,
including:
• Panelboards: I-Line, NF, NQ, and Column-width
• Surge Suppression: SPD integral to panel and/or separately mounted
• Lighting Controls: Powerlink™ or lighting contactors
• Monitoring/Metering: Powerlogic™ power meters, circuit monitors, branch circuit
monitoring, and system display meters
• Power quality and power conditioning
• Building automation
• HVAC controls
Equipment spaces including factory-installed lighting contactors are available in three
configurations:
1. Unwired: Mounted in cell only
2. Line side wired: Line side of each pole is wired to a branch circuit breaker
Integrated Power Center
3. Fully wired: Line side of each pole is wired to a branch circuit breaker, load side of
each pole is wired to a terminal block
Integrated Power Centers are NEMA 1 rated and meet the requirements of UL 891. As
with all integrated solutions, IPCs are shipped to the site fully assembled, completely
pre-tested and ready-to-install. Individual IPC configurations include panel sections in full
height, stacked, or side-by-side arrangements. IPC sections measure:
• 84 in. (2134 mm) High
• 10.25 (260 mm) Deep
• Widths vary, depending upon customer specifications
Typical applications for IPC equipment include:
• Retail stores / Grocery stores
IPC Interior • Office buildings / Public buildings
• Shopping malls / Strip malls
• Schools/Universities
• Restaurants / Food service
• Hotels/Motels
• Warehouses
• Equipment rooms
MPS and IPC Layout, Lead Time, and Pricing
Contact your local Schneider Electric representative or distributor.
MPS and IPC Shipping
MPS and IPC lineups are shipped factory-assembled and pre-wired. Customers may
specify single- or multiple-section shipping splits (some limitations apply). In addition,
lineups may be ordered with or without factory-installed power cables.
Standby Power Connection Solutions
The Standby Power Quick-Connect (SPQ) Tap Box provides a reliable solution to quickly
and safely connect to a portable standby power generator. Two versions of the SPQ Tap
Box have been designed and tested to the required UL standard and offer a wider range
of solutions for our customers. All SPQ Tap Boxes are NEMA 3R-rated.
SPQ Cam-Lock Tap Box
• UL listed - UL 1008 SB • SPQCL204RS – 400 A, 208Y/120 V
• NEMA Type 3R enclosure 3-phase, 4-wire + ground wire
(can be used for NEMA Type 1 installations)
• SPQCL404RS – 400 A, 480Y/277 V
• Lockable door for safety and control access 3-phase, 4-wire + ground wire

• Mechanical lugs to standby power disconnect • SPQCL206RS – 600 A, 208Y/120 V


3-phase, 4-wire + ground wire
• Color-coded cam-lock connectors for generator connection
• SPQCL406RS – 600 A, 480Y/277 V
• Hinged bottom access door for cam-lock connection 3-phase, 4-wire + ground wire
• Barriers over mechanical lugs for safety

• Application:
– 400 A and 600 A available
– 240 V and 480 V versions available
– Three-phase + neutral + ground

SPQ Cam-Lock Tap Box

10-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Merchandised Accessories Integrated Power Center 2 (IPC2™)
Class 2230 / Refer to Document 2230DB0601
schneider-electric.us

SPQ Lug-Lug Tap Box


• UL listed—UL 1773 (cUL listed also) • SPQTB604RS – 400 A, 600 V max.
3-phase, 4-wire + ground wire
• NEMA Type 3R enclosure
(can be used for NEMA Type 1 installations) • SPQTB608RS – 800 A, 600 V max.
3-phase, 4-wire + ground wire
• Lockable door for safety and control access
• Mechanical lugs to standby power disconnect
• Generator connection lugs rated for Type W cable
• Application:
– 400 A and 800 A available
– 600 V maximum
– Three-phase + neutral + ground

SPQ Lug-Lug Tap Box

POWER SOLUTIONS INTEGRATED


Submetering Integrated Power Center
The Submetering Integrated Power Center (IPC) is an ideal solution for multi-tenant or
departmental metering applications. It combines the ability to meter multiple feeder
breakers inside a pre-wired enclosure. The Submetering IPC offers significant space and
labor savings by replacing individually enclosed, mounted, and wired panels and

EQUIPMENT
metering components and providing an integrated solution in one enclosure/lineup
including:
• Panelboards
• PowerLogic™ EM4800 Multi-Circuit Energy Meters and associated CTs
• Surge Suppression
• Factory-installed wiring between components
Submetering IPC width and height dimensions vary depending on the application.
All sections are 10.5 in. (266.7 mm) deep.
Typical applications for Submetering IPC equipment include:

10
• Office towers • Other multi-user environments
• Condominiums • Configurations with 2-PowerLogic EM4800 meters plus Ethernet switch
• Apartment buildings when required based on the number of metered points

• Shopping centers

Submetering Integrated Power Center

Integrated Power Center 2


The Integrated Power Center 2 (IPC2™) provides maximum design flexibility. In addition
to the features found in the Integrated Power Center (IPC), IPC2 lineups are free-
standing enclosures that can be front and rear-aligned. IPC2 has the ability to
incorporate:
• Panelboards: I-Line, NF, and NQ
• Transformers: 300 kVA(max)
– K-rated also available; may limit max kVA size of transformer
• Individually mounted circuit breakers
• Surge Suppression: SPD integral to panel and/or separately mounted
• Automatic Transfer Switch: Open type 400 A 3-pole maximum including a variety
of options
• Lighting Controls: Powerlink™ or lighting contactors
• PowerLogic™ Monitoring / Metering: power meters, circuit monitors, branch circuit
monitoring, and system display meters
• Building Management Systems
As a stand-alone solution, the IPC2 family provides the flexibility to enter and/or exit the
Integrated Power Center 2 section from either the top or bottom. IPC2 is offered in a variety of widths and depths:
• 24–48 in. (610–1219 mm) Wide
• 24–36 in. (610–915 mm) Deep
Typical applications for IPC2 equipment include:

• Schools/Universities • Casinos
• Office buildings • Hotels
• Data centers • Any project with panels and transformers
• Industrial facilities

ICP2 Layout, Lead Time, and Pricing


Contact your local Schneider Electric representative or distributor.

10-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Integrated Power Center 2 (IPC2™) NQ Merchandised Accessories
Class 2230 / Refer to Document 2230DB0601
schneider-electric.us

IPC2 Shipping
IPC2 lineups are shipped fully assembled and ready-to-install. Customers may specify
single- or multiple-section shipping splits (some limitations apply). In addition, lineups
may be ordered with or without factory-installed power cables.
Integrated Power Center 2 Transformer Combo
For projects having both 480Y/277 V and 208Y/120 V requirements, the Integrated
Power Center 2 (IPC2) Transformer Combo is the perfect solution. One of the most
popular members of the IPC2 product family, the IPC2 Transformer Combo has been
recognized by the industry multiple times for its innovative design.
As a stand-alone solution, the IPC2 Transformer Combo is appropriate when
panelboards and transformers are installed in close proximity to each other. It provides
the flexibility to enter and/or exit the section from either the top or the bottom. Catalog
numbers have been created for some of the more typical configurations.
All IPC2 sections can be close-coupled to QED switchboard, MPS, and IPC products.
Enclosure options for IPC2 include NEMA 1, NEMA 1 with driphood, and NEMA 3R-
rated, and all meet the requirements of UL 891. These sections are also seismically
qualified to meet IBC and ASCE7 requirements.

IPC2 Transformer Combo

10-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents

Section 11
Switchboards and Switchgear
Power-Style™ Switchboards 11-2

Power-Style QED-2 Switchboards (UL Listed) 11-2


Power-Style QED-6 Switchboards (UL Listed) 11-3
Power-Style Commercial Multi-Metering Switchboards (UL Listed) 11-5
Speed-D™ Switchboards 11-6

Speed-D SB/SF Switchboards (UL Listed) 11-6


Low Voltage Switchgear 11-9

Power-Zone™ 4 Low Voltage Switchgear with Masterpact™ Circuit


Breakers 11-9
QED-2 S witchboa rd Power-Zone™ 4 Arc Resistant Switchgear with ArcBlok
Technology 11-10
Micrologic™ Trip Units 11-10
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed Switchgear 11-11

MiniBreak™ Compact Height Switches— 5.5 kV, 200 A 11-11


HVL/cb Vacuum Circuit Breaker Switchgear—5-15 kV, 1200 A 11-13
Premset Compact Vacuum Circuit Breaker Switchgear with Shielded
Solid Insulation System (2SIS) 11-15
HVL/cc Metal-Enclosed Load Interrupter Switchgear—Full Range 11-16
HVL/cc Switchgear Quick Ship Program—5–15 kV, 600 A 11-18

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


HVL Metal-Enclosed Load Interrupter Switchgear—Full Range 11-23
HVL Switchgear Quick Ship Program—5 kV–15 kV, 600 A 11-24
HVL Switches for Power-Dry II ™, Power-Cast II ™, and Uni-Cast II ™
Me ta lcla d a nd HVL/cc S witchge a r Transformer Connections 11-25
Square D™ Brand DIN/E Fuse Selection Tables—HVL 11-27
Boric Acid Fuse Selection Tables—HVL 11-28
Medium Voltage Gas-Insulated Switchgear 11-29

GHA Gas-Insulated Switchgear (UL Listed) 11-29


CBGS-0 Gas-Insulated Switchgear (UL Listed) 11-30
DVCAS Switchgear for Wind Farm Applications 11-31
Medium Voltage Metal-Clad Switchgear 11-33

Masterclad™ Medium Voltage Metalclad Switchgear (UL Listed) 11-33

11
Active, Arc-Resistant Arc Terminator™ Arc Extinguishing System 11-34
Passive, Arc-Resistant Masterclad™ Medium Voltage Switchgear 11-34
Unit S ubs ta tion
Unit Substations 11-35

Power-Zone Load Center Unit Substations 11-35


Power-Zone Model III Package Unit Substations 11-35
MV Controllers 11-38

Motorpact™ Medium Voltage Motor Controllers (UL Listed) 11-38


Substation Circuit Breakers 11-39

Vacuum Substation Circuit Breakers—Type VOX (Not UL Listed) 11-39


Medium Voltage Overhead Distribution 11-40

Automatic Circuit Recloser 11-40


Load Break Switch/Sectionalizer 11-40
Mode l III P a cka ge Unit S ubs ta tion ADVC Controller 11-41

© 2017 Schneider Electric


All Rights Reserved 11-1

11/10/2017
Power-Style™ Switchboards QED-2 (UL Listed)
Classes 2741, 2742 / Refer to Catalog 2700CT1101
schneider-electric.us

Power-Style QED-2 Switchboards (UL Listed)


For solutions that bring people, products, and information together, Square D™ brand
Power-Style QED-2 low voltage switchboards from Schneider Electric are built to last
and feature design innovations that make these products easier to install and maintain.
Supported by one of the largest distributor, sales, and service organizations in the
industry, QED-2 switchboards are readily available to meet the needs of contractors,
consultants, and end-users.
Q = Quality—Built to Last
As one of the most trusted names in electrical distribution, Square D™ brand QED-2
switchboards are designed with the highest standards of quality. From sturdy frames,
securely fastened thread-forming screws, and standard bolted, base channels, users will
see the difference during installation, operation, maintenance, and expansion projects.
E = Efficient and Innovative Designs
In 2010, Schneider Electric launched QED-2, Series 2 switchboard designs. Series 2
designs represent the next generation of our QED-2 switchboard offering, with new
features based on extensive customer feedback. From improved branch neutral and
ground bar access, to enhanced instrument compartments, Series 2 designs provide
easier access for performing equipment installation and maintenance procedures.
QED-2 switchboards feature Schneider Electric's unique I-Line™ plug-on connections in
group-mounted construction. With the I-Line design, a screwdriver is the only tool
required to firmly ratchet the line end of a molded-case circuit breaker directly onto the I-
Line bus assembly. This plug-on design allows quick installation and mounting flexibility
of circuit breakers up to 1200 A.
D = Delivery—Ready When You Are
To meet tight project schedules and budgets, our Square D™ brand QED-2 switchboard
offering brings together standard designs for the most frequently requested ratings and
options, providing immediate pricing for quick shipments from 11 to 30 business days.
QED-2 Switchboard

Features
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR

• QED-2 Switchboards are designed, listed, and built to UL 891


• Switchboard ratings through 6000 A, 200 kA; higher amperages available
• Front accessible load connections
• Front and rear alignment standard
• Cable, busway, transformer, or remote QED switchboard incoming fed
• Hot or cold sequence utility metering
• Thermal-magnetic, PowerPact™ electronic, or Masterpact™ NW stored energy fixed
or drawout circuit breakers used as mains and feeders
• Group-mounted circuit breaker and fusible switch mains and feeders
• Fixed-mounted fusible switch mains and feeders
• Powerlogic customer metering, including option for custom communications capability
and interwiring
• Networked communications capabilities provide direct access to energy management
at main and feeder level
• Internally-mounted Surgelogic™ surge protective devices
• Quick Connect Generator option available
• Main devices in six sub-division or single main configurations
• Main and branch devices in single section configuration
• Multiple individual devices in single section configurations
• Custom engineering, including main-tie-mains, multiple sets of thru-bus, reduced
heights, and engineered houses

Additional Information:
See Table 9.99 Circuit Breaker / Sub-feed Lug Kit Mounting Space
Requirement, page 9-42 for circuit breaker mounting height
requirements.
Where Utility compartments are required, contact your local Schneider
Electric representative.

11-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QED-6 (UL Listed) Power-Style™ Switchboards
Class 2746 / Refer to Catalog 2746CT0101
schneider-electric.us

Power-Style QED-6 Switchboards (UL Listed)


Masterpact™ NW and NT, and PowerPact™ H and J Circuit Breakers
The QED-6 switchboard is designed to provide excellent distribution, protection, and
power quality management in commercial electrical equipment. The circuit protection
components of the switchboard are the Masterpact NW circuit breakers in 800–6000 A
frame sizes, Masterpact NT circuit breakers in 800–1200 A frame sizes, and PowerPact
H and J circuit breakers in 150–250 A frame sizes. These circuit breakers deliver
maximum system uptime, system selectivity, ease of maintenance, and reliable circuit
protection.
QED-6 switchboard features include: Masterpact NW UL 489 Listed circuit breakers for
main and feeder devices, Masterpact NT UL 489 Listed circuit breakers for feeder
devices, PowerPact H and J UL 489 Listed circuit breakers for feeder devices, and a
wide range of designs and options. Highly flexible drawout/plug-in circuit breakers can
meet a wide variety of power distribution requirements. Choices include plug-in or
drawout construction in PowerPact H and J circuit breakers, and optional prepared
drawout or plug-in spaces that are equipped with all specified control functions. This
capability allows quick additions for load upgrades.
• QED-6 switchboards are designed, listed, and built to UL 891; Masterpact and
PowerPact circuit breakers are designed, listed, and built to UL 489
• Circuit breakers are individually mounted, rear connected; Masterpact NW and NT
circuit breakers are drawout; PowerPact H and J breakers are plug-in as standard,
drawout as an option
• Family of field installable and upgradeable Micrologic™ trip units with optional
Powerlogic™ data communications features
• Switchboard ratings up to 150 kA short-circuit current rating for services 1600–6000 A
at 480 V and 100 kA at 600 V
• Up to (12) 250 A PowerPact H and J circuit breakers in a single 30-inch wide section
• Up to (8) 1200 A frame Masterpact NT circuit breakers in a single 30-inch wide section
• Flexible branch circuit breaker locations: Masterpact NW and NT and PowerPact H

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


QED-6 Switchboard and J circuit breakers can be mixed in a single 30-inch wide section (15–2000 A)
(Class 2746)
• Compartmentalization:
cabling
separate compartments for circuit breakers, bussing, and load

• Available in 54-, 60-, 72-, and 80-inch deep construction


• Available in NEMA 3R outdoor walk-in enclosures
• Masterpact and PowerPact circuit breakers are field maintainable
QED-6 switchboards are reliable power protection equipment when working with
Table 11.1: Circuit Breaker Selection telecommunication facilities, e-business servers, or mainframes that perform critical
Rating (A) (Frame) Circuit Breakers business transactions. These types of facilities cannot afford downtime.
150–250 PowerPact H, J
800–1200 Masterpact NT QED-6 rear-connected switchboards are designed as standalone switchboards or as an
800–6000 Masterpact NW
integral part of the low voltage equipment lineup in a user’s power unit substation.

Specify QED-6 Switchboards


When drawout construction is required for quick circuit breaker changeout; system
requirements call for circuit breakers to close within five cycles; stored energy circuit

11
breakers are required; front access to control wires is desired; ease of installation,
maintenance, and upgrade of circuit breaker compartmentalization is required; system
integrity and segregation of circuit breaker compartments from bus and cable
compartments is required; equipment isolation is required.
Benefits/Values of Circuit Breaker Performance
Masterpact NW and NT circuit breakers are designed to provide maximum protection and
reliable operation with a long service life. They exceed all UL 489 endurance testing
requirements and are certified to a minimum of 10,000 operations through the 3000 A
frame.

11-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power-Style™ Switchboards QED-6 (UL Listed)
Class 2746 / Refer to Catalog 2746CT0101
schneider-electric.us

System Coordination
Short-time ratings are high, giving users excellent system coordination and selectivity
with downstream breakers.
High Short-Circuit Current Ratings (SCCR)
Up to 200 k AIR at 240 V, 150 k AIR at 480 V, and 100 k AIR at 600 V, which allows
customers to design systems with high fault current and paralleling schemes.
Arc Flash Limiting (LF) Feeder Breakers
High speed operation of Masterpact NW and NT circuit breakers (150 k AIR at 480 V)
helps reduce arc flash incident energy (cal/cm2) on downstream equipment.
Ease of Installation and Maintenance
Thru-the-door construction, an easy to operate drawout mechanism, and front access to
all control wiring make this equipment easy to install, maintain, and upgrade. Load
connections in the cable compartment are easily accessible in the rear of the
switchboard. Remote racking of the Masterpact NW circuit breaker is also available with
the optional remote racking tool, which, if required, is field installable.
Ability to Upgrade
UL Listed, field-installable accessories include: motor operators, shunt trips, under
voltage devices, trip units, and communication modules for trip units. Manually operated
circuit breakers are field convertible to electrical operation.
Open Communication System
The Micrologic trip units in Masterpact NW and NT circuit breakers use the Ethernet
TCP/IP or Modbus™ serial protocol. These are widely accepted protocols which allow
QED-6 to be integrated into new or many existing communication systems.
Adaptable
Drawout and bolt-in circuit breakers, front access control wiring, and expandable lineups
are quickly adaptable to changing load and control requirements.
11

Expandable
Masterpact NW and NT circuit breakers have many control termination points, giving the
equipment extensive flexibility and expandability for sophisticated control schemes.
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR

11-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
CMM (UL Listed) Power-Style™ Switchboards
Classes 2755, 2756 / Refer to Catalogs 2755CT9501, 2756CT9601
schneider-electric.us

Power-Style Commercial Multi-Metering Switchboards (UL Listed)


• Designed, built, and listed to UL 891
• Lever bypass and EUSERC non-lever bypass
• Hot or cold sequence metering—EUSERC, NEMA, LOCAL
• Front and rear alignment standard
• Switchboard ratings through 4000 A, 100 kA
• Meter sections in either three- or six-socket section configuration
• Tenant mains either circuit breaker or fusible
• 60–200 A without lever bypass with self-contained meter sockets, 5- or 7-jaw, ring type
and test block where required
• 60–200 A lever bypass with self-contained meter sockets, 7-jaw, ringless
• Factory-installed devices with completely wired from meter socket to disconnect
• Provisions for adding future tenants available, as well as future sections
• Sections in either NEMA 1 or NEMA 3R construction
• For use on 120/240 V, 120/208 V, and 277/480 V systems
• Integrated, front-accessible wireway for top exiting load cables
• Customer access area for top exiting load cables

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


11
Lever Bypass EUSERC
Class 2755 Class 2756

11-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Speed-D™ Switchboards Speed-D SB/SF (UL Listed)
Class 2710 / Refer to Catalog 2700CT1101
schneider-electric.us

Speed-D SB/SF Switchboards (UL Listed)


• UL Listed
• Hot sequence utility compartment per EUSERC requirements
• Two types:
– Utility–Service disconnect–distribution
– Utility–Up to six service disconnects

• Single service disconnect, either circuit breaker or fusible rated 400, 600, or 800 A with
either type of distribution interiors, NQ up to 240 Vac, I-Line™ through 480 Vac
• Six service disconnects, group-mounted fusible, QMB/QMJ,
30–400 A; utility compartment—400, 600, and 800 A
• Meter doors can be 15 inches high with one meter socket and test block, or 30 inches
high with two meter sockets and test block
• Meter sockets can be 6-, 8-, 13-, or 15-jaw meter sockets with test block, based on
application
• Accessories include:
– Underground pull sections with and without lug landing
– Loadside wireway
– Bus links for donut-type current transformers
– Double padlock hasp attachments
EUSERC UCT EUSERC UCT – Plug-on distribution panel
Single Main Circuit Breaker with Fusible Multiple Mains
I-Line Distribution Panel – Subfeed circuit breakers
• Full height add-on I-Line distribution section
• Stand-alone I-Line distribution section
Application
11

Suitable for use as service entrance equipment on ac systems. Sections contain


metering compartment, barriers, main disconnects, distribution panel, neutral bus, and
grounding provisions.
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR

Metering
C/T compartment with two 15-inch blank meter doors. (Order doors with meter socket
from Table 11.6 Meter Door Selection, page 11-8.) Incoming cable lugs are for top feed
with one twin conductor 2 AWG–600 kcmil lug per phase and neutral, suitable for
aluminum or copper cables. Optional single conductor lug is available. Refer to Table
11.7 Accessories, page 11-8.
Mains
Main circuit breaker types are either LH or MJ. Main fusible device is supplied with Class
T fuses. Multiple main devices use plug-on fusible switches.
Branches
NQ distribution bus is rated 400 A and provides mounting space for QO™/QOB Type
(150 A maximum) circuit breakers. Panel provides space for mounting 42 single pole
circuit breakers. One or two individually mounted 225 A maximum circuit breakers can
be added with bus connectors. (Order subfeed circuit breakers from Table 11.8 Subfeed
Circuit Breakers (Series E4) , page 11-8.)
I-Line™ distribution bus is rated 400, 600, or 800 A and will accept 27 inches of I-Line
circuit breakers on the left side with a maximum frame size of “J” . The right side will
accept either a QO plug-on distribution panel (240 V only) or LA or LH I-Line circuit
breaker.
Enclosure
Totally enclosed front accessible with ANSI 49 gray baked enamel finish. Dimensions are
90 in. (H) x 36 in. (W) x 14 in. (D) for indoor and 90 in. (H) x 36 in. (W) x 24.5 in. (D) for
outdoor enclosures.

11-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Speed-D SB/SF (UL Listed) Speed-D™ Switchboards
Class 2710 / Refer to Catalog 2700CT1101
schneider-electric.us

EUSERC Utility Metering, Main Disconnects and Distribution Panel


(UL Listed)
Table 11.2: Single Main Circuit Breaker with Distribution (Series E4)
Mains Circuit Breaker Catalog No.
Service Distribution SCCR SCCR
System Ratings
Voltage (A) Interior 240 V Max. 480 V Max. Indoor Outdoor
NQ 65 — SB124QS SB124QR
400 I-Line 65 — SB124IS SB124IR
1Ø3W 120/240 None 65 — SB124WS SB124WR
I-Line 65 — SB126IS SB126IR
600
None 65 — SB126WS SB126WR
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 400 NQ 65 — SB324QS SB324QR
240/120
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 400 None 65 — SB324WS SB324WR
240/120
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 400 I-Line 65 35 SB344IS SB344IR
480Y/277
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 400 None 65 35 SB344WS SB344WR
480Y/277
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 600 I-Line 65 50 SB346IS SB346IR
480Y/277
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 600 None 65 65 SB346WS SB346WR
480Y/277
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 800 I-Line 65 50 SB348IS SB348IR
480Y/277
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 800 None 65 65 SB348WS SB348WR
480Y/277

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


Table 11.3: Single Main Fusible Disconnect with Distribution (Series E4)
Mains SCCR SCCR Fusible Disconnect Catalog No.
Service Distribution
System Voltage Ratings 240 V 480 V
(A) Interior Max. Max. Indoor Outdoor
NQ  65 — SF124QS SF124QR
400 I-Line 100 — SF124IS SF124IR
1Ø3W 120/240 None 200 — SF124WS SF124WR
I-Line 100 — SF126IS SF126IR
600
None 200 — SF126WS SF126WR
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 400 NQ  65 — SF324QS SF324QR
240/120
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 400 None 200 — SF324WS SF324WR
240/120
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 400 I-Line 100  65 SF344IS SF344IR
480Y/277
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 400 None 200 200 SF344WS SF344WR
480Y/277
208Y/120

11
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 600 I-Line 100  65 SF346IS SF346IR
480Y/277
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 600 None 200 200 SF346WS SF346WR
480Y/277
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 800 I-Line 100  65 SF348IS SF348IR
480Y/277
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 800 None 200 200 SF348WS SF348WR
480Y/277

Table 11.4: Multiple Mains—Fusible (Series E4)


Mains 240 V Multiple Mains (6) Fusible Catalog No. [3]
Service or
System Rating
Voltage 480 V Indoor Outdoor
(A)
Max. [2]
1Ø3W 120/240 400 200 SF124FS SF124FR
1Ø3W 120/240 600 200 SF126FS SF126FR
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 400 200 SF344FS SF344FR
408Y/277
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 600 200 SF346FS SF346FR
480Y/277
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 800 200 SF348FS SF348FR
480Y/277

[1] Can be used on 3Ø3W Delta voltage systems (for example, 240 V Delta or 480 V Delta).
[2] QMB/QMJ fusible switches, maximum 400 A, SCCR based on Class J, R, or T fuses. QMB plug-in circuit breaker rating is equal to the lowest rating of the circuit breaker.
[3] Multiple mains—provisions for mounting 30 inches of fusible devices. No more than six main devices permitted per NEC.
11-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Speed-D™ Switchboards Merchandised, Service Selection
Class 2710 / Refer to Catalog 2700CT1101
schneider-electric.us

Table 11.5: I-Line™ Distribution Section (Series E4)


Mains SCCR SCCR Catalog No.
Service Distribution
System Voltage Ratings 240 V 480 V Distribution Type
(A) Interior Max. Max. Indoor Outdoor
208Y/120 Add-on distribution section, must be connected to an SB UCT and main
3Ø4W 240/120 800 I-Line  65 k  65 k section without distribution panel, such as SB348WS. An I-Line plug-on SBAD800 SBAD800R
480Y/277 subfeed lug kit must be ordered to terminate the distribution section.
208Y/120 Stand-alone distribution section not connected to an SB section. A back-fed
3Ø4W 240/120 800 I-Line 125 k 100 k main circuit breaker or I-Line plug-on subfeed lug kit must be ordered to SBSAD800 SBSAD800R
480Y/277 terminate the distribution section. (Non-ULSE)

Table 11.6: Meter Door Selection


Meter 15-inch High Door With One Meter 30-inch High Door With Two Meter
Socket Socket and Test Block Sockets and Test Blocks
Jaws Catalog No. Catalog No.
6 [4] SBA15D6MS —
8 SBA15D8MS —
13 SBA15D13MS SBA30D13MS
15 SBA15D15MS SBA30D15MS
Blank SBA15DBC —
[5] SBA15DMS —
NOTE: To order structure with meter door factory-installed, add door catalog number as suffix to structure (for example, SF344IS-15D13MS).

Table 11.7: Accessories


Description Catalog No.
Indoor underground pull section (w/o lug landing)—26-in. (W)
Order separate SA8LL lug kit below if required. SA26PS
Outdoor (3R) underground pull section (w/o lug landing)—26 in. (W) x 24.5 in. (D)
Order separate SA8LL lug landing kit below when required. SA26PSR
Lug landing kit—800 A max. For terminating utility service cables in indoor or outdoor underground pull sections. SA8LL [6]
Single barrel lug kit —Kit provides single barrel lugs and pad in lieu of twin barrel lug provided with service section.
Mechanical lugs provided are sized to fit 1-3/0–750 kcmil cable. Two lugs per phase are supplied. SA7PL
11

Loadside wireway—11.5 in. (W) x 14 in. (D)—indoor only SA10LW


Bus link kit—800 A max.—Order one kit per phase for 400, 600, and 800 A. SA10BL
Double padlock hasp attachment—For mounting two padlocks on door handle of rainproof enclosure. Padlocks not included. SS2PL
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR

System Pole
Phase Spaces
Plug-On Distribution Panel—mounts on right side of I-Line interior. Cannot be used with LA/LH branch circuit breaker. 1Ø AC SS212AC
Panel rated 225 A for 240 V applications. For QO™ type plug-on circuit breakers only.
3Ø ABC 12 SS312
3Ø AB SS212AB [7]

Table 11.8: Subfeed Circuit Breakers (Series E4)


Rating 2-Pole Catalog No. [8] 3-Pole Catalog No.
Description (A) Left Right Left Right
100 SASFBH100L( ) SASFBH100R( ) SASFBH100L SASFBH100R
110 SASFBH110L( ) SASFBH110R( ) SASFBH110L SASFBH110R
Subfeed Circuit Breaker Kit [9]
Includes circuit breaker, connectors and mounting 125 SASFBH125L( ) SASFBH125R( ) SASFBH125L SASFBH125R
hardware. The complete kit, mounting hardware, circuit 150 SASFBH150L( ) SASFBH150R( ) SASFBH150L SASFBH150R
breaker and connectors will be shipped direct from plant. SASFBJ175L( ) SASFBJ175R( )
Delivery is stock to three days. 175 SASFBJ175L SASFBJ175R
200 SASFBJ200L( ) SASFBJ200R( ) SASFBJ200L SASFBJ200R
225 SASFBJ225L( ) SASFBJ225R( ) SASFBJ225L SASFBJ225R

Ordering Information
1. Service section: Order service section from Table 11.2 Single Main Circuit Breaker
with Distribution (Series E4), page 11-7 , Table 11.3 Single Main Fusible Disconnect
with Distribution (Series E4), page 11-7 , or Table 11.4 Multiple Mains—Fusible
(Series E4) , page 11-7, as determined by mains rating, voltage, and system.
2. Meter doors: Order meter door from Table 11.6 Meter Door Selection, page 11-8 as
determined by the height and utility metering requirements.
3. Accessories and subfeeds: Order as required from Table 11.7 Accessories, page
11-8 and/or Table 11.8 Subfeed Circuit Breakers (Series E4) , page 11-8.
4. Circuit breakers and switches: Order devices from pages listed below as
determined by voltage, trip rating, AIR, and mounting space.
Multiple Mains and Branch Devices
• QO, QOB, QO-VH, QOB-VH: page 7-11 and page 9-20
• I-Line: page 9-50 to page 9-56
• QMB Switches: page 9-58

[4] 6-jaw meter socket can also be used on 4- and 5-jaw applications.
[5] Door with provisions for mounting meter socket.
[6] All EUSERC Utilities (except Arizona Public Service and Salt River Project) require a lug landing kit SA8LL.
[7] To be used on 120/240 V, 3Ø4W delta applications.
[8] Two pole circuit breaker catalog numbers are completed by adding required phase connection letters as suffix (for example, SASFBH100LAC).
[9] Cannot use subfeed circuit breaker kit with multiple mains service section switchboards.
11-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Metal-Enclosed Drawout Low Voltage Switchgear
Class 6037 / Refer to Catalog 6037CT9901
schneider-electric.us

Power-Zone™ 4 Low Voltage Switchgear with Masterpact™


Circuit Breakers
Square D™ brand Power-Zone™ 4 low voltage, metal-enclosed, drawout switchgear is
designed to provide superior electrical distribution, protection, and power quality
management. The prime components of the switchgear are the Masterpact™ NW and
NT ANSI rated circuit breaker. Power-Zone 4 switchgear is designed to maximize the
functionality of the Masterpact circuit breakers, which, in turn, deliver maximum uptime,
system selectivity, ease of maintenance, and reliable circuit protection. All of these
features are packed into the smallest footprint available for low voltage drawout
switchgear.
• Power-Zone 4 is designed and built to ANSI® C37.20.1 and is Listed to UL 1558
• Masterpact NW and NT drawout low voltage power circuit breakers are designed and
built to ANSI C37.13 and C37.16. Listed to UL 1066
• Short-circuit current rating up to 200 kA at 240 V and 480 V without fuses
• High short-time withstand ratings up to 100 kA for 1 second, minimum
• Arc flash limiting (L1F) Masterpact NW feeder breakers available in 800, 1600, and
2000 A ratings
• Family of field installable and upgradeable Micrologic™ trip units with optional
Powerlogic™ data communications features
• Power-Zone 4 switchgear can offer optional data communications capability
• Smallest equipment footprint available in this product class
• Front access to all control and communications wire connections
• Bolted copper bus provided as standard
(up to 6000 A maximum)
• Large rear cable compartment pull area allowing maximum room for power cables
• Horizontal bus provision for future equipment expansion
Power-Zone 4 • System designed for maximum uptime with low maintenance
• Modular circuit breaker designed for easy addition of control accessories

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


Low Voltage Switchgear
(Class 6037)
• Available in NEMA 3R outdoor walk-in enclosures
• Available Arc Resistant construction certified to ANSI C37.20.7. See Power-Zone™ 4
Arc Resistant Switchgear with ArcBlok Technology, page 11-10.
Masterpact NW circuit breakers are available in various levels of interrupting ratings from
42–200 kA at 480 V and 130 kA at 600 V.
The Masterpact NT circuit breaker is available in an 800 A frame size and 42 kA at 480 V
interrupting rating. Up to 8 Masterpact NT circuit breakers can be mounted in a 30-inch
wide section. (Not available for 600 V.)
Circuit breakers of like frame sizes and interrupting ratings are interchangeable.

Table 11.9: Masterpact Circuit Breaker Selection


Rating (A) Catalog No. Rating (A) Catalog No.
Masterpact NW
NW08N1
NW08H1 NW40H2
NW08H2

11
 800 NW08H3 4000 NW40H3
NW40L1
NW08L1
NW08L1F
NW16N1
NW16H1 NW50H2
NW16H2
1600 NW16H3 5000 NW50H3
NW50L1
NW16L1
NW16L1F
NW20H1
NW20H2 NW60H2
2000 NW20H3 6000 NW60H3
NW20L1 NW60L1
NW20L1F
NW32H1
NW32H2
3200
NW32H3
NW32L1
Masterpact NT
 800 NT08N1

11-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Low Voltage Switchgear Metal-Enclosed Drawout
Class 6037 / Refer to Catalog 6037CT9901
schneider-electric.us

Power-Zone™ 4 Arc Resistant Switchgear with ArcBlok


Technology
Protecting Your Personnel and Equipment from an Arc Flash
Power-Zone 4 arc resistant switchgear with Masterpact NW ArcBlok technology offers
patented, superior arc flash protection for operators and maintenance personnel. The arc
flash containment features are unique to the industry in both the circuit breaker
compartment and the structure.
Power-Zone 4 Arc Resistant Switchgear with ArcBlok Technology is certified to comply
with ANSI C37.20.7 IEEE Guide for Testing Metal-Enclosed Switchgear Rated Up to 38
kV for Internal Arcing Faults, and third-party (UL) witnessed as arc resistant switchgear.
Refer to Data Bulletin 6037DB1302 for the complete UL Witness Certification Summary.
Features
• Masterpact NW circuit breakers with patented ArcBlok technology (up to 5000 A)
• Rated for systems with up to 100kA, 635V fault current
• 60 in. (1524 mm) deep x 22 in. (559 mm) wide (smallest arc resistant footprint in the
industry)
• 22 in. (559 mm), 36 in. (914 mm) section widths
• 60 in. (1524 mm), 72 in. (1829 mm), 80 in. (2032 mm) section depths
• Internal arc gas management system for optimized cooling
• ANSI Type 2B Rating
• NEMA 1 enclosures
Available Options
• Insulated copper bus
• Zone selective interlocking
Arc Resistant Power-Zone 4 • High-resistance grounding
Low Voltage Switchgear
(Class 6037) • Energy reduction maintenance switch
11

• Section barriers (rear, cable, and side)


• Circuit breaker remote racking
• ANSI Type 2B rated arc plenum exhaust
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR

Micrologic™ Trip Units


A modern family of field-installable trip units is available with Masterpact NW and NT
circuit breakers. The circuit breaker overcurrent protection consists of a microprocessor-
based tripping device that requires no external power source. The complete tripping
system has three main components: the air-core sensors, the trip device (with rating
plug), and the trip actuator. The microprocessor-based trip unit uses true RMS current
level sensing.
The Metering and Communications system is used in conjunction with Micrologic Type A,
Type P, and Type H trip units (see Digest page 7-67 and page 7-69) for the Masterpact
NW and NT circuit breakers. Modbus™ industry standard data communications allow this
system to replace discrete meters, multiple transducers, analog wires, and analog-to-
digital conversion equipment. Extensive information can be transmitted over a single
communications cable to a Powerlogic system display, a personal computer,
programmable logic controller, or other host system.
Basic circuit information, such as amperes, can be monitored using Micrologic Type A
trip unit. Circuit breaker remote operation is available using the Micrologic Type P and
Type H trip units with Powerlogic functionality. In addition to its metering capabilities, the
Micrologic trip unit system is available with optional status inputs and relay outputs for
monitoring discrete contacts and remote control of devices by way of the data
communications channel.
Micrologic trip unit metering functions include:

• Amperes and volts • Programmable contacts


• Frequency • Current unbalance
• Power • Over/under voltage
• Power demand • Over/under frequency
• Energy • Voltage unbalance
• Energy demand • Phase sequence
• Power factor • Reverse power
• Power quality measurements • Long time imaging
• Communications • Contact wear indicator
• Waveform capture • Masterpact circuit breaker maintenance
information
• Data logging

11-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
MiniBreak™ Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6042 / Refer to Brochure 6042BR9401

MiniBreak™ Compact Height Switches— 5.5 kV, 200 A


The Square D™ brand MiniBreak compact height switch enclosure is only 66-inches
high and contains a single 3-pole load interrupter switch, rated 5.5 kV and 200 A.
Enclosures are free-standing and suitable for both indoor (NEMA 1) and outdoor (NEMA
3R) applications. These switches are available unfused or with provisions for ANSI-style,
3-inch-barrel fuses rated from 10E A to 200E A. Factory-installed accessories include an
auxiliary switch, strip heaters, and provisions for a “lock open” only key interlock. The
door is mechanically interlocked with the switch operating handle. Set screw cable lugs
for #14 solid—2/0 stranded aluminum or copper cable are provided for two line and one
load connections. Fuses are not furnished with this equipment. For fuse information,
see Table 11.12 Current-Limiting Fuses, Non-Disconnect Type. The Fused switches and
many of the fuses listed in this table are available from stock.

Table 11.10: Ratings


Max. design voltage (kV) 5.5
BIL (kV) 60
Frequency (Hz) 60
Continuous amperes 200
Interrupting amperes 200
MiniBreak Switch MiniBreak Switch
Enclosure with Door Interior Showing Fuses Momentary (amperes asymmetrical) 20,000
(Class 6042) (Class 6042) Fault close (amperes asymmetrical) 20,000
Capacitor switching (kVAR) None
Short time, 2 seconds (amperes symmetrical) 12,500
Low frequency withstand (kV) 19
Fuse integrated (symmetrical) 63,000
NOTE: 1200 hp maximum.
Ordering Information
Table 11.11: 5 kV—200 A Switch
Switch

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


Type
Catalog No.
Unfused HVMB305200U
Fused HVMB305200

1. Select switch catalog number based on fused or unfused.


2. Select catalog numbers for modifications from Factory Modifications table.
3. If fused, select 5 kV, 200 A maximum current-limiting fuse from table below.
4. Price switch and fuses separately. Switches are furnished with provisions only for
Listed Metal-Enclosed
Interrupter Switchgear fuses.
5. Weight 450 lbs (204 kg).
Table 11.12: Current-Limiting Fuses, Non-Disconnect Type
Fuse Mounting Clip
Continuous Current Catalog Number [1] [2]
Size Centers
5 kV Fuse
10E 5GS010
15E 5GS015
D 12”
20E 5GS020

11
25E 5GS025
30E 5GS030
40E 5GS040
50E 5GS050
D 12”
65E 5GS065
80E 5GS080
100E 5GS100
125E 5GS125
150E 5GS150
D 12”
175E 5GS175
200E 5GS200

Table 11.13: Factory Modifications


Catalog No. Description
HVMX1 Auxiliary switch, 1-N.O. and 1-N.C. contacts
Provisions for lock open only key interlock—Type KFL Kirk key lock with a 0-inch bolt
HVMK1 projection (Kirk item master number KFL000010SH)
HVMH1 Strip heater 100 W @ 120 V
HVMH2 Strip heater with thermostat 100 W @ 120 V
Distribution class surge arrester
HVMSA3 (set of three arresters) 3 kV, 2.55 MCOV [3]
Distribution class surge arrester
HVMSA6 (set of three arresters) 6 kV, 5.10 MCOV [3]

[1] Contact your Schneider Electric representative for current stock quantities.
[2] Includes one set of three fuses, packed in a single box.
[3] Arresters are line side connected.
11-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed MiniBreak™
Switchgear
Class 6042 / Refer to Brochure 6042BR9401 schneider-electric.us

Ordering Example
Order one (1), 5 kV, 200 A switch with 65E current-limiting fuses. Provide one auxiliary
switch with 1-N.O. and 1-N.C. contact and with provision for installing a “lock open” key
interlock on the switch operating mechanism.
Order: Catalog No.
Switch with enclosure HVMB305200
Auxiliary switch HVMX1
Key interlock adapter HVMK1
Fuses (set of three, from Table 11.12 Current-Limiting Fuses, Non-
Disconnect Type, page 11-11. [4] [5] 5GS065

25.15 25.20
2.20 639 640
56

66.00
1677
47.52
1207

29.00
737

Front View Section View


(unfused)
11

25.20
640
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR

25.15
639
2.20 20.75
56 527

23.78
604
18.38
467

47.52
1207
2.70
69

15.35
390

Section View Bottom View


(fused) Selected Area Recommended
(bottom conduit entrance)

[4] For fuses produced by other manufacturers, contact your nearest Schneider Electric sales office or your local Schneider Electric distributor.
[5] Current-limiting fuses will increase the integrated short-circuit ratings beyond the non-fusible units. Contact your nearest Schneider Electric sales office or your local Schneider Electric
distributor.
11-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
HVL/cb™ Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6065 / Refer to Brochure 6065BR1401

HVL/cb Vacuum Circuit Breaker Switchgear—5-15 kV, 1200 A


Square D™ brand metal-enclosed switchgear has become an industry standard for its
superior system performance, low maintenance cost, easy system expansion, and
reduced system expense.
Square D™ brand HVL/cb vacuum interrupter switchgear offers a small footprint,
reduced capital and operational expenditures, longer maintenance cycles, and initial low
cost offer for the market. With the incorporation of the Evolis vacuum circuit breaker, the
switchgear is able to operate at up to 10,000 operations.
Standing at 24 in. wide, 90 in. inches high, and 65 in.deep, this equipment is NEMA 1
rated and adheres to the ANSI IEEE standard. Additional features include switchgear
ratings up to 1200 A for the main bus, 15 kV for the system voltage, a 25 kA interrupting
rating, and up to 95 kV BIL.
HVL/cb switchgear is designed for front-only or front or rear access, which allows the
switchgear be placed against a wall without an NEC-governed rear aisle. The “Type 2b”
arc resistant option has a plenum behind the low voltage compartment that does not
require any additional height space to be added to the switchgear. Designed for top and
bottom cable entry, the units can be equipped with either the over-toggle mechanism
(OTM) or the stored-energy mechanism (SEM), making this switchgear ideal for most
applications.
2.0 in. x 7.0 in. 57.8
±.06
low volta ge
conduit a re a 0.56 in. bolt down
(bottom e ntry) 27.3 16.7 8.8 3.6 (five pla ce s )

4.6
6.1

8.6 7.4 ±.06

13.3

7.4 ±.06

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


14.8 in. x 14.8 in.
me dium volta ge
conduit a re a
(bottom e ntry)
14.8 in. x 14.8 in.
Founda tion P la n Vie w me dium volta ge
conduit a re a
(bottom e ntry)

Low volta ge
compa rtme nt

Low volta ge
compa rtme nt
Me dium volta ge
dis conne ctor compa rtme nt

Ce nte r of gra vity


(for re fe re nce only)
Me dium volta ge
circuit bre a ke r compa rtme nt

11
Circuit bre a ke r s ta tus
vie wing window

40.4
REF

10.1 Ze ro s e que nce


24.0 Right S ide Vie w curre nt tra ns forme r
(e nd s he e t re move d; (optiona l)
Front Vie w front a cce s s , bottom e ntry
feeder s hown)

Table 11.14: HVL/cb Vacuum Circuit Breaker Switches—600/1200 A Ratings


Switch (kV)—maximum design 5.5 17.5
BIL (kV) 60 95
Frequency (Hz) 50/60 50/60
Withstand (kV) 19 36
Continuous current (A) 600/1200 600/1200
Interrupting current (A) 600/1200 600/1200
Fault close
(kA asymmetrical) 40 40
Momentary current
(kA asymmetrical) 40 40
Short time current
(kA symmetrical) 25 25
Mechanical endurance Load break switch 1000 1000
(number of operations) Evolis circuit breaker 10,000 10,000

11-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed HVL/cb™
Switchgear
Class 6065 / Refer to Brochure 6065BR1401 schneider-electric.us

Switch Disconnector Standard Features


• Switch Positions: Closed, open, and internally grounded (optional) (connects switch
contacts to ground)
• Enclosure: Epoxy
• Medium: Sulphur hexalfluoride
• Maintenance: Maintenance free sealed for life
• Pressure:
– 5.8 PSI (≤ 17.5 kV)
– 22 PSI (25.8–38 kV)
• View ports to show switch blade position

To To To
Ground Ground Ground
Bus Bus Bus

Closed Position Open Position Grounded Position

Options
• Internal ground switch: Has full fault making capability
• Connections to HVL/cc load interrupter switchgear and Motorpact motor controllers
• Service entrance available
• Voltage transformers
• Control power transformer
11

• Fast auto transfers


• Dual main configurations
• Powerlogic™ metering
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR

Switchgear Standard Features


• Compartments: Switch, bus, circuit breaker, mechanism, and optional low voltage/
control
• 11 gauge steel enclosure
• Epoxy insulators
Listed Metal-Enclosed
Interrupter Switchgear • Circuit breaker door interlocking available
• Front and rear access available
• Animated mechanism mimic bus
• Padlocking provision—open or closed (OTM); open-only (SEM)
• Top or bottom cable entry
• UL/CUL Listed, IEEE C37.20.3
• Tin plated copper bus for lineups
• Insulated bus

11-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Premset™ Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6045 / Refer to Catalog 6045CT1601

Premset Compact Vacuum Circuit Breaker Switchgear with


Shielded Solid Insulation System (2SIS)
Premset represents the new generation of medium voltage switchgear. It is 15 kV
vacuum circuit breaker switchgear technology that takes advantage of the innovative
shielded solid insulated system (2SIS). 2SIS creates a three-layered system (medium
voltage conductive layer, epoxy insulating layer, and grounded shield layer) throughout
the entire switchgear that optimizes performance and increases life expectancy. Premset
reduces the opportunity of arc flash or contact with live parts by insulating and screening
all live parts in an epoxy dielectric molding. In addition, a grounded shield layer helps
reduce the likelihood of exposure to electrical hazards while at the same time better
protecting the insulating material from harsh environmental conditions such as moisture,
dust, chemicals, and vermin.
Premset delivers a compact architecture that is both modular and flexible. It allows for
front-only accessibility (bottom incoming cables) and the smallest 15 kV vacuum circuit
breaker footprint on the market. Plug-and-play design of accessories and auxiliaries
makes even last minute or field modifications possible. Modular design improves cost
savings and optimizes delivery times. Premset’s modular architecture makes it easy to
use in design and intuitive to learn for operators.

Table 11.15: Premset Ratings


Voltage Class 5 and 15 kV
Bus Current Rating 600 and 1200 A 1200 A
Circuit Breaker Current Rating 100 A 200 A 600 A 1200 A
Maximum Short-Time Interrupting 25 kA (2 seconds)
Current
Rated BIL Withstand Voltage 95 kV
Base Dimensions (inches) 29.5 W x 36 D x
14.75 W x 36 D x 65 H
65 H

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


Listed Metal-Enclosed
Interrupter Switchgear

11

11-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed HVL/cc™
Switchgear
Class 6045 / Refer to Catalog 6045CT9801 or Product Data 6040PD9601 schneider-electric.us

HVL/cc Metal-Enclosed Load Interrupter Switchgear—Full Range


Square D™ brand HVL/cc metal-enclosed load interrupter switchgear provides
switching, metering, and interrupting capabilities for medium voltage electrical power
distribution systems and is designed and tested per applicable ANSI/IEEE and NEMA
standards.
Made up of modular units, the HVL/cc is easy to expand. Two main bus positions allow
future extensions and connections to existing equipment.
HVL/cc switchgear is available in either single or multiple bay units. The design is
compact, with front-only accessibility.
The HVL/cc switch can be equipped with either an over-toggle mechanism (OTM), which
is standard, or an optional stored energy mechanism (SEM). An option with both
mechanisms is the Fuselogic™ system. The Fuselogic system offers fuse tripping (with
SEM) to provide protection against single phasing loads when a fuse has blown.
The HVL/cc enclosure is designed for front access only and can be positioned against
walls, in small rooms or in pre-fabricated buildings. The small footprint can result in
considerable cost savings from the reduction of building or room sizes.

Front
Optional
low voltage
compartment
Main bus
compartment
Switch with 90.00
enclosure 2286

Mechanism
compartment
Fuse cable
37.25
compartment 946

Fuse/cable
access
panel 37.25
946
W 14.75
375
Right Side
View Plan Front
View View

Table 11.16: HVL/cc Load Interrupter Switches— Full Range 600/1200 A Ratings
Switch (kV)—maximum design 5.5 17.5 17.5 25.8 38
BIL (kV) 60 95 110 125 150
Frequency (Hz) 50/60 50/60 50/60 50/60 50/60
Withstand (kV) 19 36 36 50 80
Continuous current (A) 600/1200 600/1200 600/1200 600 600
Interrupting current (A) 600/1200 600/1200 600/1200 600 600
Fault close
(kA asymmetrical) 40 40 40 32 32
Momentary current
(kA asymmetrical) 40 40 40 32 32
Short time current
(kA symmetrical) 25 25 25 25 25
Electrical endurance 100/600 A 100/600 A 100/600 A
(number of operations at 80% P.F.) 100 100
26/1200 A 26/1200 A 26/1200 A
Mechanical endurance
(number of operations) 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000

11-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
HVL/cc™ Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6045 / Refer to Catalog 6045CT9801 or Product Data 6040PD9601
Switch Standard Features
• Switch Positions: Closed, open, and internally grounded (optional) (connects switch
contacts to ground)
• Enclosure: Epoxy
• Medium: Sulphur hexalfluoride
• Maintenance: Maintenance free sealed for life
• Pressure:
– 5.8 PSI (≤ 17.5 kV)
– 22 PSI (25.8–38 kV)
• View ports to show switch blade position

To To To
Ground Ground Ground
Bus Bus Bus

Closed Position Open Position Grounded Position

Options
• Internal ground switch: Has full fault making capability
• Fuselogic™ system
• Infrared viewing windows
• Class I, Division 2
• Fast auto transfers

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


Duplex configurations
• Powerlogic™ metering
• 20-inch or 29.5-inch wide enclosures
Fuselogic™
Fuselogic is a protection system that provides the ultimate in medium voltage fuse
protection. This patented system utilizes Square D™ brand current-limiting fuses with
mechanical sensors that function without any auxiliary power requirements. Several
combinations of Fuselogic functions can be combined to provide simple blown fuse
indication contacts with mechanical lockout to anti-single phasing protection. Anti-single
phasing requires the optional stored energy mechanism. Fuselogic is available on both
HVL/cc and HVL switches.
Switchgear Standard Features
• Compartments: Switch, bus, fuse/cable, mechanism, and optional low voltage/control
• 11 gauge steel enclosure
• Epoxy insulators

11
Fuse/cable access panel interlocked with switch
Listed Metal-Enclosed
Interrupter Switchgear • Front access only
• Animated mechanism mimic bus
• Padlocking provision—open or closed (OTM); open-only (SEM)
• Top or bottom cable entry
• UL/CUL Listed, IEEE C37.20.3
• Live line indicators on all incoming switch bays and outgoing feeder circuits
• Cable lugs included for one cable per phase
• Tin plated copper bus for lineups
Table 11.17: Surge Arresters
System L-L Voltage kV Arrester MCOV-kV
Effectively Impedance Grounded
Nominal Maximum Grounded and Ungrounded
Neutral Circuits Circuits
2.4 2.54 — 2.55
4.16 4.4 2.55 5.1
4.8 5.08 — 5.1
6.9 7.26 — 7.65
12.0 12.7 7.65 12.70
12.47 13.2 7.65 12.70
13.2 13.97 8.4 —
13.8 14.52 8.4 —

11-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed HVL/cc™
Switchgear
Class 6045 / Refer to Catalog 6045CT9801 schneider-electric.us

HVL/cc Switchgear Quick Ship Program—5–15 kV, 600 A


The HVL/cc quick ship program provides basic fused and unfused load interrupter switch
configurations for standalone or transformer primary applications. The Quick Ship
program offers faster delivery, but with fewer options.
Three-pole, 600 A individual HVL/cc switches are available in free-standing indoor
(NEMA 1) enclosures. These switches are available unfused or with provisions for
Square D™ brand current-limiting DIN/E fuses. Factory optional accessories include
auxiliary bays, main bus, auxiliary switches, and distribution class surge arresters. The
fuse access panel is mechanically interlocked with the switch mechanism. Key interlocks
are not an available option with Digest-listed HVL/cc switches. (1) Set screw type lugs for
(2) #2–350 kcmil copper or aluminum cables are provided for line and load connections.
Fuses are not furnished with this equipment. For fuse information, refer to General
Purpose E-Rated Current-Limiting Fuses:Type DIN/E for HVL/cc Switches, page 11-21.
Mechanical interlock
between switch and
fuse access panel.
NOTE: Cable entry and NOTE: Mechanical
exit must be opposite to interlock is standard
maintain the minimum on switches.
sections shown.

M
M
90.00 450E
2286 M 90.00
2286 450E
11

M
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR

37.25
14.75 946 37.25
375 14.75 946
375

5 kV Indoor N1 5 kV Indoor N1
Top Cable In/Bottom Cable Top Cable In/Bottom Cable Out
Out Switch in Position A Switch in Position B

Provisions for Future Expansion


• All “single” HVL/cc switches have provisions for future expansion on either side
• Order main bus kits for copper 600 A bus
600 A Single Switch Unfused
• Manual over-toggle mechanism, no grounding switch
• Includes (1) set screw for (2) #2–350 kcmil Cu or Al conductors per phase
• Application A = Top entry (incoming—cable or main bus), bottom exit (load—cable or
main bus)
• Application B = Bottom entry (incoming—cable or main bus), top exit (load—cable or
main bus)
Table 11.18: Unfused Switch Selection
Catalog kV Width
Rating Fuse Range Application
No. in mm
HVLCCA14305N 4.76 — A 14.75 375
HVLCCA20305N 4.76 — A 20.00 508
HVLCCA14315N 15 — A 14.75 375
HVLCCA20315N 15 — A 20.00 508
HVLCCB14305N 4.76 — B 14.75 375
HVLCCB20305N 4.76 — B 20.00 508
HVLCCB14315N 15 — B 14.75 375
HVLCCB20315N 15 — B 20.00 508

11-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
HVL/cc™ Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6045 / Refer to Catalog 6045CT9801
600 A Single Switch Fused
• Provisions only for Square D™ brand current-limiting DIN/E fuses—order separately
• Manual over-toggle mechanism, no grounding switch
• Includes (1) set screw lug for (2) #2–350 kcmil Cu or Al conductor per phase
• Application A = Top entry (incoming—cable or main bus), bottom exit (load—cable or
main bus)
• Application B = Bottom entry (incoming—cable or main bus), top exit (load—cable or
main bus)
Table 11.19: Fused Switch Selection
Catalog kV Fuse Range Application Width
No. Rating in mm
HVLCCA14305D 4.76 10–450E A 14.75 375
HVLCCA20305D 4.76 10–450E A 20.00 508
HVLCCA14315D 15 10–200E A 14.75 375
HVLCCA20315D 15 10–200E A 20.00 508
HVLCCB14305D 4.76 10–450E B 14.75 375
HVLCCB20305D 4.76 10–450E B 20.00 508
HVLCCB14315D 15 10–200E B 14.75 375
HVLCCB20315D 15 10–200E B 20.00 508

600 A Incoming Line Auxiliary Bay


For bottom incoming cable to application A (bottom cable exit) switch(es), order 600 A tin
plated Cu main bus to adjacent section from bus table. Includes (1) set screw lug for (2)
#2–350 kcmil Cu or Al conductor per phase.

Table 11.20: Bays for Bottom Entry/Bottom Exit Cables


Catalog kV Width
Rating Fuse Range Application
No. in mm
HVLCCA14A 4.76/15 — A 14.75 375
HVLCCA20A 4.76/15 — A 20.00 508

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


For top incoming cable to application B (top cable exit) switch(es), order 600 A tin plated
Cu main bus to adjacent section from main bus kits table. Includes (1) set screw lug for
(2) #2–350 kcmil Cu or Al conductor per phase.

Table 11.21: Bays for Top Entry/Top Exit Cables


Catalog kV Width
Rating Fuse Range Application
No. in mm
HVLCCB14A 4.76/15 — B 14.75 375
HVLCCB20A 4.76/15 — B 20.00 508

600 A Tin Plated Copper Main Bus Kits


Table 11.22: Bus Kits
Left Width Right Width
Catalog (From) (To)
No. Applica- in mm Applica- in mm
tion tion
HVLCCMBA14A14 A 14.75 375 A 14.75 375
HVLCCMBA14A20 A 14.75 375 A 20.00 508
HVLCCMBA20A14 A 20.00 508 A 14.75 375

11
HVLCCMBA20A20 A 20.00 508 A 20.00 508
HVLCCMBB14B14 B 14.75 375 B 14.75 375
HVLCCMBB14B20 B 14.75 375 B 20.00 508
HVLCCMBB20B14 B 20.00 508 B 14.75 375
HVLCCMBB20B20 B 20.00 508 B 20.00 508

Ratings
HVL/cc Switch with manually operated type OTM mechanism in cubicle enclosure (does
not include internal ground switch). Ratings are based on an X/R ratio of 1.6.

Table 11.23: HVL/cc Switch Ratings


Switch (kV)—maximum design 5.5 17.5
BIL (kV) 60 95
Frequency (Hertz) 50/60 50/60
Withstand (kV) 19 36
Continuous current (amperes) 600 600
Interrupting current (amperes) 600 600
Fault close (amperes asymmetrical) 40,000 40,000
Integrated switch and fuse rating (amperes symmetrical)[6] 65,000 65,000
Momentary current (amperes asymmetrical) 40,000 40,000
Short time current, 2 seconds (amperes symmetrical) 25,000 25,000
Operations at Full Load 100 100
Mechanical Endurance (number of operations) 1000 1000

[6] 50,000 for 630 A fuse.


11-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed HVL/cc™
Switchgear
Class 6045 / Refer to Catalog 6045CT9801 schneider-electric.us

Factory Modifications
Table 11.24: Factory Modifications
Catalog No. Description
HVLCC-X3 Auxiliary switch 2 N.O.–2 N.C. contact

Distribution Class Surge Arresters


(One Set of Three) Switch Load Side Connected or Incoming Line Bay)

Table 11.25: Surge Arresters


Section Width
Catalog kV Rating Minimum Required
No.
in mm
HVLCCDSA3 3 kV, 2.55 kV MCOV 14.75 375
HVLCCDSA6 6 kV, 5.10 kV MCOV 14.75 375
HVLCCDSA9 9 kV, 7.65 kV MCOV 14.75 375
HVLCCDSA10 10 kV, 8.40 kV MCOV 14.75 375
HVLCCDSA12 12 kV, 10.20 kV MCOV 14.75 375
HVLCCDSA15 15 kV, 12.70 kV MVOV 20.00 508
HVLCCDSA18 18 kV, 15.3 kV MCOV 20.00 508

600 A “Single” HVL/cc Switch with PROVISIONS ONLY for Square D™ brand
600 A, Current-Limiting, Non-Disconnect Type Fuses for Cable Connection to Power-
tin-plated, Dry™, Power-Cast™, and Uni-Cast™ Transformers
copper bus (FLC = 300 A MAXIMUM)
RH—Transformer on right, LH—Transformer on Left
Application A = Top Entry (Incoming Cables)
Application B = Bottom Entry (Incoming Cables)
M
90.00 200E
2286
M
Table 11.26: 600 A “Single” HVL/cc Switch Selection
Catalog kV Ap- Width
Fuse Range plica- RH / LH
No. Rating in mm
tion
14.75 14.75 37.25 HVLCCA14405DGR 4.76 10–450E A 14.75 375 RH
946
375 375
HVLCCA20405DGR 4.76 10–450E A 20.00 508 RH
HVLCCA14405DGL 4.76 10–450E A 14.75 375 LH
HVLCCA20405DGL 4.76 10–450E A 20.00 508 LH
HVLCCA14415DGR 15 10–200E A 14.75 375 RH
HVLCCA20415DGR 15 10–200E A 20.00 508 RH
Listed Metal-Enclosed HVLCCA14415DGL 15 10–200E A 14.75 375 LH
Interrupter Switchgear
HVLCCA20415DGL 15 10–200E A 20.00 508 LH
HVLCCB14405DGR 4.76 10–450E B 14.75 375 RH
HVLCCB20405DGR 4.76 10–450E B 20.00 508 RH
HVLCCB14405DGL 4.76 10–450E B 14.75 375 LH
HVLCCB20405DGL 4.76 10–450E B 20.00 508 LH
HVLCCB14415DGR 15 10–200E B 14.75 375 RH
HVLCCB20415DGR 15 10–200E B 20.00 508 RH
HVLCCB14415DGL 15 10–200E B 14.75 375 LH
HVLCCB20415DGL 15 10–200E B 20.00 508 LH
NOTE: Switches with transformer connections are painted ANSI 49. Standalone
switches are painted ANSI 61. Transformer connections in HVL/cc switches are
based on standard Square D™ brand transformer connections. If these switches are
used to connect to other manufacturers' transformers, then connections must match
standard Square D™ brand transformer connections. (Cable connections are
furnished with the transformer.)

11-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
HVL/cc™ Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6045 / Refer to Catalog 6045CT9801
General Purpose E-Rated Current-Limiting Fuses: Type DIN/E for HVL/cc
Switches
• Integrated rating for 600 A HVL/cc switches with Square D™ brand DIN/E fuses listed
below is 65 kA rms symmetrical amperes.
• Current-limiting fuses increase the integrated short-circuit current rating because of
their energy-limiting capabilities.
• To increase the short-circuit current rating of the entire lineup of switchgear, current-
limiting fuses must be used in the entrance sections.
Table 11.27: Fuse Selection
Section
Catalog kV Fuse Set of Fuses Fuse Width Required
No. Rating Rating [7] Size
in mm
55DE010 5.5 10E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE015 5.5 15E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE020 5.5 20E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE025 5.5 25E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE030 5.5 30E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE040 5.5 40E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE050 5.5 50E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE065 5.5 65E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE080 5.5 80E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE100 5.5 100E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE125 5.5 125E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE150 5.5 150E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE175 5.5 175E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE200 5.5 200E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE250 5.5 250E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE300 5.5 300E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE350 5.5 350E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE400 5.5 400E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE450 5.5 450E 1 Actual 14.75 375
175DE010 15.5 10E 1 Actual 14.75 375
175DE015 15.5 15E 1 Actual 14.75 375

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


175DE020 15.5 20E 1 Actual 14.75 375
175DE025 15.5 25E 1 Actual 14.75 375
175DE030 15.5 30E 1 Actual 14.75 375
175DE040 15.5 40E 1 Actual 14.75 375
175DE050 15.5 50E 1 Actual 14.75 375
175DE065 15.5 65E 1 Actual 14.75 375
175DE080 15.5 80E 1 Actual 14.75 375
175DE100 15.5 100E 1 Actual 14.75 375
175DE125 15.5 125E 1 Actual 14.75 375
175DE150 15.5 150E 1 Actual 14.75 375
155DE175 15.5 175E 1 Actual 14.75 375
155DE200 15.5 200E 1 Actual 14.75 375

600 A “Duplex” HVL/cc Switch with PROVISIONS ONLY for Square D™ brand
Current-Limiting, Non-Disconnect Type Fuses for Cable Connection to Power-Dry,
Power-Cast, and Uni-Cast Transformers
• FLC = 300 A maximum
• RH—Transformer on right
• LH—Transformer on left includes mechanical interlock to prevent paralleling of

11
sources
• Application A = top entry (incoming cables)
• Application B = bottom entry (incoming cables)
Table 11.28: 600 A “Duplex” HVL/cc Switch Selection
Width
Catalog kV Appli-
Rating Fuse Range RH / LH
No. cati- in mm
on
HVLCCA14505DGR 4.76 10–450E A 14.75 375 RH
HVLCCA20505DGR 4.76 10–450E A 20.00 508 RH
HVLCCA14505DGL 4.76 10–450E A 14.75 375 LH
HVLCCA20505DGL 4.76 10–450E A 20.00 508 LH
HVLCCA14515DGR 15 10–200E A 14.75 375 RH
HVLCCA20515DGR 15 10–200E A 20.00 508 RH
HVLCCA14515DGL 15 10–200E A 14.75 375 LH
HVLCCA20515DGL 15 10–200E A 20.00 508 LH
HVLCCB14505DGR 4.76 10–450E B 14.75 375 RH
HVLCCB20505DGR 4.76 10–450E B 20.00 508 RH
HVLCCB14505DGL 4.76 10–450E B 14.75 375 LH
HVLCCB20505DGL 4.76 10–450E B 20.00 508 LH
HVLCCB14515DGR 15 10–200E B 14.75 375 RH
HVLCCB20515DGR 15 10–200E B 20.00 508 RH
HVLCCB14515DGL 15 10–200E B 14.75 375 LH
HVLCCB20515DGL 15 10–200E B 20.00 508 LH

[7] Each set of fuses contains three fuses, so, for example, two sets of fuses yield a total of six fuses.
11-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed HVL/cc™
Switchgear
Class 6045 / Refer to Catalog 6045CT9801 schneider-electric.us

Ordering Information
1. Select switch catalog number based on fused or unfused and cable entry locations
(top or bottom) from Table 11.18 Unfused Switch Selection, page 11-18, or Table
11.19 Fused Switch Selection, page 11-19.
2. Select incoming line auxiliary bay from Table 11.20 Bays for Bottom Entry/Exit
Cables, page 11-19, or Table 11.21 Bays for Top Entry/Exit Cables, page 11-19, if
required.
3. Select main bus from Table 11.22 Bus Kits, page 11-19, if required.
4. Select catalog numbers for factory modifications from Table 11.24 Factory
Modifications, page 11-20, if required.
5. If fused, select DIN/E fuses from Table 11.27 Fuse Selection, page 11-21.
Ordering Example
Order indoor 600 A, 5 kV, HVL/cc switch with bottom incoming and bottom outgoing
cables (1) #2 AWG per phase, (1) set 200E fuses, and (1) set 6 kV surge arresters.
Order: Catalog. No.
Switch w/fuse provisions and bottom exit load cables HVLCCA14305D
600 incoming line auxiliary bay (Application A—bottom entry) HVLCCA14A
Main Bus (Application A—14 in. to Application A–14 in.) HVLCCMBA14A14
6 kV LAs HVLCCDSA6
Set 200E fuses 55DE200
11
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR

11-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
HVL Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6040 / Refer to Catalog 6040CT9201 or Brochure 6040BR9401

HVL Metal-Enclosed Load Interrupter Switchgear—Full Range


HVL™ 5–38 kV Load Interrupter is the most popular ANSI-rated switchgear in its class in
America. Among medium voltage interrupter switchgear, both the switch and the
enclosure stand as industry benchmarks in the areas of design, manufacturing, and
performance. Load interrupter switchgear must perform a number of critical functions in a
unit substation - protecting equipment and disconnecting faulted lines and transformers.
Designed and tested to the latest applicable standards, HVL has been engineered to
provide superior protection for your distribution system.
HVL switchgear is available for various applications and configurations, including:
• Individual service entrance bays
• Multiple-bay lineups incorporating HVL load interrupters
• Substation primaries
Square D™ brand metal-enclosed switchgear has become an industry standard for its
better system performance, lower maintenance cost, easier system expansion, and
reduced system expense.
A full range of ratings and options are available but not listed in this publication. Contact
your nearest Schneider Electric sales office or your local Schneider Electric distributor.

Table 11.29: Ratings


Maximum design voltage (kV) 4.76 15 17 25.8 29 38
BIL (kV) 60 95 95 125 125 150
Frequency (Hz) 50/60 50/60 50/60 50/60 50/60 50/60
Continuous amperes 600/1200 600/1200 600 600/1200 600/1200 600
Interrupting amperes 600/1200 600/1200 600 600 400 400
Momentary
(kA asymmetrical) 40/61/80 40/61/80 61 40/61 40/61 40
Fault close
(kA asymmetrical) 40/61 40/61 40 28 28 20
Capacitor switching (kVAR) 2400 2400 – – – –

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


Short time rating
2 seconds (kA symmetrical) 25/38/50 25/38/50 25 25 25 25
Low frequency withstand (kV) 19 36 36 60 60 80

Standard Features
Listed Metal-Enclosed
Interrupter Switchgear • 11 gauge steel enclosure
• Direct drive mechanism
• Permanently attached operating handle
• Visible isolation viewing window
H
• Mechanical interlocked fuse access door
• Provision for padlock and key interlock
• Highly flexible design
• ANSI 61 paint
Options
D W
• Outdoor construction

11
Side view Front view
• Square D™ brand DIN-style current-limiting fuses
Recommended power • Boric acid fuses
cable conduit area • Silver or tin plated copper bus
2.00 38.00 2.00 • 600, 1200, or 2000 A main bus
51 965 51
• Heat shrink insulated bus
34 x 6
864 x 152
• Motor operator
4.00
102
34 x 6
864 x 152 • Shunt trip
D
Conduit
Control
Conduit Area
D1 • Fuselogic™ tripping system
2x4
51 x 102 • Roof bushings
6.36
• Key interlocks
35.74
162
• Surge arresters
1.13
29 908 • Utility metering bays
.875 Mounting Hole
(4 Places for .75 Anchor Bolts) • Duplex switch
• Transformer connections
• Infrared windows for thermal scanning of connections
Fuselogic™
Fuselogic is a protection system that provides the ultimate in medium voltage fuse
protection. This patented system utilizes the Square D™ brand current-limiting fuses
with mechanical sensors that function without any auxiliary power requirements. Several
combinations of Fuselogic functions can be combined to provide simple blown fuse
indication contacts with mechanical lockout to anti-single phasing protection. Anti-single
phasing requires the optional stored energy mechanism (SEM). Fuselogic is available on
both HVL/cc™ and HVL switches.

11-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed HVL
Switchgear
Class 6040 / Refer to Catalog 6040CT9201 or Brochure 6040BR9401 schneider-electric.us

HVL Switchgear Quick Ship Program—5 kV–15 kV, 600 A


The HVL quick ship program provides basic fused and unfused load interrupter switch
configurations for stand-alone or transformer primary applications. The Quick Ship
program offers faster delivery, but with fewer options.
Three-pole, 600 A individual HVL switches are available in free-standing indoor (NEMA
1) or outdoor (NEMA 3R) enclosures. The switches used in these enclosures are UL
Recognized and are listed under Category WIQG2 in File E140591(M). These switches
are available unfused or with provisions for DIN—style, Square D™ brand current-
limiting fuses or for boric acid fuses. Factory optional accessories include auxiliary
switches, extra cable terminating lugs and distribution class surge arresters. The door is
mechanically interlocked with the switch operating handle and provisions for key
interlocks are standard. Set screw type lugs for one #2 solid—600 kcmil copper or
aluminum cables are provided for line and load connections. Other standard features
include a bolted enclosure with a viewing window, ground pad, and space heater (NEMA
3R only). Control power for heater must be from external source. Fuses are not
furnished with this equipment. For fuse information, refer to Table 11.41 DIN/E
Current-Limiting Fuses, Non-Disconnecting Type , page 11-27, or Table 11.42 Boric Acid
Fuses, page 11-28. Many of the fuses listed in these tables are available from stock.
Switches are listed in the tables below and on page 11-25.

Table 11.30: 600 A “Single” Switch Unfused


Catalog No. kV Rating Fuse Range Enclosure Type
HVL305NG 4.76 — NEMA 1
HVL305NW 4.76 — NEMA 3R
HVL315NG 15 — NEMA 1
HVL315NW 15 — NEMA 3R

Table 11.31: 600 A “Single” Switch with PROVISIONS ONLY for Square D™ brand
Current-Limiting, Non-Disconnect Type Fuses
Catalog No. kV Rating Fuse Range Enclosure Type
HVL305DEG 4.76 10–450E NEMA 1
11

HVL305DEW 4.76 10–450E NEMA 3R


HVL315DEG1 15 10–100E NEMA 1
HVL315DEG2 15 125–200E NEMA 1
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR

HVL315DEW1 15 10–100E NEMA 3R


HVL315DEW2 15 125-200E NEMA 3R

Table 11.32: 600 A “Single” Switch with PROVISIONS ONLY for S&C Boric Acid
Non-Disconnect Type Fuses [8]
Catalog No. kV Rating Fuse Range Enclosure Type
HVL305BG 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 1
HVL305BW 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 3R
HVL315BG 15 10E–400E NEMA 1
HVL315BW 15 10E–400E NEMA 3R
HVL317BG 17 10E–400E NEMA 1
HVL317BW 17 10E–400E NEMA 3R

Table 11.33: Ratings


Max. Design Voltage (kV) 4.76 15.0
BIL (kV) 60 95
Frequency (Hz) 50/60 50/60
Continuous amperes 600 600
Interrupting amperes 600 600
Momentary (amperes asymmetrical) 40,000 40,000
Fault close (amperes asymmetrical) 40,000 40,000
Capacitor switching (kVAR) 2,400 2,400
Short-time rating, 2 seconds (amperes symmetrical) 25,000 25,000
Low frequency withstand (kV) 19 36

Table 11.34: Distribution Class Surge Arresters


System L-L Voltage kV Arrester MCOV-kV
Effectively Grounded Impedance Grounded
Nominal Maximum Neutral Circuits and Ungrounded Circuits
2.4 2.54 — 2.55
4.16 4.4 2.55 5.1
4.8 5.08 — 5.1
6.9 7.26 — 7.65
12.0 12.7 7.65 12.70
12.47 13.2 7.65 12.70
13.2 13.97 8.4 —
13.8 14.52 8.4 —

Table 11.35: Enclosure Type


W D H Weight
Type
in mm in mm in mm lbs kg
Indoor 38.00 965 54.50 1384 90.00 2286 1200 545
Outdoor 38.00 965 60.00 1524 97.50 2477 1400 636

[8] Boric acid fuses may increase lead times. Contact the factory for availability.
11-24
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
HVL Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6040 / Refer to Catalog 6040CT9201 or Brochure 6040BR9401
Provisions for Future Expansion
All “single” Digest switches have provisions for future expansion on either side. Order
kits HVMB for top crossover copper 600 A bus and HVLC for line connections to the top
bus. (See Table 11.40 Factory Modifications, page 11-26.)
HVL Switches for Power-Dry II ™, Power-Cast II ™,
and Uni-Cast II ™ Transformer Connections
HVL switches can be configured for close coupling cable connections to listed dry type
transformers for primary main switches of unit substations. These are listed in the tables
below with current-limiting or boric acid fuses. Both single and duplex switch mains are
included in this selection. Transformers are listed on page 14-21 and may not be suitable
for close coupling. For transformer availability and specific configurations, contact your
local Schneider Electric sales office. All connections in this digest are based on standard
Square D™ brand transformer connections. If these switches are used to connect to
other manufacturers’ transformers, then connections must coordinate with
standard Square D™ brand transformer connections. (Cable connections are furnished
with the transformer.)

Table 11.36: 600 A “Single” Switch with PROVISIONS ONLY for Square D™ brand
Current-Limiting, Non-Disconnect Type Fuses for Cable Connection to Power-Dry
II, Power-Cast II, and Uni-Cast II Transformers
(FLC = 300 A max.) RH—Transformer on Right, LH—Transformer on Left
Catalog kV Fuse Range Enclosure Type
Rating RH / LH
No.
HVL405DEGR 4.76 10–450E NEMA 1 RH
HVL405DEGL 4.76 10–450E NEMA 1 LH
HVL405DEWRH 4.76 10–450E NEMA 3R RH
HVL405DEWLH 4.76 10–450E NEMA 3R LH
HVL415DEGR1 15 10–100E NEMA 1 RH
HVL415DEGR2 15 125–200E NEMA 1 RH
HVL415DEGL1 15 10–100E NEMA 1 LH
HVL415DEGL2 15 125–200E NEMA 1 LH

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


HVL415DEWR1H 15 10–100E NEMA 3R RH
HVL415DEWR2H 15 125-200E NEMA 3R RH
HVL415DEWL1H 15 10–100E NEMA 3R LH
HVL415DEWL2H 15 125-200E NEMA 3R LH

Table 11.37: 600 A “Duplex” Switch with PROVISIONS ONLY for Square D™ brand
Current-Limiting, Non-Disconnect Type Fuses for Cable Connection to Power-Dry
II, Power-Cast II, and Uni-Cast II Transformers
(FLC = 300 A max.) RH—Transformer on Right, LH—Transformer on Left
Catalog kV
Rating Fuse Range Enclosure Type RH / LH
No.
HVL505DEGR 4.76 10–450E NEMA 1 RH
HVL505DEGL 4.76 10–450E NEMA 1 LH
HVL505DEWRH 4.76 10–450E NEMA 3R RH
HVL505DEWLH 4.76 10–450E NEMA 3R LH
HVL515DEGR1 15 10–100E NEMA 1 RH
HVL515DEGR2 15 125–200E NEMA 1 RH
HVL515DEGL1 15 10–100E NEMA 1 LH
HVL515DEGL2 15 125–200E NEMA 1 LH

11
HVL515DEWR1H 15 10–100E NEMA 3R RH
HVL515DEWR2H 15 125–200E NEMA 3R RH
HVL515DEWL1H 15 10–100E NEMA 3R LH
HVL515DEWL2H 15 125-200E NEMA 3R LH

Table 11.38: 600 A “Single” Switch with PROVISIONS ONLY for S&C Boric Acid
Non-Disconnect Type Fuses for Cable Connection to Power-Dry II, Power-Cast II,
and Uni-Cast II Transformers [9]
(FLC = 300 A max.) RH—Transformer on Right, LH—Transformer on Left
Catalog kV
Fuse Range Enclosure Type RH / LH
No. Rating
HVL405BGR 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 1 RH
HVL405BGL 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 1 LH
HVL405BWRH 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 3R RH
HVL405BWLH 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 3R LH
HVL415BGR 15 10E–400E NEMA 1 RH
HVL415BGL 15 10E–400E NEMA 1 LH
HVL415BWRH 15 10E–400E NEMA 3R RH
HVL415BWLH 15 10E–400E NEMA 3R LH

[9] Includes fuse holder only. See Table 11.42 Boric Acid Fuses , page 11-28for fuse refills. Boric acid fuses may increase lead times. Contact the factory for availability.
11-25
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed HVL
Switchgear
Class 6040 / Refer to Catalog 6040CT9201 or Brochure 6040BR9401 schneider-electric.us

Table 11.39: 600 A “Duplex” Switch with PROVISIONS ONLY for S&C Boric Acid
Non-Disconnect Type Fuses for Cable Connection to Power-Dry II, Power-Cast II,
and Uni-Cast II Transformers [10]
(FLC = 300 A max.) RH—Transformer on Right, LH—Transformer on Left
Catalog kV
Fuse Range Enclosure Type RH / LH
No. Rating
HVL505BGR 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 1 RH
HVL505BGL 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 1 LH
HVL505BWRH 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 3R RH
HVL505BWLH 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 3R LH
HVL515BGR 15 10E–400E NEMA 1 RH
HVL515BGL 15 10E–400E NEMA 1 LH
HVL515BWRH 15 10E–400E NEMA 3R RH
HVL515BWLH 15 10E–400E NEMA 3R LH
NOTE: Switches with transformer connections are painted ANSI 49. Standalone
switches are painted ANSI 61.
Fuse Selection
The rule of thumb method for selecting fuses for transformer protection is 1.33 times the
self-cooled full load current of the transformer or the next higher fuse rating. Selection of
the fuse is the customer’s responsibility and should be based on transformer and system
characteristics.
• Maximum Fuse Size:
Maximum fuse size should be determined by comparing the fuse total clearing curve
to the transformer damage curve. Contact Schneider Electric for transformer overload
and short-circuit withstand capability.
• Minimum Fuse Size:
Minimum fuse size shall carry the transformer magnetizing inrush current of 12 times
full load amperes for 0.1 second.
Table 11.40: Factory Modifications
11

Catalog Description
No.
HVMB Main Bus Kit, 600 A copper
Line side connector kit (main bus) 600 A
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR

with 2–1/0=500 MCM lugs (bottom entry only)


HVLC
Provisions for key interlocks—Type KFL Kirk key lock with a 0-inch bolt projection (Kirk
item master number KFL000010SH)
HVLX3 Auxiliary switch 2 N.O.—2 N.C. contact
HVLC2 Set screw type lugs 1/0—500 kcmil (qty. 3)
Distribution Class Surge Arresters [11]
HVDSA3 3 kV, 2.55 MCOV
HVDSA6 6 kV, 5.10 MCOV
HVDSA9 9 kV, 7.65 MCOV
HVDSA10 10 kV, 8.40 MCOV
HVDSA12 12 kV, 10.20 MCOV
HVDSA15 15 kV, 12.70 MCOV

Standard Features
• Switches for transformer primaries are cable connected only.
• Key interlocks must be ordered and coordinated by customer.
• Standard color is ANSI 61 for standalone units; ANSI 49 for switches connecting to
transformers.
• If switches are purchased to coordinate with Square D™ brand transformers,
composite drawings and shipment coordination will not be available.
• Switches are not designed for any special dimensions for retrofit purposes. For
dimensions other than shown, contact your nearest Schneider Electric sales office or
your local Schneider Electric distributor.
Ordering Information
1. Select switch catalog number based on fused or unfused and enclosure type.
2. Select catalog numbers for factory modifications from the table above.
3. If fused, select fuse from Table 11.41 DIN/E Current-Limiting Fuses, Non-
Disconnecting Type (Extended Travel Blown Fuse Indicator), page 11-27 or Table
11.42 Boric Acid Fuses, page 11-28.
4. Price switch and fuses separately. Switches are furnished with provisions only for
current-limiting fuse or boric acid fuse.

[10] Includes fuse holder only. See Table 11.42 Boric Acid Fuses , page 11-28for fuse refills. Boric acid fuses may increase lead times. Contact the factory for availability.
[11] Load side connected
11-26
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
HVL Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6040 / Refer to Catalog 6040CT9201 or Brochure 6040BR9401
Square D™ Brand DIN/E Fuse Selection Tables—HVL
Table 11.41: DIN/E Current-Limiting Fuses, Non-Disconnecting Type [12][13][14]
(Extended Travel Blown Fuse Indicator)
Fuse Mounting Clip [15]
Continuous Catalog
Current Centers Diameter No. [16][17]
(in) (mm)
5 kV Fuse
10E 17.4 51 55DE010
15E 17.4 51 55DE015
20E 17.4 51 55DE020
25E 17.4 51 55DE025
30E 17.4 51 55DE030
40E 17.4 51 55DE040
50E 17.4 51 55DE050
65E 17.4 51 55DE065
80E 17.4 51 55DE080
100E 17.4 51 55DE100
125E 17.4 76 55DE125
150E 17.4 76 55DE150
175E 17.4 76 55DE175
200E 17.4 76 55DE200
250E 17.4 76 55DE250
300E 17.4 76 55DE300
350E 17.4 76 55DE350
400E 17.4 76 55DE400
450E 17.4 76 55DE450
15 kV Fuse
10E 17.4 51 175DE010
15E 17.4 51 175DE015
20E 17.4 51 175DE020
25E 17.4 51 175DE025
30E 17.4 51 175DE030
40E 17.4 76 175DE040
50E 17.4 76 175DE050

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


65E 17.4 76 175DE065
80E 17.4 76 175DE080
100E 17.4 88 175DE100
125E 21.14 88 175DE125
150E 21.14 88 175DE150
175E 21.14 88 155DE175
200E 21.14 88 155DE200

11

[12] Square D™ brand DIN/E fuses are shown in this table. For fuses produced by other manufacturers, contact your nearest Schneider Electric sales office or your local Schneider Electric
distributor.
[13] Current-limiting fuses will increase the integrated short-circuit ratings beyond the non-fusible units. Contact your nearest Schneider Electric sales office or your local Schneider Electric
distributor.
[14] Caution—These fuses will not work for the MiniBreak. See Table 11.12 Current-Limiting Fuses, page 11-11 for the appropriate MiniBreak fuses.
[15] All fuses are single barrel arrangement with ferrule diameters per the chart.
[16] Contact your Schneider Electric representative for current stock quantities.
[17] Includes one set of three fuses, packed in a single box.
11-27
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed HVL
Switchgear
Class 6040 / Refer to Catalog 6040CT9201 or Brochure 6040BR9401 schneider-electric.us

Boric Acid Fuse Selection Tables—HVL


Table 11.42: Boric Acid Fuses [18]
Continuous Fuse Catalog Catalog
Fuse Type [20]
Current Type[19] No. No. [21][22]
5 kV Fuse Refill
10E SM-5S 5SM5010 RBA400 405WBAF010
15E SM-5S 5SM5015 RBA400 405WBAF015
20E SM-5S 5SM5020 RBA400 405WBAF020
25E SM-5S 5SM5025 RBA400 405WBAF025
30E SM-5S 5SM5030 RBA400 405WBAF030
40E SM-5S 5SM5040 RBA400 405WBAF040
50E SM-5S 5SM5050 RBA400 405WBAF050
65E SM-5S 5SM5065 RBA400 405WBAF065
80E SM-5S 5SM5080 RBA400 405WBAF080
100E SM-5S 5SM5100 RBA400 405WBAF100
125E SM-5S 5SM5125 RBA400 405WBAF125
150E SM-5S 5SM5150 RBA400 405WBAF150
175E SM-5S 5SM5175 — —
200E SM-5S 5SM5200 RBA400 405WBAF200
250E SM-5S 5SM5250 RBA400 405WBAF250
300E SM-5S 5SM5300 RBA400 405WBAF300
400E SM-5S 5SM5400 RBA400 405WBAF400
15 kV Fuse Refill
10E SM-5S 15SM5010 RBA400 415WBAF010
15E SM-5S 15SM5015 RBA400 415WBAF015
20E SM-5S 15SM5020 RBA400 415WBAF020
25E SM-5S 15SM5025 RBA400 415WBAF025
30E SM-5S 15SM5030 RBA400 415WBAF030
40E SM-5S 15SM5040 RBA400 415WBAF040
50E SM-5S 15SM5050 RBA400 415WBAF050
65E SM-5S 15SM5065 RBA400 415WBAF065
80E SM-5S 15SM5080 RBA400 415WBAF080
100E SM-5S 15SM5100 RBA400 415WBAF100
125E SM-5S 15SM5125 RBA400 415WBAF125
150E SM-5S 15SM5150 RBA400 415WBAF150
11

175E SM-5S 15SM5175 — —


200E SM-5S 15SM5200 RBA400 415WBAF200
250E SM-5S 15SM5250 RBA400 415WBAF250
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR

300E SM-5S 15SM5300 RBA400 415WBAF300


400E SM-5S 15SM5400 RBA400 415WBAF400

[18] S&C Boric Acid Fuses


Type SM-5S fuses are manufactured by the S&C Electric Company. SM-5S has a 25.0 kA symmetrical short-circuit rating from 2.4 kV to 17.0 kV. For 16.5 kV ratings, only S&C boric acid
fuses can be used.
[19] Cutler-Hammer - Westinghouse Fuses
Type RBA-400 fuses are manufactured by Cutler-Hammer - EATON Corporation. RBA-400 has a 37.5 kA symmetrical ampere short-circuit rating from 2.4 kV to 4.8 kV and 29.4 kA
symmetrical from 12 kV to 13.8 kV.
[20] Caution—These fuses will not work for the MiniBreak. See Table 11.12 Current-Limiting Fuses, page 11-11 for the appropriate MiniBreak fuses.
[21] Contact your Schneider Electric representative for current stock quantities.
[22] Includes one set of three fuses, packed in a single box.
11-28
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
GHA Medium Voltage Gas-Insulated Switchgear
Class 6047 / Refer to Brochure 0600BR1201
schneider-electric.us

GHA Gas-Insulated Switchgear (UL Listed)


Easy, innovative, and economical up to 38kV
GHA Medium Voltage (MV) switchgear is an ideal solution for a variety of applications
and requirements. GHA is well suited for public and industrial distribution networks,
infrastructure projects, petrochemical oil and gas industries, and container substations to
Listed Metal-Enclosed
name a few. This compact and modular switchgear offers both flexibility and a long, low-
Interrupter Switchgear maintenance service life.
Each section consists of sealed-for-life SF6 modules, which contain the fixed vacuum
circuit breaker, disconnect switch, and innovative busbar system. By design, there is no
gas handling throughout the service life of the equipment, from installation until recycling
at the end of life of the switchgear. Utilize the cutting-edge B-link busbar to easily install,
extend, or replace gear in the middle of a lineup, without handling SF6. Like the gas-filled
modules, the B-link system does not require any maintenance.
Front accessible and ideal for a variety of applications, GHA represents the new
generation of robust, extremely compact, and low maintenance MV switchgear.

Table 11.43: Ratings


Rated
Rated Rated Power Rated Short- Current of
Lightning Rated Arc Resistant
Rated Impulse Frequency Time Busbar Outgoing
Voltage (kV) Withstand Withstand Feeders with per IEEE
Withstand Current (A) C37.20.7
Voltage (kV) Voltage (kV) Current (kA) Natural
Cooling (A)
12 75 28 40 2500 2500
15 95 38 40 2500 2500 40 ka
duration for
27 125 50 40 2500 2500 0.5 seconds
38 170 80 40 2500 2500

Table 11.44: Dimensions


Electrical Characteristics Dimensions (in./mm)

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


Cubical Width
Rated
Rated Bus Tie with Section
Voltage (kV) nominal Bus Depth Height
current (A) Main/Feeder Circuit
Sectionalizer
Breaker
12 ≤ 1200 23.6/600 31.5/800 23.6/600 62.8/1595 94.5/2400
17.5 (with 31.5/800
24 2500 35.5/900 39.4/1000 23.6/600 62.8/1595 LV
38 compartment)

11

11-29
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Gas-Insulated Switchgear CBGS-0
Class 6047 / Refer to Brochure 6047BR1401
schneider-electric.us

CBGS-0 Gas-Insulated Switchgear (UL Listed)


Easy innovative and economical up to 38kV
CBGS-0 Medium Voltage (MV) switchgear is compact and easy to install and operate.
Due to the insulating gas as well as the solidly insulated busbar and cable connections
the medium voltage circuit is protected from environmental influences reducing the risk
Listed Metal-Enclosed
of arc flash events.
Interrupter Switchgear
Each section consists of a sealed-for-life SF6 tank which contains the fixed SF range
circuit breaker and disconnect switch. By design there is no gas handling throughout the
service life of the equipment from installation until recycling at the end of life of the
switchgear.
Front accessible and ideal for a variety of applications from transformer substations to
primary power distribution in markets ranging from mining and metals renewable
installations container substations and heavy industry where space is at a premium.

Table 11.45: Ratings


Rating Main/Feeder Bus Section Bus Riser Disconnecting Auxiliary
Switch Services

Nominal voltage
(kV) 15 27 38 15 27 38 15 27 38 15 27 38 15 27 38
Busbar system
rated current (A) 1200/2000 1200/2000 1200/2000 1200/2000 1200/2000
Outgoing rated
current (A) 1200/2000 1200/2000 1200/2000 1200/2000 —
Short-time
withstand current 25–31.5 25–31.5 25–31.5 25–31.5 Limited by the
(kA) fuse

Table 11.46: General Electrical Characteristics


kV Rating
Rated Voltage
27 38
Power frequency 60 Hz.
(efficient kV) 60 70
Rated Insulation Level Lightning impulse
withstand voltage (kV 125 150
peak)
Busbar system 1200/2000
Rated normal current (A)
Incoming/outgoing 1200/2000
Short circuit breaking current (kA) 25/31.5
Short circuit breaking current (kA peak) 63/80
Short time withstand current (kA/s) Max 25/2–31.5/2
Gas pressure at 200 °C (psi) 18.85
Standard degrees of High voltage compartment IP65
protection Low voltage compartment IP3X–IP41

Table 11.47: Dimensions and Weights


Modular Continuous Dimensions
Current Rating Inches (mm) Weight
Functional Unit
(s) (A) lbs. (kg)
Width Depth Height
Main/feeder bus 1200 23.5 (598) 1598 (725)
CBGS-0 Circuit Breaker section 47.2 (1198) 2249 (1020)
2000
Bus riser 1200 23.5 (598) 1058 (480)
disconnecting 55.1 (1400) 92.5 (2350)
2000 47.2 (1198) 2052 (930)
switch
VT auxiliary Not applicable 23.5 (598) 926 (420)
section

11-30
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
DVCAS Medium Voltage Gas-Insulated Switchgear
Class 6047 / Refer to Brochure 6000BR1202
schneider-electric.us

DVCAS Switchgear for Wind Farm Applications


DVCAS medium voltage (MV) switchgear from Schneider Electric is designed to meet
the electrical switching, protection, and connection needs of wind farm applications up to
38 kV. Three different modules are available:
• Transformer protection module D
• Outgoing line module O
• Incoming line module I
For standard wind power applications, a maximum of four modules can be connected in
various configurations to provide the most commonly used wind power functions.
DVCAS switchgear is designed, manufactured, and tested in accordance with the
following standards:
• C37.20.3
• C37.54
• CAN/CSA C22.2 No.31-M89
• UL Listed
• IEEE Cable Bushings

O
I D

VIP

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


Typical IDO Configuration

Transformer Protection Module D


DVCAS switchgear module D provides transformer protection. Construction features
include:
LE - DO
• Metal base frame
• Operating mechanism and relay compartment

11
– disconnector operating mechanism
– operating mechanism of the circuit breaker
– protection relay VIP, Sepam, or Micom
– zero sequence current transformer CSH 30

YO 1 Mitop VIP
• MV cable compartment
– bushings for cable connection
CS H 30
– Three CRc current sensors per phase
• Stainless steel, gas-tight tank
– busbar system
– three position disconnector
– circuit breaker

Module D

11-31
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Gas-Insulated Switchgear DVCAS
Class 6047 / Refer to Brochure 6000BR1202
schneider-electric.us

Outgoing Line Module O


DVCAS switchgear module O functions as an outgoing line to a downstream wind
generator. There are two medium voltage cables per phase. Construction features
include:
• Metal base frame
• Voltage presence indicator
• MV cable compartment
– bushings for cable connection
– clamps for MV cable connection

D+O
DO
Transformer protection + Outgoing line

(I + D + O)
I DO Incoming line + Transformer protection +
Outgoing line

(I + I + D + O)
I I DO Two Incoming lines + Transformer
protection + Outgoing line

Recommended Configurations

Incoming Line Module I


11

DVCAS switchgear module I is a three-position switch-disconnector. It is recommended


for the incoming line function from an upstream wind generator for the following reasons:
• Reduces downtime caused by faults
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR

• Helps with fault detection


• Reduces interruptions due to maintenance work
• Improves energization works
Module I is always connected to module D on the right with single-phase, coupling
Remote bushings. Construction features include:
Remote
operation
control • Metal base frame
Motor powe r s upply • Operating mechanism compartment
– operating mechanism of the switch-disconnector
RE - I
– motor for the operating mechanism (optional)
• MV cable compartment
– bushings for cable connection
M
• Stainless steel, gas-tight tank
Flair – busbar system
– three position disconnector

Table 11.48: Ratings


Type Rating
Frequency (Hz) 50/60
Rated voltage (kV) 38
Insulation level
  Power frequency withstand voltage (kV) 70
  Lightning impulse withstand voltage, peak (kV) 170
Rated current of the main busbar (A) 600
Module I Short time withstand current (kA/s) 20/3 [1]
Short circuit breaking current capacity (kA) 20 [1]
Short circuit making capacity, peak (kA) 50
Internal arc withstand IAC AFL (kA/1s) 20 [1]
Degree of protection (NEMA/IP)
  HV compartment 6/67
  LV and operating mechanism compartment 6P/3X
SF6 gas pressure at 20 ºC (PSI/bar) 4.35/0.3

[1] 25 kA for circuit breaker switchgear module D.


11-32
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Masterclad™; VR Circuit Breaker Medium Voltage Metal-Clad Switchgear
Class 6055 / Refer to Catalog 6055CT9901 or Handouts 6055HO0901,6000HO1001
schneider-electric.us

Masterclad™ Medium Voltage Metalclad Switchgear (UL Listed)


The Reliability of a Quality Design
The quality of Square D™ brand Masterclad medium voltage metalclad switchgear stems
from a design and manufacturing process that focuses on long-term switchgear
performance with the highest degree of reliability.
Based on specific customer application needs, Schneider Electric engineers and
Listed Metalclad
technicians select the appropriate standard sections and bus configurations, with the
Switchgear ability to customize where needed. After the specified circuit breakers, instrument and
control power transformers, relays, meters and other components are selected and
approved. All are factory-assembled, wired, and tested as a complete assembly.

Table 11.49: Ratings


Nominal voltage (kV) 4.16 7.2 13.8 24.9
Maximum voltage (kV) 4.76 8.25 15.0 27.0
BIL (kV) 60 95 95 125
Frequency (Hz) 50/60
Continuous amperes (A) 1200–4000 1200–2000
MVA (reference only) 250 350 500 500 500 750 1000 1500 1250 2000
Short-time rating (kA) 3 seconds 40 50 63 50 25 40 50 63 25 40
Close and latch rating (kA) (peak) 104 130 164 130 65 104 130 164 68 108

Two-high Masterclad 5–27 kV


Indoor, Metalclad Switchgear

Type VR Vacuum Circuit Breaker


The VR breaker is a horizontal drawout type designed to provide long life, reduced
maintenance, and ease of handling. The Type RI advanced design motor-charged stored
energy mechanism is a model of reliability with simplicity-with an operating life exceeding

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


ANSI requirements. The VR circuit breaker is UL labeled and includes a permanently
mounted manual charging handle.
Standard features include:
• 3-cycle interrupting rating
• Rated per ANSI/IEEE C37.06, C37.09, C37.013, C37.54
• UL Listed
• Motor operated, spring-charged, stored-energy operating mechanism
• Permanently mounted manual charging handle
Vacuum VR Circuit Breaker
• Five normally open and normally closed auxiliary contacts
for Masterclad Switchgear • Wheels that roll directly to floor level from lower cell
Switchgear Construction
• High-speed operation—3–cycles
• Removable (draw-out) circuit breaker
• Grounded metal barriers enclose all live parts

11
• Automatic shutters driven by breaker racking mechanism
• Closed door breaker position indication
• Closed door breaker racking mechanism
• Insulated main bus—aluminum or copper
• Standard glass polyester insulators or optional epoxy and porcelain insulators
• Mechanical interlocks
• Disconnect type CPT and VT trucks
• Grounded breaker truck in and between test/disconnected and connected positions
Masterclad 27 kV, Outdoor • Low voltage instrument/control compartment isolated from primary voltage areas
Non Walk-in, Metalclad Switchgear • Compliance to ANSI/IEEE standards C37.20.2 and C37.55 (designed and tested to
comply with or exceed ANSI and IEEE standards)
• ISO 9001 Certification (Designed and manufactured in a facility that is Quality
Systems Certified by Underwriters Laboratories, Inc.® to ISO 9001)
• Indoor NEMA 1 enclosure
• Outdoor NEMA 3R enclosure
– Walk-in enclosure
– Non walk-in enclosure

11-33
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Clad Switchgear Arc Resistant Switchgear
Class 6055 / Refer to Handouts 6055HO0101 and 6055HO0901
schneider-electric.us

Active, Arc-Resistant
Arc Terminator™ Arc Extinguishing System
Active system detects and controls the effects of internal arcing faults. It complies with
ANSI C37.20.7 requirements for arc-resistant switchgear for Type 1, Type 2B, and
Type 2C enclosures, even with the switchgear doors open.
In the event of a confirmed arcing fault inside a Masterclad switchgear or Motorpact
equipment lineup containing an Arc Terminator (AT) system, the AT system provides a
low impedance parallel path to effectively transfer the fault current from the arc to the 3-
phase main bus assembly of the switchgear.
The AT system consists of the following components:
• Aswitchgear.
high-speed closing, or shorting, switch is designed to close on the main bus of the
This creates a three-phase short circuit fault confined to the main bus.
Upstream protective device must clear fault within allowed time per applicable
standard.
Arc Terminator ™
• The controller box is the central processing device that responds to the signals given
Arc Extinguishing System
by the current sensors and the optical sensors. The current sensor module and the
control logic process incoming current and optical signals and send a signal to the
output triggering circuit. The output triggering circuit releases stored energy to initiate
closing of the mechanical switch and provides optical isolation to prevent false
triggering
• Optical sensors are located in each medium voltage compartment within switchgear
structures. A dedicated, properly sized set of current transformers is located at the
incoming power source(s).

Benefits
• Prevents pressure buildup
• Reduces release of toxic materials
11

• Eliminates need for reinforced switchgear


• Elimnates special requirements for buildings or plenums
• Minimizes equipment damage
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR

• Reduces operating downtime

Passive, Arc-Resistant
Masterclad™ Medium Voltage Switchgear
This switchgear and all its components meet the IEEE C37.20.7 arc-resistant test
guideline for Type 2B enclosures as well as all other applicable ANSI, UL, and CSA
standards for metalclad switchgear.
Switchgear Construction:
• Arc exhaust options: vented, arc shield, arc planum and duct
• High-speed operation—3–cycles
• Removable (draw-out) circuit breaker
• Fully compartmentalized construction
• Grounded metal barriers enclose all live parts
• Automatic shutters driven by breaker racking mechanism
Two-high, Masterclad 5–15 kV
• Closed door breaker position indication
Metalclad, Arc-Resistant Switchgear • Closed door breaker racking mechanism
• Insulated copper main bus
• Standard glass polyester supports
• Mechanical interlocks
• Disconnect type CPT and VT trucks
• Grounded breaker truck in and between test/disconnected and connected positions
• Low voltage instrument/control compartment isolated from primary voltage areas
• Compliance to ANSI standards C37.06, C37.09, C37.013, C37.54 and C37.55
(designed and tested to comply with or exceed ANSI and IEEE standards)

Ratings
• Up to 63 kA arc containment for 0.5 seconds
• Voltage ratings from 2.4 kV to 15 kV up to 4,000 A
• Type 2B construction, one- and two-high structures

11-34
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power-Zone Load Center; Model III Unit Substations
Classes 6010, 6020 / Refer to Catalog 6020CT9401 or Data Bulletin 6010DB1001
schneider-electric.us

Power-Zone Load Center Unit Substations


Table 11.50: Complete Close Coupled Unit Substations Available
Product Type Class Nos. Digest Section No.
Primary Section
Medium voltage load interrupter switchgear 6040, 6045
Metalclad switchgear 6055
Low voltage Power-Style™ QED switchboard 2741–2744 11
7240, 7310, 7320, 7421–
Air terminal chamber
23
Transformer Section
Open, ventilated dry—Power-Dry™ 7421–23
Open, ventilated dry/cast resin combination—Uni-Cast™ 7320
14
Open, ventilated cast resin—Power-Cast™ 7310
Mineral oil or high fire point fluid—liquid 7240
Secondary Section
Medium voltage load interrupter switchgear 6040
Unit Substation Metalclad switchgear 6055
Medium voltage motor control center 8198
Low voltage Power-Style QED switchboard 2741–2744 11
7240, 7310, 7320, 7421–
Air terminal chamber 23
Low voltage drawout switchgear 6037
Low voltage Model 6 motor control centers 8998 17

Power-Zone Model III Package Unit Substations


General
Power-Zone Model III package unit substations combine a primary switch, dry-type
transformer, and I-Line™ distribution section into a single, compact unit. All components

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


are engineered, manufactured, and tested by Schneider Electric. The substation is
available with a UL listing.
The Model III is only 49 inches deep and 90 inches high, which allows the entire
substation to pass through standard size doorways and narrow hallways.
The Model III is front accessible; the transformer taps are accessible from the side. For
proper ventilation, a minimum distance of 12 inches should be maintained on the
transformer side of the equipment.
Model III package unit substations are ideal for renovations and high rise applications
requiring increased customer electrical demand as well as new construction requiring
multiple zones and a small footprint.

75–1000 kVA at 480 V; 75–500 kVA at 240 V


Available with primary voltages of 2400–13800 V. Forced air cooling (AA/FA) provides an
additional 33%. Features 220 °C insulation and 150 °C, 115 °C, or 80 °C temperature
rise. Largest 80 °C or 115 °C rise unit available is 750 kVA.

11
The secondary circuit breaker distribution section may be equipped with an individually
mounted secondary main breaker or an I-Line distribution panelboard. Branch circuit
breakers from PowerPact™ B to PowerPact RLC 1200 A may be installed. PowerPact M-
, P-, and R-frame molded case circuit breakers are available with electronic trip units.
Additional options include PowerLogic™ and ION™ series metering, surge arresters, and
I-Line™ plug-on units with a Surgelogic™ Surge Protective Device (SPD).
Model III Package Unit Substation
with HVL/cc Load Interrupter Switch (on left)

Incoming Line Section


Most Model IIIs are supplied with a Square D™ brand fused HVL/cc 600 A load
interrupter switch. The HVL/cc offers the smallest footprint in the industry and is an
exclusive sealed interruption type compartmentalized switch. Where switching and
overcurrent protection are provided elsewhere, a full-height air-filled terminal chamber
can be provided in place of the switch.

Table 11.51: Primary Switch Ratings, Type HVL/cc


Nominal Voltage 4.16 13.8
BIL 60 95
Continuous amperes 600 600
Interrupting amperes 600 600
Fault close (kA asymmetrical) 40 40
Momentary current (kA asymmetrical 10 cycles) 40 40
Duty-cycle-fault-close (number of operations) 4 4
Grounding switch fault close (kA asymmetrical) 40 40
Short-time rating (kA asymmetrical 2 seconds) 25 25
Dielectric withstand (kV 1 minute) 19 36
Electrical endurance (close-open) 100 100
Mechanitcal endurance (close-open) 1000 1000

11-35
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Unit Substations Power-Zone™ Model III
Class 6010 / Refer to Catalog 6020CT9401
schneider-electric.us

Transformer Section
Special barrel wound dry-type transformers employing resin encapsulated VPI (Vacuum
Pressure Impregnation) techniques are used to achieve the low-loss, compact design
necessary for the space-saving package substation concept. Class H, 220 °C insulation
is used throughout. Temperature rise is 150 °C as standard, although 80°C or 115 °C low
temperature premium transformers are available through 750 kVA. Aluminum windings
are standard with copper as an option. Four full capacity 2-1/2 percent taps are provided-
two above nominal voltage and two below.
Fan cooling is optional. When selected, it increases the capacity rating of the transformer
an additional 33 percent. The Model 98 digital controller is employed. This system
provides precision control through the use of three high accuracy thermocouple type
sensors—one in each phase of the windings.
The controller has a membrane front panel for displaying the temperature of all three
phases with individual readings. The hottest phase is automatically displayed. The
Model 98 digital controller features simple three-button operation with fan, alarm and trip
function settings and is Powerlogic™ compatible.
HVL/cc™ switch, I-Line panelboard
top feed
Nameplate
Removable
cover 5.45
(138)

85.0
(2159)
11

80.00
(2032)
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR

14.75 or 20.00 60.00 or 72.00


(375) (508) (1524) (1829) Lifting jacks

Power-Zone Model III


Front View

Table 11.52: Transformer Basic Insulation Levels


KV Class Primary Voltages BIL 600 Hz Test
1.2 < 600 V Secondary 10 4 kV
2.5 2400 20 10 kV
5.0 4160, 4800 30 12 kV
7.2 6900, 7200 30 12 kV
8.7 8320 45 19 kV
15.0 12, 12.47, 13.2, 13.8 60 31 kV

11-36
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power-Zone™ Model III Unit Substations
Class 6010 / Refer to Catalog 6020CT9401
schneider-electric.us

Distribution Section
I-Line™ Mounted Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Molded case circuit breakers are group mounted in an I-Line panelboard section offering
the inherent ease of installation for which the plug-on I-Line circuit breaker has become
known. All circuit breakers are quick-make, quick-break, thermal magnetic, permanent
trip type and are factory-calibrated and sealed for accurate overcurrent response and
maximum short-circuit strength. PowerPact™ P and R circuit breakers are available with
solid-state Micrologic™ trip units. Current limiting high interrupting capacity FI, KI, and LI
circuit breakers are also available. Circuit breakers may be safely back-fed for use as
main circuit breakers. All circuit breakers are UL listed and carry integrated equipment
rating when used exclusively with other Square D™ brand circuit breakers in intended
assemblies.
I-Line panel is available in 1200 A. Maximum mounting space is 108 inches.
Tin-plated copper bus is standard.
Dimensions shown
in Inches (mm). See
table below for A, B,
A C, D, E dimensions. 8.6
1.0 (218) 8.0
(25) D Typ. E (203) 4.0
(102)

5.0 13.9
17.5 Me dium volta ge (353)
(445) (127)
conduit a re a
(top e ntry)

40.0
22.0 (1016)
29.3
(559) (744)
7.5
7.0 (191)
(178)

4.0
(102)
1.2 3.3 4.0
(30) 9.3 9.3
Low volta ge conduit 1.6 C (84) (102)
(41) 1.5 0.50 (13) dia . (236) (236)
provis ion; 2 pla ce s ; B 0.63 (16) dia .
Low volta ge (38) bolt-down bolt-down Low volta ge
1.125 (29) dia . 1.5

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


2.7 conduit a re a s (4 pla ce s ) (4 pla ce s ) conduit a re a
(38)
(69)
(bottom e ntry)
(top e ntry)
Top Vie w P la n Vie w

Table 11.53: Substation Dimensions and Approximate Weights


Tempera- Dimensions (for above drawings) Estimated
FA,FH,FY
QB, QD kVA ture Rise ° Weight
HD,HG
QG, QJ
C A B C D E
HJ, HL FA,FH,FY
½ Total
HD,HG
75
Breaker QB, QD
Mounting QG, QJ HJ, HL 112.5 80, 115, 150 3600
Space FI, KI, JD FI, KI, JD HCR-U 1200 A 150
Each JG, JJ, JL JG, JJ, JL 48 11.0 23.0 13.5 32.0
I-Line panelboards 225
Side Q4, LA, LH 80, 115, 150 4500
300
LC, LI, LX can be used for up 500 150 6000
LXI, LE
to 600 V ac. They 500 80, 115 6200
MG, MJ
are UL Listed 750 80, 115, 150 60 18.5 27.0 18.75 44.0 6700
PG, PJ, PL
PGC, PJC, PLC under File E33139. 1000 150 7500
RGC, RJC, RLC

Contact your nearest Schneider Electric sales office for ordering assistance.
1200 A Max. Main Lugs or
SN
1200 A Max. Main Breaker

11

11-37
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
MV Controllers Motorpact™
Class 8198 / Refer to Documents 8198CT0201, 8198HO0201
schneider-electric.us

Motorpact™ Medium Voltage Motor Controllers (UL Listed)


Square D™ brand Motorpact medium voltage motor controllers from Schneider Electric
are designed and manufactured to tackle the toughest power and process control
challenges. Our motor controllers feature industry-first innovations that provide
unmatched performance, high reliability, low maintenance and exclusive technologies.
Motorpact medium voltage motor controllers are designed to provide the most efficient
means to control and protect a wide range of applications and may be configured for
motor starting, transformer feeders, capacitor feeders, or future spaces. The design has
fewer losses inside the controller, providing more efficient use of power for the connected
load.
Motorpact controllers are designed to meet or exceed the standards for NEMA ICS3 Part
2, UL Standard 347, and IEC 60470. UL and cULus labels are standard.
Starting application for squirrel cage induction motors:
• Full voltage non-reversing
• Full voltage reversing
• 2-speed, 2-winding, 2-speed, 1-winding
• Reduced voltage non-reversing
– Auto transformers
– Solid state soft start
– Sequential soft start (S3) multi-motor starting
Enclosures are available in NEMA Type 1, 1A, and 3R and feature the smallest footprint
in the industry at 14.75 inches wide. Enclosures that are 20 inches and 29.5 inches wide
are also available for FVNR.
Optional arc resistant enclosures are available that meet IEEE C37.20.7.
Units are designed as one-high construction for ease of use with a optimum height for
the operator controls and isolation switch disconnect handle.
Full front and or front and rear accessibility are provided. A full height cable pulling area
is standard.
Listed Controllers
Controller voltage ratings range from 2.3–7.2 kV vacuum contactors feature a drawout
design and have ratings of 200, 400, 450, and 720 A.
Options include live line indicators, blown fuse tripping, solid state protective relays,
power factor correction capacitors, surge arresters, surge capacitors and a cable
grounding switch.

11-38
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Vacuum Substation Circuit Breakers Substation Circuit Breakers
Class 6065 / Refer to Document 1910BR0902
schneider-electric.us

Vacuum Substation Circuit Breakers—Type VOX (Not UL Listed)


Distribution companies are facing ever-increasing challenges to improve the service
quality and reduce operation cost of their network. VOX outdoor dead tank circuit
breakers provide a reliable, cost-effective solution for outdoor substation equipment. The
sealed-for-life, maintenance-free tank enables customers to reduce the cost of
inspection and maintenance. In addition, the high-endurance mechanism contributes to
further enhance the reliability of VOX reducing overall lifetime costs. Flexible and easy to
upgrade, VOX is the ideal, cost-effective choice for both dead and live tank applications,
especially when complex protection and current transformer schemes are needed.

Table 11.54: Vacuum Substation Circuit Breaker Ratings


Short-time Rating kA (3
Type Voltage (kV) Amperage (A) BIL seconds)
VOX 38 1200, 2000 150 (200) 12–40
VOX combines the best new and proven technology for outdoor distribution applications
up to 38 kV. This range of vacuum interrupters are housed in a fully welded, sealed-for-
life, stainless steel tank, providing a controlled gas insulated environment immune from
external influences such as salt, dust, humidity, small particles, and rodents. A spring
charged mechanism provides manual or motorized circuit breaker operation.
VOX has been designed and tested to meet the requirements of the relevant applicable
IEC, BS, AS, ANSI, IEEE, GOST, and GB standards.
Type VOX

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


11

11-39
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Overhead Distribution Recloser; Sectionalizer
Class 6000 / Refer to Document 6000BR1301
schneider-electric.us

Automatic Circuit Recloser


Overview
The Automatic Circuit Recloser combines state-of-the-art vacuum arc interruption with
integrated voltage and current measurement. These features are encased in a fully
welded and sealed, 316 grade, stainless steel tank. Three types of reclosers are
available: N-series (three-phase), U-series (three-phase), and W-series (single phase).

N-series U-series W-series

Applications
• Feeder automatic circuit recloser
• Substation automatic circuit recloser
• Loop automation
• Automatic change-over
11

• Smart grid
Load Break Switch/Sectionalizer
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR

Overview
The RL-series Load Break Switch/Sectionalizer is a switch used in conjunction with an
upstream recloser or circuit breaker. It counts the interruptions created by a recloser
during a fault sequence. On a preset count, the sectionalizer trips during the dead time of
the up stream recloser and isolates the faulty network section.

RL-series

Applications
• Manual load-break switch
• Motorized load-break switch
• Fully automated sectionalizer
• Normally-open tie point
Table 11.55: Ratings
Load Break Switch/
Automatic Circuit Recloser Sectionalizer
Attribute
N-series U-series W-series RL-series
Phases 3 1 3
Nominal Voltage (kV) 15, 27, 38 15, 27 15, 24 15, 27, 38
Continuous amperes (A) 800 630 400 630
Short-time rating (kA) 12.5/16 12.5 6 12.5/16
Insulation Gas Epoxy Epoxy Gas
Interruption Vacuum Gas
Operations (elec/mech) 10000/10000 600/5000

11-40
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Controller Medium Voltage Overhead Distribution
Class 6000 / Refer to Document 6000BR1301
schneider-electric.us

ADVC Controller
Overview
The ADVC controller offers advanced protection, measurement, diagnostic, and
communication features in a reliable package. Designed around the user, the controller
offers flexibility and choice. Users have a choice of two cubicle sizes (ULTRA and
COMPACT) and two operator interfaces (flexVUE and setVUE).
All the protection, monitoring, communication, diagnostic, and automation features are
included as standard in all models:
• ULTRA—large 316SS controller cubicle with two accessory mounting areas
• COMPACT—smaller 304SS controller cubicle with one accessory mounting area
• flexVUE—interface with 20 configurable status lamps and 12 quick action keys
• setVUE—large 4 x 40 LCD with familiar menu-driven operation

SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR


ADVC ULTRA Controller

Applications
The ADVC controller interfaces with the following:
• N-series recloser
• U-series recloser
• W-series recloser
• RL-series load break switch/sectionalizer

11

11-41
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
schneider-electric.us
11
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR

11-42
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents

Section 12
Busway
Powerbus™ Busway 12-2

Powerbus™ Busway 12-2


Powerbus Plug-In Units 12-3
Powerbus 100-400 A
Powerbus Plug-in Units with Metering 12-5
I-Line™ Busway 12-6

Standard Components 12-6


I-Line™ II Busway 12-7

800 A–5000 A Busway 12-7


I-Line™ II Straight Lengths, Fittings, and Accessories 12-7
800 A to 5000 A “Factory Assembled" Busway Systems (or
Components) 12-9
Additions, Accessories, and Electrical Data 12-10
I-Line Plug-in Busway 225-600 A
Electrical Data for I-Line II Busway 12-10
Plug-In Units 12-10
Fusible Plug-In Units, Class R Fuse Kits, and Hooksticks 12-10
Plug-in Style Surge Protective Device Plug-In Units 12-11
PowerPactTM H-, and J-Frame Plug-in Units 12-12
PowerPactTM H-, J-, and L-Frame Plug-in Units with Electronic Trip 12-13
H- , J-, and L-Frame Plug-In Units with Electronic Trip and
Communication 12-15
PowerPactTM M-Frame Plug-in Units with Basic Electronic Trip 12-15
PowerPactTM P-Frame Plug-in Units 12-16
PowerPactTM R-Frame Plug-in Units 12-17

Feeder Style
Power-Zone™ Busway 12-18

Non-Segregated Bus 12-18

Distinct service advantages make your Busway installation


“hassle-free”
• Missing Link program guarantees shipment in a maximum of 5 working days of a
small quantity of indoor feeder straight lengths and fittings. Orders for outdoor busway
or for international destinations may require 2 extra days for processing.
I-Line II Busway 800-5000 A • Measurement Services are offered for your critical and complex projects. Schneider
Electric will assist with field measurement and assume responsibility for the layout and

BUSWAY
exact fit of all components. Contact your local Schneider Electric sales office for exact
details.
• Emergency Service; we are on call 24 hours a day, 7 days a week, 365 days a year.
For emergencies, call 1-888-SquareD (1-888-778-2733).
• Quick Ship program provides product availability for time sensitive orders. The
program is available through the product selectors and offers a limited selection of I-
Line busway footage and fittings. Contact your local Schneider Electric sales office for
exact details.

I-Line Plug-in Units

12

Power-Zone Busway

© 2017 Schneider Electric


All Rights Reserved 12-1

11/10/2017
Powerbus™ Busway Powerbus™ Busway
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us

Powerbus Busway
Construction
Powerbus busway construction consists of a light-weight electrical grade all-aluminum
housing with up to five (5) silver-plated copper conductor bars for maximum electrical
efficiency. The total product offer includes straight sections, fittings, accessories, and
plug-in units for a total installation. This busway is available in 400 A, 225 A and 100 A
ratings. A 50% integral ground is standard.
Straight Sections
Straight sections of busway are available in 10 ft. and 4 ft. lengths in a painted black
finish. The Enhanced busway offer includes 10 plug-in openings on each side of a 10 ft.
section and 3 plug-in openings on each side of a 4 ft. section.
Metering and Communications Options

Single phase systems and DC systems are also available. Contact your local Schneider Electric representative.
Powerbus busway tap boxes and plug-in units are available with optional metering and
communication capabilities, which include an integrated display and the ability to
remotely monitor the busway.

Table 12.1: 3Ø3W—Powerbus Straight Lengths and Fittings—600 V Maximum


Amperage Component Configuration 3A–Catalog No.[1] Configuration 4B–Catalog No.[1]
Enhanced Straight 10 ft. PBCE3A100AST120B PBCE4B100AST120B
Enhanced Straight 4 ft. PBCE3A100AST048B PBCE4B100AST048B
Elbow – Left PBCF3A100ALLB PBCF4B100ALLB
100 A Elbow – Right PBCF3A100ALRB PBCF4B100ALRB
Cross Fitting PBCF3A100ACRB PBCF4B100ACRB
Tap Box PBCF3A100ATBB PBCF4B100ATBB
Tap Box w/Meter[2][3] PBCF3A100ATBM( )B PBCF4B100ATBM( )B
Enhanced Straight 10 ft. PBCE3A225AST120B PBCE4B225AST120B
Enhanced Straight 4 ft. PBCE3A225AST048B PBCE4B225AST048B
12

Elbow – Left PBCF3A225ALLB PBCF4B225ALLB


225 A Elbow – Right PBCF3A225ALRB PBCF4B225ALRB
Cross Fitting PBCF3A225ACRB PBCF4B225ACRB
Tap Box PBCF3A225ATBB PBCF4B225ATBB
Tap Box w/Meter[3] PBCF3A225ATBM( )B PBCF4B225ATBM( )B
Enhanced Straight 10 ft. PBCE3A400AST120B PBCE4B400AST120B
Enhanced Straight 4 ft. PBCE3A400AST048B PBCE4B400AST048B
Elbow – Left PBCF3A400ALLB PBCF4B400ALLB
400 A Elbow – Right PBCF3A400ALRB PBCF4B400ALRB
Cross Fitting PBCF3A400ACRB PBCF4B400ACRB
BUSWAY

Tap Box PBCF3A400ATBB PBCF4B400ATBB


Tap Box w/Meter[3] PBCF3A400ATBM( )B PBCF4B400ATBM( )B

Table 12.2: 3Ø4W—Straight Lengths and Fittings—600 V Maximum


Amperage Component Configuration 4A–Catalog No.[1] Configuration 5A–Catalog No.[1] Configuration 5B–Catalog No.[1]
Enhanced Straight 10 ft. PBCE4A100AST120B PBCE5A100AST120B PBCE5B100AST120B
Enhanced Straight 4 ft. PBCE4A100AST048B PBCE5A100AST048B PBCE5B100AST048B
Elbow – Left PBCF4A100ALLB PBCF5A100ALLB PBCF5B100ALLB
100 A Elbow – Right PBCF4A100ALRB PBCF5A100ALRB PBCF5B100ALRB
Cross Fitting PBCF4A100ACRB PBCF5A100ACRB PBCF5B100ACRB
Tap Box PBCF4A100ATBB PBCF5A100ATBB PBCF5B100ATBB
Tap Box w/Meter[2][3] PBCF4A100ATBM( )B PBCF5A100ATBM( )B PBCF5B100ATBM( )B
Enhanced Straight 10 ft. PBCE4A225AST120B PBCE5A225AST120B PBCE5B225AST120B
Enhanced Straight 4 ft. PBCE4A225AST048B PBCE5A225AST048B PBCE5B225AST048B
Elbow – Left PBCF4A225ALLB PBCF5A225ALLB PBCF5B225ALLB
225 A Elbow – Right PBCF4A225ALRB PBCF5A225ALRB PBCF5B225ALRB
Cross Fitting PBCF4A225ACRB PBCF5A225ACRB PBCF5B225ACRB
Tap Box PBCF4A225ATBB PBCF5A225ATBB PBCF5B225ATBB
Tap Box w/Meter[3] PBCF4A225ATBM( )B PBCF5A225ATBM( )B PBCF5B225ATBM( )B
Enhanced Straight 10 ft. PBCE4A400AST120B PBCE5A400AST120B PBCE5B400AST120B
Enhanced Straight 4 ft. PBCE4A400AST048B PBCE5A400AST048B PBCE5B400AST048B
Elbow – Left PBCF4A400ALLB PBCF5A400ALLB PBCF5B400ALLB
400 A
Elbow – Right PBCF4A400ALRB PBCF5A400ALRB PBCF5B400ALRB
Cross Fitting PBCF4A400ACRB PBCF5A400ACRB PBCF5B400ACRB
Tap Box PBCF4A400ATBB PBCF5A400ATBB PBCF5B400ATBB

[1] Busway catalog numbers shown include a black painted finish. Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for a natural aluminum finish option.
[2] For 100 A busway only, add an (L), for top cable access, or a (U), for bottom cable access, before the last letter in the catalog no., which is (B).
[3] Replace the ( ) in the Tap Box w/Meter catalog number with the meter suffix number in Table 12.3 Meter Suffix Number, page 12-3. The meter will be configured based on the system
voltage.
12-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Powerbus Plug-In Units Powerbus™ Busway
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us

Table 12.2 3Ø4W—Straight Lengths and Fittings—600 V Maximum (cont'd.)


Amperage Component Configuration 4A–Catalog No.[4] Configuration 5A–Catalog No.[4] Configuration 5B–Catalog No.[4]
Tap Box w/Meter[4] PBCF4A400ATBM( )B PBCF5A400ATBM( )B PBCF5B400ATBM( )B

Table 12.3: Meter Suffix Number


Meter Suffix System Voltage
1 208Y/120 V 3Ø4W
2 240 V 3Ø3W
4 415/240 V 3Ø4W
5 480Y/277 V 3Ø4W

Table 12.4: Accessories[5]


100 A 225 A 400 A
Description
Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
Standard Hanger PB100FH PB225FH PB400FH
Side Mount Hanger PB100HFW PB225HFW PB400HFW
Vertical Sway Brace PB100VSB PB225VSB PB400VSB
End Closure PB100AEC PB225AEC PB400AEC
Wall Flange PB100WF PB225WF PB400WF
Plug-in Opening Cover PBPIOCVR PBPIOCVR PBPIOCVR

Table 12.5: Hooksticks


Length Catalog No.
8' 515608
14' 515614
4'—8’ extension pole[6] PBHS0408
8'—15’ extension pole[6] PBHS0815

Powerbus Plug-In Units


Powerbus plug-in units are rated maximum 100 A and may be offered as field installable
or factory assembled units. All units conform to NEMA type 1. An optional kit is available
for FA and QO units to raise the protection to IP54. This kit raises the QOR unit to
moisture protection of IPX3.

Table 12.6: Plug-In Units—Circuit breakers not included


3 Spaces for QO/QOB
Space for One (1) 3 Spaces for Circuit Breakers
3 Phase FA Circuit QO/QOB Circuit 3 Openings for
Breaker Breakers Receptacles[7]
Busbar
Configuration

Tap Box[8] FA Unit QO Unit QOR Unit


Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
4B PBPTB4B100 PBPFA4B100 PBPQO4B100 PBPQOR4B100
3A PBPTB3A100 PBPFA3A100 PBPQO3A100 PBPQOR3A100
4A PBPTB4A100 PBPFA4A100 PBPQO4A100 PBPQOR4A100
5A PBPTB5A100 PBPFA5A100 PBPQO5A100 PBPQOR5A100

BUSWAY
Table 12.7: Factory Assembled Units with FA Circuit Breakers—600 V max[9]
Circuit 3A Configuration 4A Configuration 5A Configuration 5B Configuration
Breaker [10]
Rating Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
15 PBPFA3A100A015 PBPFA4A100A015 PBPFA5A100A015 PBPFA5B100A015
20 PBPFA3A100A020 PBPFA4A100A020 PBPFA5A100A020 PBPFA5B100A020
30 PBPFA3A100A030 PBPFA4A100A030 PBPFA5A100A030 PBPFA5B100A030
40 PBPFA3A100A040 PBPFA4A100A040 PBPFA5A100A040 PBPFA5B100A040
50 PBPFA3A100A050 PBPFA4A100A050 PBPFA5A100A050 PBPFA5B100A050
60 PBPFA3A100A060 PBPFA4A100A060 PBPFA5A100A060 PBPFA5B100A060
70 PBPFA3A100A070 PBPFA4A100A070 PBPFA5A100A070 PBPFA5B100A070
80 PBPFA3A100A080 PBPFA4A100A080 PBPFA5A100A080 PBPFA5B100A080
90 PBPFA3A100A090 PBPFA4A100A090 PBPFA5A100A090 PBPFA5B100A090

12
100 PBPFA3A100A100 PBPFA4A100A100 PBPFA5A100A100 PBPFA5B100A100

[4] Busway catalog numbers shown include a black painted finish. Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for a natural aluminum finish option.
[4] Replace the ( ) in the Tap Box w/Meter catalog number with the meter suffix number in Table 12.3 Meter Suffix Number, page 12-3. The meter will be configured based on the system
voltage.
[5] For the NetShelter TM IT Rack-Mounting Bracket, refer to 5600CT9101.
[6] For single-pole operation on QO and ED circuit breakers.
[7] Certain NEMA receptacles can be field installed in this unit. Consult your local Schneider Electric representative.
[8] Plug-in tap box to be installed on 100 A and 225 A busways only.
[9] See Digest Section 7, Table 7.147 QB, QD, QG, QJ, Q4, FA, LA, Circuit Breakers, page 7-76 for FA circuit breaker information.
[10] The 4B configuration catalog numbers are also available.
12-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Powerbus™ Busway Powerbus Plug-In Units
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us

Table 12.8: 120 V Factory Assembled Units: 1-pole QO/QOB circuit breakers with
NEMA 5-15R or 5-20R receptacles[11][12]
Circuit Breaker 4A Configuration 5A Configuration 5B Configuration
Rating Type Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
Type 1 (3 circuit breakers w. 3 duplex receptacles)
15 QO PBPQOR4A100M115 PBPQOR5A100M115 PBPQOR5B100M115
15 QOB PBPQOR4A100M115B PBPQOR5A100M115B PBPQOR5B100M115B
20 QO PBPQOR4A100M120 PBPQOR5A100M120 PBPQOR5B100M120
20 QOB PBPQOR4A100M120B PBPQOR5A100M120B PBPQOR5B100M120B
Type 2 (3 circuit breakers w. 2 duplex/1 locking recpt.)
15 QO PBPQOR4A100M215 PBPQOR5A100M215 PBPQOR5B100M215
15 QOB PBPQOR4A100M215B PBPQOR5A100M215B PBPQOR5B100M215B
20 QO PBPQOR4A100M220 PBPQOR5A100M220 PBPQOR5B100M220
20 QOB PBPQOR4A100M220B PBPQOR5A100M220B PBPQOR5B100M220B
Type 3 (3 circuit breakers w. 1 duplex/2 locking recpt.)
15 QO PBPQOR4A100M315 PBPQOR5A100M315 PBPQOR5B100M315
15 QOB PBPQOR4A100M315B PBPQOR5A100M315B PBPQOR5B100M315B
20 QO PBPQOR4A100M320 PBPQOR5A100M320 PBPQOR5B100M320
20 QOB PBPQOR4A100M320B PBPQOR5A100M320B PBPQOR5B100M320B
Type 4 (3 circuit breakers w. 3 locking receptacles)
15 QO PBPQOR4A100M415 PBPQOR5A100M415 PBPQOR5B100M415
15 QOB PBPQOR4A100M415B PBPQOR5A100M415B PBPQOR5B100M415B
20 QO PBPQOR4A100M420 PBPQOR5A100M420 PBPQOR5B100M420
20 QOB PBPQOR4A100M420B PBPQOR5A100M420B PBPQOR5B100M420B

Table 12.9: Factory Assembled Units: One (1) QOU circuit breaker and one (1) drop cord with connector[13][14]
Circuit Breaker NEMA Drop Cord 4A Configuration 5A Configuration 5B Configuration
Rating Poles Connector Length (ft) Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
15 A 1 L5-15 3 PBPQOU4A100COOL515 PBPQOU5A100COOL515 PBPQOU5B100COOL515
20 A 1 L5-20 3 PBPQOU4A100COOL520 PBPQOU5A100COOL520 PBPQOU5B100COOL520
30 A 1 L5-30 3 PBPQOU4A100COOL530 PBPQOU5A100COOL530 PBPQOU5B100COOL530
15 A 2 L6-15 3 PBPQOU4A100COOL615 PBPQOU5A100COOL615 PBPQOU5B100COOL615
20 A 2 L6-20 3 PBPQOU4A100COOL620 PBPQOU5A100COOL620 PBPQOU5B100COOL620
12

30 A 2 L6-30 3 PBPQOU4A100COOL630 PBPQOU5A100COOL630 PBPQOU5B100COOL630


20 A 3 L21-20 3 PBPQOU4A100COOL2120 PBPQOU5A100COOL2120 PBPQOU5B100COOL2120
30 A 3 L21-30 3 PBPQOU4A100COOL2130 PBPQOU5A100COOL2130 PBPQOU5B100COOL2130
15 A 1 L5-15 6 PBPQOU4A100FOOL515 PBPQOU5A100FOOL515 PBPQOU5B100FOOL515
20 A 1 L5-20 6 PBPQOU4A100FOOL520 PBPQOU5A100FOOL520 PBPQOU5B100FOOL520
30 A 1 L5-30 6 PBPQOU4A100FOOL530 PBPQOU5A100FOOL530 PBPQOU5B100FOOL530
15 A 2 L6-15 6 PBPQOU4A100FOOL615 PBPQOU5A100FOOL615 PBPQOU5B100FOOL615
20 A 2 L6-20 6 PBPQOU4A100FOOL620 PBPQOU5A100FOOL620 PBPQOU5B100FOOL620
30 A 2 L6-30 6 PBPQOU4A100FOOL630 PBPQOU5A100FOOL630 PBPQOU5B100FOOL630
20 A 3 L21-20 6 PBPQOU4A100FOOL2120 PBPQOU5A100FOOL2120 PBPQOU5B100FOOL2120
BUSWAY

30 A 3 L21-30 6 PBPQOU4A100FOOL2130 PBPQOU5A100FOOL2130 PBPQOU5B100FOOL2130

[11] Many more factory assembled units are available using combinations of 1P/2P/3P circuit breakers with other NEMA receptacles. Maximum of 3 breaker spacess available. Consult your
local Schneider Electric representative.
[12] See Digest Section 7, QO and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers, page for QOU circuit breaker information.
[13] Factory assembled units are available using combinations of 1P/2P/3P circuit breakers with other NEMA and IEC type receptacles. Maximum of three drop cords with six breaker spaces
available. Consult your local Schneider Electric representative.
[14] See Digest Section 7, QO and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers, page for QOU circuit breaker information. Catalog numbers shown have the breaker in the top slot in the front cover and
the drop cord in the left position in the base of the unit. Other combinations are available.
12-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Powerbus Plug-In Units Powerbus™ Busway
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us

Powerbus Plug-in Units with Metering


Powerbus plug-in units with metering are rated maximum 100 A and are offered as
factory assembled units. All units conform to NEMA type 1.

Table 12.10: Factory Assembled Units with NEMA Connectors and Metering[15][16]
Circuit Breaker NEMA Drop Cord Catalog Number[17][18]
Rating Poles Connector Length (ft) 4A Configuration 5A Configuration 5B Configuration
15 A 1 L5-15 3 PBPEDU4A100COOL515M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOL515M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOL515M( )
20 A 1 L5-20 3 PBPEDU4A100COOL520M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOL520M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOL520M( )
30 A 1 L5-30 3 PBPEDU4A100COOL530M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOL530M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOL530M( )
15 A 2 L6-15 3 PBPEDU4A100COOL615M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOL615M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOL615M( )
20 A 2 L6-20 3 PBPEDU4A100COOL620M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOL620M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOL620M( )
30 A 2 L6-30 3 PBPEDU4A100COOL630M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOL630M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOL630M( )
20 A 3 L21-20 3 PBPEDU4A100COOL2120M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOL2120M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOL2120M( )
30 A 3 L21-30 3 PBPEDU4A100COOL2130M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOL2130M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOL2130M( )
15 A 1 L5-15 6 PBPEDU4A100FOOL515M( ) PBPEDU5A100FOOL515M( ) PBPEDU5B100FOOL515M( )
20 A 1 L5-20 6 PBPEDU4A100FOOL520M( ) PBPEDU5A100FOOL520M( ) PBPEDU5B100FOOL520M( )
30 A 1 L5-30 6 PBPEDU4A100FOOL530M( ) PBPEDU5A100FOOL530M( ) PBPEDU5B100FOOL530M( )
15 A 2 L6-15 6 PBPEDU4A100FOOL615M( ) PBPEDU5A100FOOL615M( ) PBPEDU5B100FOOL615M( )
20 A 2 L6-20 6 PBPEDU4A100FOOL620M( ) PBPEDU5A100FOOL620M( ) PBPEDU5B100FOOL620M( )
30 A 2 L6-30 6 PBPEDU4A100FOOL630M( ) PBPEDU5A100FOOL630M( ) PBPEDU5B100FOOL630M( )
20 A 3 L21-20 6 PBPEDU4A100FOOL2120M( ) PBPEDU5A100FOOL2120M( ) PBPEDU5B100FOOL2120M( )
30 A 3 L21-30 6 PBPEDU4A100FOOL2130M( ) PBPEDU5A100FOOL2130M( ) PBPEDU5B100FOOL2130M( )

Table 12.11: Factory Assembled Units with IEC Connectors and Metering[15][16]
Circuit Breaker Drop Cord Catalog Number[18][20]
Rating Poles IEC 60309 Connector[19] Length (ft) 4A Configuration 5A Configuration 5B Configuration
20 2 2-Pole, 3-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS3420M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS3420M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS3420M( )
30 2 2-Pole, 3-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS3430M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS3430M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS3430M( )
60 2 2-Pole, 3-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS3460M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS3460M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS3460M( )
20 3 3-Pole, 4-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS4420M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS4420M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS4420M( )
30 3 3-Pole, 4-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS4430M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS4430M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS4430M( )
60 3 3-Pole, 4-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS4460M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS4460M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS4460M( )
20 3 4-Pole, 5-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS5420M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS5420M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS5420M( )
30 3 4-Pole, 5-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS5430M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS5430M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS5430M( )
60 3 4-Pole, 5-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS5460M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS5460M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS5460M( )

Table 12.12: Meter Suffix Number


Meter Suffix[21] System Voltage
1 208Y/120 V 3Ø4W
2 240 V 3Ø3W
4 415/240 V 3Ø4W
5 480Y/277 V 3Ø4W

Table 12.13: Gateway Plug-in Unit (480 V Max)[22]


4A Configuration 5A Configuration 5B Configuration
Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
PBPEGX4A100T PBPEGX5A100T PBPEGX5B100T

BUSWAY
Table 12.14: NEMA Receptacles and Connectors[23]
NEMA Non-Locking NEMA Locking
Wiring Voltage
15 A 20 A 30 A 15 A 20 A 30 A
2-pole, 3-wire grounding 120 5–15 5–20 5–30 L5–15 L5–20 L5–30
2-pole, 3-wire grounding 240 6–15 6–20 6–30 L6–15 L6–20 L6–20
3-pole, 4-wire grounding 120/240 14–15 14–20 14–30 — L14–20 L14–30
3-pole, 4-wire grounding 3Ø 240 15–15 15–20 15–30 — L15–20 L15–30
4-pole, 5-wire grounding 3ØY
120/208 — — — — L21–20 L21–30

Table 12.15: Short Circuit Current Rating[24]

12
Short-Circuit Current Rating
Product KA, RMS Symmetrical
UL 3–Cycle Test
100 A 14 kA
225 A 22 kA
400 A 35 kA

[15] See Digest Section 9, For NF Merchandised Panelboards, page 9-28 for ED circuit breaker information. Catalog numbers shown have the breaker in the top slot in the front cover and the
drop cord in the left position in the base of the unit. Other combinations are available. The Power Meter display will be located below the breaker space. For remote monitoring capabilities, a
gateway is required. The gateway is located in the tap box with metering or in a separate gateway plug-in unit listed below. The units with metering can be daisy-chained together back to the
gateway. A maximum of 30 units should be daisy-chained together to one gateway.
[16] Factory assembled units are available using combinations of 1P/2P/3P circuit breakers with other NEMA and IEC type receptacles. Maximum of three drop cords with three breaker spaces
available. Consult your local Schneider Electric representative.
[17] For IP54 splash resistant construction, add an "M54" suffix.
[18] For metering, replace ( ) in catalog number with the appropriate number in Table 12.12 Meter Suffix Number, page 12-5. Connectors must be rated for appropriate voltages.
[19] Other IEC Connectors are available.
[20] For the offer without metering, do not use the suffix “M” or any numbers following.
[21] Replace ( ) in above tables with the appropriate meter suffix number. Connectors must be rated for appropriate voltages.
[22] For remote monitoring capabilities, a gateway is required. The gateway is located in the tap box with metering or in a separate gateway plug-in unit listed above. Units with metering can be
daisy-chained together back to the gateway. A maximum of 30 units should be daisy-chained together to one gateway.
[23] Additional NEMA, IEC, and California Standard type receptacles and connectors are available.
[24] See 5600CT9101 for fuse and circuit breaker series connected ratings.
12-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ Busway Standard Components
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us

I-Line™ Standard Components and Accessories


Table 12.16: Standard Components—Aluminum
Aluminum
G G G G G G
PH PH PH PH PH PH
PH PH PH PH PH PH
PH PH PH PH PH PH
N N N N N N
Top Top Top
Front Top 1'-3"
1'-6" 1'-6" 1'-6"
10"
Front 10'-0" Front 6'-0"
Front
1'-6"
Number 10'-0" Length 6'-0" Length Front Elbow[1] Top Elbow[1] Plug-In Tee Plug-In Tap Box
Rating
of Poles (A)
and Voltage Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
225 AP30210 AP3026 AP302LF ( ) AP302LT( ) PTT23W PTB302
3Ø3W 400 AP30410 AP3046 AP304LF ( ) AP304LT( ) PTT33W PBTB306
600 AP30610 AP3066 AP306LF ( ) AP306LT( ) PTT43W PBTB306
225 AP50210 AP5026 AP502LF ( ) AP502LT( ) PTT24W PTB502
3Ø4W 400 AP50410 AP5046 AP504LF ( ) AP504LT( ) PTT34W PBTB506
600 AP50610 AP5066 AP506LF ( ) AP506LT( ) PTT44W PBTB506
225 AP302G10 AP302G6 AP302GLF ( ) AP302GLT( ) PTT23WG PTB302G
3Ø3W
+ Integral Ground Bus 400 AP304G10 AP304G6 AP304GLF ( ) AP304GLT( ) PTT33WG PBTB306G
600 AP306G10 AP306G6 AP306GLF ( ) AP306GLT( ) PTT43WG PBTB306G
3Ø4W 225 AP502G10 AP502G6 AP502GLF ( ) AP502GLT( ) PTT24WG PTB502G
400 AP504G10 AP504G6 AP504GLF ( ) AP504GLT( ) PTT34WG PBTB506G
+ Integral Ground Bus
600 AP506G10 AP506G6 AP506GLF ( ) AP506GLT( ) PTT44WG PBTB506G

Table 12.17: Standard Components—Copper


Copper
G G G G G G
PH PH PH PH PH PH
PH PH PH PH PH PH
PH PH PH PH PH PH
N N N N N N
Top Top Top
Front Top 1'-3"
1'-6" 1'-6" 1'-6"
10"
Front 10'-0" Front 6'-0"
Front
1'-6"
Number 10'-0" Length 6'-0" Length Front Elbow[1] Top Elbow[1] Plug-In Tee Plug-In Tap Box
of Poles Rating
(A) Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
and Voltage
225 CP30210 CP3026 CP302LF ( ) CP302LT( ) PTT23W PTB302
3Ø3W 400 CP30410 CP3046 CP304LF ( ) CP304LT( ) PTT33W PBTB306
600 CP30610 CP3066 CP306LF ( ) CP306LT( ) PTT33W PBTB306
12

225 CP50210 CP5026 CP502LF ( ) CP502LT( ) PTT24W PTB502


3Ø4W 400 CP50410 CP5046 CP504LF ( ) CP504LT( ) PTT34W PBTB506
600 CP50610 CP5066 CP506LF ( ) CP506LT( ) PTT34W PBTB506
3Ø3W 225 CP302G10 CP302G6 CP302GLF ( ) CP302GLT( ) PTT23WG PTB302G
400 CP304G10 CP304G6 CP304GLF ( ) CP304GLT( ) PTT33WG PBTB306G
+ Integral Ground Bus
600 CP306G10 CP306G6 CP306GLF ( ) CP306GLT( ) PTT33WG PBTB306G
225 CP502G10 CP502G6 CP502GLF ( ) CP502GLT( ) PTT24WG PTB502G
3Ø4W
400 CP504G10 CP504G6 CP504GLF ( ) CP504GLT( ) PTT34WG PBTB506G
+ Integral Ground Bus CP506GLF ( ) CP506GLT( )
600 CP506G10 CP506G6 PTT34WG PBTB506G

Table 12.18: Common Accessories


BUSWAY

Ampere Rating Hanger[2] End Closure Wall Flange Floor Flange


Aluminum Copper Flatwise Vertical Edgewise Seismic Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
 225  225 HP2F HP2V HP3E HP2SH ACP2EC ACP2WF ACP2FF
 400  400 HP3F HP3V HP3E HP3SH ACP3EC ACP3WF ACP3FF
—  600 HP3F HP3V HP3E HP3SH ACP3EC ACP3WF ACP3FF
 600 — HP5F HP4V HP5E HP5SH ACP4EC ACP4WF ACP4FF

[1] Add “I” for inside elbow; add “O” for outside elbow.
[2] For seismic applications, seismic hangers must be used with horizontal mount flatwise or edgewise busway. Vertical mount busway may use standard fixed or spring hangers.
12-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
800 A–5000 A Busway I-Line™ II Busway
Class 5615 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us

I-Line™ II Straight Lengths, Fittings, and Accessories


Table 12.19: Straight Lengths (10 ft.) and Plug-in Tap Box
Both Aluminum and
Aluminum Copper
Copper
G G G G G
PH PH PH PH PH
PH PH PH PH PH
PH PH PH PH PH
N N N N N
Number Ampere Top
of Poles Rating Top

10'0" 10'0" 10'0"

10'0" Length 10'0" Length


Plug-In Tap Box[1][2]
Feeder Style[3] Plug-In Style[4] Feeder Style[3] Plug-In Style[4]
Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
 800 AF2308G10ST AP2308G10ST PTB316G ( ) CF2308G10ST CP2308G10ST
1000 AF2310G10ST AP2310G10ST PTB316G ( ) CF2310G10ST CP2310G10ST
1200 AF2312G10ST AP2312G10ST PTB316G ( ) CF2312G10ST CP2312G10ST
1350 AF2313G10ST AP2313G10ST PTB316G ( ) CF2313G10ST CP2313G10ST
3Ø3W 1600 AF2316G10ST AP2316G10ST PTB316G ( ) CF2316G10ST CP2316G10ST
+ Integral 2000 AF2320G10ST AP2320G10ST — CF2320G10ST CP2320G10ST
Ground Bus
2500 AF2325G10ST AP2325G10ST — CF2325G10ST CP2325G10ST
3000 AF2330G10ST AP2330G10ST — CF2330G10ST CP2330G10ST
3200 — — — CF2332G10ST CP2332G10ST
4000 AF2340G10ST AP2340G10ST — CF2340G10ST CP2340G10ST
5000 — — — CF2350G10ST CP2350G10ST
 800 AF2508G10ST AP2508G10ST PTB516G ( ) CF2508G10ST CP2508G10ST
1000 AF2510G10ST AP2510G10ST PTB516G ( ) CF2510G10ST CP2510G10ST
1200 AF2512G10ST AP2512G10ST PTB516G ( ) CF2512G10ST CP2512G10ST
1350 AF2513G10ST AP2513G10ST PTB516G ( ) CF2513G10ST CP2513G10ST
3Ø4W 1600 AF2516G10ST AP2516G10ST PTB516G ( ) CF2516G10ST CP2516G10ST
+ Integral 2000 AF2520G10ST AP2520G10ST — CF2520G10ST CP2520G10ST
Ground Bus
2500 AF2525G10ST AP2525G10ST — CF2525G10ST CP2525G10ST
3000 AF2530G10ST AP2530G10ST — CF2530G10ST CP2530G10ST
3200 — — — CF2532G10ST CP2532G10ST
4000 AF2540G10ST AP2540G10ST — CF2540G10ST CP2540G10ST
5000 — — — CF2550G10ST CP2550G10ST

Table 12.20: Fittings (All Feeder Style)


Aluminum Copper

Number Ampere
of Poles Rating
End Tap Box Edgewise Elbow Flatwise Elbow End Tap Box Edgewise Elbow Flatters Elbow
Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
 800 AF2308GETBMB AF2308GLEM11 AF2308GLFM11 CF2308GETBMB CF2308GLEM11 CF2308GLFM11
1000 AF2310GETBMB AF2310GLEM11 AF2310GLFM12 CF2310GETBMB CF2310GLEM11 CF2310GLFM11
1200 AF2312GETBMB AF2312GLEM11 AF2312GLFM12 CF2312GETBMB CF2312GLEM11 CF2312GLFM12

BUSWAY
1350 AF2313GETBMB AF2313GLEM11 AF2313GLFM13 CF2313GETBMB CF2313GLEM11 CF2313GLFM12
3Ø3W 1600 AF2316GETBMB AF2316GLEM11 AF2316GLFM13 CF2316GETBMB CF2316GLEM11 CF2316GLFM12
with Integral 2000 AF2320GETBMB AF2320GLEM11 AF2320GLFM15 CF2320GETBMB CF2320GLEM11 CF2320GLFM13
Ground Bus 2500 AF2325GETBMB AF2325GLEM11 AF2325GLFM17 CF2325GETBMB CF2325GLEM11 CF2325GLFM15
3000 AF2330GETBMB AF2330GLEM11 AF2330GLFM18 CF2330GETBMB CF2330GLEM11 CF2330GLFM16
3200 — — — CF2332GETBMB CF2332GLEM11 CF2332GLFM17
4000 AF2340GETBMB AF2340GLEM11 AF2340GLFM22 CF2340GETBMB CF2340GLEM11 CF2340GLFM21
5000 — — — CF2350GETBMB CF2350GLEM11 CF2350GLFM21
 800 AF2508GETBMB AF2508GLEM11 AF2508GLFM11 CF2508GETBMB CF2508GLEM11 CF2508GLFM11
1000 AF2510GETBMB AF2510GLEM11 AF2510GLFM12 CF2510GETBMB CF2510GLEM11 CF2510GLFM11
1200 AF2512GETBMB AF2512GLEM11 AF2512GLFM12 CF2512GETBMB CF2512GLEM11 CF2512GLFM12
1350 AF2513GETBMB AF2513GLEM11 AF2513GLFM13 CF2513GETBMB CF2513GLEM11 CF2513GLFM12
3Ø4W 1600 AF2516GETBMB AF2516GLEM11 AF2516GLFM13 CF2516GETBMB CF2516GLEM11 CF2516GLFM12

12
with Integral 2000 AF2520GETBMB AF2520GLEM11 AF2520GLFM15 CF2520GETBMB CF2520GLEM11 CF2520GLFM13
Ground Bus 2500 AF2525GETBMB AF2525GLEM11 AF2525GLFM17 CF2525GETBMB CF2525GLEM11 CF2525GLFM15
3000 AF2530GETBMB AF2530GLEM11 AF2530GLFM18 CF2530GETBMB CF2530GLEM11 CF2530GLFM16
3200 — — — CF2532GETBMB CF2532GLEM11 CF2532GLFM17
4000 AF2540GETBMB AF2540GLEM11 AF2540GLFM22 CF2540GETBMB CF2540GLEM11 CF2540GLFM21
5000 — — — CF2550GETBMB CF2550GLEM11 CF2550GLFM21

Table 12.21: Accessories


Ampere Rating Hangers[5] End Closure Wall Flange
Horizontal Mount Busway Vertical Mount Busway
Al Cu Seismic Catalog No. Catalog No.
Flatwise Edgewise Fixed Spring
— 800 HF38F HF43E HFV HFVS1 HF38SH ACF38EC ACF38WF
800 1000 HF43F HF43E HFV HFVS1 HF43SH ACF43EC ACF43WF
1000 1200 HF53F HF58E HFV HFVS1 HF53SH ACF53EC ACF53WF
— 1350 HF58F HF58E HFV HFVS2 HF58SH ACF58EC ACF58WF
1200 — HF63F HF67E HFV HFVS1 HF63SH ACF63EC ACF63WF

[1] To complete the catalog number, replace the blank with an “H” for the plug-in unit to be mounted on horizontally—oriented busway and “V” for the plug-in unit to be mounted on vertically-
oriented busway.
[2] Cannot be used for 800 A copper busway.
[3] Feeder style available in lengths from 16 to 120 inches.
[4] Plug-in style also available in 4, 6, and 8 foot lengths.
[5] For seismic applications, seismic hangers must be used with horizontal mount flatwise or edgewise busway. Vertical mount busway may use standard fixed or spring hangers.
12-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ II Busway 800 A–5000 A Busway
Class 5615 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us

Table 12.21 Accessories (cont'd.)


Ampere Rating Hangers[6] End Closure Wall Flange
Horizontal Mount Busway Vertical Mount Busway
Al Cu Seismic Catalog No. Catalog No.
Flatwise Edgewise Fixed Spring
— 1600 HF67F HF67E HFV HFVS2 HF67SH ACF67EC ACF67WF
1350 — HF73F HF78E HFV HFVS1 HF73SH ACF73EC ACF73WF
— 2000 HF78F HF78E HFV HFVS2 HF78SH ACF78EC ACF78WF
1600 — HF88F HF88E HFV HFVS1 HF88SH ACF88EC ACF88WF
2000 — HF13F HF13E HFV HFVS2 HF13SH ACF13EC ACF13WF
— 2500 HF13F HF13E HFV HFVS8 HF13SH ACF13EC ACF13WF
2500 — HF16F HF16E HFV HFVS2 HF16SH ACF17EC ACF17WF
— 3000 HF15F HF15E HFV HFVS8 HF15SH ACF15EC ACF15WF
— 3200 HF16F HF16E HFV HFVS8 HF16SH ACF17EC ACF17WF
3000 — HF19F HF19E HFV HFVS8 HF19SH ACF19EC ACF19WF
4000 — HF26F HF26E HFV HFVS8 HF26SH ACF26EC ACF26WF
— 4000 HF24F HF24E HFV HFVS8 HF24SH ACF24EC ACF24WF
— 5000 HF25F HF26E HFV HFVS8 HF25SH ACF25EC ACF25WF
12
BUSWAY

[6] For seismic applications, seismic hangers must be used with horizontal mount flatwise or edgewise busway. Vertical mount busway may use standard fixed or spring hangers.
12-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
800 A to 5000 A “Factory Assembled" I-Line™ II Busway
Busway Systems (or Components)
schneider-electric.us Class 5615 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101

Standard Straight Lengths


The basic component of a busway system is a straight section with a “joint pak” factory-
affixed to one end. Plug-in busway is available in standard lengths of 4, 6, 8, and 10 feet.
Feeder busway is available in lengths from 16” to 120” in increments of 1”.
Riser Busway
We also offer a “Riser” Plug-In busway with openings on one side only for riser
installations. This busway offers the same short circuit ratings as our standard plug-in
busway.
Indoor Drip Resistant and IP54 Splash Resistant Busway
These water resistant features are available as an option for indoor plug-in and feeder
busway.
Outdoor Construction
Outdoor construction is only available in feeder busway. It prevents the entry of rain and
can be installed in any mounting position.
High Short Circuit Bracing
I-Line busway is available with either standard short circuit bracing or high short circuit
bracing. Electrical Data for I-Line II Busway, page 12-10 lists maximum short circuit
ratings for each busway type and rating.
Hangers
Indoor horizontal busway requires one hanger for every 10 feet of busway. Vertical
indoor busway requires one hanger for every 16 feet. Outdoor feeder busway requires
one hanger for every 5 feet in horizontal mounting and one hanger for every 10 feet in
vertical mounting.
Elbows
90° elbows are standard. 91° elbows to 179° elbows in 1° increments are also available.
Tee
90° flatwise tees fittings are standard. Edgewise tees and crosses are also available.
Indoor Tap Boxes
Feeder cable tap boxes are used at the end (-ETBMB) or center (-CTB) of a busway run
and incorporate a short section of busway into their construction. See 5600CT9101 for
the length of the tap box.
Plug-in cable tap boxes are plugged into the side of the busway (at any opening except
the very last opening of a run).
Lugs other than standard mechanical lugs are available.
Service Heads
Service heads are of outdoor construction and include Square D™ brand standard lugs.
Unfused Reducer

BUSWAY
Unfused reducers are used to reduce from a higher amperage busway to a lower
amperage.
NOTE: The National Electric Code does not allow the use of unfused reducers in
vertical riser installations. Refer to the NEC for restrictions in industrial installations.
Fused or Circuit Breaker Cubicle
These are used as in-line overcurrent protection devices. They can be used in
conjunction with an unfused reducer to offer a device which reduces a run of busway in
ampacity and offers overcurrent protection.
I-Line to I-Line II Adapter

12
This adapter is used to join I-Line II busway (800 A–5000 A) to existing installations of
original I-Line busway. If connecting to an existing “slot end” of original I-Line, use a “bolt
end” adapter (-12B), and vice versa.
Expansion Fittings
The expansion fitting is built into a 3 ft. – 4 in. straight length for 800 A–5000 A and a 5
feet – 0 inch straight length for 225 A–600 A. Limit of expansion or contraction is ±1-1/2
inches. Not available in outdoor construction.
Bussed Transformer Connection
A bussed transformer connection is used when the busway physically attaches (other
than cable) to a three phase transformer. For power company vault termination
information, consult the factory.
Transformer Taps
Transformer taps are used to make cable connection to transformers. Lugs other than
standard Square D brand lugs are available. Note that taps need NOT be located directly
above transformers for cable connections.
Finger Protection to IP2X
This feature provides improved protection from accidental contact with live parts during
insertion and removal of plug-in units. This feature meets the IP2X rating as defined by
IEC529 standard.
12-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ II Busway Additions, Accessories, and Electrical Data
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us

Connection to Competitive Busway


Consult your nearest Schneider Electric sales office.
Electrical Data for I-Line II Busway
Standards: UL857 (File Number E22182); CSA C22.2 No. 27-1994 (File Number LL-61778); IEC 61439–6
Systems: AC–3Ø3W, 3Ø4W, 1Ø2W, 1Ø3W. DC–2-pole. All neutrals are 100% capacity.
Voltage: 600 volts AC/DC, 50 Hz and 60 Hz
Integral 50% capacity as standard for 800 A to 5000 A, as an option on 225 A to 600 A
Ground:
Indoor, indoor drip resistant, indoor splash resistant (IP54), and outdoor (indoor drip resistant, indoor
Enclosure: splash resistant (IP54), and outdoor are available in I-Line II [800–5000 A] busway only)

Table 12.22: Short Circuit Ratings: UL 3 Cycle Test (KA, RMS Symmetrical)[7]
Aluminum Copper
Ampere APH CPH
Rating AOF2 AOFH AP COF2 COFH CP
AP2/AR2 APH2/ CF2 CFH2 CP2/CR2 CPH2/
AF2 AFH2 CRH2
ARH2
 225 — — 22 — — — 22 —
 400 — — 22 42 — — 22 42
 600 — — 22 42 — — 22 42
 800  50  85  50 75  50  85  50 75
1000  50 100  50 100  50  85  50 75
1200  50 100  50 100  50 100  50 100
1350  50 100  50 100  50 100  50 100
1600  50 100 50 100  50 100 50 100
2000 100 150 125 150  50 100 65 100
2500 100 150 125 150 100 150 125 150
3000 100 150 125 150 100 150 125 150
3200 — — — — 100 150 125 150
4000 150 200 200 — 150 200 200 —
5000 — — — — 150 200 200 —

Fusible Plug-In Units, Class R Fuse Kits, and Hooksticks


Table 12.23: Fusible Plug-In Units[8]
120/208 Vac, (240 277/480 Vac, (600
240 Vac 600 Vac
Ampere Type of 3-Pole, 3 Fuse + G Vac Max.) 3-Pole, 3 Fuse + G Vac Max.)
Rating Connection 4-Pole, 3 Fuse + G 4-Pole, 3 Fuse + G
Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
  30 PQ3203G PQ4203G PQ3603G PQ4603G
  60 PQ3206G PQ4206G PQ3606G PQ4606G
 100 PQ3210G PQ4210G PQ3610G PQ4610G
 200 Plug-in PQ3220G PQ4220G PQ3620G PQ4620G
 200[9] PS3220G [9] PS4220G [9] PS3620G [9] PS4620G [9]
 400 PBQ3640G [10] PBQ4640G [10] PBQ3640G [10] PBQ4640G [10]
 600 PBQ3660G [10] PBQ4660G [10] PBQ3660G [10] PBQ4660G [10]
PTQ36080G ( ) PTQ46080G ( )
 800 — — [11] [11]
PTQ36100G ( ) PTQ46100G ( )
1000 Bolt-on — — [11] [11]
PTQ36120G ( ) PTQ46120G ( )
1200 — — [11] [11]
Class J Fuses – Provisions for installing Class J fuses are included in 30 through 600 A fusible devices. Conversion
to Class J fuse spacing requires relocating the load side fuse base assembly from standard Class H fuse location to
an alternate position in the enclosure.
“Hook-Swing” Mounting
There are three different types of plug-in connections:
A
• High Ampere Bolt-On Connection (catalog numbers that begin with “PT”)—bolted
“joint pack” type connection
– Used on I-Line/I-Line II busway amperages 800 A aluminum and greater.
– Used on I-Line/I-Line II busway amperages 1000 A copper and greater.
B
• High Ampere Plug-In Connection (catalog numbers that begin with “PB”)—individual
bolted jaws for connections
• Low Ampere Plug-In Connection (catalog numbers that begin with “P,” except for “PB”
and “PT”)—spring pressure jaws for connection
C
A–High Ampere Plug-In Connection Table 12.24: Class R Fuse Kits[12]
B– High Ampere Bolt-On Connection
C– Low Ampere Plug-In Connection Switch Size (A) Voltage Rating Kit [12] Catalog No.
250 V [13] QMB30R
30 600 V [13] QMB36R
250 V [13] QMB36R
60 600 V [13] QMB60R
100
200 All HRK1020
400 QMB4060R
All
600
Class R Fuse Kits when installed reject all but class R fuses.

[7] 6–cycle and 30–cycle, and fuse/circuit breaker series connected ratings are available. Please reference 5600CT9101.
[8] For IP54 splash resistant construction, add an "M54" suffix.
[9] For use on vertical riser applications only.
[10] For vertical riser applications, order auxiliary mounting kit—Catalog Number PBQ4060RMK.
[11] This device uses bolt-on connection. It may be used only on plug-in busway with same number of poles. To complete the catalog number, replace the blank with an “H” for the plug-in unit to
be mounted on horizontally—oriented busway and “V” for the plug-in unit to be mounted on vertically-oriented busway. Not for use on 800 A copper busway.
[12] Kit must be field installed.
[13] Contains parts to convert two units.
12-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Plug-In Units I-Line™ II Busway
Class 5615, 5630 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us

Table 12.25: Hooksticks


Length Catalog No.
8' 515608
14' 515614

Surge Protective Device Plug-In Units


All Busway SPD Plug-In Units include as standard:
• Individually Fused Modules
• Circuit Breaker Disconnect
• Cover Mounted Diagnostic Panel
• EMI/RFI Filter
• Audible Alarm with Test/Disable/Enable
Table 12.26: Surge Capacity
160,000 Amperes Per Phase 240,000 Amperes Per Phase
System Voltage
Catalog Number[14] Catalog Number[14]
208Y/120 Vac, 3Ø4W/Grd. PIU2IMA16 PIU2IMA24
240Y/120 Vac, 3Ø4W/Grd. PIU3IMA16 PIU3IMA24
480Y/277 Vac, 3Ø4W/Grd. PIU4IMA16 PIU4IMA24
600Y/347 Vac, 3Ø4W/Grd. PIU8IMA16 PIU8IMA24

Table 12.27: Options


Description When Required Add Suffix to Catalog Number
Surge Counter and Dry Contacts —
Remote Monitor with Dry Contacts M

BUSWAY
12

[14] For IP54 splash resistant construction, add an "M54" suffix.


12-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ II Busway PowerPactTM H-, and J-Frame Plug-in Units
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us

H- and J-Frame Plug-In Units


Table 12.28: H-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units—Standard (80%) Rated—3Ø3W
Trip Rating D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting
Ampere Catalog No. [15] Catalog No. [15] Catalog No. [15] Catalog No. [15]
3Ø3W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
15 PHD36015G PHG36015G PHJ36015G PHL36015G
20 PHD36020G PHG36020G PHJ36020G PHL36020G
30 PHD36030G PHG36030G PHJ36030G PHL36030G
40 PHD36040G PHG36040G PHJ36040G PHL36040G
50 PHD36050G PHG36050G PHJ36050G PHL36050G
60 PHD36060G PHG36060G PHJ36060G PHL36060G
70 PHD36070G PHG36070G PHJ36070G PHL36070G
80 PHD36080G PHG36080G PHJ36080G PHL36080G
90 PHD36090G PHG36090G PHJ36090G PHL36090G
100 PHD36100G PHG36100G PHJ36100G PHL36100G
125 PHD36125G PHG36125G PHJ36125G PHL36125G
150 PHD36150G PHG36150G PHJ36150G PHL36150G

Table 12.29: H-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units—Standard (80%) Rated—3Ø4W


Trip Rating D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting
Ampere Catalog No. [15] Catalog No. [15] Catalog No. [15] Catalog No. [15]
3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac Max. 50/60 Hz
15 PHD36015GN PHG36015GN PHJ36015GN PHL36015GN
20 PHD36020GN PHG36020GN PHJ36020GN PHL36020GN
30 PHD36030GN PHG36030GN PHJ36030GN PHL36030GN
40 PHD36040GN PHG36040GN PHJ36040GN PHL36040GN
50 PHD36050GN PHG36050GN PHJ36050GN PHL36050GN
60 PHD36060GN PHG36060GN PHJ36060GN PHL36060GN
70 PHD36070GN PHG36070GN PHJ36070GN PHL36070GN
80 PHD36080GN PHG36080GN PHJ36080GN PHL36080GN
90 PHD36090GN PHG36090GN PHJ36090GN PHL36090GN
100 PHD36100GN PHG36100GN PHJ36100GN PHL36100GN
125 PHD36125GN PHG36125GN PHJ36125GN PHL36125GN
150 PHD36150GN PHG36150GN PHJ36150GN PHL36150GN

Table 12.30: J-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units—Standard (80%) Rated—3Ø3W


Trip Rating D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting
Ampere Catalog No. [15] Catalog No. [15] Catalog No. [15] Catalog No. [15]
3Ø3W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
175 PJD36175G PJG36175G PJJ36175G PJL36175G
200 PJD36200G PJG36200G PJJ36200G PJL36200G
225 PJD36225G PJG36225G PJJ36225G PJL36225G
250 PJD36250G PJG36250G PJJ36250G PJL36250G
12

Table 12.31: J-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units—Standard (80%) Rated—3Ø4W


Trip Rating D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting
Ampere Catalog No. [15] Catalog No. [15] Catalog No. [15] Catalog No. [15]
3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac Max. 50/60 Hz
175 PJD36175GN PJG36175GN PJJ36175GN PJL36175GN
200 PJD36200GN PJG36200GN PJJ36200GN PJL36200GN
225 PJD36225GN PJG36225GN PJJ36225GN PJL36225GN
250 PJD36250GN PJG36250GN PJJ36250GN PJL36250GN
BUSWAY

Table 12.32: Circuit Breaker Interrupting Ratings


Interrupting Ratings (kA) D G J L R
240 V 25 65 100 125 200
480 V 18 35 65 100 200
600 V 14 18 25 50 100

[15] For IP54 splash resistant construction, add an "M54" suffix.


12-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPactTM H-, J-, and L-Frame Plug-in I-Line™ II Busway
Units with Electronic Trip
schneider-electric.us Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101

H-, J-, and L-Frame Plug-In Units with Electronic Trip


Table 12.33: H- and J-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units with Electronic Trip—Standard (80%) Rated—3Ø3W
D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting
Trip Rating Trip Trip Unit
Ampere Function[16] [17] Catalog Number[18][19][20] Catalog Number[18][19] Catalog Number[18][19][20] Catalog Number[18][19][20]
[20]
Micrologic Standard Trip Unit
3Ø3W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
 60 PHD36060GU31X PHG36060GU31X PHJ36060GU31X PHL36060GU31X
 100 PHD36100GU31X PHG36100GU31X PHJ36100GU31X PHL36100GU31X
LI 3.2
 150 PHD36150GU31X PHG36150GU31X PHJ36150GU31X PHL36150GU31X
 250 PJD36250GU31X PJG36250GU31X PJJ36250GU31X PJL36250GU31X
 60 PHD36060GU33X PHG36060GU33X PHJ36060GU33X PHL36060GU33X
 100 PHD36100GU33X PHG36100GU33X PHJ36100GU33X PHL36100GU33X
LSI 3.2 S
 150 PHD36150GU33X PHG36150GU33X PHJ36150GU33X PHL36150GU33X
 250 PJD36250GU33X PJG36250GU33X PJJ36250GU33X PJL36250GU33X
Micrologic Ammeter Trip Unit
3Ø3W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
 60 PHD36060GU43X PHG36060GU43X PHJ36060GU43X PHL36060GU43X
 100 PHD36100GU43X PHG36100GU43X PHJ36100GU43X PHL36100GU43X
LSI 5.2 A
 150 PHD36150GU43X PHG36150GU43X PHJ36150GU43X PHL36150GU43X
 250 PJD36250GU43X PJG36250GU43X PJJ36250GU43X PJL36250GU43X
Micrologic Energymeter Trip Unit
3Ø3W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
 60 PHD36060GU53X PHG36060GU53X PHJ36060GU53X PHL36060GU53X
 100 PHD36100GU53X PHG36100GU53X PHJ36100GU53X PHL36100GU53X
LSI 5.2 E
 150 PHD36150GU53X PHG36150GU53X PHJ36150GU53X PHL36150GU53X
 250 PJD36250GU53X PJG36250GU53X PJJ36250GU53X PJL36250GU53X

Table 12.34: H- and J-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units with Electronic Trip—Standard (80%) Rated—3Ø4W
D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting
Trip Rating Trip Trip Unit
Ampere Function [16] [17] Catalog Number[18][19][20] Catalog Number[18][19] Catalog Number[18][19][20] Catalog Number[18][19][20]
[20]
Micrologic Standard Trip Unit
3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
 60 PHD36060GNU31X PHG36060GNU31X PHJ36060GNU31X PHL36060GNU31X
 100 PHD36100GNU31X PHG36100GNU31X PHJ36100GNU31X PHL36100GNU31X
LI 3.2
 150 PHD36150GNU31X PHG36150GNU31X PHJ36150GNU31X PHL36150GNU31X
 250 PJD36250GNU31X PJG36250GNU31X PJJ36250GNU31X PJL36250GNU31X
 60 PHD36060GNU33X PHG36060GNU33X PHJ36060GNU33X PHL36060GNU33X
 100 PHD36100GNU33X PHG36100GNU33X PHJ36100GNU33X PHL36100GNU33X
LSI 3.2 S
 150 PHD36150GNU33X PHG36150GNU33X PHJ36150GNU33X PHL36150GNU33X
 250 PJD36250GNU33X PJG36250GNU33X PJJ36250GNU33X PJL36250GNU33X
Micrologic Ammeter Trip Unit
3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
 60 PHD36060GNU43X PHG36060GNU43X PHJ36060GNU43X PHL36060GNU43X
 100 PHD36100GNU43X PHG36100GNU43X PHJ36100GNU43X PHL36100GNU43X
LSI 5.2 A
 150 PHD36150GNU43X PHG36150GNU43X PHJ36150GNU43X PHL36150GNU43X
 250 PJD36250GNU43X PJG36250GNU43X PJJ36250GNU43X PJL36250GNU43X
 60 PHD36060GNU44X PHG36060GNU44X PHJ36060GNU44X PHL36060GNU44X
 100 PHD36100GNU44X PHG36100GNU44X PHJ36100GNU44X PHL36100GNU44X
LSIG 6.2 A
 150 PHD36150GNU44X PHG36150GNU44X PHJ36150GNU44X PHL36150GNU44X

BUSWAY
 250 PJD36250GNU44X PJG36250GNU44X PJJ36250GNU44X PJL36250GNU44X
Micrologic Energymeter Trip Unit
3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
 60 PHD36060GNU53X PHG36060GNU53X PHJ36060GNU53X PHL36060GNU53X
 100 PHD36100GNU53X PHG36100GNU53X PHJ36100GNU53X PHL36100GNU53X
LSI 5.2 E
 150 PHD36150GNU53X PHG36150GNU53X PHJ36150GNU53X PHL36150GNU53X
 250 PJD36250GNU53X PJG36250GNU53X PJJ36250GNU53X PJL36250GNU53X
 60 PHD36060GNU54X PHG36060GNU54X PHJ36060GNU54X PHL36060GNU54X
 100 PHD36100GNU54X PHG36100GNU54X PHJ36100GNU54X PHL36100GNU54X
LSIG 6.2 E
 150 PHD36150GNU54X PHG36150GNU54X PHJ36150GNU54X PHL36150GNU54X
 250 PJD36250GNU54X PJG36250GNU54X PJJ36250GNU54X PJL36250GNU54X

12

[16] If alternate trip functions are required, contact your local Schneider Electric field office for pricing.
[17] For Trip Unit information, refer to Micrologic Trip Units, page 7-65.
[18] For communication capabilities, add the communication suffix as shown in Communication Suffix, page . The communication package will be configured based on the system voltage
specified by the communication suffix.
[19] For availability on 100% rated, see 5600CT9101.
[20] For IP54 splash resistant construction, add an "M54" suffix.
12-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ II Busway PowerPactTM H-, J-, and L-Frame Plug-in
Units with Electronic Trip
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101 schneider-electric.us

Table 12.35: L-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units with Electronic Trip—Standard (80%) Rated—3Ø3W
D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting R Interrupting
Trip Rating Trip
Trip Unit[22] Catalog Number[23][24] Catalog Number[23][24] Catalog Number[23] Catalog Number[23][24] Catalog Number[23][24]
Ampere Function[21]
[25][26] [25][26] [24][25][26] [25][26] [25][26]
Micrologic Standard Trip Unit
3Ø3W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
250 PBLD36250GU31X PBLG36250GU31X PBLJ36250GU31X PBLL36250GU31X PBLR36250GU31X
400 LI 3.3 PBLD36400GU31X PBLG36400GU31X PBLJ36400GU31X PBLL36400GU31X PBLR36400GU31X
600 PBLD36600GU31X PBLG36600GU31X PBLJ36600GU31X PBLL36600GU31X PBLR36600GU31X
250 PBLD36250GU33X PBLG36250GU33X PBLJ36250GU33X PBLL36250GU33X PBLR36250GU33X
400 PBLD36400GU33X PBLG36400GU33X PBLJ36400GU33X PBLL36400GU33X PBLR36400GU33X
LSI 3.3 S
600 PBLD36600GU33X PBLG36600GU33X PBLJ36600GU33X PBLL36600GU33X PBLR36600GU33X
Micrologic Ammeter Trip Unit
3Ø3W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
400 PBLD36400GU43X PBLG36400GU43X PBLJ36400GU43X PBLL36400GU43X PBLR36400GU43X
LSI 5.3 A
600 PBLD36600GU43X PBLG36600GU43X PBLJ36600GU43X PBLL36600GU43X PBLR36600GU43X
Micrologic Energymeter Trip Unit
3Ø3W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
400 PBLD36400GU53X PBLG36400GU53X PBLJ36400GU53X PBLL36400GU53X PBLR36400GU53X
LSI 5.3 E
600 PBLD36600GU53X PBLG36600GU53X PBLJ36600GU53X PBLL36600GU53X PBLR36600GU53X

Table 12.36: L-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units with Electronic Trip—Standard (80%) Rated—3Ø4W
D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting R Interrupting
Trip Rating Trip Trip Unit[22]
Ampere Function[21] Catalog Number[23][24] Catalog Number[23][24] Catalog Number[23][24] Catalog Number[23][24] Catalog Number[23][24]
[25][26] [25][26] [25][26] [25][26] [25][26]
Micrologic Standard Trip Unit
3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
250 PBLD36250GNU31X PBLG36250GNU31X PBLJ36250GNU31X PBLL36250GNU31X PBLR36250GNU31X
400 PBLD36400GNU31X PBLG36400GNU31X PBLJ36400GNU31X PBLL36400GNU31X PBLR36400GNU31X
LI 3.3
600 PBLD36600GNU31X PBLG36600GNU31X PBLJ36600GNU31X PBLL36600GNU31X PBLR36600GNU31X
250 PBLD36250GNU33X PBLG36250GNU33X PBLJ36250GNU33X PBLL36250GNU33X PBLR36250GNU33X
400 PBLD36400GNU33X PBLG36400GNU33X PBLJ36400GNU33X PBLL36400GNU33X PBLR36400GNU33X
LSI 3.3 S
600 PBLD36600GNU33X PBLG36600GNU33X PBLJ36600GNU33X PBLL36600GNU33X PBLR36600GNU33X
Micrologic Ammeter Trip Unit
3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
400 PBLD36400GNU43X PBLG36400GNU43X PBLJ36400GNU43X PBLL36400GNU43X PBLR36400GNU43X
LSI 5.3 A
600 PBLD36600GNU43X PBLG36600GNU43X PBLJ36600GNU43X PBLL36600GNU43X PBLR36600GNU43X
400 PBLD36400GNU44X PBLG36400GNU44X PBLJ36400GNU44X PBLL36400GNU44X PBLR36400GNU44X
LSIG 6.3 A
600 PBLD36600GNU44X PBLG36600GNU44X PBLJ36600GNU44X PBLL36600GNU44X PBLR36600GNU44X
Micrologic Energymeter Trip Unit
3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
400 PBLD36400GNU53X PBLG36400GNU53X PBLJ36400GNU53X PBLL36400GNU53X PBLR36400GNU53X
LSI 5.3 E
600 PBLD36600GNU53X PBLG36600GNU53X PBLJ36600GNU53X PBLL36600GNU53X PBLR36600GNU53X
400 PBLD36400GNU54X PBLG36400GNU54X PBLJ36400GNU54X PBLL36400GNU54X PBLR36400GNU54X
LSIG 6.3 E
600 PBLD36600GNU54X PBLG36600GNU54X PBLJ36600GNU54X PBLL36600GNU54X PBLR36600GNU54X
12
BUSWAY

[21] If alternate trip functions are required, contact your local Schneider Electric field office for pricing.
[22] For Trip Unit information, refer to Micrologic Trip Units, page 7-65.
[23] For communication capabilities, add the communication suffix as shown in Communication Suffix, page . The communication package will be configured based on the system voltage
specified by the communication suffix.
[24] For availability on 100% rated, see 5600CT9101.
[25] For IP54 splash resistant construction, add an "M54" suffix.
[26] For vertical riser applications, order auxiliary mounting kit—Catalog Number PBQ4060RMK.
12-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPactTM M-Frame Plug-in Units with I-Line™ II Busway
Basic Electronic Trip
schneider-electric.us Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
H- , J-, and L-Frame Plug-In Units with Electronic Trip and
Communication
Hardware communication packages are now available on Powerpact H-, J-, and
L-Frame Plug-in Units with Electronic Trip. These hardware communication packages
will provide you the capability to access and monitor circuit breaker data from these plug-
in units. The packages are available in Modbus and Ethernet.
Add the appropriate communication system voltage suffix to the end of the associated
H-, J-, or L-Frame breaker with electronic trip, for example: PHD36060GNU31XIFE4.

Table 12.37: Communication Suffix[27]


System Voltage Communication Type System Voltage Suffix
Communication
Suffix
Ethernet IFE
Up to 480Y/277 V 4
Modbus IFM
Ethernet IFE
480 V only 5
Modbus IFM
Ethernet IFE
600Y/347 V, 600 V 6
Modbus IFM

M-Frame Plug-In Units


Table 12.38: M-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units with Basic Electronic Trip Unit
(ET 1.0)—3Ø3W[28][29]
G Interrupting J Interrupting
Trip Rating Ampere
Catalog Number[30] Catalog Number[30]
3Ø3W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
300 PTMG36300G( ) PTMJ36300G( )
350 PTMG36350G( ) PTMJ36350G( )
400 PTMG36400G( ) PTMJ36400G( )
450 PTMG36450G( ) PTMJ36450G( )
500 PTMG36500G( ) PTMJ36500G( )
600 PTMG36600G( ) PTMJ36600G( )
700 PTMG36700G( ) PTMJ36700G( )
800 PTMG36800G( ) PTMJ36800G( )

Table 12.39: M-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units with Basic Electronic Trip Unit
(ET 1.0)—3Ø4W[28][29]
G Interrupting J Interrupting
Trip Rating Ampere
Catalog Number[30] Catalog Number[30]
3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
300 PTMG36300GN( ) PTMJ36300GN( )
350 PTMG36350GN( ) PTMJ36350GN( )
400 PTMG36400GN( ) PTMJ36400GN( )
450 PTMG36450GN( ) PTMJ36450GN( )
500 PTMG36500GN( ) PTMJ36500GN( )
600 PTMG36600GN( ) PTMJ36600GN( )
700 PTMG36700GN( ) PTMJ36700GN( )
800 PTMG36800GN( ) PTMJ36800GN( )

BUSWAY
12

[27] Communication packages are housed in a separate enclosure mounted adjacent to the plug-in units.
[28] The ET 1.0 trip unit cannot be field replaced or have the long-time trip point setting adjusted.
[29] All these devices use bolt-on connection. It may be used only on busway with same number of poles. Not for use on 800 A copper busway. To complete the catalog number, replace the
blank with an “H” for horizontal applications and “V” for vertical applications.
[30] For IP54 splash resistant construction, add an "M54" suffix.
12-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ II Busway PowerPactTM P-Frame Plug-in Units
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us

P-Frame Plug-In Units


Table 12.40: P-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units—3Ø3W[31]
Interrupting Rating
Trip Rating Ampere Trip Function[32] Trip Unit[33] G J
Catalog Number[34][35][36][37] Catalog Number[34][35][36][37]
Micrologic Standard Trip Unit
3Ø3W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
400 PTPG36040G( )U31A PTPJ36040G( )U31A
600 PTPG36060G( )U31A PTPJ36060G( )U31A
800 LI 3.0 PTPG36080G( )U31A PTPJ36080G( )U31A
1000 PTPG36100G( )U31A PTPJ36100G( )U31A
1200 PTPG36120G( )U31A PTPJ36120G( )U31A
400 PTPG36040G( )U33A PTPJ36040G( )U33A
600 PTPG36060G( )U33A PTPJ36060G( )U33A
800 LSI 5.0 PTPG36080G( )U33A PTPJ36080G( )U33A
1000 PTPG36100G( )U33A PTPJ36100G( )U33A
1200 PTPG36120G( )U33A PTPJ36120G( )U33A
Micrologic Ammeter Trip Unit
3Ø3W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
400 PTPG36040G( )U41A PTPJ36040G( )U41A
600 PTPG36060G( )U41A PTPJ36060G( )U41A
800 LI 3.0 A PTPG36080G( )U41A PTPJ36080G( )U41A
1000 PTPG36100G( )U41A PTPJ36100G( )U41A
1200 PTPG36120G( )U41A PTPJ36120G( )U41A
400 PTPG36040G( )U43A PTPJ36040G( )U43A
600 PTPG36060G( )U43A PTPJ36060G( )U43A
800 LSI 5.0 A PTPG36080G( )U43A PTPJ36080G( )U43A
1000 PTPG36100G( )U43A PTPJ36100G( )U43A
1200 PTPG36120G( )U43A PTPJ36120G( )U43A
400 PTPG36040G( )U44A PTPJ36040G( )U44A
600 PTPG36060G( )U44A PTPJ36060G( )U44A
800 LSIG 6.0 A PTPG36080G( )U44A PTPJ36080G( )U44A
1000 PTPG36100G( )U44A PTPJ36100G( )U44A
1200 PTPG36120G( )U44A PTPJ36120G( )U44A

Table 12.41: P-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units—3Ø4W


Interrupting Rating
Trip Rating Ampere Trip Function Trip Unit G J
Catalog Number[34][35][36] Catalog Number[34][35][36]
12

Micrologic Standard Trip Unit


3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
400 PTPG36040GN( )U31A PTPJ36040GN( )U31A
600 PTPG36060GN( )U31A PTPJ36060GN( )U31A
800 LI 3.0 PTPG36080GN( )U31A PTPJ36080GN( )U31A
1000 PTPG36100GN( )U31A PTPJ36100GN( )U31A
1200 PTPG36120GN( )U31A PTPJ36120GN( )U31A
400 PTPG36040GN( )U33A PTPJ36040GN( )U33A
600 PTPG36060GN( )U33A PTPJ36060GN( )U33A
800 LSI 5.0 PTPG36080GN( )U33A PTPJ36080GN( )U33A
BUSWAY

1000 PTPG36100GN( )U33A PTPJ36100GN( )U33A


1200 PTPG36120GN( )U33A PTPJ36120GN( )U33A
Micrologic Ammeter Trip Unit
3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
400 PTPG36040GN( )U41A PTPJ36040GN( )U41A
600 PTPG36060GN( )U41A PTPJ36060GN( )U41A
800 LI 3.0 A PTPG36080GN( )U41A PTPJ36080GN( )U41A
1000 PTPG36100GN( )U41A PTPJ36100GN( )U41A
1200 PTPG36120GN( )U41A PTPJ36120GN( )U41A
400 PTPG36040GN( )U43A PTPJ36040GN( )U43A
600 PTPG36060GN( )U43A PTPJ36060GN( )U43A
800 LSI 5.0 A PTPG36080GN( )U43A PTPJ36080GN( )U43A
1000 PTPG36100GN( )U43A PTPJ36100GN( )U43A
1200 PTPG36120GN( )U43A PTPJ36120GN( )U43A
400 PTPG36040GN( )U44A PTPJ36040GN( )U44A
600 PTPG36060GN( )U44A PTPJ36060GN( )U44A
800 LSIG 6.0 A PTPG36080GN( )U44A PTPJ36080GN( )U44A
1000 PTPG36100GN( )U44A PTPJ36100GN( )U44A
1200 PTPG36120GN( )U44A PTPJ36120GN( )U44A

[31] The 250 A is available as a special device. Contact your local Schneider Electric field office for ordering information.
[32] If alternate trip functions are required, contact your local Schneider Electric field office for pricing.
[33] For Trip Unit information, refer to Micrologic Trip Units, page 7-65.
[34] Listed catalog numbers are for 80% rated circuit breakers. For 100% rated circuit breakers, replace the blank with an “HC” for horizontal applications and “VC” for vertical applications. For
example, the catalog number for a 100% standard trip unit with standard LI trip functions at 800 A 3Ø3W for a horizontal application would be PTPG36080GHCU31A.
[35] The standard rating plug supplied with a trip unit will be the "A" rating plug. To specify an alternative rating plug, replace the "A" at the end of the catalog number with the applicable suffix
letter. See Table 7.132 Rating Plugs, page 7-69 for rating plug catalog suffix letters.
[36] All these devices use bolt-on connection. It may be used only on busway with same number of poles. Not for use on 800 A copper busway. To complete the catalog number, replace the
blank with an “H” for horizontal applications and “V” for vertical applications.
[37] For IP54 splash resistant construction, add an "M54" suffix.
12-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPactTM R-Frame Plug-in Units I-Line™ II Busway
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us

R-Frame Plug-In Units


Table 12.42: R-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units—3Ø3W[38]
Interrupting Rating
Trip Rating Ampere Trip Function Trip Unit G J L
Catalog Number[39][40][41][42] Catalog Number[39][40][41][42] Catalog Number[39][40][41][42]
Micrologic Standard Trip Unit
3Ø3W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
800 PTRG36080G( )U31A PTRJ36080G( )U31A PTRL36080G( )U31A
1000 PTRG36100G( )U31A PTRJ36100G( )U31A PTRL36100G( )U31A
LI 3.0
1200 PTRG36120G( )U31A PTRJ36120G( )U31A PTRL36120G( )U31A
1600 PTRG36160G( )U31A PTRJ36160G( )U31A PTRL36160G( )U31A
800 PTRG36080G( )U33A PTRJ36080G( )U33A PTRL36080G( )U33A
1000 PTRG36100G( )U33A PTRJ36100G( )U33A PTRL36100G( )U33A
LSI 5.0
1200 PTRG36120G( )U33A PTRJ36120G( )U33A PTRL36120G( )U33A
1600 PTRG36160G( )U33A PTRJ36160G( )U33A PTRL36160G( )U33A
Micrologic Ammeter Trip Unit
3Ø3W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
800 PTRG36080G( )U41A PTRJ36080G( )U41A PTRL36080G( )U41A
1000 PTRG36100G( )U41A PTRJ36100G( )U41A PTRL36100G( )U41A
LI 3.0 A
1200 PTRG36120G( )U41A PTRJ36120G( )U41A PTRL36120G( )U41A
1600 PTRG36160G( )U41A PTRJ36160G( )U41A PTRL36160G( )U41A
800 PTRG36080G( )U43A PTRJ36080G( )U43A PTRL36080G( )U43A
1000 PTRG36100G( )U43A PTRJ36100G( )U43A PTRL36100G( )U43A
LSI 5.0 A
1200 PTRG36120G( )U43A PTRJ36120G( )U43A PTRL36120G( )U43A
1600 PTRG36160G( )U43A PTRJ36160G( )U43A PTRL36160G( )U43A
800 PTRG36080G( )U44A PTRJ36080G( )U44A PTRL36080G( )U44A
1000 PTRG36100G( )U44A PTRJ36100G( )U44A PTRL36100G( )U44A
LSIG 6.0 A
1200 PTRG36120G( )U44A PTRJ36120G( )U44A PTRL36120G( )U44A
1600 PTRG36160G( )U44A PTRJ36160G( )U44A PTRL36160G( )U44A

Table 12.43: R-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units—3Ø4W[38]


Interrupting Rating
Trip Rating Ampere Trip Function Trip Unit G J L
Catalog Number[39][40][41][42] Catalog Number[39][40][41][42] Catalog Number[39][40][41][42]
Micrologic Standard Trip Unit
3Ø4W + G, 277/480 Vac (600 Vac Max.) 50/60 Hz
800 PTRG36080GN( )U31A PTRJ36080GN( )U31A PTRL36080GN( )U31A
1000 PTRG36100GN( )U31A PTRJ36100GN( )U31A PTRL36100GN( )U31A
LI 3.0
1200 PTRG36120GN( )U31A PTRJ36120GN( )U31A PTRL36120GN( )U31A
1600 PTRG36160GN( )U31A PTRJ36160GN( )U31A PTRL36160GN( )U31A
800 PTRG36080GN( )U33A PTRJ36080GN( )U33A PTRL36080GN( )U33A
1000 PTRG36100GN( )U33A PTRJ36100GN( )U33A PTRL36100GN( )U33A
LSI 5.0
1200 PTRG36120GN( )U33A PTRJ36120GN( )U33A PTRL36120GN( )U33A
1600 PTRG36160GN( )U33A PTRJ36160GN( )U33A PTRL36160GN( )U33A
Micrologic Ammeter Trip Unit
3Ø4W + G, 277/480 Vac (600 Vac Max.) 50/60 Hz

BUSWAY
800 PTRG36080GN( )U41A PTRJ36080GN( )U41A PTRL36080GN( )U41A
1000 PTRG36100GN( )U41A PTRJ36100GN( )U41A PTRL36100GN( )U41A
LI 3.0 A
1200 PTRG36120GN( )U41A PTRJ36120GN( )U41A PTRL36120GN( )U41A
1600 PTRG36160GN( )U41A PTRJ36160GN( )U41A PTRL36160GN( )U41A
800 PTRG36080GN( )U43A PTRJ36080GN( )U43A PTRL36080GN( )U43A
1000 PTRG36100GN( )U43A PTRJ36100GN( )U43A PTRL36100GN( )U43A
LSI 5.0 A
1200 PTRG36120GN( )U43A PTRJ36120GN( )U43A PTRL36120GN( )U43A
1600 PTRG36160GN( )U43A PTRJ36160GN( )U43A PTRL36160GN( )U43A
800 PTRG36080GN( )U44A PTRJ36080GN( )U44A PTRL36080GN( )U44A
1000 PTRG36100GN( )U44A PTRJ36100GN( )U44A PTRL36100GN( )U44A
LSIG 6.0 A
1200 PTRG36120GN( )U44A PTRJ36120GN( )U44A PTRL36120GN( )U44A
1600 PTRG36160GN( )U44A PTRJ36160GN( )U44A PTRL36160GN( )U44A

12

[38] The 600 A is available as a special device. Contact your local Schneider Electric field office for ordering information.
[39] Listed catalog numbers are for 80% rated circuit breakers. For 100% rated circuit breakers, replace the blank with an “HC” for horizontal applications and “VC” for vertical applications. For
example, the catalog number for a 100% standard trip unit with standard LI trip functions at 800 A 3Ø3W for a horizontal application would be PTPG36080GHCU31A.
[40] The standard rating plug supplied with a trip unit will be the "A" rating plug. To specify an alternative rating plug, replace the "A" at the end of the catalog number with the applicable suffix
letter. See Table 7.132 Rating Plugs, page 7-69 for rating plug catalog suffix letters.
[41] All these devices use bolt-on connection. It may be used only on busway with same number of poles. Not for use on 800 A copper busway. To complete the catalog number, replace the
blank with an “H” for horizontal applications and “V” for vertical applications.
[42] For IP54 splash resistant construction, add an "M54" suffix.
12-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power-Zone™ Busway Non-Segregated Bus
Class 6090 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us

Non-Segregated Bus
• Non-segregated phase bus
• 600 V through 38 kV (1200 A–6000 A)
• Aluminum, steel or stainless steel housing
• Aluminum or copper bus bars
• Insulated with fluidized bed epoxy (5 kV–38 kV)
• Complete line of fittings provides for any configuration
• Indoor trapeze and outdoor column supports
• For use in utilities, industrial and commercial facilities

Power-Zone bus is custom designed, manufactured and tested per ANSI C37.23
standards to meet customer specifications. The 600 V product is also UL Listed. It is a
completely coordinated package of equipment with all the auxiliary material and supports
for connecting transformers, switchgear, MCCs, and motors, in all types of utility,
industrial, and commercial facilities.

Bus Options
Some available options are special momentary rating, special housing material and/or
finish, special conductor supports, heaters and thermostats, and ground bus.

Weatherproof Bus
12

All weatherproof runs must be equipped with strip heaters to eliminate condensation and,
if applicable, a thermostat. A heater should be used for every seven (7) foot of bus and
no more than 20 heaters can be controlled by one thermostat. Also, each bus run should
have its own thermostat. The heaters are rated 240 V, 500 watts and operate at 120 V,
125 watts.

Flanged Ends
A flanged end is used to terminate the bus into switchgear, motor control centers,
BUSWAY

switchboards, or any rigid bus-to-bus connection. It consists of a gasketed equipment


flange, up to 1'-0" of 3Ø3W conductor (3Ø4W as applicable), necessary insulation tapes,
and required bolting hardware.

Cable Tap Box


A cable tap box includes a gasketed and accessible termination box, lugs, necessary
insulation tape (between bus and lugs only), and required bolting hardware. Lug sizes
and quantity should be specified by purchaser.

Transformer/Generator Connection
This type of termination should be used whenever the bus is connecting to a transformer,
generator, motor, switch or any connection where the bus bars are connecting to
porcelain mounted equipment terminals. It will include the same components as a
flanged end plus one set of flexible braid type connectors and a terminal box (if required).

Bushing Box (Weatherhead)


A bushing box is used on service entrance run where the cable connection to the bus
must be made via porcelain bushings. It is comprised of the same components as a
transformer connection plus 3 through stud type apparatus bushings, bushing stud
connectors (lug pads) and a strip heater.

12-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Non-Segregated Bus Power-Zone™ Busway
Class 6090 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us

Ground Bus
The bus housing is designed and constructed to provide an electrically continuous
ground path. The side rails of the bus housings are capable of carrying the full rated
phase current continuously and, under short circuit conditions, are capable of carrying up
to 60 kA RMS asymmetrical fault current for 3 seconds. Consequently, a separate
ground bus is not necessary unless specified.

Wall Entrance Seal


A wall entrance seal consists of a wall throat, wall flange (one side of wall only), and a
barrier which prevents air or vapor from passing from one room to another or from
outdoors to indoors. It also carries a 1/2 hour fire rating. Consult factory for higher fire
ratings.

Table 12.44: Wall Flange


Description
Optional (in addition to wall entrance seal)
Aluminum
14 Gauge Steel
14 Gauge 304 Stainless Steel
14 Gauge 316 Stainless Steel

Equipment Entrance Seal


An equipment entrance seal should be used whenever a barrier is required to prevent
the passing of flame and/or gasses between the bus housing and the terminating
equipment.

Expansion Fittings
An expansion fitting is used to counteract the strain placed on the bus due to the
expansion and contraction of the building or the bus itself. One should be used whenever
the bus run crosses a building expansion joint and whenever a straight run of bus
exceeds 60 feet.

Flexible Housing (Misalignment) Collar


Required at terminations or wall penetrations when vibrations due to seismic forces may
cause damage to the bus. It may also be used to adjust for the “settling” of terminating
equipment after installation.

Supporting Steel (Hangers)


Supports should be added on the basis of one for every 10 ft. for indoor and one for
every 12 ft. for outdoor. Indoor supports are a trapeze type hanger while outdoor
supports are a single or double column type support. Consult factory for other type
supports.

BUSWAY
Table 12.45: Hangers/Supports
Support Description Maximum Height Options
Indoor Trapeze Hanger —
Outdoor, Single
Column Support 12 feet
Outdoor, Double
Column Support 22 feet

Hazardous or Seismic Locations


Consult factory for bus runs which are to be installed in a location which is classified as
hazardous or in a seismic location.

12

12-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power-Zone™ Busway Non-Segregated Bus
Class 6090 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us

Standard Construction
Standard construction is as follows:
• Conductor (plating): Copper (silver) or Aluminum (tin)
• Conductor Insulation (5 kV through 38 kV only): epoxy
• Conductor
kV)
Supports: Glass reinforced polyester blocks (5 kV and 15 kV); porcelain (38

• Housing Material: Extruded Aluminum (1/8-inch Nominal)


• Housing Construction: Totally Enclosed Non-ventilated
• Joint Insulation: EPR and PVC tape
• BIL Rating: 30 kV (600 V), 60 kV (5 kV) and 95 kV (15 kV)
• Momentary (Short Circuit) Rating: 75 kA (600 V), 60 kA (5 kV, 15 kV), and 39 kA (38
kV)
• Ground Conductor: Housing (100% rated)
Table 12.46: Bus Enclosures
Material and Finish
Painted Aluminum (1/8” Nominal)
Painted 14 Gauge Steel
Painted 11 Gauge Steel
Painted 14 Gauge 304 Stainless Steel
Painted 14 Gauge 316 Stainless Steel

Table 12.47: Momentary (Asymmetrical Short Circuit) Ratings


Voltage Class Ampere Options
75 kA
600 V 100 kA
125 kA
150 kA
60 kA
5 kV 80 kA
15 kV 100 kA
150 kA
39 kA
49 kA
38 kV 62 kA
100 kA
12
BUSWAY

12-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents

Section 13
Wire Management
Wireway 13-2

General Purpose—NEMA Type 1 13-2


Oiltight—NEMA Type 12 13-3
Raintight Wireway—NEMA Type 3R 13-4
Raintight Trough—NEMA Type 3R 13-4
Wireway Wall Duct 13-4

Wall Duct General Description 13-4


Components and Accessories 13-5
Wall Duct Accessories 13-6
Trench Duct 13-7

Trench Duct General Description 13-7


Trench Duct Fittings 13-7
Accessories and Components 13-8

Wa ll Duct

Tre nch Duct

WIRE MANAGEMENT
13

© 2017 Schneider Electric


All Rights Reserved 13-1

11/10/2017
Wireway Non-Segregated Bus
Class 5100 / Refer to Catalog 5100CT0101
schneider-electric.us

General Purpose—NEMA Type 1


Standards
Square-Duct wireway is Underwriters Laboratories listed as steel enclosed wireway and
auxiliary gutter. CSA listing is also available.

Painted Hinge-Cover
Type LDB—ANSI 61 Gray
Polyester Powder Finish

Sizes
2-1/2”, 4”, and 6” sizes are manufactured from 16 gauge steel. Straight lengths are
available with or without knockouts. Knockouts are of various sizes in sides and bottom
of wireway. 8”, 10”, and 12” sizes are made of 14 gauge steel and are furnished without
knockouts.
Table 13.1: General Purpose (Connectors not supplied; order separately)[1][2]
2-1/2" x 2-1/2" 4" x 4" 6" x 6" 8" x 8" 10" x 10" 12" x 12"[3]
Component Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
With Without With Without With Without Without Without Without
Knockouts Knockouts Knockouts Knockouts Knockouts Knockouts Knockouts Knockouts Knockouts
1' Length LDB21KO LDB21 LDB41KO LDB41 LDB61KO LDB61 LDB81 LDB101 LDB121
2' Length LDB22KO LDB22 LDB42KO LDB42 LDB62KO LDB62 LDB82 LDB102 LDB122
3' Length LDB23KO LDB23 LDB43KO LDB43 LDB63KO LDB63 LDB83 LDB103 LDB123
4' Length LDB24KO LDB24 LDB44KO LDB44 LDB64KO LDB64 LDB84 LDB104 LDB124
5' Length LDB25KO LDB25 LDB45KO LDB45 LDB65KO LDB65 LDB85 LDB105 LDB125
6' Length — — LDB46KO LDB46 LDB66KO LDB66 LDB86 LDB106 —
10' Length LDB210KO LDB210 LDB410KO LDB410 LDB610KO LDB610 LDB810 LDB1010 LDB1210
90o L — LDB290L — LDB490L — LDB690L LDB890L LDB1090L LDB1290L
90o Sweep L — LDB290LS — LDB490LS — LDB690LS LDB890LS LDB1090LS LDB1290LS
45o L — LDB245L — LDB445L — LDB645L LDB845L LDB1045L LDB1245L
Tee — LDB2T — LDB4T — LDB6T LDB8T LDB10T LDB12T
Junction Box — LDB2J — LDB4J — LDB6J LDB8J LDB10J LDB12J
Telescope Ftg. — LDB2TF — LDB4TF — LDB6TF LDB8TF LDB10TF LDB12TF
Connector[2] — LDB2C — LDB4C — LDB6C LDB8C LDB10C LDB12C
Drop/Brkt Hgr. — LDB2H — LDB4H — LDB6H LDB8H LDB10H LDB12H
Support Hanger — LDB2SH — LDB4SH — LDB6SH LDB8SH LDB10SH LDB12SH
Closing Plate LDB2CPKO LDB2CP LDB4CPKO LDB4CP LDB6CPKO LDB6CP LDB8CP[4] LDB10CP[4] LDB12CP[4]
Panel Adapter — LDB2A — LDB4A — LDB6A LDB8A LDB10A LDB12A
Open Adapter — LDB2OA — LDB4OA — LDB6OA LDB8OA LDB10OA LDB12OA
— — — LDB42R — LDB64R LDB86R LDB108R LDB1210R
Reducer
— — — — — — — — LDB128R
Adapter
to “LD”[5] — LDB2GASK — LDB4GAS — LDB6GAS LDB8GASK LDB10GASK —
Barrier Kit—5 ft.
long w/hardware — — — LJB45B — LJB65B LJB85B — —
5 pc. Barrier
Pack—5 ft. long — — — LJB45BKM — LJB65BKM — — —
13

5 pc. Barrier Bracket—


2 compartment — — — LJB4BB2C — LJB6BB2C — — —
5 pc. Barrier
Bracket— — — — LJB4BB3C — LJB6BB3C — — —
3 compartment
WIRE MANAGEMENT

[1] For wireway fill information, see NEC 376.


[2] Add connectors for all lengths and fittings, except closing plates, reducers, and adapters.
[3] Painted 12" x 12" wireway is not furnished with hinge-cover (screw-cover only).
[4] These closing plates also available with knockout. Add "KO" to cat #.
[5] Adapters to competitors’ wireways also available. Contact your nearest Schneider Electric sales office for availability.
13-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Non-Segregated Bus Wireway
Class 5100 / Refer to Catalog 5100CT0101
schneider-electric.us

Oiltight—NEMA Type 12
Type LJB Oiltight lay-in wireway is fully gasketed and used to protect runs of electrical
wiring from oil, water, coolants, dirt, or dust as well as physical damage. This wireway is
manufactured to exceed oiltight and NFPA standards for industrial control equipment.
Lengths and fittings are made of 14 gauge steel with 10 gauge end flanges. Straight
lengths and fittings have hinged covers with oil resistant gasket all around and are held
closed with pull-down latches. All lengths and fittings are without knockouts. Type LJB
lay-in Wireway is finished with ANSI-61 gray polyester powder finish over a corrosion
resistant phosphate preparation. All Type LJB oiltight wireway is UL listed as steel
enclosed wireway and auxiliary gutter. Conforms to NEMA Type 12.

Table 13.2: Type LJB Lay-in [6]


2-1/2" x 2-1/2" 4" x 4" 6" x 6" 8" x 8" 12" x 6"
Description
Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
1" Nipple LJB201 LJB401 LJB601 — —
2" Nipple LJB202 LJB402 LJB602 — —
3" Nipple LJB203 LJB403 LJB603 — —
6" Length LJB206 LJB406 LJB606 LJB806 LJB12606
1' Length LJB21 LJB41 LJB61 LJB81 LJB1261
2' Length LJB22 LJB42 LJB62 LJB82 LJB1262
3' Length LJB23 LJB43 LJB63 LJB83 LJB1263
4' Length LJB24 LJB44 LJB64 LJB84 LJB1264
5' Length LJB25 LJB45 LJB65 LJB85 LJB1265
10' Length [7] LJB210 LJB410 LJB610 LJB810 LJB12610
45o Top Opening LJB245LT LJB445LT LJB645LT LJB845LT LJB12645LT
45o Inside Opening LJB245LI LJB445LI LJB645LI LJB845LI —
45o Outside Opening LJB245LO LJB445LO LJB645LO LJB845LO —
90o Inside Opening LJB290LI LJB490LI LJB690LI LJB890LI LJB12690LI
90o Outside Opening LJB290LO LJB490LO LJB690LO LJB890LO LJB12690LO
90o Outside Top Opening — LJB490LOT LJB690LOT LJB890LOT —
90o Top Opening LJB290LT LJB490LT LJB690LT LJB890LT LJB12690LT
Tee—Top Opening LJB2TT LJB4TT LJB6TT LJB8TT LJB126TT
Tee—Outside Opening LJB2TO LJB4TO LJB6TO LJB8TO —
Cross LJB2X LJB4X LJB6X LJB8X LJB126X
Junction Box LJB2JB LJB4JB LJB6JB LJB8JB —
Telescopic Fitting LJB2TF LJB4TF LJB6TF LJB8TF LJB126TF
Closing Plate LJB2CP LJB4CP LJB6CP LJB8CP LJB126CP
Panel Adapter LJB2A LJB4A LJB6A LJB8A LJB126A
Bracket Hanger LJB2BH LJB4BH LJB6BH LJB8BH —
Drop Hanger LJB2DH LJB4DH LJB6DH LJB8DH —
Extra Connector Kit [6] LJB2C LJB4C LJB6C LJB8C LJB126C
90o Connector LJB290C LJB490C LJB690C LJB890C LJB12690C
Reducer to 2" — LJB42R — — —
Reducer to 4" — — LJB64R — LJB1264R
Reducer to 6" — — — LJB86R LJB1266R
Cut-off fitting—not Lay-in LJB2CF LJB4CF LJB6CF LJB8CF LJB126CF
Cut-off fitting—Lay-in LJB2CFL LJB4CFL LJB6CFL LJB8CFL LJB126CFL
Transposition Fitting—CCW (Str) LJB21CCW LJB41CCW LJB61CCW — —
Transposition Fitting—CW (Str) LJB21CW LJB41CW LJB61CW — —
Transposition Elbow—CCW LJB290LCCW LJB490LCCW LJB690LCCW LJB890LCCW —
Transposition Elbow—CW LJB290LCW LJB490LCW LJB690LCW LJB890LCW —
Swivel fitting—Wireway to Wireway LJB2S LJB4S LJB6S LJB8S —
Swivel fitting—Wireway to Box LJB2SB LJB4SB LJB6SB LJB8SB —
Flex Fitting—Feed Through LJB2FF LJB4FF LJB6FF LJB8FF —
Barrier Kit—5 ft. long w/hardware — LJB45B LJB65B LJB85B LJB65B
5 pc. Barrier Pack—5 ft. long — LJB45BKM LJB65BKM — —
5 pc. Barrier Bracket—2 compartment — LJB4BB2C LJB6BB2C — —

WIRE MANAGEMENT
5 pc. Barrier Bracket—3 compartment — LJB4BB3C LJB6BB3C — —

13

[6] Connector kit furnished with each length and fitting.


[7] 10 foot straight lengths UL listed for up to 10 foot hanger spacing.
13-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Wall Duct Non-Segregated Bus
Class 5250 / Refer to Catalog 5250CT9201
schneider-electric.us

Raintight Wireway—NEMA Type 3R


Outdoor raintight wireway is used to protect electrical wiring against rain, sleet, and
physical damage. Unique drip shield cover protects wiring from weather and maintains
the “lay-in” feature for ease of wiring installation. Lengths and fittings are constructed of
16 gauge galvanized steel with ANSI-61 gray polyester powder finish over a corrosion
resistant phosphate preparation. Underwriters Laboratories Listed as steel enclosed
wireway and auxiliary gutter (horizontal mounting only). Conforms to NEMA Type 3R.

Table 13.3: Raintight Wireway


4" x 4" 6" x 6" 8" x 8"
Description[8] Catalog Catalog Catalog
Number Number Number
1' Length LDRB41M LDRB61M LDRB81M
5' Length LDRB45M LDRB65M LDRB85M
10' Length LDRB410M LDRB610M LDRB810M
90o L LDRB490L LDRB690L LDRB890L
30o Sweep L LDRB430SE LDRB630SE LDRB830SE
Tee LDRB4T LDRB6T LDRB8T
Junction Box LDRB4J LDRB6J LDRB8J
Panel Adapter LDRB44A LDRB66A LDRB88A
Connector[8] LDRB4C LDRB6C LDRB8C
Closing Plate LDRB4CP LDRB6CP LDRB8CP
Drop Hanger LDRB4DH LDRB6DH LDRB8DH
Wall Hanger LDRB4WH LDRB6WH LDRB8WH
Reducer — LDRB64R LDRB86R

Raintight Trough—NEMA Type 3R


Raintight trough is designed for ganging meter devices, panelboards, switches, and
circuit breaker enclosures. Each length is a completely enclosed section with a
removable cover that has provisions for sealing.
Design: 4” and 6” wireway is constructed of 16 gauge galvanized steel. 8”, 10”, and 12”
wireway is constructed of 14 gauge galvanized steel. All raintight troughs conform to
NEMA Type 3R.
Finish: ANSI-61 gray polyester powder finish over a corrosion resistant phosphate
preparation. All raintight troughs are Underwriters Laboratories listed as steel enclosed
wireway and auxiliary gutter (horizontal mounting only).

Table 13.4: Raintight Trough


4" x 4" 6" x 6" 8" x 8" 10" x 10" 12" x 12"
Length
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
1' RDB41 RDB61 — — —
2' RDB42 RDB62 RDB82 RDB102 RDB122
3' RDB43 RDB63 RDB83 RDB103 RDB123
4' RDB44 RDB64 RDB84 — —
5' RDB45 RDB65 RDB85 RDB105 RDB125
6' — RDB66 RDB86 RDB106 RDB126

Wall Duct General Description


UL Listed, File E65247, for Enclosure of Wiring to X-Ray Machines. Also available
in aluminum for MRI application.
Wall duct is used as the continuation for standard trench duct in the floor. Wall duct can
be routed up the wall and across the ceiling or under the finished floor (in ceiling space
below) to provide a continuous lay-in raceway system from control consoles and floor
equipment to overhead apparatus. Devices are furnished complete with covers and are
available for either flush or surface mounted installations.
General Notes:
• Standard construction is 14 gauge steel with gray electrodeposition paint. Alternate
construction is painted aluminum.
• Covers and coupling devices are furnished with each device.
• Wire retainers are furnished with each device.
• Straight lengths are field cut to length.
• Partitions and tunnels are to be field modified and installed where required.
• Hangers or other mounting devices to be furnished by others.

Typical Surface Mount, Straight-Length Wall Duct

[8] Add connectors for all lengths and fittings.


13-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Non-Segregated Bus Wall Duct
Class 5250 / Refer to Catalog 5250CT9201
schneider-electric.us
With SURFACE Covers (Matching Width) With FLUSH Covers (2" Oversize)

6 x 3 1 ⁄2 " 10 x 3 1 ⁄2 " 6 x 3 1 ⁄2 " 10 x 3 1 ⁄2 "

Lay-In
Wall Duct
18 x 3 1 ⁄2 " 18 x 3 1 ⁄2 "

Trench Duct

Components and Accessories

Horizontal Edgewise Tee Cross Flanged Wall Duct Sweep


Elbow Elbow Cabinet Dust Cover Edgewise Reverse Ceiling Drop-out
Edgewise Tee Kit Sweep Edgewise
Connector Tee Kit Edgewise (Depth Adj.
Elbow Elbow Cabinet
4" to 7") Connector
Flush
Mounted Sweep
Surface Wall Duct
Mounted To Trench
Duct
Sweep 18" to 10" Cabinet End Cap Flush to Floor Trench Split Cover Adaptor
Edgewise Elbow Reducer Connector Surface Adaptor Vertical Elbow with Grommet

Table 13.5: Lay-In Wall Duct Components [1]


Flush Cover Surface Cover
Component
Catalog Number Weight Lbs. Catalog Number Weight Lbs.
5'–0" Straight Length With Cover 6"W RWT06S60 22.5 RWT06S60S 20.4
10"W RWT10S60 39.2 RWT10S60S 36.4
18"W RWT18S60 62.2 RWT18S60S 59.4
1'–6" Straight Length With Cover 6"W RWT06S18 12.6 RWT06S18S 12.6
10"W RWT10S18 16.4 RWT10S18S 16.3
18"W RWT18S18 23.3 RWT18S18S 23.3
Horizontal Elbow With Cover—90o 6"W RWT06HE 6.5 RWT06HES 6.0
10"W RWT10HE 9.3 RWT10HES 8.1
18"W RWT18HE 24.9 RWT18HES 23.7
Horizontal Elbow With Cover—45o 6"W — — RWT06HE45S 6.0
10"W — — RWT10HE45S 8.1
18"W — — RWT18HE45S 23.7
Edgewise Elbow With Cover 6"W RWT06EE 5.5 RWT06EES 5.5
10"W RWT10EE 7.5 RWT10EES 7.4
18"W RWT18EE 11.1 RWT18EES 11.0
Tee With Cover 6"W RWT06TE 6.2 RWT06TES 5.9
10"W RWT10TE 8.5 RWT10TES 7.3
18"W RWT18TE 24.1 RWT18TES 22.9
Cross With Cover 10"W RWT10XE 1.3 RWT10XES 6.2
18"W RWT18XE 1.8 RWT18XES 21.8
Flanged Cabinet Connector With Cover 10"W RWT10CUC 8.0 RWT10CUCS 7.8
Reverse Edgewise Elbow With Cover 6"W RWT06REE 5.8 RWT06REES 5.7
10"W RWT10REE 7.5 RWT10REES 7.4
18"W RWT18REE 11.1 RWT18REES 11.0
Sweep Edgewise Elbow With Cover 6"W — 10.0 RWT06SSEES 4.8
10"W RWT10SFEE 12.0 RWT10SSEES 11.8
18"W RWT18SFEE 16.5 RWT18SSEES 16.3

WIRE MANAGEMENT
Sweep Edgewise Elbow Cabinet Connector 10"W — — RWT10SWEECC 14.0
18"W — — RWT18SWEECC 20.0

13

[1] All devices available in aluminum. Add “A” suffix to the catalog number.
13-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Wall Duct Non-Segregated Bus
Class 5250 / Refer to Catalog 5250CT9201
schneider-electric.us

Wall Duct Accessories


Table 13.6: Lay-In Wall Duct Accessories [2]
Catalog Number Weight
Accessories
Lbs.
5'–0" Partition RWTP60 5.4
Straight through tunnel
RWT10ST 2.9
for tees [3] 10"W RWT18ST 3.8
18"W
90o Elbow tunnel for crosses [3] 10"W RWT10ET 3.2
18"W RWT18ET 5.1
3 compartment tunnel for tees 10"W RWT10PTE 5.0
18"W RWT18PTE 6.0
3 compartment tunnel for crosses 10"W RWT10PXE 8.0
18"W RWT18PXE 9.0
Edgewise Tee Kit 10"W RWT10ETK 1.3
18"W RWT18ETK 2.1
Sweep Edgewise Tee Kit 10"W RWT10SWET 8.0
18"W RWT18SWET 8.0
Flush to Surface Adaptor 10"W RWT10FS 11.9
18"W RWT18FS 16.4
Ceiling Drop-Out RWTCDO 15.0
12x12 Flush Cover 8"x8"
Extra Coupling Device 10"W RWT10COUP .4
18"W RWT18COUP .5
Extra Straight Cover—30" long
(Order 2 pcs. for 5 ft. of duct.) RWT10SCOV 7.2
Flush 10"W RWT18SCOV 13.0
18"W RWT10SCOVS 6.1
Surface 10"W RWT18SCOVS 11.8
18"W

Table 13.7: Wall Duct Accessories [2]


Catalog Number Weight
Accessories Lbs.
Reducer Coupling— 18" to 10" RWTRC 2.1
10" to  6" RWT06RC 1.6
Cabinet Connector 6"W RWT06CC 1.0
10"W RWT10CC 1.3
18"W RWT18CC 2.4
End Cap 6"W RWT06EC 1.0
10"W RWT10EC 1.3
18"W RWT18EC 1.8
Vertical Elbows for:
6" Trench to 6" Wall Duct RWT06FTVE06 1.1
RWT10FTVE12
12" Trench to 10" Wall Duct RWT18FTVE12 1.2
12" Trench to 18" Wall Duct 1.2
RWT10FTVE18
18" Trench to 10" Wall Duct RWT18FTVE18 1.3
18" Trench to 18" Wall Duct
Sweep Trench Duct to Wall Duct Adapter
(available in surface cover only)
RWT10SWFTVE12 10.0
RWT18SWFTVE18 14.0
12" Trench to 10" Wall Duct
18" Trench to 18" Wall Duct
Split Cover with Grommet
12" long–3"x 8" Opening RWT06ACP 2.6
Flush 6"W RWT10ACP 3.1
10"W RWT18ACP 4.8
18"W RWT06ACPS 2.0
Surface 6"W RWT10ACPS 2.7
10"W RWT18ACPS 4.0
18"W
Dust Cover—5 ft. long RWTDCOV60 5.5
Grommet—100 ft. roll RWTBG100
13
WIRE MANAGEMENT

[2] All devices available in aluminum. Add “A” suffix to the catalog number.
[3] Tunnels form a 3" wide compartment.
13-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Non-Segregated Bus Trench Duct
Class 5200 / Refer to Catalog 5230CT9601
schneider-electric.us

Trench Duct General Description


• STANDARD LENGTH of trench duct is 10 ft. Gasketed cover plates are ordered and
shipped separately.
• FEATURES of trench duct:
– Trench duct width is cover plate width.
– Tub width is trench duct width less 1.8".
– Overall width (bottom flange to flange) is 3" wider than trench duct width.
– Standard depth is adjustable from 2-3/8" to 3-3/8". Also available as standard is
depth adjustable from 3" to 4". To order, change “2” to “3”. Ex. RSV063100120.
Applies to trench duct, elbows, crosses, tees, and reducers. Other depths available.
– Tees, crosses, horizontal elbows, and reducers are shipped complete with cover
plates assembled.
– Grey vinyl tile trim is furnished as standard. Aluminum is available when requested.
– All compartments over 17" wide must be supported with dividers or posts.
W (width)

2 3/8 - 3 3/8"
Standard or
Depth Width Less 1.8"
3 - 4"

W + 3"

Table 13.8: Assembled Trench Duct


Straight Trench Duct
Sections Length Width Catalog Number
6" RSV062100120
9" RSV092100120
12" RSV122100120
10'-0" 18" RSV182100120
24" RSV242100120
30" RSV302100120
Covers Only (5 Plates per 10' Length) [1]
Full Length 6" RCP0624
9" RCP0924
12" RCP1224
24" 18" RCP1824
24" RCP2424
30" RCP3024
12" RCP1212
12" 18" RCP1812
6'-0"L 12" RSV122100072
4'-3- 1/2"L 12" RSV122100051.5
3'-3- 1/2"L 12" RSV122100039.5
2'-0"L 12" RSV122100024
1'-0"L 12" RSV122100012
Factory Cut-to-Length 0'-3-1/2"L 12" RSV122100003.5
(12" Wide Only) 3–24" Long Covers [2]
2–24" Long Covers & 1 – Wall Duct Vertical Elbow[2]
1–24" & 1–12" Long Cover & 1—Wall Duct Vertical Elbow [2]
1–24" Long Cover [2]
1–12" Long Cover [2]
1–Wall Duct Vertical Elbow[2]

Trench Duct Fittings


Table 13.9: Trench Duct Fittings
Item Width [3] Catalog No.

WIRE MANAGEMENT
6" REC06
9" REC09
End Closures[4] 12" REC12
18" REC18
24" REC24
30" REC30
6" RVE06
9" RVE09
12" RVE12
Vertical Elbows
18" RVE18
24" RVE24
30" RVE30

6" RRC06
Riser and Cabinet 9" RRC09
Connector 12" RRC12
(Removable Front) 18" RRC18
24" RRC24
30" RRC30
13

Z-Divider 5'-0"[4]
Adjustable Barrier and RZD60
Support Strip

[1] Straight length cover plates are shipped separately and must be ORDERED SEPARATELY.
[2] Covers and/or vertical elbows for connecting trench duct to lay-in wall duct—ORDER SEPARATELY.
[3] All devices through 18" width are available in aluminum. Height is factory-set to customer specifications from 2-1/2 to 4 inches. (Non-Adjustable)
[4] For 3" to 4" trench duct, add a “3” to end of catalog number.
13-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Trench Duct Non-Segregated Bus
Class 5200 / Refer to Catalog 5230CT9601
schneider-electric.us

Table 13.9 Trench Duct Fittings (cont'd.)


Item Width [5] Catalog No.
Tape for Trench Duct (180 ft. rolls) G1414
Marker for Cellular Floor G1426

Table 13.10: Trench Duct Elbows, Tees, and Crosses


Complete Device
Item
Width Catalog Number
90o Horizontal [6] 6" RHV062100009
Elbows 9" RHV092100012
12" RHV122100015
18" RHV182100021
24" RHV242100027
30" RHV302100033
Tee
45o Horizontal Elbow [6] 12" RHV12245
Tees [6] 6" RTV062100011
9" RTV092100014
12" RTV122100017
18" RTV182100023
24" RTV242100029
30" RTV302100035
Crosses[6] 6" RXV062100012
9" RXV092100015
12" RXV122100018
18" RXV182100024
24" RXV242100030
30" RXV302100036

Accessories and Components


Table 13.11: Trench Duct Accessories
Item/Catalog Number Item/Catalog Number

12" U-Compartment
Right Hand Reducer
18" to 12" RRV182100012RR 5'-0" Long x 3 -1/2" Wide with RUC60
Cover Included Adjustable Height Sides

Leveling 9" and 12" wide trench G1500T12


Legs 18" and 24" wide trench G1500T24
30" wide trench G1500T36
Left Hand Reducer Support
18" to 12" RRV182100012LR Channel
12" Cover Included Leveling Legs Not Included

5/16 x 18 x 3" G19103

15"
Reducing Tee Cover Lifter
18" to 12" RTV182100017 (Suction Cup Device) G1735S
Cover Included

Tunnels for Trench Duct Elbows


6" (Tee or Cross)
9" Straight through tunnel 90o tunnel for 12" trench RSV122ET
Spacer Bar and Barrier 12" 90° elbow tunnel 90o tunnel for 18" trench RSV182ET
Adjustment Gage 18" Straight tunnel for 12" trench RSV122ST
24" Straight tunnel for 18" trench RSV182ST
30"
13

Support Post Strips


RSP60
5’

Table 13.12: Grommets


WIRE MANAGEMENT

Grommet Material (50 ft. rolls) RG50

[5] All devices through 18" width are available in aluminum. Height is factory-set to customer specifications from 2-1/2 to 4 inches. (Non-Adjustable)
[6] Includes cover; shipped attached. All coverplate corner notches are 1–1/2” deep.
13-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents

Section 14
Transformers
EZ Selector–Selection Assistance 14-2

LV Transformers EZ Selector–Selection Assistance 14-2


LV Transformers EZ Selector–Selection Assistance 14-2
Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution Transformers 14-3

Overview 14-3
General Purpose Dry Type 600 Volts and Below Overview 14-3
New! Energy Efficient Three Phase 14-4
Energy Efficient Single Phase and Single Phase Watchdog 14-7
Accessories 14-8
Enclosures and Accessories 14-8
Mini Power-Zone Unit Substation 14-10
Sealed, Mini Power-Zone™ Unit Substation 14-10
Resin Encapsulated Three and Single Phase Transformers 14-11
Resin Encapsulated Export Model and Buck Boost Transformers 14-12
Non-Ventilated and Transformer House 14-13
PZC Transformer Enclosures 14-13
Industrial Control 14-14

Type T and Type TF 14-14


Transformer Disconnects 14-19
Transformer Disconnects for NEMA Type 1 and Type 12
Enclosures 14-19
Instrument, 600 Volt Class 14-20

Voltage and Current Transformers 14-20


Voltage Transformers 14-20
Current Transformers 14-20
Energy Efficient, Dry Type 2.4, 5, and 15 kV 14-21

New! Energy Efficient Medium Voltage Distribution Transformers 14-21


Medium Voltage Distribution Transformers 14-21
Dry Type Medium Voltage 14-22
New! 1,201–15,000 Vac Three-Phase Indoor Transformers 14-22
1,201–15,000 Vac Single-Phase Indoor Transformers 14-23
Enclosures 14-23

TRANSFORMERS

© 2017 Schneider Electric


14

All Rights Reserved 14-1

11/10/2017
EZ Selector–Selection Assistance LV Transformers EZ Selector–Selection
Assistance
schneider-electric.us

LV Transformers EZ Selector–Selection Assistance


LV Transformers EZ Selector
Steps to select an LV transformer.

1. Select product type:


• Three Phase – Energy Efficient – EX (DOE 2016)
• Three Phase – Energy Efficient – EX, K-13 Rated (DOE 2016)
• Three Phase – Energy Efficient – EX, Watchdog Low Temperature Rise (DOE
2016)
• Single Phase – Energy Efficient – EE (DOE 2016)
• Three Phase – Resin Encapsulated
• Single Phase – Resin Encapsulated
2. Select kVA Rating – 15, 30, 45, 75, 112.5, 150, 225, 300, 500, or 750 kVA
3. Select Primary Voltage – 208, 240, 480, or 600 Vac Delta
4. Select Secondary Voltage – 208Y/120, 240 Vac Delta 120 V CT, 480Y/277
5. Select Mounting – Floor, Wall
6. Select Enclosure – Indoor (Type 1), Indoor (Type 2), Indoor/Outdoor (Type 3R),
Indoor/Outdoor (Type 4X)
7. Select Temperature Rise – 55°C, 80°C, 115°C, 150°C
8. Select Material – Aluminum, Copper
9. Select Sound Level – 39 dB (6 dB below), 44 dB (6 dB below), 47 dB (3 dB below),
49 dB (6 dB below), 54 dB (6 dB below), 58 dB (6 dB below)
Additional Information
Search for “LV Transformers ” from our technical FAQs page: www.schneider-electric.us/
en/faqs
For catalog information, please use this link: LV Transformer Documents
14
TRANSFORMERS

14-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Overview Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution
Transformers
schneider-electric.us

General Purpose Dry Type 600 Volts and Below Overview


The Energy Policy and Conservation Act of 1975 (EPCA), update in the Energy Policy
Act of 2005, authorized the Department of Energy (DOE) to evaluate and set minimum
efficiency levels for Low Voltage Distribution Ttransformers. The DOE published a final
rule prescribing new energy conservation standards for distribution transformers. 78 FR
23335 (April 18, 2013).
10 CFR 431.196: The efficiency of a low-voltage dry-type distribution transformer
manufactured on or after January 1, 2016, shall be no less than that required for their
kVA rating in the table below. Low-voltage dry-type distribution transformers with kVA
ratings not appearing in the table shall have their minimum efficiency level determined by
linear interpolation of the kVA and efficiency values immediately above and below that
kVA rating. All efficiency values are at thirty-five percent of nameplate-rated load
temperature corrected to 75°C, determined according to the DOE Test Method for
Measuring the Energy Consumption of Distribution Transformers under Appendix A to
Subpart K of 10 CFR part 431. https://www1.eere.energy.gov/buildings/appliance_
standards/standards.aspx?productid=55&action=viewcurrent
Energy Conservation Standards for Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution Transformers
Single phase Three phase
kVA Efficiency % [1] kVA Efficiency % [1]
15 97.70 15 97.89
25 98.00 30 98.23
37.5 98.20 45 98.40
50 98.30 75 98.60
75 98.50 112.5 98.74
100 98.60 150 98.83
167 98.70 225 98.94
250 98.80 300 99.02
333 98.90 500 99.14
— — 750 99.23
— — 1000 99.28

Distribution transformer means a transformer that (1) has an input voltage of 34.5 kV or
less; (2) has an ouput voltage of 600 V or less; (3) is rated for operation at a frequency of
60 Hz; and (4) has a capacity of 10 to 2500 kVA for liquid-immersed units and 15 to 2500
kVA for dry-type units.
Low voltage dry-type distribution transformer means a distribution transformer that: has
an input voltage of 600 V or less, is air-cooled, and not used oil as a coolant.
The following product offering must comply with the table above:
• Three- and single-phase
• Step up and step down transformers
• General purpose ventilated transformers (isolation transformers)
• Watchdog general purpose ventilated transformers (low temperature rise)
• Transformers designed for harmonic applications (K-rated, harmonic mitigating, data
center transformers, etc.)
• General purpose open core and coil transformers
The following low voltage transformers do not need to comply with the table above:
• Auto-transformers
• Drive isolation transformers
• Non-ventilated transformers
• Resin encapsulated transformers
• Buck boost transformers
• Control transformers (machine tool)
• Medical isolation panel transformers compliance with UL 1047 (tables 30.1 and 30.2)
(SPECIAL IZ — LOW LEAKAGE)
New Three-Phase Offering from Square D — DOE 2016 EX
• Exceed the efficiency levels from 10 CFR 431.196
• Terminals sized to handle wire ranges to match Square D circuit breakers, switches,
panelboards, etc. Located to meet NEC bending radius and layout to simplifiy
connections
• IZ Levels to allow for designing with the minimum AIC Panels available
• In-rush current limited to expand the Square D circuit breaker options at both 125 and
250% sizing
• Sound level at 3 dB for all designs, but up to 6–10 dB below on certain units—QUIET
TRANSFORMERS

QUALITY
• 1/2 in. clearance from the rear and side, UL 1561alcove testing all enclosures to
not exceed 90°C on adjacent walls
• Four product families of the DOE 2016 EX: General purpose, aluminum and copper
windings, 150°C rise; Watchdog, low temperature rise, aluminum and coover
windings, 115 or 80°C rise; Two solutions for harominic loads: K-13 Wye secondary,
harmonic mitigating transformers and K-9 ZigZag secondary, harmonic mitigating
transformers.

[1] Efficiencies are determined at the following reference conditions:


(1) for no-load losses, at the temperature of 20° C; (2) for load-losses, at the temperature of 75° C and 35% of nameplate load. (Source: Table 4– 2 of National Electrical Manufacturers
14

Association (NEMA) Standard TP–1–2002, Guide for Determining Energy Efficiency for Distribution Transformers.)
14-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution New! Energy Efficient Three Phase
Transformers
Class 7400 / Refer to Catalog 7400CT1501 schneider-electric.us

Energy Efficient Three Phase


Table 14.1: EX Three-Phase 60 Hz, 208Y/120 Vac Secondary; UL Listed
kVA Catalog No. Minimum Efficiency Full Capacity Taps Degree C Temp. Insulation Class %IZ Sound Weight (lbs) Enclosure[3]
@ 35% 75°C Rise Level dB [2]
480 Vac Delta Primary, Aluminum Windings
15 EX15T3H 97.89% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.9% 42 dB 245 17K
30 EX30T3H 98.23% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.2% 42 dB 400 18K
45 EX45T3H 98.40% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.1% 42 dB 490 18K
75 EX75T3H 98.60% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 5.8% 47 dB 710 20K
112.5 EX112T3H 98.74% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.5% 47 dB 920 21K
150 EX150T3H 98.83% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.1% 47 dB 1170 22K
225 EX225T3H 98.94% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.5% 52 dB 1825 25J
300 EX300T3H 99.02% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 5.2% 52 dB 1975 25J
500 EX500T68H 99.14% 4–2.5%2+2– 150 220 4.9% 57 dB 3100 30J
750 EX750T68H 99.23% 4–2.5%2+2– 150 220 4.5% 61 dB 4125 31J
600 Vac Delta Primary, Aluminum Windings
15 EX15T65H 97.89% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 42 dB 240 17K
30 EX30T65H 98.23% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 42 dB 400 18K
45 EX45T65H 98.40% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 42 dB 490 18K
75 EX75T65H 98.60% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 47 dB 710 20K
112.5 EX112T65H 98.74% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 47 dB 920 21K
150 EX150T65H 98.83% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 47 dB 1170 22K
225 EX225T65H 98.94% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 52 dB 1825 25J
300 EX300T65H 99.02% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 52 dB 1970 25J
500 EX500T79H 99.14% 4–2.5%2+2– 150 220 — 57 dB 3095 30J
750 EX750T79H 99.23% 4–2.5%2+2– 150 220 — 61 dB 4120 31J
208 Vac Delta Primary, Aluminum Windings
15 EX15T211H 97.89% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 42 dB 240 17K
30 EX30T211H 98.23% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 42 dB 410 18K
45 EX45T211H 98.40% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 42 dB 495 18K
75 EX75T211H 98.60% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 47 dB 650 20K
112.5 EX112T211H 98.74% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 47 dB 920 21K
150 EX150T211H 98.83% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 47 dB 1170 22K
225 EX225T211H 98.94% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 52 dB 1825 25J
300 EX300T211H 99.02% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 52 dB 1970 25J
500 EX500T211H 99.14% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 57 dB 3095 30J
240 Vac Delta Primary, Aluminum Windings
15 EX15T239H 97.89% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 42 dB 235 17K
30 EX30T239H 98.23% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 42 dB 410 18K
45 EX45T239H 98.40% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 42 dB 495 18K
75 EX75T239H 98.60% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 47 dB 650 20K
112.5 EX112T239H 98.74% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 47 dB 920 21K
150 EX150T239H 98.83% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 47 dB 1170 22K
225 EX225T239H 98.94% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 52 dB 1825 25J
300 EX300T239H 99.02% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 52 dB 1970 25J
500 EX500T239H 99.14% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 57 dB 3095 30J
480 Vac Delta Primary, Copper Windings
15 EX15T3HCU 97.89% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.4% 42 dB 250 17K
30 EX30T3HCU 98.23% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.0% 42 dB 435 18K
45 EX45T3HCU 98.40% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.4% 42 dB 515 18K
75 EX75T3HCU 98.60% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.8% 47 dB 770 20K
112.5 EX112T3HCU 98.74% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.1% 47 dB 1065 21K
150 EX150T3HCU 98.83% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.7% 47 dB 1325 22K
225 EX225T3HCU 98.94% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 6.9% 52 dB 1810 25J
300 EX300T3HCU 99.02% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 5.4% 52 dB 2100 25J
500 EX500T68HCU 99.14% 4–2.5%2+2– 150 220 4.8% 57 dB 3975 30J
750 EX750T68HCU 99.23% 4–2.5%2+2– 150 220 4.8% 61 dB 4670 31J

Table 14.2: EX Three-Phase 60 Hz, 480Y/277 Vac Secondary; UL Listed


kVA Catalog No. Minimum Efficiency Full Capacity Taps Degree C Temp. Insulation Class %IZ Sound Weight (lbs) Enclosure[3]
@ 35% 75°C Rise Level [2]
208 Vac Delta Primary, Aluminum Windings
15 EX15T212H 97.89% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 42 dB 235 17K
30 EX30T212H 98.23% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 42 dB 410 18K
45 EX45T212H 98.40% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 42 dB 495 18K
75 EX75T212H 98.60% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 47 dB 650 20K
112.5 EX112T212H 98.74% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 47 dB 920 21K
150 EX150T212H 98.83% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 47 dB 1170 22K
14

225 EX225T212H 98.94% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 52 dB 1825 25J


300 EX300T212H 99.02% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 52 dB 1970 25J
500 EX500T212H 99.14% 3–5%1+2– 150 220 — 57 dB 3100 30J
480 Vac Delta Primary, Aluminum Windings
15 EX15T1814H 97.89% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 42 dB 235 17K
30 EX30T1814H 98.23% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 42 dB 410 18K
45 EX45T1814H 98.40% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 42 dB 495 18K
75 EX75T1814H 98.60% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 47 dB 660 20K
112.5 EX112T1814H 98.74% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 47 dB 925 21K
TRANSFORMERS

150 EX150T1814H 98.83% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 47 dB 1175 22K


225 EX225T1814H 98.94% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 52 dB 1830 25J
300 EX300T1814H 99.02% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 52 dB 1975 25J
500 EX500T76H 99.14% 4–2.5%2+2– 150 220 — 57 dB 3100 30J

[2] Not for construction, Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for certified prints.
[3] For enclosure styles, see Table 14.8 Enclosure Dimensions and Accessories, page 14-8
14-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
New! Energy Efficient Three Phase Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution
Transformers
schneider-electric.us Class 7400 / Refer to Catalog 7400CT1501

Table 14.3: EX Three Phase 60 Hz, 240 Vac Delta Secondary; UL Listed
120 Volt Center Tap - Limited to 7.5% Loading, Design for Ground Reference and Light Maintenance Loading.
kVA Catalog No. Minimum Efficiency Full Capacity Taps Degree C Temp. Insulation Class %IZ Sound Weight (lbs) Enclosure[5]
@ 35% 75°C Rise Level dB [4]
480 Vac Delta Primary, Aluminum Windings
15 EX15T6HCT 97.89% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.9% 42 dB 235 17K
30 EX30T6HCT 98.23% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.2% 42 dB 405 18K
45 EX45T6HCT 98.40% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.1% 42 dB 480 18K
75 EX75T6HCT 98.60% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 5.8% 47 dB 640 20K
112.5 EX112T6HCT 98.74% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.5% 47 dB 910 21K
150 EX150T6HCT 98.83% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.1% 47 dB 1140 22K
225 EX225T6HCT 98.94% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.5% 52 dB 1820 25J
300 EX300T6HCT 99.02% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 5.2% 52 dB 1960 25J
500 EX500T63HCT 99.14% 4–2.5%2+2– 150 220 4.9% 57 dB 3090 30J
750 EX750T63HCT 99.23% 4–2.5%2+2– 150 220 4.9% 61 dB 4120 31J
Watchdog transformers, by design, reduct energy consumption at loads greater than
50% loading, giving fewer BTUs/hour at those loading levels. The life expectancy is
greater than that of 150°C rise General Purpose units.
• Aluminum or copper windings
• Two temperature rise options: 115°C rise on 220°C insulation systems (15%
continuous emergency overload capacity); 80°C rise on 220°C insulation systems
(30% continuous emergency overload capacity)
Table 14.4: EX Three Phase 60 Hz, 480Y/277 Vac Secondary; UL Listed
kVA Catalog No. Minimum Efficiency Full Capacity Taps Degree C Temp. Insulation Class %IZ Sound Weight (lbs) Enclosure[5]
@ 35% 75°C Rise Level [4]
480 V Delta Primary, 208Y/120 Secondary, Aluminum Windings
15 EX15T3HF 97.89% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.5% 39 dB 245 17K
30 EX30T3HF 98.23% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.5% 39 dB 400 18K
45 EX45T3HF 98.40% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 5.1% 39 dB 490 18K
75 EX75T3HF 98.60% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.3% 44 dB 920 20K
112.5 EX112T3HF 98.74% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.4% 47 dB 1170 21K
150 EX150T3HF 98.83% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.8% 49 dB 825 22K
225 EX225T3HF 98.94% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.5% 49 dB 1825 24J
300 EX300T3HF 99.02% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 30.0% 49 dB 1975 25J
500 EX500T68HF 99.14% 4–2.5%2+2– 115 220 4.9% 56 dB 3100 30J
750 EX750T68HF 99.23% 4–2.5%2+2– 115 220 5.0% 58 dB 4125 31J
480 V Delta Primary, 208Y/120 Secondary, Copper Windings
15 EX15T3HFCU 97.89% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.1% 39 dB 250 17K
30 EX30T3HFCU 98.23% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.5% 39 dB 410 18K
45 EX45T3HFCU 98.40% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.3% 39 dB 495 18K
75 EX75T3HFCU 98.60% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.6% 44 dB 755 20K
112.5 EX112T3HFCU 98.74% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.1% 47 dB 1025 21K
150 EX150T3HFCU 98.83% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.9% 49 dB 1270 22K
225 EX225T3HFCU 98.94% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 6.8% 49 dB 1545 24J
300 EX300T3HFCU 99.02% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 5.0% 49 dB 1975 25J
500 EX500T68HFCU 99.14% 4–2.5%2+2– 115 220 4.8% 56 dB 3705 30J
750 EX750T68HFCU 99.23% 4–2.5%2+2– 115 220 5.3% 58 dB 4400 31J
480 V Delta Primary, 208Y/120 Secondary, Aluminum Windings
15 EX15T3HB 97.89% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 4.7% 39 dB 400 18K
30 EX30T3HB 98.23% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 3.8% 39 dB 490 18K
45 EX45T3HB 98.40% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 3.9% 44 dB 920 20K
75 EX75T3HB 98.60% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 5.2% 47 dB 1170 21K
112.5 EX112T3HB 98.74% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 4.3% 49 dB 1825 22K
150 EX150T3HB 98.83% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 4.2% 49 dB 1825 24J
225 EX225T3HB 98.94% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 4.6% 49 dB 1975 25J
300 EX300T68HB 99.02% 4–2.5%2+2– 80 220 4.4% 56 dB 3100 30J
500 EX500T68HB 99.14% 4–2.5%2+2– 80 220 4.9% 58 dB 4125 31J
480 V Delta Primary, 208Y/120 Secondary, Copper Windings
15 EX15T3HBCU 97.89% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 4.4% 39 dB 400 18K
30 EX30T3HBCU 98.23% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 3.7% 39 dB 495 18K
45 EX45T3HBCU 98.40% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 4.4% 44 dB 755 20K
75 EX75T3HBCU 98.60% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 3.6% 47 dB 1025 21K
112.5 EX112T3HBCU 98.74% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 4.2% 49 dB 1270 22K
150 EX150T3HBCU 98.83% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 3.8% 49 dB 1545 24J
225 EX225T3HBCU 98.94% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 6.9% 49 dB 1975 25J
300 EX300T68HBCU 99.02% 4–2.5%2+2– 80 220 5.0% 56 dB 3705 30J
500 EX500T68HBCU 99.14% 4–2.5%2+2– 80 220 4.8% 58 dB 4400 31J
TRANSFORMERS

[4] Not for construction, Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for certified prints.
14

[5] For enclosure styles, see Table 14.8 Enclosure Dimensions and Accessories, page 14-8
14-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution New! Energy Efficient Three Phase
Transformers
Class 7400 / Refer to Catalog 7400CT1501 schneider-electric.us

DOE 2016 Low Voltage Distribution Transformers designed for applications with
harmonic loads.
Square D offers offers Delta - Wye 30°Phase Shift transformers which reconfigure the
harmonic models and mitigate the harmful effects of triplens. UL Listed with the following
K-ratings to handle excess heat created by harmonic wave forms, K13. Available with
aluminum or copper windings and 150°C or 115°C Rise with 220C insulation system.

Table 14.5: EX Three Phase 60 Hz, 30° Phase Shift, 480 Delta to 208Y/120; UL Listed, K-13
kVA Catalog No. Minimum Phase Full Capacity Taps Degree C Insulation Class %IZ Sound Weight (lbs) Enclosure[7]
Efficiency @ 35% Shift Temp. Rise Level [6]
75°C
480 Delta Primary, 208Y/120 Secondary, Aluminum Windings, 150°C Rise, 220C Insulation, K13 Listed
15 EX15T3HNLP 97.89% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 1.90% 39 dB 400 18K
30 EX30T3HNLP 98.23% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 2.60% 39 dB 490 18K
45 EX45T3HNLP 98.40% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.10% 44 dB 920 20K
75 EX75T3HNLP 98.60% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 2.80% 47 dB 1170 21K
112.5 EX112T3HNLP 98.74% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.30% 49 dB 1825 22K
150 EX150T3HNLP 98.83% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.00% 49 dB 1825 24J
225 EX225T3HNLP 98.94% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.30% 49 dB 1975 25J
480 Delta Primary, 208Y/120 Secondary, Copper Windings, 150°C Rise, 220C Insulation, K13 Listed
15 EX15T3HCUNLP 97.89% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 1.90% 39 dB 400 18K
30 EX30T3HCUNLP 98.23% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.00% 39 dB 495 18K
45 EX45T3HCUNLP 98.40% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.00% 44 dB 755 20K
75 EX75T3HCUNLP 98.60% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 2.80% 47 dB 1025 21K
112.5 EX112T3HCUNLP 98.74% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.00% 49 dB 1270 22K
150 EX150T3HCUNLP 98.83% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.60% 49 dB 1545 24J
225 98.94% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.80% 49 dB 1975 25J
480 Delta Primary, 208Y/120 Secondary, Aluminum Windings, 115°C Rise, 220C Insulation, K13 Listed
15 EX15T3HFNLP 97.89% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 1.80% 39 dB 400 18K
30 EX30T3HFNLP 98.23% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 2.50% 39 dB 490 18K
45 EX45T3HFNLP 98.40% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.00% 44 dB 920 20K
75 EX75T3HFNLP 98.60% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 2.80% 47 dB 1170 21K
112.5 EX112T3HFNLP 98.74% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.30% 49 dB 1825 22K
150 EX150T3HFNLP 98.83% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.00% 49 dB 1825 24J
225 EX225T3HFNLP 98.94% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.30% 49 dB 1975 25J
480 Delta Primary, 208Y/120 Secondary, Copper Windings, 115°C Rise, 220C Insulation, K13 Listed
15 EX15T3HFCUNLP 97.89% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 1.70% 39 dB 400 18K
30 EX30T3HFCUNLP 98.23% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 2.80% 39 dB 495 18K
45 EX45T3HFCUNLP 98.40% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.00% 44 dB 755 20K
75 EX75T3HFCUNLP 98.60% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 2.70% 47 dB 1025 21K
112.5 EX112T3HFCUNLP 98.74% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 2.90% 49 dB 1270 22K
150 EX150T3HFCUNLP 98.83% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.60% 49 dB 1545 24J
225 EX225T3HFCUNLP 98.94% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.70% 49 dB 1975 25J
14
TRANSFORMERS

[6] Not for construction, Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for certified prints.
[7] For enclosure styles, see Table 14.8 Enclosure Dimensions and Accessories, page 14-8
14-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Energy Efficient Single Phase and Single Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution
Phase Watchdog Transformers
schneider-electric.us Class 7400 / Refer to Catalog 7400CT0601

Energy Efficient Single Phase and Single Phase Watchdog


Table 14.6: EE Single-Phase 60 Hz, 120/240 Vac Secondary; cULus Listed
kVA Catalog No. Minimum Efficiency Full Capacity Taps Degree C Temp. Insulation Class %IZ Sound Level Weight (lbs) Enclosure[10]
@ 35% 75°C [8] Rise dB [9]
240 x 480 Vac Primary, Aluminum Windings
15 EE15S3H 97.70% 150 220 6.1% 45dB 215 17D
25 EE25S3H 98.00% 150 220 5.9% 45dB 275 17H
37.5 EE37S3H 98.20% 150 220 6.1% 45dB 340 18H
50 EE50S3H 98.30% 480 Vac 150 220 5.1% 45dB 395 18H
6-2.5% 2+4-
75 EE75S3H 98.50% 240 Vac 150 220 5.7% 50dB 619 21D
100 EE100S3H 98.60% 3-5% 1+2- 150 220 4.7% 50dB 682 22D
167 EE167S3H 98.70% 150 220 3.9% 55dB 982 24D
250 EE250S3H 98.80% 150 220 5.7% 55dB 1060 25D
333 EE333S3H 98.90% 150 220 6.3% 60dB 1854 31D
600 Vac Primary, Aluminum Windings
15 EE15S3534H 97.70% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.0 45dB 215 17D
25 EE25S3534H 98.00% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.3 45dB 275 17H
37.5 EE37S3534H 98.20% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.8 45dB 400 18H
50 EE50S3534H 98.30% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.2 45dB 450 18H
75 EE75S3534H 98.50% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.2 50dB 605 21D
100 EE100S3534H 98.60% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 2.9 50dB 795 22D
167 EE167S3534H 98.70% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.7 55dB 985 24D
250 EE250S3534H 98.80% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 55dB 1065 25D
333 EE333S3534H 98.90% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 — 60dB 1865 31D
208 Vac Primary, Aluminum Windings
15 EE15S60H 97.70% 2 - 5% FCBN 150 220 4.3 45dB 200 17D
25 EE25S60H 98.00% 2 - 5% FCBN 150 220 4.1 45dB 275 17H
37.5 EE37S60H 98.20% 2 - 5% FCBN 150 220 3.6 45dB 397 18H
50 EE50S60H 98.30% 2 - 5% FCBN 150 220 5.7 45dB 420 18H
75 EE75S60H 98.50% 2 - 5% FCBN 150 220 3.6 50dB 621 21D
100 EE100S60H 98.60% 2 - 5% FCBN 150 220 6.3 50dB 795 22D
167 EE167S60H 98.70% 2 - 5% FCBN 150 220 4.2 55dB 985 24D
277 Vac Primary, Aluminum Windings
15 EE15S61H 97.70% 2 - 5% FCBN 150 220 5.8 45dB 225 17D
25 EE25S61H 98.00% 2 - 5% FCBN 150 220 5.8 45dB 285 17H
37.5 EE37S61H 98.20% 2 - 5% FCBN 150 220 5.7 45dB 410 18H
50 EE50S61H 98.30% 2 - 5% FCBN 150 220 5.1 45dB 460 18H
75 EE75S61H 98.50% 2 - 5% FCBN 150 220 5.6 50dB 630 21D
100 EE100S61H 98.60% 2 - 5% FCBN 150 220 6.5 50dB 795 22D
167 EE167S61H 98.70% 2 - 5% FCBN 150 220 4.9 55dB 995 24D

Table 14.7: EE Single Phase Watchdog Transformers: 60 Hz, cULus Listed


kVA Catalog No. Minimum Full Capacity Taps Degree C Insulation %IZ Sound Weight Enclosure[10]
Efficiency @ 35% Temp. Rise Class Level dB (lbs)[9]
75°C
240 x 480 Vac Primary, 120/240 Vac Secondary, Aluminum Windings
15 EE15S3HF 97.70% 115 220 3.5% 45dB 275 17D
25 EE25S3HF 98.00% 115 220 4.0% 45dB 340 18H
37.5 EE37S3HF 98.20% 115 220 3.7% 45dB 395 18H
50 EE50S3HF 98.30% 115 220 3.7% 45dB 620 21D
75 EE75S3HF 98.50% 480 Vac 115 220 3.5% 50dB 685 22D
100 EE100S3HF 98.60% 6-2.5% 2+4- 115 220 3.5% 50dB 985 24D
15 EE15S3HB 97.70% 240 Vac 80 220 1.7% 45dB 280 17D
25 EE25S3HB 98.00% 3-5% 1+2- 80 220 3.9% 45dB 345 18H
37.5 EE37S3HB 98.20% 80 220 3.7% 45dB 400 18H
50 EE50S3HB 98.30% 80 220 3.6% 45dB 625 21D
75 EE75S3HB 98.50% 80 220 3.4% 50dB 690 22D
100 EE100S3HB 98.60% 80 220 3.4% 50dB 995 24D
Other Primary and Secondary combinations are available via the Schneider Electric
Product Configurator. Contact your local Schnedier Electric representative for more
information.

TRANSFORMERS

[8] FCBN = Full Capacity Below Normal.


[9] Not for construction, Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for certified prints.
14

[10] For enclosure styles, see Table 14.8 Enclosure Dimensions and Accessories, page 14-8
14-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution Accessories
Transformers
schneider-electric.us

Enclosures and Accessories

Style D and H—Type 2 Rated Style K—Type 2 Rated Style J—Type 2 Rated
Converts to Type 3R with Weathershield Converts to Type 3R with Weathershield Converts to Type 3R with Weathershield

Table 14.8: Enclosure Dimensions and Accessories


Enclosure Number/Style Height Width[11] Depth Mounting Weather- Wall Mounting Ceiling Mounting Insulation
in. mm in. mm in. mm shield Bracket [12] Bracket [13] Classo C
D 27 686 20 508 16 406 Floor WS363 WMB361362 CMB363 220
17
H 37 940 20 508 16 406 Floor WS363 WMB361362 CMB363 220
D 30 762 20 508 20 508 Floor WS363 WMB363364 CMB363 220
18
H 37 940 20 508 20 508 Floor WS363 WMB363364 CMB363 220
19 D 30 762 30 762 20 508 Floor WS364 WMB363364 CMB364 220
20 D 37 940 30 762 20 508 Floor WS364 WMB363364 CMB364 220
21 D 37 940 30 762 24 610 Floor WS364 — CMB364 220
22 D 43.8 1111 32 813 27 686 Floor WS380 — CMB380 220
24 D 49.5 1257 35 889 28.5 724 Floor WS381 — CMB381 220
25 D 49.5 1257 41 1041 32 813 Floor WS382 — — 220
26 D 57.5 1461 41 1041 32 813 Floor WS382 — — 220
28 D 60 1524 56 1422 36 914 Floor WS370A — — 220
29 D 68 1727 56 1422 36 914 Floor WS370A — — 220
30 D 71 1803 48 1219 36 914 Floor WS383 — — 220
31 D 74 1880 56 1422 40.5 1029 Floor WS384 — — 220
17 K 27 686 20.5 521 17.25 438 Floor 7400WS17K 7400WMB17K 7400CMB17K 220
18 K 35.32 897 25.5 648 21 533 Floor 7400WS18K 7400WMB18K20K 7400CMB18K20K 220
19 K — — — — — — Floor 7400WS19K 7400WMB19K 7400CMB19K 220
20 K 42 1067 30.06 778 22.75 578 Floor 7400WS20K 7400WMB18K20K 7400CMB18K20K 220
21 K 46 1168 31.32 796 24 610 Floor 7400WS21K — 7400CMB21K 220
22 K 49.1 1247 33.65 855 28.45 723 Floor 7400WS22K — 7400CMB22K 220
24 — — — — — — — Floor factory — — 220
25 J 57.5 1461 40.1 1019 32.75 832 Floor factory — — 220
30 J 71 1803 48.25 1226 37.9 963 Floor factory — — 220
31 J 76 1930 56 1422 44.5 1130 Floor factory — — 220

New Optional Floor Mounting Kit — Enclosures K and J


14
TRANSFORMERS

[11] These dimensions are not for construction. Contact your local Schneider Electric.
[12] Wall mounting brackets are used with units weighing no more than 700 lbs.
[13] Ceiling mounting brackets are used with units weighing no more than 1200 lbs.
14-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution
Transformers
schneider-electric.us

Table 14.9: Mechanical Lug Kits


Lugs Per Grounding Bonding Lugs
Catalog No. Wire Range Cap Screws Current Range Lugs per Kit Wire Range Wire Range
Kit per Kit
Single-Phase Primary, Single-Phase Secondary, Three-Phase Delta Primary, Three-Phase Delta Secondary
DASKP100 3 1/0–14 STR. 1/4 x 1 in Up to 100 A
DASKP250 3 350 kcmil–6 STR. 3/8 x 2 in 101 to 250 A
600 kcmil–4 STR.
DASKP400 3 (2) 250 kcmil–1/0 STR. 3/8 x 2 in 201 to 400 A
Not applicable Not applicable Not applicable Not applicable
600 kcmil–4 STR.
DASKP600 6 (2) 250 kcmil–1/0 STR. 3/8 x 2 in 601 to 800 A
DASKP1000 9 600 kcmil–2 STR. 3/8 x 2 in 601 to 800 A
DASKP1200 12 600 kcmil–2 STR. 3/8 x 2 in 801 to 1200 A
Single-Phase Primary and Secondary, Three-Phase Wye Secondary, Three-Phase Delta with Center Tap
DASKGS100 5 1/0–14 STR. 1/4 x 1 in Up to 100 A 1 (4) 2/0 to 14 STR 1 2 to 14 STR
DASKGS250 5 350 kcmil–6 STR. 3/8 x 2 in 101 to 250 A 1 (4) 2/0 to 14 STR 1 2 to 14 STR
600 kcmil–4 STR.
DASKGS400 5 3/8 x 2 in 201 to 400 A 1 (4) 2/0 to 14 STR 1 1/0 to 14 STR
(2) 250 kcmil–1/0 STR.
DASKGS600 10 600 kcmil–2 STR. 3/8 x 2 in 601 to 800 A 1 (4) 350 kcmil to 6 STR. 1 250 kcmil to 6 STR.
DASKGS1000 15 600 kcmil–2 STR. 3/8 x 2 in 601 to 800 A 1 (4) 350 kcmil to 6 STR. 1 250 kcmil to 6 STR.
DASKGS1200 20 600 kcmil–2 STR. 3/8 x 2 in 801 to 1200 A 1 (4) 350 kcmil to 6 STR. 1 250 kcmil to 6 STR.
DASKGS2000 25 600 kcmil–2 STR. 3/8 x 2 in 1201 to 2000 A 1 (4) 350 kcmil to 6 STR. 1 250 kcmil to 6 STR.
Lugs are not supplied with transformer units. They must be purchased separately.

Table 14.10: Compression Lug Kits


Terminal Lugs Aluminum or Copper Conductor Hardware Included
Transformer kVA Sizes Kit Catalog No.
Qty. Catalog No. Range (AWG or kcmil) Qty. Cap Screws
15–37 ½ 1Ø 8 VCEL02114S1 #8–1/0 8 1/4 x 1 in
15–45 3Ø VCELSK1 5 VCEL030516H1 #4–300 kcmil 1/4 x 2 in
1
50–75 1Ø 8 1/4 x 1 in
75–112 ½ 3 Ø VCELSK2 13 VCEL030516H1 #4–300 kcmil 8 1/4 x 2 in
VCEL030516H1 #4–300 kcmil 3 1/4 x 3/4 in
100–167 1Ø 3
150–300 3Ø VCELSK3 26 500–750 kcmil Al
VCEL07512H1 500 kcmil Cu 16 3/8 x 2 in

500 3Ø VCELSK4 34 VCEL07512H1 500–750 kcmil Al


500 kcmil Cu 21 3/8 x 2 in

Schneider Electric Low Voltage Transformers have been qualified to the site-specific
requirements of the following listed model building code and/or standard. (International
Building Code, California Buildling Code, Uniformed Building Code). Qualification based
on tri-axial shake table test results conduced in accordance with the AC156 test
protocol3 (Acceptance Criteria for Seismic Qualification Testing of Nonstructural
Components).
• Enclosure 1A to 11A, 12C to 16C, 12B to 15B (Resin Encapsulated Transformers)
• Enclosure 17D to 31D, 17H to 18H, 17K to 22K, 25J to 31J (Ventilated Transformers)
• Enclosure 17K to 20K with wall mounting bracket (Ventilated Transformres)
• Enclosure 17E to 31E (Non-ventilated Transformers)
• Enclosure MPZ A, AA, B, BB, C, CC (MPZB)
Product is Listed for installation in Hospitals State of California–OSHPD Special Seismic
Certification Preapproval OSP-0023-10.
Accessory Lables–required for Building Inspection–OSHPD
OSP Label Catalog Number Products Enclosure Style
7400CAOSHPDABC Resin encapsulated, buck boost Style A, B, C
transformers
7400CAOSHPDDH Ventilated Type EE, drive isolation, Style D, H
auto-transformers
7400CAOSHPDF Low voltage 750 and 1000 kVA Type Style F
EE
7400CAOSHPDJ Ventilated Type EX Style J
7400CAOSHPDK Ventilated Type EX Style K
7400CAOSHPDKO Ventilated Type EX, wall-mounted Style K with WMB
using Square D brackets
7400CAOSHPDMPZB Mini Power Zone Bolt-on A, AA, B, BB, C, CC

TRANSFORMERS
14

14-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution Mini Power-Zone Unit Substation
Transformers
Class 7400 / Refer to Catalog 7400CT0901 schneider-electric.us

Sealed, Mini Power-Zone™ Unit Substation


The Square D™ brand Mini Power-Zone™ unit substation from Schneider Electric
provides the answer to requirements for a portable, compact power supply for small
loads. This complete package yields considerable savings in installation time and costs.
Its NEMA Type 3R enclosure is suitable for both indoor and outdoor use. The transformer
is 115°C rise and epoxy-resin encapsulated. The panel section uses Square D™ brand
QO™ style circuit breakers.
NOTE: Mini Power-Zone unit substations are UL 1062 File E92978 Listed.
Mini Power-Zone unit substations include factory-installed primary main and secondary
main circuit breakers. Circuit breaker ratings are selected to meet National Electrical
Code requirements and coordinate with transformer magnetizing inrush current. Order
feeder circuit breakers (QO™ plug-on type) from your local Schneider Electric distributor.
Use Qwik-Gard™ circuit breakers for required ground fault protection. Tandem circuit
breakers are not permitted.
If bolt-on circuit breakers are required instead of plug-on, change the Mini Power-Zone
part number from MPZ to MPZB. The MPZB product line leverages the NQ interior for
application requirements.
The Mini Power-Zone unit substation uses a separate transformer and panel section.
This allows the panel section to be removed and wired first if desired. Also the
transformer can be replaced without disturbing the panel section and associated wiring.
The new transformer simply slides into the top of the panel section and primary and
secondary leads are reconnected to the main circuit breakers.

Table 14.11: Plug On Circuit Breakers


kVA Catalog No. Full Capacity Enclosure Weight Primary Main Secondary Square D Load Center
Taps[14] (lbs) Circuit Breaker Main Circuit Circuit Breaker Spaces
18k AIC 25k AIC Rating (A) Breaker Maximum Max. A
Rating (A) Number 1- or 2-
Pole
480 Vac Input into Transformer Output Single-Phase Panel Rated 120/240 Vac
3 MPZ3S40F MPZ3S40FSS MPZ3S40F25K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - A 85 15 15 10 or 5 20
5 MPZ5S40F MPZ5S40FSS MPZ5S40F25K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - A 135 20 30 10 or 5 20
7.5 MPZ7S40F MPZ7S40FSS MPZ7S40F25K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - A 145 30 40 10 or 5 30
10 MPZ10S40F MPZ10S40FSS MPZ10S40F25K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - A 220 30 60 10 or 5 40
15 MPZ15S40F MPZ15S40FSS MPZ15S40F25K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - B 350 60 80 28 or 14 60
25 MPZ25S40F MPZ25S40FSS MPZ25S40F25K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - B 425 100 125 28 or 14 100
Feeder Circuit Breakers
Output Three-Phase Panel Rated 208Y/120 Vac Maximum Max. A
Number 1- or 3-
Pole
15 MPZ15T2F MPZ15T2FSS MPZ15T2F25K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - C 710 40 60 27 or 9 40
22.5 MPZ22T2F MPZ22T2FSS MPZ22T2F25K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - C 670 70 80 27 or 9 60
30 MPZ30T2F MPZ30T2FSS MPZ30T2F25K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - C 815 90 100 27 or 9 80

Table 14.12: Bolt On Circuit Breakers


kVA Catalog No. Full Enclo- Weight Primary Main Secondary Feeder Circuit Breakers
18k AIC 25k AIC 65k AIC Capacity sure (lbs) Circuit Main Maximum Max. A
Taps[14] Breaker Circuit Number 1- or 2-
Rating (A) Breaker Pole
Rating (A)
Output Single-Phase Panel Rated 120/240 Vac
3 MPZB3S40F MPZB3S40FSS MPZB3S40F25K MPZB3S40F65K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - AA 85 15 15 16 or 8 20
5 MPZB5S40F MPZB5S40FSS MPZB5S40F25K MPZB5S40F65K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - AA 135 20 30 16 or 8 20
7.5 MPZB7S40F MPZB7S40FSS MPZB7S40F25K MPZB7S40F65K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - AA 145 30 40 16 or 8 30
10 MPZB10S40F MPZB10S40FSS MPZB10S40F25K MPZB10S40F65K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - AA 220 40 60 16 or 8 40
15 MPZB15S40F MPZB15S40FSS MPZB15S40F25K MPZB15S40F65K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - BB 350 60 80 28 or 14 60
25 MPZB25S40F MPZB25S40FSS MPZB25S40F25K MPZB25S40F65K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - BB 425 100 125 28 or 14 100
Output Three-Phase Panel Rated 208Y/120 Vac
15 MPZB15T2F MPZB15T2FSS MPZB15T2F25K MPZB15T2F65K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - CC 510 40 60 27 or 9 40
22.5 MPZB22T2F MPZB22T2FSS MPZB22T2F25K MPZB22T2F65K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - CC 670 70 80 27 or 9 60
30 MPZB30T2F MPZB30T2FSS MPZB30T2F25K MPZB30T2F65K 2–5% FCBN MPZ - CC 815 90 100 27 or 9 80

Table 14.13: Enclosure Dimensions and Accessories


Enclosure Number/Style Height Width Depth Mounting
14

in. mm in. mm in. mm


MPZ A 32.7 831 12 305 11.9 302 WALL
MPZ AA 41 1041 12 305 11.9 302 WALL
MPZ B 42.9 1090 17.4 442 13.5 343 WALL
MPZ BB 51 1295 17.4 442 13.5 343 WALL
MPZ C 44.6 1133 27.4 696 13.6 345 WALL
MPZ CC 48.6 1234 27.4 696 13.6 345 WALL
NOTE: Dimensions should not be used for construction. Contact you local Schneider
Electric representative for certified prints.
TRANSFORMERS

FCBN = Full Capacity Below Normal

[14] FCBN = Full Capacity Below Normal.

14-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Resin Encapsulated Three and Single Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution
Phase Transformers Transformers
schneider-electric.us Class 7400 / Refer to Catalog 7400CT9601

Resin Encapsulated Three and Single Phase Transformers


Table 14.14: Resin Encapsulated Three and Single Phase Transformers
kVA Type 3R STD Type 3R 304 Stainless Type 4X 304 Stainless
Catalog Weight Enclosure Catalog No. Weight Enclosure Catalog No. Weight Enclosure Full Deg C Insulation
No. (lbs)[15] [16] (lbs)[15] [17] (lbs)[15] [17] Capacity Temp. Class
Taps[18] Rise
Three Phase—480 Vac Delta Primary 208Y/120 Vac Secondary, 60 Hz; UL/cULus Listed
3 3T2F 120 12C 3T2SS 120 12C 4X3T2FSS 165 54X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
6 6T2F 145 12C 6T2SS 145 12C 4X6T2FSS 195 54X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
9 9T2F 235 14C 9T2SS 235 14C 4X9T2FSS 290 54X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
15 15T2F 300 14C 15T2SS 300 14C 4X15T2FSS 350 54X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
30 30T2F 660 16C 30T2SS 660 16C 4X30T2FSS 850 55X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
Three Phase—480 Vac Delta Primary 240 Vac Delta Secondary, 60 Hz; UL/cULus Listed
3 3T5F 120 12C 3T5SS 120 12C 4X3T5FSS 165 54X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
6 6T5F 145 12C 6T5SS 145 12C 4X6T5FSS 195 54X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
9 9T75F 235 14C 9T75SS 235 14C 4X9T75FSS 290 54X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
15 15T75F 300 14C 15T75SS 300 14C 4X15T75FSS 350 54X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
30 30T75F 660 16C 30T75SS 660 16C 4X30T75FSS 850 55X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
Single Phase—240 x 480 Vac Primary 120/240 Vac Secondary, 60 Hz; UL/cULus Listed
1 1S1F 21.2 7A 1S1FSS 21.2 7A 4X1S1FSS 48 51X None 115 180
1.5 1.5S1F 30.1 8A 1.5S1FSS 30.1 8A 4X1.5S1FSS 55 51X None 115 180
2 2S1F 39.1 9A 2S1FSS 39.1 9A 4X2S1FSS 55 51X None 115 180
3 3S1F 60 10A 3S1FSS 60 10A 4X3S1FSS 75 52X None 115 180
5 5S1F 115 13B 5S1FSS 115 13B 4X5S1FSS 125 52X None 115 180
7.5 7S1F 135 13B 7S1FSS 135 13B 4X7S1FSS 150 52X None 115 180
10 10S1F 165 13B 10S1FSS 165 13B 4X10S1FSS 180 52X None 115 180
15 15S1F 225 15B 15S1FSS 225 15B 4X15S1FSS 390 53X None 115 180
25 25S1F 300 15B 25S1FSS 300 15B 4X25S1FSS 450 53X None 115 180
Single Phase—480 Vac Primary 120/240 Vac Secondary, 60 Hz; UL/cULus Listed
1 1S40F 21.2 7A 1S40FSS 21.2 7A 4X1S40FSS 48 51X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
1.5 1.5S40F 30.1 8A 1.5S40FSS 30.1 8A 4X1.5S40FSS 55 51X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
2 2S40F 39.1 9A 2S40FSS 39.1 9A 4X2S40FSS 55 51X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
3 3S40F 60 10A 3S40FSS 60 10A 4X3S40FSS 75 52X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
5 5S40F 115 13B 5S40FSS 115 13B 4X5S40FSS 125 52X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
7.5 7S40F 135 13B 7S40FSS 135 13B 4X7S40FSS 150 52X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
10 10S40F 165 13B 10S40FSS 165 13B 4X10S40FSS 180 52X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
15 15S40F 225 15B 15S40FSS 225 15B 4X15S40FSS 390 53X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
25 25S40F 300 15B 25S40FSS 300 15B 4X25S40FSS 450 53X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
Single Phase—600 Vac Primary 120/240 Vac Secondary, 60 Hz; UL/cULus Listed
1 1S51F 21.2 7A 1S51FSS 21.2 7A 4X1S51FSS 48 51X None 115 180
1.5 1.5S51F 30.1 8A 1.5S51FSS 30.1 8A 4X1.5S51FSS 55 51X None 115 180
2 2S51F 39.1 9A 2S51FSS 39.1 9A 4X2S51FSS 55 51X None 115 180
3 3S4F 60 10A 3S4FSS 60 10A 4X3S4FSS 75 52X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
5 5S4F 115 13B 5S4FSS 115 13B 4X5S4FSS 125 52X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
7.5 7S4F 135 13B 7S4FSS 135 13B 4X7S4FSS 150 52X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
10 10S4F 165 13B 10S4FSS 165 13B 4X10S4FSS 180 52X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
15 15S4F 225 15B 15S4FSS 225 15B 4X15S4FSS 390 53X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
25 25S4F 300 15B 25S4FSS 300 15B 4X25S4FSS 450 53X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
Single Phase—208 Vac Primary 120/240 Vac Secondary, 60 Hz; UL/cULus Listed
1 1S7F 21.2 7A 1S7FSS 21.2 7A 4X1S7FSS 48 51X None 115 180
1.5 1.5S7F 30.1 8A 1.5S7FSS 30.1 8A 4X1.5S7FSS 55 51X None 115 180
2 2S7F 39.1 9A 2S7FSS 39.1 9A 4X2S7FSS 55 51X None 115 180
3 3S60F 60 10A 3S60FSS 60 10A 4X3S60FSS 75 52X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
5 5S60F 115 13B 5S60FSS 115 13B 4X5S60FSS 125 52X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
7.5 7S60F 135 13B 7S60FSS 135 13B 4X7S60FSS 150 52X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
10 10S60F 165 13B 10S60FSS 165 13B 4X10S60FSS 180 52X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
15 15S60F 225 15B 15S60FSS 225 15B 4X15S60FSS 390 53X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
25 25S60F 300 15B 25S60FSS 300 15B 4X25S60FSS 450 53X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
Single Phase—277 Vac Primary 120/240 Vac Secondary, 60 Hz; UL/cULus Listed
1 1S8F 21.2 7A 1S8FSS 21.2 7A 4X1S8FSS 48 51X None 115 180
1.5 1.5S8F 30.1 8A 1.5S8FSS 30.1 8A 4X1.5S8FSS 55 51X None 115 180
2 2S8F 39.1 9A 2S8FSS 39.1 9A 4X2S8FSS 55 51X None 115 180
3 3S61F 60 10A 3S61FSS 60 10A 4X3S61FSS 75 52X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
5 5S61F 115 13B 5S61FSS 115 13B 4X5S61FSS 125 52X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
7.5 7S61F 135 13B 7S61FSS 135 13B 4X7S61FSS 150 52X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
10 10S61F 165 13B 10S61FSS 165 13B 4X10S61FSS 180 52X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
15 15S61F 225 15B 15S61FSS 225 15B 4X15S61FSS 390 53X 2–5%FCBN 115 180
25 25S61F 300 15B 25S61FSS 300 15B 4X25S61FSS 450 53X 2–5%FCBN 115 180

Table 14.15: Single-Phase—120/240 Vac Secondary 60 Hz; cULus Listed


kVA 240 x 480 Primary Weight (lbs) Enclosure[17] 600 Primary Weight (lbs) Enclosure[17] Full Degree C Insulation Class
Catalog No. [15] Catalog No. [15] Capacity Taps Temperature
Rise
0.05 50SV1A 4.2 1A 50SV51A 4.2 1A None 55 105
TRANSFORMERS

0.1 100SV1A 4.5 2A 100SV51A 4.5 2A None 55 105


0.15 150SV1A 6.2 3A 150SV51A 6.2 3A None 55 105
0.25 250SV1B 10.5 4A 250SV51B 10.5 4A None 80 130
0.5 500SV1B 13.8 5A 500SV51B 13.8 5A None 80 130
0.75 750SV1F 15.5 6A 750SV51F 15.5 6A None 115 180

[15] Not for construction, Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for certified prints.
[16] For enclosure styles, see Table 14.8 Enclosure Dimensions and Accessories, page 14-8
[17] For enclosure styles, see Table 14.17 Enclosure Dimensions, page 14-12
14

[18] FCBN = Full Capacity Below Normal.


14-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution Resin Encapsulated Export Model and
Transformers Buck Boost Transformers
Class 7400 and 7414 / Refer to Catalogs 7400CT9601 and 7414CT0201 schneider-electric.us

Resin Encapsulated Export Model and Buck Boost Transformers


Single Phase Export Model
These general purpose transformers accommodate voltage systems world wide. Export
model transformers 10 kVA and smaller, CE marked in addition to being cULus Listed.
For CE marked transformers in other ratings, contact your local Schneider Electric
representative for CE marked transformers up to 300 kVA, single and three phase.

Table 14.16: Single-Phase—110/220 Vac Secondary; 50/60 Hz; cULus Listed (240 x 480 Vac Primary to 120/240 Vac Secondary - 60 Hz
only)
kVA 220 x 440 Primary Weight (lbs)[19] Enclosure[20] Full Capacity Taps Degree C Insulation
Catalog No. Temperature Class
Rise
1 1S67F 21.2 7A 190/200/208/220 x 380/400/416/440 115 180
2 2S67F 39.1 9A 190/200/208/220 x 380/400/416/440 115 180
3 3S67F 55.2 10A 190/200/208/220 x 380/400/416/440 115 180
5 5S67F 135 13B 190/200/208/220 x 380/400/416/440 115 180
7.5 7S67F 165 13B 190/200/208/220 x 380/400/416/440 115 180
10 10S67F 165 13B 190/200/208/220 x 380/400/416/440 115 180

Sealed Single-Phase Buck and Boost


When buck and boost transformers are interconnected as an autotransformer, they can
supply small changes in voltage. Wiring diagrams and sizing are available from catalog
7414CT0201 or www.buckboostcalculator.com.
Units can also be used as isolation transformers for:
120 x 240 to 12/24 or 16/32 and 240 x 480 to 24/48 by connecting using the diagram on
the nameplate.
NOTE: When used to supply a three-phase four-wire load, the source must be three-
phase four-wire.
kVA 120 x 240 Vac Primary 60 Hz 240 x 480 Vac Primary 60 Weight (lbs)[19] Enclosure[20] Degree C Insulation Class
Hz Temperature
12/24 Vac 16/32 Vac 24/48 Vac Secondary Rise
Secondary Secondary
0.05 50SV43A 50SV46A 50SV82A 4.2 1A 55 105
0.1 100SV43A 100SV46A 100SV82A 4.5 2A 55 105
0.15 150SV43A 150SV46A 150SV82A 6.2 3A 55 105
0.25 250SV43B 250SV46B 250SV82B 10.5 4A 80 130
0.5 500SV43B 500SV46B 500SV82B 13.8 5A 80 130
0.75 750SV43F 750SV46F 750SV82F 15.5 6A 115 180
1 1S43F 1S46F 1S82F 21.2 7A 115 180
1.5 1.5S43F 1.5S46F 1.5S82F 30.1 8A 115 180
2 2S43F 2S46F 2S82F 39.1 9A 115 180
3 3S43F 3S46F 3S82F 60 * See table 14.17 115 180
3 kVA Buck Boost

3 kVA Buck Boost


Table 14.17: Enclosure Dimensions
Enclosure Number/ Height Width Depth Mounting
Style in. mm in. mm in. mm
1 A 5.00 127 4.47 114 3.44 87 Wall
2 A 5.50 140 4.47 114 3.44 87 Wall
3 A 5.00 127 4.85 123 3.75 95 Wall
4 A 5.50 140 5.23 133 4.06 103 Wall
5 A 6.19 157 6.19 157 4.69 119 Wall
6 A 6.69 170 6.19 157 4.69 119 Wall
7 A 8.13 270 6.94 176 5.31 135 Wall
8 A 8.25 210 8.68 220 6.56 167 Wall
Style A—Type 3R Rated Style B—Type 3R Rated 9 A 9.56 243 8.68 220 6.56 167 Wall
10 A 10.50 267 8.62 219 6.50 165 Wall
11 A 12.56 319 8.62 219 6.50 165 Wall
* 3 kVA Buck Boost 14.5 — 8.62 — 6.5 — —
12 C 13.50 343 14.75 375 9 229 Wall
13 B 14.75 375 9.75 248 11.75 298 Wall
14 C 14.75 375 19.1 485 2.25 311 Wall
15 B 20.00 508 15 381 13.5 343 Wall
16 C 22.00 559 25 635 13.5 343 Wall
51 X 9.5 24 10 25 7.75 20 Wall
52 X 12 30 13.75 35 13.75 35 Wall
53 X 24 61 21.5 55 16.38 42 Floor
54 X 23 58 25.5 65 13.75 35 Floor
Style C—Type 3R Rated Style X—Type 4X Rated 55 X 31.5 80 31.5 80 16.25 41 Floor
These dimensions are not for construction. Contact you local Schneider Electric representative for certified prints.

Fingersafe™ terminal block cover kits for encapsulated transformers can be used to
meet touch-safe requirements.
Enclosure Kit Catlog Number Description
7A (1 kVA) 7400ENT9 Terminal Block H1, H2, H3, H4, H5, H6, H7, H8, H9, H10 and X1, X2, X3, X4
9A (2 kVA) 7400ENT11 Terminal Block H1, H2, H3, H4, H5, H6, H7, H8, H9, H10 and X1, X2, X3, X4
10A (3 kVA) 7400ENT11 Terminal Block H1, H2, H3, H4, H5, H6, H7, H8, H9, H10 and X1, X2, X3, X4
13B (5–10 kVA) 7400ENT13 Terminal Block H1, H2, H3, H4, H5, H6, H7, H8, H9, H10 and X1, X2, X3, X4

[19] Not for construction, Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for certified prints.
[20] For enclosure styles, see Table 14.17 Enclosure Dimensions, page 14-12
14-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Non-Ventilated and Transformer House Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution
Transformers
schneider-electric.us

Non-Ventilated and Transformer House


Table 14.18: NV Three Phase; 60 Hz; 208Y/120 Vac Secondary[21]
kVA Type 3R - IP 54 Catalog No. Type 3R - IP 54 Catalog Full Capacity Taps Degree C Insulation %IZ Weight (lbs) Enclosure[23]
304 Stainless Steel Temp. Rise Class [22]
480 Vac Delta Primary, Aluminum Windings
15 15T3HNV 15T3HNVSS 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 2.8 — —
30 30T3HNV 30T3HNVSS 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.5 340 19E
45 45T3HNV 45T3HNVSS 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.3 510 19E
75 75T3HNV 75T3HNVSS 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 2.5 1025 22E
112.5 112T3HNV 112T3HNVSS 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.3 1250 24E
150 150T3HNV 150T3HNVSS 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 2.9 2000 25E
225 225T3HNV 225T3HNVSS 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.3 2100 30E
300 300T3HNV 300T3HNVSS 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 2.8 3950 31E

Table 14.19: NV Single Phase; 60 Hz; 120/240 Vac Secondary[21]


kVA Type 3R - IP 54 Catalog No. Type 3R - IP 54 Catalog Full Capacity Taps Degree C Insulation %IZ Weight (lbs) Enclosure[23]
304 Stainless Steel Temp. Rise Class [22]
240 x 480 Vac Primary, Aluminum Windings
15 15S3HNV 15S3HNVSS 150 220 4.4 230 17E
25 25S3HNV 25S3HNVSS 480 Vac 150 220 4.1 310 18E
37.5 37S3HNV 37S3HNVSS 6 - 2.5% 2+4- 150 220 4.4 350 18E
50 50S3HNV 50S3HNVSS 240 Vac 150 220 3.1 450 21E
75 75S3HNV 75S3HNVSS 3 -5% 1+2- 150 220 2.9 880 24E
100 100S3HNV 100S3HNVSS 150 220 1.7 975 25E

Table 14.20: Enclosure Dimensions and Accessories


Enclosure Height Width Depth Moun- Wall Ceiling Insula-
Number/ in. mm in. mm in. mm ting Mounting Mounting tion
Style Bracket Bracket Class oC
17 E 27 686 20 508 16 406 Floor WMB361362 CMB363 220
18 E 30 762 20 508 20 508 Floor WMB363364 CMB363 220
19 E 30 762 30 762 20 508 Floor WMB363364 CMB364 220
21 E 37 940 30 762 24 610 Floor — CMB364 220
22 E 43.75 1111 32 813 27 686 Floor — CMB380 220
24 E 49.5 1257 35 889 28.5 724 Floor — CMB381 220
25 E 49.5 1257 41 1041 32 813 Floor — — 220
26 E 57.5 1461 41 1041 32 813 Floor — — 220
28 E 60 1524 56 1422 36 914 Floor — — 220
29 E 68 1727 56 1422 36 914 Floor — — 220
30 E 71 1803 48 1219 36 914 Floor — — 220
31 E 74 1880 56 1422 40.5 1029 Floor — — 220
These dimensions are not for construction. Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for certified prints.
Style E—IP55 Rated

PZC Transformer Enclosures


Power Zone Center house is installed over the standard ventilated units to provide
additional security and environmental protection.
Type 3R enclosure Option # 1 constructed of 304 stainless steel for corrosive
protection.
Designed to allow energy efficient transformers to be installed in environments requiring
more protection.

Type 3R enclosure Option # 2 constructed of painted galvanized for safety


Designed to allow energy efficient transformers to be secured with a padlockable handle
for security, which is ideal for school yards.

PZC transformer enclosures are shipped separately from transformers so they can be
pre-installed on the job site.
Four standard enclosures of each type material are available for installation of
transformer enclosure types D and H.
Drawings are in the Classic Technical Library. Search by catalog number, which is the
same as the drawing number.

Table 14.21: Stainless Steel Option Table 14.22: Painted Galvanized Option
Catalog No. L W H Weight Enclosure Catalog No. L W H Weight Enclosure
7400SS3R-001 3'-8" 3'-4" 4'-9" 450 lbs 17D, 17H, 18D, 18H, 19D, 20D, 21D, 7400PG3R-001 3'-8" 3'-4" 4'-9" 450 lbs 17D, 17H, 18D, 18H, 19D,
22D 20D, 21D, 22D
7400SS3R-002 4'-6" 3'-9" 6'-0" 500 lbs 24D, 25D, 26D, 36D, 37D 7400PG3R-002 4'-6" 3'-9" 6'-0" 500 lbs 24D, 25D, 26D, 36D, 37D
TRANSFORMERS

7400SS3R-003 5'-8" 4'-1" 7'-0" 550 lbs 28D, 29D, 30D, 38D 7400PG3R-003 5'-8" 4'-1" 7'-0" 550 lbs 28D, 29D, 30D, 38D
7400SS3R-004 6'-4" 4'-9" 7'-10" 600 lbs 31D, 45D 7400PG3R-004 6'-4" 4'-9" 7'-10" 600 lbs 31D, 45D

[21] Lugs are furnished by customer.


[22] Not for construction, Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for certified prints.
14

[23] For enclosure styles, see Table 14.20 Enclosure Dimensions and Accessories, page 14-13
14-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Industrial Control Type T and Type TF
Class 9070 / Refer to Catalog 9070CT9901
schneider-electric.us

Type T and Type TF


Type T transformers are designed with low impedance windings for excellent voltage
regulation and can accommodate the high inrush current associated with contactors,
starters, solenoids, and relays. Type T transformers are manufactured using the most
advanced insulating materials and are the best choice if size and cost are of concern.
Type TF transformers include factory-installed primary and secondary fuse blocks. Type
TF transformers consist of two primary fuse blocks and one secondary fuse block. The
primary includes rejection-style clips to increase the AIC ratings for the fuses. Since the
fuse blocks are mounted on the top of the transformer, Type TF transformers are
interchangeable with Type T transformers except for their increased height.

Selection Guide
1. Determine the inrush and sealed VA of each coil in the control circuit and the VA of
all other components.
2. Total the sealed VA of all operating coils and the VA of all other loads. (This
determines the minimum VA size required for the circuit.)
3. Total the inrush VA of all coils that are starting at the same time and all loads and
coils that are running.
4. Locate a value in the VA column ofTable 14.23 Regulation Chart for Type T, page
14-14, shown below, that is equal to or greater than the value calculated in step 2.
5. In the VA row selected in step 4, find the inrush value under the appropriate voltage
regulation column ofTable 14.23 Regulation Chart for Type T, page 14-14, shown
below. If this value is greater than the calculated value from step 3, this is the
correct transformer VA rating.
If the inrush value on the selected VA row is not greater than the calculated value
from step 3, use the next higher transformer VA rating, that is, the rating on the next
row.
If your supply voltage is stable and fluctuates less than 5%, Schneider Electric
recommends you use the 90% secondary voltage column. If your supply voltage is not
stable and fluctuates more than 10% we recommend you use the 95% secondary
voltage column. We recommend that you never use the 85% secondary voltage column
since magnetic devices lose life expectancy if they are continuously started at 85% of
rated voltage.

Table 14.23: Regulation Chart for Type T


Inrush VA @ 20% power factor Inrush VA @ 40% power factor
VA 95% 90% 85% 95% 90% 85%
Secondary Secondary Secondary Secondary Secondary Secondary
Voltage Voltage Voltage Voltage Voltage Voltage
50 193 266 339 151 215 282
75 271 396 20 210 318 430
100 339 499 659 266 404 549
150 666 893 1120 529 731 942
200 588 815 1041 459 659 866
250 1416 1910 2388 1057 1494 1936
300 1634 2184 2709 1194 1681 2169
350 1894 2592 3261 1392 2005 621
500 3197 4104 4981 2374 3195 4019
750 3770 5515 7231 2887 4391 5945
1000 6587 9079 11430 4706 6886 9051
1500 19324 23983 28607 15066 19361 23756
2000 31384 38777 6161 24794 31630 38667
3000 26539 39934 52713 19355 30721 42216
5000 53111 85265 116277 39368 66309 93882
14
TRANSFORMERS

14-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Type T and Type TF Industrial Control
Class 9070 / Refer to Catalog 9070CT9901
schneider-electric.us

Table 14.24: 240 x 480 V Primary, 120 V Secondary; 230 x 460 V Primary, 115 V Secondary; 220 x 440 V Primary, 110 V Secondary
VA Type T Type TF Weight Height Width Depth Acceso-
Type T Type TF ry
Finger-
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm safe
Covers
25 25 9070T25D1 9070TF25D1 2.5 2.58 66 4.00 102 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
50 50 9070T50D1 9070TF50D1 2.5 2.58 66 4.00 102 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D1 9070TF75D1 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D1 9070TF100D1 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
150 150 9070T150D1 9070TF150D1 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
200 200 9070T200D1 9070TF200D1 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
250 160 9070T250D1 9070TF250D1 7.1 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D1 9070TF300D1 8.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D1 9070TF350D1 10.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D1 9070TF500D1 11.9 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
750 500 9070T750D1 9070TF750D1 11.0 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D1 9070TF1000D1 20.6 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2
1500 1000 9070T1500D1 9070TF1500D1 34.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC2
2000 1500 9070T2000D1 9070TF2000D1 47.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 7.17 182 FSC2
3000 2000 9070T3000D1 — 60.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 7.24 184 FSC2
5000 3000 9070T5000D1 — 89.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 9.15 232 FSC2

Table 14.25: 208 Vac Primary, 120 Vac Secondary


VA Type T Type TF Weight Height Width Depth Acceso-
Type T Type TF ry
Finger-
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm safe
Covers
25 25 9070T25D3 9070TF25D3 2.5 2.58 66 4.00 102 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
50 50 9070T50D3 9070TF50D3 2.5 2.58 66 4.00 102 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D3 9070TF75D3 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D3 9070TF100D3 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
150 150 9070T150D3 9070TF150D3 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
200 200 9070T200D3 9070TF200D3 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
250 160 9070T250D3 9070TF250D3 7.1 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D3 9070TF300D3 8.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D3 9070TF350D3 10.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D3 9070TF500D3 11.9 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
750 500 9070T750D3 9070TF750D3 11.0 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D3 9070TF1000D3 20.6 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2
1500 1000 9070T1500D3 9070TF1500D3 34.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC2
2000 1500 9070T2000D3 9070TF2000D3 47.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 7.17 182 FSC2
3000 2000 9070T3000D3 — 60.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 7.24 184 FSC2
5000 3000 9070T5000D3 — 89.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 9.15 232 FSC2

Table 14.26: 600 Vac Primary, 120 Vac Secondary


VA Type T Type TF Weight Height Width Depth Acceso-
Type T Type TF ry
Finger-
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm safe
Covers
25 25 9070T25D5 9070TF25D5 2.5 2.58 66 4.00 102 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
50 50 9070T50D5 9070TF50D5 2.5 2.58 66 4.00 102 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D5 9070TF75D5 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D5 9070TF100D5 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
150 150 9070T150D5 9070TF150D5 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
200 200 9070T200D5 9070TF200D5 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
250 160 9070T250D5 9070TF250D5 7.1 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D5 9070TF300D5 8.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D5 9070TF350D5 10.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D5 9070TF500D5 11.9 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
750 500 9070T750D5 9070TF750D5 11.0 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D5 9070TF1000D5 20.6 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2
1500 1000 9070T1500D5 9070TF1500D5 34.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC2
2000 1500 9070T2000D5 9070TF2000D5 47.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 7.17 182 FSC2
3000 2000 9070T3000D5 — 60.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 7.24 184 FSC2
5000 3000 9070T5000D5 — 89.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 9.15 232 FSC2

Table 14.27: 277 Vac Primary, 120 Vac Secondary


VA Type T Type TF[1] Weight Height Width Depth Acceso-
Type T Type TF ry
Finger-
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm safe
Covers
25 25 9070T25D4 — 2.5 2.58 66 — — 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
50 50 9070T50D4 — 2.5 2.58 66 — — 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D4 — 3.8 2.89 73 — — 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D4 — 3.8 2.89 73 — — 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
TRANSFORMERS

150 150 9070T150D4 — 5.5 3.20 81 — — 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1


200 200 9070T200D4 — 5.5 3.20 81 — — 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
250 160 9070T250D4 — 7.1 3.20 81 — — 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D4 — 8.5 3.84 98 — — 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D4 — 10.5 3.84 98 — — 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D4 — 11.9 3.84 98 — — 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
750 500 9070T750D4 — 11.0 4.51 115 — — 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D4 — 20.6 4.51 115 — — 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2
1500 1000 9070T1500D4 — 34.0 6.17 157 — — 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC2
2000 1500 9070T2000D4 — 47.0 6.17 157 — — 7.06 179 7.17 182 FSC2
3000 2000 9070T3000D4 — 60.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 7.24 184 FSC2
5000 3000 9070T5000D4 — 89.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 9.15 232 FSC2
14

[1] TF units are design for line to line voltages on the primary, 277 Vac is a line to neutral voltage.
14-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Industrial Control Type T and Type TF
Class 9070 / Refer to Catalog 9070CT9901
schneider-electric.us

Table 14.28: 240 x 480 V Primary, 120/240 V Secondary; 230 x 460 V Primary, 115/230 V Secondary; 220 x 440 V Primary, 110/220 V
Secondary
VA Type T Type TF[2] Weight Height Width Depth Acceso-
Type T Type TF ry
Finger-
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm safe
Covers
25 25 9070T25D31 9070TF25D31 2.5 2.58 66 4.00 102 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
50 50 9070T50D31 9070TF50D31 2.5 2.58 66 4.00 102 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D31 9070TF75D31 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D31 9070TF100D31 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
150 150 9070T150D31 9070TF150D31 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
200 200 9070T200D31 9070TF200D31 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
250 160 9070T250D31 9070TF250D31 7.1 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D31 9070TF300D31 8.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D31 9070TF350D31 10.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D31 9070TF500D31 11.9 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
750 500 9070T750D31 9070TF750D31 11.0 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D31 9070TF1000D31 20.6 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2
1500 1000 9070T1500D31 9070TF1500D31 34.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC2
2000 1500 9070T2000D31 9070TF2000D31 47.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 7.17 182 FSC2
3000 2000 9070T3000D31 — 60.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 7.24 184 FSC2
5000 3000 9070T5000D31 — 89.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 9.15 232 FSC2

Table 14.29: 600 Vac Primary, 120/240 Vac Secondary


VA Type T Type TF[2] Weight Height Width Depth Acceso-
Type T Type TF ry
Finger-
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm safe
Covers
25 25 9070T25D37 9070TF25D37 2.5 2.58 66 4.00 102 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
50 50 9070T50D37 9070TF50D37 2.5 2.58 66 4.00 102 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D37 9070TF75D37 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D37 9070TF100D37 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
150 150 9070T150D37 9070TF150D37 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
200 200 9070T200D37 9070TF200D37 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
250 160 9070T250D37 9070TF250D37 7.1 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D37 9070TF300D37 8.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D37 9070TF350D37 10.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D37 9070TF500D37 11.9 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
750 500 9070T750D37 9070TF750D37 11.0 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D37 9070TF1000D37 20.6 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2
1500 1000 9070T1500D37 9070TF1500D37 34.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC2
2000 1500 9070T2000D37 9070TF2000D37 47.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 7.17 182 FSC2
3000 2000 9070T3000D37 — 60.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 7.24 184 FSC2
5000 3000 9070T5000D37 — 89.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 9.15 232 FSC2

Table 14.30: 380/400/415 Vac Primary, 115/230 Vac Secondary


VA Type T Type TF Weight Height Width Depth Acceso-
Type T Type TF ry
Finger-
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm safe
Covers
25 25 9070T25D33 9070TF25D33 2.5 2.58 66 4.00 102 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
50 50 9070T50D33 9070TF50D33 2.5 2.58 66 4.00 102 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D33 9070TF75D33 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D33 9070TF100D33 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
150 150 9070T150D33 9070TF150D33 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
200 200 9070T200D33 9070TF200D33 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
250 160 9070T250D33 9070TF250D33 7.1 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D33 9070TF300D33 8.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D33 9070TF350D33 10.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D33 9070TF500D33 11.9 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
750 500 9070T750D33 9070TF750D33 11.0 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D33 9070TF1000D33 20.6 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2
1500 1000 9070T1500D33 9070TF1500D33 34.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC2
2000 1500 9070T2000D33 9070TF2000D33 47.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 7.17 182 FSC2
3000 2000 9070T3000D33 — 60.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 7.24 184 FSC2
5000 3000 9070T5000D33 — 89.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 9.15 232 FSC2
Field Installed Fuse Blocks—Design for Line to Line Primary Voltages and Line to
Neutral Secondary Voltages

Table 14.31: Accessories


14

Catalog No. Voltage Codes Description Order Qty


Fuse Kit
D1, D2, D3, D4, D5, D20, D32 D19, D50
— D13, D14,D15, D23, — —
D31, D33, D37
9070FB3A T25–T200 T25–T150 — 3-pole fuse block for primary and secondary fusing, accommodates 1- 1
9070FB3B T250–T3000 T250–T2000 T25–T2000 1/2 x 13/32 in. midget fuse (2 rejection and 1 non-rejection) 1
9070FB2A T25–T200 T25–T150 2-pole fuse block for primary fusing, accommodates 1-1/2 x 13/32 in. 1
TRANSFORMERS

9070FB2B T250–T3000 T250–T2000 T25–T2000 midget fuse (2 rejection) 1


9070SF25A T25–T200 T25–T150 Secondary fuse clips accommodates 1-1/4 x 1/4 in. fuse 10
9070SF25B T250–T3000 T250–T2000 T25–T2000 10
9070SF41A T25–T200 T25–T150 Secondary fuse clips accommodates 1-1/2 x 13/32 in. fuse 10
9070SF41B T250–T3000 T250–T2000 T25–T2000 10
9070FB1A T25–T200 T25–T150 Secondary fuse block accommodates 1-1/4 x 1/4 in. fuse 1
9070FB1B T250–T3000 T250–T2000 T25–T2000 1
9070FP1 — — — Fuse puller for TF and FB kits 10

[2] TF designed for line to line primary and line to neutral secondary. If secondary connected in series, fuse block should be disconnected.
14-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Type T and Type TF Industrial Control
Class 9070 / Refer to Catalog 9070CT9901
schneider-electric.us

Table 14.32: 208/230/460 Vac Primary, 115 Vac Secondary


VA Type T Type TF Weight Height Width Depth Acceso-
Type T Type TF ry
Finger-
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm safe
Covers
50 50 9070T50D20 9070TF50D20 4.0 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D20 9070TF75D20 5.5 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D20 9070TF100D20 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
150 150 9070T150D20 9070TF150D20 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
200 200 9070T200D20 9070TF200D20 8.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
250 160 9070T250D20 9070TF250D20 10.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D20 9070TF300D20 10.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D20 9070TF350D20 11.9 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D20 9070TF500D20 11.0 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
750 500 9070T750D20 9070TF750D20 20.6 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D20 9070TF1000D20 34.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC2
1500 1000 9070T1500D20 9070TF1500D20 47.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 7.17 182 FSC2
2000 1500 9070T2000D20 9070TF2000D20 60.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 7.24 184 FSC2
3000 2000 9070T3000D20 — 89.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 9.15 232 FSC2

Table 14.33: 240/480/600 V Primary, 120 V Secondary; 230/460/575 V Primary, 115 V Secondary; 220/440/550 V Primary to 110 V
Secondary
VA Type T Type TF Weight Height Width Depth Acceso-
Type T Type TF ry
Finger-
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm safe
Covers
50 50 9070T50D32 9070TF50D32 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D32 9070TF75D32 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D32 9070TF100D32 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
150 150 9070T150D32 9070TF150D32 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
200 200 9070T200D32 9070TF200D32 7.1 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
250 160 9070T250D32 9070TF250D32 8.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D32 9070TF300D32 10.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D32 9070TF350D32 11.9 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D32 9070TF500D32 11.0 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
750 500 9070T750D32 9070TF750D32 20.6 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D32 9070TF1000D32 34.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC2
1500 1000 9070T1500D32 9070TF1500D32 47.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 7.17 182 FSC2
2000 1500 9070T2000D32 9070TF2000D32 60.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 7.24 184 FSC2
3000 2000 9070T3000D32 — 89.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 9.15 232 FSC2

Table 14.34: 240/416/480/600 Vac Primary, 99/120/130 Vac Secondary; 230/400/460/575 Vac Primary, 95/115/125 Vac Secondary;
220/380/440/550 Vac Primary, 90/110/120 Vac Secondary; 208/360/416/520 Vac Primary, 85/104/115 Vac Secondary
VA Type T Type TF Weight Height Width Depth Acceso-
Type T Type TF ry
Finger-
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm safe
Covers
50 50 9070T50D50 9070TF50D50 4.0 2.89 73 4.19 106 3.38 86 4.43 113 FSC23
75 75 9070T75D50 9070TF75D50 7.2 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 4.70 119 FSC23
100 100 9070T100D50 9070TF100D50 7.1 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 4.70 119 FSC23
150 150 9070T150D50 9070TF150D50 8.5 3.84 98 5.14 131 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC23
200 200 9070T200D50 9070TF200D50 10.5 3.84 98 5.14 131 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC23
250 160 9070T250D50 9070TF250D50 10.5 3.84 98 5.14 131 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC23
300 200 9070T300D50 9070TF300D50 11.9 3.84 98 5.14 131 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC23
350 250 9070T350D50 9070TF350D50 11.0 4.51 115 5.81 148 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC23
500 300 9070T500D50 9070TF500D50 11.0 4.51 115 5.81 148 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC23
750 500 9070T750D50 9070TF750D50 20.6 4.51 115 5.81 148 5.25 133 6.3. 160 FSC23
1000 630 9070T1000D50 9070TF1000D50 34.0 6.17 157 7.47 190 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC23
1500 1000 9070T1500D50 9070TF1500D50 47.0 6.17 157 7.47 190 7.06 179 7.17 182 FSC23
2000 1500 9070T2000D50 9070TF2000D50 60.0 7.63 194 8.93 227 9.00 229 6.38 162 FSC23

Table 14.35: 240 x 480 Vac Primary, 120/24 Vac Secondary (24 Vac limited to 20% of nameplate VA)
VA Type T Type TF Weight Height Width Depth Acceso-
Type T Type TF ry
Finger-
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm safe
Covers
50 50 9070T50D15 — 2.5 2.58 66 — — 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D15 — 3.8 2.89 73 — — 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D15 — 3.8 2.89 73 — — 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
150 150 9070T150D15 — 5.5 3.20 81 — — 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
200 200 9070T200D15 — 5.5 3.20 81 — — 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
250 160 9070T250D15 — 7.1 3.20 81 — — 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D15 — 8.5 3.84 98 — — 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D15 — 10.5 3.84 98 — — 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D15 — 11.9 3.84 98 — — 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
TRANSFORMERS

750 500 9070T750D15 — 11.0 4.51 115 — — 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D15 — 20.6 4.51 115 — — 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2
1500 1000 9070T1500D15 — 34.0 6.17 157 — — 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC2
2000 1500 9070T2000D15 — 47.0 6.17 157 — — 7.06 179 7.17 182 FSC2
3000 2000 9070T3000D15 — 60.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 7.24 184 FSC2
5000 3000 9070T5000D15 — 89.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 9.15 232 FSC2

Table 14.36: Accessories


Catalog No. Voltage Codes Description Order Qty
D1, D2, D3, D4, D5, D13, D14,D15, D23, D31, D20, D32 D19, D50
— D33, D37 — —
9070FSC1 T25–T200 T25–T150 — 2 covers per kit 10
9070FSC2 T250–T5000 T250–T5000 — 2 covers per kit 10
9070FSC23 — — T25–T5000 2 covers per kit 10
14

14-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Industrial Control Type T and Type TF
Class 9070 / Refer to Catalog 9070CT9901
schneider-electric.us

Table 14.37: 240 x 480 Vac Primary, 24 Vac Secondary


VA Type T Weight Height Width Depth Accesory
Type T Fingersafe
Covers
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm
50 50 9070T50D2 2.5 2.58 66 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D2 3.8 2.89 73 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D2 3.8 2.89 73 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
150 150 9070T150D2 5.5 3.20 81 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
200 200 9070T200D2 5.5 3.20 81 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
250 160 9070T250D2 7.1 3.20 81 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D2 8.5 3.84 98 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D2 10.5 3.84 98 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D2 11.9 3.84 98 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
750 500 9070T750D2 11.0 4.51 115 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D2 20.6 4.51 115 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2

Table 14.38: 208 Vac Primary, 24 Vac Secondary


VA Type T Weight Height Width Depth Accesory
Type T Fingersafe
Covers
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm
50 50 9070T50D14 2.5 2.58 66 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D14 3.8 2.89 73 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D14 3.8 2.89 73 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
150 150 9070T150D14 5.5 3.20 81 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
200 200 9070T200D14 5.5 3.20 81 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
250 160 9070T250D14 7.1 3.20 81 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D14 8.5 3.84 98 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D14 10.5 3.84 98 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D14 11.9 3.84 98 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
750 500 9070T750D14 11.0 4.51 115 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D14 20.6 4.51 115 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2

Table 14.39: 120 x 240 Vac Primary, 24 Vac Secondary


VA Type T Weight Height Width Depth Accesory
Type T Fingersafe
Covers
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm
50 50 9070T50D23 2.5 2.58 66 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D23 3.8 2.89 73 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D23 3.8 2.89 73 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
150 150 9070T150D23 5.5 3.20 81 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
200 200 9070T200D23 5.5 3.20 81 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
250 160 9070T250D23 7.1 3.20 81 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D23 8.5 3.84 98 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D23 10.5 3.84 98 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D23 11.9 3.84 98 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
750 500 9070T750D23 11.0 4.51 115 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D23 20.6 4.51 115 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2

Table 14.40: 120 Vac Primary, 12/24 Vac Secondary


VA Type T Weight Height Width Depth Accesory
Type T Fingersafe
Covers
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm
50 50 9070T50D13 2.5 2.58 66 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D13 3.8 2.89 73 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D13 3.8 2.89 73 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
150 150 9070T150D13 5.5 3.20 81 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
200 200 9070T200D13 5.5 3.20 81 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
250 160 9070T250D13 7.1 3.20 81 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D13 8.5 3.84 98 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D13 10.5 3.84 98 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D13 11.9 3.84 98 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
750 500 9070T750D13 11.0 4.51 115 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D13 20.6 4.51 115 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2

Table 14.41: 208/240/277/380/480 Vac Primary, 24 Vac Secondary


VA Type T Weight Height Width Depth Accesory
Type T Fingersafe
Covers
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm
14

50 50 9070T50D19 4.0 2.89 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC23


75 75 9070T75D19 5.5 2.89 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC23
100 100 9070T100D19 5.5 3.20 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC23
150 150 9070T150D19 5.5 3.20 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC23
200 200 9070T200D19 8.5 3.20 114 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC23
250 160 9070T250D19 10.5 3.84 130 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC23
300 200 9070T300D19 10.5 3.84 130 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC23
350 250 9070T350D19 11.9 3.84 130 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC23
TRANSFORMERS

500 300 9070T500D19 11.0 4.51 147 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC23
750 500 9070T750D19 20.6 4.51 147 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC23
1000 630 9070T1000D19 34.0 6.17 190 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC23

14-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Transformer Disconnects Industrial Control
Class 9070 / Refer to Catalog 9070CT0301
schneider-electric.us

Transformer Disconnects for NEMA Type 1 and Type 12


Enclosures
Square D™ brand transformer disconnects mount inside or outside a control system
enclosure. The transformer disconnect being connected directly to the 480 Vac system
controls power for auxiliary, single-phase loads when the main three-phase disconnect is
either ON or OFF. The transformer disconnect is normally wired to the line side of the
control panel's main disconnect.
This convenient source of 120 Vac power can be used for auxiliary or isolated loads,
such as panel lighting, portable power tools, and programmable controller equipment.
Units consist of copper-wound transformers, a disconnect switch, and primary and
secondary fuse blocks. All blocks are installed in NEMA Type 1 or Type 12 enclosures.
Transformer disconnects are UL Listed. Use Square D™ brand Type TF industrial
control transformers and Square D™ brand disconnect switches.
Multiple enclosure options and accessories are available. See catalog 9070CT0301 or
contact your local Schneider Electric representative or distributor.
• Standard NEMA Type 1
Transformer disconnects are available in NEMA Type 1
• Mini NEMA Type 1
Standard, NEMA Type 12 Standard, and NEMA Type 1 Mini. • Compact NEMA Type 1
• NEMA Type 12
Table 14.42: Transformer Disconnects
Catalog Catalog
No. No. H W D Weight
VA Enclosure (lbs)
Without Outlet With Outlet in. mm in. mm in. mm
NEMA Type 1 Enclosure, 240 x 480 Vac Primary, 120 Vac Secondary (Compact Design)
100 9070MN100G0D1 9070MN100G0D1G13 G0 7.00 178 11.30 287 7.81 198 16
250 9070MN250G0D1 9070MN250G0D1G13 G0 7.00 178 11.30 287 7.81 198 21
500 9070MN500G0D1 9070MN500G0D1G13 G0 7.00 178 11.30 287 7.81 198 24
750 9070SK750G3D1 9070SK750G3D1G13 G3 13.40 340 14.80 376 10.21 259 47
1000 9070SK1000G3D1 9070SK1000G3D1G13 G3 13.40 340 14.80 376 10.21 259 51
1500 9070SK1500G3D1 9070SK1500G3D1G13 G3 13.40 340 14.80 376 10.21 259 65
2000 9070SK2000G3D1 9070SK2000G3D1G13 G3 13.40 340 14.80 376 10.21 259 71
3000 9070SK3000G3D1 9070SK3000G3D1G13 G3 13.40 340 14.80 376 10.21 259 85
NEMA Type 1 Enclosure, 240 x 480 Vac Primary, 120 Vac Secondary
250 9070SK250G1D1 9070SK250G1D1G13 G1 9.40 239 11.80 300 8.96 228 26
500 9070SK500G1D1 9070SK500G1D1G13 G1 9.40 239 11.80 300 8.96 228 28
750 9070SK750G1D1 9070SK750G1D1G13 G1 9.40 239 11.80 300 8.96 228 33
1000 9070SK1000G1D1 9070SK1000G1D1G13 G1 9.40 239 11.80 300 8.96 228 37
1500 9070SK1500G2D1 9070SK1500G2D1G13 G2 13.40 340 14.80 376 12.21 310 67
2000 9070SK2000G2D1 9070SK2000G2D1G13 G2 13.40 340 14.80 376 12.21 310 73
3000 9070SK3000G2D1 9070SK3000G2D1G13 G2 13.40 340 14.80 376 12.21 310 87
NEMA Type 1 Enclosure, 480 Vac Primary, 120 Vac Secondary
5000 9070SK5000G4D9 9070SK5000G4D9G13 G4 16.90 429 18.20 462 14.50 368 125
NEMA Type 12 Enclosure, 240 x 480 Vac Primary, 120 Vac Secondary
250 9070SK250A2D1 9070SK250A2D1G13 A2 16.50 419 14.50 368 13.50 343 46
500 9070SK500A2D1 9070SK500A2D1G13 A2 16.50 419 14.50 368 13.50 343 49
750 9070SK750A2D1 9070SK750A2D1G13 A2 16.50 419 14.50 368 13.50 343 53
1000 9070SK1000A2D1 9070SK1000A2D1G13 A2 16.50 419 14.50 368 13.50 343 58
1500 9070SK1500A2D1 9070SK1500A2D1G13 A2 16.50 419 14.50 368 13.50 343 79
2000 9070SK2000A2D1 9070SK2000A2D1G13 A2 16.50 419 14.50 368 13.50 343 85
3000 9070SK3000A2D1 9070SK3000A2D1G13 A2 16.50 419 14.50 368 13.50 343 99
NEMA Type 12 Enclosure, 240 x 480 Vac Primary, 120 Vac Secondary, Flange Switch
250 9070SK250A3D1 9070SK250A3D1G13 A3 15.50 394 17.00 432 10.00 254 48
500 9070SK500A3D1 9070SK500A3D1G13 A3 15.50 394 17.00 432 10.00 254 53
750 9070SK750A3D1 9070SK750A3D1G13 A3 15.50 394 17.00 432 10.00 254 57
1000 9070SK1000A3D1 9070SK1000A3D1G13 A3 15.50 394 17.00 432 10.00 254 61
1500 9070SK1500A3D1 9070SK1500A3D1G13 A3 15.50 394 17.00 432 10.00 254 75
2000 9070SK2000A3D1 9070SK2000A3D1G13 A3 15.50 394 17.00 432 10.00 254 86

TRANSFORMERS
14

14-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Instrument, 600 Volt Class Voltage and Current Transformers
Class 4210 / Refer to Catalog 4210CT9701
schneider-electric.us

Voltage Transformers
Schneider Electric offers three models of voltage transformers, each suited for a
particular application:
• Model 450R
– Applications requiring accurate voltage measurement within the 0.3% accuracy
class
– Switchboards with 1% instrumentation
• Model 460R
– Applications with less critical accuracy and low burden requirements
– Transducers and other panelboard monitoring
• Model 470R
– Extremely accurate voltage measurement
– Low burden applications, such as PLC modules and similar, high-impedance
electronic devices

Table 14.43: Voltage Transformers


Accuracy/Burden and Thermal Rating Primary Voltages
Application Model Number (120 Vac Secondary)
Large burden 450R 0.3 W, X, M, Y; 500 VA Thermal 120–600 Vac
Small burden 460R 0.6 W, 1.2X; 150 VA Thermal 120–600 Vac
Small burden 470R 0.3W, 1.2X; 150 VA Thermal 120–600 Vac

Current Transformers
Current transformers are low cost, compact units that offer good electrical performance
in a general purpose transformer.
• They are very easy to mount on the conductors.
• All current transformers feature permanent polarity marks molded into the case.
The following types of current transformers are available:
• General purpose
• Toroidal (single ratio)
• Rectangle window (single ratio)
• Split core
• Bushing (single ratio) (multi-ratio)
For part numbers, see Section 6 of the Supplemental Digest or see the Schneider
Electric Product Configurator.
Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for other available features.

Table 14.44: Current Transformers


Window Diameter Usual Application
Model Number Primary Range in Amperes [1] UL Recognized
Metering or Control High Output Product
in. mm Metering Relaying Relaying
1.3 28 2NR X — — 50–300
5NR X — — 100–600
1.56 40
54R X — — 100–600
64R X — — 100–750
1.94 49
66R — X — 100–750
7RL — — — 50–1500
2.25 57 50–1500
7RT — — —   150–1500 [2]
74R X — — 200–1500
2.34 59
76R — X — 200–1500
74RFT — — — —
2.50 63 180R — X — 100–1500
200R — X — 100–600
3.50 89 201R — X — 100–800
100R — X — 200–2000 Yes
4.00 102
110R — X — 200–2000
4.25 108 170R — X — 200–2000
14

312R — X 600–4000
4.50 114
202R — X X 100–1000
5.25 133 203R — X — 100–3000
5.75 146 120R — X — 200–3000
6.25 159 210R — X X 200–3000
151R — X 600–4000
6.88 175
152R — X X 50–4000
8.13 206 140R — X X 50–6000
2.12 x 4.25 54 x 108 260R X — — 100–4000
TRANSFORMERS

3.50 x 6.25 89 x 159 273 X — — 200–4000


3.56 x 8.81 90 x 224 270R X — — 400–5000
7.45 x 3.75 189 x 95 560R X — — 400–5000

[1] With a 5 A secondary.


[2] With a 1 A secondary.
14-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
New! Energy Efficient Medium Voltage Energy Efficient, Dry Type 2.4, 5, and 15 kV
Distribution Transformers
schneider-electric.us Class 7432

Medium Voltage Distribution Transformers


New! Revised Medium Voltage Transformer Energy Efficiency Information For 2016!
In 2010 Schneider Electric released new efficiencies for MV transformers based on The
Department of Energy (DOE) 10 CFR Part 431 Energy Conservation program for
Commercial Equipment. We are now launching even more efficient transformers to
further reduce energy consumption from MV transformers. Starting January 1, 2016
certain medium voltage distribution transformers with ratings of 2,500 kVA and below,
34.5 kV primary and below and 600 Vac class secondary voltages must meet revised
minimum efficiency requirements. Liquid Filled Padmounts, Liquid Filled Substations,
Dry Type VPI and Power Cast products shipped after January 1, 2016 will all be
included. The minimum efficiency tables are listed below. Please contact your nearest
Schneider Electric Sales Office for more information. Page 14-19 and 14-20 includes our
updated offer.

Table 14.45: New! Standard Efficiency Levels for Liquid Immersed Distribution
Transformers
Power Cast II™
Single Phase Three Phase
kVA Efficiency % kVA Efficiency %
10 98.7 — —
15 98.82 — —
25 98.95 45 98.92
37.5 99.05 75 99.03
50 99.11 112.5 99.11
75 99.19 150 99.16
100 99.25 225 99.23
167 99.33 300 99.27
250 99.39 500 99.35
333 99.43 750 99.4
500 99.49 1000 99.43
667 99.52 1500 99.48
833 99.55 2000 99.51
Liquid Filled Pad Mounted — — 2500 99.53
All Efficiency values are at 50% of nameplate-rated load, determined according to the
DOE Test Procedure 10 CFR 431, Subpart K, Appendix A.

Table 14.46: New! Standard Levels for Medium Voltage Dry Type Distribution
Transformers
kVA Single Phase kVA Three Phase
20-45kV 46-95 kV >/ 96 kV 20-45kV 46-95 kV >/ 96 kV
BIL BIL BIL BIL BIL BIL
Efficiency Efficiency Efficiency Efficiency Efficiency Efficiency
% % % % % %
15 98.1 97.86 — 45 98.1 97.86 —
25 98.33 98.12 — 75 98.33 98.13 —
37.5 98.49 98.3 — 112.5 98.52 98.36 —
50 98.6 98.42 — 150 98.65 98.51 —
75 98.73 98.57 98.53 225 98.82 98.69 98.57
Liquid Filled Substation
100 98.82 98.67 98.63 300 98.93 98.81 98.69
167 98.96 98.83 98.8 500 99.09 98.99 98.89
250 99.07 98.95 98.91 750 99.21 99.12 99.02
333 99.14 99.03 98.99 1000 99.28 99.2 99.11
500 99.22 99.12 99.09 1500 99.37 99.3 99.21
667 99.27 99.18 99.15 2000 99.43 99.36 99.28
833 99.31 99.23 99.2 2500 99.47 99.41 99.33
NOTE: BIL means Basic Impulse Level.
NOTE: All Efficiency values are at 50% of nameplate-rated load, determined
according to the DOE Test Procedure 10 CFR 431, Subpart K, Appendix A.

Power Dry II™

TRANSFORMERS
14

14-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Energy Efficient, Dry Type 2.4, 5, and 15 kV New! Energy Efficient Medium Voltage
Distribution Transformers
Class 7432 schneider-electric.us

Dry Type Medium Voltage


All transformers are built with 220 oC insulation and 150 oC temperature rise.
For 115 oC rise add F to catalog number. For 80 oC rise add B to catalog number. For
copper windings, add CU to the end of the part number. Check with factory to verify
dimensional changes and weights for copper windings or alternate temperature rises.
Standard high voltage taps: 4-2.5%, 2AN and 2BN. For 4-2.5% FCBN, add BN to catalog
number.
New! 1,201–15,000 Vac Three-Phase Indoor Transformers
See Table 14.51 New! Enclosure Dimensions, page 14-23. Enclosures are for indoor use
only. If outdoor enclosure is required, this is outside the scope of the digest, contact your
local Schneider Electric Representative.
Lugs: Furnished by customer.

Table 14.47: New! EX Three Phase Medium Voltage Transformers Table 14.48: New! Three Phase Voltage Codes
kVA Catalog No. Minimum Weight (lbs) Enclosure kV Class Code Primary Secondary
Efficiency @ 50% 13 2400 Delta 208Y/120
load
14 2400 Delta 480Y/277
2.4 kV and 5 kV Voltage Class 60 Hz 150oC Rise 2.4
15 2400 Delta 240 Delta
112.5 EX112T( )H 98.52 1200 50D 30 kV BIL
16 2400 Delta 480 Delta
150 EX150T( )H 98.65 1400 51D 17 2400 Delta 600 Delta
225 EX225T( )H 98.82 1900 51D 18 4160 Delta 208Y/120
300 EX300T( )H 98.93 2100 52D 19 4160 Delta 480Y/277
500 EX500T( )H 99.09 3000 52D 20 4160 Delta 240 Delta
21 4160 Delta 480 Delta
750 EX750T( )H 99.21 5000 55F
22 4160 Delta 600 Delta
1000 EX1000T( )H 99.28 6000 56F 23 4160Y/2400 240 Delta
1500 EX1500T( )H 99.37 8100 56F 5 25 4160Y/2400 480 Delta
30 kV BIL
2000 EX2000T( )H 99.43 11000 57F 26 4160/2400 600 Delta
2500 EX2500T( )H 99.47 13100 58F 27 4800 Delta 208Y/120
15 kV Voltage Class 60 Hz 150oC Rise 28 4800 Delta 480Y/277
29 4800 Delta 240 Delta
112.5 EX112T( )H 98.36 2000 52D
30 4800 Delta 480 Delta
150 EX150T( )H 98.51 2200 52D 31 4800 Delta 600 Delta
225 EX225T( )H 98.69 2800 53D 32 7200 Delta 208Y/120
300 EX300T( )H 98.81 3300 53D 33 7200 Delta 480Y/277
500 EX500T( )H 98.99 5000 54F 34 7200 Delta 240 Delta
750 EX750T( )H 99.12 6000 55F 35 7200 Delta 480 Delta
36 7200 Delta 600 Delta
1000 EX1000T( )H 99.2 7400 56F
37 12000 Delta 208Y/120
1500 EX1500T( )H 99.3 9000 56F 38 12000 Delta 480Y/277
2000 EX2000T( )H 99.36 11000 57F 39 12000 Delta 240 Delta
2500 EX2500T( )H 99.41 13000 58F 40 12000 Delta 480 Delta
3000 EX3000T( )H — 18000 58F 41 12000 Delta 600 Delta
42 12470 Delta 208Y/120
43 12470 Delta 480Y/277
44 12470 Delta 240 Delta
45 12470 Delta 480 Delta
46 12470 Delta 600 Delta
15
47 12470Y/7200 240 Delta
60 kV BIL
48 12470Y/7200 480 Delta
49 12470Y/7200 600 Delta
50 13200 Delta 208Y/120
51 13200 Delta 480Y/277
52 13200 Delta 240 Delta
53 13200 Delta 480 Delta
54 13200 Delta 600 Delta
55 13200Y/7620 240 Delta
56 13200Y/7620 480 Delta
57 13200Y/7620 600 Delta
58 13800 Delta 208Y/120
59 13800 Delta 480Y/277
60 13800 Delta 240 Delta
61 13800 Delta 480 Delta
62 13800 Delta 600 Delta
All secondary voltages are at 10 KV BIL (BIL means Basic Impulse Level).

To complete the three-phase catalog numbers on this page:


1. Select the voltage you require from the chart on the pricing page.
14

2. Insert the voltage code number in place of the ( ) in the catalog number.

Example 1: 1,000 kVA Energy Efficient, 3Ø, 60 Hz, 150oC temp. rise, 60 kV BIL, NEMA sound level, ventilated
indoor enclosure, 13.2 kV delta 480Y/277, with 2-2.5% full capacity taps. 2AN and 2BN = EX1000T51H .
Example 2: 750 KVA Energy Efficient 3Ø, 60 Hz, 80oC temp. rise, 60 kV BIL, NEMA sound level, ventilated indoor
enclosure, 4160 V Delta, 480Y/277, 2-2.5% full capacity taps. 2AN and 2BN = Part number EX750T19HB.
Example 3: 500 kVA Energy Efficient, 3Ø, 60 Hz, 115oC temp. rise, Copper Windings, 60 kV BIL, NEMA sound level,
ventilated indoor enclosure, 12470 Vac delta, 208Y/120, with 2-2.5% full capacity taps. 2AN and 2BN =
EX500T42BCU.
TRANSFORMERS

14-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
New! Energy Efficient Medium Voltage Energy Efficient, Dry Type 2.4, 5, and 15 kV
Distribution Transformers
schneider-electric.us Class 7432
1,201–15,000 Vac Single-Phase Indoor Transformers
Table 14.49: New! EX Single Phase Medium Voltage Transformers
kVA Catalog No. Minimum Weight Enclosure
Efficiency @ (lbs)
50% load
2.4 kV Voltage Class 60 Hz 150 oC Rise
167 EX167S( )H 98.96 1500 51D
250 EX250S( )H 99.07 2200 52D
333 EX333S( )H 99.14 2500 52D
5 kV Voltage Class 60 Hz 150 oC Rise
167 EX167S( )H 99.07 1500 52D
250 EX250S( )H 99.14 2400 52D
333 EX333S( )H 99.22 3000 53D
15 kV Voltage Class 60 Hz 150 oC Rise
167 EX167S( )H 98.95 2400 52D
250 EX250S( )H 99.03 3400 53D
333 EX333S( )H 99.12 4000 53D
Lugs: Furnished by customer.

Table 14.50: New! Single Phase Voltage Codes


kV Class Code Primary Secondary
2.4 14 2400 Delta 120/240
30 kV BIL 25 2400 Delta 277
13 2400/4160Y 120/240
15 4800 Delta 120/240
5 16 4160 Delta 120/240
30 kV BIL 24 2400/4160Y 277
26 4800 Delta 277
27 4160 Delta 277
17 4160/7200Y 120/240
18 7200 120/240
28 4160/7200Y 277
29 7200 277
19 7200/12470Y 120/240
20 7620/13200Y 120/240
15 21 12470 120/240
60 kV BIL 22 13200 120/240
23 13800 120/240
30 7200/12470Y 277
31 7620/13200Y 277
32 12470 277
33 13200 277
34 13800 277

To complete the single-phase catalog numbers on this page:


1. Select the voltage you require from the chart on the pricing page.
2. Insert the voltage code number in place of the ( ) in the catalog number.

Example: 167 kVA Energy Efficient 1Ø 2400/4160Y-120/240 Vac, 1Ø 60 Hz unit is EX167S13H. The unit would be
supplied with 2–2.5% above and 2–2.5% full capacity below normal taps on the primary.

Enclosures
Table 14.51: New! Enclosure Dimensions
Enclosure Number/ Style Height Width Depth Mounting NEMA 3R
in. mm in. mm in. mm
50 D 40.5 1029 36.5 927 21.75 552 Floor n/a consult
factory
51 D 51.5 1308 40.5 1029 26.5 673 Floor n/a consult
factory
52 D 66 1676 50.5 1283 32 813 Floor n/a consult
factory
53 D 80 2032 64 1626 44 1118 Floor n/a consult
factory
54 F 90 2286 72 1829 50 1270 Floor n/a consult
factory
55 F 90 2286 80 2032 50 1270 Floor n/a consult
factory
Style D, NEMA 1 Rated 56 F 90 2286 90 2286 50 1270 Floor n/a consult
factory
57 F 100 2540 100 2540 60 1524 Floor n/a consult
factory
58 F 108 2743 108 2743 60 1524 Floor n/a consult
factory
TRANSFORMERS

These dimensions are not for construction. Contact your local Schneider Electric sales
office for certified prints.
Special outdoor construction required for NEMA 3R applications. Contact your local
Schneider Electric sales office for details.

Style F—NEMA 1 Rated


14

14-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Energy Efficient, Dry Type 2.4, 5, and 15 kV New! Energy Efficient Medium Voltage
Distribution Transformers
Class 7432 schneider-electric.us
14
TRANSFORMERS

14-24
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents

Section 15

MEDICAL PRODUCTS
Medical Products
Line Isolation Monitor (LIM) 15-2

Iso-Gard™ Series 6—UL Recognized 15-2


Remote Alarm Indicators 15-3

IG2000P 15-3
IG2000CBM 15-3
Isolated Power Panels 15-4

Accessories 15-5

15
Receptacle Modules for Controlled Panels 15-5
Hospital Ground Cords and Jacks 15-5
Ordering Information 15-6

Operating Room Isolated Power Panel

Iso-Gard Series 6 LIM

IG2000CBM Remote Alarm Indicator

© 2017 Schneider Electric


All Rights Reserved 15-1

11/10/2017
Line Isolation Monitor (LIM) Iso-Gard™ Series 6
Class 4800 / Refer to Catalog 4805CT1301
15

schneider-electric.us

Overview of Isolated Power Panels


Schneider Electric has been involved in the design and manufacture of isolated power
systems since 1944. Our isolated power panels have evolved over the years and will
MEDICAL PRODUCTS

continue to do so to meet the ever-changing needs of the health care industry.


All of our current power panels incorporate single-phase, NQ panelboard interiors that
accept plug-on or bolt-on branch circuit breakers. The panels are designed to support up
to 16 branch circuits, eight of which are factory-installed. Since the average number of
circuits required per panel in an operating room is five, the eight factory-installed branch
circuit breakers will meet the majority of applications.
The Iso-Gard™ Series 6 Line Isolation Monitor (LIM) is readily visible in all layouts,
eliminating the need for a composite unit when isolation power panels are installed in
operating rooms.
Iso-Gard™ Series 6—UL Recognized
The Square D™ brand, Iso-Gard Series 6, microprocessor-controlled, line isolation
monitor (LIM) is included as standard equipment in all Schneider Electric hospital
isolation panels. The Iso-Gard Series 6 LIM incorporates automatic and manual self-test
and self-calibration to reduce the frequency of required periodic testing. Other features
include:
• Digital and analog display
• Unique audible alarm that will not be confused with other equipment
• UL component recognized and CSA classified
• Microprocessor-controlled circuitry for highest accuracy and stability
• Total hazard current factory set to 5 mA; field-capable setting to 2 mA
• Communication to MODBUS via Gateway
The Iso-Gard Series 6 LIM is also available as a replacement unit for older LIMs, is a
direct replacement for all previous Schneider Electric LIMs, and is electrically compatible
with all hospital isolated power systems. For more details, refer to 4805CT1301 and
MED101301xx.
Schneider Electric created the following four upgrade kits to simplify the ordering
process. With a single catalog number, you can now purchase all components necessary
for the functional replacement of your existing Iso-Gard LIM.
Iso—Gard Series 6 LIM
Table 15.1: Upgrade Kit Ordering Information
Includes
Upgrade
Kit Line Isolation Converter Box and
Mounting Bracket Transformer
Monitor Wiring Harness
IG6ADKIT IG6M IG6CBKTVM Not applicable 4800XMIA
IG6BDKIT IG6M IG6CBKTVM 4800RA1WMAHA 4800XMIA
IG6DDKIT IG6M IG6CBKTVM 4800RA1WMAHA Not applicable
IG6KIT IG6M IG6CBKTVM Not applicable Not applicable

15-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
IG2000 Series Remote Alarm Indicators
Class 4800 / Refer to Catalog 4800CT1201
schneider-electric.us

NEC® Requirement

MEDICAL PRODUCTS
The National Electrical Code® (NEC®) requires audible and visual alarm indication
where isolation power is used (NEC 517-160). Schneider Electric offers the IG2000P and
IG2000CBM remote alarm indicators for this purpose.
IG2000P
The Iso-Gard™ IG2000P remote indicator from Schneider Electric provides remote
indication of the visible and audible alarms from a line isolation monitor (LIM).
• Green LED—stays illuminated while the system is in normal condition
• Red hazard LED—illuminates when the Total Hazard Current (THC) exceeds the
preset alarm level
• Audible hazard alarm—sounds when the THC exceeds the preset alarm level
Mute button with yellow LED—silences the audible alarm on the remote indicator
(local muting), or silences all audible alarms in the system (system muting)

15
• Test button—remotely performs a functional test of the LIM
The IG2000P remote indicator is available mounted in a one- or two-gang stainless steel
faceplate for flush mounting into a panel or wall box with a two-inch minimum depth. The
basic electrical connection is made using three wires.

IG2000CBM
The Iso-Gard™ IG2000CBM remote indicator from Schneider Electric provides remote
indication of the visible and audible alarms and digital mA reading from an Iso-Gard
Series 6 (IG6) line isolation monitor (LIM).
• Green LED—stays illuminated while the system is in normal condition
• Red hazard LED—illuminates when the Total Hazard Current (THC) exceeds the
preset alarm level
• Audible hazard alarm—sounds when the THC exceeds the preset alarm level
Mute button with yellow LED—silences the audible alarm on the remote indicator
(local muting), or silences all audible alarms in the system (system muting)
• Test button—remotely performs a functional test of the LIM
The IG2000CBM remote indicator is available mounted in a two-gang stainless steel
faceplate for flush mounting into a wall box with a two-inch minimum depth. The basic
electrical connection is made using four wires.

15-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Isolated Power Panels Panel Layout Types
Class 4800 / Refer to Catalog 4800CT1201
15

schneider-electric.us

Overview
Incoming powe r
(customer conne ction)
Isolated power panels provide a small local electrical network that can be monitored from
a line isolation monitor (LIM), allowing for predictive ground fault protection instead of
MEDICAL PRODUCTS

reactive.
A typical isolated power system contains:
• Main disconnect
Electrostatic shi e ld
connected to pa ne l
– QO circuit breaker (120 V, 208 V, 240 V)
Main
circuit
ground bus – H-Frame circuit breaker (277 V, 480 V)
breaker

Line • Isolation Transformer


Isolation
Monitor
• Line isolation monitor
• NQ interior
To pa ne l
ground bus
• QO branch circuit breakers
– Eight factory-installed
– Space for eight additional
To s ys te m ground
(customer conne ction) • Ground bus
Multiple layouts are available:

Panel
• Standard isolation panels
ground • Duplex panels
bus
• Dual voltage panels
• Controlled panels
Standard Isolation Panels
Standard panels offer the most compact solution for a single isolated power system
feeding one operating room.
120 V Distribution
• Available in four options: 3, 5, 7.5, or 10 kVA
• Up to 16 branch circuits
208 V (240 V) Distribution
• Available in four options: 3, 5, 7.5, or 10 kVA
• One or two branch circuits
Duplex Panels
Duplex panels offer two isolated power systems in a single panel. The systems are
separated from each other by a barrier. Duplex panels provide the ability to mix and
match the two systems for kVA and distribution voltage to help the designer maximize
wall space while meeting the power requirements of the operating room(s).
Dual Voltage Panels
Dual voltage panels supply both 120 V and 208 V (240 V) isolated power to an operating
room.
• Back box requires a 14–inch-deep wall
• Each panel supplies up to sixteen 120 V circuits, plus two 208 V branch circuits
The standard offering includes the following:
• One 30 A, 208 V circuit for equipment such as a laser receptacle
• One 50 A, 208 V circuit for equipment such as an X-ray receptacle
Controlled Panels
Controlled panels are designed to provide 208 V (240 V) of isolated power to multiple
areas from one central location. Historically, they were used to retrofit operating rooms
with 208 V. A programmable logic controller (PLC) lets the panel be designed to feed
multiple load location, but only provide power to specific power modules. This helps
prevent overloading of the system. Since the PLC limits the number of circuits, only the
longest-possible conductor length is taken into account during start-up testing.

15-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power/Ground Modules, Ground Cords Accessories
Class 4800 / Refer to Catalog 4800CT1201
schneider-electric.us

Schneider Electric offers 208 V or 240 V modules designed to complete the control circuit

MEDICAL PRODUCTS
of a controlled power panel.
Receptacle Modules for Controlled Panels
X-ray/laser power receptacle modules provide a convenient source of power for portable
X-ray and laser equipment. The receptacle provided in each module is matched to the
NEMA plug configuration of the equipment with which it will be used, and is mounted
behind the door on the stainless steel face plate. The door features a concealed hinge
and a touch latch.

15
Power/Ground Modules
When both ground jacks and power receptacles are required, these UL Listed modules
offer convenience and save labor in field wiring. The units include four power
receptacles, four twist-to-lock ground jacks, and a ground bus with a generous number of
lugs for external ground connections.
The main ground connection in the module accommodates up to a #1/0 cable. The units
are completely factory wired; only field power connections and ground connections are
necessary. They are furnished with Type 304, brushed stainless steel face plates.

4 Red Duplex Receptacles 4 Locking Receptacles


and 4 Ground Jacks and 4 Ground Jacks

Hospital Ground Cords and Jacks


Schneider Electric provides hospital-grade devices for the supply and grounding of
portable equipment.
• Hospital ground cords
– Highly flexible wire with a heavy duty lug or clip end
– Ground cord with lug end is UL Listed (UL 467)
– Various lengths available

Ground Cord with Lug End Ground Cord with Clip End

• Hospital ground jacks

15-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Ordering Information Standard Panels
Class 4800 / Refer to Catalog 4800CT1201
15

schneider-electric.us

Medical Isolated Power Panels


Table 15.2: 120 V Distribution
Transformer Interior Trim Catalog No. Back Box Catalog No.
MEDICAL PRODUCTS

LIM Circuit
Included Main Breakers
kVA Primary Secondary Catalog No. (field- (factory- Spaces Catalog No. Flush Surface Flush Surface
Disconnect
installed) installed)
Plug-on Circuit Breakers
208 V SXM03BA SIP03BA
Iso-Gard QOU220 Eight
3 240 V 120 V SXM03CA Eight 2-pole SIP03CA ST4526 ST4324 SB432406 SB432406S
Series 6 QO220
277 V SXM03DA HDL26015 SIP03DA
208 V SXM05BA SIP05BA
QOU230
240 V SXM05CA Iso-Gard Eight SIP05CA
5 120 V Eight 2-pole ST4526 ST4324 SB432406 SB432406S
277 V SXM05DA Series 6 HDL26025 QO220 SIP05DA
480 V SXM05EA HDL26015 SIP05EA
208 V SXM07BA QOU245 SIP07BA
240 V SXM07CA Iso-Gard QOU240 Eight SIP07CA
7.5 120 V Eight 2-pole ST4526 ST4324 SB432408 SB432408S
277 V SXM07DA Series 6 HDL26035 QO220 SIP07DA
480 V SXM07EA HDL26020 SIP07EA
208 V SXM10BA SIP10BA
QOU260
240 V SXM10CA Iso-Gard Eight SIP10CA
10 120 V Eight 2-pole ST4526 ST4324 SB432408 SB432408S
277 V SXM10DA Series 6 HDL26045 QO220 SIP10DA
480 V SXM10EA HDL26030 SIP10EA

Table 15.3: 120 V Distribution on Both Sides of the Panel


Transformer Interior
Catalog No. Left Right
LIM Circuit LIM Circuit
kVA Primary Secondary Included Main Breakers Included Main Breakers Catalog No.
Left Right (field- (field- Spaces (field- (field- Spaces
Disconnect Disconnect
installed) installed) installed) installed)
Plug-on Circuit Breakers
208 V SXM03BA SXM03BA SIX03BA03BA
Iso-Gard QOU220 Eight Eight Iso-Gard QOU220 Eight Eight
3 240 V 120 V SXM03CA SXM03CA QO220 2-pole QO220 2-pole SIX03CA03CA
Series 6 Series 6
277 V SXM03DA SXM03DA HDL26015 HDL26015 SIX03DA03DA
208 V SXM05BA SXM05BA SIX05BA05BA
QOU230 QOU230
240 V SXM05CA SXM05CA Iso-Gard Eight Eight Iso-Gard Eight Eight SIX05CA05CA
5 120 V Series 6 QO220 2-pole Series 6 QO220 2-pole
277 V SXM05DA SXM05DA HDL26025 HDL26025 SIX05DA05DA
480 V SXM05EA SXM05EA HDL26015 HDL26015 SIX05EA05EA
208 V SXM07BA SXM07BA QOU245 QOU245 SIX07BA07BA
240 V SXM07CA SXM07CA Iso-Gard QOU240 Eight Eight Iso-Gard QOU240 Eight Eight SIX07CA07CA
7.5 120 V QO220 2-pole QO220 2-pole
277 V SXM07DA SXM07DA Series 6 HDL26035 Series 6 HDL26035 SIX07DA07DA
480 V SXM07EA SXM07EA HDL26020 HDL26020 SIX07EA07EA
208 V SXM10BA SXM10BA SIX10BA10BA
QOU260 QOU260
240 V SXM10CA SXM10CA Iso-Gard Eight Eight Iso-Gard Eight Eight SIX10CA10CA
10 120 V QO220 2-pole QO220 2-pole
277 V SXM10DA SXM10DA Series 6 HDL26045 Series 6 HDL26045 SIX10DA10DA
480 V SXM10EA SXM10EA HDL26030 HDL26030 SIX10EA10EA
Bolt-on Circuit Breakers
208 V SXM03BA SXM03BA SIX03BA03BAB
Iso-Gard QOU220 Eight Eight Iso-Gard QOU220 Eight Eight
3 240 V 120 V SXM03CA SXM03CA Series 6 QOB220 2-pole Series 6 QOB220 2-pole SIX03CA03CAB
277 V SXM03DA SXM03DA HDL26015 HDL26015 SIX03DA03DAB
208 V SXM05BA SXM05BA SIX05BA05BAB
QOU230 QOU230
240 V SXM05CA SXM05CA Iso-Gard Eight Eight Iso-Gard Eight Eight SIX05CA05CAB
5 120 V QOB220 2-pole QOB220 2-pole
277 V SXM05DA SXM05DA Series 6 HDL26025 Series 6 HDL26025 SIX05DA05DAB
480 V SXM05EA SXM05EA HDL26015 HDL26015 SIX05EA05EAB
208 V SXM07BA SXM07BA QOU245 QOU245 SIX07BA07BAB
240 V SXM07CA SXM07CA Iso-Gard QOU240 Eight Eight Iso-Gard QOU240 Eight Eight SIX07CA07CAB
7.5 120 V QOB220 2-pole QOB220 2-pole
277 V SXM07DA SXM07DA Series 6 HDL26035 Series 6 HDL26035 SIX07DA07DAB
480 V SXM07EA SXM07EA HDL26020 HDL26020 SIX07EA07EAB
208 V SXM10BA SXM10BA SIX10BA10BAB
QOU260 QOU260
240 V SXM10CA SXM10CA Iso-Gard Eight Eight Iso-Gard Eight Eight SIX10CA10CAB
10 120 V Series 6 QOB220 2-pole Series 6 QOB220 2-pole
277 V SXM10DA SXM10DA HDL26045 HDL26045 SIX10DA10DAB
480 V SXM10EA SXM10EA HDL26030 HDL26030 SIX10EA10EAB

15-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents

Section 16
NEMA and Definite Purpose Contactors and
Starters
Selection Information 16-2

Manual Starters and Switches 16-4

NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE


CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
Manual Start e rs a nd S witche s
TeSys™ U Motor Starters 16-12

TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters 16-13

Type S Full Voltage Contactors and Starters 16-28

Definite Purp os e Conta ctors a nd S ta rte rs


Vacuum Contactors and Starters, Full Voltage 16-42

Type S Combination Starters 16-45

Type S Reversing Full Voltage Contactors and Starters 16-58

16
Reversing Vacuum Contactors, Full Voltage 16-64

Type S Reversing Combination Starters 16-65


NEMA Style Type S Conta ctors a nd S ta rte rs
Lighting Contactors 16-72

Definite Purpose Contactors 16-87

Definite Purpose Starters 16-90

Well-Guard Control™ Pump Panels 16-91


Lighting Co nta ctors

Duplex AC Motor Controllers 16-94

Definite Purpose Contactors 16-97

Thermal Overload Relays 16-98

Separate Enclosures 16-108

Factory Modifications (Forms) 16-115

Pump Panel Combinatio n S ta rte rs


Magnetic Coils 16-120

Replacement Parts Kits 16-122

Accessories 16-124

Thermal Units 16-130

NEMA Style Te S ys N Conta ctors a nd S ta rte rs

© 2017 Schneider Electric


All Rights Reserved 16-1

11/10/2017
Selection Information NEMA and Definite Purpose Contactors
and Starters
Class 4800 / Refer to Catalog 4800CT1201 schneider-electric.us

Selection Information
16
NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE
CONTACTORS AND STARTERS

Class 2510, 2511, 2512 T02, T36 8502 & 8702 8536 & 8736 8538 & 8738
NEMA Style, Full Voltage Non-Reversing and Full Voltage Reversing
Manual Starters and Switches, Combination Magnetic
Type of Product Non-Reversing, Reversing and TeSys™ N AC Magnetic Contactors AC Magnetic Starters Starters with
Two Speed Contactors and Starters
Disconnect Switch

8502: page 16-28 8536: page 16-32 8538: page 16-45


Page page 16-4 page 16-14 8702: page 16-58 8736: page 16-60 8738: page 16-65

M-0 8538: 0– 6
NEMA Sizes M-1 00–7 00–7 00–7 8738: 0–5
M-1P

Load Type F: 277 Vac


Voltage 600 Vac Max. 600 Vac Max. 600 Vac Max. 600 Vac Max.
Types K & M: 600 Vac

Current Ratings Type F: 16 A 8538: 18–540 A


(Continuous) 9–810 A 9–810 A 9–810 A
Types K & M: 30 A 8738: 18–270 A

Horsepower Type F: 1 8538: 0.5–400


Ratings Type K: 20 600 0.5–600 0.5–600
(Maximum) 8738: 0.5–200
Type M: 10

Type F: Melting Alloy Melting Alloy Melting Alloy


Contactors: N/A
Overload Relay Type K: N/A Starters: Bimetallic (Size 00-2) or N/A Bimetallic (Size 00–2) Bimetallic (Size 0–2)
Type M: Melting Alloy Solid-State Solid State Solid State

1, Flush Mount, 1, 3R, 4, 4X, 1, 3R, 4, 4X,


Enclosure Types 3R, 4, 4X, 7 & 9 Open 12/3R, 7 & 9 12/3R, 7 & 9 1, 4, 4X, 12/3R
and Open and Open and Open

UL File E42243 NLRV Contactors: UL File E164862 UL File E78351 NLDX UL File E78351 NLDX UL File E152395 NKJH7
NLDX
UR File E42243 NLRV2 CSA LR43364 Class 3211-24 CSA 60905 Class 3211-04 CSA 60905 Class 3211-04 CSA LR584 Class 3211 04
Approvals Starters: UL File E152395 NKJH
CSA File LR 25490 CSA LR60905 Class 3211-24 CE IEC 947-4-1 CE IEC 947-4-1
Sizes 00–5 Only Sizes 00–5 Only

16-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NEMA and Definite Purpose Contactors Selection Information
and Starters
schneider-electric.us Class 4800 / Refer to Catalog 4800CT1201
Selection Information

NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE


CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
Class 8539 & 8739 8903L & 8903S 8903 8910, 8911, 8965 8940 8941
Combination Devices
Definite Purpose non-
Multipole electrically held Type S lighting contactors reversing contactors Well-Guard Control™ NEMA Style AC
Combination Magnetic and mechanically held electrically held and available as compact 1 or Pumping Plant Panels Duplex Motor
Starters with contactors available in 30 mechanically held 2 pole to 40 A and 2 to 4 available Controllers available as
Type of Product A configurations to 12 a combination starter
PowerPact™ Circuit available with disconnect pole to 90 A. Reversing with disconnect switches
poles and 800 A or without

16
Breaker switches or PowerPact™ and Starter or PowerPact™ circuit
configurations to 3 poles. circuit breakers Configurations also breakers. disconnecting means.
available.

8539: page 16-49 8910: page 16-87 page 16-91


Page page 16-72 page 16-75 8911: page 16-90 page 16-94
8739: page 16-67 8965: page 16-97 page 16-92

NEMA Sizes 8539: 0–7 N/A N/A N/A 1–7 1–4


8739: 0–6

Load
Voltage 600 Vac Max. 600 Vac Max. 600 Vac Max. 600 Vac Max. 600 Vac Max. 600 Vac Max.

Current Ratings 8539: 18–810 A 8903L to 30 A 300 A (Disconnect) 20–40 A (Compact)


(Continuous) 27–810 A 27–135 A
8739: 18–540 A 8903S to 800 A 600 A (Circuit Breaker) 20–90 A

Horsepower 8539: 0.5–600 N/A N/A 0.5–50 0.5–600 0.5–100


Ratings
(Maximum) 8739: 0.5–400

Melting Alloy N/A N/A Melting Alloy (8911) Melting Alloy Melting Alloy
Overload Relay Bimetallic
(Size 0–1) Bimetallic Bimetallic
Solid State Solid State Solid State

1, 3R, 4, 4X, 1, 4, 4X,


Enclosure Types 1, 4, 4X, 12/3R 1, 4, 4X, 12/3R 1 3R
12/3R and Open 12/3R and Open

UL File E152395 NKJH7 UL File E78427 NRNT UL File E16151 NRNT UL E3190 NLDX2 UL/cUL 152395 NKJH UL File E152395
Approvals CSA LR584 CSA LR60905 cUL File E16151 NRNT CSA LR25490 NKJH7
Class 3211 04 Class 3231 01 Class 3211 04

16-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Manual Starters and Switches Manual Starters, Type F—Fractional
Horsepower
Class 2510, 2512 / Refer to Catalog 2510CT9701 schneider-electric.us

Fractional Horsepower Manual Starters with Melting Alloy Type


Thermal Overload Relay
Table 16.1: Single-Unit Types—Class 2510—Rated 16 A—Thermal Units (see Thermal Unit Selection, page 16-130)
NEMA 1 General Purpose Flush Mounting NEMA Types 3R, 7 & 9
General Purpose (Without Pull Box) NEMA Type 4 [1]
Enclosure Enclosure Number
Enclosure Standard Jumbo Hazardous Locations Open of
Type of No.of Surface Mounting Gray Watertight Type
Features Stainless Stainless and Div. 1 & 2 Thermal
Operator Poles Flush Class I Groups B, C, & D, &
16

Steel Steel Dusttight Units


Standard Oversized Plate Class II Groups E, F, & G Required
Flush Plate Flush Plate
Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type
Basic Starter—Class 2510
Standard FG1 FGJ1 FF1 FS1 — — — FO1 1
1
NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE

With Red Pilot Light [2] FG1P FGJ1P FF1P FS1P FSJ1P — — FO1P 1
CONTACTORS AND STARTERS

Toggle
Standard FG2 FGJ2 FF2 FS2 — — — FO2 1
2
With Red Pilot Light [2] FG2P FGJ2P FF2P FS2P FSJ2P — — FO2P 1
Standard FG3 FGJ3 FF3 FS3 — — — FO3 1
1
With Red Pilot Light [2] FG3P FGJ3P FF3P FS3P FSJ3P — — FO3P 1
Key
Standard FG4 FGJ4 FF4 FS4 — — — FO4 1
2 With Red Pilot Light [2] FG4P FGJ4P FF4P FS4P FSJ4P — — FO4P 1
Starter with Handle Guard/Lock-Off—Class 2510
Standard FG5 FGJ5 FW1 FR1 [3] [4] 1
1
With Red Pilot Light [2] FG5P FGJ5P Order basic starter plus FW1P — [3] [4] 1
Toggle
Standard FG6 FGJ6 separate handle guard kit. FW2 FR2 [3] [4] 1
2 With Red Pilot Light [2] FG6P FGJ6P FW2P — [3] [4] 1

Table 16.2: Duplex Units—Class 2510


NEMA 1 General Purpose General Purpose Flush Mounting (Without Pull Box) Number of
Type of No. of Enclosure Surface Gray Flush Plate for Wall Stainless Steel Flush Plate Replacement Starter Thermal
Operator Features Mounting or Cavity Mounting for Wall or Cavity Mounting Units
Poles Class 2510
Type Type Type Type Required
One Starter in Duplex Enclosure—Class 2510
Standard FG02 — — —
Toggle 2 1
With Red Pilot Light [2] FG02P — — —
Key 2 With Red Pilot Light [2] FG04P — — — 1
Two Starters in One Enclosure—Class 2510
Toggle 2 Each Standard FG22 FF22 — —
Str. With Red Pilot Light on Each[2] 2
FG22P FF22P FS22P —
Key 2 Each With Red Pilot Light on Each[2]
FG44P FF44P FS44P — 2
Str.
Starter and Auto-Off-Hand SPDT Selector Switch (AC Only)—Class 2510
Standard FG71 FF71 — —
1 1
With Red Pilot Light [2] FG71P FF71P FS71P —
Toggle
Standard FG72 FF72 — —
2 With Red Pilot Light[2] 1
FG72P FF72P FS72P —
Key 2 With Red Pilot Light[2] FG74P FF74P FS74P — 1
Two Speed Starters (AC Only)—Class 2512 Replacement Starter—Class 2510
With Mechanical Interlock:
Standard FG11 FF11 — FO1T
1 With 2 Red Pilot Lights [2] FG11P FF11P — FO1PT 2
With High-Off-Low Selector Switch:
With 2 Red Pilot Lights [2] — — FS101P FO1PT
Toggle
With Mechanical Interlock:
Standard FG22 FF22 — FO2T
2 With 2 Red Pilot Lights [2] FG22P FF22P — FO2PT 2
With High-Off-Low Selector Switch:
With 2 Red Pilot Lights [2] — — FS202P FO2PT

Table 16.3: Horsepower Ratings, Type F (continuous current rating: 16 A)


Maximum Horsepower
Volts AC Single Phase DC
1-Pole 2-Pole 2-Pole Only
115 1 1 3/4
230 1 2 3/4
277 1 1 —

Table 16.4: Approvals—2510 Type F and K


Agency Enclosed Open
UL UL Listed File: E42243, CCN: NLRV UL Component Recognized File: E42243, CCN: NLRV2
CSA CSA Certified File: LR25490, Class: 3211-05

Table 16.5: How to Order


To Order Specify: Catalog Number
Type FG2P Type FO2
• Class Number Class Type
• Type Number 2510 FG1

[1] Furnished with one 3/4" pipe tap in the bottom (reversible for top feed). For a 3/4" pipe tap in the top and bottom, add the suffix H to the Type.
[2] For a green pilot light, add the letter G to the catalog number (i.e. 2510FG2PG).
[3] For a replacement starter, order the Open type above.
[4] When replacing a starter equipped with a pilot light in NEMA 4 enclosure, retain the pilot light mounting bracket from the original device.
16-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Manual Switches, 30 A—Type K Manual Starters and Switches
Class 2510, 2511, 2512 / Refer to Catalog 2510CT9701
schneider-electric.us

Manual Switches, Type K


Table 16.6: Non-Reversing—Class 2510
NEMA 1
General Purpose Flush Mounting NEMA 3R, 7 & 9
General Purpose Enclosure NEMA 4
Surface Mounting (Without Pull Box) Enclosures[5]
Enclosure[5] Open
Watertight Hazardous Locations
Operator No. of Standard Jumbo Div. 1 & 2 Style
Style Features Gray and
Poles Standard Oversized Flush Stainless Stainless Class I Groups B, C, & D, &
Steel Steel Dusttight
Plate Class II Groups E, F, and G
Flush Plate Flush Plate
Type Type Type Type Type Type Type Type

NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE


CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
Standard KG1 KGJ1 KF1 KS1 — KW1 KR1 KO1
2 With Pilot 115 Vac KG1A KGJ1A KF1A KS1A KSJ1A KW1A — KO1A [7]
Light [6] 230 Vac KG1B KGJ1B KF1B KS1B KSJ1B KW1B — KO1B [7]
Standard KG2 KGJ2 KF2 KS2 — KW2 KR2 KO2
3 With Pilot 208–277 Vac KG2B KGJ2B KF2B KS2B KSJ2B KW2B — KO2B [7]
Light [6] 440–600 Vac KG2C KGJ2C KF2C KS2C KSJ2C KW2C — KO2C [7]
Toggle
Standard KG5 KGJ5 — — — KW5 — KO5
2 With Pilot 115 Vac KG5A — — — — KW5A — KO5A [7]
Light [6] 230 Vac KG5B — — — — KW5B — KO5B [7]
Standard KG6 KGJ6 — — — KW6 — KO6
3 With Pilot 208–277 Vac KG6B — — — — KW6B — KO6B [7]
Light [6] 440–600 Vac KG6C — — — — KW6C — KO6C [7]
Standard KG3 KGJ3 KF3 KS3 — — — KO3
2 With Pilot 115 Vac KG3A KGJ3A KF3A KS3A KSJ3A — — KO3A
Light [6] 230 Vac KG3B KGJ3B KF3B KS3B KSJ3B — — KO3B
Key
Standard KG4 KGJ4 KF4 KS4 — — — KO4
3 With Pilot 208–277 Vac KG4B KGJ4B KF4B KS4B KSJ4B — — KO4B
Light [6] 440–600 Vac KG4C KGJ4C KF4C KS4C KSJ4C — — KO4C

16
Table 16.7: Reversing—Class 2511
NEMA 1 With Flush Plate for
General Purpose Replacement
Operator Suitable for Features Cavity Mounting Switch
No. of Poles Enclosure (Without Pull Box)
Style Motor Types (Including Mechanical Interlock) Surface Mounting Class 2510
Type Type Type

1Ø KG11 KF11 KO1T


Standard
2 3-Lead
Repulsion-Induction 115 Vac KG11A KF11A KO1AT
With Pilot Light [6]
230 Vac KG11B KF11B KO1BT
Toggle
3 Ø; Also KG22 KF22 KO2T
Standard
1 Ø Capacitor, 110–120 Vac KG22A KF22A KO2AT
3 Split Ø, or 4-Lead
Repulsion-Induction With Pilot Light [6] 208–220 Vac KG22B KF22B KO2BT
440–600 Vac KG22C KF22C KO2CT

Table 16.8: Two Speed—Class 2512


NEMA 1 General With Flush Plate for Replacement
Operator Suitable for Features Purpose Enclosure Cavity Mounting Switch
Style No. of Poles Motor Types (Including Mechanical Interlock) Surface Mounting (Without Pull Box) Class 2510
Type Type Type

1Ø KG11 KF11 KO1T


Standard
2 Two Winding
(3-Lead) 115 Vac KG11A KF11A KO1AT
With 2 Pilot Lights [6]
230 Vac KG11B KF11B KO1BT
Toggle
3Ø KG22 KF22 KO2T
Standard
3 Separate Winding
(Wye-Connected) 208–240 Vac KG22B KF22B KO2BT
With 2 Pilot Lights [6]
440–600 Vac KG22C KF22C KO2CT

Table 16.9: Class 2511 and 2512 Horsepower Ratings Type K Table 16.10: Class 2510 Horsepower Ratings
Maximum DC Hp Maximum DC Hp
No. of Motor Type Maximum Hp Maximum Hp (breaking 2 poles)
Device (breaking 2 poles) Class No. of Motor
Poles AC 2510 Poles Type AC
115 V 230 V 460–575 V 90 V 115 V 230 V 115 230 460 575 90 V 115 V 230 V
Class 2 1Ø 2 2 3 V V V V
2511 3 3Ø 2 7-1/2 10 KO1 Single Ø
KO3 2 2 2 3 3
2 1Ø 2 2 3
KO2
3 Ø, KO4 3 Three Ø 2 7-1/2 10 10 1 2 1-1/2
1 2 1-1/2
Class 3 Constant or 2 7-1/2 10
Variable Torque KO5 2 Single Ø 2 3 7-1/2 10
2512
3 Ø, KO6 3 Three Ø 2 7-1/2 15 20
3 Constant Hp 2 7-1/2 10 Continuous current rating 30 A at 600 Vac maximum 30 A at 24 Vdc maximum
Continuous current rating 30 A at 600 Vac maximum 30 A at 24 Vdc maximum
Table 16.11: How to Order
To Order Specify: Catalog Number
• Class Number Class Type
• Type Number 2510 KO2

[5] Furnished with one 3/4" pipe tap in the bottom (reversible for top feed). For a 3/4" pipe tap in the top and bottom, add the suffix H to the Type.
[6] For a green pilot light, add the letter G to the catalog number (i.e. 2510FG2PG)
[7] When replacing a starter equipped with a pilot light in NEMA 4 enclosure, retain the pilot light mounting bracket from the original device.
16-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Manual Starters and Switches Type F and K—Approximate Dimensions
Class 2510, 2511, 2512 / Refer to Catalog 2510CT9701
schneider-electric.us

Open Type
Mtg. Holes for #6-32 Screws (2)
Pilot Light Mtg. Holes For #6-32 Screws (2)
Pilot Light
1.69

OFF
43 1.69
.84

OFF
43
21 .84
21
16

2.38
60 2.38
3.28
83 3.28 60
4.13
105 4.13 83
105
NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE
CONTACTORS AND STARTERS

2.22
2.34
56
60
1.59 1.70
40
43

Types FO1, 1P, 2 Types KO1, 1A, 1B, 2, 2B, 2C


Fractional Hp Starter Types KO5, 5A, 5B, 6, 6B, 6C
Motor Starting Switch

NEMA 1 General Purpose Enclosure (Surface Mount)


Mtg. Holes .25 dia. (2) Mtg. Holes .25 dia. (2)
6 6

3.00 4.25 3.00 OFF 4.25


OFF
76 108 76 108

2.75 1.63 2.75 1.63


70 41 Pilot 70 41 Pilot
2.44 Light 2.88 Light
2.88 2.88 3.28
73 62 73 73 4.86 83
0.71
0.56 0.56 123
18
14 14
0.41
10 0.69
17 OFF 4.35 2.20
110 56
1.06 1.06
27 27

1/2–3/4" Conduit 1/2–3/4" Conduit 3.09


Pilot Light
Knockout, Both Ends Knockout, Both Ends 78

Standard Oversized Jumbo


(Class 2510 Types FG & KG, Single (Class 2510 Types FGJ & KGJ, (Class 9991Type KE2, see Table
Unit) Single Unit) 16.29)

NEMA 1 General Purpose Enclosure (Flush Mount)


Table 16.12: General Purpose Enclosure (Flush
Mount)
Type of Dimensions
Device Class 2510 Type
Operator A B C OFF C 2.56
FF1, 1P, 2, 2P,
FS1, 1P, 2, 2P 1.44 2.75 4.5 D 65
Toggle
Fractional FSJ1P, 2P 1.44 3.5 5.25
Hp Starter FF3, 3P, 4, 4P,
FS3, 3P, 4, 4P 1.44 2.75 4.5
Key
FSJ3P, 4P 1.44 3.5 5.25 .50
KF1, 1A, 1B, 2, 2B, 2C 13 0.66
KS1, 1A, 1B, 2, 2B, 2C 1.75 2.75 4.5 B
Toggle
Motor KSJ1A, 1B, 2B, 2C 1.75 3.5 5.25 1.78 17
Starting D
Switch KF3, 3A, 3B, 4, 4B, 4C 45
KS3, 3A, 3B, 4, 4B, 4C 1.75 2.75 4.5
Key Pilot
KSJ3A, 3B, 4B, 4C 1.75 3.5 5.25 Light
.75
A
NOTE: These dimensions are for reference only. .91 19 1.69
If you need precise measurements, contact the 23 43
Customer Care Center at 1-888-778-2733.
NEMA 4 Watertight Die-Cast Zinc Enclosure
3
Table 16.13: NEMA 4 Watertight Die-Cast Zinc 76 2.75 4.56
.25 1.13 70 116 4.25
Enclosure 6 29 108
Device Class Type (2) .22 DIA. MTG. HOLE
6
Fractional Hp Starter 2510 FW1, 1P, 2, 2P
PILOT LIGHT
Motor Starting Switch 2510 KW1, 1A, 1B, 2, 2B, 2C
ON 3.75
95
OFF 4.38
111

.28 DIA. PADLOCK HOLE


1.13 .31 7
29 8 3" 14 PIPE TAP .78
CONDUIT CENTER LINE 4 20

16-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Approximate Dimensions—Type F and K Manual Starters and Switches
Class 2510, 2511, 2512 / Refer to Catalog 2510CT9701
schneider-electric.us

NEMA 3R, 7, and 9 Aluminum Enclosure for Hazardous Locations


Table 16.14: NEMA 3R, 7, and 9 Aluminum Enclosure for Hazardous Locations
4.35
3.95
110 Device Class Type
2X .30
1.37
100
8 Fractional Hp Starter 2510 FR1, 2
35
Motor Starting Switch 2510 KR1, 2

6.36
161

NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE


ON

CONTACTORS AND STARTERS


5.75
146
OFF

.28 PADLOCK HOLE


7
CONDUIT CENTERLINE
3/4-14 PIPE TAP,
2X .31 MTG. HOLES BOTTOM ONLY 1.19
8 1.37 .70
35 18 30

Dimensions for Duplex Devices


NOTE: These dimensions are for reference only. If you need precise measurements,
(4)
.25
Dia. Mtg. Holes
contact the Customer Care Center at 1-888-778-2733.
6

Table 16.15: NEMA 1 General Purpose Surface Mount Enclosure for Duplex
Pilot
Light Devices
3.00 Type of Type
OFF OFF 76 Device Operator Class

16
4.25 Toggle 2510 FGO2, 02P
108 One Starter
Key 2510 FGO4P
Toggle 2510 FG22, 22P
Two Starters
2.75 .38 1.88 1.88
0.56 2.56 Key 2510 FG44P
70 10 48 48 65
4.50 14 Toggle
2.88
114
2.63 One Starter and 2510 FG71, 71P, 72, 72P
73 67
3.81 One Selector Switch[8] Key 2510 FG74P
97
Reversing Switch[9] Toggle 2511 KG11, 11A, 11B, 22, 22A, 22B, 22C
Two-Speed Starter Toggle 2512 FG11, 11P, 22, 22P
1.06 Two-Speed Switch Toggle 2512 KG11, 11A, 11B, 22, 22B, 22C
27

0.5–0.75 Conduit Knockout, Both Ends Table 16.16: General Purpose Flush Mounting Plate for Duplex Devices
Type of Dimensions[10]
Device Class Type
Operator A B C D
 FF22, 22P 5.25 3.75 5.25 1.44
Toggle 2510
Two  FS22P 4.56 3.5 4.5 1.44
Starters  FF44P 5.25 3.75 5.25 1.44
Key 2510
 FS44P 4.56 3.5 4.5 1.44
One  FF71, 71P, 72, 72P 5.25 0.75 5.25 2
Toggle 2510
2.56 OFF OFF C Starter  FS71P, 72P 4.56 3.5 4.5 2
and One
65 Selector Key
 FF74P 5.25 3.75 5.25 2
2510
Switch[11]  FS74P 4.56 3.5 4.5 2
 KF11, 11A, 11B
Reversing Toggle  KF22, 22A
2511 5.25 3.75 5.25 1.75
Switch  KF22B, 22C
A Pilot Two-Speed Toggle 2512  FF11, 11P, 22, 22P 5.25 3.75 5.25 1.44
Light Starter
Two-Speed Toggle  KF11, 11A, 11B,
Switch 2512  KF22, 22B, 22C 5.25 3.75 5.25 1.75
.75
D
19
.91
23 B

[8] Selector switch is on the left and increases the overall depth to 3.5 in.
[9] Only one pilot light (located on right) is used on Class 2511 switches.
[10] Dimensions include factory wired power connections.
[11] Selector Switch is on left, extends 1-5/8" from mounting surface.
16-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Manual Starters and Switches Manual Starters, Type M and T—Integral
Horsepower
Class 2510, 2511, 2512 / Refer to Catalog 2510CT9701 schneider-electric.us

Integral Horsepower
Types M and T integral horsepower manual starters provide
convenient On-Off operation of small single phase, polyphase or DC
motors. Typical applications include small machine tools, pumps, fans
and conveyors.
• Push button (M) or toggle (T) operators
• Reliable overload protection
16

• Pilot light and auxiliary contact available

Table 16.17: Integral Horsepower Manual Starters (see Thermal Unit Selection, page 16-130)
NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE
CONTACTORS AND STARTERS

Non-Reversing, Class 2510, Max. Voltage: 600 Vac


Ratings NEMA 1 NEMA 4/4X NEMA 7 & 9 Open Type
Surface Mounting Watertight, For NEMA 12
NEMA 4/4X
Watertight and Dusttight Hazardous Dusttight
and Locations and
Dusttight Corrosion- Class I— Driptight
No. of NEMA Square Enclosure Square
Toggle Resistant Groups C, D Industrial Toggle
Poles Size Max. Hp P.B. Operator Brushed P.B. Operator
Motor Operator Glass- Class II— Use Operator
Voltage Stainless Steel
Polyester Groups E, F & Enclosure
Enclosure G
Poly- Single Type Type Type Type [12] Type Type
Phase Phase
115 — 1 MBW11 [13] MBW1 [13] MBR1 [13] MBA1 [13]
M-0 MBG1 TBG1 MBO1 TBO1
230 — 2
2- 115 — 2 MCG1 TCG1 MCW11 MCW1 MCR1 MCA1 MCO1 TCO1
Pole M-1 230 3

115 — 3
M-1P 230 5 MCG2 TCG2 MCW12 MCW2 MCR2 MCA2 MCO2 TCO2

— —
200-230 MBW12 [13] MBW2 [13] MBR2 [13] MBA2 [13]
M-0 380-575 3 — MBG2 TBG2 MBO2 TBO2
3- 5 —
Pole — —
200-230 7.5 MCG3 TCG3 MCW13 MCW3 MCR3 MCA3 MCO3 TCO3
M-1 380-575 —
10 —
115 1 hp DC
DC M-0 1.5 hp DC MBG4 TBG4 MBW14 MBW4 — MBA4 MBO4 TBO4
230
2-
Pole 115 1.5 hp DC
M-1 2 hp DC MCG5 TCG5 MCW15 MCW5 MCR5 MCA5 MCO5 TCO5
230

All Except NEMA 7 and 9 All Except NEMA 7 and 9


Table 16.18: How to Order
File E42243 File LR60905 To Order Specify: Catalog Number
CCN NLRV Class 3211-05
NEMA 7 and 9 Only NEMA 7 and 9 Only • Class Number Class Type

File E58760 File LR26817 • Type Number 2510 MCA1


CCN NPXZ Class 3218-04

[12] NEMA 7 & 9 enclosures are cast iron. NEMA 7 & 9 cast aluminum enclosures are also available; to order, replace the R in the catalog number with a T. For additional information, contact the
Customer Care Center.
[13] Approved for group motor installations per NEC 430-53(c).
16-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Manual Starters, Type M and T—Integral Manual Starters and Switches
Horsepower
schneider-electric.us Class 2510, 2511, 2512 / Refer to Catalog 2510CT9701
Reversing and Two Speed
Class 2511 reversing and Class 2512 two-speed manual starters consist of two
mechanically interlocked Class 2510 Types M or T manual starters.

Table 16.19: Reversing Class 2511


NEMA 1
Ratings Surface Mounting Open Type
Number
Class Description of NEMA
Size Motor Square Square
Poles Maximum Toggle Toggle
Voltage Hp P.B. Operator P.B. Operator
Operator Operator
200-230 3
M-0 MBG1 TBG1 MBO1 TBO1

NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE


CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
380-575 5
2511 Standard 3-Pole
200-230 7-1/2
M-1 MCG1 TCG1 MCO1 TCO1
380-575 10

Table 16.20: Two Speed, Class 2512 (Wye-Connected Separate Winding Motors Only)
Ratings NEMA 1 Open Type
Surface Mounting
Number
Description NEMA Constant
Class of Size Square Square
Poles Motor Constant Torque or Toggle Toggle
Voltage P.B. P.B.
Hp Variable Operator Operator Operator Operator
Torque
200-230 2 3
M-0 MBG1 TBG1 MBO1 TBO1
380-575 3 5
2512 Standard 3-Pole
200-230 5 7-1/2
M-1 MCG1 TCG1 MCO1 TCO1
380-575 7-1/2 10

Thermal Units
Starters will not operate without properly installed thermal units and device reset.

16
Thermal unit must be installed so that markings face the front of starter.
Application Data
Size–Available in NEMA Sizes M-0, M-1, and M-1P.
Poles–Two poles single phase; three poles polyphase; 2 poles DC.
Voltage–600 Vac max.; 250 Vdc max.
Overload Relays–Melting alloy thermal overload relays have provisions for one Type B
thermal unit for single phase starters and three Type B thermal units for three phase
starters. All thermal units must be installed and the device reset before the starter
contacts will operate. After overload relays have tripped, allow one or two minutes for
the alloy to solidify before resetting.
Operator–Available with a push button or toggle operator in open and NEMA 1 versions.
NEMA 4/4X (stainless) and 12 versions utilize a direct acting push button only.
NEMA 4/4X (polyester) and 7/9 versions utilize an external toggle to actuate a push
button device inside.
Maintenance of Equipment
For proper performance, all equipment should be periodically inspected and maintained.
Replacement contacts and interlocks are available in kit form to facilitate servicing and
stocking. In addition, the service bulletin contains an exploded view of the device with
components clearly marked for easy identification by description and part number.
Mechanism Lock Off – Both open devices and starters in NEMA 1 surface and flush
mounting, and NEMA 4, 4X, 7 & 9, and 12 enclosures can be locked in the Off or Stop
position.
The NEMA 1 surface mounting, 4, 4X, 7 & 9, and 12 enclosures can also be locked
closed to prevent unauthorized entry.

Table 16.21: Terminal information and Replacement Contact Kits


Auxiliary Interlock Replacement
Power Terminals Terminals Contact Kit
Wire Size Wire Size Num- Service
NEMA ber of Bulle-
Size Type of (Solid or Type of (Solid or
Stranded Stranded Poles tin Class Type
Lug Lug
Copper Wire) Copper Wire)
Min.-Max. Min.-Max.
M-0 Pressure 14–8 Pressure 16–12 2 or 3 312AS 9998 ML1
Wire Wire
Pressure Pressure
M-1 Wire 14–8 Wire 16–12 2 or 3 312AS 9998 ML2

Box Lug Pressure


M-1P 14–6 16–12 2 312AS 9998 ML2
Wire

Accessories and Modification Kits


One auxiliary contact, either N.O. or N.C. can easily be added internally to any open or
enclosed Type M or T manual starter. It occupies the space provided in either the upper
right hand or left hand corners of the device. These contacts are for AC loads only. For
electrical ratings, refer to page 16-125, Class 9999 Types SX11 or SX12.
A unique red pilot light assembly that clips into place is available factory installed on
NEMA 1, 4, 4X, 12 and flush enclosures or as a field modification kit on the NEMA 1
surface or flush mounting enclosures. See page 16-11. The color cap assembly snaps
into a knockout in the enclosure cover on the NEMA 1 enclosures. Pilot light kits are
available for use on Various voltages (110-600 V). Pilot light assemblies are not available
for NEMA 7 and 9 enclosures.

16-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Manual Starters and Switches Manual Starters, Type M and T—Integral
Horsepower
Class 2510, 2511, 2512 / Refer to Catalog 2510CT9701 schneider-electric.us

Approximate Dimensions

3.50 .28
1.75 89 7 4.03
44 102

1.25
32
START
5.13
16

STOP
130
RESET
5.72
1.13 145
29

.44 Travel to
NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE

.69 Prov. for


CONTACTORS AND STARTERS

18 1.13 (3) #10 11 Reset


29 Mounting 3.97
Screws 101

NEMA 1 NEMA 12 NEMA 4/4X Class 2510 Type M


General Purpose Surface Mounting Dusttight and Driptight Watertight and Dusttight Sizes M-0, M-1 and M-1P, Open Style
Industrial Use Stainless Steel Approximate Shipping Weight: 3 lb

.28 Dia.
(3) .5 -.75 K.O. .22
Top and Bottom 6
Mtg. Holes
START START

STOP STOP 9.34


RESET RESET
237
4.25
7.88 108
200

1.69
.75 43 1.28
7.25 19
3.38 33
184 86
8.94 .84
227 21

NEMA 4/4X NEMA 7 & 9 Classes 2511, 2512, Types M & T


Watertight, Dusttight Hazardous Locations Sizes M-0 and M-1 NEMA 1
and Corrosion Resistant Cast Iron General Purpose Enclosure
Glass Polyester Approximate Shipping Weight: 9 lb

3.38 .22 5.00 2.13 .22 3.91


86 .88 6 127
54 6
.94 1.69 22 99 5.78 .75 Conduit Hub
1.06 1.06 1.02 Top and Bottom
1.31
24 43 27 147 33
27 26 1.27 3.25 .38 NEMA 4/4X
1.00 1.14 32 83 10
25
29

.50 - .75 K.O. 10.00 .50 - .75 K.O.


8.63
.31 Dia. .47
(2) Top Back START
254 (2) Each Side (2) Mounting 12
START
219 .50 - .75 K.O. Holes
STOP Each Side 10.75
8.13 STOP START 273
RESET

207 .22 Dia. RESET 5.75


(4) Mounting 146 STOP
10.00 10.92
RESET 277
.22 Dia. Holes 254
(3) Mounting
Holes
1.00 1.00 1.44
25 25 37
.94 4.13 1.00 3.00
24 105 (1) .50 - .75 K.O. 25 76
(2) .50 - .75 K.O. 1.02
6.00 (2) .75 - 1.00 K.O. Top and Bottom 26
152 Top and Bottom
1.06 5.00 2.89 (2) .31 Wide Slots 5.76
27 127 73 146

Class 2510 Type M & T Size M-1P Class 2510 Types M & T Sizes M-0 and M-1 Class 2510 Type M Sizes M-0, M-1 and M-1P
NEMA 1 General Purpose Enclosure NEMA 1 General Purpose Enclosure NEMA 4/4X Watertight Stainless Steel Enclosure
Approximate Shipping Weight: 5 lb Approximate Shipping Weight: 5 lb NEMA 12 Dusttight Industrial Use Enclosure
Approximate Shipping Weight: 9 lb

6.50 .75 6.41 6.00


5.78 165 19 163 152
147 .75 5.00 .66 4.69 .34 6.13
19 127 1.28 17 119 9 156
33
1.69
43
R
E ON
S
8.75
222 R ON
E E R ON
T E
S
E S 10.50
OFF 7.31 10.34 T
OFF
E
T
267
186 263 8.75
222 OFF 9.94
(2) .31 Dia. 252
Mtg. Holes 12.13
308
(2) .31 Dia.
Mtg. Holes (4) .13 Wide
1.69 Mtg. Slots
.72 3.69 .75 Conduit Hub 43
18 94 .72 Top and Bottom
5.13 18 .81 1.41 2.19 .75 Conduit Hub 2.34 (1) .75 Conduit Top and Bottom (Std.)
21 36 In Top and Bottom 59 (1) 1.50 Conduit Top and Bottom (Max.)
130 56

Class 2510 Type M Size M-0 (AC–DC) Class 2510 Type M Sizes M-1 and M-1P (AC) Class 2510 Type M Sizes M-0, M-1 and M-1P
and Size M-1 (DC) NEMA 4/4X NEMA 4/4X Watertight Corrosion-Resistant NEMA 7 & 9 Hazardous Location
Watertight Corrosion-Resistant Glass Polyester Enclosure Cast Iron Enclosure
Glass Polyester Enclosure Approximate Shipping Weight—6 lb Approximate Shipping Weight—18 lb
Approximate Shipping Weight—6 lb

16-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories, Modifications, and Manual Starters and Switches
Replacement Parts
schneider-electric.us Class 2510, 2511, 2512 / Refer to Catalog 2510CT9701

Accessories, Modifications, and Replacement Parts


Table 16.23: Modifications (Types M & T only)
Table 16.22: P11 Pilot Light Voltage Codes
Field Modification Kits, Class &
Voltage Code Description Factory Modifications (Forms) Type
120 V V02 9999MP1 (110–120 V)
200/208 V V08 Red Pilot Light [14] P11[15] 9999MP2 (208–240 V)
230 V V03 9999MP3 (440–600 V)
460 V V06 X1 (1 N.O.) 9999SX11 (N.O.)
575 V V07 Auxiliary Contacts [16]
X2 (1 N.C.) 9999SX12 (N.C.)

NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE


Jumper Straps [17] N/A 9998SO31

CONTACTORS AND STARTERS


Contactor only Y76 N/A

Table 16.24: Accessories—Class 2510 Table 16.25: Pilot Light Kits—Class 2510 Types F and K
Red Pilot Light Green Pilot Light
Types F and K Application Voltage
Class & Type Class & Type
Description Class & Type 110–120 Vac 9999PL11 9999PL11G
Handle Guard Kit with Padlock Provision [18] 2510FL1 Type KF, KG, KW [19] 208–277 Vac 9999PL12 9999PL12G
Emergency Off Actuator 2510PB1 440–600 Vac 9999PL13 9999PL13G
Additional Key for Key Operated Devices 2510FK1 Type FF, FG, FW [19] 115–240 Vac/dc 9999PL10 9999PL10G

Table 16.26: Replacement Nameplates—Class 2510 Types F and K


Nameplate Type Number—Class 2510
For Type F Starter
Nameplate For Type K Switch
Description Application (includes Reset indication)
Marking
Without With Without With
Pilot Light Pilot Light Pilot Light Pilot Light

16
1-3/4" x 2-13/16" Nameplate Standard commercial switch (Blank) FN1 — FN2 —
with Embossed Mounting Holes box cover or flush plate, including
for #6 Oval Head Screws Square D stainless steel plates (Special marking –specify the marking desired) FN5 — FN6 —
(Blank) FN10 FN20 FN30 FN40
High FN11 FN21 FN31 FN41
1-29/32" x 3-27/32" Square D NEMA 1 Low FN12 FN22 FN32 FN42
Flat Nameplate surface mounted enclosure
with Mounting Holes Forward FN13 — — —
or gray flush plate
for #6 Pan Head Screws Reverse FN14 FN24 — —
(Special marking—specify the marking desired) FN15 FN25 FN35 FN45

Contact Kits
See page 16-122 for Class 9998 Replacement Contact Kits.

Table 16.27: Replacement Part Kits


Enclosure Product Description Kit Catalog No.
Replacement Toggle Kits
NEMA 4 Type FW and KW 9998HW1
NEMA 7 & 9 Type FR and KR 9998HR2
Replacement Handle Kits
Type MBA, MCA (Ser. A & B) 9998HWA1
NEMA 12
Type MBA, MCA (Ser. C) 31085-381-50
Type MBW, MCW (Ser. A & B) 9998HWA1
NEMA 4/4X (Stainless)
Type MBW, MCW (Ser. C) 31085-381-50
Type MBW (Size 0) 9998HWA1
NEMA 4/4X (Polyester)
Type MCW (Size 1) 9998HR3
NEMA 7 and 9 Type MBR, MCR 9998HR3
Description Kit Catalog No.
Internal Lever 9998IL1

Table 16.28: How to Order Table 16.29: Enclosures


For use with Class 2510 Type Enclosure Catalog No.
To Order Specify: Catalog Number
F and K 9991EN1
• Class Number Class Type
M: Sizes M-0 & M-1 NEMA 1 Standard 9991MG1
• Type Number 9991 KE1 M: Size M-1P
NEMA 1 Flush Mount
9991MG2

(with pull box and plaster adjustment) 9991MF1


NEMA 1 Flush Mount
MBO and MCO (without pullbox but with mounting strap) 9991MF2
NEMA 4X (Polyester) 9991MW1
NEMA 4 (Stainless Steel) 9991MW11
FO1, FO1P, FO2, FO2P, FO3, FO3P, FO4, FO4P NEMA 1 Oversized 9991FE1
KO1, KO1A, KO1B, KO2, KO2B, KO2C, NEMA 1 Oversized 9991KE1
KO3, KO3A, KO3B, KO4, KO4B, KO4C, NEMA 1 Jumbo 9991KE2
KO5, KO5A, KO5B, KO6, KO6B, KO6C NEMA 3R 9991KE3

[14] May only be field-added to NEMA 1 enclosures. For green pilot light, order 9999SPG1 additionally.
[15] Form P11 pilot lights require a voltage code. Refer to Table 16.22. Catalog number example: 2510MBG1V02P11.
[16] For proper operation, only one auxiliary contact kit per device may be added.
[17] Used to control a single phase motor utilizing a three phase starter.
[18] Standard on Type K devices.
[19] The lens cannot be replaced. The pilot light kits for NEMA 4 enclosed units are for replacement only.
16-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ U Motor Starters TeSys™ U Starter Components
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us

TeSys U Selection
The NEMA style TeSys U motor starter is an integrated product—simple to choose and
For detailed information about TeSys U, to install—consisting of a control unit snapped into a power base. TeSys U can be
visit www.schneider-electric.com/us. configured to fit specific applications as well. The NEMA style TeSys U starter uses the
same optional accessories—reverser, current limiter, predictive maintenance options,
and communication options—as the IEC TeSys U.
Selecting a NEMA TeSys U Motor Starter in Three Steps

Step 1
Power Base
Step 2
Control Unit
Step 3 = NEMA TeSys™ U Motor Starter
Function Modules
Auxiliary Contacts

Table 16.30: Step 1. Select Power Base


Max. hp, Power
Max. hp, Three Phase Single Phase
Control NEMA Bases
Power Base
Connection Size Catalog
200/208 V 220/240 V 460 V 575/600 V 120 V 240 V
Number
With screw
terminations 1 7.5 7.5 10 10 2 3 LUB32NR

Table 16.32: Step 2. Select Control Unit [3]


Table 16.31: Voltage Codes
Setting Range Standard 3-phase Advanced 3-Phase Advanced Single-Phase Advanced 3-Phase
Volts 24 48–72 110–240 A Class 10 trip [4] Class 10 trip [4] Class 10 trip [4] Class 20 trip [4]
DC BL[1] — — 0.15–0.6 LUCAX6•• LUCBX6•• LUCCX6•• LUCDX6••
AC B — — 0.3–1.4 LUCA1X•• LUCB1X•• LUCC1X•• LUCD1X••
DC or AC — ES[2] FU 1.25–5.0 LUCA05•• LUCB05•• LUCC05•• LUCD05••
3–12 LUCA12•• LUCB12•• LUCC12•• LUCD12••
4.5–18 LUCA18•• LUCB18•• LUCC18•• LUCD18••
8–32 LUCA32•• LUCB32•• LUCC32•• LUCD32••

Table 16.33: Step 3. Select Auxiliary Contacts (optional)


Auxiliary Contact Blocks
Contact State for Each Mode [5]
Contact Normal Catalog
Terminals Contact Short Overload Overload Trip
Indicates Off Ready Run Circuit Trip (Manual (Remote/Auto Number
Status
Trip Reset) Reset) [6]
Ready
N.O. O I I O O I
condition
Screw LUA1C11
Fault N.C. I I I O O I
condition
Ready
condition N.O. O I I O O I
Screw LUA1C20
Auxiliary Contact Fault
Control Unit condition N.O. O O O I I O

Table 16.34: TeSys U Auxiliary Contact Function Modules


Terminals Contact Indicates Normal Contact Status Catalog Number
Screw Power pole status 2 N.O. LUFN20
Screw Power pole status 1 N.O. and 1 N.C. LUFN11
Screw Power pole status 2 N.C. LUFN02

Table 16.35: TeSys U Accessories


For details and selection,
E164862 Accessories for LUB32NR Quick Description see pages:
CCN NLDX Increases the breaking capacity to 130kA @ 460 V
Current limiter 18-25
Reverser Stacked or side mounted (LU6MB0•• [4] only) 18-25
Required for use as a self-protected combination
Line phase barrier starter (UL508 Type E) 18-25
LR43364
Class 3211 08 Has functions for monitoring and predictive
Multifunction control unit maintenance 18-25
Fault differentiation, thermal overload, motor load
Function modules 18-25
indication
Integrates into existing networks, major protocols
Communication modules 18-26
available
Soft starter + TeSys U Use Altistart U01Soft Starter with TeSys U 18-42
Power bus bars TeSys U cabling accessory 18-26
Control circuit contact block, external handles, and
Control circuit accessories control circuit filters 18-26

Accessories and Dimensions: See Section 18.

[1] DC voltage with range of 0.90 to 1.10 of nominal.


[2] 48–72 Vdc; 48 Vac.
[3] The control unit contains solid-state overload relay and control power source for TeSys U. For more details on the different control units, their functions, and placement on the power base
see Section 18.
[4] Complete the catalog number by adding the appropriate voltage code from Table 16.31. For example: LUCAX6FU.
[5] I = closed contact; O = open contact.
[6] Requires a multifunction or advanced control unit, plus fault differentiation module LUFDDA10.
16-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Catalog Numbering System: T02 and T36 TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us

Interpreting the Catalog Number


Table 16.36: TeSys N Catalog Numbering System
T 02 C N 1 3 G7
Product Family Voltage Code
T: TeSys N
B7: 24 Vac, 50/60 Hz
BD: 24 Vdc
Device Type G7: 120 Vac, 50/60 Hz
LE7: 208 Vac, 50/60 Hz
02: Contactor, page 16-14 U7: 240 Vac, 50/60 Hz
36: Starter, page 16-16 T7: 480 Vac, 50/60 Hz

NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE


CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
NEMA Size Numerals
A: Size 00 F: Size 4 Used to define specific, physical arrangements such as
B: Size 0 G: Size 5 number of poles for devices type T02 or protection type for
C: Size 1 H: Size 6 [1] devices type T36. Consult the Digest listings for specific
D: Size 2 J: Size 7 [1] device numbers.
E: Size 3
Direction
1: Non-reversing
2: Reversing

Enclosure Type
N: No enclosure

16

[1] Not available for reversing Type T36 devices.


16-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters Non-Reversing Contactors
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us

TeSys N Non-Reversing Contactors


TeSys N contactors are used to switch heating loads, capacitors, transformers and
electric motors where overload protection is provided separately. TeSys N contactors are
available in NEMA Sizes 00–7. Target market segments include hospitals; retail; food
and beverage; marine; oil and gas; and mining, metals, and minerals.

Table 16.37: TeSys N Non-Reversing Contactors, 3-Pole Polyphase, 600 Vac Max.
(replace ●● with the coil voltage code)
Continuous Open
NEMA Size Current Motor Voltage Max HP
Rating (A) Catalog No. [2]
200 1.5
230 1.5
00 9 T02AN13●●
460 2
575 2
200 3
230 3
0 18 T02BN13●●
460 5
575 5
TeSys N non-reversing contactor, Size 1 200 7.5
230 7.5
1 27 T02CN13●●
460 10
575 10
200 10
230 15
2 45 T02DN13●●
460 25
575 25
200 25
230 30
3 90 T02EN13●●[3]
460 50
575 50
200 40
230 50
4 135 T02FN13●●[3]
460 100
575 100
200 75
TeSys N non-reversing contactor, Size 3 230 100
5 270 T02GN13●●[3]
460 200
575 200
200 150
230 200
6 540 T02HN13●●[3]
460 400
575 400
200 —
230 300
7 810 T02JN13●●[3]
460 600
575 600

Table 16.38: TeSys N Non-Reversing Contactors, 3-Pole Single Phase, 600 Vac
Max.
(replace ●● with the coil voltage code)
Continuous Open
NEMA Size Current Motor Voltage Max HP
Rating (A) Catalog Number
115 1/3
00 9 T02AN13●●
230 1
115 1
0 18 T02BN13●●
230 2
115 2
1 27 T02CN13●●
230 3
115 3
2 45 T02DN13●●
230 7.5

Table 16.39: TeSys N Coil Voltage Codes


Voltage Code by NEMA Size
Voltage
Size 00 Size 0 Size 1 Size 2 Size 3 Size 4 Size 5 Size 6 Size 7
24 Vac B7 B7 B7 B7 B6 B6 n/a
24 Vdc BD BD BD BD BD BD n/a
120 Vac G7 G7 G7 G7 G6 G6 G7 F7 F7
208 Vac LE7 LE7 LE7 LE7 L6 L6 L7 L7 L7
240 Vac U7 U7 U7 U7 U6 U6 U7 U7 U7
480 Vac T7 T7 T7 T7 Q5 Q5 S7 N7 N7

Dimensions: page 16-22 to page 16-26


Accessories: page 16-18 to page 16-20
Replacement Parts: page 16-21
Lugs: page 16-20

[2] Replace the bullets (●●) in the catalog number with the coil voltage code. Refer to voltage codes shown in Table 16.39.
[3] Order lugs separately. See Table 16.61. The mounting hardware (screws, washers, and nuts) comes with the contactors, not the lugs. Starters Sizes 3–7 come with lugs.
16-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Reversing Contactors TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us

TeSys N Reversing Contactors


TeSys N reversing contactors are used for starting, stopping and reversing AC motors
where overload protection is provided separately. TeSys N reversing contactors are
mechanically and electrically interlocked and are available in NEMA Sizes 00–7. Target
market segments include hospitals; retail; food and beverage; marine; oil and gas; and
mining, metals, and minerals.

Table 16.40: TeSys N Reversing Contactors, 3-Pole Polyphase, 600 Vac Max.
(replace ●● with the coil voltage code)

NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE


CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
Continuous Open
NEMA Size Current Motor Voltage Max HP
Rating (A) Catalog No. [4]

TeSys N reversing contactor, Size 00 200 1.5


230 1.5
00 9 T02AN23●●
460 2
575 2
200 3
230 3
0 18 T02BN23●●
460 5
575 5
200 7.5
230 7.5
1 27 T02CN23●●
460 10
575 10
200 10
TeSys N reversing contactor, Size 4 230 15
2 45 T02DN23●●
460 25
575 25

16
200 25
230 30
3 90 T02EN23●●[5]
460 50
575 50
200 40
230 50
4 135 T02FN23●●[5]
460 100
575 100
200 75
230 100
5 270 T02GN23●●[5]
460 200
575 200
200 150
230 200
6 540 T02HN23●●[5]
460 400
575 400
200 —
230 300
7 810 T02JN23●●[5]
460 600
575 600

Table 16.41: TeSys N Reversing Contactors, 3-Pole Single Phase, 600 Vac Max.
(replace ●● with the coil voltage code)
Continuous Open
NEMA Size Current Motor Voltage Max HP
Rating (A) Catalog No. [4]
115 1/3
00 9 T02AN23●●
230 1
115 1
0 18 T02BN23●●
230 2
115 2
1 27 T02CN23●●
230 3
115 3
2 45 T02DN23●●
230 7.5

Table 16.42: TeSys N Coil Voltage Codes


Voltage Code by NEMA Size
Voltage
Size 00 Size 0 Size 1 Size 2 Size 3 Size 4 Size 5 Size 6 Size 7
24 Vac B7 B7 B7 B7 B6 B6 n/a
24 Vdc BD BD BD BD BD BD n/a
120 Vac G7 G7 G7 G7 G6 G6 G7 F7 F7
208 Vac LE7 LE7 LE7 LE7 L6 L6 L7 L7 L7
240 Vac U7 U7 U7 U7 U6 U6 U7 U7 U7
480 Vac T7 T7 T7 T7 Q5 Q5 S7 N7 N7

Dimensions: page 16-22 to page 16-26


Accessories: page 16-18 to page 16-20
Replacement Parts: page 16-21
Lugs: page 16-20

[4] Replace the bullets (●●) in the catalog number with the coil voltage code. Refer to the voltage codes shown in Table 16.42.
[5] Order lugs separately. See Table 16.61. The mounting hardware (screws, washers, and nuts) comes with the contactors, not the lugs. Starters Sizes 3–7 come with lugs.
16-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters Non-Reversing Starters
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us

TeSys N Non-Reversing Starters


TeSys N starters are used for full-voltage starting and stopping of AC squirrel-cage
motors. Starters are available in NEMA Sizes 00–7 and come standard with Motor Logic
Class 10/20 selectable solid-state overload relays. Starters with bimetal overload
protection can be assembled from TeSys N contactors and TeSys D overload relays.

Table 16.43: 3-Pole Polyphase, 600 Vac Max. (replace ●● with the coil voltage code)
Continuous Current Open
NEMA Size Motor Voltage Max HP
Rating (A) Catalog No. [6]
200 1.5
230 1.5
00 9 T36AN13●●
460 2
575 2
200 3
230 3
0 18 T36BN13●●
TeSys N Size 1 Contactor + 460 5
TeSys N non-reversing starter, TeSys LRD Bimetallic Overload 575 5
Size 1 Relay 200 7.5
230 7.5
1 [7] 27 T36CN13●●
460 10
575 10
200 10
230 15
2 45 T36DN13●●
460 25
575 25
200 25
230 30
3 90 T36EN13●●
460 50
575 50
200 40
230 50
4 135 T36FN13●●
460 100
575 100
TeSys N Size 1 Contactor + 200 75
TeSys N non-reversing starter, TeSys LR9D Electronic Overload 230 100
Size 3 Relay 5 270 T36GN13●●
460 200
For more information on TeSys D relays, see 575 200
Section 18. 200 150
230 200
6 540 T36HN13●●
460 400
575 400
Dimensions: page 16-22 200 —
TeSys N Accessories: pages page 16-18 230 300
7 810 T36JN13●●
460 600
575 600

Table 16.44: TeSys N Coil Voltage Codes Table 16.45: TeSys LR9D Electronic Overload Relays
Voltage Code by NEMA Size Current Setting Range (A) For Direct Mounting to Class 5/10/20/30
Voltage TeSys N Contactors Selectable
Size 00 Size 0 Size 1 Size 2 Size 3 Size 4 Size 5 Size 6 Size 7
24 Vac [8] B7 B7 B7 B7 B6 B6 — — — 0.1–0.5 LR9D01
24 Vdc [9] 0.4–2.0 LR9D02
BD BD BD BD BD BD — — — Size 00–1
1.6–8.0 LR9D08
120 Vac [8] G7 G7 G7 G7 G6 G6 G7 F7 F7 6.4–32 LR9D32
208 Vac LE7 LE7 LE7 LE7 L6 L6 L7 L7 L7
240 Vac U7 U7 U7 U7 U6 U6 U7 U7 U7
480 Vac T7 T7 T7 T7 Q5 Q5 S7 N7 N7

Table 16.46: TeSys D Overload Relays—Ambient Compensated, Bimetallic, Direct Mounting


Current Setting For Direct Mounting to Class 10 with Class 10 without Class 20 with Class 20 without
Range (A) TeSys N Contactors Single-Phase Sensitivity Single-Phase Sensitivity Single-Phase Sensitivity Single-Phase Sensitivity
0.10–0.16 Size 00–1 LRD01 LR3D01 — —
0.16–0.25 Size 00–1 LRD02 LR3D02 — —
0.25–0.40 Size 00–1 LRD03 LR3D03 — —
0.40–0.63 Size 00–1 LRD04 LR3D04 LRD04L LR3D04L
0.63–1 Size 00–1 LRD05 LR3D05 LRD05L LR3D05L
1–1.6 Size 00–1 LRD06 LR3D06 LRD06L LR3D06L
1.6–2.5 Size 00–1 LRD07 LR3D07 LRD07L LR3D07L
2.5–4 Size 00–1 LRD08 LR3D08 LRD08L LR3D08L
4–6 Size 00–1 LRD10 LR3D10 LRD10L LR3D10L
5.5–8 Size 00–1 LRD12 LR3D12 LRD12L LR3D12L
7–10 Size 00–1 LRD14 LR3D14 LRD14L LR3D14L
9–13 Size 0–1 LRD16 LR3D16 LRD16L LR3D16L
12–18 Size 0–1 LRD21 LR3D21 LRD21L LR3D21L
16–24 Size 0–1 LRD22 LR3D22 — —
17–24 Size 0–1 — — LRD22L LR3D22L
23–32 Size 1 LRD32 LR3D32 LRD32L LR3D32L
9–13 Size 2 LRD313 LR3D313 LRD313L —
12–18 Size 2 LRD318 LR3D318 LRD318L —
16–25 Size 2 LRD325 LR3D325 LRD325L —
23–32 Size 2 LRD332 LR3D332 LRD332L —
30–40 Size 2 LRD340 LR3D340 LRD340L —
37–50 Size 2 LRD350 LR3D350 LRD350L —

[6] Replace the bullets (●●) in the catalog number with the coil voltage code. Refer to the coil voltage codes shown in Table 16.44.
[7] Special size combinations of the contactor and Motor Logic overload relay are available. Add 0 to the catalog number before the coil voltage for a Size 0 overload relay (6–18 A); 9 for a Size
00C (3–9 A); and 8 for a Size 00B (1.5–4.5 A)—for example, T36CN130G7.
[8] The 24 and 120 Vac coils are available with optional separate control; add Form S to the catalog number (for example, T36AN13B7S).
[9] The 24 Vdc coil requires separate control; add Form S to the catalog number (for example, T36AN13BDS).
16-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Reversing Starters TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us

TeSys N Reversing Starters


TeSys N reversing starters are used for full-voltage starting, stopping, and reversing of
AC squirrel cage motors. Reversing starters are mechanically and electrically interlocked
and are available in NEMA Sizes 00 through 5. Starters come with Motor Logic Class 10/
20 selectable solid-state overload relays as standard. Reversing starters with bimetal
overload protection can be assembled from TeSys N reversing contactors and TeSys D
overload relays. For more information on TeSys D overload relays, see Section 18.

Table 16.47: TeSys N Reversing Starters, 3-Pole Polyphase, 600 Vac Max.

NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE


CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
(replace ●● with the coil voltage code)
Continuous Current Open
NEMA Size Motor Voltage Max HP
Rating (A) Catalog No. [10]
200 1.5
230 1.5
00 9 T36AN23●●
460 2
575 2
200 3
TeSys N reversing starter, Size 00 230 3
0 18 T36BN23●●
460 5
575 5
200 7.5
230 7.5
1[11] 27 T36CN23●●
460 10
575 10
200 10
230 15
2 45 T36DN23●●
460 25

16
575 25
200 25
230 30
3 90 T36EN23●●
460 50
575 50
200 40
230 50
4 135 T36FN23●●
460 100
TeSys N reversing starter, Size 4 575 100
200 75
230 100
5 270 T36GN23●●
460 200
575 200

Table 16.48: TeSys N Coil Voltage Codes


Voltage Code by NEMA Size
Voltage
Size 00 Size 0 Size 1 Size 2 Size 3 Size 4 Size 5
24 Vac[12] B7 B7 B7 B7 B6 B6 n/a
24 Vdc [13] BD BD BD BD BD BD n/a
120 Vac[12] G7 G7 G7 G7 G6 G6 G7
208 Vac LE7 LE7 LE7 LE7 L6 L6 L7
240 Vac U7 U7 U7 U7 U6 U6 U7
480 Vac T7 T7 T7 T7 Q5 Q5 S7

Dimensions: page 16-22 to page 16-26


Accessories: page 16-18 to page 16-20
E164862 Replacement Parts: page 16-21
CCN NLDX Lugs: page 16-20

LR43364
Class 3211 04

[10] Replace the bullets (●●) in the catalog number with the coil voltage code. Refer to the coil voltage codes shown in Table 16.48.
[11] Special size combinations of the contactor and Motor Logic overload relay are available. Add 0 to the catalog number before the coil voltage for Size 0 overload relays (6–18 A); 9 for Size
00C (3–9 A); and 8 for Size 00B (1.5–4.5 A)—for example, T36CN230G7.
[12] The 24 and 120 Vac coils are available with optional separate control; add Form S to the catalog number (for example, T36AN13B7S).
[13] The 24 Vdc coil requires separate control; add Form S to the catalog number (for example, T36AN23BDS).
16-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters Accessories
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us

Auxiliary Contacts, Time Delay, Mechanical Latch


Table 16.49: Standard, Instantaneous Auxiliary Contact Blocks
Snap-On Number of Composition
Mounting Catalog Number
Contacts N.O. N.C.
2 2 LADN22 [14]
1 3 LADN13 [14]
4 0 LADN40 [14]
To front of 4
Size 00–2 0 4 LADN04 [14]
or 3 1 LADN31 [14]
To right side of 2 [15] 2 [15] LADC22 [15]
Size 3–7
1 1 LADN11 [14]
2 2 0 LADN20 [14]
0 2 LADN02 [14]
Front Mounted Auxiliary Blocks To left side of 1 0 LADN10
Size 3–7 1
0 1 LADN01
To side of 1 1 LAD8N11 [16]
Size 00–2 2
2 0 LAD8N20 [16]

Table 16.50: Instantaneous Blocks with Dust-Tight Auxiliary Contacts (IP54)


NEMA 12
Snap-On Standard Contacts Dust-Tight Contacts
Catalog Number
Mounting N.O. N.C. N.O. N.C.
To front of — — 2 — LA1DX20
Size 00–2 2 — 2 — LA1DZ40
or 1 1 2 — LA1DZ31
To right side of
Size 3–7 — — 2 — LA1DY20 [17]

Table 16.51: Pneumatic Time Delay Contact Blocks


Time Delay
Snap-On Contacts Type Range of Catalog
Mounting Time Delay Number [18]
N.O. N.C.
0.1 to 3 s [19] LADT0
On energization 0.1 to 30 s LADT2
To front of 1 1 (on delay)
Size 00–2 10 to 180 s LADT4
or 1 to 30 s [20] LADS2
To right side of 0.1 to 3 s [19] LADR0
Size 3–7 On de-
1 1 energization 0.1 to 30 s LADR2
(off-delay) 10 to 180 s LADR4

Table 16.52: Mechanical Latch Blocks with Manual or Electrical Unlatch


Front snap-on
mounting onto Application Catalog Number
For silent operation and
Size 00–2 energy conservation LAD6K10 [21][22]

Table 16.53: Coil Voltage Codes for LA6DK Mechanical Latch Blocks
Volts 24 120 208 240 480
AC or DC [23] B F L M R

[14] For spring terminal versions of these blocks, add a 3 to the end of the catalog number (for example, LADN223). For slip-on versions, add 9 to the end of the catalog number (for example,
LADN229).
[15] Including 1 N.O. + 1 N.C. make-before-break overlapping contacts.
[16] 1 block may be added to the left side of Size 00–1, AC coils only; only 1 block may be added to either side of the Size 2 contactor, AC coil only. Cannot be installed on Size 00–2 contactors
with DC coils.
[17] Device comes with 4 ground terminal points.
[18] For spring terminal versions of these blocks, add a 3 to the end of the catalog number (for example, LADT23). There is no charge for this modification.
[19] Scale range is expanded between 0.1 and 0.6 seconds on the dial for more accurate settings at the lower end of the range.
[20] Switching time between the opening of the N.C. contact and the closing of the N.O. contact: 40 ms ± 15 ms .
[21] Complete the catalog number by adding the coil voltage code (for example, LAD6K10F).
[22] Does not include internal coil clearing contact.
[23] DC available at 24 V only.
16-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us

Coil Suppressors and Cabling Accessories


RC Coil Suppressor
• Transient voltage limited to 300% of nominal voltage, maximum.
• Oscillating frequency is limited to 400 Hz maximum. Slight increase in drop-out time
(1.2 to 2 times normal).
Table 16.54: Resistor/Capacitor Circuit (RC) for Reduction of Electrical Noise in AC
Contactor Coils
Installed by Mounting on Operating Voltage Catalog Number
50/60 Hz

NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE


CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
LA4DA1U 24 V LAD4RCE
Snapping into the cavity on the right side
without tools [24] Size 00–1 120 V LAD4RCG
120–240 V LAD4RCU
24 V LAD4RC3E
Snap-on mounting, and connection without Size 2 120 V LAD4RC3G
tools to the contactor coil terminals
120-240 V LAD4RC3U

Varistor Coil Suppressor


• Transient voltage value limited to 200% of nominal voltage, maximum.
• Maximum reduction of transient voltage peaks. Slight increase in drop-out time (1.1 to
1.5 times normal).
Table 16.55: Varistor (Peak Limiting) for Reduction of Electrical Noise in AC
Contactor Coils
Installed by Mounting on Operating Voltage Catalog
50/60 Hz Number
24 V LAD4VE
Snapping into the cavity on the right side
Size 00–1 120 V LAD4VG

16
without tools[25]
120–240 V LAD4VU
24 V LAD4V3E
Snap-on mounting, and connection without
Size 2 120 V LAD4V3G
tools to the contactor coil terminals
120-240 V LAD4V3U

Diode Coil Suppressor


• No overvoltage or oscillating frequency.
• Polarized component. Increased drop-out time (6–10 times normal).
Table 16.56: Diode for Reduction of Electrical Noise in DC Contactor Coils
Operating Catalog
Installed on the upper part by Mounting on
Voltage, DC Number
Snap-on mounting and connection w/o tools to the
Size 00–1 24 Vdc LAD4DDL
contactor coil terminals
Clip-on front mounting Size 2 24 Vdc LAD4D3U

LAD4T3B

Bidirectional Diode Coil Suppressor


• Protection provided by limiting the transient voltage to 2 Uc max.
• Maximum reduction of transient voltage peaks.
Table 16.57: Bidirectional Peak Limiting Diode
Installed by Mounting on Operating Voltage Catalog
50/60 Hz and DC Number
Snapping into the cavity on the right side of Size 00–1[27] 24 (AC only)
the contactor [26] LAD4TB
Clip-on front mounting and connection 24 V LAD4T3B
without tools Size 2 120 V LAD4T3G
to the contactor coil terminals [27] 208–240 V LAD4T3U
LAD4BB• •

TeSys N Cabling Accessories


Table 16.58: Cabling Accessories
Usage Mounting on Operating Voltage Catalog Number
50/60 Hz
Without coil suppression LAD4BB
For adapting existing wiring to a new product Size 00–1, AC With coil 24 V LAD4BBVE
or for use with top-mounting accessory. only suppression 120 V LAD4BBVG
(varistor) 120-240 V LAD4BBVU
For adapting existing wiring to a new product
or for use with top-mounting accessory Size 2, AC only — LAD4BB3

[24] Installing the suppressor into the cavity makes the electrical connection. The overall width of the contactor remains the same.
[25] Installing the suppressor into the cavity makes the electrical connection. The overall width of the contactor remains the same.
[26] Installing the suppressor into the cavity makes the electrical connection. The overall width of the contactor remains the same.
[27] For Size 00–2 with DC coils, 3-pole contactors are fitted with built-in bidirectional diode suppression as standard.
16-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters Accessories
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us

Electronic Timers and Interface Modules


The following accessories require use of cabling accessories (LAD4BB●●) for proper
mounting. See page 16-19 for illustration.
The solid-state Electronic Serial Timer Modules in Table 16.59 delay the energizing of
the contactor coil, and feature built-in varistor surge suppression.

Table 16.59: Electronic Serial Timer Modules


Type Operational Voltage Time Delay Catalog Number
24–250 Vac
16

0.1–2 s LA4DT0U
On-delay Size 00–2 1.5–30 s LA4DT2U
25–500 s LA4DT4U
NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE

The Interface Modules in Table 16.60 allow the contactor coils to be energized from low
CONTACTORS AND STARTERS

voltage and low current level signals. They come in mechanical relay and solid-state
versions. The relay plus manual operation versions include a lever for manually turning
the contactor on and off. When a module receives a low-level signal, it allows the
separate-sourced control voltage to flow to the contactor coil. It saves space and wiring
time compared to conventional interposing relays.

Table 16.60: Interface Modules [28]


Interface Type Operational Voltage Input Voltage Catalog Number
24–250 Vac
Relay Size 00–2 24 Vdc LA4DFB
Relay Plus
Manual Operation Size 00–2 24 Vdc LA4DLB
Solid State Size 00–2 24 Vdc LA4DWB

Table 16.61: Lugs and Lug Kits [29]


TeSys N Lugs Cable size AWG
Lug Kits[30] range
Contactor Line Size Load Side
Size 3 3 each DZ2FF1 3 each DZ2FF1 DZ2FF6 14 to 2/0
Size 4 3 each DZ2FG1 3 each DZ2FG1 DZ2FG6 6 to 3/0
Size 5 3 each DZ2FJ1 3 each DZ2FJ1 DZ2FJ6 4 to 500 MCM
Size 6 3 each DZ2FK1 3 each DZ2FK1 DZ2FK6 2 x 2 to 600 MCM
1 each DZ2FL1 1 each DZ2FL1
Size 7 DZ2FL2 DZ2FL2 DZ2FL6 3 x 2 to 600 MCM
LA4DFB DZ2FL3 DZ2FL3

Table 16.62: TeSys Safety-Chain Identification System


Description Compatibility Package Qty Catalog Number
Red retrofit contactor safety cover Size 00–2 10 LAD9ET1S
Red auxiliary contact block, 2 N.O. + 2 N.C. Size 00–2 1 LADN22S

LAD9ET1S LADN22S

[28] Adapter required. See Table 16.58.


[29] The mounting hardware (screws, washers, and nuts) comes with the contactors, not the lugs. Starters Sizes 3–7 come with lugs.
[30] Lug kits incude 6 lugs.
16-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Replacement Parts TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us

Replacement Contacts and Coils


Table 16.63: Replacement Contact Sets [31]
For use on contactors Number of Poles Catalog Number
Size 3–4 3 poles LA5FF431
Size 5 3 poles LA5F400803
Size 6 3 poles LA5F500803
Size 7 3 poles LA5F630803

TeSys N Magnet Coils

NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE


CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
Table 16.64: Size 00–1 AC Coils Table 16.65: Size 2 AC Coils
Rated Nominal Voltage Catalog Number 50/60 Hz Rated Nominal Voltage V Catalog Number 50/60 Hz
24 LXD1B7 24 LXD3B7
32 LXD1C7 32 LXD3C7
36 LXD1CC7 42 LXD3D7
42 LXD1D7 48 LXD3E7
48 LXD1E7 100 LXD3K7
60 LXD1EE7 110 LXD3F7
100 LXD1K7 115 LXD3FE7
110 LXD1F7 120 LXD3G7
115 LXD1FE7 127 LXD3FC7
120 LXD1G7 200 LXD3L7
127 LXD1FC7 208 LXD3LE7
200 LXD1L7 220 LXD3M7
208 LXD1LE7 230 LXD3P7
220/230 LXD1M7 240 LXD3U7
230 LXD1P7 277 LXD3W7

16
230/240 LXD1U7 380 LXD3Q7
277 LXD1W7 400 LXD3V7
380/400 LXD1Q7 415 LXD3N7
400 LXD1V7 440 LXD3R7
415 LXD1N7 480 LXD3T7
440 LXD1R7 500 LXD3S7
480 LXD1T7 575 LXD3SC7
575 LXD1SC7 600 LXD3X7
600 LXD1X7 Specification 50/60 Hz
Specifications 50/60 Hz Average consumption:
Average consumption - Inrush (inductance 0.3) 140 VA (inductance: 0.9)
- Inrush (inductance 0.75) 70 VA - Sealed (inductance 0.3) 7.5 VA (inductance: 0.9)
- Sealed (inductance 0.3) 7 VA Operating range at θ < 55 °C / 131 °F 80–115% of nominal voltage
Operating range@ 60 °C 50 Hz: 80–110% of nominal
60 Hz: 85–110% of nominal

Table 16.66: Size 3–7 AC Coils


Contactor Hz Catalog Catalog Number Suffix [32]
Size Number 24 V 48 V 110 V 120 V 208 V 220 V 240 V 277 V 380 V 415 V 440 V 480 V 600 V
Size 3–4 60 LX1FF● 020 040 092 095 162 184 187 220 316 340 360 380 475
Size 5 40–400 LX1FH● 0242 0482 1102 1272 2002 2202 2402 2772 3802 3802 4402 5002 6002
Size 6[33] 40–400 LX1FK● — 048 110 110 200 220 240 280 380 415 415 415 600
Size 7[33] 40–400 LX1FL● — 048 110 110 200 220 240 260 380 415 415 415 600

Table 16.67: Size 3–4 DC Coils


Device Catalog Catalog Number Suffix [34]
Type Number 24 V 36 V 48 V 60 V 72 V 110 V 125 V 220 V 250 V 440 V
Size 3–4 LX4FF● 024 035 048 060 070 110 125 220 250 440

[31] Provided per pole: 2 fixed contacts, 1 movable contact, 2 deflectors, 1 backplate, and the mounting screws and washers.
[32] Complete the catalog number by adding the suffix (for example, LX1FF020).
[33] The 600 V coils for Sizes 6 and 7 do not include an auxiliary contact for holding circuits. If required, select the appropriate contacts from page 16-18.
[34] Complete the catalog number by adding the suffix (for example, LX4FF024).
16-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters TeSys™ N Dimensions
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us

TeSys™ N Non-Reversing Contactors


Table 16.68: TeSys N Contactors, Size 00–1, Non-Reversing [35]
Dimensions
Dimensional Diagram Dimension Description AC Coil DC Coil
in. mm in. mm
Minimum electrical clearance b Without add-on accessories 3.35 85 3.35 85
With LAD4BB 3.86 98 n/a n/a
With LA4D•2 4.49 114 n/a n/a
16

b1 With LA4DF, DT 4.84 123 n/a n/a


b

With LA4DR, DW, DL 5.12 130 n/a n/a


Without cover or add-on blocks 3.54 90 3.90 99
c
.39 c With cover, without add-on blocks 3.62 92 3.98 101
NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE
CONTACTORS AND STARTERS

10 c1 c1 With LADN or LADC 4.84 123 5.20 132


c2 1.77 c2 With LAD6K10 5.31 135 5.67 144
45
c3 With LADT, R, S 5.63 143 5.98 152
c3
With LADT, R, S and sealing cover 5.79 147 6.14 156

Table 16.69: TeSys N Contactors, Size 2, Non-Reversing [35]


Dimensions
Dimensional Diagram Dimension Description AC or DC Coils
in. mm
Minimum electrical clearance a Contactor 2.17 55
With LA4 DB3 or LAD 4BB3 5.35 136
b1 With LA4 DF, DT 6.18 157
With LA4 DM, DW, DL
b1

6.54 166
Without cover or add-on blocks 4.65 118
4.80

4.61

c
117
122

With cover, without add-on blocks 4.72 120


c1 With LAD N or C (2 or 4 contacts) 5.91 150
c2 With LAD 6K10 or LA6 DK 6.42 163
With LAD T, R, S 6.73 171
0.47 c c3
With LAD T, R, S and sealing cover 6.89 175
12 c1
0.49 a 0.49
c2 12.5 12.5
c3 (LAD 8N) (LAD 8N)

Table 16.70: TeSys N Contactors, Size 3–7, Non-Reversing


Dimensions
Dimensional Diagram, Size 3–5 Dimension T02EN13 T02FN13 T02GN13
in. mm in. mm in. mm
S Ø a 6.4 163.5 6.4 163.5 8.4 213
P 1.5 37 1.6 40 1.9 48
Q 1.2 29.5 1 26 1.7 43
Q1 2.4 60 2.3 57.5 2.9 74
X1
T02EN13 S 0.8 20 0.8 20 1 25
M b1 H M b ø M6 M8 M10
T02FN13
X1 f 5.2 131 5.2 131 5.8 147
T02GN13 b 6.4 162 6.7 170 8.1 206
b1 5.4 137 5.4 137 5.7 145
Q P P Q1 L M 5.8 147 5.9 150 7.1 181
a f c H 4.9 124 4.9 124 6.2 158
c 6.7 171 6.7 171 8.6 219
L 4.2 107 4.2 107 5.7 145
X1 220–500 V 0.4 10 0.4 10 0.4 10
T02HN13
Dimensional Diagram, Size 6 Dimension
in. mm
T02HN13 a 9.2 233
P 2.2 55
S Ø
Q 1.8 46
Q1 3 77
X1 S 1.2 30
M
ø M10
b1 H M b
f 5.9 150
X1 b 9.4 238
b1 8.2 209
M 8.2 208
Q P P Q1 L
H 6.8 172
a f c
c 9.1 232
L 5.7 146
X1 220–500 V 0.6 15
T02JN13
Dimensional Diagram, Size 7 Dimension
in. mm
T02JN13 a 12.2 309
P 3.2 80
S Ø
Q 2.4 60
Q1 3.5 89
S 1.6 40
X1 ø M12
M b1 H M b f 7.1 181
b 12 304
X1 b1 11 280
M 10.4 264
H 8 202
Q P P Q1
L c 10 255
a f c L 6.1 155
X1 220–500 V 0.8 20

[35] DIN rail and panel mountable.


16-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ N Dimensions TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us

TeSys™ N Reversing Contactors


Table 16.71: TeSys N Size 00–1, Reversing Contactors [36]
Dimensions
Dimensional Diagram Dimension AC Coil DC Coil
in. mm in. mm
2xM4 a: Without side-mount accessories 3.54 90 3.54 90
e1

=
b: Contactor base 3.35 85 3.35 85
c: With cover, without add-on blocks 3.62 92 3.98 101
e1 0.35 9 0.35 9
e2 0.20 5 0.20 5

60/70
G: Mounting holes 3.15 80 3.15 80

NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE


b

CONTACTORS AND STARTERS


c = G

=
=
e2

Table 16.72: TeSys N Size 2, Reversing Contactors [36]


Dimensions
Dimensional Diagram Description AC and DC Coils
in. mm
37,5 26,5 37,5 6xM4 Width 4.69 119
Height 4.80 122
Depth with cover, without add-on blocks 4.72 120
Load side mounting hole width 2.52 64
Line side mounting hole width 3.40 101.5
Mounting hole height 5.04 128

16
122

128

120 18,7 64 18,7


119

Table 16.73: TeSys N Size 3–7, Reversing Contactors


Dimensions
Dimensional Diagram Dimension T02EN23 T02FN23 T02GN23 T02HN23 T02JN23
in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm
W R N D 0.38 9.7 0.38 9.7 0.56 14.2 0.56 14.2 0.56 14.2
D L H 7.96 202.2 7.96 202.2 15.27 387.9 15.27 387.9 22.25 565.2
L 11.75 298.5 11.75 298.5 18 457.2 18 457.2 30 762.0
M 7 177.8 7 177.8 14 355.6 14 355.6 19.75 501.7
N 0.49 12.5 0.49 12.5 0.62 15.8 0.62 15.8 1.25 31.8
R 0.49 12.5 0.49 12.5 0.62 15.8 0.62 15.8 0.69 17.5
H W 12.71 322.8 12.71 322.8 19.27 489.5 19.27 489.5 31.38 797.0
X 5.16 131.0 5.16 131.0 5.79 147.0 5.91 150.0 7.13 181.0
M

X X

[36] DIN rail and panel mountable.


16-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters TeSys™ N Dimensions
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us

TeSys N Starters, Size 00–2


Table 16.74: TeSys N Size 00–2 Dimensions
Non-reversing Reversing Depth
T36AN13 / T36BN13 / T36CN13 / T36DN13 T36AN23 / T36BN23 / T36CN23 / T36DN23

A A J
G G
F F
16
NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE
CONTACTORS AND STARTERS

B B
H H

R
K
D D
E E

Table 16.75: TeSys N Size 00–2, Non-Reversing and Reversing Starters


Non-Reversing Reversing
Dimension Size 00 Size 0 Size 1 Size 2 Size 00 Size 0 Size 1 Size 2
T36AN13 T36BN13 T36CN13 T36DN13 T36AN23 T36BN23 T36CN23 T36DN23
in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm
A 3.19 81.0 3.19 81.0 3.19 81.0 3.19 81.0 43.9 111.5 43.9 111.5 43.9 111.5 5.19 131.8
B 6.64 168.7 6.64 168.7 6.64 168.7 8.61 218.7 6.64 168.7 6.64 168.7 6.64 168.7 8.61 218.7
D 0.5 12.7 0.5 12.7 0.5 12.7 0.5 12.7 0.5 12.7 0.5 12.7 0.5 12.7 0.5 12.7
E 1.0 25.4 1.0 25.4 1.0 25.4 1.0 25.4 1.0 25.4 1.0 25.4 1.0 25.4 1.0 25.4
F 1.59 40.5 1.59 40.5 1.59 40.5 1.59 40.5 1.59 40.5 1.59 40.5 1.59 40.5 1.59 40.5
G 0.20 5.2 0.20 5.2 0.20 5.2 0.20 5.2 0.20 5.2 0.20 5.2 0.20 5.2 0.20 5.2
H 6.16 156.5 6.16 156.5 6.16 156.5 8.22 208.8 6.16 156.5 6.16 156.5 6.16 156.5 8.22 208.8
J (AC Coil) 4.17 105.9 4.17 105.9 4.17 105.9 4.17 105.9 4.17 105.9 4.17 104.9
4.94 125.4 4.94 125.4
J (DC Coil) 4.52 114.9 4.52 114.9 4.52 114.9 4.52 114.9 4.52 114.9 4.52 114.9
K 3.90 99.0 3.90 99.0 3.90 99.0 3.90 99.0 3.90 99.0 3.90 99.0 3.90 99.0 3.90 99.0
R[37] 0.24 6.1 0.24 6.1 0.24 6.1 0.24 6.1 0.24 6.1 0.24 6.1 0.24 6.1 0.24 6.1

[37] Reset travel.


16-24
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ N Dimensions TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us

TeSys N Starters, Size 3–4


Table 16.76: TeSys N Size 3–4 Dimensions
Non-Reversing Reversing Depth
T36EN13 / T36FN13 T36EN23 / T36FN23

A N
G G A
F A/2 P
E F

X X

NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE


CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
M
J H
B
H
B
K X
L M

RESET
RESET

T
D
O D R
E

16
N

Table 16.77: TeSys N Size 3–4, Non-Reversing and Reversing Starters


Non-Reversing Reversing
Dimension Size 3 Size 4 Size 3 Size 4
T36EN13 T36FN13 T36EN23 T36FN23
in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm
A 5.31 134.9 5.31 134.9 12.71 322.8 12.71 322.8
B 10.82 274.8 10.82 274.8 11.71 297.4 11.71 297.4
D 0.88 22.4 0.88 22.4 6.0 152.4 6.0 152.4
E 1.75 44.5 1.75 44.5 11.75 298.5 11.75 298.5
F 1.78 45.0 1.78 45.0 0.48 12.2 0.48 12.2
G 0.32 8.1 0.32 8.1 0.48 12.2 0.48 12.2
H 10.19 258.8 10.19 258.8 10.75 273.1 10.75 273.1
J 6.03 153.2 6.03 153.2 — — — —
K 0.59 15.0 0.59 15.0 — — — —
L 0.22 5.6 0.22 5.6 — — — —
M 11.91 302.4 11.91 302.4 11.96 303.8 11.96 303.8
N 6.57 166.8 6.57 166.8 13.58 344.9 13.58 344.9
O 0.375 9.5 0.375 9.5 0.375 9.5 0.375 9.5
P 6.96 176.7 6.96 176.7 7.18 182.4 7.18 182.4
R 3.8 97 3.8 97 3.8 97 3.8 97
T[38] 0.24 6.1 0.24 6.1 0.24 6.1 0.24 6.1
X[39] 5.16 131.0 5.16 131.0 5.16 131.0 5.16 131.0

[38] Reset travel.


[39] Minimum distance for coil removal.
16-25
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters TeSys™ N Dimensions
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us

TeSys N Starters, Size 5–7


Table 16.78: TeSys N Size 5–7 Dimensions
No n -reve rs in g Reve rs in g De p th
T36GN13 / T36HN13 / T36J N13 T36GN23

G A G A
F F G
P
16

X
X X
NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE
CONTACTORS AND STARTERS

B H
H
B

RES ET

RES ET

K T
K D R
E D
J E

Table 16.79: TeSys N Size 5–7, Non-Reversing and Reversing Starters


Non-Reversing Reversing
Dimension Size 5 Size 6 Size 7 Size 5
T36GN13 T36HN13 T36JN13 T36GN23
in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm
A 8.58 217.9 8.58 217.9 8.58 217.9 19.3 489.4
B 17.56 446.0 19.75 501.7 23.58 598.9 20.3 514.8
D 4.75 120.7 4.75 120.7 4.75 120.7 4.75 120.7
E 7.25 184.2 7.25 184.2 7.25 184.2 7.25 184.2
F 3.17 80.4 3.17 80.4 3.17 80.4 18.0 457.2
G 0.63 16.0 0.63 16.0 0.63 16.0 0.63 16.1
H 16.37 415.8 18.56 463.6 22.38 565.9 19.0 482.6
J 9.91 251.6 9.91 251.6 9.91 251.6 — —
K 0.56 14.2 0.56 14.2 0.56 14.2 0.56 14.2
P 9.32 236.8 9.32 236.8 9.32 236.8 9.95 252.7
R 7.38 187.0 9.16 232.7 8.07 205.0 7.38 187.0
T[40] 0.24 6.1 0.24 6.1 0.24 6.1 0.24 6.1
X[40] 5.79 147 1 5.91 150.1 7.13 181.1 5.79 147.1

[40] Minimum distance for coil removal.


16-26
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NEMA AC Magnetic Contactors and Catalog Numbering System
Starters
schneider-electric.us Class 8502, 8536, 8538 / Refer to Catalog 8502CT9701

Catalog Numbering
Class 8536 Type S C G 3 V02 Form S

General Classification Numerals

8502 Contactor Used to designate specific physical arrangements,


such as the number of poles, fuse clip size, etc.;
8536 Starter but the numbering varies with the Class of the
8538 Combination Starter with Disconnect Switch equipment. Consult the Digest listings for the

NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE


CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
specific device numbers.
8539 Combination Starter with Circuit Breaker
8702 Reversing Contactor
Voltage Code
8736 Reversing Starter
AC operated devices without control transformer
8738 Reversing Combination Starter with Disconnect Switch
Code Voltage/Frequency
8739 Reversing Combination Starter with Circuit Breaker
V01 24/60
8810 Two Speed Starter
V02 120/60 or 110/50
8903 Type S Lighting Contactors
V06 480/60 or 440/50
8940 Pumping Plant Panel
V07 600/60 or 550/50
8941 Duplex Controller
V08 208/60
Consult the Table of Contents for page numbers. V81: 480 V Primary, 120 V Secondary for
units using a fused transformer control circuit
(Form F4T)
This is only a partial listing. Consult the Digest

16
Design
page for each product for more options.
Type S NEMA Contactors and Starters

Common Forms (factory modifications)


NEMA Size Rating (8903 only) A Start-Stop pushbuttons in the enclosure cover
A Size 00
C Hand-Off-Auto selector switch in the enclosure cover
B Size 0 M 30 A
E Bimetallic overload relays
C Size 1 P 60 A
Q 100 A F4T Fused transformer control circuit (primary fuses only)
D Size 2
Fused transformer control circuit
E Size 3 V 200 A FF4T (primary & secondary fuses)
F Size 4 X 300 A H Solid-state overload relay (SSOLR)
G Size 5 Y 400 A
P1 Red ON pilot light in the enclosure cover
H Size 6 Z 600 A P2 Green OFF pilot light in the enclosure cover
J Size 7 J 800 A S Separate control circuit
X01 One normally closed auxiliary contact N.C.
Enclosure X10 One normally open auxiliary contact N.O.
A NEMA 12 Industrial Use Consult “Factory Modifications (Forms)” for additional Form
designations. When more than one Form is applied to a single
F NEMA 1 Flush Mounting General Purpose device, arrange the Forms in alphanumerical order.
G NEMA 1 General Purpose Surface Mounting
H NEMA 3R Rainproof
O Open Style Device (no enclosure)
R NEMA 7 & 9 Hazardous Environments, Spin Top™
T NEMA 7 & 9 Hazardous Environments, Bolted
W NEMA 4 Watertight, 4X Corrosion Resistant

IMPORTANT: This information is intended for general interpretation of the catalog


Table 16.80: How to Order numbers. Do not use it to create catalog numbers for this product line.
To Order Specify: Catalog Number
For more ordering information, refer to the Product Selector at www.schneider-electric.
• Class Number Class Type Voltage
Code
Form(s)
com/us/.
• Type Number
• Voltage Code NOTE: The terms Class, Type, and Form do not appear in the catalog number.
8539 SCG44 V06 AH30P1X11
• Form(s): see page
16-115
Devices are wired from the factory according to customer preference as follows:
Description: NEMA Size 1 (10 hp) electronic motor circuit protector • Common control
(MCP) combo starter in a NEMA 1 enclosure with a 480 V coil, start/
stop push button (A), trip-class selectable SSOLR (H30), red pilot light • Separate control (Form S)
(P1), and 1 N.O. and 1 N.C. auxiliary contact (X11). • Control power transformer (CPT)
NOTE: TeSys T devices are unwired.

16-27
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Type S Full Voltage Contactors and Starters Contactors, Type S
Class 8502 / Refer to Catalog 8502CT9701
schneider-electric.us

General Information
Class 8502 Type S magnetic contactors are used to switch heating loads, capacitors,
transformers, and electric motors where overload protection is provided separately.
Class 8502 contactors are available in NEMA Sizes 00–7. Type S contactors are
designed for operation up to 600 Vac, 50–60 Hz.
NOTE: In Table 16.81, replace ●●● with the voltage code shown in Table 16.82.
Table 16.81: 3-Pole Polyphase—600 Vac Maximum—50–60 Hz
NEMA 4 & 4X
NEMA 1 Watertight, Dusttight
Continuous Open Type General Brushed Stainless
NEMA Motor Max. Purpose
Current Steel Enclosure
Size Ratings Voltage Hp Enclosure (Size 0-5) [1]
Type Type Type
200 1.5
230 1.5
Type SCO2 00   9 SAO12●●● SAG12●●● Use Size 0
460 2
Size 1, 3-Pole Contactor 575 2
200 3
230 3
0  18 SBO2●●● SBG2●●● SBW12●●●
460 5
575 5
200 7.5
230 7.5 SCO2●●● SCG2●●● SCW12●●●
1  27 460 10
575 10
200 10
230 15 SDO2●●● SDG2●●● SDW12●●●
2  45 460 25
575 25
200 25
3  90 230 30 SEO2●●● SEG2●●● SEW12●●●
460 50
575 50
200 40
230 50
4 135 460 100 SFO2●●● SFG2●●● SFW12●●●
575 100
200 75
230 100
5 270 460 200 SGO2●●● SGG2●●● SGW12●●●
575 200
200 150
230 200
6 540 SHO2●●● SHG2●●● SHW2●●●
460 400
575 400
200 —
230 300
7 810 SJO2●●● SJG2●●● SJW2●●●
460 600
575 600

Table 16.82: Coil Voltage Codes


Voltage
Code
60 Hz 50 Hz
 24 [2] — V01
120 [3] 110 V02
208 — V08
240 220 V03
277 — V04
480 440 V06
600 550 V07
Specify Specify V99
NOTE: For voltage codes used with control transformers, see Table 16.320.
Form S (separate control) is used when a separate source of power is available for
the control (coil) voltage. Available at no charge.
Dimensions: page 16-38
Factory Modifications (Forms) page 16-115
Separate Enclosures (Class 9991): page 16-108
Replacement Parts (Class 9998): page 16-120
Type S Accessories (Class 9999): page 16-123
For How to Order Information, see page 16-27.

[1] Size 6 and 7 are NEMA 4 only, painted sheet steel enclosures.
[2] 24 V coils are not available on Sizes 4–7. On Sizes 00–3, where 24 V coils are available, Form S (separate control) must be specified (for example, order as 8502SBO2V01S).
[3] 120 V polyphase contactors are wired for separate control. Form S must be specified (i.e., order as 8502SCO2V02S).
16-28
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Contactors, Type S Type S Full Voltage Contactors and Starters
Class 8502 / Refer to Catalog 8502CT9701
schneider-electric.us

3-Pole Polyphase—NEMA 4X, 7 & 9, and 12/3R


NOTE: In Table 16.83, replace ●●● with the voltage code shown in Table 16.82.
For information on field modification of NEMA 12 enclosures, see page 16-110.

Table 16.83: 3-Pole Polyphase—600 Vac Maximum—50–60 Hz


NEMA 4X
Watertight, NEMA 7 & 9 NEMA 12/3R [4]
Dusttight, Hazardous Locations Div. 1 & 2 Dusttight &
Continuous Corrosion- Class I, Groups C & D Driptight
NEMA Motor Max. Resistant Industrial Use
Current Class II, Groups E, F, & G
Size Ratings Voltage Hp Glass-Polyester Enclosure

NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE


Enclosure

CONTACTORS AND STARTERS


Bolted Type Spin Top™
Type Type
Cast Iron [5] Cast Aluminum[6] Type
200 1-1/2
230 1-1/2
00 9 460 Use Size 0 Use Size 0 Use Size 0 Use Size 0 Use Size 0
2
575 2
200 3
230 3
0 18 SBW22●●● SBT2●●● SBT42●●● SBR2●●● SBA2●●●
460 5
575 5
200 7-1/2
230 7-1/2
1 27 SCW22●●● SCT2●●● SCT42●●● SCR2●●● SCA2●●●
460 10
575 10
200 10
230 15
2 45 SDW22●●● SDT2●●● SDT42●●● SDR2●●● SDA2●●●
460 25
575 25
200 25
3 90 230 30 SEW22●●● — SET42●●● SER2●●● SEA2●●●
460 50

16
575 50
200 40
230 50 SFW22●●● — SFT42●●● SFR2●●● SFA2●●●
4 135 460 100
575 100
200 75
230 100
5 270 460 200 — — SGT42●●● SGR2●●● SGA2●●●
575 200
200 150
230 200
6 540 460 400 — — — — SHA2●●●
575 400
200 –
230 300
7 810 — — — — SJA2●●●
460 600
575 600

Auxiliary Units
Auxiliary contacts and power poles can be added in the factory or the field on all Type S
starters and contactors. Table 16.84 shows the maximum number of auxiliary units, in
addition to the holding circuit contact, that can be added to a given size starter or
contactor. In addition, it is possible to add a second internal contact on NEMA Size 0, 1,
and 2 contactors and starters.
Table 16.84: Auxiliary Units—Class 8502 and 8536
Type Maximum Number of External Auxiliary Units
NEMA Size No. of Poles—Basic Contactor (in addition to holding circuit contact)
00 SA 2–3 4 single-circuit auxiliary contacts (N.O. or N.C.) if second internal auxiliary contact is not used.
4 single-circuit auxiliary contacts (N.O. or N.C.) [7]
1–3
0–2 SB–SD 2 single-circuit auxiliary contacts (N.O. or N.C.) plus 1 power pole adder (1 or 2 poles, N.O. or N.C.)
4–5 2 single-circuit auxiliary contacts (N.O. or N.C.)
3–4 SE–SF 2–5 3 single-circuit auxiliary contacts (N.O. or N.C.)
5 SG 2 single-circuit auxiliary contacts (N.O. or N.C.) plus 1 NEMA Size 0–1 or Size 2 power pole adder
2–3 (1 or 2 poles, N.O. or N.C.)
3 single-circuit auxiliary contacts (N.O. or N.C.)
6–7 SH–SJ 2–3 2 single-circuit auxiliary contacts (N.O. or N.C.) plus 1 NEMA Size 0–1 or Size 2 power pole adder
(1 or 2 poles, N.O. or N.C.)
Dimensions page 16-38
Factory Modifications (Forms) page 16-115
Separate Enclosures (Class 9991) page 16-108
Replacement Parts (Class 9998) page 16-90
Type S Accessories (Class 9999) page 16-123
For How to Order Information, see page 16-27.

[4] NEMA 12 enclosures can be field modified for outdoor non-corrosive and non–service entrance rated applications.
[5] Limited to one pilot light, and a selector switch or Start-Stop push button.
[6] NEMA 7 and 9 bolted cast aluminum are not UL listed

You might also like